Use these links to rapidly review the document
TABLE OF CONTENTS
INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Table of Contents

As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on August 29, 2012

Registration No. 333-182276

UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549



Amendment No. 2
to
Form S-1
REGISTRATION STATEMENT
UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933



Susser Petroleum Partners LP
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

Delaware
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
  5172
(Primary Standard Industrial
Classification Code Number)
  30-0740483
(I.R.S. Employer
Identification Number)

555 East Airtex Drive
Houston, Texas 77073
(832) 234-3600
(Address, including zip code, and telephone number,
Including area code, of registrant's principal executive offices)

E.V. Bonner, Jr.
555 East Airtex Drive
Houston, Texas 77073
(832) 234-3600
(Name, address, including zip code, and telephone number,
including area code, of agent for service)

Copies to:

David Palmer Oelman
Alan P. Baden
Vinson & Elkins L.L.P.
1001 Fannin Street, Suite 2500
Houston, Texas 77002
Tel: (713) 758-2222
Fax: (713) 758-2346
  William J. Cooper
Jon W. Daly
Andrews Kurth LLP
600 Travis Street, Suite 4200
Houston, Texas 77002
Tel: (713) 220-4200
Fax: (713) 220-4285



                 Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale to the public: As soon as practicable after this Registration Statement becomes effective.

                If any of the securities being registered on this Form are to be offered on a delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act of 1933, check the following box.  o

                If this Form is filed to register additional securities for an offering pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.  o

                If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.  o

                If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(d) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.  o

                Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of "large accelerated filer," "accelerated filer" and "smaller reporting company" in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):

Large accelerated filer  o   Accelerated filer  o   Non-accelerated filer ý
(Do not check if a
smaller reporting company)
  Smaller reporting company  o



                 The Registrant hereby amends this Registration Statement on such date or dates as may be necessary to delay its effective date until the Registrant shall file a further amendment which specifically states that this Registration Statement shall thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of the Securities Act of 1933 or until the Registration Statement shall become effective on such date as the Securities and Exchange Commission, acting pursuant to said Section 8(a), may determine.

   


Table of Contents

The information in this preliminary prospectus is not complete and may be changed. These securities may not be sold until the registration statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission is effective. This preliminary prospectus is not an offer to sell nor does it seek an offer to buy these securities in any jurisdiction where the offer or sale is not permitted.

Subject to Completion
Preliminary Prospectus dated August 29, 2012

PROSPECTUS

GRAPHIC

                  Common Units
Representing Limited Partner Interests

Susser Petroleum Partners LP



                This is the initial public offering of our common units representing limited partner interests. Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for our common units. We currently expect the initial public offering price to be between $            and $            per common unit. We have granted the underwriters an option to purchase up to                        additional common units to cover over allotments. Our common units have been approved for listing on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol "SUSP," subject to official notice of issuance.



                 Investing in our common units involves risks. See "Risk Factors" beginning on page 21.



                These risks include the following:

                 Neither the Securities and Exchange Commission nor any state securities commission has approved or disapproved of these securities or determined if this prospectus is truthful or complete. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.

 
 
Per Common Unit
 
Total
 

Public Offering Price

  $     $    

Underwriting Discount(1)(2)

  $     $    

Proceeds to Susser Petroleum Partners LP (before expenses)

  $     $    

(1)
Excludes a structuring fee equal to        % of the gross proceeds of this offering payable to Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated and Barclays Capital Inc. Please read "Underwriting."

(2)
The underwriters will not receive any underwriting discount or commission on $         million of common units offered by this prospectus through our directed unit program to certain of our general partner's directors and executive officers. Accordingly, proceeds to us (before expenses) include the full per unit initial public offering price of these units. Please read "Underwriting."

                The underwriters expect to deliver the common units to purchasers on or about                                    , 2012 through the book-entry facilities of The Depository Trust Company.



Joint Book-Running Managers

BofA Merrill Lynch   Barclays



Co-Managers



   

The date of this prospectus is                        , 2012.


LOGO


Table of Contents

              You should rely only on the information contained in this prospectus, any free writing prospectus prepared by us or on our behalf or any other information to which we have referred you in connection with this offering. We have not, and the underwriters have not, authorized anyone to provide you with different information. If anyone provides you with different or inconsistent information, you should not rely on it. We are not, and the underwriters are not, making an offer to sell these securities in any jurisdiction where the offer or sale is not permitted. You should not assume that the information contained in this prospectus is accurate as of any date other than the date on the front of this prospectus.


TABLE OF CONTENTS

SUMMARY

  1

Susser Petroleum Partners LP

  1

Our Relationship with Susser Holdings Corporation

  3

Our Business Strategies

  4

Our Competitive Strengths

  4

Risk Factors

  5

Our Management

  5

Summary of Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties

  5

Principal Executive Offices

  6

Formation Transactions and Partnership Structure

  6

Organizational Structure

  8

The Offering

  9

Summary Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data

  15

Non-GAAP Financial Measure

  19

RISK FACTORS

 
21

Risks Inherent in Our Business

  21

Risks Inherent in an Investment in Us

  33

Tax Risks to Common Unitholders

  44

USE OF PROCEEDS

 
48

CAPITALIZATION

 
49

DILUTION

 
50

CASH DISTRIBUTION POLICY AND RESTRICTIONS ON DISTRIBUTIONS

 
51

General

  51

Our Minimum Quarterly Distribution

  52

Subordinated Units

  54

Unaudited Pro Forma Available Cash for the Year Ended December 31, 2011 and the Twelve Months Ended June 30, 2012

  54

Estimated Available Cash for the Twelve Months Ending September 30, 2013

  60

Significant Forecast Assumptions

  63

PROVISIONS OF OUR PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT RELATING TO CASH DISTRIBUTIONS

 
69

Distributions of Available Cash

  69

Operating Surplus and Capital Surplus

  70

Capital Expenditures

  72

Subordinated Units

  73

Distributions of Available Cash From Operating Surplus During the Subordination Period

  75

Distributions of Available Cash From Operating Surplus After the Subordination Period

  75

i


Table of Contents

General Partner Interest

  76

Incentive Distribution Rights

  76

Percentage Allocations of Available Cash From Operating Surplus

  76

SHC's Right to Reset Incentive Distribution Levels

  77

Distributions From Capital Surplus

  80

Adjustment to the Minimum Quarterly Distribution and Target Distribution Levels

  80

Distributions of Cash Upon Liquidation

  81

SELECTED HISTORICAL FINANCIAL DATA

 
84

MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

 
86

Overview

  86

Our Predecessor, Susser Petroleum Company LLC

  87

How We Evaluate and Assess Our Business

  87

Factors Impacting the Comparability of Our Financial Results

  88

Market and Industry Trends and Outlook

  90

Historical Results of Operations of Our Predecessor

  92

Pro Forma Results of Operations

  95

Cash Flows of Our Predecessor

  98

Liquidity and Capital Resources

  99

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

  102

Impact of Inflation

  102

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

  102

Significant Accounting Policies and Estimates

  103

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

  107

INDUSTRY

 
108

BUSINESS

 
113

Overview

  113

Our Relationship with Susser Holdings Corporation

  115

Our Business Strategies

  118

Our Competitive Strengths

  120

Our Business and Properties

  122

Competition

  127

Seasonality

  127

Insurance

  128

Environmental Matters

  128

Other Government Regulation

  130

Employee Safety

  130

Title to Properties, Permits and Licenses

  130

Our Employees

  131

Legal Proceedings

  131

MANAGEMENT

 
132

Management of Susser Petroleum Partners LP

  132

Executive Officers and Directors of our General Partner

  132

Director Independence

  135

Committees of the Board of Directors

  135

EXECUTIVE OFFICER COMPENSATION

 
137

SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT

 
162

ii


Table of Contents

CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS

  164

Distributions and Payments to Our General Partner and Its Affiliates

  164

Agreements with Affiliates in Connection with the Transactions

  165

Other Transactions with Related Persons

  168

CONFLICTS OF INTEREST AND FIDUCIARY DUTIES

 
170

Conflicts of Interest

  170

Fiduciary Duties

  176

DESCRIPTION OF THE COMMON UNITS

 
179

The Units

  179

Transfer Agent and Registrar

  179

Transfer of Common Units

  179

THE PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT

 
181

Organization and Duration

  181

Purpose

  181

Cash Distributions

  181

Capital Contributions

  181

Voting Rights

  182

Applicable Law; Forum, Venue and Jurisdiction

  183

Limited Liability

  183

Issuance of Additional Partnership Interests

  184

Amendment of the Partnership Agreement

  185

Merger, Consolidation, Conversion, Sale or Other Disposition of Assets

  187

Dissolution

  188

Liquidation and Distribution of Proceeds

  188

Withdrawal or Removal of Our General Partner

  188

Transfer of General Partner Interest

  190

Transfer of Ownership Interests in the General Partner

  190

Transfer of Subordinated Units and Incentive Distribution Rights

  190

Change of Management Provisions

  191

Limited Call Right

  191

Non-Taxpaying Holders; Redemption

  191

Non-Citizen Assignees; Redemption

  192

Meetings; Voting

  192

Voting Rights of Incentive Distribution Rights

  193

Status as Limited Partner

  193

Indemnification

  193

Reimbursement of Expenses

  194

Books and Reports

  194

Right to Inspect Our Books and Records

  195

Registration Rights

  195

UNITS ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE

 
196

MATERIAL U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES

 
197

Taxation of the Partnership

  197

Tax Consequences of Unit Ownership

  199

Tax Treatment of Operations

  204

Disposition of Units

  205

Uniformity of Units

  207

Tax-Exempt Organizations and Other Investors

  208

iii


Table of Contents

Administrative Matters

  209

State, Local and Other Tax Considerations

  211

INVESTMENT IN SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP BY EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS

 
212

UNDERWRITING

 
213

VALIDITY OF OUR COMMON UNITS

 
220

EXPERTS

 
220

WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION

 
220

FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

 
221

INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 
F-1

APPENDIX A—AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP OF SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP.

 
A-1

              Until                        , 2012 (25 days after the date of this prospectus), all dealers that buy, sell or trade our common units, whether or not participating in this offering, may be required to deliver a prospectus. This is in addition to the dealers' obligation to deliver a prospectus when acting as underwriters and with respect to their unsold allotments or subscriptions.

Industry and Market Data

              This prospectus includes industry data and forecasts that we obtained from industry publications and surveys, public filings and internal company sources. Industry publications and surveys and forecasts generally state that the information contained therein has been obtained from sources believed to be reliable, but there can be no assurance as to the accuracy or completeness of the included information. Statements as to our market position and market estimates are based on independent industry publications, government publications, third-party forecasts, management's estimates and assumptions about our markets and our internal research. While we are not aware of any misstatements regarding the market, industry or similar data presented herein, such data involve risks and uncertainties and are subject to change based on various factors, including those discussed under the headings "Forward-Looking Statements" and "Risk Factors" in this prospectus.

Trademarks and Trade Names

              We own or have rights to various trademarks, service marks and trade names that we use in connection with the operation of our business. This prospectus may also contain trademarks, service marks and trade names of SHC and third parties, which are the property of their respective owners. Our use or display of third parties' trademarks, service marks, trade names or products in this prospectus is not intended to, and should not be read to, imply a relationship with or endorsement or sponsorship of us. Solely for convenience, the trademarks, service marks and trade names referred to in this prospectus may appear without the ®, TM or SM symbols, but such references are not intended to indicate, in any way, that we will not assert, to the fullest extent under applicable law, our rights or the right of the applicable licensor to these trademarks, service marks and trade names.

iv


Table of Contents


SUMMARY

               This summary highlights information contained elsewhere in this prospectus. You should read the entire prospectus carefully, including the historical and pro forma financial statements and the notes to those financial statements, before investing in our common units. The information presented in this prospectus assumes, unless otherwise indicated, that the underwriters' option to purchase additional common units is not exercised. You should read "Risk Factors" beginning on page 21 for information about important risks that you should consider before buying our common units.

               References in this prospectus to "Susser Petroleum Partners LP," the "partnership," "we," "our," "us" or like terms, when used in a historical context, refer to Susser Petroleum Company LLC, our predecessor for accounting purposes, also referenced as "our predecessor" or "SPC." SPC is a wholly owned subsidiary of Susser Holdings Corporation, our parent and the owner of our general partner. When used in the present tense or prospectively, those terms refer to Susser Petroleum Partners LP, a Delaware limited partnership, and its subsidiaries. Unless the context otherwise requires, references in this prospectus to "SHC" refer to Susser Holdings Corporation and its subsidiaries, other than Susser Petroleum Partners LP, its subsidiaries and its general partner. References in this prospectus to "our general partner" refer to Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC, a Delaware limited liability company and the general partner of the partnership.


Susser Petroleum Partners LP

              We are a growth-oriented Delaware limited partnership formed by Susser Holdings Corporation, or SHC, to engage in the primarily fee-based wholesale distribution of motor fuels to SHC and third parties. SHC operates 545 retail convenience stores under its proprietary Stripes ® convenience store brand, primarily in growing Texas markets. Stripes ® is the largest independent chain of convenience stores in Texas based on store count and retail motor fuel volumes sold. Our business is integral to the success of SHC's retail operations, and upon the completion of this offering, SHC will purchase all of its motor fuel from us. For the year ended December 31, 2011, we distributed 789.6 million gallons of motor fuel to Stripes® convenience stores and 522.8 million gallons of motor fuel to other customers. We believe we are the largest independent motor fuel distributor by gallons in Texas, and among the largest distributors of Valero and Chevron branded motor fuel in the United States. In addition to distributing motor fuel, we also distribute other petroleum products such as propane and lube oil, and we receive rental income from real estate that we lease or sublease.

              We purchase motor fuel primarily from independent refiners and major oil companies and distribute it throughout Texas and in Louisiana, New Mexico and Oklahoma to:

    Stripes® convenience stores, pursuant to a ten-year motor fuel distribution agreement with SHC, which we refer to as the SHC Distribution Contract;

    over 80 other independently operated consignment locations where SHC sells motor fuel to retail customers, also pursuant to the SHC Distribution Contract;

    over 480 convenience stores and retail fuel outlets operated by independent operators, which we refer to as "dealers," pursuant to long-term distribution agreements; and

    other commercial customers, including unbranded convenience stores, other fuel distributors, school districts and municipalities and other industrial customers.

In addition to SHC's existing Stripes® convenience stores and independently operated consignment locations, we will distribute fuel to substantially all retail convenience stores and independently operated consignment locations that SHC constructs or acquires in the future.

              The total amount of motor fuel we sold grew from 892.0 million gallons during 2007 to over 1.3 billion gallons during 2011, primarily as a result of the increase in the number of Stripes®

 

1


Table of Contents

convenience stores, growth in average annual per-store volumes at Stripes ® convenience stores and expansion of our dealer network. Since January 1, 2007, the number of Stripes ® convenience store locations has grown from 325 to 545, while the amount of motor fuel sold to such stores grew from 426.8 million gallons during 2007 to 789.6 million gallons during 2011. During this period, the combined number of dealer and consignment locations increased from 367 to 565.

              During the twelve months ended June 30, 2012 and after giving pro forma effect to the SHC Distribution Contract, approximately 90% of our motor fuel sales by volume would have been made pursuant to fee-based, long-term distribution agreements. Under the SHC Distribution Contract, we will be the exclusive distributor of motor fuel purchased by SHC's existing Stripes® convenience stores and independently operated consignment locations for ten years at cost plus a fixed profit margin of three cents per gallon, as described in more detail below in "—Our Relationship with Susser Holdings Corporation—Our Agreements with SHC." Our third-party dealer distribution contracts generally have an initial term of ten years, and currently have an average remaining term of approximately five years. These contracts typically provide that we will distribute motor fuel at the posted purchase price at the fuel supply terminal, plus transportation costs, taxes and a fixed, volume-based fee, which is usually expressed in cents per gallon.

              We believe that we have limited exposure to fluctuating commodity prices because we generally pass the cost of the fuel that we distribute through to our customers. In 2011, over 95% of our motor fuel gallons were purchased only after receiving a customer order, and we held title to the fuel only for the period of time required for delivery, which is typically less than a day. We frequently use commodity derivative instruments to mitigate the price risk for the limited amounts of fuel for which we take title for a more extended period of time, typically not in excess of 60 days.

              In addition to revenues earned in our wholesale motor fuel distribution business, we will also receive rental income from convenience store properties that we lease or sublease to SHC and third parties. We currently receive rental income from 55 properties, most of which are in Texas, and all of which we lease to third parties. Pursuant to the omnibus agreement that we will enter into with SHC at the closing of this offering, we will have a three-year option to purchase up to 75 new or recently constructed Stripes® convenience stores from SHC and lease them back to SHC. Furthermore, any stores that we purchase and lease back to SHC pursuant to the 75 store option will be added to the SHC Distribution Contract, pursuant to which we will be the exclusive distributor of motor fuel to the applicable stores for ten years from the time of purchase at cost plus a fixed profit margin of three cents per gallon. For a more detailed description of the sale and leaseback option, please read "Business—Our Relationship with Susser Holdings Corporation—Our Agreements with SHC—Omnibus Agreement." Although we may purchase and lease convenience store properties to SHC or third parties, we do not currently operate or have any intention to operate any retail convenience stores that we own or may acquire in the future.

              For the year ended December 31, 2011, we would have had pro forma gross profit of approximately $50.3 million, pro forma Adjusted EBITDA of approximately $39.1 million, and pro forma net income of approximately $31.7 million. Sales to SHC would have accounted for approximately 54% of our pro forma gross profit for that period. For the six months ended June 30, 2012, we would have had pro forma gross profit of approximately $27.6 million, pro forma Adjusted EBITDA of approximately $20.8 million, and pro forma net income of approximately $16.2 million. Please read "—Summary Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data" for the definition of Adjusted EBITDA and a reconciliation of Adjusted EBITDA to our most directly comparable financial measures calculated and presented in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, or GAAP.

 

2


Table of Contents


Our Relationship with Susser Holdings Corporation

              One of our principal strengths is our relationship with SHC. SHC is the largest independent operator of convenience stores in Texas based on store count and retail motor fuel volumes sold. The Susser family entered the motor fuel retailing and distribution business in the 1930's. Sam L. Susser, the President and Chief Executive Officer of SHC and Chief Executive Officer and chairman of the board of directors of our general partner, joined SHC in 1988, when it operated five stores and had revenues of $8.4 million. SHC has demonstrated a strong track record of internal growth and the ability to successfully integrate acquisitions into its operations, completing 13 significant acquisitions consisting of 520 retail stores and 394 wholesale distribution contracts since 1988. In addition, SHC constructed over 115 large-format convenience stores from January 2000 through December 31, 2011, and intends to open an additional 26 to 29 newly constructed stores during 2012 and 28 to 35 newly constructed stores during 2013. SHC has also developed its proprietary Laredo Taco Company ® in-house restaurant concept and implemented it in over 320 Stripes® convenience stores, and intends to implement it in all newly constructed Stripes® convenience stores. In 2006, SHC completed an initial public offering of common stock and SHC's common stock trades on the NASDAQ under the symbol "SUSS."

              Following the completion of this offering, SHC will continue to operate its retail convenience store business and will retain its consignment and transportation business, and we will operate the balance of its wholesale motor fuel distribution business and lease convenience store properties. SHC will own our general partner, which controls us, and will also retain a significant economic interest in us through its direct and indirect ownership of        % of our limited partner interests and all of our incentive distribution rights, which will entitle SHC to increasing percentages of the cash we distribute in excess of $            per unit per quarter.

Our Agreements with SHC

              In connection with the completion of this offering, two long-term, fee-based commercial agreements with SHC will be contributed to us, and we will enter into an omnibus agreement with SHC. These agreements are summarized below:

    the SHC Distribution Contract, a fuel distribution agreement, pursuant to which we will be the exclusive distributor of motor fuel purchased by SHC's existing Stripes® convenience stores and independently operated consignment locations at cost, including tax and transportation costs, plus a fixed profit margin of three cents per gallon for a period of ten years, in addition to future volumes added pursuant to the terms of our omnibus agreement;

    a ten-year transportation logistics agreement, pursuant to which SHC will arrange for motor fuel to be delivered from our suppliers to our customers at rates consistent with those charged to third parties for the delivery of motor fuel, with the cost being entirely passed along to our customers, including SHC, which we refer to as the SHC Transportation Contract; and

    the omnibus agreement, pursuant to which, among other things, we will receive:

    a three-year option to purchase from SHC up to 75 new or recently constructed Stripes ® convenience stores at SHC's cost and lease the stores back to SHC at a specified rate for a 15-year initial term as well as to supply fuel to such stores for a period of ten years from the date of purchase pursuant to the SHC Distribution Contract; and

    a ten-year right to participate in acquisition opportunities with SHC, to the extent we are able to reach an agreement on terms.

 

3


Table of Contents

              In addition, our omnibus agreement provides that SHC is obligated to purchase from us any fuel it sells in the future for its own account for a period of ten years pursuant to the SHC Distribution Contract, and we are obligated to distribute such volumes to SHC, either at a negotiated rate or the alternate fuel sales rate, as described further in "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions—Agreements with Affiliates in Connection with the Transactions—Omnibus Agreement."

              For more information on our agreements with SHC and its subsidiaries, please read "Business—Our Relationship with Susser Holdings Corporation—Our Agreements with SHC," and "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions—Agreements with Affiliates in Connection with the Transactions—Omnibus Agreement." For a discussion of risks that could adversely affect our expected long-term contractual cash flow stability, please read "Risk Factors—Risks Inherent in Our Business."


Our Business Strategies

              Our primary business objectives are to maintain stable cash flows and to increase our quarterly cash distribution per unit over time. We intend to accomplish these objectives by executing the following strategies:

    Leverage our relationship with SHC to maintain and grow stable cash flows by:

    Increasing our motor fuel distribution volumes through growth in the number of Stripes ® convenience stores and consignment locations and in the volumes of motor fuel sold at existing Stripes ® convenience stores and consignment locations;

    Executing sale and leaseback arrangements with SHC that provide additional rental income and incremental income from motor fuel sales; and

    Pursuing strategic acquisition opportunities with SHC;

    Expand our third-party wholesale motor fuel distribution business by:

    Expanding our dealer network through the growth of our existing dealer locations, recruitment of new dealers and acquisitions; and

    Adding new commercial customers;

    Continue to enter into fee-based, long-term distribution contracts with our customers that we believe will help us achieve cash flow stability;

    Continue to leverage our volume growth and relationships with fuel suppliers to provide attractive motor fuel pricing to our customers; and

    Pursue a disciplined financial policy and maintain a conservative capital structure.

              For a more detailed description of our business strategies, please read "Business—Our Business Strategies."


Our Competitive Strengths

              We believe that we are well positioned to execute our business strategies successfully because of the following competitive strengths:

    Our relationship with SHC, the largest independent convenience store operator in Texas, and the owner of our general partner, our incentive distribution rights and a majority of our limited partnership units;

    Our position as the largest independent motor fuel distributor in growing Texas markets and our exposure to other adjacent regions;

 

4


Table of Contents

    Relatively stable cash flows from long-term, fee-based contracts and real estate rental income, as well as relatively low maintenance capital requirements and working capital requirements;

    Our strong, long-term relationships with suppliers and competitive pricing through ongoing purchases of large volumes of motor fuel;

    Our strong relationships with our diversified third-party customer base; and

    Our management team's proven ability to develop and maintain customer relationships, integrate acquisitions and grow operations while maintaining financial discipline.

              For a more detailed description of our competitive strengths, please read "Business—Our Competitive Strengths."


Risk Factors

              An investment in our common units involves risks. You should carefully consider the risks described in "Risk Factors" and the other information in this prospectus before deciding whether to invest in our common units. If any of these risks were to occur, our financial condition, results of operations, cash flows and ability to make distributions to our unitholders would be adversely affected and you could lose all or part of your investment. For more information regarding the known material risks that could impact our business, please read "Risk Factors" beginning on page 21.


Our Management

              We are managed and operated by the board of directors and executive officers of our general partner, Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC, a wholly owned subsidiary of SHC. Following this offering, SHC will own, directly or indirectly, approximately        % of our outstanding common units and all of our outstanding subordinated units and incentive distribution rights. As a result of owning our general partner, SHC will have the right to appoint all of the members of the board of directors of our general partner, with at least three of these directors meeting the independence standards established by the New York Stock Exchange ("NYSE"). Upon the completion of this offering, we expect that our general partner will have five directors. We expect that three independent directors will be appointed to the board of directors of our general partner prior to the date our common units are listed for trading on the NYSE. Our unitholders will not be entitled to elect our general partner or its directors or otherwise directly participate in our management or operations. For more information about the executive officers and directors of our general partner, please read "Management."

              Following the consummation of this offering, neither our general partner nor SHC will receive any management fee or other compensation in connection with our general partner's management of our business, but we will reimburse our general partner and its affiliates, including SHC, for all expenses they incur and payments they make on our behalf pursuant to our partnership agreement and the omnibus agreement. Neither our partnership agreement nor our omnibus agreement limits the amount of expenses for which our general partner and its affiliates may be reimbursed. Our partnership agreement provides that our general partner will determine in good faith the expenses that are allocable to us. Please read "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions—Agreements with Affiliates in Connection with the Transactions."


Summary of Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties

              While our relationship with SHC and its subsidiaries is a significant strength, it is also a source of potential conflicts. Our general partner has a legal duty to manage us in a manner beneficial to us and the holders of our common and subordinated units. This legal duty is commonly referred to as a "fiduciary duty." However, the officers and directors of our general partner also have fiduciary duties

 

5


Table of Contents

to manage our general partner in a manner beneficial to its owner, SHC. Additionally, each of our executive officers and certain of our directors are also officers and directors of SHC. As a result, conflicts of interest may arise in the future between us and our unitholders, on the one hand, and SHC and our general partner, on the other hand. For example, our general partner will be entitled to make determinations that affect the amount of cash distributions we make to holders of common and subordinated units, which in turn has an effect on whether our general partner receives incentive cash distributions.

              Delaware law provides that Delaware limited partnerships may, in their partnership agreements, restrict, eliminate or expand the fiduciary duties owed by the general partner to limited partners and the partnership. Our partnership agreement limits the liability of, and reduces the fiduciary duties owed by, our general partner to our common unitholders. Our partnership agreement also restricts the remedies available to our unitholders for actions that might otherwise constitute a breach of fiduciary duty by our general partner or its officers and directors. For example, our partnership agreement provides that our general partner will not have any liability to us or our unitholders for decisions made in its capacity as general partner so long as it acted in good faith, meaning it believed that the decisions were not adverse to the interests of our partnership. Our partnership agreement also provides that our general partner, and the officers and directors of our general partner, will not be liable for monetary damages to us for any acts or omissions unless there has been a final and non-appealable judgment entered by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that our general partner or those persons acted in bad faith, or, in the case of a criminal matter, acted with knowledge that such person's conduct was criminal. For more information, please read "Risk Factors—Risks Inherent in an Investment in Us—Our partnership agreement limits the liability and duties of our general partner and restricts the remedies available to us and our common unitholders for actions taken by our general partner that might otherwise constitute breaches of fiduciary duty." By purchasing a common unit, the purchaser agrees to be bound by the terms of our partnership agreement, and each unitholder is treated as having consented to various actions and potential conflicts of interest contemplated in the partnership agreement that might otherwise be considered a breach of fiduciary or other duties under applicable state law.

              For a more detailed description of the conflicts of interest and the fiduciary duties of our general partner, please read "Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties." For a description of other relationships with our affiliates, please read "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions."


Principal Executive Offices

              Our principal executive offices are located at 555 East Airtex Drive, Houston, Texas 77073. Our telephone number is (832) 234-3600. Our website will be located at http://www.                .com. We intend to make our periodic reports and other information filed with or furnished to the Securities and Exchange Commission, or SEC, pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, or the Exchange Act, available, free of charge, through our website, as soon as reasonably practicable after those reports and other information are electronically filed with or furnished to the SEC. Information on our website or any other website is not incorporated by reference into this prospectus and does not constitute a part of this prospectus. The SEC maintains an internet site at http://www.sec.gov that contains reports and other information regarding issuers that file electronically with the SEC.


Formation Transactions and Partnership Structure

              We are a Delaware limited partnership formed in June 2012 by SHC to own and operate the wholesale motor fuel distribution business that has historically been conducted by SPC, our accounting predecessor and a wholly owned subsidiary of SHC.

 

6


Table of Contents

              At the closing of this offering, the following transactions will occur:

    SPC will contribute substantially all of its wholesale motor fuel distribution business (other than its motor fuel consignment business and transportation assets and substantially all of its accounts receivable and payable) to a newly formed operating subsidiary, Susser Petroleum Operating Company LLC ("Susser Operating");

    SPC and SHC will contribute certain owned and leased convenience store properties to Susser Operating;

    SHC, Stripes LLC, a wholly owned subsidiary of SHC, and SPC will enter into the SHC Distribution Contract with Susser Operating;

    SPC will enter into the SHC Transportation Contract with Susser Operating and one of its wholly owned subsidiaries;

    SHC will contribute to us all of the equity interests in Susser Operating;

    We will issue to our general partner a 0.0% non-economic general partner interest in us;

    We will issue to SHC or a wholly owned subsidiary of SHC an aggregate of                        common units representing a         % limited partner interest in us and                        subordinated units representing a        % limited partner interest in us, as well as all of our incentive distribution rights. To the extent that the underwriters do not exercise their right to purchase up to            common units, up to            common units will be issued to SHC or a wholly owned subsidiary of SHC within 30 days of the completion of this offering for no additional consideration, and the aggregate limited partner interest represented by SHC and its wholly owned subsidiary's common units will increase to up to        %. Please read "—The Offering—Units outstanding after this offering;"

    We will issue to the public                        common units representing a        % limited partner interest in us (                         common units if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional common units in full), and we will use the net proceeds from this offering as described under "Use of Proceeds;"

    We will enter into a new $250 million revolving credit facility, under which we will draw $2.4 million at the closing of this offering, and a new term loan facility. We will borrow approximately $147.3 million of term debt, which will be secured by an equivalent amount of U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities, and will use the proceeds as described under "Use of Proceeds;" and

    We will enter into the omnibus agreement with SHC, pursuant to which, among other things, (i) SHC will provide us with certain rights relating to certain future business opportunities; (ii) SHC will provide certain operational services to us in support of our operations and various centralized corporate services; and (iii) the parties will agree to certain indemnification obligations.

 

7


Table of Contents


Organizational Structure

              The following is a simplified diagram of our ownership structure after giving effect to this offering and the related transactions.

GRAPHIC

Public Common Units(2)

      %

Interests of SHC:

       

Common Units(2)

      %

Subordinated Units

      %

General Partner Interest

    0.0 %
       

    100.0 %
       

(1)
One of our operating subsidiaries, Susser Petroleum Property Company LLC ("Susser Propco"), will be treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes. Susser Propco does not presently own or operate any assets. However, we expect that this subsidiary will own all Stripes ® convenience stores purchased from SHC in connection with our option to execute sale and leaseback transactions under the omnibus agreement or otherwise.

(2)
                        common units will be issued to SHC or a wholly owned subsidiary of SHC at the closing of this offering and up to                                    common units will be issued to SHC or a wholly owned subsidiary of SHC within 30 days of this offering. However, if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase                        additional common units in part or in full, the number of common units purchased by the underwriters pursuant to such exercise will be issued to the public and the remainder, if any, will be issued to SHC or a wholly owned subsidiary of SHC. Please read "—The Offering—Units outstanding after this offering."

 

8


Table of Contents


The Offering

Common units offered to the public                     common units.
                      common units if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase an additional                  common units (the "option units") in full.
Units outstanding after this offering                     common units and                  subordinated units, for a total of                  limited partner units, regardless of whether or not the underwriters exercise their option to purchase any of the option units. Of this amount,                  common units will be issued to SHC or a wholly owned subsidiary of SHC at the closing of this offering and, assuming the underwriters do not exercise their option to purchase any of the option units, all such option units will be issued to SHC or a wholly owned subsidiary of SHC 30 days following this offering, upon the expiration of the underwriters' option exercise period. However, if the underwriters do exercise their option to purchase any portion of the option units, we will (i) issue to the public the number of option units purchased by the underwriters pursuant to such exercise and (ii) issue to SHC or a wholly owned subsidiary of SHC, upon the expiration of the option exercise period, all remaining option units. Any such option units issued to SHC or a wholly owned subsidiary of SHC will be issued for no additional consideration. Accordingly, the exercise of the underwriters' option will not affect the total number of common units outstanding. In addition, our general partner will own a 0.0% non-economic general partner interest in us.
Use of proceeds   We intend to use the estimated net proceeds of approximately $                  million from this offering, based upon the assumed initial public offering price of $            per common unit (the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover of this prospectus), after deducting underwriting discounts, structuring fees and offering expenses, to:
   

distribute $            million to SHC as reimbursement of certain capital expenditures incurred with respect to the assets contributed to us; and

   

purchase approximately $147.3 million of U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities, which will be assigned as collateral to secure a new $147.3 million term loan that will be fully guaranteed by SHC. The proceeds of the new term loan will be used to make a $147.3 million distribution to SHC to finance in part our acquisition of the assets transferred by SHC to us in connection with this offering. In addition, we will draw $2.4 million in borrowings under our revolving credit facility in order to pay our transaction expenses associated with entering into the term loan and the revolving credit facility.

 

9


Table of Contents

    If the underwriters exercise their option to purchase the option units in full, the additional net proceeds would be approximately $    million. The net proceeds from any exercise of such option will be used to purchase additional U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities, which will be assigned as collateral to secure an equal amount of additional term loan borrowings that will be fully guaranteed by SHC. The proceeds of any such additional term loan borrowings will be distributed to SHC. See "Use of Proceeds."
Cash distributions   Upon completion of this offering, our partnership agreement will provide for a minimum quarterly distribution of $            per common unit and subordinated unit ($            per common unit and subordinated unit on an annualized basis) to the extent we have sufficient cash after establishment of reserves and payment of fees and expenses, including payments to our general partner and its affiliates. We refer to this cash as "available cash," and it is defined in our partnership agreement included in this prospectus as Appendix A. Our ability to pay the minimum quarterly distribution is subject to various restrictions and other factors described in more detail under the caption "Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions."
    For the first quarter that we are publicly traded, we will pay investors in this offering a prorated distribution covering the period from the completion of this offering through                  , 2012, based on the actual length of that period.
    Our partnership agreement requires us to distribute all of our available cash each quarter in the following manner:
   

first , to the holders of common units, until each common unit has received the minimum quarterly distribution of $                  plus any arrearages from prior quarters;

   

second , to the holders of subordinated units, until each subordinated unit has received the minimum quarterly distribution of $                  ; and

   

third , to all unitholders, pro rata, until each unit has received a distribution of $                  .

    If cash distributions to our unitholders exceed $            per unit in any quarter, the holders of our incentive distribution rights will receive increasing percentages, up to 50%, of the cash we distribute in excess of that amount. We refer to these distributions as "incentive distributions." Please read "Provisions of Our Partnership Agreement Relating to Cash Distributions."

 

10


Table of Contents

    We believe, based on our financial forecast and related assumptions included in "Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions," that we will have sufficient available cash to pay the minimum quarterly distribution of $                  on all of our common units and subordinated units for each quarter in the twelve months ending September 30, 2013. However, we do not have a legal obligation to pay quarterly distributions at our minimum quarterly distribution rate or at any other rate except as provided in our partnership agreement. There is no guarantee that we will distribute quarterly cash distributions to our unitholders in any quarter. Please read "Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions."
Subordinated units   SHC initially will own, directly or indirectly, all of our subordinated units. The principal difference between our common units and subordinated units is that in any quarter during the subordination period, holders of the subordinated units are not entitled to receive any distribution until the common units have received the minimum quarterly distribution plus any arrearages in the payment of the minimum quarterly distribution from prior quarters. Subordinated units will not accrue arrearages.
Conversion of subordinated units   The subordination period will end on the first business day after we have earned and paid at least (1)  $                  (the minimum quarterly distribution on an annualized basis) on each outstanding common and subordinated unit for each of three consecutive, non-overlapping four-quarter periods ending on or after                  , 2015 or (2)  $                  (150% of the annualized minimum quarterly distribution) on each outstanding common and subordinated unit and the related distributions on the incentive distribution rights for the four-quarter period immediately preceding that date, in each case provided there are no arrearages on our common units at that time.
    The subordination period also will end upon the removal of our general partner other than for cause if no subordinated units or common units held by the holder(s) of subordinated units or their affiliates are voted in favor of that removal.
    When the subordination period ends, all subordinated units will convert into common units on a one-for-one basis, and thereafter no common units will be entitled to arrearages.

 

11


Table of Contents

SHC's right to reset the target distribution levels   SHC, as the initial holder of all of our incentive distribution rights, has the right, at any time when there are no subordinated units outstanding and it has received incentive distributions at the highest level to which it is entitled (50%) for each of the prior four consecutive whole fiscal quarters, to reset the initial target distribution levels at higher levels based on our cash distributions at the time of the exercise of the reset election. If SHC transfers all or a portion of our incentive distribution rights in the future, then the holder or holders of a majority of our incentive distribution rights will be entitled to exercise this right. Following a reset election, the minimum quarterly distribution will be adjusted to equal the reset minimum quarterly distribution, and the target distribution levels will be reset to correspondingly higher levels based on the same percentage increases above the reset minimum quarterly distribution.
    If SHC elects to reset the target distribution levels, it will be entitled to receive a number of common units equal to the number of common units that would have entitled their holder to an average aggregate quarterly cash distribution in the prior two quarters equal to the average of the distributions to SHC on the incentive distribution rights in such prior two quarters. Please read "Provisions of Our Partnership Agreement Relating to Cash Distributions—SHC's Right to Reset Incentive Distribution Levels."
Issuance of additional units   Our partnership agreement authorizes us to issue an unlimited number of additional units without the approval of our unitholders. Please read "Units Eligible for Future Sale" and "The Partnership Agreement—Issuance of Additional Interests."

 

12


Table of Contents

Limited voting rights   Our general partner will manage and operate us. Unlike the holders of common stock in a corporation, our unitholders will have only limited voting rights on matters affecting our business. Our unitholders will have no right to elect our general partner or its directors on an annual or other continuing basis. Furthermore, our partnership agreement restricts our unitholders' voting rights by providing that any units held by a person or group that owns 20% or more of any class of units then outstanding, other than our general partner and its affiliates, their transferees and persons who acquired such units with the prior approval of the board of directors of our general partner, cannot be voted on any matter. Our general partner may not be removed except by a vote of the holders of at least 66 2 / 3 % of the outstanding voting units, including any units owned by our general partner and its affiliates, voting together as a single class. Upon consummation of this offering, SHC will own an aggregate of        % of our outstanding voting units (or        % of our outstanding voting units, if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional common units in full). This will give SHC the ability to prevent the removal of our general partner. Please read "The Partnership Agreement—Voting Rights."
Limited call right   If at any time our general partner and its affiliates own more than 80% of the outstanding common units, our general partner will have the right, but not the obligation, to purchase all of the remaining common units at a price equal to the greater of (1) the average of the daily closing price of the common units over the 20 trading days preceding the date three days before notice of exercise of the call right is first mailed and (2) the highest per-unit price paid by our general partner or any of its affiliates for common units during the 90-day period preceding the date such notice is first mailed. Please read "The Partnership Agreement—Limited Call Right."
Estimated ratio of taxable income to distributions   We estimate that if you own the common units you purchase in this offering through the record date for distributions for the period ending December 31, 2015, you will be allocated, on a cumulative basis, an amount of federal taxable income for that period that will be        % or less of the cash distributed to you with respect to that period. For example, if you receive an annual distribution of $                  per unit, we estimate that your average allocable federal taxable income per year will be no more than approximately $                  per unit. Thereafter, the ratio of allocable taxable income to cash distributions to you could substantially increase. Please read "Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences—Tax Consequences of Unit Ownership" for the basis of this estimate.

 

13


Table of Contents

Material federal income tax consequences   For a discussion of the material federal income tax consequences that may be relevant to prospective unitholders who are individual citizens or residents of the United States, please read "Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences."
Exchange listing   Our common units have been approved for listing on the NYSE under the symbol "SUSP," subject to official notice of issuance.

 

14


Table of Contents


Summary Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data

              The following table shows summary historical financial and operating data of Susser Petroleum Company LLC, our predecessor for accounting purposes, and summary pro forma financial and operating data of Susser Petroleum Partners LP for the periods and as of the dates indicated. The summary historical financial data of our predecessor as of December 31, 2010 and 2011 and for the years ended December 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011 are derived from the audited consolidated financial statements of our predecessor appearing elsewhere in this prospectus. The summary historical balance sheet data of our predecessor as of December 31, 2009 are derived from the unaudited consolidated financial statements of our predecessor not appearing in this prospectus. The summary historical financial data of our predecessor as of June 30, 2012 and for the six months ended June 30, 2011 and June 30, 2012 are derived from the unaudited consolidated financial statements of our predecessor appearing elsewhere in this prospectus.

              The summary pro forma financial data of Susser Petroleum Partners LP for the year ended December 31, 2011 and as of and for the six months ended June 30, 2012 are derived from our unaudited pro forma financial statements appearing elsewhere in this prospectus. The pro forma balance sheet assumes that the offering and the related transactions occurred on June 30, 2012, and the pro forma statements of operations for the year ended December 31, 2011 and the six months ended June 30, 2012 assume that the offering and the related transactions occurred on January 1, 2011. These transactions include, and the pro forma financial data give effect to, the following:

    the contribution by SPC to us of substantially all of the assets and operations comprising its wholesale motor fuel distribution business (other than its motor fuel consignment business and transportation assets and substantially all of its accounts receivable and payable);

    the contribution by SHC and SPC to us of certain convenience store properties;

    the consummation of this offering and our issuance of                        common units to the public,                         common units and                        subordinated units to SHC or a wholly owned subsidiary of SHC, our incentive distribution rights to SHC and a 0.0% non-economic general partner interest in us to our general partner;

    our borrowings under our new term loan facility of $147.3 million in term debt and $2.4 million in borrowings under our new revolving credit facility;

    the application of the net proceeds from this offering, together with the proceeds from borrowings under our new term loan facility, as described under "Use of Proceeds";

    our treatment as a pass-through entity for federal income tax purposes;

    the SHC Distribution Contract and recognition of incremental revenues under this agreement that were not recognized by our predecessor; and

    the SHC Transportation Contract and the elimination of revenues and costs associated with the transportation business that were included in our predecessor's results of operations.

              The pro forma financial data does not give pro forma effect to incremental external general and administrative expenses of approximately $2.0 million that we expect to incur as a result of being a publicly traded partnership.

              Our assets have historically been a part of the integrated operations of SHC, and our predecessor distributed motor fuel and other petroleum products to SHC without any profit margin. Accordingly, the gross profit in our predecessor's historical consolidated financial statements relates only to margins received from third parties for our wholesale distribution services. In addition, our predecessor's results of operations included results from consignment contracts that will be retained by SHC following the completion of this offering. At these consignment locations, our predecessor

 

15


Table of Contents

provides and controls motor fuel inventory and price at the site and receives the actual retail selling price for each gallon sold, less a commission paid to the independent operator of the location, as opposed to the fixed profit margin per gallon that we will receive for fuel supplied to SHC for existing consignment locations. For this reason, as well as the other factors described in "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Factors Impacting the Comparability of Our Financial Results," our future results of operations will not be comparable to our predecessor's historical results of operations.

              The following table should be read together with, and is qualified in its entirety by reference to, the historical and pro forma financial statements and the accompanying notes appearing elsewhere in this prospectus. Among other things, the historical and pro forma financial statements include more detailed information regarding the basis of presentation for the information in the following table. The table should also be read together with "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations," "Use of Proceeds" and "Business—Our Relationship with Susser Holdings Corporation."

              The following table presents a non-GAAP financial measure, Adjusted EBITDA, which we use in our business as an important supplemental measure of our performance and liquidity. Adjusted EBITDA represents net income before interest expense, income tax expense and depreciation and amortization expense, as further adjusted to reflect certain other non-recurring and non-cash items. This measure is not calculated or presented in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, or GAAP. We explain this measure under "—Non-GAAP Financial Measure" below and reconcile it to its most directly comparable financial measures calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP.

 

16


Table of Contents

                                                 
 
  Predecessor Historical    
  Pro Forma  
 
  Fiscal Year Ended
December 31,
  Six Months
Ended
June 30,
 




   
   
 
 
   
  Six Months
Ended
June 30,
2012
 
 
  Year Ended
December 31,
2011
 
 
  2009   2010   2011   2011   2012  
 
   
 
 
  (in thousands)
 
 
   
   
   
  (unaudited)
   
  (unaudited)
 
                                                 

Statement of Income Data:

                                               

Revenues:

                                               

Motor fuel sales to third parties

  $ 875,891   $ 1,094,273   $ 1,549,143   $ 748,430   $ 905,544       $ 1,216,896   $ 724,743  

Motor fuel sales to affiliates

    1,205,890     1,578,653     2,257,788     1,108,669     1,247,170         2,605,050     1,435,235  

Rental income

    4,245     5,351     5,467     2,734     2,718         3,304     1,679  

Other income(1)

    7,462     5,515     7,980     3,243     3,732         4,596     2,450  
                                   

Total revenues

    2,093,488     2,683,792     3,820,378     1,863,076     2,159,164         3,829,846     2,164,107  

Gross profit:

                                               

Motor fuel sales to third parties

    20,584     26,065     31,217     15,440     18,250         17,579     10,037  

Motor fuel sales to affiliates

                            26,956     14,457  

Rental income

    4,245     5,351     5,467     2,734     2,718         3,304     1,679  

Other income

    7,501     4,683     6,339     2,849     3,094         2,474     1,380  
                                   

Total gross profit

    32,330     36,099     43,023     21,023     24,062         50,313     27,553  

Operating expenses:

                                               

General and administrative

    7,593     8,480     10,559     5,126     5,801         9,262     5,196  

Other operating

    4,728     4,229     4,870     2,490     3,638         1,496     1,461  

Rent

    1,578     3,797     4,322     2,175     2,180         1,031     531  

Loss (gain) on disposal of assets

    (6 )   86     221     144     36         142     122  

Depreciation, amortization and accretion

    4,901     4,771     6,090     2,483     3,776         4,281     2,778  
                                   

Total operating expenses

    18,794     21,363     26,062     12,418     15,431         16,212     10,088  
                                   

Income from operations

    13,536     14,736     16,961     8,605     8,631         34,101     17,465  

Other expense:

                                               

Interest expense, net

    191     284     324     159     180         2,096     1,066  
                                   

Income before income taxes

    13,345     14,452     16,637     8,446     8,451         32,005     16,399  

Tax expense(2)

    4,831     5,236     6,039     3,059     3,074         276     152  
                                   

Net income

  $ 8,514   $ 9,216   $ 10,598   $ 5,387   $ 5,377       $ 31,729   $ 16,247  
                                   

Other Financial Data:

                                               

Adjusted EBITDA(3)

    19,057     20,145     23,979     11,613     13,012         39,113     20,839  

Capital expenditures

    11,379     13,963     19,438     4,069     6,870         13,709     3,262  

Cash Flow Data :

                                               

Net cash provided by (used in):

                                               

Operating activities

    9,833     17,469     14,263     (98 )   7,333                  

Investing activities

    (11,356 )   (13,897 )   (19,153 )   (4,069 )   (6,539 )                

Financing activities

    331     731     381     24     111                  

(1)
Other income for historical periods includes income from a transportation services business, which will be retained by SHC following the offering, as well as income from sales of lube oil, propane and other petroleum products, sales of rights to operate dealer locations and other miscellaneous non-motor fuel income sources.

(2)
Historically, our predecessor's wholesale motor fuel distribution business has been included in SHC's U.S. federal and state tax returns, and therefore, our predecessor's results of operations include an allocation of SHC's federal income taxes attributable to the wholesale business. Due to our status as a partnership, we will not be subject to U.S. federal income tax and certain state income taxes in the future, except for our subsidiary that will be treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes. This subsidiary does not presently have any operations, but is expected to own stores purchased pursuant to sale and leaseback transactions with SHC and receive rental income from SHC in future periods. In addition, we will continue to be subject to the Texas franchise tax.

(3)
Adjusted EBITDA is defined in "—Non-GAAP Financial Measure" below.

 

17


Table of Contents

                                                 
 
  Predecessor Historical    
  Pro Forma  
 
  Fiscal Year Ended
December 31,
  Six Months
Ended
June 30,
 




   
   
 
 
   
  Six Months
Ended
June 30,
2012
 
 
  Year Ended
December 31,
2011
 
 
  2009   2010   2011   2011   2012  
 
   
 
 
  (in thousands, except operating data)
 
 
   
   
   
  (unaudited)
   
  (unaudited)
 
                                                 

Balance Sheet Data (at period end):

                                               

Cash and cash equivalents

  $ 446   $ 4,749   $ 240   $ 606   $ 1,145             $ 1,152  

Treasury securities

                                  146,800  

Property and equipment, net

    47,602     35,247     39,049     36,704     43,051               35,441  

Total assets

    192,857     202,587     231,316     231,052     242,763               229,517  

Total liabilities

    96,858     97,372     115,503     120,449     121,573               156,092  

Total unitholder's equity            

    95,999     105,215     115,813     110,603     121,190               73,425  

Operating Data:

                                               

Motor fuel gallons sold (in thousands):

                                               

Stripes ® convenience stores

    707,106     739,104     789,578     384,661     425,249         789,578     425,249  

Consignment locations

    100,609     106,073     108,944     52,551     56,621         108,944     56,621  

Third-party dealers and other
commercial customers            

    394,212     388,136     413,888     196,527     238,526         413,888     238,526  
                                   

Total gallons sold

    1,201,927     1,233,313     1,312,410     633,739     720,396         1,312,410     720,396  

Average wholesale selling price per gallon(4)

  $ 1.73   $ 2.17   $ 2.90   $ 2.93   $ 2.99       $ 2.91   $ 3.00  

Motor fuel gross profit cents per gallon:

                                               

Affiliated(5)

    0.0¢     0.0¢     0.0¢     0.0¢     0.0¢         3.0¢     3.0¢  

Third-party(5)

    4.2¢     5.3¢     6.0¢     6.2¢     6.2¢         4.2¢     4.2¢  

Volume-weighted average for all gallons

    1.7¢     2.1¢     2.4¢     2.4¢     2.5¢         3.4¢     3.4¢  

Rental locations (at period end)

    80     86     83     82     81         54     55  

(4)
Excludes excise tax.

(5)
Our predecessor sold motor fuel directly to independently operated consignment locations during the historical periods. Following this offering, SHC will retain the consignment contracts and assets, and, pursuant to the SHC Distribution Contract, we will sell fuel to SHC for both Stripes® convenience stores and SHC's independently operated consignment locations at a fixed profit margin of three cents per gallon. As a result, volumes sold to consignment locations are included in the calculation of third-party motor fuel gross profit cents per gallon in the historical operating data and in the calculation of affiliated motor fuel gross profit cents per gallon in the pro forma operating data.

 

18


Table of Contents


Non-GAAP Financial Measure

              We define Adjusted EBITDA as net income before net interest expense, income taxes and depreciation, amortization and accretion, as further adjusted to exclude allocated non-cash stock-based compensation expense and certain other operating expenses that are reflected in our net income that we do not believe are indicative of our ongoing core operations, such as the gain or loss on disposal of assets.

              We believe Adjusted EBITDA is useful to investors in evaluating our operating performance because:

    securities analysts and other interested parties use such calculations as a measure of financial performance and debt service capabilities;

    it facilitates management's ability to measure the operating performance of our business on a consistent basis by excluding the impact of items not directly resulting from our wholesale motor fuel distribution operations; and

    it is used by our management for internal planning purposes, including aspects of our consolidated operating budget and capital expenditures.

              Adjusted EBITDA is not calculated or presented in accordance with GAAP and does not purport to be an alternative to net income as a measure of operating performance or to cash flows from operating activities as a measure of liquidity. Adjusted EBITDA has limitations as an analytical tool, and you should not consider it in isolation or as a substitute for analysis of our results as reported under GAAP. Some of these limitations include:

    it does not reflect our cash expenditures, or future requirements, for capital expenditures or contractual commitments;

    it does not reflect changes in, or cash requirements for, working capital;

    it does not reflect significant interest expense, or the cash requirements necessary to service interest or principal payments on our new credit facilities;

    it does not reflect payments made or future requirements for income taxes;

    although depreciation and amortization are non-cash charges, the assets being depreciated and amortized will often have to be replaced in the future, and Adjusted EBITDA does not reflect cash requirements for such replacements; and

    because not all companies use identical calculations, our presentation of Adjusted EBITDA may not be comparable to similarly titled measures of other companies.

 

19


Table of Contents

              The following table presents a reconciliation of net income to Adjusted EBITDA:

                                                 
 
  Predecessor Historical    
  Pro Forma  
 
  Fiscal Year Ended
December 31,
  Six Months
Ended
June 30,
 




   
   
 
 
   
  Six Months
Ended
June 30,
2012
 
 
  Year Ended
December 31,
2011
 
 
  2009   2010   2011   2011   2012  
 
   
 
 
  (in thousands)
 
                                                 

Net income

  $ 8,514   $ 9,216   $ 10,598   $ 5,387   $ 5,377       $ 31,729   $ 16,247  

Depreciation, amortization and accretion

    4,901     4,771     6,090     2,483     3,776         4,281     2,778  

Interest expense, net

    191     284     324     159     180         2,096     1,066  

Income tax expense

    4,831     5,236     6,039     3,059     3,074         276     152  
                                   

EBITDA

    18,437     19,507     23,051     11,088     12,407         38,382     20,243  
                                   

Non-cash stock-based compensation

    626     552     707     381     569         589     474  

Loss (gain) on disposal of assets

    (6 )   86     221     144     36         142     122  
                                   

Adjusted EBITDA

  $ 19,057   $ 20,145   $ 23,979   $ 11,613   $ 13,012       $ 39,113   $ 20,839  
                                   

              The following table presents a reconciliation of net cash provided by (used in) operating activities to Adjusted EBITDA:

 
  Predecessor Historical  
 
  Fiscal Year Ended
December 31,
  Six Months
Ended
June 30,
 
 
  2009   2010   2011   2011   2012  
 
  (in thousands)
 

Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities

  $ 9,833   $ 17,469   $ 14,263   $ (98 ) $ 7,333  

Changes in operating assets and liabilities

    4,562     (4,923 )   3,897     8,658     2,480  

Gain (loss) on disposal of assets

    6     (86 )   (221 )   (144 )   (36 )

Deferred income tax

    (986 )   1,527     (1,251 )   (546 )   (624 )

Interest expense, net

    191     284     324     159     180  

Income tax expense

    4,831     5,236     6,039     3,059     3,074  
                       

EBITDA

    18,437     19,507     23,051     11,088     12,407  
                       

Non-cash stock-based compensation

    626     552     707     381     569  

Loss (gain) on disposal of assets

    (6 )   86     221     144     36  
                       

Adjusted EBITDA

  $ 19,057   $ 20,145   $ 23,979   $ 11,613   $ 13,012  
                       

 

20


Table of Contents


RISK FACTORS

               Limited partner interests are inherently different from the capital stock of a corporation, although many of the business risks to which we are subject are similar to those that would be faced by a corporation engaged in a similar business. You should carefully consider the following risk factors together with all of the other information included in this prospectus in evaluating an investment in our common units.

               If any of the following risks were to occur, our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash available for distribution could be materially adversely affected. In that case, we might not be able to make distributions on our common units, the trading price of our common units could decline, and you could lose all or part of your investment in us.


Risks Inherent in Our Business

SHC is our largest customer, and we are dependent on SHC for a significant majority of our revenues. Therefore, we are indirectly subject to the business risks of SHC. If SHC changes its business strategy, is unable to satisfy its obligations under our various commercial agreements for any reason, or significantly reduces the volume of motor fuel it purchases under the SHC Distribution Contract, our revenues will decline and our financial condition, results of operations, cash flows and ability to make distributions to our unitholders will be adversely affected.

              For the year ended December 31, 2011, on a pro forma basis, SHC would have accounted for approximately 68% of our revenues, 54% of our gross profit and 68% of our motor fuel volumes sold. As we expect to continue to derive a significant percentage of our revenues from SHC for the foreseeable future, we are subject to the risk of nonpayment or nonperformance by SHC under the SHC Distribution Contract. Furthermore, the SHC Distribution Contract does not impose any minimum volume obligations on SHC and SHC will have a limited ability to remove Stripes ® convenience stores from the SHC Distribution Contract after the closing of this offering. Please read "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions—Omnibus Agreement—Exclusivity on Substantially all future volumes sold by SHC." If SHC changes its business strategy or significantly reduces the volume of motor fuel it purchases for its Stripes ® convenience stores and independently operated consignment locations, our cash flows will be adversely impacted. Any event, whether in our areas of operation or otherwise, that materially and adversely affects SHC's financial condition, results of operation or cash flows may adversely affect our ability to sustain or increase cash distributions to our unitholders. Accordingly, we are indirectly subject to the operational and business risks of SHC, some which are related to the following:

    competitive pressures from convenience stores, gasoline stations, and non-traditional fuel retailers such as supermarkets, club stores and mass merchants located in SHC's markets;

    volatility in prices for motor fuel, which could adversely impact consumer demand for motor fuel;

    increasing consumer preferences for alternative motor fuels, or improvements in fuel efficiency;

    seasonal trends in the convenience store industry, which significantly impact SHC's motor fuel sales;

    the impact of severe or unfavorable weather conditions on SHC's facilities or communications networks, or on consumer behavior, travel and convenience store traffic patterns;

    cross-border risks associated with the concentration of SHC's stores in markets bordering Mexico;

    SHC's dependence on information technology systems;

    SHC's ability to build or acquire and successfully integrate new stores;

    the operation of SHC's retail stores in close proximity to stores of our other customers; and

    risks relating to SHC's substantial indebtedness and its dependence on us for cash flow generation.

21


Table of Contents

              Finally, we have no control over SHC, our largest source of revenue and our primary customer. SHC may elect to pursue a business strategy that does not favor us and our business. Please read "—Risks Inherent in an Investment in Us—SHC owns and controls our general partner, which has sole responsibility for conducting our business and managing our operations. Our general partner and its affiliates, including SHC, have conflicts of interest with us and limited fiduciary duties and they may favor their own interests to the detriment of us and our unitholders."

We may not have sufficient cash from operations following the establishment of cash reserves and payment of costs and expenses, including cost reimbursements to our general partner, to enable us to pay the minimum quarterly distribution to our unitholders.

              We may not have sufficient cash each quarter to pay the full amount of our minimum quarterly distribution of $            per unit, or $            per unit per year, which will require us to have available cash of approximately $            per quarter, or $             million per year, based on the number of common and subordinated units to be outstanding after the completion of this offering. The amount of cash we can distribute on our common and subordinated units principally depends upon the amount of cash we generate from our operations, which will fluctuate from quarter to quarter based on a number of factors, some of which are beyond our control, including, among other things:

    demand for motor fuel in the markets we serve, including seasonal fluctuations in demand for motor fuel;

    competition from other companies that sell motor fuel products in our market areas;

    regulatory action affecting the supply of or demand for motor fuel, our operations, our existing contracts or our operating costs;

    prevailing economic conditions; and

    volatility of prices for motor fuel.

              In addition, the actual amount of cash we will have available for distribution will depend on other factors including:

    the level and timing of capital expenditures we make;

    the cost of acquisitions, if any;

    our debt service requirements and other liabilities;

    fluctuations in our working capital needs;

    reimbursements made to our general partner and its affiliates for all direct and indirect expenses they incur on our behalf pursuant to the partnership agreement;

    our ability to borrow funds and access capital markets;

    restrictions contained in debt agreements to which we are a party; and

    the amount of cash reserves established by our general partner.

              For a description of additional restrictions and factors that may affect our ability to pay cash distributions, please read "Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions."

The assumptions underlying our forecast of available cash included in "Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions" are inherently uncertain and subject to significant business, economic, financial, regulatory and competitive risks and uncertainties that could cause available cash to differ materially from our estimates.

              The forecast of available cash set forth in "Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions" includes our forecast of our results of operations and available cash for the twelve

22


Table of Contents

months ending September 30, 2013. Our ability to pay the full minimum quarterly distribution in the forecast period is based on a number of assumptions that may not prove to be correct, including, but not limited to, the volume of motor fuel that we will sell pursuant to the SHC Distribution Contract and our third-party dealer distribution contracts, and the margins that we will receive on volumes sold to third parties, as well as the amount of rental income that we will receive for convenience stores that we lease or sublease to third-party operators or SHC.

              Our forecast of available cash has been prepared by management, and we have not received an opinion or report on it from any independent registered public accountants. The assumptions underlying our forecast of available cash are inherently uncertain and are subject to significant business, economic, financial, regulatory and competitive risks and uncertainties that could cause available cash to differ materially from that which is forecasted. If we do not achieve our forecasted results, we may not be able to pay the minimum quarterly distribution or any amount on our common units or subordinated units, in which event the market price of our common units may decline materially. Please read "Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions."

The growth of our wholesale business depends in part on SHC's ability to construct, open and profitably operate new Stripes® convenience stores. If SHC does not construct additional Stripes® convenience stores, our growth strategy and ability to increase cash distributions to our unitholders may be adversely affected.

              A significant part of our growth strategy is to increase our wholesale fuel distribution volumes and rental income relating to newly constructed Stripes ® convenience stores. SHC may not be able to construct and open new convenience stores, and any new stores that SHC opens may be unprofitable or fail to attract expected volumes of motor fuel sales. Several factors that could affect SHC's ability to open and profitably operate new stores include:

    competition in targeted market areas;

    the inability to identify and acquire suitable sites for new stores or to negotiate acceptable leases for such sites;

    difficulties in adapting distribution and other operational and management systems to an expanded network of stores;

    the potential inability to obtain adequate financing to fund its expansion; and

    difficulties in obtaining governmental and other third-party consents, permits and licenses needed to construct and operate additional stores.

              Furthermore, SHC is not obligated to construct additional Stripes® convenience stores nor enter into additional sale and leaseback transactions with respect to any newly constructed stores beyond the 75 option stores under the omnibus agreement. In addition, SHC currently contracts with a motor fuel wholesaler which distributes motor fuel on a consignment basis to one of SHC's Stripes ® convenience stores. Under this arrangement, as a consignee, SHC does not purchase the fuel sold at this store and instead receives a commission on volumes sold by the wholesaler. As a result, we will not distribute any volumes nor earn any revenues for fuel sold at that store. Further, under the SHC Distribution Contract, SHC will continue to have the right to convert a limited number of stores each year to third-party consignment contracts, and the third-party wholesalers party to such consignment contracts would not be obligated to purchase any motor fuel from us. If SHC were to determine in the future that growth via the construction of additional Stripes® convenience stores or additional sale and leaseback transactions is not attractive or that it is more advantageous to contract for third-party consignment sales of motor fuel at existing or future locations as opposed to SHC selling the motor fuel, it could adversely impact our ability to grow our motor fuel volumes and rental income and our ability to make distributions to our unitholders could be adversely affected.

23


Table of Contents

A substantial majority of our revenues are generated under contracts that must be renegotiated or replaced periodically. If we are unable to successfully renegotiate or replace these contracts, then our results of operations and financial condition could be adversely affected.

              For the year ended December 31, 2011, on a pro forma basis, SHC would have accounted for approximately 68% of our revenues, 54% of our gross profit and 68% of our motor fuel volumes sold. The SHC Distribution Contract has (i) a term of ten years from the consummation of this offering with respect to sales of motor fuel to existing Stripes ® convenience stores and consignment locations and any sales made at cost plus the alternate fuel sales rate and (ii) a term of ten years from the applicable option store closing date with respect to any Stripes ® convenience stores we purchase and lease back to SHC pursuant to the 75 store option. However, SHC is under no obligation to renew these volumes under the SHC Distribution Contract on similar terms or at all, and SHC's failure to renew the SHC Distribution Contract would have a material adverse effect on our business, liquidity and results of operations. In addition, SHC's obligation under the omnibus agreement to purchase any fuel it sells in the future for its own account will expire after ten years from the date of consummation of this offering.

              Our third-party revenues are generated under contracts with specified term lengths. As these contracts expire, they must be renegotiated or replaced. Our existing third-party dealer distribution contracts generally have an initial term of ten years and currently have an average remaining term of approximately five years. These dealers have no obligation to renew their distribution contracts with us on similar terms or at all.

              Also, we receive rental income from 55 properties that we currently lease or sublease to third parties. Our lessees have no obligation to renew their contracts. Our third-party rental contracts typically have an initial term of five to ten years, and, as of June 30, 2012, had an average remaining life of seven years.

              We may be unable to renegotiate or replace our third-party distribution contracts or leases when they expire, and the terms of any renegotiated contracts may not be as favorable as the terms of the contracts they replace. Whether these contracts are successfully renegotiated or replaced is frequently subject to factors beyond our control. Such factors include fluctuations in motor fuel prices, counterparty ability to pay for or accept the contracted volumes and a competitive marketplace for the services offered by us. If we cannot successfully renegotiate or replace our third-party contracts or must renegotiate or replace them on less favorable terms, revenues from these arrangements could decline and our ability to make distributions to our unitholders could be adversely affected.

Our financial condition and results of operations are influenced by changes in the prices of motor fuel, which may adversely impact our margins, our customers' financial condition and the availability of trade credit.

              Our operating results are influenced by prices for motor fuel, pricing volatility and the market for such products. When prices for motor fuel rise, some of our customers may have insufficient credit to purchase motor fuel from us at their historical volumes. In addition, significant and persistent increases in the retail price of motor fuel could also diminish consumer demand, which could subsequently diminish the volume of motor fuel we distribute. Furthermore, higher prices for motor fuel may reduce our access to trade credit support or cause it to become more expensive. On the other hand, significant decreases in wholesale motor fuel prices could result in lower motor fuel gross margins per gallon due to the reduction in value of discounts from our suppliers.

A significant decrease in demand for motor fuel in the areas we serve would reduce our ability to make distributions to our unitholders.

              A significant decrease in demand for motor fuel in the areas that we serve could significantly reduce our revenues and, therefore, reduce our ability to make or increase distributions to our unitholders. Our revenues are dependent on various trends, such as trends in commercial truck traffic, travel and tourism in our areas of operation, and these trends can change. Furthermore, seasonal

24


Table of Contents

fluctuations or regulatory action, including government imposed fuel efficiency standards, may affect demand for motor fuel. Because certain of our operating costs and expenses are fixed and do not vary with the volumes of motor fuel we distribute, our costs and expenses might not decrease ratably or at all should we experience a reduction in our volumes distributed. As a result, we may experience declines in our profit margin if our fuel distribution volumes decrease.

Certain of our contracts with suppliers currently have early payment and volume-related discounts which reduce the price we pay for motor fuel that we purchase from them. If we are unable to renew these contracts on similar terms, our gross profit will correspondingly decrease.

              Certain of our contracts with suppliers currently have early payment and volume-related discounts based on the timing of our payment and the market price of the fuel and volumes that we purchase. During the year ended December 31, 2011, on a pro forma basis, we would have received early payment and volume-related discounts on approximately 32% of all motor fuel volumes purchased. If we were to be unable to qualify for these discounts, or unable to renew these contracts on similar terms, our gross profit would decrease, which could, in turn, reduce our cash available for distribution to our unitholders.

We currently depend on two principal suppliers for the majority of our motor fuel. A failure by a principal supplier to renew our supply agreement, a disruption in supply or an unexpected change in our supplier relationships could have a material adverse effect on our business.

              For fiscal 2011, Valero supplied approximately 40% and Chevron supplied approximately 20% of our consolidated motor fuel purchases. Our supply agreement with Valero expires in July 2018 and our supply agreement with Chevron expires in August 2014. If Valero or Chevron elects not to renew their contracts with us, we may be unable to replace the volume of motor fuel we currently purchase from them on similar terms or at all. Furthermore, a disruption in supply or a significant change in our relationship with our principal fuel suppliers could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operation and cash available for distribution to our unitholders.

We are exposed to performance risk in our supply chain. If our suppliers are unable to sell to us sufficient amounts of motor fuel products, we may be unable to satisfy our customers' demand for motor fuel.

              We rely upon our suppliers to timely provide the volumes and types of motor fuels for which they contract with us. We purchase motor fuels from a variety of suppliers under term contracts. Generally, our supply contracts do not guarantee that we will receive all of the volumes that we need to fulfill the demands of our distribution customers. In times of extreme market demand or supply disruption, we may be unable to acquire enough fuel to satisfy the fuel demand of our customers. Furthermore, the feedstock for a significant portion of our supply comes from other countries, which could be disrupted by political events. In the event that such feedstock becomes scarce, whether as a result of political events or otherwise, we may be unable to meet our customers' demand for motor fuel.

Increasing consumer preferences for alternative motor fuels, or improvements in fuel efficiency, could adversely impact our business.

              Any technological advancements, regulatory changes or changes in consumer preferences causing a significant shift toward alternative motor fuels, or non-fuel dependent means of transportation, could reduce demand for conventional petroleum based motor fuels. Additionally, a shift toward electric, hydrogen, natural gas or other alternative or non-fuel-powered vehicles could fundamentally change consumers' spending habits or lead to new forms of fueling destinations or new competitive pressures. Finally, new technologies have been developed and governmental mandates have been implemented to improve fuel efficiency. Any of these outcomes could potentially result in decreased consumer demand for motor fuel, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash available for distribution to our unitholders.

25


Table of Contents

The wholesale motor fuel distribution industry is characterized by intense competition and fragmentation, and our failure to effectively compete could result in lower margins.

              The market for distribution of wholesale motor fuel is highly competitive and fragmented, which results in narrow margins. We have numerous competitors, some of which may have significantly greater resources and name recognition than us. We rely on our ability to provide value-added, reliable services and to control our operating costs in order to maintain our margins and competitive position. If we were to fail to maintain the quality of our services, certain of our customers could choose alternative distribution sources and our margins could decrease. While major integrated oil companies have generally continued to divest retail sites and the corresponding wholesale distribution to such sites, such major oil companies could shift from this strategy and decide to distribute their own products in direct competition with us, or large customers could attempt to buy directly from the major oil companies. The occurrence of any of these events could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and cash available for distribution to our unitholders.

The motor fuel business is subject to seasonal trends, which may affect our earnings and ability to make distributions.

              Our customers experience more demand for motor fuel during the late spring and summer months than during the fall and winter. Travel, recreation and construction activities typically increase in these months in the geographic areas in which we operate, increasing the demand for motor fuel. Therefore, the volume of motor fuel that we distribute is typically somewhat higher in the second and third quarters of our fiscal year. As a result, our results from operations may vary from period to period, affecting our earnings and ability to make cash distributions.

Severe weather could adversely affect our business by damaging our, our suppliers or our customers' facilities or communications networks.

              A substantial portion of our wholesale distribution network is located on the Texas gulf coast. Although South Texas is generally known for its mild weather, the region is susceptible to severe storms, including hurricanes. A severe storm could damage our facilities or communications networks, or those of our suppliers or our customers, as well as interfere with our ability to distribute motor fuel to our customers or our customers' ability to operate their locations. If warmer temperatures, or other climate changes, lead to changes in extreme weather events, including increased frequency, duration or severity, these weather-related risks could become more pronounced. Any weather-related catastrophe or disruption could have a material adverse effect on our business and results of operations, potentially causing losses beyond the limits of the insurance we currently carry.

Negative events or developments associated with our branded suppliers could have an adverse impact on our revenues.

              We believe that the success of our operations is dependent, in part, on the continuing favorable reputation, market value and name recognition associated with the motor fuel brands sold both at Stripes ® convenience stores and to independent, branded dealers. Erosion of the value of those brands could have an adverse impact on the volumes of motor fuel we distribute, which in turn could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and ability to make distributions to our unitholders.

26


Table of Contents

If we cannot otherwise agree with SHC on fuel supply terms for volumes we sell to SHC in the future (other than for stores purchased by us pursuant to our sale and leaseback option), then we will be required to supply volumes at a price equal to our motor fuel cost plus the alternate fuel sales rate, which will be substantially less than the fixed profit margin of three cents per gallon we will receive for motor fuel sold pursuant to the SHC Distribution Contract. Furthermore, if certain of our operating costs increase significantly, we may not realize our anticipated profit margin with regard to motor fuel distributed to SHC at the alternate fuel sales rate.

              Our omnibus agreement will provide that if we cannot agree with SHC on fuel supply terms for volumes we sell to SHC in the future (other than for stores purchased by us pursuant to our sale and leaseback option), we will be required to distribute motor fuel to SHC's newly built, acquired or added retail stores or consignment locations at a price equal to our motor fuel cost plus the alternate fuel sales rate, which will be substantially less than the fixed profit margin of three cents we will receive for motor fuel sold pursuant to the SHC Distribution Contract. The alternate fuel sales rate is a per gallon fee we will receive equal to our prior year per-gallon motor fuel distribution costs, excluding the cost of the motor fuel, plus 30% of such costs. Our motor fuel distribution costs include direct distribution expenses as well as general and administrative expenses, maintenance capital expenditures, franchise taxes and other miscellaneous costs. Under the omnibus agreement, the alternate fuel sales rate will reset annually, but the fixed fee included in the rate for a given year will be based on our motor fuel distribution costs for the immediately preceding year. For a discussion of the alternate fuel sales rate, please read "Business—Our Relationship with Susser Holdings Corporation—Our Agreements with SHC—Omnibus Agreement."

              Accordingly, even though the alternate fuel sales rate will reset annually, we may not realize our anticipated profit margin on motor fuel distributed to SHC at the alternate fuel sales rate. If our operating costs significantly increase in a given year as compared to immediately preceding year operating costs, the profit margin we receive for fuel distributed at the alternate fuel sales rate will be reduced, which will negatively impact our results of operations and cash available for distribution to our unitholders.

Due to our lack of geographic diversification, adverse developments in our operating areas could adversely affect our results of operations and cash available for distribution to our unitholders.

              Our operations are located in Texas, New Mexico, Louisiana and Oklahoma. Due to our lack of geographic diversification, an adverse development in the areas in which we operate, such as a catastrophic weather event or a decrease in demand for motor fuel, could have a significantly greater impact on our results of operations and cash available for distribution than it would if we operated in more diverse locations.

If we do not make acquisitions on economically acceptable terms, our future growth may be limited.

              Our ability to grow depends substantially on our ability to make acquisitions that result in an increase in available cash per unit. We intend to expand our dealer distribution network through acquisitions, and we anticipate that we may jointly pursue mutually beneficial acquisition opportunities with SHC. However, we may be unable to take advantage of accretive opportunities for any of the following reasons:

    we are unable to identify attractive acquisition opportunities or negotiate acceptable terms;

    we are unable to reach an agreement with SHC regarding the terms of jointly pursued acquisitions;

    we are unable to raise financing for such acquisitions on economically acceptable terms; or

    we are outbid by competitors.

27


Table of Contents

              Pursuant to the omnibus agreement, we will have a three-year option to purchase up to 75 new or recently constructed Stripes ® convenience stores from SHC and lease them back to SHC on specified terms set forth in a lease agreement, including a specified lease rate, for an initial term of 15 years. However, such specified terms may not be economically favorable to us in the future, and we may not choose to exercise this option.

              In addition, we expect to grow through additional sale and leaseback transactions with SHC beyond the 75 store option set forth in the omnibus agreement. However, SHC is under no obligation to pursue acquisitions with us, enter into additional sale and leaseback arrangements with us beyond the 75 store option or generally pursue projects that enhance the value of our business. Finally, we may complete acquisitions which at the time of completion we believe will be accretive, but which ultimately may not be accretive. If any of these events were to occur, our future growth would be limited.

Any acquisitions we complete are subject to substantial risks that could reduce our ability to make distributions to unitholders.

              Even if we do make acquisitions that we believe will increase available cash per unit, these acquisitions may nevertheless result in a decrease in available cash per unit. Any acquisition involves potential risks, including, among other things:

    we may not be able to obtain the cost savings and financial improvements we anticipate or acquired assets may not perform as we expect;

    we may not be able to successfully integrate the businesses we acquire;

    we may fail or be unable to discover some of the liabilities of businesses that we acquire, including liabilities resulting from a prior owner's noncompliance with applicable federal, state or local laws;

    acquisitions may divert the attention of our senior management from focusing on our core business;

    we may experience a decrease in our liquidity by using a significant portion of our available cash or borrowing capacity to finance acquisitions; and

    we face the risk that our existing financial controls, information systems, management resources and human resources will need to grow to support future growth.

Our operations are subject to federal, state and local laws and regulations pertaining to environmental protection and operational safety that may require significant expenditures or result in liabilities that could have a material adverse effect on our business.

              Our business is subject to various federal, state and local environmental laws and regulations, including those relating to underground storage tanks, the release or discharge of regulated materials into the air, water and soil, the generation, storage, handling, use, transportation and disposal of hazardous materials, the exposure of persons to regulated materials, and the health and safety of our employees. A violation of, liability under or compliance with these laws or regulations or any future environmental laws or regulations, could have a material adverse effect on our business and results of operations.

              Where releases of refined petroleum products, renewable fuels and crude oil have occurred, federal and state laws and regulations require that contamination caused by such releases be assessed and remediated to meet applicable standards. The costs associated with the investigation and remediation of contamination, as well as any associated third-party claims, could be substantial, and could have a material adverse effect on our business and results of operations and our ability to make distributions to our unitholders.

28


Table of Contents

New, stricter environmental laws and regulations could significantly increase our costs, which could adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition.

              The trend in environmental regulation is towards more restrictions and limitations on activities that may affect the environment. Our business may be adversely affected by increased costs and liabilities resulting from such stricter laws and regulations. We try to anticipate future regulatory requirements that might be imposed and plan accordingly to remain in compliance with changing environmental laws and regulations and to minimize the costs of such compliance. However, there can be no assurances as to the timing and type of such changes in existing laws or the promulgation of new laws or the amount of any required expenditures associated therewith.

We are subject to federal, state and local laws and regulations that govern the product quality specifications of the refined petroleum products we purchase, store, transport and sell to our distribution customers.

              Various federal, state and local government agencies have the authority to prescribe specific product quality specifications for certain commodities, including commodities that we distribute. Changes in product quality specifications, such as reduced sulfur content in refined petroleum products, or other more stringent requirements for fuels, could reduce our ability to procure product, require us to incur additional handling costs and/or require the expenditure of capital. If we are unable to procure product or recover these costs through increased sales, we may not be able to meet our financial obligations. Failure to comply with these regulations could result in substantial penalties.

The dangers inherent in the storage of motor fuel could cause disruptions in our operations and could expose us to potentially significant losses, costs or liabilities.

              We store motor fuel in underground and above ground storage tanks. Our operations are subject to significant hazards and risks inherent in storing motor fuel. These hazards and risks include, but are not limited to, fires, explosions, spills, discharges and other releases, any of which could result in distribution difficulties and disruptions, environmental pollution, governmentally-imposed fines or clean-up obligations, personal injury or wrongful death claims and other damage to our properties and the properties of others. Any such event could significantly disrupt our operations or expose us to significant liabilities, to the extent such liabilities are not covered by insurance. Therefore, the occurrence of such an event could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash available for distribution to our unitholders.

We are not fully insured against all risks incident to our business.

              We are not fully insured against all risks incident to our business. We may be unable to obtain or maintain insurance with the coverage that we desire at reasonable rates. As a result of market conditions, the premiums and deductibles for certain of our insurance policies have increased and could continue to do so. Certain insurance coverage could become unavailable or available only for reduced amounts of coverage. If we were to incur a significant liability for which we were not fully insured, it could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and ability to make distributions to our unitholders.

Future litigation could adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations.

              We are occasionally exposed to various litigation claims in the ordinary course of our business, including dealer litigation and industry-wide or class-action claims arising from the equipment or processes we use or employ or industry-specific business practices. If we were to become subject to any such claims in the future, our defense costs and any resulting awards or settlement amounts may not be fully covered by our insurance policies. An unfavorable outcome or settlement of any future lawsuits could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, results of operation and cash available for distribution to our unitholders.

29


Table of Contents

We rely on SHC for transportation of all of our motor fuel, which in turn relies, in part, on third-party transportation providers. As a result, a change in SHC's transportation providers, a significant change in SHC's relationship with its transportation providers or nonperformance or a disruption of motor fuel transportation services by SHC or by SHC's transportation providers could have a material adverse effect on our business.

              SHC transports all of our motor fuel from terminals to its Stripes ® convenience stores and third-party dealers pursuant to the SHC Transportation Contract. SHC transports a portion of our motor fuel itself and has contracts with third-party transportation carriers for the remainder of our motor fuel. SHC's third-party contracts with its transportation providers may be terminated by either party upon 30 days' notice. A change in transportation providers, a significant change in SHC's relationship with its transportation providers or nonperformance or a disruption in service by SHC or by SHC's transportation providers could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and cash available for distribution.

We rely on our suppliers to provide trade credit terms to adequately fund our ongoing operations.

              Our business is impacted by the availability of trade credit to fund fuel purchases. An actual or perceived downgrade in our liquidity or operations (including any credit rating downgrade by a rating agency) could cause our suppliers to seek credit support in the form of additional collateral, limit the extension of trade credit, or otherwise materially modify their payment terms. Any material changes in our payments terms, including early payment discounts, or availability of trade credit provided by our principal suppliers could impact our liquidity, results of operations and cash available for distribution to our unitholders.

Because we depend on our senior management's experience and knowledge of our industry, we could be adversely affected were we to lose key members of our senior management team.

              We are dependent on the expertise and continued efforts of our senior management team. If, for any reason, our senior executives do not continue to be active in our management, our business, financial condition or results of operations could be adversely affected. In addition, other than the key man life insurance for Sam L. Susser held by SHC, we do not maintain key man life insurance on our senior executives and other key employees.

Terrorist attacks and threatened or actual war may adversely affect our business.

              Our business is affected by general economic conditions and fluctuations in consumer confidence and spending, which can decline as a result of numerous factors outside of our control. Terrorist attacks or threats, whether within the United States or abroad, rumors or threats of war, actual conflicts involving the United States or its allies, or military or trade disruptions impacting our suppliers or our customers may adversely impact our operations. Specifically, strategic targets such as energy related assets (which could include refineries that produce the motor fuel we purchase or ports in which crude oil is delivered) may be at greater risk of future terrorist attacks than other targets in the United States. These occurrences could have an adverse impact on energy prices, including prices for motor fuels, and an adverse impact on our operations. Any or a combination of these occurrences could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and cash available for distribution to our unitholders.

We rely on our information technology systems to manage numerous aspects of our business, and a disruption of these systems or an act of cyber-terrorism could adversely affect our business.

              We depend on our information technology (IT) systems to manage numerous aspects of our business transactions and provide analytical information to management. Our IT systems are an essential component of our business and growth strategies, and a serious disruption to our IT systems could significantly limit our ability to manage and operate our business efficiently. These systems are

30


Table of Contents

vulnerable to, among other things, damage and interruption from power loss or natural disasters, computer system and network failures, loss of telecommunications services, physical and electronic loss of data, cyber-security breaches or cyber-terrorism, and computer viruses. Any disruption could cause our business and competitive position to suffer and cause our operating results to be reduced.

Our future debt levels may impair our financial condition.

              After giving effect to this offering and the related transactions, we estimate that we would have had approximately $150.8 million of debt outstanding on a pro forma basis as of June 30, 2012, substantially all of which would have been secured by U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities. Following the completion of this offering, we will have the ability to incur additional debt, including under a new revolving credit facility that we will enter into in connection with this offering. The level of our future indebtedness could have important consequences to us, including:

    making it more difficult for us to satisfy our obligations with respect to our credit agreement governing our revolving credit facility;

    limiting our ability to borrow additional amounts to fund working capital, capital expenditures, acquisitions, debt service requirements, the execution of our growth strategy and other activities;

    requiring us to dedicate a substantial portion of our cash flow from operations to pay interest on our debt, which would reduce our cash flow available to fund working capital, capital expenditures, acquisitions, execution of our growth strategy and other activities;

    making us more vulnerable to adverse changes in general economic conditions, our industry and government regulations and in our business by limiting our flexibility in planning for, and making it more difficult for us to react quickly to, changing conditions; and

    placing us at a competitive disadvantage compared with our competitors that have less debt.

              In addition, we may not be able to generate sufficient cash flow from our operations to repay our indebtedness when it becomes due and to meet our other cash needs. Our ability to service our debt will depend upon, among other things, our future financial and operating performance, which will be affected by prevailing economic conditions and financial, business, regulatory and other factors, some of which are beyond our control. In addition, our ability to service our debt will depend on market interest rates, since we anticipate that the interest rates applicable to our borrowings will fluctuate. If we are not able to pay our debts as they become due, we will be required to pursue one or more alternative strategies, such as selling assets, refinancing or restructuring our indebtedness or selling additional debt or equity securities. We may not be able to refinance our debt or sell additional debt or equity securities or our assets on favorable terms, if at all, and if we must sell our assets, it may negatively affect our ability to generate revenues.

Our new credit facilities will have substantial restrictions and financial covenants that may restrict our business and financing activities and our ability to pay distributions to our unitholders.

              We will be dependent upon the earnings and cash flow generated by our operations in order to meet our debt service obligations and to allow us to make cash distributions to our unitholders. The operating and financial restrictions and covenants in our new credit facilities and any future financing agreements may restrict our ability to finance future operations or capital needs, to engage in or expand our business activities or to pay distributions to our unitholders. For example, our new credit facilities will restrict our ability to, among other things:

    Incur additional debt or issue guarantees;

    Incur or permit liens to exist on certain property;

    Make certain investments, acquisitions or other restricted payments;

31


Table of Contents

    Modify or terminate certain material contracts;

    Merge or dispose of all or substantially all of our assets.

              In addition, our new revolving credit agreement will contain covenants requiring us to maintain certain financial ratios. Please read "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources—Our Anticipated New Credit Facilities" for additional information about our credit facilities.

              Our future ability to comply with these restrictions and covenants is uncertain and will be affected by the levels of cash flow from our operations and other events or circumstances beyond our control. If market or other economic conditions deteriorate, our ability to comply with these covenants may be impaired. If we violate any provisions of our new credit facilities that are not cured or waived within the appropriate time periods provided in the applicable credit facility, a significant portion of our indebtedness may become immediately due and payable, our ability to make distributions to our unitholders will be inhibited and our lenders' commitment to make further loans to us may terminate. We might not have, or be able to obtain, sufficient funds to make these accelerated payments.

              If we were unable to repay the accelerated amounts, our lenders could proceed against the collateral granted to them to secure such debt. If the payment of our debt is accelerated, our assets may be insufficient to repay such debt in full, which could result in our insolvency. In the event of our insolvency, the holders of our units could experience a partial or total loss of their investment. Our revolving credit facility will also have cross-default provisions that apply to our term loan facility and to other indebtedness we may have with an outstanding principal amount in excess of $12.5 million. Our term loan facility will have cross default provisions that apply to our revolving credit facility.

We depend on cash flow generated by our subsidiaries.

              We are a holding company with no material assets other than the equity interests in our subsidiaries. Upon completion of this offering, we will have three subsidiaries that conduct all of our operations and own all of our assets. These subsidiaries will be distinct legal entities and, under certain circumstances, legal and contractual restrictions may limit our ability to obtain cash from our subsidiaries and our subsidiaries may not be able to, or be permitted to, make distributions to us. In the event that we do not receive distributions from our subsidiaries, we may be unable to meet our financial obligations or make distributions to our unitholders.

The impact of derivatives legislation by the United States Congress could have an adverse effect on our ability to use derivative instruments to reduce the effect of changes in commodity prices and interest rates and other risks associated with our business.

              The United States Congress recently adopted comprehensive financial reform legislation that establishes federal oversight and regulation of the over-the-counter derivatives market and entities, such as us, that participate in that market. The new legislation, known as the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the "Dodd-Frank Act") was signed into law on July 21, 2010 and requires the Commodities Futures Trading Commission (the "CFTC"), the SEC and other regulators to promulgate rules and regulations implementing the new legislation. The CFTC has issued final regulations to set position limits for certain futures and option contracts in the major energy markets and for swaps that are their economic equivalent. Certain bona fide hedging transactions or positions would be exempt from these position limits. The financial reform legislation may also require compliance with margin requirements and with certain clearing and trade-execution requirements in connection with certain derivative activities, although the application of those provisions is uncertain at this time. The financial reform legislation may also require the counterparties to our derivative instruments to spin off some of their derivatives activities to a separate entity, which may not be as creditworthy as the current counterparty.

32


Table of Contents

              The final rules will be phased in over time according to a specified schedule which is dependent on the finalization of certain other rules to be promulgated jointly by the CFTC and the SEC. The Dodd-Frank Act and any new regulations could significantly increase the cost of some derivative contracts (including through requirements to post collateral which could adversely affect our available liquidity), materially alter the terms of some derivative contracts, reduce the availability of some derivatives to protect against risks we encounter, reduce our ability to monetize or restructure our existing derivative contracts, and potentially increase our exposure to less creditworthy counterparties. Any of these consequences could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, results of operations and cash available for distribution to our unitholders.

Changes in accounting standards, policies, estimates or procedures may impact our reported financial condition or results of operations.

              The accounting standard setters, including the Financial Accounting Standards Board, the SEC and other regulatory bodies, periodically change the financial accounting and reporting standards that govern the preparation of our financial statements. These changes can be difficult to predict and can materially impact how we record and report our financial condition and results of operations. In some cases, we could be required to apply a new or revised standard retroactively, resulting in the restatement of prior period financial statements. In addition, the preparation of consolidated financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires management to make significant estimates that affect the financial statements. Due to the inherent nature of these estimates, no assurance can be given that we will not be required to recognize significant, unexpected losses due to actual results varying materially from management's estimates. Additional information regarding our critical accounting policies can be found in the section captioned "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Significant Accounting Policies and Estimates."


Risks Inherent in an Investment in Us

SHC owns and controls our general partner, which has sole responsibility for conducting our business and managing our operations. Our general partner and its affiliates, including SHC, have conflicts of interest with us and limited fiduciary duties and they may favor their own interests to the detriment of us and our unitholders.

              Following this offering, SHC will own and control our general partner and will appoint all of the officers and directors of our general partner. All of the officers and certain of the directors of our general partner are also officers and/or directors of SHC. Although our general partner has a fiduciary duty to manage us in a manner beneficial to us and our unitholders, the executive officers and directors of our general partner have a fiduciary duty to manage our general partner in a manner beneficial to SHC. Therefore, conflicts of interest may arise between SHC and its affiliates, including our general partner, on the one hand, and us and our unitholders, on the other hand. In resolving these conflicts of interest, our general partner may favor its own interests and the interests of its affiliates over the interests of our common unitholders. These conflicts include the following situations, among others:

    Neither our partnership agreement nor any other agreement requires SHC to pursue a business strategy that favors us. The affiliates of our general partner have fiduciary duties to make decisions in their own best interests and in the best interest of their owners, which may be contrary to our interests. In addition, our general partner is allowed to take into account the interests of parties other than us or our unitholders, such as SHC, in resolving conflicts of interest, which has the effect of limiting its fiduciary duty to our unitholders.

    All of the officers and certain of the directors of our general partner are also officers and/or directors of SHC and will owe fiduciary duties to SHC. Certain officers of our general partner will also devote significant time to the business of SHC and will be compensated by SHC accordingly.

33


Table of Contents

    Other than as provided in the omnibus agreement, SHC is not limited in its ability to compete with us and may offer business opportunities or sell assets to parties other than us.

    The limited partner interests that SHC will initially own will permit it to effectively control any vote of our limited partners. SHC will be entitled to vote its units in accordance with its own interests, which may be contrary to the interests of our other unitholders.

    Our partnership agreement limits the liability of, and reduces the fiduciary duties owed by, our general partner and also restricts the remedies available to unitholders for actions that, without the limitations, might constitute breaches of fiduciary duty. As a result of purchasing common units, unitholders consent to some actions and conflicts of interest that might otherwise constitute a breach of fiduciary or other duties under applicable state law.

    Except in limited circumstances, our general partner has the power and authority to conduct our business without unitholder approval.

    Our general partner determines the amount and timing of asset purchases and sales, borrowings, repayment of indebtedness and issuances of additional partnership securities and the level of reserves, each of which can affect the amount of cash that is distributed to our unitholders.

    Our general partner determines whether or not to purchase and lease stores to SHC pursuant to our 75 store option.

    Our general partner determines the amount and timing of any capital expenditure and whether a capital expenditure is classified as a maintenance capital expenditure or an expansion capital expenditure. Please read "Provisions of Our Partnership Agreement Relating to Cash Distributions—Capital Expenditures." These determinations can affect the amount of cash that is distributed to our unitholders which, in turn, affects the ability of the subordinated units to convert to common units. Please read "Provisions of Our Partnership Agreement Relating to Cash Distributions—Subordinated Units."

    Our general partner may cause us to borrow funds in order to permit the payment of cash distributions, even if the purpose or effect of the borrowing is to make a distribution on the subordinated units, to make incentive distributions or to accelerate the expiration of the subordination period.

    Our partnership agreement permits us to distribute up to $             million as operating surplus, even if it is generated from asset sales, non-working capital borrowings or other sources that would otherwise constitute capital surplus. This cash may be used to fund distributions on our subordinated units or the incentive distribution rights.

    Our general partner determines which costs incurred by it and its affiliates are reimbursable by us.

    Our partnership agreement does not restrict our general partner from causing us to pay it or its affiliates for any services rendered to us or entering into additional contractual arrangements with its affiliates on our behalf. There is no limitation on the amounts our general partner can cause us to pay it or its affiliates.

    Our general partner intends to limit its liability regarding our contractual and other obligations.

    Our general partner may exercise its right to call and purchase common units if it and its affiliates own more than 80% of the common units.

    Our general partner will control the enforcement of obligations owed to us by it and its affiliates. In addition, our general partner will decide whether to retain separate counsel or others to perform services for us.

34


Table of Contents

    SHC may elect to cause us to issue common units to it in connection with a resetting of the target distribution levels related to SHC's incentive distribution rights without the approval of the conflicts committee of the board of directors of our general partner or our unitholders. This election may result in lower distributions to our common unitholders in certain situations.

Our general partner intends to limit its liability regarding our obligations.

              Other than with respect to our new credit facilities, our general partner intends to limit its liability under contractual arrangements so that the counterparties to such arrangements have recourse only against our assets, and not against our general partner or its assets. Our general partner may therefore cause us to incur indebtedness or other obligations that are nonrecourse to our general partner. Our partnership agreement provides that any action taken by our general partner to limit its liability is not a breach of our general partner's fiduciary duties, even if we could have obtained more favorable terms without the limitation on liability. In addition, we are obligated to reimburse or indemnify our general partner to the extent that it incurs obligations on our behalf. Any such reimbursement or indemnification payments would reduce the amount of cash otherwise available for distribution to our unitholders.

Our partnership agreement requires that we distribute all of our available cash, which could limit our ability to grow and make acquisitions.

              Our partnership agreement requires that we distribute all of our available cash to our unitholders, and we will rely primarily upon external financing sources, including borrowings under our revolving credit facility and the issuance of debt and equity securities, to fund our acquisitions and expansion capital expenditures. As a result, to the extent we are unable to finance growth externally, our cash distribution policy will significantly impair our ability to grow.

              In addition, because we distribute all of our available cash, our growth may not be as fast as that of businesses that reinvest their available cash to expand ongoing operations. To the extent we issue additional units in connection with any acquisitions or expansion capital expenditures, the payment of distributions on those additional units may increase the risk that we will be unable to maintain or increase our per unit distribution level. There are no limitations in our partnership agreement or our new credit facilities on our ability to issue additional units, including units ranking senior to the common units. The incurrence of bank borrowings or other debt to finance our growth strategy will result in increased interest expense, which, in turn, may impact the available cash that we have to distribute to our unitholders.

Our partnership agreement limits the liability and duties of our general partner and restricts the remedies available to us and our common unitholders for actions taken by our general partner that might otherwise constitute breaches of fiduciary duty.

              Our partnership agreement limits the liability and duties of our general partner, while also restricting the remedies available to our common unitholders for actions that, without these limitations, might constitute breaches of fiduciary duty. Delaware partnership law permits such contractual reductions of fiduciary duty. By purchasing common units, common unitholders consent to be bound by the partnership agreement, and pursuant to our partnership agreement, each holder of common units consents to various actions and conflicts of interest contemplated in our partnership agreement that might otherwise constitute a breach of fiduciary or other duties under Delaware law. Our partnership agreement contains provisions that reduce the standards to which our general partner would otherwise be held by state fiduciary duty law. For example:

    Our partnership agreement permits our general partner to make a number of decisions in its individual capacity, as opposed to its capacity as general partner. This entitles our general partner to consider only the interests and factors that it desires, and it has no duty or

35


Table of Contents

      obligation to give any consideration to any interest of, or factors affecting, our common unitholders. Decisions made by our general partner in its individual capacity will be made by SHC, as the owner of our general partner, and not by the board of directors of our general partner. Examples of these decisions include:

      Whether to exercise its limited call right;

      How to exercise its voting rights with respect to any units it may own;

      Whether to exercise its registration rights; and

      Whether or not to consent to any merger or consolidation or amendment to our partnership agreement.

    Our partnership agreement provides that our general partner will not have any liability to us or our unitholders for decisions made in its capacity as general partner so long as it acted in good faith, meaning it believed that the decisions were not adverse to the interests of our partnership.

    Our partnership agreement provides that our general partner and the officers and directors of our general partner will not be liable for monetary damages to us for any acts or omissions unless there has been a final and non-appealable judgment entered by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that our general partner or those persons acted in bad faith or, in the case of a criminal matter, acted with knowledge that such person's conduct was criminal.

    Our partnership agreement provides that our general partner will not be in breach of its obligations under the partnership agreement or its duties to us or our limited partners with respect to any transaction involving an affiliate if:

    the transaction with an affiliate or the resolution of a conflict of interest is:

    approved by the conflicts committee of the board of directors of our general partner, although our general partner is not obligated to seek such approval; or

    approved by the vote of a majority of the outstanding common units, excluding any common units owned by our general partner and its affiliates; or

    the board of directors of our general partner acted in good faith in taking any action or failing to act.

              If an affiliate transaction or the resolution of a conflict of interest is not approved by our common unitholders or the conflicts committee then it will be presumed that, in making its decision, taking any action or failing to act, the board of directors acted in good faith, and in any proceeding brought by or on behalf of any limited partner or the partnership, the person bringing or prosecuting such proceeding will have the burden of overcoming such presumption. Please read "Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties."

              By purchasing a common unit, a unitholder will become bound by the provisions of our partnership agreement, including the provisions described above. See "Description of the Common Units—Transfer of Common Units."

SHC may compete with us or contract with third-party wholesalers to distribute motor fuel to SHC's convenience stores on a consignment basis.

              Pursuant to the omnibus agreement and SHC Distribution Contract, for a period of ten years, we will be the exclusive distributor of all motor fuel purchased by SHC for its existing Stripes ®

36


Table of Contents

convenience stores and independently operated consignment locations. Additionally, SHC must purchase any motor fuel it sells at its newly built, acquired or added retail stores from us, except if such stores are already party to a supply agreement or in the case of third-party consignment sales described below. If these provisions of the SHC Distribution Contract and omnibus agreement expire at the end of their respective ten-year terms and are not renewed, SHC will no longer be required to purchase motor fuel from us (except in the case of delivery arrangements that under the SHC Distribution Contract extend beyond the ten-year term). SHC could then compete with us to deliver motor fuel to its Stripes ® stores and consignment locations. Furthermore, subject to our right to participate in acquisitions, SHC is permitted to compete with us for investment opportunities, and SHC is permitted to own an interest in entities that compete with us.

              Under the omnibus agreement, SHC will continue to have the right to contract for third-party consignment sales of motor fuel with other wholesalers at any newly constructed or acquired locations. Under these arrangements, as the consignee, SHC would not purchase any fuel and would instead receive a commission on sales made by the wholesaler. As a result, we will not distribute any volumes nor earn any revenues for fuel sold at that store. SHC is under no obligation to purchase fuel from us for its convenience stores if it determines that consignment arrangements with third parties are more advantageous to SHC and its shareholders.

              Pursuant to the terms of our partnership agreement, the doctrine of corporate opportunity, or any analogous doctrine, will not apply to our general partner or any of its affiliates, including its executive officers and directors and SHC. Any such person or entity will not be liable to us or to any limited partner under our partnership agreement for breach of any fiduciary duty or other duty by reason of the fact that such person or entity pursues or acquires such opportunity for itself, directs such opportunity to another person or entity or does not communicate such opportunity or information to us. This may create actual and potential conflicts of interest between us and affiliates of our general partner and result in less than favorable treatment of us and our unitholders. Please read "Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties."

SHC may elect to cause us to issue common units to it in connection with a resetting of the target distribution levels related to its incentive distribution rights, without the approval of the conflicts committee of our general partner's board of directors or the holders of our common units. This could result in lower distributions to holders of our common units.

              SHC has the right, at any time when there are no subordinated units outstanding and it has received incentive distributions at the highest level to which it is entitled (50%) for each of the prior four consecutive whole fiscal quarters (and the amount of each such did not exceed adjusted operating surplus for each such quarter), to reset the initial target distribution levels at higher levels based on our cash distributions at the time of the exercise of the reset election. Following a reset election by SHC, the minimum quarterly distribution will be adjusted to equal the reset minimum quarterly distribution, and the target distribution levels will be reset to correspondingly higher levels based on the same percentage increases above the reset minimum quarterly distribution reflected by the current target distribution levels.

              If SHC elects to reset the target distribution levels, it will be entitled to receive a number of common units equal the number of common units which would have entitled their holder to an average aggregate quarterly cash distribution in the prior two quarters equal to the average of the distributions to SHC on the incentive distribution rights in the prior two quarters. We anticipate that SHC would exercise this reset right in order to facilitate acquisitions or internal growth projects that would not be sufficiently accretive to cash distributions per common unit without such conversion. It is possible, however, that SHC could exercise this reset election at a time when it is experiencing, or expects to experience, declines in the cash distributions it receives related to its incentive distribution rights and may, therefore, desire to be issued common units rather than retain the right to receive incentive distributions based on the initial target distribution levels. As a result, a reset election may cause our

37


Table of Contents

common unitholders to experience a reduction in the amount of cash distributions that they would have otherwise received had we not issued new common units to SHC in connection with resetting the target distribution levels. Please read "Provisions of Our Partnership Agreement Relating to Cash Distributions—SHC's Right to Reset Incentive Distribution Levels."

Holders of our common units have limited voting rights and are not entitled to elect our general partner or its directors, which could reduce the price at which our common units will trade.

              Unlike the holders of common stock in a corporation, our unitholders will have only limited voting rights on matters affecting our business and, therefore, limited ability to influence management's decisions regarding our business. Our unitholders will have no right on an annual or ongoing basis to elect our general partner or its board of directors. The board of directors of our general partner, including the independent directors, will be chosen entirely by SHC due to its ownership of our general partner, and not by our unitholders. Please read "Management—Management of Susser Petroleum Partners LP" and "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions." Unlike a publicly traded corporation, we will not conduct annual meetings of our unitholders to elect directors or conduct other matters routinely conducted at annual meetings of stockholders of corporations. Our partnership agreement also contains provisions limiting the ability of unitholders to call meetings or to acquire information about our operations, as well as other provisions limiting our unitholders' ability to influence the manner or direction of management. As a result of these limitations, the price at which the common units will trade could be diminished because of the absence or reduction of a takeover premium in the trading price.

Even if holders of our common units are dissatisfied, they cannot initially remove our general partner without its consent.

              If our unitholders are dissatisfied with the performance of our general partner, they will have limited ability to remove our general partner. Unitholders initially will be unable to remove our general partner without its consent because our general partner and its affiliates will own sufficient units upon the completion of this offering to be able to prevent its removal. The vote of the holders of at least 66 2 / 3 % of all our outstanding common and subordinated units voting together as a single class is required to remove our general partner. Following the closing of this offering, SHC will own, directly or indirectly, an aggregate of        % of our common and subordinated units (or        % of our common and subordinated units, if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional common units in full). Also, if our general partner is removed without cause during the subordination period and no units held by our general partner or its affiliates are voted in favor of that removal, all remaining subordinated units will automatically convert into common units and any existing arrearages on the common units will be extinguished. Cause is narrowly defined in our partnership agreement to mean that a court of competent jurisdiction has entered a final, non-appealable judgment finding our general partner liable for actual fraud or willful or wanton misconduct in its capacity as our general partner. Cause does not include most cases of charges of poor management of the business.

Unitholders will experience immediate and substantial dilution in pro forma net tangible book value of $            per common unit.

              The estimated initial public offering price of $            per common unit exceeds our pro forma net tangible book value of $            per common unit. Based on the estimated initial public offering price of $            per common unit, unitholders will incur immediate and substantial dilution of $            per common unit. This dilution results primarily because the assets contributed to us by affiliates of our general partner are recorded at their historical cost in accordance with GAAP, and not their fair value. Please read "Dilution."

38


Table of Contents

Our general partner interest or the control of our general partner may be transferred to a third party without unitholder consent.

              Our general partner may transfer its general partner interest to a third party without the consent of our unitholders in a merger, in a sale of all or substantially all of its assets or in other transactions so long as certain conditions are satisfied. Please read "The Partnership Agreement—Transfer of General Partner Interest." Furthermore, our partnership agreement does not restrict the ability of SHC to transfer all or a portion of its direct or indirect interest in our general partner to a third party. Any new owner of our general partner or our general partner interest would then be in a position to replace the board of directors and executive officers of our general partner with its own designees without the consent of unitholders and thereby exert significant control over us, and may change our business strategy. Any of these changes, or any other changes resulting from a change in control of our general partner or general partner interest, may lower the trading price of our common units and otherwise have a material adverse effect on us.

The incentive distribution rights may be transferred by SHC to a third party without unitholder consent.

              SHC may transfer all or a portion of its incentive distribution rights to a third party at any time without the consent of our unitholders. If SHC transfers its incentive distribution rights to a third party but retains its ownership interest in our general partner, it would not have the same incentive to grow our partnership and increase quarterly distributions to unitholders over time as it would if it had retained ownership of the incentive distribution rights. For example, a transfer of incentive distribution rights by SHC could reduce the likelihood of SHC renewing the SHC Distribution Contract, entering into additional sale and leaseback transactions or otherwise negotiating supply terms with respect to future volumes, as SHC would have less of an economic incentive to grow our business.

Our general partner has a limited call right that may require unitholders to sell their common units at an undesirable time or price.

              If at any time our general partner and its affiliates own more than 80% of the common units, our general partner will have the right, which it may assign to any of its affiliates or to us, but not the obligation, to acquire all, but not less than all, of the common units held by unaffiliated persons at a price equal to the greater of (1) the average of the daily closing price of the common units over the 20 trading days preceding the date three days before notice of exercise of the call right is first mailed and (2) the highest per-unit price paid by our general partner or any of its affiliates for common units during the 90-day period preceding the date such notice is first mailed. As a result, unitholders may be required to sell their common units at an undesirable time or price and may not receive any return or a negative return on their investment. Unitholders may also incur a tax liability upon a sale of their units. Our general partner is not obligated to obtain a fairness opinion regarding the value of the common units to be repurchased by it upon exercise of the limited call right. There is no restriction in our partnership agreement that prevents our general partner from issuing additional common units and exercising its call right. If our general partner exercised its limited call right, the effect would be to take us private and, if the units were subsequently deregistered, we would no longer be subject to the reporting requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, or the Exchange Act. Upon completion of this offering, and assuming no exercise of the underwriters' option to purchase additional common units, SHC will own, directly or indirectly, an aggregate of approximately        % of our common units. At the end of the subordination period, assuming no additional issuances of units (other than upon the conversion of the subordinated units), SHC will own approximately        % of our common units. For additional information about the limited call right, please read "The Partnership Agreement—Limited Call Right."

39


Table of Contents

We may issue additional units without unitholder approval, which would dilute existing unitholder ownership interests.

              Our partnership agreement does not limit the number of additional limited partner interests we may issue at any time without the approval of our unitholders. The issuance of additional common units or other equity interests of equal or senior rank will have the following effects:

    our existing unitholders' proportionate ownership interest in us will decrease;

    the amount of cash available for distribution on each unit may decrease;

    because a lower percentage of total outstanding units will be subordinated units, the risk that a shortfall in the payment of the minimum quarterly distribution will be borne by our common unitholders will increase;

    the ratio of taxable income to distributions may increase;

    the relative voting strength of each previously outstanding unit may be diminished; and

    the market price of the common units may decline.

              Please read "The Partnership Agreement—Issuance of Additional Interests."

The market price of our common units could be adversely affected by sales of substantial amounts of our common units in the public or private markets, including sales by SHC or other large holders.

              After this offering, we will have                        common units and                                    subordinated units outstanding, which includes the                         common units we are selling in this offering that may be resold in the public market immediately (                        common units if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional common units). All of the subordinated units will convert into common units on a one-for-one basis at the end of the subordination period. Although all of the                        common units (                        common units if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional common units) that are issued to SHC or a wholly owned subsidiary of SHC will be subject to resale restrictions, such restrictions may be waived in the discretion of certain of the underwriters. In addition, under our partnership agreement, our general partner and its affiliates have registration rights relating to the offer and sale of any units that they hold, subject to certain limitations. Please read "Units Eligible for Future Sale." Sales by SHC or other large holders of a substantial number of our common units in the public markets following this offering, or the perception that such sales might occur, could have a material adverse effect on the price of our common units or could impair our ability to obtain capital through an offering of equity securities.

Our partnership agreement restricts the voting rights of unitholders owning 20% or more of our outstanding common units.

              Our partnership agreement restricts unitholders' voting rights by providing that any units held by a person or group that owns 20% or more of any class of units then outstanding, other than our general partner and its affiliates, their transferees and persons who acquired such units with the prior approval of the board of directors of our general partner, cannot be voted on any matter.

Cost reimbursements due to our general partner and its affiliates for services provided to us or on our behalf will reduce cash available for distribution to our unitholders. The amount and timing of such reimbursements will be determined by our general partner.

              Prior to making any distribution on the common units, we will reimburse our general partner and its affiliates for all expenses they incur and payments they make on our behalf pursuant to the

40


Table of Contents

omnibus agreement and our partnership agreement. Neither our partnership agreement nor our omnibus agreement will limit the amount of expenses for which our general partner and its affiliates may be reimbursed. Our omnibus agreement and partnership agreement provide that our general partner will determine in good faith the expenses that are allocable to us. The reimbursement of expenses and payment of fees to our general partner and its affiliates will reduce the amount of cash available to pay cash distributions to our unitholders. Please read "Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions."

The amount of cash we have available for distribution to holders of our units depends primarily on our cash flow and not solely on profitability, which may prevent us from making cash distributions during periods when we record net income.

              The amount of cash we have available for distribution depends primarily upon our cash flow, including cash flow from working capital or other borrowings, and not solely on profitability, which will be affected by non-cash items. As a result, we may pay cash distributions during periods when we record net losses for financial accounting purposes and may not pay cash distributions during periods when we record net income.

While our partnership agreement requires us to distribute all of our available cash, our partnership agreement, including the provisions requiring us to make cash distributions, may be amended.

              While our partnership agreement requires us to distribute all of our available cash, our partnership agreement, including the provisions requiring us to make cash distributions, may be amended. Our partnership agreement generally may not be amended during the subordination period without the approval of our public common unitholders. However, our partnership agreement can be amended with the consent of our general partner and the approval of a majority of the outstanding common units (including common units held by SHC or its wholly owned subsidiary) after the subordination period has ended. At the closing of this offering, SHC will own, directly or indirectly, approximately        % of the outstanding common units and all of our outstanding subordinated units. Please read "The Partnership Agreement—Amendment of the Partnership Agreement."

There is no existing market for our common units, and a trading market that will provide unitholders with adequate liquidity may not develop. The price of our common units may fluctuate significantly, and unitholders could lose all or part of their investment.

              Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for our common units. After this offering, there will be only                         publicly traded common units (                        common units if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional common units in full). We do not know the extent to which investor interest will lead to the development of a trading market or how liquid that market might be. Unitholders may not be able to resell their common units at or above the initial public offering price. Additionally, the lack of liquidity may result in wide bid-ask spreads, contribute to significant fluctuations in the market price of the common units and limit the number of investors who are able to buy the common units.

              The initial public offering price for our common units will be determined by negotiations between us and the representative of the underwriters and may not be indicative of the market price of the common units that will prevail in the trading market. The market price of our common units may decline below the initial public offering price. The market price of our common units may also be influenced by many factors, some of which are beyond our control, including:

    our quarterly distributions;

    our quarterly or annual earnings or those of other companies in our industry;

    announcements by us or our competitors of significant contracts or acquisitions;

41


Table of Contents

    changes in accounting standards, policies, guidance, interpretations or principles;

    general economic conditions;

    the failure of securities analysts to cover our common units after this offering or changes in financial estimates by analysts;

    future sales of our common units; and

    the other factors described in these "Risk Factors."

Unitholders may have liability to repay distributions and in certain circumstances may be personally liable for the obligations of the partnership.

              Under certain circumstances, unitholders may have to repay amounts wrongfully returned or distributed to them. Under Section 17-607 of the Delaware Revised Uniform Limited Partnership Act, or the Delaware Act, we may not make a distribution to our unitholders if the distribution would cause our liabilities to exceed the fair value of our assets. Delaware law provides that for a period of three years from the date of an impermissible distribution, limited partners who received the distribution and who knew at the time of the distribution that it violated Delaware law will be liable to the limited partnership for the distribution amount. A purchaser of units who becomes a limited partner is liable for the obligations of the transferring limited partner to make contributions to the partnership that are known to such purchaser at the time it became a limited partner and for unknown obligations if the liabilities could be determined from the partnership agreement. Liabilities to partners on account of their partnership interests and liabilities that are non-recourse to the partnership are not counted for purposes of determining whether a distribution is permitted.

              In addition, it may be determined that the right, or the exercise of the right by the limited partners as a group, to (i) remove or replace our general partner, (ii) approve some amendments to our partnership agreement or (iii) take other action under our partnership agreement constitutes "participation in the control" of our business. A limited partner that participates in the control of our business within the meaning of the Delaware Act may be held personally liable for our obligations under the laws of Delaware, to the same extent as our general partner. This liability would extend to persons who transact business with us under the reasonable belief that the limited partner is a general partner. In addition, we conduct business in a number of other states in which the limitations on the liability of holders of limited partner interests for the obligations of a limited partnership have not been clearly established. Neither our partnership agreement nor the Delaware Act specifically provides for legal recourse against our general partner if a limited partner were to lose limited liability through any fault of our general partner. Please read "The Partnership Agreement—Limited Liability."

The NYSE does not require a publicly traded partnership like us to comply with certain corporate governance requirements.

              Our common units have been approved for listing on the NYSE, subject to official notice of issuance. Because we will be a publicly traded partnership, the NYSE will not require us to have a majority of independent directors on our general partner's board of directors or to establish a compensation committee or a nominating and corporate governance committee. Accordingly, unitholders will not have the same protections afforded to stockholders of corporations that are subject to all of the corporate governance requirements of the applicable stock exchange. Please read "Management—Management of Susser Petroleum Partners LP."

We will incur increased costs as a result of being a publicly traded partnership.

              We have no history operating as a publicly traded partnership. As a publicly traded partnership, we will incur significant legal, accounting and other expenses that we did not incur prior to this

42


Table of Contents

offering. For example, the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, as well as rules implemented by the SEC and the NYSE, require publicly traded entities to adopt various corporate governance practices that will further increase our costs, including requirements to have at least three independent directors, create an audit committee and adopt policies regarding internal controls and disclosure controls and procedures, including the preparation of reports on internal controls over financial reporting.

              In addition, following this offering, we will become subject to the public reporting requirements of the Exchange Act. We expect these rules and regulations to increase certain of our legal and financial compliance costs and to make certain activities more time-consuming and costly.

              We also expect to incur significant expense in order to obtain director and officer liability insurance. Because of the limitations in coverage for directors, it may be more difficult for us to attract and retain qualified persons to serve on our general partner's board or as executive officers.

              We estimate that we will incur approximately $2.0 million of incremental external costs per year and additional internal costs associated with being a publicly traded partnership. However, it is possible that our actual incremental costs of being a publicly traded partnership will be higher than we currently estimate. Before we are able to make distributions to our unitholders, we must first pay or reserve cash for our expenses, including the costs of being a publicly traded partnership. As a result, the amount of cash we have available for distribution to our unitholders will be reduced by the costs associated with being a public company.

If we fail to develop or maintain an effective system of internal controls, we may not be able to report our financial results accurately or prevent fraud, which would likely have a negative impact on the market price of our common units.

              SHC is a publicly traded corporation and has developed a system of internal controls for compliance with public reporting requirements. However, prior to this offering, our predecessor has not been required to file reports with the SEC on a stand-alone basis and will have lower materiality thresholds on the wholesale business than SHC previously has had. Upon the completion of this offering, we will become subject to the public reporting requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, or the Exchange Act. We prepare our consolidated financial statements in accordance with GAAP, but our internal accounting controls may not currently meet all standards applicable to companies with publicly traded securities. Effective internal controls are necessary for us to provide reliable financial reports, prevent fraud and to operate successfully as a publicly traded partnership. Our efforts to develop and maintain our internal controls may not be successful, and we may be unable to maintain effective controls over our financial processes and reporting in the future or to comply with our obligations under Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, which we refer to as Section 404. For example, Section 404 will require us, among other things, to annually review and report on, and our independent registered public accounting firm to attest to, the effectiveness of our internal controls over financial reporting. We must comply with Section 404 for our fiscal year ending December 31, 2013. Any failure to develop, implement or maintain effective internal controls or to improve our internal controls could harm our operating results or cause us to fail to meet our reporting obligations. Given the difficulties inherent in the design and operation of internal controls over financial reporting, we can provide no assurance as to our, or our independent registered public accounting firm's, conclusions about the effectiveness of our internal controls, and we may incur significant costs in our efforts to comply with Section 404. Ineffective internal controls will subject us to regulatory scrutiny and a loss of confidence in our reported financial information, which could have an adverse effect on our business and would likely have a negative effect on the trading price of our common units.

43


Table of Contents

An increase in interest rates will increase our borrowing costs and may cause the market price of our common units to decline.

              Like all equity investments, an investment in our common units is subject to certain risks. Borrowings under the new credit facilities will bear interest at variable rates. If market interest rates increase, such variable-rate debt will create higher debt service requirements, which could adversely affect our cash flow and ability to make cash distributions. In exchange for accepting these risks, investors may expect to receive a higher rate of return than would otherwise be obtainable from lower-risk investments. Accordingly, as interest rates rise, the ability of investors to obtain higher risk-adjusted rates of return by purchasing government-backed debt securities may cause a corresponding decline in demand for riskier investments generally, including yield-based equity investments such as publicly traded limited partnership interests. Reduced demand for our common units resulting from investors seeking other more favorable investment opportunities may cause the trading price of our common units to decline.


Tax Risks to Common Unitholders

              In addition to reading the following risk factors, please read "Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences" for a more complete discussion of the expected material federal income tax consequences of owning and disposing of common units.

Our tax treatment depends on our status as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes, as well as our not being subject to a material amount of entity-level taxation by individual states. If the IRS were to treat us as a corporation for federal income tax purposes or we were to become subject to material additional amounts of entity-level taxation for state tax purposes, then our cash available for distribution to our unitholders would be substantially reduced.

              The anticipated after-tax economic benefit of an investment in our common units depends largely on our being treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes. We have not requested, and do not plan to request, a ruling from the Internal Revenue Service, or the IRS, on this or any other tax matter affecting us.

              Despite the fact that we are organized as a limited partnership under Delaware law, it is possible in certain circumstances for a partnership such as ours to be treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes. Although we do not believe, based upon our current operations, that we will be so treated, a change in our business (or a change in current law) could cause us to be treated as a corporation for federal income tax purposes or otherwise subject us to taxation as an entity.

              If we were treated as a corporation for federal income tax purposes, we would pay federal income tax on our taxable income at the corporate tax rate, which is currently a maximum of 35%, and would likely pay state income tax at varying rates. Distributions to our unitholders would generally be taxed again as corporate distributions, and no income, gains, losses, deductions or credits would flow through to our unitholders. Because a tax would be imposed upon us as a corporation, our cash available for distribution to our unitholders would be substantially reduced. Therefore, treatment of us as a corporation would result in a material reduction in the anticipated cash flow and after-tax return to our unitholders, likely causing a substantial reduction in the value of our common units.

              We will be subject to the entity-level Texas franchise tax. Imposition of any such additional taxes on us or an increase in the existing tax rates would reduce the cash available for distribution to our unitholders.

              Our partnership agreement provides that if a law is enacted or existing law is modified or interpreted in a manner that subjects us to taxation as a corporation or otherwise subjects us to entity-level taxation for federal, state or local income tax purposes, the minimum quarterly distribution amount and the target distribution amounts may be adjusted to reflect the impact of that law on us.

44


Table of Contents

The tax treatment of publicly traded partnerships or an investment in our common units could be subject to potential legislative, judicial or administrative changes and differing interpretations, possibly on a retroactive basis.

              The present federal income tax treatment of publicly traded partnerships, including us, or an investment in our common units may be modified by administrative, legislative or judicial interpretation at any time. For example, from time to time, members of the U.S. Congress propose and consider substantive changes to the existing federal income tax laws that affect publicly traded partnerships. Currently, one such legislative proposal would eliminate the qualifying income exception upon which we rely for our treatment as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes. Please read "Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences—Taxation of the Partnership—Partnership Status." We are unable to predict whether any such legislation will ultimately be enacted. However, it is possible that a change in law could affect us and may, if enacted, be applied retroactively. Any such changes could negatively impact the value of an investment in our common units

We have a subsidiary that is treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes and is subject to corporate-level income tax.

              We conduct a portion of our operations through a subsidiary that is treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes. We intend to engage in our sale and leaseback transactions with SHC, and may elect to conduct additional operations, through this subsidiary in the future. This subsidiary is subject to U.S. corporate-level tax, which may reduce the cash available for distribution to us and, in turn, to our unitholders. If the IRS were to successfully assert that this corporation has more tax liability than we anticipate or legislation were to be enacted that increased the corporate tax rate, our cash available for distribution to our unitholders would be further reduced.

Our unitholders will be required to pay taxes on their share of our income even if they do not receive any cash distributions from us.

              Because our unitholders will be treated as partners to whom we will allocate taxable income that could be different in amount than the cash we distribute, our unitholders will be required to pay federal income taxes and, in some cases, state and local income taxes on their share of our taxable income whether or not they receive cash distributions from us. Our unitholders may not receive cash distributions from us equal to their share of our taxable income or even equal to the actual tax liability that results from that income.

The sale or exchange of 50% or more of our capital and profits interests during any twelve-month period will result in the termination of our partnership for federal income tax purposes.

              We will be considered to have terminated our partnership for federal income tax purposes if there is a sale or exchange of 50% or more of the total interests in our capital and profits within a twelve-month period. Immediately following this offering, SHC will directly and indirectly own more than 50% of the total interests in our capital and profits. Therefore, a transfer by SHC of all or a portion of its direct or indirect interests in us could result in a termination of our partnership for federal income tax purposes. Our termination would, among other things, result in the closing of our taxable year for all unitholders and could result in a deferral of depreciation or amortization deductions allowable in computing our taxable income. In the case of a unitholder reporting on a taxable year other than the calendar year, the closing of our taxable year may also result in more than twelve months of our taxable income or loss being includable in his taxable income for the year of termination. Our termination would not affect our classification as a partnership for federal income tax purposes, but instead, after our termination, we would be treated as a new partnership for federal income tax purposes. If treated as a new partnership, we must make new tax elections and could be subject to penalties if we are unable to determine that a termination occurred. Please read "Material

45


Table of Contents

U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences—Disposition of Units—Constructive Termination" for a discussion of the consequences of our termination for federal income tax purposes.

Tax gain or loss on the disposition of our common units could be more or less than expected.

              If a unitholder sells its common units, it will recognize a gain or loss equal to the difference between the amount realized and its tax basis in those common units. Because distributions in excess of a unitholder's allocable share of our net taxable income result in a decrease in its tax basis in its common units, the amount, if any, of such prior excess distributions with respect to the units it sells will, in effect, become taxable income to the unitholder if it sells such units at a price greater than its tax basis in those units, even if the price the unitholder receives is less than its original cost. Furthermore, a substantial portion of the amount realized, whether or not representing gain, may be taxed as ordinary income due to potential recapture of depreciation deductions and certain other items. In addition, because the amount realized includes a unitholder's share of our nonrecourse liabilities, if a unitholder sells its units, the unitholder may incur a tax liability in excess of the amount of cash it receives from the sale. Please read "Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences—Disposition of Units—Recognition of Gain or Loss" for a further discussion of the foregoing.

Tax-exempt entities and non-U.S. persons face unique tax issues from owning common units that may result in adverse tax consequences to them.

              Investments in common units by tax-exempt entities, such as employee benefit plans and individual retirement accounts (or "IRAs"), and non-U.S. persons raise issues unique to them. For example, virtually all of our income allocated to organizations that are exempt from federal income tax, including IRAs and other retirement plans, will be unrelated business taxable income and will be taxable to them. Distributions to non-U.S. persons will be reduced by withholding taxes, and non-U.S. persons will be required to file U.S. federal tax returns and pay tax on their shares of our taxable income. Unitholders that are tax-exempt entities or non-U.S. persons should consult their tax advisors before investing in our common units.

If the IRS contests the federal income tax positions we take, the market for our common units may be adversely impacted and the cost of any IRS contest will reduce our cash available for distribution to our unitholders.

              The IRS may adopt positions that differ from the positions we take. It may be necessary to resort to administrative or court proceedings to sustain some or all of the positions we take. A court may not agree with some or all of the positions we take. Any contest by the IRS may materially and adversely impact the market for our common units and the price at which they trade. Our costs of any contest by the IRS will be borne indirectly by our unitholders because the costs will reduce our cash available for distribution.

We will treat each purchaser of our common units as having the same tax benefits without regard to the actual common units purchased. The IRS may challenge this treatment, which could adversely affect the value of the common units.

              Because we cannot match transferors and transferees of common units, we will adopt depreciation and amortization positions that may not conform to all aspects of existing Treasury Regulations. A successful IRS challenge to those positions could adversely affect the amount of tax benefits available to a unitholder. It also could affect the timing of these tax benefits or the amount of gain from a unitholder's sale of common units and could have a negative impact on the value of our common units or result in audit adjustments to a unitholder's tax returns. Please read "Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences—Tax Consequences of Unit Ownership—Section 754 Election" for a further discussion of the effect of the depreciation and amortization positions we adopt.

46


Table of Contents

We will prorate our items of income, gain, loss and deduction between transferors and transferees of our units each month based upon the ownership of our units on the first day of each month, instead of on the basis of the date a particular unit is transferred. The IRS may challenge this treatment, which could change the allocation of items of income, gain, loss and deduction among our unitholders.

              We generally prorate our items of income, gain, loss and deduction between transferors and transferees of our common units each month based upon the ownership of our common units on the first day of each month, instead of on the basis of the date a particular common unit is transferred. Nonetheless, we allocate certain deductions for depreciation of capital additions based upon the date the underlying property is placed in service. The use of this proration method may not be permitted under existing Treasury Regulations, and although the U.S. Treasury Department issued proposed Treasury Regulations allowing a similar monthly simplifying convention, such regulations are not final and do not specifically authorize the use of the proration method we have adopted. Accordingly, our counsel is unable to opine as to the validity of this method. If the IRS were to successfully challenge our proration method, we may be required to change the allocation of items of income, gain, loss, and deduction among our unitholders.

A unitholder whose common units are the subject of a securities loan (e.g., a loan to a "short seller" to cover a short sale of common units) may be considered as having disposed of those common units. If so, the unitholder would no longer be treated for tax purposes as a partner with respect to those common units during the period of the loan and may recognize gain or loss from the disposition.

              Because there is no tax concept of loaning a partnership interest, a unitholder whose common units are the subject of a securities loan may be considered as having disposed of the loaned units. In that case, he may no longer be treated for tax purposes as a partner with respect to those common units during the period of the loan and the unitholder may recognize gain or loss from such disposition. Moreover, during the period of the loan, any of our income, gain, loss or deduction with respect to those common units may not be reportable by the unitholder and any cash distributions received by the unitholder as to those common units could be fully taxable as ordinary income. Unitholders desiring to assure their status as partners and avoid the risk of gain recognition from a loan of their common units should modify any applicable brokerage account agreements to prohibit their brokers from borrowing their common units.

Unitholders will likely be subject to state and local taxes and return filing requirements in states where they do not live as a result of investing in our common units.

              In addition to U.S. federal income taxes, unitholders will likely be subject to other taxes, including state and local taxes, unincorporated business taxes and estate, inheritance or intangible taxes that are imposed by the various jurisdictions in which we conduct business or own property now or in the future, even if they do not live in any of those jurisdictions. We currently own assets or conduct business in Texas, Louisiana, New Mexico and Oklahoma. Each of these states, other than Texas, currently imposes a personal income tax on individuals. Each of these states also imposes an income or other entity-level tax on corporations and other entities. Unitholders may be required to file state and local income tax returns and pay state and local income taxes in some or all of these various jurisdictions. Further, unitholders may be subject to penalties for failure to comply with those requirements. As we make acquisitions or expand our business, we may own assets or conduct business in additional states or non-U.S. jurisdictions that impose a personal income tax or an income or other entity-level tax on corporations and other entities. It is the unitholder's responsibility to file all U.S. federal, state, local and non-U.S. tax returns. Our counsel has not rendered an opinion on the non-U.S., state or local tax consequences of an investment in our common units.

47


Table of Contents


USE OF PROCEEDS

              We intend to use the estimated net proceeds of approximately $             million from this offering, based upon the assumed initial public offering price of $            per common unit (the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover of this prospectus), after deducting underwriting discounts, structuring fees and offering expenses, to:

    distribute $             million to SHC as reimbursement of certain capital expenditures incurred with respect to the assets contributed to us in connection with this offering; and

    purchase approximately $147.3 million of U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities, which will be assigned as collateral to secure a new $147.3 million term loan that will be fully guaranteed by SHC. The proceeds of such term loan will be used to make a $147.3 million distribution to SHC to finance in part our acquisition of the assets transferred by SHC to us in connection with this offering. In addition, we will draw $2.4 million in borrowings under our revolving credit facility in order to pay our transaction expenses associated with entering into the term loan and the revolving credit facility.

              If and to the extent the underwriters exercise their option to purchase any portion of the option units, the number of option units purchased by the underwriters pursuant to such exercise will be issued to the public and the remainder of the option units, if any, will be issued to SHC or a wholly owned subsidiary of SHC. Any such units issued to SHC or a wholly owned subsidiary of SHC will be issued for no additional consideration. Accordingly, the exercise of the underwriters' option will not affect the total number of common units outstanding or the amount of cash needed to pay the minimum quarterly distribution on all units. Please read "Underwriting." If the underwriters exercise their option to purchase the option units in full, the additional net proceeds would be approximately $         million, based upon the assumed initial public offering price of $        per common unit (the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover of this prospectus). The net proceeds received in connection with any exercise of such option will be used to purchase a corresponding amount of additional U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities, which will be assigned as collateral to secure additional term loan borrowings in the amount of such net proceeds, which will be fully guaranteed by SHC. The proceeds of such additional term loan borrowings will be used to make an additional distribution to SHC.

48


Table of Contents


CAPITALIZATION

              The following table shows:

    the historical cash and cash equivalents and capitalization of our predecessor as of June 30, 2012; and

    our pro forma cash and cash equivalents and capitalization as of June 30, 2012, adjusted to reflect the pro forma adjustments described in our pro forma financial statements, including the issuance and sale of common units to the public at an assumed initial offering price of $            per common unit (the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover of this prospectus), the other formation transactions described under "Summary—Formation Transactions and Partnership Structure" and the application of the net proceeds from this offering as described under "Use of Proceeds."

              We derived this table from, and it should be read in conjunction with and is qualified in its entirety by reference to, the unaudited historical and pro forma financial statements and the accompanying notes included elsewhere in this prospectus. You should also read this table in conjunction with "Summary—Formation Transactions and Partnership Structure," "Use of Proceeds" and "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations."

 
  As of June 30, 2012  
 
  Predecessor
Historical
  Susser Petroleum
Partners LP
Pro Forma
 
 
  (In thousands)
 

Cash and cash equivalents

  $ 1,145   $    

U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities

  $   $    
           

Debt:

             

Term loan facility

           

Revolving credit facility

           

Other long-term debt

    1,087        
           

Total debt

  $ 1,087   $    
           

Partners' equity:

             

Our predecessor

  $ 121,190   $    

Held by public:

             

Common units

           

Held by SHC or its wholly owned subsidiary:

             

Common units

           

Subordinated units

           

General partner interest

           
           

Total partners' equity

  $ 121,190   $    
           

Total capitalization

  $ 122,277   $    
           

49


Table of Contents


DILUTION

              Dilution is the amount by which the offering price paid by the purchasers of common units sold in this offering will exceed the pro forma net tangible book value per common unit after the offering. Based on an assumed initial public offering price of $            per common unit, on a pro forma basis as of June 30, 2012, after giving effect to the offering of common units and the related transactions, our net tangible book value would have been approximately $             million, or $            per common unit. Purchasers of our common units in this offering will experience substantial and immediate dilution in net tangible book value per common unit for financial accounting purposes, as illustrated in the following table.

Initial public offering price per common unit

        $    

Pro forma net tangible book value per common unit before the offering(1)

  $          

Increase in pro forma net tangible book value per common unit attributable to purchasers in the offering

             

Less: Pro forma net tangible book value per common unit after the offering(2)

             
             

Immediate dilution in net tangible book value per common unit to purchasers in the offering(3)

        $    
             

(1)
Determined by dividing the pro forma net tangible book value of the contributed assets and liabilities by the number of units (                        common units and                                    subordinated units) to be issued to SHC or a wholly owned subsidiary of SHC and its affiliates for their contribution of assets and liabilities to us.

(2)
Determined by dividing our pro forma net tangible book value, after giving effect to the use of the net proceeds of the offering, by the total number of units (                        common units and                        subordinated units) to be outstanding after the offering.

(3)
Because the total number of units outstanding following this offering will not be impacted by any exercise of the underwriters' option to purchase additional common units and any net proceeds from such exercise will not be retained by us, there will be no change to the dilution in net tangible book value per common unit to purchasers in the offering due to any such exercise of the option.

              A $1.00 increase (decrease) in the assumed initial public offering price of $            per common unit would increase (decrease) our pro forma as adjusted net tangible book value per unit by $            .

              The following table sets forth the number of units that we will issue and the total consideration contributed to us by our general partner and its affiliates and by the purchasers of our common units in this offering upon completion of the transactions contemplated by this prospectus.

 
  Units   Total Consideration  
 
  Number   Percent   Amount   Percent  

SHC and affiliates(1)(2)(3)

          % $         %

Purchasers in the offering

          % $         %
                   

Total

        100.0 % $       100.0 %
                   

(1)
Upon the completion of the transactions contemplated by this prospectus, SHC and its affiliates will own                        common units and                         subordinated units.

(2)
The assets contributed by SHC will be recorded at historical cost. The book value of the consideration provided by SHC as of June 30, 2012 was approximately $             million.

(3)
Assumes the underwriters' option to purchase additional common units is not exercised.

50


Table of Contents


CASH DISTRIBUTION POLICY AND RESTRICTIONS ON DISTRIBUTIONS

               You should read the following discussion of our cash distribution policy in conjunction with "—Significant Forecast Assumptions" below, which includes the factors and assumptions upon which we base our cash distribution policy. In addition, you should read "Forward-Looking Statements" and "Risk Factors" for information regarding statements that do not relate strictly to historical or current facts and certain risks inherent in our business.

               For additional information regarding our historical and pro forma results of operations, you should refer to our audited historical financial statements as of December 31, 2010 and 2011 and for the fiscal years ended December 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011, our unaudited historical financial statements as of June 30, 2012 and for the six months ended June 30, 2011 and 2012 and our unaudited pro forma financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2011 and as of and for the six months ended June 30, 2012 included elsewhere in this prospectus.


General

Rationale for Our Cash Distribution Policy

              Our partnership agreement requires us to distribute all of our available cash quarterly. Our cash distribution policy reflects a fundamental judgment that our unitholders generally will be better served by our distributing rather than retaining our available cash. Our partnership agreement generally defines available cash as cash on hand at the end of a quarter after the payment of expenses, less the amount of cash reserves established by our general partner to provide for the conduct of our business, to comply with applicable law, any of our debt instruments or other agreements or to provide for future distributions to our unitholders for any one or more of the next four quarters. Our available cash also may include, if our general partner so determines, all or any portion of the cash on hand immediately prior to the date of distribution of available cash for the quarter resulting from working capital borrowings made subsequent to the end of such quarter. Because we are not subject to an entity-level federal income tax, we expect to have more cash to distribute to our unitholders than would be the case if we were subject to entity-level federal income tax.

Limitations on Cash Distributions and Our Ability to Change Our Cash Distribution Policy

              There is no guarantee that we will distribute quarterly cash distributions to our unitholders. We do not have a legal obligation to pay our minimum quarterly distribution or any other distribution except as provided in our partnership agreement. Our cash distribution policy may be changed at any time and is subject to certain restrictions and uncertainties, including the following:

    Our cash distribution policy will be subject to restrictions on distributions under our new revolving credit facility, which will contain financial tests and covenants that we must satisfy. Should we be unable to satisfy these covenants or if we are otherwise in default under our revolving line of credit, we will be prohibited from making cash distributions to you notwithstanding our stated cash distribution policy.

    Our general partner will have the authority to establish cash reserves for the prudent conduct of our business and for future cash distributions to our unitholders, and the establishment of or increase in those reserves could result in a reduction in cash distributions from levels we currently anticipate pursuant to our stated cash distribution policy. Our partnership agreement does not set a limit on the amount of cash reserves that our general partner may establish. Any decision to establish cash reserves made by our general partner in good faith will be binding on our unitholders.

    Prior to making any distribution on our common units, we will reimburse our general partner and its affiliates for all direct and indirect expenses they incur on our behalf pursuant to the partnership agreement and the omnibus agreement. Neither our partnership agreement nor the omnibus agreement will limit the amount of expenses for which our general partner and

51


Table of Contents

      its affiliates may be reimbursed. Our partnership agreement provides that our general partner will determine in good faith the expenses that are allocable to us. The reimbursement of expenses and payment of fees, if any, to our general partner and its affiliates will reduce the amount of available cash.

    While our partnership agreement requires us to distribute all of our available cash, our partnership agreement, including the provisions requiring us to make cash distributions contained therein, may be amended. Our partnership agreement generally may not be amended during the subordination period without the approval of our public common unitholders, except in certain limited circumstances when our general partner can amend our partnership agreement without unitholder approval. However, after the subordination period has ended, our partnership agreement can be amended with the consent of our general partner and the approval of a majority of the outstanding common units (including common units held by SHC or a wholly owned subsidiary of SHC). At the closing of this offering, SHC will own, directly or indirectly, approximately        % of our limited partner interests. Please read "The Partnership Agreement—Amendment of the Partnership Agreement."

    Even if our cash distribution policy is not modified or revoked, the decisions regarding the amount of distributions to pay under our cash distribution policy and whether to pay any distribution are made by our general partner, taking into consideration the terms of our partnership agreement.

    Under Section 17-607 of the Delaware Act, we may not make a distribution if the distribution would cause our liabilities to exceed the fair value of our assets.

    We may lack sufficient cash to pay distributions to our unitholders due to cash flow shortfalls attributable to a number of operational, commercial or other factors as well as increases in our operating or general and administrative expenses, principal and interest payments on our outstanding debt, tax expenses, working capital requirements or anticipated cash needs.

    Our ability to make distributions to our unitholders depends on the performance of our subsidiaries and their ability to distribute cash to us. The ability of our subsidiaries to make distributions to us may be restricted by, among other things, the provisions of existing and future indebtedness, applicable state partnership and limited liability company laws and other laws and regulations.

Our Ability to Grow is Dependent on Our Ability to Access External Expansion Capital

              Our partnership agreement requires us to distribute all of our available cash to our unitholders on a quarterly basis. As a result, we expect that we will rely primarily upon external financing sources, including commercial bank borrowings and issuances of debt and equity securities, to fund any future expansion capital expenditures. To the extent we are unable to finance growth externally, our cash distribution policy will significantly impair our ability to grow. In addition, because we intend to distribute all of our available cash, our growth may not be as fast as that of businesses that reinvest all of their available cash to expand ongoing operations. To the extent we issue additional units, the payment of distributions on those additional units may increase the risk that we will be unable to maintain or increase our per unit distribution level. There are no limitations in our partnership agreement or our new credit facilities on our ability to issue additional units, including units ranking senior to the common units. The incurrence of additional commercial bank borrowings or other debt to finance our growth would result in increased interest expense, which in turn may impact the available cash that we have to distribute to our unitholders.


Our Minimum Quarterly Distribution

              Upon completion of this offering, our partnership agreement will provide for a minimum quarterly distribution of $            per unit for each complete quarter, or $            per unit on an

52


Table of Contents

annualized basis. Quarterly distributions, if any, will be made within 60 days after the end of each quarter. This equates to an aggregate cash distribution of approximately $             million per quarter, or approximately $             million per year, based on the number of common and subordinated units to be outstanding immediately after completion of this offering. The table below sets forth the number of common units and subordinated units that will be outstanding immediately after this offering, assuming that the underwriters do not exercise their option to purchase additional common units, and the available cash needed to pay the aggregate minimum quarterly distribution on all of such units for a single fiscal quarter and a four quarter period:

 
   
  Distributions  
 
  Number of
Units
 
 
  One Quarter   Annualized  

Publicly held common units(1)

      $     $    

Common units held by SHC and its affiliates(1)

                 

Subordinated units held by SHC and its affiliates

                 
               

Total

      $     $    
               

(1)
Does not include any common units that may be issued under the long-term incentive plan that our general partner is expected to adopt prior to the closing of this offering.

              If the underwriters do not exercise their option to purchase additional common units, we will issue                        common units to SHC or a wholly owned subsidiary of SHC at the expiration of the option period. If and to the extent the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional common units, the number of common units purchased by the underwriters pursuant to such exercise will be issued to the public, and the remainder, if any, will be issued to SHC or a wholly owned subsidiary of SHC for no additional consideration. Accordingly, the exercise of the underwriters' option will not affect the total number of units outstanding or the amount of cash needed to pay the minimum quarterly distribution on all units.

              SHC will also hold our incentive distribution rights, which entitle the holder to increasing percentages, up to a maximum of 50.0% of the cash we distribute in excess of $            per unit per quarter.

              We will pay our distributions around the last business day of the month of each of February, May, August and November to holders of record on or about the 1st day of each such month. If the distribution date does not fall on a business day, we will make the distribution on the business day immediately preceding the indicated distribution date. We will adjust the quarterly distribution for the period from the closing of this offering through                        , 2012 based on the actual length of the period.

              Although holders of our common units may pursue judicial action to enforce provisions of our partnership agreement, including those related to requirements to make cash distributions as described above, our partnership agreement provides that any determination made by our general partner in its capacity as our general partner must be made in good faith and that any such determination will not be subject to any other standard imposed by the Delaware Act or any other law, rule or regulation or at equity. Our partnership agreement provides that, in order for a determination by our general partner to be made in "good faith," our general partner must believe that the determination is in our best interest. Please read "Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties."

              Our cash distribution policy, as expressed in our partnership agreement, may not be modified or repealed without amending our partnership agreement. However, the actual amount of our cash distributions for any quarter is subject to fluctuations based on the amount of cash we generate from our business and the amount of reserves our general partner establishes in accordance with our partnership agreement as described above.

53


Table of Contents


Subordinated Units

              SHC will initially own, directly or indirectly, all of our subordinated units. The principal difference between our common units and subordinated units is that in any quarter during the subordination period, holders of the subordinated units will not be entitled to receive any distribution until the common units have received the minimum quarterly distribution plus any arrearages in the payment of the minimum quarterly distribution from prior quarters. To the extent that we do not pay the minimum quarterly distribution on our common units, our common unitholders will not be entitled to receive such payments in the future except during the subordination period. Subordinated units will not accrue arrearages.

              To the extent that we have available cash in any future quarter during the subordination period in excess of the amount necessary to pay the minimum quarterly distribution to holders of our common units, we will use this excess available cash to pay any distribution arrearages on the common units related to prior quarters before any cash distribution is made to holders of subordinated units. When the subordination period ends, all of the subordinated units will convert into an equal number of common units. Please read "Provisions of Our Partnership Agreement Relating to Cash Distributions—Subordinated Units."


Unaudited Pro Forma Available Cash for the Year Ended December 31, 2011 and the Twelve Months Ended June 30, 2012

              If we had completed the transactions contemplated in this prospectus on January 1, 2011, our unaudited pro forma available cash for the year ended December 31, 2011 would have been approximately $34.2 million. This amount would have been sufficient to pay the full minimum quarterly distribution of $            per unit per quarter (or $            per unit on an annualized basis) on all of our common units and a cash distribution of $            per unit per quarter ($            per unit on an annualized basis), or approximately        % of the minimum quarterly distribution, on our subordinated units for the year ended December 31, 2011. If we had completed the transactions contemplated in this prospectus on July 1, 2011, our unaudited pro forma available cash for the twelve months ended June 30, 2012 would have been approximately $35.7 million. This amount would have been sufficient to pay the full minimum quarterly distribution on all of our common units and a cash distribution of $            per unit per quarter ($             per unit on an annualized basis), or approximately        % of the minimum quarterly distribution, on our subordinated units for the twelve months ended June 30, 2012.

              Our calculation of unaudited pro forma available cash includes incremental external general and administrative expenses that we expect to incur as a result of being a publicly traded partnership, including costs associated with SEC reporting requirements, tax return and Schedule K-1 preparation and distribution, independent auditor fees, investor relations activities, Sarbanes-Oxley Act compliance, stock exchange listing, registrar and transfer agent fees, incremental director and officer liability insurance and director compensation. We estimate that these incremental external general and administrative expenses initially will be approximately $2.0 million per year. Such expenses are not reflected in our unaudited pro forma financial statements.

              Our unaudited pro forma financial statements, from which our unaudited pro forma available cash was derived, do not purport to present our results of operations had the transactions contemplated in this prospectus actually been completed as of the dates indicated. Furthermore, available cash is a cash accounting concept, while our predecessor's historical financial statements and our pro forma financial statements were prepared on an accrual basis. We derived the amounts of unaudited pro forma available cash stated above in the manner shown in the table below. As a result, the amount of unaudited pro forma available cash should only be viewed as a general indication of the amount of available cash that we might have generated had we been formed and completed the transactions contemplated in this prospectus in earlier periods.

              Our unaudited pro forma financial statements were derived from the audited and unaudited historical financial statements of our predecessor included elsewhere in this prospectus and our

54


Table of Contents

predecessor's accounting records, which are also unaudited. Our unaudited pro forma financial statements and the table below should be read together with "Summary—Summary Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data," "Selected Historical Financial Data," "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and the audited and unaudited historical financial statements of our predecessor included elsewhere in this prospectus.

              The following tables illustrate our unaudited pro forma available cash for the year ended December 31, 2011 and the twelve months ended June 30, 2012, and for each of the four quarters in each respective period. The footnotes to the table below provide additional information about the pro forma adjustments and should be read along with the table.

Susser Petroleum Partners LP
Unaudited Pro Forma Available Cash
    

 
 
  Year Ended
December 31,
2011
  Twelve Months
Ended
June 30,
2012
 
 
  (In thousands, except per unit data)
 

Revenues:

             

Motor fuel sales

  $ 3,821,946   $ 4,118,093  

Rental income

    3,304     3,354  

Other income(1)

    4,596     4,767  
           

Total revenues

    3,829,846     4,126,214  
           

Gross profit:

             

Motor fuel sales

    44,535     47,125  

Rental income

    3,304     3,354  

Other income(1)

    2,474     2,640  
           

Total gross profit

    50,313     53,119  
           

Operating expenses:

             

Selling, general and administrative

    10,900     12,203  

Rent

    1,031     1,046  

Depreciation and amortization

    4,281     5,358  
           

Total operating expenses

    16,212     18,607  
           

Operating income

    34,101     34,512  

Interest expense, net(2)

   
2,096
   
2,117
 

State franchise tax expense(3)

    276     291  
           

Net income

   
31,729
   
32,104
 
           

Net income per common unit—basic and diluted(4)

             

Net income per subordinated unit—basic and diluted(4)

             

55


Table of Contents

Susser Petroleum Partners LP
Unaudited Pro Forma Available Cash
    

 
 
  Year Ended
December 31,
2011
  Twelve Months
Ended
June 30,
2012
 
 
  (In thousands, except per unit data)
 

Adjustments to reconcile net income to Adjusted EBITDA:

             

Net income

    31,729     32,104  

Add:

             

Non-cash stock compensation expense

    589     746  

Loss on disposal of assets(5)

    142     142  

Interest expense, net(2)

    2,096     2,117  

Depreciation and amortization

    4,281     5,358  

State franchise tax expense(3)

    276     291  
           

Adjusted EBITDA(6)

    39,113     40,758  

Less:

             

Incremental external general and administrative expense(7)

    (2,000 )   (2,000 )

Cash interest expense(2)

    (1,626 )   (1,647 )

State franchise tax expense(3)

    (276 )   (291 )

Maintenance capital expenditures(8)

    (1,034 )   (1,076 )

Expansion capital expenditures(8)

    (12,676 )   (14,585 )

Add:

             

Capital contributions to fund expansion capital expenditures(9)

    12,676     14,585  
           

Available cash

  $ 34,177   $ 35,744  
           

Cash distributions:

             

Distributions to public common unitholders

             

Distributions to SHC and its affiliates—common units

             

Distributions to SHC and its affiliates—subordinated units

             
           

Total distributions

             
           

Excess (shortfall)

  $     $    
           

Percent of minimum quarterly distributions payable to common unitholders

      %     %

Percent of minimum quarterly distributions payable to subordinated unitholders

      %     %

(1)
Other income and other gross profit includes propane and lube oil sales, sales of rights to operate dealer locations and other miscellaneous non-motor fuel income sources.

(2)
Interest expense and cash interest expense both reflect, on a net basis, the interest expense related to the $147.3 million of term loan borrowings we expect to incur under the new term loan facility we will enter into in connection with this offering, reduced by the interest income related to the $147.3 million of U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities we intend to purchase with a portion of the proceeds from this offering. Interest expense and cash interest expense also include interest expense on an existing mortgage note, net of interest income on notes receivable from dealers, and letter of credit and commitment fees related to the $250.0 million revolving credit facility. Included in interest expense but excluded from cash interest expense is amortization of expected loan fees.

56


Table of Contents

(3)
Includes the Texas franchise tax. Due to our status as a partnership, we will not be subject to U.S. federal income tax in the future, except for our subsidiary that is treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes. This subsidiary does not presently have any operations, but is expected to own all stores purchased pursuant to sale and leaseback transactions with SHC and receive rental income from SHC. As a result, we may incur federal income tax expense with regard to the operations of this subsidiary in future periods.

(4)
Pro forma net income per limited partner unit is determined by dividing the pro forma net income available to our common and subordinated unitholders by the number of common and subordinated units expected to be outstanding at the closing of the offering. For purposes of this calculation, we have assumed there will be                common units and                 subordinated units outstanding.

(5)
Loss on disposal of assets reflects the non-cash write-off resulting from the sales of excess assets, the closure of certain locations or the termination of certain of our contracts.

(6)
Adjusted EBITDA is defined and reconciled to its most directly comparable financial measures calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP in "Summary—Non-GAAP Financial Measure."

(7)
Reflects the incurrence of estimated incremental cash expenses associated with being a publicly traded partnership of approximately $2.0 million, including costs associated with SEC reporting requirements, tax return and Schedule K-1 preparation and distribution, independent auditor fees, investor relations activities, Sarbanes-Oxley compliance, stock exchange listing, registrar and transfer agent fees, incremental director and officer liability insurance and director compensation. Pro forma selling, general and administrative expense does not reflect this incremental expense.

(8)
Historically, our predecessor has not made a distinction between maintenance capital expenditures and expansion capital expenditures. Under our partnership agreement, maintenance capital expenditures are capital expenditures made to maintain our long-term operating income or operating capacity, while expansion capital expenditures are capital expenditures that we expect will increase our operating income or operating capacity over the long term. Examples of maintenance capital expenditures are those made to maintain existing contract volumes, including payments to renew existing distribution contracts, or to maintain our real estate leased to third-party dealers in leaseable condition, such as parking lot or roof replacement/renovation, or to replace equipment required to operate our existing business. In contrast, expansion capital expenditures are those made to acquire additional assets to grow our business, such as new distribution contracts or real estate, including exercising our options to purchase convenience stores from SHC.

For the year ended December 31, 2011, our pro forma capital expenditures totaled $13.7 million, which is less than the total capital expenditures incurred by our predecessor as we have excluded capital expenditures relating to assets of our predecessor that will not be contributed to us. We estimate that approximately $1.0 million of our pro forma capital expenditures were maintenance capital expenditures and that approximately $12.7 million of our pro forma capital expenditures were expansion capital expenditures. Expansion capital expenditures for the year ended December 31, 2011 primarily consisted of investments associated with the acquisition of 121 dealer supply contracts from Community Fuels of Texas, LP as well as amounts spent to acquire other new dealer contracts.

For the twelve months ended June 30, 2012, our pro forma capital expenditures totaled $15.7 million. We estimate that approximately $1.1 million of our pro forma capital expenditures were maintenance capital expenditures and that $14.6 million of our pro forma capital expenditures were expansion capital expenditures. Expansion capital expenditures for the twelve months ended June 30, 2012 primarily consisted of expenses associated with the acquisition of the new dealer supply contracts referenced above.

57


Table of Contents

(9)
We have assumed for purposes of calculating our pro forma available cash that we funded our expansion capital expenditures during the year ended December 31, 2011 and the twelve months ended June 30, 2012 with capital contributions made to us by SHC. We expect that in the future, our expansion capital expenditures will primarily be funded through the liquidation of our U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities, borrowings or the sale of debt or equity securities.

 
  Susser Petroleum Partners LP
Unaudited Pro Forma Available Cash
(on a Quarterly Basis)
    

 
 
  Three Months Ended   Year Ended  
 
  March 31,
2011
  June 30,
2011
  September 30,
2011
  December 31,
2011
  December 31,
2011
 
 
  (In thousands, except per unit data)
 

Revenues:

                               

Motor fuel sales

  $ 852,760   $ 1,011,071   $ 991,394   $ 966,721   $ 3,821,946  

Rental income

    804     825     827     848     3,304  

Other income

    1,219     1,060     1,062     1,255     4,596  
                       

Total revenues

    854,783     1,012,956     993,283     968,824     3,829,846  
                       

Gross profit:

                               

Motor fuel sales

    10,355     11,549     11,327     11,304     44,535  

Rental income

    804     825     827     848     3,304  

Other income

    591     623     575     685     2,474  
                       

Total gross profit

    11,750     12,997     12,729     12,837     50,313  
                       

Operating expenses:

                               

Selling, general and administrative

    2,514     2,962     2,707     2,717     10,900  

Rent

    265     251     255     260     1,031  

Depreciation and amortization

    836     865     984     1,596     4,281  
                       

Total operating expenses

    3,615     4,078     3,946     4,573     16,212  
                       

Operating income

    8,135     8,919     8,783     8,264     34,101  

Interest expense, net

   
520
   
525
   
530
   
521
   
2,096
 

State franchise tax expense

    65     72     70     69     276  
                       

Net income

   
7,550
   
8,322
   
8,183
   
7,674
   
31,729
 
                       

Net income per common unit—basic and diluted

                               

Net income per subordinated unit—basic and diluted

                               

Adjustments to reconcile net income to Adjusted EBITDA:

                               

Add:

                               

Non-cash stock compensation expense

    143     174     172     100     589  

Loss on disposal of assets

    59     63     20         142  

Interest expense, net

    520     525     530     521     2,096  

Depreciation and amortization

    836     865     984     1,596     4,281  

State franchise tax expense

    65     72     70     69     276  
                       

Adjusted EBITDA

    9,173     10,021     9,959     9,960     39,113  

Less:

                               

Incremental external general and administrative expense

    (500 )   (500 )   (500 )   (500 )   (2,000 )

Cash interest expense

    (402 )   (408 )   (412 )   (404 )   (1,626 )

State franchise tax expense

    (65 )   (72 )   (70 )   (69 )   (276 )

Maintenance capital expenditures

    (220 )   (253 )   (392 )   (169 )   (1,034 )

Expansion capital expenditures

    (631 )   (207 )   (142 )   (11,696 )   (12,676 )

Add:

                               

Capital contributions to fund expansion capital expenditures

    631     207     142     11,696     12,676  
                       

Available cash

  $ 7,986   $ 8,788   $ 8,585   $ 8,818   $ 34,177  
                       

Cash distributions:

                               

Distributions to public common unitholders

                               

Distributions to SHC and its affiliates—common units

                               

Distributions to SHC and its affiliates—subordinated units

                               
                       

Total distributions

  $     $     $     $     $    
                       

Excess (shortfall)

  $     $     $     $     $    
                       

Percent of minimum quarterly distributions payable to common unitholders

      %     %     %     %     %

Percent of minimum quarterly distributions payable to subordinated unitholders

      %     %     %     %     %

58


Table of Contents

 
  Susser Petroleum Partners LP
Unaudited Pro Forma Available Cash
(on a Quarterly Basis)
  
Three Months Ended
  Twelve Months
Ended
 
 
  September 30,
2011
  December 31,
2011
  March 31,
2012
  June 30,
2012
  June 30,
2012
 

Revenues:

                               

Motor fuel sales

  $ 991,394   $ 966,721   $ 1,074,341   $ 1,085,637   $ 4,118,093  

Rental income

    827     848     839     840     3,354  

Other income

    1,062     1,255     1,352     1,098     4,767  
                       

Total revenues

    993,283     968,824     1,076,532     1,087,575     4,126,214  
                       

Gross profit:

                               

Motor fuel sales

    11,327     11,304     11,936     12,558     47,125  

Rental income

    827     848     839     840     3,354  

Other income

    575     685     729     651     2,640  
                       

Total gross profit

    12,729     12,837     13,504     14,049     53,119  
                       

Operating expenses:

                               

Selling, general and administrative

    2,707     2,717     3,043     3,736     12,203  

Rent

    255     260     267     264     1,046  

Depreciation and amortization

    984     1,596     1,400     1,378     5,358  
                       

Total operating expenses

    3,946     4,573     4,710     5,378     18,607  
                       

Operating income

    8,783     8,264     8,794     8,671     34,512  

Interest expense, net

   
530
   
521
   
530
   
536
   
2,117
 

State franchise tax expense

    70     69     73     79     291  
                       

Net income

   
8,183
   
7,674
   
8,191
   
8,056
   
32,104
 
                       

Net income per common unit—basic and diluted

                               

Net income per subordinated unit—basic and diluted

                               

Adjustments to reconcile net income to Adjusted EBITDA:

                               

Add:

                               

Non-cash stock compensation expense

    172     100     143     331     746  

Loss on disposal of assets

    20         106     16     142  

Interest expense, net

    530     521     530     536     2,117  

Depreciation and amortization

    984     1,596     1,400     1,378     5,358  

State franchise tax expense

    70     69     73     79     291  
                       

Adjusted EBITDA

    9,959     9,960     10,443     10,396     40,758  

Less:

                               

Incremental external general and administrative expense

    (500 )   (500 )   (500 )   (500 )   (2,000 )

Cash interest expense

    (412 )   (404 )   (412 )   (419 )   (1,647 )

State franchise tax expense

    (70 )   (69 )   (73 )   (79 )   (291 )

Maintenance capital expenditures

    (392 )   (169 )   (366 )   (149 )   (1,076 )

Expansion capital expenditures

    (142 )   (11,696 )   (353 )   (2,394 )   (14,585 )

Add:

                               

Capital contributions to fund expansion capital expenditures

    142     11,696     353     2,394     14,585  
                       

Available cash

  $ 8,585   $ 8,818   $ 9,092   $ 9,249   $ 35,744  
                       

Cash distributions:

                               

Distributions to public common unitholders

                               

Distributions to SHC and its affiliates—common units

                               

Distributions to SHC and its affiliates—subordinated units

                               
                       

Total distributions

  $     $     $     $     $    
                       

Excess (shortfall)

  $     $     $     $     $    
                       

Percent of minimum quarterly distributions payable to common unitholders

      %     %     %     %     %

Percent of minimum quarterly distributions payable to subordinated unitholders

      %     %     %     %     %

59


Table of Contents


Estimated Available Cash for the Twelve Months Ending September 30, 2013

              We forecast that our available cash during the twelve months ending September 30, 2013 will be approximately $44.0 million. This amount would be sufficient to pay the full minimum quarterly distribution of $            per unit on all of our common units and subordinated units for each quarter in the twelve months ending September 30, 2013. The assumed number of outstanding units upon which we have based our belief does not include any common units that may be issued under the long-term incentive plan that our general partner will adopt prior to the completion of this offering.

              We are providing this forecast to supplement our predecessor's historical and our pro forma financial statements in support of our belief that we will have sufficient available cash to pay the full minimum quarterly distribution on all of our common units and subordinated units for each quarter in the twelve months ending September 30, 2013. Please read "—Significant Forecast Assumptions" for further information as to the assumptions we have made for the forecast. Please read "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Significant Accounting Policies and Estimates" for information regarding the accounting policies we have followed for the forecast.

              Our forecast reflects our judgment as of the date of this prospectus of the conditions we expect to exist and the course of action we expect to take during the twelve months ending September 30, 2013. We believe that we have a reasonable objective basis for these assumptions and that our actual results of operations will approximate those reflected in our forecast, but we can give no assurance that our forecasted results will be achieved. If our forecasted results are not achieved, we may not be able to pay the minimum quarterly distribution or any other distribution on our common and subordinated units. The assumptions and estimates underlying the forecast are inherently uncertain and, although we consider them reasonable as of the date of this prospectus, they are subject to a wide variety of significant business, economic, and competitive risks and uncertainties that could cause actual results to differ materially from forecasted results, including, among others, the risks and uncertainties described in "Risk Factors." Accordingly, there can be no assurance that the forecast will be indicative of our future performance or that actual results will not differ materially from those presented in the forecast. Inclusion of the forecast in this prospectus should not be regarded as a representation by us, the underwriters or any other person that the results contained in the forecast will be achieved.

              As a matter of course, we do not make public forecasts as to future revenues, earnings or other results. The forecast was not prepared with a view toward complying with the guidelines established by the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants with respect to prospective financial information, but, in our view, was prepared on a reasonable basis, reflects the best currently available estimates and judgments, and presents, to the best of management's knowledge and belief, our expected future course of action and financial performance. However, this information is not necessarily indicative of future results.

              Neither our independent auditors, nor any other independent accountants, have compiled, examined or performed any procedures with respect to our forecast, nor have they expressed any opinion or any other form of assurance on our forecast or its achievability, and our independent auditors assume no responsibility for, and disclaim any association with, our forecast.

              We do not undertake any obligation to release publicly any revisions or updates that we may make to the forecast or the assumptions used to prepare the forecast to reflect events or circumstances after the date of this prospectus. In light of this, the statement that we believe that we will have sufficient available cash to allow us to pay the full minimum quarterly distribution on all of our common and subordinated units for each quarter in the twelve months ending September 30, 2013 should not be regarded as a representation by us, the underwriters or any other person that we will make such distributions. Therefore, you are cautioned not to place undue reliance on this information.

60


Table of Contents

              The following table illustrates our estimated available cash for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013 and for each of the four quarters in the twelve months ending September 30, 2013.

 
  Three Months Ending   Twelve
Months
Ending
 
 
  December 31,
2012
  March 31,
2013
  June 30,
2013
  September 30,
2013
  September 30,
2013
 
 
  (in thousands, except per unit data)
 

Revenues:

                               

Motor fuel sales

  $ 1,046,089   $ 1,077,053   $ 1,112,962   $ 1,099,969   $ 4,336,073  

Rental income

    841     1,219     1,507     1,651     5,217  

Other income(1)

    1,329     1,359     1,359     1,364     5,411  
                       

Total revenues

    1,048,259     1,079,630     1,115,827     1,102,984     4,346,701  
                       

Gross profit:

                               

Motor fuel sales

    12,725     13,050     13,547     13,405     52,726  

Rental income

    841     1,219     1,507     1,651     5,217  

Other income(1)

    854     861     863     886     3,463  
                       

Total gross profit

    14,419     15,129     15,916     15,941     61,406  
                       

Operating expenses:

                               

Selling, general and administrative(2)

    3,203     3,287     3,248     3,241     12,979  

Rent

    264     264     264     264     1,056  

Depreciation and amortization

    1,498     1,785     2,109     2,135     7,527  
                       

Total operating expenses

    4,965     5,336     5,621     5,640     21,562  
                       

Operating income

    9,454     9,793     10,296     10,301     39,844  

Interest expense, net(3)

    508     550     642     693     2,393  

State franchise tax expense, net of other income tax benefit(4)

    72     90     37     58     257  
                       

Net income

    8,874     9,153     9,617     9,550     37,194  

Net income per common unit—basic and diluted(5)

                               

Net income per subordinated unit—basic and diluted(5)

                               

Adjustments to reconcile net income to estimated Adjusted EBITDA:

                               

Add:

                               

Non-cash stock compensation expense

    147     147     147     147     589  

Gain/loss on disposals

                             

Interest expense, net(3)

    508     550     642     693     2,393  

Depreciation and amortization

    1,498     1,785     2,109     2,135     7,527  

State franchise tax expense, net of other income tax benefit(4)

    72     90     37     58     257  
                       

Estimated Adjusted EBITDA(6)

    11,099     11,726     12,552     12,583     47,960  
                       

Adjustments to reconcile estimated Adjusted EBITDA to estimated available cash:

                               

Less:

                               

Cash interest expense, net(3)

    (392 )   (432 )   (524 )   (574 )   (1,922 )

State franchise tax expense (cash)

    (71 )   (76 )   (80 )   (80 )   (307 )

Maintenance capital expenditures

    (425 )   (425 )   (425 )   (425 )   (1,700 )

Expansion capital expenditures(7)

    (500 )   (19,400 )   (22,100 )   (500 )   (42,500 )

Add:

                               

Liquidation of U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities to fund expansion capital expenditures(3)(7)

    500     19,400     22,100     500     42,500  
                       

Estimated available cash

  $ 10,211   $ 10,793   $ 11,523   $ 11,504   $ 44,031  
                       

61


Table of Contents

 
  Three Months Ending   Twelve
Months
Ending
 
 
  December 31,
2012
  March 31,
2013
  June 30,
2013
  September 30,
2013
  September 30,
2013
 
 
  (in thousands, except per unit data)
 

Cash distributions:

                               

Distributions to public common unitholders

                               

Distributions to SHC and its affiliates—common units

                               

Distributions to SHC and its affiliates—subordinated units

                               
                       

Total distributions at the minimum distribution rate

                               
                       

Excess (shortfall)

 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
                       

Percent of minimum quarterly distributions payable to common unitholders

      %     %     %     %     %

Percent of minimum quarterly distributions payable to subordinated unitholders

      %     %     %     %     %

(1)
Other income and other gross profit includes propane and lube oil sales, sales of rights to operate dealer locations and other miscellaneous non-motor fuel income sources.

(2)
Includes estimated incremental cash expenses associated with being a publicly traded partnership of approximately $2.0 million, including costs associated with SEC reporting requirements, tax return and Schedule K-1 preparation and distribution, independent auditor fees, investor relations activities, Sarbanes-Oxley compliance, stock exchange listing, registrar and transfer agent fees, incremental director and officer liability insurance and director compensation.

(3)
We expect to incur approximately $147.3 million of term loan borrowings under our new term loan facility at the completion of this offering, which will be secured by an equal amount of U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities we intend to purchase with a portion of the proceeds from this offering. We will finance our $42.5 million in expansion capital expenditures by selling $42.5 million of the U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities that serve as collateral for our term loan. Immediately prior to selling these securities, in order to release them as collateral for our term loan, we will repay $42.5 million of borrowings under our term loan facility with an equivalent amount of borrowings under our new revolving credit facility. We also expect to incur approximately $2.4 million in borrowings under our new revolving credit facility at the completion of this offering. Interest expense and cash interest expense both reflect the interest expense incurred on our term loan borrowings, net of the interest income received on our U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities, and our borrowings under our new revolving credit facility. Interest expense also includes interest expense on an existing mortgage note, net of interest income on notes receivable from dealers.

(4)
Includes the Texas franchise tax. Due to our status as a partnership, we will not be subject to U.S. federal income tax in the future, except for our subsidiary that is treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes. This subsidiary is expected to own the 15 Stripes® convenience stores we have assumed we will purchase pursuant to sale and leaseback transactions from SHC during the forecast period and will receive rental income from SHC. However, we believe this rental income will be more than offset by depreciation and interest deductions associated with our purchase and ownership of these stores, resulting in a net federal tax benefit of $50,000 for the forecast period.

(5)
Pro forma net income per limited partner unit is determined by dividing the pro forma net income available to our common and subordinated unitholders by the number of common and subordinated units expected to be outstanding at the closing of the offering. For purposes of this calculation, we have assumed there will be                common units and                 subordinated units outstanding.

(6)
Adjusted EBITDA is defined and reconciled to its most directly comparable financial measures calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP in "Summary—Non-GAAP Financial Measure."

(7)
Our expansion capital expenditures include an estimated $40.5 million that we expect to pay to SHC to purchase 15 stores in 2013 pursuant to our sale-leaseback option in the omnibus agreement.

62


Table of Contents


Significant Forecast Assumptions

              The forecast has been prepared by and is the responsibility of our management. Our forecast reflects our judgment as of the date of this prospectus of the conditions we expect to exist and the course of action we expect to take during the forecast period. While the assumptions disclosed in this prospectus are not all-inclusive, the assumptions listed are those that we believe are significant to our forecasted results of operations. We believe we have a reasonable objective basis for these assumptions. We believe that our actual results of operations will approximate those reflected in our forecast, but we can give no assurance that our forecasted results will be achieved. There will likely be differences between our forecast and the actual results, and those differences could be material. If our forecast is not achieved, we may not be able to pay cash distributions on our common units at the minimum distribution rate or at all.

General Considerations and Risks

    The volume of motor fuel delivered is the primary factor that will influence whether the amount of cash available for distribution for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013 is above or below our forecast.

    Our total volume of fuel sold can be impacted by material changes to prices paid by consumers at the pump. While our overall and average per-store volumes have grown consistently over time, significant increases in fuel prices or significant economic contraction in the areas in which we operate could materially and adversely impact the volumes of motor fuel we sell. A 10% decline in our estimated volumes distributed to each of our customers on a pro rata basis for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013 would result in a decline of approximately $5 million in Adjusted EBITDA and available cash for the forecast period, assuming motor fuel prices and all other variables are held constant.

    Because our motor fuel distribution business is primarily a fee-based business, the overall level of motor fuel prices has a limited effect on our gross profit per gallon. The profit margin we earn on gallons we sell to SHC is fixed under the SHC Distribution Contract, while the profit margin we earn on gallons sold to third parties can vary with the cost of fuel. We estimate that if our projected average motor fuel cost of $2.86 per gallon (excluding transportation costs and excise taxes) for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013 increased or decreased by $0.10, this would result in an approximate $300,000 increase or decrease in Adjusted EBITDA and available cash for the forecast period, assuming no changes to estimated volumes for the forecast period. Although we have not assumed any changes in volumes for purposes of this sensitivity analysis, we believe demand for motor fuel would decrease if there were a material increase in the price of motor fuel and the negative impact to our volumes would partially or completely offset the positive impact on our margins. Please read "Risk Factors—Risks Inherent in Our Business—Our financial condition and results of operations are influenced by changes in the prices of motor fuel, which may adversely impact our margins, our customers' financial condition and the availability of trade credit."

Revenues and Gross Profit

              We forecast that our total revenues and gross profit for the twelve months ending September 30, 2013, or the "forecast period," will be $4.3 billion and $61.4 million, respectively, as compared to $4.1 billion and $53.1 million, respectively, on a pro forma basis for the twelve months ended June 30, 2012, or the "base period." We estimate that we will distribute 1.5 billion gallons of motor fuel for the forecast period, as compared to 1.4 billion gallons we distributed for the base period. We anticipate that the profit margin per gallon of motor fuel we distribute will be similar

63


Table of Contents

during the forecast period to the profit margin we would have earned on a pro forma basis during the base period. Our revenue forecast is based primarily on the following assumptions:

      Motor Fuel Revenues and Gross Profit

    Revenues and Gross Profit from Fuel Sales to SHC .   Based on our volume and cost per gallon estimates for the forecast period and our fixed profit margin on fuel sales to SHC under the SHC Distribution Contract, we forecast that our motor fuel distribution revenues and gross profit from fuel sales to SHC will be $2.9 billion and $30.4 million, respectively, for the forecast period, as compared to $2.7 billion and $28.3 million, respectively, on a pro forma basis for the base period.

    Volumes to SHC.   We estimate that we will distribute 1.0 billion gallons of motor fuel to SHC during the forecast period, as compared to the 943 million gallons we distributed to SHC on a pro forma basis for the base period. This volume estimate is based on the following assumptions:

    We will distribute motor fuel to a monthly weighted average of 560 Stripes® convenience stores and 84 consignment locations during the forecast period, as compared to a monthly weighted average of 534 Stripes ® convenience stores and 84 consignment locations during the base period. The average number of Stripes® convenience stores for the forecast period takes into account (i) the stores that SHC expects to have completed prior to the completion of this offering and (ii) assumes that we will exercise our option on 15 new stores built during the forecast period. Pursuant to the provisions of the omnibus agreement, we have assumed that we will distribute motor fuel to all of these additional stores at a fixed three cent per gallon profit margin. Our forecast does not reflect an incremental 10.8 million gallons that we expect to distribute during the forecast period to other newly constructed Stripes® convenience stores we expect to be completed in 2013 based on SHC's announced new store construction plan. Under the omnibus agreement, we will negotiate with SHC to determine the rate at which we distribute motor fuel to these additional new stores. See "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions—Agreements with Affiliates in Connection with the Transactions—Omnibus Agreement."

    Annual volumes per Stripes ® convenience store will grow by approximately 4.0% to 1.60 million gallons per store during the forecast period, as compared to 1.54 million gallons per store during the base period, which is consistent with our historical per Stripes ® convenience store growth trends. Historical volume growth per Stripes ® convenience store averaged 6.9% for the six months ended June 30, 2012, 4.9% for fiscal 2011 and 4.0% per year from January 1, 2006 through June 30, 2012. In recent years, SHC has been focused on the construction of large format stores, which generally sell higher volumes of motor fuel as compared to older, smaller stores, increasing average annual per-store growth. SHC expects to continue construction of these large format stores in 2012 and 2013.

    Volumes per consignment location will be equal to the consignment volumes distributed during the base period, which is consistent with our predecessor's historical trends.

    Commodity Prices.   We have assumed that our average weighted cost to purchase each gallon of motor fuel sold during the forecast period will be $2.86 per gallon, which was derived by adjusting our average cost of $2.88 per gallon of motor fuel sold for fiscal 2011 to reflect the estimated forecast period volume mix by customer group.

64


Table of Contents

      Profit Margin from Sales to SHC.   Our profit margin on sales to SHC is fixed at three cents per gallon under the SHC Distribution Contract. We have added the fixed profit margin set forth in the SHC Distribution Contract to the average cost per gallon to calculate our assumed revenue per gallon of motor fuel sold. Because we receive a fixed fee for all volumes distributed to SHC, the overall level of motor fuel prices has no direct effect on our profit margin per gallon of motor fuel sold to SHC.

    Revenues and Gross Profit from Fuel Sales to Third Parties .   Based on our volume and cost estimates for the forecast period, we forecast that our motor fuel distribution revenues and gross profit from fuel sales to third parties will be $1.4 billion and $22.4 million, respectively, for the forecast period, as compared to $1.4 billion and $18.8 million, respectively, on a pro forma basis for the base period.

    Volumes to Third Parties.   We estimate that we will distribute 488 million gallons of motor fuel to third-party dealers and commercial customers during the forecast period, compared to the 456 million gallons we distributed to third-party dealers and commercial customers for the base period. In calculating our estimated third party gallons for the forecast period, we have assumed (i) that 25 net dealer locations will be added, based on 35 new dealer locations added, and the closure of ten of our smaller locations, during the forecast period, as compared to our historic average of 40 net dealer additions per year over the last five years; (ii) annualized volumes for the 121 dealer supply contracts acquired from Community Fuels of Texas, LP in October 2011 based on average monthly volumes for such sites since the acquisition; (iii) that there will be a slight decline in volumes distributed per existing dealer location for the forecast period as compared to the base period based on historical trends in dealer volumes and (iv) that volumes to our commercial customers will be similar to those distributed during the base period.

    Commodity Prices.   We have assumed that our average weighted cost to purchase each gallon of motor fuel sold during the forecast period will be $2.86 per gallon, which was derived by adjusting our average cost of $2.88 per gallon of motor fuel sold for fiscal 2011 to reflect the estimated forecast period volume mix by customer group.

    Profit Margin from Sales to Third Parties.   The profit margin we earn on gallons sold to our dealers and other third parties can vary with the cost of fuel. We have assumed that our profit margin per gallon of motor fuel sold to third parties will be 4.6 cents per gallon for the forecast period, which is consistent with our pro forma average profit margin per gallon to third parties for both fiscal 2011 and for the base period and consistent with our commodity price assumptions for the forecast period.

      Rental Income Revenues and Rent Expense

    Rental Income from SHC .   We have not historically received any rental income from SHC. We estimate that we will receive $1.9 million in rental income from SHC during the forecast period, based on the assumption that we will exercise our option to purchase each of the 15 Stripes ® convenience stores included in the first annual option period, all of which are expected to be purchased prior to May 2013, in each case at the cost set forth in our capital expenditure assumptions below. We have also assumed that we will receive rental income at an annual rate of 8% of the purchase price on such stores as set forth in the omnibus agreement. Our projected rental income only reflects rental income for the portion of the forecast period after the applicable option exercise date and does not reflect the annualized rental income. We estimate that annualized rental income for these 15 stores would be approximately $3.2 million. For a more detailed description of the omnibus agreement,

65


Table of Contents

      please read "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions—Agreements with Affiliates in Connection with the Transactions—Omnibus Agreement."

    Taxes on Rental Income from SHC .   Our subsidiary that is treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes is expected to own the 15 Stripes ® convenience stores we have assumed we will purchase pursuant to sale and leaseback transactions with SHC during the forecast period and will be subject to federal income tax on rental income received from SHC. However, we believe that the estimated rental income from SHC for the forecast period will be more than offset by depreciation and interest deductions associated with our purchase and ownership of these stores, resulting in a net federal tax benefit of $50,000 for the forecast period.

    Rental Income from Third Parties .   We estimate that our rental income from third parties will be $3.4 million during the forecast period, which is the same as it would have been on a pro forma basis during the base period. This estimated rental income is based primarily on the expectation that we will lease or sublease the same 55 sites to third parties during the forecast period on the same terms as we leased to third parties during the first half of 2012.

    Rental Expense Related to Certain Properties Subleased to Third Parties .   Twelve of the 55 sites referenced above are properties that we lease from third parties and then subsequently sublease to other third parties. We forecast that our rental expense associated with leasing these 12 sites will be $1.1 million during the forecast period, which is comparable with the rent expense during the base period.

      Other Income and Other Gross Profit.

              Other income and other gross profit includes propane and lube oil sales, sale of rights to operate dealer locations and other miscellaneous non-fuel income sources. We forecast other income and gross profit for the forecast period of $5.4 million and $3.5 million, respectively, compared to $4.8 million and $2.6 million, respectively, for the base period. The forecast for other gross profit was developed based on recent operating trends, which include increased activity in our propane and lube oil business and a full year impact related to the dealer supply contracts acquired in late 2011.

Selling, General and Administrative Expenses

              We estimate that selling, general and administrative ("SG&A") expenses for the forecast period will be approximately $13.0 million, compared to $12.2 million on a pro forma basis for the base period. Our forecast for SG&A expense was developed by reference to our SG&A expense to date in 2012 and during the base period, on a pro forma basis, excluding certain non-recurring or unusually large items. These items included approximately $0.6 million of incremental bonus and 401(k) discretionary match expense that reflected the significant above-target performance of our predecessor for 2011 and the first half of 2012, approximately $200,000 of certain public company expenses of SHC that were allocated to our predecessor in the base period that we do not expect to be allocated in the future and a $200,000 loss on disposal of assets that we do not expect to recur. Estimated corporate overhead costs to manage our business and SHC's business for the forecast period are allocated based on a percentage of time we estimate the employees of our general partner or SHC will devote to the operation of our business. Our forecast also reflects the approximately $2.0 million of incremental SG&A expenses that we expect to incur as a result of being a publicly traded partnership, including costs associated with SEC reporting requirements, tax return and Schedule K-1 preparation and distribution, independent auditor fees, investor relations activities, Sarbanes-Oxley Act compliance, stock exchange listing, registrar and transfer agent fees, incremental director and officer liability insurance and director compensation.

66


Table of Contents

Depreciation and Amortization

              We estimate that depreciation and amortization will increase to $7.5 million for the forecast period compared to pro forma $5.4 million for the base period. Forecasted depreciation and amortization expense reflects management's estimates, which are based on consistent average depreciable asset lives and depreciation methodologies, taking into account forecasted capital expenditures described below, including the purchase of 15 Stripes® convenience stores for $40.5 million pursuant to the exercise of our sale and leaseback option. We have assumed that the average depreciable asset lives are 40 years for buildings and seven years for equipment.

Capital Expenditures

              We estimate that total capital expenditures for the forecast period will be approximately $44.2 million, as compared to $15.7 million for the base period.

    Expansion capital expenditures are projected to be approximately $42.5 million for the forecast period. These expenditures include an estimated $40.5 million that we expect to pay to SHC to purchase 15 stores during 2013 pursuant to our sale and leaseback option, based on SHC's current average construction cost of $2.7 million per store, excluding costs for equipment retained by SHC. We expect to exercise our option with respect to each of the 15 stores included in the first annual option period, and each of those exercised stores and associated fuel volumes will be immediately added to the SHC Distribution Contract at that time. Expansion capital expenditures also include $2.0 million, primarily to invest in new third-party fuel distribution agreements or real estate associated with acquisitions. Although we may make significant acquisitions during the forecast period, our forecast does not reflect any multi-unit acquisitions by us or SHC.

    Maintenance capital expenditures are projected to be approximately $1.7 million for the forecast period, as compared to $1.1 million for the base period. Maintenance capital expenditures are incurred primarily to renew existing fuel distribution contracts, to maintain the real estate we lease to third-party dealers in leaseable condition, or to replace equipment required to operate our existing business. The increase of $0.6 million in projected maintenance capital expenditures for the forecast period as compared to the base period is due to an expected increase in the number of distribution contract renewals during the forecast period as compared to the base period and conservative estimates of the costs to renew such contracts. We do not expect to incur any maintenance expense on Stripes ® convenience stores leased to SHC because under the form of lease SHC will be responsible for all maintenance, taxes and environmental costs on such stores.

Financing

              We estimate that interest expense will be approximately $2.4 million for the forecast period as compared to $0.7 million for the base period. Our interest expense is based on the following financing assumptions:

    $147.3 million of proceeds from this offering will be invested in U.S. treasury or other investment grade securities.

    Our debt levels during the forecast period will not exceed $150.7 million, with $147.3 million initially drawn under our term loan facility and $2.4 million drawn under the revolving credit facility.

    Borrowings under our term loan facility will bear an average interest rate of 0.25%, net of interest earned on the $147.3 million of U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities pledged to secure the term loan.

67


Table of Contents

    We will finance our $42.5 million in expansion capital expenditures by selling $42.5 million of U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities.

    Immediately prior to selling such securities, we will repay $42.5 million of borrowings under our term loan facility with an equivalent amount of borrowings under our new revolving credit facility.

    The borrowings under our revolving credit facility will bear an average interest rate of 2.40%. This rate is based on a current forecast of LIBOR for the forecast period plus a margin.

    Net interest expense also includes existing interest expense on mortgage debt, net of interest income on notes receivable from dealers and non-cash amortization of loan fees on our new secured term loan and revolving credit facilities.

Regulatory, Industry and Economic Factors

              Our estimated results of operations for the forecast period are based on the following assumptions related to regulatory, industry and economic factors:

    no material nonperformance or credit-related defaults by suppliers, SHC, dealers or our commercial customers;

    no new federal, state or local regulation, or interpretation of existing regulation, of the portions of the motor fuels industry in which we operate that in either case will be materially adverse to our business or our customers' or suppliers' businesses;

    no material adverse effects to our business, industry or our customers' or suppliers' businesses on account of natural disasters;

    no material adverse change resulting from supply disruptions or reduced demand for motor fuels; and

    no material adverse changes in market, regulatory and overall economic conditions.

              Actual results could vary significantly from the foregoing assumptions. Please read "Risk Factors—Risks Inherent in Our Business—The assumptions underlying our forecast of our available cash included in "Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions" are inherently uncertain and subject to significant business, economic, financial, regulatory and competitive risks and uncertainties that could cause our available cash for distribution to differ materially from our estimates."

68


Table of Contents


PROVISIONS OF OUR PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT RELATING TO CASH DISTRIBUTIONS

              Set forth below is a summary of the significant provisions of our partnership agreement that relate to cash distributions.


Distributions of Available Cash

General

              Our partnership agreement requires that, within 60 days after the end of each quarter, beginning with the quarter ending                         , 2012, we distribute all of our available cash to unitholders of record on the applicable record date. We will adjust the minimum quarterly distribution for the period from the completion of the offering through                        , 2012 based on the actual length of that period.

Definition of Available Cash

              Available cash, for any quarter, generally consists of all cash and cash equivalents on hand at the end of that quarter:

    less , the amount of cash reserves established by our general partner to:

    provide for the proper conduct of our business;

    comply with applicable law, any of our debt instruments or other agreements or any other obligation; or

    provide funds for distributions to our unitholders for any one or more of the next four quarters (provided that our general partner may not establish cash reserves for the payment of distributions unless it determines that the establishment of such reserves will not prevent us from distributing the minimum quarterly distribution on all common units and any cumulative arrearages on such common units for the current quarter);

    plus , if our general partner so determines on the date of determination, all or any portion of the cash on hand immediately prior to the date of distribution of available cash for the quarter, including cash on hand resulting from working capital borrowings made after the end of the quarter.

              The purpose and effect of the last bullet point above is to allow our general partner, if it so decides, to use cash received by us after the end of the quarter but on or before the date of distribution of available cash for that quarter, including cash on hand resulting from working capital borrowings made after the end of the quarter, to pay distributions to unitholders. Under our partnership agreement, working capital borrowings are borrowings that are made under a credit agreement, commercial paper facility or similar financing arrangement with the intent to repay such borrowings within twelve months from sources other than additional working capital borrowings, and that are used solely for working capital purposes or to pay distributions to partners.

Intent to Distribute the Minimum Quarterly Distribution

              We intend to distribute to the holders of common and subordinated units at least the minimum quarterly distribution of $            per unit, or $            on an annualized basis, to the extent we have sufficient cash from our operations after establishment of cash reserves and payment of fees and expenses, including payments to our general partner and its affiliates. However, there is no guarantee that we will pay the minimum quarterly distribution on our units in any quarter. Even if our cash distribution policy is not modified or revoked, the amount of distributions paid under our policy and

69


Table of Contents

the decision to make any distribution is determined by our general partner, taking into consideration the terms of our partnership agreement.

General Partner Interest and Incentive Distribution Rights

              Initially, our general partner will own a 0.0% non-economic general partner interest. SHC will initially hold our incentive distribution rights, which will entitle it to receive increasing percentages, up to a maximum of 50.0%, of the cash we distribute from operating surplus (as defined below) in excess of $            per unit per quarter. The maximum distribution of 50.0% does not include any distributions that SHC may receive on any limited partner units that it owns.


Operating Surplus and Capital Surplus

General

              All cash distributed to unitholders will be characterized as being paid from either "operating surplus" or "capital surplus." Our partnership agreement requires that we distribute available cash from operating surplus differently than available cash from capital surplus. Operating surplus distributions will be made to our unitholders and, if we make quarterly distributions above the first target distribution level described below, to the holder of our incentive distribution rights. We do not anticipate that we will make any distributions from capital surplus. In such an event, however, any capital surplus distribution would be made pro rata to all unitholders, but the holder of the incentive distribution rights would generally not participate in any capital surplus distributions with respect to those rights.

Operating Surplus

              We define operating surplus as:

    $             million (as described below); plus

    all of our cash receipts after the closing of this offering, excluding cash from interim capital transactions (as defined below), provided that cash receipts from the termination of any hedge contract prior to its stipulated settlement or termination date will be included in equal quarterly installments over the remaining scheduled life of such hedge contract had it not been terminated; plus

    working capital borrowings made after the end of a period but on or before the date of distribution of operating surplus for that period; plus

    cash distributions paid on equity issued (including incremental distributions on incentive distribution rights), other than equity issued in this offering, to finance all or a portion of expansion capital expenditures in respect of the period from the date that we enter into a binding obligation to commence the construction, acquisition or improvement of a capital asset until the earlier to occur of the date the capital asset commences commercial service and the date that it is abandoned or disposed of; plus

    cash distributions paid on equity issued (including incremental distributions on incentive distribution rights), other than equity issued in this offering, to pay the construction period interest on debt incurred, or to pay construction period distributions on equity issued, to finance the expansion capital expenditures referred to above, in each case, in respect of the period from the date that we enter into a binding obligation to commence the construction, acquisition or improvement of a capital asset until the earlier to occur of the date the capital asset is placed in service and the date that it is abandoned or disposed of; less

    all of our operating expenditures (as defined below) after the closing of this offering; less

70


Table of Contents

    the amount of cash reserves established by our general partner to provide funds for future operating expenditures; less

    all working capital borrowings not repaid within twelve months after having been incurred, or repaid within such twelve-month period with the proceeds of additional working capital borrowings; less

    any cash loss realized on the disposition of an investment capital expenditure.

              As described above, operating surplus does not reflect actual cash on hand that is available for distribution to our unitholders and is not limited to cash generated by our operations. For example, it includes a basket of $             million that will enable us, if we choose, to distribute as operating surplus up to that amount of cash we receive in the future from non-operating sources such as asset sales, issuances of securities and long-term borrowings that would otherwise be distributed as capital surplus. In addition, the effect of including certain cash distributions on equity interests in operating surplus, as described above, will be to increase operating surplus by the amount of any such cash distributions. As a result, we may also distribute as operating surplus up to that amount of cash that we receive from non-operating sources.

              The proceeds of working capital borrowings increase operating surplus and repayments of working capital borrowings are generally operating expenditures, as described below, and thus reduce operating surplus when made. However, if a working capital borrowing is not repaid during the twelve-month period following the borrowing, it will be deemed repaid at the end of such period, thus decreasing operating surplus at such time. When such working capital borrowing is in fact repaid, it will be excluded from operating expenditures because operating surplus will have been previously reduced by the deemed repayment.

              We define operating expenditures as all of our cash expenditures, including, but not limited to, taxes, reimbursement of expenses to our general partner or its affiliates, payments made in the ordinary course of business under interest rate hedge agreements or commodity hedge agreements (provided that (1) payments made in connection with the initial purchase of an interest rate hedge contract or a commodity hedge contract will be amortized over the life of the applicable interest rate hedge contract or commodity hedge contract and (2) payments made in connection with the termination of any interest rate hedge contract or commodity hedge contract prior to its stipulated settlement or termination date will be included in operating expenditures in equal quarterly installments over the remaining scheduled life of such contract), compensation of officers, directors and employees of our general partner, repayment of working capital borrowings, debt service payments and maintenance capital expenditures (as discussed in further detail below), provided that operating expenditures will not include:

    repayment of working capital borrowings deducted from operating surplus pursuant to the penultimate bullet point of the definition of operating surplus above when such repayment actually occurs;

    payments (including prepayments and prepayment penalties) of principal of and premium on indebtedness other than working capital borrowings;

    expansion capital expenditures;

    investment capital expenditures;

    payment of transaction expenses relating to interim capital transactions;

    distributions to our partners (including distributions in respect of our incentive distribution rights); or

71


Table of Contents

    repurchases of equity interests (other than repurchases to satisfy obligations under employee benefit plans) or reimbursements of our general partner for such purchases.

Interim Capital Transactions

              We define cash from interim capital transactions to include proceeds from:

    borrowings other than working capital borrowings;

    sales of our equity and debt securities; and

    sales or other dispositions of assets, other than inventory, accounts receivable and other assets sold in the ordinary course of business or assets sold or disposed of as part of normal retirement or replacement of assets.

Capital Surplus

              Capital surplus is defined as any distribution of available cash in excess of our operating surplus. Although the cash proceeds from interim capital transactions do not increase operating surplus, all distributions of available cash from whatever source are deemed to be from operating surplus until cumulative distributions of available cash exceed cumulative operating surplus. Thereafter, all distributions of available cash are deemed to be from capital surplus to the extent they continue to exceed cumulative operating surplus.

Characterization of Cash Distributions

              Our partnership agreement requires that we treat all available cash distributed by us as coming from operating surplus until the sum of all available cash distributed since the closing of this offering equals the operating surplus from the closing of this offering through the end of the quarter immediately preceding that distribution. Our partnership agreement requires that we treat any amount distributed in excess of operating surplus, regardless of its source, as capital surplus. As described above, operating surplus includes a basket of $             million, and therefore does not reflect actual cash on hand that is available for distribution to our unitholders. Rather, this provision will enable us, if we choose, to distribute as operating surplus up to that amount of cash we receive in the future from interim capital transactions that would otherwise be distributed as capital surplus. We do not anticipate that we will make any distributions from capital surplus.


Capital Expenditures

              Maintenance capital expenditures reduce operating surplus, but expansion capital expenditures and investment capital expenditures do not. Under our partnership agreement, maintenance capital expenditures are capital expenditures made to maintain our long-term operating income or operating capacity, while expansion capital expenditures are capital expenditures that we expect will increase our operating income or operating capacity over the long term. Examples of maintenance capital expenditures are those made to maintain existing contract volumes or renew existing distribution contracts or maintain our real estate leased to third-party dealers in leaseable condition. Maintenance capital expenditures will also include interest (and related fees) on debt incurred and distributions in respect of equity issued (including incremental distributions on incentive distribution rights), other than equity issued in this offering, to finance all or any portion of the construction or development of a replacement asset that are paid in respect of the period that begins when we enter into a binding obligation to commence construction or development of a replacement asset and ending on the earlier to occur of the date that such replacement asset commences commercial service and the date that it is abandoned or disposed of. Capital expenditures made solely for investment purposes will not be considered maintenance capital expenditures.

72


Table of Contents

              Expansion capital expenditures are capital expenditures made to increase our operating capacity over the long term. Examples of expansion capital expenditures include the acquisition of new properties or equipment, to the extent such capital expenditures are expected to expand our long-term operating capacity. Expansion capital expenditures will also include interest (and related fees) on debt incurred and distributions in respect of equity issued (including incremental distributions on incentive distribution rights) to finance all or any portion of the construction of a capital improvement paid in respect of the period that commences when we enter into a binding obligation to commence construction of a capital improvement and ending on the earlier to occur of date such capital improvement commences commercial service and the date that it is disposed of or abandoned. Capital expenditures made solely for investment purposes will not be considered expansion capital expenditures.

              Investment capital expenditures are those capital expenditures that are neither maintenance capital expenditures nor expansion capital expenditures. Investment capital expenditures largely will consist of capital expenditures made for investment purposes. Examples of investment capital expenditures include traditional capital expenditures for investment purposes, such as purchases of securities, as well as other capital expenditures that might be made in lieu of such traditional investment capital expenditures, such as the acquisition of a capital asset for investment purposes or the development of assets that are in excess of those needed for the maintenance of our existing operating capacity, but which are not expected to expand, for more than the short term, our operating capacity.

              As described above, neither investment capital expenditures nor expansion capital expenditures are included in operating expenditures, and thus will not reduce operating surplus. Because expansion capital expenditures include interest payments (and related fees) on debt incurred to finance all or a portion of the construction, acquisition or development of a capital improvement during the period that begins when we enter into a binding obligation to commence construction, acquisition or development of a capital improvement and ending on the earlier to occur of the date such capital improvement commences commercial service and the date that it is abandoned or disposed of, such interest payments also do not reduce operating surplus. Losses on the disposition of an investment capital expenditure will reduce operating surplus when realized and cash receipts from an investment capital expenditure will be treated as a cash receipt for purposes of calculating operating surplus only to the extent the cash receipt is a return on principal.

              Capital expenditures that are made in part for maintenance capital purposes, investment capital purposes and/or expansion capital purposes will be allocated as maintenance capital expenditures, investment capital expenditures or expansion capital expenditure by our general partner.


Subordinated Units

General

              Our partnership agreement provides that, during the subordination period (which we define below), the common units will have the right to receive distributions of available cash from operating surplus each quarter in an amount equal to $            per common unit, which amount is defined in our partnership agreement as the minimum quarterly distribution, plus any arrearages in the payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units from prior quarters, before any distributions of available cash from operating surplus may be made on the subordinated units. These units are deemed "subordinated" because for a period of time, referred to as the subordination period, the subordinated units will not be entitled to receive any distributions from operating surplus until the common units have received the minimum quarterly distribution plus any arrearages in the payment of the minimum quarterly distribution from prior quarters. Furthermore, no arrearages will be paid on the subordinated units. The practical effect of the subordinated units is to increase the likelihood that

73


Table of Contents

during the subordination period there will be sufficient available cash from operating surplus to pay the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units. SHC will initially own, directly or indirectly, all of our subordinated units.

Subordination Period

              Except as described below, the subordination period will begin on the closing date of this offering and expire on the first business day after a distribution to unitholders has been made in respect of any quarter, beginning with the quarter ending on or after                                    , 2015, if each of the following has occurred:

    distributions of available cash from operating surplus on each of the outstanding common and subordinated units equaled or exceeded the annualized minimum quarterly distribution for each of the three consecutive, non-overlapping four-quarter periods immediately preceding that date;

    the "adjusted operating surplus" (as defined below) generated during each of the three consecutive, non-overlapping four-quarter periods immediately preceding that date equaled or exceeded the sum of the minimum quarterly distributions on all of the outstanding common and subordinated units during those periods on a fully diluted, weighted-average basis; and

    there are no arrearages in the payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units.

Early Termination of Subordination Period

              Notwithstanding the foregoing, the subordination period will automatically terminate on the first business day after a distribution to unitholders has been made in respect of any quarter, if each of the following has occurred:

    distributions of available cash from operating surplus on each of the outstanding common and subordinated units exceeded $            (150.0% of the annualized minimum quarterly distribution) for the four-quarter period immediately preceding that date;

    the "adjusted operating surplus" (as defined below) generated during the four-quarter period immediately preceding that date equaled or exceeded the sum of (i) $            (150.0% of the annualized minimum quarterly distribution) on all of the outstanding common and subordinated units during that period on a fully diluted, weighted-average basis and (ii) the distributions made on the incentive distribution rights; and

    there are no arrearages in the payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units.

              In addition, if the unitholders remove our general partner other than for cause:

    the subordinated units held by any person will immediately and automatically convert into common units on a one-for-one basis, provided (i) neither such person nor any of its affiliates voted any of its units in favor of the removal and (ii) such person is not an affiliate of the successor general partner; and

    if all of the subordinated units convert pursuant to the foregoing, all cumulative common unit arrearages on the common units will be extinguished and the subordination period will end.

74


Table of Contents

Effect of Expiration of the Subordination Period

              When the subordination period ends, each outstanding subordinated unit will convert into one common unit and will then participate pro-rata with the other common units in distributions of available cash.

Adjusted Operating Surplus

              Adjusted operating surplus is intended to reflect the cash generated from operations during a particular period and therefore excludes net changes in working capital borrowings and net changes in reserves of cash established in prior periods. Adjusted operating surplus consists of:

    operating surplus generated with respect to that period (excluding any amount attributable to the item described in the first bullet point under the caption "—Operating Surplus and Capital Surplus—Operating Surplus" above); less

    any net increase in working capital borrowings with respect to that period; less

    any net decrease in cash reserves for operating expenditures with respect to that period not relating to an operating expenditure made with respect to that period; plus

    any net decrease in working capital borrowings with respect to that period; plus

    any net increase in cash reserves for operating expenditures with respect to that period required by any debt instrument for the repayment of principal, interest or premium; plus

    any net decrease made in subsequent periods in cash reserves for operating expenditures initially established with respect to such period to the extent such decrease results in a reduction of adjusted operating surplus in subsequent periods pursuant to the third bullet point above.


Distributions of Available Cash From Operating Surplus During the Subordination Period

              Our partnership agreement requires that we make distributions of available cash from operating surplus for any quarter during the subordination period in the following manner:

    first , to the common unitholders, pro rata, until we distribute for each common unit an amount equal to the minimum quarterly distribution for that quarter;

    second , to the common unitholders, pro rata, until we distribute for each common unit an amount equal to any arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units for any prior quarters during the subordination period;

    third , to the subordinated unitholders, pro rata, until we distribute for each subordinated unit an amount equal to the minimum quarterly distribution for that quarter; and

    thereafter , in the manner described in "—Incentive Distribution Rights" below.

              The preceding discussion is based on the assumption that we do not issue additional classes of equity interests.


Distributions of Available Cash From Operating Surplus After the Subordination Period

              Our partnership agreement requires that we make distributions of available cash from operating surplus for any quarter after the subordination period in the following manner:

    first , to the common unitholders, pro rata, until we distribute for each common unit an amount equal to the minimum quarterly distribution for that quarter; and

75


Table of Contents

    thereafter , in the manner described in "—Incentive Distribution Rights" below.

              The preceding discussion is based on the assumption that we do not issue additional classes of equity interests.


General Partner Interest

              Our general partner owns a 0.0% non-economic general partner interest in us, which does not entitle it to receive cash distributions. However, our general partner may in the future own common units or other equity interests in us, and will be entitled to receive distributions on such interests.


Incentive Distribution Rights

              Incentive distribution rights represent the right to receive an increasing percentage (15.0%, 25.0% and 50.0%) of quarterly distributions of available cash from operating surplus after the minimum quarterly distribution and the target distribution levels have been achieved. Upon the closing of this offering, SHC will hold all of our incentive distribution rights, but may transfer these rights, subject to the restrictions set forth in the partnership agreement.

              The following discussion assumes that there are no arrearages on the common units and that SHC continues to own the incentive distribution rights.

              If for any quarter:

    we have distributed available cash from operating surplus to the common and any subordinated unitholders in an amount equal to the minimum quarterly distribution; and

    we have distributed available cash from operating surplus on outstanding common units in an amount necessary to eliminate any cumulative arrearages in the payment of the minimum quarterly distribution;

then, our partnership agreement requires that we distribute any additional available cash from operating surplus for that quarter among the unitholders and SHC (in its capacity as the holder of our incentive distribution rights) in the following manner:

    first , to all unitholders, pro rata, until each unitholder receives a total of $            per unit for that quarter (the "first target distribution");

    second , 85.0% to all unitholders, pro rata, and 15.0% to SHC (in its capacity as the holder of our incentive distribution rights), until each unitholder receives a total of $            per unit for that quarter (the "second target distribution");

    third , 75.0% to all unitholders, pro rata, and 25.0% to SHC (in its capacity as the holder of our incentive distribution rights), until each unitholder receives a total of $            per unit for that quarter (the "third target distribution"); and

    thereafter , 50.0% to all unitholders, pro rata, and 50.0% to SHC (in its capacity as the holder of our incentive distribution rights).


Percentage Allocations of Available Cash From Operating Surplus

              The following table illustrates the percentage allocations of available cash from operating surplus between our unitholders and SHC (in its capacity as the holder of our incentive distribution rights) based on the specified target distribution levels. The amounts set forth under "Marginal Percentage Interest in Distributions" are the percentage interests of SHC (in its capacity as the holder of our incentive distribution rights) and our unitholders in any available cash from operating surplus we distribute up to and including the corresponding amount in the column "Total Quarterly Distribution

76


Table of Contents

Per Common Unit and Subordinated Unit." The percentage interests shown for our unitholders and SHC (in its capacity as the holder of our incentive distribution rights) for the minimum quarterly distribution are also applicable to quarterly distribution amounts that are less than the minimum quarterly distribution. The percentage interests set forth below for SHC (in its capacity as the holder of our incentive distribution rights) assume that SHC has not transferred its incentive distribution rights and that there are no arrearages on common units.

 
   
  Marginal Percentage
Interest in Distributions
 
 
  Total Quarterly Distribution Per
Common Unit and Subordinated Unit
  Unitholders   SHC (in its Capacity
as the Holder of
Our Incentive
Distribution Rights)
 

Minimum Quarterly Distribution

  $       100.0 %    

First Target Distribution

  above $              up to $                  100.0 %    

Second Target Distribution

  above $              up to $                  85.0 %   15.0 %

Third Target Distribution

  above $              up to $                  75.0 %   25.0 %

Thereafter

  above $                   50.0 %   50.0 %


SHC's Right to Reset Incentive Distribution Levels

              SHC, as the initial holder of our incentive distribution rights, has the right under our partnership agreement to elect to relinquish the right to receive incentive distribution payments based on the initial target distribution levels and to reset, at higher levels, the minimum quarterly distribution amount and target distribution levels upon which the incentive distribution payments to SHC would be based. If SHC transfers all or a portion of our incentive distribution rights in the future, then the holder or holders of a majority of our incentive distribution rights will be entitled to exercise this right. The following discussion assumes that SHC holds all of the incentive distribution rights at the time that a reset election is made. The right to reset the minimum quarterly distribution amount and the target distribution levels upon which the incentive distributions are based may be exercised, without approval of our unitholders or the conflicts committee of the board of directors of our general partner, at any time when there are no subordinated units outstanding and we have made cash distributions to the holders of the incentive distribution rights at the highest level of incentive distribution for each of the four most recently completed fiscal quarters (and the amount of each such distribution did not exceed adjusted operating surplus for such quarter). The reset minimum quarterly distribution amount and target distribution levels will be higher than the minimum quarterly distribution amount and the target distribution levels prior to the reset such that there will be no incentive distributions paid under the reset target distribution levels until cash distributions per unit following this event increase as described below. We anticipate that SHC would exercise this reset right in order to facilitate acquisitions or internal growth projects that would otherwise not be sufficiently accretive to cash distributions per common unit, taking into account the existing levels of incentive distribution payments being made to SHC.

              In connection with the resetting of the minimum quarterly distribution amount and the target distribution levels and the corresponding relinquishment by SHC of incentive distribution payments based on the target distributions prior to the reset, SHC will be entitled to receive a number of newly issued common units based on a predetermined formula described below that takes into account the "cash parity" value of the average of the cash distributions related to the incentive distribution rights received by SHC for the two quarters prior to the reset event as compared to the average of the cash distributions per common unit during this period.

              The number of common units that SHC would be entitled to receive from us in connection with a resetting of the minimum quarterly distribution amount and the target distribution levels then in effect would be equal to the quotient determined by dividing (x) the average of the aggregate cash

77


Table of Contents

distributions received by SHC in respect of its incentive distribution rights during the two consecutive fiscal quarters ended immediately prior to the date of such reset election by (y) the average of the cash distributed per common unit during each of those two quarters.

              Following a reset election, the minimum quarterly distribution amount will be reset to an amount equal to the average of the cash distributions per common unit for the two fiscal quarters immediately preceding the reset election (which amount we refer to as the "reset minimum quarterly distribution") and the target distribution levels will be reset to be correspondingly higher such that we would distribute all of our available cash from operating surplus for each quarter thereafter, after payment of the reset minimum quarterly distribution, as follows:

    first , to all unitholders, pro rata, until each unitholder receives an amount per unit equal to 115.0% of the reset minimum quarterly distribution for that quarter;

    second , 85.0% to all unitholders, pro rata, and 15.0% to SHC (in its capacity as the holder of our incentive distribution rights), until each unitholder receives an amount per unit equal to 125.0% of the reset minimum quarterly distribution for the quarter;

    third , 75.0% to all unitholders, pro rata, and 25.0% to SHC (in its capacity as the holder of our incentive distribution rights), until each unitholder receives an amount per unit equal to 150.0% of the reset minimum quarterly distribution for the quarter; and

    thereafter , 50.0% to all unitholders, pro rata, and 50.0% to SHC (in its capacity as the holder of our incentive distribution rights).

              The following table illustrates the percentage allocation of available cash from operating surplus between the unitholders and SHC (in its capacity as the holder of our incentive distribution rights) at various cash distribution levels (1) pursuant to the cash distribution provisions of our partnership agreement in effect at the closing of this offering, as well as (2) following a hypothetical reset of the minimum quarterly distribution and target distribution levels based on the assumption that the average of the quarterly cash distributions per common unit during the two fiscal quarters immediately preceding the reset election was $            .

 
   
  Marginal Percentage Interest in Distributions    
 
  Quarterly Distribution
Per Unit Prior to Reset
  Unitholders   SHC (in its Capacity
as the Holder of
Our Incentive
Distribution Rights)
  Quarterly Distribution Per Unit
Following Hypothetical Reset

Minimum Quarterly Distribution

  $       100.0 %     $           (1)

First Target Distribution

  above $            up to $                100.0 %     above $           (1) up to $           (2)

Second Target Distribution

  above $            up to $                85.0 %   15.0 % above $           (2) up to $           (3)

Third Target Distribution

  above $            up to $                75.0 %   25.0 % above $           (3) up to $           (4)

Thereafter

  above $                 50.0 %   50.0 % above $           (4)

(1)
This amount is equal to the hypothetical reset minimum quarterly distribution.

(2)
This amount is 115.0% of the hypothetical reset minimum quarterly distribution.

(3)
This amount is 125.0% of the hypothetical reset minimum quarterly distribution.

(4)
This amount is 150.0% of the hypothetical reset minimum quarterly distribution.

              The following table illustrates the total amount of available cash from operating surplus that would be distributed to the unitholders and SHC (in its capacity as the holder of our incentive

78


Table of Contents

distribution rights), based on an average of the amounts distributed each quarter for the two quarters immediately prior to the reset. The table assumes that immediately prior to the reset there would be common units outstanding, and the average of the cash distributions made on each common unit for the two quarters prior to the reset would be $            .

 
   
   
  Cash Distributions
to SHC (in Its
Capacity as the
Holder of Our
Incentive
Distribution Rights)
Prior to Reset
   
 
 
   
  Cash
Distributions
to Common
Unitholders
Prior to Reset
   
 
 
  Quarterly
Distribution Per
Unit Prior to Reset
  Incentive
Distribution
Rights
  Total   Total
Distributions
 

Minimum Quarterly Distribution

  $   $     $   $     $    

First Target Distribution

  above $         up to $                                 

Second Target Distribution

  above $         up to $                                   

Third Target Distribution

  above $         up to $                                   

Thereafter

  above $                                   
                       

      $     $     $     $    
                       

              The following table illustrates the total amount of available cash from operating surplus that would be distributed to the unitholders and SHC (in its capacity as the holder of our incentive distribution rights), with respect to the quarter in which the reset occurs. The table reflects that as a result of the reset there would be                         common units outstanding, and the average distribution to each common unit would be $            . The number of common units to be issued to SHC (in its capacity as the holder of our incentive distribution rights) upon the reset was calculated by dividing (1) the average of the aggregate cash distributions received by SHC (in its capacity as the holder of our incentive distribution rights) for the two quarters prior to the reset as shown in the table above, or $             million, by (2) the average of the cash distributions made on each common unit for the two quarters prior to the reset as shown in the table above, or $            .

 
   
   
  Cash Distributions to SHC After
Reset
   
 
 
   
  Cash
Distributions
to Common
Unitholders
After Reset
   
 
 
  Quarterly
Distribution Per
Unit After Reset
  New
Common
Units
  Incentive
Distribution
Rights
  Total   Total
Distributions
 

Minimum Quarterly Distribution

  $   $     $     $   $     $    

First Target Distribution

  above $         up to $                               

Second Target Distribution

  above $         up to $                               

Third Target Distribution

  above $         up to $                               

Thereafter

  above $                               
                           

      $     $     $   $     $    
                           

              SHC will be entitled to cause the minimum quarterly distribution amount and the target distribution levels to be reset on more than one occasion, provided that it may not make a reset election except at a time when it has received incentive distributions for the prior four consecutive fiscal quarters based on the highest level of incentive distributions that it is entitled to receive under our partnership agreement.

79


Table of Contents


Distributions From Capital Surplus

How Distributions From Capital Surplus Will Be Made

              Our partnership agreement requires that we make distributions of available cash from capital surplus, if any, in the following manner:

    first , to all unitholders, pro rata, until the minimum quarterly distribution level has been reduced to zero as described below;

    second , to the common unitholders, pro rata, until we distribute for each common unit an amount of available cash from capital surplus equal to any unpaid arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units; and

    thereafter , we will make all distributions of available cash from capital surplus as if they were from operating surplus.

              The preceding paragraph assumes that we do not issue additional classes of equity interests.

Effect of a Distribution From Capital Surplus

              Our partnership agreement treats a distribution of capital surplus as the repayment of the initial unit price from this initial public offering, which is a return of capital. The initial public offering price less any distributions of capital surplus per unit is referred to as the "unrecovered initial unit price." Each time a distribution of capital surplus is made, the minimum quarterly distribution and the target distribution levels will be reduced in the same proportion that the distribution had to the fair market value of the common units immediately prior to the announcement of the distribution (or the average of the closing prices for the 20 consecutive trading days immediately prior to the ex-dividend date). Because distributions of capital surplus will reduce the minimum quarterly distribution and target distribution levels after any of these distributions are made, it may be easier for SHC (in its capacity as the holder of our incentive distribution rights) to receive incentive distributions and for the subordinated units to convert into common units. However, any distribution of capital surplus before the unrecovered initial unit price is reduced to zero cannot be applied to the payment of the minimum quarterly distribution or any arrearages.

              Once we distribute capital surplus on a unit issued in this offering in an amount equal to the initial unit price, our partnership agreement specifies that the minimum quarterly distribution and the target distribution levels will be reduced to zero. Our partnership agreement specifies that we will then make all future distributions from operating surplus, with 50.0% being paid to our unitholders and 50.0% to SHC (in its capacity as the holder of our incentive distribution rights). The percentage interest shown for SHC assumes that SHC has not transferred the incentive distribution rights.


Adjustment to the Minimum Quarterly Distribution and Target Distribution Levels

              In addition to adjusting the minimum quarterly distribution and target distribution levels to reflect a distribution of capital surplus, if we combine our common units into fewer common units or subdivide our common units into a greater number of common units, our partnership agreement specifies that the following items will be proportionately adjusted:

    the minimum quarterly distribution;

    the target distribution levels;

    the unrecovered initial unit price;

    the per unit amount of any outstanding arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units; and

80


Table of Contents

    the number of common units into which a subordinated unit is convertible.

              For example, if a two-for-one split of the common units should occur, the minimum quarterly distribution, each target distribution level and the unrecovered initial unit price would be reduced to 50.0% of its initial level, and each subordinated unit would be convertible into two subordinated units. Our partnership agreement provides that we will not make any adjustment by reason of the issuance of additional units for cash or property.

              In addition, if legislation is enacted or if existing law is modified or interpreted by a governmental taxing authority, so that we become taxable as a corporation or otherwise subject to taxation as an entity for federal, state or local income tax purposes, our partnership agreement specifies that the minimum quarterly distribution and the target distribution levels for each quarter may, in the sole discretion of the general partner, be reduced by multiplying each distribution level by a fraction, the numerator of which is available cash for that quarter (reduced by the amount of the estimated tax liability for such quarter) and the denominator of which is the sum of available cash for that quarter before any adjustment for estimated taxes. To the extent that the actual tax liability differs from the estimated tax liability for any quarter, the difference will be accounted for in subsequent quarters.


Distributions of Cash Upon Liquidation

General

              If we dissolve in accordance with our partnership agreement, we will sell or otherwise dispose of our assets in a process called liquidation. We will first apply the proceeds of liquidation to the payment of our creditors. We will distribute any remaining proceeds to the unitholders and the holders of the incentive distribution rights, in accordance with their capital account balances, as adjusted to reflect any gain or loss upon the sale or other disposition of our assets in liquidation.

              The allocations of gain and loss upon liquidation are intended, to the extent possible, to entitle the holders of common units to a preference over the holders of subordinated units upon our liquidation, to the extent required to permit common unitholders to receive their unrecovered initial unit price plus the minimum quarterly distribution for the quarter during which liquidation occurs plus any unpaid arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units. However, there may not be sufficient gain upon our liquidation to enable the common unitholders to fully recover all of these amounts, even though there may be cash available for distribution to the holders of subordinated units. Any further net gain recognized upon liquidation will be allocated in a manner that takes into account the incentive distribution rights.

Manner of Adjustments for Gain

              The manner of the adjustment for gain is set forth in our partnership agreement. If our liquidation occurs before the end of the subordination period, we will generally allocate any gain to our partners in the following manner:

    first , to the common unitholders, pro rata, until the capital account for each common unit is equal to the sum of: (1) the unrecovered initial unit price; (2) the unpaid amount of the minimum quarterly distribution for the quarter during which our liquidation occurs; and (3) any unpaid arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution;

    second , to the subordinated unitholders, pro rata, until the capital account for each subordinated unit is equal to the sum of: (1) the unrecovered initial unit price; and (2) the unpaid amount of the minimum quarterly distribution for the quarter during which our liquidation occurs;

81


Table of Contents

    third , to all unitholders, pro rata, until we allocate under this paragraph an amount per unit equal to: (1) the excess of the first target distribution per unit over the minimum quarterly distribution per unit for each quarter of our existence; less (2) the cumulative amount per unit of any distributions of available cash from operating surplus in excess of the minimum quarterly distribution per unit that we distributed to the unitholders, pro rata, for each quarter of our existence;

    fourth , 85.0% to all unitholders, pro rata, and 15.0% to SHC (in its capacity as the holder of our incentive distribution rights), until we allocate under this paragraph an amount per unit equal to: (1) the excess of the second target distribution per unit over the first target distribution per unit for each quarter of our existence; less (2) the cumulative amount per unit of any distributions of available cash from operating surplus in excess of the first target distribution per unit that we distributed 85.0% to the unitholders, pro rata, and 15.0% to SHC (in its capacity as the holder of our incentive distribution rights) for each quarter of our existence;

    fifth , 75.0% to all unitholders, pro rata, and 25.0% to SHC (in its capacity as the holder of our incentive distribution rights), until we allocate under this paragraph an amount per unit equal to: (1) the excess of the third target distribution per unit over the second target distribution per unit for each quarter of our existence; less (2) the cumulative amount per unit of any distributions of available cash from operating surplus in excess of the second target distribution per unit that we distributed 75.0% to the unitholders, pro rata, and 25.0% to SHC (in its capacity as the holder of our incentive distribution rights) for each quarter of our existence; and

    thereafter , 50.0% to all unitholders, pro rata, and 50.0% to SHC (in its capacity as the holder of our incentive distribution rights).

              If the liquidation occurs after the end of the subordination period, the distinction between common units and subordinated units will disappear, so that clause (3) of the first bullet point above and all of the second bullet point above will no longer be applicable.

              We may make special allocations of gain among the partners in a manner to create economic uniformity among the common units into which the subordinated units convert and the common units held by public unitholders.

Manner of Adjustments for Losses

              If our liquidation occurs before the end of the subordination period, we will generally allocate any loss to our unitholders in the following manner:

    first , to holders of subordinated units, pro rata, until the capital accounts of the subordinated unitholders have been reduced to zero; and

    thereafter , to the holders of common units, pro rata, until the capital accounts of the common unitholders have been reduced to zero.

              If the liquidation occurs after the end of the subordination period, the distinction between common units and subordinated units will disappear, so that all of the first bullet point above will no longer be applicable.

              We may make special allocations of loss among the partners in a manner to create economic uniformity among the common units into which the subordinated units convert and the common units held by public unitholders.

82


Table of Contents

Adjustments to Capital Accounts

              We will make adjustments to capital accounts upon the issuance of additional units. In doing so, we generally will allocate any unrealized and, for tax purposes, unrecognized gain resulting from the adjustments to the unitholders and the holders of our incentive distribution rights in the same manner as we allocate gain upon liquidation. By contrast to the allocations of gain, and except as provided above, we generally will allocate any unrealized and unrecognized loss resulting from the adjustments to capital accounts upon the issuance of additional units to the unitholders based on their percentage ownership of us. In this manner, prior to the end of the subordination period, we generally will allocate any such loss equally with respect to our common and subordinated units. In the event we make negative adjustments to the capital accounts as a result of such loss, future positive adjustments resulting from the issuance of additional units will be allocated in a manner designed to reverse the prior negative adjustments, and special allocations will be made upon liquidation in a manner that results, to the extent possible, in our unitholders' capital account balances equaling the amounts they would have been if no earlier adjustments for loss had been made.

83


Table of Contents


SELECTED HISTORICAL FINANCIAL DATA

              The following table shows selected historical financial data of Susser Petroleum Company LLC, the predecessor for accounting purposes for the periods and as of the dates indicated. The selected historical financial data of the predecessor as of December 31, 2010 and 2011 and for the years ended December 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011 are derived from the audited consolidated financial statements of the predecessor appearing elsewhere in this prospectus. The selected historical financial data of the predecessor as of December 31, 2007, 2008 and 2009 and for the years ended December 31, 2007 and 2008 are derived from the unaudited consolidated financial statements of the predecessor not appearing elsewhere in this prospectus. The selected historical financial data of the predecessor as of June 30, 2012 and for the six months ended June 30, 2011 and June 30, 2012 are derived from the unaudited consolidated historical financial statements of the predecessor appearing elsewhere in this prospectus.

              Our assets have historically been a part of the integrated operations of SHC, and the predecessor distributed motor fuel and other petroleum products to SHC without any profit margin. Accordingly, the gross profit in the predecessor's historical consolidated financial statements relate only to gross profit received from third parties for our wholesale distribution services. In addition, the predecessor's results of operations included results from consignment contracts that will be retained by SHC following the completion of this offering. At these consignment locations, the predecessor provides and controls motor fuel inventory and retail price at the site and received the actual retail selling price for each gallon sold, less a commission paid to the independent operator of the location, instead of the fixed profit margin per gallon that we will receive for fuel supplied to SHC for existing consignment locations. For this reason, as well as the other factors described in "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Factors Impacting the Comparability of Our Financial Results," our future results of operations will not be comparable to the predecessor's historical results of operations.

              The following table should be read together with, and is qualified in its entirety by reference to, the historical and pro forma consolidated financial statements and the accompanying notes appearing elsewhere in this prospectus. Among other things, the historical financial statements include more detailed information regarding the basis of presentation for the information in the following table. The table should also be read together with "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations," "Use of Proceeds" and "Business—Our Relationship with Susser Holdings Corporation."

 
  Predecessor Historical  
 
  Fiscal Year Ended
December 31,
  Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
 
  2007   2008   2009   2010   2011   2011   2012  
 
  (in thousands)
 
 
  (unaudited)
   
   
   
  (unaudited)
 

Statement of Income Data:

                                           

Revenues:

                                           

Motor fuel sales to third parties

  $ 1,046,808   $ 1,323,494   $ 875,891   $ 1,094,273   $ 1,549,143   $ 748,430   $ 905,544  

Motor fuel sales to affiliates

    911,388     1,571,810     1,205,890     1,578,653     2,257,788     1,108,669     1,247,170  

Rental income

    3,666     3,676     4,245     5,351     5,467     2,734     2,718  

Other income

    4,793     5,254     7,462     5,515     7,980     3,243     3,732  
                               

Total revenues

    1,966,655     2,904,234     2,093,488     2,683,792     3,820,378     1,863,076     2,159,164  

Gross profit:

                                           

Motor fuel sales to third parties

    25,229     29,844     20,584     26,065     31,217     15,440     18,250  

Motor fuel sales to affiliates

                             

Rental income

    3,666     3,676     4,245     5,351     5,467     2,734     2,718  

Other

    3,151     4,506     7,501     4,683     6,339     2,849     3,094  
                               

Total gross profit

    32,046     38,026     32,330     36,099     43,023     21,023     24,062  

                                           

84


Table of Contents

 
  Predecessor Historical  
 
  Fiscal Year Ended
December 31,
  Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
 
  2007   2008   2009   2010   2011   2011   2012  
 
  (in thousands)
 
 
  (unaudited)
   
   
   
  (unaudited)
 

Operating expenses:

                                           

General and administrative

    7,850     9,286     7,593     8,480     10,559     5,126     5,801  

Other operating

    3,907     4,220     4,728     4,229     4,870     2,490     3,638  

Rent

    1,040     1,039     1,578     3,797     4,322     2,175     2,180  

Loss (gain) on disposal of assets

    (201 )   (66 )   (6 )   86     221     144     36  

Depreciation, amortization and accretion

    4,311     4,423     4,901     4,771     6,090     2,483     3,776  
                               

Total operating expenses

    16,907     18,902     18,794     21,363     26,062     12,418     15,431  
                               

Income from operations

    15,139     19,124     13,536     14,736     16,961     8,605     8,631  

Other expense (income):

                                           

Interest expense, net

    (25 )   29     191     284     324     159     180  
                               

Income before income taxes

    15,164     19,095     13,345     14,452     16,637     8,446     8,451  

Income tax expense

    5,594     6,874     4,831     5,236     6,039     3,059     3,074  
                               

Net income

  $ 9,570   $ 12,221   $ 8,514   $ 9,216   $ 10,598   $ 5,387   $ 5,377  
                               

Cash Flow Data:

                                           

Net cash provided by (used in):

                                           

Operating activities

                9,833     17,469     14,263     (98 )   7,333  

Investing activities

                (11,356 )   (13,897 )   (19,153 )   (4,069 )   (6,539 )

Financing activities

                331     731     381     24     111  

 

 
  Predecessor Historical  
 
  As of December 31,   As of June 30,  
 
  2007   2008   2009   2010   2011   2011   2012  
 
  (in thousands)
(unaudited)

 

Balance Sheet Data (at period end):

                                           

Cash and cash equivalents

  $ 793   $ 1,638   $ 446   $ 4,749   $ 240   $ 606   $ 1,145  

Property and equipment, net

    48,067     47,969     47,602     35,247     39,049     36,704     43,051  

Total assets

    164,380     158,673     192,857     202,587     231,316     231,052     242,763  

Total liabilities

    89,116     71,188     96,858     97,372     115,503     120,449     121,573  

Total unitholder's equity

    75,264     87,485     95,999     105,215     115,813     110,603     121,190  

85


Table of Contents


MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF
FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

               The following discussion analyzes the historical financial condition and results of operations of Susser Petroleum Company LLC, our predecessor for accounting purposes, before the impact of pro forma adjustments related to the formation transactions, our entry into our new credit facilities, our entry into the SHC Distribution Contract and the SHC Transportation Contract, the completion of this offering and the application of proceeds from this offering. This discussion also analyzes our pro forma revenue and gross profit demonstrating the pro forma impact of the SHC Distribution Contract on our predecessor's historical results of operations. You should read the following discussion of the historical financial condition and results of operations of our predecessor in conjunction with the historical financial statements and accompanying notes of our predecessor and the pro forma condensed financial statements for Susser Petroleum Partners LP included elsewhere in this prospectus. This discussion includes forward-looking statements that are subject to risks and uncertainties that may result in actual results differing from statements we make. Please read "Forward-Looking Statements." Factors that could cause actual results to differ include those risks and uncertainties that are discussed in "Risk Factors."


Overview

              We are a growth-oriented Delaware limited partnership formed by Susser Holdings Corporation, or SHC, to engage in the primarily fee-based wholesale distribution of motor fuels to SHC and third parties. SHC operates 545 retail convenience stores under its proprietary Stripes ® convenience store brand, primarily in growing Texas markets. Stripes ® is the largest independent chain of convenience stores in Texas based on store count and retail motor fuel volumes sold. Our business is integral to the success of SHC's retail operations, and upon the completion of this offering, SHC will purchase all of its motor fuel from us. For the year ended December 31, 2011, we distributed 789.6 million gallons of motor fuel to Stripes® convenience stores and 522.8 million gallons of motor fuel to other customers. We believe we are the largest independent motor fuel distributor by gallons in Texas, and among the largest distributors of Valero and Chevron branded motor fuel in the United States. In addition to distributing motor fuel, we also distribute other petroleum products such as propane and lube oil, and we receive rental income from real estate that we lease or sublease.

              For the year ended December 31, 2011, we would have had pro forma gross profit of approximately $50.3 million, pro forma Adjusted EBITDA of approximately $39.1 million, and pro forma net income of approximately $31.7 million. Sales to SHC would have accounted for approximately 54% of our pro forma gross profit for that period. For the six months ended June 30, 2012, we would have had pro forma gross profit of approximately $27.6 million, pro forma Adjusted EBITDA of approximately $20.8 million, and pro forma net income of approximately $16.2 million. Please read "Summary—Summary Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data" for the definition of Adjusted EBITDA and a reconciliation of Adjusted EBITDA to our most directly comparable financial measures calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP.

Wholesale Motor Fuel Distribution

              We purchase motor fuel primarily from independent refiners and major oil companies and distribute it throughout Texas and in Louisiana, New Mexico and Oklahoma to:

    Stripes® convenience stores, pursuant to the SHC Distribution Contract;

    over 80 independently operated consignment locations where SHC sells motor fuel to retail customers, also pursuant to the SHC Distribution Contract;

    over 480 convenience stores and fueling stations operated by independent operators, which we refer to as "dealers," pursuant to long-term distribution agreements; and

86


Table of Contents

    other commercial customers, including unbranded convenience stores, other fuel distributors, school districts and municipalities and other industrial customers.

              We distribute Chevron, CITGO, Conoco, Exxon, Mobil, Phillips 66, Shamrock, Shell, Texaco and Valero branded motor fuel, as well as unbranded motor fuel. We believe the variety and large volumes of branded and unbranded motor fuel that we distribute is a key competitive advantage relative to other, smaller wholesale distributors in our markets. In addition to distributing motor fuel, we also distribute other petroleum products such as propane and lube oil.

Real Estate

              In addition to revenues earned in our wholesale motor fuel distribution business, we also receive rental income from convenience store properties that we lease or sublease to SHC and third parties. Our predecessor earned rental income from third parties with respect to 85 properties during 2011. We expect that 55 properties will be contributed to us in connection with this offering, most of which are located in Texas. Pursuant to the omnibus agreement that we will enter into with SHC at the closing of this offering, we will have a three-year option to purchase and lease back to SHC a total of 75 new or recently constructed Stripes® convenience stores on specified terms set forth in a lease agreement for an initial lease term of 15 years. Furthermore, each store that we purchase and lease back to SHC pursuant to the 75 store option will be added to the SHC Distribution Contract, and we will be the exclusive distributor of motor fuel to the store for ten years from the time of purchase at cost plus a fixed profit margin of three cents per gallon. For a more detailed description of the sale and leaseback option, please read "Business—Our Relationship with Susser Holdings Corporation—Our Agreements with SHC—Omnibus Agreement." Although we may purchase and lease convenience store properties to SHC or third parties, we do not currently operate or have any intention to operate any retail convenience stores that we own or may acquire in the future.


Our Predecessor, Susser Petroleum Company LLC

              Susser Petroleum Company LLC, a wholly owned subsidiary of SHC, is our predecessor for accounting purposes. Our predecessor previously conducted SHC's wholesale motor fuel distribution business, substantially all of which will be contributed to us in connection with this offering. Our predecessor will retain contracts and assets relating to consignment locations and motor fuel transportation services, as well as certain convenience store properties. Our pro forma financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus reflect the financial impact of SHC's retention of such assets and operations.

              Following the completion of this offering, SHC will continue to operate its retail convenience store business and will retain its consignment and transportation business, and we will operate the balance of its wholesale motor fuel distribution business and lease convenience store properties.


How We Evaluate and Assess Our Business

              Our management uses a variety of financial measurements to analyze our performance. Key measures we use to evaluate and assess our business include the following:

    Motor fuel gallons sold.   One of the primary drivers of our business is the total volume of motor fuel sold. Our long-term fuel distribution contracts with our customers, including SHC, typically provide that we will distribute motor fuel at a fixed, volume-based profit margin. As a result, our gross profit is directly tied to the volume of motor fuel that we distribute.

    Gross profit per gallon.   Gross profit per gallon reflects the gross profit on motor fuel divided by the number of gallons sold, which we typically express in terms of cents per gallon. Historically, sales of motor fuel to SHC's retail convenience stores have been at cost and

87


Table of Contents

      therefore, our predecessor earned profits only on gallons sold to third parties. Pursuant to the SHC Distribution Contract, we will receive a fixed profit margin per gallon on all of the motor fuel we distribute to Stripes ® convenience stores and to SHC's consignment locations. The financial impact of this fee if it had been generated on our historical volumes sold is reflected in our pro forma financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus. Our gross profit cents per gallon varies among our third-party customers and is impacted by the availability of certain discounts and rebates from our suppliers. Pursuant to the SHC Transportation Contract, SHC will arrange for motor fuel to be delivered from our suppliers to our customers, with the costs being passed entirely along to our customers. As a result, our cost to purchase fuel and any transportation costs that we incur are generally passed through to our customers, and therefore, do not have a substantial impact on our gross profit cents per gallon.

    Adjusted EBITDA.   We define Adjusted EBITDA as net income before net interest expense, income taxes and depreciation, amortization and accretion, as further adjusted to exclude allocated non-cash stock-based compensation expense and certain other operating expenses that are reflected in our net income that we do not believe are indicative of our ongoing core operations, such as the gain or loss on disposal of assets.

      We believe Adjusted EBITDA is useful to investors in evaluating our operating performance because:

      securities analysts and other interested parties use Adjusted EBITDA as a measure of financial performance and debt service capabilities;

      it facilitates management's ability to measure the operating performance of our business on a consistent basis by excluding the impact of items not directly resulting from our wholesale motor fuel distribution operations; and

      it is used by our management for internal planning purposes, including aspects of our consolidated operating budget and capital expenditures.

      This measure is not calculated or presented in accordance with GAAP. The GAAP measures most directly comparable to Adjusted EBITDA is net income. Adjusted EBITDA should not be considered as an alternative to GAAP net income; it has important limitations as an analytical tool because it excludes some but not all items that affect net income. You should not consider Adjusted EBITDA in isolation or as a substitute for analysis of our results as reported under GAAP. Because Adjusted EBITDA may be defined differently by other companies in our industry, our definitions of Adjusted EBITDA may not be comparable to similarly titled measures of other companies, thereby diminishing its utility.

      For a reconciliation of Adjusted EBITDA to its most directly comparable financial measure calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP, please read "Summary—Non-GAAP Financial Measure."


Factors Impacting the Comparability of Our Financial Results

              Our future results of operations may not be comparable to our predecessor's historical results of operations for the following reasons:

    Revenues and Gross Profit.   Our assets have historically been a part of the integrated operations of SHC, and our predecessor distributed motor fuel and other petroleum products to SHC without any profit margin. Accordingly, the gross profit in our predecessor's historical consolidated financial statements relates only to the profit margin received from third parties for our wholesale distribution services and from consignment contracts that will be retained by SHC following the completion of this offering. At these consignment

88


Table of Contents

      locations, our predecessor provided and controlled motor fuel inventory and price at the site and received the actual retail selling price for each gallon sold, less a commission paid to the independent operator of the location. As a result, the gross profit received from consignment locations by our predecessor varied in a similar manner to retail fuel margins per gallon, which are driven by changes in fuel prices, competitive dynamics of the market, and other factors. In connection with this offering, the SHC Distribution Contract, a ten-year fuel distribution agreement with SHC and certain of its wholly owned subsidiaries, will be contributed to us, pursuant to which we will be the exclusive distributor of motor fuel purchased by SHC's existing Stripes ® convenience stores and independently operated consignment locations at cost, including tax and transportation costs, plus a fixed profit margin. Based on historical volumes distributed to SHC, and after giving pro forma effect to the SHC Distribution Contract, for the twelve months ended June 30, 2012, we would have derived approximately $28.3 million in gross profit from sales to SHC. Our pro forma gross profit cents per gallon for the year ended December 31, 2011 was 3.4 cents per gallon as compared to the average rate of 2.4 cents per gallon for our predecessor for the same period, primarily as a result of (i) the fixed profit margin of three cents per gallon that we would have earned on the motor fuel distributed to Stripes® convenience stores pursuant to the SHC Distribution Contract instead of no margin historically received by our predecessor and (ii) the fixed profit margin that we would have received on all volumes sold to consignment locations under the SHC Distribution Contract instead of the variable and higher margin received by our predecessor under consignment contracts. For a discussion of the pro forma impact of the SHC Distribution Contract on revenue and gross profit, please read "—Pro Forma Results of Operations."

    General and Administrative Expenses.   Our predecessor's general and administrative expenses included direct charges for the management and operation of our wholesale business and certain expenses allocated by SHC for general corporate services, such as finance, internal audit and legal services. These expenses were charged or allocated to our predecessor based on the nature of the expenses and our predecessor's proportionate share of employee time and headcount. Following the closing of this offering, SHC will continue to charge us directly for the management and operation of our wholesale business. However, we will no longer bear an expense allocation for general and administrative expenses related to the retained consignment contracts and transportation business. We also expect to incur additional personnel and related costs and incremental external general and administrative expenses of approximately $2.0 million annually as a result of being a publicly traded partnership, consisting of costs associated with SEC reporting requirements, tax return and Schedule K-1 preparation and distribution, independent auditor fees, investor relations activities, Sarbanes-Oxley Act compliance, stock exchange listing, registrar and transfer agent fees, incremental director and officer liability insurance and director compensation. These additional personnel and related costs and incremental external general and administrative expenses are not reflected in our historical or our pro forma financial statements.

    Financing.   There are differences in the way we will finance our operations going forward as compared to the way our predecessor financed its operations. Historically, our predecessor's operations were financed as part of SHC's integrated operations and our predecessor did not record any separate costs associated with financing its operations. Additionally, our predecessor largely relied on internally generated cash flows to satisfy its capital expenditure requirements. Following the closing of this offering, we expect that we will distribute to our unitholders most of the cash generated by our operations. As a result, we expect to fund future capital expenditures primarily from the sale of U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities, external sources, including borrowings under our revolving credit facility and issuances of equity and debt securities. In connection with the closing of this offering, we will enter into a five-year, $250 million revolving credit facility, and a three-year, up to

89


Table of Contents

      $175 million term loan facility. The revolving credit facility will be available for general partnership purposes, including working capital, capital expenditures and acquisitions.

    Taxes.   Historically, our predecessor's wholesale distribution business has been included in SHC's U.S. federal and state tax returns. SHC's tax obligations have historically been based upon all of its wholesale and retail operations combined, and accordingly, its tax model is not necessarily reflective of the tax model for the wholesale distribution business on a stand-alone basis. Furthermore, due to our status as a partnership, we will not be subject to U.S. federal income tax and certain state income taxes in the future, except for our subsidiary that is treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes. This subsidiary does not presently have any operations, but is expected to own all stores purchased pursuant to sale and leaseback transactions with SHC and receive rental income from SHC and, as a result, will be subject to federal income tax on rental income received from SHC. However, in the near term, we believe any rental income we receive from SHC will be more than offset by depreciation and interest deductions associated with our purchase and ownership of any Stripes® convenience stores. In addition, we will continue to be subject to the Texas franchise tax, which is based on taxable margin generated by our Texas operations.


Market and Industry Trends and Outlook

              We expect that certain trends and economic or industry-wide factors will continue to affect our business, both in the short-term and long-term. We have based our expectations described below on assumptions made by us and on the basis of information currently available to us. To the extent our underlying assumptions about or interpretation of available information prove to be incorrect, our actual results may vary materially from our expected results. Please read "Risk Factors" for additional information about the risks associated with purchasing our common units.

Regional Trends

              The majority of our fuel distribution business is conducted in Texas. The economy in Texas continues to fare better than many other parts of the nation, partly as a result of a relatively stable housing market and strong population growth and job creation. In 2011, Texas ranked first in the United States for job growth according to the U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics and first in the United States for population growth for the ten-year period ended 2010 as reflected in the 2010 census report. Furthermore, according to a report issued by the Texas Comptroller of Public Accounts, the population in our South Texas markets, in which the majority of our distribution customers are located, is growing faster than the population of the state as a whole. We also believe the significant expansion of oil and gas development in the Eagle Ford Shale and Permian Basin has resulted in increased motor fuel usage in South and West Texas.

              The Texas Comptroller of Public Accounts has reported that gasoline gallons taxed in Texas have grown significantly during the last several decades. From 1989 to 2011, gasoline consumption grew approximately 41.2% from 8.5 billion gallons to 11.9 billion gallons, or at an approximate 1.6% compound annual growth rate. Gasoline consumption grew in 17 of the 22 years during the period. As of 2011, Texas motor gasoline consumption totaled approximately 8.9% of U.S. consumption. Similarly, diesel gallons taxed in Texas have grown significantly during the last several decades. From 1989 to 2011, diesel consumption grew approximately 144.1%, from 1.6 billion gallons to 3.8 billion gallons, or at an approximate 4.1% compound annual growth rate. Diesel consumption grew in 17 of the 22 years during the period.

Economic Conditions

              The condition of credit markets may adversely affect our liquidity. In the recent past, world financial markets experienced a severe reduction in the availability of credit. Although we were not

90


Table of Contents

substantially impacted by this condition, possible negative impacts in the future could include a decrease in the availability of borrowings under our credit agreements. In addition, we could experience a tightening of trade credit from our suppliers.

Industry Consolidation

              We believe that there is considerable opportunity for consolidation in our industry as major integrated oil companies continue to divest sites they own or lease, and independent dealers have experienced pressure from increased competition from non-traditional fuel suppliers, such as Walmart and grocery store chains. We intend to capitalize on the relationship between our wholesale business and SHC's complementary retail business by jointly pursuing mixed asset acquisition opportunities with SHC which may not be attractive to a pure wholesaler or pure retailer. Pursuant to the omnibus agreement, we will have a right to negotiate with SHC to acquire any third-party distribution contracts and to distribute fuel to any retail stores or consignment locations included in a potential acquisition under consideration by SHC, other than any retail stores already party to an existing supply agreement. We therefore expect to have the opportunity to participate with SHC in acquiring convenience store operations and related wholesale distribution businesses through (i) directly purchasing any dealer distribution contracts or other wholesale distribution contracts and assets owned by the acquisition target, (ii) selling additional fuel volumes to convenience stores that SHC acquires or to SHC for any acquired consignment locations, and (iii) entering into additional sale and leaseback arrangements with respect to acquired stores. We believe these opportunities will provide for growth in both our fuel volumes and rental income.

Seasonality

              Our business exhibits some seasonality due to our customers' increasing demand for motor fuel during the late spring and summer months as compared to the fall and winter months. Travel, recreation and construction activities typically increase in these months in the geographic areas in which we operate, increasing the demand for motor fuel. Therefore, the volume of motor fuel that we distribute is typically somewhat higher in the second and third quarters of our fiscal year. As a result, our results from operations may vary from period to period.

91


Table of Contents


Historical Results of Operations of Our Predecessor

              The following table and discussion is a summary of our predecessor's actual results of operations for each of the years ended December 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011, respectively, and the six months ended June 30, 2011 and June 30, 2012, respectively. These historical results have not been adjusted for the pro forma impacts of this offering.

 
  Year Ended December 31,   Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
 
  2009   2010   2011   2011   2012  
 
  (In thousands)
 
 
   
   
   
  (Unaudited)
 

Statement of Income Data:

                               

Revenues:

                               

Motor fuel sales to third parties

  $ 875,891   $ 1,094,273   $ 1,549,143   $ 748,430   $ 905,544  

Motor fuel sales to affiliates

    1,205,890     1,578,653     2,257,788     1,108,669     1,247,170  

Rental income

    4,245     5,351     5,467     2,734     2,718  

Other income

    7,462     5,515     7,980     3,243     3,732  
                       

Total revenues

    2,093,488     2,683,792     3,820,378     1,863,076     2,159,164  

Gross profit:

                               

Motor fuel sales to third parties

    20,584     26,065     31,217     15,440     18,250  

Motor fuel sales to affiliates

                     

Rental income

    4,245     5,351     5,467     2,734     2,718  

Other

    7,501     4,683     6,339     2,849     3,094  
                       

Total gross profit

    32,330     36,099     43,023     21,023     24,062  

Total operating expenses

    18,794     21,363     26,062     12,418     15,431  
                       

Income from operations

    13,536     14,736     16,961     8,605     8,631  

Interest expense, net

    191     284     324     159     180  
                       

Income before taxes

    13,345     14,452     16,637     8,446     8,451  

Income tax expense

    4,831     5,236     6,039     3,059     3,074  
                       

Net Income

  $ 8,514   $ 9,216   $ 10,598   $ 5,387   $ 5,377  
                       

Adjusted EBITDA(1)

  $ 19,057   $ 20,145   $ 23,979   $ 11,613   $ 13,012  

Operating Data:

                               

Motor fuel gallons sold:

                               

To affiliates (at cost)(2)

    707,106     739,104     789,578     384,661     425,249  

To third parties

    494,821     494,209     522,832     249,078     295,147  
                       

Total gallons

    1,201,927     1,233,313     1,312,410     633,739     720,396  

Average wholesale selling price per gallon

  $ 1.73   $ 2.17   $ 2.90   $ 2.93   $ 2.99  

Motor fuel gross profit cents per gallon(2):

                               

Affiliated

    0.0¢     0.0¢     0.0¢     0.0¢     0.0¢  

Third-party

    4.2¢     5.3¢     6.0¢     6.2¢     6.2¢  

Volume-weighted average for all gallons

    1.7¢     2.1¢     2.4¢     2.4¢     2.5¢  

(1)
We define Adjusted EBITDA as net income before net interest expense, income tax expense and depreciation and amortization expense, as further adjusted to reflect certain other non-recurring and non-cash items. Adjusted EBITDA is not a financial measure calculated in accordance with GAAP. For a reconciliation of this measure to its directly comparable financial measures calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP, please read "Summary—Non-GAAP Financial Measure."

(2)
For the historical periods presented, affiliated volumes only include sales to Stripes ® convenience stores, for which our predecessor historically received no margin, and third-party motor fuel gross profit cents per gallon includes the motor fuel sold directly to independently operated consignment locations, as well as sales to third-party dealers and other commercial customers. Following this offering, SHC will retain the consignment contracts and assets and, pursuant to the SHC Distribution Contract, we will sell fuel to SHC for both Stripes ® convenience stores and SHC's independently operated consignment locations at a fixed profit margin of three cents per gallon. As a result, volumes sold to consignment locations are included in the calculation of third-party motor fuel gross profit cents per gallon in the historical operating data and in the calculation of affiliated motor fuel gross profit cents per gallon in the pro forma operating data.

92


Table of Contents

Six Months Ended June 30, 2012 Compared to Six Months Ended June 30, 2011

              Revenue.     Total revenue for the first half of 2012 was $2.2 billion, an increase of $296.1 million, or 15.9%, from the first half of 2011. Motor fuel sales to third parties increased $157.1 million, or 21.0%. Of this increase, $15.8 million was driven by a 2.1% increase in the wholesale selling price per gallon of motor fuel, and $141.3 million was due to an 18.5% increase in gallons sold to third parties. Motor fuel sales to affiliates increased $138.5 million, or 12.5%, from the first half of 2011. This increase consisted of $19.4 million related to a 1.8% increase in the wholesale selling price of motor fuel and $119.0 million related to a 10.6% increase in gallons sold to affiliates. The increase in other income of $0.5 million was attributable to increases in freight revenues. Our transportation business will be retained by SHC after the completion of this offering.

              Cost of Sales and Gross Profit.     Gross profit for the first half of 2012 was $24.1 million, an increase of $3.0 million, or 14.5%, over the first half of 2011. Gross profit on motor fuel sales to third parties increased $2.8 million attributable to the 18.5% increase in gallons sold to third parties, which was partially offset by a 0.3% increase in third-party gross profit cents per gallon. Although the sales price of motor fuel sold to third parties increased by 6.3 cents per gallon, the cost of fuel also increased 6.3 cents per gallon, resulting in flat gross profit cents per gallon. Motor fuel was sold to affiliates at cost, resulting in no gross profit on motor fuel sales to affiliates. The increase in other gross profit was related to the growth in transportation services which contributed $0.3 million in gross profit.

              Total Operating Expenses.     For the first half of 2012, general and administrative expenses, or G&A expenses, increased by $0.7 million, or 13.2%, from 2011. The increase in G&A was primarily attributable to increased cost of salaries, bonus and benefits related to annual compensation increases and some headcount additions during 2011. Other operating expenses increased $1.1 million, or 46.1%, due primarily to higher maintenance costs. Depreciation, amortization and accretion expense for the first half of 2012 of $3.8 million was up $1.3 million, or 52.1%, from 2011 due to depreciation and amortization on additional capital investments, including the acquisition of 121 dealer distribution agreements made in the fourth quarter of 2011.

              Income Tax Expense.     Income tax expense was flat at $3.1 million for both the first half of 2011 and 2012. The effective tax rate for the first half of 2011 was 36.2% compared to 36.4% for the first half of 2012.

Year Ended December 31, 2011 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2010

              Revenue.     Total revenue for 2011 was $3.8 billion, an increase of $1.1 billion, or 42.4%, from 2010. Motor fuel sales to third parties increased $454.9 million, or 41.6%. Of this increase, $370.1 million was driven by a 33.8% increase in the wholesale selling price per gallon of motor fuel, and $84.8 million was due to a 5.8% increase in gallons sold to third parties. Motor fuel sales to affiliates increased $679.1 million, or 43.0%, from 2010. This increase consisted of $534.8 million related to a 33.9% increase in the wholesale selling price of motor fuel and $144.3 million related to a 6.8% increase in gallons sold to affiliates. The increase in other income of $2.5 million, or 44.7%, was primarily due to $2.1 million in increases in freight revenues from third parties.

              Cost of Sales and Gross Profit.     Gross profit for 2011 was $43.0 million, an increase of $6.9 million, or 19.2%, over 2010. Gross profit on motor fuel sales to third parties increased $5.2 million, partially attributable to a 13.2% increase in third party gross profit cents per gallon. While the sales price of motor fuel sold to third parties increased by 74.9 cents per gallon, the cost of fuel increased by 74.2 cents per gallon, resulting in a 0.7 cents per gallon increase in gross profit, or a $3.4 million increase in gross profit. Also contributing to the increase in motor fuel gross profit from third parties was the 5.8% increase in gallons sold, resulting in an additional $1.7 million of motor fuel gross profit from third parties. Motor fuel was sold to affiliates at cost, resulting in no gross profit on

93


Table of Contents

motor fuel sales to affiliates. The $1.7 million increase in other gross profit was primarily related to the growth in transportation services.

              Total Operating Expenses.     For 2011, general and administrative expenses increased by $2.1 million, or 24.5%, from 2010. Of this amount, $0.8 million of the increase was due to higher salaries and benefits, partially related to annual compensation increases and partially related to additional headcount. Another $0.6 million of the increase in general and administrative expenses was due to increased bonus expense. An additional $0.2 million of corporate overhead expenses was allocated from SHC in 2011 versus 2010. Other operating costs increased $0.6 million, or 15.2%, in 2011, consisting of increases in maintenance costs of $0.3 million, customer service costs of $0.2 million and property taxes of $0.1 million. Depreciation, amortization and accretion expense for 2011 of $6.1 million was up $1.3 million, or 27.6%, from 2010 due to depreciation and amortization expense on capital investments, including an acquisition made in the fourth quarter of 2010 and an acquisition made in the fourth quarter of 2011.

              Income Tax Expense.     Income tax expense increased $0.8 million, or 15.3%, due to the increase in operating income. The effective tax rate for 2010 was 36.2% compared to 36.3% for 2011.

Year Ended December 31, 2010 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2009

              Revenue.     Total revenue for 2010 was $2.7 billion, an increase of $590.3 million, or 28.2%, from 2009. Motor fuel sales to third parties increased $218.4 million, or 24.9%. This increase was driven by a 25.1% increase in the wholesale selling price per gallon of motor fuel, resulting in $219.8 million in increased motor fuel sales to third parties. Gallons sold to third parties decreased 0.1%, resulting in a $1.4 million decrease in sales to third parties. Motor fuel sales to affiliates increased $372.8 million, or 30.9%, from 2009. This increase consisted of $304.4 million related to a 25.2% increase in the wholesale selling price of motor fuel and $68.3 million related to a 4.5% increase in gallons sold to affiliates. Rental income increased $1.1 million, or 26.1%, due to additional rental locations acquired as part of an acquisition made in the fourth quarter of 2009. Other income decreased $1.9 million, or 26.1%, from 2009 due to a $3.1 million gain from the sale to dealers of rights to operate convenience store locations we acquired in 2009. Partially offsetting this was a $0.6 million increase in other income from higher propane and lube oil sales.

              Cost of Sales and Gross Profit.     Gross profit for 2010 was $36.1 million, an increase of $3.8 million, or 11.7%, over 2009. Gross profit on motor fuel sales to third parties increased $5.5 million attributable to a 26.8% increase in third-party gross profit cents per gallon. While the sales price of motor fuel sold to third parties increased by 44.4 cents per gallon, the cost of fuel increased by 43.3 cents per gallon, resulting in a 1.1 cents per gallon increase in gross profit, or a $5.5 million increase in gross profit. Gallons sold to third parties were slightly down at 0.1% from 2009 to 2010, with a nominal effect on gross profit. Motor fuel was sold to affiliates at cost, resulting in no gross profit on motor fuel sales to affiliates. Gross profit from rental income increased $1.1 million primarily due to the acquisition closed in the fourth quarter of 2009. Other gross profit decreased $2.8 million due primarily to the $3.1 million of income from the sale of rights to operate dealer locations received in 2009.

              Total Operating Expenses.     For 2010, general and administrative expenses increased by $0.9 million, or 11.7%, from 2009. This increase was primarily attributable to $0.8 million in increased bonus expense. Other operating expense decreased by $0.5 million due to $0.3 million in advertising reimbursements received from refiners in 2010 and $0.2 million in decreased bad debt expense in 2010 versus 2009. Rent expense increased by $2.2 million due to rent expense on additional locations included in the 2009 acquisition. Depreciation, amortization and accretion expense for 2010 of $4.8 million was down $0.1 million, or 2.7%, from 2009 due to the sale of assets offset by additional assets placed in service.

94


Table of Contents

              Income Tax Expense.     Income tax expense of $5.2 million was higher by $0.4 million due to increased operating income. The effective tax rate was 36.2% for both 2009 and 2010.


Pro Forma Results of Operations

              We have provided below certain pro forma results for the years ended December 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011 and the six months ended June 30, 2011 and 2012.

              Our assets have historically been a part of the integrated operations of SHC, and our predecessor distributed motor fuel and other petroleum products to SHC, as opposed to third parties, without receiving any profit margin. Accordingly, the gross profit in our predecessor's historical consolidated financial statements relates only to the profit margin received from third parties for our wholesale distribution services and from consignment contracts that will be retained by SHC following the completion of this offering. The pro forma information presented in the table below was derived based upon known volumes distributed by our predecessor to SHC reflected in our predecessor's historical financial statements for which our predecessor did not receive any profit margin, and the profit margin that we will receive going forward pursuant to the SHC Distribution Contract applied to those volumes. The pro forma information was also derived based upon the volumes distributed by our predecessor under consignment arrangements, for which it historically received variable margins, and the profit margin contained in the SHC Distribution Contract applied to those volumes.

              Management believes the pro forma presentation is useful to investors because, had it been in effect during the historical periods presented, the SHC Distribution Contract would have had a substantial impact on our historical results of operations as a result of (i) the fixed profit margin that we would have earned on the motor fuel distributed to SHC instead of no margin historically reflected in our predecessor financial statements and (ii) the fixed profit margin that we would have received on all volumes sold to consignment locations instead of the variable and higher margin received by our predecessor under consignment contracts.

              For more information with respect to these pro forma adjustments, as well as the impact of other pro forma adjustments please see "—Factors Impacting the Comparability of Our Financial Results," above, as well as the full pro forma financial statements included elsewhere herein.

95


Table of Contents

              This pro forma information may not be indicative of our future performance, and actual future results may differ materially from those presented in the pro forma results of operations.

 
  Pro Forma Year Ended
December 31,
  Pro Forma Six
Months Ended
June 30,
 
 
  2009   2010   2011   2011   2012  
 
  (In thousands)
 

Revenues:

                               

Motor fuel sales to affiliates(1)

  $ 1,411,297   $ 1,833,163   $ 2,605,050   $ 1,278,286   $ 1,435,235  

Motor fuel sales to third parties

    684,326     852,002     1,216,896     585,545     724,743  

Rental income

    2,451     2,963     3,304     1,629     1,679  

Other

    5,087     4,565     4,596     2,279     2,450  
                       

Total revenue

  $ 2,103,161     2,692,693     3,829,846     1,867,739     2,164,107  

Gross profit:

                               

Motor fuel to affiliates(1)

    24,296     25,314     26,956     13,117     14,457  

Motor fuel sales to third parties

    10,756     13,756     17,579     8,786     10,037  

Rental income

    2,451     2,963     3,304     1,629     1,679  

Other

    3,723     2,675     2,474     1,213     1,380  
                       

Total gross profit

  $ 41,226   $ 44,708   $ 50,313   $ 24,745   $ 27,553  

Operating Data:

                               

Motor fuel gallons sold:

                               

Stripes ® convenience stores

    707,106     739,104     789,578     384,661     425,249  

Consignment locations

    100,609     106,073     108,944     52,551     56,621  

Third-party dealers and other commercial customers

    394,212     388,136     413,888     196,527     238,526  
                       

Total gallons sold

    1,201,927     1,233,313     1,312,410     633,739     720,396  

Motor fuel gross profit cents per gallon:

                               

Affiliated

    3.0¢     3.0¢     3.0¢     3.0¢     3.0¢  

Third-party

    2.7¢     3.5¢     4.2¢     4.5¢     4.2¢  

Volume-weighted average for all gallons

    2.9¢     3.2¢     3.4¢     3.5¢     3.4¢  

(1)
Historically, affiliated volumes only included sales to Stripes ® convenience stores, for which our predecessor received no margin, and third-party motor fuel gross profit cents per gallon included the motor fuel sold directly to independently operated consignment locations, as well as sales to third-party dealers and other commercial customers. Following this offering, SHC will retain the consignment contracts and assets, and, pursuant to the SHC Distribution Contract, we will sell fuel to SHC for both Stripes ® convenience stores and SHC's independently operated consignment locations at a fixed profit margin of three cents per gallon. As a result, volumes sold to consignment locations are included in the calculation of affiliated motor fuel gross profit cents per gallon in the pro forma operating data instead of third-party motor fuel gross profit cents per gallon.

Pro Forma Six Months Ended June 30, 2012 Compared to Pro Forma Six Months Ended June 30, 2011

              Pro Forma Revenue.     Pro forma revenue for the first half of 2012 would have been $2.2 billion, an increase of $296.4 million, or 15.9%, from the first half of 2011. Pro forma motor fuel sales to third parties would have increased $139.2 million, or 23.8%. Of this increase, $11.6 million would have been driven by a 2.0% increase in the wholesale selling price per gallon of motor fuel, and $127.6 million would have been due to a 21.4% increase in gallons sold to third parties. Pro forma motor fuel sales to affiliates would have increased $156.9 million, or 12.3%, from the first half of 2011. This increase would have consisted of $23.9 million related to a 1.9% increase in the wholesale selling price of motor fuel and $133.0 million related to a 10.2% increase in gallons sold to affiliates.

              Pro Forma Cost of Sales and Gross Profit.     Pro forma motor fuel gross profit from third-party sales for the first half of 2012 would have been $10.0 million, an increase of $1.3 million, or 14.2%, over the first half of 2011. This increase would have been attributable to the 21.4% increase in gallons sold to third parties, increasing gross profit by $1.8 million. A decrease of 5.9% in third-party gross profit cents per gallon would have offset the increase by $0.5 million. While the sales price of motor fuel sold to third parties increased by 5.9 cents per gallon, the cost of fuel increased by 6.2 cents per gallon, which would have resulted in a 0.3 cents per gallon decrease in gross profit. Pro forma motor

96


Table of Contents

fuel gross profit from sales to affiliates for the first half of 2012 would have been $14.5 million, a 10.2% increase over the first half of 2011. The increase would have been entirely due to a 10.2% increase in gallons sold to affiliates. Cost of sales per gallon would have increased commensurate with revenue per gallon, which would have resulted in a flat 3.0 cents per gallon gross profit for each period. Gross profit from rental income and other income on a pro forma basis during the first half of 2012 would have been $3.1 million, a slight increase of $0.2 million over the prior year period.

Pro Forma Year Ended December 31, 2011 Compared to Pro Forma Year Ended December 31, 2010

              Pro Forma Revenue.     Pro forma revenue for 2011 would have been $3.8 billion, an increase of $1.1 billion, or 42.2%, from 2010. Pro forma motor fuel sales to third parties would have increased $364.9 million, or 42.8%. Of this increase, $289.2 million would have been driven by a 33.9% increase in the wholesale selling price per gallon of motor fuel, and $75.7 million would have been due to a 6.6% increase in gallons sold to third parties. Pro forma motor fuel sales to affiliates would have increased $771.9 million, or 42.1%, from 2010. This increase would have consisted of $617.2 million related to a 33.7% increase in the wholesale selling price of motor fuel and $154.7 million related to a 6.3% increase in gallons sold to affiliates. Pro forma rental income would have increased $0.3 million due to increases in contractual rental payments from third parties.

              Pro Forma Cost of Sales and Gross Profit.     Pro forma motor fuel gross profit from third-party sales for 2011 would have been $17.6 million, an increase of $3.8 million, or 27.8%, over 2010. This increase would have been attributable to a 19.8% increase in third-party gross profit cents per gallon, or 0.7 cents per gallon, contributing $2.7 million. Also, the 6.6% increase in gallons sold to third parties increased gross profit $1.1 million. The sales price of motor fuel sold to third parties increased by 74.5 cents per gallon while the cost of fuel increased by 73.8 cents per gallon. Pro forma motor fuel gross profit from sales to affiliates for 2011 would have been $27.0 million, a 6.5% increase over 2010. The increase would have been entirely due to a 6.3% increase in gallons sold to affiliates. Cost of sales per gallon would have increased commensurate with revenue per gallon, which would have resulted in a flat 3.0 cents per gallon gross profit for each period. Pro forma gross profit from rental income and other income on a pro forma basis during 2011 would have been $5.8 million, an increase of $0.1 million, which would have been due to the $0.3 million increase in pro forma rental income, partially offset by a $0.2 million decrease in pro forma other gross profit.

Pro Forma Year Ended December 31, 2010 Compared to Pro Forma Year Ended December 31, 2009

              Pro Forma Revenue.     Pro forma revenue for 2010 would have been $2.7 billion, an increase of $589.5 million, or 28.0%, from 2009. Pro forma motor fuel sales to third parties would have increased $167.7 million, or 24.5%. Of this increase, $181.0 million would have been driven by a 26.5% increase in the wholesale selling price per gallon of motor fuel. This would have been slightly offset by a 1.5% decrease in gallons sold to third parties, or a $13.3 million decrease in motor fuel sold to third parties. Pro forma motor fuel sales to affiliates would have increased $421.9 million, or 29.9%, from 2009. This increase would have consisted of $340.6 million related to a 24.1% increase in the wholesale selling price of motor fuel and $81.3 million related to a 4.6% increase in gallons sold to affiliates. Pro forma rental income would have increased $0.5 million related to an acquisition of new rental locations during the fourth quarter of 2009. Pro forma other income, however, would have decreased $0.5 million in 2010 versus 2009.

              Pro Forma Cost of Sales and Gross Profit.     Pro forma motor fuel gross profit from third-party sales for 2010 would have been $13.8 million, an increase of $3.0 million, or 24.4%, over 2009. This increase would have been attributable to a 29.9% increase in third-party gross profit cents per gallon, or 0.8 cents per gallon, contributing $3.2 million. Slightly offsetting this would have been a decrease in motor fuel gross profit from third parties of $0.2 million related to the 1.5% decrease in gallons sold to third parties. The sales price of motor fuel sold to third parties would have increased by 45.9 cents per gallon, while the cost of fuel would have increased by 45.1 cents per gallon. Pro forma motor fuel gross

97


Table of Contents

profit from sales to affiliates for 2010 would have been $25.3 million, a 4.2% increase over 2009. The increase would have been entirely due to the increase in gallons sold to affiliates. Cost of sales per gallon would have increased commensurate with revenue per gallon, which would have resulted in a flat 3.0 cents per gallon gross profit for each period. Pro forma gross profit from rental income during 2010 would have been $3.0 million, a $0.5 million increase from 2009 due to an acquisition in the fourth quarter of 2009. Pro forma gross profit from other income would have decreased $1.0 million in 2010 versus 2009.


Cash Flows of Our Predecessor

              Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities, investing activities and financing activities for the first half of 2012 and 2011 and for the years 2011, 2010 and 2009 were as follows:

 
  Year Ended December 31,   Six Months Ended June 30,  
 
  2009   2010   2011   2011   2012  
 
  (In thousands)
 
 
   
   
   
  (Unaudited)
 

Net cash provided by (used in):

                               

Operating activities

  $ 9,833   $ 17,469   $ 14,263   $ (98 ) $ 7,333  

Investing activities

    (11,356 )   (13,897 )   (19,153 )   (4,069 )   (6,539 )

Financing activities

    331     731     381     24     111  

              Cash Flows from Operating Activities.     Cash flow provided by operating activities is primarily impacted by our operating results and changes in working capital.

              Cash flows from operating activities for the first half of 2012 increased $7.4 million from cash used of $0.1 million during the first half of 2011 to cash provided of $7.3 million for the first half of 2012. Although our accounts receivable and affiliate receivable balances increased due to the cost of fuel increases in the first half of 2012 versus the first half of 2011, these increases were partially offset by similar increases in our accounts payable, netting to a $6.2 million improvement in cash from changes in our operating assets and liabilities. For fiscal 2011, cash flows from operating activities decreased $3.2 million from 2010. Similarly, our accounts receivable and fuel inventory balances increased due to the cost of fuel increases in 2011 versus 2010, these increases were offset by similar increases in our accounts payable, netting to a minimal increase to net cash flow between the two years. The net decrease for 2011 was primarily attributable to the impact of additional cash balances paid by us to SHC, resulting in an increase in our affiliate receivable.

              For fiscal 2010, cash flow from operating activities increased $7.6 million from 2009. This significant increase was partly attributable to an improvement in accounts receivable collections achieved with the implementation of a new accounting system which automated certain processes.

              Cash Flows from Investing Activities.     Cash flows used in investing activities reflect capital expenditures for acquisitions and replacing and maintaining existing facilities and equipment used in the business.

              Cash invested in capital expenditures and for the acquisition of new fuel supply contracts was $6.9 million for the first half of 2012 as compared to $4.1 million for the first half of 2011. This increase of $2.5 million was due to the timing between years of the acquisition of new dealer contracts.

              For fiscal 2011, we invested $7.4 million in capital expenditures and $12.1 million in new fuel supply contracts. These compare to investments made in fiscal 2010 of $4.7 million in capital expenditures and $9.2 million in new fuel supply contracts.

              The investments made in 2010 of $13.9 million compare to $4.4 million in capital expenditures and $7.0 million in new fuel supply contracts completed in 2009.

              Cash Flows from Financing Activities.     Cash flows from financing activities primarily consist of increases and decreases in notes receivable to dealers.

98


Table of Contents

              For the first half of 2012, net payments on dealer notes receivable of $0.1 million were received compared to net payments on dealer notes receivable during the first half of 2011 of less than $0.1 million.

              For fiscal 2011, net payments on notes receivable of $0.4 million were received compared to new net dealer notes receivable during 2010 of $0.4 million. In addition, during 2010, we entered into a mortgage note in the amount of $1.2 million which is secured by real estate.

              The net new dealer notes receivable during 2010 of $0.4 million compared to net payments received on dealer notes receivable of $0.3 million during 2009.


Liquidity and Capital Resources

Liquidity

              Our principal liquidity requirements are to finance current operations, fund capital expenditures, including acquisitions from time to time, and to service our debt. Historically, our predecessor's operations were financed as part of SHC's integrated operations and our predecessor did not record any significant costs associated with financing its operations. Additionally, our predecessor largely relied on internally generated cash flows to satisfy its capital expenditure requirements. Following the closing of this offering, we expect our ongoing sources of liquidity to include cash generated from operations, borrowings under our new revolving credit and term loan facilities, the issuance of additional partnership units as appropriate given market conditions, and the liquidation of U.S. Treasury and other investment grade securities that will be pledged under our term loan facility. We will sell our U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities over time to fund our capital expenditures. Immediately prior to selling such securities, we will repay an equal amount of term loan borrowings with borrowings under our new revolving credit facility. As a result, our U.S. Treasury and other investment grade securities provide us with the ability to fund capital expenditures without increasing the net amount of our outstanding borrowings. We expect that these sources of funds will be adequate to provide for our short-term and long-term liquidity needs. Our ability to meet our debt service obligations and other capital requirements, including capital expenditures, as well as make acquisitions, will depend on our future operating performance which, in turn, will be subject to general economic, financial, business, competitive, legislative, regulatory and other conditions, many of which are beyond our control. As a normal part of our business, depending on market conditions, we will from time to time consider opportunities to repay, redeem, repurchase or refinance our indebtedness. Changes in our operating plans, lower than anticipated sales, increased expenses, acquisitions or other events may cause us to seek additional debt or equity financing in future periods. There can be no guarantee that financing will be available on acceptable terms or at all. Debt financing, if available, could impose additional cash payment obligations and additional covenants and operating restrictions. In addition, any of the items discussed in detail under "Risk Factors" may also significantly impact our liquidity.

              Following the completion of this offering, we intend to pay a minimum quarterly distribution of $            per common unit and subordinated unit per quarter, which equates to $             million per quarter, or $             million per year, based on the number of common and subordinated units to be outstanding immediately after completion of this offering, to the extent we have sufficient cash from our operations after establishment of cash reserves and payment of fees and expenses, including payments to our general partner and its affiliates. We do not have a legal obligation to pay this distribution. Please read "Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions."

Cash Flows Provided by Operations

              Cash flows provided by operations are our main source of liquidity. We have historically relied primarily on cash provided by operating activities, supplemented as necessary from time to time by

99


Table of Contents

borrowings by SHC under its credit facility and other debt or equity transactions to finance our operations and to fund our capital expenditures. Following this offering, we will enter into our own credit facility to provide liquidity as needed to meet changes in working capital requirements. Our daily working capital requirements fluctuate within each month, primarily in response to payments for timing of motor fuel, motor fuel tax and rent. Due to the seasonal nature of our business, our operating cash flow is typically the lowest during the first quarter of the year since sales tend to be lower during the winter months. The summer months are our peak sales months, and therefore our operating cash flow tends to be the highest during the third quarter.

Capital Expenditures

              Capital expenditures, net of proceeds from disposals of property and equipment, were $11.4 million, $13.9 million and $19.2 million for 2009, 2010 and 2011, respectively. Our capital spending program is focused on expanding our wholesale distribution network, maintaining our owned properties and equipment, and maintaining and updating our information systems. Capital expenditure plans are generally evaluated based on return on investment and estimated incremental cash flow. We develop annual capital spending plans based on historical trends for maintenance capital, plus identified projects for new sites, technology and revenue-generating capital. In addition to the annually recurring capital expenditures, potential acquisition opportunities are evaluated based on their anticipated return on invested capital, accretive impact to operating results, and strategic fit.

              Following this offering, our capital expenditures will no longer include the acquisition, replacement, and maintenance of certain transportation, fuel and other equipment and facilities that are not being contributed to us. We estimate that we would have incurred a total of $13.7 million in capital expenditures for 2011 related to the business that will be contributed to us in connection with this offering. Of this amount, $12.7 million would have been for expansion capital, primarily for the acquisition of new dealer supply contracts, and $1.0 million would have been for maintenance capital, including payments to renew existing distribution contracts, or to maintain our real estate leased to third parties in leasable condition, such as parking lot or roof replacement or renovation, or to replace equipment required to operate our existing business.

Our New Credit Facilities

              In connection with the closing of this offering, we will enter into a five-year, $250 million revolving credit facility with a syndicate of financial institutions and a three-year, up to $175 million term loan facility with Bank of America, N.A.

              Our new revolving credit facility will be available for general partnership purposes, including working capital, capital expenditures and acquisitions and will allow us to request that the maximum amount of the credit facility be increased up to an aggregate additional amount of $100 million, subject to certain conditions. The revolving credit facility will include a $75 million sublimit for letters of credit and a $25 million sublimit for same day swing line advances. The availability of the revolving credit facility is subject to certain conditions precedent, including the closing of this offering, and at the closing of this offering, we expect to draw $2.4 million in borrowings under this facility.

              Borrowings under the revolving credit facility will bear interest at a base rate (a rate based off of the higher of a) the Federal Funds Rate plus 0.5%, b) Bank of America's prime rate or c) LIBOR plus 1.00%) or LIBOR, in each case plus an applicable margin ranging from 2.00% to 3.25%, in the case of a LIBOR loan, and from 1.00% to 2.25%, in the case of a base rate loan (determined with reference to our consolidated total leverage ratio). Interest will be payable quarterly, or if LIBOR applies, it may be payable at more frequent intervals. In addition, the unused portion of our revolving credit facility will be subject to a commitment fee ranging from 0.375% to 0.50%, based on our consolidated total leverage ratio.

100


Table of Contents

              The revolving credit facility will require us to maintain a minimum consolidated interest coverage ratio (as defined the revolving credit agreement) of not less than 2.50 to 1.00, and a consolidated total leverage ratio (as defined in the revolving credit agreement) of not more than 4.50 to 1.00. If we decide to issue certain unsecured notes subject to certain conditions contained in the revolving credit agreement, our consolidated total leverage ratio may not exceed, depending on such conditions, 5.50 to 1.00 or 5.00 to 1.00 and our consolidated senior secured leverage ratio (as defined in the revolving credit agreement) may not exceed 3.50 to 1.00. In addition, the revolving credit agreement will contain customary affirmative and negative covenants for transactions of this nature, including, but not limited to restrictions on (i) incurrence of debt and liens (in each case, subject to certain carve outs); (ii) investments, acquisitions, mergers and asset sales (in each case, subject to certain carve outs); (iii) payments of dividends and distributions (with exceptions for distributions of available cash consistent with the partnership agreement, so long as no event of default has occurred and is continuing, and (iv) certain modifications to organizational documents and material contracts. If we should fail to perform our obligations under these and other covenants, the revolving commitments could terminate and any outstanding borrowings under the revolving credit agreement, together with accrued interest, could become immediately due and payable. In addition, the revolving credit facility will contain cross default provisions that apply to our term loan facility and to other indebtedness we may have with an outstanding principal amount in excess of $12.5 million.

              Indebtedness under the revolving credit agreement will be secured by a security interest in, among other things, all of our present and future personal property and all of the personal property of our guarantors, the capital stock of our subsidiaries, and any intercompany debt. Additionally, if our consolidated total leverage ratio exceeds 3.00 to 1.00 at the end of any fiscal quarter, we will be required upon request to grant mortgage liens in favor of the lenders under the revolving credit facility on all real property owned by us and our subsidiary guarantors.

              At the closing of this offering, we expect we will borrow approximately $147.3 million under the term loan facility and use $147.3 million of the proceeds from the offering to purchase U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities. We will pledge such securities to secure the term loan facility and distribute the $147.3 million borrowed under the term loan facility to SHC. If the underwriters exercise their option to purchase up to an additional                        common units from us in full, we will borrow up to approximately $             million in additional funds under the term loan facility. We will then purchase and pledge an equal amount of additional U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities to further secure the additional borrowings under the term loan facility. We will distribute the additional $             million borrowed under the term loan facility to SHC. See "Use of Proceeds."

              The term loan facility will be secured at all times by the U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities in an amount equal to or greater than the outstanding principal amount of the term loan. We expect that we will sell the collateral for the term loan facility in order to fund capital expenditures. Immediately prior to selling such securities, we will repay an equal amount of term loan borrowings with borrowings under our new revolving credit facility. As a result, there will be no change in the net amount of our outstanding borrowings.

              Borrowings under the term loan facility will bear interest at a base rate (a rate based off of the higher of a) the Federal Funds Rate plus 0.5%, b) Bank of America's prime rate or c) LIBOR plus 1.00%) or LIBOR plus 0.25%, payable quarterly or, if LIBOR applies, it may be payable at more frequent intervals. The term loan agreement will contain customary affirmative and negative covenants for transactions of this nature. If we should fail to perform our obligations under these covenants, any outstanding borrowings under the term loan agreement, together with accrued interest, could become immediately due and payable. In addition, the term loan credit facility will contain cross default provisions that apply to our revolving credit facility.

101


Table of Contents

              Our credit facilities are subject to a number of conditions, including the negotiation, execution and delivery of definitive documentation and the closing of this offering.

Contractual Obligations

              We have contractual obligations that are required to be settled in cash. Our contractual obligations as of December 31, 2011 were as follows:

 
  Payments Due by Period  
 
  2012   2013   2014   2015   2016   Thereafter   Total  
 
  (In thousands)
 

Long-term debt obligations

  $ 22   $ 24   $ 25   $ 26   $ 1,023   $   $ 1,120  

Interest payments

    67     65     64     62     35         293  

Operating lease obligations

    2,569     2,417     2,352     2,331     2,306     14,980     26,955  
                               

Total

  $ 2,658   $ 2,506   $ 2,441   $ 2,419   $ 3,364   $ 14,980   $ 28,368  


Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

              We do not maintain any off-balance sheet arrangements for the purpose of credit enhancement, hedging transactions or other financial or investment purposes.


Impact of Inflation

              The impact of inflation has minimal impact on our results of operations, as we generally are able to pass along energy cost increases in the form of increased sales prices to our customers. Inflation in energy prices impacts our sales and cost of motor fuel products and working capital requirements. Increased fuel prices may also require us to post additional letters of credit or other collateral if our fuel purchases exceed unsecured credit limits extended to us by our suppliers. Although we believe we have historically been able to pass on increased costs through price increases and maintain adequate liquidity to support any increased collateral requirements, there can be no assurance that we will be able to do so in the future.


Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

Commodity Price Risk

              Market risk is the risk of loss arising from adverse changes in market rates and prices. We purchase over 95% of our motor fuel only when we receive an order from one of our customers and take title to the motor fuel only for the short period of time (typically less than a day) between pick-up and delivery. In addition, a substantial majority of our gross profit is generated by fixed fees that we charge for each gallon sold and any transportation costs that we incur are passed through to our customers. We may periodically purchase motor fuel in bulk and hold in inventory or transport it via pipeline, in which case we mitigate the inventory risk through the use of commodity futures contracts or other derivative instruments which are matched in quantity and timing to the anticipated usage of the inventory. These fuel hedging positions have not been material to our operations.

              We have limited exposure to commodity price risk as a result of the payment and volume-related discounts in certain of our supply contracts with our suppliers, which are based on the market price of motor fuel. If fuel prices were to decrease dramatically, the amount of the discount we receive would be reduced. Based on our motor fuel volumes sold for the year ended December 31, 2011, an increase or decrease in our average motor fuel cost of $0.10 would result in an approximate $275,000 increase or decrease in Adjusted EBITDA.

102


Table of Contents

Interest Rate Risk

              We may be subject to market risk from exposure to changes in interest rates based on our financing, investing, and cash management activities. In connection with the closing of this offering, we will enter into a five-year, $250 million credit facility and a three-year, up to $175 million term loan facility, in each case bearing interest at variable rates. Interest rates on commercial bank borrowings and debt offerings could be higher than current levels, causing our financing costs to increase accordingly. Although this could limit our ability to raise funds in the debt capital markets, we expect to remain competitive with respect to acquisitions and capital projects, as our competitors would likely face similar circumstances.


Significant Accounting Policies and Estimates

              The discussion and analysis of our financial condition and results of operations are based upon the financial statements of our predecessor, which have been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States. The preparation of these financial statements requires the use of estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, revenues and expenses, and related disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities. Certain accounting policies involve judgments and uncertainties to such an extent that there is a reasonable likelihood that materially different amounts could have been reported under different conditions, or if different assumptions had been used. Estimates and assumptions are evaluated on a regular basis. We and our predecessor base our respective estimates on historical experience and various other assumptions that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances, the results of which form the basis for making judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities that are not readily apparent from other sources. Actual results may differ from the estimates and assumptions used in preparation of the financial statements.

              Upon the closing of this offering, the historical financial statements of our predecessor will become the historical financial statements of Susser Petroleum Partners LP. Consequently, the critical accounting policies and estimates of our predecessor will become our critical accounting policies and estimates. We believe these accounting policies reflect the more significant estimates and assumptions used in preparation of the financial statements. Please read Note 2 to our predecessor audited historical financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus, for a discussion of additional accounting policies, estimates and judgments made by its management.

              Business Combinations and Intangible Assets Including Goodwill.     We account for acquisitions using the purchase method of accounting. Accordingly, assets acquired and liabilities assumed are recorded at their estimated fair values at the acquisition date. The excess of purchase price over fair value of net assets acquired, including the amount assigned to identifiable intangible assets, is recorded as goodwill. Given the time it takes to obtain pertinent information to finalize the acquired company's balance sheet, it may be several quarters before we are able to finalize those initial fair value estimates. Accordingly, it is not uncommon for the initial estimates to be subsequently revised. The results of operations of acquired businesses are included in the consolidated financial statements from the acquisition date.

              Our recorded identifiable intangible assets primarily include the estimated value assigned to certain customer related and contract-based assets. Identifiable intangible assets with finite lives are amortized over their estimated useful lives, which is the period over which the asset is expected to contribute directly or indirectly to our future cash flows. Supply agreements are amortized on a straight-line basis over the remaining terms of the agreements, which generally range from five to fifteen years. Favorable/unfavorable lease arrangements are amortized on a straight-line basis over the remaining lease terms. In October 2011, we completed the acquisition of 121 wholesale dealer fuel supply agreements, with a remaining average useful life of six years, and fuel supply rights to 26 commercial accounts, with a remaining average useful life of one year. The determination of the fair

103


Table of Contents

market value of the intangible asset and the estimated useful life are based on an analysis of all pertinent factors including (1) the use of widely-accepted valuation approaches, the income approach or the cost approach, (2) the expected use of the asset by us, (3) the expected useful life of related assets, (4) any legal, regulatory or contractual provisions, including renewal or extension periods that would cause substantial costs or modifications to existing agreements, and (5) the effects of obsolescence, demand, competition, and other economic factors. Should any of the underlying assumptions indicate that the value of the intangible assets might be impaired, we may be required to reduce the carrying value and subsequent useful life of the asset. If the underlying assumptions governing the amortization of an intangible asset were later determined to have significantly changed, we may be required to adjust the amortization period of such asset to reflect any new estimate of its useful life. Any write-down of the value or unfavorable change in the useful life of an intangible asset would increase expense at that time.

              Under the accounting rules, goodwill is not amortized. Instead, goodwill is subject to annual reviews on the first day of the fourth fiscal quarter for impairment at a reporting unit level. The reporting unit or units used to evaluate and measure goodwill for impairment are determined primarily from the manner in which the business is managed or operated. A reporting unit is an operating segment or a component that is one level below an operating segment. In accordance with ASC 350 "Intangibles—Goodwill and Other", we have assessed the reporting unit definitions and determined that we have one operating segment that is appropriate for testing goodwill impairment.

              The impairment analysis performed in the fourth quarter of fiscal year 2011 indicated no impairment.

              The Financial Accounting Standards Board issued ASU 2011-08 "Intangibles-Goodwill and Other (Topic 350)," effective for annual and interim impairment tests performed for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2011. We have elected to adopt this standard early and therefore the new standard was applied for the impairment test performed in the fourth quarter of fiscal year 2011.

              ASU 2011-08 provides that qualitative factors are first assessed to determine whether it is necessary to perform the two-step goodwill impairment test. Under the new requirements, we used these qualitative factors to determine whether it is more likely than not (likelihood of more than 50%) that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount, including goodwill. We used the most recent calculation of the reporting unit's fair values as a starting point for the qualitative screen.

              Some of the factors considered in applying this test include the consideration of macroeconomic conditions, industry and market considerations, cost factors affecting the business, and the overall financial performance of the business. In addition, the key inputs used to determine fair value were considered, including industry multiples, the weighted average cost of capital, and the cash flow. Because the prior year margin between the fair value and carrying amount was not significant, we determined that step one of the two-step goodwill impairment test should be applied in testing the goodwill. The result of this analysis (in thousands) is as follows:

 
  Fair Value   Carrying Value   Excess   % Excess  

Goodwill

  $ 196,832   $ 132,726   $ 64,106     48 %

              We compute the fair value employing multiple valuation methodologies, including a market approach (market price multiples of comparable companies) and an income approach (discounted cash flow analysis).

              This approach is consistent with the requirement to utilize all appropriate valuation techniques as described in ASC 820-10-35-24 "Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures." The values ascertained using these methods were weighted to obtain a total fair value. The computations require management to make significant estimates and assumptions. Critical estimates and assumptions that are used as part of these evaluations include, among other things, selection of comparable publicly traded companies,

104


Table of Contents

the discount rate applied to future earnings reflecting a weighted average cost of capital rate, and earnings growth assumptions.

              A discounted cash flow analysis requires us to make various judgmental assumptions about sales, operating margins, capital expenditures, working capital and growth rates. Assumptions about sales, operating margins, capital expenditures and growth rates are based on our budgets, business plans, economic projections, and anticipated future cash flows. The annual planning process that we undertake to prepare the long range financial forecast takes into consideration a multitude of factors including historical growth rates and operating performance, related industry trends, macroeconomic conditions, inflationary and deflationary forces, pricing strategies, customer demand analysis, operating trends, competitor analysis, and marketplace data, among others. In determining the fair value of our reporting units, we were required to make significant judgments and estimates regarding the impact of anticipated economic factors on our business. The forecast assumptions used in the 2011 analysis anticipate continued growth using slightly conservative rates compared to historical averages. Assumptions are also made for a "normalized" perpetual growth rate for periods beyond the long range financial forecast period.

              Our estimates of fair value are sensitive to changes in all of these variables, certain of which relate to broader macroeconomic conditions outside our control. As a result, actual performance in the near and longer-term could be different from these expectations and assumptions. This could be caused by events such as strategic decisions made in response to economic and competitive conditions and the impact of economic factors, such as continued increases in unemployment rates on our customer base. In addition, some of the inherent estimates and assumptions used in determining fair value of the reporting units are outside the control of management, including interest rates, cost of capital, tax rates, and our credit ratings. While we believe we have made reasonable estimates and assumptions to calculate the fair value of the reporting units and other intangible assets, it is possible a material change could occur. If our future actual results are significantly lower than our current operating results or our estimates and assumptions used to calculate fair value are materially different, the value determined using the discounted cash flow analysis could result in a lower value. A significant decrease in value could result in a fair value lower than carrying value, and require us to perform the second step which could result in impairment of our goodwill.

              Property and Equipment.     We calculate depreciation on property and equipment using the straight-line method based on the estimated useful lives of the assets ranging from three to forty years. Changes in the estimated useful lives of our property and equipment could have a material effect on our results of operations. The estimates of the assets' useful lives require our judgment regarding assumptions about the useful life of the assets being depreciated. When necessary, the depreciable lives are revised and the impact on deprecation is treated on a prospective basis. Changes in the estimated life of assets could have a material effect on our results of operations.

              Long-Lived Assets and Assets Held for Sale.     Long-lived assets at the individual store level are reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate the carrying amount of the asset may not be recoverable. If indicators exist, we compare the estimated discounted future cash flows related to the asset to the carrying value of the asset. If impairment is indicated, we then would write down the asset to its net realizable value (fair value less cost to sell). Assumptions are made with respect to cash flows expected to be generated by the related assets based upon management projections. Any changes in key assumptions used to compile these projections, particularly store performance or market conditions, could result in an unanticipated impairment charge. For instance, changes in market demographics, traffic patterns, competition and other factors may impact the overall operations of certain individual store locations and may require us to record impairment charges in the future.

              Store properties that have been closed and other excess real property are recorded as assets held and used, and are written down to the lower of cost or estimated net realizable value at the time

105


Table of Contents

we close such stores or determine that these properties are in excess and intend to offer them for sale. We estimate the net realizable value based on our experience in utilizing or disposing of similar assets and on estimates provided by our own and third-party real estate experts. Although we have not experienced significant changes in our estimate of net realizable value, changes in real estate markets could significantly impact the net values realized from the sale of assets. When we have determined that an asset is more likely than not to be sold in the next twelve months, that asset is classified as assets held for sale and reflected in other current assets.

              Insurance Liabilities.     We use a combination of self-insurance and third-party insurance with predetermined deductibles that cover certain insurable risks. Our costs are allocated from SHC and SHC carries a liability which represents an estimate of the ultimate cost of claims incurred as of the balance sheet dates. The estimated undiscounted liability is established based upon analysis of historical data and include judgments and actuarial assumptions regarding economic conditions, the frequency and severity of claims, claim development patterns and claim management and settlement practices. Although we have not experienced significant changes in actual expenditures compared to actuarial assumptions as a result of increased costs or incidence rates, such changes could occur in the future and could significantly impact our results of operations and financial position.

              Asset Retirement Obligations.     We recognize the estimated future cost to remove an underground storage tank over the estimated useful life of the storage tank in accordance with the provisions of ASC 410— "Asset Retirement and Environmental Obligations." We record a discounted liability for the fair value of an asset retirement obligation with a corresponding increase to the carrying value of the related long-lived asset at the time an underground storage tank is installed. We amortize the amount added to property and equipment and recognize accretion expense in connection with the discounted liability over the remaining life of the tank. We base our estimates of the anticipated future costs for removal of an underground storage tank on our prior experience with removal. We annually compare our cost estimates with actual removal experience, and when the actual costs we experience differ from our original estimates, we will adjust the liability for estimated future costs to remove the underground storage tanks.

              Deferred Branding Incentives.     Unearned branding incentives are deferred and amortized as earned over the term of the respective agreement.

              Stock-Based Compensation.     Certain employees supporting our operations were historically granted long-term incentive compensation awards under SHC's stock-based compensation programs, which consist of stock options and restricted common stock. We were allocated expenses for stock-based compensation costs. These costs are included in our general and administrative expenses. Our allocated expense was $0.6 million, $0.6 million and $0.7 million for the years ended December 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011, respectively.

              Income Taxes.     Pursuant to ASC 740 "Income Taxes" (ASC 740), we recognize deferred income tax liabilities and assets for the expected future income tax consequences of temporary differences between financial statement carrying amounts and the related income tax basis. These balances, as well as income tax expense, are determined through management's estimations, interpretation of tax law for multiple jurisdictions and tax planning. If our actual results differ from estimated results due to changes in tax laws, our effective tax rate and tax balances could be affected. As such these estimates may require adjustment in the future as additional facts become known or as circumstances change.

              ASC 740 requires recognition and measurement of uncertain tax positions that we have taken or expect to take in its income tax returns. The benefit of an uncertain tax position can only be recognized in the financial statements if management concludes that it is more likely than not that the position will be sustained with the tax authorities. For a position that is likely to be sustained, the benefit recognized in the financial statements is measured at the largest amount that is greater than 50 percent likely of being realized. In determining the future tax consequences of events that have been

106


Table of Contents

recognized in our financial statements or tax returns, judgment is required. Differences between the anticipated and actual outcomes of these future tax consequences could have a material impact on our consolidated results of operations or financial position.


Recent Accounting Pronouncements

              FASB ASU No. 2011-04.     In May 2011, the FASB issued ASU No. 2011-04, " Fair Value Measurement, Amendments to Achieve Common Fair Value Measurement and Disclosure Requirements in U.S. GAAP and IFRS (ASC 820—Fair Value Measurement). " This guidance amends ASC 820 on fair value measurements and disclosures to (1) clarify the board's intent in respect of existing measurement guidance, (2) revise certain measurement guidance that changes or modifies a principle for measuring fair value, and (3) add disclosure requirements concerning the measurement uncertainty of level 3 measurements. The ASU is effective for interim and annual periods beginning after December 15, 2011. No impact is expected on our financial statements.

              FASB ASU No. 2011-05.     In June 2011, the FASB issued ASU No. 2011-05, " Comprehensive Income: Presentation of Comprehensive Income (ASC 220—Comprehensive Income). " This guidance removes the presentation options in ASC 220 and requires entities to report components of comprehensive income in either (1) a continuous statement of comprehensive income or (2) two separate but consecutive statements. The ASU does not change the items that must be reported in other comprehensive income. It is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2011 (and for interim periods within such years). In December 2011, the FASB issued ASU No. 2011-12, which deferred certain aspects of ASU No. 2011-05. We adopted this accounting standard beginning January 1, 2012. This standard affects presentation and disclosure, and therefore will not affect our consolidated financial position, results of operations or cash flows.

              FASB ASU No. 2011-08.     In September 2011, the FASB issued ASU NO. 2011-08, " Intangibles-Goodwill and Other (ASC350-20—Goodwill): Testing Goodwill for Impairment. " This guidance permits an entity to first assess qualitative factors to determine whether it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount as a basis for determining whether it is necessary to perform the two-step goodwill impairment test. The ASU is effective for annual and interim goodwill impairment tests performed for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2011, but early adoption is permitted. We have early adopted ASU No. 2011-08 during the fourth quarter of Fiscal 2011 and used it to perform the annual goodwill impairment test.

107


Table of Contents


INDUSTRY

              Unless stated otherwise, the following information is derived from the most current information available from the U.S. Energy Information Administration, or EIA, the statistical and analytical agency within the United States Department of Energy.


The Motor Fuel Industry

              The United States consumes nearly 19 million barrels of petroleum products each day, and roughly 67% is for gasoline and distillate fuel oil used primarily for ground transportation. The primary use for motor fuels is in automobiles and light trucks. Motor fuels are also used to fuel boats, recreational vehicles, and various farm and other equipment. The United States is divided into five separate Petroleum Administration for Defense Districts ("PADDs") as it relates to refined product supply, delivery and usage. Our suppliers and customers generally reside in PADD 3 which includes 44 refineries with capacity to handle over 8.8 million barrels of crude oil per day. The majority of our business is in Texas, which has 27 petroleum refineries that can process more than 4.7 million barrels of crude oil per day, and account for more than one-fourth of total U.S. refining capacity.

Motor Fuels Value Chain

GRAPHIC

              In 2011, PADD 3 refineries produced approximately 48% of total U.S. refined petroleum products. After crude oil is refined into motor fuels and other petroleum products, the products must be distributed to facilities that service consumers. The majority of motor fuels is transported first by pipeline to storage terminals near consuming areas and then loaded into trucks for delivery to individual convenience stores.

Gasoline Demand Overview

              In 2011, gasoline represented the largest share of refined petroleum products consumed in the United States at 52% of all refined petroleum. Motor fuel demand is driven primarily by general economic expansion as well as by geographic and demographic factors. As illustrated in the following chart, since 1985 consumption of gasoline has increased in the United States from 105 billion gallons per year to 134 billion gallons per year in 2011, which represents compound average annual growth of approximately 1%.

108


Table of Contents


U.S. Product Supplied of Finished Motor Gasoline

GRAPHIC


Source: Energy Information Administration. According to the EIA, "U.S. Product Supplied of Finished Motor Gasoline" approximately represents consumption of finished motor gasoline.

              Gasoline consumption in the United States has grown in 53 of the 66 years in the period from 1945 to 2011. In general, down years in gasoline consumption have largely been driven by historical external shocks or other unusual economic factors in the broader economy. While national gasoline consumption has declined moderately since 2007 due to recession-related factors and the improved fuel efficiency of newer vehicles, strong population growth and economic growth in Texas has led to a slight increase in gasoline consumption over the same period.

              According to the Texas Comptroller of Public Accounts, gasoline gallons taxed in Texas has grown significantly during the last several decades. From 1989 to 2011, annual gasoline consumption grew approximately 41.2% from 8.5 billion gallons to 11.9 billion gallons, or at an approximate 1.6% compound annual growth rate. Gasoline consumption grew in 17 of the 22 years during the period. As of 2011, Texas motor gasoline consumption totaled approximately 8.9% of U.S. consumption.

Texas Gasoline Gallons Taxed

GRAPHIC


Source: Texas Comptroller of Public Accounts.

Diesel Demand Overview

              Diesel is principally consumed in the United States by large trucks. Diesel is also used by electricity generators, railroad locomotives, farming equipment, military vehicles and engines and some cars and light trucks. The United States consumed 0.8 billion barrels of on-highway diesel in 2010. On-highway diesel has grown from 55% in 2001 to 65% in 2010 of total distillate fuel oil consumption.

109


Table of Contents

Since 1985, consumption of on-highway diesel fuel has experienced an average annual growth of 2.9%. Because it is primarily used for commercial and industrial transportation, on-highway diesel consumption is more cyclical and fluctuates more than gasoline. From 1985 to 2010, there were nine years where on-highway diesel experienced greater than 5% annual growth rates and there were two years where on-highway diesel experienced greater than 5% declines.

              According to the Texas Comptroller of Public Accounts, diesel gallons taxed in Texas has also grown significantly during the last several decades. From 1989 to 2011, annual diesel consumption grew approximately 144.1% from 1.6 billion gallons to 3.8 billion gallons, or at an approximate 4.1% compound annual growth rate. Diesel consumption grew in 18 of the 22 years during the period.

Texas Diesel Gallons Taxed

GRAPHIC


Source: Texas Comptroller of Public Accounts.

Motor Fuel Demand Projections

              In the EIA's 2011 Annual Energy Outlook, it projected transportation energy consumption will grow at an average annual rate of 0.7% per year thru 2035. The EIA estimates moderate increases by heavy-duty vehicles for freight travel demand and slight increases by automobiles. In the EIA's 2011 baseline projections, consumption of gasoline is projected to remain almost flat through 2035 while consumption of on-highway diesel fuel is projected to increase at an average annual rate of 1.6% through 2035. This growth trend also factors in increased fuel economy standards which the EIA does not expect will overcome overall increases in transportation demand, which drives the continued growth during the forecast period.

Motor Fuels

              In general, motor fuels are homogenous commoditized products. Gasoline is typically sold by octane grades: regular, midgrade and premium. In 2011, 87.2% of U.S. gasoline sales were regular grade, 3.9% medium grade and 9.0% premium grade. In contrast to gasoline, on-highway diesel is not generally available in different grades. One way in which wholesale and retail marketers engage in product differentiation is to increase sales volume by purchasing specialized motor fuel blends from established global/national brand refiners such as Chevron, Conoco, Phillip 66, ExxonMobil, BP, Shell, Valero, Sunoco and Gulf. These large refiners have substantial influence over the wholesale distribution system and have extensive networks for getting their fuels to retail markets.

110


Table of Contents

Regional and Seasonal Demand Patterns

              Different regions exhibit different motor fuel consumption patterns. Population, demographics, and regional economic activity are important determinants affecting demand, but availability of alternative fuels, petroleum transportation costs, geography and other factors are also important. The United States government categorizes motor fuel consumption into five Petroleum Administration for Defense Districts (PADD), with the Gulf Coast (PADD III, including Alabama, Arkansas, Louisiana Mississippi, New Mexico and Texas) consuming approximately 15.2% of the nation's gasoline in 2011. In 2011, Texas consumed approximately 8.9% of gasoline, second only to California with approximately 10.9%, and followed by Florida with an estimated 6.0%.

              Gasoline volumes are also considered to be seasonal because gasoline demand rises moderately in the warmer months and falls moderately in the cooler months, exhibiting a shallow swing between the "low" demand season and the "high" demand season. Since 2000, January and February have been the low end of the demand season as gasoline consumption averages approximately 3% to 10% below the monthly average whereas July and August have been the high-end of the demand season as gasoline consumption averages approximately 5% to 6% above the monthly average. On-highway diesel does not typically exhibit the same seasonal variation in consumption.

Wholesale Motor Fuel Marketing

              The wholesale motor fuel marketing industry consists of sales of branded and unbranded gasoline and on- and off-highway diesel to retail convenience store operators, other wholesale distributors and the other commercial customers. In general, wholesalers' motor fuel revenues are heavily influenced by final retail prices, which are influenced by crude oil prices and refining and transportation costs and other factors. However, final retail prices paid by consumers are ultimately set by the retailers subject to certain regulations and taxes, which vary from state to state. While factors such as geopolitical events, inclement weather and other events can disrupt the supply and price of crude oil and the supply and distribution of refined petroleum products, the impact on retail motor fuel prices may not necessarily be immediate and can take several days or weeks to be reflected in retail prices.

              Wholesale distributors purchase branded and unbranded motor fuels from integrated oil companies and refiners and take delivery of the purchased motor fuel at a distribution terminal. The price at which a wholesale distributor generally purchases motor fuel from an integrated oil company or refiner at the terminal is referred to as the "rack" price, which includes the refiner's profit on the motor fuel.

              Wholesale distributors typically sell motor fuels to their customers at either "dealer tank wagon" prices, also referred to as "DTW," or "rack plus" prices. DTW prices represent the cost of the motor fuels to the customer and include the profit to the wholesale distributor, taxes, transportation and other costs. Under DTW pricing, the wholesale distributor may provide additional services and benefits to the customer, such as the use of branded trademarks and advertising.

              "Rack plus" pricing is the rack price plus a margin that represents the profit to the wholesale distributor. Transportation, taxes, insurance and other services to the wholesale distributor's customers may be charged separately. Rack prices are influenced primarily by crude oil prices. At a minimum, rack prices typically exceed refinery gate prices (prices set by the refiner as it leaves the refinery) by the transportation cost to move the gasoline from the refinery to the terminal, usually by pipeline or by barge.

111


Table of Contents

Our Wholesale Motor Fuel Customers

              We distribute to four primary customer groups:

    Stripes® convenience stores—We distribute motor fuel for a fixed fee and Stripes® sets the retail price of the motor fuel.

    SHC's consignment locations—Pursuant to our commercial agreements with SHC, we distribute motor fuel to SHC for a fixed fee whereby SHC distributes to its consignment locations. At these consignment locations, SHC provides and controls motor fuel inventory and price at the site and receives the actual selling price for each gallon sold, less a commission paid to the independent operator at the location.

    Contracted third parties—Under a typical distribution contract, we agree to distribute a particular branded or unbranded motor fuel to a location or group of locations operated by independent third parties, which we refer to as "dealers," primarily on a "rack-plus" basis. The initial term of most dealer distribution contracts is ten years.

    Other commercial customers—Includes convenience stores, unattended fueling facilities and other customers comprised primarily of commercial, governmental and other parties who buy motor fuel by the load or in bulk and who do not enter into exclusive contracted relationships with us. Sales to these customers are typically made at quoted prices based on our total cost plus a margin at the time of the sale.

              Retail convenience stores are the primary customers for most wholesale motor fuel distribution. For example, according to the National Association of Convenience Stores, there were 148,126 retail convenience stores in the United States at December 31, 2011. Once dominated by the major integrated oil companies, the retail gasoline market has become increasingly more fragmented and many are owned and operated as small independent businesses. In recent years the major integrated oil companies have reduced their United States convenience store holdings. For example, according to its periodic reports filed with the SEC, ExxonMobil owned or leased 451, 1,243 and 1,921 convenience stores as of December 31, 2011, 2010, and 2009, respectively. The major integrated oil companies reference intense competition in the retail motor fuels market as well as higher returns and margins in other areas of the oil and gas business for their shift in strategy.

112


Table of Contents


BUSINESS

Overview

              We are a growth-oriented Delaware limited partnership formed in June 2012 by Susser Holdings Corporation, or SHC, to engage in the primarily fee-based wholesale distribution of motor fuels to SHC and third parties. SHC operates 545 retail convenience stores under its proprietary Stripes ® brand, primarily in growing Texas markets. Stripes ® is the largest independent chain of convenience stores in Texas based on store count and retail motor fuel volumes sold. Our business is integral to the success of SHC's retail operations, and upon the completion of this offering, SHC will purchase all of its motor fuel from us. For the year ended December 31, 2011, we distributed 789.6 million gallons of motor fuel to Stripes® convenience stores and 522.8 million gallons of motor fuel to other customers. We believe we are the largest independent motor fuel distributor by gallons in Texas, and among the largest distributors of Valero and Chevron branded motor fuel in the United States. We also receive rental income from real estate that we lease or sublease.

              We purchase motor fuel primarily from independent refiners and major oil companies and distribute it throughout Texas and in Louisiana, New Mexico and Oklahoma to:

    Stripes® convenience stores, pursuant to the SHC Distribution Contract;

    over 80 other independently operated consignment locations where SHC sells motor fuel to retail customers, also pursuant to the SHC Distribution Contract;

    over 480 convenience stores and retail fuel outlets operated by independent third parties, which we refer to as "dealers," pursuant to long-term distribution agreements; and

    other commercial customers, including unbranded convenience stores, other fuel distributors, school districts and municipalities and other industrial customers.

              We distribute Chevron, CITGO, Conoco, Exxon, Mobil, Phillips 66, Shamrock, Shell, Texaco and Valero branded motor fuel, as well as unbranded motor fuel. We believe the variety and relatively large volumes of branded and unbranded motor fuel that we distribute is a key competitive advantage relative to other wholesale distributors in our markets. In addition to distributing motor fuel, we also distribute other petroleum products such as propane and lube oil.

              In addition to SHC's existing Stripes® convenience stores and independently operated consignment locations, we will distribute fuel to substantially all retail convenience stores and independently operated consignment locations that SHC constructs or acquires in the future. The total amount of motor fuel we sold grew from 892.0 million gallons during 2007 to over 1.3 billion gallons during 2011, primarily as a result of the increase in the number of Stripes® convenience stores, growth in average annual per-store volumes at Stripes ® convenience stores and expansion of our dealer network. Since January 1, 2007, the number of Stripes ® convenience store locations has grown from 325 to 545, while the amount of motor fuel sold to such stores grew from 426.8 million gallons during 2007 to 789.6 million gallons during 2011. During this period, the combined number of dealer and consignment locations increased from 367 to 565.

113


Table of Contents


Total Motor Fuel Gallons Sold

GRAPHIC

              During the twelve months ended June 30, 2012 and after giving pro forma effect to the SHC Distribution Contract, approximately 90% of our motor fuel sales by volume would have been made pursuant to fee-based, long-term distribution agreements. Under the ten-year SHC Distribution Contract, which will be contributed to us in connection with this offering, we will be the exclusive distributor of motor fuel purchased by SHC's existing Stripes® convenience stores and independently operated consignment locations. We will distribute such motor fuel to SHC at cost plus a fixed profit margin of three cents per gallon, as described in more detail below in "—Our Relationship with Susser Holdings Corporation—Our Agreements with SHC—Our Agreements with SHC." Our third-party dealer distribution contracts generally have an initial term of ten years, and currently have an average remaining term of approximately five years. These contracts typically provide that we will distribute motor fuel at the posted purchase price at the fuel supply terminal, plus transportation costs, taxes and a fixed, volume-based fee, which is usually expressed in cents per gallon.

              We believe that we have limited exposure to fluctuating commodity prices because we generally pass the cost of the fuel that we distribute through to our customers. In 2011, over 95% of our motor fuel gallons were purchased only after receiving a customer order and we held title to the fuel only for the period of time required for delivery, which is typically less than a day. We frequently use commodity derivative instruments to mitigate the price risk for the limited amounts of fuel for which we take title for a more extended period of time typically not in excess of 60 days.

              In addition to revenues earned in our wholesale motor fuel distribution business, we will also receive rental income from convenience store properties that we lease or sublease to SHC and third parties. We currently receive rental income from 55 properties, most of which are in Texas, and all of which we lease to third parties. Pursuant to the omnibus agreement that we will enter into with SHC at the closing of this offering, we will have a three-year option to purchase up to 75 new or recently constructed Stripes® convenience stores from SHC and lease them back to SHC for a 15-year initial term. Furthermore, any stores that we purchase and lease back to SHC pursuant to the 75 store option will be added to the SHC Distribution Contract, pursuant to which we will be the exclusive distributor of motor fuel to the applicable stores for ten years from the time of purchase at cost plus a fixed profit margin of three cents per gallon. For a more detailed description of the sale and leaseback option, please read "Business—Our Relationship with Susser Holdings Corporation—Our Agreements with SHC—Omnibus Agreement." Although we may purchase real estate and lease it to SHC or third

114


Table of Contents

parties, we do not currently operate or have any intention to operate any retail convenience stores that we own or may acquire in the future.

              For the year ended December 31, 2011, we would have had pro forma gross profit of approximately $50.3 million, pro forma Adjusted EBITDA of approximately $39.1 million, and pro forma net income of approximately $31.7 million. Sales to SHC would have accounted for approximately 54% of our pro forma gross profit for that period. For the six months ended June 30, 2012, we would have had pro forma gross profit of approximately $27.6 million, pro forma Adjusted EBITDA of approximately $20.8 million, and pro forma net income of approximately $16.2 million. Please read "Summary—Summary Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data" for the definition of Adjusted EBITDA and a reconciliation of Adjusted EBITDA to our most directly comparable financial measures calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP.


Our Relationship with Susser Holdings Corporation

              One of our principal strengths is our relationship with SHC. SHC is the largest independent operator of convenience stores in Texas based on store count and retail motor fuel volumes sold. The Susser family entered the motor fuel retailing and distribution business in the 1930's. Sam L. Susser, the President and Chief Executive Officer of SHC and our general partner, joined SHC in 1988, when it operated five stores and had revenues of $8.4 million. SHC has demonstrated a strong track record of internal growth and the ability to successfully integrate acquisitions into its operations, completing 13 significant acquisitions consisting of 520 retail stores and 394 wholesale distribution contracts since 1988. In addition, SHC constructed over 115 large-format convenience stores from January 2000 through December 31, 2011, and intends to open an additional 26 to 29 newly constructed stores during 2012 and 28 to 35 newly constructed stores during 2013. SHC has also developed its proprietary Laredo Taco Company ® in-house restaurant concept and implemented it in over 320 Stripes® convenience stores, and intends to implement it in all newly constructed Stripes® convenience stores. In 2006, SHC completed an initial public offering of common stock and SHC's common stock trades on the NASDAQ under the symbol "SUSS."

              Following the completion of this offering, SHC will continue to operate its retail convenience store business and will retain its consignment and transportation business, and we will operate the balance of its wholesale motor fuel distribution business and lease convenience store properties. SHC will own our general partner, which controls us, and will also retain a significant economic interest in us through its direct and indirect ownership of        % of our limited partner interests and all of our incentive distribution rights, which will entitle SHC to increasing percentages of the cash we distribute in excess of $            per unit per quarter.

Our Agreements with SHC

      Commercial Agreements

              In connection with the completion of this offering, two long-term, fee-based commercial agreements with SHC will be contributed to us. These commercial agreements with SHC will consist of:

    the SHC Distribution Contract, a fuel distribution agreement, pursuant to which we will be the exclusive distributor of motor fuel to SHC's existing Stripes® convenience stores and independently operated consignment locations purchased at cost, including tax and transportation costs, plus a fixed profit margin of three cents per gallon, for a period of ten years, in addition to all future motor fuel volumes purchased by SHC for its own account pursuant to the terms of our omnibus agreement; and

    the SHC Transportation Contract, pursuant to which SHC will arrange for motor fuel to be delivered from our suppliers to our customers at rates consistent with those charged to third parties for the delivery of motor fuel, with the cost being entirely passed along to our customers, including SHC.

115


Table of Contents

      Omnibus Agreement

              In addition to the commercial agreements with SHC that will be contributed to us in connection with the completion of this offering, we will enter into an omnibus agreement with SHC. Below are some of the primary commercial terms of the omnibus agreement. For more information regarding the omnibus agreement, please read "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions—Agreements with Affiliates in Connection with the Transactions—Omnibus Agreement."

      Option on 75 New or Recently Constructed Stripes® Convenience Stores.

              Pursuant to the omnibus agreement SHC will grant us an option to acquire up to 75 new or recently constructed convenience stores and lease the stores back to SHC under a form lease agreement. Our option with respect to 15 stores will begin upon completion of this offering and expire on the first anniversary of the completion of this offering. Our option with respect to 25 additional stores will begin on the first anniversary of the completion of this offering and expire on the second anniversary of the completion of this offering. The option period with respect to the remaining 35 stores will begin on the second anniversary of the completion of this offering and expire on the third anniversary of the completion of this offering. The omnibus agreement provides that we may mutually agree with SHC to accelerate our purchase of the second and third year option stores.

              Each store purchased and leased pursuant to the exercise of the sale and leaseback option will be (i) purchased by us at SHC's cost, including real estate and construction costs (as calculated consistently with SHC's prior practices, and pursuant to a certificate of cost delivered to us), and (ii) leased to SHC under a form lease agreement at an initial annual rate of 8% of the purchase price for an initial term of 15 years. In addition, any stores that we purchase and lease back to SHC will be added to the SHC Distribution Contract, pursuant to which we will be the exclusive distributor of motor fuel purchased by SHC at the applicable stores for ten years from the time of purchase at cost plus a fixed profit margin of three cents per gallon.

              We currently expect that, based on SHC's current construction plans, each of the 75 stores included in the sale and leaseback option will be a store completed after the consummation of this offering. In the event that SHC determines to cease or reduce new store construction, SHC, pursuant to our sale and leaseback option, will have the right to substitute an existing store for any of the 75 stores included in the sale and leaseback option. SHC's existing stores will already be supplied by us at cost plus a fixed profit margin of three cents per gallon and, as a result, we would not receive incremental income from motor fuel sales as a result of the purchase of an existing store.

              SHC will continue to operate the stores. SHC will have the option to extend the term of the lease of the stores for five consecutive five-year renewal terms. If SHC exercises its option to renew the lease on any store, the annual rent will increase by 15% for the first five-year renewal period, and by an additional 5% for each subsequent renewal period.

      Exclusivity on Substantially All Future Volumes Sold by SHC.

              Our omnibus agreement provides that SHC is obligated to purchase from us any fuel it sells in the future for its own account, and we are obligated to distribute such fuel to them at the price and for the term provided for under the SHC Distribution Contract, except in the case of any acquired retail stores already party to an existing supply agreement.

              As described above, for any stores we purchase pursuant to the sale and leaseback option, we will distribute motor fuel to SHC at our cost plus a fixed profit margin of three cents per gallon for a period of ten years from the time of purchase. We will distribute additional motor fuel volumes to SHC at other stores or sites at a negotiated rate or, if we fail to reach a negotiated agreement, at cost plus the alternate fuel sales rate, as described further below, until the negotiated termination date, in the case of sales made at a negotiated rate, or until ten years after the closing of this offering, in the case of sales made at cost plus the alternate fuel sales rate.

116


Table of Contents

              However, SHC will have a limited ability to remove Stripes® convenience stores and SHC's independently operated consignment locations from the SHC Distribution Contract after the closing of this offering. Specifically, the SHC Distribution Contract provides that SHC may remove an independently operated consignment location if the related contract is terminated and not renewed. In addition, the SHC Distribution Contract provides that SHC may sell or close a Stripes convenience store or convert the location to a third party consignment arrangement (where a third party, as opposed to SHC, sells the motor fuel to retail customers), provided that (a) the applicable location was supplied at our cost plus the alternate fuel sales rate, (b) SHC has agreed to substitute one or more locations comprising equivalent volumes at the same price per gallon charged for the removed Stripes® convenience store within                        of closure, sale or conversion, (c) SHC has received our consent for sale, closure or conversion or (d) such sale, closure or conversion does not cause the aggregate number of Stripes® convenience stores closed, sold or converted in any fiscal year to exceed 20 locations.

      Right to Supply Fuel to SHC for Newly Constructed Stores and Independently Operated Consignment Locations.

              The omnibus agreement will also provide that, for a period of ten years, SHC will present to us an annual construction plan each year, which will include (i) the proposed fuel supply terms for any new Stripes® convenience stores or consignment locations expected to be completed or added in the ordinary course of business in the upcoming year and (ii) any proposal for additional sale and leaseback transactions with respect to Stripes® convenience stores that are not subject to the 75 store option. We will negotiate with SHC to reach an agreement on the fuel supply terms for future stores and consignment locations as well as the sale and leaseback terms, as applicable.

      Right to Participate in Acquisitions.

              The omnibus agreement will also provide that, for a period of ten years, SHC will allow us to participate in its acquisition opportunities, to the extent we are able to reach an agreement on terms. Specifically, we will have a right to negotiate with SHC to acquire any motor fuel distribution contracts and to negotiate the fuel supply terms for distributing fuel to any retail stores or consignment locations included in a potential acquisition under consideration by SHC, other than any retail stores already party to an existing supply agreement.

      Alternate Fuel Sales Rate Provision.

              If we cannot agree with SHC on fuel supply terms for the expected future distribution volumes set forth in the annual construction plan, or if we opt not to participate in an acquisition, the omnibus agreement will require us to distribute motor fuel to SHC's newly built, acquired or added retail stores or consignment locations at a price equal to our motor fuel cost plus the alternate fuel sales rate. The alternate fuel sales rate is a per gallon fee we will receive equal to our prior year per-gallon motor fuel distribution costs, excluding the cost of the motor fuel, plus 30% of such costs. Our motor fuel distribution costs include direct distribution expenses as well as general and administrative expenses, maintenance capital expenditures, franchise taxes and other miscellaneous costs. The alternate fuel sales rate in effect at the time we commence deliveries to a location will remain in effect for the balance of the ten-year term under the SHC Distribution Contract. However, under the omnibus agreement, the alternate fuel sales rate applicable to new delivery locations will reset annually, but the fixed fee included in the rate for a given year will be based on our motor fuel distribution costs for the immediately preceding year. Please read "Risk Factors—Risks Inherent in Our Business—If we cannot otherwise agree with SHC on fuel supply terms for volumes we sell to SHC in the future (other than for stores purchased by us pursuant to our sale and leaseback option), then we will be required to supply volumes at a price equal to our motor fuel cost plus the alternate fuel sales rate, which will be substantially less than the fixed profit margin of three cents per gallon we will receive for motor fuel sold pursuant to the SHC Distribution Contract. Furthermore, if certain of our operating costs significantly increase, we may not realize our anticipated profit margin with regard to motor fuel distributed to SHC at the alternate fuel sales rate."

117


Table of Contents

      Reimbursement for Services.

              Pursuant to the omnibus agreement, we will reimburse our general partner and its affiliates for the costs incurred in managing and operating us, including costs incurred in rendering corporate staff and support services. Our general partner will not receive a management fee or other compensation for its management of our partnership, but our partnership agreement and the omnibus agreement will require us to reimburse our general partner and its affiliates, including SHC, for all direct and indirect expenses they incur and payments they make on our behalf in connection with operating our business. Neither our partnership agreement nor the omnibus agreement will limit the amount of expenses for which our general partner and its affiliates may be reimbursed.


Our Business Strategies

              Our primary business objectives are to maintain stable cash flows and to increase our quarterly cash distribution per unit over time. We intend to accomplish these objectives by executing the following strategies:

Grow Through Our Relationship with SHC

              We plan to leverage our relationship with SHC in order to generate stable cash flows and provide us with both organic growth and acquisition opportunities through the following avenues of growth:

    Increasing motor fuel volumes through SHC's growth in the number of Stripes® convenience stores and consignment locations and in volumes at existing Stripes® convenience stores and consignment locations.   Pursuant to the SHC Distribution Contract, we will be the sole distributor of motor fuel purchased by existing Stripes® convenience stores and consignment locations. We believe that the SHC Distribution Contract will provide us with substantial opportunities for future volume growth, because per-store motor fuel volumes at SHC's existing Stripes® convenience stores grew at a compound annual growth rate of 4.0% from January 1, 2006 through June 30, 2012. In addition, pursuant to the terms of our omnibus agreement, SHC is required to negotiate with us regarding the terms of fuel distribution to any new stores and consignment locations on an annual basis or otherwise purchase its motor fuel volumes from us at our motor fuel cost plus the alternate fuel sales rate. SHC will also be required to enter into a ten-year, exclusive fuel distribution agreement with us for any stores that are sold to us and leased back to SHC. SHC expects to open an additional 26 to 29 newly constructed stores during 2012 and 28 to 35 newly constructed stores during 2013.

    Executing sale and leaseback arrangements with SHC which will provide additional rental income and additional wholesale fuel income.   Pursuant to the omnibus agreement, we will have the option to purchase up to 75 Stripes® convenience stores at various times during the three years following the completion of this offering under sale and leaseback arrangements. In addition, SHC may offer us the opportunity to enter into similar sale and leaseback arrangements for other SHC convenience stores in the future. The omnibus agreement provides that any stores that we purchase and lease back to SHC pursuant to this option will be added to the SHC Distribution Contract at cost plus a fixed profit margin of three cents per gallon for a term of ten years from the date of purchase. We believe that the sale and leaseback arrangements with SHC simultaneously promote both SHC's and our organic growth strategies, because they will allow SHC to reinvest the proceeds of the sale of convenience stores in additional new store construction while providing us with additional rental income and potentially incremental wholesale fuel income.

    Pursuing strategic acquisition opportunities with SHC.   We believe that there is considerable opportunity for consolidation in our industry as major integrated oil companies continue to divest sites they own or lease, and independent dealers have experienced pressure from

118


Table of Contents

      increased competition from non-traditional fuel suppliers, such as Walmart. We intend to capitalize on the relationship between our wholesale business and SHC's complementary retail business by jointly pursuing mixed asset acquisition opportunities with SHC which may not be attractive to a pure wholesaler or pure retailer. Pursuant to the omnibus agreement, for a period of ten years, we will have a right to negotiate with SHC to acquire any third-party distribution contracts and to distribute fuel to any retail stores or consignment locations included in a potential acquisition under consideration by SHC, other than any retail stores already party to an existing supply agreement. We therefore expect to have the opportunity to participate with SHC in acquiring convenience store operations and related wholesale distribution businesses through (i) directly purchasing any dealer distribution contracts or other wholesale distribution contracts and assets owned by the acquisition target, (ii) selling additional fuel volumes to convenience stores that SHC acquires or to SHC for any acquired consignment locations, and (iii) entering into additional sale and leaseback arrangements with respect to acquired stores. We believe these opportunities will provide for growth in both our fuel volumes and rental income.

Expand Our Third-Party Wholesale Motor Fuel Distribution Business

              We plan to continue to grow our wholesale motor fuel distribution business by (i) expanding our dealer distribution network within our existing areas of operations and in new geographic areas, including by (a) completing acquisitions of distribution contracts from other distributors and (b) executing contracts with existing and new dealers and (ii) adding new commercial customers to our distribution network. As of June 30, 2012, we distributed motor fuel to 484 locations operated by third parties under long-term contracts. Since January 1, 2007, we have increased our contracted dealer locations by approximately 45% through acquisitions and organic growth. Most recently, in 2011, we acquired the assets of Community Fuels of Texas, LP, which included wholesale fuel distribution contracts with 121 dealer locations and fuel distribution rights for 26 commercial accounts.

Focus on Stable, Fee-Based Business Activities

              We intend to continue to focus on maintaining stable, fee-based cash flows generated primarily under long-term contracts with our customers. Following the closing of this offering, we expect that a substantial majority of our gross profit from the sale of motor fuel will be fee-based, and approximately 90% of our motor fuel sales will be under long-term wholesale distribution agreements with SHC, our primary customer, as well as dealers. We also receive rental income from 55 properties that we currently lease or sublease to third parties, typically for an initial term of ten years, and we will have the option to purchase up to 75 new or recently constructed Stripes® convenience stores and lease them back to SHC for a term of 15 years, with renewal options for up to 25 additional years. We evaluate potential independent site operators based on their creditworthiness and the quality of their site and operations, including the site's size and location, monthly volumes of motor fuel sold, monthly merchandise sales, overall financial performance and previous operating experience. We intend to continue to pursue long-term distribution contracts and sale and leaseback arrangements that generate stable cash flows.

Continue to Develop and Capitalize on Our Supplier Relationships

              We intend to continue to leverage our volume growth and relationships with fuel suppliers to provide attractive motor fuel pricing to our customers, acquire additional wholesale distribution contracts and enhance our cash flows. We distribute a wide variety of major fuel brands, including Chevron, CITGO, Conoco, Exxon, Mobil, Phillips 66, Shamrock, Shell, Texaco and Valero. We believe that we are the largest independent motor fuel distributor by gallons in Texas, and among the largest distributors of Valero and Chevron branded motor fuel in the United States. Our suppliers continue to raise the minimum volume requirements and credit and other standards for wholesalers, which we believe benefits us, given SHC's longstanding relationships with such suppliers, the volume of motor fuel we purchase, the size of our distribution channel, our credit, and our growth strategy. As our

119


Table of Contents

wholesale distribution business grows, we expect to benefit from more favorable procurement costs and other economies of scale. We also believe that the continued escalation of the requirements imposed on wholesalers by suppliers will provide further opportunities for consolidation in the wholesale motor fuel distribution industry.

Maintain Financial Flexibility and Conservative Leverage

              We plan to pursue a disciplined financial policy and maintain a conservative capital structure, which we believe will allow us to take advantage of attractive growth projects and acquisition opportunities, even in challenging industry or capital markets environments. At the completion of this offering, we anticipate entering into a new revolving credit facility. We believe that our borrowing capacity under that revolving credit facility and our cash flow from operations will be sufficient to fund identified growth opportunities and working capital needs.


Our Competitive Strengths

              We believe we are well positioned to achieve our primary business objectives and execute our business strategies based on the following competitive strengths:

Our Relationship with SHC

              SHC is the largest independent convenience store operator in Texas based on store count and retail motor fuel volumes sold. In addition, SHC has generated positive same-store merchandise sales growth for 23 consecutive years as well as in 23 of the last 24 quarters. SHC's larger sized stores and strong foodservice presence (which includes its proprietary Laredo Taco Company ® in-house restaurant concept in the majority of its stores) draws strong traffic to the stores and benefits our fuel volumes.

              We believe that SHC's ownership of our general partner, all of our incentive distribution rights and a majority of our limited partnership units will serve to align SHC's interests with ours and promote and support the successful execution of our business strategies. SHC is also our largest customer and will commit to purchase all of its fuel requirements for its existing Stripes® convenience stores and independently operated consignment locations from us for the ten-year term of the SHC Distribution Contract. Since 1988, SHC has successfully executed and integrated 13 significant acquisitions, and grown from five convenience stores to 545 convenience stores currently operated under the Stripes® brand, including through the construction of over 115 large format convenience stores from January 2000 through December 31, 2011. SHC currently intends to open an additional 26 to 29 newly constructed stores in 2012, and 28 to 35 newly constructed stores during 2013. We believe our exclusive distribution rights under the SHC Distribution Contract, our option with respect to the sale and leaseback of new or recently constructed Stripes® convenience stores and our rights to the distribution of fuel to newly constructed or acquired convenience stores will provide a ready pipeline for additional growth in fuel gallons and rental income.

              Moreover, we believe that the relationship between our wholesale business and SHC's complementary retail business fosters a mutually beneficial commercial relationship that allows us and SHC to benefit from our combined economies of scale and purchasing power. We believe this relationship also provides us with a competitive advantage in that we and SHC can jointly pursue mixed asset acquisition opportunities which may not be attractive to a pure wholesaler or pure retailer.

Our Leading Position in Highly Attractive Markets in Texas

              We believe that we are the largest independent motor fuel distributor in Texas, selling over 1.3 billion gallons annually, which was more than double the gallons sold by our next largest competitor in Texas over the same period according to 2011 fuel tax reports filed with the Texas Comptroller of Public Accounts. As a result, we are well positioned to capitalize on numerous attractive growth trends in our primary markets. In 2011, Texas ranked first in the United States for job growth according to the U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics and first in the United States for population growth for the ten-year period ended 2010 as reflected in the 2010 census report. Furthermore, according to a report issued by

120


Table of Contents

the Texas Comptroller of Public Accounts, the population in our South Texas markets, in which the majority of our distribution customers are located, is growing faster than the population of the state as a whole. We also believe the significant expansion of oil and gas development in the Eagle Ford Shale and Permian Basin has resulted in increased motor fuel usage in South and West Texas.

              The Texas Comptroller of Public Accounts has reported that gasoline gallons taxed in Texas have grown significantly during the last several decades. From 1989 to 2011, gasoline consumption grew approximately 41.2% from 8.5 billion gallons to 11.9 billion gallons, or at an approximate 1.6%, compound annual growth rate. Gasoline consumption grew in 17 of the 22 years during the period. As of 2011, Texas motor gasoline consumption totaled approximately 8.9% of U.S. consumption. Similarly, diesel gallons taxed in Texas have grown significantly during the last several decades. From 1989 to 2011, diesel consumption grew approximately 144.1%, from 1.6 billion gallons to 3.8 billion gallons, or at an approximate 4.1% compound annual growth rate. Diesel consumption grew in 18 of the 22 years during the period.

Stable Cash Flows from Long-term, Fee-based Contracts and Real Estate Rental Income and Relatively Low Maintenance Capital Requirements and Working Capital Requirements

              During the twelve months ended June 30, 2012 and after giving pro forma effect to the SHC Distribution Contract, approximately 90% of our motor fuel sales by volume would have been made pursuant to fee-based, long-term distribution agreements. Pursuant to the SHC Distribution Contract, which will have an initial term of ten years, we will be the exclusive distributor of motor fuel purchased by SHC's existing Stripes ® convenience stores and independently operated consignment locations at cost plus a fixed profit margin. Our existing third-party dealer distribution contracts generally have an initial term of ten years, and currently have an average remaining term of approximately five years. These contracts typically provide that we will distribute motor fuel at the posted purchase price at the fuel supply terminal, plus transportation costs, taxes and a fixed, volume-based fee, which is usually expressed in cents per gallon. In addition, if we consummate any sale and leaseback transactions with SHC with regard to newly constructed Stripes ® convenience stores, we will be the exclusive distributor of motor fuel to such stores at cost plus a fixed profit margin.

              We believe that we have limited exposure to fluctuating commodity prices because we generally pass the cost of the fuel that we distribute through to our customers. In 2011, over 95% of our motor fuel gallons were purchased only after receiving a customer order and we held title to the fuel only for the period of time required for delivery, which is typically less than a day. We frequently use commodity derivative instruments to mitigate the price risk for the limited amounts of fuel for which we take title for a more extended period of time, typically not in excess of 60 days. Any transportation costs that we incur are passed through to our customers. We will also receive rental income from convenience store properties that we lease or sublease to third parties, as well as stores that we acquire from SHC pursuant to our option to purchase up to 75 stores. We believe that the combination of our fee-based motor fuel distribution business, the long-term nature of our distribution contracts, our limited commodity price risk, the growing demand for motor fuel in the areas in which we operate and the additional consistent cash flows provided by our rental income will provide us with a stable base of cash flows and a strong platform from which to grow our business. In addition, we believe we have relatively low maintenance capital requirements and working capital requirements.

Our Strong, Long-term Relationships with Suppliers and Competitive Pricing Through Large Volume Purchases

              We believe that our strong, long-standing relationships with major fuel suppliers and large volumes of motor fuel purchased provide us with significant advantages over our smaller competitors in negotiating supply terms with our suppliers. We believe we are among the largest distributors of Valero and Chevron branded motor fuel in the United States, and we have been a distributor for Valero since 2004 and Chevron since 1996.

121


Table of Contents

Our Strong Relationships with Our Diversified Third-Party Customer Base

              We have a diversified base of over 480 dealer locations, and no single third-party dealer is material to our business. We have established strong customer relationships with our third-party dealers by focusing on customer service, including consistent, prompt delivery. Our proprietary web-based system allows our dealers to access their accounts at any time from a personal computer to conveniently and efficiently obtain prices, place orders and review invoices. This platform is scalable and is designed to accommodate new fuel distribution customers.

              We distribute a wide selection of branded fuels, including Chevron, CITGO, Conoco, Exxon, Mobil, Phillips 66, Shamrock, Shell, Texaco and Valero branded motor fuel, as well as unbranded motor fuel. We believe the variety and large volumes of branded and unbranded motor fuel that we distribute is a key competitive advantage relative to other, smaller wholesale distributors in our markets. In addition, the size of our wholesale distribution network and our strong long-standing relationships with our suppliers allows us to offer our customers competitive prices for motor fuel. We also provide opportunities to our dealers to access products and services that they would not likely be able to obtain either on their own or at our discounted rates.

              We believe that our strong customer relationships and focus on customer service, our differentiated product offering and our competitive pricing make us an attractive partner for new or existing retailers who are looking for a wholesale distributor.

Our Experienced Management Team and Proven Track Record

              Our management team has a proven ability to develop and maintain customer relationships, integrate acquisitions and grow operations while maintaining financial discipline. The Susser family entered the motor fuel retailing and distribution business in the 1930's. Our current executive management team, which is led by Sam L. Susser, our President and Chief Executive Officer, has average industry experience of 19 years. Since its IPO in 2006 through June 30, 2012, SHC's Adjusted EBITDA more than tripled, fuel volumes sold increased by 66% and total retail stores increased by 68%. SHC has completed 13 significant acquisitions in the last 23 years, including three acquisitions in the past three years which have added 174 dealer contracts to our wholesale distribution network.


Our Business and Properties

              We are a wholesale distributor of motor fuels and other petroleum products, and we lease or sublease real estate used primarily in the retail distribution of motor fuels. We do not operate or intend to operate any retail convenience stores.

Wholesale Motor Fuel Distribution

              We purchase motor fuel from refiners and distribute it throughout Texas and in Louisiana, New Mexico and Oklahoma to (i)  Stripes® convenience stores, (ii) SHC's independently operated consignment locations; (iii) convenience stores and retail fuel outlets operated by third parties and (iv) other commercial customers. The following table highlights our total motor fuel gallons sold during each of the last five fiscal years and for the twelve months ended June 30, 2012, by principal customer group (gallons in thousands):

 
  Year Ended December 31,   Twelve
Months Ended
June 30,
2012
 
Customer Group
  2007   2008   2009   2010   2011  

Stripes ® stores

    426,779     609,821     707,106     739,104     789,578     830,165  

Consignment locations

    100,066     94,882     100,609     106,073     108,944     113,014  

Third-party dealers and other commercial customers

    369,960     391,634     394,212     388,136     413,888     455,890  
                           

Total

    896,805     1,096,337     1,201,927     1,233,313     1,312,410     1,399,069  
                           

122


Table of Contents

              The following table highlights the number of locations as of the end of the year and as of June 30, 2012, by principal customer group:

 
  As of Year Ended December 31,    
 
 
  As of June 30,
2012
 
Customer Group
  2007   2008   2009   2010   2011  

Stripes ® stores(1)

    504     512     526     526     541     545  

Consignment locations

    76     78     84     85     84     83  

Third-party dealer locations

    311     294     306     346     481     484  
                           

Total(1)

    891     884     916     957     1,106     1,112  
                           

(1)
As of the years ended December 31, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010 and 2011, and as of June 30, 2012, eight, eight, nine, four, four and four Stripes ® convenience stores, respectively, did not sell motor fuel.

      Sales to Stripes® Convenience Stores

              Pursuant to the SHC Distribution Contract that will be contributed to us in connection with the completion of this offering, which will have an initial term of ten years, we will be the exclusive distributor of motor fuel purchased by SHC's existing Stripes® convenience store locations for a fixed profit margin of three cents per gallon. As of June 30, 2012, SHC operated 545 Stripes® convenience stores, 498 of which were in Texas, 29 of which were in New Mexico, and 18 of which were in Oklahoma. Of these stores, 541 sell motor fuel. One of these Stripes® convenience stores is subject to a consignment contract with a third party which pays SHC a commission to sell motor fuel at that location and, as a result, we will not sell any motor fuel to that location.

              Approximately 85% of the Stripes® convenience stores are open 24 hours a day, 365 days a year. SHC has built over 115 Stripes® convenience stores since January 1, 2000 through December 31, 2011, which average approximately 5,000 square feet and are built on large lots with much larger motor fueling and parking facilities as compared to older stores and many of our competitors' stores. According to a report of 2010 industry data issued by the National Association of Convenience Stores, the average size of new stores in the U.S. was 3,590 square feet in urban areas, and 3,788 square feet in rural areas.

              The following table provides a history of SHC's retail openings, conversions, acquisitions and closings for each of the last five years and during the six months ended June 30, 2012:

 
  Year Ended December 31,   Six Months
Ended
June 30,
2012
 
 
  2007   2008   2009   2010   2011  

Number of stores at beginning of period

    325     504     512     526     526     541  

New stores constructed

    17     8     7     12     17     7  

Acquired stores(1)

    169     4     8     2     2      

Closed, relocated or divested stores(2)

    (7 )   (4 )   (1 )   (14 )   (4 )   (3 )
                           

Number of stores at end of period

    504     512     526     526     541     545  
                           

(1)
Acquired 168 stores from TCFS Holdings, Inc. in November 2007.

(2)
Included in closures for 2010 are the divestiture of seven grocery stores that were acquired from TCFS Holdings, Inc. in 2007, and the conversion of three stores to wholesale dealer-operated that had been acquired from Jack in the Box, Inc. in 2009.

123


Table of Contents

      Sales to SHC's Consignment Locations

              Pursuant to the SHC Distribution Contract that will be contributed to us in connection with this offering, which will have an initial term of ten years, we will be the exclusive distributor of motor fuel to SHC's existing independently operated consignment locations for a fixed profit margin of three cents per gallon. As of June 30, 2012, SHC had consignment arrangements with independent operators at 83 locations. At these consignment locations, SHC provides and controls motor fuel inventory and price at the site and receives the actual retail selling price for each gallon sold, less a commission paid to the retail operator of the location. The following table provides a history of SHC's contracted consignment location openings, conversions, acquisitions and closings for each of the last five years and during the six months ended June 30, 2012:

 
  Year Ended December 31,   Six Months
Ended
June 30,
2012
 
 
  2007   2008   2009   2010   2011  

Number of independently operated consignment locations at beginning of period

    77     76     78     84     85     84  

New locations

    0     4     6              

Discontinued locations

    (3 )   (2 )       (2 )   (1 )   (3 )

Transfers from supply

    3             4     5     2  

Transfers to supply

    (1 )           (1 )   (5 )    
                           

Number of independently operated consignment locations at end of period

    76     78     84     85     84     83  
                           

      Sales to Third Parties

              As of June 30, 2012, we distributed fuel under long-term contracts to over 480 convenience stores and retail fuel outlets operated by third parties. No single third-party dealer is material to our business. Under our distribution contracts with third parties, we agree to distribute a particular branded or unbranded motor fuel to a location or group of locations and arrange for all transportation. We typically receive a fee per gallon equal to the posted purchase price at the fuel supply terminal, plus transportation costs, taxes and a fixed, volume-based fee, which is usually expressed in cents per gallon. The initial term of most dealer distribution contracts is ten years, and as of June 30, 2012, our dealer distribution contracts had an average remaining life of five years. These dealer distribution agreements require, among other things, that dealers maintain the standards established by the applicable brand. At our option, we may provide credit to dealers for seven to ten days. In October 2011, we completed the acquisition of 121 dealer distribution agreements which had an average remaining life of five years as of June 30, 2012.

              The following table provides a history of our dealer location openings, conversions, acquisitions and closings for each of the last five years and the six months ended June 30, 2012:

 
  Year Ended December 31,   Six Months
Ended
June 30,
2012
 
 
  2007   2008   2009   2010   2011  

Number of dealer locations at beginning of period

    290     311     294     306     346     481  

New locations(1)

    30     23     28     59     142     14  

Discontinued locations

    (7 )   (40 )   (16 )   (16 )   (7 )   (9 )

Transfers to consignment

    (3 )           (4 )   (5 )   (2 )

Transfers from consignment

    1             1     5      
                           

Number of dealer locations at end of period

    311     294     306     346     481     484  
                           

(1)
In 2011, includes the acquisition of 121 dealer distribution contracts from Community Fuels of Texas, LP.

124


Table of Contents

              We continually seek to expand our dealer distribution network through acquisitions of contracts for existing independently operated sites from other distributors and through incremental additions of existing and new dealers. We evaluate potential independent site operators based on their creditworthiness and the quality of their site and operations, including the site's size and location, projected monthly volumes of motor fuel, monthly merchandise sales, overall financial performance and previous operating experience. We may extend credit to certain dealers based on our credit evaluation process.

      Dealer Incentives

              In addition to motor fuel distribution, we offer dealers the opportunity to participate in merchandise purchasing and promotional programs arranged with vendors. We believe the vendor relationships we have established through SHC's retail operations and our ability to develop programs provide us with an advantage over other distributors when recruiting new dealers into our network, as well as retaining current dealers. Our dealer incentives allow our dealers to access products and services, such as ATM machines and automated movie rental kiosks, that they would not likely be able to obtain either on their own or at our discounted rates. Also, as an incentive to dealers, we may provide store equipment or motor fuel distribution equipment for use at designated sites. Generally, this equipment is provided to the dealer on the condition that the dealer continues to comply with the terms of its distribution agreement with us.

      Sales to Other Commercial Customers

              We also distribute unbranded fuel to numerous other customers, including convenience stores, unattended fueling facilities and certain other commercial customers. These distribution arrangements totaled approximately 147.8 million gallons during the twelve months ended June 30, 2012. These customers are primarily commercial, governmental and other parties who buy motor fuel by the load or in bulk and who do not generally enter exclusive contractual relationships with us, if they enter into a contractual relationship with us at all. Sales to these customers are typically made at a quoted price based upon our cost plus taxes, cost of transportation and a margin determined by us at time of sale and may provide for immediate payment or the extension of credit for up to 30 days.

      Sales of Propane, Lube Oil and Other Petroleum Products

              In connection with an acquisition completed in 2007, we acquired two bulk plant facilities, which, in addition to the distribution of motor fuel, were used to distribute propane, lube oil and other petroleum products. Since the acquisition, we have sold, and will continue to sell, these products to third-party commercial customers on both a spot and contracted basis.

      Fuel Supplier Arrangements

              We distribute branded motor fuel under the Chevron, CITGO, Conoco, Exxon, Mobil, Phillips 66, Shamrock, Shell, Texaco and Valero brands. We purchase this branded motor fuel from major oil companies and refiners under supply agreements. We also distribute unbranded motor fuel, which we purchase either on a rack basis based upon prices posted by the refiner at a fuel supply terminal, or on a contract basis with the price tied to one or more market indices.

              For fiscal 2011, Valero supplied approximately 40% and Chevron supplied approximately 20% of our consolidated motor fuel purchases. Our supply agreement with Valero expires in July 2018. We have been distributors for Chevron since 1996 and our current contract with Chevron expires in August 2014. We purchase the motor fuel at the supplier's applicable price at the terminal, which typically changes daily. Our supply agreements with other suppliers generally have an initial term of three years. In addition, each supply agreement typically contains provisions relating to payment terms, use of the supplier's brand names, credit card processing, compliance with supplier's requirements, insurance

125


Table of Contents

coverage and compliance with legal and environmental requirements, among others. As is typical in the industry, our suppliers generally can terminate the supply contract if we do not comply with any material condition of the contract, including our failure to make payments when due, fraud, criminal misconduct, bankruptcy or insolvency. Generally, our supply agreements have provisions that obligate the supplier to sell up to an agreed upon number of gallons, subject to certain limitations. Any amount in excess of that agreed upon amount is subject to availability. Due to the large volumes of motor fuel we purchase, we may receive volume rebates or incentive payments to drive volumes and provide an incentive for branding new locations. Certain suppliers require that all or a portion of any such branding incentive payments be repaid to the supplier in the event that the sites are closed or rebranded within a stated number of years. In some cases, our supply agreements provide that motor fuel suppliers have a right of first refusal to acquire assets used by us to sell their branded motor fuel.

              We have historically received early payment and volume-related discounts from our suppliers, although there is no guarantee that we will continue to receive these discounts in the future. Please read "Risk Factors—Risks Inherent in Our Business—Certain of our contracts with suppliers currently have early payment and volume-related discounts which reduce the price we pay for motor fuel that we purchase from them. If we are unable to renew these contracts on similar terms, our gross profit will correspondingly decrease."

      Bulk Fuel Purchases

              We may periodically purchase motor fuel in bulk and hold it in inventory or transport it via pipeline, in which case we mitigate the inventory risk through the use of commodity futures contracts or other derivative instruments which are matched in quantity and timing to the anticipated usage of the inventory. These fuel hedging positions have not been material to our operations. In certain instances, we blend in various additives including ethanol and bio-mass based diesel. During 2011, bulk fuel purchases were immaterial to our total fuel purchases, representing only 2.4% of our total gallons purchased for the year ended December 31, 2011.

      Transportation Logistics

              Pursuant to the SHC Transportation Agreement that will be contributed to us upon completion of this offering, SHC will provide all transportation logistics for our motor fuel deliveries. Through third-party transportation providers or its own fleet of fuel transportation vehicles, SHC will arrange for motor fuel to be delivered from the storage terminals to the appropriate sites in our distribution network at prices consistent with those historically charged to third parties for the delivery of fuel. Under this arrangement and pursuant to our contracts with third-party customers and SHC, we will pass through all transportation costs and consequently will not incur any profit or loss relating to transportation.

      Technology

              Technology is an important part of our wholesale operations. We utilize a proprietary web-based system that allows our wholesale customers to access their accounts at any time from a personal computer to obtain prices, place orders and review invoices, credit card transactions and electronic funds transfer notifications. Substantially all of our dealer payments are processed by electronic funds transfer. We use an internet-based system to assist with fuel inventory management and procurement and an integrated wholesale fuel system for financial accounting, procurement, billing and inventory management.

Real Estate and Lease Arrangements

              Following the completion of this offering, we will own 41 retail fuel locations and lease 12 additional retail fuel locations, most of which are in Texas, and all of which we rent or sublease to third

126


Table of Contents

parties. We collect rent from the lessees pursuant to lease agreements with them. Our leases typically have a term of five to ten years and as of June 30, 2012, the average remaining lease term for our current lease agreements was approximately seven years.

      Growth Opportunities in Rental Income from SHC

              Pursuant to the omnibus agreement, we will have the option to enter into sale and leaseback transactions with SHC for up to 75 Stripes® convenience stores. We intend to pursue additional sale and leaseback transactions with SHC in the future, which we believe will help promote SHC's organic growth strategy while providing us with additional cash flows from rent and the wholesale distribution of fuel.

              SHC's organic growth plans call for the opening of 26 to 29 newly constructed stores in 2012 and an additional 28 to 35 newly constructed stores in 2013. SHC currently owns sufficient properties for all of the stores to be completed in 2012 and a portion of the stores scheduled to be built in 2013, and is continuously evaluating new properties within or contiguous to its existing Stripes® market areas. In evaluating potential properties, SHC considers a number of factors, including strategic fit, desirability of location, cost efficiency of serving the site with our wholesale business and price. SHC considers acquiring ownership of sites that are not within or contiguous to our current markets if the opportunity meets certain criteria, such as the availability of other sites in the area, motor traffic, potential sales volumes and cash flow potential, among others.


Competition

              We compete with major oil companies that distribute their own products, as well as other independent motor fuel distributors. The market for distribution of wholesale motor fuel is highly competitive and fragmented, which results in narrow margins. We have numerous competitors, some of which may have significantly greater resources and name recognition than we do. We rely on our ability to provide value-added and reliable service and to control our operating costs in order to maintain our margins and competitive position.

              We may encounter more significant competition if major integrated oil companies shift from their current trend of divesting retail sites, and the corresponding wholesale distribution to such sites, to distributing their own products in direct competition with us. Furthermore, we may encounter competition if our larger wholesale customers choose to purchase their motor fuel supplies directly from the major oil companies. Significant competitive factors include the availability of major brands, customer service, price, range of services offered and quality of service, among others. If we were to fail to maintain the quality of our services, our customers may choose alternative distribution sources and our margins could decrease.

              SHC has in the past executed sale and leaseback transactions with real estate investment trusts, or REITs. After the expiration of our option to purchase and leaseback up to 75 recently constructed Stripes® convenience stores from SHC, SHC will have no obligation to execute additional sale and leaseback transactions. In the future, we may compete with REITs for sale and leaseback opportunities.


Seasonality

              Our business exhibits some seasonality due to our customers' increased demand for motor fuel during the late spring and summer months as compared to the fall and winter months. Travel, recreation and construction activities typically increase in these months in the geographic areas in which we operate, increasing the demand for motor fuel. Therefore, the volume of motor fuel that we distribute is typically somewhat higher in the second and third quarters of our fiscal year. As a result, our results from operations may vary from period to period.

127


Table of Contents


Insurance

              Our operations and assets are insured under an insurance program administered by SHC. SHC uses a combination of self-insurance and third-party insurance with predetermined deductibles that cover certain insurable risks. SHC's liability represents an estimate of the ultimate cost of claims incurred as of the balance sheet dates. The estimated undiscounted liability is established based upon analysis of historical data and include judgments and actuarial assumptions regarding economic conditions, the frequency and severity of claims, claim development patterns and claim management and settlement practices. Although we have not experienced significant changes in actual expenditures compared to actuarial assumptions as a result of increased costs or incidence rates, such changes could occur in the future and could significantly impact our results of operations and financial position. We will reimburse SHC under the omnibus agreement for insurance costs.

              Management believes that the amount of coverage provided is reasonable and appropriate. We have obtained directors' and officers' liability insurance for the directors and officers of our general partner.


Environmental Matters

Environmental Laws and Regulations

              We are subject to various federal, state and local environmental laws and regulations, including those relating to underground storage tanks; the release or discharge of hazardous materials into the air, water and soil; the generation, storage, handling, use, transportation and disposal of regulated materials; the exposure of persons to regulated materials; remediation of contaminated soil and groundwater; and the health and safety of our employees.

              Environmental laws and regulations can restrict or impact our business activities in many ways, such as:

    requiring remedial action to mitigate releases of hydrocarbons, hazardous substances or wastes caused by our operations or attributable to former operators;

    requiring capital expenditures to comply with environmental control requirements; and

    enjoining the operations of facilities deemed to be in noncompliance with environmental laws and regulations.

              Failure to comply with environmental laws and regulations may trigger a variety of administrative, civil and criminal enforcement measures, including the assessment of monetary penalties, the imposition of remedial requirements and the issuance of orders enjoining or otherwise curtailing future operations. Certain environmental statutes impose strict, joint and several liability for costs required to clean up and restore sites where hydrocarbons, hazardous substances or wastes have been released or disposed of. Moreover, neighboring landowners and other third parties may file claims for personal injury and property damage allegedly caused by the release of hydrocarbons, hazardous substances or other wastes into the environment.

              The trend in environmental regulation is to place more restrictions and limitations on activities that may affect the environment. As a result, there can be no assurance as to the amount or timing of future expenditures for environmental compliance or remediation, and actual future expenditures may be different from the amounts we currently anticipate. We try to anticipate future regulatory requirements that might be imposed and plan accordingly to remain in compliance with changing environmental laws and regulations and minimize the costs of such compliance.

              We believe we are in compliance in all material respects with applicable environmental laws and regulations, and we do not believe that compliance with federal, state or local environmental laws and regulations will have a material adverse effect on our financial position, results of operations or

128


Table of Contents

cash available for distribution to our unitholders. We can provide no assurance, however, that future events, such as changes in existing laws (including changes in the interpretation of existing laws), the promulgation of new laws, or the development or discovery of new facts or conditions will not cause us to incur significant costs.

Hazardous Substances and Releases

              Certain environmental laws, including the Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation and Liability Act of 1980 ("CERCLA"), impose strict, and under certain circumstances, joint and several, liability on the owner and operator as well as former owners and operators of properties for the costs of investigation, removal or remediation of contamination and also impose liability for any related damages to natural resources without regard to fault. In addition, under CERCLA and similar state laws, as persons who arrange for the transportation, treatment or disposal of hazardous substances, we also may be subject to similar liability at sites where such hazardous substances come to be located. We may also be subject to third-party claims alleging property damage and/or personal injury in connection with releases of or exposure to hazardous substances at, from or in the vicinity of our current properties or off-site waste disposal sites.

              We are required to comply with federal and state financial responsibility requirements to demonstrate that we have the ability to pay for remediation or to compensate third parties for damages incurred as a result of a release of regulated materials from our underground storage tank systems. We meet these requirements by maintaining insurance which we purchase from private insurers and in certain circumstances, rely on applicable state trust funds, which are funded by underground storage tank registration fees and taxes on wholesale purchase of motor fuels.

Environmental Reserves

              As of December 31, 2011, our predecessor had environmental reserves of $100,000 for estimated costs associated with remediating a release from an underground storage tank at a single facility. SHC is in the process of remediating this site and will indemnify us for any associated costs under the environmental indemnification provisions of our omnibus agreement. Accordingly, on a pro forma basis, our financial statements reflect no environmental reserves for this matter.

Underground Storage Tanks

              We are required to make financial expenditures to comply with regulations governing underground storage tanks adopted by federal, state and local regulatory agencies. Pursuant to the RCRA, the Environmental Protection Agency, or EPA, has established a comprehensive regulatory program for the detection, prevention, investigation and cleanup of leaking underground storage tanks. State or local agencies are often delegated the responsibility for implementing the federal program or developing and implementing equivalent state or local regulations. We have a comprehensive program in place for performing routine tank testing and other compliance activities which are intended to promptly detect and investigate any potential releases. Our predecessor spent approximately $0.3 million on these compliance activities associated with 84 sites with underground storage tanks for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2011. At the completion of this offering, we will own 15 of such sites. We believe we are in compliance in all material respects with requirements applicable to our underground storage tanks.

Air Emissions

              The Federal Clean Air Act (the "CAA") and similar state laws impose requirements on emissions to the air from motor fueling activities in certain areas of the country, including those that do not meet state or national ambient air quality standards. These laws may require the installation of vapor recovery systems to control emissions of volatile organic compounds to the air during the motor

129


Table of Contents

fueling process. Under the CAA and comparable state and local laws, permits are typically required to emit regulated air pollutants into the atmosphere. We believe that we currently hold or have applied for all necessary air permits and that we are in substantial compliance with applicable air laws and regulations. Although we can give no assurances, we are aware of no changes to air quality regulations that will have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, results of operations or cash available for distribution to our unitholders.

              Various federal, state and local agencies have the authority to prescribe product quality specifications for the motor fuels that we sell, largely in an effort to reduce air pollution. Failure to comply with these regulations can result in substantial penalties. Although we can give no assurances, we believe we are currently in substantial compliance with these regulations.

              Efforts at the federal and state level are currently underway to reduce the levels of greenhouse gas ("GHG") emissions from various sources in the United States. At the federal level, Congress has considered legislation to reduce GHG emissions in the United States but no such legislation has been passed. Such federal legislation may impose a carbon emissions tax or establish a cap-and-trade program or regulation by the EPA. Even in the absence of new federal legislation, GHG emissions have begun to be regulated by the EPA pursuant to the CAA. For example, in April 2010, the EPA set a new emissions standard for motor vehicles to reduce GHG emissions. New federal or state restrictions on emissions of GHGs that may be imposed in areas of the United States in which we conduct business and that apply to our operations could adversely affect the demand for our products.


Other Government Regulation

              The Petroleum Marketing Practices Act, or PMPA, is a federal law that governs the relationship between a refiner and a distributor, as well as between a distributor and branded dealer, pursuant to which the refiner or distributor permits a distributor or dealer to use a trademark in connection with the sale or distribution of motor fuel. Under the PMPA, we may not terminate or fail to renew a branded distributor contract unless certain enumerated preconditions or grounds for termination or nonrenewal are met and we also comply with the prescribed notice requirements.


Employee Safety

              We are subject to the requirements of the Occupational Safety and Health Act, or "OSHA," and comparable state statutes that regulate the protection of the health and safety of workers. In addition, OSHA's hazard communication standards require that information be maintained about hazardous materials used or produced in operations and that this information be provided to employees, state and local government authorities and citizens. We believe that we are in substantial compliance with the applicable OSHA requirements.


Title to Properties, Permits and Licenses

              We believe we have all of the assets needed, including leases, permits and licenses, to operate our business in all material respects. With respect to any consents, permits or authorizations that have not been obtained, we believe that the failure to obtain these consents, permits or authorizations will not have a material adverse effect on our financial position, results of operations or cash available for distribution to our unitholders.

              We believe we have satisfactory title to all of our assets. Title to property may be subject to encumbrances, including repurchase rights and use, operating and environmental covenants and restrictions, including restrictions on branded motor fuels that may be sold at such sites. We believe that none of these encumbrances will detract materially from the value of our sites or from our interest in these sites, nor will they interfere materially with the use of these sites in the operation of our

130


Table of Contents

business. These encumbrances may, however, impact our ability to sell the site to an entity seeking to use the land for alternative purposes.


Our Employees

              We are managed and operated by the board of directors and executive officers of our general partner. Neither we nor our subsidiaries have any employees. Our general partner has the sole responsibility for providing the employees and other personnel necessary to conduct our operations. All of the employees that conduct our business are employed by SHC and its affiliates. Following the completion of this offering, we expect that our general partner and its affiliates will have approximately 100 employees performing services for our operations, and appropriate costs will be allocated to us. We believe that our general partner and its affiliates have a satisfactory relationship with those employees. None of these employees are subject to collective bargaining agreements.


Legal Proceedings

              Although we may, from time to time, be involved in litigation and claims arising out of our operations in the normal course of business, we do not believe that we are a party to any litigation that will have a material adverse impact on our financial condition or results of operations. Similarly, we do not believe that any legal proceedings involving our predecessor will have a material impact on our financial condition or results of operations. Our general partner is not involved in any legal proceedings.

131


Table of Contents


MANAGEMENT

Management of Susser Petroleum Partners LP

              Our general partner will manage our operations and activities on our behalf through its directors and officers, the latter of whom will be employed by SHC. References to "our officers" and "our directors" refer to the officers and directors of our general partner. Our general partner is not elected by our unitholders and will not be subject to re-election in the future. The directors of our general partner oversee our operations. Unitholders will not be entitled to elect the directors of our general partner, all of whom will be appointed by SHC, or directly or indirectly participate in our management or operations. Our general partner will, however, be accountable to us and our unitholders as a fiduciary. Fiduciary duties owed to unitholders by our general partner are prescribed by law and our partnership agreement, which contains various provisions modifying and restricting the fiduciary duties that might otherwise be owed by our general partner. Please read "Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties" for more information.

              Upon the completion of this offering, our general partner will have five directors, three of whom will be independent as defined under the independence standards established by the NYSE and the Exchange Act. The NYSE does not require a listed publicly traded partnership, such as ours, to have a majority of independent directors on the board of directors of our general partner or to establish a compensation committee or a nominating and corporate governance committee. We are, however, required to have an audit committee of at least three members, and all its members are required to meet the independence and experience standards established by the NYSE and the Exchange Act, subject to certain transitional relief during the one-year period following completion of this offering.

              All of the executive officers of our general partner also serve as executive officers of SHC. Our executive officers listed below will allocate their time between managing our business and the business of SHC. Our executive officers intend, however, to devote as much time as is necessary for the proper conduct of our business. We currently expect that the executive officers of our general partner, other than Rocky B. Dewbre, will allocate approximately 15% of their time to managing our business. We expect that Mr. Dewbre will allocate approximately 60% of his time to managing our business.

              Following the completion of this offering, neither our general partner nor SHC will receive any management fee or other compensation in connection with our general partner's management of our business, but our partnership agreement and the omnibus agreement will require us to reimburse our general partner and its affiliates, including SHC, for all expenses they incur and payments they make on our behalf in connection with operating our business. Neither our partnership agreement nor the omnibus agreement will limit the amount of expenses for which our general partner and its affiliates may be reimbursed. Our partnership agreement provides that our general partner will determine in good faith the expenses that are allocable to us. Please read "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions—Agreements with Affiliates in Connection with the Transactions" and "The Partnership Agreement—Reimbursement of Expenses."

              In evaluating director candidates, SHC will assess whether a candidate possesses the integrity, judgment, knowledge, experience, skill and expertise that are likely to enhance the board's ability to manage and direct our affairs and business, including, when applicable, to enhance the ability of committees of the board to fulfill their duties.


Executive Officers and Directors of our General Partner

              The following table shows information for the executive officers and directors of our general partner upon the consummation of this offering. Directors are appointed to hold office until their

132


Table of Contents

successors have been elected or qualified or until the earlier of their death, resignation, removal or disqualification. Executive officers serve at the discretion of the board.

Name
  Age   Position With Our General Partner

Sam L. Susser

    49   Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of the Board

E.V. Bonner, Jr. 

    56   Executive Vice President, Secretary and General Counsel

Rocky B. Dewbre

    46   President and Chief Operating Officer

Mary E. Sullivan

    55   Executive Vice President, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

Sam J. Susser

    72   Director Nominee

Armand S. Shapiro

    71   Director Nominee

David P. Engel

    61   Director Nominee

Bryan F. Smith Jr.

    59   Director Nominee

              Sam L. Susser—Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of the Board.     Mr. Sam L. Susser was appointed Chief Executive Officer and chairman of the board of directors of our general partner in June 2012. Mr. Susser has served as SHC's President and Chief Executive Officer since 1992. From 1988 to 1992, Mr. Susser served as SHC's General Manager and Vice President of Operations. From 1985 through 1987, Mr. Susser served in the corporate finance division and the mergers and acquisitions group with Salomon Brothers Inc., an investment bank. Mr. Susser currently serves as a director of a number of charitable, educational and civic organizations. Sam L. Susser is the son of Sam J. Susser, who is also a member of Susser Holdings Corporation's Board of Directors and a director nominee to our general partner's board of directors. The Susser family has been in the fuel distribution business for over 70 years. Mr. Susser provides insight into all aspects of our business. We believe that his financial industry experience along with his in-depth knowledge of our business will greatly help the board of directors of our general partner in setting strategic, financial and operating strategies.

              E.V. Bonner, Jr.—Executive Vice President, Secretary and General Counsel.     Mr. Bonner was appointed Executive Vice President, Secretary and General Counsel of our general partner in June 2012. Mr. Bonner has served as SHC's Executive Vice President and General Counsel since March 2000 and prior to joining SHC, Mr. Bonner was a stockholder in the law firm of Porter, Rogers, Dahlman & Gordon, P.C. from 1986 to 2000. He is board certified in commercial real estate law by the Texas Board of Legal Specialization. Mr. Bonner has been involved in numerous charitable, educational and civic organizations.

              Rocky B. Dewbre—President and Chief Operating Officer.     Mr. Dewbre was appointed President and Chief Operating Officer of our general partner in June 2012. Mr. Dewbre has served as SHC's Executive Vice President and President/Chief Operating Officer-Wholesale since January 2005. Mr. Dewbre served as SHC's Executive Vice President and Chief Operating Officer-Wholesale from 1999 to 2005, as Vice President from 1995 to 1999 and as Manager of Finance and Administration from 1992 to 1995. Before joining SHC in 1992, Mr. Dewbre was a corporate internal auditor with Atlantic Richfield Corporation, a petroleum/chemical company, from 1991 to 1992 and an auditor and consultant at Deloitte & Touche LLP from 1988 to 1991. Mr. Dewbre serves as a director of Tank Owner Members Insurance Company and the Society of Independent Gasoline Marketers of America.

              Mary E. Sullivan—Executive Vice President, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer.     Ms. Sullivan was appointed Executive Vice President, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer of our general partner in June 2012. Ms. Sullivan has served as SHC's Executive Vice President, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer since November 2005 and as SHC's Vice President of Finance from February 2000 to 2005. Prior to joining SHC in 2000, Ms. Sullivan served as Director of Finance for the City of Corpus Christi from 1999 to 2000. Ms. Sullivan's previous experience includes serving as the Controller and member of the board of directors of Elementis Chromium, a producer of chromium chemicals, from 1993 to 1999,

133


Table of Contents

and various positions with Central Power and Light Company, culminating in Treasurer, over the 13 year period from 1979 to 1992.

              Sam J. Susser—Director Nominee.     Mr. Sam J. Susser is expected to join our general partner's board of directors in connection with the offering and has served as a member of SHC's board of directors since 1988. He also served as chairman of SHC's board of directors from 1988 to 1992. Mr. Susser was also the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of Plexus Financial Services, a holding company based in Dallas, Texas, from 1987 through 1991. Mr. Susser's experience includes various positions with The Southland Corporation (7-Eleven, Inc.), Plexus Financial Services and CITGO Petroleum Corporation, where he served as President. Mr. Susser is a director and member of the Audit Committee and Executive Committee of Alberto-Culver Company, a manufacturer and marketer of personal care and household brands. Mr. Susser previously has served on the board of directors of Garden Ridge Pottery and Computer Craft, Inc. Sam J. Susser is the father of Sam L. Susser, our general partner's Chief Executive Officer and Chairman. Mr. Susser's father founded the family's fuel distribution business in the 1930's. In addition to his entrepreneurial spirit and extensive experience with SHC, Mr. Susser also has gained substantial executive experience in other companies and on other boards, which enhances the leadership he provides to our general partner's board, as well as his insights into corporate governance, risk management, strategic and financial planning, and operating strategy.

              David P. Engel—Director Nominee.     Mr. Engel is expected to join our general partner's board of directors in connection with the offering and has served as a member of SHC's board of directors since September 2007. Mr. Engel has been the principal of Corpus Christi-based Engel and Associates, LLC since 1999, a company which provides business management consulting services to public and private companies in the areas of financial performance improvement, acquisitions and divestitures. Prior to joining Engel and Associates, LLC, Mr. Engel was president of Airgas Southwest, Inc. and he served as CEO, president and owner of Welders Equipment Company. Mr. Engel serves on the board of directors of several privately held companies. Mr. Engel is expected to be appointed to serve on our general partner's audit committee in connection with the offering. Mr. Engel's service on SHC's board of directors and executive management and consulting experience is valuable to the board of directors of our general partner in setting strategic direction, and developing and executing growth and compensation strategies.

              Armand S. Shapiro—Director Nominee.     Mr. Shapiro is expected to join our general partner's board of directors in connection with the offering and has served as a member of SHC's board of directors since 1997. Mr. Shapiro joined Newport Board Group as a Partner in October of 2011. Newport Board Group is a partnership of board director and senior executive leaders that assist emerging growth and middle market companies improve their performance. Prior to that, Mr. Shapiro served as a business consultant and mentor to chief executive officers of private companies to develop strategies to improve growth and profitability of the company. He served from October 2001 through January 2006 on the board of directors of Bindview Development Corporation, then a publicly traded corporation that provided software for proactively managing information technology security compliance operations. Mr. Shapiro was the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of Garden Ridge Corporation from 1990 until June 1999. During the 1980s, Mr. Shapiro also served as President, a member of the executive management team, and a director of Computer Craft, Inc., then a publicly traded retailer of computer products. He was also previously a partner and Chief Operating Officer of Modern Furniture Rentals, Inc., a family-owned and operated business. Mr. Shapiro is a graduate of Renesselaer Polytechnic Institute and has served as an officer in the United States Army. Mr. Shapiro is expected to be appointed to serve as the Chairman of our general partner's audit committee in connection with the offering. Mr. Shapiro's extensive corporate and financial management experience and tenure on SHC's board of directors, as well as his specific background in technology and retail operations, provide valuable expertise to the board of our general partner in strategic planning, risk management, financial and accounting oversight.

134


Table of Contents

              Bryan F. Smith Jr.—Director Nominee.     Mr. Smith is expected to join our general partner's board of directors in connection with the offering. Mr. Smith's business experience includes over 25 years at 7-Eleven, Inc. (formerly the Southland Corporation), beginning in 1980 and culminating with his retirement in June 2006. During his tenure at 7-Eleven, Mr. Smith served in a variety of positions, most recently as Executive Vice President, Chief Administrative Officer and Secretary from 2005 to 2006 and Executive Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary from 2002 to 2005, as well as chief compliance officer under the 7-Eleven Code of Conduct from 1992 to 2006 and a member of the executive committee from 1995 to 2006. Mr. Smith was also briefly engaged as a consultant to Blockbuster Inc. in late 2007, serving as its interim general counsel. Mr. Smith is expected to be appointed to serve on our general partner's audit committee and as Chairman of our general partner's conflicts committee in connection with the offering. We believe that Mr. Smith's broad range of work for 7-Eleven and knowledge of the convenience store industry apart from SHC will enable him to offer a unique perspective to our general partner's board of directors.


Director Independence

              In accordance with the rules of the NYSE, SHC must appoint at least one independent director prior to the listing of our common units on the NYSE, one additional member within ninety days of that listing, and one additional independent member within one year of that listing. Messrs. Shapiro, Engel and Smith, each of whom meets the independence standards established by the NYSE, will be appointed to the board of directors of our general partner prior to the date our common units are listed for trading on the NYSE.


Committees of the Board of Directors

              The board of directors of our general partner will have an audit committee and a conflicts committee. Messrs. Shapiro, Engel and Smith are the initial members of the Audit Committee and Mr. Smith is the initial member of our Conflicts Committee. We do not expect that we will have a compensation committee, but rather that our general partner's board of directors will approve equity grants to directors and employees. We also do not expect to have a nominating and corporate governance committee.

Audit Committee

              We are required to have an audit committee of at least three members, and all its members are required to meet the independence and experience standards established by the NYSE and the Exchange Act. The board of directors of our general partner has determined that each director nominee to be appointed to the audit committee is "financially literate," and the director nominee to be appointed as chairman of the audit committee has "accounting or related financial management expertise," in accordance with the NYSE rules and regulations. The audit committee of the board of directors of our general partner will serve as our audit committee and will assist the board in its oversight of the integrity of our consolidated financial statements and our compliance with legal and regulatory requirements and partnership policies and controls. The audit committee will have the sole authority to (1) retain and terminate our independent registered public accounting firm, (2) approve all auditing services and related fees and the terms thereof performed by our independent registered public accounting firm, and (3) pre-approve any non-audit services and tax services to be rendered by our independent registered public accounting firm. The audit committee will also be responsible for confirming the independence and objectivity of our independent registered public accounting firm. Our independent registered public accounting firm will be given unrestricted access to the audit committee and our management, as necessary.

135


Table of Contents

Conflicts Committee

              We expect that at least two independent members of the board of directors of our general partner will serve on a conflicts committee to review specific matters that the board believes may involve conflicts of interest (including certain transactions with affiliates of SHC), but our partnership agreement only requires the conflicts committee to have one member. The conflicts committee will determine if the resolution of the conflict of interest is fair and reasonable to us. The members of the conflicts committee may not be officers or employees of our general partner or directors, officers, or employees of its affiliates, including SHC, and must meet the independence standards established by the NYSE and the Exchange Act to serve on an audit committee of a board of directors, along with other requirements. Any matters approved by the conflicts committee will be conclusively deemed to be fair and reasonable to us, approved by all of our partners and not a breach by our general partner of any duties it may owe us or our unitholders.

              Because our partnership agreement only requires that the conflicts committee have at least one member, during any time that the committee only has one member, that single member of the conflicts committee will be able to approve resolutions of conflicts of interest. It is possible that a single-member committee may not function as effectively as a multiple-member committee and, if we pursue a transaction with an affiliate while the conflicts committee has only one member, our limited partners will be deemed to have approved that transaction through the approval of that single-member committee, in the same manner as would have occurred had the committee consisted of more directors.

136


Table of Contents


EXECUTIVE OFFICER COMPENSATION

Compensation of Our Executive Officers

              We and our general partner were formed in June 2012. Accordingly, neither we nor our general partner accrued any obligations with respect to management compensation or retirement benefits for directors and executive officers for any periods prior to our formation date.

              The officers of our general partner will manage the day-to-day affairs of our business. All of the officers of our general partner are also executive officers of SHC, will have responsibilities to both us and SHC and will devote part of their business time to our business and part of their business time to SHC's business. Compensation will be determined and paid by SHC and a portion of that compensation will be reimbursed by us based on the amount of time spent by such officers in managing our business and operations. The officers of our general partner, as well as the employees of SHC who provide services to us, may participate in employee benefit plans and arrangements sponsored by SHC, including plans that may be established in the future. Certain of our general partner's officers and employees and certain employees of SHC who provide services to us currently hold grants under SHC's equity incentive plans and will retain these grants after the completion of this offering.

              In connection with the completion of this offering, our general partner plans to adopt a long-term incentive plan. Certain of our general partner's officers, employees and non-employee directors, and other key employees of SHC who make significant contributions to our business, will be eligible to receive awards under our long-term incentive plan. Our general partner intends to implement the long-term incentive plan to provide our general partner with maximum flexibility with respect to the design of compensatory arrangements for individuals providing services to us. Our general partner's board of directors will determine any grants to officers under our long-term incentive plan. The terms of the long-term incentive plan as well as the awards that will be granted to our NEOs (defined below) prior to the closing of this offering are outlined in detail in this registration statement below.


Compensation of Our Directors

              The officers or employees of our general partner or of SHC who also serve as directors of our general partner will not receive additional compensation for their service as a director of our general partner. Directors of our general partner who are not officers or employees of our general partner or of SHC will receive compensation as "non-employee directors" as set by our general partner's board of directors.

              Effective as of the closing of this offering, each non-employee director will receive a compensation package that will consist of an annual retainer of $            . In addition, our directors will be reimbursed for out-of-pocket expenses in connection with attending meetings of the board of directors or its committees. Prior to the closing of this offering, each non-employee director will receive a grant of        phantom units on the date of grant. One-third of this grant of phantom units will vest on each of the first three anniversaries of the date of grant. As a general matter, we expect that in the future each non-employee director will receive grants of equity-based awards upon appointment to the board of directors and from time to time thereafter for so long as he or she serves as a director.

              Each member of the board of directors of our general partner will be indemnified for his actions associated with being a director to the fullest extent permitted under Delaware law.


Compensation Discussion and Analysis

Overview

              Our general partner has the sole responsibility for conducting our business and for managing our operations, and its board of directors and officers make decisions on our behalf. References to

137


Table of Contents

"our officers" and "our directors" refer to the officers and directors of our general partner. Following the closing of this offering, we expect that the most highly compensated executive officers of our general partner, including our general partner's principal executive and financial officers, will be Sam L. Susser, our Chief Executive Officer; Mary E. Sullivan, our Executive Vice President, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer; Rocky B. Dewbre, our President and Chief Operating Officer; and E.V. Bonner, Jr., our Executive Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary. Each of the executives who we expect to be one of our named executive officers ("NEOs") is also a NEO of SHC, and we expect that our NEOs will allocate their time between managing our business and managing the business of SHC.

              We do not and will not directly employ any of the persons responsible for managing our business and we currently do not have a compensation committee. Our officers will be employed and compensated by SHC or a subsidiary of SHC and the responsibility and authority for compensation-related decisions for our executive officers will reside with the SHC compensation committee. In accordance with the terms of our partnership agreement and the omnibus agreement, we will reimburse SHC for compensation related expenses attributable to the portion of the executive's time dedicated to providing services to us. Please read "The Partnership Agreement—Reimbursement of Expenses" and "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions—Agreements with Affiliates in Connection with the Transactions—Omnibus Agreement." SHC currently expects that Mr. Susser, Ms. Sullivan and Mr. Bonner will each generally devote approximately 15% of their total business time to our general partner and us and that Mr. Dewbre will devote approximately 60% of his total business time to our general partner and us; however, our actual future compensation allocation may differ from current expectations. SHC has the ultimate decision-making authority with respect to the total compensation of the NEOs that are employed by SHC including, subject to the terms of the partnership agreement, determining the portion of that compensation that is allocated to us based on the time spent by such officers in managing our business and operations. Any such compensation decisions will not be subject to any approvals by the board of directors of our general partner or any committees thereof. However, all determinations with respect to awards to be made under our long-term incentive plan to our executive officers, key employees, and independent directors will be made by the board of directors of our general partner or a committee thereof that may be established for such purpose.

2012 Long-Term Incentive Plan

              Our general partner intends to implement the Susser Petroleum Partners LP 2012 Long-Term Incentive Plan, or the 2012 LTIP, to provide maximum flexibility with respect to the design of compensatory arrangements for individuals providing services to us. The 2012 LTIP will be for the benefit of employees, consultants, and directors of our general partner and its affiliates, who perform services for us. Each of the Named Executive Officers will be eligible to participate in the 2012 LTIP. Any awards that are made under our long-term incentive plan to our executive officers will be approved by the board of directors of our general partner or a committee thereof that may be established for such purpose.

              The 2012 LTIP will provide us with the flexibility to grant unit options, restricted units, phantom units, unit appreciation rights, cash awards, distribution equivalent rights, substitute awards, and other unit-based awards, or any combination of the foregoing. These awards are intended to align the interests of plan participants (including the NEOs) with those of our unitholders and to give plan participants the opportunity to share in our long-term performance.

      Common Units Reserved Under the 2012 LTIP

              The 2012 LTIP will initially limit the number of common units that may be delivered pursuant to vested awards to                        of our common units. Additionally, on January 1 of each calendar year occurring prior to the expiration of the 2012 LTIP, the total number of our common units reserved and available for issuance under the 2012 LTIP shall increase by                        of our

138


Table of Contents

common units if, and only if, we completed a sale or other disposition of our common units during the previous calendar year, including, but not limited to, (i) an issuance of common units as consideration for an asset purchase or merger, (ii) a public offering of our common units (other than this offering), (iii) an offering of our common units under Rule 144A or Regulation D of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or (iv) any other offering of our common units in a private placement, in each case, to any unaffiliated, non-employee, third party. Our common units cancelled, settled in cash, forfeited or withheld to satisfy exercise prices or tax withholding obligations will be available for delivery pursuant to other awards. The common units delivered pursuant to such awards may be common units acquired in the open market or acquired from any affiliate or other person, or any combination of the foregoing, as determined in the discretion of the committee (as defined below).

      Administration of the 2012 LTIP

              The 2012 LTIP will be administered by the board of directors of our general partner or an alternative committee appointed by the board of directors of our general partner, which we refer to together as the committee. The committee may also delegate its duties as appropriate. The committee may terminate or amend the 2012 LTIP or any part of the 2012 LTIP at any time with respect to any common units for which a grant has not yet been made, including increasing the number of common units that may be granted, subject to the requirements of the exchange upon which the units are listed at that time or other applicable law. However, no change other than changes pursuant to a subdivision or consolidation of units, a recapitalization, or a change in control or other "corporate event", may be made that would materially reduce the rights or benefits of a participant without the consent of the participant. The 2012 LTIP will expire upon the earlier of (i) its termination by the board of directors of our general partner, (ii) the date common units are no longer available under the 2012 LTIP for grants or (iii) the tenth anniversary of the date the 2012 LTIP is approved by our general partner.

      Awards Under the 2012 LTIP

              In General.     The committee may make grants of unit options, restricted units, phantom units, unit appreciation rights, distribution equivalent rights, substitute awards, cash awards and other unit-based awards, or any combination of the foregoing, which grants shall contain such terms as the committee shall determine, including terms governing the service period and/or performance conditions pursuant to which any such awards will vest and/or be settled, as applicable. The availability and grant of units and other unit-based awards are intended to furnish additional compensation to plan participants and to align their economic interests with those of our public unitholders. In addition, the grant of restricted units and phantom units under the 2012 LTIP is intended to serve as a means of incentive compensation for performance and, to a lesser extent, to provide an opportunity for plan participants to participate in the equity appreciation of our common units. Plan participants will not pay any consideration for the common units they receive pursuant to an award of restricted units, or in connection with the settlement of an award of phantom units, and, as such, we will receive no remuneration for such units. The number of common units subject to awards will be determined by the committee. When considering the type and number of awards to grant under the 2012 LTIP, the committee will consider its general compensation policies and philosophies.

              Options.     Options are options to acquire common units at a specified price. The exercise price of each option granted under the 2012 LTIP will be stated in the option agreement and may vary; provided, however, that, the exercise price for an option must not be less than 100% of the fair market value per common unit as of the date of grant of the option unless that option award is intended to otherwise comply with the requirements of Section 409A of the Code. Options may be exercised in the manner and at such times as the committee determines for each option, unless that option award is determined to be subject to Section 409A of the Code, in which case the option award will be subject to any necessary timing restrictions imposed by the Code or federal regulations. The committee will

139


Table of Contents

determine the methods and form of payment for the exercise price of an option and the methods and forms in which common units will be delivered to a participant.

              Restricted Common Units.     A restricted unit is a common unit that vests over a period of time and during that time is subject to forfeiture. The committee will be able to make grants of restricted units containing such terms as it shall determine, including the period over which restricted units will vest.

              Phantom Common Units.     A phantom unit entitles the grantee to receive a common unit upon or as soon as reasonably practicable following the phantom unit's settlement date or, in the discretion of the committee, a cash payment equivalent to the fair market value of a common unit calculated on the day the phantom units vest. The committee will be able to make grants of phantom units containing such terms as it shall determine, including the period over which phantom units vest.

              Unit Appreciation Rights ("UAR").     A UAR is the right to receive, in cash or in common units, as determined by the committee, an amount equal to the excess of the fair market value of one common unit on the date of exercise over the grant price of the UAR. The committee will be able to make grants of UARs and will determine the time or times at which a UAR may be exercised in whole or in part. The exercise price of each UAR granted under the 2012 LTIP will be stated in the UAR agreement and may vary; provided, however, that, the exercise price must not be less than 100% of the fair market value per common unit as of the date of grant of the UAR unless that UAR award is intended to otherwise comply with the requirements of Section 409A of the Code.

              Distribution Equivalent Rights ("DER").     The committee will be able to grant DERs in tandem with awards under the 2012 LTIP (other than an award of restricted units or a unit award). DERs entitle the participant to receive cash equal to the amount of any cash distributions made by us during the period the DER is outstanding. Payment of a DER issued in connection with another award may be subject to the same vesting terms as the award to which it relates or different vesting terms, in the discretion of the committee.

              Substitute Awards.     The 2012 LTIP will permit the grant of awards in substitution for similar awards held by individuals who become employees, consultants or directors as a result of a merger, consolidation or acquisition by us, an affiliate of another entity or the assets of another entity. Such substitute awards that are unit options or UARs may have exercise prices less than 100% of the fair market value per common unit on the date of the substitution if such substitution complies with Section 409A of the Code and its regulations, and other applicable laws and exchange rules.

              Cash Awards and Other Unit-Based Awards.     The 2012 LTIP will permit the grant of cash awards or other unit-based awards, which are awards that may be based, in whole or in part, on the value or performance of a common unit or are denominated or payable in common units. Upon settlement, the unit-based award may be paid in common units, cash or a combination thereof, as provided in the award agreement.

              Performance Awards.     The committee may condition the right to exercise or receive an award under the 2012 LTIP, or may increase or decrease the amount payable with respect to an award, based on the attainment of one or more performance conditions deemed appropriate by the committee.

      Other 2012 LTIP Provisions

              Termination of Employment.     If a grantee's employment, consulting arrangement or membership on the board of directors of our general partner terminates for any reason, the grantee's unvested options, restricted units, phantom units and UARs will automatically be forfeited unless and to the extent the committee or the terms of the award agreement provide otherwise.

140


Table of Contents

              Tax Withholding.     Unless other arrangements are made, the committee will be authorized to withhold from any award, from any payment due under any award, or from any compensation or other amount owing to a participant the amount (in cash, units, units that would otherwise be issued pursuant to such award, or other property) of any applicable taxes payable with respect to the grant of an award, its settlement, its exercise, the lapse of restrictions applicable to an award or in connection with any payment relating to an award or the transfer of an award and to take such other actions as may be necessary to satisfy the withholding obligations with respect to an award.

              Anti-Dilution Adjustments.     If any "equity restructuring" event occurs that could result in an additional compensation expense under Financial Accounting Standards Board Accounting Standards Codification Topic 718 ("FASB ASC Topic 718") if adjustments to awards with respect to such event were discretionary, the committee will equitably adjust the number and type of units covered by each outstanding award and the terms and conditions of such award to equitably reflect the restructuring event, and the committee will adjust the number and type of units with respect to which future awards may be granted. With respect to a similar event that would not result in a FASB ASC Topic 718 accounting charge if adjustment to awards were discretionary, the committee shall have complete discretion to adjust awards in the manner it deems appropriate. In the event the committee makes any adjustment in accordance with the foregoing provisions, a corresponding and proportionate adjustment shall be made with respect to the maximum number of units available under the 2012 LTIP and the kind of units or other securities available for grant under the 2012 LTIP. Furthermore, in the case of (i) a subdivision or consolidation of the common units (by reclassification, split or reverse split or otherwise), (ii) a recapitalization, reclassification or other change in our capital structure or (iii) any other reorganization, merger, combination, exchange or other relevant change in capitalization of our equity, then a corresponding and proportionate adjustment shall be made in accordance with the terms of the 2012 LTIP, as appropriate, with respect to the maximum number of units available under the 2012 LTIP, the number of units that may be acquired with respect to an award, and, if applicable, the exercise price of an award in order to prevent dilution or enlargement of awards as a result of such events.

              Change of Control.     Upon a "change of control" (as defined in the 2012 LTIP and as summarized below), the committee may, in its discretion, (i) remove any forfeiture restrictions applicable to an award, (ii) accelerate the time of exercisability or vesting of an award, (iii) require awards to be surrendered in exchange for a cash payment, (iv) cancel unvested awards without payment or (v) make adjustments to awards as the committee deems appropriate to reflect the change of control. For purposes of the 2012 LTIP, a "change of control" occurs (a) when any person or group, other than us, our general partner or an affiliate of either us or of our general partner, becomes the beneficial owner of 50% or more of the voting power of the voting securities of us or our general partner, (b) upon the approval of a plan of complete liquidation of us or our general partner, (c) upon the sale or other disposition of all or substantially all of our general partner's assets or our assets, (d) when our current general partner or an affiliate of our current general partner ceases to be our general partner, or (e) upon any other event as described in an award agreement with respect to an award under the 2012 LTIP. Further, if an award granted under the 2012 LTIP constitutes a "deferral of compensation" under Section 409A of the Code, a "change of control" will not be deemed to occur unless that event also constitutes a "change in the ownership of a corporation", a "change in the effective control of a corporation", or a "change in the ownership of a substantial portion of a corporation's assets", in each case within the meaning of Section 1.409A-3(i)(5) of the treasury regulations promulgated under Section 409A of the Code, as applied to non-corporate entities.

Grants Under 2012 Long-Term Incentive Plan

              Prior to the closing of this offering, each of our NEOs will receive a grant of        phantom units under the 2012 LTIP on the date of grant. One-fifth of this grant of phantom units will vest on

141


Table of Contents

each of the first five anniversaries of the date of grant. These awards are being made to our NEOs to better align their interests with the interests of our unitholders and to serve as a retention tool.

Historic Compensation

              As we are a newly formed subsidiary of SHC consisting of portions of several different parts of SHC's business that are being contributed to us in connection with this offering, neither we nor our general partner incurred any cost or liability with respect to compensation of our NEOs prior to our formation on June 11, 2012. Accordingly, we have no historical compensation information to present. As previously discussed, all compensation-related decisions made with respect to our NEOs (other than any grants under our LTIP) will be the responsibility of SHC and its compensation committee. We have provided a full discussion of the policies and programs of SHC and its compensation committee, as well as all compensation paid by SHC to our NEOs in 2011, below. Following the closing of this offering, we will only reimburse SHC for compensation related expenses incurred by SHC attributable to the portion of the executive's time dedicated to providing services to us.

SHC's Compensation Philosophy and Practices

              The SHC compensation committee acknowledges the importance of the role of management in long-term success and seeks to align compensation practices to the achievement of annual and long-term goals. The SHC compensation committee generally seeks to attract and retain key personnel by setting target annual compensation levels that are competitive with prevailing market practices while also taking into account each individual's responsibilities and contributions over both short-term and long-term horizons. However, the SHC compensation committee believes that compensation should correlate strongly organizational and individual performance and that a significant portion of target compensation should be tied to internal annual financial performance criteria and/or creation of long-term value for investors.

              In communicating the SHC compensation culture to employees, SHC frequently refers to its "share" philosophy: when SHC achieves its financial objectives, it believes in providing the management team an opportunity to share in the financial benefits of those achievements. Similarly, if annual performance does not meet expectations, SHC does not believe in paying members of management generous bonuses or other short-term payouts. This philosophy is intended to create a performance-oriented compensation culture which closely aligns the interests of management with the interests of the other critical stakeholders. This culture is exemplified by target compensation heavily weighted toward performance-based and long-term equity incentive compensation, an annual bonus program tied to meeting or exceeding internal performance goals, a bonus program including a fuel-margin-neutral component to recognize that fuel margins are largely outside of management's control and a future performance hurdle included in certain restricted stock awards.

              Sam L. Susser, SHC's and our Chief Executive Officer, is currently SHC's largest shareholder—owning approximately 11% of SHC's common stock. Mr. Susser has discussed with the SHC compensation committee a preference that he receive any increases in base salary in the form of one-time equity grants rather than cash compensation. Accordingly, his base cash salary has not increased since 2003. These two factors—his large equity interest in SHC and his historical reluctance to accept long-term increases in base salary—have distinguished the SHC compensation committee's approach to compensating Mr. Susser from SHC's other named executive officers in important respects.

              SHC is cognizant of the risks that may arise when companies make incentive compensation a strong component of compensation practices. However, SHC's incentive compensation practices are generally tied to annual corporate or segment-level financial performance metrics that it believes are indicative of prudent management and sustainable growth in its core business and do not create incentives for pursuing short-term gains or engaging in other significant risk-taking behavior.

142


Table of Contents

Accordingly, SHC does not believe the form, condition or allocation of the compensation elements provided to employees contributes to any significant level of incremental risk.

SHC's Compensation Setting Process

              The SHC compensation committee assists SHC's board of directors in overseeing compensation policies and practices including: (i) reviewing and approving corporate goals and objectives relevant to the chief executive officer and assessing his performance in light of those goals; (ii) determining and approving chief executive officer compensation; (iii) reviewing and approving compensation levels for all management-level employees, including the named executive officers; (iv) reviewing and approving management incentive compensation policies and programs; (v) reviewing and approving equity compensation programs for employees; and (vi) exercising discretion in the administration of such programs.

              The compensation-setting process used by the SHC compensation committee for senior management consists of establishing targeted total compensation levels based upon information gained from consultants and through internal research and an assessment of an individual's performance and contributions to SHC, and then allocating that compensation among base salary and short- and long-term incentive compensation. The SHC compensation committee has periodically engaged third-party compensation consultants to provide data or advice regarding compensation determinations and analysis and comparisons of peer company compensation.

Elements of Compensation

              Base Salary.     Each of our and SHC's named executive officers is currently party to an employment agreement with SHC that sets his or her base annual salary and target bonus level, in either case, subject to annual review and discretionary increase by the SHC compensation committee for reasons such as changes in job responsibility or market trends or to reward individual performance. Base salary is designed to provide a fixed minimum level of annual compensation as well as a lever off of which incentive opportunities and other benefit levels are established in the administration of compensation programs.

              Annual Bonuses.     Annual bonuses are intended to motivate and reward SHC's named executive officers by tying performance awards to both the achievement of organization-wide and segment-specific financial goals for the performance year as well as individual performance and achievements. Target bonus levels are established in the named executive officers' employment agreements and may be increased from time to time at the discretion of the SHC compensation committee.

              Final bonus awards are determined in the sole discretion of the SHC compensation committee. The SHC compensation committee chooses to retain ultimate authority over bonus decisions due to the impact that outside variables beyond management's control may have on SHC's results of operations, and its observation that organization-wide or segment-specific performance metrics may not reflect the growth or performance of individuals within SHC. Consequently, while the SHC compensation committee strongly considers the objective performance criteria established as part of the management bonus program to be important components in making award determinations, final bonus decisions are nonetheless entirely discretionary in nature.

              For purposes of assisting its annual bonus determinations, the SHC compensation committee selects internal performance targets that it believes are achievable while also aspirational, insofar as they are indicative of strong organization-wide or, as the case may be, segment-specific performance. While SHC believes that target levels are reasonably attainable, they are necessarily based on certain assumptions as to variables beyond SHC's control, including events of war or terrorism, severe weather events such as hurricanes, changes in commodity price levels and the impact of outside competition—all of which may have a significant impact on SHC's business. The SHC compensation committee also notes any significant impact to financial performance of acquisitions or divestitures that were not

143


Table of Contents

contemplated at the time the internal targets were finalized. Historically, the SHC compensation committee has elected to revise the performance criteria whenever there has been a material acquisition or divestiture but has elected not to adjust bonus targets for hurricanes, unanticipated changes in the price of oil and other significant but unforeseen events. Consequently, while the SHC compensation committee looks generally to objective performance measures, it does not take a purely formulaic approach to making bonus decisions and reserves discretion and ultimate authority to consider and discuss any number of subjective factors in making award determinations.

              For the 2011 fiscal year, the SHC compensation committee utilized adjusted EBITDAR of SHC—or net income before net interest expense, income taxes, depreciation, amortization and accretion, and rent, adjusted to exclude certain non-cash compensation and other expenses—as the relevant performance measure for making awards under the management bonus program. The SHC compensation committee strongly believes that performance awards should be tied to variables within management's control and recognizes that fuel margins are subject to market and other competitive pressures that may cause fuel gross profit to vary from year to year for reasons largely outside of management's control. Accordingly, in 2011 the SHC compensation committee utilized a fuel-margin-neutral measure of adjusted EBITDAR, in addition to reported adjusted EBITDAR, for assessing 2011 performance against targets. For each of its named executive officers, 2011 performance versus target was measured 50% on an actual basis and 50% on a fuel-margin-neutral basis to help mitigate the impact that significant swings in fuel margins, which are subject to market variability beyond SHC's control, may have on SHC's operating results. Regardless of the fuel margin neutral EBITDAR, SHC must achieve a certain base level of actual EBITDAR before its named executive officers are eligible for any bonus payments.

              Benefit Plans.     SHC provides other benefits, including medical, life, dental, and disability insurance in line with competitive market conditions. SHC's named executive officers are eligible for the same benefit plans provided to certain other employees, including insurance plans and supplemental plans chosen and paid for by employees who wish additional coverage.

              SHC's named executive officers, other than Mr. Susser, may also participate in SHC's Employee Stock Purchase Plan. Mr. Susser is not eligible to participate because he beneficially owns 5% or more of SHC's common stock. Shares of SHC's common stock are purchased quarterly through payroll deductions, with employee contributions limited to the lesser of 10% of compensation or $25,000 annually. Stock purchases are made shortly after the end of each fiscal quarter at 85% of the closing price on the last trading day of the quarter.

              SHC maintains a 401(k) benefit plan for the benefit of its employees. All full-time employees who are over 21 years of age and have greater than six months tenure are eligible to participate. Under the terms of the 401(k) plan, employees can contribute up to 100% of their wages, subject to IRS limitations. SHC has also implemented a nonqualified deferred compensation (NQDC) plan for key executives, officers, and certain other employees to allow compensation deferrals in addition to that allowable under the 401(k) plan limitations, in that the contribution limits and compensation limits of the 401(k) plan do not apply to the NQDC plan.

              Long-Term Incentives.     Long-term incentives generally take the form of equity awards and form a performance-based component of pay historically tied to achievement of internal financial and operational goals at SHC. These awards are generally made at levels intended to provide meaningful incentive for continued employment, and for strong financial performance, over the vesting period. The SHC compensation committee views the incentivizing characteristics of these awards as continuing throughout the full vesting period. Since SHC's initial public offering in 2006, the SHC compensation committee has increasingly recognized the value of long-term equity grants in incentivizing and retaining employees. Beginning in 2010, SHC has made increasing use of annual equity incentive awards as a means of compensating key employees and members of management. Beginning in 2010, SHC also added to its equity compensation program restricted stock units (RSUs) with performance hurdles tied to achievement of internal fuel-margin-neutral EBITDAR targets. These changes have been made to ensure the alignment of long-term interests between named executive officers and outside stakeholders.

144


Table of Contents

Significant Policies and Practices

              Stock Ownership and Retention Policy.     SHC recognizes that ownership of common stock is an effective means to align the interests of its directors and executives with those of its shareholders. It has emphasized the importance of equity ownership among executives and directors. Existing ownership positions of named executive officers combined with equity awards issued in the past create a strong incentive to achieve long-term growth in the price of SHC's common stock. In furtherance of these goals, SHC adopted a set of Corporate Governance Guidelines in 2010 with a stock ownership and retention policy applicable to its directors and executive officers as follows:

Position
  Market Value of
Common Stock Owned

Chief Executive Officer

  6x Base Salary

Executive Vice President

  1.5x Base Salary

Senior Vice President

  1x Base Salary

Member of Board of Directors

  3x Base Retainer

              Each person serving in any of the above capacities is expected to accumulate and retain the corresponding market value of shares in SHC common stock (including "in the money" vested options) within five years of coming under this policy. To the extent this objective is not being met, officers and directors are expected not to sell any shares until their holdings are in line with this policy. SHC believes this policy will reinforce and strengthen the alignment between the interests of directors and senior officers and those of SHC's shareholders.

              Prohibition on Hedging.     No director or officer subject to stock ownership and retention requirements described above is permitted to sell-short, hedge or otherwise engage in transactions in SHC derivative securities the intent or effect of which is to insulate such person's interest in SHC stock, stock options, restricted stock, restricted stock units, or other SHC securities from declines in market value.

              Claw-Back Policy.     SHC's Corporate Governance Guidelines also include a policy that requires it to "claw-back" or recoup any incentive compensation (both cash bonuses and equity awards) paid in the three years preceding the date of any accounting restatement due to material non-compliance with any financial reporting requirements under the securities laws.

              Prohibition on Insider Trading.     SHC has established policies prohibiting officers, directors, and employees from purchasing or selling SHC securities while in possession of material, nonpublic information, or outside of certain "window periods" following the release of annual and quarterly financial results, or otherwise using such information for personal benefit or in any manner that would violate applicable laws and regulations.

              Perquisites and Other Benefits.     SHC provides certain perquisites to executive officers. Executives are eligible to receive annual health examinations and personal administrative and bookkeeping services support from corporate staff. SHC does not provide executive officers with supplemental executive medical benefits or coverage. In addition, SHC generally does not pay for or reimburse executives for aircraft time relating to personal use, such as travel to and from vacation destinations. However, spouses (or other family members) occasionally accompany executives when executives are traveling on private aircraft for business purposes, such as attending an industry business conference at which spouses are invited and expected to attend.

Employment Agreements

              Each of SHC's named executive officers is currently party to an employment agreement with SHC that sets his or her base annual salary and target bonus level, in either case, subject to annual

145


Table of Contents

review and discretionary increase by SHC's compensation committee for reasons such as changes in job responsibility or market trends or to reward individual performance. These employment agreements provide for severance payments upon certain events of termination with SHC. If SHC terminates the executive "without cause," or the executive elects to terminate employment for "good reason," he or she is generally entitled to two times (three times in the case of Mr. Susser) base salary paid out in five installments over two years, plus any earned and accrued but unpaid bonus and any accrued vacation pay, 24 months of continued health insurance coverage for the executive and his or her family, and the reimbursement of any previously-incurred job-related expenses.

              For purposes of these employment agreements, "good reason" generally includes, (i) a reduction of the executive's base salary or target bonus percentage; (ii) the relocation of the executive's principal office location to a location outside of Corpus Christi or Houston, Texas; (iii) SHC's failure to provide any employee benefits owed to the executive; (iv) a material breach of the executive's employment agreement by SHC; or (v) the acquisition by a financial or strategic buyer of 51% of the outstanding equity interests of SHC, provided, in the latter case, the executive negotiates to provide continued transition services for a reasonable period. Under these employment agreements, the executives are entitled to various "gross-up" payments for certain excise taxes they may incur in connection with annual compensation or any severance payments.

              The SHC compensation committee believes the termination and change of control provisions contained in its executive employment agreements play an important role in attracting, recruiting and retaining executive talent by partially offsetting the career and relocation risks associated with changing jobs and, frequently, moving from larger cities offering greater opportunities for executive-level employment. Additionally, the employment agreements provide long-term protections for SHC through non-competition provisions prohibiting the executives from working in or maintaining anything other than a de minimis ownership interest in another company operating in the convenience store or wholesale motor fuel distribution industry—in any county in which SHC operates at the date of termination of employment—as well as non-solicitation agreements prohibiting the executive from hiring SHC employees, for a period of two years from the date of termination.


Process and Timing of Compensation Decisions

              The compensation-setting process used by the SHC compensation committee for senior management consists of establishing targeted total compensation levels based upon information gained from consultants and/or through internal research and an assessment of an individual's performance and contributions to SHC, and then allocating that compensation among base salary and short and long-term incentive compensation.

              The SHC compensation committee reviews and approves all compensation targets and payments for senior management, including SHC's NEOs. Sam L. Susser, SHC's and our Chief Executive Officer, evaluates the performance of other officers and develops individual recommendations for the SHC compensation committee's assessment and approval. CEO compensation is reviewed and approved by the SHC compensation committee and by the Board, based upon their independent evaluation of the CEO's performance and contributions.

              The SHC compensation committee periodically engages third-party compensation consultants to provide data or advice regarding compensation determinations. In 2011, the SHC compensation committee engaged Buck Consultants LLC to update their 2010 executive and director compensation market analysis, as discussed in more detail below.

              Market Compensation Analysis.     In the fourth quarter of 2010 the SHC compensation committee engaged the services of Buck Consultants LLC ("Buck") to conduct an independent study to compare salaries, bonuses, and long-term incentives for the CEO, NEOs and the Board of Directors on the basis of both (i) a broad market survey analysis utilizing both private and public company data

146


Table of Contents

obtained from proprietary sources and (ii) a proxy analysis of comparable public companies. The broad market survey analysis aggregates data from hundreds of companies across a variety of industries with similar annual revenues to those of SHC. Due to SHC's unique retail convenience store, wholesale fuel distribution and restaurant business structure and its relative size, the SHC compensation committee believes SHC has no direct peer companies. Also, individual roles, experience levels and other factors within peer companies may vary. Accordingly, these studies played a role in satisfying the SHC compensation committee that its compensation plan was in line with appropriate ranges of NEO and director compensation, and assisted the SHC compensation committee in determining salary, bonus and long-term incentives for the 2011 fiscal year. In the fourth quarter of 2011 the SHC compensation committee engaged Buck to perform an update of their broad market survey analysis and proxy analysis to assist them in determining salary, bonus and long-term incentives for the 2012 fiscal year.

              The public company comparison group used by Buck to complete its public company proxy analysis consisted of the following 21 companies, which is the same peer group as was used in the 2010 analysis except that 99 Cent Only Stores, Inc. and California Pizza Kitchen were removed, as they are no longer publicly traded, and O'Reilly Auto Parts, Jack in the Box and Tractor Supply were added:

Alon USA Energy, Inc.   Weiss Markets Inc.   Spartan Stores Inc.
The Pantry, Inc.   Jack in the Box   Bob Evans Farms, Inc.
Casey's General Stores, Inc.   O'Reilly Auto Parts   Village Super Market Inc.
Delek US Holdings, Inc.   Fred's Inc.   Nustar Energy L.P.
Texas Roadhouse, Inc.   Ingles Markets Inc.   Sally Beauty Holdings, Inc.
Cracker Barrel Old Country Stores, Inc.
Tractor Supply
  Carrols Restaurant Group, Inc.
Regency Energy Partners LP
  Red Robin Gourmet Burgers, Inc.
Ruddick Corporation

              The SHC compensation committee reviewed the mean, median and 25th and 75th percentile base salary, total cash and total compensation levels by position in this analysis, and considered these findings in assessing 2012 executive compensation levels. SHC's CEO's 2011 target compensation was between the 25th and 50th percentiles in this analysis reflecting his repeated recommendation to the SHC compensation committee that it consider one-time equity grants in lieu of making any increases to his base salary above the level set in 2003. The SHC compensation committee also considered Mr. Susser's significant ownership (approximately 11%) of its outstanding common stock. Average NEO 2011 target compensation excluding its CEO was also between the 25th and 50th percentiles. Average annual compensation for its non-employee, independent directors was between the 25th and 50th percentiles.

              Individual Responsibilities, Performance and Contributions.     Individual responsibilities and performance criteria may also provide the impetus for certain compensation decisions and are used by the SHC compensation committee in assessing comparability of market data, refining decisions regarding target levels of NEO annual compensation and considering equity award grants. These criteria are specific to each NEO position and may relate to a number of characteristics, including:

    Role and Responsibilities within SHC

    Leadership

    Customer/Frontline Employee Experience

    Financial Performance/Acumen

    Ethics/Integrity

    Driving Growth

    Planning, Execution and Problem Solving

147


Table of Contents

    Strategic Vision/Direction

    Leadership Development/Succession Planning

    Internal Controls/Risk Management

    External Relations

    Board Relations and Operations

              These criteria may also be used at the SHC compensation committee's discretion to adjust an individual's annual performance bonus above or below the level called for by reference to achievement of specific financial targets.

              Timing of Compensation Decisions.     The SHC compensation committee meets annually in the first quarter of each fiscal year to review the previous year's performance relative to financial targets and may award bonuses and long-term incentive awards that tie to the achievement of those goals. The SHC compensation committee will also then review the goals and management strategies for the new year, establish the target bonus levels for that fiscal year and approve any salary adjustments and associated effective dates. The SHC compensation committee may, however, review salary and bonus levels at other times in the event of mid-year appointments, changes in responsibility or promotions. The SHC compensation committee may also consider and grant long-term incentive awards from time to time as deemed appropriate during the year.

              The following table summarizes the approximate timing of some of SHC's more significant compensation events:

Event
 
Timing

Determine annual incentive bonus for preceding fiscal year

  First quarter

Consider base salary adjustments for executive officers for current fiscal year

 

First quarter

Establish financial performance objectives for annual bonuses for following fiscal year

 

Fourth quarter

Consider long-term incentive compensation awards

 

First quarter and from time to time


SHC Equity Plans

              In connection with its initial public offering, SHC adopted the SHC 2006 Equity Incentive Plan (the "SHC Plan") which governs the terms of equity awards granted to its management team prior to its initial public offering as well as any future equity awards granted by SHC. The SHC Plan is intended to provide incentives that will attract, retain and motivate highly competent persons as directors and employees of, and consultants to, SHC and its subsidiaries, by providing them with opportunities to acquire shares of its common stock or to receive monetary payments. Additionally, the SHC Plan provides SHC a means of directly tying its executives' financial reward opportunities to its shareholders' return on investment.

              Employees and directors of, and consultants to, SHC or any of its subsidiaries are eligible to participate in the SHC Plan, which is administered by the SHC compensation committee. The SHC Plan makes available an aggregate of 2,637,277 shares of SHC's common stock, subject to adjustments. The SHC Plan provides for the grant of stock options, including incentive stock options and non-qualified stock options, shares of restricted stock, and other stock-based awards. The SHC compensation committee determines, with regard to each type of award, the terms and conditions of the award, including the number of shares subject to the award, the vesting terms of the award, and the purchase price for each award. Additionally, in 2008, its shareholders approved the 2008 Susser

148


Table of Contents

Holdings Corporation Employee Stock Purchase Plan (the "2008 Employee Stock Purchase Plan"), which permits eligible employees to purchase SHC common stock through accumulated payroll deductions.

              As of January 1, 2012, a total of 817,681 shares of SHC stock had been issued under its equity compensation plans, net of forfeitures, with 410,148 shares remaining subject to vesting provisions. Total shares remaining available for issuance under its equity compensation plans were as follows:

SHC Plan Category
  Number of securities to
be issued upon exercise
of outstanding options,
warrants and rights
  Weighted-average
exercise price of
outstanding options,
warrants and rights
  Number of securities
remaining available for
future issuance under
equity compensation
plans(1)
 

Equity compensation plans approved by security holders

    793,494   $ 12.30     1,670,158  

Equity compensation plans not approved by security holders

             
               

Total

    793,494   $ 12.30     1,670,158  
               

(1)
Includes 993,016 shares remaining available for future issuance under the SHC Plan and 677,142 shares remaining available for future issuance under the 2008 Employee Stock Purchase Plan.

              Adjustment of Awards.     In the event of any corporate event or transaction such as a merger, consolidation, reorganization, recapitalization, stock split, or other like change in capital structure (other than normal cash dividends) or similar corporate event or transaction of SHC, the SHC compensation committee will determine whether and to what extent it should substitute or adjust, as applicable, the number and kind of shares of stock that may be issued under the SHC Plan or under particular forms and conditions of such awards.

              In the event SHC is a party to a merger or consolidation or similar transaction (including a change of control), the SHC compensation committee is authorized (but not obligated) to make adjustments in the terms and conditions of outstanding awards, including, without limitation, that at any time prior to such transaction, all then outstanding awards shall become immediately exercisable or vested and any restrictions on any awards shall immediately lapse. In addition, the SHC compensation committee may provide that all awards held by participants, who are at the time of the event in its service or the service of any of its subsidiaries or affiliates, shall remain exercisable for the remainder of their terms notwithstanding any subsequent termination of a participant's service or that all awards will be substituted with awards that will substantially preserve the otherwise applicable terms of affected awards previously granted hereunder, in each case, as determined by the SHC compensation committee in its sole discretion.

              Amendment and Termination.     The SHC compensation committee has the right to amend, suspend or terminate the SHC Plan at any time, provided that no amendment may adversely affect in any material respect any participant's rights under any award previously made or granted under the SHC Plan without the participant's consent. Also, no amendment of the SHC Plan may be made without approval of its shareholders if the approval is necessary to comply with any tax or regulatory requirement applicable to the SHC Plan.

              Compliance with Internal Revenue Code Section 409A.     In the event that the SHC compensation committee determines that the SHC Plan and/or awards are subject to Internal Revenue Code Section 409A, the SHC compensation committee may, in its sole discretion and without a participant's prior consent, amend the SHC Plan and/or awards, adopt policies and procedures, or take any other

149


Table of Contents

actions (including amendments, policies, procedures and actions with retroactive effect) as are necessary or appropriate to (i) exempt the SHC Plan and/or any award from the application of Code Section 409A, (ii) preserve the intended tax treatment of any such award, and (iii) comply with the requirements of Code Section 409A, including any regulations or other interpretive guidance that may be issued after the grant of any award. However, neither SHC nor the SHC compensation committee is obligated to ensure that awards comply with Code Section 409A or to take any actions to ensure such compliance.


Termination and Change of Control Benefits

              Employment agreements between SHC and each of the NEOs provide for severance payments upon certain events of termination of employment from SHC. For more information regarding the termination and change of control benefits set forth in these employment agreements, see "—Compensation Discussion and Analysis—Elements of Compensation—Employment Agreements."


Discussion and Tabular Disclosure Regarding Historical and Current Compensation

              Adjustments to Base Compensation and Target Bonus Levels.     Each of SHC's NEOs is currently party to an employment agreement that sets his or her base annual salary and target bonus level, in either case, subject to annual review and discretionary increase by the SHC compensation committee for reasons such as changes in job responsibility or market trends or to reward individual performance. The table below presents the annual base salary levels and target bonus levels (expressed as a percentage of base salary) for each of SHC's NEOs after giving effect to any increases approved by the SHC compensation committee from the base levels specified in the executives' respective employment agreements:

Executive Officer
  Year   Base
Salary(1)
  Target Bonus
Percentage
 

Sam L. Susser

    2012   $ 500,000 (2)   75 %(2)

President and CEO

    2011     500,000 (2)   60 %(2)

Mary E. Sullivan

   
2012
 
$

266,738
   
60

%

Executive Vice President, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

    2011     231,946     60 %

E.V. Bonner, Jr

   
2012
 
$

310,040
   
60

%

Executive Vice President, Secretary and General Counsel

    2011     303,960     60 %

Rocky B. Dewbre

   
2012
 
$

269,124
   
60

%

Executive Vice President and President/Chief Operating Officer—Wholesale

    2011
    244,658
    60

%


(1)
Annualized base salary level, which, to the extent of any increase or decrease from the preceding year, generally becomes effective during the first fiscal quarter.

(2)
Mr. Susser's base compensation in 2011 and 2012 consists of $500,000 in cash base salary together with an award of $100,000 in restricted stock. His annual bonus will be calculated as a percentage of the total $600,000 in base compensation.

              Mr. Susser's cash base salary has remained unchanged at $500,000 since 2003. For the 2011 fiscal year the SHC compensation committee increased Mr. Susser's total base compensation to $600,000 per year, consisting of $500,000 in cash base salary and $100,000 in restricted stock. This increase was approved in recognition of Mr. Susser's significant contributions to SHC's 2010 performance and in recognition of market compensation practices. For the 2012 fiscal year, the SHC compensation committee determined that Mr. Susser's base compensation would remain at $600,000, consisting of $500,000 cash salary and $100,000 in restricted stock. Additionally, as further discussed

150


Table of Contents

below, the SHC compensation committee granted Mr. Susser restricted stock valued at $600,000 in light of SHC's record performance for 2011 and considering Mr. Susser's recommendation that his base compensation not be increased.

              Each of SHC's other NEOs received a 3% increase in base salary for 2011, based on the SHC compensation committee's determination that they led significant improvement at SHC in 2010 and to better reflect competitive market conditions. In the first quarter of 2012, the SHC compensation committee determined that each of its other NEOs should receive a base salary increase reflecting their leadership contributing to achieving record performance for 2011, executing on SHC's growth plans by achieving its 23rd consecutive year of increasing same store merchandise sales, adding 19 new retail stores and completing an acquisition in the wholesale segment, and continuing to improve organizational competencies. The SHC compensation committee also considered other components of NEO short and long-term compensation, market considerations and peer group analysis for each NEO, and economic factors which SHC considers in developing salary increase recommendations for its non-NEO employees. Mr. Bonner received a 2% increase in base salary. Mr. Dewbre received a 10% base salary increase and Ms. Sullivan received a 15% base salary increase, reflecting adjustments the SHC compensation committee determined were appropriate to move them closer to the 50th percentile of the peer group analysis.

              2011 and 2012 Bonus Programs.     For the 2011 fiscal year, the SHC compensation committee utilized consolidated, retail segment and wholesale segment adjusted EBITDAR—or net income before net interest expense, income taxes, depreciation, amortization and accretion, and rent, adjusted to exclude certain non-cash compensation and other expenses—as the relevant performance measure for making awards under the management bonus program.

              The SHC compensation committee strongly believes that performance awards should be tied to variables within its employees' control and recognizes that fuel margins are subject to market and other competitive pressures that may cause fuel gross profit to vary from year to year for reasons largely outside of its employees' control. Accordingly, in 2011, the SHC compensation committee utilized a fuel-margin-neutral measure of adjusted EBITDAR, in addition to reported adjusted EBITDAR, for assessing 2011 performance against targets. Each of SHC's NEOs (and for each of these three adjusted EBITDAR measures, as applicable) 2011 performance versus target was measured 50% on an actual basis and 50% on a fuel-margin-neutral basis to help mitigate the impact that significant swings in fuel margins, which are subject to market variability beyond its control, may have on its operating results. Regardless of the fuel margin neutral EBITDAR, SHC must achieve a certain base level of actual EBITDAR before its NEOs are eligible for any bonus payments.

              At the beginning of the 2011 fiscal year, the SHC compensation committee determined that its objective assessment of Mr. Dewbre's performance would be based 66.7% on achievement of targeted consolidated adjusted EBITDAR with the remaining 33.3% being based on achieving targeted levels of wholesale segment adjusted EBITDAR. The performance of its other NEOs was assessed based upon performance of SHC relative to internal target levels of consolidated adjusted EBITDAR. The following table reflects the correlation between (i) achievement of internal target levels of these metrics and (ii) corresponding target bonus dollars available for each of its NEOs (expressed as a percentage of base salary) for the 2011 fiscal year.

151


Table of Contents


2011 Management Bonus Program
Relationship of Nominal Bonus Dollars (As Percentage of Annual Salary)
To Achievement of Internal Performance Targets

 
  Annual Adjusted EBITDAR
Result as a Percentage of
Internal Target
 
 
  90%   100%   110%   120%  

Sam L. Susser

    *     *     *     *  

All other Named Executive Officers

    3.0 %   60.0 %   100.0 %   175.0 %

*
Mr. Susser's Employment Agreement specifies a bonus of 50% of base salary when SHC achieves its annual internal target, but the SHC compensation committee has the sole discretion and flexibility to set appropriate bonus payments for performance below or above the internal target level.

              The table below reflects the performance of SHC in its achievement of 2011 adjusted EBITDAR targets and the relative importance each of these components played in NEO nominal bonus calculations under SHC's 2011 annual bonus program.


2011 SHC Results vs. Internal Performance Targets and
Relative Weight of Targets in Nominal NEO Bonus Determinations

 
  Adjusted
Consolidated
EBITDAR
  Wholesale
Segment
Adjusted
EBITDAR
 
 
  ($ in thousands)
 

2011 Internal Performance Target

  $ 167,049   $ 25,373  

2011 Results as a Percentage of Target(1):

             

Actual Result

    127.4 %   115.3 %

Fuel-Margin-Neutral Result(2)

    98.6 %   100.0 %

Allocation of EBITDAR Components in Nominal Bonus Calculations (by NEO):

             

Sam L. Susser

    100.0 %    

Mary E. Sullivan

    100.0 %    

E.V. Bonner, Jr. 

    100.0 %    

Rocky B. Dewbre

    66.7 %   33.3 %

(1)
2011 bonus amounts based on a (i) 50% weighting of actual results to target adjusted EBITDAR and (ii) 50% weighting of fuel-margin-neutral results to target adjusted EBITDAR.

(2)
Fuel-margin-neutral result is the calculation of adjusted EBITDAR as if fuel margin expressed in terms of cents per gallon ("CPG") was equal to the target CPG.

              For their 2011 performance, the SHC compensation committee approved bonus awards to each of its NEOs at the nominal levels set forth in the 2011 bonus program, as reflected under the "Summary Compensation Table" presented below. The SHC compensation committee determined that Mr. Susser's total bonus for 2011 would be $830,000 to reflect record financial and operating performance for 2011, but determined that one-third of his bonus would be paid in the form of shares of restricted stock, vesting 50% each on November 1 of 2012 and 2013, to further reinforce alignment with shareholders. Bonuses for the other four NEOs were paid in cash.

152


Table of Contents

              For fiscal 2012, the SHC compensation committee decided to adopt a similar bonus program for 2012, which is as follows:


2012 Management Bonus Program
Relationship of Nominal Bonus Dollars (As Percentage of Annual Salary)
To Achievement of Internal Performance Targets

 
  Annual Adjusted EBITDAR Result as a
Percentage of Internal Target
 
 
  90%   100%   110%   120%  

Sam L. Susser

    *     75.0 %   *     *  

All other Named Executive Officers

    3.0 %   60.0 %   100.0 %   175.0 %

*
Mr. Susser's Employment Agreement specifies a bonus of 50% of base salary when SHC achieves its annual internal target, but the SHC compensation committee has the sole discretion and flexibility to set appropriate bonus payments for performance below or above the internal target level. The SHC compensation committee has elected 75% of base salary as a preliminary guide for 2012 at the 100% of target performance level.

              2011 and 2012 Long-term Equity Awards.     In 2011, SHC granted each of its NEOs, other than its CEO, 10,000 restricted stock units ("RSUs"). These RSUs were subject to an initial performance hurdle, namely, the achievement of internal plan consolidated adjusted EBITDAR on a fuel-margin-neutral basis. Effective March 16, 2012 (the date of its Form 10-K filing with the SEC) the SHC compensation committee concluded that this performance hurdle had been achieved at the 98.6% level, and that each of its non-CEO NEOs would receive 6,733 RSUs, which remain subject to time vesting ratably on November 1 of 2012, 2013 and 2014.

              In March 2012, each of SHC's NEOs, other than its CEO, received 10,000 RSUs, which are subject to achieving specific performance hurdles relative to their respective 2012 internal target for consolidated adjusted EBITDAR on a fuel-margin-neutral basis. The determination of whether any or all of the performance criteria are met will be made in March 2013. Any RSUs ultimately awarded based on achieving 2012 performance targets will remain subject to time vesting ratably on November 1 of 2013, 2014 and 2015.

              In March of 2011, in addition to the 15,518 shares of restricted stock he received as part of his 2010 bonus, SHC granted its CEO, Sam L. Susser, 37,008 shares ($500,000 grant date fair value) of restricted stock vesting ratably on November 1 of 2011, 2012 and 2013. One-fifth of these shares were granted as part of Mr. Susser's 2011 base compensation (as discussed above). The remainder were granted in recognition of his, and SHC's, exceptional performance in 2010, and growth in cash flow and personnel development over the last five years.

              In March 2012, Mr. Susser received a total of 39,523 shares of restricted stock, comprised of the following:

    11,196 shares in lieu of cash for one-third of his 2011 bonus, as discussed above, with a fair value on the date of grant of $276,653. These shares vest ratably on November 1 of 2012 and 2013.

    4,046 shares ($100,000 fair value) granted as part of his 2012 base compensation. These shares vest ratably on November 1 of 2012, 2013 and 2014.

    24,281 shares ($600,000 fair value) granted in recognition for exceptional performance in 2011. These shares vest ratably on November 1 of 2012, 2013 and 2014.

153


Table of Contents

              In addition to these restricted stock grants, Mr. Susser received a long-term incentive performance grant of 6,070 RSUs. These RSUs are subject to meeting cumulative internal performance targets for 2012, 2013 and 2014. The determination of how many, if any, of these RSUs will be awarded will be made in early 2015. Vesting for any of these RSUs earned will take place on March 1, 2015.


Summary Compensation Table

              The following table provides a summary of total compensation paid by SHC for 2011 to its NEOs. The table shows amounts earned by such persons for services rendered to SHC in all capacities in which they served. The elements of compensation listed in the table are more fully described in the "SHC Compensation Discussion and Analysis" section of this report and in the footnotes that follow this table.

Name and Principal Position
  Year   Salary
($)(1)
  Bonus
($)(2)
  Stock
Awards
($)(3)
  Option
Awards
($)
  All Other
Compensation
($)(4)
  Total
($)
 

Sam L. Susser

    2011     500,000 (5)   553,347 (6)   776,631 (6)       89,577     1,919,555  

SHC President and Chief

                                           

Executive Officer

                                           

Mary E. Sullivan

    2011     230,647     256,301     90,963         31,006     608,917  

SHC Executive Vice President,

                                           

Chief Financial Officer

                                           

and Treasurer

                                           

E.V. Bonner, Jr. 

    2011     302,258     335,876     90,963         40,633     769,730  

SHC Executive Vice President,

                                           

Secretary and General

                                           

Counsel

                                           

Rocky B. Dewbre

    2011     243,288     260,820     90,963         30,377     625,448  

SHC Executive Vice President

                                           

and President and Chief

                                           

Operating Officer—Wholesale

                                           

(1)
Includes base salary paid to each NEO during 2011, which included 26 pay periods.

(2)
Amounts included in bonus column are the amounts earned for 2011, but such amounts were paid in March of 2012.

(3)
The amounts reported for stock awards represent the full grant date fair value of the restricted stock awards granted in 2011 calculated in accordance with the accounting guidance on share-based payments. Included in the 2011 grants are awards of RSUs that were subject to performance criteria, as further described in the "Grants of Plan-Based Awards" table below. Also included in these amounts are restricted shares granted to Mr. Susser in lieu of cash payments for his base salary and bonus for the applicable fiscal year, as further discussed in notes 5 and 6 to this table. These amounts reflect the stock price on the date of grant, but do not correspond to the actual value that may be recognized by the NEOs upon disposition of vested stock and do not give effect to any decline or increase in the trading price of its stock since the date of grant. Compensation cost is being recognized over the related vesting period in accordance with FASB ASC Topic 718.

(4)
The details of amounts listed as "All Other Compensation" are presented in the "All Other Compensation" table below.

(5)
Mr. Susser received $100,000 of his 2011 base salary in restricted stock instead of cash. The value of these shares of restricted stock is included in the stock awards column for 2011 above, and not

154


Table of Contents

      included in the salary column. These shares vest ratably on November 1, 2011, November 1, 2012 and November 1, 2013.

(6)
Sam L. Susser was granted a cash bonus for 2011 in the amount of $553,347, plus 11,196 shares of restricted stock on March 1, 2012 in recognition of SHC's performance for 2011. Shares vest ratably on November 1, 2012 and November 1, 2013. The fair value of the grant is $276,653, based on the closing price on the date of grant of $24.71 per share. The value of these shares of restricted stock are included in the stock awards column for 2011.


All Other Compensation

Name
  Year   Perquisites and
Other Personal
Benefits ($)(1)
  Company Contributions
to 401(k) and Deferred
Compensation Benefits
Plans ($)(2)
  Total  

Sam L. Susser

    2011     34,038     55,539     89,577  

Mary E. Sullivan

    2011         31,006     31,006  

E.V. Bonner, Jr. 

    2011         40,633     40,633  

Rocky B. Dewbre

    2011         30,377     30,377  

(1)
Perquisites and other personal benefits are included for each NEO only to the extent the aggregate value is equal to or greater than $10,000 in any year. For Sam L. Susser, perquisites consisted primarily of the estimated value of personal bookkeeping and secretarial services provided by Susser personnel ($34,038 in 2011) and the cost of annual health examinations.

(2)
Each of its NEOs is eligible to participate in a 401(k) plan that is generally available to all employees. Additionally, certain highly compensated employees, including its NEOs, are eligible to participate in its NQDC plan. The investment options in the NQDC plan mirror those available in its 401(k) plan, and do not contain any above-market or preferential earnings. SHC's contributions to the 401(k) and NQDC plans accrued for fiscal 2011 included a discretionary match of 80% on the first 6% of salary deferred in addition to the 20% guaranteed match.

155


Table of Contents


Grants of Plan-Based Awards
For Fiscal Year Ended January 1, 2012

 
   
   
   
  Estimated
Future
Payouts
Under
Equity
Incentive
Plan
Awards
   
   
   
   
 
 
   
   
   
   
  All Other
Option
Awards:
Number of
Securities
Underlying
Options
(#)
   
   
 
 
   
   
   
  All Other
Stock
Awards:
Number of
Shares of
Stock
(#)(2)
   
   
 
 
   
   
   
  Exercise
Price of
Option
Awards
($/Sh)
  Grant Date
Fair Value
of Stock
Awards
($)(3)
 
Name
  Type of Award(1)   Grant
Date
  Approval
Date
  Target
(#)(1)
 

Sam L. Susser

  Performance RSUs                              

  Restricted Stock Awards     3/1/2011     2/9/2011         52,526             709,626  

  Non-Qualified Options                              

Mary E. Sullivan

  Performance RSUs     3/1/2011     2/9/2011     6,733                 90,963  

  Restricted Stock Awards                              

  Non-Qualified Options                              

E.V. Bonner, Jr. 

  Performance RSUs     3/1/2011     2/9/2011     6,733                 90,963  

  Restricted Stock Awards                              

  Non-Qualified Options                              

Rocky B. Dewbre

  Performance RSUs     3/1/2011     2/9/2011     6,733                 90,963  

  Restricted Stock Awards                              

  Non-Qualified Options                              

(1)
Performance RSUs are Restricted Stock Units subject to performance criteria. The reported grant date fair value of the restricted stock unit award was determined based on the closing price of its stock on the grant date of $13.51. These grants were subject to performance criteria, in addition to time vesting requirements. The performance criteria for a portion of these has been deemed to have been met effective March 16, 2012 and are reflected in the table above. The RSUs vest over a 44 month period, vesting equally on November 1, 2012, November 1, 2013 and November 1, 2014.

(2)
The reported grant date fair value of the restricted stock award was determined based on the closing price of its stock on the grant date of $13.51. Mr. Susser received 15,518 shares of restricted stock as part of his 2010 bonus, which vest ratably on November 1, 2011 and November 1, 2012. The value of these shares is reflected in the summary compensation table as compensation for 2010. Included in Mr. Susser's 2011 compensation in the summary compensation table are 11,196 restricted shares with a grant date fair value of $276,653. These shares were granted in March 2012 as part of his 2011 bonus, and therefore are not reflected in the 2011 activity above. The other restricted shares vest ratably over three years on November 1, 2011, November 1, 2012 and November 1, 2013.

(3)
The reported grant date fair value of each stock award was determined in compliance with FASB ASC Topic 718 and are more fully described in Note 17—Share Based Compensation of SHC's Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements included in its Annual Report on Form 10-K, which is included in its 2011 Annual Report to Security Holders.

156


Table of Contents


Outstanding Equity Awards at January 1, 2012

 
   
   
   
   
  Stock Awards(1)  
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
  Equity
Incentive
Plan
Awards:
Market
or Payout
Value of
Unearned
Shares,
Units or
Other
Rights
That
Have Not
Vested
($) (2)
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
  Equity
Incentive
Plan
Awards:
Number
of
Unearned
Shares,
Units or
Other
Rights
That
Have Not
Vested
(#)
 
 
  Option Awards(1)    
   
 
Name
  Number of
Securities
Underlying
Exercisable
Options
(#)
  Number of
Securities
Underlying
Unexercised
Options (#)
Unexercisable
(#)
  Option
Exercise
Price
($)
  Option
Expiration
Date
  Number of
Shares or
Units
That Have
Not Vested
(#)
  Market Value
of Shares or
Units That
Have Not
Vested ($)
(2)
 

Sam L. Susser

                    2,500     56,550 (4)        

                    3,334     75,415 (5)        

                    2,500     56,550 (6)        

                    7,759     175,509 (9)        

                    24,672     558,081 (10)        

Mary E. Sullivan

    27,936 (3)   27,936 (3)   11.19     12/20/2015     1,334     30,175 (6)        

    2,596 (3)   2,596 (3)   11.19     3/1/2018     3,000     67,860 (7)        

                            3,000 (8)   67,860  

                            6,733 (11)   152,300  

E.V. Bonner, Jr. 

    27,936 (3)   27,936 (3)   11.19     12/20/2015     1,334     30,175 (6)        

    2,596 (3)   2,596 (3)   11.19     3/1/2018     3,000     67,860 (7)        

                            3,000 (8)   67,860  

                            6,733 (11)   152,300  

Rocky B. Dewbre

    27,936 (3)   27,936 (3)   11.19     12/20/2015     1,334     30,175 (6)        

    2,596 (3)   2,596 (3)   11.19     3/1/2018     3,000     67,860 (7)        

                            3,000 (8)   67,860  

                            6,733 (11)   152,300  

(1)
Reflects options, restricted stock and restricted stock units granted under the SHC Plan. The awards generally vest over a two to four year period. The option awards expire 10 years after date of grant. For additional information, refer to Note 17—Share Based Compensation of SHC's Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements included in its Annual Report on Form 10-K, which is included in its 2011 Annual Report to Security Holders.

(2)
Based on closing market price of $22.62 on December 30, 2011.

(3)
These options were granted related to the one-time option exchange program that was approved by Shareholders on May 26, 2010. Messrs. Bonner and Dewbre and Ms. Sullivan each tendered 85,531 options with an exercise price of $16.50 and 10,000 options with an exercise price of $24.22 in exchange for these new options. The unvested portion of these awards is scheduled to vest on September 30, 2012.

(4)
The unvested portion of this award is scheduled to vest on March 27, 2012.

(5)
The unvested portion of this award is scheduled to vest on February 29, 2012 and February 28, 2013.

(6)
The unvested portion of this award is scheduled to vest on March 3, 2012.

(7)
The unvested portion of this award is scheduled to vest on April 8, 2012, April 8, 2013 and April 8, 2014.

(8)
The performance criteria for this award was met as of March 18, 2011, and the unvested portion is scheduled to vest on November 1, 2012.

(9)
The unvested portion of this award is scheduled to vest on November 1, 2012.

(10)
The unvested portion of this award is scheduled to vest on November 1, 2012 and November 1, 2013.

(11)
The performance criteria for this award was met as of March 16, 2012, and the unvested portion is scheduled to vest in equal installments on November 1, 2012, November 1, 2013 and November 1, 2014.

157


Table of Contents


Option Exercises and Stock Vested

              The following table provides information regarding the vesting of restricted stock in SHC held by SHC's NEOs during 2011. No options have been exercised by any NEO.

 
  Stock Awards  
Name
  Number of
Shares
Acquired on
Vesting (#)
  Value Realized
on Vesting ($)(1)
 

Sam L. Susser

    26,761     513,872  

Mary E. Sullivan

    5,333     94,802  

E.V. Bonner, Jr. 

    5,333     94,802  

Rocky B. Dewbre

    5,333     94,802  

(1)
The reported value for this column is determined by multiplying number of vested shares by the closing price on the date of vesting.


Pension Benefits

              Other than its 401(k) and non-qualified deferred compensation plans described elsewhere in this document, SHC does not maintain any other plan that provides for payments or other benefits at, following or in connection with retirement.


Non-Qualified Deferred Compensation

              The following table provides information regarding contributions by SHC and each NEO participating in its non-qualified deferred compensation plan during 2011. The table also presents each NEO's earnings and year-end balances in the SHC Plan. SHC's non-qualified deferred compensation plan is described above in "Compensation Discussion and Analysis" under the caption "Perquisites and Other Benefits."

Name
  Executive
Contributions in 2011
($)(1)
  Registrant
Contributions in 2011
($)(2)
  Aggregate
Earnings in 2011
($)(3)
  Aggregate
Withdrawals/
Distributions
($)
  Aggregate
Balance at Last
Fiscal
Year-End ($)(4)
 

Sam L. Susser

    694,238     55,539     (75,010 )       2,257,060  

Mary E. Sullivan

    20,672     20,672     (4,171 )       161,456  

E.V. Bonner, Jr. 

    115,115     32,781     (5,730 )       465,875  

Rocky B. Dewbre

    20,253     20,253     (11,754 )       322,944  

(1)
The amounts shown reflect the executive's contributions to the NQDC plan during the fiscal year, and are included in the salary and incentive compensation numbers shown in the Summary Compensation Table.

(2)
The amounts included in this column reflect SHC's matching contributions to the NQDC plan, and are included within the amounts reported "All Other Compensation" for 2011 in the Summary Compensation Table.

(3)
Reflects net earnings/(losses) in each participant's plan account. These amounts do not constitute above market interest or preferential earnings, and, therefore, are not included in the summary compensation table above.

158


Table of Contents

(4)
The following table provides information regarding amounts reported in the aggregate balance at last fiscal year end that were previously reported as compensation to the NEOs in the Summary Compensation Table related to 2003 through 2010.

 
Name
  Previously Reported
Compensation ($)
 
 

Sam L. Susser

    1,211,588  
 

Mary E. Sullivan

    108,659  
 

E.V. Bonner, Jr. 

    272,651  
 

Rocky B. Dewbre

    272,839  


Potential Payments Upon Termination or Change of Control

              In addition to the termination and change of control provisions in SHC's employment agreements with its NEOs, each of its NEOs currently holds stock options and/or shares of restricted stock that have not vested. A number of these shares and options will vest immediately upon a change of control of SHC, irrespective of whether the employment of any NEO is terminated, and all vest upon the termination of the executive due to death or disability, as further discussed in the table below.

159


Table of Contents

              The following table shows the amount of incremental value that would have been received by each of the NEOs upon certain events of termination or a change of control of SHC on January 1, 2012:

Name
  Benefit   Termination Due
to Death or
Disability
($)(1)
  Termination by
Executive for
"Good Reason"
except Change of
Control, or by
Company Other
than for
"Cause"
($)(2)
  Change of Control
Followed by
Termination for
"Good Reason"
($)(3)
  Change of Control
with Continued
Employment
($)(4)
 

Sam L. Susser

  Salary         1,500,000     1,500,000      

  Health/Medical     13,146     40,691     40,691      

  Option Vesting                  

  Stock Vesting     922,104         922,104     339,300  

  Tax Gross-Up             528,091      

Mary E. Sullivan

 

Salary

   
   
463,892
   
463,892
   
 

  Health/Medical     4,800     22,800     22,800      

  Option Vesting     348,981         348,981     348,981  

  Stock Vesting     318,196         318,196     30,175  

  Tax Gross-Up                  

E.V. Bonner, Jr. 

 

Salary

   
   
607,920
   
607,920
   
 

  Health/Medical     10,200     33,600     33,600      

  Option Vesting     348,981         348,981     348,981  

  Stock Vesting     318,196         318,196     30,175  

  Tax Gross-Up                  

Rocky B. Dewbre

 

Salary

   
   
489,316
   
489,316
   
 

  Health/Medical     10,200     33,600     33,600      

  Option Vesting     348,981         348,981     348,981  

  Stock Vesting     318,196         318,196     30,175  

  Tax Gross-Up                  

(1)
Health care benefits do not continue upon an executive's disability; upon death, spouse and dependents of executives are entitled to continuation of health coverage for one year; amounts reflected represent portion of annualized premiums attributable to spouse/dependent coverage. Any unvested options or restricted stock fully vests upon death or disability. The amounts stated for option vesting represent the assumed cash value of the accelerated options derived by multiplying the difference between $22.62 (the closing price of its common stock on December 30, 2011) and the options' exercise prices, times the number of options. The amounts stated for stock vesting represent the product of the number of shares whose restrictions lapsed and $22.62.

(2)
Three times base salary for Mr. Susser and two times base salary for Ms. Sullivan and Messrs. Bonner and Dewbre. Amount of health care benefits represent 18 months of COBRA premiums, plus a cash payment representing 6 months of COBRA premiums, if the executive has not obtained coverage after such 18 month period. If any payment or benefit is determined to be subject to an excise tax under Section 4999 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, the executive is entitled to receive an additional payment (tax gross-up) to adjust for the incremental tax cost of the payment or benefit. An excise tax is not payable if the present value of the payments and benefits to be received is less than three times the average compensation for the prior five years.

160


Table of Contents

(3)
In the case an executive terminates employment for "good reason" related to a change of control event, in addition to any payments that would be due for salary and health care benefits, any unvested options or restricted stock would also fully vest. The amounts stated for option vesting represent the assumed cash value of the accelerated options derived by multiplying the difference between $22.62 (the closing price of its common stock on December 30, 2011) and the options' exercise prices, times the number of options. The amounts stated for stock vesting represent the product of the number of shares whose restrictions lapsed and $22.62. The present value of the benefit attributed to early vesting of options and restricted stock is included in the payments or benefits subject to potential excise tax under Section 4999 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.

(4)
Certain unvested options or restricted stock fully vest upon a change of control event for Messrs. Susser, Bonner and Dewbre and Ms. Sullivan. The amounts stated for option vesting represent the assumed cash value of the accelerated options derived by multiplying the difference between $22.62 (the closing price of its common stock on December 30, 2011) and the options' exercise prices, times the number of options. The amounts stated for stock vesting represent the product of the number of shares whose restrictions lapsed and $22.62. Certain of Messrs. Bonner and Dewbre and Ms. Sullivan restricted stock vest upon change of control only if the NEO does not retain his or her current position. The amounts reflected in the above table include only those options or restricted stock for which vesting acceleration occurs upon change of control without regard to continued employment.

              In the event an executive resigns for reasons other than death, disability or "good reason," its employment agreements do not provide for any special payments or benefits.

161


Table of Contents


SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT

              The following table sets forth the beneficial ownership of common units and subordinated units of Susser Petroleum Partners LP that will be issued and outstanding upon the consummation of this offering and the related transactions and held by:

    beneficial owners of 5% or more of our common units;

    each director, director nominee and named executive officer of our general partner; and

    all of our directors and executive officers of our general partner, as a group.

              The following table does not include any awards granted under the long-term incentive plan in connection with this offering or any common units that directors and executive officers may purchase in this offering through the directed unit program described under "Underwriting." Please read "Executive Officer Compensation—Compensation Discussion and Analysis."

Name of Beneficial Owner(1)
  Common
Units
Beneficially
Owned
  Percentage of
Common Units
Beneficially Owned
  Subordinated Units
Beneficially Owned
  Percentage of
Subordinated Units
Beneficially Owned
  Percentage of
Common and
Subordinated Units
Beneficially Owned
 

SHC(2)

      (3)     %         100 %     %

Sam L. Susser(4)

                               

E.V. Bonner, Jr. 

                     

Rocky B. Dewbre

                     

Mary E. Sullivan

                     

All executive officers and directors as a group (four persons)

         
%
       
%
 
%

(1)
As of the date of this prospectus, there are no arrangements for any listed beneficial owner to acquire within 60 days common units from options, warrants, rights, conversion privileges or similar obligations. Unless otherwise indicated, the address for all beneficial owners in this table is 555 East Airtex Drive, Houston, Texas 77073.

(2)
The address for SHC is 4525 Ayers Street, Corpus Christi, Texas 78415.

(3)
Of this amount,                        common units will be issued to SHC or a wholly owned subsidiary of SHC at the closing of this offering and up to                         common units will be issued to SHC or a wholly owned subsidiary of SHC within 30 days of this offering, assuming the underwriters do not exercise their option to purchase up to an additional                        common units. Please read "Summary—The Offering—Units outstanding after this offering."

(4)
In addition to serving as the chairman of our board of directors of our general partner, Mr. Susser is also a director of SHC, and as such, he is entitled to vote on decisions to vote, or to direct to vote, and to dispose, or to direct the disposition of, the common units and subordinated units held by SHC or a wholly owned subsidiary of SHC but he cannot individually control the outcome of such decisions. Mr. Susser disclaims beneficial ownership of the common units and subordinated units held by SHC or a wholly owned subsidiary of SHC.

              The following table sets forth, as of August 21, 2012, the number of shares of common stock of SHC owned by each of the named executive officers, directors and nominees to the board of directors of our general partner and all directors and executive officers of our general partner as a group.

Name and address of beneficial owner(1)
  Total
shares of
common
stock
beneficially
owned(2)
  Percentage
of total
shares of
common
stock
beneficially
owned(3)
 

Sam L. Susser(4)

    2,394,058     11.2 %

E.V. Bonner, Jr.(5)

    213,650     1.0 %

Rocky B. Dewbre

    125,502     *  

Mary E. Sullivan

    128,645     *  

All directors and executive officers as a group (four persons)

    2,861,855     13.4 %

*
Less than 1.0%

(1)
Unless otherwise indicated, the address for all beneficial owners in this table is 4525 Ayers Street, Corpus Christi, TX 78415.

162


Table of Contents

(2)
Beneficial ownership for the purposes of the above table is determined in accordance with the rules and regulation of the Securities and Exchange Commission. These rules generally provide that a person is the beneficial owner of securities if they have or share the power to vote or direct the voting thereof, or to dispose or direct the disposition thereof, or have the right to acquire such powers with sixty (60) days. Accordingly, this table does not include options to purchase our shares of common stock which are not scheduled to vest and become exercisable within the next sixty (60) days, or shares of restricted stock or shares underlying restricted stock units unless any performance criteria have been satisfied and all time-based restrictions associated therewith will lapse within the next sixty (60) days. The share numbers reflected in the table set forth above include shares actually owned as of August 21, 2012 plus 91,596 options to purchase common shares scheduled to vest within the next 60 days.

(3)
As of August 21, 2012, there were 21,296,683 shares of SHC common stock deemed to be beneficially owned for purposes of the above table.

(4)
The total number of shares of common stock includes shares held in trust in which Mr. Susser acts as Trustee. The address for Mr. Susser is P.O. Box 9036, Corpus Christi, TX 78469.

(5)
Includes 1,000 shares owned by Mr. Bonner's minor children.

              In addition to the unit ownership described above, members of our senior management have expressed an interest to the underwriters in participating in our directed unit program to purchase an aggregate of $         million in common units at the initial public offering price as follows: (Sam L. Susser: $         million; E.V. Bonner, Jr. $         million; Rocky B. Dewbre: $         million; Mary E. Sullivan: $         million); and we expect that other members of senior management will purchase approximately $         million of our common units. These amounts are initial indications of interest to the underwriters, and actual amounts purchased by these members of senior management remain subject to confirmation at the closing of this offering and may be withdrawn by such persons or amounts modified at their discretion based on market conditions or otherwise.

163


Table of Contents


CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS

              After this offering, assuming that the underwriters do not exercise their option to purchase additional common units, SHC will own, directly or indirectly,                        common units and                        subordinated units representing an aggregate approximately        % limited partner interest in us, and will own and control our general partner. SHC will also appoint all of the directors of our general partner, which will maintain a 0.0% non-economic general partner interest in us, and SHC will be issued the incentive distribution rights.

              The terms of the transactions and agreements disclosed in this section were determined by and among affiliated entities and, consequently, are not the result of arm's length negotiations. These terms are not necessarily at least as favorable to the parties to these transactions and agreements as the terms that could have been obtained from unaffiliated third parties.


Distributions and Payments to Our General Partner and Its Affiliates

              The following table summarizes the distributions and payments to be made by us to our general partner and its affiliates in connection with the formation, ongoing operation and any liquidation of Susser Petroleum Partners LP.

Formation Stage    

The aggregate consideration received by our general partner and its affiliates, including SHC, for the contribution of their interests

 

                        common units;

 

                        subordinated units;

 

0.0% non-economic general partner interest; and

 

our incentive distribution rights.


 

 

In addition, in connection with the completion of this offering, we will purchase approximately $147.3 million of U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities, which will be assigned as collateral to secure a new term loan that is fully guaranteed by SHC, and the proceeds from such term loan will be used to make a $147.3 million distribution to SHC or its affiliates.

Operational Stage

 

 

Distributions of available cash to SHC and its affiliates

 

We will generally make cash distributions to our unitholders, including affiliates of our general partner as the holders of an aggregate of                        common units and all of the subordinated units. In addition, if distributions exceed the minimum quarterly distribution and other higher target distribution levels, SHC (in its capacity as the holder of our incentive distribution rights) will be entitled to increasing percentages of the distributions, up to a maximum of 50.0% of the distributions above the highest target distribution level. Our general partner will not receive distributions on its non-economic general partner interest.

164


Table of Contents

    Assuming we have sufficient available cash to pay the full minimum quarterly distribution on all of our outstanding common units and subordinated units for four quarters, SHC and its affiliates would receive an annual distribution of approximately $             million on their common units and subordinated units.

Payments to our general partner and its affiliates

 

Our general partner will not receive a management fee or other compensation for its management of our partnership, but we will reimburse our general partner and its affiliates for all direct and indirect expenses they incur and payments they make on our behalf in connection with operating our business. Neither our partnership agreement nor the omnibus agreement will limit the amount of expenses for which our general partner and its affiliates may be reimbursed. Our partnership agreement provides that our general partner will determine in good faith the expenses that are allocable to us.

Withdrawal or removal of our general partner

 

If our general partner withdraws or is removed, its 0.0% non-economic general partner interest and its affiliates' incentive distribution rights will either be sold to the new general partner for cash or converted into common units, in each case for an amount equal to the fair market value of those interests. Please read "The Partnership Agreement—Withdrawal or Removal of Our General Partner."

Liquidation Stage

 

 

Liquidation

 

Upon our liquidation, the partners will be entitled to receive liquidating distributions according to their particular capital account balances.


Agreements with Affiliates in Connection with the Transactions

              In connection with this offering, certain other agreements with SHC will be contributed to us, as described in more detail below.

Contribution Agreement

              In connection with the completion of this offering, we will enter into a contribution agreement that will effect the formation transactions described herein, including the transfer of the ownership interests in Susser Operating and the use of the net proceeds of this offering. While we believe this agreement is on terms no less favorable to any party than those that could have been negotiated with an unaffiliated third party, it will not be the result of arm's-length negotiations. All of the transaction expenses incurred in connection with these transactions will be paid from the proceeds of this offering.

Omnibus Agreement

              In addition to the commercial agreements with SHC that will be contributed to us in connection with the completion of this offering, we will enter into an omnibus agreement with SHC, which is summarized below.

165


Table of Contents

      Option on 75 New or Recently Constructed Stripes® Convenience Stores.

              Pursuant to the omnibus agreement, among other things, SHC will grant us an option to acquire up to 75 new or recently constructed convenience stores and lease the stores back to SHC under a form lease agreement. Our option with respect to 15 stores will begin upon completion of this offering and expire on the first anniversary of the completion of this offering. Our option with respect to 25 additional stores will begin on the first anniversary of the completion of this offering and expire on the second anniversary of the completion of this offering. The option period with respect to the remaining 35 stores will begin on the second anniversary of the completion of this offering and expire on the third anniversary of the completion of this offering.

              Each store purchased and leased pursuant to the exercise of the sale and leaseback option will be (i) purchased by us at SHC's cost, including real estate and construction costs (as calculated consistently with SHC's prior practices, and pursuant to a certificate of cost delivered to us), and (ii) leased to SHC under a form lease agreement at an initial annual rate of 8% of the purchase price for an initial term of 15 years. In addition, any stores that we purchase and lease back to SHC will be added to the SHC Distribution Contract, pursuant to which we will be the exclusive distributor of motor fuel to the applicable stores for ten years from the time of purchase at cost plus a fixed profit margin of three cents per gallon.

              SHC will continue to operate the stores. SHC will have the option to extend the term of the lease of the stores for five consecutive five-year renewal terms. If SHC exercises its option to renew the lease on any store, the annual rent will increase by 15% for the first five-year renewal period, and by an additional 5% for each subsequent renewal period.

      Exclusivity on Substantially All Future Volumes Sold by SHC.

              Our omnibus agreement provides that, for a period of ten years, SHC is obligated to purchase from us any fuel it sells in the future for its own account (other than any acquired retail stores already party to an existing distribution agreement), and we are obligated to distribute such volumes to them, either at a negotiated rate or at cost plus the alternate fuel sales rate described further below. However, SHC will have a limited ability to remove Stripes® convenience stores and SHC's independently operated consignment locations from the SHC Distribution Contract after the closing of this offering. Specifically, the SHC Distribution Contract provides that SHC may remove an independently operated consignment location if the related contract is terminated and not renewed. In addition, the SHC Distribution Contract provides that SHC may sell or close a Stripes convenience store or convert the location to a third party consignment arrangement (where a third party, as opposed to SHC, sells the motor fuel to retail customers), provided that (a) the applicable location was supplied at our cost plus the alternate fuel sales rate, (b) SHC has agreed to substitute one or more locations comprising equivalent volumes at the same price per gallon charged for the removed Stripes® convenience store within                        of closure, sale or conversion, (c) SHC has received our consent for sale, closure or conversion or (d) such sale, closure or conversion does not cause the aggregate number of Stripes® convenience stores closed, sold or converted in any fiscal year to exceed 20 locations.

      Right to Distribute Fuel to SHC for Newly Constructed Stores and Independently Operated Consignment Locations.

              The omnibus agreement will also provide that, for a period of ten years, SHC will present to us a construction plan each year, which will include (i) the proposed fuel distribution terms for any new Stripes® convenience stores or consignment locations expected to be completed or added in the ordinary course of business in the upcoming year and (ii) any proposal for additional sale and leaseback transactions with respect to Stripes® convenience stores that are not subject to the 75 store option. We will negotiate with SHC to reach an agreement on the fuel distribution terms for future stores and consignment locations as well as the sale and leaseback terms, as applicable.

166


Table of Contents

      Right to Participate in Acquisitions.

              The omnibus agreement will also provide that, for a period of ten years, SHC will allow us to participate in its acquisition opportunities, to the extent we are able to reach an agreement on terms. Specifically, we will have a right to negotiate with SHC to acquire any distribution contracts and to negotiate the fuel supply terms for distributing fuel to any retail stores or independently operated consignment locations included in a potential acquisition under consideration by SHC, other than any retail stores already party to an existing supply agreement.

      Alternate Fuel Sales Rate.

              If we cannot agree with SHC on fuel supply terms for the expected future distribution volumes set forth in the annual construction plan pursuant to our right to participate in acquisition opportunities, or if we opt not to participate in an acquisition, the omnibus agreement will require us to distribute motor fuel to SHC's newly built, acquired or added retail stores or consignment locations at a price equal to our motor fuel cost plus the alternate fuel sales rate. The alternate fuel sales rate is a per gallon fee we will receive equal to our prior year per-gallon motor fuel distribution costs, excluding the cost of the motor fuel, plus 30% of such costs. Our motor fuel distribution costs include direct distribution expenses as well as general and administrative expenses, maintenance capital expenditures, franchise taxes and other miscellaneous costs. The alternate fuel sales rate in effect at the time we commence deliveries to a location will remain in effect for the balance of the ten-year term under the SHC Distribution Contract. However, under the omnibus agreement, the alternate fuel sales rate applicable to new delivery locations will reset annually, but the fixed fee included in the rate for a given year will be based on our motor fuel distribution costs for the immediately preceding year. Please read "Risk Factors—Risks Inherent in Our Business—If we cannot otherwise agree with SHC on fuel supply terms for volumes we sell to SHC in the future (other than for stores purchased by us pursuant to our sale and leaseback option), then we will be required to supply volumes at a price equal to our motor fuel cost plus the alternate fuel sales rate, which will be substantially less than the fixed profit margin of three cents per gallon we will receive for motor fuel sold pursuant to the SHC Distribution Contract. Furthermore, if certain of our operating costs increase, we may not realize our anticipated profit margin with regard to motor fuel distributed to SHC at the alternate fuel sales rate."

      Reimbursement for Services.

              Pursuant to the omnibus agreement, we will reimburse our general partner and its affiliates for the costs incurred in managing and operating us, including costs incurred in rendering corporate staff and support services. Our general partner will not receive a management fee or other compensation for its management of our partnership, but our partnership agreement and the omnibus agreement will require us to reimburse our general partner and its affiliates, including SHC, for all direct and indirect expenses they incur and payments they make on our behalf in connection with operating our business. Neither our partnership agreement nor the omnibus agreement will limit the amount of expenses for which our general partner and its affiliates may be reimbursed.

      Environmental Indemnification.

              The omnibus agreement will provide that SHC must indemnify us for any costs or expenses, up to $15 million and subject to a $250,000 deductible, that we incur for environmental liabilities and third-party claims that are based on environmental conditions in existence at our predecessor's properties prior to the closing of this offering. Other than with respect to liabilities resulting from SHC's bad faith or willful misconduct, we must indemnify SHC for any costs or expenses it incurs in connection with environmental liabilities and third-party claims that are based on environmental conditions that arise at our properties following the closing of this offering. The environmental indemnity provisions in the omnibus agreement will survive for three years following the closing of the offering.

167


Table of Contents

      Tax Indemnification.

              The omnibus agreement will provide that SHC must indemnify us for any costs or expenses that we incur for federal, state and local income tax liabilities attributable to the ownership and operation of the businesses and subsidiaries being contributed to us for the period prior to the closing of this offering, including (i) income tax liabilities that may result from the formation transactions, and (ii) any income tax liabilities arising under Treasury Regulation Section 1.1502-6 and similar provisions of applicable state, local or foreign law or by contract, as successor or transferee or otherwise. This indemnification obligation shall survive until the 60th day following the expiration of the applicable statute of limitations.

      Title Indemnification.

              The omnibus agreement will provide that SHC must indemnify us for any costs or expenses that we incur for losses resulting from defects in title to the assets contributed or sold to us in connection with the transactions contemplated by this offering and any failure to obtain, prior to the time they were contributed to us, certain consents and permits necessary to conduct our business. This indemnification obligation shall survive until the third anniversary of the closing of this offering.

      Indemnification with Regard to Permits.

              The omnibus agreement will provide that SHC must indemnify us for any costs or expenses that we incur for losses resulting from our predecessor's failure to have permits or governmental approvals necessary for us to operate our business in substantially the same manner as our predecessor operated such business prior to the closing of this offering. This indemnification obligation shall survive until the third anniversary of the closing of this offering.

SHC Distribution Contract

              In connection with this offering, the SHC Distribution Contract, a fuel distribution agreement with SHC and certain of its wholly owned subsidiaries, will be contributed to us. Pursuant to this agreement, we will be the exclusive distributor of (i) motor fuel to SHC's existing Stripes® convenience stores and independently operated consignment locations and to all future sites purchased by us pursuant to the sale and leaseback option described below, for a period of ten years at cost, including tax and transportation costs (as calculated consistently with SHC's prior practices), plus a fixed profit margin of three cents per gallon, and (ii) all other motor fuel volumes purchased by SHC for its own account. This contract will allow us to earn a margin on volumes that were historically sold to SHC at cost, as described above.

SHC Transportation Contract

              In connection with this offering, the SHC Transportation Contract, a ten-year transportation logistics agreement with certain wholly owned subsidiaries of SHC, will be contributed to us. Pursuant to this agreement, SHC will arrange for motor fuel to be delivered from our suppliers to our customers at rates consistent with those charged to third parties for the delivery of motor fuel, with such rates being entirely passed along to our customers, including SHC.


Other Transactions with Related Persons

Our Predecessor's Sales to Affiliates and Predecessor Transactions with Certain Officers and Directors

              We have historically engaged in certain transactions with other subsidiaries of SHC, including the wholesale distribution of motor fuel and other petroleum products to such affiliates. These transactions include sales of motor fuel to Stripes'® retail stores, which we have historically provided at cost, including tax and transportation costs. For the years ended December 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011,

168


Table of Contents

approximately 58.8%, 59.9% and 60.2% of our total motor fuel gallons sold were sales to SHC's other subsidiaries.

              SPC leases two dealer sites from Sam L. Susser, the Chief Executive Officer of SHC and our general partner. The leases are classified as operating leases and provide for minimum annual rentals of approximately $0.2 million in 2012 through 2016. The lease expiration dates with the exercise of all options range from 2050 to 2051. These dealer sites will not be contributed to us in connection with this offering.

Financing Transactions with Affiliates

              In connection with the completion of this offering, we will purchase approximately $147.3 million of U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities, which will be assigned as collateral to secure a new term loan that will be fully guaranteed by SHC, and the proceeds from such loan will be used to make a $147.3 million distribution to SHC or its affiliates.

              In addition, SHC will provide credit support to our suppliers under certain of our supply contracts, provided that the pricing of such support is no more than the cost to us of issuing a comparable letter of credit under our revolving credit facility.

              In connection with this offering, Messrs. Susser, Dewbre and Bonner, Jr. and Ms. Sullivan, in addition to certain other persons who are directors, employees or officers of our general partner or who are otherwise associated with us, will purchase            common units pursuant to our directed unit program. Messrs. Susser, Dewbre and Bonner, Jr. and Ms. Sullivan may each purchase units with a value in excess of $        in our directed unit program. Please read "Underwriting."

Procedures for Review, Approval and Ratification of Transactions with Related Persons

              We expect that the board of directors of our general partner will adopt policies for the review, approval and ratification of transactions with related persons. We anticipate the board will adopt a written code of business conduct and ethics, under which a director would be expected to bring to the attention of the chief executive officer or the board any conflict or potential conflict of interest that may arise between the director or any affiliate of the director, on the one hand, and us or our general partner on the other. The resolution of any such conflict or potential conflict should, at the discretion of the board in light of the circumstances, be determined by a majority of the disinterested directors.

              If a conflict or potential conflict of interest arises between our general partner or its affiliates, on the one hand, and us and our limited partners, on the other hand, the resolution of any such conflict or potential conflict should be addressed by the board in accordance with the provisions of our partnership agreement. At the discretion of the board in light of the circumstances, the resolution may be determined by the board in its entirety or by a conflicts committee meeting the definitional requirements for such a committee under our partnership agreement.

              Upon our adoption of our code of business conduct, we would expect that any executive officer will be required to avoid conflicts of interest unless approved by the board of directors.

              In the case of any sale of equity by us in which an owner or affiliate of an owner of our general partner participates, we anticipate that our practice will be to obtain approval of the board for the transaction. We anticipate that the board will typically delegate authority to set the specific terms to a pricing committee, consisting of the chief executive officer and one independent director. Actions by the pricing committee will require unanimous approval. Please read "Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties—Conflicts of Interest" for additional information regarding the relevant provisions of our partnership agreement.

              The code of business conduct and ethics described above will be adopted in connection with the completion of this offering, and as a result the transactions described above were not reviewed according to such procedures.

169


Table of Contents


CONFLICTS OF INTEREST AND FIDUCIARY DUTIES

Conflicts of Interest

              Conflicts of interest exist and may arise in the future as a result of the relationships between our general partner and its affiliates, including SHC, on the one hand, and us and our public unitholders, on the other hand. Conflicts may arise as a result of the duties of our general partner to act for the benefit of its owners, which may conflict with our interests and the interests of our public unitholders. The directors and officers of our general partner, who are responsible for managing our business, have fiduciary duties to manage our general partner in a manner beneficial to its owners. At the same time, our general partner has a duty under our partnership agreement to manage us in good faith.

              Whenever a conflict arises between our general partner, on the one hand, and us or any other public unitholder, on the other, our general partner will resolve that conflict. Our partnership agreement contains provisions that replace default fiduciary duties under applicable law with contractual corporate governance standards as set forth therein. Our partnership agreement also restricts the remedies available to unitholders for actions taken that, without such replacement, might constitute breaches of fiduciary duty.

              Our general partner will not be in breach of its obligations under our partnership agreement or its duties to us or our unitholders if the resolution or course of action taken with respect to a conflict is:

    approved by a majority of the members of the conflicts committee of the board of directors of our general partner, although our general partner is not obligated to seek such approval; or

    approved by the vote of a majority of the outstanding common units, excluding any units owned by the general partner or any of its affiliates, although our general partner is not obligated to seek such approval.

              Our general partner may, but is not required to, seek the approval of such resolution from the conflicts committee of its board of directors or from the common unitholders. Because our partnership agreement only requires that the conflicts committee have at least one member, during any time that the committee only has one member, that single member of the conflicts committee will be able to approve resolutions of conflicts of interest. It is possible that a single-member committee may not function as effectively as a multiple-member committee and, if we pursue a transaction with an affiliate while the conflicts committee has only one member, our limited partners will be deemed to have approved that transaction through the approval of that single-member committee, in the same manner as would have occurred had the committee consisted of more directors.

              If our general partner does not seek approval from the conflicts committee or from a majority of the common units, as described above, and the board of directors of our general partner approves the resolution or course of action taken with respect to the conflict of interest, then it will be presumed that, in making its decision, the board of directors of our general partner acted in good faith, and in any proceeding brought by or on behalf of any limited partner or the partnership, the person bringing or prosecuting such proceeding will have the burden of overcoming such presumption. Unless the resolution of a conflict is specifically provided for in our partnership agreement, the board of directors of our general partner or the conflicts committee of the board of directors of our general partner may consider any factors they determine in good faith to consider when resolving a conflict. An independent third party is not required to evaluate the resolution. Under our partnership agreement, a determination, other action or failure to act by our general partner, the board of directors of our general partner or any committee thereof (including the conflicts committee) will be deemed to be "in good faith" unless our general partner, the board of directors of our general partner or any committee thereof (including the conflicts committee) believed such determination, other action or failure to act was adverse to the interests of the partnership. For the avoidance of doubt, any potential conflict of

170


Table of Contents

interest that exists or arises between our general partner or its affiliates, on the one hand, and the partnership or any other person who is bound by the partnership agreement on the other hand, may be resolved by the conflicts committee or a vote of the common unitholders as described above or as directed by the board of directors of our general partner, provided that the board of directors of the general partner makes, takes or declines to take any action to resolve the conflict in accordance with the standard of care set forth in the partnership agreement. Please read "Management—Committees of the Board of Directors" for information about the conflicts committee of our general partner's board of directors.

              Conflicts of interest could arise in the situations described below, among others.

Our general partner's affiliates may compete with us.

              Our partnership agreement provides that our general partner will be restricted from engaging in any business activities other than acting as our general partner, acting as the general partner or managing member of its affiliates, those activities incidental to its ownership of interests in us and its affiliates, acquiring, owning or disposing of debt securities or equity interests in us or its affiliates and the provision of management, advisory and administrative services to its affiliates or to other persons. Certain members of our executive management team on whom we rely to manage important aspects of our business may, from time to time, face conflicts regarding the allocation of their time. In addition, except as provided in our partnership agreement and in the omnibus agreement, affiliates of our general partner, including SHC, are not prohibited from engaging in other businesses or activities, including those that might be in direct competition with us. Further, after the expiration of the ten-year terms in the omnibus agreement, SHC will no longer be obligated to provide us with a right to supply fuel at newly constructed Stripes ® stores or consignment locations or with a right to participate with SHC in acquisition opportunities.

Affiliates of our general partner, including SHC, are not required to share business opportunities with us.

              Our partnership agreement provides that affiliates of our general partner, including SHC, are permitted to engage in separate businesses which directly compete with us and are not required to share or communicate or offer any potential business opportunities to us even if the opportunity is one that we might reasonably have pursued. The partnership agreement provides that affiliates of our general partner, including SHC, will not be liable to us or any unitholder for breach of any duty or obligation by reason of the fact that such person or entity pursued or acquired for itself any business opportunity.

Our general partner is allowed to take into account the interests of parties other than us (such as SHC) in exercising certain rights under our partnership agreement.

              Our partnership agreement contains provisions that reduce the default standards to which our general partner would otherwise be held by state fiduciary duty law. For example, our partnership agreement permits our general partner to make a number of decisions in its individual capacity, as opposed to in its capacity as our general partner. This entitles our general partner to consider only the interests and factors that it desires, and it has no duty or obligation to give any consideration to any interest of, or factors affecting, us, our affiliates or any limited partner. Examples include the exercise of its call right, its voting rights with respect to the units it owns, its registration rights and the determination of whether to consent to any merger or consolidation of the partnership or amendment of the partnership agreement.

171


Table of Contents

Our general partner has limited its liability in the partnership agreement and replaced default fiduciary duties with contractual corporate governance standards set forth therein, thereby restricting the remedies available to our unitholders for actions that, without such replacement, might constitute breaches of fiduciary duty.

              In addition to the provisions described above, our partnership agreement contains provisions that restrict the remedies available to our unitholders for actions that might otherwise constitute breaches of fiduciary duty. For example, our partnership agreement:

    permits our general partner to make a number of decisions in its individual capacity, as opposed to its capacity as general partner, thereby entitling our general partner to consider only the interests and factors that it desires, and imposes no duty or obligation on our general partner to give any consideration to any interest of, or factors affecting, us, our affiliates or any limited partner;

    provides that our general partner shall not have any liability to us or our unitholders for decisions made in its capacity as general partner so long as it acted in good faith, meaning it believed that the decision was not adverse to the partnership;

    provides that our general partner and its officers and directors will not be liable for monetary damages to us or our limited partners for any acts or omissions unless there has been a final and non-appealable judgment entered by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that the general partner or its officers or directors acted in bad faith or, in the case of a criminal matter, acted with knowledge that the conduct was criminal; and

    provides that in resolving conflicts of interest, it will be presumed that in making its decision the general partner, the board of directors of the general partner or the conflicts committee of the board of directors of our general partner acted in good faith, and in any proceeding brought by or on behalf of any limited partner or us, the person bringing or prosecuting such proceeding will have the burden of overcoming such presumption.

              By purchasing a common unit, a common unitholder will agree to become bound by the provisions in our partnership agreement, including the provisions discussed above. Please read "—Fiduciary Duties."

Except in limited circumstances, our general partner has the power and authority to conduct our business without unitholder approval.

              Under our partnership agreement, our general partner has full power and authority to do all things, other than those items that require unitholder approval or with respect to which our general partner has sought conflicts committee approval, on such terms as it determines to be necessary or appropriate to conduct our business including, but not limited to, the following:

    the making of any expenditures, the lending or borrowing of money, the assumption or guarantee of or other contracting for, indebtedness and other liabilities, the issuance of evidences of indebtedness, including indebtedness that is convertible into our securities, and the incurring of any other obligations;

    the purchase, sale or other acquisition or disposition of our securities, or the issuance of additional options, rights, warrants and appreciation rights relating to our securities;

    the acquisition, disposition, mortgage, pledge, encumbrance, hypothecation or exchange of any or all of our assets;

    the negotiation, execution and performance of any contracts, conveyances or other instruments;

    the exercise of our option pursuant to the omnibus agreement to purchase up to 75 new or recently completed Stripes ® convenience stores from SHC and lease them back to SHC;

    the distribution of our cash;

172


Table of Contents

    the selection and dismissal of employees and agents, outside attorneys, accountants, consultants and contractors and the determination of their compensation and other terms of employment or hiring;

    the maintenance of insurance for our benefit and the benefit of our partners;

    the formation of, or acquisition of an interest in, the contribution of property to, and the making of loans to, any limited or general partnership, joint venture, corporation, limited liability company or other entity;

    the control of any matters affecting our rights and obligations, including the bringing and defending of actions at law or in equity, otherwise engaging in the conduct of litigation, arbitration or mediation and the incurring of legal expense and the settlement of claims and litigation;

    the indemnification of any person against liabilities and contingencies to the extent permitted by law;

    the making of tax, regulatory and other filings, or the rendering of periodic or other reports to governmental or other agencies having jurisdiction over our business or assets; and

    the entering into of agreements with any of its affiliates to render services to us or to itself in the discharge of its duties as our general partner.

              Our partnership agreement provides that our general partner must act in "good faith" when making decisions on our behalf, and our partnership agreement further provides that in order for a determination to be made in "good faith," our general partner must believe that the determination is in our best interests. Please read "The Partnership Agreement—Voting Rights" for information regarding matters that require unitholder approval.

Our general partner determines the amount and timing of asset purchases and sales, capital expenditures, borrowings, issuances of additional partnership securities and the creation, reduction or increase of reserves, each of which can affect the amount of cash that is distributed to our unitholders.

              The amount of cash that is available for distribution to our unitholders is affected by decisions of our general partner regarding such matters as:

    amount and timing of asset purchases and sales;

    cash expenditures;

    borrowings;

    issuance of additional units; and

    the creation, reduction, or increase of reserves in any quarter.

              Our general partner determines the amount and timing of any capital expenditures and whether a capital expenditure is classified as a maintenance capital expenditure, which reduces operating surplus, or an expansion capital expenditure, which does not reduce operating surplus. Please read "Provisions of Our Partnership Agreement Relating to Cash Distributions—Capital Expenditures" for a discussion on when a capital expenditure constitutes a maintenance capital expenditure or an expansion capital expenditure. This determination can affect the amount of cash that is distributed to our unitholders and to our general partner and the ability of the subordinated units to convert. Please read "Provisions of Our Partnership Agreement Relating to Cash Distributions—Subordinated Units."

              In addition, our general partner may use an amount, initially equal to $             million, which would not otherwise constitute available cash from operating surplus, in order to permit the payment of cash distributions on its units and SHC's incentive distribution rights. All of these actions may affect the amount of cash distributed to our unitholders and our general partner and may facilitate the

173


Table of Contents

conversion of subordinated units into common units. Please read "Provisions of Our Partnership Agreement Relating to Cash Distributions."

              In addition, borrowings by us and our affiliates do not constitute a breach of any duty owed by our general partner to our unitholders, including borrowings that have the purpose or effect of:

    enabling our general partner or its affiliates to receive distributions on any subordinated units held by them or the incentive distribution rights; or

    accelerating the expiration of the subordination period.

              For example, in the event we have not generated sufficient cash from our operations to pay the minimum quarterly distribution on our common and subordinated units, our partnership agreement permits us to borrow funds, which would enable us to make this distribution on all of our outstanding units. Please read "Provisions of Our Partnership Agreement Relating to Cash Distributions—Subordinated Units."

              Our partnership agreement provides that we and our subsidiaries may borrow funds from our general partner and its affiliates. Our general partner and its affiliates may borrow funds from us, or our operating company and its operating subsidiaries.

Our general partner and its affiliates are not required to own any of our common units. If our general partner's affiliates were to sell all or substantially all of their common units, this would heighten the risk that our general partner would act in ways that are more beneficial to itself than our common unitholders.

              Upon the closing of this offering, affiliates of our general partner will own a majority of our outstanding units, but there is no requirement that they continue to do so. SHC and its affiliates are permitted to sell all of their common units, subject to certain limitations contained in our partnership agreement. If SHC does not own any of our common units, this would heighten the risk that our general partner would act in ways that are more beneficial to SHC than our common unitholders.

Our general partner determines which of the costs it incurs on our behalf are reimbursable by us.

              We will reimburse our general partner and its affiliates for the costs incurred in managing and operating us, including costs incurred in rendering corporate staff and support services to us pursuant to an omnibus agreement with SHC. Neither our partnership agreement nor the omnibus agreement will limit the amount of expenses for which our general partner and its affiliates may be reimbursed. Our partnership agreement provides that our general partner will determine in good faith such other expenses that are allocable to us. The fully allocated basis charged by our general partner does not include a profit component. Please read "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions."

Our partnership agreement does not restrict our general partner from causing us to pay it or its affiliates for any services rendered to us or from entering into additional contractual arrangements with any of these entities on our behalf.

              Our partnership agreement allows our general partner to determine, in good faith, any amounts to pay itself or its affiliates for any services rendered to us. Our general partner may also enter into additional contractual arrangements with any of its affiliates on our behalf. Neither our partnership agreement nor any of the other agreements, contracts or arrangements between us, on the one hand, and our general partner and its affiliates, on the other hand, that will be in effect as of the closing of this offering, will be the result of arm's-length negotiations. Similarly, agreements, contracts or arrangements between us and our general partner and its affiliates that are entered into following the closing of this offering may not be negotiated on an arm's-length basis, although, in some circumstances, our general partner may determine that the conflicts committee of our general partner may make a determination on our behalf with respect to such arrangements.

              Our general partner will determine, in good faith, the terms of any such transactions entered into after the closing of this offering.

174


Table of Contents

              Our general partner and its affiliates will have no obligation to permit us to use any of its or its affiliates' facilities or assets, except as may be provided in contracts entered into specifically for such use. There is no obligation of our general partner or its affiliates to enter into any contracts of this kind.

Our general partner intends to limit its liability regarding our obligations.

              Except in the case of our new credit facilities, our general partner intends to limit its liability under contractual arrangements so that counterparties to such arrangements have recourse only against our assets, and not against our general partner or its assets. Our partnership agreement provides that any action taken by our general partner to limit its liability is not a breach of our general partner's fiduciary duties, even if we could have obtained more favorable terms without the limitation on liability.

Common units are subject to our general partner's call right.

              If at any time our general partner and its affiliates own more than 80% of the common units, our general partner will have the right, which it may assign to any of its affiliates or to us, but not the obligation, to acquire all, but not less than all, of the common units held by public unitholders at a price not less than their then-current market price, as calculated pursuant to the terms of our partnership agreement. As a result, you may be required to sell your common units at an undesirable time or price and may not receive any return on your investment. You may also incur a tax liability upon a sale of your common units. Our general partner is not obligated to obtain a fairness opinion regarding the value of the common units to be repurchased by it upon exercise of the call right. There is no restriction in our partnership agreement that prevents our manager from issuing additional common units and exercising its call right. Our general partner may use its own discretion, free of fiduciary duty restrictions, in determining whether to exercise this right. See "The Partnership Agreement—Limited Call Right."

Common unitholders will have no right to enforce obligations of our general partner and its affiliates under agreements with us.

              Any agreements between us, on the one hand, and our general partner and its affiliates, on the other, will not grant to the unitholders, separate and apart from us, the right to enforce the obligations of our general partner and its affiliates in our favor.

Our general partner decides whether to retain separate counsel, accountants or others to perform services for us.

              The attorneys, independent accountants and others who have performed services for us regarding this offering have been retained by our general partner. Attorneys, independent accountants and others who perform services for us are selected by our general partner or the conflicts committee and may perform services for our general partner and its affiliates. We may retain separate counsel for ourselves or the common unitholders in the event of a conflict of interest between our general partner and its affiliates, on the one hand, and us or the common unitholders, on the other, depending on the nature of the conflict. We do not intend to do so in most cases.

SHC may elect to cause us to issue common units to it in connection with a resetting of the target distribution levels related to SHC's incentive distribution rights without the approval of the conflicts committee of the board of directors of our general partner or our unitholders. This election may result in lower distributions to our common unitholders in certain situations.

              SHC has the right, at any time when there are no subordinated units outstanding and it has received incentive distributions at the highest level to which it is entitled (50.0%) for the prior four consecutive fiscal quarters, to reset the initial target distribution levels at higher levels based on our cash distribution at the time of the exercise of the reset election. Following a reset election by SHC, the minimum quarterly distribution will be reset to an amount equal to the average cash distribution

175


Table of Contents

per common unit for the two fiscal quarters immediately preceding the reset election (such amount is referred to as the "reset minimum quarterly distribution"), and the target distribution levels will be reset to correspondingly higher levels based on percentage increases above the reset minimum quarterly distribution.

              We anticipate that SHC would exercise this reset right in order to facilitate acquisitions or internal growth projects that would not be sufficiently accretive to cash distributions per common unit without such conversion; however, it is possible that SHC could exercise this reset election at a time when we are experiencing declines in our aggregate cash distributions or at a time when SHC expects that we will experience declines in our aggregate cash distributions in the foreseeable future. In such situations, SHC may be experiencing, or may expect to experience, declines in the cash distributions it receives related to its incentive distribution rights and may therefore desire to be issued our common units, which are entitled to specified priorities with respect to our distributions and which therefore may be more advantageous for SHC to own in lieu of the right to receive incentive distribution payments based on target distribution levels that are less certain to be achieved in the then current business environment. As a result, a reset election may cause our common unitholders to experience dilution in the amount of cash distributions that they would have otherwise received had we not issued new common units to SHC in connection with resetting the target distribution levels related to SHC's incentive distribution rights. Please read "Provisions of Our Partnership Agreement Relating to Cash Distributions—Incentive Distribution Rights."


Fiduciary Duties

              Our general partner is accountable to us and our unitholders as a fiduciary. Fiduciary duties owed to unitholders by our general partner are prescribed by law and our partnership agreement. The Delaware Act provides that Delaware limited partnerships may, in their partnership agreements, modify, restrict or expand the fiduciary duties otherwise owed by a general partner to limited partners and the partnership.

              Our partnership agreement contains various provisions modifying and restricting the fiduciary duties that might otherwise be owed by our general partner. We have adopted these restrictions to allow our general partner or its affiliates to engage in transactions with us that would otherwise be prohibited by state-law fiduciary duty standards and to take into account the interests of other parties in addition to our interests when resolving conflicts of interest. We believe this is appropriate and necessary because our general partner's board of directors will have fiduciary duties to manage our general partner in a manner that is beneficial to its owners, as well as to our unitholders. Without these modifications, our general partner's ability to make decisions involving conflicts of interest would be restricted. The modifications to the fiduciary standards enable our general partner to take into consideration all parties involved in the proposed action. These modifications also enable our general partner to attract and retain experienced and capable directors. However, these modifications disadvantage our public common unitholders because they restrict the remedies available to unitholders for actions that, without those limitations, might constitute breaches of fiduciary duty, as described below, and permit our general partner to take into account the interests of third parties in addition to our interests when resolving conflicts of interest. The following is a summary of the material restrictions of:

    the default fiduciary duties under by the Delaware Act;

    material modifications of these duties contained in our partnership agreement that replace the default fiduciary duties;

    certain rights and remedies of limited partners contained in the Delaware Act; and

    the standards contained in our partnership agreement that restrict those rights and remedies.

176


Table of Contents

State law fiduciary duty standards   Fiduciary duties are generally considered to include an obligation to act in good faith and with due care and loyalty. The duty of care, in the absence of a provision in a partnership agreement providing otherwise, would generally require a general partner to act for the partnership in the same manner as a prudent person would act on his own behalf. The duty of loyalty, in the absence of a provision in a partnership agreement providing otherwise, would generally require that any action taken or transaction engaged in be entirely fair to the partnership.
Partnership agreement modified standards   Our partnership agreement contains provisions that waive or consent to conduct by our general partner and its affiliates that might otherwise raise issues about compliance with fiduciary duties or applicable law. For example, our partnership agreement provides that when our general partner is acting in its capacity as our general partner, as opposed to in its individual capacity, it must act in "good faith" and will not be subject to any other standard under applicable law. In addition, when our general partner is acting in its individual capacity, as opposed to in its capacity as our general partner, it may act without any fiduciary obligation to us or the unitholders whatsoever. These standards reduce the obligations to which our general partner would otherwise be held.
    If our general partner does not obtain approval from the conflicts committee or our common unitholders, excluding common units owned by our general partner or its affiliates, and the board of directors of our general partner approves the resolution or course of action taken with respect to the conflict of interest, then it will be presumed that, in making its decision, the board of directors, which may include board members affected by the conflict of interest, acted in good faith, and in any proceeding brought by or on behalf of any limited partner or the partnership, the person bringing or prosecuting such proceeding will have the burden of overcoming such presumption. These standards reduce the obligations to which our general partner would otherwise be held.
Rights and remedies of unitholders   The Delaware Act generally provides that a limited partner may institute legal action on behalf of the partnership to recover damages from a third party where a general partner has refused to institute the action or where an effort to cause a general partner to do so is not likely to succeed. These actions include actions against a general partner for breach of its fiduciary duties or of our partnership agreement. In addition, the statutory or case law of some jurisdictions may permit a limited partner to institute legal action on behalf of himself and all other similarly situated limited partners to recover damages from a general partner for violations of its fiduciary duties to the limited partners.

177


Table of Contents

    The Delaware Act provides that, unless otherwise provided in a partnership agreement, a partner or other person shall not be liable to a limited partnership or to another partner or to another person that is a party to or is otherwise bound by a partnership agreement for breach of fiduciary duty for the partner's or other person's good faith reliance on the provisions of the partnership agreement. Under our partnership agreement, to the extent that, at law or in equity an indemnitee has duties (including fiduciary duties) and liabilities relating thereto to us or to our partners, our general partner and any other indemnitee acting in connection with our business or affairs shall not be liable to us or to any partner for its good faith reliance on the provisions of our partnership agreement.
Partnership agreement modified standard   In addition to the other more specific provisions limiting the obligations of our general partner, our partnership agreement further provides that our general partner and its officers and directors will not be liable for monetary damages to us or our limited partners for errors of judgment or for any acts or omissions unless there has been a final and non-appealable judgment by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that our general partner or its officers and directors acted in bad faith or, in the case of a criminal matter, acted with knowledge that such person's conduct was unlawful.

              By purchasing our common units, each common unitholder automatically agrees to be bound by the provisions in our partnership agreement, including the provisions discussed above. This is in accordance with the policy of the Delaware Act favoring the principle of freedom of contract and the enforceability of partnership agreements. The failure of a limited partner to sign a partnership agreement does not render the partnership agreement unenforceable against that person.

              Under our partnership agreement, we must indemnify our general partner and its officers, directors, managers and certain other specified persons, to the fullest extent permitted by law, against liabilities, costs and expenses incurred by our general partner or these other persons. We must provide this indemnification unless there has been a final and non-appealable judgment by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that these persons acted in bad faith. We must also provide this indemnification for criminal proceedings unless our general partner or these other persons acted with knowledge that their conduct was unlawful. Thus, our general partner or these other persons could be indemnified for their negligent or grossly negligent acts if they meet the requirements set forth above. To the extent these provisions purport to include indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act in the opinion of the SEC, such indemnification is contrary to public policy and, therefore, unenforceable. Please read "The Partnership Agreement—Indemnification."

178


Table of Contents


DESCRIPTION OF THE COMMON UNITS

The Units

              The common units and the subordinated units are separate classes of units representing limited partner interests in us. The holders of units are entitled to participate in partnership distributions and exercise the rights or privileges available to limited partners under our partnership agreement. For a description of the relative rights and preferences of holders of common units and subordinated units in and to partnership distributions, please read this section and "Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions." For a description of other rights and privileges of limited partners under our partnership agreement, including voting rights, please read "The Partnership Agreement."


Transfer Agent and Registrar

Duties

              Computershare Trust Company, N.A. will serve as the registrar and transfer agent for the common units. We will pay all fees charged by the transfer agent for transfers of common units except the following, which must be paid by unitholders:

    surety bond premiums to replace lost or stolen certificates, taxes and other governmental charges;

    special charges for services requested by a holder of a common unit; and

    other similar fees or charges.

              There will be no charge to unitholders for disbursements of our cash distributions. We will indemnify the transfer agent, its agents and each of their stockholders, directors, officers and employees against all claims and losses that may arise out of acts performed or omitted for its activities in that capacity, except for any liability due to any gross negligence or intentional misconduct of the indemnified person or entity.

Resignation or Removal

              The transfer agent may resign, by notice to us, or be removed by us. The resignation or removal of the transfer agent will become effective upon our appointment of a successor transfer agent and registrar and its acceptance of the appointment. If no successor is appointed, our general partner may act as the transfer agent and registrar until a successor is appointed.


Transfer of Common Units

              Upon the transfer of a common unit in accordance with our partnership agreement, the transferee of the common unit shall be admitted as a limited partner with respect to the common units transferred when such transfer and admission are reflected in our books and records. Each transferee:

    represents that the transferee has the capacity, power and authority to become bound by our partnership agreement;

    automatically becomes bound by the terms and conditions of, and is deemed to have executed, our partnership agreement; and

    gives the consents, waivers and approvals contained in our partnership agreement, such as the approval of all transactions and agreements that we are entering into in connection with our formation and this offering.

              Our general partner will cause any transfers to be recorded on our books and records no less frequently than quarterly.

179


Table of Contents

              We may, at our discretion, treat the nominee holder of a common unit as the absolute owner. In that case, the beneficial holder's rights are limited solely to those that it has against the nominee holder as a result of any agreement between the beneficial owner and the nominee holder.

              Common units are securities and any transfers are subject to the laws governing the transfer of securities. In addition to other rights acquired upon transfer, the transferor gives the transferee the right to become a substituted limited partner in our partnership for the transferred common units.

              Until a common unit has been transferred on our books, we and the transfer agent may treat the record holder of the common unit as the absolute owner for all purposes, except as otherwise required by law or stock exchange regulations.

180


Table of Contents


THE PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT

              The following is a summary of the material provisions of our partnership agreement. The form of our partnership agreement is included in this prospectus as Appendix A. We will provide prospective investors with a copy of our partnership agreement upon request at no charge.

              We summarize the following provisions of our partnership agreement elsewhere in this prospectus:

    with regard to distributions of available cash, please read "Provisions of Our Partnership Agreement Relating to Cash Distributions";

    with regard to the fiduciary duties of our general partner, please read "Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties";

    with regard to the authority of our general partner to manage our business and activities, please read "Management—Management of Susser Petroleum Partners LP";

    with regard to the transfer of common units, please read "Description of the Common Units—Transfer of Common Units"; and

    with regard to allocations of taxable income and taxable loss, please read "Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences."


Organization and Duration

              Our partnership was organized in June 2012 and will have a perpetual existence unless terminated pursuant to the terms of our partnership agreement.


Purpose

              Our purpose, as set forth in our partnership agreement, is limited to any business activity that is approved by our general partner and that lawfully may be conducted by a limited partnership organized under Delaware law.

              Although our general partner has the ability to cause us and our subsidiaries to engage in activities other than the business of the wholesale distribution of motor fuels and other petroleum products and the owning and leasing of real estate used as sites for convenience stores, our general partner has no plans to do so and may decline to do so free of any fiduciary duty or obligation whatsoever to us or our limited partners, including any duty to act in good faith or in the best interests of us or our limited partners. Our general partner is generally authorized to perform all acts it determines to be necessary or appropriate to carry out our purposes and to conduct our business.


Cash Distributions

              Our partnership agreement specifies the manner in which we will make cash distributions to holders of our common units and other partnership securities as well as to SHC in respect of incentive distribution rights. For a description of these cash distribution provisions, please read "Provisions of Our Partnership Agreement Relating to Cash Distributions."


Capital Contributions

              Unitholders are not obligated to make additional capital contributions, except as described below under "—Limited Liability."

181


Table of Contents


Voting Rights

              The following is a summary of the unitholder vote required for approval of the matters specified below. Matters that require the approval of a "unit majority" require:

    during the subordination period, the approval of a majority of the common units, excluding those common units held by our general partner and its affiliates, and a majority of the subordinated units, voting as separate classes;

    after the subordination period, the approval of a majority of the common units, voting as a single class.

              By virtue of the exclusion of the common units held by our general partner and its affiliates from the required vote, and their ownership of all of our subordinated units, during the subordination period our general partner and its affiliates do not have the ability to ensure the approval of, but do have the ability to ensure the defeat of, any matter that requires the approval of a unit majority.

              In voting their common and subordinated units, SHC and its affiliates will have no fiduciary duty or obligation whatsoever to us or our limited partners, including any duty to act in good faith or in the best interests of us or our limited partners.

              The incentive distribution rights may be entitled to vote in certain circumstances.

Issuance of additional units

  No approval right. Please read "—Issuance of Additional Partnership Interests."

Amendment of the partnership agreement

 

Certain amendments may be made by our general partner without the approval of our unitholders. Other amendments generally require the approval of a unit majority. Please read "—Amendment of the Partnership Agreement."

Merger of our partnership or the sale of all or substantially all of our assets

 

Unit majority in certain circumstances. Please read "—Merger, Consolidation, Conversion, Sale or Other Disposition of Assets."

Dissolution of our partnership

 

Unit majority in certain circumstances. Please read "—Dissolution."

Continuation of our business upon dissolution

 

Unit majority. Please read "—Dissolution."

Withdrawal of our general partner

 

Under most circumstances, the approval of the holders of a majority of the common units, excluding common units held by our general partner and its affiliates, is required for the withdrawal of our general partner prior to September 30, 2022, in a manner that would cause a dissolution of our partnership. Please read "—Withdrawal or Removal of Our General Partner."

Removal of our general partner

 

Not less than 66 2 / 3 % of the outstanding units, voting as a single class, including units held by our general partner and its affiliates. Please read "—Withdrawal or Removal of Our General Partner."

182


Table of Contents

Transfer of our general partner interest

 

No approval right. Please read "—Transfer of General Partner Interest."

Transfer of incentive distribution rights

 

No approval right. Please read "—Transfer of Subordinated Units and Incentive Distribution Rights."

Transfer of ownership interests in our general partner

 

No approval right. Please read "—Transfer of Ownership Interests in the General Partner."

              If any person or group other than our general partner and its affiliates acquires beneficial ownership of 20% or more of any class of units then outstanding, that person or group loses voting rights on all of its units. This loss of voting rights does not apply to any person or group that acquires the units from our general partner or its affiliates and any transferees of that person or group approved by our general partner or to any person or group who acquires the units with the specific approval of our general partner.


Applicable Law; Forum, Venue and Jurisdiction

              Our partnership agreement is governed by Delaware law. Our partnership agreement requires that any claims, suits, actions or proceedings:

    arising out of or relating in any way to the partnership agreement (including any claims, suits or actions to interpret, apply or enforce the provisions of the partnership agreement or the duties, obligations or liabilities among our limited partners or of our limited partners to us, or the rights or powers of, or restrictions on, our limited partners or us);

    brought in a derivative manner on our behalf;

    asserting a claim of breach of a fiduciary duty owed by any director, officer or other employee of us or our general partner, or owed by our general partner, to us or the limited partners;

    asserting a claim arising pursuant to any provision of the Delaware Act; or

    asserting a claim governed by the internal affairs doctrine,

shall be exclusively brought in the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware (or, if such court does not have subject matter jurisdiction thereof, any other court located in the State of Delaware with subject matter jurisdiction). By purchasing a common unit, a limited partner is irrevocably consenting to these limitations and provisions regarding claims, suits, actions or proceedings and submitting to the exclusive jurisdiction of the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware in connection with any such claims, suits, actions or proceedings.


Limited Liability

              Assuming that a limited partner does not participate in the control of our business within the meaning of the Delaware Act and that he otherwise acts in conformity with the provisions of the partnership agreement, his liability under the Delaware Act will be limited, subject to possible exceptions, to the amount of capital he is obligated to contribute to us for his common units plus his share of any undistributed profits and assets. However, if it were determined that the right, or exercise of the right, by the limited partners as a group:

    to remove or replace our general partner;

183


Table of Contents

    to approve some amendments to our partnership agreement; or

    to take other action under our partnership agreement;

constituted "participation in the control" of our business for the purposes of the Delaware Act, then the limited partners could be held personally liable for our obligations under the laws of Delaware, to the same extent as our general partner. This liability would extend to persons who transact business with us under the reasonable belief that the limited partner is a general partner. Neither our partnership agreement nor the Delaware Act specifically provides for legal recourse against our general partner if a limited partner were to lose limited liability through any fault of our general partner. While this does not mean that a limited partner could not seek legal recourse, we know of no precedent for this type of a claim in Delaware case law.

              Under the Delaware Act, a limited partnership may not make a distribution to a partner if, after the distribution, all liabilities of the limited partnership, other than liabilities to partners on account of their partnership interests and liabilities for which the recourse of creditors is limited to specific property of the partnership, would exceed the fair value of the assets of the limited partnership. For the purpose of determining the fair value of the assets of a limited partnership, the Delaware Act provides that the fair value of property subject to liability for which recourse of creditors is limited shall be included in the assets of the limited partnership only to the extent that the fair value of that property exceeds the nonrecourse liability. The Delaware Act provides that a limited partner who receives a distribution and knew at the time of the distribution that the distribution was in violation of the Delaware Act shall be liable to the limited partnership for the amount of the distribution for three years. Under the Delaware Act, a substituted limited partner of a limited partnership is liable for the obligations of its assignor to make contributions to the partnership, except that such person is not obligated for liabilities unknown to it at the time it became a limited partner and that could not be ascertained from the partnership agreement.

              Following the completion of this offering, we expect that our subsidiaries will conduct business in four states, and we may have subsidiaries that conduct business in other states in the future. Maintenance of our limited liability as owner of our operating subsidiaries may require compliance with legal requirements in the jurisdictions in which the operating subsidiaries conduct business, including qualifying our subsidiaries to do business there.

              Limitations on the liability of members or limited partners for the obligations of a limited liability company or limited partnership have not been clearly established in many jurisdictions. If, by virtue of our ownership interest in our subsidiaries or otherwise, it were to be determined that we were conducting business in any jurisdiction without compliance with the applicable limited partnership or limited liability company statute, or that the right, or exercise of the right, by the limited partners as a group to remove or replace our general partner, to approve some amendments to our partnership agreement, or to take other action under our partnership agreement constituted "participation in the control" of our business for purposes of the statutes of any relevant jurisdiction, then our limited partners could be held personally liable for our obligations under the law of that jurisdiction to the same extent as our general partner under the circumstances. We will operate in a manner that our general partner considers reasonable and necessary or appropriate to preserve the limited liability of our limited partners.


Issuance of Additional Partnership Interests

              Our partnership agreement authorizes us to issue an unlimited number of additional partnership interests for the consideration and on the terms and conditions determined by our general partner without the approval of our unitholders.

184


Table of Contents

              It is possible that we will fund acquisitions through the issuance of additional common units, subordinated units or other partnership interests. Holders of any additional common units we issue will be entitled to share equally with the then-existing common unitholders in our distributions of available cash. In addition, the issuance of additional common units or other partnership interests may dilute the value of the interests of the then-existing common unitholders in our net assets.

              In accordance with Delaware law and the provisions of our partnership agreement, we may also issue additional partnership interests that, as determined by our general partner, may have special voting rights to which the common units are not entitled or be senior in right of distribution to the common units. In addition, our partnership agreement does not prohibit our subsidiaries from issuing equity interests which effectively rank senior to the common units.

              Our general partner will have the right, which it may from time to time assign in whole or in part to any of its affiliates, to purchase common units, subordinated units or other partnership interests whenever, and on the same terms that, we issue partnership interests to persons other than our general partner and its affiliates, to the extent necessary to maintain the percentage interest of the general partner and its affiliates, including such interest represented by common and subordinated units, that existed immediately prior to each issuance. The unitholders will not have preemptive rights under our partnership agreement to acquire additional common units or other partnership interests.


Amendment of the Partnership Agreement

General

              Amendments to our partnership agreement may be proposed only by our general partner. However, our general partner will have no duty or obligation to propose any amendment and may decline to do so free of any fiduciary duty or obligation whatsoever to us or our limited partners, including any duty to act in good faith or in the best interests of us or our limited partners. In order to adopt a proposed amendment, other than the amendments discussed under "—No Unitholder Approval" below, our general partner is required to seek written approval of the holders of the number of units required to approve the amendment or to call a meeting of the limited partners to consider and vote upon the proposed amendment. Except as described below, an amendment must be approved by a unit majority.

Prohibited Amendments

              No amendment may be made that would:

    enlarge the obligations of any limited partner without its consent, unless approved by at least a majority of the type or class of limited partner interests so affected; or

    enlarge the obligations of, restrict, change or modify in any way any action by or rights of, or reduce in any way the amounts distributable, reimbursable or otherwise payable by us to, our general partner or any of its affiliates without the consent of our general partner, which consent may be given or withheld at its option.

              The provisions of our partnership agreement preventing the amendments having the effects described in the clauses above can be amended upon the approval of the holders of at least 90.0% of the outstanding units, voting as a single class (including units owned by our general partner and its affiliates). Upon completion of this offering, one or more affiliates of our general partner will own approximately        % of our outstanding common and subordinated units.

185


Table of Contents

No Unitholder Approval

              Our general partner may generally make amendments to our partnership agreement without the approval of any limited partner to reflect:

    a change in our name, the location of our principal place of business, our registered agent or our registered office;

    the admission, substitution, withdrawal or removal of partners in accordance with our partnership agreement;

    a change that our general partner determines to be necessary or appropriate to qualify or continue our qualification as a limited partnership or partnership in which the limited partners have limited liability under the laws of any state or to ensure that neither we nor any of our subsidiaries (other than Susser Propco) will be treated as an association taxable as a corporation or otherwise taxed as an entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes;

    an amendment that is necessary, in the opinion of our counsel, to prevent us, our general partner or its directors, officers, agents or trustees from in any manner being subjected to the provisions of the Investment Company Act of 1940, the Investment Advisers Act of 1940 or "plan asset" regulations adopted under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, or ERISA, whether or not substantially similar to plan asset regulations currently applied or proposed;

    an amendment that our general partner determines to be necessary or appropriate in connection with the creation, authorization or issuance of additional partnership interests or the right to acquire partnership interests;

    any amendment expressly permitted in our partnership agreement to be made by our general partner acting alone;

    an amendment effected, necessitated or contemplated by a merger agreement that has been approved under the terms of our partnership agreement;

    any amendment that our general partner determines to be necessary or appropriate to reflect and account for the formation by us of, or our investment in, any corporation, partnership, joint venture, limited liability company or other entity, as otherwise permitted by our partnership agreement;

    a change in our fiscal year or taxable year and related changes;

    conversions into, mergers with or conveyances to another limited liability entity that is newly formed and has no assets, liabilities or operations at the time of the conversion, merger or conveyance other than those it receives by way of the conversion, merger or conveyance; or

    any other amendments substantially similar to any of the matters described in the clauses above.

186


Table of Contents

              In addition, our general partner may make amendments to our partnership agreement, without the approval of any limited partner, if our general partner determines that those amendments:

    do not adversely affect the limited partners (or any particular class of limited partners) in any material respect;

    are necessary or appropriate to satisfy any requirements, conditions or guidelines contained in any opinion, directive, order, ruling or regulation of any federal or state agency or judicial authority or contained in any federal or state statute;

    are necessary or appropriate to facilitate the trading of limited partner interests or to comply with any rule, regulation, guideline or requirement of any securities exchange on which the limited partner interests are or will be listed for trading;

    are necessary or appropriate for any action taken by our general partner relating to splits or combinations of units under the provisions of our partnership agreement; or

    are required to effect the intent expressed in this prospectus or the intent of the provisions of our partnership agreement or are otherwise contemplated by our partnership agreement.

Opinion of Counsel and Unitholder Approval

              Any amendment that would have a material adverse effect on the rights or preferences of any type or class of outstanding units in relation to other classes of units will require the approval of at least a majority of the type or class of units so affected. Any amendment that would reduce or increase the voting percentage required to take any action other than to remove the general partner or call a meeting of unitholders is required to be approved by the affirmative vote of limited partners whose aggregate outstanding units constitute not less than the voting requirement sought to be reduced or increased.

              For amendments of the type not requiring unitholder approval, our general partner will not be required to obtain an opinion of counsel that an amendment will neither result in a loss of limited liability to the limited partners nor result in our being treated as a taxable entity for federal income tax purposes in connection with any of the amendments. No other amendments to our partnership agreement will become effective without the approval of holders of at least 90% of the outstanding units, voting as a single class, unless we first obtain an opinion of counsel to the effect that the amendment will not affect the limited liability under applicable law of any of our limited partners. Upon completion of this offering, one or more affiliates of our general partner will own approximately        % of our outstanding common and subordinated units.


Merger, Consolidation, Conversion, Sale or Other Disposition of Assets

              A merger or consolidation of us requires the prior consent of our general partner. However, our general partner will have no duty or obligation to consent to any merger or consolidation and may decline to do so free of any fiduciary duty or obligation whatsoever to us or our limited partners, including any duty to act in good faith or in the best interest of us or our limited partners. Our general partner may, however, consummate any merger without the prior approval of our unitholders if we are the surviving entity in the transaction, our general partner has received an opinion of counsel regarding limited liability and tax matters, the transaction would not result in an amendment to the partnership agreement (other than an amendment that the general partner could adopt without the consent of other partners), each of our partnership interests will be an identical partnership interest following the transaction and the partnership interests to be issued do not exceed 20% of our outstanding partnership interests (other than incentive distribution rights) immediately prior to the transaction.

              In addition, our partnership agreement generally prohibits our general partner, without the prior approval of the holders of a unit majority, from causing us to sell, exchange or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all of our assets in a single transaction or a series of related transactions, including by way of merger, consolidation or other combination. Our general partner may, however,

187


Table of Contents

mortgage, pledge, hypothecate or grant a security interest in all or substantially all of our assets without such approval. Our general partner may also sell all or substantially all of our assets under a foreclosure or other realization upon those encumbrances without such approval. If the conditions specified in our partnership agreement are satisfied, our general partner may also convert us or any of our subsidiaries into a new limited liability entity or merge us or any of our subsidiaries into, or convey all of our assets to, a newly formed limited liability entity that has no assets, liabilities or operations, if the sole purpose of that conversion, merger or conveyance is to effect a mere change in our legal form into another limited liability entity, our general partner has received an opinion of counsel regarding limited liability and tax matters and the governing instruments of the new entity provide the limited partners and our general partner with substantially the same rights and obligations as those contained in our partnership agreement. Our unitholders are not entitled to dissenters' rights of appraisal under our partnership agreement or applicable Delaware law in the event of a conversion, merger or consolidation, a sale of substantially all of our assets or any other similar transaction or event.


Dissolution

              We will continue as a limited partnership until dissolved under our partnership agreement. We will dissolve upon:

    the election of our general partner to dissolve us, if approved by the holders of a unit majority;

    there being no limited partners, unless we are continued without dissolution in accordance with applicable Delaware law;

    the entry of a decree of judicial dissolution of our partnership pursuant to the provisions of the Delaware Act; or

    the withdrawal or removal of our general partner or any other event that results in its ceasing to be our general partner, other than by reason of a transfer of its 0.0% non-economic general partner interest in accordance with our partnership agreement, unless a successor general partner is admitted pursuant to our partnership agreement.

              Upon a dissolution under the last clause above, the holders of a unit majority may elect, within specific time limitations, to continue our business on the same terms and conditions described in our partnership agreement by appointing as a successor general partner an entity approved by the holders of a unit majority, subject to our receipt of an opinion of counsel to the effect that:

    the action would not result in the loss of limited liability under Delaware law of any limited partner; and

    neither we nor any of our subsidiaries would be treated as an association taxable as a corporation or otherwise be taxable as an entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes upon the exercise of that right to continue (to the extent not already so treated or taxed).


Liquidation and Distribution of Proceeds

              Upon our dissolution, unless our business is continued, the liquidator authorized to wind up our affairs will, acting with all of the powers of our general partner that are necessary or appropriate, liquidate our assets and apply the proceeds of the liquidation as described in "Provisions of Our Partnership Agreement Relating to Cash Distributions—Distributions of Cash Upon Liquidation." The liquidator may defer liquidation or distribution of our assets for a reasonable period of time or distribute assets to partners in kind if it determines that a sale would be impractical or would cause undue loss to our partners.


Withdrawal or Removal of Our General Partner

              Except as described below, our general partner has agreed not to withdraw voluntarily as our general partner on or prior to September 30, 2022 without obtaining the approval of the holders of at

188


Table of Contents

least a majority of the outstanding common units, excluding common units held by our general partner and its affiliates, and furnishing an opinion of counsel regarding limited liability and tax matters. After September 30, 2022, our general partner may withdraw as general partner without first obtaining approval of any unitholder by giving 90 days' advance notice, and that withdrawal will not constitute a violation of our partnership agreement. Notwithstanding the information above, our general partner may withdraw without unitholder approval upon 90 days' advance notice to the limited partners if at least 50% of the outstanding units are held or controlled by one person and its affiliates, other than our general partner and its affiliates. In addition, our partnership agreement permits our general partner, in some instances, to sell or otherwise transfer all of its 0.0% non-economic general partner interest in us without the approval of the unitholders. Please read "—Transfer of General Partner Interest."

              Upon withdrawal of our general partner under any circumstances, other than as a result of a transfer by our general partner of all or a part of its 0.0% non-economic general partner interest in us, the holders of a unit majority may elect a successor to that withdrawing general partner. If a successor is not elected, or is elected but an opinion of counsel regarding limited liability and tax matters cannot be obtained, we will be dissolved, wound up and liquidated, unless within a specified period after that withdrawal, the holders of a unit majority agree in writing to continue our business and to appoint a successor general partner. Please read "—Dissolution."

              Our general partner may not be removed unless that removal is approved by the vote of the holders of not less than 66 2 / 3 % of the outstanding units, voting together as a single class, including units held by our general partner and its affiliates, and we receive an opinion of counsel regarding limited liability and tax matters. Any removal of our general partner is also subject to the approval of a successor general partner by the vote of the holders of a majority of the outstanding common units, voting as a separate class, and the outstanding subordinated units, voting as a separate class including, in each case, units held by our general partner and its affiliates. The ownership of more than 33 1 / 3 % of the outstanding units by our general partner and its affiliates gives them the ability to prevent our general partner's removal. At the closing of this offering, affiliates of our general partner will own        % of our outstanding limited partner units, including all of our subordinated units.

              Our partnership agreement also provides that if our general partner is removed as our general partner under circumstances where cause does not exist:

    the subordinated units held by any person will immediately and automatically convert into common units on a one-for-one basis, provided (i) neither such person nor any of its affiliates voted any of its units in favor of the removal and (ii) such person is not an affiliate of the successor general partner; and

    if all of the subordinated units convert pursuant to the foregoing, all cumulative common unit arrearages on the common units will be extinguished and the subordination period will end.

              In the event of the removal of our general partner under circumstances where cause exists or withdrawal of our general partner where that withdrawal violates our partnership agreement, a successor general partner will have the option to purchase the general partner interest of the departing general partner and the incentive distribution rights of its affiliates for a cash payment equal to the fair market value of those interests. Under all other circumstances where our general partner withdraws or is removed by the limited partners, the departing general partner will have the option to require the successor general partner to purchase the general partner interest of the departing general partner and the incentive distribution rights of its affiliates for fair market value. In each case, this fair market value will be determined by agreement between the departing general partner and the successor general partner. If no agreement is reached within 30 days after the effective date of the departing general partner's withdrawal or removal, an independent investment banking firm or other independent expert selected by the departing general partner and the successor general partner will determine the fair

189


Table of Contents

market value. If the departing general partner and the successor general partner cannot agree upon an expert within 45 days after the withdrawal or removal, then an expert chosen by agreement of the experts selected by each of them will determine the fair market value.

              If the option described above is not exercised by either the departing general partner or the successor general partner, the departing general partner's general partner interest and all of its affiliates' incentive distribution rights will automatically convert into common units with a value equal to the fair market value of those interests as determined by an investment banking firm or other independent expert selected in the manner described in the preceding paragraph.

              In addition, we will be required to reimburse the departing general partner for all amounts due the departing general partner, including, without limitation, all employee-related liabilities, including severance liabilities, incurred as a result of the termination of any employees employed for our benefit by the departing general partner or its affiliates.


Transfer of General Partner Interest

              Our general partner may at its option transfer all or any part of its general partner interest without approval from the unitholders, so long as:

    the transferee agrees to assume the rights and duties of the general partner under the partnership agreement and agrees to be bound by the provisions of the partnership agreement;

    we receive an opinion of counsel that such transfer would not result in the loss of limited liability under the Delaware Act of any unitholders or cause us to be treated as an association taxable as a corporation or otherwise to be taxed as an entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes (to the extent not already so treated or taxed); and

    such transferee also agrees to purchase all (or the appropriate portion thereof, if applicable) of the partnership or membership interest held by the general partner as the general partner or managing member, if any, of any of our subsidiaries.

              In the case of a transfer of the general partner interest, the transferee or successor will be subject to compliance with the terms of our partnership agreement and will be admitted as the general partner effective immediately prior to the transfer of the general partner interest.

              Our general partner and its affiliates may, at any time, transfer common units, subordinated units or incentive distribution rights to one or more persons, without unitholder approval, except that they may not transfer subordinated units to us.


Transfer of Ownership Interests in the General Partner

              At any time, the owner of our general partner may sell or transfer all or part of its ownership interests in our general partner to an affiliate or a third party without the approval of our unitholders.


Transfer of Subordinated Units and Incentive Distribution Rights

              At any time, our general partner and its affiliates may sell or transfer all or a portion of their subordinated units or incentive distribution rights to an affiliate or third party without the approval of our unitholders.

              By transfer of subordinated units or incentive distribution rights in accordance with our partnership agreement, each transferee of subordinated units or incentive distribution rights will be admitted as a limited partner with respect to the subordinated units or incentive distribution rights transferred when such transfer and admission is reflected in our books and records. Each transferee:

    represents that the transferee has the capacity, power and authority to become bound by our partnership agreement;

    automatically becomes bound by the terms and conditions of our partnership agreement; and

190


Table of Contents

    gives the consents, waivers and approvals contained in our partnership agreement, such as the approval of all transactions and agreements we are entering into in connection with our formation and this offering.

              Our general partner will cause any transfers to be recorded on our books and records.

              We may, at our discretion, treat the nominee holder of subordinated units or incentive distribution rights as the absolute owner. In that case, the beneficial holder's rights are limited solely to those that it has against the nominee holder as a result of any agreement between the beneficial owner and the nominee holder.

              Subordinated units or incentive distribution rights are securities and any transfers are subject to the laws governing transfer of securities. In addition to other rights acquired upon transfer, the transferor gives the transferee the right to become a limited partner for the transferred subordinated units or incentive distribution rights.

              Until a subordinated unit or incentive distribution right has been transferred on our books, we and the transfer agent may treat the record holder of the unit or right as the absolute owner for all purposes, except as otherwise required by law or stock exchange regulations.


Change of Management Provisions

              Our partnership agreement contains specific provisions that are intended to discourage a person or group from attempting to remove Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC as our general partner or from otherwise changing our management. Please read "—Withdrawal or Removal of Our General Partner" for a discussion of certain consequences of the removal of our general partner. If any person or group, other than our general partner and its affiliates, acquires beneficial ownership of 20% or more of any class of partnership interests, that person or group loses voting rights on all of such person's or group's partnership interests. This loss of voting rights does not apply in certain circumstances. Please read "—Meetings; Voting."


Limited Call Right

              If at any time our general partner and its affiliates own more than 80% of the then-issued and outstanding limited partner interests of any class, our general partner will have the right, which it may assign in whole or in part to any of its affiliates or to us, to acquire all, but not less than all, of the limited partner interests of such class held by unaffiliated persons, as of a record date to be selected by our general partner, on at least 10, but not more than 60 days' notice. The purchase price in the event of this purchase is the greater of:

    the highest price paid by our general partner or any of its affiliates for any limited partner interests of such class purchased within the 90 days preceding the date on which our general partner first mails notice of its election to purchase those limited partner interests; and

    the average of the daily closing prices of the partnership securities of such class over the 20 consecutive trading days immediately preceding the date three days before the date the notice is mailed.

              As a result of our general partner's right to purchase outstanding limited partner interests, a holder of limited partner interests may have his limited partner interests purchased at an undesirable time or price. The tax consequences to a unitholder of the exercise of this call right are the same as a sale by that unitholder of his common units in the market. Please read "Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences—Disposition of Units."


Non-Taxpaying Holders; Redemption

              To avoid any adverse effect on the maximum applicable rates chargeable to customers by us or any of our future subsidiaries, or in order to reverse an adverse determination that has occurred regarding such maximum rate, our partnership agreement provides our general partner the power to

191


Table of Contents

amend the agreement. If our general partner, with the advice of counsel, determines that our not being treated as an association taxable as a corporation or otherwise taxable as an entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes, coupled with the tax status (or lack of proof thereof) of one or more of our limited partners, has, or is reasonably likely to have, a material adverse effect on the maximum applicable rates chargeable to customers by our subsidiaries, then our general partner may adopt such amendments to our partnership agreement as it determines necessary or advisable to:

    obtain proof of the U.S. federal income tax status of our limited partners (and their owners, to the extent relevant); and

    permit us to redeem the units held by any person whose tax status has or is reasonably likely to have a material adverse effect on the maximum applicable rates or who fails to comply with the procedures instituted by our general partner to obtain proof of the U.S. federal income tax status. The redemption price in the case of such a redemption will be the average of the daily closing prices per unit for the 20 consecutive trading days immediately prior to the date set for redemption.


Non-Citizen Assignees; Redemption

              If our general partner, with the advice of counsel, determines we are subject to U.S. federal, state or local laws or regulations that, in the reasonable determination of our general partner, create a substantial risk of cancellation or forfeiture of any property that we have an interest in because of the nationality, citizenship or other related status of any limited partner, then our general partner may adopt such amendments to our partnership agreement as it determines necessary or advisable to:

    obtain proof of the nationality, citizenship or other related status of our limited partners (and their owners, to the extent relevant); and

    permit us to redeem the units held by any person whose nationality, citizenship or other related status creates substantial risk of cancellation or forfeiture of any property or who fails to comply with the procedures instituted by the general partner to obtain proof of the nationality, citizenship or other related status. The redemption price in the case of such a redemption will be the average of the daily closing prices per unit for the 20 consecutive trading days immediately prior to the date set for redemption.


Meetings; Voting

              Except as described below regarding certain persons or groups owning 20% or more of any class of partnership interests then outstanding, record holders of limited partner interests on the record date will be entitled to notice of, and to vote at, meetings of our limited partners and to act upon matters for which approvals may be solicited.

              Our general partner does not anticipate that any meeting of our unitholders will be called in the foreseeable future. Any action that is required or permitted to be taken by the unitholders may be taken either at a meeting of the unitholders or without a meeting if consents in writing describing the action so taken are signed by holders of the number of units necessary to authorize or take that action at a meeting. Meetings of the unitholders may be called by our general partner or by unitholders owning at least 20% of the outstanding units of the class for which a meeting is proposed. Unitholders may vote either in person or by proxy at meetings. The holders of a majority of the outstanding units of the class or classes for which a meeting has been called, represented in person or by proxy, will constitute a quorum, unless any action by the unitholders requires approval by holders of a greater percentage of the units, in which case the quorum will be the greater percentage.

              Each record holder of a unit has a vote according to his percentage interest in us, although additional limited partner interests having special voting rights could be issued. Please read "—Issuance of Additional Interests." However, if at any time any person or group, other than our general partner and its affiliates, a direct transferee of our general partner or its affiliates or a purchaser specifically

192


Table of Contents

approved by our general partner, acquires, in the aggregate, beneficial ownership of 20% or more of any class of partnership interests then outstanding, that person or group will lose voting rights on all of its partnership interests and the partnership interests may not be voted on any matter and will not be considered to be outstanding when sending notices of a meeting of unitholders, calculating required votes, determining the presence of a quorum or for other similar purposes. Common units held in nominee or street name account will be voted by the broker or other nominee in accordance with the instruction of the beneficial owner unless the arrangement between the beneficial owner and his nominee provides otherwise. Except as our partnership agreement otherwise provides, subordinated units will vote together with common units, as a single class.

              Any notice, demand, request, report or proxy material required or permitted to be given or made to record holders of common units under our partnership agreement will be delivered to the record holder by us or by the transfer agent.


Voting Rights of Incentive Distribution Rights

              If a majority of the incentive distribution rights are held by the general partner and its affiliates, the holders of the incentive distribution rights will have no right to vote in respect of such rights on any matter, unless otherwise required by law, and the holders of the incentive distribution rights, in their capacity as such, shall be deemed to have approved any matter approved by our general partner.

              If less than a majority of the incentive distribution rights are held by the general partner and its affiliates, the incentive distribution rights will be entitled to vote on all matters submitted to a vote of unitholders, other than amendments and other matters that our general partner determines do not adversely affect the holders of the incentive distribution rights in any material respect. On any matter in which the holders of incentive distribution rights are entitled to vote, such holders will vote together with the subordinated units, prior to the end of the subordination period, or together with the common units, thereafter, in either case as a single class (except in the case of any amendment to the partnership agreement that would have a material adverse effect on the rights of any class and require the separate approval of the class affected under the provisions of the partnership agreement), and such incentive distribution rights shall be treated in all respects as subordinated units or common units, as applicable, when sending notices of a meeting of our limited partners to vote on any matter (unless otherwise required by law), calculating required votes, determining the presence of a quorum or for other similar purposes under our partnership agreement. The relative voting power of the holders of the incentive distribution rights and the subordinated units or common units, depending on which class the holders of incentive distribution rights are voting with, will be set in the same proportion that the cumulative cash distributions, if any, in respect of the incentive distribution rights for the four consecutive quarters prior to the record date for the vote bear to the cumulative cash distributions in respect of such class of units for such four quarters.


Status as Limited Partner

              By transfer of common units in accordance with our partnership agreement, each transferee of common units shall be admitted as a limited partner with respect to the common units transferred when such transfer and admission are reflected in our books and records. Except as described under "—Limited Liability," the common units will be fully paid, and unitholders will not be required to make additional contributions.


Indemnification

              Under our partnership agreement, in most circumstances, we will indemnify the following persons, to the fullest extent permitted by law, from and against all losses, claims, damages or similar liabilities:

    our general partner;

193


Table of Contents

    any departing general partner;

    any person who is or was an affiliate of our general partner or any departing general partner;

    any person who is or was a manager, managing member, general partner, director, officer, employee, agent, fiduciary or trustee of our partnership, our subsidiaries, our general partner, any departing general partner or any of their affiliates;

    any person who is or was serving at the request of our general partner, any departing general partner, or any of their affiliates as a manager, managing member, general partner, director, officer, employee, agent, fiduciary or trustee of another person owing a fiduciary duty to us or our subsidiaries;

    any person who controls our general partner or any departing general partner; and

    any person designated by our general partner.

              Any indemnification under these provisions will only be out of our assets. Unless our general partner otherwise agrees, it will not be personally liable for, or have any obligation to contribute or lend funds or assets to us to enable us to effectuate, indemnification. We may purchase insurance against liabilities asserted against and expenses incurred by persons for our activities, regardless of whether we would have the power to indemnify the person against such liabilities under our partnership agreement.


Reimbursement of Expenses

              Our partnership agreement requires us to reimburse our general partner for all direct and indirect expenses it incurs or payments it makes on our behalf and all other expenses allocable to us or otherwise incurred by our general partner in connection with operating our business. These expenses will include salary, bonus, incentive compensation and other amounts paid to persons who perform services for us or on our behalf and expenses allocated to our general partner by its affiliates. Our general partner is entitled to determine the expenses that are allocable to us. Neither the partnership agreement nor the omnibus agreement limit the amount of expenses for which our general partner and its affiliates may be reimbursed. For more information on the omnibus agreement, please read "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions—Agreements with Affiliates in Connection with the Transactions—Omnibus Agreement."


Books and Reports

              Our general partner is required to keep appropriate books of our business at our principal offices. These books will be maintained for both tax and financial reporting purposes on an accrual basis. For tax and fiscal reporting purposes, our fiscal year is the calendar year.

              We will furnish or make available to record holders of our units or other partnership interests within 105 days after the close of each fiscal year, an annual report containing audited financial statements and a report on those financial statements by our independent registered public accounting firm. Except for our fourth quarter, we will also furnish or make available unaudited financial information within 50 days after the close of each quarter. We will be deemed to have made any such report available if we file such report with the SEC on EDGAR or make the report available on a publicly available website which we maintain.

              We will furnish each record holder with information reasonably required for U.S. federal, state and local tax reporting purposes within 90 days after the close of each calendar year. This information is expected to be furnished in summary form so that some complex calculations normally required of partners can be avoided. Our ability to furnish this summary information to our unitholders will depend on their cooperation in supplying us with specific information. Every unitholder will receive information

194


Table of Contents

to assist him in determining his U.S. federal and state tax liability and in filing his U.S. federal and state income tax returns, regardless of whether he supplies us with the necessary information.


Right to Inspect Our Books and Records

              Our partnership agreement provides that a limited partner can, for a purpose reasonably related to his interest as a limited partner, upon reasonable written demand stating the purpose of such demand and at his own expense, have furnished to him:

    true and full information regarding the status of our business and financial condition (provided that obligation shall be satisfied to the extent the limited partner is furnished our most recent annual report and any subsequent quarterly or periodic reports required to be filed (or which would be required to be filed) with the SEC pursuant to Section 13 of the Exchange Act);

    a current list of the name and last known address of each record holder; and

    a copy of our partnership agreement, our certificate of limited partnership and all amendments thereto, together with copies of the executed copies of all powers of attorney under which they have been executed.

              Our general partner may, and intends to, keep confidential from the limited partners trade secrets or other information the disclosure of which our general partner believes is not in our best interests, could damage us or our business or that we are required by law or by agreements with third parties to keep confidential.


Registration Rights

              Under our partnership agreement, we have agreed to register for resale under the Securities Act and applicable state securities laws any common units, subordinated units or other limited partner interests proposed to be sold by our general partner or any of its affiliates, including SHC or their assignees if an exemption from the registration requirements is not otherwise available. These registration rights continue for two years following any withdrawal or removal of our general partner. We are obligated to pay all expenses incidental to the registration, excluding underwriting discounts.

195


Table of Contents


UNITS ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE

              After the sale of the common units offered by this prospectus, SHC will own, directly or indirectly, an aggregate of                 common units and                subordinated units. All of the subordinated units will convert into common units at the end of the subordination period and some may convert earlier. The sale of these common and subordinated units could have an adverse impact on the price of the common units or on any trading market that may develop.

              Our common units sold in this offering will generally be freely transferable without restriction or further registration under the Securities Act, except that any common units held by an "affiliate" of ours may not be resold publicly except in compliance with the registration requirements of the Securities Act or under an exemption under Rule 144 or otherwise. Rule 144 permits securities acquired by an affiliate of the issuer to be sold into the market in an amount that does not exceed, during any three-month period, the greater of:

    1% of the total number of the securities outstanding; or

    the average weekly reported trading volume of our common units for the four weeks prior to the sale.

              Sales under Rule 144 are also subject to specific manner of sale provisions, holding period requirements, notice requirements and the availability of current public information about us. Once we have been a reporting company for at least 90 days, a person who is not deemed to have been an affiliate of ours at any time during the three months preceding a sale, and who has beneficially owned the common units proposed to be sold for at least six months, would be entitled to sell without complying with the manner of sale, volume limitation or notice provisions of Rule 144, subject only to the current public information requirement. After beneficially owning Rule 144 restricted units for at least one year, such person would be entitled to freely sell those common units without regard to any of the requirements of Rule 144.

              Our partnership agreement provides that we may issue an unlimited number of limited partner interests of any type without a vote of the unitholders at any time. Any issuance of additional common units or other equity securities would result in a corresponding decrease in the proportionate ownership interest in us represented by, and could adversely affect the cash distributions to and market price of, common units then outstanding. Please read "The Partnership Agreement—Issuance of Additional Interests."

              Under our partnership agreement and the registration rights agreement that we will enter into, our general partner and its affiliates will have the right to cause us to register under the Securities Act and applicable state securities laws the offer and sale of any units that they hold. Subject to the terms and conditions of the partnership agreement and the registration rights agreement, these registration rights allow our general partner and its affiliates or their assignees holding any units to require registration of any of these units and to include any of these units in a registration by us of other units, including units offered by us or by any unitholder. Our general partner and its affiliates will continue to have these registration rights for two years following its withdrawal or removal as our general partner. In connection with any registration of this kind, we will indemnify each unitholder participating in the registration and its officers, directors, and controlling persons from and against any liabilities under the Securities Act or any applicable state securities laws arising from the registration statement or prospectus. We will bear all costs and expenses incidental to any registration, excluding any underwriting discount. Except as described below, our general partner and its affiliates may sell their units in private transactions at any time, subject to compliance with applicable laws.

              SHC and the executive officers and directors of our general partner have agreed not to sell any common units they beneficially own for a period of 180 days from the date of this prospectus. Please read "Underwriting" for a description of these lock-up provisions.

196


Table of Contents


MATERIAL U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES

              This section summarizes the material U.S. federal income tax consequences that may be relevant to prospective unitholders and is based upon current provisions of the U.S. Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code"), existing and proposed U.S. Treasury regulations thereunder (the "Treasury Regulations"), and current administrative rulings and court decisions, all of which are subject to change. Changes in these authorities may cause the federal income tax consequences to a prospective unitholder to vary substantially from those described below. Unless the context otherwise requires, references in this section to "we" or "us" are references to Susser Petroleum Partners LP and our operating companies (other than our operating company that is treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes).

              Legal conclusions contained in this section, unless otherwise noted, are the opinion of Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. and are based on the accuracy of representations made by us to them for this purpose. However, this section does not address all federal income tax matters that affect us or our unitholders. Furthermore, this section focuses on unitholders who are individual citizens or residents of the United States (for federal income tax purposes), whose functional currencies are the U.S. dollar and who hold units as capital assets (generally, property that is held for investment). This section has limited applicability to corporations, partnerships, entities treated as partnerships for federal income tax purposes, estates, trusts, non-resident aliens or other unitholders subject to specialized tax treatment, such as tax-exempt institutions, non-U.S. persons, individual retirement accounts ("IRAs"), employee benefit plans, real estate investment trusts or mutual funds. Accordingly, because each unitholder may have unique circumstances beyond the scope of the discussion herein, we encourage each unitholder to consult such unitholder's own tax advisor in analyzing the federal, state, local and non-U.S. tax consequences that are particular to that unitholder resulting from ownership or disposition of its units.

              We are relying on opinions and advice of Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. with respect to the matters described herein. An opinion of counsel represents only that counsel's best legal judgment and does not bind the Internal Revenue Service ("IRS") or courts. Accordingly, the opinions and statements made herein may not be sustained by a court if contested by the IRS. Any such contest of the matters described herein may materially and adversely impact the market for our units and the prices at which such units trade. In addition, our costs of any contest with the IRS will be borne indirectly by our unitholders because the costs will reduce our cash available for distribution. Furthermore, our tax treatment, or the tax treatment of an investment in us, may be significantly modified by future legislative or administrative changes or court decisions, which may be retroactively applied.

              For the reasons described below, Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. has not rendered an opinion with respect to the following federal income tax issues: (1) the treatment of a unitholder whose units are the subject of a securities loan (please read "—Tax Consequences of Unit Ownership—Treatment of Securities Loans"); (2) whether our monthly convention for allocating taxable income and losses is permitted by existing Treasury Regulations (please read "—Disposition of Units—Allocations Between Transferors and Transferees"); and (3) whether our method for taking into account Section 743 adjustments is sustainable in certain cases (please read "—Tax Consequences of Unit Ownership—Section 754 Election" and "—Uniformity of Units").


Taxation of the Partnership

Partnership Status

              We expect to be treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes and, therefore, generally will not be liable for federal income taxes. Instead, as described below, each of our unitholders will take into account its respective share of our items of income, gain, loss and deduction in computing its federal income tax liability as if the unitholder had earned such income directly, even if we do not make any distributions to the unitholder. Distributions by us to a unitholder generally will

197


Table of Contents

not give rise to income or gain taxable to such unitholder, unless the amount of cash distributed to a unitholder exceeds the unitholder's adjusted tax basis in its units.

              Section 7704 of the Code generally provides that publicly traded partnerships will be treated as corporations for federal income tax purposes. However, if 90% or more of a partnership's gross income for every taxable year it is publicly traded consists of "qualifying income," the partnership may continue to be treated as a partnership for federal income tax purposes (the "Qualifying Income Exception"). Qualifying income includes (i) income and gains derived from the refining, transportation, storage, processing and marketing of crude oil, natural gas and products thereof (including motor fuels), (ii) rents from the leasing of real property, (iii) interest (other than from a financial business), (iv) dividends, (v) gains from the sale of real property, and (vi) gains from the sale or other disposition of capital assets held for the production of qualifying income. We estimate that approximately        % of our current gross income is not qualifying income; however, this estimate could change from time to time.

              Based upon factual representations made by us and our general partner regarding the composition of our income and the other representations set forth below, Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. is of the opinion that we will be treated as a partnership and each of our operating companies, other than Susser Propco, will be disregarded as an entity separate from us for federal income tax purposes. In rendering its opinion, Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. has relied on factual representations made by us and our general partner. The representations made by us and our general partner upon which Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. has relied include, without limitation:

              (a)   Neither we nor any of our operating companies, other than Susser Propco, has elected or will elect to be treated as a corporation for federal income tax purposes; and

              (b)   For each taxable year, more than 90% of our gross income has been and will be income of a character that Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. has opined or will opine is "qualifying income" within the meaning of Section 7704(d) of the Code.

              We believe that these representations are true and will be true in the future.

              If we fail to meet the Qualifying Income Exception, other than a failure that is determined by the IRS to be inadvertent and that is cured within a reasonable time after discovery (in which case the IRS may also require us to make adjustments with respect to our unitholders or pay other amounts), we will be treated as transferring all of our assets, subject to liabilities, to a newly formed corporation, on the first day of the year in which we fail to meet the Qualifying Income Exception, in return for stock in that corporation and then distributing that stock to our unitholders in liquidation of their units. This deemed contribution and liquidation should not result in the recognition of taxable income by our unitholders or us so long as our liabilities do not exceed the tax basis of our assets. Thereafter, we would be treated as an association taxable as a corporation for federal income tax purposes.

              If for any reason we are taxable as a corporation in any taxable year, our items of income, gain, loss and deduction would be taken into account by us in determining the amount of our liability for federal income tax, rather than being passed through to our unitholders. Accordingly, our taxation as a corporation would materially reduce the cash available for distribution to unitholders and thus would likely substantially reduce the value of our units. In addition, any distribution made to a unitholder at a time we are treated as a corporation would be (i) a taxable dividend to the extent of our current or accumulated earnings and profits, then (ii) a nontaxable return of capital to the extent of the unitholder's tax basis in its units, and thereafter (iii) taxable capital gain.

              The remainder of this discussion is based on the opinion of Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. that we will be treated as a partnership for federal income tax purposes.

198


Table of Contents


Tax Consequences of Unit Ownership

Limited Partner Status

              Unitholders who are admitted as limited partners of the partnership, as well as unitholders whose units are held in street name or by a nominee and who have the right to direct the nominee in the exercise of all substantive rights attendant to the ownership of units, will be treated as partners of the partnership for federal income tax purposes. For a discussion related to the risks of losing partner status as a result of securities loans, please read "—Treatment of Securities Loans." Unitholders who are not treated as partners in us as described above are urged to consult their own tax advisors with respect to the tax consequences applicable to them under the circumstances.

Flow-Through of Taxable Income

              Subject to the discussion below under "—Entity-Level Collections of Unitholder Taxes" with respect to payments we may be required to make on behalf of our unitholders, and aside from any taxes paid by our subsidiary that is treated as a corporation for federal income tax purposes, we will not pay any federal income tax. Rather, each unitholder will be required to report on its federal income tax return each year its share of our income, gains, losses and deductions for our taxable year or years ending with or within its taxable year without regard to whether we make cash distributions to such unitholder. Consequently, we may allocate income to a unitholder even if that unitholder has not received a cash distribution.

Ratio of Taxable Income to Distributions

              We estimate that a purchaser of common units in this offering who owns those common units from the date of closing of this offering through the record date for distributions for the period ending December 31, 2015, will be allocated, on a cumulative basis, an amount of federal taxable income for that period that will be       % or less of the cash distributed with respect to that period. Our estimate is based on many assumptions regarding our business and operations, including assumptions as to our revenues, capital expenditures, cash flow, net working capital and anticipated cash distributions. These estimates and assumptions are subject to, among other things, numerous business, economic, regulatory, legislative, competitive and political uncertainties beyond our control. Further, the estimates are based on current tax law and tax reporting positions that we will adopt and with which the IRS could disagree. Accordingly, we cannot assure unitholders that these estimates will prove to be correct. The actual ratio of taxable income to cash distributions could be higher or lower than expected, and any differences could be material and could materially affect the value of the common units. For example, the ratio of taxable income to cash distributions to a purchaser of common units in this offering would be higher, and perhaps substantially higher, than our estimate with respect to the period described above if:

    the earnings from operations exceeds the amount required to make minimum quarterly distributions on all units, yet we only distribute the minimum quarterly distribution on all units; or

    we make a future offering of common units and use the proceeds of the offering in a manner that does not produce substantial additional deductions during the period described above, such as to repay indebtedness outstanding at the time of this offering or to acquire property that is not eligible for depreciation or amortization for federal income tax purposes or that is depreciable or amortizable at a rate significantly slower than the rate applicable to our assets at the time of this offering.

199


Table of Contents

Basis of Units

              A unitholder's tax basis in its units initially will be the amount it paid for those units plus its initial share of our liabilities. That basis generally will be (i) increased by the unitholder's share of our income and any increases in such unitholder's share of our nonrecourse liabilities, and (ii) decreased, but not below zero, by distributions to it, by its share of our losses, any decreases in its share of our nonrecourse liabilities and its share of our expenditures that are neither deductible nor required to be capitalized.

Treatment of Distributions

              Distributions made by us to a unitholder generally will not be taxable to the unitholder, unless such distributions are of cash or marketable securities that are treated as cash and exceed the unitholder's tax basis in its units, in which case the unitholder will recognize gain taxable in the manner described below under "—Disposition of Units."

              Any reduction in a unitholder's share of our liabilities will be treated as a distribution by us of cash to that unitholder. A decrease in a unitholder's percentage interest in us because of our issuance of additional units will generally decrease the unitholder's share of our liabilities. For purposes of the foregoing, a unitholder's share of our nonrecourse liabilities (liabilities for which no partner bears the economic risk of loss) generally will be based upon that unitholder's share of the unrealized appreciation (or depreciation) in our assets, to the extent thereof, with any excess liabilities allocated based on the unitholder's share of our profits. Please read "—Disposition of Units."

              A non-pro rata distribution of money or property (including a deemed distribution as a result of a reallocation of our liabilities described above) may cause a unitholder to recognize ordinary income, if the distribution reduces the unitholder's share of our "unrealized receivables," including depreciation recapture and substantially appreciated "inventory items," both as defined in Section 751 of the Code ("Section 751 Assets"). To the extent of such reduction, the unitholder would be deemed to receive its proportionate share of the Section 751 Assets and exchange such assets with us in return for an allocable portion of the non-pro rata distribution. This deemed exchange generally will result in the unitholder's recognition of ordinary income in an amount equal to the excess of (1) the non-pro rata portion of that distribution over (2) the unitholder's tax basis (generally zero) in the Section 751 Assets deemed to be relinquished in the exchange.

Limitations on Deductibility of Losses

              A unitholder may not be entitled to deduct the full amount of loss we allocate to it because its share of our losses will be limited to the lesser of (i) the unitholder's tax basis in its units, and (ii) in the case of a unitholder that is an individual, estate, trust or certain type of closely-held corporation, the amount for which the unitholder is considered to be "at risk" with respect to our activities. In general, a unitholder will be at risk to the extent of its tax basis in its units, reduced by (1) any portion of that basis attributable to the unitholder's share of our liabilities, (2) any portion of that basis representing amounts otherwise protected against loss because of a guarantee, stop loss agreement or similar arrangement and (3) any amount of money the unitholder borrows to acquire or hold its units, if the lender of those borrowed funds owns an interest in us, is related to another unitholder or can look only to the units for repayment.

              A unitholder subject to the basis and at risk limitation must recapture losses deducted in previous years to the extent that distributions (including distributions deemed to result from a reduction in a unitholder's share of nonrecourse liabilities) cause the unitholder's at risk amount to be less than zero at the end of any taxable year. Losses disallowed to a unitholder or recaptured as a result of basis or at risk limitations will carry forward and will be allowable as a deduction in a later year to the extent that the unitholder's tax basis or at risk amount, whichever is the limiting factor, is

200


Table of Contents

subsequently increased. Upon a taxable disposition of units, any gain recognized by a unitholder can be offset by losses that were previously suspended by the at risk limitation but not losses suspended by the basis limitation. Any loss previously suspended by the at risk limitation in excess of that gain can no longer be used.

              In addition to the basis and at risk limitations, a passive activity loss limitation generally limits the deductibility of losses incurred by individuals, estates, trusts, some closely held corporations and personal service corporations from "passive activities" (generally, trade or business activities in which the taxpayer does not materially participate). The passive loss limitations are applied separately with respect to each publicly traded partnership. Consequently, any passive losses we generate will be available to offset only passive income generated by us. Passive losses that are not deductible because they exceed a unitholder's share of passive income we generate may be deducted in full when the unitholder disposes of all of its units in a fully taxable transaction with an unrelated party. The passive activity loss rules are generally applied after other applicable limitations on deductions, including the at risk and basis limitations.

Limitations on Interest Deductions

              The deductibility of a non-corporate taxpayer's "investment interest expense" is generally limited to the amount of that taxpayer's "net investment income." Investment interest expense includes:

    interest on indebtedness properly allocable to property held for investment;

    interest expense attributed to portfolio income; and

    the portion of interest expense incurred to purchase or carry an interest in a passive activity to the extent attributable to portfolio income.

              The computation of a unitholder's investment interest expense will take into account interest on any margin account borrowing or other loan incurred to purchase or carry a unit. Net investment income includes gross income from property held for investment and amounts treated as portfolio income under the passive loss rules, less deductible expenses other than interest directly connected with the production of investment income. Net investment income generally does not include qualified dividend income or gains attributable to the disposition of property held for investment. A unitholder's share of a publicly traded partnership's portfolio income and, according to the IRS, net passive income will be treated as investment income for purposes of the investment interest expense limitation.

Entity-Level Collections of Unitholder Taxes

              If we are required or elect under applicable law to pay any federal, state, local or non-U.S. tax on behalf of any current or former unitholder, we are authorized to treat the payment as a distribution of cash to the relevant unitholder. Where the tax is payable on behalf of all the unitholders or we cannot determine the specific unitholder on whose behalf the tax is payable, we are authorized to treat the payment as a distribution to all current unitholders. Payments by us as described above could give rise to an overpayment of tax on behalf of a unitholder, in which event the unitholder may be entitled to claim a refund of the overpayment amount. Unitholders are urged to consult their tax advisors to determine the consequences to them of any tax payment we make on their behalf.

Allocation of Income, Gain, Loss and Deduction

              In general, our net income and net loss will be allocated among our unitholders in accordance with their percentage interests in us. At any time that distributions are made to the common units and not to the subordinated units, or that incentive distributions are made, gross income will be allocated to the recipients to the extent of such distributions.

201


Table of Contents

              Specified items of our income, gain, loss and deduction will be allocated under Section 704(c) of the Code to account for any difference between the tax basis and fair market value of our assets at the time such assets are contributed to us and at the time of any subsequent offering of our units (a "Book-Tax Disparity"). In addition, items of recapture income will be specially allocated to the extent possible to the unitholder who was allocated the deduction giving rise to that recapture income in order to minimize the recognition of ordinary income by other unitholders.

              An allocation of items of our income, gain, loss or deduction, generally must have "substantial economic effect" as determined under Treasury Regulations. If an allocation does not have substantial economic effect, it will be reallocated to our unitholders on the basis of their interests in us, which will be determined by taking into account all the facts and circumstances, including:

    our partners' relative contributions to us;

    the interests of all of our partners in our profits and losses;

    the interest of all of our partners in our cash flow; and

    the rights of all of our partners to distributions of capital upon liquidation.

              Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. is of the opinion that, with the exception of the issues described in "—Section 754 Election" and "—Disposition of Units—Allocations Between Transferors and Transferees," allocations under our partnership agreement will have substantial economic effect.

Treatment of Securities Loans

              A unitholder whose units are loaned (for example, to a "short seller" to cover a short sale of units) may be treated as having disposed of those units. If so, such unitholder would no longer be treated for tax purposes as a partner with respect to those units during the period of the loan and may recognize gain or loss from the disposition. As a result, during this period (i) any of our income, gain, loss or deduction allocated to those units would not be reportable by the lending unitholder, and (ii) any cash distributions received by the unitholder as to those units may be treated as ordinary income.

              Due to a lack of controlling authority, Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. has not rendered an opinion regarding the tax treatment of a unitholder that enters into a securities loan with respect to its units. Unitholders desiring to assure their status as partners and avoid the risk of gain recognition from a loan of their units are urged to modify any applicable brokerage account agreements to prohibit their brokers from borrowing and lending their units. The IRS has announced that it is studying issues relating to the tax treatment of short sales of partnership interests. Please read "—Disposition of Units—Recognition of Gain or Loss."

Alternative Minimum Tax

              If a unitholder is subject to federal alternative minimum tax, such tax will apply to such unitholder's distributive share of any items of our income, gain, loss or deduction. The current alternative minimum tax rate for non-corporate taxpayers is 26% on the first $175,000 of alternative minimum taxable income in excess of the exemption amount and 28% on any additional alternative minimum taxable income. Prospective common unitholders are urged to consult with their tax advisors with respect to the impact of an investment in our units on their alternative minimum tax liability.

Tax Rates

              Under current law, the highest marginal federal income tax rates for individuals applicable to ordinary income and long-term capital gains (generally, gains from the sale or exchange of certain investment assets held for more than one year) are 35% and 15%, respectively. However, absent new

202


Table of Contents

legislation extending the current rates, beginning January 1, 2013, the highest marginal federal income tax rate applicable to ordinary income and long-term capital gains of individuals will increase to 39.6% and 20%, respectively. These rates are subject to change by new legislation at any time.

              A 3.8% Medicare tax on certain investment income earned by individuals, estates, and trusts will apply for taxable years beginning after December 31, 2012. For these purposes, investment income generally includes a unitholder's allocable share of our income and gain realized by a unitholder from a sale of units. In the case of an individual, the tax will be imposed on the lesser of (i) the unitholder's net investment income from all investments, or (ii) the amount by which the unitholder's modified adjusted gross income exceeds $250,000 (if the unitholder is married and filing jointly or a surviving spouse), $125,000 (if the unitholder is married and filing separately) or $200,000 (in any other case). In the case of an estate or trust, the tax will be imposed on the lesser of (i) undistributed net investment income, or (ii) the excess adjusted gross income over the dollar amount at which the highest income tax bracket applicable to an estate or trust begins.

Section 754 Election

              We will make the election permitted by Section 754 of the Code that permits us to adjust the tax bases in our assets as to specific purchasers of our units under Section 743(b) of the Code to reflect the unit purchase price. The Section 743(b) adjustment separately applies to each purchaser of units based upon the values and bases of our assets at the time of the relevant purchase. The Section 743(b) adjustment does not apply to a person who purchases units directly from us. For purposes of this discussion, a unitholder's basis in our assets will be considered to have two components: (1) its share of the tax basis in our assets as to all unitholders ("common basis") and (2) its Section 743(b) adjustment to that tax basis (which may be positive or negative).

              Under Treasury Regulations, a Section 743(b) adjustment attributable to property depreciable under Section 168 of the Code may be amortizable over the remaining cost recovery period for such property, while a Section 743(b) adjustment attributable to properties subject to depreciation under Section 167 of the Code, must be amortized straight-line or using the 150% declining balance method. As a result, if we owned any assets subject to depreciation under Section 167 of the Code, the amortization rates could give rise to differences in the taxation of unitholders purchasing units from us and unitholders purchasing from other unitholders.

              Under our partnership agreement, we are authorized to take a position to preserve the uniformity of units even if that position is not consistent with these or any other Treasury Regulations. Please read "—Uniformity of Units." Consistent with this authority, we intend to treat properties depreciable under Section 167, if any, in the same manner as properties depreciable under Section 168 for this purpose. These positions are consistent with the methods employed by other publicly traded partnerships but are inconsistent with the existing Treasury Regulations, and Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. has not opined on the validity of this approach.

              The IRS may challenge the positions we adopt with respect to depreciating or amortizing the Section 743(b) adjustment we take to preserve the uniformity of units due to lack of controlling authority. Because a unitholder's tax basis for its units is reduced by its share of our items of deduction or loss, any position we take that understates deductions will overstate a unitholder's basis in its units, and may cause the unitholder to understate gain or overstate loss on any sale of such units. Please read "—Disposition of Units—Recognition of Gain or Loss." If a challenge to such treatment were sustained, the gain from the sale of units may be increased without the benefit of additional deductions.

              A Section 754 election is advantageous if the transferee's tax basis in his units is higher than the units' share of the aggregate tax basis of our assets immediately prior to the transfer. In that case, as a result of the election, the transferee would have, among other items, a greater amount of depreciation deductions and his share of any gain or loss on a sale of our asses would be less.

203


Table of Contents

Conversely, a Section 754 election is disadvantageous if the transferee's tax basis in his units is lower than those units' share of the aggregate tax basis of our assets immediately prior to the transfer. Thus, the fair market value of the units may be affected either favorably or unfavorably by the election.

              The calculations involved in the Section 754 election are complex and will be made on the basis of assumptions as to the value of our assets and other matters. The IRS could seek to reallocate some or all of any Section 743(b) adjustment we allocated to our assets subject to depreciation to goodwill or non-depreciable assets. Goodwill, as an intangible asset, is generally non-amortizable or amortizable over a longer period of time or under a less accelerated method than our tangible assets. We cannot assure any unitholder that the determinations we make will not be successfully challenged by the IRS or that the resulting deductions will not be reduced or disallowed altogether. Should the IRS require a different tax basis adjustment to be made, and should, in our opinion, the expense of compliance exceed the benefit of the election, we may seek permission from the IRS to revoke our Section 754 election. If permission is granted, a subsequent purchaser of units may be allocated more income than it would have been allocated had the election not been revoked.


Tax Treatment of Operations

Accounting Method and Taxable Year

              We will use the year ending December 31 as our taxable year and the accrual method of accounting for federal income tax purposes. Each unitholder will be required to include in income its share of our income, gain, loss and deduction for each taxable year ending within or with its taxable year. In addition, a unitholder who has a taxable year ending on a date other than December 31 and who disposes of all of its units following the close of our taxable year but before the close of its taxable year must include its share of our income, gain, loss and deduction in income for its taxable year, with the result that it will be required to include in income for its taxable year its share of more than one year of our income, gain, loss and deduction. Please read "—Disposition of Units—Allocations Between Transferors and Transferees."

Tax Basis, Depreciation and Amortization

              The tax basis of our assets will be used for purposes of computing depreciation, amortization and cost recovery deductions and, ultimately, gain or loss on the disposition of these assets. The federal income tax burden associated with the difference between the fair market value of our assets and their tax basis immediately prior to (i) this offering will be borne by SHC and its affiliates, and (ii) any other offering will be borne by our partners holding interests in us prior to such offering. Please read "—Tax Consequences of Unit Ownership—Allocation of Income, Gain, Loss and Deduction."

              If we dispose of depreciable or amortizable property by sale, foreclosure or otherwise, all or a portion of any gain, determined by reference to the amount of depreciation or amortization previously deducted and the nature of the property, may be subject to the recapture rules and taxed as ordinary income rather than capital gain. Similarly, a unitholder who has taken cost recovery, depreciation or amortization deductions with respect to property we own will likely be required to recapture some or all of those deductions as ordinary income upon a sale of its interest in us. Please read "—Tax Consequences of Unit Ownership—Allocation of Income, Gain, Loss and Deduction" and "—Disposition of Units—Recognition of Gain or Loss."

              The costs we incur in offering and selling our units (called "syndication expenses") must be capitalized and cannot be deducted currently, ratably or upon our termination. While there are uncertainties regarding the classification of costs as organization expenses, which may be amortized by us, and as syndication expenses, which may not be amortized by us, the underwriting discounts and commissions we incur will be treated as syndication expenses.

204


Table of Contents

Valuation and Tax Basis of Our Properties

              The federal income tax consequences of the ownership and disposition of units will depend in part on our estimates of the relative fair market values and the initial tax bases of our assets. Although we may from time to time consult with professional appraisers regarding valuation matters, we will make many of the relative fair market value estimates ourselves. These estimates and determinations of tax basis are subject to challenge and will not be binding on the IRS or the courts. If the estimates of fair market value or basis are later found to be incorrect, the character and amount of items of income, gain, loss or deduction previously reported by unitholders could change, and unitholders could be required to adjust their tax liability for prior years and incur interest and penalties with respect to those adjustments.


Disposition of Units

Recognition of Gain or Loss

              A unitholder will be required to recognize gain or loss on a sale of units equal to the difference between the unitholder's amount realized and tax basis in the units sold. A unitholder's amount realized generally will equal the sum of the cash or the fair market value of other property it receives plus its share of our liabilities with respect to such units. Because the amount realized includes a unitholder's share of our liabilities, the gain recognized on the sale of units could result in a tax liability in excess of any cash received from the sale. Prior distributions from us in excess of cumulative net taxable income for a common unit that decreased a unitholder's tax basis in that common unit will, in effect, become taxable income if the common unit is sold at a price greater than the unitholder's tax basis in that common unit, even if the price received is less than his original cost.

              Except as noted below, gain or loss recognized by a unitholder on the sale or exchange of a unit held for more than one year generally will be taxable as long-term capital gain or loss. However, gain or loss recognized on the disposition of units will be separately computed and taxed as ordinary income or loss under Section 751 of the Code to the extent attributable to Section 751 assets that we own, primarily depreciation recapture. Ordinary income attributable to Section 751 Assets may exceed net taxable gain realized on the sale of a unit and may be recognized even if there is a net taxable loss realized on the sale of a unit. Thus, a unitholder may recognize both ordinary income and capital gain or loss upon a sale of units. Net capital loss may offset capital gains and, in the case of individuals, up to $3,000 of ordinary income per year.

              The IRS has ruled that a partner who acquires interests in a partnership in separate transactions must combine those interests and maintain a single adjusted tax basis for all those interests. Upon a sale or other disposition of less than all of those interests, a portion of that tax basis must be allocated to the interests sold using an "equitable apportionment" method, which generally means that the tax basis allocated to the interest sold equals an amount that bears the same relation to the partner's tax basis in its entire interest in the partnership as the value of the interest sold bears to the value of the partner's entire interest in the partnership.

              Treasury Regulations under Section 1223 of the Code allow a selling unitholder who can identify units transferred with an ascertainable holding period to elect to use the actual holding period of the units transferred. Thus, according to the ruling discussed above, a unitholder will be unable to select high or low basis units to sell as would be the case with corporate stock, but, according to the Treasury Regulations, it may designate specific units sold for purposes of determining the holding period of units transferred. A unitholder electing to use the actual holding period of units transferred must consistently use that identification method for all subsequent sales or exchanges of our units. A unitholder considering the purchase of additional units or a sale of units purchased in separate transactions is urged to consult its tax advisor as to the possible consequences of this ruling and application of the Treasury Regulations.

205


Table of Contents

              Specific provisions of the Code affect the taxation of some financial products and securities, including partnership interests, by treating a taxpayer as having sold an "appreciated" financial position, including a partnership interest with respect to which gain would be recognized if it were sold, assigned or terminated at its fair market value, in the event the taxpayer or a related person enters into:

    a short sale;

    an offsetting notional principal contract; or

    a futures or forward contract with respect to the partnership interest or substantially identical property.

              Moreover, if a taxpayer has previously entered into a short sale, an offsetting notional principal contract or a futures or forward contract with respect to the partnership interest, the taxpayer will be treated as having sold that position if the taxpayer or a related person then acquires the partnership interest or substantially identical property. The Secretary of the Treasury is also authorized to issue regulations that treat a taxpayer that enters into transactions or positions that have substantially the same effect as the preceding transactions as having constructively sold the financial position.

Allocations Between Transferors and Transferees

              In general, our taxable income or loss will be determined annually, will be prorated on a monthly basis and will be subsequently apportioned among the unitholders in proportion to the number of units owned by each of them as of the opening of the applicable exchange on the first business day of the month (the "Allocation Date"). Nevertheless, we allocate certain deductions for depreciation of capital additions based upon the date the underlying property is placed in service, and gain or loss realized on a sale or other disposition of our assets or, in the discretion of the general partner, any other extraordinary item of income, gain, loss or deduction will be allocated among the unitholders on the Allocation Date in the month in which such income, gain, loss or deduction is recognized. As a result, a unitholder transferring units may be allocated income, gain, loss and deduction realized after the date of transfer.

              Although simplifying conventions are contemplated by the Code and most publicly traded partnerships use similar simplifying conventions, the use of this method may not be permitted under existing Treasury Regulations. Recently, however, the Department of the Treasury and the IRS issued proposed Treasury Regulations that provide a safe harbor pursuant to which a publicly traded partnership may use a similar monthly simplifying convention to allocate tax items among transferor and transferee unitholders, although such tax items must be prorated on a daily basis. Nonetheless, the safe harbor in the proposed regulations does not specifically authorize the use of the proration method we have adopted Accordingly, Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. is unable to opine on the validity of this method of allocating income and deductions between transferee and transferor unitholders. If this method is not allowed under the final Treasury Regulations, or only applies to transfers of less than all of the unitholder's interest, our taxable income or losses could be reallocated among our unitholders. We are authorized to revise our method of allocation between transferee and transferor unitholders, as well as among unitholders whose interests vary during a taxable year, to conform to a method permitted under future Treasury Regulations.

              A unitholder who disposes of units prior to the record date set for a cash distribution for that quarter will be allocated items of our income, gain, loss and deduction attributable to the month of disposition but will not be entitled to receive a cash distribution for that period.

Notification Requirements

              A unitholder who sells or purchases any of its units is generally required to notify us in writing of that transaction within 30 days after the transaction (or, if earlier, January 15 of the year following

206


Table of Contents

the transaction). Upon receiving such notifications, we are required to notify the IRS of that transaction and to furnish specified information to the transferor and transferee. Failure to notify us of a transfer of units may, in some cases, lead to the imposition of penalties. However, these reporting requirements do not apply to a sale by an individual who is a citizen of the United States and who effects the sale through a broker who will satisfy such requirements.

Constructive Termination

              We will be considered to have "constructively" terminated our partnership for federal income tax purposes upon the sale or exchange of 50% or more of the total interests in our capital and profits within a twelve-month period. Immediately following this offering, SHC will directly and indirectly own more than 50% of the total interests in our capital and profits. Therefore, a transfer by SHC of all or a portion of its direct or indirect interests in us could result in a termination of our partnership for federal income tax purposes. For such purposes, multiple sales of the same unit are counted only once. A constructive termination results in the closing of our taxable year for all unitholders. In the case of a unitholder reporting on a taxable year other than the calendar year, the closing of our taxable year may result in more than twelve months of our taxable income or loss being includable in such unitholder's taxable income for the year of termination.

              A constructive termination occurring on a date other than December 31 generally would require that we file two tax returns for one fiscal year and the cost of the preparation of these returns will be borne by all unitholders. However, pursuant to an IRS relief procedure the IRS may allow, among other things, a constructively terminated partnership to provide to each unitholder a single Schedule K-1 for the calendar year in which a termination occurs. We would be required to make new tax elections after a termination, including a new election under Section 754 of the Code, and the termination would result in a deferral of our deductions for depreciation and certain amortization. A termination could also result in penalties if we were unable to determine that the termination had occurred. Moreover, a termination may either accelerate the application of, or subject us to, any tax legislation enacted before the termination that would not otherwise have been applied to us as a continuing as opposed to a terminating partnership.


Uniformity of Units

              Because we cannot match transferors and transferees of units and for other reasons, we must maintain uniformity of the economic and tax characteristics of the units to a purchaser of these units. In the absence of uniformity, we may be unable to completely comply with a number of federal income tax requirements, both statutory and regulatory. A lack of uniformity could result from a literal application of Treasury Regulation Section 1.167(c)-1(a)(6), which is not anticipated to apply to a material portion of our assets. Any non-uniformity could have a negative impact on the value of the units. Please read "—Tax Consequences of Unit Ownership—Section 754 Election."

              If necessary to preserve the uniformity of our units, our partnership agreement permits our general partner to take positions in filing our tax returns even when contrary to a literal application of regulations like the one described above. These positions may include reducing for some unitholders the depreciation, amortization or loss deductions to which they would otherwise be entitled or reporting a slower amortization of Section 743(b) adjustments for some unitholders than that to which they would otherwise be entitled. The general partner does not anticipate needing to take such positions, but if they were necessary, Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. would be unable to opine as to validity of such filing positions in the absence of direct and controlling authority.

              A unitholder's basis in units is reduced by its share of our deductions (whether or not such deductions were claimed on an individual income tax return) so that any position that we take that understates deductions will overstate the unitholder's basis in its units, and may cause the unitholder to

207


Table of Contents

understate gain or overstate loss on any sale of such units. Please read "—Disposition of Units—Recognition of Gain or Loss" above and "—Tax Consequences of Unit Ownership—Section 754 Election" above. The IRS may challenge one or more of any positions we take to preserve the uniformity of units. If such a challenge were sustained, the uniformity of units might be affected, and, under some circumstances, the gain from the sale of units might be increased without the benefit of additional deductions.


Tax-Exempt Organizations and Other Investors

              Ownership of units by employee benefit plans, other tax-exempt organizations, non-resident aliens, non-U.S. corporations and other non-U.S. persons raises issues unique to those investors and, as described below, may have substantially adverse tax consequences to them. Prospective unitholders that are tax-exempt entities or non-U.S. persons should consult their tax advisors before investing in our units. Employee benefit plans and most other tax-exempt organizations, including IRAs and other retirement plans, are subject to federal income tax on unrelated business taxable income. Virtually all of our income will be unrelated business taxable income and will be taxable to a tax-exempt unitholder.

              Non-resident aliens and foreign corporations, trusts or estates that own units will be considered to be engaged in business in the United States because of their ownership of our units. Consequently, they will be required to file federal tax returns to report their share of our income, gain, loss or deduction and pay federal income tax at regular rates on their share of our net income or gain. Moreover, under rules applicable to publicly traded partnerships, distributions to non-U.S. unitholders are subject to withholding at the highest applicable effective tax rate. Each non-U.S. unitholder must obtain a taxpayer identification number from the IRS and submit that number to our transfer agent on a Form W-8BEN or applicable substitute form in order to obtain credit for these withholding taxes. A change in applicable law may require us to change these procedures.

              In addition, because a foreign corporation that owns units will be treated as engaged in a United States trade or business, that corporation may be subject to the U.S. branch profits tax at a rate of 30%, in addition to regular federal income tax, on its share of our income and gain, as adjusted for changes in the foreign corporation's "U.S. net equity," which is effectively connected with the conduct of a United States trade or business. That tax may be reduced or eliminated by an income tax treaty between the United States and the country in which the foreign corporate unitholder is a "qualified resident." In addition, this type of unitholder is subject to special information reporting requirements under Section 6038C of the Code.

              A non-U.S. unitholder who sells or otherwise disposes of a unit will be subject to federal income tax on gain realized from the sale or disposition of that unit to the extent the gain is effectively connected with a U.S. trade or business of the non-U.S. unitholder. Under a ruling published by the IRS, interpreting the scope of "effectively connected income," a non-U.S. unitholder would be considered to be engaged in a trade or business in the U.S. by virtue of the U.S. activities of the partnership, and part or all of that unitholder's gain would be effectively connected with that unitholder's indirect U.S. trade or business. Therefore, foreign unitholders may be subject to federal income tax on gain from the sale or disposition of their units. Moreover, under the Foreign Investment in Real Property Tax Act, a foreign unitholder generally will be subject to federal income tax upon the sale or disposition of a unit if (i) it owned (directly or constructively applying certain attribution rules) more than 5% of our units at any time during the five-year period ending on the date of such disposition and (ii) 50% or more of the fair market value of all of our assets consisted of U.S. real property interests at any time during the shorter of the period during which such unitholder held the units or the 5-year period ending on the date of disposition. Currently, we believe that less than 50% of our assets consist of U.S. real property interests and we do not expect that to change in the foreseeable future. However, this could change in the future.

208


Table of Contents


Administrative Matters

Information Returns and Audit Procedures

              We intend to furnish to each unitholder, within 90 days after the close of each taxable year, specific tax information, including a Schedule K-1, which describes its share of our income, gain, loss and deduction for our preceding taxable year. In preparing this information, which will not be reviewed by counsel, we will take various accounting and reporting positions, some of which have been mentioned earlier, to determine each unitholder's share of income, gain, loss and deduction. We cannot assure our unitholders that those positions will yield a result that conforms to all of the requirements of the Code, Treasury Regulations or administrative interpretations of the IRS.

              The IRS may audit our federal income tax information returns. Neither we, nor Vinson & Elkins L.L.P., can assure prospective unitholders that the IRS will not successfully challenge the positions we adopt, and such a challenge could adversely affect the value of the units. Adjustments resulting from an IRS audit may require each unitholder to adjust a prior year's tax liability and may result in an audit of the unitholder's own return. Any audit of a unitholder's return could result in adjustments unrelated to our returns.

              Partnerships generally are treated as entities separate from their owners for purposes of federal income tax audits, judicial review of administrative adjustments by the IRS and tax settlement proceedings. The tax treatment of partnership items of income, gain, loss and deduction are determined in a partnership proceeding rather than in separate proceedings with the partners. The Code requires that one partner be designated as the "Tax Matters Partner" for these purposes, and our partnership agreement designates SHC, or such other partner as determined by the Board.

              The Tax Matters Partner will make some elections on our behalf and on behalf of unitholders. In addition, the Tax Matters Partner can extend the statute of limitations for assessment of tax deficiencies against unitholders for items in our returns. The Tax Matters Partner may bind a unitholder with less than a 1% profits interest in us to a settlement with the IRS unless that unitholder elects, by filing a statement with the IRS, not to give that authority to the Tax Matters Partner. The Tax Matters Partner may seek judicial review, by which all the unitholders are bound, of a final partnership administrative adjustment and, if the Tax Matters Partner fails to seek judicial review, judicial review may be sought by any unitholder having at least a 1% interest in profits or by any group of unitholders having in the aggregate at least a 5% interest in profits. However, only one action for judicial review may go forward, and each unitholder with an interest in the outcome may participate in that action.

              A unitholder must file a statement with the IRS identifying the treatment of any item on its federal income tax return that is not consistent with the treatment of the item on our return. Intentional or negligent disregard of this consistency requirement may subject a unitholder to substantial penalties.

Nominee Reporting

              Persons who hold an interest in us as a nominee for another person are required to furnish to us:

              (1)   the name, address and taxpayer identification number of the beneficial owner and the nominee;

              (2)   a statement regarding whether the beneficial owner is:

                    (a)   a non-U.S. person;

                    (b)   a non-U.S. government, an international organization or any wholly owned agency or instrumentality of either of the foregoing; or

209


Table of Contents

                    (c)   a tax-exempt entity;

              (3)   the amount and description of units held, acquired or transferred for the beneficial owner; and

              (4)   specific information including the dates of acquisitions and transfers, means of acquisitions and transfers, and acquisition cost for purchases, as well as the amount of net proceeds from sales.

              Brokers and financial institutions are required to furnish additional information, including whether they are U.S. persons and specific information on units they acquire, hold or transfer for their own account. A penalty of $100 per failure, up to a maximum of $1.5 million per calendar year, is imposed by the Code for failure to report that information to us. The nominee is required to supply the beneficial owner of the units with the information furnished to us.

Accuracy-Related Penalties

              An additional tax equal to 20% of the amount of any portion of an underpayment of tax that is attributable to one or more specified causes, including negligence or disregard of rules or regulations, substantial understatements of income tax and substantial valuation misstatements, is imposed by the Code. No penalty will be imposed, however, for any portion of an underpayment if it is shown that there was a reasonable cause for the underpayment of that portion and that the taxpayer acted in good faith regarding the underpayment of that portion.

              For individuals, a substantial understatement of income tax in any taxable year exists if the amount of the understatement exceeds the greater of 10% of the tax required to be shown on the return for the taxable year or $5,000. The amount of any understatement subject to penalty generally is reduced if any portion is attributable to a position adopted on the return:

              (1)   for which there is, or was, "substantial authority"; or

              (2)   as to which there is a reasonable basis and the relevant facts of that position are disclosed on the return.

              If any item of income, gain, loss or deduction included in the distributive shares of unitholders might result in that kind of an "understatement" of income for which no "substantial authority" exists, we must disclose the relevant facts on our return. In addition, we will make a reasonable effort to furnish sufficient information for unitholders to make adequate disclosure on their returns and to take other actions as may be appropriate to permit unitholders to avoid liability for this penalty. More stringent rules apply to "tax shelters," which we do not believe includes us, or any of our investments, plans or arrangements.

              A substantial valuation misstatement exists if (a) the value of any property, or the tax basis of any property, claimed on a tax return is 150% or more of the amount determined to be the correct amount of the valuation or tax basis, (b) the price for any property or services (or for the use of property) claimed on any such return with respect to any transaction between persons described in Code Section 482 is 200% or more (or 50% or less) of the amount determined under Section 482 to be the correct amount of such price, or (c) the net Code Section 482 transfer price adjustment for the taxable year exceeds the lesser of $5 million or 10% of the taxpayer's gross receipts. No penalty is imposed unless the portion of the underpayment attributable to a substantial valuation misstatement exceeds $5,000 ($10,000 for a corporation other than an S Corporation or a personal holding company). The penalty is increased to 40% in the event of a gross valuation misstatement. We do not anticipate making any valuation misstatements.

210


Table of Contents

              In addition, the 20% accuracy-related penalty also applies to any portion of an underpayment of tax that is attributable to transactions lacking economic substance. To the extent that such transactions are not disclosed, the penalty imposed is increased to 40%. Additionally, there is no reasonable cause defense to the imposition of this penalty to such transactions.

Reportable Transactions

              If we were to engage in a "reportable transaction," we (and possibly our unitholders and others) would be required to make a detailed disclosure of the transaction to the IRS. A transaction may be a reportable transaction based upon any of several factors, including the fact that it is a type of tax avoidance transaction publicly identified by the IRS as a "listed transaction" or that it produces certain kinds of losses for partnerships, individuals, S corporations, and trusts in excess of $2 million in any single tax year, or $4 million in any combination of six successive tax years. Our participation in a reportable transaction could increase the likelihood that our federal income tax information return (and possibly our unitholders' tax return) would be audited by the IRS. Please read "—Administrative Matters—Information Returns and Audit Procedures."

              Moreover, if we were to participate in a reportable transaction with a significant purpose to avoid or evade tax, or in any listed transaction, our unitholders may be subject to the following additional consequences:

    accuracy-related penalties with a broader scope, significantly narrower exceptions, and potentially greater amounts than described above at "—Accuracy-Related Penalties";

    for those persons otherwise entitled to deduct interest on federal tax deficiencies, non-deductibility of interest on any resulting tax liability; and

    in the case of a listed transaction, an extended statute of limitations.

              We do not expect to engage in any "reportable transactions."


State, Local and Other Tax Considerations

              In addition to U.S. federal income taxes, unitholders will likely be subject to other taxes, including state and local income taxes, unincorporated business taxes, and estate, inheritance or intangibles taxes that may be imposed by the various jurisdictions in which we conduct business or own property now or in the future, even if they do not live in any of those jurisdictions. We currently conduct business or own assets in Texas, Louisiana, New Mexico and Oklahoma. Each of these states, other than Texas, currently imposes a personal income tax on individuals. Each of these states also imposes an income or other entity-level tax on corporations and other entities. Unitholders may be required to file state and local income tax returns and pay state and local income taxes in some or all of these various jurisdictions. Further, unitholders may be subject to penalties for failing to comply with these requirements. Moreover, as we make acquisitions or expand our business, we may also own assets or conduct business in additional states or non-U.S. jurisdictions that impose income or similar taxes on individuals and corporations and other entities. Although an analysis of those various taxes is not presented here, each prospective unitholder should consider their potential impact on its investment in us.

              It is the responsibility of each unitholder to investigate the legal and tax consequences, under the laws of pertinent states and localities, of its investment in us. Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. has not rendered an opinion on the state, local, or non-U.S. tax consequences of an investment in us. We strongly recommend that each prospective unitholder consult, and depend on, its own tax counsel or other advisor with regard to those matters. It is the responsibility of each unitholder to file all tax returns that may be required of it.

211


Table of Contents


INVESTMENT IN SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP BY
EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS

              An investment in us by an employee benefit plan is subject to additional considerations because the investments of these plans are subject to the fiduciary responsibility and prohibited transaction provisions of ERISA and restrictions imposed by Section 4975 of the Internal Revenue Code. For these purposes the term "employee benefit plan" includes, but is not limited to, qualified pension, profit-sharing and stock bonus plans, Keogh plans, simplified employee pension plans and tax deferred annuities or IRAs established or maintained by an employer or employee organization. Among other things, consideration should be given to:

    whether the investment is prudent under Section 404(a)(1)(B) of ERISA;

    whether in making the investment, that plan will satisfy the diversification requirements of Section 404(a)(1)(C) of ERISA; and

    whether the investment will result in recognition of unrelated business taxable income by the plan and, if so, the potential after-tax investment return. Please read "Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences—Tax-Exempt Organizations and Other Investors."

              The person with investment discretion with respect to the assets of an employee benefit plan, often called a fiduciary, should determine whether an investment in us is authorized by the appropriate governing instrument and is a proper investment for the plan or IRA.

              Section 406 of ERISA and Section 4975 of the Internal Revenue Code prohibit employee benefit plans, and also IRAs that are not considered part of an employee benefit plan, from engaging in specified transactions involving "plan assets" with parties that are "parties in interest" under ERISA or "disqualified persons" under the Internal Revenue Code with respect to the plan.

              In addition to considering whether the purchase of common units is a prohibited transaction, a fiduciary of an employee benefit plan should consider whether the plan will, by investing in us, be deemed to own an undivided interest in our assets, with the result that our operations would be subject to the regulatory restrictions of ERISA, including its prohibited transaction rules, as well as the prohibited transaction rules of the Internal Revenue Code.

              The Department of Labor regulations provide guidance with respect to whether the assets of an entity in which employee benefit plans acquire equity interests would be deemed "plan assets" under some circumstances. Under these regulations, an entity's assets would not be considered to be "plan assets" if, among other things:

                    (1)   the equity interests acquired by employee benefit plans are publicly offered securities—i.e., the equity interests are widely held by 100 or more investors independent of the issuer and each other, freely transferable and registered under some provisions of the federal securities laws;

                    (2)   the entity is an "operating company"—i.e., it is primarily engaged in the production or sale of a product or service other than the investment of capital either directly or through a majority-owned subsidiary or subsidiaries; or

                    (3)   there is no significant investment by benefit plan investors, which is defined to mean that less than 25% of the value of each class of equity interest is held by the employee benefit plans referred to above, and IRAs that are subject to ERISA or Section 4975 of the Internal Revenue Code.

              Our assets should not be considered "plan assets" under these regulations because it is expected that the investment will satisfy the requirements in (a) and (b) above.

              Plan fiduciaries contemplating a purchase of common units should consult with their own counsel regarding the consequences under ERISA and the Internal Revenue Code in light of the serious penalties imposed on persons who engage in prohibited transactions or other violations.

212


Table of Contents


UNDERWRITING

              Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated and Barclays Capital Inc. are acting as representatives of each of the underwriters named below. Subject to the terms and conditions set forth in an underwriting agreement among us and the underwriters, we have agreed to sell to the underwriters, and each of the underwriters has agreed, severally and not jointly, to purchase from us, the number of common units set forth opposite its name below.

                       Underwriter
 
Number
of Common Units
 

Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
                      Incorporated

       

Barclays Capital Inc. 

       
       

                      Total

       
       

              Subject to the terms and conditions set forth in the underwriting agreement, the underwriters have agreed, severally and not jointly, to purchase all of the common units sold under the underwriting agreement if any of these common units are purchased. If an underwriter defaults, the underwriting agreement provides that the purchase commitments of the nondefaulting underwriters may be increased or the underwriting agreement may be terminated.

              We, our general partner and certain of our affiliates have agreed to indemnify the underwriters against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act, or to contribute to payments the underwriters may be required to make in respect of those liabilities.

              The underwriters are offering the common units, subject to prior sale, when, as and if issued to and accepted by them, subject to approval of legal matters by their counsel, including the validity of the common units, and other conditions contained in the underwriting agreement, such as the receipt by the underwriters of officer's certificates and legal opinions. The underwriters reserve the right to withdraw, cancel or modify offers to the public and to reject orders in whole or in part.


Commissions and Discounts

              The representatives have advised us that the underwriters propose initially to offer the common units to the public at the public offering price set forth on the cover page of this prospectus and to dealers at that price less a concession not in excess of $            per common unit. After the initial offering, the public offering price, concession or any other term of the offering may be changed.

              The following table shows the public offering price, underwriting discount and proceeds before expenses to us. The information assumes either no exercise or full exercise by the underwriters of their option to purchase additional common units.

 
  Per Common Unit   Without Option   With Option  

Public offering price

  $     $     $    

Underwriting discount(1)(2)

  $     $     $    

Proceeds, before expenses, to us

  $     $     $    

(1)
Excludes a structuring fee equal to        % of the gross proceeds of this offering payable to Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated and Barclays Capital Inc.

(2)
The underwriters will not receive any underwriting discount or commission on $             million of common units offered by this prospectus through our directed unit program to certain of our general partner's directors and executive officers.

213


Table of Contents

      Accordingly, proceeds to us (before expenses) include the full per unit initial public offering price of these units.

                    The expenses of the offering, not including the underwriting discount or the structuring fee, are estimated at $            and are payable by us. We will pay a structuring fee equal to        % of the gross proceeds of this offering (including any proceeds from the exercise of the option of purchase additional common units) to Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated and Barclays Capital Inc. for the evaluation, analysis and structuring of our partnership.


Option to Purchase Additional Common Units

                    We have granted an option to the underwriters, exercisable for 30 days after the date of this prospectus, to purchase up to additional            common units at the public offering price, less the underwriting discount. If the underwriters exercise this option, each will be obligated, subject to conditions contained in the underwriting agreement, to purchase a number of additional common units proportionate to that underwriter's initial amount reflected in the above table.


No Sales of Similar Securities

                    We, our general partner, certain of our general partner's executive officers and directors and certain of our affiliates, including SHC, have agreed not to sell or transfer any common units or securities convertible into, exchangeable for, exercisable for, or repayable with common units, for 180 days after the date of this prospectus without first obtaining the written consent of Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated. Specifically, we and these other persons have agreed, with certain limited exceptions, not to directly or indirectly:

    offer, pledge, sell or contract to sell any common units;

    sell any option or contract to purchase any common units;

    purchase any option or contract to sell any common units;

    grant any option, right or warrant for the sale of any common units;

    lend or otherwise dispose of or transfer any common units;

    request or demand that we file a registration statement related to the common units; or

    enter into any swap or other agreement that transfers, in whole or in part, the economic consequence of ownership of any common units whether any such swap or transaction is to be settled by delivery of common units or other securities, in cash or otherwise.

              This lock-up provision applies to common units and to securities convertible into or exchangeable or exercisable for or repayable with common units. It also applies to common units owned now or acquired later by the person executing the agreement or for which the person executing the agreement later acquires the power of disposition. In the event that either (x) during the last 17 days of the lock-up period referred to above, we issue an earnings release or material news or a material event relating to us occurs or (y) prior to the expiration of the lock-up period, we announce that we will release earnings results or become aware that material news or a material event will occur during the 16-day period beginning on the last day of the lock-up period, the restrictions described above shall continue to apply until the expiration of the 18-day period beginning on the issuance of the earnings release or the occurrence of the material news or material event.

              The lock-up provision described above will not apply to (i) any common units purchased pursuant to the directed unit program by persons other than our general partner's executive officers and directors, (ii) any common units issued or options to purchase common units granted pursuant our employee benefit or equity compensation plans described herein or (iii) any securities equal to up to

214


Table of Contents

10% of our outstanding common and subordinated units issued by us in connection with an acquisition by us or any of our subsidiaries of the securities, business, property or other assets of another person or entity or pursuant to any plan assumed by us in connection with such acquisition.


Stock Exchange Listing

              The common units have been approved for listing on the NYSE, subject to notice of issuance, under the symbol "SUSP."

              Before this offering, there has been no public market for our common units. The initial public offering price will be determined through negotiations between us and the representatives. In addition to prevailing market conditions, the factors to be considered in determining the initial public offering price are

    the valuation multiples of publicly traded companies that the representatives believe to be comparable to us;

    our financial information;

    the history of, and the prospects for, our partnership and the industry in which we compete;

    an assessment of our management, its past and present operations, and the prospects for, and timing of, our future revenues;

    the present state of our development;

    the recent market prices of, and demand for, publicly traded equity securities of generally comparable companies; and

    the above factors in relation to market values and various valuation measures of other companies engaged in activities similar to ours.

              An active trading market for the common units may not develop. It is also possible that after the offering the common units will not trade in the public market at or above the initial public offering price.

              The underwriters do not expect to sell more than 5% of the common units in the aggregate to accounts over which they exercise discretionary authority.


Price Stabilization, Short Positions and Penalty Bids

              Until the distribution of the common units is completed, SEC rules may limit underwriters and selling group members from bidding for and purchasing our common units. However, the representatives may engage in transactions that stabilize the price of the common units, such as bids or purchases to peg, fix or maintain that price.

              In connection with the offering, the underwriters may purchase and sell our common units in the open market. These transactions may include short sales, purchases on the open market to cover positions created by short sales and stabilizing transactions. Short sales involve the sale by the underwriters of a greater number of common units than they are required to purchase in the offering. "Covered" short sales are sales made in an amount not greater than the underwriters' option to purchase additional common units described above. The underwriters may close out any covered short position by either exercising their option to purchase additional common units or purchasing common units in the open market. In determining the source of common units to close out the covered short position, the underwriters will consider, among other things, the price of common units available for purchase in the open market as compared to the price at which they may purchase common units through the option granted to them. "Naked" short sales are sales in excess of such option. The underwriters must close out any naked short position by purchasing common units in the open market. A naked short position is more likely to be created if the underwriters are concerned that there may be

215


Table of Contents

downward pressure on the price of our common units in the open market after pricing that could adversely affect investors who purchase in the offering. Stabilizing transactions consist of various bids for or purchases of common units made by the underwriters in the open market prior to the completion of the offering.

              The underwriters may also impose a penalty bid. This occurs when a particular underwriter repays to the underwriters a portion of the underwriting discount received by it because the representatives have repurchased common units sold by or for the account of such underwriter in stabilizing or short covering transactions.

              Similar to other purchase transactions, the underwriters' purchases to cover the syndicate short sales may have the effect of raising or maintaining the market price of our common units or preventing or retarding a decline in the market price of our common units. As a result, the price of our common units may be higher than the price that might otherwise exist in the open market. The underwriters may conduct these transactions on the NYSE, in the over-the-counter market or otherwise.

              Neither we nor any of the underwriters make any representation or prediction as to the direction or magnitude of any effect that the transactions described above may have on the price of our common units. In addition, neither we nor any of the underwriters make any representation that the representatives will engage in these transactions or that these transactions, once commenced, will not be discontinued without notice.


Electronic Distribution

              In connection with the offering, certain of the underwriters or securities dealers may distribute prospectuses by electronic means, such as e-mail.


Conflicts of Interest

              Because the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, or FINRA, views the common units offered hereby as interests in a direct participation program, this offering is being made in compliance with Rule 2310 of the FINRA Rules. Investor suitability with respect to the common units should be judged similarly to the suitability with respect to other securities that are listed for trading on a national securities exchange.


Other Relationships

              Some of the underwriters and their affiliates have engaged in, and may in the future engage in, investment banking and other commercial dealings in the ordinary course of business with us or our affiliates. They have received, or may in the future receive, customary fees and commissions for these transactions. Bank of America, N.A., an affiliate of Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated, is the administrative agent, swing line lender and l/c issuer, and Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated is the sole lead arranger and sole book manager, under our new revolving credit facility. Bank of America, N.A. is also the sole lender under our new term loan facility. Bank of America, N.A. is also the revolving administrative agent, swing line lender and l/c issuer, and Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated is a joint lead arranger and joint bookrunner, under SHC's revolving credit facility. Bank of America, N.A. will also be a lender under the term loan facility SHC will enter into in connection with this offering. SHC may use a portion of the distributions made to it in the event the underwriters exercise their option to purchase up to                    additional common units, as described in "Use of Proceeds," to repay borrowings outstanding under the term loan facility. Accordingly, Bank of America, N.A., may receive a portion of the distributions made to SHC in connection with this offering.

              In addition, in the ordinary course of their business activities, the underwriters and their affiliates may make or hold a broad array of investments and actively trade debt and equity securities

216


Table of Contents

(or related derivative securities) and financial instruments (including bank loans) for their own account and for the accounts of their customers. Such investments and securities activities may involve securities and/or instruments of ours or our affiliates. The underwriters and their affiliates may also make investment recommendations and/or publish or express independent research views in respect of such securities or financial instruments and may hold, or recommend to clients that they acquire, long and/or short positions in such securities and instruments.


Directed Unit Program

              At our request, the underwriters have reserved up to 10% of the common units offered hereby for sale at the initial public offering price to persons who are directors, officers and employees of our general partner and SHC and its subsidiaries, through a directed unit program. The number of common units available for sale to the general public will be reduced by the number of units purchased by participants in the program. Any reserved common units which are not so purchased will be offered by the underwriters to the general public on the same terms as the other common units offered hereby.

              Certain of our general partner's officers and directors who purchase units through the directed unit program will be subject to the 180-day lock-up provision described above under the caption "—No Sales of Similar Securities."


Selling Restrictions

      European Economic Area

              In relation to each member state of the European Economic Area that has implemented the Prospectus Directive (each, a "relevant member state"), other than Germany, with effect from and including the date on which the Prospectus Directive is implemented in that relevant member state, an offer of securities described in this prospectus may not be made to the public in that relevant member state other than:

    to any legal entity which is a qualified investor as defined in the Prospectus Directive;

    to fewer than 100 or, if the relevant member state has implemented the relevant provision of the 2010 PD Amending Directive, 150, natural or legal persons (other than qualified investors as defined in the Prospectus Directive), as permitted under the Prospectus Directive, subject to obtaining the prior consent of the relevant dealer or dealers nominated by the issuer for any such offer; or

    in any other circumstances falling within Article 3(2) of the Prospectus Directive;

provided that no such offer of securities shall require us or any underwriter to publish a prospectus pursuant to Article 3 of the Prospectus Directive.

              For purposes of this provision, the expression an "offer of securities to the public" in any relevant member state means the communication in any form and by any means of sufficient information on the terms of the offer and the securities to be offered so as to enable an investor to decide to purchase or subscribe for the securities, as the expression may be varied in that member state by any measure implementing the Prospectus Directive in that member state, and the expression "Prospectus Directive" means Directive 2003/71/EC (and amendments thereto, including the 2010 PD Amending Directive, to the extent implemented in the relevant member state), and includes any relevant implementing measure in each relevant member state. The expression "2010 PD Amending Directive" means Directive 2010/73/EU.

              We have not authorized and do not authorize the making of any offer of securities through any financial intermediary on their behalf, other than offers made by the underwriters with a view to the final placement of the securities as contemplated in this prospectus. Accordingly, no purchaser of the

217


Table of Contents

securities, other than the underwriters, is authorized to make any further offer of the securities on behalf of us or the underwriters.

      United Kingdom

              We may constitute a "collective investment scheme" as defined by section 235 of the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000, or FSMA, that is not a "recognized collective investment scheme" for the purposes of FSMA, or CIS, and that has not been authorized or otherwise approved. As an unregulated scheme, it cannot be marketed in the United Kingdom to the general public, except in accordance with FSMA. This prospectus is only being distributed in the United Kingdom to, and is only directed at:

    (i)
    (a) investment professionals falling within the description of persons in Article 14(5) of the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 (Promotion of Collective Investment Schemes) Order 2001, as amended, or the CIS Promotion Order, or Article 19(5) of the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 (Financial Promotion) Order 2005, as amended, or the Financial Promotion Order, or (b) high net worth companies and other persons falling within Article 22(2)(a) to (d) of the CIS Promotion Order or Article 49(2)(a) to (d) of the Financial Promotion Order; or

    (ii)
    to any other person to whom it may otherwise lawfully be made (all such persons together being referred to as "relevant persons").

              The common units are only available to, and any invitation, offer or agreement to subscribe, purchase or otherwise acquire such common units will be engaged in only with, relevant persons. Any person who is not a relevant person should not act or rely on this prospectus or any of its contents.

              An invitation or inducement to engage in investment activity (within the meaning of Section 21 of FSMA) in connection with the issue or sale of any common units which are the subject of the offering contemplated by this prospectus will only be communicated or caused to be communicated in circumstances in which Section 21(1) of FSMA does not apply to us.

      Switzerland

              This prospectus is being communicated in Switzerland to a small number of selected investors only. Each copy of this prospectus is addressed to a specifically named recipient and may not be copied, reproduced, distributed or passed on to third parties. The common units are not being offered to the public in Switzerland, and neither this prospectus nor any other offering materials relating to the common units may be distributed in connection with any such public offering.

              We have not been registered with the Swiss Financial Market Supervisory Authority FINMA as a foreign collective investment scheme pursuant to Article 120 of the Collective Investment Schemes Act of June 23, 2006, or the CISA. Accordingly, the common units may not be offered to the public in or from Switzerland, and neither this prospectus nor any other offering materials relating to the common units may be made available through a public offering in or from Switzerland. The common units may only be offered and this prospectus may only be distributed in or from Switzerland by way of private placement exclusively to qualified investors (as this term is defined in the CISA and its implementing ordinance).

      Germany

              This document has not been prepared in accordance with the requirements for a securities or sales prospectus under the German Securities Prospectus Act (Wertpapierprospektgesetz), the German Sales Prospectus Act (Verkaufsprospektgesetz), or the German Investment Act (Investmentgesetz). Neither the German Federal Financial Services Supervisory Authority (Bundesanstalt für Finanzdienstleistungsaufsicht—BaFin) nor any other German authority has been notified of the

218


Table of Contents

intention to distribute the common units in Germany. Consequently, the common units may not be distributed in Germany by way of public offering, public advertisement or in any similar manner and this document and any other document relating to the offering, as well as information or statements contained therein, may not be supplied to the public in Germany or used in connection with any offer for subscription of the common units to the public in Germany or any other means of public marketing. The common units are being offered and sold in Germany only to qualified investors which are referred to in Section 3 paragraph 2 no. 1, in connection with Section 2 no. 6, of the German Securities Prospectus Act, Section 8f paragraph 2 no. 4 of the German Sales Prospectus Act, and in Section 2 paragraph 11 sentence 2 no. 1 of the German Investment Act. This document is strictly for use of the person who has received it. It may not be forwarded to other persons or published in Germany.

              The offering does not constitute an offer to sell or the solicitation or an offer to buy the common units in any circumstances in which such offer or solicitation is unlawful.

      Netherlands

              The common units may not be offered or sold, directly or indirectly, in the Netherlands, other than to qualified investors (gekwalificeerde beleggers) within the meaning of Article 1:1 of the Dutch Financial Supervision Act (Wet op het financieel toezicht).

219


Table of Contents


VALIDITY OF OUR COMMON UNITS

              The validity of our common units will be passed upon for us by Vinson & Elkins L.L.P., Houston, Texas. Certain legal matters in connection with our common units offered hereby will be passed upon for the underwriters by Andrews Kurth LLP, Houston, Texas.


EXPERTS

              The consolidated financial statements of Susser Petroleum Company LLC as of December 31, 2010 and December 31, 2011 and for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2011, appearing in this prospectus and registration statement have been audited by Ernst & Young LLP, independent registered public accounting firm, as set forth in their report thereon appearing elsewhere herein, and are included in reliance upon such report given on the authority of such firm as experts in accounting and auditing.

              The balance sheet of Susser Petroleum Partners LP as of June 11, 2012 (date of inception) appearing in this prospectus and registration statement has been audited by Ernst & Young LLP, independent registered public accounting firm, as set forth in their report thereon appearing elsewhere herein, and are included in reliance upon such experts in auditing and accounting.


WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION

              We have filed with the SEC a registration statement on Form S-1 regarding our common units. This prospectus, which constitutes part of the registration statement, does not contain all of the information set forth in the registration statement. For further information regarding us and our common units offered in this prospectus, we refer you to the registration statement and the exhibits and schedule filed as part of the registration statement. The registration statement, including the exhibits, may be inspected and copied at the public reference facilities maintained by the SEC at 100 F Street, N.E., Room 1580, Washington, D.C. 20549. Copies of this material can also be obtained upon written request from the Public Reference Section of the SEC at 100 F Street, N.E., Room 1580, Washington, D.C. 20549, at prescribed rates or from the SEC's web site on the Internet at http:// www.sec.gov . Please call the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 for further information on public reference rooms.

              As a result of the offering, we will file with or furnish to the SEC periodic reports and other information. These reports and other information may be inspected and copied at the public reference facilities maintained by the SEC or obtained from the SEC's website as provided above. Our website will be located at http://www.                        .com and we intend to make our periodic reports and other information filed with or furnished to the SEC available, free of charge, through our website, as soon as reasonably practicable after those reports and other information are electronically filed with or furnished to the SEC. Information on our website or any other website is not incorporated by reference into this prospectus and does not constitute a part of this prospectus.

              We intend to furnish or make available to our unitholders annual reports containing our audited financial statements prepared in accordance with GAAP. We also intend to furnish or make available to our unitholders quarterly reports containing our unaudited interim financial information, including the information required by Form 10-Q, for the first three fiscal quarters of each fiscal year.

220


Table of Contents


FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

              Some of the information in this prospectus may contain forward-looking statements. Forward-looking statements give our current expectations, contain projections of results of operations or of financial condition, or forecasts of future events. Words such as "may," "assume," "forecast," "position," "predict," "strategy," "expect," "intend," "plan," "estimate," "anticipate," "believe," "project," "budget," "potential," or "continue," and similar expressions are used to identify forward-looking statements. They can be affected by assumptions used or by known or unknown risks or uncertainties. Consequently, no forward-looking statements can be guaranteed. When considering these forward-looking statements, you should keep in mind the risk factors and other cautionary statements in this prospectus. Actual results may vary materially. You are cautioned not to place undue reliance on any forward-looking statements. You should also understand that it is not possible to predict or identify all such factors and should not consider the following list to be a complete statement of all potential risks and uncertainties. Factors that could cause our actual results to differ materially from the results contemplated by such forward-looking statements include:

    SHC's business strategy and operations and SHC's conflicts of interest with us;

    Renewal or renegotiation of our long-term distribution contracts with our customers;

    Changes in the price of and demand for the motor fuel that we distribute;

    Our dependence on two principal suppliers;

    Competition in the wholesale motor fuel distribution industry;

    Seasonal trends;

    Increased costs;

    Our ability to make acquisitions;

    Environmental laws and regulations;

    Dangers inherent in the storage of motor fuel; and

    Our reliance on SHC for transportation services.

              All forward-looking statements are expressly qualified in their entirety by the foregoing cautionary statements.

221


Table of Contents


INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 
  Page

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP
UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

   

Introduction

  F-2

Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Balance Sheet as of June 30, 2012

  F-3

Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Operations for the Six Months Ended June 30, 2012

  F-5

Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Operations for the Year Ended December 31, 2011

  F-6

Notes to Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Financial Statements

  F-7

SUSSER PETROLEUM COMPANY LLC (PREDECESSOR)
UNAUDITED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

   

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2011 and June 30, 2012 (Unaudited)

  F-11

Unaudited Consolidated Statements of Operations for the Three and Six Months Ended June 30, 2011 and 2012

  F-12

Unaudited Consolidated Statements of Unitholder's Equity for the Six Months Ended June 30, 2012

  F-13

Unaudited Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Six Months Ended June 30, 2011 and 2012

  F-14

Notes to the Unaudited Consolidated Financial Statements

  F-15

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP
UNAUDITED STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL POSITION

   

Balance Sheet as of June 30, 2012

  F-22

Notes to Balance Sheet

  F-23

SUSSER PETROLEUM COMPANY LLC (PREDECESSOR)
AUDITED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

   

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

  F-24

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2010 and December 31, 2011

  F-25

Consolidated Statements of Operations for the Years Ended December 31, 2009, December 31, 2010 and December 31, 2011

  F-26

Consolidated Statements of Unitholder's Equity for the Years Ended December 31, 2009, December 31, 2010 and December 31, 2011

  F-27

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended December 31, 2009, December 31, 2010 and December 31, 2011

  F-28

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

  F-29

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP
AUDITED STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL POSITION

   

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

  F-49

Balance Sheet as of June 11, 2012 (Date of Inception)

  F-50

Notes to Balance Sheet

  F-51

F-1


Table of Contents


Susser Petroleum Partners LP

Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Financial Statements

Introduction

              The accompanying unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements of Susser Petroleum Partners LP, a newly formed Delaware limited partnership (the "Partnership"), are derived from Susser Petroleum Company LLC's (the "Predecessor") audited historical consolidated financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2011, and the unaudited historical consolidated financial statements as of and for the six months ended June 30, 2012, and have been prepared to reflect the formation of the Partnership, the contribution of certain assets of the Predecessor to the Partnership, the SHC Distribution Contract, the SHC Transportation Contract, the new credit agreements, the initial public offering (the "Offering") and use of proceeds from the Offering.

              In connection with the Offering, certain assets and liabilities of the Predecessor will be contributed to the Partnership, and the Partnership will begin providing wholesale fuel distribution services for Susser Holdings Corporation and its subsidiaries (the "Parent" of the Predecessor) and other third-party customers. Please read Note 1 to our Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Financial Statements for a detailed description of the pro forma adjustments to our historical operating results. The assets, liabilities and results of operations of the Predecessor for periods prior to their actual contribution to the Partnership are presented as the Predecessor.

              The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements of the Partnership should be read together with the historical consolidated financial statements of the Predecessor included elsewhere in this prospectus. The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements of the Partnership were derived by making certain adjustments to the historical consolidated financial statements of the Predecessor for the year ended December 31, 2011, and as of and for the six months ended June 30, 2012. The adjustments are based on currently available information and certain estimates and assumptions. Therefore, the actual adjustments may differ from the pro forma adjustments. However, management believes that the estimates and assumptions provide a reasonable basis for presenting the significant effects of the contemplated transactions and that the pro forma adjustments give appropriate effect to those estimates and assumptions and are properly applied in the unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements.

              The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements are not necessarily indicative of the results that actually would have occurred if the Partnership had assumed the operations of the Predecessor on the dates indicated nor are they indicative of future results, in part because they include allocations of various corporate operating expenses that may differ from our actual corporate operating expenses and they do not give pro forma effect to incremental external general and administrative expenses of approximately $2.0 million that we expect to incur as a result of being a publicly traded partnership. In addition, although our unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements do give effect to the SHC Distribution Contract and the SHC Transportation Contract, they do not include the effects of other agreements that may be entered into with Parent.

F-2


Table of Contents


Susser Petroleum Partners LP

Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Balance Sheet

as of June 30, 2012

 
  Susser
Petroleum
Company LLC
(Predecessor)
Historical
  Predecessor
Retained
Operations
  SHC
Distribution
and
Transportation
Contract
  Assets
Contributed by
Parent
  Offering
Related
Adjustments
  Susser
Petroleum
Partners LP
Pro Forma
 
 
  (in thousands)
 

Assets

                                     

Current assets:

                                     

Cash and cash equivalents

  $ 1,145   $ 7  (b) $   $   $   $ 1,152  

Marketable Securities

                      147,300     147,300  

Accounts receivable

    40,621     (40,621 )(a)                

Receivables with affiliates

    102,654     (103,425 )(a)                  

          771  (b)                

Inventories, net

    10,883     (3,409 )(a)               7,474  

Other current assets

    886     23  (a)           (360 )(k)   549  
                           

Total current assets

    156,189     (146,654 )           146,940     156,475  

Property and equipment, net

    43,051     (9,460 )(a)       6,650  (i)       35,441  

          (4,800 )(b)                  

Other assets:

                                     

Goodwill

    20,661     (7,725 )(a)               12,936  

Intangible assets

    22,053     (144 )(a)           2,350  (j)   24,259  

Other noncurrent assets

    809     (403 )(a)               406  
                           

Total assets

  $ 242,763   $ (169,186 ) $   $ 6,650   $ 149,290   $ 229,517  
                           

   

See accompanying notes

F-3


Table of Contents


Susser Petroleum Partners LP

Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Balance Sheet

as of June 30, 2012

 
  Susser
Petroleum
Company LLC
(Predecessor)
Historical
  Predecessor
Retained
Operations
  SHC Distribution
and
Transportation
Contract
  Assets
Contributed by
Parent
  Offering
Related
Adjustments
  Susser
Petroleum
Partners LP
Pro Forma
 
 
  (in thousands)
 

Liabilities, unitholder's equity and partners' equity

                                     

Current liabilties:

                                     

Accounts payable

  $ 108,201   $ (107,647 )(a) $   $   $   $  

          (477 )(c)                  

          (77 )(b)                  

Accrued expenses and other current liabilities

    4,246     (183 )(a)           (2,300 )(k)   943  

          (108 )(b)                  

          (712 )(e)                  

Current maturities of long-term debt

    23                     23  
                           

Total current liabilities

    112,470     (109,204 )           (2,300 )   966  

Long-term debt

    1,087                 149,650   (j)   150,737  

Deferred branding incentives, long-term portion

    4,366                     4,366  

Deferred tax liability, long-term portion

    2,969                 (2,969 )(k)    

Other noncurrent liabilities

    681     (658 )(a)               23  
                           

Total liabilities

    121,573     (109,862 )           144,381     156,092  
                           

Commitments and contingencies:

                                     

Unitholder's and partners' equity:

                                     

Unitholder's equity:

                                     

Common units

                         

Retained earnings

    121,190     (56,676 )(a)       6,650 (i)   4,909 (k)    

          477   (c)           (73,425 )(l)      

          (3,837 )(b)                  

          712   (e)                  

Partners' equity:

                                     

Common and subordinated unitholders

                      73,425   (l)   73,425  

General partner

                                   
                           

Total unitholder's and partners' equity

    121,190     (59,324 )       6,650     4,909     73,425  
                           

Total liabilities, unitholder's and partners' equity

  $ 242,763   $ (169,186 ) $   $ 6,650   $ 149,290   $ 229,517  
                           

   

See accompanying notes

F-4


Table of Contents


Susser Petroleum Partners LP

Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statements of Operations

for the Six Months Ended June 30, 2012

 
  Susser
Petroleum
Company LLC
(Predecessor)
Historical
  Predecessor
Retained
Operations
  SHC
Distribution
and
Transportation
Contract
  Assets
Contributed by
Parent
  Offering
Related
Adjustments
  Susser
Petroleum
Partners LP
Pro Forma
 
 
  (dollars in thousands, except share and per units amounts)
 

Revenues:

                                     

Motor fuel sales to third parties

  $ 905,544   $ (180,801 )(a) $   $   $   $ 724,743  

Motor fuel sales to affiliates

    1,247,170         175,307   (g)               1,435,235  

                12,758   (h)                  

Rental income

    2,718     (1,039 )(a)                     1,679  

Other income

    3,732     (324 )(a)                     2,450  

          (958 )(b)                        
                           

Total revenues

    2,159,164     (183,122 )   188,065               2,164,107  

Cost of sales:

                                     

Motor fuel cost of sales to third parties

    887,294     (172,778 )(a)                     714,706  

          4   (b)                        

          481   (c)                        

          269   (d)                        

          (564 )(f)                        

Motor fuel cost of sales to affiliates

    1,247,170           173,608   (g)               1,420,778  

Other

    638     432 (b)                     1,070  
                           

Total cost of sales

    2,135,102     (172,156 )   173,608                 2,136,554  
                           

Gross profit

    24,062     (10,966 )   14,457                 27,553  

Operating expenses:

                                     

General and administrative

    5,801     (3,092 )(a)                     5,196  

          2,487   (e)                        

Other operating

    3,638     (2,177 )(a)                     1,461  

Rent

    2,180     (1,094 )(a)         (325 )(i)         531  

          (230 )(b)                        

Loss (gain) on disposal of assets

    36     (22 )(a)                     122  

          108   (b)                        

Depreciation, amortization and accretion

    3,776     (703 )(a)         241   (i)         2,778  

          (536 )(b)                        
                           

Total operating expenses

    15,431     (5,259 )       (84 )       10,088  
                           

Income from operations

    8,631     (5,707 )   14,457     84         17,465  

Other expense:

                                     

Interest expense, net

    180                     886   (j)   1,066  
                           

Income before income taxes

    8,451     (5,707 )   14,457     84     (886 )   16,399  

Income tax expense (benefit)

    3,074                     (2,922 )(k)   152  
                           

Net income

  $ 5,377   $ (5,707 ) $ 14,457   $ 84   $ 2,036   $ 16,247  
                           

Limited partners' interest in net income

                                $ 16,247  

Net income per common unit—basic and diluted

                                $  

Net income per subordinated unit—basic and diluted

                                $  

Weighted average limited partners' units outstanding—basic and diluted:

                                     

Common units

                                     

Subordinated units

                                     

   

See accompanying notes

F-5


Table of Contents


Susser Petroleum Partners LP

Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statements of Operations

for the Year Ended December 31, 2011

 
  Susser Petroleum
Company LLC
(Predecessor)
Historical
  Predecessor
Retained
Operations
  SHC
Distribution
and
Transportation
Contract
  Assets
Contributed
by Parent
  Offering
Related
Adjustments
  Susser
Petroleum
Partners LP
Pro Forma
 

Revenues:

                                     

Motor fuel sales to third parties

  $ 1,549,143   $ (332,247 )(a) $     $     $     $ 1,216,896  

Motor fuel sales to affiliates

    2,257,788           323,575  (g)               2,605,050  

                23,687  (h)                  

Rental income

    5,467     (2,163 )(a)                     3,304  

Other income

    7,980     (1,305 )(a)                     4,596  

          (2,079 )(b)                        
                           

Total revenues

    3,820,378     (337,794 )   347,262             3,829,846  

Cost of sales:

                                     

Motor fuel cost of sales to third parties

    1,517,926     (319,749 )(a)                     1,199,317  

          1,383  (c)                        

          445  (d)                        

          (688 )(f)                        

Motor fuel cost of sales to affiliates

    2,257,788           320,306  (g)               2,578,094  

Other

    1,641     481  (b)                     2,122  
                           

Total cost of sales

    3,777,355     (318,128 )   320,306             3,779,533  
                           

Gross profit

    43,023     (19,666 )   26,956             50,313  

Operating expenses:

                                     

General and administrative

    10,559     (1,297 )(e)                     9,262  

Other operating

    4,870     (3,374 )(a)                     1,496  

Rent

    4,322     (2,206 )(a)         (649 )(i)         1,031  

          (436 )(b)                        

Loss (gain) on disposal of assets

    221     (79 )(a)                     142  

Depreciation, amortization and accretion

    6,090     (1,524 )(a)         498  (i)         4,281  

          (783 )(b)                        
                           

Total operating expenses

    26,062     (9,699 )       (151 )       16,212  
                           

Income from operations

    16,961     (9,967 )   26,956     151         34,101  

Other expense:

                                     

Interest expense, net

    324                       1,772  (j)   2,096  
                           

Income before income taxes

    16,637     (9,967 )   26,956     151     (1,772 )   32,005  

Income tax expense (benefit)

    6,039                       (5,763 )(k)   276  
                           

Net income

  $ 10,598   $ (9,967 ) $ 26,956   $ 151   $ 3,991   $ 31,729  
                           

Limited partners' interest in net income

                                $ 31,729  

Net income per common unit—basic and diluted

                                $    

Net income per subordinated unit—basic and diluted

                                $    

Weighted average limited partners' units outstanding—basic and diluted:

                                     

Common units

                                     

Subordinated units

                                     

   

See accompanying notes

F-6


Table of Contents


Susser Petroleum Partners LP

Notes to Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Financial Statements

1. Organization and Basis of Presentation

              The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements of Susser Petroleum Partners LP are derived from the historical consolidated financial statements of Susser Petroleum Company LLC (Predecessor). In connection with the Offering, certain assets and liabilities of the Predecessor will be contributed to the Partnership, and the Partnership will begin providing wholesale distribution services for Susser Holdings Corporation and its subsidiaries (the "Parent" of the Predecessor) and other third-party customers. The assets, liabilities and results of operations of the Predecessor for the periods prior to their actual contribution to the Partnership are presented as the Predecessor.

              The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements reflect the following transactions:

    The contribution to the Partnership by Predecessor of substantially all of its wholesale motor fuel distribution business, other than its motor fuel consignment business and transportation assets and substantially all of its accounts receivable and payable;

    The contribution to the Partnership by Predecessor and Susser Holdings Corporation (SHC) of certain owned and leased convenience store properties to Susser Operating;

    The issuance to SHC or Stripes LLC of            common units representing a        % limited partner interest and            subordinated units representing a        % limited partner interest, as well as all of the incentive distribution rights in the Partnership;

    The issuance to Susser Petroleum GP LLC, our general partner, of a 0.0% non-economic general partner interest.

    The issuance and sale by the Partnership of                        common units to the public, representing a        % limited partner interest in the Partnership, at an assumed initial public offering price of $            per unit;

    The payment by the Partnership of the estimated underwriting discount and structuring fee (approximately $             million) and of the offering expenses (approximately $             million);

    The Partnership's entry into a new revolving credit facility, under which $2.4 million will be drawn at the closing of this offering, and a term loan facility. The Partnership will borrow approximately $147.3 million of term debt;

    The application of the net proceeds from the issuance and sale of common units by the Partnership to make a distribution to SHC as reimbursement of certain capital expenditures and to purchase $147.3 million in U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities, which will be assigned as collateral to secure a new $147.3 million term loan that will be fully guaranteed by SHC;

    The treatment of the Partnership and certain of its subsidiaries, as pass-through entities for federal income tax purposes. For these pass-through entities, all income, expense, gains, losses and tax credits generated flow through to the Partnership's unitholders and, accordingly, do not result in a provision for federal income taxes in the Partnership's financial statements. However, income from activities conducted by                                    , a wholly owned subsidiary of the Partnership, will be taxed at the applicable corporate federal and state tax rate and any such income taxes will be paid by                                    . All transactions in this entity will occur in future periods and therefore no adjustments are

F-7


Table of Contents


Susser Petroleum Partners LP

Notes to Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

1. Organization and Basis of Presentation (Continued)

      reflected for this entity. The Partnership's subsidiaries will be subject to the Texas franchise tax as members of a combined group.

              Upon completion of the Offering, the Partnership anticipates incurring incremental general and administrative expenses related to becoming a public entity (e.g. cost of tax return preparation, annual and quarterly reporting to unitholders, audit fees, stock exchange listing fees and registrar and transfer agent fees) in an annual amount estimated to be $2.0 million. The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements do not reflect this $2.0 million in anticipated incremental general and administrative expenses.

              In connection with the Offering, the Partnership will grant the underwriters a 30-day option to purchase an additional                        common units. The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements assume that the underwriters do not exercise the option to purchase additional units and that all                        of the option units will be issued to SHC or its wholly owned subsidiary at the expiration of the option period. If and to the extent the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional units, the number of units purchased by the underwriters pursuant to any exercise of the option will be sold to the public (instead of being issued to SHC or its wholly owned subsidiary). The net proceeds from any exercise of the underwriters' option to purchase additional units (approximately $             million based on an assumed initial public offering price of $            per unit, if exercised in full, after deducting the estimated underwriting discounts and structuring fee) will be used to purchase additional U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities, which will be assigned as collateral to secure an equal amount of additional term loan borrowings that will be fully guaranteed by SHC.

2. Pro Forma Adjustments and Assumptions

              The unaudited pro forma consolidated balance sheet gives effect to the adjustments as if they had occurred on June 30, 2012. The unaudited pro forma consolidated statements of income give effect to the adjustments as if they had occurred beginning January 1, 2011. The adjustments are based upon currently available information and certain estimates and assumptions; therefore, actual adjustments will differ from the pro forma adjustments. A general description of these adjustments is provided as follows:

                    (a)   Reflects the elimination of income and expenses related to the consignment operations of the Predecessor which are not being contributed to the Partnership. Historically, at these consignment locations, the Predecessor received the actual retail selling price for each gallon sold, less a commission paid to the independent operator of the location. Reflects elimination of the assets and liabilities of the consignment business as these assets and liabilities are not being contributed to the Partnership. These excluded assets and liabilities include accounts receivable, receivables from affiliates, inventories, miscellaneous current assets, certain property and equipment, the allocable portion of goodwill and other intangible assets, accounts payable and accrued expenses, including environmental reserves.

                    (b)   Reflects the elimination of the income and expenses and assets and liabilities of the freight company subsidiary of the Predecessor which is not being contributed to the Partnership.

                    (c)   Reflects the elimination of any Predecessor freight-related net profit or expense, as the transportation and logistics business will be retained by the Predecessor. Following the

F-8


Table of Contents


Susser Petroleum Partners LP

Notes to Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

2. Pro Forma Adjustments and Assumptions (Continued)

      closing of the Offering, the Predecessor will provide freight logistics for the Partnership on the same basis it provides to unrelated parties, and the Partnership will pass through freight costs to customers without any profit or loss pursuant to the terms of the SHC Transportation Contract. Reflects the elimination of payables to carriers as this activity will remain with the Predecessor.

                    (d)   Reflects the elimination of operations from a joint venture being retained by the Predecessor.

                    (e)   Reflects the allocation of certain general and administrative expenses, including overhead charges from the Parent and its subsidiaries that are associated with the pro forma operations of the Partnership. The portion of the general and administrative expenses reflected in the Predecessor operations attributable to the consignment and transportation operations are excluded from allocated general and administrative expenses. Reflects the elimination of accrued compensation expense as these expenses will not be paid directly by the Partnership but will be included in the allocation of general and administrative expenses from the general partner.

                    (f)    Reflects elimination of cost reimbursement for certain logistics expenses that were previously allocated by the Predecessor to the Parent and reflected in cost of sales. Following the Offering, the fuel margin to be charged under the SHC Distribution Contract will cover these costs.

                    (g)   Reflects the sale of fuel to the Predecessor for use by the consignment operations at a three cents per gallon gross margin over delivered cost instead of the variable and higher margin received by the Predecessor under the consignment contracts (as reported by the Predecessor).

                    (h)   Reflects the sale of fuel to Stripes LLC at a three cents per gallon margin over delivered cost instead of at cost with no margin (as reported by the Predecessor).

                    (i)    Reflects the adjustment of rental income and expenses for rental properties of the Parent which are being contributed to the Partnership. Adjusts property and equipment to properly reflect the properties being contributed to the Partnership by the Parent which are being leased to dealers.

                    (j)    Reflects the pro forma adjustment for interest expense related to the $147.3 million of borrowings under the Partnership's term loan facility made in connection with this offering, reduced by the interest income related to the U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities the Partnership intends to purchase with a portion of the proceeds from this offering. Borrowings under the Partnership's term loan facility will bear an average interest rate of approximately 0.25%, net of interest earned on the $147.3 million of U.S. Treasury or other investment grade securities pledged to secure the term loan. Interest expense also includes interest expense on an existing mortgage note, net of interest income on notes receivable from dealers, and letter of credit and commitment fees related to the $250.0 million revolving credit facility. In addition, interest expense includes $0.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 and $0.2 million for the six months ended June 30, 2012 in amortization of $2.4 million in loan fees, which are expected to be funded by drawing on the revolving credit facility.

F-9


Table of Contents


Susser Petroleum Partners LP

Notes to Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

2. Pro Forma Adjustments and Assumptions (Continued)

                    (k)   Reflects the adjustment of the income tax provision to eliminate the federal income tax and a portion of the state income tax expense recorded by the Predecessor. The expense for the Texas franchise tax will continue to be incurred by the Partnership. Reflects the elimination of the deferred tax balances and the federal income tax payable.

                    (l)    Reflects the contribution by the Parent of the net assets to the Partnership.

3. Pro Forma Net Income Per Unit

              Pro forma net income per limited partner unit is determined by dividing the pro forma net income available to common and subordinated unitholders of the Partnership by the number of common and subordinated units expected to be outstanding at the closing of the offering. For purposes of this calculation, we have assumed there will be            common units and             subordinated units outstanding.

              All units were assumed to have been outstanding since January 1, 2011. Basic and diluted pro forma net income per unit are the same, as there are no potentially dilutive units expected to be outstanding at the closing of the offering.

              Pursuant to the partnership agreement, SHC is entitled to receive certain incentive distributions that will result in less net earnings allocable to common and subordinated unitholders provided that the quarterly distributions exceed certain targets. The pro forma net earnings per limited partner unit computations assume that no incentive distributions were made to SHC because no such distributions would have been paid based upon the calculation of pro forma available cash from operating surplus for the periods presented.

F-10


Table of Contents


Susser Petroleum Company LLC (Predecessor)

Consolidated Balance Sheets

 
  December 31,
2011
  June 30,
2012
 
 
   
  unaudited
 
 
  (in thousands except units)
 

Assets

             

Current assets:

             

Cash and cash equivalents

  $ 240   $ 1,145  

Accounts receivable, net of allowance for doubtful accounts of $167 at December 31, 2011, and $427 at June 30, 2012

    31,760     40,621  

Receivables from affiliates

    106,553     102,654  

Inventories, net

    7,023     10,883  

Other current assets

    1,836     886  
           

Total current assets

    147,412     156,189  

Property and equipment, net

    39,049     43,051  

Other assets:

             

Goodwill

    20,661     20,661  

Intangible assets, net

    23,309     22,053  

Other noncurrent assets

    885     809  
           

Total assets

  $ 231,316   $ 242,763  
           

Liabilities and unitholder's equity

             

Current liabilities:

             

Accounts payable

  $ 98,316   $ 108,201  

Accrued expenses and other current liabilities

    8,010     4,246  

Current maturities of long-term debt

    22     23  
           

Total current liabilities

    106,348     112,470  

Long-term debt

    1,098     1,087  

Deferred gains, long-term portion

    4,812     4,366  

Deferred tax liability, long-term portion

    2,595     2,969  

Other noncurrent liabilities

    650     681  
           

Total liabilities

    115,503     121,573  
           

Commitments and contingencies:

             

Unitholder's equity:

             

Susser Petroleum Company LLC unitholder's equity:

             

Common units, no par value; 1,000 units authorized; 1,000 issued and 1,000 outstanding as of December 31, 2011 and June 30, 2012

         

Retained earnings

    115,813     121,190  
           

Total unitholder's equity

    115,813     121,190  
           

Total liabilities and unitholder's equity

  $ 231,316   $ 242,763  
           

   

See accompanying notes

F-11


Table of Contents


Susser Petroleum Company LLC (Predecessor)

Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income

Unaudited

 
  Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended  
 
  June 30,
2011
  June 30,
2012
  June 30,
2011
  June 30,
2012
 
 
  (dollars in thousands)
 

Revenues:

                         

Motor fuel sales to third parties

  $ 412,069   $ 466,743   $ 748,430   $ 905,544  

Motor fuel sales to affiliates

    596,310     616,727     1,108,669     1,247,170  

Rental income

    1,364     1,349     2,734     2,718  

Other income

    1,602     1,692     3,243     3,732  
                   

Total revenues

    1,011,345     1,086,511     1,863,076     2,159,164  

Cost of sales:

                         

Motor fuel cost of sales to third parties

    402,846     455,604     732,990     887,294  

Motor fuel cost of sales to affiliates

    596,310     616,727     1,108,669     1,247,170  

Other

            394     638  
                   

Total cost of sales

    999,156     1,072,331     1,842,053     2,135,102  
                   

Gross profit

    12,189     14,180     21,023     24,062  

Operating expenses:

                         

General and administrative

    2,811     3,151     5,126     5,801  

Other operating

    1,347     2,204     2,490     3,638  

Rent

    1,085     1,110     2,175     2,180  

Loss (gain) on disposal of assets

    53     (74 )   144     36  

Depreciation, amortization and accretion

    1,294     1,893     2,483     3,776  
                   

Total operating expenses

    6,590     8,284     12,418     15,431  
                   

Income from operations

    5,599     5,896     8,605     8,631  

Other expense:

                         

Interest expense, net

    82     93     159     180  
                   

Income before income taxes

    5,517     5,803     8,446     8,451  

Income tax expense

    1,991     2,101     3,059     3,074  
                   

Net income and comprehensive income

  $ 3,526   $ 3,702   $ 5,387   $ 5,377  
                   

   

See accompanying notes

F-12


Table of Contents


Susser Petroleum Company LLC (Predecessor)

Consolidated Statement of Unitholders' Equity

Unaudited

 
  Susser Petroleum Company LLC Unitholders  
 
  Common Stock    
 
 
  Units   Par
Value
  Retained
Earnings
 

Balance at December 31, 2011

    1,000   $   $ 115,813  

Net income and comprehensive income

            5,377  
               

Balance at June 30, 2012

  $ 1,000   $   $ 121,190  
               

   

See accompanying notes

F-13


Table of Contents


Susser Petroleum Company LLC

Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows

Unaudited

 
  Six Months Ended  
 
  June 30,
2011
  June 30,
2012
 
 
  (in thousands)
 

Cash flows from operating activities:

             

Net income

  $ 5,387   $ 5,377  

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash (used in) provided by operating activities:

             

Depreciation, amortization and accretion

    2,483     3,776  

Loss on disposal of assets and impairment charge

    144     36  

Deferred income tax

    546     624  

Changes in operating assets and liabilities:

             

Receivables

    (14,229 )   (8,862 )

Receivables from affiliates

    (12,687 )   3,900  

Inventories

    (4,461 )   (3,861 )

Other assets

    235     656  

Accounts payable

    27,752     9,886  

Accrued liabilities

    (5,053 )   (3,784 )

Other noncurrent liabilities

    (215 )   (415 )
           

Net cash (used in) provided by operating activities

    (98 )   7,333  

Cash flows from investing activities:

             

Capital expenditures

    (2,611 )   (6,475 )

Purchase of intangibles

    (1,458 )   (395 )

Proceeds from disposal of property and equipment

        331  
           

Net cash used in investing activities

    (4,069 )   (6,539 )

Cash flows from financing activities:

             

Change in notes receivable

    34     122  

Payments on long-term debt

    (10 )   (11 )
           

Net cash provided by financing activities

    24     111  

Net increase (decrease) in cash

    (4,143 )   905  

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year

    4,749     240  
           

Cash and cash equivalents at end of period

  $ 606   $ 1,145  
           

   

See accompanying notes

F-14


Table of Contents


Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

1. Organization and Principles of Consolidation

              The consolidated financial statements are composed of Susser Petroleum Company LLC (the "Predecessor", "SPC" or the "Company"), a Texas Limited Liability Company, and its consolidated subsidiaries, which distribute motor fuels in Texas, New Mexico, Oklahoma and Louisiana. The Company was formed and is a wholly owned subsidiary of Stripes LLC, which is a wholly owned subsidiary of Susser Holdings Corporation ("Parent"). SPC, through its subsidiaries and predecessors, has been supplying motor fuel to service stations, convenience stores and other commercial customers since the 1930's.

              The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company and all of its subsidiaries. The Company's primary operations are conducted by the following consolidated wholly owned subsidiaries:

    GoPetro Transport LLC, a Texas Limited Liability Company, provides transportation of motor fuels.

    T&C Wholesale, Inc. ("TCW"), a Texas Corporation, distributes motor fuels, propane and lubricating oils, primarily in Texas.

              In connection with the planned offering of limited partnership interests by Susser Petroleum Partners LP, a newly formed Delaware limited partnership (the "Partnership"), the Parent will contribute substantially all of the Predecessor's motor fuel distribution business to the Partnership (other than its motor fuel consignment business and transportation assets and substantially all of its accounts receivable and payable). All of the assets and liabilities of SPC that are contributed will be recorded at historical cost as this transaction is considered to be a reorganization of entities under common control.

              All significant intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation. In preparing the accompanying unaudited consolidated financial statements, the Company has reviewed as determined necessary by the Company's management, events that have occurred after June 30, 2012, up until the issuance of these financial statements.

              The consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles for interim financial information and Article 10 of Regulation S-X. The interim consolidated financial statements have been prepared from the accounting records of the Predecessor, and all amounts at June 30, 2012 and for the three and six months ended June 30, 2011 and June 30, 2012 are unaudited. Pursuant to Regulation S-X, certain information and note disclosures normally included in annual financial statements have been condensed or omitted. The information furnished reflects all adjustments which are, in the opinion of management, necessary for a fair statement of the results for the interim periods presented, and which are of a normal, recurring nature.

              The interim consolidated financial statements included herein should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements and the notes thereto included in our consolidated financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2011.

2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

Accounts Receivable

              Receivables from affiliates have risen from transactions with non-consolidated affiliates and include the concentration of excess cash to the Parent, the sale of fuel and settling of credit cards to

F-15


Table of Contents


Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

the Parent, and other miscellaneous transactions with the Parent. These receivables are recorded at face value, without interest or discount.

Earnings Per Unit

              During the periods presented, we were wholly owned by the Parent. Accordingly, we have not calculated or reported earnings per unit.

Comprehensive Income

              The Predecessor accounts for comprehensive income in accordance with ASC 220, "Comprehensive Income," which established standards for the reporting and presentation of comprehensive income in the consolidated financial statements. The Predecessor has no transactions which affect comprehensive income and, accordingly, comprehensive income equals net income for all periods presented.

Stock-based Compensation

              Certain employees supporting the Company's operations were historically granted long-term incentive compensation awards under the Parent's stock-based compensation programs, which primarily consist of stock options and restricted common stock. The Company was allocated expenses for stock-based compensation costs. These costs are included in the Company's general and administrative expenses. The allocated expense was $0.2 million and $0.3 million for the three months ended June 30, 2011 and June 30, 2012, respectively and $0.4 million and $0.6 million for the six months ended June 30, 2011 and June 30, 2012, respectively.

New Accounting Pronouncements

              FASB ASU No. 2011-04.     In May 2011, the FASB issued ASU No. 2011-04, " Fair Value Measurement, Amendments to Achieve Common Fair Value Measurement and Disclosure Requirements in U.S. GAAP and IFRS (ASC 820—Fair Value Measurement) ." This guidance amends ASC 820 on fair value measurements and disclosures to (1) clarify the board's intent in respect of existing measurement guidance, (2) revise certain measurement guidance that changes or modifies a principle for measuring fair value, and (3) add disclosure requirements concerning the measurement uncertainty of Level 3 measurements. The ASU is effective for interim and annual periods beginning after December 15, 2011. The adoption of this amended guidance did not have a material effect on the Company's consolidated financial position, results of operations, cash flows or related disclosures.

              FASB ASU No. 2011-05.     In June 2011, the FASB issued ASU No. 2011-05, " Comprehensive Income: Presentation of Comprehensive Income (ASC 220—Comprehensive Income) ." This guidance removes the presentation options in ASC 220 and requires entities to report components of comprehensive income in either (1) a continuous statement of comprehensive income or (2) two separate but consecutive statements. The ASU does not change the items that must be reported in other comprehensive income. It is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2011 (and for interim periods within such years). In December 2011, the FASB issued ASU No. 2011-12, which deferred certain aspects of ASU No. 2011-05. The Company adopted this accounting standard in the first quarter of Fiscal 2012. This standard affects presentation and disclosure, and therefore will not affect the Company's consolidated financial position, results of operations or cash flows.

F-16


Table of Contents


Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

              FASB ASU No. 2011-08.     In September 2011, the FASB issued ASU No. 2011-08, " Intangibles—Goodwill and Other (ASC 350-20—Goodwill): Testing Goodwill for Impairment ." This guidance permits an entity to first assess qualitative factors to determine whether it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount as a basis for determining whether it is necessary to perform the two-step goodwill impairment test. The ASU is effective for annual and interim goodwill impairment tests performed for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2011. The Company adopted ASU No. 2011-08 during the fourth quarter of fiscal 2011 and used it to perform the annual goodwill impairment test. This amendment affects testing steps only, and therefore adoption did not affect the Company's consolidated financial position, results of operations or cash flows.

3. Accounts Receivable

              Accounts receivable consisted of the following:

 
  December 31, 2011   June 30, 2012  
 
  (in thousands)
 

Accounts receivable, trade

  $ 30,963   $ 40,818  

Receivable from state environmental reimbursement funds

    61      

Other receivables

    903     230  

Allowance for uncollectible accounts, trade

    (153 )   (420 )

Allowance for uncollectible accounts, environmental

    (14 )   (7 )
           

Accounts receivable, net

  $ 31,760   $ 40,621  
           

4. Inventories

              Inventories consisted of the following:

 
  December 31, 2011   June 30, 2012  
 
  (in thousands)
 

Fuel—consignment

  $ 3,538   $ 3,410  

Fuel—wholesale

    1,767     1,780  

Fuel—bulk

    1,180     5,113  

Other

    538     580  
           

Inventories, net

  $ 7,023   $ 10,883  
           

F-17


Table of Contents


Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

5. Property and Equipment

              Property and equipment consisted of the following:

 
  December 31, 2011   June 30, 2012  
 
  (in thousands)
 

Land

  $ 19,552   $ 19,550  

Buildings and leasehold improvements

    8,315     8,534  

Equipment

    27,943     31,230  

Construction in progress

    1,116     3,311  
           

Total property and equipment

    56,926     62,625  

Less: Accumulated depreciation

    (17,877 )   (19,574 )
           

Property and equipment, net

  $ 39,049   $ 43,051  
           

6. Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets

              Goodwill is not being amortized, but is tested annually for impairment, or more frequently if events and circumstances indicate that the asset might be impaired. The annual impairment test is performed as of the first day of the fourth quarter of the fiscal year. At December 31, 2011 and June 30, 2012, we had $20.7 million of goodwill recorded in conjunction with past business combinations. The 2011 impairment analysis indicated no impairment in goodwill. As of June 30, 2012, we evaluated potential impairment indicators and we believe no indicators of impairment occurred during the first half of 2012, and we believe the assumptions used in the analysis performed in 2011 are still relevant and indicative of our current operating environment. As a result, no impairment was recorded to goodwill during the first six months of 2012.

              The Company has finite-lived intangible assets recorded that are amortized. The finite-lived assets consist of supply agreements, favorable/unfavorable leasehold arrangements and customer intangibles all of which are amortized over the respective lives of the agreements or over the period of time the assets are expected to contribute directly or indirectly to the Company's future cash flows. Supply agreements are being amortized over a weighted average period of approximately nine years. Favorable/unfavorable leasehold arrangements are being amortized over a weighted average period of approximately eleven years. Customer intangibles are being amortized over a weighted average period of less than one year.

              The following table presents the gross carrying amount and accumulated amortization for each major class of intangible assets, excluding goodwill, at December 31, 2011 and June 30, 2012:

 
  December 31, 2011   June 30, 2012  
 
  Gross
Carrying
Amount
  Accumulated
Amortization
  Net Amount   Gross
Carrying
Amount
  Accumulated
Amortization
  Net Amount  
 
  (in thousands)
 

Amortized

                                     

Supply agreements

  $ 29,654   $ 6,432   $ 23,222   $ 29,944   $ 7,975   $ 21,969  

Unfavorable leasehold arrangements, net

    (950 )   (391 )   (559 )   (950 )   (444 )   (506 )

Other

    690     44     646     690     100     590  
                           

Intangible assets, net

  $ 29,394   $ 6,085   $ 23,309   $ 29,684   $ 7,631   $ 22,053  
                           

F-18


Table of Contents


Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

7. Long-Term Debt

              Long-term debt consisted of the following:

 
  December 31, 2011   June 30, 2012  
 
  (in thousands)
 

Notes payable

  $ 1,120   $ 1,110  

Less: Current maturities

    22     23  
           

Long-term debt, net of current maturities

  $ 1,098   $ 1,087  
           

              In August 2010 we entered into a mortgage note for an aggregate initial borrowing amount of $1.2 million. Pursuant to the terms of the mortgage note, we make monthly installment payments that are comprised of principal and interest through the maturity date of July 1, 2016. The balance outstanding at June 30, 2012 and December 31, 2011 was $1.1 million and $1.1 million, respectively. The mortgage note bears interest at a fixed rate of 6.0%. Interest expense for the six months ended June 30, 2011 and June 30, 2012 was $34,000 and $33,000, respectively. The mortgage note is secured by a first priority security interest in a property owned by the Company.

              The fair value of debt as of June 30, 2012, is estimated to be approximately $1.4 million based on an analysis of the net present value of remaining payment at a rate calculated off U.S. Treasury securities. The estimated fair value of long-term debt is calculated using Level 2 inputs.

Fair Value Measurements

              We use fair value measurements to measure, among other items, purchased assets and investments, leases and derivative contracts. We also use them to assess impairment of properties, equipment, intangible assets and goodwill. Fair value is defined as the price at which an asset could be exchanged in a current transaction between knowledgeable, willing parties. A liability's fair value is defined as the amount that would be paid to transfer the liability to a new obligor, not the amount that would be paid to settle the liability with the creditor. Where available, fair value is based on observable market prices or parameters, or are derived from such prices or parameters. Where observable prices or inputs are not available, use of unobservable prices or inputs are used to estimate the current fair value, often using an internal valuation model. These valuation techniques involve some level of management estimation and judgment, the degree of which is dependent on the item being valued.

              ASC 820 " Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures " prioritizes the inputs used in measuring fair value into the following hierarchy:

  Level 1   Quoted prices (unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets or liabilities;

 

Level 2

 

Inputs other than quoted prices included within Level 1 that are either directly or indirectly observable;

 

Level 3

 

Unobservable inputs in which little or no market activity exists, therefore requiring an entity to develop its own assumptions about the assumptions that market participants would use in pricing.

              The Company periodically enters into derivatives, such as futures and options, to manage its fuel price risk, primarily related to bulk purchases of fuel. We hedge this inventory risk through the use of fuel futures contracts which are matched in quantity and timing to the anticipated usage of the inventory. Bulk fuel purchases and fuel hedging positions have not been material to our operations.

F-19


Table of Contents


Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

7. Long-Term Debt (Continued)

The fair value of our derivative contracts are measured using Level 2 inputs, and are determined by either market prices on an active market for similar assets or by prices quoted by a broker or other market-corroborated prices. This price does not differ materially from the amount that would be paid to transfer the liability to a new obligor due to the short term nature of these contracts. At December 31, 2010, the Company held fuel futures contracts with a fair value of ($14,300) (six contracts representing 0.3 million gallons). At December 31, 2011, the Company held fuel futures contracts with a fair value of ($12,800) (16 contracts representing 0.6 million gallons), which is classified in other current assets in the Company's consolidated balance sheets. At June 30, 2012, the Company held fuel futures contract with a fair value of ($100,900) (60 contracts representing 2.5 million gallons). The Company recognized a gain/(loss) during the second quarter of 2011 and 2012 related to these contracts of ($0.1) million and $0.5 million, respectively. The Company recognized a loss during the first six months of 2011 and 2012 related to these contracts of $1.0 million and less than $0.1 million, respectively. The loss realized on hedging contracts is substantially offset by increased profitability on sale of fuel inventory. The Company is not using hedge accounting with regards to these contracts.

8. Commitments and Contingencies

Leases

              The Company leases a portion of its dealer properties under non-cancellable operating leases, whose initial terms are typically 10 to 20 years, along with options that permit renewals for additional periods. Minimum rent is typically expensed on a straight-line basis over the term of the lease. The Company is typically responsible for payment of real estate taxes, maintenance expenses and insurance.

              The components of rent expense are as follows:

 
  Three Months Ended
June 30,
  Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
 
  2011   2012   2011   2012  
 
  (in thousands)
   
   
 

Store base rent

  $ 926   $ 940   $ 1,868   $ 1,873  

Equipment rent

    159     170     307     307  
                   

Total rent expense

  $ 1,085   $ 1,110   $ 2,175   $ 2,180  
                   

              Equipment rent consists primarily of store equipment and vehicles.

9. Interest Expense and Interest Income

              The components of net interest expense are as follows:

 
  Three Months Ended
June 30,
  Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
 
  2011   2012   2011   2012  
 
  (in thousands)
 

Cash interest expense

  $ 103   $ 112   $ 206   $ 219  

Cash interest income

    (21 )   (19 )   (47 )   (39 )
                   

Interest expense, net

  $ 82   $ 93   $ 159   $ 180  
                   

F-20


Table of Contents


Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

10. Income Tax

              A reconciliation of the statutory federal income tax rate to the Company's effective tax rate for the three months and six months ended June 30, 2012 and June 30, 2011 is as follows:

 
  Three Months Ended
June 30, 2012
  Six Months Ended
June 30, 2012
 
 
  (in thousands)
  Tax rate %
  (in thousands)
  Tax rate %
 

Tax at statutory federal rate

  $ 2,031     35.0 % $ 2,958     35.0 %

State and local tax, net of federal benefit

    58     1.0 %   97     1.2 %

Other

    12     0.2 %   19     0.2 %
                   

Income tax expense

  $ 2,101     36.2 % $ 3,074     36.4 %
                   

 


 

Three Months Ended
June 30, 2011

 

Six Months Ended
June 30, 2011

 
 
  (in thousands)
  Tax rate %
  (in thousands)
  Tax rate %
 

Tax at statutory federal rate

  $ 1,931     35.0 % $ 2,956     35.0 %

State and local tax, net of federal benefit

    51     1.0 %   87     1.0 %

Other

    9     0.1 %   16     0.2 %
                   

Income tax expense

  $ 1,991     36.1 % $ 3,059     36.2 %
                   

              Included in our provision for income tax is a tax imposed by the state of Texas of 0.5% of taxable margin generated by our operations in Texas ("franchise tax").

              The Company and Parent file consolidated federal and state income tax returns. Income taxes are allocated based on separate Company computations of income or loss.

11. Related-Party Transactions

              The Company sold motor fuel to its Parent at a zero gross profit. These sales are reflected in motor fuel sales to affiliates with the corresponding cost reflected in motor fuel cost of sales to affiliates. In addition the Company collected credit card receipts from the motor fuel suppliers on the Parent's behalf. The Parent charged the Company $0.5 million and $0.6 million for the three months ended June 30, 2011 and June 30, 2012 and $0.9 million and $1.0 million for the six months ended June 30, 2011 and June 30, 2012 for oversight of the Company. Such amounts include certain expenses allocated by Parent for general corporate services, such as finance, internal audit and legal services, which are included in general and administrative expense. These expenses were charged or allocated to the Company based on the nature of the expenses and the Company's proportionate share of employee time and headcount, which management believes to be reasonable. The allocation methods used were consistently applied in all periods presented. Rent expense is charged by the Parent on certain real estate which is in turn subleased by the Company to dealers. This rent expense was $0.3 million for each of the three months ended June 30, 2011 and June 30, 2012, and $0.6 million for each of the six months ended June 30, 2011 and June 30, 2012. All charges are recorded to an intracompany accounts receivable, which does not bear interest. The balance in account receivables with affiliates was $106.6 million and $102.7 million at December 31, 2011 and June 30, 2012, respectively.

F-21


Table of Contents


SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP

BALANCE SHEET

as of June 30, 2012

 
  June 30, 2012  
 
  Unaudited  

Assets

  $  
       

Liabilities

  $  

Partners' Capital:

       

Limited Partners

    1,000  

General Partner

     

Less: Contribution Receivable from Partners

    (1,000 )
       

Total Partners' Capital

     
       

Total Liabilities and Partners' Capital

  $  
       

   

The accompanying notes are an integral part of this balance sheet.

F-22


Table of Contents


SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP

NOTES TO BALANCE SHEET

as of June 30, 2012

1. Nature of Operations

              Susser Petroleum Partners LP (the "Partnership") is a Delaware limited partnership formed in June 2012. Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC (the "General Partner") is a limited liability company formed in June 2012 as the general partner of the Partnership.

              In June 2012, Susser Holdings Corporation, a Delaware corporation, agreed to contribute $1,000 to the Partnership in exchange for a 100% limited partner interest. The agreement to contribute has been recorded as a contribution receivable and is reflected in the accompanying balance sheet as a reduction to partners' capital.

              There have been no other transactions involving the Partnership as of June 30, 2012. The Partnership will ultimately receive the transfer from Susser Petroleum Company LLC (the "Predecessor") of certain contributed assets, liabilities, operations and/or equity interests (the "Contributed Assets"). Taken together with other affiliated entities and including the Predecessor, the entities are under common control and are collectively referred to as Susser Holdings Corporation ("SHC").

              The Partnership, pursuant to an initial public offering, intends to sell common units representing limited partnership interests in the Partnership. The Partnership will issue and sell common units and subordinated units to the shareholders (or their assigns) of the Partnership in consideration of their transfer of the Contributed Assets to the Partnership.

              The Partnership, upon the transfer of the Contributed Assets will be engaged in substantially the same business and revenue generating activities as the Predecessor, principally: (1) distributing motor fuels to SHC and third parties and (ii) ownership or lease of locations and, in turn, generating rental-fee income revenue from the lease or subleases of the locations to third-party operators.


2. Basis of Presentation

              This balance sheet has been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States. Since the Partnership has had no activity since its inception, separate statements of income, changes in partners' equity and cash flows have not been presented.


3. Subsequent Events

              The Partnership has evaluated events and transactions that occurred subsequent to June 30, 2012 up until the date these financial statements were filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

F-23


Table of Contents


Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

The Board of Directors of
Susser Holdings Corporation

              We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Susser Petroleum Company LLC (the Predecessor) as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, and the related consolidated statements of operations, unitholder's equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2011. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Predecessor's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

              We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. We were not engaged to perform an audit of the Company's internal control over financial reporting. Our audits included consideration of internal control over financial reporting as a basis for designing audit procedures that are appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the Company's internal control over financial reporting. Accordingly, we express no such opinion. An audit also includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

              In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial position of Susser Petroleum Company LLC at December 31, 2011 and 2010, and the consolidated results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2011, in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.

/s/ ERNST & YOUNG LLP

San Antonio, Texas
June 21, 2012

F-24


Table of Contents


Susser Petroleum Company LLC (Predecessor)

Consolidated Balance Sheets

 
  December 31,  
 
  2010   2011  
 
  (in thousands)
 

Assets

             

Current assets:

             

Cash and cash equivalents

  $ 4,749   $ 240  

Accounts receivable net of allowance for doubtful accounts of $346 at December 31, 2010 and $167 at December 31, 2011

    19,096     31,760  

Receivables from affiliates

    100,152     106,553  

Inventories, net

    5,932     7,023  

Other current assets

    2,487     1,836  
           

Total current assets

    132,416     147,412  

Property and equipment, net

    35,247     39,049  

Other assets:

             

Goodwill

    20,661     20,661  

Intangible assets, net

    13,128     23,309  

Other noncurrent assets

    1,135     885  
           

Total assets

  $ 202,587   $ 231,316  
           

Liabilities and unitholder's equity

             

Current liabilities:

             

Accounts payable

  $ 79,842   $ 98,316  

Accrued expenses and other current liabilities

    9,667     8,010  

Current maturities of long-term debt

    21     22  
           

Total current liabilities

    89,530     106,348  

Long-term debt

    1,121     1,098  

Deferred branding incentives, long-term portion

    5,228     4,812  

Deferred tax liability, long-term portion

    799     2,595  

Other noncurrent liabilities

    694     650  
           

Total liabilities

    97,372     115,503  
           

Commitment and contingencies:

             

Unitholder's equity:

             

Susser Petroleum Company LLC unitholder's equity:

             

Common units no par value; 1,000 shares authorized; 1,000 issued and outstanding as of December 31, 2010; 1,000 issued and outstanding as of December 31, 2011

         

Retained earnings

    105,215     115,813  
           

Total unitholder's equity

    105,215     115,813  
           

Total liabilities and unitholder's equity

  $ 202,587   $ 231,316  
           

   

See accompanying notes

F-25


Table of Contents


Susser Petroleum Company LLC (Predecessor)

Consolidated Statements of Operations

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2009   2010   2011  
 
  (in thousands)
 

Revenues:

                   

Motor fuel sales to third parties

  $ 875,891   $ 1,094,273   $ 1,549,143  

Motor fuel sales to affiliates

    1,205,890     1,578,653     2,257,788  

Rental income

    4,245     5,351     5,467  

Other income

    7,462     5,515     7,980  
               

Total revenues

    2,093,488     2,683,792     3,820,378  

Cost of sales:

                   

Motor fuel cost of sales to third parties

    855,307     1,068,208     1,517,926  

Motor fuel cost of sales to affiliates

    1,205,890     1,578,653     2,257,788  

Other

    (39 )   832     1,641  
               

Total cost of sales

    2,061,158     2,647,693     3,777,355  
               

Gross profit

    32,330     36,099     43,023  

Operating expenses:

                   

General and administrative

    7,593     8,480     10,559  

Other operating

    4,728     4,229     4,870  

Rent

    1,578     3,797     4,322  

Loss (gain) on disposal of assets

    (6 )   86     221  

Depreciation, amortization and accretion

    4,901     4,771     6,090  
               

Total operating expenses

    18,794     21,363     26,062  
               

Income from operations

    13,536     14,736     16,961  

Other expense:

                   

Interest expense, net

    191     284     324  
               

Income before income taxes

    13,345     14,452     16,637  

Income tax expense

    4,831     5,236     6,039  
               

Net income

  $ 8,514   $ 9,216   $ 10,598  
               

   

See accompanying notes

F-26


Table of Contents


Susser Petroleum Company LLC (Predecessor)

Consolidated Statements of Unitholder's Equity

 
  Susser Petroleum Company LLC Unitholder  
 
  Common Units    
   
   
 
 
  Retained
Earnings
  Comprehensive
Income
   
 
 
  Units   Par Value   Total  

Balance at December 31, 2008

    1,000   $   $ 87,485         $ 87,485  

Comprehensive income:

                               

Net income

            8,514   $ 8,514        
                               

Comprehensive income

                8,514     8,514  
                       

Balance at December 31, 2009

    1,000         95,999           95,999  

Comprehensive income:

                               

Net income

            9,216     9,216        
                               

Comprehensive income

                9,216     9,216  
                       

Balance at December 31, 2010

    1,000         105,215           105,215  

Comprehensive income:

                               

Net income

            10,598     10,598        
                               

Comprehensive income

              $ 10,598     10,598  
                       

Balance at December 31, 2011

    1,000   $   $ 115,813         $ 115,813  
                         

   

See accompanying notes

F-27


Table of Contents


Susser Petroleum Company LLC (Predecessor)

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

 
  Year Ended  
 
  December 31,
2009
  December 31,
2010
  December 31,
2011
 
 
  (in thousands)
 

Cash flows from operating activities:

                   

Net income

  $ 8,514   $ 9,216   $ 10,598  

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:

                   

Depreciation, amortization and accretion

    4,901     4,771     6,090  

(Gain) Loss on disposal of assets and impairment charge          

    (6 )   86     221  

Deferred income tax

    986     (1,527 )   1,251  

Changes in operating assets and liabilities:

                   

Receivables

    (8,415 )   7,323     (12,664 )

Receivables from affiliates

    (20,327 )   (4,573 )   (7,491 )

Inventories

    (781 )   853     (1,091 )

Other assets

    287     472     1,044  

Accounts payable

    28,366     (4,112 )   18,474  

Accrued liabilities

    (4,879 )   3,702     (1,708 )

Other noncurrent liabilities

    1,187     1,258     (461 )
               

Net cash provided by operating activities

    9,833     17,469     14,263  

Cash flows from investing activities:

                   

Capital expenditures

    (4,390 )   (4,743 )   (7,388 )

Purchase of intangibles

    (6,989 )   (9,220 )   (12,050 )

Proceeds from disposal of property and equipment

    23     66     285  
               

Net cash used in investing activities

    (11,356 )   (13,897 )   (19,153 )

Cash flows from financing activities:

                   

Change in notes receivable

    331     (411 )   402  

Proceeds from issuance of long-term debt

        1,150      

Payments on long-term debt

        (8 )   (21 )
               

Net cash provided by financing activities

    331     731     381  

Net increase (decrease) in cash

    (1,192 )   4,303     (4,509 )

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year

    1,638     446     4,749  
               

Cash and cash equivalents at end of period

  $ 446   $ 4,749   $ 240  
               

Supplemental disclosure of cash flow information:

                   

Interest paid

  $ 307   $ 332   $ 412  

   

See accompanying notes

F-28


Table of Contents


SUSSER PETROLEUM COMPANY LLC (PREDECESSOR)

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

1. Organization and Principles of Consolidation

              The consolidated financial statements are composed of Susser Petroleum Company LLC (the "Predecessor", "SPC" or the "Company"), a Texas Limited Liability Company, and its consolidated subsidiaries, which distribute motor fuels in Texas, New Mexico, Oklahoma and Louisiana. The Company was formed and is a wholly owned subsidiary of Stripes LLC, which is wholly owned subsidiary of Susser Holdings Corporation ("Parent"). SPC, through its subsidiaries and predecessors, has been acquiring, operating, and supplying motor fuel to service stations and convenience stores since the 1930's.

              The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company and all of its subsidiaries. The Company's primary operations are conducted by the following consolidated wholly owned subsidiaries:

    GoPetro Transport LLC, a Texas Limited Liability Company, provides transportation of motor fuels.

    T&C Wholesale, Inc. ("TCW"), a Texas Corporation, distributes motor fuels, propane and lubricating oils, primarily in Texas.

              In connection with the planned offering of limited partnership interest by Susser Petroleum Partners LP, a newly formed Delaware limited partnership (the "Partnership") in 2012, the Parent will contribute substantially all of the Predecessor's motor fuel distribution business (other than its motor fuel consignment business and transportation assets and substantially all of its accounts receivable and payable). All of the assets and liabilities of SPC that are contributed will be recorded at historical cost as it is considered to be a reorganization of entities under common control.

              All significant intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation. In preparing the accompanying audited consolidated financial statements, the Company has reviewed as determined necessary by the Company's management, events that have occurred after December 31, 2011, up until the issuance of these financial statements.

2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

Fiscal Year

              The Company uses calendar month accounting periods, and ends its fiscal year on December 31.

Use of Estimates

              The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

Fair Value Measurements

              ASC 820 " Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures " defines and establishes a framework for measuring fair value and expands related disclosures. We use fair value measurements to measure, among other items, purchased assets and investments, leases and derivative contracts. We also use them to assess impairment of properties, equipment, intangible assets, and goodwill.

F-29


Table of Contents


SUSSER PETROLEUM COMPANY LLC (PREDECESSOR)

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

              Where available, fair value is based on observable market prices or parameters, or are derived from such prices or parameters. Where observable prices or inputs are not available, use of unobservable prices or inputs are used to estimate the current fair value, often using an internal valuation model. These valuation techniques involve some level of management estimation and judgment, the degree of which is dependent on the item being valued.

Segment Reporting

              The Company operates in one operating segment, distribution of motor fuels, consisting primarily of gasoline and diesel fuel, and to own and lease real estate used in the distribution of motor fuels, with a single management team that reports to the chief executive officer, who is our chief operating decision maker, as that term is defined in ASC 280 "Segment Reporting." Accordingly, the Company does not prepare discrete financial information with respect to separate product lines and does not have separately reportable segments. All of the operations are located in the United States.

Acquisition Accounting

              Acquisitions of assets or entities that include inputs and processes and have the ability to create outputs are accounted for as business combinations. The purchase price is recorded for tangible and intangible assets acquired and liabilities assumed based on fair value. The excess of fair value of the consideration conveyed over the fair value of the net assets acquired is recorded as goodwill. The Consolidated Statements of Operations for the years presented include the results of operations for each acquisition from their respective date of acquisition.

Cash and Cash Equivalents

              Cash and cash equivalents include cash on hand, demand deposits, and short-term investments with original maturities of three months or less.

Accounts Receivable

              The majority of the trade receivables are from wholesale fuel customers. Credit is extended based on evaluation of the customer's financial condition. Receivables are recorded at face value, without interest or discount. The Company provides an allowance for doubtful accounts based on historical experience and on a specific identification basis. Credit losses are recorded when accounts are deemed uncollectible. Receivables from affiliates have risen from transactions with non-consolidated affiliates and include the concentration of excess cash to the Parent, the sale of the fuel and settling of credit cards to the Parent, and other miscellaneous transactions with the Parent. These receivables are recorded at face value, without interest or discount.

Inventories

              Fuel inventories are stated at the lower of average cost or market. Shipping and handling costs are included in the cost of inventories.

F-30


Table of Contents


SUSSER PETROLEUM COMPANY LLC (PREDECESSOR)

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

Property and Equipment

              Property and equipment are recorded at cost. Depreciation is computed on a straight-line basis over the useful lives of the assets, estimated to be forty years for buildings, three to fifteen years for equipment and thirty years for underground storage tanks.

              Amortization of leasehold improvements is based upon the shorter of the remaining terms of the leases including renewal periods that are reasonably assured, or the estimated useful lives, which approximate twenty years. Expenditures for major renewals and betterments that extend the useful lives of property and equipment are capitalized. Maintenance and repairs are charged to operations as incurred. Gains or losses on the disposition of property and equipment are recorded in the period incurred.

Assets Not in Productive Use

              Properties are classified as other noncurrent assets when management determines that they are in excess and intends to offer them for sale, and are recorded at the lower of cost or fair value less cost to sell. Excess properties are classified as assets held for sale in current assets when they are under contract for sale, or otherwise probable that they will be sold within the ensuing fiscal year. These assets primarily consist of land and some buildings.

Long-Lived Assets

              Long-lived assets (including intangible assets) are tested for possible impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate the carrying amount of the asset may not be recoverable. If indicators exist, the estimated undiscounted future cash flows related to the asset are compared to the carrying value of the asset. If the carrying value is greater than the estimated undiscounted future cash flow amount, an impairment charge is recorded within loss on disposal of assets and impairment charge in the statement of operations for amounts necessary to reduce the corresponding carrying value of the asset to fair value. The impairment loss calculations require management to apply judgment in estimating future cash flows and the discount rates that reflect the risk inherent in future cash flows.

Goodwill

              Goodwill represents the excess of cost over fair value of assets of businesses acquired. Goodwill and intangible assets acquired in a purchase business combination are recorded at fair value as of the date acquired. The annual impairment test of goodwill is performed as of the first day of the fourth quarter of the fiscal year.

              The Financial Accounting Standards Board issued ASU 2011-08 effective for annual and interim impairment tests performed for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2011. The Company elected to adopt this standard early and therefore the new standard was applied for the impairment test performed in the fourth quarter of fiscal year 2011.

              ASU 2011-08 provides that qualitative factors are first assessed to determine whether it is necessary to perform the two-step goodwill impairment test. Under the new requirements, the Company used these qualitative factors to determine whether it is more likely than not (likelihood of more than 50%) that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount, including goodwill.

F-31


Table of Contents


SUSSER PETROLEUM COMPANY LLC (PREDECESSOR)

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

              The Company has one reporting unit. Some of the factors considered in applying the new standard include the consideration of macroeconomic conditions, industry and market considerations, cost factors affecting the business, and the overall financial performance of the Company.

              The Company determined that step one of the two step approach should be applied given the narrow margin between fair value and carrying value in the prior year goodwill analysis. In applying the step one approach, the Company employed multiple valuation methodologies, including a market approach (market price multiples of comparable companies) and an income approach (discounted cash flow analysis). This is consistent with the requirement to utilize all appropriate valuation techniques as described in ASC 820-10-35-24 " Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures. " The values ascertained using these methods were weighted to obtain a total fair value. The computations require management to make significant estimates and assumptions. Critical estimates and assumptions that are used as part of these evaluations include, among other things, selection of comparable publicly traded companies, the discount rate applied to future earnings reflecting a weighted average cost of capital rate, and earnings growth assumptions. A discounted cash flow analysis requires us to make various judgmental assumptions about sales, operating margins, capital expenditures, working capital and growth rates. Assumptions about sales, operating margins, capital expenditures and growth rates are based on our budgets, business plans, economic projections, and anticipated future cash flows. The annual planning process that we undertake to prepare the long range financial forecast takes into consideration a multitude of factors including historical growth rates and operating performance, related industry trends, macroeconomic conditions, inflationary and deflationary forces, pricing strategies, customer demand analysis, operating trends, competitor analysis, and marketplace data, among others. The results of the Company's tests indicated no goodwill impairment as the estimated fair value was greater than the carrying value.

              If after assessing the totality of events or circumstances an entity determines that it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is greater than its carrying amount then performing the two-step test is unnecessary.

              If the estimated fair value of a reporting unit is less than the carrying value, a second step is performed to compute the amount of the impairment by determining an "implied fair value" of goodwill. The determination of the Company's "implied fair value" requires the Company to allocate the estimated fair value of the reporting unit to the assets and liabilities of the reporting unit. Any unallocated fair value represents the "implied fair value" of goodwill, which is compared to the corresponding carrying value.

Other Intangible Assets

              Other intangible assets consist of supply agreements with customers, customer intangibles and favorable and unfavorable lease arrangements. We account for other intangible assets acquired through business combinations in accordance ASC 805 "Business Combinations" (ASC 805) and ASC 350. Separable intangible assets that are not determined to have an indefinite life will continue to be amortized over their useful lives and assessed for impairment under the provisions of ASC 360 " Property, Plant, and Equipment ". The determination of the fair market value of the intangible asset and the estimated useful life are based on an analysis of all pertinent factors including (1) the use of widely-accepted valuation approaches, the income approach or the cost approach, (2) the expected use of the asset by the Company, (3) the expected useful life of related assets, (4) any legal, regulatory or contractual provisions, including renewal or extension period that would cause substantial costs or

F-32


Table of Contents


SUSSER PETROLEUM COMPANY LLC (PREDECESSOR)

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

modifications to existing agreements, and (5) the effects of obsolescence, demand, competition, and other economic factors. Should any of the underlying assumptions indicate that the value of the intangible assets might be impaired, we may be required to reduce the carrying value and subsequent useful life of the asset. If the underlying assumptions governing the amortization of an intangible asset were later determined to have significantly changed, we may be required to adjust the amortization period of such asset to reflect any new estimate of its useful life. Any write-down of the value or unfavorable change in the useful life of an intangible asset would increase expense at that time.

              Supply agreements are being amortized on a straight-line basis over the remaining terms of the agreements, which generally range from five to fifteen years. Favorable and unfavorable lease arrangements are amortized on a straight-line basis over the remaining lease terms.

Environmental Liabilities

              Environmental expenditures related to existing conditions, resulting from past or current operations and from which no current or future benefit is discernible, are expensed by the Company. Expenditures that extend the life of the related property or prevent future environmental contamination are capitalized. The Company determines its liability on a site-by-site basis and records a liability when it is probable and can be reasonably estimated. The estimated liability is not discounted. Certain environmental expenditures incurred for motor fuel sites are eligible for refund under the reimbursement programs administered by the Texas Commission on Environmental Quality (TCEQ). A related receivable is recorded for estimated probable reimbursements. Environmental expenditures not eligible for refund from the TCEQ may be recoverable in whole or part from a third party or from the Company's tank owners insurance coverage, in which case the Company has recorded a liability for its estimated net exposure.

Asset Retirement Obligations

              The estimated future cost to remove an underground storage tank is recognized over the estimated useful life of the storage tank in accordance with the provisions of ASC 410 " Asset Retirement and Environmental Obligations ". We record a discounted liability for the fair value of an asset retirement obligation with a corresponding increase to the carrying value of the related long-lived asset at the time an underground storage tank is installed. We depreciate the amount added to property and equipment and recognize accretion expense in connection with the discounted liability over the remaining life of the tank. We base our estimates of the anticipated future costs for removal of an underground storage tank on our prior experience with removal. We review our assumptions for computing the estimated liability for the removal of underground storage tanks on an annual basis. Any change in estimated cash flows are reflected as an adjustment to the liability and the associated asset.

Revenue Recognition

              Revenues from motor fuel sales are recognized at the time that fuel is delivered to the customer, with the exception of consignment sales, which are discussed in greater detail below. Shipment and delivery of motor fuel generally occurs on the same day. The Company charges its wholesale customers for third-party transportation costs, which are recorded net in cost of sales. A portion of our motor fuel sales to wholesale customers are on a consignment basis, in which we retain title to inventory, control access to and sale of fuel inventory, and recognize revenue at the time the fuel is sold to the ultimate customer. We typically own the fuel dispensing equipment and underground

F-33


Table of Contents


SUSSER PETROLEUM COMPANY LLC (PREDECESSOR)

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

storage tanks at consignment sites, and in some cases we own the entire site and have entered into an operating lease with the wholesale customer operating the site. The amount of fuel inventory held on consignment is provided in Note 4. We derive other income from rental income, propane and lubricating oils and other ancillary product and service of offerings.

Rental Income

              Rental income from operating leases is recognized on a straight-line basis over the term of the lease.

Cost of Sales

              We include in "Cost of Sales" all costs we incur to acquire wholesale fuel, including the costs of purchasing, storing and transporting inventory prior to delivery to our wholesale customers. Cost of sales does not include any depreciation of our property, plant and equipment, as any amounts attributed to cost of sales would not be significant. Depreciation is separately classified in our Consolidated Statements of Operations. Total cost of sales of suppliers who accounted for 10% or more of our total combined cost of sales during the years ended December 31 are as follows:

 
  2009   2010   2011  

Valero

    48%     41%     37%  

Chevron

    23%     16%     20%  

Deferred Branding Incentives

              We receive payments for deferred branding incentives related to our fuel supply contracts. Unearned branding incentives are deferred and amortized as earned over the term of the respective agreement. Deferred branding incentives are amortized on a straight line basis over the term of the agreement as a credit to cost of sales.

Lease Accounting

              The Company leases a portion of its properties under non-cancelable operating leases, whose initial terms are typically 10 to 20 years, along with options that permit renewals for additional periods. Minimum rent is typically expensed on a straight-line basis over the term of the lease including renewal periods that are reasonably assured at the inception of the lease. The Company is typically responsible for payment of real estate taxes, maintenance expenses and insurance. The Company also leases certain vehicles, which are typically less than five years.

Stock-Based Compensation

              Certain employees supporting the Company's operations were historically granted long-term incentive compensation awards under the Parent's stock-based compensation programs, which consist of stock options and restricted common stock. The Company was allocated expenses for stock-based compensation costs. These costs are included in the Company's general and administrative expenses. The Company allocated expense was $0.6 million, $0.6 million and $0.7 million for the years ended December 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011, respectively.

F-34


Table of Contents


SUSSER PETROLEUM COMPANY LLC (PREDECESSOR)

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

Income Taxes

              Pursuant to ASC 740 " Income Taxes " (ASC 740), we recognize deferred income tax liabilities and assets for the expected future income tax consequences of temporary differences between financial statement carrying amounts and the related income tax basis.

              ASC 740 prescribes a recognition threshold and measurement attribute for the financial statement recognition and measurement of a tax position taken or expected to be taken in a tax return. The Company recognizes the impact of a tax position in the financial statements, if that position is not more likely than not of being sustained, based on the technical merits of the position. ASC 740 also provides guidance on de-recognition, classification, interest and penalties, accounting in interim periods and disclosure (see Note 16).

              The Company and Parent file consolidated federal and state income tax returns. Income taxes are allocated based on separate Company computations of income or loss.

Motor Fuel Taxes

              Certain motor fuel and sales taxes are collected from customers and remitted to governmental agencies either directly or through suppliers by the Company. The Company's accounting policy is to exclude the tax collected and remitted from revenues and cost of sales and account for them as liabilities.

Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities

              All derivative financial instruments are reported on the balance sheet at fair value. Changes in the fair value are recognized either in earnings or as other comprehensive income in equity, depending on whether the derivative has been designated as a fair value or cash flow hedge and qualifies as part of a hedging relationship, the nature of the exposure being hedged, and how effective the derivative is at offsetting movements in underlying exposure. The Company does not engage in the trading of derivatives. All such financial instruments are used to manage risk.

              The Company periodically enters into derivatives, such as futures and options, to manage its fuel price risk. Net proceeds received and the change in value of the derivatives are recorded as increases or decreases to fuel cost of sales. At December 31, 2011, the Company held 16 fuel futures contracts with a fair value of ($12,800). At December 31, 2010, the Company held six fuel futures contracts with a fair value of ($14,300).

Fair Value of Financial Instruments

              Cash, accounts receivable, certain other current assets, accounts payable, accrued expenses and other current liabilities are reflected in the consolidated financial statements at fair value because of the short-term maturity of the instruments.

Concentration Risk

              Motor fuel sold to Stripes LLC, an affiliate of the Company, represented approximately 60% of the total motor fuel sales for each of the years ended December 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011. These sales were at cost and no profit is reflected on these sales.

F-35


Table of Contents


SUSSER PETROLEUM COMPANY LLC (PREDECESSOR)

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

Earnings Per Share

              During the periods presented, we were wholly owned by the Parent. Accordingly, we have not calculated earnings per share.

Comprehensive Income

              The Predecessor accounts for comprehensive income in accordance with ASC 220, " Comprehensive Income ," which established standards for the reporting and presentation of comprehensive income on the consolidated financial statements. The Predecessor has no transactions which affect comprehensive income and, accordingly, comprehensive income equals net income for all periods presented.

New Accounting Pronouncements

              FASB ASU No. 2011-04.     In May 2011, the FASB issued ASU No. 2011-04, " Fair Value Measurement, Amendments to Achieve Common Fair Value Measurement and Disclosure Requirements in U.S. GAAP and IFRS (ASC 820—Fair Value Measurement). " This guidance amends ASC 820 on fair value measurements and disclosures to (1) clarify the board's intent in respect of existing measurement guidance, (2) revise certain measurement guidance that changes or modifies a principle for measuring fair value, and (3) add disclosure requirements concerning the measurement uncertainty of level 3 measurements. The ASU is effective for interim and annual periods beginning after December 15, 2011. No impact is expected on our financial statements.

              FASB ASU No. 2011-05.     In June 2011, the FASB issued ASU No. 2011-05, " Comprehensive Income: Presentation of Comprehensive Income (ASC 220—Comprehensive Income). " This guidance removes the presentation options in ASC 220 and requires entities to report components of comprehensive income in either (1) a continuous statement of comprehensive income or (2) two separate but consecutive statements. The ASU does not change the items that must be reported in other comprehensive income. It is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2011 (and for interim periods within such years). In December 2011, the FASB issued ASU No. 2011-12, which deferred certain aspects of ASU No. 2011-05. The Company will adopt this accounting standard in the three months ended March 31, 2012. This standard affects presentation and disclosure, and therefore will not affect the Company's consolidated financial position, results of operations or cash flows.

              FASB ASU No. 2011-08.     In September 2011, the FASB issued ASU NO. 2011-08, " Intangibles-Goodwill and Other (ASC350-20—Goodwill): Testing Goodwill for Impairment. " This guidance permits an entity to first assess qualitative factors to determine whether it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount as a basis for determining whether it is necessary to perform the two-step goodwill impairment test. The ASU is effective for annual and interim goodwill impairment tests performed for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2011. The Company has early adopted ASU No. 2011-08 during the fourth quarter of Fiscal 2011 and used it to perform the annual goodwill impairment test.

F-36


Table of Contents


SUSSER PETROLEUM COMPANY LLC (PREDECESSOR)

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

3. Accounts Receivable

              Accounts receivable consisted of the following:

 
  December 31,  
 
  2010   2011  
 
  (in thousands)
 

Accounts receivable, trade

  $ 18,299   $ 30,963  

Receivable from state environmental reimbursement funds

    198     61  

Other receivables

    945     903  

Allowance for uncollectible accounts, trade

    (332 )   (153 )

Allowance for uncollectible accounts, environmental

    (14 )   (14 )
           

Accounts receivable, net

  $ 19,096   $ 31,760  
           

              An allowance for uncollectible accounts is provided based on management's evaluation of outstanding accounts receivable. Following is a summary of the valuation accounts related to accounts and notes receivable:

 
  Balance at
Beginning of
Period
  Additions
Charged to Costs
and Expenses
  Amounts Written
Off, Net of
Recoveries
  Balance at
End of Period
 
 
  (in thousands)
 

Allowance for doubtful accounts:

                         

December 31, 2009

  $ 350   $ 385   $ 422   $ 313  

December 31, 2010

    313     214     195     332  

December 31, 2011

    332     (58 )   121     153  

Allowance for environmental cost reimbursements:

                         

December 31, 2009

  $ 14   $   $   $ 14  

December 31, 2010

    14             14  

December 31, 2011

    14             14  

4. Inventories

              Inventories consisted of the following:

 
  December 31,  
 
  2010   2011  
 
  (in thousands)
 

Fuel—consignment

  $ 3,150   $ 3,538  

Fuel—wholesale

    1,473     1,767  

Fuel—bulk

    737     1,180  

Other

    572     538  
           

Inventories, net

  $ 5,932   $ 7,023  
           

F-37


Table of Contents


SUSSER PETROLEUM COMPANY LLC (PREDECESSOR)

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

5. Assets Not in Productive Use

Assets Held and Used

              Long-lived assets to be held and used at December 31, 2010 and December 31, 2011, classified as other noncurrent assets were $0.5 million and $0.5 million, respectively. These assets continue to be depreciated over their remaining useful life. Fair value is determined based on prices of similar assets. These assets are being offered for sale, however, our expectation is that it may take longer than one year to close such sales.

Assets Held for Sale

              Assets held for sale are currently under contract for sale and are expected to be closed within one year. We had no assets classified as held for sale as of December 31, 2010 or 2011.

6. Property and Equipment

 
  December 31,  
 
  2010   2011  
 
  (in thousands)
 

Land

  $ 18,236   $ 19,552  

Buildings and leasehold improvements

    7,488     8,315  

Equipment

    22,882     27,943  

Construction in progress

    986     1,116  
           

Total property and equipment

    49,592     56,926  

Less: Accumulated depreciation

    14,345     17,877  
           

Property and equipment, net

  $ 35,247   $ 39,049  
           

              Depreciation expense on property and equipment was $4.1 million, $3.5 million and $3.9 million for 2009, 2010 and 2011, respectively.

              The Company records any excess properties for sale as assets held for sale in current assets, or as assets held and used in other noncurrent assets at the lower of carrying cost or estimated fair value, less cost to sell.

              During 2009, the Company recorded a negligible gain on the disposal of assets. During 2010, the Company recorded a net loss of $0.1 million on disposal of assets. During 2011, the Company recorded a net loss of $0.2 million on disposal of assets. Gains and losses of property and equipment and assets not in productive use are recorded in gain/loss on disposal of assets and impairment charges in the Statements of Operations.

7. Intangible Assets

Goodwill

              No changes in goodwill were recorded during 2010 or 2011. No impairment charges related to goodwill were recognized in 2009, 2010 or 2011.

F-38


Table of Contents


SUSSER PETROLEUM COMPANY LLC (PREDECESSOR)

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

7. Intangible Assets (Continued)

Other Intangibles

              In accordance with ASC 350 "Intangibles—Goodwill and Other", the Company has finite-lived intangible assets recorded that are amortized. The finite-lived assets consist of supply agreements and favorable/unfavorable leasehold arrangements, all of which are amortized over the respective lives of the agreements or over the period of time the assets are expected to contribute directly or indirectly to the Company's future cash flows. Supply agreements are being amortized over a weighted average period of approximately nine years. Favorable/unfavorable leasehold arrangements are being amortized over a weighted average period of approximately eleven years.

              In the years ended 2010 and 2011, we acquired fuel supply contracts and other commercial accounts valued at $7.8 million and $10.4 million, respectively.

              The following table presents the gross carrying amount and accumulated amortization for each major class of intangible assets, excluding goodwill, at December 31, 2010 and December 31, 2011:

 
  December 31, 2010   December 31, 2011  
 
  Gross Carrying Amount   Accumulated Amortization   Net Amount   Gross Carrying Amount   Accumulated Amortization   Net Amount  
 
  (in thousands)
 

Amortized:

                                     

Supply agreements

  $ 18,086   $ 4,293   $ 13,793   $ 29,654   $ 6,432   $ 23,222  

Unfavorable lease arrangements, net

    (2,036 )   (1,371 )   (665 )   (950 )   (391 )   (559 )

Other

                690     44     646  
                           

Intangible assets, net

  $ 16,050   $ 2,922   $ 13,128   $ 29,394   $ 6,085   $ 23,309  
                           

              Total amortization expense on finite-lived intangibles included in depreciation, amortization and accretion for 2009, 2010 and 2011 was $0.8 million, $1.2 million and $2.2 million, respectively. The following table presents the Company's estimate of amortization includable in amortization expense for each of the five succeeding fiscal years for finite-lived intangibles as of December 31, 2011 (in thousands):

 
  Amortization  

2012

  $ 3,485  

2013

    3,190  

2014

    2,882  

2015

    2,702  

2016

    2,318  

F-39


Table of Contents


SUSSER PETROLEUM COMPANY LLC (PREDECESSOR)

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

8. Accrued Expenses and Other Current Liabilities

              Current accrued expenses and other current liabilities consisted of the following:

 
  December 31,  
 
  2010   2011  
 
  (in thousands)
 

Accrued federal and state income taxes

  $ 6,763   $ 4,788  

Property and sales tax

    741     1,042  

Payroll and employee benefits

    1,000     1,417  

Reserve for environmental remediation, short-term

    269     98  

Deferred branding incentives, short-term

    175     151  

Deposits and other

    719     514  
           

Total

  $ 9,667   $ 8,010  
           

              At December 31, 2010 and December 31, 2011, the Company had approximately $5.4 million and $5.0 million respectively, of deferred incentives related to branding agreements with fuel suppliers, of which $5.2 million and $4.8 million, respectively, are included in deferred branding incentives, long-term portion in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. The Company is recognizing the income on a straight-line basis over the agreement periods, which range from three to ten years.

9. Long-Term Debt

              Long-term debt consisted of the following:

 
  December 31,  
 
  2010   2011  
 
  (in thousands)
 

Other notes payable

  $ 1,142   $ 1,120  

Less: Current maturities

    21     22  
           

Long-term debt, net of current maturities

  $ 1,121   $ 1,098  
           

              At December 31, 2011 scheduled future debt maturities are as follows (in thousands):

2012

  $ 22  

2013

    24  

2014

    25  

2015

    26  

2016

    1,023  

Thereafter

     
       

Total

  $ 1,120  
       

              In August 2010 we entered into a mortgage note with a lender for an aggregate initial borrowing amount of $1.2 million. Pursuant to the terms of the mortgage note, we make monthly installment payments that are comprised of principal and interest through the maturity date of July 1, 2016. The balance outstanding at December 31, 2010 and 2011 was $1.1 million and $1.1 million, respectively. The mortgage note bears interest at a fixed rate of 6.0%. Interest expense for the twelve

F-40


Table of Contents


SUSSER PETROLEUM COMPANY LLC (PREDECESSOR)

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

9. Long-Term Debt (Continued)

months ended December 31, 2010 and December 31, 2011, was $29,000 and $68,000, respectively. The mortgage note is secured by a first priority security interest in a property owned by the Company.

              The fair value of debt as of December 31, 2011 is estimated to be approximately $1.4 million based on an analysis of the net present value of remaining payment at a rate calculated off U.S. Treasury securities. The estimated fair value of long-term debt is calculated using Level 2 inputs.

Fair Value Measurements

              We use fair value measurements to measure, among other items, purchased assets and investments, leases and derivative contracts. We also use them to assess impairment of properties, equipment, intangible assets and goodwill. Fair value is defined as the price at which an asset could be exchanged in a current transaction between knowledgeable, willing parties. A liability's fair value is defined as the amount that would be paid to transfer the liability to a new obligor, not the amount that would be paid to settle the liability with the creditor. Where available, fair value is based on observable market prices or parameters, or are derived from such prices or parameters. Where observable prices or inputs are not available, use of unobservable prices or inputs are used to estimate the current fair value, often using an internal valuation model. These valuation techniques involve some level of management estimation and judgment, the degree of which is dependent on the item being valued.

              ASC 820 " Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures " prioritizes the inputs used in measuring fair value into the following hierarchy:

              Level 1  Quoted prices (unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets or liabilities;

              Level 2  Inputs other than quoted prices included within Level 1 that are either directly or indirectly observable;

              Level 3  Unobservable inputs in which little or no market activity exists, therefore requiring an entity to develop its own assumptions about the assumptions that market participants would use in pricing.

              The Company periodically enters into derivatives, such as futures and options, to manage its fuel price risk, primarily related to bulk purchases of fuel. We hedge this inventory risk through the use of fuel futures contracts which are matched in quantity and timing to the anticipated usage of the inventory. Bulk fuel purchases and fuel hedging positions have not been material to our operations. The fair value of our derivative contracts are measured using Level 2 inputs, and are determined by either market prices on an active market for similar assets or by prices quoted by a broker or other market-corroborated prices. This price does not differ materially from the amount that would be paid to transfer the liability to a new obligor due to the short term nature of these contracts. At December 31, 2010, the Company held fuel futures contracts with a fair value of ($14,300) (six contracts representing 0.3 million gallons). At December 31, 2011, the Company held fuel futures contracts with a fair value of ($12,800) (16 contracts representing 0.6 million gallons), which is classified in other current assets in the Company's consolidated balance sheets. The Company recognized a loss during 2011 related to these contracts of $0.8 million. The loss realized on hedging contracts is substantially offset by increased profitability on sale of fuel inventory. The loss recognized on these contracts is recorded in motor fuel cost of sales in the Company's consolidated statements of operations. The Company is not using hedge accounting with regards to these contracts.

F-41


Table of Contents


SUSSER PETROLEUM COMPANY LLC (PREDECESSOR)

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

10. Other Noncurrent Liabilities

              Other noncurrent liabilities consisted of the following:

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2010   2011  
 
  (in thousands)
 

Reserve for underground storage tank removal

  $ 575   $ 600  

Reserve for environmental remediation, long-term

    119     50  
           

Total

  $ 694   $ 650  
           

              We record an asset retirement obligation for the estimated future cost to storage tanks. The liability has been discounted using credit-adjusted risk-free rates ranging from 9.0% to 11.0%. Revisions to the liability could occur due to changes in tank removal costs, tank useful lives or if federal and/or state regulators enact new guidance on the removal of such tanks. The following table presents the changes in the carrying amount of asset retirement obligations for the years ended December 31, 2010 and December 31, 2011:

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2010   2011  
 
  (in thousands)
 

Balance at beginning of period

  $ 508   $ 575  

Liabilities incurred

    0     3  

Liabilities settled

    (10 )   (29 )

Accretion expense

    77     51  
           

Balance at end of period

  $ 575   $ 600  
           

11. Benefit Plans

              The Company participates in a 401(k) benefit plan (the "Plan") established by the Parent for the benefit of our employees. All full-time employees who are over 21 years of age and have greater than six months tenure are eligible to participate. Under the terms of the Plan, employees can defer up to 100% of their wages, with the Company matching a portion of the first 6% of the employee's contribution.

              The Company also participates in a Nonqualified Deferred Compensation Plan ("NQDC") established by the Parent for key executives, officers, and certain other employees to allow compensation deferrals in addition to that allowable under the 401(k) plan limitations. We match a portion of the participant's contribution each year using the same percentage used for our 401(k) plan match. NQDC benefits will be paid from our assets.

              Expenses related to these plans are allocated to the Company by the Parent. The Company's net expense incurred for these plans for 2009, 2010 and 2011, was approximately $32,000, $0.1 million and $0.2 million, respectively.

F-42


Table of Contents


SUSSER PETROLEUM COMPANY LLC (PREDECESSOR)

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

12. Related-Party Transactions

              The Company sold motor fuel to its Parent at a zero gross profit. These sales are reflected in motor fuel sales to affiliates with the corresponding cost reflected in motor fuel cost of sales to affiliates. In addition the Company collected credit card receipts from the motor fuel suppliers on the Parents behalf.

              The Parent charged the Company $1.3 million, $1.4 million and $1.6 million for the years ended December 31, 2009, December 31, 2010, and December 31, 2011 for oversight of the Company. Such amounts include certain expenses allocated by Parent for general corporate services, such as finance, internal audit and legal services, which are included in general and administrative expense. These expenses were charged or allocated to the Company based on the nature of the expenses and the Company's proportionate share of employee time and headcount, which management believes to be reasonable. The allocation methods used were consistently applied in all periods presented. Rent expense is charged by the Parent on certain real estate which is in turn subleased by the Company to dealers. This rent expense was $0.2 million, $1.0 million and $1.1 million for each of the years ended December 31, 2009, December 31, 2010 and December 31, 2011. All charges are recorded to an intracompany accounts receivable, which does not bear interest. The balance in accounts receivable with affiliates was $100.2 million and $106.6 million at December 31, 2010 and December 31, 2011, respectively.

              We lease two dealer sites from Sam L. Susser, our chief executive officer. The leases are classified as operating leases and provide for minimum annual rentals of approximately $0.2 million in 2012 through 2016. The lease expiration dates with the exercise of all options range from 2050 to 2051. The annual rentals on related-party leases are included in the table of future minimum lease payments presented in Note 13.

13. Commitments and Contingencies

Leases

              The Company leases a portion of its properties under non-cancellable operating leases, whose initial terms are typically 10 to 20 years, along with options that permit renewals for additional periods. Minimum rent is typically expensed on a straight-line basis over the term of the lease. The Company is typically responsible for payment of real estate taxes, maintenance expenses and insurance.

              The components of net rent expense are as follows:

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2009   2010   2011  
 
  (in thousands)
 

Store base rent

  $ 1,281   $ 3,351   $ 3,729  

Equipment rent

    297     446     593  
               

Total rent expense

  $ 1,578   $ 3,797   $ 4,322  
               

              Equipment rent consists primarily of store equipment and vehicles. Sublease rental income for 2009, 2010 and 2011 was $1.2 million, $2.3 million and $2.5 million, respectively, and is included in other income.

F-43


Table of Contents


SUSSER PETROLEUM COMPANY LLC (PREDECESSOR)

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

13. Commitments and Contingencies (Continued)

              Future minimum lease payments for future fiscal years are as follows:

 
  (in thousands)  

2012

  $ 2,569  

2013

    2,417  

2014

    2,352  

2015

    2,331  

2016

    2,306  

Thereafter

    14,980  
       

Total

  $ 26,955  
       

Environmental Remediation

              We are subject to various federal, state and local environmental laws and make financial expenditures in order to comply with regulations governing underground storage tanks adopted by federal, state and local regulatory agencies. In particular, at the federal level, the Resource Conservation and Recovery Act of 1976, as amended, requires the EPA to establish a comprehensive regulatory program for the detection, prevention and cleanup of leaking underground storage tanks (e.g. overfills, spills and underground storage tank releases).

              Federal and state regulations require us to provide and maintain evidence that we are taking financial responsibility for corrective action and compensating third parties in the event of a release from our underground storage tank systems. In order to comply with these requirements, we have historically obtained private insurance for Texas, New Mexico and Oklahoma. These policies provide protection from third-party liability claims. For 2011, our coverage was $1.0 million per occurrence, with a $2.0 million aggregate and $0.5 million self-insured retention. Additionally, we rely on state trust funds that cover certain claims.

              We are currently involved in the remediation of motor fuel storage sites where releases of regulated substances have been detected. We accrue for anticipated future costs and the related probable state reimbursement amounts for its remediation activities. Accordingly, we have recorded estimated undiscounted liabilities for these sites totaling $0.4 million and $0.1 million, of which $0.3 million and $0.1 million are classified as accrued expenses and other current liabilities as of December 31, 2010 and December 31, 2011, respectively, with the balance included in other noncurrent liabilities. As of December 31, 2011, approximately $0.1 million of the total environmental reserve is for the investigation and remediation of contamination at four sites that qualify for reimbursement under state funds.

              Under state reimbursement programs, we are eligible to receive reimbursement for certain future remediation costs, as well as the remediation costs previously paid. Accordingly, we have recorded a net receivable of $0.2 million and $61,000 for the estimated probable state reimbursements which are included in other assets as of December 31, 2010 and December 31, 2011, respectively. The Texas Petroleum Storage Tank Remediation fund, which was covering releases that occurred prior to December 23, 1998, expired on August 31, 2011. All eligible claims from this fund must be paid by August 31, 2012. Remaining open cases were transferred to the State Lead Remediation Program, of

F-44


Table of Contents


SUSSER PETROLEUM COMPANY LLC (PREDECESSOR)

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

13. Commitments and Contingencies (Continued)

which we have two sites. This program will complete the remediation at no out-of-pocket cost to the responsible party. However, the responsible party remains liable for any third-party claims.

              An additional two sites have state reimbursement payments directly assigned to remediation contractors for which the Company has no out of pocket expenses and maintains no reserve and may or may not have responsibility for contamination. The remaining $37,000 represents our estimate of deductibles under insurance policies that we anticipate being required to pay with respect to two additional sites. We have additional reserves of $0.6 million that represent our estimate for future asset retirement obligations for underground storage tanks.

Deferred Branding Incentives

              We receive deferred branding incentives and other incentive payments from a number of our fuel suppliers. A portion of the deferred branding incentives may be passed on to our wholesale branded dealers under the same terms as required by our fuel suppliers. Many of the agreements require repayment of all or a portion of the amount received if we (or our branded dealers) elect to discontinue selling the specified brand of fuel at certain locations. As of December 31, 2011, the estimated amount of deferred branding incentives that would have to be repaid upon de-branding at these locations was $18.6 million. Of this amount, approximately $10.9 million would be the responsibility of SPC's branded dealers under reimbursement agreements with the dealers. In the event a dealer were to default on this reimbursement obligation, SPC would be required to make this payment. No liability is recorded for the amount of dealer obligations which would become payable upon de-branding. We have $5.0 million recorded on the balance sheet as of December 31, 2011, of which $0.2 million is included in accrued expenses and other current liabilities and $4.8 million is included in other noncurrent liabilities. The Company amortizes its retained portion of the incentives to income on a straight-line basis over the term of the agreements.

14. Rental Income under Operating Leases

              The following schedule details our investment in property on operating leases as of December 31, 2011:

Land

  $ 18,591  

Buildings and improvements

    6,932  

Equipment

    4,890  
       

    30,413  

Less: Accumulated depreciation

    5,425  
       

  $ 24,988  
       

F-45


Table of Contents


SUSSER PETROLEUM COMPANY LLC (PREDECESSOR)

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

14. Rental Income under Operating Leases (Continued)

              The following is a schedule by years of minimum future rental income on noncancelable operating leases as of December 31, 2011:

Year ended December 31,

       

2012

  $ 5,137  

2013

    4,968  

2014

    4,621  

2015

    4,278  

2016

    3,804  

Thereafter

    17,679  
       

Total minimum future rentals

  $ 40,487  
       

15. Interest Expense and Interest Income

              The components of net interest expense are as follows:

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2009   2010   2011  
 
  (in thousands)
 

Cash interest expense

  $ 309   $ 332   $ 412  

Cash interest income

    (118 )   (48 )   (88 )
               

Interest expense, net

  $ 191   $ 284   $ 324  
               

16. Income Tax

              Components of the Company's income tax benefit and provision for fiscal years ended December 31, 2009, December 31, 2010, and December 31, 2011 are as follows:

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2009   2010   2011  
 
  (in thousands)
 

Current:

                   

Federal

  $ 3,647   $ 6,527   $ 4,524  

State

    198     236     265  
               

Total current income tax expense

    3,845     6,763     4,789  

Deferred:

                   

Federal

    981     (1,519 )   1,245  

State

    5     (8 )   5  
               

Total deferred tax expense (benefit)

    986     (1,527 )   1,250  
               

Net income tax expense

  $ 4,831   $ 5,236   $ 6,039  
               

F-46


Table of Contents


SUSSER PETROLEUM COMPANY LLC (PREDECESSOR)

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

16. Income Tax (Continued)

              A reconciliation of the statutory federal income tax rate to the Company's effective tax rate for the fiscal years ended December 31, 2009, December 31, 2010, and December 31, 2011 are as follows:

 
  December 31,  
 
  2009   2010   2011  
 
  (in thousands)   Tax Rate %   (in thousands)   Tax Rate %   (in thousands)   Tax Rate %  

Tax at statutory federal rate

  $ 4,671     35.0 % $ 5,058     35.0 % $ 5,823     35.0 %

State and local tax, net of federal benefit

    132     1.0     149     1.0     176     1.0  

Other

    28     0.2     29     0.2     40     0.3  
                           

Tax expense per financial statement

  $ 4,831     36.2 % $ 5,236     36.2 % $ 6,039     36.3 %
                           

              Included in our provision for income tax is a tax imposed by the state of Texas of 0.5% of taxable margin generated by our operations in Texas ("franchise tax"). The franchise tax accrued for years ended December 31, 2010 and December 31, 2011 was $0.2 million and $0.2 million, respectively.

              The Company and Parent file consolidated federal and state income tax returns. Income taxes are allocated based on separate Company computations of income or loss.

              Components of deferred tax assets and liabilities are as follows:

 
  December 31,  
 
  2010   2011  
 
  (in thousands)
 

Deferred tax assets:

             

Allowance for doubtful accounts

  $ 94   $ 112  

Environmental reserves

    78     73  

Intangible assets

    1,377     1,047  

Deferred revenue

    1,901     1,747  

Accrued bonuses

        517  
           

Total deferred tax assets

    3,450     3,496  

Deferred tax liabilities:

             

Fixed assets

    4,075     5,297  

Prepaid assets

    28     20  

Other accruals and reserves

    80     164  
           

Total deferred tax liabilities

    4,183     5,481  
           

Net deferred income tax assets (liabilities)

  $ (733 ) $ (1,985 )
           

Current net deferred tax assets (liabilities)

  $ 66   $ 610  
           

Noncurrent net deferred tax assets (liabilities)

  $ (799 ) $ (2,595 )
           

              The Company has determined that it is more likely than not that all deferred tax assets will be realized, and has therefore determined that no valuation allowance is needed as of December 31, 2010 or December 31, 2011.

F-47


Table of Contents


SUSSER PETROLEUM COMPANY LLC (PREDECESSOR)

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

16. Income Tax (Continued)


Uncertain Tax Positions

              It is the Company's policy to recognize interest and penalties related to uncertain tax positions in general and administrative expense. Interest and penalties incurred by the company have not been material in 2009, 2010 or 2011. The Parent of the Company files income tax returns in the U.S. federal jurisdiction, Texas, Oklahoma, Louisiana and New Mexico. These returns are subject to examinations in all jurisdictions for all returns for the 2007 through 2011 tax years.

              As of December 31, 2011, all tax positions taken by the Company are considered highly certain. There are no positions the Company reasonably anticipates will significantly increase or decrease within 12 months of the reporting date, and therefore no adjustments have been recorded related to unrecognized tax benefits.

17. Unitholder's Equity

              A total of 1,000 units of common units have been authorized, $0.00 par value, of which 1,000 were issued and 1,000 were outstanding as of December 31, 2010, and 1,000 were issued and 1,000 were outstanding as of December 31, 2011, respectively.

18. Quarterly Results of Operations and Seasonality (Unaudited)

              The following table sets forth certain unaudited financial and operating data for each quarter during 2010 and 2011. The unaudited quarterly information includes all normal recurring adjustments that we consider necessary for a fair presentation of the information shown.

 
  2010   2011  
 
  1 st  QTR   2 nd  QTR   3 rd  QTR   4 th  QTR   1 st  QTR   2 nd  QTR   3 rd  QTR   4 th  QTR  
 
  (dollars and gallons in thousands)
 

Motor fuel sales

  $ 637,813   $ 687,053   $ 639,623   $ 708,437   $ 848,719   $ 1,008,380   $ 987,738   $ 962,094  

Rental and Other income

    2,498     2,353     2,603     3,412     3,011     2,966     4,125     3,345  

Total revenue

    640,311     689,406     642,226     711,849     851,730     1,011,346     991,863     965,439  

Motor fuel gross profit

    5,210     7,330     7,277     6,248     6,231     9,052     8,518     7,416  

Other gross profit

    2,207     2,183     2,489     3,155     2,617     3,142     3,021     3,026  

Total gross profit

    7,417     9,513     9,766     9,403     8,848     12,194     11,539     10,442  

Income from operations

    2,341     4,120     4,390     3,885     3,007     5,606     5,062     3,286  

Net income

  $ 1,447   $ 2,588   $ 2,761   $ 2,420   $ 1,861   $ 3,531   $ 3,176   $ 2,030  

Fuel gallons

    300,962     315,312     307,771     309,268     311,098     322,641     330,903     347,768  

Motor fuel margin (a)

    4.3¢     5.7¢     6.0¢     5.1¢     5.1¢     7.1¢     6.6¢     5.2¢  

(a)
Excludes the impact of motor fuel sold to affiliates at zero gross profit.

F-48


Table of Contents


REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To the Partners of
Susser Petroleum Partners LP

              We have audited the accompanying balance sheet of Susser Petroleum Partners LP (the "Partnership") (a Delaware Limited Partnership) as of June 11, 2012 (date of inception). This financial statement is the responsibility of the Partnership's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on this financial statement based on our audit.

              We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards required that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the balance sheet is free of material misstatement. We were not engaged to perform an audit of the Partnership's internal control over financial reporting. Our audit included consideration of internal controls over financial reporting as a basis for designing audit procedures appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the Partnership's internal controls over financial reporting. Accordingly, we express no such opinion. An audit also includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the balance sheet, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimate made by management, and evaluating the overall balance sheet presentation. We believe our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

              In our opinion, the consolidated balance sheet referred to above presents fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Partnership at June 11, 2012 (date of inception) in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.

/s/ ERNST & YOUNG LLP

San Antonio, Texas
June 21, 2012

F-49


Table of Contents


SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP

BALANCE SHEET

as of June 11, 2012
(date of inception)

 
  June 11, 2012
(date of inception)
 

Assets

  $  
       

Liabilities

  $  

Partners' Capital:

       

Limited Partners

    1,000  

General Partner

     

Less: Contribution Receivable from Partners

    (1,000 )
       

Total Partners' Capital

     
       

Total Liabilities and Partners' Capital

  $  
       

   

The accompanying notes are an integral part of this balance sheet

F-50


Table of Contents


SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP

NOTES TO BALANCE SHEET

as of June 11, 2012 (date of inception)

1. Nature of Operations

              Susser Petroleum Partners LP (the "Partnership") is a Delaware limited partnership formed in June 2012. Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC (the "General Partner") is a limited liability company formed in June 2012 as the general partner of the Partnership.

              In June 2012, Susser Holdings Corporation, a Delaware corporation, agreed to contribute $1,000 to the Partnership in exchange for a 100% limited partner interest. The agreement to contribute has been recorded as a contribution receivable and is reflected in the accompanying balance sheet as a reduction to partners' capital.

              There have been no other transactions involving the Partnership as of June 11, 2012. The Partnership will ultimately receive the transfer from Susser Petroleum Company LLC (the "Predecessor") of certain contributed assets, liabilities, operations and/or equity interests (the "Contributed Assets"). Taken together with other affiliated entities and including the Predecessor, the entities are under common control and are collectively referred to as Susser Holdings Corporation ("SHC").

              The Partnership, pursuant to an initial public offering, intends to sell common units representing limited partnership interests in the Partnership. The Partnership will issue and sell common units and subordinated units to the shareholders (or their assigns) of the Partnership in consideration of their transfer of the Contributed Assets to the Partnership.

              The Partnership, upon the transfer of the Contributed Assets will be engaged in substantially the same business and revenue generating activities as the Predecessor, principally: (i) distributing motor fuels to SHC and third parties and (ii) ownership or lease of locations and, in turn, generating rental-fee income revenue from the lease or subleases of the locations to third-party operators.

2. Basis of Presentation

              This balance sheet has been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States. Since the Partnership has had no activity since its inception, separate statements of income, changes in partners' equity and cash flows have not been presented.

3. Subsequent Events

              The Partnership has evaluated events and transactions that occurred subsequent to June 11, 2012 up until the date these financial statements were filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

F-51


Table of Contents


Appendix A

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED

AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

OF

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP

   


Table of Contents

TABLE OF CONTENTS


ARTICLE I
DEFINITIONS

Section 1.1

 

Definitions

 
A-1

Section 1.2

 

Construction

  A-19

ARTICLE II
ORGANIZATION

Section 2.1

 

Formation

 
A-19

Section 2.2

 

Name

  A-19

Section 2.3

 

Registered Office; Registered Agent; Principal Office; Other Offices

  A-19

Section 2.4

 

Purpose and Business

  A-19

Section 2.5

 

Powers

  A-20

Section 2.6

 

Term

  A-20

Section 2.7

 

Title to Partnership Assets

  A-20

ARTICLE III
RIGHTS OF LIMITED PARTNERS

Section 3.1

 

Limitation of Liability

 
A-20

Section 3.2

 

Management of Business

  A-20

Section 3.3

 

Outside Activities of the Limited Partners

  A-21

Section 3.4

 

Rights of Limited Partners

  A-21

ARTICLE IV
CERTIFICATES; RECORD HOLDERS; TRANSFER OF PARTNERSHIP INTERESTS;
REDEMPTION OF PARTNERSHIP INTERESTS

Section 4.1

 

Certificates

 
A-22

Section 4.2

 

Mutilated, Destroyed, Lost or Stolen Certificates

  A-22

Section 4.3

 

Record Holders

  A-23

Section 4.4

 

Transfer Generally

  A-23

Section 4.5

 

Registration and Transfer of Limited Partner Interests

  A-23

Section 4.6

 

Transfer of the General Partner's General Partner Interest

  A-24

Section 4.7

 

Restrictions on Transfers

  A-24

Section 4.8

 

Eligibility Certificates; Ineligible Holders

  A-25

Section 4.9

 

Redemption of Partnership Interests of Ineligible Holders

  A-26

ARTICLE V
CAPITAL CONTRIBUTIONS AND ISSUANCE OF PARTNERSHIP INTERESTS

Section 5.1

 

Organizational Contributions

 
A-27

Section 5.2

 

Contributions by the General Partner and its Affiliates

  A-27

Section 5.3

 

Contributions by Initial Limited Partners

  A-27

Section 5.4

 

Interest and Withdrawal

  A-27

Section 5.5

 

Capital Accounts

  A-28

Section 5.6

 

Issuances of Additional Partnership Interests and Derivative Instruments

  A-30

Section 5.7

 

Conversion of Subordinated Units

  A-31

Section 5.8

 

Limited Preemptive Right

  A-31

Section 5.9

 

Splits and Combinations

  A-31

A-i


Table of Contents

Section 5.10

 

Fully Paid and Non-Assessable Nature of Limited Partner Interests

  A-32

Section 5.11

 

Issuance of Common Units in Connection with Reset of Incentive Distribution Rights

  A-32

ARTICLE VI
ALLOCATIONS AND DISTRIBUTIONS

Section 6.1

 

Allocations for Capital Account Purposes

 
A-33

Section 6.2

 

Allocations for Tax Purposes

  A-41

Section 6.3

 

Requirements and Characterization of Distributions; Distributions to Record Holders

  A-42

Section 6.4

 

Distributions of Available Cash from Operating Surplus

  A-42

Section 6.5

 

Distributions of Available Cash from Capital Surplus

  A-44

Section 6.6

 

Adjustment of Minimum Quarterly Distribution and Target Distribution Levels

  A-44

Section 6.7

 

Special Provisions Relating to the Holders of Subordinated Units

  A-44

Section 6.8

 

Special Provisions Relating to the Holders of IDR Reset Common Units

  A-45

Section 6.9

 

Entity-Level Taxation

  A-45

ARTICLE VII
MANAGEMENT AND OPERATION OF BUSINESS

Section 7.1

 

Management

 
A-46

Section 7.2

 

Replacement of Fiduciary Duties

  A-47

Section 7.3

 

Certificate of Limited Partnership

  A-48

Section 7.4

 

Restrictions on the General Partner's Authority

  A-48

Section 7.5

 

Reimbursement of the General Partner

  A-48

Section 7.6

 

Outside Activities

  A-49

Section 7.7

 

Indemnification

  A-50

Section 7.8

 

Liability of Indemnitees

  A-51

Section 7.9

 

Standards of Conduct and Modification of Duties

  A-52

Section 7.10

 

Other Matters Concerning the General Partner and Indemnitees

  A-53

Section 7.11

 

Purchase or Sale of Partnership Interests

  A-53

Section 7.12

 

Registration Rights of the General Partner and its Affiliates

  A-54

Section 7.13

 

Reliance by Third Parties

  A-56

ARTICLE VIII
BOOKS, RECORDS, ACCOUNTING AND REPORTS

Section 8.1

 

Records and Accounting

 
A-56

Section 8.2

 

Fiscal Year

  A-56

Section 8.3

 

Reports

  A-56

ARTICLE IX
TAX MATTERS

Section 9.1

 

Tax Returns and Information

 
A-57

Section 9.2

 

Tax Elections

  A-57

Section 9.3

 

Tax Controversies

  A-58

Section 9.4

 

Withholding; Tax Payments

  A-58

A-ii


Table of Contents

ARTICLE X
ADMISSION OF PARTNERS

Section 10.1

 

Admission of Limited Partners

 
A-58

Section 10.2

 

Admission of Successor General Partner

  A-59

Section 10.3

 

Amendment of Agreement and Certificate of Limited Partnership

  A-59

ARTICLE XI
WITHDRAWAL OR REMOVAL OF PARTNERS

Section 11.1

 

Withdrawal of the General Partner

 
A-59

Section 11.2

 

Removal of the General Partner

  A-61

Section 11.3

 

Interest of Departing General Partner and Successor General Partner

  A-61

Section 11.4

 

Termination of Subordination Period, Conversion of Subordinated Units and Extinguishment of Cumulative Common Unit Arrearages

  A-62

Section 11.5

 

Withdrawal of Limited Partners

  A-63

ARTICLE XII
DISSOLUTION AND LIQUIDATION

Section 12.1

 

Dissolution

 
A-63

Section 12.2

 

Continuation of the Business of the Partnership After Dissolution

  A-63

Section 12.3

 

Liquidator

  A-64

Section 12.4

 

Liquidation

  A-64

Section 12.5

 

Cancellation of Certificate of Limited Partnership

  A-65

Section 12.6

 

Return of Contributions

  A-65

Section 12.7

 

Waiver of Partition

  A-65

Section 12.8

 

Capital Account Restoration

  A-65

ARTICLE XIII
AMENDMENT OF PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT; MEETINGS; RECORD DATE

Section 13.1

 

Amendments to be Adopted Solely by the General Partner

 
A-65

Section 13.2

 

Amendment Procedures

  A-66

Section 13.3

 

Amendment Requirements

  A-67

Section 13.4

 

Special Meetings

  A-67

Section 13.5

 

Notice of a Meeting

  A-68

Section 13.6

 

Record Date

  A-68

Section 13.7

 

Adjournment

  A-68

Section 13.8

 

Waiver of Notice; Approval of Meeting; Approval of Minutes

  A-68

Section 13.9

 

Quorum and Voting

  A-69

Section 13.10

 

Conduct of a Meeting

  A-69

Section 13.11

 

Action Without a Meeting

  A-69

Section 13.12

 

Right to Vote and Related Matters

  A-70

Section 13.13

 

Voting of Incentive Distribution Rights

  A-70

A-iii


Table of Contents

ARTICLE XIV
MERGER OR CONSOLIDATION

Section 14.1

 

Authority

 
A-71

Section 14.2

 

Procedure for Merger or Consolidation

  A-71

Section 14.3

 

Approval by Limited Partners

  A-72

Section 14.4

 

Certificate of Merger

  A-73

Section 14.5

 

Effect of Merger or Consolidation

  A-73

ARTICLE XV
RIGHT TO ACQUIRE LIMITED PARTNER INTERESTS

Section 15.1

 

Right to Acquire Limited Partner Interests

 
A-73

ARTICLE XVI
GENERAL PROVISIONS

Section 16.1

 

Addresses and Notices; Written Communications

 
A-74

Section 16.2

 

Further Action

  A-75

Section 16.3

 

Binding Effect

  A-75

Section 16.4

 

Integration

  A-75

Section 16.5

 

Creditors

  A-75

Section 16.6

 

Waiver

  A-75

Section 16.7

 

Third-Party Beneficiaries

  A-75

Section 16.8

 

Counterparts

  A-75

Section 16.9

 

Applicable Law; Forum, Venue and Jurisdiction; Waiver of Trial by Jury

  A-76

Section 16.10

 

Invalidity of Provisions

  A-76

Section 16.11

 

Consent of Partners

  A-77

Section 16.12

 

Facsimile Signatures

  A-77

A-iv


Table of Contents


FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT
OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP OF SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP

              THIS FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP OF SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP dated as of                                    , 2012, is entered into by and between Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, as the General Partner, and Susser Holdings Corporation, a Delaware corporation, in its capacity as the Organizational Limited Partner, together with any other Persons who become Partners in the Partnership or parties hereto as provided herein. In consideration of the covenants, conditions and agreements contained herein, the parties hereto hereby agree as follows:

ARTICLE I

DEFINITIONS

              Section 1.1     Definitions.     The following definitions shall be for all purposes, unless otherwise clearly indicated to the contrary, applied to the terms used in this Agreement.

              " Additional Book Basis " means the portion of any remaining Carrying Value of an Adjusted Property that is attributable to positive adjustments made to such Carrying Value as a result of Book-Up Events. For purposes of determining the extent that Carrying Value constitutes Additional Book Basis:

              (a)   Any negative adjustment made to the Carrying Value of an Adjusted Property as a result of either a Book-Down Event or a Book-Up Event shall first be deemed to offset or decrease that portion of the Carrying Value of such Adjusted Property that is attributable to any prior positive adjustments made thereto pursuant to a Book-Up Event or Book-Down Event.

              (b)   If Carrying Value that constitutes Additional Book Basis is reduced as a result of a Book-Down Event and the Carrying Value of other property is increased as a result of such Book-Down Event, an allocable portion of any such increase in Carrying Value shall be treated as Additional Book Basis; provided, that the amount treated as Additional Book Basis pursuant hereto as a result of such Book-Down Event shall not exceed the amount by which the Aggregate Remaining Net Positive Adjustments after such Book-Down Event exceeds the remaining Additional Book Basis attributable to all of the Partnership's Adjusted Property after such Book-Down Event (determined without regard to the application of this clause (b) to such Book-Down Event).

              " Additional Book Basis Derivative Items " means any Book Basis Derivative Items that are computed with reference to Additional Book Basis. To the extent that the Additional Book Basis attributable to all of the Partnership's Adjusted Property as of the beginning of any taxable period exceeds the Aggregate Remaining Net Positive Adjustments as of the beginning of such period (the " Excess Additional Book Basis "), the Additional Book Basis Derivative Items for such period shall be reduced by the amount that bears the same ratio to the amount of Additional Book Basis Derivative Items determined without regard to this sentence as the Excess Additional Book Basis bears to the Additional Book Basis as of the beginning of such period. With respect to a Disposed of Adjusted Property, the Additional Book Basis Derivative Items shall be the amount of Additional Book Basis taken into account in computing gain or loss from the disposition of such Disposed of Adjusted Property.

              " Adjusted Capital Account " means the Capital Account maintained for each Partner as of the end of each taxable period of the Partnership, (a) increased by any amounts that such Partner is obligated to restore under the standards set by Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-1(b)(2)(ii)(c) (or is deemed obligated to restore under Treasury Regulation Sections 1.704-2(g) and 1.704-2(i)(5)) and (b) decreased by (i) the amount of all losses and deductions that, as of the end of such taxable period,

A-1


Table of Contents

are reasonably expected to be allocated to such Partner in subsequent taxable periods under Sections 704(e)(2) and 706(d) of the Code and Treasury Regulation Section 1.751-1(b)(2)(ii), and (ii) the amount of all distributions that, as of the end of such taxable period, are reasonably expected to be made to such Partner in subsequent taxable periods in accordance with the terms of this Agreement or otherwise to the extent they exceed offsetting increases to such Partner's Capital Account that are reasonably expected to occur during (or prior to) the taxable period in which such distributions are reasonably expected to be made (other than increases as a result of a minimum gain chargeback pursuant to Section 6.1(d)(i) or 6.1(d)(ii)). The foregoing definition of Adjusted Capital Account is intended to comply with the provisions of Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-1(b)(2)(ii)(d) and shall be interpreted consistently therewith. The "Adjusted Capital Account" of a Partner in respect of any Partnership Interest shall be the amount that such Adjusted Capital Account would be if such Partnership Interest were the only interest in the Partnership held by such Partner from and after the date on which such Partnership Interest was first issued.

              " Adjusted Operating Surplus " means, with respect to any period, (a) Operating Surplus generated with respect to such period; less (b)(i) the amount of any net increase in Working Capital Borrowings (or the Partnership's proportionate share of any net increase in Working Capital Borrowings in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) with respect to that period; and (ii) the amount of any net decrease in cash reserves (or the Partnership's proportionate share of any net decrease in cash reserves in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) for Operating Expenditures with respect to such period not relating to an Operating Expenditure made with respect to such period; and plus (c)(i) the amount of any net decrease in Working Capital Borrowings (or the Partnership's proportionate share of any net decrease in Working Capital Borrowings in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) with respect to that period; (ii) the amount of any net increase in cash reserves (or the Partnership's proportionate share of any net increase in cash reserves in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) for Operating Expenditures with respect to such period required by any debt instrument for the repayment of principal, interest or premium; and (iii) the amount of any net decrease made in subsequent periods in cash reserves for Operating Expenditures initially established with respect to such period to the extent such decrease results in a reduction in Adjusted Operating Surplus in subsequent periods pursuant to clause (b)(ii). Adjusted Operating Surplus does not include that portion of Operating Surplus included in clause (a)(i) of the definition of Operating Surplus.

              " Adjusted Property " means any property the Carrying Value of which has been adjusted pursuant to Section 5.5(d).

              " Affiliate " means, with respect to any Person, any other Person that directly or indirectly through one or more intermediaries controls, is controlled by or is under common control with, the Person in question. As used herein, the term "control" means the possession, direct or indirect, of the power to direct or cause the direction of the management and policies of a Person, whether through ownership of voting securities, by contract or otherwise.

              " Aggregate Quantity of IDR Reset Common Units " is defined in Section 5.11(a).

              " Aggregate Remaining Net Positive Adjustments " means, as of the end of any taxable period, the sum of the Remaining Net Positive Adjustments of all the Partners.

              " Agreed Allocation " means any allocation, other than a Required Allocation, of an item of income, gain, loss or deduction pursuant to the provisions of Section 6.1, including a Curative Allocation (if appropriate to the context in which the term "Agreed Allocation" is used).

              " Agreed Value " of any Contributed Property means the fair market value of such property at the time of contribution and in the case of an Adjusted Property, the fair market value of such

A-2


Table of Contents

Adjusted Property on the date of the revaluation event as described in Section 5.5(d), in both cases as determined by the General Partner.

              " Agreement " means this First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of Susser Petroleum Partners LP, as it may be amended, supplemented or restated from time to time.

              " Associate " means, when used to indicate a relationship with any Person, (a) any corporation or organization of which such Person is a director, officer, manager, general partner or managing member or is, directly or indirectly, the owner of 20% or more of any class of voting stock or other voting interest; (b) any trust or other estate in which such Person has at least a 20% beneficial interest or as to which such Person serves as trustee or in a similar fiduciary capacity; and (c) any relative or spouse of such Person, or any relative of such spouse, who has the same principal residence as such Person.

              " Available Cash " means, with respect to any Quarter ending prior to the Liquidation Date:

              (a)   the sum of (i) all cash and cash equivalents of the Partnership Group (or the Partnership's proportionate share of cash and cash equivalents in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) on hand at the end of such Quarter, and (ii) if the General Partner so determines, all or any portion of any additional cash and cash equivalents of the Partnership Group (or the Partnership's proportionate share of cash and cash equivalents in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) on hand immediately prior to the date of distribution of Available Cash with respect to such Quarter (including any Working Capital Borrowings made subsequent to the end of such Quarter), less

              (b)   the amount of any cash reserves established by the General Partner (or the Partnership's proportionate share of cash reserves in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) to (i) provide for the proper conduct of the business of the Partnership Group (including reserves for future capital expenditures and for anticipated future credit needs of the Partnership Group) subsequent to such Quarter, (ii) comply with applicable law or any loan agreement, security agreement, mortgage, debt instrument or other agreement or obligation to which any Group Member is a party or by which it is bound or its assets are subject or (iii) provide funds for distributions under Section 6.4 or 6.5 in respect of any one or more of the next four Quarters;

provided, however , that the disbursements made (including contributions to a Group Member or disbursements on behalf of a Group Member), cash received or cash reserves established, increased or reduced after the end of such period but on or before the date of distribution of Available Cash with respect to such period shall be deemed to have been made, received, established, increased or reduced, for purposes of determining Available Cash, within such Quarter if the General Partner so determines.

              Notwithstanding the foregoing, "Available Cash" with respect to the Quarter in which the Liquidation Date occurs and any subsequent Quarter shall equal zero.

              " Board of Directors " means the board of directors of the General Partner.

              " Book Basis Derivative Items " means any item of income, deduction, gain or loss that is computed with reference to the Carrying Value of an Adjusted Property (e.g., depreciation, depletion, or gain or loss with respect to an Adjusted Property).

              " Book-Down Event " means an event that triggers a negative adjustment to the Capital Accounts of the Partners pursuant to Section 5.5(d).

              " Book-Tax Disparity " means with respect to any item of Contributed Property or Adjusted Property, as of the date of any determination, the difference between the Carrying Value of such Contributed Property or Adjusted Property and the adjusted basis thereof for U.S. federal income tax purposes as of such date. A Partner's share of the Partnership's Book-Tax Disparities in all of its Contributed Property and Adjusted Property will be reflected by the difference between such Partner's

A-3


Table of Contents

Capital Account balance as maintained pursuant to Section 5.5 and the hypothetical balance of such Partner's Capital Account computed as if it had been maintained strictly in accordance with U.S. federal income tax accounting principles.

              " Book-Up Event " means an event that triggers a positive adjustment to the Capital Accounts of the Partners pursuant to Section 5.5(d).

              " Business Day " means Monday through Friday of each week, except that a legal holiday recognized as such by the government of the United States of America or the State of Texas shall not be regarded as a Business Day.

              " Capital Account " means the capital account maintained for a Partner pursuant to Section 5.5. The "Capital Account" of a Partner in respect of any Partnership Interest shall be the amount that such Capital Account would be if such Partnership Interest were the only interest in the Partnership held by such Partner from and after the date on which such Partnership Interest was first issued.

              " Capital Contribution " means any cash, cash equivalents or the Net Agreed Value of Contributed Property that a Partner contributes to the Partnership or that is contributed or deemed contributed to the Partnership on behalf of a Partner (including, in the case of an underwritten offering of Units, the amount of any underwriting discounts or commissions).

              " Capital Improvement " means any (a) addition or improvement to the capital assets owned by any Group Member, (b) acquisition (through an asset acquisition, merger, stock acquisition or other form of investment) of existing, or the construction of new, capital assets by any Group Member, or (c) capital contribution by a Group Member to a Person that is not a Subsidiary, in which a Group Member has, or after such capital contribution will have an equity interest, to fund the Group Member's pro rata share of the cost of the acquisition of existing or the construction of new or the improvement of existing, capital assets, in each case if such addition, improvement, acquisition or construction is made to increase the long-term operating capacity or operating income of the Partnership Group from the long-term operating capacity or operating income of the Partnership Group, in the case of clauses (a) and (b), or such Person, in the case of clause (c), from that existing immediately prior to such addition, improvement, acquisition or construction.

              " Capital Surplus " means Available Cash distributed by the Partnership in excess of Operating Surplus, as described in Section 6.3(a).

              " Carrying Value " means (a) with respect to a Contributed Property or an Adjusted Property, the Agreed Value of such property reduced (but not below zero) by all depreciation, amortization and cost recovery deductions charged to the Partners' Capital Accounts in respect of such property, and (b) with respect to any other Partnership property, the adjusted basis of such property for U.S. federal income tax purposes, all as of the time of determination. The Carrying Value of any property shall be adjusted from time to time in accordance with Section 5.5(d) and to reflect changes, additions or other adjustments to the Carrying Value for dispositions and acquisitions of Partnership properties, as deemed appropriate by the General Partner.

              " Cause " means a court of competent jurisdiction has entered a final, non-appealable judgment finding the General Partner is liable to the Partnership or any Limited Partner for actual fraud or willful misconduct in its capacity as a general partner of the Partnership.

              " Certificate " means a certificate in such form (including in global form if permitted by applicable rules and regulations of the Depository Trust Company and its permitted successors and assigns) as may be adopted by the General Partner, issued by the Partnership evidencing ownership of one or more Partnership Interests. The initial form of certificate approved by the General Partner for Common Units is attached as Exhibit A to this Agreement.

A-4


Table of Contents

              " Certificate of Limited Partnership " means the Certificate of Limited Partnership of the Partnership filed with the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware as referenced in Section 7.3, as such Certificate of Limited Partnership may be amended, supplemented or restated from time to time.

              " Citizenship Eligibility Trigger " is defined in Section 4.8(a)(ii).

              " claim " (as used in Section 7.12(c)) is defined in Section 7.12(c).

              " Closing Date " means the first date on which Common Units are issued and delivered by the Partnership to the Underwriters pursuant to the provisions of the Underwriting Agreement.

              " Closing Price " means, in respect of any class of Limited Partner Interests, as of the date of determination, the last sale price on such day, regular way, or in case no such sale takes place on such day, the average of the closing bid and asked prices on such day, regular way, in either case as reported in the principal consolidated transaction reporting system with respect to securities listed or admitted to trading on the principal National Securities Exchange on which such Limited Partner Interests are listed or admitted to trading or, if such Limited Partner Interests are not listed or admitted to trading on any National Securities Exchange, the last quoted price on such day or, if not so quoted, the average of the high bid and low asked prices on such day in the over-the-counter market, as reported by the primary reporting system then in use in relation to such Limited Partner Interests of such class, or, if on any such day such Limited Partner Interests of such class are not quoted by any such organization, the average of the closing bid and asked prices on such day as furnished by a professional market maker making a market in such Limited Partner Interests of such class selected by the General Partner, or if on any such day no market maker is making a market in such Limited Partner Interests of such class, the fair value of such Limited Partner Interests on such day as determined by the General Partner.

              " Code " means the U.S. Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended and in effect from time to time. Any reference herein to a specific section or sections of the Code shall be deemed to include a reference to any corresponding provision of any successor law.

              " Combined Interest " is defined in Section 11.3(a).

              " Commences Commercial Service " means the date a Capital Improvement is first put into or commences commercial service by a Group Member following, if applicable, completion of construction, acquisition, development or testing, as applicable.

              " Commission " means the United States Securities and Exchange Commission.

              " Common Unit " means a Partnership Interest having the rights and obligations specified with respect to Common Units in this Agreement. The term "Common Unit" does not refer to or include any Subordinated Unit prior to its conversion into a Common Unit pursuant to the terms hereof.

              " Common Unit Arrearage " means, with respect to any Common Unit, whenever issued, with respect to any Quarter wholly within the Subordination Period, the excess, if any, of (a) the Minimum Quarterly Distribution with respect to a Common Unit in respect of such Quarter over (b) the sum of all Available Cash distributed with respect to a Common Unit in respect of such Quarter pursuant to Section 6.4(a)(i).

              " Conflicts Committee " means a committee of the Board of Directors composed entirely of one or more directors, each of whom (a) is not an officer or employee of the General Partner (b) is not an officer or employee of any Affiliate of the General Partner or a director of any Affiliate of the General Partner (other than any Group Member), (c) is not a holder of any ownership interest in the General Partner or any of its Affiliates, including any Group Member, other than Common Units and awards that are granted to such director under the LTIP; provided that a director that is a member of the Conflicts Committee may beneficially own publicly traded common stock of Susser Holdings

A-5


Table of Contents

Corporation with an aggregate value of up to one percent (1%) of such directors net worth as of the date of determination, and (d) is determined by the Board of Directors of the General Partner to be independent under the independence standards required for directors who serve on an audit committee of a board of directors established by the Securities Exchange Act and the rules and regulations of the Commission thereunder and by the National Securities Exchange on which any class of Partnership Interests is listed or admitted to trading.

              " Contributed Property " means each property or asset, in such form as may be permitted by the Delaware Act, but excluding cash, contributed to the Partnership. Once the Carrying Value of a Contributed Property is adjusted pursuant to Section 5.5(d), such property shall no longer constitute a Contributed Property, but shall be deemed an Adjusted Property.

              " Contribution Agreement " means that certain Contribution, Conveyance and Assumption Agreement, dated as of                        , 2012, among the General Partner, the Partnership, SHC and certain other parties, together with the additional conveyance documents and instruments contemplated or referenced thereunder, as such may be amended, supplemented or restated from time to time.

              " Cumulative Common Unit Arrearage " means, with respect to any Common Unit, whenever issued, and as of the end of any Quarter, the excess, if any, of (a) the sum of the Common Unit Arrearages with respect to an Initial Common Unit for each of the Quarters wholly within the Subordination Period ending on or before the last day of such Quarter over (b) the sum of any distributions theretofore made pursuant to Section 6.4(a)(ii) and the second sentence of Section 6.5 with respect to an Initial Common Unit (including any distributions to be made in respect of the last of such Quarters).

              " Curative Allocation " means any allocation of an item of income, gain, deduction, loss or credit pursuant to the provisions of Section 6.1(d)(xi).

              " Current Market Price " means, in respect of any class of Limited Partner Interests, as of the date of determination, the average of the daily Closing Prices per Limited Partner Interest of such class for the 20 consecutive Trading Days immediately prior to such date.

              " Deferred Issuance and Distribution " means both (a) the issuance by the Partnership of a number of additional Common Units that is equal to the excess, if any, of (x)                                      over (y) the aggregate number, if any, of Common Units actually purchased by and issued to the Underwriters pursuant to the Over-Allotment Option on the Option Closing Date(s), and (b) distribution(s) of cash contributed by the Underwriters to the Partnership on or in connection with any Option Closing Date with respect to Common Units issued by the Partnership upon the applicable exercise of the Over-Allotment Option as described in Section 5.3(b), if any.

              " Delaware Act " means the Delaware Revised Uniform Limited Partnership Act, 6 Del C. Section 17-101, et seq., as amended, supplemented or restated from time to time, and any successor to such statute.

              " Departing General Partner " means a former General Partner from and after the effective date of any withdrawal or removal of such former General Partner pursuant to Section 11.1 or 11.2.

              " Derivative Instruments " means options, rights, warrants, appreciation rights, tracking, profit and phantom interests and other derivative instruments relating to, convertible into or exchangeable for Partnership Interests.

              " Disposed of Adjusted Property " is defined in Section 6.1(d)(xii)(B).

              " Economic Risk of Loss " has the meaning set forth in Treasury Regulation Section 1.752-2(a).

              " Eligibility Certificate " is defined in Section 4.8(b).

A-6


Table of Contents

              " Eligible Holder " means a Limited Partner whose (a) U.S. federal income tax status would not, in the determination of the General Partner, have the material adverse effect described in Section 4.9(a)(i) or Section 4.9(b) nationality, citizenship or other related status would not, in the determination of the General Partner, create a substantial risk of cancellation or forfeiture as described in Section 4.9(a)(ii).

              " Estimated Incremental Quarterly Tax Amount " is defined in Section 6.9.

              " Event of Withdrawal " is defined in Section 11.1(a).

              " Excess Additional Book Basis " is defined in the definition of Additional Book Basis Derivative Items.

              " Excess Distribution " is defined in Section 6.1(d)(iii)(A).

              " Excess Distribution Unit " is defined in Section 6.1(d)(iii)(A).

              " Expansion Capital Expenditures " means cash expenditures for Capital Improvements, and shall not include Maintenance Capital Expenditures or Investment Capital Expenditures. Expansion Capital Expenditures shall include interest (and related fees) on debt incurred to finance the construction of a Capital Improvement and paid in respect of the period beginning on the date that a Group Member enters into a binding obligation to commence construction of a Capital Improvement and ending on the earlier to occur of the date that such Capital Improvement Commences Commercial Service and the date that such Capital Improvement is abandoned or disposed of. Debt incurred to fund such construction period interest payments or to fund distributions in respect of equity issued (including incremental Incentive Distributions related thereto) to fund the construction of a Capital Improvement as described in clause (a)(iv) of the definition of Operating Surplus shall also be deemed to be debt incurred to finance the construction of a Capital Improvement. Where capital expenditures are made in part for Expansion Capital Expenditures and in part for other purposes, the General Partner shall determine the allocation between the amounts paid for each.

              " Final Subordinated Units " is defined in Section 6.1(d)(x)(A).

              " First Liquidation Target Amount " is defined in Section 6.1(c)(i)(D).

              " First Target Distribution " means $            per Unit per Quarter (or, with respect to periods of less than a full fiscal quarter, it means the product of such amount multiplied by a fraction of which the numerator is the number of days in such period, and the denominator is the total number of days in such fiscal quarter), subject to adjustment in accordance with Sections 5.11, 6.6 and Section 6.8.

              " Fully Diluted Weighted Average Basis " means, when calculating the number of Outstanding Units for any period, a basis that includes (1) the weighted average number of Units Outstanding during such period plus (2) all Partnership Interests and Derivative Instruments (a) that are convertible into or exercisable or exchangeable for Units or for which Units are issuable, each case that are senior to or pari passu with the Subordinated Units, (b) whose conversion, exercise or exchange price is less than the Current Market Price on the date of such calculation, (c) that may be converted into or exercised or exchanged for such Units prior to or during the Quarter immediately following the end of the period for which the calculation is being made without the satisfaction of any contingency beyond the control of the holder other than the payment of consideration and the compliance with administrative mechanics applicable to such conversion, exercise or exchange and (d) that were not converted into or exercised or exchanged for such Units during the period for which the calculation is being made; provided , however , that for purposes of determining the number of Outstanding Units on a Fully Diluted Weighted Average Basis when calculating whether the Subordination Period has ended or the Subordinated Units are entitled to convert into Common Units pursuant to Section 5.7, such Partnership Interests and Derivative Instruments shall be deemed to have been Outstanding Units only for the four Quarters that comprise the last four Quarters of the measurement period; provided , further ,

A-7


Table of Contents

that if consideration will be paid to any Group Member in connection with such conversion, exercise or exchange, the number of Units to be included in such calculation shall be that number equal to the difference between (i) the number of Units issuable upon such conversion, exercise or exchange and (ii) the number of Units that such consideration would purchase at the Current Market Price.

              " General Partner " means Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, and its successors and permitted assigns that are admitted to the Partnership as general partner of the Partnership, in their capacities as general partner of the Partnership (except as the context otherwise requires).

              " General Partner Interest " means the non-economic management interest of the General Partner in the Partnership (in its capacity as a general partner and without reference to any Limited Partner Interest held by it) and includes any and all rights, powers and benefits to which the General Partner is entitled as provided in this Agreement, together with all obligations of the General Partner to comply with the terms and provisions of this Agreement. The General Partner Interest does not include any rights to profits or losses or any rights to receive distributions from operations or upon the liquidation or winding-up of the Partnership.

              " Gross Liability Value " means, with respect to any Liability of the Partnership described in Treasury Regulation Section 1.752-7(b)(3)(i), the amount of cash that a willing assignor would pay to a willing assignee to assume such Liability in an arm's-length transaction.

              " Group " means two or more Persons that with or through any of their respective Affiliates or Associates have any contract, arrangement, understanding or relationship for the purpose of acquiring, holding, voting (except voting pursuant to a revocable proxy or consent given to such Person in response to a proxy or consent solicitation made to 10 or more Persons), exercising investment power or disposing of any Partnership Interests with any other Person that beneficially owns, or whose Affiliates or Associates beneficially own, directly or indirectly, Partnership Interests.

              " Group Member " means a member of the Partnership Group.

              " Group Member Agreement " means the partnership agreement of any Group Member, other than the Partnership, that is a limited or general partnership, the limited liability company agreement of any Group Member that is a limited liability company, the certificate of incorporation and bylaws or similar organizational documents of any Group Member that is a corporation, the joint venture agreement or similar governing document of any Group Member that is a joint venture and the governing or organizational or similar documents of any other Group Member that is a Person other than a limited or general partnership, limited liability company, corporation or joint venture, as such may be amended, supplemented or restated from time to time.

              " Hedge Contract " means any exchange, swap, forward, cap, floor, collar, option or other similar agreement or arrangement entered into for the purpose of reducing the exposure of the Partnership Group to fluctuations in commodities, financial instruments or other capital activity, in each case, other than for speculative purposes.

              " Holder " as used in Section 7.12, is defined in Section 7.12(a).

              " IDR Reset Common Unit " is defined in Section 5.11(a).

              " IDR Reset Election " is defined in Section 5.11(a).

              " Incentive Distribution Right " means a Limited Partner Interest having the rights and obligations specified with respect to Incentive Distribution Rights in this Agreement.

              " Incentive Distributions " means any amount of cash distributed to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights pursuant to Section 6.4.

A-8


Table of Contents

              " Incremental Income Taxes " is defined in Section 6.9.

              " Indemnified Persons " is defined in Section 7.12(c).

              " Indemnitee " means (a) any General Partner, (b) any Departing General Partner, (c) any Person who is or was an Affiliate of the General Partner or any Departing General Partner, (d) any Person who is or was a manager, managing member, general partner, director, officer, employee, agent, fiduciary or trustee of any Group Member, a General Partner, any Departing General Partner or any of their respective Affiliates, (e) any Person who is or was serving at the request of a General Partner, any Departing General Partner or any of their respective Affiliates as an officer, director, manager, managing member, general partner, employee, agent, fiduciary or trustee of another Person owing a fiduciary or similar duty to any Group Member; provided that a Person shall not be an Indemnitee by reason of providing, on a fee-for-services basis, trustee, fiduciary or custodial services, (f) any Person who controls a General Partner or Departing General Partner and (g) any Person the General Partner designates as an "Indemnitee" for purposes of this Agreement because such Person's service, status or relationship exposes such Person to potential claims, demands, actions, suits or proceedings relating to the Partnership Group's business and affairs.

              " Ineligible Holder " is defined in Section 4.8(c).

              " Initial Common Units " means the Common Units sold in the Initial Offering.

              " Initial Limited Partners " means SHC (with respect to the Common Units, Subordinated Units and Incentive Distribution Rights received by it pursuant to Section 5.2), Stripes LLC (with respect to the Common Units received by it pursuant to Section 5.2) and the Underwriters, in each case upon being admitted to the Partnership in accordance with Section 10.1.

              " Initial Offering " means the initial offering and sale of Common Units to the public, as described in the Registration Statement, including any offer and sale of Common Units pursuant to the exercise of the Over-Allotment Option.

              " Initial Unit Price " means (a) with respect to the Common Units and the Subordinated Units, the initial public offering price per Common Unit at which the Underwriters first offered the Common Units to the public for sale as set forth on the cover page of the prospectus included as part of the Registration Statement and first issued at or after the time the Registration Statement first became effective or (b) with respect to any other class or series of Units, the price per Unit at which such class or series of Units is initially sold by the Partnership, as determined by the General Partner, in each case adjusted as the General Partner determines to be appropriate to give effect to any distribution, subdivision or combination of Units.

              " Interim Capital Transactions " means the following transactions if they occur prior to the Liquidation Date: (a) borrowings, refinancings or refundings of indebtedness (other than Working Capital Borrowings and other than for items purchased on open account or for a deferred purchase price in the ordinary course of business) by any Group Member and sales of debt securities of any Group Member; (b) sales of equity interests of any Group Member (including the Common Units sold to the Underwriters pursuant to the Underwriting Agreement); (c) sales or other voluntary or involuntary dispositions of any assets of any Group Member other than (i) sales or other dispositions of inventory, accounts receivable and other assets in the ordinary course of business, and (ii) sales or other dispositions of assets as part of normal retirements or replacements and (d) Capital Contributions received by a Group Member.

              " Investment Capital Expenditures " means capital expenditures other than Maintenance Capital Expenditures and Expansion Capital Expenditures.

              " Liability " means any liability or obligation of any nature, whether accrued, contingent or otherwise.

A-9


Table of Contents

              " Limited Partner " means, unless the context otherwise requires, each Initial Limited Partner, each additional Person that becomes a Limited Partner pursuant to the terms of this Agreement and any Departing General Partner upon the change of its status from General Partner to Limited Partner pursuant to Section 11.3, in each case, in such Person's capacity as a limited partner of the Partnership.

              " Limited Partner Interest " means the ownership interest of a Limited Partner in the Partnership, which may be evidenced by Common Units, Subordinated Units, Incentive Distribution Rights or other Partnership Interests or a combination thereof or interest therein, and includes any and all benefits to which such Limited Partner is entitled as provided in this Agreement, together with all obligations of such Limited Partner to comply with the terms and provisions of this Agreement.

              " Liquidation Date " means (a) in the case of an event giving rise to the dissolution of the Partnership of the type described in clauses (a) and (b) of the first sentence of Section 12.2, the date on which the applicable time period during which the holders of Outstanding Units have the right to elect to continue the business of the Partnership has expired without such an election being made, and (b) in the case of any other event giving rise to the dissolution of the Partnership, the date on which such event occurs.

              " Liquidator " means one or more Persons selected pursuant to Section 12.3 to perform the functions described in Section 12.4 as liquidating trustee of the Partnership within the meaning of the Delaware Act.

              " LTIP " means the Long-Term Incentive Plan of the General Partner, as may be amended, or any equity compensation plan successor thereto.

              " Maintenance Capital Expenditures " means cash expenditures (including expenditures for the addition or improvement to or replacement of the capital assets owned by any Group Member or for the acquisition of existing, or the construction or development of new, capital assets) if such expenditures are made to maintain the long-term operating capacity or operating income of the Partnership Group.

              " Merger Agreement " is defined in Section 14.1.

              " Minimum Quarterly Distribution " means $            per Unit per Quarter (or with respect to periods of less than a full fiscal quarter, it means the product of such amount multiplied by a fraction of which the numerator is the number of days in such period and the denominator is the total number of days in such fiscal quarter), subject to adjustment in accordance with Sections 5.11, 6.6 and 6.8.

              " National Securities Exchange " means an exchange registered with the Commission under Section 6(a) of the Securities Exchange Act (or any successor to such Section) and any other securities exchange (whether or not registered with the Commission under Section 6(a) (or successor to such Section) of the Securities Exchange Act) that the General Partner shall designate as a National Securities Exchange for purposes of this Agreement.

              " Net Agreed Value " means, (a) in the case of any Contributed Property, the Agreed Value of such property reduced by any Liabilities either assumed by the Partnership upon such contribution or to which such property is subject when contributed and (b) in the case of any property distributed to a Partner by the Partnership, the Partnership's Carrying Value of such property (as adjusted pursuant to Section 5.5(d)(ii)) at the time such property is distributed, reduced by any Liabilities either assumed by such Partner upon such distribution or to which such property is subject at the time of distribution.

              " Net Income " means, for any taxable period, the excess, if any, of the Partnership's items of income and gain (other than those items taken into account in the computation of Net Termination Gain or Net Termination Loss) for such taxable period over the Partnership's items of loss and deduction (other than those items taken into account in the computation of Net Termination Gain or Net Termination Loss) for such taxable period. The items included in the calculation of Net Income

A-10


Table of Contents

shall be determined in accordance with Section 5.5 but shall not include any items specially allocated under Section 6.1(d); provided, that the determination of the items that have been specially allocated under Section 6.1(d) shall be made without regard to any reversal of such items under Section 6.1(d)(xii).

              " Net Loss " means, for any taxable period, the excess, if any, of the Partnership's items of loss and deduction (other than those items taken into account in the computation of Net Termination Gain or Net Termination Loss) for such taxable period over the Partnership's items of income and gain (other than those items taken into account in the computation of Net Termination Gain or Net Termination Loss) for such taxable period. The items included in the calculation of Net Loss shall be determined in accordance with Section 5.5 but shall not include any items specially allocated under Section 6.1(d); provided, that the determination of the items that have been specially allocated under Section 6.1(d) shall be made without regard to any reversal of such items under Section 6.1(d)(xii).

              " Net Positive Adjustments " means, with respect to any Partner, the excess, if any, of the total positive adjustments over the total negative adjustments made to the Capital Account of such Partner pursuant to Book-Up Events and Book-Down Events.

              " Net Termination Gain " means, for any taxable period, the sum, if positive, of all items of income, gain, loss or deduction (determined in accordance with Section 5.5) that are (a) recognized (i) after the Liquidation Date or (ii) upon the sale, exchange or other disposition of all or substantially all of the assets of the Partnership Group, taken as a whole, in a single transaction or a series of related transactions (excluding any disposition to a member of the Partnership Group), or (b) deemed recognized by the Partnership pursuant to Section 5.5(d); provided , however , the items included in the determination of Net Termination Gain shall not include any items of income, gain or loss specially allocated under Section 6.1(d).

              " Net Termination Loss " means, for any taxable period, the sum, if negative, of all items of income, gain, loss or deduction (determined in accordance with Section 5.5) that are (a) recognized (i) after the Liquidation Date or (ii) upon the sale, exchange or other disposition of all or substantially all of the assets of the Partnership Group, taken as a whole, in a single transaction or a series of related transactions (excluding any disposition to a member of the Partnership Group), or (b) deemed recognized by the Partnership pursuant to Section 5.5(d); provided , however , items included in the determination of Net Termination Loss shall not include any items of income, gain or loss specially allocated under Section 6.1(d).

              " Nonrecourse Built-in Gain " means with respect to any Contributed Properties or Adjusted Properties that are subject to a mortgage or pledge securing a Nonrecourse Liability, the amount of any taxable gain that would be allocated to the Partners pursuant to Section 6.2(b) if such properties were disposed of in a taxable transaction in full satisfaction of such liabilities and for no other consideration.

              " Nonrecourse Deductions " means any and all items of loss, deduction or expenditure (including any expenditure described in Section 705(a)(2)(B) of the Code) that, in accordance with the principles of Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-2(b), are attributable to a Nonrecourse Liability.

              " Nonrecourse Liability " has the meaning set forth in Treasury Regulation Section 1.752-1(a)(2).

              " Notice of Election to Purchase " is defined in Section 15.1(b).

              " Omnibus Agreement " means that certain Omnibus Agreement dated                        , 2012, among SHC, the General Partner and the Partnership, as such agreement may be amended, supplemented or restated from time to time.

              " Operating Expenditures " means all Partnership Group cash expenditures (or the Partnership's proportionate share of expenditures in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned), including

A-11


Table of Contents

taxes, reimbursements of expenses of the General Partner and its Affiliates, payments made in the ordinary course of business under any Hedge Contracts, officer compensation, repayment of Working Capital Borrowings, debt service payments and capital expenditures, subject to the following:

              (a)   repayments of Working Capital Borrowings deducted from Operating Surplus pursuant to clause (b)(iii) of the definition of "Operating Surplus" shall not constitute Operating Expenditures when actually repaid;

              (b)   payments (including prepayments and prepayment penalties) of principal of and premium on indebtedness other than Working Capital Borrowings shall not constitute Operating Expenditures;

              (c)   Operating Expenditures shall not include (i) Expansion Capital Expenditures, (ii) Investment Capital Expenditures, (iii) payment of transaction expenses (including taxes) relating to Interim Capital Transactions, (iv) distributions to Partners, or (v) repurchases of Partnership Interests, other than repurchases of Partnership Interests to satisfy obligations under employee benefit plans, or reimbursements of expenses of the General Partner for such purchases. Where capital expenditures are made in part for Maintenance Capital Expenditures and in part for other purposes, the General Partner shall determine the allocation between the amounts paid for each; and

              (d)   (i) payments made in connection with the initial purchase of any Hedge Contract shall be amortized over the life of such Hedge Contract and (ii) payments made in connection with the termination of any Hedge Contract prior to its stipulated settlement or termination date shall be included in equal quarterly installments over what would have been the remaining scheduled term of such Hedge Contract had it not been so terminated.

              " Operating Surplus " means, with respect to any period ending prior to the Liquidation Date, on a cumulative basis and without duplication,

              (a)   the sum of (i) $             million, (ii) all cash receipts of the Partnership Group (or the Partnership's proportionate share of cash receipts in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) for the period beginning on the Closing Date and ending on the last day of such period, but excluding cash receipts from Interim Capital Transactions and provided that cash receipts from the termination of any Hedge Contract prior to its stipulated settlement or termination date shall be included in equal quarterly installments over what would have been the remaining scheduled life of such Hedge Contract had it not been so terminated, (iii) all cash receipts of the Partnership Group (or the Partnership's proportionate share of cash receipts in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) after the end of such period but on or before the date of determination of Operating Surplus with respect to such period resulting from Working Capital Borrowings, and (iv) the amount of cash distributions paid (including incremental Incentive Distributions) in respect of equity issued, other than equity issued in the Initial Offering, to finance all or a portion of the construction, acquisition or improvement of a Capital Improvement and paid in respect of the period beginning on the date that the Group Member enters into a binding obligation to commence the construction, acquisition or improvement of a Capital Improvement and ending on the earlier to occur of the date that such Capital Improvement or replacement capital asset Commences Commercial Service and the date that it is abandoned or disposed of (equity issued, other than equity issued in the Initial Offering, to fund the construction period interest payments on debt incurred, or construction period distributions on equity issued, to finance the construction, acquisition or improvement of a Capital Improvement shall also be deemed to be equity issued to finance the construction, acquisition or improvement of a Capital Improvement for purposes of this clause (iv)), less

              (b)   the sum of (i) Operating Expenditures for the period beginning on the Closing Date and ending on the last day of such period; (ii) the amount of cash reserves established by the General Partner (or the Partnership's proportionate share of cash reserves in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) to provide funds for future Operating Expenditures; (iii) all Working Capital

A-12


Table of Contents

Borrowings not repaid within twelve (12) months after having been incurred and (iv) any cash loss realized on disposition of an Investment Capital Expenditure;

provided, however , that the disbursements made (including contributions to a Group Member or disbursements on behalf of a Group Member), cash received or cash reserves established, increased or reduced after the end of such period but on or before the date of determination of Available Cash with respect to such period shall be deemed to have been made, received, established, increased or reduced, for purposes of determining Operating Surplus, within such period if the General Partner so determines.

              Notwithstanding the foregoing, " Operating Surplus " with respect to the Quarter in which the Liquidation Date occurs and any subsequent Quarter shall equal zero. Cash receipts from an Investment Capital Expenditure shall be treated as cash receipts only to the extent they are a return on principal, but in no event shall a return of principal be treated as cash receipts.

              " Opinion of Counsel " means a written opinion of counsel (who may be regular counsel to the Partnership or the General Partner or any of its Affiliates) acceptable to the General Partner.

              " Option Closing Date " means the date or dates on which any Common Units are sold by the Partnership to the Underwriters upon exercise of the Over-Allotment Option.

              " Organizational Limited Partner " means SHC, in its capacity as the organizational limited partner of the Partnership pursuant to this Agreement.

              " Outstanding " means, with respect to Partnership Interests, all Partnership Interests that are issued by the Partnership and reflected as outstanding on the Partnership's books and records as of the date of determination; provided , however , that if at any time any Person or Group (other than the General Partner or its Affiliates) beneficially owns 20% or more of the Outstanding Partnership Interests of any class then Outstanding, none of the Partnership Interests owned by such Person or Group shall be entitled to be voted on any matter or be considered to be Outstanding when sending notices of a meeting of Limited Partners to vote on any matter (unless otherwise required by law), calculating required votes, determining the presence of a quorum or for other similar purposes under this Agreement, except that Partnership Interests so owned shall be considered to be Outstanding for purposes of Section 11.1(b) (such Partnership Interests shall not, however, be treated as a separate class of Partnership Interests for purposes of this Agreement or the Delaware Act); provided , further , that the foregoing limitation shall not apply to (i) any Person or Group who acquired 20% or more of the Outstanding Partnership Interests of any class then Outstanding directly from the General Partner or its Affiliates (other than the Partnership), (ii) any Person or Group who acquired 20% or more of the Outstanding Partnership Interests of any class then Outstanding directly or indirectly from a Person or Group described in clause (i) provided that the General Partner shall have notified such Person or Group in writing that such limitation shall not apply, or (iii) any Person or Group who acquired 20% or more of any Partnership Interests issued by the Partnership provided that the General Partner shall have notified such Person or Group in writing that such limitation shall not apply.

              " Over-Allotment Option " means the over-allotment option granted to the Underwriters by the Partnership pursuant to the Underwriting Agreement.

              " Partner Nonrecourse Debt " has the meaning set forth in Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-2(b)(4).

              " Partner Nonrecourse Debt Minimum Gain " has the meaning set forth in Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-2(i)(2).

              " Partner Nonrecourse Deductions " means any and all items of loss, deduction or expenditure (including any expenditure described in Section 705(a)(2)(B) of the Code) that, in accordance with the principles of Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-2(i), are attributable to a Partner Nonrecourse Debt.

A-13


Table of Contents

              " Partners " means the General Partner and the Limited Partners.

              " Partnership " means Susser Petroleum Partners LP, a Delaware limited partnership.

              " Partnership Group " means, collectively, the Partnership and its Subsidiaries.

              " Partnership Interest " means any class or series of equity interest in the Partnership, which shall include any General Partner Interest and Limited Partner Interests, but shall exclude Derivative Instruments.

              " Partnership Minimum Gain " means that amount determined in accordance with the principles of Treasury Regulation Sections 1.704-2(b)(2) and 1.704-2(d).

              " Percentage Interest " means as of any date of determination (a) as to any Unitholder with respect to Units, the quotient obtained by dividing (A) the number of Units held by such Unitholder by (B) the total number of Outstanding Units. The Percentage Interest with respect to an Incentive Distribution Right shall be zero. The Percentage Interest with respect to the General Partner Interest shall at all times be zero.

              " Person " means an individual or a corporation, firm, limited liability company, partnership, joint venture, trust, unincorporated organization, association, government agency or political subdivision thereof or other entity.

              " Per Unit Capital Amount " means, as of any date of determination, the Capital Account, stated on a per Unit basis, underlying any class of Units held by a Person other than the General Partner or any Affiliate of the General Partner who holds Units.

              " Permitted Actions " means the following arrangements with, actions taken by, or determinations made by, the General Partner:

              (a)   The General Partner's agreement with SHC on the reasonable allocation and other procedures to effect the reimbursement of all direct and indirect costs and expenses incurred by SHC or its Affiliates in connection with the provision of services to the Partnership Group under the terms of the Omnibus Agreement; and

              (b)   the exercise of the Partnership's Sale and Leaseback Option.

              " Potential SHC Financial Support " means the provision by SHC or any of its Affiliates to any member of the Partnership Group of any guaranties or trade credit support to support the ongoing operations of the Partnership Group contemplated by Section            of the Omnibus Agreement; provided , that (i) the pricing of any such guaranties or trade credit support is no more than the cost to the Partnership of issuing a comparable letter of credit under its Credit Agreement and (ii) any such guaranties or trade credit support are limited to ordinary course obligations of members of the Partnership Group and do not extend to indebtedness for borrowed money or other obligations that could be characterized as debt.

              " Pro Rata " means (a) when used with respect to Units or any class thereof, apportioned equally among all designated Units in accordance with their relative Percentage Interests, (b) when used with respect to Partners or Record Holders, apportioned among all Partners or Record Holders in accordance with their relative Percentage Interests and (c) when used with respect to holders of Incentive Distribution Rights, apportioned equally among all holders of Incentive Distribution Rights in accordance with the relative number or percentage of Incentive Distribution Rights held by each such holder.

              " Purchase Date " means the date determined by the General Partner as the date for purchase of all Outstanding Limited Partner Interests of a certain class (other than Limited Partner Interests owned by the General Partner and its Affiliates) pursuant to Article XV.

A-14


Table of Contents

              " Quarter " means, unless the context requires otherwise, a fiscal quarter of the Partnership, or, with respect to the fiscal quarter of the Partnership in which the Closing Date occurs, the portion of such fiscal quarter after the Closing Date.

              " Rate Eligibility Trigger " is defined in Section 4.8(a)(i).

              " Recapture Income " means any gain recognized by the Partnership (computed without regard to any adjustment required by Section 734 or Section 743 of the Code) upon the disposition of any property or asset of the Partnership, which gain is characterized as ordinary income because it represents the recapture of deductions previously taken with respect to such property or asset.

              " Record Date " means the date established by the General Partner or otherwise in accordance with this Agreement for determining (a) the identity of the Record Holders entitled to notice of, or to vote at, any meeting of Limited Partners or entitled to vote by ballot or give approval of Partnership action in writing without a meeting or entitled to exercise rights in respect of any lawful action of Limited Partners or (b) the identity of Record Holders entitled to receive any report or distribution or to participate in any offer.

              " Record Holder " means (a) with respect to any class of Partnership Interests for which a Transfer Agent has been appointed, the Person in whose name a Partnership Interest of such class is registered on the books of the Transfer Agent as of the closing of business on a particular Business Day, or (b) with respect to other classes of Partnership Interests, the Person in whose name any such other Partnership Interest is registered on the books that the General Partner has caused to be kept as of the closing of business on such Business Day.

              " Redeemable Interests " means any Partnership Interests for which a redemption notice has been given, and has not been withdrawn, pursuant to Section 4.9(a).

              " Registration Statement " means the Registration Statement on Form S-1 (Registration No. 333-182276) as it has been or as it may be amended or supplemented from time to time, filed by the Partnership with the Commission under the Securities Act to register the offering and sale of the Common Units in the Initial Offering.

              " Remaining Net Positive Adjustments " means as of the end of any taxable period, (i) with respect to the Unitholders holding Common Units or Subordinated Units, the excess of (a) the Net Positive Adjustments of the Unitholders holding Common Units or Subordinated Units as of the end of such period over (b) the sum of those Partners' Share of Additional Book Basis Derivative Items for each prior taxable period and (ii) with respect to the holders of Incentive Distribution Rights, the excess of (a) the Net Positive Adjustments of the holders of Incentive Distribution Rights as of the end of such period over (b) the sum of the Share of Additional Book Basis Derivative Items of the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights for each prior taxable period.

              " Required Allocations " means any allocation of an item of income, gain, loss or deduction pursuant to Section 6.1 (d)(i), Section 6.1(d)(ii), Section 6.1(d)(iv), Section 6.1(d)(v), Section 6.1(d)(vi), Section 6.1(d)(vii) or Section 6.1(d)(ix).

              " Reset MQD " is defined in Section 5.11(a).

              " Reset Notice " is defined in Section 5.11(b).

              " SHC " means Susser Holdings Corporation, a Delaware corporation.

              " Sale and Leaseback Option " has the meaning set forth in the Omnibus Agreement.

A-15


Table of Contents

              " Second Liquidation Target Amount " is defined in Section 6.1(c)(i)(E).

              " Second Target Distribution " means $            per Unit per Quarter (or, with respect to periods of less than a full fiscal quarter, it means the product of such amount multiplied by a fraction of which the numerator is the number of days in such period, and the denominator is the total number of days in such fiscal quarter), subject to adjustment in accordance with Section 5.11, Section 6.6 and Section 6.8.

              " Securities Act " means the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, supplemented or restated from time to time and any successor to such statute.

              " Securities Exchange Act " means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, supplemented or restated from time to time and any successor to such statute.

              " Share of Additional Book Basis Derivative Items " means in connection with any allocation of Additional Book Basis Derivative Items for any taxable period, (i) with respect to the Unitholders holding Common Units or Subordinated Units, the amount that bears the same ratio to such Additional Book Basis Derivative Items as the Unitholders' Remaining Net Positive Adjustments as of the end of such taxable period bears to the Aggregate Remaining Net Positive Adjustments as of that time and (ii) with respect to the Partners holding Incentive Distribution Rights, the amount that bears the same ratio to such Additional Book Basis Derivative Items as the Remaining Net Positive Adjustments of the Partners holding the Incentive Distribution Rights as of the end of such period bears to the Aggregate Remaining Net Positive Adjustments as of that time.

              " Special Approval " means approval by a majority of the members of the Conflicts Committee.

              " Subordinated Unit " means a Partnership Interest having the rights and obligations specified with respect to Subordinated Units in this Agreement. The term "Subordinated Unit" does not refer to or include a Common Unit. A Subordinated Unit that is convertible into a Common Unit shall not constitute a Common Unit until such conversion occurs.

              " Subordination Period " means the period commencing on the Closing Date and ending on the first to occur of the following dates:

              (a)   the first Business Day following the distribution of Available Cash to Partners pursuant to Section 6.3(a) in respect of any Quarter beginning with the Quarter ending [September 30], 2015 in respect of which (i) (A) distributions of Available Cash from Operating Surplus on each of the Outstanding Common Units and Subordinated Units and any other Outstanding Units that are senior or equal in right of distribution to the Subordinated Units, in each case with respect to each of the three consecutive, non-overlapping four-Quarter periods immediately preceding such date equaled or exceeded the sum of the Minimum Quarterly Distribution on all Outstanding Common Units and Subordinated Units and any other Outstanding Units that are senior or equal in right of distribution to the Subordinated Units, in each case in respect of such periods and (B) the Adjusted Operating Surplus for each of the three consecutive, non-overlapping four-Quarter periods immediately preceding such date equaled or exceeded the sum of the Minimum Quarterly Distribution on all of the Common Units, Subordinated Units and any other Units that are senior or equal in right of distribution to the Subordinated Units, in each case that were Outstanding during such periods on a Fully Diluted Weighted Average Basis, and (ii) there are no Cumulative Common Unit Arrearages;

              (b)   the first Business Day following the distribution of Available Cash to Partners pursuant to Section 6.3(a) in respect of any Quarter in respect of which (i) (A) distributions of Available Cash from Operating Surplus on each of the Outstanding Common Units and Subordinated Units and any other Outstanding Units that are senior or equal in right of distribution to the Subordinated Units, in each case with respect to the four-Quarter period immediately preceding such date equaled or exceeded 150% of the Minimum Quarterly Distribution on all of the Outstanding Common Units and

A-16


Table of Contents

Subordinated Units and any other Outstanding Units that are senior or equal in right of distribution to the Subordinated Units, in each case in respect of such period and (B) the Adjusted Operating Surplus for the four-Quarter period immediately preceding such date equaled or exceeded 150% of the sum of the Minimum Quarterly Distribution on all of the Common Units and Subordinated Units and any other Units that are senior or equal in right of distribution to the Subordinated Units, in each case that were Outstanding during such period on a Fully Diluted Weighted Average Basis and the corresponding Incentive Distributions and (ii) there are no Cumulative Common Unit Arrearages; and

              (c)   the first date on which there are no longer outstanding any Subordinated Units due to the conversion of Subordinated Units into Common Units pursuant to Section 5.7 or otherwise.

              " Subsidiary " means, with respect to any Person, (a) a corporation of which more than 50% of the voting power of shares entitled (without regard to the occurrence of any contingency) to vote in the election of directors or other governing body of such corporation is owned, directly or indirectly, at the date of determination, by such Person, by one or more Subsidiaries (as defined, but excluding subsection (d) of this definition) of such Person or a combination thereof, (b) a partnership (whether general or limited) in which such Person or a Subsidiary (as defined, but excluding subsection (d) of this definition) of such Person is, at the date of determination, a general partner of such partnership, but only if such Person, directly or by one or more Subsidiaries (as defined, but excluding subsection (d) of this definition) of such Person, or a combination thereof, controls such partnership at the date of determination, (c) any other Person in which such Person, one or more Subsidiaries (as defined, but excluding this subsection (d) of this definition) of such Person, or a combination thereof, directly or indirectly, at the date of determination, has (i) at least a majority ownership interest or (ii) the power to elect or direct the election of a majority of the directors or other governing body of such Person [or (d) any other Person in which such Person, one or more Subsidiaries (as defined, but excluding subsection (d) of this definition) of such Person, or a combination thereof, directly or indirectly, at the date of determination, has (i) less than a majority ownership interest or (ii) less than the power to elect or direct the election of a majority of the directors or other governing body of such Person, provided that (A) such Person, one or more Subsidiaries (as defined, but excluding this subsection (d) of this definition) of such Person, or a combination thereof, directly or indirectly, at the date of the determination, has at least a 20% ownership interest in such other Person, (B) such Person accounts for such other Person (under U.S. GAAP, as in effect on the later of the date of investment in such other Person or material expansion of the operations of such other Person) on a consolidated or equity accounting basis, (C) such Person has directly or indirectly material negative control rights regarding such other Person including over such other Person's ability to materially expand its operations beyond that contemplated at the date of investment in such other Person, and (D) such other Person is obligated under its constituent documents, or as a result of a unanimous agreement of its owners, to distribute to its owners all of its income on at least an annual basis (less any cash reserves that are approved by such Person).]

              " Surviving Business Entity " is defined in Section 14.2(b)(ii).

              " Target Distribution " means each of the Minimum Quarterly Distribution, the First Target Distribution, Second Target Distribution and Third Target Distribution.

              " Third Target Distribution " means $            per Unit per Quarter (or, with respect to periods of less than a full fiscal quarter, it means the product of such amount multiplied by a fraction of which the numerator is the number of days in such period, and the denominator is the total number of days in such fiscal quarter), subject to adjustment in accordance with Sections 5.11, 6.6 and Section 6.8.

              " Trading Day " means, for the purpose of determining the Current Market Price of any class of Limited Partner Interests, a day on which the principal National Securities Exchange on which such class of Limited Partner Interests is listed or admitted to trading is open for the transaction of business

A-17


Table of Contents

or, if Limited Partner Interests of a class are not listed or admitted to trading on any National Securities Exchange, a day on which banking institutions in New York City generally are open.

              " transfer " is defined in Section 4.4(a).

              " Transfer Agent " means such bank, trust company or other Person (including the General Partner or one of its Affiliates) as may be appointed from time to time by the Partnership to act as registrar and transfer agent for any class of Partnership Interests; provided , that if no Transfer Agent is specifically designated for any class of Partnership Interests, the General Partner shall act in such capacity.

              " Underwriter " means each Person named as an underwriter in Schedule I to the Underwriting Agreement who purchases Common Units pursuant thereto.

              " Underwriting Agreement " means that certain Underwriting Agreement, dated as of                        , 2012, among the Underwriters, the Partnership, the General Partner, [SHC] and the other parties thereto, providing for the purchase of Common Units by the Underwriters.

              " Unit " means a Partnership Interest that is designated as a "Unit" and shall include Common Units and Subordinated Units but shall not include (i) the General Partner Interest or (ii) Incentive Distribution Rights.

              " Unitholders " means the holders of Units.

              " Unit Majority " means (i) during the Subordination Period, at least a majority of the Outstanding Common Units (excluding Common Units owned by the General Partner and its Affiliates), voting as a class, and at least a majority of the Outstanding Subordinated Units, voting as a class, and (ii) after the end of the Subordination Period, at least a majority of the Outstanding Common Units.

              " Unpaid MQD " is defined in Section 6.1(c)(i)(B).

              " Unrealized Gain " attributable to any item of Partnership property means, as of any date of determination, the excess, if any, of (a) the fair market value of such property as of such date (as determined under Section 5.5(d)) over (b) the Carrying Value of such property as of such date (prior to any adjustment to be made pursuant to Section 5.5(d) as of such date).

              " Unrealized Loss " attributable to any item of Partnership property means, as of any date of determination, the excess, if any, of (a) the Carrying Value of such property as of such date (prior to any adjustment to be made pursuant to Section 5.5(d) as of such date) over (b) the fair market value of such property as of such date (as determined under Section 5.5(d)).

              " Unrecovered Initial Unit Price " means at any time, with respect to a Unit, the Initial Unit Price less the sum of all distributions constituting Capital Surplus theretofore made in respect of an Initial Common Unit and any distributions of cash (or the Net Agreed Value of any distributions in kind) in connection with the dissolution and liquidation of the Partnership theretofore made in respect of an Initial Common Unit, adjusted as the General Partner determines to be appropriate to give effect to any distribution, subdivision, or combination of such Units.

              " Unrestricted Person " means (a) each Indemnitee, (b) each Partner, (c) each Person who is or was a member, partner, director, officer, employee or agent of any Group Member, a General Partner or any Departing General Partner or any Affiliate of any Group Member, a General Partner or any Departing General Partner and (d) any Person the General Partner designates as an "Unrestricted Person" for purposes of this Agreement.

              " U.S. GAAP " means United States generally accepted accounting principles, as in effect from time to time, consistently applied.

A-18


Table of Contents

              " Withdrawal Opinion of Counsel " is defined in Section 11.1(b).

              " Working Capital Borrowings " means borrowings used solely for working capital purposes or to pay distributions to Partners, made pursuant to a credit facility, commercial paper facility or other similar financing arrangement; provided that when incurred it is the intent of the borrower to repay such borrowings within 12 months from sources other than additional Working Capital Borrowings.

              Section 1.2     Construction.     Unless the context requires otherwise: (a) any pronoun used in this Agreement shall include the corresponding masculine, feminine or neuter forms; (b) references to Articles and Sections refer to Articles and Sections of this Agreement; (c) the terms "include", "includes", "including" and words of like import shall be deemed to be followed by the words "without limitation"; and (d) the terms "hereof", "herein" and "hereunder" refer to this Agreement as a whole and not to any particular provision of this Agreement. The table of contents and headings contained in this Agreement are for reference purposes only, and shall not affect in any way the meaning or interpretation of this Agreement.

ARTICLE II

ORGANIZATION

              Section 2.1     Formation.     The General Partner and the Organizational Limited Partner have previously formed the Partnership as a limited partnership pursuant to the provisions of the Delaware Act. This amendment and restatement shall become effective on the date of this Agreement. Except as expressly provided to the contrary in this Agreement, the rights, duties (including fiduciary duties), liabilities and obligations of the Partners and the administration, dissolution and termination of the Partnership shall be governed by the Delaware Act.

              Section 2.2     Name.     The name of the Partnership shall be "Susser Petroleum Partners LP". The Partnership's business may be conducted under any other name or names as determined by the General Partner, including the name of the General Partner. The words "Limited Partnership," "L.P.," "Ltd." or similar words or letters shall be included in the Partnership's name where necessary for the purpose of complying with the laws of any jurisdiction that so requires. The General Partner may change the name of the Partnership at any time and from time to time and shall notify the Limited Partners of such change in the next regular communication to the Limited Partners.

              Section 2.3     Registered Office; Registered Agent; Principal Office; Other Offices.     Unless and until changed by the General Partner, the registered office of the Partnership in the State of Delaware shall be located at Corporation Trust Center, 1209 Orange Street, Wilmington, Delaware 19801, and the registered agent for service of process on the Partnership in the State of Delaware at such registered office shall be Corporation Trust Company. The principal office of the Partnership shall be located at 555 East Airtex Drive, Houston, TX 77073, or such other place as the General Partner may from time to time designate by notice to the Limited Partners. The Partnership may maintain offices at such other place or places within or outside the State of Delaware as the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate. The address of the General Partner shall be 555 East Airtex Drive, Houston, TX 77073, or such other place as the General Partner may from time to time designate by notice to the Limited Partners.

              Section 2.4     Purpose and Business.     The purpose and nature of the business to be conducted by the Partnership shall be to (a) engage directly in, or enter into or form, hold and dispose of any corporation, partnership, joint venture, limited liability company or other arrangement to engage indirectly in, any business activity that is approved by the General Partner, in its sole discretion, and that lawfully may be conducted by a limited partnership organized pursuant to the Delaware Act and, in connection therewith, to exercise all of the rights and powers conferred upon the Partnership pursuant to the agreements relating to such business activity, and (b) do anything necessary or

A-19


Table of Contents

appropriate to the foregoing, including the making of capital contributions or loans to a Group Member; provided, however , that the General Partner shall not cause the Partnership to engage, directly or indirectly, in any business activity that the General Partner determines would be reasonably likely to cause the Partnership to be treated as an association taxable as a corporation or otherwise taxable as an entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes. To the fullest extent permitted by law, the General Partner shall have no duty or obligation to propose or approve, and may, in its sole discretion, decline to propose or approve, the conduct by the Partnership of any business.

              Section 2.5     Powers.     The Partnership shall be empowered to do any and all acts and things necessary, appropriate, proper, advisable, incidental to or convenient for the furtherance and accomplishment of the purposes and business described in Section 2.4 and for the protection and benefit of the Partnership.

              Section 2.6     Term.     The term of the Partnership commenced upon the filing of the Certificate of Limited Partnership in accordance with the Delaware Act and shall continue in existence until the dissolution of the Partnership in accordance with the provisions of Article XII. The existence of the Partnership as a separate legal entity shall continue until the cancellation of the Certificate of Limited Partnership as provided in the Delaware Act.

              Section 2.7     Title to Partnership Assets.     Title to Partnership assets, whether real, personal or mixed and whether tangible or intangible, shall be deemed to be owned by the Partnership as an entity, and no Partner, individually or collectively, shall have any ownership interest in such Partnership assets or any portion thereof. Title to any or all of the Partnership assets may be held in the name of the Partnership, the General Partner, one or more of its Affiliates or one or more nominees, as the General Partner may determine. The General Partner hereby declares and warrants that any Partnership assets for which record title is held in the name of the General Partner or one or more of its Affiliates or one or more nominees shall be held by the General Partner or such Affiliate or nominee for the use and benefit of the Partnership in accordance with the provisions of this Agreement; provided, however , that the General Partner shall use reasonable efforts to cause record title to such assets (other than those assets in respect of which the General Partner determines that the expense and difficulty of conveyancing makes transfer of record title to the Partnership impracticable) to be vested in the Partnership or one or more of the Partnership's designated Affiliates as soon as reasonably practicable; provided , further , that, prior to the withdrawal or removal of the General Partner or as soon thereafter as practicable, the General Partner shall use reasonable efforts to effect the transfer of record title to the Partnership and, prior to any such transfer, will provide for the use of such assets in a manner satisfactory to the General Partner. All Partnership assets shall be recorded as the property of the Partnership in its books and records, irrespective of the name in which record title to such Partnership assets is held.

ARTICLE III

RIGHTS OF LIMITED PARTNERS

              Section 3.1     Limitation of Liability.     The Limited Partners shall have no liability under this Agreement except as expressly provided in this Agreement or the Delaware Act.

              Section 3.2     Management of Business.     No Limited Partner, in its capacity as such, shall participate in the operation, management or control (within the meaning of the Delaware Act) of the Partnership's business, transact any business in the Partnership's name or have the power to sign documents for or otherwise bind the Partnership. All actions taken by any Affiliate of the General Partner or any officer, director, employee, manager, member, general partner, agent or trustee of the General Partner or any of its Affiliates, or any officer, director, employee, manager, member, general partner, agent or trustee of a Group Member, in its capacity as such, shall not be deemed to be participating in the control of the business of the Partnership by a limited partner of the Partnership

A-20


Table of Contents

(within the meaning of Section 17-303(a) of the Delaware Act) and shall not affect, impair or eliminate the limitations on the liability of the Limited Partners under this Agreement.

              Section 3.3     Outside Activities of the Limited Partners.     Subject to the provisions of Section 7.6, which shall continue to be applicable to the Persons referred to therein, regardless of whether such Persons shall also be Limited Partners, each Limited Partner shall be entitled to and may have business interests and engage in business activities in addition to those relating to the Partnership, including business interests and activities in direct competition with the Partnership Group. Neither the Partnership nor any of the other Partners shall have any rights by virtue of this Agreement in any business ventures of any Limited Partner.

              Section 3.4     Rights of Limited Partners.     

              (a)   Each Limited Partner shall have the right, for a purpose that is reasonably related, as determined by the General Partner, to such Limited Partner's interest as a Limited Partner in the Partnership, upon reasonable written demand stating the purpose of such demand and at such Limited Partner's own expense, to obtain:

                             (i)  true and full information regarding the status of the business and financial condition of the Partnership (provided that the requirements of this Section 3.4(a)(i) shall be satisfied if the Limited Partner is furnished the Partnership's most recent annual report and any subsequent periodic reports required to be filed (or which would be required to be filed) with the Commission pursuant to Section 13 of the Exchange Act);

                            (ii)  a current list of the name and last known business, residence or mailing address of each Record Holder; and

                          (iii)  a copy of this Agreement and the Certificate of Limited Partnership and all amendments thereto, together with copies of the executed copies of all powers of attorney pursuant to which this Agreement, the Certificate of Limited Partnership and all amendments thereto have been executed.

              (b)   The rights to information granted to each of the Limited Partners pursuant to Section 3.4(a) replace in their entirety any rights to information provided for in Section 17-305(a) of the Delaware Act and each of the Partners and each other Person or Group who acquires an interest in Partnership Interests hereby agrees to the fullest extent permitted by law that they do not have any rights as Partners to receive any information either pursuant to Sections 17-305(a) of the Delaware Act or otherwise except for the information identified in Section 3.4(a).

              (c)   The General Partner may keep confidential from the Limited Partners, for such period of time as the General Partner deems reasonable, (i) any information that the General Partner reasonably believes to be in the nature of trade secrets or (ii) other information the disclosure of which the General Partner believes (A) is not in the best interests of the Partnership Group, (B) could damage the Partnership Group or its business or (C) that any Group Member is required by law or by agreement with any third party to keep confidential (other than agreements with Affiliates of the Partnership the primary purpose of which is to circumvent the obligations set forth in this Section 3.4).

              (d)   Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement or Section 17-305 of the Delaware Act, each of the Partners, each other Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest and each other Person bound by this Agreement hereby agrees to the fullest extent permitted by law that they do not have rights to receive information from the Partnership or any Indemnitee for the purpose of determining whether to pursue litigation or assist in pending litigation against the Partnership or any Indemnitee relating to the affairs of the Partnership except pursuant to the applicable rules of discovery relating to litigation commenced by such Person.

A-21


Table of Contents

ARTICLE IV

CERTIFICATES; RECORD HOLDERS; TRANSFER OF PARTNERSHIP INTERESTS; REDEMPTION OF PARTNERSHIP INTERESTS

              Section 4.1     Certificates.     Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, unless the General Partner shall determine otherwise in respect of some or all of any or all classes of Partnership Interests, Partnership Interests shall not be evidenced by certificates. Certificates that may be issued shall be executed on behalf of the Partnership by the Chairman of the Board, President, the Chief Executive Officer or any Senior Vice President or Vice President and the Chief Financial Officer or the Secretary or any Assistant Secretary of the General Partner. No Certificate for a class of Partnership Interests shall be valid for any purpose until it has been countersigned by the Transfer Agent for such class of Partnership Interests; provided, however , that if the General Partner elects to cause the Partnership to issue Partnership Interests of such class in global form, the Certificate shall be valid upon receipt of a certificate from the Transfer Agent certifying that the Partnership Interests have been duly registered in accordance with the directions of the Partnership. Subject to the requirements of Section 6.7(c), if Common Units are evidenced by Certificates, on or after the date on which Subordinated Units are converted into Common Units pursuant to the terms of Section 5.7, the Record Holders of such Subordinated Units (i) if the Subordinated Units are evidenced by Certificates, may exchange such Certificates for Certificates evidencing Common Units or (ii) if the Subordinated Units are not evidenced by Certificates, shall be issued Certificates evidencing Common Units.

              Section 4.2     Mutilated, Destroyed, Lost or Stolen Certificates.     

              (a)   If any mutilated Certificate is surrendered to the Transfer Agent, the appropriate officers of the General Partner on behalf of the Partnership shall execute, and the Transfer Agent shall countersign and deliver in exchange therefor, a new Certificate evidencing the same number and type of Partnership Interests as the Certificate so surrendered.

              (b)   The appropriate officers of the General Partner on behalf of the Partnership shall execute and deliver, and the Transfer Agent shall countersign, a new Certificate in place of any Certificate previously issued, if the Record Holder of the Certificate:

                             (i)  makes proof by affidavit, in form and substance satisfactory to the General Partner, that a previously issued Certificate has been lost, destroyed or stolen;

                            (ii)  requests the issuance of a new Certificate before the General Partner has notice that the Certificate has been acquired by a purchaser for value in good faith and without notice of an adverse claim;

                          (iii)  if requested by the General Partner, delivers to the General Partner a bond, in form and substance satisfactory to the General Partner, with surety or sureties and with fixed or open penalty as the General Partner may direct to indemnify the Partnership, the Partners, the General Partner and the Transfer Agent against any claim that may be made on account of the alleged loss, destruction or theft of the Certificate; and

                           (iv)  satisfies any other reasonable requirements imposed by the General Partner or the Transfer Agent.

              If a Limited Partner fails to notify the General Partner within a reasonable period of time after such Limited Partner has notice of the loss, destruction or theft of a Certificate, and a transfer of the Limited Partner Interests represented by the Certificate is registered before the Partnership, the General Partner or the Transfer Agent receives such notification, the Limited Partner shall be precluded from making any claim against the Partnership, the General Partner or the Transfer Agent for such transfer or for a new Certificate.

A-22


Table of Contents

              (c)   As a condition to the issuance of any new Certificate under this Section 4.2, the General Partner may require the payment of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or other governmental charge that may be imposed in relation thereto and any other expenses (including the fees and expenses of the Transfer Agent) reasonably connected therewith.

              Section 4.3     Record Holders.     The Partnership shall be entitled to recognize the Record Holder as the Partner with respect to any Partnership Interest and, accordingly, shall not be bound to recognize any equitable or other claim to, or interest in, such Partnership Interest on the part of any other Person, regardless of whether the Partnership shall have actual or other notice thereof, except as otherwise provided by law or any applicable rule, regulation, guideline or requirement of any National Securities Exchange on which such Partnership Interests are listed or admitted to trading. Without limiting the foregoing, when a Person (such as a broker, dealer, bank, trust company or clearing corporation or an agent of any of the foregoing) is acting as nominee, agent or in some other representative capacity for another Person in acquiring and/or holding Partnership Interests, as between the Partnership on the one hand, and such other Persons on the other, such representative Person shall be (a) the Record Holder of such Partnership Interest and (b) bound by this Agreement and shall have the rights and obligations of a Partner hereunder as, and to the extent, provided herein.

              Section 4.4     Transfer Generally.     

              (a)   The term "transfer," when used in this Agreement with respect to a Partnership Interest, shall mean a transaction (i) by which the General Partner assigns its General Partner Interest to another Person, and includes a sale, assignment, gift, pledge, encumbrance, hypothecation, mortgage, exchange or any other disposition by law or otherwise or (ii) by which the holder of a Limited Partner Interest assigns such Limited Partner Interest to another Person who is or becomes a Limited Partner, and includes a sale, assignment, gift, exchange or any other disposition by law or otherwise, excluding a pledge, encumbrance, hypothecation or mortgage but including any transfer upon foreclosure of any pledge, encumbrance, hypothecation or mortgage.

              (b)   No Partnership Interest shall be transferred, in whole or in part, except in accordance with the terms and conditions set forth in this Article IV. Any transfer or purported transfer of a Partnership Interest not made in accordance with this Article IV shall be, to the fullest extent permitted by law, null and void.

              (c)   Nothing contained in this Agreement shall be construed to prevent a disposition by any stockholder, member, partner or other owner of any Partner of any or all of the shares of stock, membership interests, partnership interests or other ownership interests in such Partner and the term "transfer" shall not mean any such disposition.

              Section 4.5     Registration and Transfer of Limited Partner Interests.     

              (a)   The General Partner shall keep or cause to be kept on behalf of the Partnership a register in which, subject to such reasonable regulations as it may prescribe and subject to the provisions of Section 4.5(b), the Partnership will provide for the registration and transfer of Limited Partner Interests.

              (b)   The Partnership shall not recognize any transfer of Limited Partner Interests evidenced by Certificates until the Certificates evidencing such Limited Partner Interests are surrendered for registration of transfer. No charge shall be imposed by the General Partner for such transfer; provided , that as a condition to the issuance of any new Certificate under this Section 4.5, the General Partner may require the payment of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or other governmental charge that may be imposed with respect thereto. Upon surrender of a Certificate for registration of transfer of any Limited Partner Interests evidenced by a Certificate, and subject to the provisions hereof, the appropriate officers of the General Partner on behalf of the Partnership shall execute and deliver, and in the case of Certificates evidencing Limited Partner Interests, the Transfer Agent shall countersign

A-23


Table of Contents

and deliver, in the name of the holder or the designated transferee or transferees, as required pursuant to the holder's instructions, one or more new Certificates evidencing the same aggregate number and type of Limited Partner Interests as was evidenced by the Certificate so surrendered.

              (c)   By acceptance of the transfer of any Limited Partner Interests in accordance with this Section 4.5 and except as provided in Section 4.8, each transferee of a Limited Partner Interest (including any nominee holder or an agent or representative acquiring such Limited Partner Interests for the account of another Person) acknowledges and agrees to the provisions of Section 10.1(a).

              (d)   Subject to (i) the foregoing provisions of this Section 4.5, (ii) Section 4.3, (iii) Section 4.7, (iv) with respect to any class or series of Limited Partner Interests, the provisions of any statement of designations or an amendment to this Agreement establishing such class or series, (v) any contractual provisions binding on any Limited Partner and (vi) provisions of applicable law including the Securities Act, Limited Partner Interests shall be freely transferable.

              (e)   The General Partner and its Affiliates shall have the right at any time to transfer their Subordinated Units, Common Units and Incentive Distribution Rights to one or more Persons.

              Section 4.6     Transfer of the General Partner's General Partner Interest.     

              (a)   Subject to Section 4.6(b) below, the General Partner may at its option transfer all or any part of its General Partner Interest without approval from any other Partner.

              (b)   Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, no transfer by the General Partner of all or any part of its General Partner Interest to another Person shall be permitted unless (i) the transferee agrees to assume the rights and duties of the General Partner under this Agreement and to be bound by the provisions of this Agreement, (ii) the Partnership receives an Opinion of Counsel that such transfer would not result in the loss of limited liability under the Delaware Act of any Limited Partner or cause the Partnership to be treated as an association taxable as a corporation or otherwise to be taxed as an entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes (to the extent not already so treated or taxed) and (iii) such transferee also agrees to purchase all (or the appropriate portion thereof, if applicable) of the partnership or membership interest held by the General Partner as the general partner or managing member, if any, of each other Group Member. In the case of a transfer pursuant to and in compliance with this Section 4.6, the transferee or successor (as the case may be) shall, subject to compliance with the terms of Section 10.2, be admitted to the Partnership as the General Partner effective immediately prior to the transfer of the General Partner Interest, and the business of the Partnership shall continue without dissolution.

              Section 4.7     Restrictions on Transfers.     

              (a)   Notwithstanding the other provisions of this Article IV, no transfer of any Partnership Interests shall be made if such transfer would (i) violate the then applicable federal or state securities laws or rules and regulations of the Commission, any state securities commission or any other governmental authority with jurisdiction over such transfer, (ii) terminate the existence or qualification of the Partnership under the laws of the jurisdiction of its formation, or (iii) cause the Partnership to be treated as an association taxable as a corporation or otherwise to be taxed as an entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes (to the extent not already so treated or taxed).

              (b)   The General Partner may impose restrictions on the transfer of Partnership Interests if it determines, with the advice of counsel, that such restrictions are necessary or advisable to (i) avoid a significant risk of the Partnership becoming taxable as a corporation or otherwise becoming taxable as an entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes or (ii) preserve the uniformity of the Limited Partner Interests (or any class or classes thereof). The General Partner may impose such restrictions by amending this Agreement; provided, however , that any amendment that would result in the delisting or suspension of trading of any class of Limited Partner Interests on the principal National Securities

A-24


Table of Contents

Exchange on which such class of Limited Partner Interests is then listed or admitted to trading must be approved, prior to such amendment being effected, by the holders of at least a majority of the Outstanding Limited Partner Interests of such class.

              (c)   Nothing contained in this Agreement, other than Section 4.7(a), shall preclude the settlement of any transactions involving Partnership Interests entered into through the facilities of any National Securities Exchange on which such Partnership Interests are listed or admitted to trading.

              (d)   The transfer of a Subordinated Unit that has converted into a Common Unit shall be subject to restrictions imposed by Section 6.7.

              (e)   The transfer of an IDR Reset Common Unit that was issued in connection with an IDR Reset Election pursuant to Section 5.11 shall be subect to the restrictions imposed by Section 6.8.

              Section 4.8     Eligibility Certificates; Ineligible Holders.     

              (a)   If at any time the General Partner determines, with the advice of counsel, that:

                             (i)  the U.S. federal income tax status (or lack of proof of the U.S. federal income tax status) of one or more Limited Partners or their beneficial owners has or is reasonably likely to have a material adverse effect on the rates that can be charged to customers by any Group Member with respect to assets that are subject to regulation by the Federal Energy Regulatory Commission or similar regulatory body (a " Rate Eligibility Trigger "); or

                            (ii)  any Group Member is subject to any federal, state or local law or regulation that would create a substantial risk of cancellation or forfeiture of any property in which the Group Member has an interest based on the nationality, citizenship or other related status of a Limited Partner (a " Citizenship Eligibility Trigger ");

      then, the General Partner may adopt such amendments to this Agreement as it determines to be necessary or appropriate to (x) in the case of a Rate Eligibility Trigger, obtain such proof of the U.S. federal income tax status of the Limited Partners and, to the extent relevant, their beneficial owners, as the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate to reduce risk of the occurrence of a material adverse effect on the rates that can be charged to customers by any Group Member or (y) in the case of a Citizenship Eligibility Trigger, obtain such proof of the nationality, citizenship or other related status of the Limited Partner and, to the extent relevant, their beneficial owners as the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate to eliminate or mitigate a significant risk of cancellation or forfeiture of any properties or interests therein of a Group Member.

              (b)   Such amendments may include provisions requiring all Partners to certify as to their (and their beneficial owners') status as Eligible Holders upon demand and on a regular basis, as determined by the General Partner, and may require transferees of Units to so certify prior to being admitted to the Partnership as a Partner (any such required certificate, an " Eligibility Certificate ").

              (c)   Such amendments may provide that any Partner who fails to furnish to the General Partner within a reasonable period requested proof of its (and its beneficial owners') status as an Eligible Holder or if upon receipt of such Eligibility Certificate or other requested information the General Partner determines that a Limited Partner (or its beneficial owner) is not an Eligible Holder (an " Ineligible Holder "), the Partnership Interests owned by such Limited Partner shall be subject to redemption in accordance with the provisions of Section 4.9. In addition, the General Partner shall be substituted and treated as the owner of all Partnership Interests owned by an Ineligible Holder.

              (d)   The General Partner shall, in exercising voting rights in respect of Partnership Interests held by it on behalf of Ineligible Holders, cast such votes in the same manner and in the same ratios as

A-25


Table of Contents

the votes of Partners (including the General Partner and its Affiliates) in respect of Partnership Interests other than those of Ineligible Holders are cast.

              (e)   Upon dissolution of the Partnership, an Ineligible Holder shall have no right to receive a distribution in kind pursuant to Section 12.4 but shall be entitled to the cash equivalent thereof, and the Partnership shall provide cash in exchange for an assignment of the Ineligible Holder's share of any distribution in kind. Such payment and assignment shall be treated for purposes hereof as a purchase by the Partnership from the Ineligible Holder of the portion of his Partnership Interest representing his right to receive his share of such distribution in kind.

              (f)    At any time after he can and does certify that he has become an Eligible Holder, an Ineligible Holder may, upon application to the General Partner, request that with respect to any Partnership Interests of such Ineligible Holder not redeemed pursuant to Section 4.9, such Ineligible Holder be admitted as a Partner, and upon approval of the General Partner, such Ineligible Holder shall be admitted as a Partner and shall no longer constitute an Ineligible Holder and the General Partner shall cease to be deemed to be the owner in respect of such Ineligible Holder's Partnership Interests.

              Section 4.9     Redemption of Partnership Interests of Ineligible Holders.     

              (a)   If at any time a Partner falsely certifies its status as an Eligible Holder or fails to furnish an Eligibility Certificate or other information requested within the period of time specified in amendments adopted pursuant to Section 4.8 or if upon receipt of such Eligibility Certificate, the General Partner determines, with the advice of counsel, that a Partner is an Ineligible Holder, the Partnership may, unless the Partner establishes to the satisfaction of the General Partner that such Partner is an Eligible Holder or has transferred his Limited Partner Interests to a Person who is an Eligible Holder and who furnishes an Eligibility Certificate to the General Partner prior to the date fixed for redemption as provided below, redeem the Partnership Interest of such Partner as follows:

                             (i)  The General Partner shall, not later than the 30th day before the date fixed for redemption, give notice of redemption to the Partner, at his last address designated on the records of the Partnership or the Transfer Agent, as applicable, by registered or certified mail, postage prepaid. The notice shall be deemed to have been given when so mailed. The notice shall specify the Redeemable Interests, the date fixed for redemption, the place of payment, that payment of the redemption price will be made upon redemption of the Redeemable Interests (or, if later in the case of Redeemable Interests evidenced by Certificates, upon surrender of the Certificate evidencing the Redeemable Interests) and that on and after the date fixed for redemption no further allocations or distributions to which the Partner would otherwise be entitled in respect of the Redeemable Interests will accrue or be made.

                            (ii)  The aggregate redemption price for Redeemable Interests shall be an amount equal to the Current Market Price (the date of determination of which shall be the date fixed for redemption) of Partnership Interests of the class to be so redeemed multiplied by the number of Partnership Interests of each such class included among the Redeemable Interests. The redemption price shall be paid, as determined by the General Partner, in cash or by delivery of a promissory note of the Partnership in the principal amount of the redemption price, bearing interest at the rate of 8% annually and payable in three equal annual installments of principal together with accrued interest, commencing one year after the redemption date.

                          (iii)  The Partner or his duly authorized representative shall be entitled to receive the payment for the Redeemable Interests at the place of payment specified in the notice of redemption on the redemption date (or, if later in the case of Redeemable Interests evidenced by Certificates, upon surrender by or on behalf of the Partner at the place specified in the

A-26


Table of Contents

      notice of redemption, of the Certificate evidencing the Redeemable Interests, duly endorsed in blank or accompanied by an assignment duly executed in blank).

                           (iv)  After the redemption date, Redeemable Interests shall no longer constitute issued and Outstanding Limited Partner Interests.

              (b)   The provisions of this Section 4.9 shall also be applicable to Partnership Interests held by a Partner as nominee of a Person determined to be an Ineligible Holder.

              (c)   Nothing in this Section 4.9 shall prevent the recipient of a notice of redemption from transferring his Partnership Interest before the redemption date if such transfer is otherwise permitted under this Agreement. Upon receipt of notice of such a transfer, the General Partner shall withdraw the notice of redemption, provided the transferee of such Partnership Interest certifies to the satisfaction of the General Partner that he is an Eligible Holder. If the transferee fails to make such certification, such redemption will be effected from the transferee on the original redemption date.

ARTICLE V

CAPITAL CONTRIBUTIONS AND ISSUANCE OF PARTNERSHIP INTERESTS

              Section 5.1     Organizational Contributions.     In connection with the formation of the Partnership under the Delaware Act, the General Partner has been admitted as the General Partner of the Partnership. The Organizational Limited Partner made an initial Capital Contribution to the Partnership in the amount of $1,000.00 in exchange for a Limited Partner Interest equal to a 100% Percentage Interest and has been admitted as a Limited Partner of the Partnership. As of the Closing Date, and effective with the admission of another Limited Partner to the Partnership, the interests of the Organizational Limited Partner will be redeemed as provided in the Contribution Agreement and the initial Capital Contribution of the Organizational Limited Partner will be refunded. One-hundred percent of any interest or other profit that may have resulted from the investment or other use of such initial Capital Contribution will be allocated and distributed to the Organizational Limited Partner.

              Section 5.2     Contributions by the General Partner and its Affiliates.     On the Closing Date and pursuant to the Contribution Agreement, SHC and its subsidiaries shall contribute to the Partnership, as a Capital Contribution, the Susser Operating Interests (as defined in the Contribution Agreement) in exchange for                        Common Units,                         Subordinated Units, the Incentive Distribution Rights and the right to receive the Deferred Issuance and Distribution.

              Section 5.3     Contributions by Initial Limited Partners.     

              (a)   On the Closing Date and pursuant to the Underwriting Agreement, each Underwriter shall contribute cash to the Partnership in exchange for the issuance by the Partnership of Common Units to each Underwriter, all as set forth in the Underwriting Agreement.

              (b)   Upon the exercise, if any, of the Over-Allotment Option, each Underwriter shall contribute cash to the Partnership in exchange for the issuance by the Partnership of Common Units to each Underwriter, all as set forth in the Underwriting Agreement.

              Section 5.4     Interest and Withdrawal.     No interest shall be paid by the Partnership on Capital Contributions. No Partner shall be entitled to the withdrawal or return of its Capital Contribution, except to the extent, if any, that distributions made pursuant to this Agreement or upon liquidation of the Partnership may be considered as such by law and then only to the extent provided for in this Agreement. Except to the extent expressly provided in this Agreement, no Partner shall have priority over any other Partner either as to the return of Capital Contributions or as to profits, losses or distributions. Any such return shall be a compromise to which all Partners agree within the meaning of Section 17-502(b) of the Delaware Act.

A-27


Table of Contents

              Section 5.5     Capital Accounts.     

              (a)   The Partnership shall maintain for each Partner (or a beneficial owner of Partnership Interests held by a nominee in any case in which the nominee has furnished the identity of such owner to the Partnership in accordance with Section 6031(c) of the Code or any other method acceptable to the General Partner) owning a Partnership Interest a separate Capital Account with respect to such Partnership Interest in accordance with the rules of Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-1(b)(2)(iv). Such Capital Account shall be increased by (i) the amount of all Capital Contributions made to the Partnership with respect to such Partnership Interest and (ii) all items of Partnership income and gain (including income and gain exempt from tax) computed in accordance with Section 5.5(b) and allocated with respect to such Partnership Interest pursuant to Section 6.1, and decreased by (x) the amount of cash or Net Agreed Value of all actual and deemed distributions of cash or property made with respect to such Partnership Interest and (y) all items of Partnership deduction and loss computed in accordance with Section 5.5(b) and allocated with respect to such Partnership Interest pursuant to Section 6.1.

              (b)   For purposes of computing the amount of any item of income, gain, loss or deduction that is to be allocated pursuant to Article VI and is to be reflected in the Partners' Capital Accounts, the determination, recognition and classification of any such item shall be the same as its determination, recognition and classification for U.S. federal income tax purposes (including any method of depreciation, cost recovery or amortization used for that purpose), provided , that:

                             (i)  Solely for purposes of this Section 5.5, the Partnership shall be treated as owning directly its proportionate share (as determined by the General Partner based upon the provisions of the applicable Group Member Agreement) of all property owned by (x) any other Group Member that is classified as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes and (y) any other partnership, limited liability company, unincorporated business or other entity classified as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes of which a Group Member is, directly or indirectly, a partner, member or other equity holder.

                            (ii)  All fees and other expenses incurred by the Partnership to promote the sale of (or to sell) a Partnership Interest that can neither be deducted nor amortized under Section 709 of the Code, if any, shall, for purposes of Capital Account maintenance, be treated as an item of deduction at the time such fees and other expenses are incurred and shall be allocated among the Partners pursuant to Section 6.1.

                          (iii)  Except as otherwise provided in Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-1(b)(2)(iv)(m), the computation of all items of income, gain, loss and deduction shall be made without regard to any election under Section 754 of the Code that may be made by the Partnership and, as to those items described in Section 705(a)(1)(B) or 705(a)(2)(B) of the Code, without regard to the fact that such items are not includable in gross income or are neither currently deductible nor capitalized for U.S. federal income tax purposes. To the extent an adjustment to the adjusted tax basis of any Partnership asset pursuant to Section 734(b) or 743(b) of the Code is required, pursuant to Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-1(b)(2)(iv)(m), to be taken into account in determining Capital Accounts, the amount of such adjustment in the Capital Accounts shall be treated as an item of gain or loss.

                           (iv)  Any income, gain or loss attributable to the taxable disposition of any Partnership property shall be determined as if the adjusted basis of such property as of such date of disposition were equal in amount to the property's Carrying Value as of such date.

                            (v)  Any deductions for depreciation, cost recovery or amortization attributable to any Contributed Property or Adjusted Property shall be determined under the rules prescribed

A-28


Table of Contents

      by Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-3(d)(2) as if the adjusted basis of such property were equal to the Carrying Value of such property immediately following such adjustment.

                           (vi)  The Gross Liability Value of each Liability of the Partnership described in Treasury Regulation Section 1.752-7(b)(3)(i) shall be adjusted at such times as provided in this Agreement for an adjustment to Carrying Values. The amount of any such adjustment shall be treated for purposes hereof as an item of loss (if the adjustment increases the Carrying Value of such Liability of the Partnership) or an item of gain (if the adjustment decreases the Carrying Value of such Liability of the Partnership).

              (c)   (i) Except as otherwise provided in this Section 5.5(c), a transferee of a Partnership Interest shall succeed to a pro rata portion of the Capital Account of the transferor relating to the Partnership Interest so transferred.

                            (ii)  Subject to Section 6.7(b), immediately prior to the transfer of a Subordinated Unit or of a Subordinated Unit that has converted into a Common Unit pursuant to Section 5.7 by a holder thereof (in each case, other than a transfer to an Affiliate unless the General Partner elects to have this subparagraph 5.5(c)(ii) apply), the Capital Account maintained for such Person with respect to its Subordinated Units or converted Subordinated Units will (A) first, be allocated to the Subordinated Units or converted Subordinated Units to be transferred in an amount equal to the product of (x) the number of such Subordinated Units or converted Subordinated Units to be transferred and (y) the Per Unit Capital Amount for a Common Unit, and (B) second, any remaining balance in such Capital Account will be retained by the transferor, regardless of whether it has retained any Subordinated Units or converted Subordinated Units. Following any such allocation, the transferor's Capital Account, if any, maintained with respect to the retained Subordinated Units or retained converted Subordinated Units, if any, will have a balance equal to the amount allocated under clause (B) above, and the transferee's Capital Account established with respect to the transferred Subordinated Units or transferred converted Subordinated Units will have a balance equal to the amount allocated under clause (A) above.

                          (iii)  Subject to 6.8(b), immediately prior to the transfer of an IDR Reset Common Unit by a holder thereof (other than a transfer to an Affiliate unless the General Partner elects to have this subparagraph 5.5(c)(iii) apply), the Capital Account maintained for such Person with respect to its IDR Reset Common Units will (A) first, be allocated to the IDR Reset Common Units to be transferred in an amount equal to the product of (x) the number of such IDR Reset Common Units to be transferred and (y) the Per Unit Capital Amount for a Common Unit, and (B) second, any remaining balance in such Capital Account will be retained by the transferor, regardless of whether it has retained any IDR Reset Common Units. Following any such allocation, the transferor's Capital Account, if any, maintained with respect to the retained IDR Reset Common Units, if any, will have a balance equal to the amount allocated under clause (B) hereinabove, and the transferee's Capital Account established with respect to the transferred IDR Reset Common Units will have a balance equal to the amount allocated under clause (A) above.

              (d)   (i) Consistent with Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-1(b)(2)(iv)(f), on an issuance of additional Partnership Interests for cash or Contributed Property, the issuance of Partnership Interests as consideration for the provision of services, or the conversion of the Combined Interest to Common Units pursuant to Section 11.3(b), the Carrying Value of each Partnership property immediately prior to such issuance shall be adjusted upward or downward to reflect any Unrealized Gain or Unrealized Loss attributable to such Partnership property, and any such Unrealized Gain or Unrealized Loss shall be treated, for purposes of maintaining Capital Accounts, as if it had been recognized on an actual sale of each such property for an amount equal to its fair market value immediately prior to such issuance

A-29


Table of Contents

and had been allocated among the Partners at such time pursuant to Section 6.1 in the same manner as any item of gain or loss actually recognized following an event giving rise to the dissolution of the Partnership would have been allocated; provided, however , that in the event of an issuance of Partnership Interests for a de minimis amount of cash or Contributed Property, or in the event of an issuance of a de minimis amount of Partnership Interests as consideration for the provision of services, the General Partner may determine that such adjustments are unnecessary for the proper administration of the Partnership. In determining such Unrealized Gain or Unrealized Loss, the aggregate fair market value of all Partnership property (including cash or cash equivalents) immediately prior to the issuance of additional Partnership Interests shall be determined by the General Partner using such method of valuation as it may adopt. In making its determination of the fair market values of individual properties, the General Partner may determine that it is appropriate to first determine an aggregate value for the Partnership, based on the current trading price of the Common Units, and taking fully into account the fair market value of the Partnership Interests of all Partners at such time, and then allocate such aggregate value among the individual properties of the Partnership (in such manner as it determines appropriate).

                            (ii)  In accordance with Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-1(b)(2)(iv)(f), immediately prior to any actual or deemed distribution to a Partner of any Partnership property (other than a distribution of cash that is not in redemption or retirement of a Partnership Interest), the Carrying Value of all Partnership property shall be adjusted upward or downward to reflect any Unrealized Gain or Unrealized Loss attributable to such Partnership property, and any such Unrealized Gain or Unrealized Loss shall be treated, for purposes of maintaining Capital Accounts, as if it had been recognized on an actual sale of each such property immediately prior to such distribution for an amount equal to its fair market value, and had been allocated among the Partners, at such time, pursuant to Section 6.1 in the same manner as any item of gain or loss actually recognized following an event giving rise to the dissolution of the Partnership would have been allocated. In determining such Unrealized Gain or Unrealized Loss the aggregate fair market value of all Partnership property (including cash or cash equivalents) immediately prior to a distribution shall (A) in the case of an actual or deemed distribution other than a distribution made pursuant to Section 12.4, be determined in the same manner as that provided in Section 5.5(d)(i) or (B) in the case of a liquidating distribution pursuant to Section 12.4, be determined by the Liquidator using such method of valuation as it may adopt.

              Section 5.6     Issuances of Additional Partnership Interests and Derivative Instruments.     

              (a)   The Partnership may issue additional Partnership Interests and Derivative Instruments for any Partnership purpose at any time and from time to time to such Persons for such consideration and on such terms and conditions as the General Partner shall determine, all without the approval of any Limited Partners.

              (b)   Each additional Partnership Interest authorized to be issued by the Partnership pursuant to Section 5.6(a) may be issued in one or more classes, or one or more series of any such classes, with such designations, preferences, rights, powers and duties (which may be senior to existing classes and series of Partnership Interests), as shall be fixed by the General Partner, including (i) the right to share in Partnership profits and losses or items thereof; (ii) the right to share in Partnership distributions; (iii) the rights upon dissolution and liquidation of the Partnership; (iv) whether, and the terms and conditions upon which, the Partnership may or shall be required to redeem the Partnership Interest (including sinking fund provisions); (v) whether such Partnership Interest is issued with the privilege of conversion or exchange and, if so, the terms and conditions of such conversion or exchange; (vi) the terms and conditions upon which each Partnership Interest will be issued, evidenced by certificates and assigned or transferred; (vii) the method for determining the Percentage Interest as to such Partnership

A-30


Table of Contents

Interest; and (viii) the right, if any, of each such Partnership Interest to vote on Partnership matters, including matters relating to the relative rights, preferences and privileges of such Partnership Interest.

              (c)   The General Partner shall take all actions that it determines to be necessary or appropriate in connection with (i) each issuance of Partnership Interests and Derivative Instruments pursuant to this Section 5.6, (ii) the conversion of the Combined Interest into Units pursuant to the terms of this Agreement, (iii) the issuance of Common Units pursuant to Section 5.11, (iv) reflecting admission of such additional Limited Partners in the books and records of the Partnership as the Record Holders of such Limited Partner Interests and (v) all additional issuances of Partnership Interests. The General Partner shall determine the relative rights, powers and duties of the holders of the Units or other Partnership Interests being so issued. The General Partner shall do all things necessary to comply with the Delaware Act and is authorized and directed to do all things that it determines to be necessary or appropriate in connection with any future issuance of Partnership Interests or in connection with the conversion of the Combined Interest into Units pursuant to the terms of this Agreement, including compliance with any statute, rule, regulation or guideline of any federal, state or other governmental agency or any National Securities Exchange on which the Units or other Partnership Interests are listed or admitted to trading.

              (d)   No fractional Units shall be issued by the Partnership.

              Section 5.7     Conversion of Subordinated Units.     

              (a)   All of the Subordinated Units shall convert into Common Units on a one-for-one basis on the first Business Day following the distribution of Available Cash to Partners pursuant to Section 6.3(a) in respect of the final Quarter of the Subordination Period.

              (b)   Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement, all of the then Outstanding Subordinated Units may convert into Common Units on a one-for-one basis as set forth in, and pursuant to the terms of, Section 11.4.

              Section 5.8     Limited Preemptive Right.     Except as provided in this Section 5.8 or as otherwise provided in a separate agreement by the Partnership, no Person shall have any preemptive, preferential or other similar right with respect to the issuance of any Partnership Interest, whether unissued, held in the treasury or hereafter created. The General Partner shall have the right, which it may from time to time assign in whole or in part to any of its Affiliates, to purchase Partnership Interests from the Partnership whenever, and on the same terms that, the Partnership issues Partnership Interests to Persons other than the General Partner and its Affiliates, to the extent necessary to maintain the Percentage Interests of the General Partner and its Affiliates equal to that which existed immediately prior to the issuance of such Partnership Interests.

              Section 5.9     Splits and Combinations.     

              (a)   Subject to Section 5.9(d), the Partnership may make a Pro Rata distribution of Partnership Interests to all Record Holders or may effect a subdivision or combination of Partnership Interests so long as, after any such event, each Partner shall have the same Percentage Interest in the Partnership as before such event, and any amounts calculated on a per Unit basis (including any Common Unit Arrearage or Cumulative Common Unit Arrearage) or stated as a number of Units are proportionately adjusted retroactive to the beginning of the Partnership.

              (b)   Whenever such a distribution, subdivision or combination of Partnership Interests is declared, the General Partner shall select a Record Date as of which the distribution, subdivision or combination shall be effective and shall send notice thereof at least 20 days prior to such Record Date to each Record Holder as of a date not less than 10 days prior to the date of such notice. The General Partner also may cause a firm of independent public accountants selected by it to calculate the number of Partnership Interests to be held by each Record Holder after giving effect to such distribution, subdivision or combination. The General Partner shall be entitled to rely on any certificate provided by such firm as conclusive evidence of the accuracy of such calculation.

              (c)   Promptly following any such distribution, subdivision or combination, the Partnership may issue Certificates to the Record Holders of Partnership Interests as of the applicable Record Date representing the new number of Partnership Interests held by such Record Holders, or the General Partner may adopt such other procedures that it determines to be necessary or appropriate to reflect such changes. If any such combination results in a smaller total number of Partnership Interests Outstanding, the Partnership shall require, as a condition to the delivery to a Record Holder of such new Certificate, the surrender of any Certificate held by such Record Holder immediately prior to such Record Date.

A-31


Table of Contents

               (d)   The Partnership shall not issue fractional Units upon any distribution, subdivision or combination of Units. If a distribution, subdivision or combination of Units would result in the issuance of fractional Units but for the provisions of Section 5.6(d) and this Section 5.9(d), each fractional Unit shall be rounded to the nearest whole Unit (and a 0.5 Unit shall be rounded to the next higher Unit).

              Section 5.10     Fully Paid and Non-Assessable Nature of Limited Partner Interests.     All Limited Partner Interests issued pursuant to, and in accordance with the requirements of, this Article V shall be fully paid and non-assessable Limited Partner Interests in the Partnership, except as such non-assessability may be affected by Section 17-607 or 17-804 of the Delaware Act.

              Section 5.11     Issuance of Common Units in Connection with Reset of Incentive Distribution Rights.     

              (a)   Subject to the provisions of this Section 5.11, the holder of the Incentive Distribution Rights (or, if there is more than one holder of the Incentive Distribution Rights, the holders of a majority in interest of the Incentive Distribution Rights) shall have the right, at any time when there are no Subordinated Units Outstanding and the Partnership has made a distribution pursuant to Section 6.4(b)(v) for each of the four most recently completed Quarters and the amount of each such distribution did not exceed Adjusted Operating Surplus for such Quarter, to make an election (the " IDR Reset Election ") to cause the Target Distributions to be reset in accordance with the provisions of Section 5.11(e) and, in connection therewith, the holder or holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights will become entitled to receive their respective proportionate share of a number of Common Units (the " IDR Reset Common Units ") derived by dividing (i) the average amount of aggregate cash distributions made by the Partnership for the two full Quarters immediately preceding the giving of the Reset Notice (as defined in Section 5.11(b)) in respect of the Incentive Distribution Rights by (ii) the average of the cash distributions made by the Partnership in respect of each Common Unit for the two full Quarters immediately preceding the giving of the Reset Notice (the " Reset MQD ") (the number of Common Units determined by such quotient is referred to herein as the " Aggregate Quantity of IDR Reset Common Units "). The making of the IDR Reset Election in the manner specified in Section 5.11(b) shall cause the Target Distributions to be reset in accordance with the provisions of Section 5.11(e) and, in connection therewith, the holder or holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights will become entitled to receive Common Units on the basis specified above, without any further approval required by the General Partner or the Unitholders, at the time specified in Section 5.11(c) unless the IDR Reset Election is rescinded pursuant to Section 5.11(d).

              (b)   To exercise the right specified in Section 5.11(a), the holder of the Incentive Distribution Rights (or, if there is more than one holder of the Incentive Distribution Rights, the holders of a majority in interest of the Incentive Distribution Rights) shall deliver a written notice (the " Reset Notice ") to the Partnership. Within 10 Business Days after the receipt by the Partnership of such Reset Notice, the Partnership shall deliver a written notice to the holder or holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights of the Partnership's determination of the aggregate number of Common Units that each holder of Incentive Distribution Rights will be entitled to receive.

              (c)   The holder(s) of the Incentive Distribution Rights will be entitled to receive the Aggregate Quantity of IDR Reset Common Units on the fifteenth Business Day after receipt by the Partnership of the Reset Notice; provided, however , that the issuance of Common Units to the holder or holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights shall not occur prior to the approval of the listing or admission for trading of such Common Units by the principal National Securities Exchange upon which the Common Units are then listed or admitted for trading if any such approval is required pursuant to the rules and regulations of such National Securities Exchange.

              (d)   If the principal National Securities Exchange upon which the Common Units are then traded has not approved the listing or admission for trading of the Common Units to be issued pursuant to this Section 5.11 on or before the 30th calendar day following the Partnership's receipt of

A-32


Table of Contents

the Reset Notice and such approval is required by the rules and regulations of such National Securities Exchange, then the holder of the Incentive Distribution Rights (or, if there is more than one holder of the Incentive Distribution Rights, the holders of a majority in interest of the Incentive Distribution Rights) shall have the right to either rescind the IDR Reset Election or elect to receive other Partnership Interests having such terms as the General Partner may approve, with the approval of the Conflicts Committee, that will provide (i) the same economic value, in the aggregate, as the Aggregate Quantity of IDR Reset Common Units would have had at the time of the Partnership's receipt of the Reset Notice, as determined by the General Partner, and (ii) for the subsequent conversion (on terms acceptable to the National Securities Exchange upon which the Common Units are then traded) of such Partnership Interests into Common Units within not more than 12 months following the Partnership's receipt of the Reset Notice upon the satisfaction of one or more conditions that are reasonably acceptable to the holder of the Incentive Distribution Rights (or, if there is more than one holder of the Incentive Distribution Rights, the holders of a majority in interest of the Incentive Distribution Rights).

              (e)   The Target Distributions shall be adjusted at the time of the issuance of Common Units or other Partnership Interests pursuant to this Section 5.11 such that (i) the Minimum Quarterly Distribution shall be reset to be equal to the Reset MQD, (ii) the First Target Distribution shall be reset to equal 115% of the Reset MQD, (iii) the Second Target Distribution shall be reset to equal 125% of the Reset MQD and (iv) the Third Target Distribution shall be reset to equal 150% of the Reset MQD.

              (f)    Upon the issuance of IDR Reset Common Units pursuant to Section 5.11(a) (or other Partnership Interests as described in Section 5.11(d)), the Capital Account maintained with respect to the Incentive Distribution Rights shall (A) first, be allocated to IDR Reset Common Units (or other Partnership Interests) in an amount equal to the product of (x) the Aggregate Quantity of IDR Reset Common Units (or other Partnership Interests) and (y) the Per Unit Capital Amount for an Initial Common Unit, and (B) second, any remaining balance in such Capital Account will be retained by the holder of the Incentive Distribution Rights. If there is not a sufficient Capital Account associated with the Incentive Distribution Rights to allocate the full Per Unit Capital Amount for an Initial Common Unit to the IDR Reset Common Units in accordance with clause (A) of this Section 5.11(f), the IDR Reset Common Units shall be subject to Section 6.1(d)(x)(B) and (C).

ARTICLE VI

ALLOCATIONS AND DISTRIBUTIONS

              Section 6.1     Allocations for Capital Account Purposes.     For purposes of maintaining the Capital Accounts and in determining the rights of the Partners among themselves, the Partnership's items of income, gain, loss and deduction (computed in accordance with Section 5.5(b)) for each taxable period shall be allocated among the Partners as provided herein below.

              (a)     Net Income.     Net Income for each taxable period (including a pro rata part of each item of income, gain, loss and deduction taken into account in computing Net Income for such taxable period) shall be allocated:

                  (i) First, to the Unitholders to which Net Loss has been allocated pursuant to the proviso provision of Section 6.1(b), in proportion to the allocations of Net Loss pursuant to the proviso provision of Section 6.1(b) until the aggregate Net Income allocated pursuant to this Section 6.1(a)(i) is equal to the aggregate Net Loss previously allocated pursuant to the proviso provision of Section 6.1(b); and

                  (ii) Thereafter, to the Unitholders, Pro Rata.

              (b)     Net Loss.     Net Loss for each taxable period (including a pro rata part of each item of income, gain, loss and deduction taken into account in computing Net Loss for such taxable period)

A-33


Table of Contents

shall be allocated to the Unitholders, Pro Rata; provided , that Net Loss shall not be allocated pursuant to this Section 6.1(b) to the extent that such allocation would cause any Unitholder to have a deficit balance in its Adjusted Capital Account at the end of such taxable period (or increase any existing deficit balance in its Adjusted Capital Account) and such Net Loss shall instead be allocated to the Unitholders with positive Adjusted Capital Account balances in proportion to such positive balances

              (c)     Net Termination Gains and Losses.     Net Termination Gain or Net Termination Loss for each taxable period shall be allocated in the manner set forth in this Section 6.1(c). All allocations under this Section 6.1(c) shall be made after Capital Account balances have been adjusted by all other allocations provided under this Section 6.1 and after all distributions of cash and cash equivalents provided under Section 6.4 and Section 6.5 have been made; provided, however , that solely for purposes of this Section 6.1(c), Capital Accounts shall not be adjusted for distributions made pursuant to Section 12.4.

                             (i)  Except as provided in Section 6.1(c)(iv), Net Termination Gain (including a pro rata part of each item of income, gain, loss, and deduction taken into account in computing Net Termination Gain) shall be allocated:

                        (A)  First, to the Unitholders allocated Net Termination Loss pursuant to the proviso provision of Section 6.1(c)(ii)(C), in proportion to the allocations of Net Termination Loss pursuant to the proviso provision of Section 6.1(c)(ii)(C), until the aggregate Net Termination Gain allocated pursuant to this Section 6.1(c)(i)(A) is equal to the aggregate Net Termination Loss previously allocated pursuant to the proviso provision of Section 6.1(c)(ii)(C);

                        (B)  Second, to all Unitholders holding Common Units, Pro Rata, until the Capital Account in respect of each Common Unit then Outstanding is equal to the sum of (1) its Unrecovered Initial Unit Price, (2) the Minimum Quarterly Distribution for the Quarter during which the Liquidation Date occurs, reduced by any distribution pursuant to Section 6.4(a)(i) or Section 6.4(b)(i) with respect to such Common Unit for such Quarter (the amount determined pursuant to this clause (2) is hereinafter referred to as the " Unpaid MQD ") and (3) any then existing Cumulative Common Unit Arrearage;

                        (C)  Third, if such Net Termination Gain is recognized (or is deemed to be recognized) prior to the conversion of the last Outstanding Subordinated Unit into a Common Unit, to all Unitholders holding Subordinated Units, Pro Rata, until the Capital Account in respect of each Subordinated Unit then Outstanding equals the sum of (1) its Unrecovered Initial Unit Price, determined for the taxable period (or portion thereof) to which this allocation of gain relates, and (2) the Minimum Quarterly Distribution for the Quarter during which the Liquidation Date occurs, reduced by any distribution pursuant to Section 6.4(a)(iii) with respect to such Subordinated Unit for such Quarter;

                        (D)  Fourth, to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, until the Capital Account in respect of each Common Unit then Outstanding is equal to the sum of (1) its Unrecovered Initial Unit Price, (2) the Unpaid MQD, (3) any then existing Cumulative Common Unit Arrearage, and (4) the excess of (aa) the First Target Distribution less the Minimum Quarterly Distribution for each Quarter of the Partnership's existence over (bb) the cumulative per Unit amount of any distributions of cash or cash equivalents that are deemed to be Operating Surplus made pursuant to Section 6.4(a)(iv) and Section 6.4(b)(ii) (the sum of (1), (2), (3) and (4) is hereinafter referred to as the " First Liquidation Target Amount ");

A-34


Table of Contents

                        (E)  Fifth, 15.0% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata, and 85.0% to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, until the Capital Account in respect of each Common Unit then Outstanding is equal to the sum of (1) the First Liquidation Target Amount, and (2) the excess of (aa) the Second Target Distribution less the First Target Distribution for each Quarter of the Partnership's existence over (bb) the cumulative per Unit amount of any distributions of cash or cash equivalents that are deemed to be Operating Surplus made pursuant to Section 6.4(a)(v) and Section 6.4(b)(iii) (the sum of (1) and (2) is hereinafter referred to as the " Second Liquidation Target Amount ");

                        (F)  Sixth, 25.0% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata, and 75% to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, until the Capital Account in respect of each Common Unit then Outstanding is equal to the sum of (1) the Second Liquidation Target Amount, and (2) the excess of (aa) the Third Target Distribution less the Second Target Distribution for each Quarter of the Partnership's existence over (bb) the cumulative per Unit amount of any distributions of cash or cash equivalents that are deemed to be Operating Surplus made pursuant to Section 6.4(a)(vi) and Section 6.4(b)(iv); and

                        (G)  Finally, 50.0% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata, and 50.0% to all Unitholders, Pro Rata.

                            (ii)  Except as otherwise provided by Section 6.1(c)(iii), Net Termination Loss shall be allocated:

                        (A)  First, if Subordinated Units remain Outstanding, to all Unitholders holding Subordinated Units, Pro Rata, until the Capital Account in respect of each Subordinated Unit then Outstanding has been reduced to zero;

                        (B)  Second, to all Unitholders holding Common Units, Pro Rata, until the Capital Account in respect of each Common Unit then Outstanding has been reduced to zero; and

                        (C)  Third, to the Unitholders, Pro Rata; provided, however , that Net Termination Loss shall not be allocated pursuant to this Section 6.1(c)(ii)(C) to the extent such allocation would cause any Unitholder to have a deficit balance in its Adjusted Capital Account (or increase any existing deficit in its Adjusted Capital Account) and such Net Termination Loss shall instead be allocated to the Unitholders with positive Adjusted Capital Account balances in proportion to such positive balances.

                          (iii)  Any Net Termination Loss deemed recognized pursuant to Section 5.5(d) prior to the Liquidation Date shall be allocated to the Unitholders, Pro Rata; provided, however , that Net Termination Loss shall not be allocated pursuant to this Section 6.1(c)(iii) to the extent such allocation would cause any Unitholder to have a deficit balance in its Adjusted Capital Account at the end of such taxable period (or increase any existing deficit in its Adjusted Capital Account) and such Net Termination Loss shall instead be allocated to the Unitholders with positive Adjusted Capital Account balances in proportion to such positive balances.

                           (iv)  If a Net Termination Loss has been allocated pursuant to Section 6.1(c)(iii), any subsequent Net Termination Gain deemed recognized pursuant to Section 5.5(d) prior to the Liquidation Date shall be allocated:

                        (A)  First, to the Unitholders to which Net Termination Loss has been allocated pursuant to the proviso provision of Section 6.1(c)(iii), in proportion to the allocations of Net Termination Loss pursuant to the proviso provision of Section 6.1(c)(iii) until the aggregate Net Termination Gain allocated pursuant to this

A-35


Table of Contents

          Section 6.1(c)(iv)(A) is equal to the aggregate Net Termination Loss previously allocated pursuant to the proviso provision of Section 6.1(c)(iii);

                        (B)  Second, to the Unitholders, Pro Rata, until the aggregate Net Termination Gain allocated pursuant to this Section 6.1(c)(iv)(B) is equal to the aggregate Net Termination Loss previously allocated pursuant to Section 6.1(c)(iii) (other than pursuant to the proviso provision); and

                        (C)  The balance, if any, pursuant to the provisions of Section 6.1(c)(i).

              (d)     Special Allocations.     Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section 6.1, the following special allocations shall be made for each taxable period.

                    (i)     Partnership Minimum Gain Chargeback.     Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section 6.1, if there is a net decrease in Partnership Minimum Gain during any Partnership taxable period, each Partner shall be allocated items of Partnership income and gain for such period (and, if necessary, subsequent periods) in the manner and amounts provided in Treasury Regulation Sections 1.704-2(f)(6), 1.704-2(g)(2) and 1.704-2(j)(2)(i), or any successor provision. For purposes of this Section 6.1(d), each Partner's Adjusted Capital Account balance shall be determined, and the allocation of income or gain required hereunder shall be effected, prior to the application of any other allocations pursuant to this Section 6.1(d) with respect to such taxable period (other than an allocation pursuant to Section 6.1(d)(vi) and Section 6.1(d)(vii)). This Section 6.1(d)(i) is intended to comply with the Partnership Minimum Gain chargeback requirement in Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-2(f) and shall be interpreted consistently therewith.

                    (ii)     Chargeback of Partner Nonrecourse Debt Minimum Gain.     Notwithstanding the other provisions of this Section 6.1 (other than Section 6.1(d)(i)), except as provided in Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-2(i)(4), if there is a net decrease in Partner Nonrecourse Debt Minimum Gain during any Partnership taxable period, any Partner with a share of Partner Nonrecourse Debt Minimum Gain at the beginning of such taxable period shall be allocated items of Partnership income and gain for such period (and, if necessary, subsequent periods) in the manner and amounts provided in Treasury Regulation Sections 1.704-2(i)(4) and 1.704-2(j)(2)(ii), or any successor provisions. For purposes of this Section 6.1(d), each Partner's Adjusted Capital Account balance shall be determined, and the allocation of income or gain required hereunder shall be effected, prior to the application of any other allocations pursuant to this Section 6.1(d), other than Section 6.1(d)(i) and other than an allocation pursuant to Section 6.1(d)(vi) and Section 6.1(d)(vii), with respect to such taxable period. This Section 6.1(d)(ii) is intended to comply with the chargeback of items of income and gain requirement in Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-2(i)(4) and shall be interpreted consistently therewith.

                    (iii)     Priority Allocations.     

                        (A)  If the amount of cash or the Net Agreed Value of any property distributed (except cash or property distributed pursuant to Section 12.4) with respect to a Unit for a taxable period exceeds the amount of cash or the Net Agreed Value of property distributed with respect to another Unit within the same taxable period (the amount of the excess, an " Excess Distribution " and the Unit with respect to which the greater distribution is paid, an " Excess Distribution Unit "), then there shall be allocated gross income and gain to each Unitholder receiving an Excess Distribution with respect to the Excess Distribution Unit until the aggregate amount of such items allocated with respect to such Excess Distribution Unit pursuant to this Section 6.1(d)(iii)(A) for the current taxable period and all previous taxable periods is equal to the amount of the Excess Distribution.

A-36


Table of Contents

                        (B)  After the application of Section 6.1(d)(iii)(A), the remaining items of Partnership gross income or gain for the taxable period, if any, shall be allocated to the holders of Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata, until the aggregate amount of such items allocated to the holders of Incentive Distribution Rights pursuant to this Section 6.1(d)(iii)(B) for the current taxable period and all previous taxable periods is equal to the cumulative amount of all Incentive Distributions made to the holders of Incentive Distribution Rights from the Closing Date to a date 45 days after the end of the current taxable period.

                    (iv)     Qualified Income Offset.     In the event any Partner unexpectedly receives any adjustments, allocations or distributions described in Treasury Regulation Sections 1.704-1(b)(2)(ii)(d)(4), 1.704-1(b)(2)(ii)(d)(5), or 1.704-1(b)(2)(ii)(d)(6), items of Partnership gross income and gain shall be specially allocated to such Partner in an amount and manner sufficient to eliminate, to the extent required by the Treasury Regulations promulgated under Section 704(b) of the Code, the deficit balance, if any, in its Adjusted Capital Account created by such adjustments, allocations or distributions as quickly as possible; provided, that an allocation pursuant to this Section 6.1(d)(iv) shall be made only if and to the extent that such Partner would have a deficit balance in its Adjusted Capital Account after all other allocations provided for in this Section 6.1 have been tentatively made as if this Section 6.1(d)(iv) were not in this Agreement.

                    (v)     Gross Income Allocation.     In the event any Partner has a deficit balance in its Capital Account at the end of any taxable period in excess of the sum of (A) the amount such Partner is required to restore pursuant to the provisions of this Agreement and (B) the amount such Partner is deemed obligated to restore pursuant to Treasury Regulation Sections 1.704-2(g) and 1.704-2(i)(5), such Partner shall be specially allocated items of Partnership gross income and gain in the amount of such excess as quickly as possible; provided, that an allocation pursuant to this Section 6.1(d)(v) shall be made only if and to the extent that such Partner would have a deficit balance in its Capital Account after all other allocations provided for in this Section 6.1 have been tentatively made as if Section 6.1(d)(iv) and this Section 6.1(d)(v) were not in this Agreement.

                    (vi)     Nonrecourse Deductions.     Nonrecourse Deductions for any taxable period shall be allocated to the Partners Pro Rata. If the General Partner determines that the Partnership's Nonrecourse Deductions should be allocated in a different ratio to satisfy the safe harbor requirements of the Treasury Regulations promulgated under Section 704(b) of the Code, the General Partner is authorized to revise the prescribed ratio to the numerically closest ratio that does satisfy such requirements.

                    (vii)     Partner Nonrecourse Deductions.     Partner Nonrecourse Deductions for any taxable period shall be allocated 100% to the Partner that bears the Economic Risk of Loss with respect to the Partner Nonrecourse Debt to which such Partner Nonrecourse Deductions are attributable in accordance with Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-2(i). If more than one Partner bears the Economic Risk of Loss with respect to a Partner Nonrecourse Debt, the Partner Nonrecourse Deductions attributable thereto shall be allocated between or among such Partners in accordance with the ratios in which they share such Economic Risk of Loss.

                    (viii)     Nonrecourse Liabilities.     For purposes of Treasury Regulation Section 1.752-3(a)(3), the Partners agree that Nonrecourse Liabilities of the Partnership in excess of the sum of (A) the amount of Partnership Minimum Gain and (B) the total amount of Nonrecourse Built-in Gain shall be allocated among the Partners Pro Rata.

                    (ix)     Code Section 754 Adjustments.     To the extent an adjustment to the adjusted tax basis of any Partnership asset pursuant to Section 734(b) or 743(b) of the Code is required,

A-37


Table of Contents

      pursuant to Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-1(b)(2)(iv)(m), to be taken into account in determining Capital Accounts as a result of a distribution to a Partner in complete liquidation of such Partner's interest in the Partnership, the amount of such adjustment to the Capital Accounts shall be treated as an item of gain (if the adjustment increases the basis of the asset) or loss (if the adjustment decreases such basis) taken into account pursuant to Section 5.5, and such item of gain or loss shall be specially allocated to the Partners in a manner consistent with the manner in which their Capital Accounts are required to be adjusted pursuant to such Section of the Treasury Regulations.

                    (x)     Economic Uniformity; Changes in Law.     

                        (A)  At the election of the General Partner with respect to any taxable period ending upon, or after, the termination of the Subordination Period, all or a portion of the remaining items of Partnership gross income or gain for such taxable period, after taking into account allocations pursuant to Section 6.1(d)(iii), shall be allocated 100% to each Partner holding Subordinated Units that are Outstanding as of the termination of the Subordination Period (" Final Subordinated Units ") in the proportion of the number of Final Subordinated Units held by such Partner to the total number of Final Subordinated Units then Outstanding, until each such Partner has been allocated an amount of gross income or gain that increases the Capital Account maintained with respect to such Final Subordinated Units to an amount that after taking into account the other allocations of income, gain, loss and deduction to be made with respect to such taxable period will equal the product of (1) the number of Final Subordinated Units held by such Partner and (2) the Per Unit Capital Amount for a Common Unit. The purpose of this allocation is to establish uniformity between the Capital Accounts underlying Final Subordinated Units and the Capital Accounts underlying Common Units held by Persons other than the General Partner and its Affiliates immediately prior to the conversion of such Final Subordinated Units into Common Units. This allocation method for establishing such economic uniformity will be available to the General Partner only if the method for allocating the Capital Account maintained with respect to the Subordinated Units between the transferred and retained Subordinated Units pursuant to Section 5.5(c)(ii) does not otherwise provide such economic uniformity to the Final Subordinated Units.

                        (B)  With respect to an event triggering an adjustment to the Carrying Value of Partnership property pursuant to Section 5.5(d) during any taxable period of the Partnership ending upon, or after, the issuance of IDR Reset Common Units pursuant to Section 5.11, after the application of Section 6.1(d)(x)(A), any Unrealized Gains and Unrealized Losses shall be allocated among the Partners in a manner that to the nearest extent possible results in the Capital Accounts maintained with respect to such IDR Reset Common Units issued pursuant to Section 5.11 equaling the product of (1) the Aggregate Quantity of IDR Reset Common Units and (2) the Per Unit Capital Amount for an Initial Common Unit.

                        (C)  With respect to any taxable period during which an IDR Reset Common Unit is transferred to any Person who is not an Affiliate of the transferor, all or a portion of the remaining items of Partnership gross income or gain for such taxable period shall be allocated 100% to the transferor Partner of such transferred IDR Reset Common Unit until such transferor Partner has been allocated an amount of gross income or gain that increases the Capital Account maintained with respect to such transferred IDR Reset Common Unit to an amount equal to the Per Unit Capital Amount for an Initial Common Unit.

A-38


Table of Contents

                        (D)  For the proper administration of the Partnership and for the preservation of uniformity of the Limited Partner Interests (or any class or classes thereof), the General Partner shall (1) adopt such conventions as it deems appropriate in determining the amount of depreciation, amortization and cost recovery deductions; (2) make special allocations of income, gain, loss, deduction, Unrealized Gain or Unrealized Loss; and (3) amend the provisions of this Agreement as appropriate (x) to reflect the proposal or promulgation of Treasury Regulations under Section 704(b) or Section 704(c) of the Code or (y) otherwise to preserve or achieve uniformity of the Limited Partner Interests (or any class or classes thereof). The General Partner may adopt such conventions, make such allocations and make such amendments to this Agreement as provided in this Section 6.1(d)(x)(D) only if such conventions, allocations or amendments would not have a material adverse effect on the Partners, the holders of any class or classes of Outstanding Limited Partner Interests or the Partnership.

                    (xi)     Curative Allocation.     

                        (A)  Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section 6.1, other than the Required Allocations, the Required Allocations shall be taken into account in making the Agreed Allocations so that, to the extent possible, the net amount of items of gross income, gain, loss and deduction allocated to each Partner pursuant to the Required Allocations and the Agreed Allocations, together, shall be equal to the net amount of such items that would have been allocated to each such Partner under the Agreed Allocations had the Required Allocations and the related Curative Allocation not otherwise been provided in this Section 6.1. In exercising its discretion under this Section 6.1(d)(xi)(A), the General Partner may take into account future Required Allocations that, although not yet made, are likely to offset other Required Allocations previously made. Allocations pursuant to this Section 6.1(d)(xi)(A) shall only be made with respect to Required Allocations to the extent the General Partner determines that such allocations will otherwise be inconsistent with the economic agreement among the Partners.

                        (B)  The General Partner shall, with respect to each taxable period, (1) apply the provisions of Section 6.1(d)(xi)(A) in whatever order is most likely to minimize the economic distortions that might otherwise result from the Required Allocations, and (2) divide all allocations pursuant to Section 6.1(d)(xi)(A) among the Partners in a manner that is likely to minimize such economic distortions.

                    (xii)     Corrective and Other Allocations.     In the event of any allocation of Additional Book Basis Derivative Items or any Book-Down Event or any recognition of a Net Termination Loss, the following rules shall apply:

                        (A)  Except as provided in Section 6.1(d)(xii)(B), in the case of any allocation of Additional Book Basis Derivative Items (other than an allocation of Unrealized Gain or Unrealized Loss under Section 5.5(d) hereof), the General Partner shall allocate such Additional Book Basis Derivative Items to (1) the holders of Incentive Distribution Rights to the same extent that the Unrealized Gain or Unrealized Loss giving rise to such Additional Book Basis Derivative Items was allocated to them pursuant to Section 5.5(d) and (2) all Unitholders, Pro Rata, to the extent that the Unrealized Gain or Unrealized Loss giving rise to such Additional Book Basis Derivative Items was allocated to any Unitholders pursuant to Section 5.5(d).

                        (B)  In the case of any allocation of Additional Book Basis Derivative Items (other than an allocation of Unrealized Gain or Unrealized Loss under Section 5.5(d)

A-39


Table of Contents

          hereof or an allocation of Net Termination Gain or Net Termination Loss pursuant to Section 6.1(c) hereof) as a result of a sale or other taxable disposition of any Partnership asset that is an Adjusted Property (" Disposed of Adjusted Property "), the General Partner shall allocate (1) additional items of gross income and gain (x) away from the holders of Incentive Distribution Rights and (y) to the Unitholders, or (2) additional items of deduction and loss (x) away from the Unitholders and (y) to the holders of Incentive Distribution Rights, to the extent that the Additional Book Basis Derivative Items allocated to the Unitholders exceed their Share of Additional Book Basis Derivative Items with respect to such Disposed of Adjusted Property. Any allocation made pursuant to this Section 6.1(d)(xii)(B) shall be made after all of the other Agreed Allocations have been made as if this Section 6.1(d)(xii) were not in this Agreement and, to the extent necessary, shall require the reallocation of items that have been allocated pursuant to such other Agreed Allocations.

                        (C)  In the case of any negative adjustments to the Capital Accounts of the Partners resulting from a Book-Down Event or from the recognition of a Net Termination Loss, such negative adjustment (1) shall first be allocated, to the extent of the Aggregate Remaining Net Positive Adjustments, in such a manner, as determined by the General Partner, that to the extent possible the aggregate Capital Accounts of the Partners will equal the amount that would have been the Capital Account balances of the Partners if no prior Book-Up Events had occurred, and (2) any negative adjustment in excess of the Aggregate Remaining Net Positive Adjustments shall be allocated pursuant to Section 6.1(c) hereof.

                        (D)  For purposes of this Section 6.1(d)(xii), the Unitholders shall be treated as being allocated Additional Book Basis Derivative Items to the extent that such Additional Book Basis Derivative Items have reduced the amount of income that would otherwise have been allocated to the Unitholders under this Agreement. In making the allocations required under this Section 6.1(d)(xii), the General Partner may apply whatever conventions or other methodology it determines will satisfy the purpose of this Section 6.1(d)(xii). Without limiting the foregoing, if an Adjusted Property is contributed by the Partnership to another entity classified as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes (the "lower tier partnership"), the General Partner may make allocations similar to those described in Sections 6.1(d)(xii)(A)—(C) to the extent the General Partner determines such allocations are necessary to account for the Partnership's allocable share of income, gain, loss and deduction of the lower tier partnership that relate to the contributed Adjusted Property in a manner that is consistent with the purpose of this Section 6.1(d)(xii).

                    (xiii)     Special Curative Allocation in Event of Liquidation Prior to End of Subordination Period.     Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section 6.1 (other than the Required Allocations), if the Liquidation Date occurs prior to the conversion of the last Outstanding Subordinated Unit, then items of income, gain, loss and deduction for the taxable period that includes the Liquidation Date (and, if necessary, items arising in previous taxable periods to the extent the General Partner determines such items may be so allocated), shall be specially allocated among the Partners in the manner determined appropriate by the General Partner so as to cause, to the maximum extent possible, the Capital Account in respect of each Common Unit to equal the amount such Capital Account would have been if all prior allocations of Net Termination Gain and Net Termination Loss had been made pursuant to Section 6.1(c)(i) or Section 6.1(c)(ii), as applicable.

                    (xiv)     Special Allocation in Event of Section 482 Adjustment.     If, and to the extent that, the Partnership is deemed to recognize any item of income, gain, loss or deduction (or any

A-40


Table of Contents

      adjustment to these items) pursuant to Section 482 of the Code or similar provision now or hereafter in effect and the Treasury Regulations promulgated thereunder as a result of any transaction between a Partner and the Partnership, the General Partner shall allocate such items among the Partners in a manner that will, as nearly as possible, cause the Capital Account balance of each Partner (taking into account any deemed contributions or distributions) to equal the amount it would have been had no adjustment under Section 482 or similar provision been made.

              Section 6.2     Allocations for Tax Purposes.     

              (a)   Except as otherwise provided herein, for U.S. federal income tax purposes, each item of income, gain, loss and deduction shall be allocated among the Partners in the same manner as its correlative item of "book" income, gain, loss or deduction is allocated pursuant to Section 6.1.

              (b)   In an attempt to eliminate Book-Tax Disparities attributable to a Contributed Property or Adjusted Property, items of income, gain, loss, depreciation, amortization and cost recovery deductions shall be allocated for U.S. federal income tax purposes among the Partners in the manner provided under Section 704(c) of the Code, and the Treasury Regulations promulgated under Section 704(b) and 704(c) of the Code, as determined appropriate by the General Partner (taking into account the General Partner's discretion under Section 6.1(d)(x)(D)); provided , that the General Partner shall apply the principles of Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-3(d) in all events.

              (c)   The General Partner may determine to depreciate or amortize the portion of an adjustment under Section 743(b) of the Code attributable to unrealized appreciation in any Adjusted Property (to the extent of the unamortized Book-Tax Disparity) using a predetermined rate derived from the depreciation or amortization method and useful life applied to the unamortized Book-Tax Disparity of such property, despite any inconsistency of such approach with Treasury Regulation Section 1.167(c)-l(a)(6) or any successor regulations thereto. If the General Partner determines that such reporting position cannot reasonably be taken, the General Partner may adopt depreciation and amortization conventions under which all purchasers acquiring Limited Partner Interests in the same month would receive depreciation and amortization deductions, based upon the same applicable rate as if they had purchased a direct interest in the Partnership's property. If the General Partner chooses not to utilize such aggregate method, the General Partner may use any other depreciation and amortization conventions to preserve the uniformity of the intrinsic tax characteristics of any Limited Partner Interests, so long as such conventions would not have a material adverse effect on the Limited Partners or the Record Holders of any class or classes of Limited Partner Interests.

              (d)   In accordance with Treasury Regulation Sections 1.1245-1(e) and 1.1250-1(f), any gain allocated to the Partners upon the sale or other taxable disposition of any Partnership asset shall, to the extent possible, after taking into account other required allocations of gain pursuant to this Section 6.2, be characterized as Recapture Income in the same proportions and to the same extent as such Partners (or their predecessors in interest) have been allocated any deductions directly or indirectly giving rise to the treatment of such gains as Recapture Income.

              (e)   All items of income, gain, loss, deduction and credit recognized by the Partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes and allocated to the Partners in accordance with the provisions hereof shall be determined without regard to any election under Section 754 of the Code that may be made by the Partnership; provided, however , that such allocations, once made, shall be adjusted (in the manner determined by the General Partner) to take into account those adjustments permitted or required by Sections 734 and 743 of the Code.

              (f)    Each item of Partnership income, gain, loss and deduction shall, for U.S. federal income tax purposes, be determined for each taxable period and prorated on a monthly basis and shall be allocated to the Partners as of the opening of the National Securities Exchange on which Partnership Interests are listed or admitted to trading on the first Business Day of each month; provided, however ,

A-41


Table of Contents

such items for the period beginning on the Closing Date and ending on the last day of the month in which the Over-Allotment Option is exercised in full or the expiration of the Over-Allotment Option occurs shall be allocated to the Partners as of the opening of the National Securities Exchange on which Partnership Interests are listed or admitted to trading on the first Business Day of the next succeeding month; provided, further , that gain or loss on a sale or other disposition of any assets of the Partnership or any other extraordinary item of income, gain, loss or deduction as determined by the General Partner, shall be allocated to the Partners as of the opening of the National Securities Exchange on which Partnership Interests are listed or admitted to trading on the first Business Day of the month in which such item is recognized for federal income tax purposes. The General Partner may revise, alter or otherwise modify such methods of allocation to the extent permitted or required by Section 706 of the Code and the regulations or rulings promulgated thereunder.

              (g)   Allocations that would otherwise be made to a Limited Partner under the provisions of this Article VI shall instead be made to the beneficial owner of Limited Partner Interests held by a nominee in any case in which the nominee has furnished the identity of such owner to the Partnership in accordance with Section 6031(c) of the Code or any other method determined by the General Partner.

              Section 6.3     Requirements and Characterization of Distributions; Distributions to Record Holders.     

              (a)   Within 60 days following the end of each Quarter commencing with the Quarter ending on [September 30,] 2012, an amount equal to 100% of Available Cash with respect to such Quarter shall be distributed in accordance with this Section 6.3 by the Partnership to Partners as of the Record Date selected by the General Partner. All amounts of Available Cash distributed by the Partnership on any date from any source shall be deemed to be Operating Surplus until the sum of all amounts of Available Cash theretofore distributed by the Partnership to the Partners pursuant to Section 6.4 equals the Operating Surplus from the Closing Date through the close of the immediately preceding Quarter. Any remaining amounts of Available Cash distributed by the Partnership on such date shall, except as otherwise provided in Section 6.5, be deemed to be " Capital Surplus ." All distributions required to be made under this Agreement or otherwise made by the Partnership shall be made subject to Sections 17-607 and 17-804 of the Delaware Act.

              (b)   Notwithstanding Section 6.3(a), in the event of the dissolution and liquidation of the Partnership, all Partnership assets shall be applied and distributed solely in accordance with, and subject to the terms and conditions of, Section 12.4.

              (c)   Each distribution in respect of a Partnership Interest shall be paid by the Partnership, directly or through any Transfer Agent or through any other Person or agent, only to the Record Holder of such Partnership Interest as of the Record Date set for such distribution. Such payment shall constitute full payment and satisfaction of the Partnership's liability in respect of such payment, regardless of any claim of any Person who may have an interest in such payment by reason of an assignment or otherwise.

              Section 6.4     Distributions of Available Cash from Operating Surplus.     

              (a)     During Subordination Period.     Available Cash with respect to any Quarter wholly within the Subordination Period that is deemed to be Operating Surplus pursuant to the provisions of Section 6.3 or 6.5 shall be distributed as follows, except as otherwise contemplated by Section 5.6(b) in respect of other Partnership Interests issued pursuant thereto:

                             (i)  First, to all Unitholders holding Common Units, Pro Rata, until there has been distributed in respect of each Common Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the Minimum Quarterly Distribution for such Quarter;

A-42


Table of Contents

                            (ii)  Second, to all Unitholders holding Common Units, Pro Rata, until there has been distributed in respect of each Common Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the Cumulative Common Unit Arrearage existing with respect to such Quarter;

                          (iii)  Third, to all Unitholders holding Subordinated Units, Pro Rata, until there has been distributed in respect of each Subordinated Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the Minimum Quarterly Distribution for such Quarter;

                           (iv)  Fourth, to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, until there has been distributed in respect of each Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the excess of the First Target Distribution over the Minimum Quarterly Distribution for such Quarter;

                            (v)  Fifth, (A) 15.0% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata; and (B) 85.0% to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, until there has been distributed in respect of each Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the excess of the Second Target Distribution over the First Target Distribution for such Quarter;

                           (vi)  Sixth, (A) 25.0% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata; and (B) 75.0% to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, until there has been distributed in respect of each Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the excess of the Third Target Distribution over the Second Target Distribution for such Quarter; and

                          (vii)  Thereafter, 50.0% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata; and (B) 50.0% to all Unitholders, Pro Rata;

provided, however , if the Target Distributions have been reduced to zero pursuant to the second sentence of Section 6.6(a), the distribution of Available Cash that is deemed to be Operating Surplus with respect to any Quarter will be made solely in accordance with Section 6.4(a)(vii).

              (b)     After Subordination Period.     Available Cash with respect to any Quarter ending after the Subordination Period has ended that is deemed to be Operating Surplus pursuant to the provisions of Section 6.3 or Section 6.5 shall be distributed as follows, except as otherwise contemplated by Section 5.6(b) in respect of additional Partnership Interests issued pursuant thereto:

                             (i)  First, to all the Unitholders, Pro Rata, until there has been distributed in respect of each Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the Minimum Quarterly Distribution for such Quarter;

                            (ii)  Second, to all the Unitholders, Pro Rata, until there has been distributed in respect of each Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the excess of the First Target Distribution over the Minimum Quarterly Distribution for such Quarter;

                          (iii)  Third, (A) 15.0% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata; and (B) 85.0% to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, until there has been distributed in respect of each Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the excess of the Second Target Distribution over the First Target Distribution for such Quarter;

                           (iv)  Fourth, (A) 25.0% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata; and (B) 75.0% to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, until there has been distributed in respect of each Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the excess of the Third Target Distribution over the Second Target Distribution for such Quarter; and

                            (v)  Thereafter, (A) 50.0% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata; and (B) 50.0% to all Unitholders, Pro Rata;

provided, however , if the Target Distributions have been reduced to zero pursuant to the second sentence of Section 6.6(a), the distribution of Available Cash that is deemed to be Operating Surplus with respect to any Quarter will be made solely in accordance with Section 6.4(b)(v).

A-43


Table of Contents

              Section 6.5 Distributions of Available Cash from Capital Surplus . Available Cash that is deemed to be Capital Surplus pursuant to the provisions of Section 6.3(a) shall be distributed, unless the provisions of Section 6.3 require otherwise:

              (a)   First, 100% to all the Unitholders, Pro Rata, until the Minimum Quarterly Distribution has been reduced to zero pursuant to the second sentence of Section 6.6(a);

              (b)   Second, 100% to all Unitholders holding Common Units, Pro Rata, until there has been distributed in respect of each Common Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the Cumulative Common Unit Arrearage; and

              (c)   Thereafter, all Available Cash shall be distributed as if it were Operating Surplus and shall be distributed in accordance with Section 6.4.

              Section 6.6     Adjustment of Minimum Quarterly Distribution and Target Distribution Levels.     

              (a)   The Target Distributions, Common Unit Arrearages and Cumulative Common Unit Arrearages shall be proportionately adjusted in the event of any distribution, combination or subdivision (whether effected by a distribution payable in Units or otherwise) of Units or other Partnership Interests. In the event of a distribution of Available Cash that is deemed to be from Capital Surplus, the then applicable Target Distributions shall be reduced in the same proportion that the distribution had to the fair market value of the Common Units immediately prior to the announcement of the distribution. If the Common Units are publicly traded on a National Securities Exchange, the fair market value will be the Current Market Price before the ex-dividend date. If the Common Units are not publicly traded, the fair market value will be determined by the Board of Directors.

              (b)   The Target Distributions shall also be subject to adjustment pursuant to Section 5.11 and Section 6.8.

              Section 6.7     Special Provisions Relating to the Holders of Subordinated Units.     

              (a)   Except with respect to the right to vote on or approve matters requiring the vote or approval of a percentage of the holders of Outstanding Common Units and the right to participate in allocations of income, gain, loss and deduction and distributions made with respect to Common Units, the holder of a Subordinated Unit shall have all of the rights and obligations of a Unitholder holding Common Units hereunder; provided, however , that immediately upon the conversion of Subordinated Units into Common Units pursuant to Section 5.7, the Unitholder holding Subordinated Units shall possess all of the rights and obligations of a Unitholder holding Common Units hereunder with respect to such converted Subordinated Units, including the right to vote as a Common Unitholder and the right to participate in allocations of income, gain, loss and deduction and distributions made with respect to Common Units; provided, however , that such converted Subordinated Units shall remain subject to the provisions of Section 5.5(c)(ii), Section 6.1(d)(x), and Section 6.7(b) and (c).

              (b)   A Unitholder shall not be permitted to transfer a Subordinated Unit or a Subordinated Unit that has converted into a Common Unit pursuant to Section 5.7 (other than a transfer to an Affiliate) if the remaining balance in the transferring Unitholder's Capital Account with respect to the retained Subordinated Units or retained converted Subordinated Units would be negative after giving effect to the allocation under Section 5.5(c)(ii).

              (c)   The Unitholder holding a Common Unit that has resulted from the conversion of a Subordinated Unit pursuant to Section 5.7 shall not be issued a Common Unit Certificate pursuant to Section 4.1, if the Common Units are evidenced by Certificates, and shall not be permitted to transfer such Common Unit to a Person that is not an Affiliate of the holder until such time as the General Partner determines, based on advice of counsel, that each such Common Unit should have, as a substantive matter, like intrinsic economic and federal income tax characteristics, in all material respects, to the intrinsic economic and federal income tax characteristics of an Initial Common Unit. In

A-44


Table of Contents

connection with the condition imposed by this Section 6.7(c), the General Partner may take whatever steps are required to provide economic uniformity to such Common Units in preparation for a transfer of such Common Units, including the application of Sections 5.5(c)(ii), 6.1(d)(x) and 6.7(b); provided, however , that no such steps may be taken that would have a material adverse effect on the Unitholders holding a Common Unit.

              Section 6.8     Special Provisions Relating to the Holders of IDR Reset Common Units.     

              (a)   A Unitholder shall not be permitted to transfer an IDR Reset Common Unit (other than a transfer to an Affiliate) if the remaining balance in the transferring Unitholder's Capital Account with respect to the retained IDR Reset Common Units would be negative after giving effect to the allocation under Section 5.5(c)(iii).

              (b)   A Unitholder holding an IDR Reset Common Unit shall not be permitted to transfer such Common Unit to a Person that is not an Affiliate of the holder until such time as the General Partner determines, based on advice of counsel, that upon transfer each such Common Unit should have, as a substantive matter, like intrinsic economic and U.S. federal income tax characteristics to the transferee, in all material respects, to the intrinsic economic and U.S. federal income tax characteristics of an Initial Common Unit to such transferee. In connection with the condition imposed by this Section 6.8(b), the General Partner may apply Sections 5.5(c)(iii), 6.1(d)(x) and 6.8(a) or, to the extent not resulting in a material adverse effect on the Unitholders holding Common Units, take whatever steps are required to provide economic uniformity to such Common Units in preparation for a transfer of such IDR Reset Common Units.

              Section 6.9     Entity-Level Taxation.     If legislation is enacted or the official interpretation of existing legislation is modified by a governmental authority, which after giving effect to such enactment or modification, results in a Group Member becoming subject to federal, state or local or non-U.S. income or withholding taxes in excess of the amount of such taxes due from the Group Member prior to such enactment or modification (including, for the avoidance of doubt, any increase in the rate of such taxation applicable to the Group Member), then the General Partner may, in its sole discretion, reduce the Target Distributions by the amount of income or withholding taxes that are payable by reason of any such new legislation or interpretation (the " Incremental Income Taxes "), or any portion thereof selected by the General Partner, in the manner provided in this Section 6.9. If the General Partner elects to reduce the Target Distributions for any Quarter with respect to all or a portion of any Incremental Income Taxes, the General Partner shall estimate for such Quarter the Partnership Group's aggregate liability (the " Estimated Incremental Quarterly Tax Amount ") for all (or the relevant portion of) such Incremental Income Taxes; provided that any difference between such estimate and the actual liability for Incremental Income Taxes (or the relevant portion thereof) for such Quarter may, to the extent determined by the General Partner, be taken into account in determining the Estimated Incremental Quarterly Tax Amount with respect to each Quarter in which any such difference can be determined. For each such Quarter, the Target Distributions, shall be the product obtained by multiplying (a) the amounts therefor that are set out herein prior to the application of this Section 6.9 times (b) the quotient obtained by dividing (i) Available Cash with respect to such Quarter by (ii) the sum of Available Cash with respect to such Quarter and the Estimated Incremental Quarterly Tax Amount for such Quarter, as determined by the General Partner. For purposes of the foregoing, Available Cash with respect to a Quarter will be deemed reduced by the Estimated Incremental Quarterly Tax Amount for that Quarter.

A-45


Table of Contents

ARTICLE VII

MANAGEMENT AND OPERATION OF BUSINESS

              Section 7.1     Management.     

              (a)   The General Partner shall conduct, direct and manage all activities of the Partnership. Except as otherwise expressly provided in this Agreement, but without limitation on the ability of the General Partner to delegate its rights and power to other Persons, all management powers over the business and affairs of the Partnership shall be exclusively vested in the General Partner, and no other Partner shall have any management power over the business and affairs of the Partnership. In addition to the powers now or hereafter granted to a general partner of a limited partnership under applicable law or that are granted to the General Partner under any other provision of this Agreement, the General Partner, subject to Section 7.4, shall have full power and authority to do all things and on such terms as it determines to be necessary or appropriate to conduct the business of the Partnership, to exercise all powers set forth in Section 2.5 and to effectuate the purposes set forth in Section 2.4, including the following:

                             (i)  the making of any expenditures, the lending or borrowing of money, the assumption or guarantee of, or other contracting for, indebtedness and other liabilities, the issuance of evidences of indebtedness, including indebtedness that is convertible or exchangeable into Partnership Interests, and the incurring of any other obligations;

                            (ii)  the making of tax, regulatory and other filings, or rendering of periodic or other reports to governmental or other agencies having jurisdiction over the business or assets of the Partnership;

                          (iii)  the acquisition, disposition, mortgage, pledge, encumbrance, hypothecation or exchange of any or all of the assets of the Partnership or the merger or other combination of the Partnership with or into another Person (the matters described in this clause (iii) being subject, however, to any prior approval that may be required by Section 7.4 or Article XIV);

                           (iv)  the use of the assets of the Partnership (including cash on hand) for any purpose consistent with the terms of this Agreement, including the financing of the conduct of the operations of the Partnership Group; the lending of funds to other Persons (including other Group Members); the repayment or guarantee of obligations of any Group Member; and the making of capital contributions to any Group Member;

                            (v)  the negotiation, execution and performance of any contracts, conveyances or other instruments (including instruments that limit the liability of the Partnership under contractual arrangements to all or particular assets of the Partnership, with the other party to the contract to have no recourse against the General Partner or its assets other than its interest in the Partnership, even if the same results in the terms of the transaction being less favorable to the Partnership than would otherwise be the case);

                           (vi)  the distribution of cash or cash equivalents by the Partnership;

                          (vii)  the selection, employment, retention and dismissal of employees (including employees having titles such as "president," "vice president," "secretary" and "treasurer") and agents, outside attorneys, accountants, consultants and contractors of the General Partner or the Partnership Group and the determination of their compensation and other terms of employment or hiring;

                         (viii)  the maintenance of insurance for the benefit of the Partnership Group, the Partners and Indemnitees;

A-46


Table of Contents

                           (ix)  the formation of, or acquisition of an interest in, and the contribution of property and the making of loans to, any further limited or general partnerships, joint ventures, corporations, limited liability companies or other Persons (including the acquisition of interests in, and the contributions of property to, any Group Member from time to time);

                            (x)  the control of any matters affecting the rights and obligations of the Partnership, including the bringing and defending of actions at law or in equity and otherwise engaging in the conduct of litigation, arbitration or mediation and the incurring of legal expense and the settlement of claims and litigation;

                           (xi)  the indemnification of any Person against liabilities and contingencies to the extent permitted by law;

                          (xii)  the entering into of listing agreements with any National Securities Exchange and the delisting of some or all of the Limited Partner Interests from, or requesting that trading be suspended on, any such exchange;

                         (xiii)  the purchase, sale or other acquisition or disposition of Partnership Interests, or the issuance of Derivative Instruments;

                         (xiv)  the undertaking of any action in connection with the Partnership's participation in the management of any Group Member; and

                          (xv)  the entering into of agreements with any of its Affiliates to render services to a Group Member or to itself in the discharge of its duties as General Partner of the Partnership.

              (b)   Each of the Partners and each other Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest and each other Person who is otherwise bound by this Agreement hereby (i) approves, ratifies and confirms the execution, delivery and performance by the parties thereto of this Agreement, the Underwriting Agreement, the Contribution Agreement and the other agreements described in or filed as exhibits to the Registration Statement that are related to the transactions contemplated by the Registration Statement (in the case of each agreement other than this Agreement, without giving effect to any amendments, supplements or restatements after the date hereof); (ii) agrees that the General Partner (on its own behalf or on behalf of the Partnership) is authorized to execute, deliver and perform the agreements referred to in clause (b) of this sentence and the other agreements, acts, transactions and matters described in or contemplated by the Registration Statement on behalf of the Partnership without any further act, approval or vote of the Partners, the other Persons who acquire a Partnership Interest and the Persons who are otherwise bound by this Agreement; and (iii) agrees that the execution, delivery or performance by the General Partner, any Group Member or any Affiliate of any of them of this Agreement or any agreement authorized or permitted under this Agreement (including the exercise by the General Partner or any Affiliate of the General Partner of the rights accorded pursuant to Article XV) shall not constitute a breach by the General Partner of any fiduciary or other duty existing at law, in equity or otherwise that the General Partner may owe the Partnership, the Limited Partners, the other Persons who acquire a Partnership Interest or the Persons who are otherwise bound by this Agreement.

              (c)   As used in the following provisions of this Article VII other than Section 7.12, the term Partnership Interest shall include any Derivative Instruments.

              Section 7.2     Replacement of Fiduciary Duties.     

              Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement, to the extent that any provision of this Agreement purports or is interpreted (a) to have the effect of replacing, restricting or eliminating the duties that might otherwise, as a result of Delaware or other applicable law, be owed by the General Partner or any other Indemnitee to the Partnership, the Limited Partners, any other Person who

A-47


Table of Contents

acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest or any other Person who is bound by this Agreement, or (b) to constitute a waiver or consent by the Partnership, the Limited Partners, any other Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest or any other Person who is bound by this Agreement to any such replacement or restriction, such provision shall be deemed to have been approved by the Partnership, all the Partners, each other Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest and each other Person who is bound by this Agreement.

              Section 7.3     Certificate of Limited Partnership.     The General Partner has caused the Certificate of Limited Partnership to be filed with the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware as required by the Delaware Act. The General Partner shall use all reasonable efforts to cause to be filed such other certificates or documents that the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate for the formation, continuation, qualification and operation of a limited partnership (or a partnership in which the limited partners have limited liability) in the State of Delaware or any other state in which the Partnership may elect to do business or own property. To the extent the General Partner determines such action to be necessary or appropriate, the General Partner shall file amendments to and restatements of the Certificate of Limited Partnership and do all things to maintain the Partnership as a limited partnership (or a partnership or other entity in which the limited partners have limited liability) under the laws of the State of Delaware or of any other state in which the Partnership may elect to do business or own property. Subject to the terms of Section 3.4(a), the General Partner shall not be required, before or after filing, to deliver or mail a copy of the Certificate of Limited Partnership, any qualification document or any amendment thereto to any Partner.

              Section 7.4     Restrictions on the General Partner's Authority.     Except as provided in Article XII and Article XIV, the General Partner may not sell, exchange or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all of the assets of the Partnership Group, taken as a whole, in a single transaction or a series of related transactions without the approval of a Unit Majority; provided, however, that this provision shall not preclude or limit the General Partner's ability to mortgage, pledge, hypothecate or grant a security interest in all or substantially all of the assets of the Partnership Group and shall not apply to any forced sale of any or all of the assets of the Partnership Group pursuant to the foreclosure of, or other realization upon, any such encumbrance.

              Section 7.5     Reimbursement of the General Partner.     

              (a)   The General Partner shall be reimbursed by the Partnership Group on a monthly basis, or such other basis as the General Partner may determine, for (i) all direct and indirect expenses it incurs or payments it makes on behalf of the Partnership Group (including salary, bonus, incentive compensation and other amounts paid to any Person (including Affiliates of the General Partner) to perform services for the Partnership Group or for the General Partner in the discharge of its duties to the Partnership Group), and (ii) all other expenses allocable to the Partnership Group or otherwise incurred by the General Partner in connection with operating the Partnership Group's business (including expenses allocated to the General Partner by its Affiliates). The General Partner shall determine the expenses that are allocable to the General Partner or any member of the Partnership Group. Reimbursements pursuant to this Section 7.5 shall be in addition to any reimbursement to the General Partner as a result of indemnification pursuant to Section 7.7. The General Partner and its Affiliates may charge any member of the Partnership Group a management fee to the extent necessary to allow the Partnership Group to reduce the amount of any state franchise or income tax or any tax based upon revenues or gross margin of any member of the Partnership Group if the tax benefit produced by the payment for such management fee exceeds the amount of such fee.

              (b)   The General Partner, without the approval of the Limited Partners (who shall have no right to vote in respect thereof), may propose and adopt on behalf of the Partnership benefit plans, programs and practices (including plans, programs and practices involving the issuance of Partnership Interests), or cause the Partnership to issue Partnership Interests in connection with, or pursuant to,

A-48


Table of Contents

any benefit plan, program or practice maintained or sponsored by the General Partner or any of its Affiliates, in each case for the benefit of employees, officers, consultants and directors of the General Partner or its Affiliates, in respect of services performed, directly or indirectly, for the benefit of the Partnership Group. The Partnership agrees to issue and sell to the General Partner or any of its Affiliates any Partnership Interests that the General Partner or such Affiliates are obligated to provide to any employees, officers, consultants and directors pursuant to any such benefit plans, programs or practices. Expenses incurred by the General Partner in connection with any such plans, programs and practices (including the net cost to the General Partner or such Affiliates of Partnership Interests purchased by the General Partner or such Affiliates, from the Partnership or otherwise, to fulfill awards under such plans, programs and practices) shall be reimbursed in accordance with Section 7.5(a). Any and all obligations of the General Partner under any benefit plans, programs or practices adopted by the General Partner as permitted by this Section 7.5(b) shall constitute obligations of the General Partner hereunder and shall be assumed by any successor General Partner approved pursuant to Section 11.1 or Section 11.2 or the transferee of or successor to all of the General Partner's General Partner Interest pursuant to Section 4.6.

              Section 7.6     Outside Activities.     

              (a)   The General Partner, for so long as it is the General Partner of the Partnership, shall not engage in any business or activity or incur any debts or liabilities except in connection with or incidental to (A) its performance as general partner or managing member, if any, of one or more Group Members or as described in or contemplated by the Registration Statement, (B) the acquiring, owning or disposing of debt securities or equity interests in any Group Member or (C) the direct or indirect provision of management, advisory, and administrative services to its Affiliates or to other Persons.

              (b)   Except to the extent otherwise set forth in the Omnibus Agreement, each Unrestricted Person (other than the General Partner) shall have the right to engage in businesses of every type and description and other activities for profit and to engage in and possess an interest in other business ventures of any and every type or description, whether in businesses engaged in or anticipated to be engaged in by any Group Member, independently or with others, including business interests and activities in direct competition with the business and activities of any Group Member. No such business interest or activity shall constitute a breach of this Agreement, any fiduciary or other duty existing at law, in equity or otherwise, or obligation of any type whatsoever to the Partnership or other Group Member, any Partner, any Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest or any Person who is otherwise bound by this Agreement.

              (c)   Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Agreement, the doctrine of corporate opportunity, or any analogous doctrine, shall not apply to any Unrestricted Person (including the General Partner). Except to the extent otherwise set forth in the Omnibus Agreement, no Unrestricted Person (including the General Partner) who acquires knowledge of a potential transaction, agreement, arrangement or other matter that may be an opportunity for the Partnership, shall have any duty to communicate or offer such opportunity to any Group Member, and such Unrestricted Person (including the General Partner) shall not be liable to the Partnership or any other Group Member, any Partner any person who acquires a Partnership Interest or any other Person who is otherwise bound by this Agreement for breach of any fiduciary or other duty existing at law, in equity or otherwise by reason of the fact that such Unrestricted Person (including the General Partner) pursues or acquires such opportunity for itself, directs such opportunity to another Person or does not communicate such opportunity or information to any Group Member.

              (d)   The General Partner and each of its Affiliates may acquire Units or other Partnership Interests in addition to those acquired on the Closing Date and, except as otherwise expressly provided in this Agreement, shall be entitled to exercise, at their option, all rights relating to all Units or other

A-49


Table of Contents

Partnership Interests acquired by them. The term "Affiliates" when used in this Section 7.6(d) with respect to the General Partner shall not include any Group Member.

              Section 7.7     Indemnification.     

              (a)   To the fullest extent permitted by law, all Indemnitees shall be indemnified and held harmless by the Partnership from and against any and all losses, claims, damages, liabilities, joint or several, expenses (including legal fees and expenses), judgments, fines, penalties, interest, settlements or other amounts arising from any and all threatened pending or completed claims, demands, actions, suits or proceedings, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative, and whether formal or informal and including appeals, in which any Indemnitee may be involved, or is threatened to be involved, as a party or otherwise, by reason of its status as an Indemnitee and acting (or refraining to act) in such capacity; provided , that the Indemnitee shall not be indemnified and held harmless if there has been a final and non-appealable judgment entered by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that, in respect of the matter for which the Indemnitee is seeking indemnification pursuant to this Agreement, the Indemnitee acted in bad faith or engaged in fraud, willful misconduct or, in the case of a criminal matter, acted with knowledge that the Indemnitee's conduct was unlawful [; provided, further that no indemnification pursuant to this Section 7.7 shall be available to the General Partner, any of its Affiliates or any other Indemnitee (other than a Group Member) with respect to its obligations pursuant to the Underwriting Agreement or the Omnibus Agreement]. Any indemnification pursuant to this Section 7.7 shall be made only out of the assets of the Partnership, it being agreed that the General Partner shall not be personally liable for such indemnification and shall have no obligation to contribute or loan any monies or property to the Partnership to enable it to effectuate such indemnification.

              (b)   To the fullest extent permitted by law, expenses (including legal fees and expenses) incurred by an Indemnitee who is indemnified pursuant to Section 7.7(a) in appearing at, participating in or defending any claim, demand, action, suit or proceeding shall, from time to time, be advanced by the Partnership prior to a final and non-appealable judgment entered by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that, in respect of the matter for which the Indemnitee is seeking indemnification pursuant to this Section 7.7, the Indemnitee is not entitled to be indemnified upon receipt by the Partnership of any undertaking by or on behalf of the Indemnitee to repay such amount if it shall be ultimately determined that the Indemnitee is not entitled to be indemnified as authorized by this Section 7.7.

              (c)   The indemnification provided by this Section 7.7 shall be in addition to any other rights to which an Indemnitee may be entitled under any agreement, pursuant to any vote of the holders of Outstanding Limited Partner Interests, as a matter of law, in equity or otherwise, both as to actions in the Indemnitee's capacity as an Indemnitee and as to actions in any other capacity, and shall continue as to an Indemnitee who has ceased to serve in such capacity and shall inure to the benefit of the heirs, successors, assigns and administrators of the Indemnitee.

              (d)   The Partnership may purchase and maintain (or reimburse the General Partner or its Affiliates for the cost of) insurance, on behalf of an Indemnitee and such other Persons as the General Partner shall determine, against any liability that may be asserted against, or expense that may be incurred by, such Indemnitee in connection with the Partnership's activities or such Indemnitee's activities on behalf of the Partnership, regardless of whether the Partnership would have the power to indemnify such Indemnitee against such liability under the provisions of this Agreement.

              (e)   For purposes of this Section 7.7, the Partnership shall be deemed to have requested an Indemnitee to serve as fiduciary of an employee benefit plan whenever the performance by it of its duties to the Partnership also imposes duties on, or otherwise involves services by, it to the plan or participants or beneficiaries of the plan; excise taxes assessed on an Indemnitee with respect to an employee benefit plan pursuant to applicable law shall constitute "fines" within the meaning of

A-50


Table of Contents

Section 7.7(a); and action taken or omitted by an Indemnitee with respect to any employee benefit plan in the performance of its duties for a purpose reasonably believed by it to be in the best interest of the participants and beneficiaries of the plan shall be deemed to be for a purpose that is in the best interests of the Partnership.

              (f)    In no event may an Indemnitee subject the Limited Partners to personal liability by reason of the indemnification provisions set forth in this Agreement.

              (g)   An Indemnitee shall not be denied indemnification in whole or in part under this Section 7.7 because the Indemnitee had an interest in the transaction with respect to which the indemnification applies if the transaction was otherwise permitted by the terms of this Agreement.

              (h)   The provisions of this Section 7.7 are for the benefit of the Indemnitees and their heirs, successors, assigns, executors and administrators and shall not be deemed to create any rights for the benefit of any other Persons.

              (i)    No amendment, modification or repeal of this Section 7.7 or any provision hereof shall in any manner terminate, reduce or impair the right of any past, present or future Indemnitee to be indemnified by the Partnership, nor the obligations of the Partnership to indemnify any such Indemnitee under and in accordance with the provisions of this Section 7.7 as in effect immediately prior to such amendment, modification or repeal with respect to claims arising from or relating to matters occurring, in whole or in part, prior to such amendment, modification or repeal, regardless of when such claims may arise or be asserted.

              Section 7.8     Liability of Indemnitees.     

              (a)   Notwithstanding anything to the contrary set forth in this Agreement, no Indemnitee shall be liable for monetary damages to the Partnership, the Partners or any other Persons who have acquired interests in a Partnership Interest or is otherwise bound by this Agreement, for losses sustained or liabilities incurred as a result of any act or omission of an Indemnitee unless there has been a final and non-appealable judgment entered by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that, in respect of the matter in question, the Indemnitee acted in bad faith or engaged in fraud, willful misconduct or, in the case of a criminal matter, acted with knowledge that the Indemnitee's conduct was criminal. In the case where an Indemnitee is liable for damages, those damages shall only be direct damages and shall not include punitive damages, consequential damages or lost profits.

              (b)   The General Partner may exercise any of the powers granted to it by this Agreement and perform any of the duties imposed upon it hereunder either directly or by or through its agents, and the General Partner shall not be responsible for any misconduct or negligence on the part of any such agent appointed by the General Partner in good faith.

              (c)   To the extent that, at law or in equity, an Indemnitee has duties (including fiduciary duties) and liabilities relating thereto to the Partnership, the Partners, any Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest or is otherwise bound by this Agreement, the General Partner and any other Indemnitee acting in connection with the Partnership's business or affairs shall not be liable, to the fullest extent permitted by law, to the Partnership, the Partners, any Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest or is otherwise bound by this Agreement, for its reliance on the provisions of this Agreement.

              (d)   Any amendment, modification or repeal of this Section 7.8 or any provision hereof shall be prospective only and shall not in any way affect the limitations on the liability of the Indemnitees under this Section 7.8 as in effect immediately prior to such amendment, modification or repeal with respect to claims arising from or relating to matters occurring, in whole or in part, prior to such amendment, modification or repeal, regardless of when such claims may arise or be asserted.

A-51


Table of Contents

              Section 7.9     Standards of Conduct and Modification of Duties.     

              (a)   Whenever the General Partner, the Board of Directors or any committee of the Board of Directors (including the Conflicts Committee), makes a determination or takes or declines to take any other action, or any Affiliates of the General Partner cause the General Partner to do so, in its capacity as the general partner of the Partnership as opposed to in its individual capacity, whether under this Agreement, any Group Member Agreement or any other agreement contemplated hereby or otherwise, then, unless another express standard is provided for in this Agreement, the General Partner, the Board of Directors, such committee or such Affiliates causing the General Partner to do so, shall make such determination or take or decline to take such other action in good faith and shall not be subject to any higher standard contemplated hereby or under the Delaware Act or any other law, rule or regulation or at equity. A determination, other action or failure to act by the General Partner, the Board of Directors of the General Partner or any committee thereof (including the Conflicts Committee) will be deemed to be in good faith unless the General Partner, the Board of Directors of the General Partner or any committee thereof (including the Conflicts Committee) believed such determination, other action or failure to act was adverse to the interests of the Partnership. In any proceeding brought by the Partnership, any Limited Partner, or any Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest or any other Person who is bound by this Agreement challenging such action, determination or failure to act, the Person bringing or prosecuting such proceeding shall have the burden of proving that such determination, action or failure to act was not in good faith.

              (b)   Whenever the General Partner makes a determination or takes or declines to take any other action, or any of its Affiliates causes it to do so, in its individual capacity as opposed to in its capacity as the general partner of the Partnership, whether under this Agreement or any other agreement contemplated hereby or otherwise, then the General Partner, or such Affiliates causing it to do so, are entitled, to the fullest extent permitted by law, to make such determination or to take or decline to take such other action free of any fiduciary duty or other duty existing at law, in equity or otherwise or obligation whatsoever to the Partnership, any Limited Partner, any other Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest or any other Person who otherwise is bound by this Agreement, and the General Partner, or such Affiliates causing it to do so, shall not, to the fullest extent permitted by law, be required to act in good faith or pursuant to any other standard imposed by this Agreement or any other agreement contemplated hereby or under the Delaware Act or any other law, rule or regulation or at equity. By way of illustration and not of limitation, whenever the phrases, "at the option of the General Partner," "in its sole discretion" or some variation of those phrases, are used in this Agreement, it indicates that the General Partner is acting in its individual capacity. For the avoidance of doubt, whenever the General Partner votes or transfers its Partnership Interests, or refrains from voting or transferring its Partnership Interests, it shall be acting in its individual capacity.

              (c)   Whenever a potential conflict of interest exists or arises between the General Partner or any Affiliates, on the one hand, and the Partnership, any Group Member or any Partner, any other Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest or any other Person who is bound by this Agreement on the other hand, the General Partner may in its discretion submit any resolution or course of action with respect to such conflict of interest for (i) Special Approval or (ii) approval by the vote of a majority of the Common Units (excluding Common Units owned by the General Partner and its Affiliates). If such course of action or resolution receives Special Approval or approval of a majority of the Common Units (excluding Common Units owned by the General Partner and its Affiliates), then such course of action or resolution shall be conclusively deemed approved by the Partnership, all the Partners, each Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest and each other Person who is bound by this Agreement, and shall not constitute a breach of this Agreement, of any Group Member Agreement, of any agreement contemplated herein or therein, or of any fiduciary or other duty existing at law, in equity or otherwise or obligation of any type whatsoever. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Agreement or any duty otherwise existing at law or equity, the existence of the conflicts

A-52


Table of Contents

of interest described in the Registration Statement and any actions of the General Partner taken in connection therewith, including any conflicts of interest arising from the provision of Potential SHC Financial Support or other Permitted Actions, are hereby approved by all Partners and shall not constitute a breach of this Agreement or of any duty hereunder or existing at law, in equity or otherwise. For the avoidance of doubt, any potential conflict of interest that exists or arises between the General Partner or any Affiliates, on the one hand, and the Partnership, any Group Member or any Partner, any other Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest or any other Person who is bound by this Agreement on the other hand may be resolved as provided in this Section 7.9(c)(i) and (ii) or as directed by the Board of Directors of the General Partner, provided that the Board of Directors of the General Partner makes takes or declines to take any action to resolve the conflict in accordance with the standard of care set forth in Section 7.9(a).

              (d)   Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Agreement, the General Partner and its Affiliates or any other Indemnitee shall have no duty or obligation, express or implied, to (i) sell or otherwise dispose of any asset of the Partnership Group other than in the ordinary course of business or (ii) permit any Group Member to use any facilities or assets of the General Partner and its Affiliates, except as may be provided in contracts entered into from time to time specifically dealing with such use. Any determination by the General Partner or any of its Affiliates to enter into such contracts shall be in its sole discretion.

              (e)   The Partners, each Person who acquires an interest in a Partnership Interest or is otherwise bound by this Agreement hereby authorize the General Partner, on behalf of the Partnership as a partner or member of a Group Member, to approve actions by the general partner or managing member of such Group Member similar to those actions permitted to be taken by the General Partner pursuant to this Section 7.9.

              Section 7.10     Other Matters Concerning the General Partner and Indemnitees.     

              (a)   The General Partner and any other Indemnitee may rely upon, and shall be protected in acting or refraining from acting upon, any resolution, certificate, statement, instrument, opinion, report, notice, request, consent, order, bond, debenture or other paper or document believed by it to be genuine and to have been signed or presented by the proper party or parties.

              (b)   The General Partner and any other Indemnitee may consult with legal counsel, accountants, appraisers, management consultants, investment bankers and other consultants and advisers selected by it, and any act taken or omitted in reliance upon the advice or opinion (including an Opinion of Counsel) of such Persons as to matters that the General Partner reasonably believes to be within such Person's professional or expert competence shall be conclusively presumed to have been done or omitted in good faith and in accordance with such advice or opinion.

              (c)   The General Partner shall have the right, in respect of any of its powers or obligations hereunder, to act through any of its duly authorized officers, a duly appointed attorney or attorneys-in-fact or the duly authorized officers of any Group Member.

              Section 7.11     Purchase or Sale of Partnership Interests.     The General Partner may cause the Partnership to purchase or otherwise acquire Partnership Interests; provided that, except as permitted by Section 4.9, the General Partner may not Cause any Group Member to purchase Subordinated Units during the Subordination Period. As long as Partnership Interests are held by any Group Member, such Partnership Interests shall not be considered Outstanding for any purpose, except as otherwise provided herein. The General Partner or any Affiliate of the General Partner may also purchase or otherwise acquire and sell or otherwise dispose of Partnership Interests for its own account, subject to the provisions of Article IV and Article VX.

A-53


Table of Contents

              Section 7.12     Registration Rights of the General Partner and its Affiliates.     

              (a)   If (i) the General Partner or any Affiliate of the General Partner (including for purposes of this Section 7.12, any Person that is an Affiliate of the General Partner at the date hereof notwithstanding that it may later cease to be an Affiliate of the General Partner) holds Partnership Interests that it desires to sell and (ii) Rule 144 of the Securities Act (or any successor rule or regulation to Rule 144) or another exemption from registration is not available to enable such holder of Partnership Interests (the " Holder ") to dispose of the number of Partnership Interests it desires to sell at the time it desires to do so without registration under the Securities Act, then at the option and upon the request of the Holder, the Partnership shall file with the Commission as promptly as practicable after receiving such request, and use all commercially reasonable efforts to cause to become effective and remain effective for a period of not less than six months following its effective date or such shorter period as shall terminate when all Partnership Interests covered by such registration statement have been sold, a registration statement under the Securities Act registering the offering and sale of the number of Partnership Interests specified by the Holder; provided, however , that the Partnership shall not be required to effect more than three registrations pursuant to this Section 7.12(a); provided further, however , that if the General Partner determines that a postponement of the requested registration would be in the best interests of the Partnership and its Partners due to a pending transaction, investigation or other event, the filing of such registration statement or the effectiveness thereof may be deferred for up to six months, but not thereafter. In connection with any registration pursuant to the immediately preceding sentence, the Partnership shall (i) promptly prepare and file (A) such documents as may be necessary to register or qualify the securities subject to such registration under the securities laws of such states as the Holder shall reasonably request; provided, however , that no such qualification shall be required in any jurisdiction where, as a result thereof, the Partnership would become subject to general service of process or to taxation or qualification to do business as a foreign corporation or partnership doing business in such jurisdiction solely as a result of such registration, and (B) such documents as may be necessary to apply for listing or to list the Partnership Interests subject to such registration on such National Securities Exchange as the Holder shall reasonably request, and (ii) do any and all other acts and things that may be necessary or appropriate to enable the Holder to consummate a public sale of such Partnership Interests in such states. Except as set forth in Section 7.12(c), all costs and expenses of any such registration and offering (other than the underwriting discounts and commissions) shall be paid by the Partnership, without reimbursement by the Holder.

              (b)   If the Partnership shall at any time propose to file a registration statement under the Securities Act for an offering of Partnership Interests for cash (other than an offering relating solely to a benefit plan), the Partnership shall use all commercially reasonable efforts to include such number or amount of Partnership Interests held by any Holder in such registration statement as the Holder shall request; provided, that the Partnership is not required to make any effort or take any action to so include the Partnership Interests of the Holder once the registration statement becomes or is declared effective by the Commission, including any registration statement providing for the offering from time to time of Partnership Interests pursuant to Rule 415 of the Securities Act. If the proposed offering pursuant to this Section 7.12(b) shall be an underwritten offering, then, in the event that the managing underwriter or managing underwriters of such offering advise the Partnership and the Holder that in their opinion the inclusion of all or some of the Holder's Partnership Interests would adversely and materially affect the timing or success of the offering, the Partnership shall include in such offering only that number or amount, if any, of Partnership Interests held by the Holder that, in the opinion of the managing underwriter or managing underwriters, will not so adversely and materially affect the offering. Except as set forth in Section 7.12(c), all costs and expenses of any such registration and offering (other than the underwriting discounts and commissions) shall be paid by the Partnership, without reimbursement by the Holder.

A-54


Table of Contents

              (c)   If underwriters are engaged in connection with any registration referred to in this Section 7.12, the Partnership shall provide indemnification, representations, covenants, opinions and other assurance to the underwriters in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to such underwriters. Further, in addition to and not in limitation of the Partnership's obligation under Section 7.7, the Partnership shall, to the fullest extent permitted by law, indemnify and hold harmless the Holder, its officers and directors and each Person who controls the Holder (within the meaning of the Securities Act) and any agent thereof (collectively, " Indemnified Persons ") from and against any and all losses, claims, damages, liabilities, joint or several, expenses (including legal fees and expenses), judgments, fines, penalties, interest, settlements or other amounts arising from any and all claims, demands, actions, suits or proceedings, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative, in which any Indemnified Person may be involved, or is threatened to be involved, as a party or otherwise, under the Securities Act or otherwise (hereinafter referred to in this Section 7.12(c) as a "claim" and in the plural as "claims") based upon, arising out of or resulting from any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement of any material fact contained in any registration statement under which any Partnership Interests were registered under the Securities Act or any state securities or Blue Sky laws, in any preliminary prospectus (if used prior to the effective date of such registration statement), or in any summary or final prospectus or issuer free writing prospectus or in any amendment or supplement thereto (if used during the period the Partnership is required to keep the registration statement current), or arising out of, based upon or resulting from the omission or alleged omission to state therein a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements made therein not misleading; provided, however , that the Partnership shall not be liable to any Indemnified Person to the extent that any such claim arises out of, is based upon or results from an untrue statement or alleged untrue statement or omission or alleged omission made in such registration statement, such preliminary, summary or final prospectus or free writing prospectus or such amendment or supplement, in reliance upon and in conformity with written information furnished to the Partnership by or on behalf of such Indemnified Person specifically for use in the preparation thereof.

              (d)   The provisions of Section 7.12(a) and Section 7.12(b) shall continue to be applicable with respect to the General Partner (and any of the General Partner's Affiliates) after it ceases to be a general partner of the Partnership, during a period of two years subsequent to the effective date of such cessation and for so long thereafter as is required for the Holder to sell all of the Partnership Interests with respect to which it has requested during such two-year period inclusion in a registration statement otherwise filed or that a registration statement be filed; provided, however , that the Partnership shall not be required to file successive registration statements covering the same Partnership Interests for which registration was demanded during such two-year period. The provisions of Section 7.12(c) shall continue in effect thereafter.

              (e)   The rights to cause the Partnership to register Partnership Interests pursuant to this Section 7.12 may be assigned (but only with all related obligations) by a Holder to a transferee or assignee of such Partnership Interests, provided (i) the Partnership is, within a reasonable time after such transfer, furnished with written notice of the name and address of such transferee or assignee and the Partnership Interests with respect to which such registration rights are being assigned; and (ii) such transferee or assignee agrees in writing to be bound by and subject to the terms set forth in this Section 7.12.

              (f)    Any request to register Partnership Interests pursuant to this Section 7.12 shall (i) specify the Partnership Interests intended to be offered and sold by the Person making the request, (ii) express such Person's present intent to offer such Partnership Interests for distribution, (iii) describe the nature or method of the proposed offer and sale of Partnership Interests, and (iv) contain the undertaking of such Person to provide all such information and materials and take all action as may be required in order to permit the Partnership to comply with all applicable requirements in connection with the registration of such Partnership Interests.

A-55


Table of Contents

              Section 7.13     Reliance by Third Parties.     Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Agreement, any Person dealing with the Partnership shall be entitled to assume that the General Partner and any officer of the General Partner authorized by the General Partner to act on behalf of and in the name of the Partnership has full power and authority to encumber, sell or otherwise use in any manner any and all assets of the Partnership and to enter into any authorized contracts on behalf of the Partnership, and such Person shall be entitled to deal with the General Partner or any such officer as if it were the Partnership's sole party in interest, both legally and beneficially. Each Limited Partner hereby waives, to the fullest extent permitted by law, any and all defenses or other remedies that may be available against such Person to contest, negate or disaffirm any action of the General Partner or any such officer in connection with any such dealing. In no event shall any Person dealing with the General Partner or any such officer or its representatives be obligated to ascertain that the terms of this Agreement have been complied with or to inquire into the necessity or expedience of any act or action of the General Partner or any such officer or its representatives. Each and every certificate, document or other instrument executed on behalf of the Partnership by the General Partner or its representatives shall be conclusive evidence in favor of any and every Person relying thereon or claiming thereunder that (a) at the time of the execution and delivery of such certificate, document or instrument, this Agreement was in full force and effect, (b) the Person executing and delivering such certificate, document or instrument was duly authorized and empowered to do so for and on behalf of the Partnership and (c) such certificate, document or instrument was duly executed and delivered in accordance with the terms and provisions of this Agreement and is binding upon the Partnership.

ARTICLE VIII

BOOKS, RECORDS, ACCOUNTING AND REPORTS

              Section 8.1     Records and Accounting.     The General Partner shall keep or cause to be kept at the principal office of the Partnership appropriate books and records with respect to the Partnership's business, including all books and records necessary to provide to the Limited Partners any information required to be provided pursuant to Section 3.4(a). Any books and records maintained by or on behalf of the Partnership in the regular course of its business, including the record of the Record Holders of Units or other Partnership Interests, books of account and records of Partnership proceedings, may be kept on, or be in the form of, computer disks, hard drives, magnetic tape, photographs, micrographics or any other information storage device; provided, that the books and records so maintained are convertible into clearly legible written form within a reasonable period of time. The books of the Partnership shall be maintained, for financial reporting purposes, on an accrual basis in accordance with U.S. GAAP. The Partnership shall not be required to keep books maintained on a cash basis and the General Partner shall be permitted to calculate cash-based measures, including Operating Surplus and Adjusted Operating Surplus, by making such adjustments to its accrual basis books to account for non-cash items and other adjustments as the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate.

              Section 8.2     Fiscal Year.     The fiscal year of the Partnership shall be a fiscal year ending December 31.

              Section 8.3     Reports.     

              (a)   As soon as practicable, but in no event later than 105 days after the close of each fiscal year of the Partnership, the General Partner shall cause to be mailed or made available, by any reasonable means, to each Record Holder of a Unit or other Partnership Interest as of a date selected by the General Partner, an annual report containing financial statements of the Partnership for such fiscal year of the Partnership, presented in accordance with U.S. GAAP, including a balance sheet and statements of operations, Partnership equity and cash flows, such statements to be audited by a firm of independent public accountants selected by the General Partner, and such other information as may be

A-56


Table of Contents

required by applicable law, regulation or rule of any National Securities Exchange on which the Units are listed or admitted to trading, or as the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate.

              (b)   As soon as practicable, but in no event later than 50 days after the close of each Quarter except the last Quarter of each fiscal year, the General Partner shall cause to be mailed or made available, by any reasonable means to each Record Holder of a Unit or other Partnership Interest, as of a date selected by the General Partner, a report containing unaudited financial statements of the Partnership and such other information as may be required by applicable law, regulation or rule of any National Securities Exchange on which the Units are listed or admitted to trading, or as the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate.

              (c)   The General Partner shall be deemed to have made a report available to each Record Holder as required by this Section 8.3 if it has either (i) filed such report with the Commission via its Electronic Data Gathering, Analysis and Retrieval system or any successor system and such report is publicly available on such system or (ii) made such report available on any publicly available website maintained by the Partnership.

ARTICLE IX

TAX MATTERS

              Section 9.1     Tax Returns and Information.     The Partnership shall timely file all returns of the Partnership that are required for federal, state and local income tax purposes on the basis of the accrual method and the taxable period or year that it is required by law to adopt, from time to time, as determined by the General Partner. In the event the Partnership is required to use a taxable period other than a year ending on December 31, the General Partner shall use reasonable efforts to change the taxable period of the Partnership to a year ending on December 31. The tax information reasonably required by Record Holders for federal, state and local income tax reporting purposes with respect to a taxable period shall be furnished to them within 90 days of the close of the calendar year in which the Partnership's taxable period ends. The classification, realization and recognition of income, gain, losses and deductions and other items shall be on the accrual method of accounting for U.S. federal income tax purposes.

              Section 9.2     Tax Elections.     

              (a)   The Partnership shall make the election under Section 754 of the Code in accordance with applicable regulations thereunder, subject to the reservation of the right to seek to revoke any such election upon the General Partner's determination that such revocation is in the best interests of the Limited Partners. Notwithstanding any other provision herein contained, for the purposes of computing the adjustments under Section 743(b) of the Code, the General Partner shall be authorized (but not required) to adopt a convention whereby the price paid by a transferee of a Limited Partner Interest will be deemed to be the lowest quoted closing price of the Limited Partner Interests on any National Securities Exchange on which such Limited Partner Interests are listed or admitted to trading during the calendar month in which such transfer is deemed to occur pursuant to Section 6.2(f) without regard to the actual price paid by such transferee.

              (b)   Except as otherwise provided herein, the General Partner shall determine whether the Partnership should make any other elections permitted by the Code.

A-57


Table of Contents

              Section 9.3     Tax Controversies.     Subject to the provisions hereof, the General Partner shall designate the Organizational Limited Partner, or such other Partner as the General Partner shall designate, as the Tax Matters Partner (as defined in the Code) and is authorized and required to represent the Partnership (at the Partnership's expense) in connection with all examinations of the Partnership's affairs by tax authorities, including resulting administrative and judicial proceedings, and to expend Partnership funds for professional services and costs associated therewith. Each Partner agrees to cooperate with the General Partner and to do or refrain from doing any or all things reasonably required by the General Partner to conduct such proceedings.

              Section 9.4     Withholding; Tax Payments.     

              (a)   The General Partner may treat taxes paid by the Partnership on behalf of, all or less than all of the Partners, either as a distribution of cash to such Partners or as a general expense of the Partnership, as determined appropriate under the circumstances by the General Partner.

              (b)   Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement, the General Partner is authorized to take any action that may be required to cause the Partnership and other Group Members to comply with any withholding requirements established under the Code or any other federal, state or local law including pursuant to Sections 1441, 1442, 1445 and 1446 of the Code. To the extent that the Partnership is required or elects to withhold and pay over to any taxing authority any amount resulting from the allocation or distribution of income or from a distribution to any Partner (including by reason of Section 1446 of the Code), the General Partner may treat the amount withheld as a distribution of cash pursuant to Section 6.3 in the amount of such withholding from such Partner.

ARTICLE X

ADMISSION OF PARTNERS

              Section 10.1     Admission of Limited Partners.     

              (a)   A Person shall be admitted as a Limited Partner and shall become bound by the terms of this Agreement if such Person purchases or otherwise lawfully acquires any Limited Partner Interest and becomes the Record Holder of such Limited Partner Interests in accordance with the provisions of Article IV or Article V hereof. Upon the issuance by the Partnership of Common Units, Subordinated Units and Incentive Distribution Rights to the General Partner, the Organizational Limited Partner and the Underwriters as described in Article V in connection with the Initial Offering, such parties will be automatically admitted to the Partnership as Initial Limited Partners in respect of the Common Units, Subordinated Units or Incentive Distribution Rights issued to them.

              (b)   By acceptance of the transfer of any Limited Partner Interests in accordance with Article IV or the acceptance of any Limited Partner Interests issued pursuant to Article V or pursuant to a merger or consolidation or conversion pursuant to Article XIV, and except as provided in Section 4.8, each transferee of, or other such Person acquiring, a Limited Partner Interest (including any nominee holder or an agent or representative acquiring such Limited Partner Interests for the account of another Person) (i) shall be admitted to the Partnership as a Limited Partner with respect to the Limited Partner Interests so transferred or issued to such Person when any such transfer or admission is reflected in the books and records of the Partnership and such Limited Partner becomes the Record Holder of the Limited Partner Interests so transferred, (ii) shall become bound, and shall be deemed to have agreed to be bound, by the terms of this Agreement, (iii) represents that the transferee or other recipient has the capacity, power and authority to enter into this Agreement, (iv) makes the consents, acknowledgements and waivers contained in this Agreement [and (v) shall be deemed to certify that the transferee is not an Ineligible Holder], all with or without execution of this Agreement by such Person. The transfer of any Limited Partner Interests and the admission of any new Limited Partner shall not constitute an amendment to this Agreement. A Person may become a

A-58


Table of Contents

Limited Partner or Record Holder of a Limited Partner Interest without the consent or approval of any of the Partners. A Person may not become a Limited Partner without acquiring a Limited Partner Interest and until such Person is reflected in the books and records of the Partnership as the Record Holder of such Limited Partner Interest. The rights and obligations of a Person who is an Ineligible Holder shall be determined in accordance with Section 4.8.

              (c)   The name and mailing address of each Record Holder shall be listed on the books and records of the Partnership maintained for such purpose by the Partnership or the Transfer Agent. The General Partner shall update the books and records of the Partnership from time to time as necessary to reflect accurately the information therein (or shall cause the Transfer Agent to do so, as applicable). A Limited Partner Interest may be represented by a Certificate, as provided in Section 4.1.

              (d)   Any transfer of a Limited Partner Interest shall not entitle the transferee to share in the profits and losses, to receive distributions, to receive allocations of income, gain, loss, deduction or credit or any similar item or to any other rights to which the transferor was entitled until the transferee becomes a Limited Partner pursuant to Section 10.1(b).

              Section 10.2     Admission of Successor General Partner.     A successor General Partner approved pursuant to Section 11.1 or Section 11.2 or the transferee of or successor to all of the General Partner Interest pursuant to Section 4.6 who is proposed to be admitted as a successor General Partner shall be admitted to the Partnership as the General Partner, effective immediately prior to the withdrawal or removal of the predecessor or transferring General Partner, pursuant to Section 11.1 or 11.2 or the transfer of the General Partner Interest pursuant to Section 4.6, provided, however , that no such successor shall be admitted to the Partnership until compliance with the terms of Section 4.6 has occurred and such successor has executed and delivered such other documents or instruments as may be required to effect such admission. Any such successor shall, subject to the terms hereof, carry on the business of the members of the Partnership Group without dissolution.

              Section 10.3     Amendment of Agreement and Certificate of Limited Partnership.     To effect the admission to the Partnership of any Partner, the General Partner shall take all steps necessary or appropriate under the Delaware Act to amend the records of the Partnership to reflect such admission and, if necessary, to prepare as soon as practicable an amendment to this Agreement and, if required by law, the General Partner shall prepare and file an amendment to the Certificate of Limited Partnership.

ARTICLE XI

WITHDRAWAL OR REMOVAL OF PARTNERS

              Section 11.1     Withdrawal of the General Partner.     

              (a)   The General Partner shall be deemed to have withdrawn from the Partnership upon the occurrence of any one of the following events (each such event herein referred to as an " Event of Withdrawal ");

                             (i)  The General Partner voluntarily withdraws from the Partnership by giving written notice to the other Partners;

                            (ii)  The General Partner transfers all of its General Partner Interest pursuant to Section 4.6;

                          (iii)  The General Partner is removed pursuant to Section 11.2;

                           (iv)  The General Partner (A) makes a general assignment for the benefit of creditors; (B) files a voluntary bankruptcy petition for relief under Chapter 7 of the United States Bankruptcy Code; (C) files a petition or answer seeking for itself a liquidation,

A-59


Table of Contents

      dissolution or similar relief (but not a reorganization) under any law; (D) files an answer or other pleading admitting or failing to contest the material allegations of a petition filed against the General Partner in a proceeding of the type described in clauses (iv)-(iv) of this Section 11.1(a)(iv); or (E) seeks, consents to or acquiesces in the appointment of a trustee (but not a debtor-in-possession), receiver or liquidator of the General Partner or of all or any substantial part of its properties;

                            (v)  A final and non-appealable order of relief under Chapter 7 of the United States Bankruptcy Code is entered by a court with appropriate jurisdiction pursuant to a voluntary or involuntary petition by or against the General Partner; or

                           (vi)  (A) if the General Partner is a corporation, a certificate of dissolution or its equivalent is filed for the General Partner, or 90 days expire after the date of notice to the General Partner of revocation of its charter without a reinstatement of its charter, under the laws of its state of incorporation; (B) if the General Partner is a partnership or a limited liability company, the dissolution and commencement of winding up of the General Partner; (C) if the General Partner is acting in such capacity by virtue of being a trustee of a trust, the termination of the trust; (D) if the General Partner is a natural person, his death or adjudication of incompetency; and (E) otherwise upon the termination of the General Partner.

              If an Event of Withdrawal specified in Section 11.1(a)(iv), (v) or (vi)(A), (B), (C) or (D) occurs, the withdrawing General Partner shall give notice to the Limited Partners within 30 days after such occurrence. The Partners hereby agree that only the Events of Withdrawal described in this Section 11.1 shall result in the withdrawal of the General Partner from the Partnership.

              (b)   Withdrawal of the General Partner from the Partnership upon the occurrence of an Event of Withdrawal shall not constitute a breach of this Agreement under the following circumstances: (i) at any time during the period beginning on the Closing Date and ending at 11:59 pm, prevailing Central Time, on September 30, 2022, the General Partner voluntarily withdraws by giving at least 90 days' advance notice of its intention to withdraw to the Limited Partners; provided, that prior to the effective date of such withdrawal, the withdrawal is approved by Unitholders holding at least a majority of the Outstanding Common Units (excluding Common Units held by the General Partner and its Affiliates) and the General Partner delivers to the Partnership an Opinion of Counsel (" Withdrawal Opinion of Counsel ") that such withdrawal (following the selection of the successor General Partner) would not result in the loss of the limited liability under the Delaware Act of any Limited Partner or cause any Group Member to be treated as an association taxable as a corporation or otherwise to be taxed as an entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes (to the extent not already so treated or taxed); (ii) at any time after 11:59 pm, prevailing Central Time, on September 30, 2022, the General Partner voluntarily withdraws by giving at least 90 days' advance notice to the Unitholders, such withdrawal to take effect on the date specified in such notice; (iii) at any time that the General Partner ceases to be the General Partner pursuant to Section 11.1(a)(ii) or is removed pursuant to Section 11.2; or (iv) notwithstanding clause (b) of this sentence, at any time that the General Partner voluntarily withdraws by giving at least 90 days' advance notice of its intention to withdraw to the Limited Partners, such withdrawal to take effect on the date specified in the notice, if at the time such notice is given one Person and its Affiliates (other than the General Partner and its Affiliates) own beneficially or of record or control at least 50% of the Outstanding Units. The withdrawal of the General Partner from the Partnership upon the occurrence of an Event of Withdrawal shall also constitute the withdrawal of the General Partner as general partner or managing member, if any, to the extent applicable, of the other Group Members. If the General Partner gives a notice of withdrawal pursuant to Section 11.1(a)(i), a Unit Majority, may, prior to the effective date of such withdrawal, elect a successor General Partner. The Person so elected as successor General Partner shall automatically become the successor general partner or managing member, to the extent applicable, of the other Group Members of which the General Partner is a general partner or a managing member. If, prior to the effective date of the General Partner's

A-60


Table of Contents

withdrawal pursuant to Section 11.1(a)(i), a successor is not selected by the Unitholders as provided herein or the Partnership does not receive a Withdrawal Opinion of Counsel, the Partnership shall be dissolved in accordance with Section 12.1 unless the business of the Partnership is continued pursuant to Section 12.2. Any successor General Partner elected in accordance with the terms of this Section 11.1 shall be subject to the provisions of Section 10.3.

              Section 11.2     Removal of the General Partner.     The General Partner may be removed if such removal is approved by the Unitholders holding at least 66 2 / 3 % of the Outstanding Units (including Units held by the General Partner and its Affiliates) voting as a single class. Any such action by such holders for removal of the General Partner must also provide for the election of a successor General Partner by the Unitholders holding a majority of the Outstanding Common Units, voting as a class, and a majority of the Outstanding Subordinated Units (if any Subordinated Units are then Outstanding), voting as a class (including, in each case, Units held by the General Partner and its Affiliates). Such removal shall be effective immediately following the admission of a successor General Partner pursuant to Section 10.2. The removal of the General Partner shall also automatically constitute the removal of the General Partner as general partner or managing member, to the extent applicable, of the other Group Members of which the General Partner is a general partner or a managing member. If a Person is elected as a successor General Partner in accordance with the terms of this Section 11.2, such Person shall, upon admission pursuant to Section 10.2, automatically become a successor general partner or managing member, to the extent applicable, of the other Group Members of which the General Partner is a general partner or a managing member. The right of the holders of Outstanding Units to remove the General Partner shall not exist or be exercised unless the Partnership has received an opinion opining as to the matters covered by a Withdrawal Opinion of Counsel. Any successor General Partner elected in accordance with the terms of this Section 11.2 shall be subject to the provisions of Section 10.2.

              Section 11.3     Interest of Departing General Partner and Successor General Partner.     

              (a)   In the event of (i) withdrawal of the General Partner under circumstances where such withdrawal does not violate this Agreement or (ii) removal of the General Partner by the holders of Outstanding Units under circumstances where Cause does not exist, if the successor General Partner is elected in accordance with the terms of Section 11.1 or Section 11.2, the Departing General Partner shall have the option, exercisable prior to the effective date of the withdrawal or removal of such Departing General Partner, to require its successor to purchase its General Partner Interest and its or its Affiliates' general partner interest (or equivalent interest), if any, in the other Group Members and all of its or its Affiliates' Incentive Distribution Rights (collectively, the " Combined Interest ") in exchange for an amount in cash equal to the fair market value of such Combined Interest, such amount to be determined and payable as of the effective date of its withdrawal or removal. If the General Partner is removed by the Unitholders under circumstances where Cause exists or if the General Partner withdraws under circumstances where such withdrawal violates this Agreement, and if a successor General Partner is elected in accordance with the terms of Section 11.1 or Section 11.2 (or if the business of the Partnership is continued pursuant to Section 12.2 and the successor General Partner is not the former General Partner), such successor shall have the option, exercisable prior to the effective date of the withdrawal or removal of such Departing General Partner (or, in the event the business of the Partnership is continued, prior to the date the business of the Partnership is continued), to purchase the Combined Interest for such fair market value of such Combined Interest. In either event, the Departing General Partner shall be entitled to receive all reimbursements due such Departing General Partner pursuant to Section 7.5, including any employee-related liabilities (including severance liabilities), incurred in connection with the termination of any employees employed by the Departing General Partner or its Affiliates (other than any Group Member) for the benefit of the Partnership or the other Group Members.

A-61


Table of Contents

              For purposes of this Section 11.3(a), the fair market value of the Combined Interest shall be determined by agreement between the Departing General Partner and its successor or, failing agreement within 30 days after the effective date of such Departing General Partner's withdrawal or removal, by an independent investment banking firm or other independent expert selected by the Departing General Partner and its successor, which, in turn, may rely on other experts, and the determination of which shall be conclusive as to such matter. If such parties cannot agree upon one independent investment banking firm or other independent expert within 45 days after the effective date of such withdrawal or removal, then the Departing General Partner shall designate an independent investment banking firm or other independent expert, the Departing General Partner's successor shall designate an independent investment banking firm or other independent expert, and such firms or experts shall mutually select a third independent investment banking firm or independent expert, which third independent investment banking firm or other independent expert shall determine the fair market value of the Combined Interest. In making its determination, such third independent investment banking firm or other independent expert may consider the value of the Units, including the then current trading price of Units on any National Securities Exchange on which Units are then listed or admitted to trading, the value of the Partnership's assets, the rights and obligations of the Departing General Partner, the value of the Incentive Distribution Rights and the General Partner Interest and other factors it may deem relevant.

              (b)   If the Combined Interest is not purchased in the manner set forth in Section 11.3(a), the Departing General Partner (and its Affiliates, if applicable) shall become a Limited Partner and the Combined Interest shall be converted into Common Units pursuant to a valuation made by an investment banking firm or other independent expert selected pursuant to Section 11.3(a), without reduction in such Partnership Interest (but subject to proportionate dilution by reason of the admission of its successor). Any successor General Partner shall indemnify the Departing General Partner as to all debts and liabilities of the Partnership arising on or after the date on which the Departing General Partner becomes a Limited Partner. For purposes of this Agreement, conversion of the Combined Interest to Common Units will be characterized as if the Departing General Partner (and its Affiliates, if applicable) contributed the Combined Interest to the Partnership in exchange for the newly issued Common Units.

              (c)   If a successor General Partner is elected in accordance with the terms of Section 11.1 or Section 11.2 (or if the business of the Partnership is continued pursuant to Section 12.2 and the successor General Partner is not the former General Partner) and the option described in Section 11.3(a) is not exercised by the party entitled to do so, the successor General Partner shall, at the effective date of its admission to the Partnership, contribute to the Partnership cash in the amount equal to the product of (x) the quotient obtained by dividing (A) the Percentage Interest of the General Partner Interest of the Departing General Partner by (B) a percentage equal to 100% less the Percentage Interest of the General Partner Interest of the Departing General Partner and (y) the Net Agreed Value of the Partnership's assets on such date. In such event, such successor General Partner shall, subject to the following sentence, be entitled to its Percentage Interest of all Partnership allocations and distributions to which the Departing General Partner was entitled. In addition, the successor General Partner shall cause this Agreement to be amended to reflect that, from and after the date of such successor General Partner's admission, the successor General Partner's interest in all Partnership distributions and allocations shall be its Percentage Interest.

              Section 11.4     Termination of Subordination Period, Conversion of Subordinated Units and Extinguishment of Cumulative Common Unit Arrearages.     Notwithstanding any provision of this Agreement, if the General Partner is removed as general partner of the Partnership under circumstances where Cause does not exist:

              (a)   the Subordinated Units held by any Person will immediately and automatically convert into Common Units on a one-for-one basis, provided (i) neither such Person nor any of its Affiliates voted

A-62


Table of Contents

any of its Units in favor of the removal and (ii) such Person is not an Affiliate of the successor General Partner; and

              (b)   if all of the Subordinated Units convert into Common Units pursuant to Section 11.4(a), all Cumulative Common Unit Arrearages on the Common Units will be extinguished and the Subordination Period will end;

provided, however , that such converted Subordinated Units shall remain subject to the provisions of Section 5.5(c)(ii), Section 6.1(d)(x), Section 6.7(b) and Section 6.7(c).

              Section 11.5     Withdrawal of Limited Partners.     No Limited Partner shall have any right to withdraw from the Partnership; provided, however , that when a transferee of a Limited Partner's Limited Partner Interest becomes a Record Holder of the Limited Partner Interest so transferred, such transferring Limited Partner shall cease to be a Limited Partner with respect to the Limited Partner Interest so transferred.

ARTICLE XII

DISSOLUTION AND LIQUIDATION

              Section 12.1     Dissolution.     The Partnership shall not be dissolved by the admission of additional Limited Partners or by the admission of a successor General Partner in accordance with the terms of this Agreement. Upon the removal or withdrawal of the General Partner, if a successor General Partner is elected pursuant to Section 11.1, 11.2 or 12.2, the Partnership shall not be dissolved and such successor General Partner is hereby authorized to, and shall, continue the business of the Partnership. Subject to Section 12.2, the Partnership shall dissolve, and its affairs shall be wound up, upon:

              (a)   an Event of Withdrawal of the General Partner as provided in Section 11.1(a) (other than Section 11.1(a)(ii)), unless a successor is elected and such successor is admitted to the Partnership pursuant to this Agreement;

              (b)   an election to dissolve the Partnership by the General Partner that is approved by a Unit Majority;

              (c)   the entry of a decree of judicial dissolution of the Partnership pursuant to the provisions of the Delaware Act; or

              (d)   at any time there are no Limited Partners, unless the Partnership is continued without dissolution in accordance with the Delaware Act.

              Section 12.2     Continuation of the Business of the Partnership After Dissolution.     Upon (a) an Event of Withdrawal caused by the withdrawal or removal of the General Partner as provided in Section 11.1(a)(i) or (iii) and the failure of the Partners to select a successor to such Departing General Partner pursuant to Section 11.1 or Section 11.2, then within 90 days thereafter, or (b) an event constituting an Event of Withdrawal as defined in Section 11.1(a)(iv), (v) or (vi), then, to the maximum extent permitted by law, within 180 days thereafter, a Unit Majority may elect to continue the business of the Partnership on the same terms and conditions set forth in this Agreement by appointing as a successor General Partner a Person approved by a Unit Majority. Unless such an election is made within the applicable time period as set forth above, the Partnership shall conduct only activities necessary to wind up its affairs. If such an election is so made, then:

                       (i)  the Partnership shall continue without dissolution unless earlier dissolved in accordance with this Article XII;

                      (ii)  if the successor General Partner is not the former General Partner, then the interest of the former General Partner shall be treated in the manner provided in Section 11.3; and

A-63


Table of Contents

                    (iii)  the successor General Partner shall be admitted to the Partnership as General Partner, effective as of the Event of Withdrawal, by agreeing in writing to be bound by this Agreement; provided , that the right of a Unit Majority to approve a successor General Partner and to continue the business of the Partnership shall not exist and may not be exercised unless the Partnership has received an Opinion of Counsel that (x) the exercise of the right would not result in the loss of limited liability under the Delaware Act of any Limited Partner and (y) neither the Partnership nor any Group Member would be treated as an association taxable as a corporation or otherwise be taxable as an entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes upon the exercise of such right to continue (to the extent not already so treated or taxed).

              Section 12.3     Liquidator.     Upon dissolution of the Partnership, unless the business of the Partnership is continued pursuant to Section 12.2, the General Partner shall select one or more Persons to act as Liquidator. The Liquidator (if other than the General Partner) shall be entitled to receive such compensation for its services as may be approved by holders of at least a majority of the Outstanding Common Units and Subordinated Units, if any, voting as a single class. The Liquidator (if other than the General Partner) shall agree not to resign at any time without 15 days' prior notice and may be removed at any time, with or without cause, by notice of removal approved by holders of at least a majority of the Outstanding Common Units and Subordinated Units, if any, voting as a single class. Upon dissolution, removal or resignation of the Liquidator, a successor and substitute Liquidator (who shall have and succeed to all rights, powers and duties of the original Liquidator) shall within 30 days thereafter be approved by holders of at least a majority of the Outstanding Common Units and Subordinated Units, if any, voting as a single class. The right to approve a successor or substitute Liquidator in the manner provided herein shall be deemed to refer also to any such successor or substitute Liquidator approved in the manner herein provided. Except as expressly provided in this Article XII, the Liquidator approved in the manner provided herein shall have and may exercise, without further authorization or consent of any of the parties hereto, all of the powers conferred upon the General Partner under the terms of this Agreement (but subject to all of the applicable limitations, contractual and otherwise, upon the exercise of such powers, other than the limitation on sale set forth in Section 7.4) necessary or appropriate to carry out the duties and functions of the Liquidator hereunder for and during the period of time required to complete the winding up and liquidation of the Partnership as provided for herein.

              Section 12.4     Liquidation.     The Liquidator shall proceed to dispose of the assets of the Partnership, discharge its liabilities, and otherwise wind up its affairs in such manner and over such period as determined by the Liquidator, subject to Section 17-804 of the Delaware Act and the following:

              (a)   The assets may be disposed of by public or private sale or by distribution in kind to one or more Partners on such terms as the Liquidator and such Partner or Partners may agree. If any property is distributed in kind, the Partner receiving the property shall be deemed for purposes of Section 12.4(c) to have received cash equal to its fair market value; and contemporaneously therewith, appropriate cash distributions must be made to the other Partners. The Liquidator may defer liquidation or distribution of the Partnership's assets for a reasonable time if it determines that an immediate sale or distribution of all or some of the Partnership's assets would be impractical or would cause undue loss to the Partners. The Liquidator may distribute the Partnership's assets, in whole or in part, in kind if it determines that a sale would be impractical or would cause undue loss to the Partners.

              (b)   Liabilities of the Partnership include amounts owed to the Liquidator as compensation for serving in such capacity (subject to the terms of Section 12.3) and amounts to Partners otherwise than in respect of their distribution rights under Article VI. With respect to any liability that is contingent, conditional or unmatured or is otherwise not yet due and payable, the Liquidator shall either settle such claim for such amount as it thinks appropriate or establish a reserve of cash or other assets to

A-64


Table of Contents

provide for its payment. When paid, any unused portion of the reserve shall be distributed as additional liquidation proceeds.

              (c)   All property and all cash in excess of that required to discharge liabilities as provided in Section 12.4(b) shall be distributed to the Partners in accordance with, and to the extent of, the positive balances in their respective Capital Accounts, as determined after taking into account all Capital Account adjustments (other than those made by reason of distributions pursuant to this Section 12.4(c)) for the taxable period of the Partnership during which the liquidation of the Partnership occurs (with such date of occurrence being determined pursuant to Treasury Regulation Section 1.704-1(b)(2)(ii)(g)), and such distribution shall be made by the end of such taxable period (or, if later, within 90 days after said date of such occurrence).

              Section 12.5     Cancellation of Certificate of Limited Partnership.     Upon the completion of the distribution of Partnership cash and property as provided in Section 12.4 in connection with the liquidation of the Partnership, the Certificate of Limited Partnership and all qualifications of the Partnership as a foreign limited partnership in jurisdictions other than the State of Delaware shall be canceled and such other actions as may be necessary to terminate the Partnership shall be taken.

              Section 12.6     Return of Contributions.     The General Partner shall not be personally liable for, and shall have no obligation to contribute or loan any monies or property to the Partnership to enable it to effectuate, the return of the Capital Contributions of the Limited Partners or Unitholders, or any portion thereof, it being expressly understood that any such return shall be made solely from Partnership assets.

              Section 12.7     Waiver of Partition.     To the maximum extent permitted by law, each Partner hereby waives any right to partition of the Partnership property.

              Section 12.8     Capital Account Restoration.     No Limited Partner shall have any obligation to restore any negative balance in its Capital Account upon liquidation of the Partnership. The General Partner shall be obligated to restore any negative balance in its Capital Account upon liquidation of its interest in the Partnership by the end of the taxable period of the Partnership during which such liquidation occurs, or, if later, within 90 days after the date of such liquidation.

ARTICLE XIII

AMENDMENT OF PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT; MEETINGS; RECORD DATE

              Section 13.1     Amendments to be Adopted Solely by the General Partner.     Each Partner agrees that the General Partner, without the approval of any Partner, may amend any provision of this Agreement and execute, swear to, acknowledge, deliver, file and record whatever documents may be required in connection therewith, to reflect:

              (a)   a change in the name of the Partnership, the location of the principal place of business of the Partnership, the registered agent of the Partnership or the registered office of the Partnership;

              (b)   admission, substitution, withdrawal or removal of Partners in accordance with this Agreement;

              (c)   a change that the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate to qualify or continue the qualification of the Partnership as a limited partnership or a partnership in which the Limited Partners have limited liability under the laws of any state or to ensure that the Group Members will not be treated as associations taxable as corporations or otherwise taxed as entities for U.S. federal income tax purposes;

              (d)   a change that the General Partner determines (i) does not adversely affect the Limited Partners (including any particular class of Partnership Interests as compared to other classes of

A-65


Table of Contents

Partnership Interests) in any material respect (except as permitted by subsection (g) hereof), (ii) to be necessary or appropriate to (A) satisfy any requirements, conditions or guidelines contained in any opinion, directive, order, ruling or regulation of any federal or state agency or judicial authority or contained in any federal or state statute (including the Delaware Act) or (B) facilitate the trading of the Units (including the division of any class or classes of Outstanding Units into different classes to facilitate uniformity of tax consequences within such classes of Units) or comply with any rule, regulation, guideline or requirement of any National Securities Exchange on which the Units are or will be listed or admitted to trading, (iii) to be necessary or appropriate in connection with action taken by the General Partner pursuant to Section 5.9 or (iv) is required to effect the intent expressed in the Registration Statement or the intent of the provisions of this Agreement or is otherwise contemplated by this Agreement;

              (e)   a change in the fiscal year or taxable period of the Partnership and any other changes that the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate as a result of a change in the fiscal year or taxable period of the Partnership including, if the General Partner shall so determine, a change in the definition of "Quarter" and the dates on which distributions are to be made by the Partnership;

              (f)    an amendment that is necessary, in the Opinion of Counsel, to prevent the Partnership, or the General Partner or its directors, officers, trustees or agents from in any manner being subjected to the provisions of the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended, the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, as amended, or "plan asset" regulations adopted under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended, regardless of whether such are substantially similar to plan asset regulations currently applied or proposed by the United States Department of Labor;

              (g)   an amendment that the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate in connection with the creation, authorization or issuance of any class or series of Partnership Interests or Derivative Instruments pursuant to Section 5.6;

              (h)   any amendment expressly permitted in this Agreement to be made by the General Partner acting alone;

              (i)    an amendment effected, necessitated or contemplated by a Merger Agreement approved in accordance with Section 14.3;

              (j)    an amendment that the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate to reflect and account for the formation by the Partnership of, or investment by the Partnership in, any corporation, partnership, joint venture, limited liability company or other entity, in connection with the conduct by the Partnership of activities permitted by the terms of Section 2.4 or Section 7.1(a);

              (k)   a merger, conveyance or conversion pursuant to Section 14.3(d); or

              (l)    any other amendments substantially similar to the foregoing.

              Section 13.2     Amendment Procedures.     Amendments to this Agreement may be proposed only by the General Partner. To the fullest extent permitted by law, the General Partner shall have no duty or obligation to propose or approve any amendment to this Agreement and may decline to do so in its sole discretion, and, in declining to propose or approve an amendment, to the fullest extent permitted by law, shall not be required to act in good faith or pursuant to any other standard imposed by this Agreement, any Group Member Agreement, any other agreement contemplated hereby or under the Delaware Act or any other law, rule or regulation or at equity. An amendment shall be effective upon its approval by the General Partner and, except as otherwise provided by Section 13.1 or 13.3, a Unit Majority, unless a greater or different percentage is required under this Agreement or by Delaware law. Each proposed amendment that requires the approval of the holders of a specified percentage of Outstanding Units shall be set forth in a writing that contains the text of the proposed amendment. If such an amendment is proposed, the General Partner shall seek the written approval of the requisite

A-66


Table of Contents

percentage of Outstanding Units or call a meeting of the Unitholders to consider and vote on such proposed amendment. The General Partner shall notify all Record Holders upon final adoption of any amendments. The General Partner shall be deemed to have notified all Record Holders as required by this Section 13.2 if it has either (i) filed such amendment with the Commission via its Electronic Data Gathering, Analysis and Retrieval system and such amendment is publicly available on such system or (ii) made such amendment available on any publicly available website maintained by the Partnership

              Section 13.3     Amendment Requirements.     

              (a)   Notwithstanding the provisions of Section 13.1 and Section 13.2, no provision of this Agreement (other than Section 11.2 or 13.4) that establishes a percentage of Outstanding Units (including Units deemed owned by the General Partner) or requires a vote or approval of Partners (or a subset of Partners) holding a specified Percentage Interest required to take any action shall be amended, altered, changed, repealed or rescinded in any respect that would have the effect of reducing or increasing such percentage, unless such amendment is approved by the written consent or the affirmative vote of holders of Outstanding Units whose aggregate Outstanding Units constitute not less than the voting requirement sought to be reduced or increased, as applicable, or the affirmative vote of Partners whose aggregate Percentage Interests constitute not less than the voting requirement sought to be reduced, as applicable.

              (b)   Notwithstanding the provisions of Section 13.1 and Section 13.2, no amendment to this Agreement may (i) enlarge the obligations of (including requiring any holder of a class of Partnership Interests to make additional Capital Contributions to the Partnership) any Limited Partner without its consent, unless such shall be deemed to have occurred as a result of an amendment approved pursuant to Section 13.3(c), or (ii) enlarge the obligations of, restrict, change or modify in any way any action by or rights of, or reduce in any way the amounts distributable, reimbursable or otherwise payable to, the General Partner or any of its Affiliates without its consent, which consent may be given or withheld at its option.

              (c)   Except as provided in Section 14.3 or Section 13.1, any amendment that would have a material adverse effect on the rights or preferences of any class of Partnership Interests in relation to other classes of Partnership Interests must be approved by the holders of not less than a majority of the Outstanding Partnership Interests of the class affected. If the General Partner determines an amendment does not satisfy the requirements of Section 13.1(d) because it adversely affects one or more classes of Partnership Interests, as compared to other classes of Partnership Interests, in any material respect, such amendment shall only be required to be approved by the adversely affected class or classes.

              (d)   Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement, except for amendments pursuant to Section 13.1 and except as otherwise provided by Section 14.3(b), no amendments shall become effective without the approval of the holders of at least 90% of the Percentage Interests of all Limited Partners voting as a single class unless the Partnership obtains an Opinion of Counsel to the effect that such amendment will not affect the limited liability of any Limited Partner under applicable partnership law of the state under whose laws the Partnership is organized.

              (e)   Except as provided in Section 13.1, this Section 13.3 shall only be amended with the approval of Partners (including the General Partner and its Affiliates) holding at least 90% of the Percentage Interests of all Limited Partners.

              Section 13.4     Special Meetings.     All acts of Limited Partners to be taken pursuant to this Agreement shall be taken in the manner provided in this Article XIII. Special meetings of the Limited Partners may be called by the General Partner or by Limited Partners owning 20% or more of the Outstanding Units of the class or classes for which a meeting is proposed. Limited Partners shall call a special meeting by delivering to the General Partner one or more requests in writing stating that the

A-67


Table of Contents

signing Limited Partners wish to call a special meeting and indicating the general or specific purposes for which the special meeting is to be called. Within 60 days after receipt of such a call from Limited Partners or within such greater time as may be reasonably necessary for the Partnership to comply with any statutes, rules, regulations, listing agreements or similar requirements governing the holding of a meeting or the solicitation of proxies for use at such a meeting, the General Partner shall send a notice of the meeting to the Limited Partners either directly or indirectly through the Transfer Agent. A meeting shall be held at a time and place determined by the General Partner on a date not less than 10 days nor more than 60 days after the time notice of the meeting is given as provided in Section 16.1. Limited Partners shall not vote on matters that would cause the Limited Partners to be deemed to be taking part in the management and control of the business and affairs of the Partnership so as to jeopardize the Limited Partners' limited liability under the Delaware Act or the law of any other state in which the Partnership is qualified to do business.

              Section 13.5     Notice of a Meeting.     Notice of a meeting called pursuant to Section 13.4 shall be given to the Record Holders of the class or classes of Units for which a meeting is proposed in writing by mail or other means of written communication in accordance with Section 16.1. The notice shall be deemed to have been given at the time when deposited in the mail or sent by other means of written communication.

              Section 13.6     Record Date.     For purposes of determining the Limited Partners entitled to notice of or to vote at a meeting of the Limited Partners or to give approvals without a meeting as provided in Section 13.11 the General Partner may set a Record Date, which shall not be less than 10 nor more than 60 days before (a) the date of the meeting (unless such requirement conflicts with any rule, regulation, guideline or requirement of any National Securities Exchange on which the Units are listed or admitted to trading or U.S. federal securities laws, in which case the rule, regulation, guideline or requirement of such National Securities Exchange or U.S. federal securities laws shall govern) or (b) in the event that approvals are sought without a meeting, the date by which Limited Partners are requested in writing by the General Partner to give such approvals. If the General Partner does not set a Record Date, then (a) the Record Date for determining the Limited Partners entitled to notice of or to vote at a meeting of the Limited Partners shall be the close of business on the day next preceding the day on which notice is given, and (b) the Record Date for determining the Limited Partners entitled to give approvals without a meeting shall be the date the first written approval is deposited with the Partnership in care of the General Partner in accordance with Section 13.11.

              Section 13.7     Adjournment.     When a meeting is adjourned to another time or place, notice need not be given of the adjourned meeting and a new Record Date need not be fixed, if the time and place thereof are announced at the meeting at which the adjournment is taken, unless such adjournment shall be for more than 45 days. At the adjourned meeting, the Partnership may transact any business which might have been transacted at the original meeting. If the adjournment is for more than 45 days or if a new Record Date is fixed for the adjourned meeting, a notice of the adjourned meeting shall be given in accordance with this Article XIII.

              Section 13.8     Waiver of Notice; Approval of Meeting; Approval of Minutes.     The transaction of business at any meeting of Limited Partners, however called and noticed, and whenever held, shall be as valid as if it had occurred at a meeting duly held after regular call and notice, if a quorum is present either in person or by proxy. Attendance of a Limited Partner at a meeting shall constitute a waiver of notice of the meeting, except when the Limited Partner attends the meeting for the express purpose of objecting, at the beginning of the meeting, to the transaction of any business because the meeting is not lawfully called or convened; and except that attendance at a meeting is not a waiver of any right to disapprove the consideration of matters required to be included in the notice of the meeting, but not so included, if the disapproval is expressly made at the meeting.

A-68


Table of Contents

              Section 13.9     Quorum and Voting.     The holders of a majority, by Percentage Interest, of Partnership Interests of the class or classes for which a meeting has been called (including Partnership Interests deemed owned by the General Partner) represented in person or by proxy shall constitute a quorum at a meeting of Partners of such class or classes unless any such action by the Partners requires approval by holders of a greater Percentage Interest, in which case the quorum shall be such greater Percentage Interest. At any meeting of the Partners duly called and held in accordance with this Agreement at which a quorum is present, the act of Partners holding Partnership Interests that, in the aggregate, represent a majority of the Percentage Interest of those present in person or by proxy at such meeting shall be deemed to constitute the act of all Partners, unless a greater or different percentage is required with respect to such action under the provisions of this Agreement, in which case the act of the Partners holding Partnership Interests that in the aggregate represent at least such greater or different percentage shall be required; provided, however , that if, as a matter of law or amendment to this Agreement, approval by plurality vote of Partners (or any class thereof) is required to approve any action, no minimum quorum shall be required. The Partners present at a duly called or held meeting at which a quorum is present may continue to transact business until adjournment, notwithstanding the withdrawal of enough Partners to leave less than a quorum, if any action taken (other than adjournment) is approved by Partners holding the required Percentage Interest specified in this Agreement. In the absence of a quorum any meeting of Partners may be adjourned from time to time by the affirmative vote of Partners with at least a majority, by Percentage Interest, of the Partnership Interests entitled to vote at such meeting (including Partnership Interests deemed owned by the General Partner) represented either in person or by proxy, but no other business may be transacted, except as provided in Section 13.7.

              Section 13.10     Conduct of a Meeting.     The General Partner shall have full power and authority concerning the manner of conducting any meeting of the Limited Partners or solicitation of approvals in writing, including the determination of Persons entitled to vote, the existence of a quorum, the satisfaction of the requirements of Section 13.4, the conduct of voting, the validity and effect of any proxies and the determination of any controversies, votes or challenges arising in connection with or during the meeting or voting. The General Partner shall designate a Person to serve as chairman of any meeting and shall further designate a Person to take the minutes of any meeting. All minutes shall be kept with the records of the Partnership maintained by the General Partner. The General Partner may make such other regulations consistent with applicable law and this Agreement as it may deem advisable concerning the conduct of any meeting of the Limited Partners or solicitation of approvals in writing, including regulations in regard to the appointment of proxies, the appointment and duties of inspectors of votes and approvals, the submission and examination of proxies and other evidence of the right to vote, and the revocation of approvals in writing.

              Section 13.11     Action Without a Meeting.     If authorized by the General Partner, any action that may be taken at a meeting of the Limited Partners may be taken without a meeting, without a vote and without prior notice, if an approval in writing setting forth the action so taken is signed by Limited Partners owning not less than the minimum percentage, by Percentage Interest, of the Partnership Interests of the class or classes for which a meeting has been called (including Partnership Interests deemed owned by the General Partner), as the case may be, that would be necessary to authorize or take such action at a meeting at which all the Limited Partners entitled to vote at such meeting were present and voted (unless such provision conflicts with any rule, regulation, guideline or requirement of any National Securities Exchange on which the Units are listed or admitted to trading, in which case the rule, regulation, guideline or requirement of such National Securities Exchange shall govern). Prompt notice of the taking of action without a meeting shall be given to the Limited Partners who have not approved in writing. The General Partner may specify that any written ballot submitted to Limited Partners for the purpose of taking any action without a meeting shall be returned to the Partnership within the time period, which shall be not less than 20 days, specified by the General Partner. If a ballot returned to the Partnership does not vote all of the Units held by the Limited

A-69


Table of Contents

Partners, the Partnership shall be deemed to have failed to receive a ballot for the Units that were not voted. If approval of the taking of any action by the Limited Partners is solicited by any Person other than by or on behalf of the General Partner, the written approvals shall have no force and effect unless and until (a) they are deposited with the Partnership in care of the General Partner and (b) an Opinion of Counsel is delivered to the General Partner to the effect that the exercise of such right and the action proposed to be taken with respect to any particular matter (i) will not cause the Limited Partners to be deemed to be taking part in the management and control of the business and affairs of the Partnership so as to jeopardize the Limited Partners' limited liability, and (ii) is otherwise permissible under the state statutes then governing the rights, duties and liabilities of the Partnership and the Partners. Nothing contained in this Section 13.11 shall be deemed to require the General Partner to solicit all Limited Partners in connection with a matter approved by the holders of the requisite percentage of Units acting by written consent without a meeting.

              Section 13.12     Right to Vote and Related Matters.     

              (a)   Only those Record Holders of the Outstanding Units on the Record Date set pursuant to Section 13.6 shall be entitled to notice of, and to vote at, a meeting of Limited Partners or to act with respect to matters as to which the holders of the Outstanding Units have the right to vote or to act. All references in this Agreement to votes of, or other acts that may be taken by, the Outstanding Units shall be deemed to be references to the votes or acts of the Record Holders of such Outstanding Units.

              (b)   With respect to Units that are held for a Person's account by another Person (such as a broker, dealer, bank, trust company or clearing corporation, or an agent of any of the foregoing), in whose name such Units are registered, such other Person shall, in exercising the voting rights in respect of such Units on any matter, and unless the arrangement between such Persons provides otherwise, vote such Units in favor of, and at the direction of, the Person who is the beneficial owner, and the Partnership shall be entitled to assume it is so acting without further inquiry. The provisions of this Section 13.12(b) (as well as all other provisions of this Agreement) are subject to the provisions of Section 4.3.

              Section 13.13     Voting of Incentive Distribution Rights.     

              (a)   For so long as a majority of the Incentive Distribution Rights are held by the General Partner and its Affiliates, the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights shall not be entitled to vote such Incentive Distribution Rights on any Partnership matter except as may otherwise be required by law and the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, in their capacity as such, shall be deemed to have approved any matter approved by the General Partner.

              (b)   If less than a majority of the Incentive Distribution Rights are held by the General Partner and its Affiliates, the Incentive Distribution Rights will be entitled to vote on all matters submitted to a vote of Unitholders, other than amendments and other matters that the General Partner determines do not adversely affect the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights as a whole in any material respect. On any matter in which the holders of Incentive Distribution Rights are entitled to vote, such holders will vote together with the Subordinated Units, prior to the end of the Subordination Period, or together with the Common Units, thereafter, in either case as a single class except as otherwise required by Section 13.3(c), and such Incentive Distribution Rights shall be treated in all respects as Subordinated Units or Common Units, as applicable, when sending notices of a meeting of Limited Partners to vote on any matter (unless otherwise required by law), calculating required votes, determining the presence of a quorum or for other similar purposes under this Agreement. The relative voting power of the Incentive Distribution Rights and the Subordinated Units or Common Units, as applicable, will be set in the same proportion as cumulative cash distributions, if any, in respect of the Incentive Distribution Rights for the four consecutive Quarters prior to the record date for the vote bears to the cumulative cash distributions in respect of such class of Units for such four Quarters.

              (c)   In connection with any equity financing, or anticipated equity financing, by the Partnership of an Expansion Capital Expenditure, the General Partner may, without the approval of the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, temporarily or permanently reduce the amount of Incentive Distributions that would otherwise be distributed to such holders, provided that in the judgment of the General Partner, such reduction will be in the long-term best interest of such holders.

A-70


Table of Contents

ARTICLE XIV

MERGER OR CONSOLIDATION

              Section 14.1     Authority.     The Partnership may merge or consolidate with or into one or more corporations, limited liability companies, statutory trusts or associations, real estate investment trusts, common law trusts or unincorporated businesses, including a partnership (whether general or limited (including a limited liability partnership)) or convert into any such entity, whether such entity is formed under the laws of the State of Delaware or any other state of the United States of America, pursuant to a written plan of merger or consolidation (" Merger Agreement ") in accordance with this Article XIV.

              Section 14.2     Procedure for Merger or Consolidation.     

              (a)   Merger or consolidation of the Partnership pursuant to this Article XIV requires the prior consent of the General Partner, provided, however , that, to the fullest extent permitted by law, the General Partner shall have no duty or obligation to consent to any merger or consolidation of the Partnership and may decline to do so free of any fiduciary duty or obligation whatsoever to the Partnership, any Limited Partner and, in declining to consent to a merger or consolidation, shall not be required to act in good faith or pursuant to any other standard imposed by this Agreement, any other agreement contemplated hereby or under the Delaware Act or any other law, rule or regulation or at equity.

              (b)   If the General Partner shall determine to consent to the merger or consolidation, the General Partner shall approve the Merger Agreement, which shall set forth:

                             (i)  the name and jurisdiction of formation or organization of each of the business entities proposing to merge or consolidate;

                            (ii)  the name and jurisdiction of formation or organization of the business entity that is to survive the proposed merger or consolidation (the " Surviving Business Entity ");

                          (iii)  the terms and conditions of the proposed merger or consolidation;

                           (iv)  the manner and basis of exchanging or converting the equity interests of each constituent business entity for, or into, cash, property or interests, rights, securities or obligations of the Surviving Business Entity; and (i) if any interests, securities or rights of any constituent business entity are not to be exchanged or converted solely for, or into, cash, property or interests, rights, securities or obligations of the Surviving Business Entity, then the cash, property or interests, rights, securities or obligations of any general or limited partnership, corporation, trust, limited liability company, unincorporated business or other entity (other than the Surviving Business Entity) which the holders of such interests, securities or rights are to receive in exchange for, or upon conversion of their interests, securities or rights, and (ii) in the case of equity interests represented by certificates, upon the surrender of such certificates, which cash, property or interests, rights, securities or obligations of the Surviving Business Entity or any general or limited partnership, corporation, trust, limited liability company, unincorporated business or other entity (other than the Surviving Business Entity), or evidences thereof, are to be delivered;

                            (v)  a statement of any changes in the constituent documents or the adoption of new constituent documents (the articles or certificate of incorporation, articles of trust, declaration of trust, certificate or agreement of limited partnership, certificate of formation or limited liability company agreement or other similar charter or governing document) of the Surviving Business Entity to be effected by such merger or consolidation;

                           (vi)  the effective time of the merger, which may be the date of the filing of the certificate of merger pursuant to Section 14.4 or a later date specified in or determinable in

A-71


Table of Contents

      accordance with the Merger Agreement (provided, that if the effective time of the merger is to be later than the date of the filing of such certificate of merger, the effective time shall be fixed at a date or time certain and stated in the certificate of merger); and

                          (vii)  such other provisions with respect to the proposed merger or consolidation that the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate.

              Section 14.3     Approval by Limited Partners.     

              (a)   Except as provided in Section 14.3(d), the General Partner, upon its approval of the Merger Agreement shall direct that the Merger Agreement and the merger or consolidation contemplated thereby, as applicable, be submitted to a vote of Limited Partners, whether at a special meeting or by written consent, in either case in accordance with the requirements of Article XIII. A copy or a summary of the Merger Agreement, as the case may be, shall be included in or enclosed with the notice of a special meeting or the written consent.

              (b)   Except as provided in Sections 14.3(d) and 14.3(e), the Merger Agreement shall be approved upon receiving the affirmative vote or consent of the holders of a Unit Majority unless the Merger Agreement contains any provision that, if contained in an amendment to this Agreement, the provisions of this Agreement or the Delaware Act would require for its approval the vote or consent of a greater percentage of the Outstanding Units or of any class of Limited Partners, in which case such greater percentage vote or consent shall be required for approval of the Merger Agreement.

              (c)   Except as provided in Sections 14.3(d) and 14.3(e), after such approval by vote or consent of the Limited Partners, and at any time prior to the filing of the certificate of merger pursuant to Section 14.4, the merger or consolidation may be abandoned pursuant to provisions therefor, if any, set forth in the Merger Agreement.

              (d)   Notwithstanding anything else contained in this Article XIV or in this Agreement, the General Partner is permitted, without Limited Partner approval, to convert the Partnership or any Group Member into a new limited liability entity, to merge the Partnership or any Group Member into, or convey all of the Partnership's assets to, another limited liability entity that shall be newly formed and shall have no assets, liabilities or operations at the time of such merger or conveyance other than those it receives from the Partnership or other Group Member if (i) the General Partner has received an Opinion of Counsel that the merger or conveyance, as the case may be, would not result in the loss of the limited liability under the Delaware Act of any Limited Partner or cause the Partnership or any Group Member to be treated as an association taxable as a corporation or otherwise to be taxed as an entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes (to the extent not already treated as such), (ii) the sole purpose of such merger, or conveyance is to effect a mere change in the legal form of the Partnership into another limited liability entity and (iii) the governing instruments of the new entity provide the Limited Partners and the General Partner with substantially the same rights and obligations as are herein contained.

              (e)   Additionally, notwithstanding anything else contained in this Article XIV or in this Agreement, the General Partner is permitted, without Limited Partner approval, to merge or consolidate the Partnership with or into another entity if (A) the General Partner has received an Opinion of Counsel that the merger or consolidation, as the case may be, would not result in the loss of the limited liability under the Delaware Act of any Limited Partner or cause the Partnership or any Group Member to be treated as an association taxable as a corporation or otherwise to be taxed as an entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes (to the extent not already treated as such), (B) the merger or consolidation would not result in an amendment to this Agreement, other than any amendments that could be adopted pursuant to Section 13.1, (C) the Partnership is the Surviving Business Entity in such merger or consolidation, (D) each Partnership Interest outstanding immediately prior to the effective date of the merger or consolidation is to be an identical Partnership Interest of the

A-72


Table of Contents

Partnership after the effective date of the merger or consolidation, and (E) the number of Partnership Interests to be issued by the Partnership in such merger or consolidation does not exceed 20% of the Partnership Interests (other than Incentive Distribution Rights) Outstanding immediately prior to the effective date of such merger or consolidation.

              (f)    Pursuant to Section 17-211(g) of the Delaware Act, an agreement of merger or consolidation approved in accordance with this Article XIV may (a) effect any amendment to this Agreement or (b) effect the adoption of a new partnership agreement for the Partnership if it is the Surviving Business Entity. Any such amendment or adoption made pursuant to this Section 14.3 shall be effective at the effective time or date of the merger or consolidation.

              Section 14.4     Certificate of Merger.     Upon the required approval by the General Partner and the Unitholders of a Merger Agreement, a certificate of merger shall be executed and filed with the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware in conformity with the requirements of the Delaware Act.

              Section 14.5     Effect of Merger or Consolidation.     

              (a)   At the effective time of the certificate of merger:

                             (i)  all of the rights, privileges and powers of each of the business entities that has merged or consolidated, and all property, real, personal and mixed, and all debts due to any of those business entities and all other things and causes of action belonging to each of those business entities, shall be vested in the Surviving Business Entity and after the merger or consolidation shall be the property of the Surviving Business Entity to the extent they were of each constituent business entity;

                            (ii)  the title to any real property vested by deed or otherwise in any of those constituent business entities shall not revert and is not in any way impaired because of the merger or consolidation;

                          (iii)  all rights of creditors and all liens on or security interests in property of any of those constituent business entities shall be preserved unimpaired; and

                           (iv)  all debts, liabilities and duties of those constituent business entities shall attach to the Surviving Business Entity and may be enforced against it to the same extent as if the debts, liabilities and duties had been incurred or contracted by it.

ARTICLE XV

RIGHT TO ACQUIRE LIMITED PARTNER INTERESTS

              Section 15.1     Right to Acquire Limited Partner Interests.     

              (a)   Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement, if at any time the General Partner and its Affiliates hold more than 80% of the total Limited Partner Interests of any class then Outstanding, the General Partner shall then have the right, which right it may assign and transfer in whole or in part to the Partnership or any Affiliate of the General Partner, exercisable in its sole discretion, to purchase all, but not less than all, of such Limited Partner Interests of such class then Outstanding held by Persons other than the General Partner and its Affiliates, at the greater of (x) the Current Market Price as of the date three days prior to the date that the notice described in Section 15.1(b) is mailed and (y) the highest price paid by the General Partner or any of its Affiliates for any such Limited Partner Interest of such class purchased during the 90-day period preceding the date that the notice described in Section 15.1(b) is mailed.

              (b)   If the General Partner, any Affiliate of the General Partner or the Partnership elects to exercise the right to purchase Limited Partner Interests granted pursuant to Section 15.1(a), the General Partner shall deliver to the Transfer Agent notice of such election to purchase (the " Notice of

A-73


Table of Contents

Election to Purchase ") and shall cause the Transfer Agent to mail a copy of such Notice of Election to Purchase to the Record Holders of Limited Partner Interests of such class (as of a Record Date selected by the General Partner) at least 10, but not more than 60, days prior to the Purchase Date. Such Notice of Election to Purchase shall also be published for a period of at least three consecutive days in at least two daily newspapers of general circulation printed in the English language and published in the Borough of Manhattan, New York. The Notice of Election to Purchase shall specify the Purchase Date and the price (determined in accordance with Section 15.1(a)) at which Limited Partner Interests will be purchased and state that the General Partner, its Affiliate or the Partnership, as the case may be, elects to purchase such Limited Partner Interests, upon surrender of Certificates representing such Limited Partner Interests in the case of Limited Partner Interests evidenced by Certificates, in exchange for payment, at such office or offices of the Transfer Agent as the Transfer Agent may specify, or as may be required by any National Securities Exchange on which such Limited Partner Interests are listed or admitted to trading. Any such Notice of Election to Purchase mailed to a Record Holder of Limited Partner Interests at his address as reflected in the records of the Transfer Agent shall be conclusively presumed to have been given regardless of whether the owner receives such notice. On or prior to the Purchase Date, the General Partner, its Affiliate or the Partnership, as the case may be, shall deposit with the Transfer Agent cash in an amount sufficient to pay the aggregate purchase price of all of such Limited Partner Interests to be purchased in accordance with this Section 15.1. If the Notice of Election to Purchase shall have been duly given as aforesaid at least 10 days prior to the Purchase Date, and if on or prior to the Purchase Date the deposit described in the preceding sentence has been made for the benefit of the holders of Limited Partner Interests subject to purchase as provided herein, then from and after the Purchase Date, notwithstanding that any Certificate shall not have been surrendered for purchase, all rights of the holders of such Limited Partner Interests shall thereupon cease, except the right to receive the purchase price (determined in accordance with Section 15.1(a)) for Limited Partner Interests therefor, without interest, upon surrender to the Transfer Agent of the Certificates representing such Limited Partner Interests in the case of Limited Partner Interests evidenced by Certificates, and such Limited Partner Interests shall thereupon be deemed to be transferred to the General Partner, its Affiliate or the Partnership, as the case may be, on the record books of the Transfer Agent and the Partnership, and the General Partner or any Affiliate of the General Partner, or the Partnership, as the case may be, shall be deemed to be the owner of all such Limited Partner Interests from and after the Purchase Date and shall have all rights as the owner of such Limited Partner Interests.

              (c)   In the case of Limited Partner Interests evidenced by Certificates, at any time from and after the Purchase Date, a holder of an Outstanding Limited Partner Interest subject to purchase as provided in this Section 15.1 may surrender his Certificate evidencing such Limited Partner Interest to the Transfer Agent in exchange for payment of the amount described in Section 15.1(a), therefor, without interest thereon.

ARTICLE XVI

GENERAL PROVISIONS

              Section 16.1     Addresses and Notices; Written Communications.     

              (a)   Any notice, demand, request, report or proxy materials required or permitted to be given or made to a Partner under this Agreement shall be in writing and shall be deemed given or made when delivered in person or when sent by first class United States mail or by other means of written communication to the Partner at the address described below. Any notice, payment or report to be given or made to a Partner hereunder shall be deemed conclusively to have been given or made, and the obligation to give such notice or report or to make such payment shall be deemed conclusively to have been fully satisfied, upon sending of such notice, payment or report to the Record Holder of such Partnership Interests at his address as shown on the records of the Transfer Agent or as otherwise

A-74


Table of Contents

shown on the records of the Partnership, regardless of any claim of any Person who may have an interest in such Partnership Interests by reason of any assignment or otherwise. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if (i) a Partner shall consent to receiving notices, demands, requests, reports or proxy materials via electronic mail or by the Internet or (ii) the rules of the Commission shall permit any report or proxy materials to be delivered electronically or made available via the Internet, any such notice, demand, request, report or proxy materials shall be deemed given or made when delivered or made available via such mode of delivery. An affidavit or certificate of making of any notice, payment or report in accordance with the provisions of this Section 16.1 executed by the General Partner, the Transfer Agent or the mailing organization shall be prima facie evidence of the giving or making of such notice, payment or report. If any notice, payment or report given or made in accordance with the provisions of this Section 16.1 is returned marked to indicate that such notice, payment or report was unable to be delivered, such notice, payment or report and, in the case of notices, payments or reports returned by the United States Postal Service (or other physical mail delivery mail service outside the United States of America), any subsequent notices, payments and reports shall be deemed to have been duly given or made without further mailing (until such time as such Record Holder or another Person notifies the Transfer Agent or the Partnership of a change in his address) or other delivery if they are available for the Partner at the principal office of the Partnership for a period of one year from the date of the giving or making of such notice, payment or report to the other Partners. Any notice to the Partnership shall be deemed given if received by the General Partner at the principal office of the Partnership designated pursuant to Section 2.3. The General Partner may rely and shall be protected in relying on any notice or other document from a Partner or other Person if believed by it to be genuine.

              (b)   The terms "in writing", "written communications," "written notice" and words of similar import shall be deemed satisfied under this Agreement by use of e-mail and other forms of electronic communication.

              Section 16.2     Further Action.     The parties shall execute and deliver all documents, provide all information and take or refrain from taking action as may be necessary or appropriate to achieve the purposes of this Agreement.

              Section 16.3     Binding Effect.     This Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the parties hereto and their heirs, executors, administrators, successors, legal representatives and permitted assigns.

              Section 16.4     Integration.     This Agreement constitutes the entire agreement among the parties hereto pertaining to the subject matter hereof and supersedes all prior agreements and understandings pertaining thereto.

              Section 16.5     Creditors.     None of the provisions of this Agreement shall be for the benefit of, or shall be enforceable by, any creditor of the Partnership.

              Section 16.6     Waiver.     No failure by any party to insist upon the strict performance of any covenant, duty, agreement or condition of this Agreement or to exercise any right or remedy consequent upon a breach thereof shall constitute waiver of any such breach of any other covenant, duty, agreement or condition.

              Section 16.7     Third-Party Beneficiaries.     Each Partner agrees that (a) any Indemnitee shall be entitled to assert rights and remedies hereunder as a third-party beneficiary hereto with respect to those provisions of this Agreement affording a right, benefit or privilege to such Indemnitee and (b) any Unrestricted Person shall be entitled to assert rights and remedies hereunder as a third-party beneficiary hereto with respect to those provisions of this Agreement affording a right, benefit or privilege to such Unrestricted Person.

              Section 16.8     Counterparts.     This Agreement may be executed in counterparts, all of which together shall constitute an agreement binding on all the parties hereto, notwithstanding that all such

A-75


Table of Contents

parties are not signatories to the original or the same counterpart. Each party shall become bound by this Agreement immediately upon affixing its signature hereto or, in the case of a Person acquiring a Limited Partner Interest, pursuant to Section 10.1(a) without execution hereof.

              Section 16.9     Applicable Law; Forum, Venue and Jurisdiction; Waiver of Trial by Jury.     

              (a)   This Agreement shall be construed in accordance with and governed by the laws of the State of Delaware, without regard to the principles of conflicts of law.

              (b)   Each of the Partners and each Person holding any beneficial interest in the Partnership (whether through a broker, dealer, bank, trust company or clearing corporation or an agent of any of the foregoing or otherwise):

                             (i)  irrevocably agrees that any claims, suits, actions or proceedings (A) arising out of or relating in any way to this Agreement (including any claims, suits or actions to interpret, apply or enforce the provisions of this Agreement or the duties, obligations or liabilities among Partners or of Partners to the Partnership, or the rights or powers of, or restrictions on, the Partners or the Partnership), (B) brought in a derivative manner on behalf of the Partnership, (C) asserting a claim of breach of a fiduciary duty owed by any director, officer, or other employee of the Partnership or the General Partner, or owed by the General Partner, to the Partnership or the Partners, (D) asserting a claim arising pursuant to any provision of the Delaware Act or (E) asserting a claim governed by the internal affairs doctrine shall be exclusively brought in the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware (or, if such court does not have subject matter jurisdiction thereof, any other court located in the State of Delaware with subject matter jurisdiction), in each case regardless of whether such claims, suits, actions or proceedings sound in contract, tort, fraud or otherwise, are based on common law, statutory, equitable, legal or other grounds, or are derivative or direct claims;

                            (ii)  irrevocably submits to the exclusive jurisdiction of the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware (or, if such court does not have subject matter jurisdiction thereof, any other court located in the State of Delaware with subject matter jurisdiction) in connection with any such claim, suit, action or proceeding;

                          (iii)  agrees not to, and waives any right to, assert in any such claim, suit, action or proceeding that (A) it is not personally subject to the jurisdiction of the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware or of any other court to which proceedings in the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware may be appealed, (B) such claim, suit, action or proceeding is brought in an inconvenient forum, or (C) the venue of such claim, suit, action or proceeding is improper;

                           (iv)  expressly waives any requirement for the posting of a bond by a party bringing such claim, suit, action or proceeding; and

                            (v)  consents to process being served in any such claim, suit, action or proceeding by mailing, certified mail, return receipt requested, a copy thereof to such party at the address in effect for notices hereunder, and agrees that such services shall constitute good and sufficient service of process and notice thereof; provided, nothing in clause (v) hereof shall affect or limit any right to serve process in any other manner permitted by law.

              Section 16.10     Invalidity of Provisions.     If any provision or part of a provision of this Agreement is or becomes for any reason, invalid, illegal or unenforceable in any respect, the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions and/or parts thereof contained herein shall not be affected thereby and this Agreement shall, to the fullest extent permitted by law, be reformed and construed as if such invalid, illegal or unenforceable provision, or part of a provision, had never been contained herein, and such provision or part reformed so that it would be valid, legal and enforceable to the maximum extent possible.

A-76


Table of Contents

              Section 16.11     Consent of Partners.     Each Partner hereby expressly consents and agrees that, whenever in this Agreement it is specified that an action may be taken upon the affirmative vote or consent of less than all of the Partners, such action may be so taken upon the concurrence of less than all of the Partners and each Partner shall be bound by the results of such action.

              Section 16.12     Facsimile Signatures.     The use of facsimile signatures affixed in the name and on behalf of the transfer agent and registrar of the Partnership on Certificates representing Units is expressly permitted by this Agreement.

              [REMAINDER OF THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK.]

A-77


Table of Contents

              IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have executed this Agreement as of the date first written above.

    GENERAL PARTNER:

 

 

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS GP LLC

 

 

By:

 



        Name:  

        Title:  


 

 

ORGANIZATIONAL LIMITED PARTNER:

 

 

SUSSER HOLDINGS CORPORATION

 

 

By:

 



        Name:  

        Title:  

A-78


Table of Contents

EXHIBIT A
to the First Amended and Restated
Agreement of Limited Partnership of
Susser Petroleum Partners LP

Certificate Evidencing Common Units
Representing Limited Partner Interests in
Susser Petroleum Partners LP

No.                                                       Common Units

              In accordance with Section 4.1 of the First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of Susser Petroleum Partners LP, as amended, supplemented or restated from time to time (the " Partnership Agreement "), Susser Petroleum Partners LP, a Delaware limited partnership (the " Partnership "), hereby certifies that                                    (the " Holder ") is the registered owner of                         Common Units representing limited partner interests in the Partnership (the " Common Units ") transferable on the books of the Partnership, in person or by duly authorized attorney, upon surrender of this Certificate properly endorsed. The rights, preferences and limitations of the Common Units are set forth in, and this Certificate and the Common Units represented hereby are issued and shall in all respects be subject to the terms and provisions of, the Partnership Agreement. Copies of the Partnership Agreement are on file at, and will be furnished without charge on delivery of written request to the Partnership at, the principal office of the Partnership located 919 Milam, Suite 100, Houston, TX 77002. Capitalized terms used herein but not defined shall have the meanings given them in the Partnership Agreement.

              THE HOLDER OF THIS SECURITY ACKNOWLEDGES FOR THE BENEFIT OF SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP THAT THIS SECURITY MAY NOT BE SOLD, OFFERED, RESOLD, PLEDGED OR OTHERWISE TRANSFERRED IF SUCH TRANSFER WOULD (A) VIOLATE THE THEN APPLICABLE FEDERAL OR STATE SECURITIES LAWS OR RULES AND REGULATIONS OF THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION, ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION OR ANY OTHER GOVERNMENTAL AUTHORITY WITH JURISDICTION OVER SUCH TRANSFER, (B) TERMINATE THE EXISTENCE OR QUALIFICATION OF SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP UNDER THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF DELAWARE, OR (C) CAUSE SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP TO BE TREATED AS AN ASSOCIATION TAXABLE AS A CORPORATION OR OTHERWISE TO BE TAXED AS AN ENTITY FOR FEDERAL INCOME TAX PURPOSES (TO THE EXTENT NOT ALREADY SO TREATED OR TAXED). SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS GP LLC, THE GENERAL PARTNER OF SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP, MAY IMPOSE ADDITIONAL RESTRICTIONS ON THE TRANSFER OF THIS SECURITY IF IT DETERMINES, WITH THE ADVICE OF COUNSEL, THAT SUCH RESTRICTIONS ARE NECESSARY OR ADVISABLE (i) TO AVOID A SIGNIFICANT RISK OF SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP BECOMING TAXABLE AS A CORPORATION OR OTHERWISE BECOMING TAXABLE AS AN ENTITY FOR U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX PURPOSES OR (ii) TO PRESERVE THE ECONOMIC UNIFORMITY OF THE LIMITED PARTNER INTERESTS (OR ANY CLASS OR CLASSES THEREOF). THE RESTRICTIONS SET FORTH ABOVE SHALL NOT PRECLUDE THE SETTLEMENT OF ANY TRANSACTIONS INVOLVING THIS SECURITY ENTERED INTO THROUGH THE FACILITIES OF ANY NATIONAL SECURITIES EXCHANGE ON WHICH THIS SECURITY IS LISTED OR ADMITTED TO TRADING.

              The Holder, by accepting this Certificate, (i) shall be admitted to the Partnership as a Limited Partner with respect to the Limited Partner Interests so transferred to such person when any such transfer or admission is reflected on the books and records of the Partnership and such Limited Partner

A-A-1


Table of Contents

becomes the Record Holder of the Limited Partner Interests so transferred, (ii) shall become bound by the terms of the Partnership Agreement, (iii) represents that the transferee has the capacity, power and authority to enter into the Partnership Agreement and (iv) makes the consents, acknowledgements and waivers contained in the Partnership Agreement, with or without the execution of the Partnership Agreement by the Holder.

              This Certificate shall not be valid for any purpose unless it has been countersigned and registered by the Transfer Agent and Registrar.

Dated:  

  Susser Petroleum Partners LP

Countersigned and Registered by:

 

By:

 

Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC

[American Stock Transfer and Trust Company, N.A.],

 

By:

 



As Transfer Agent and Registrar   Name:  


 

 

 

 

Title:

 




 

 

 

 

By:

 




 

 

 

 

Name:

 




 

 

 

 

Title:

 



A-A-2


Table of Contents

[Reverse of Certificate]

ABBREVIATIONS

              The following abbreviations, when used in the inscription on the face of this Certificate, shall be construed as follows according to applicable laws or regulations:

TEN COM—as tenants in common   UNIF GIFT/TRANSFERS MIN ACT
TEN ENT—as tenants by the entireties                              Custodian                 
JT TEN—   as joint tenants with right of survivorship and not as tenants in common  
(Cust)                                             (Minor)
Under Uniform Gifts/Transfers to CD Minors Act
(State)

              Additional abbreviations, though not in the above list, may also be used.

ASSIGNMENT OF COMMON UNITS OF
SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP

              FOR VALUE RECEIVED,                          hereby assigns, conveys, sells and transfers unto



(Please print or typewrite name and address of assignee)
 

(Please insert Social Security or other identifying number of assignee)

                          Common Units representing limited partner interests evidenced by this Certificate, subject to the Partnership Agreement, and does hereby irrevocably constitute and appoint                          as its attorney-in-fact with full power of substitution to transfer the same on the books of Susser Petroleum Partners LP

Date:

 




 

NOTE: The signature to any endorsement hereon must correspond with the name as written upon the face of this Certificate in every particular. without alteration, enlargement or change.

THE SIGNATURE(S) MUST BE GUARANTEED BY AN ELIGIBLE GUARANTOR INSTITUTION (BANKS, STOCKBROKERS, SAVINGS AND LOAN ASSOCIATIONS AND CREDIT UNIONS WITH MEMBERSHIP IN AN APPROVED SIGNATURE GUARANTEE MEDALLION PROGRAM), PURSUANT TO S.E.C. RULE 17Ad-15

 



(Signature)




(Signature)




 

 

A-A-3


Table of Contents

              Through and including                        , 2012 (25 days after the date of this prospectus), all dealers that buy, sell or trade our common units, whether or not participating in this offering, may be required to deliver a prospectus. This is in addition to the dealers' obligation to deliver a prospectus when acting as underwriters and with respect to their unsold allotments or subscriptions.

                  Common Units
Representing Limited Partner Interests

Susser Petroleum Partners LP

GRAPHIC


PROSPECTUS


BofA Merrill Lynch

Barclays



                , 2012

   


Table of Contents


Part II
Information required in the registration statement

ITEM 13.    OTHER EXPENSES OF ISSUANCE AND DISTRIBUTION.

              Set forth below are the expenses (other than underwriting discounts) expected to be incurred in connection with the issuance and distribution of the securities registered hereby. With the exception of the Securities and Exchange Commission registration fee, the FINRA filing fee and the exchange listing fee the amounts set forth below are estimates.

SEC registration fee

  $ 22,920  

FINRA filing fee

    20,500  

Printing and engraving expenses

    300,000  

Fees and expenses of legal counsel

    1,500,000  

Accounting fees and expenses

    835,000  

Transfer agent and registrar fees

    *  

NYSE listing fee

    125,000  

Miscellaneous

    296,580  
       

Total

  $ 3,100,000  
       

ITEM 14.    INDEMNIFICATION OF OFFICERS AND MEMBERS OF OUR BOARD OF DIRECTORS.

              Subject to any terms, conditions or restrictions set forth in the partnership agreement, Section 17-108 of the Delaware Revised Uniform Limited Partnership Act empowers a Delaware limited partnership to indemnify and hold harmless any partner or other persons from and against all claims and demands whatsoever. The section of the prospectus entitled "The Partnership Agreement—Indemnification" discloses that we will generally indemnify officers, directors and affiliates of the general partner to the fullest extent permitted by the law against all losses, claims, damages or similar events and is incorporated herein by this reference.

              Our general partner will purchase insurance covering its officers and directors against liabilities asserted and expenses incurred in connection with their activities as officers and directors of the general partner or any of its direct or indirect subsidiaries.

              Our general partner will enter into indemnification agreements (each, an "Indemnification Agreement") with each of its officers and directors (each, an "Indemnitee"). Each Indemnification Agreement provides that our general partner will indemnify and hold harmless each Indemnitee against all expense, liability and loss (including attorney's fees, judgments, fines or penalties and amounts to be paid in settlement) actually and reasonably incurred or suffered by the Indemnitee in connection with serving in their capacity as officers and directors of our general partner (or of any subsidiary of our general partner) or in any capacity at the request of our general partner or its board of directors to the fullest extent permitted by applicable law, including Section 18-108 of the Delaware Limited Liability Company Act in effect on the date of the agreement or as such laws may be amended to provide more advantageous rights to the Indemnitee. The Indemnification Agreement also provides that the general partner must advance payment of certain expenses to the Indemnitee, including fees of counsel, in advance of final disposition of any proceeding subject to receipt of an undertaking from the Indemnitee to return such advance if it is ultimately determined that the Indemnitee is not entitled to indemnification.

              Any underwriting agreement entered into in connection with the sale of the securities offered pursuant to this registration statement will provide for indemnification of Susser Holdings Corporation

II-1


Table of Contents

and our general partner, their officers and directors, and any person who controls Susser Holdings Corporation and our general partner, including indemnification for liabilities under the Securities Act.

ITEM 15.    RECENT SALES OF UNREGISTERED SECURITIES.

              On June 11, 2012, in connection with the formation of Susser Petroleum Partners LP, we issued (i) a 0.0% non-economic general partner interest in us to Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC and (ii) a 100.0% limited partner interest in us to Susser Holdings Corporation for $1,000. The issuance was exempt from registration under Section 4(2) of the Securities Act. There have been no other sales of unregistered securities within the past three years.

ITEM 16.    EXHIBITS.

              The following documents are filed as exhibits to this registration statement:

 
  Exhibit
Number
  Description
      1.1         Form of Underwriting Agreement
      3.1   **     Certificate of Limited Partnership of Susser Petroleum Partners LP
      3.2   **     Agreement of Limited Partnership of Susser Petroleum Partners LP
      3.3         Form of First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership Agreement of Susser Petroleum Partners LP (included as Appendix A in the prospectus included in this Registration Statement)
      3.4   **     Certificate of Formation of Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC
      3.5   **     Limited Liability Company Agreement of Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC
      3.6         Form of Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement of Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC
      5.1         Form of Opinion of Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. as to the legality of the securities being registered
      8.1         Form of Opinion of Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. relating to tax matters
      10.1         Form of Contribution Agreement
      10.2   **     Form of Susser Petroleum Partners LP 2012 Long-Term Incentive Plan
      10.3         Form of Omnibus Agreement
      10.4         Form of Revolving Credit Agreement
      10.5         Form of Term Loan Agreement
      10.6         Form of SHC Distribution Contract
      10.7   *     Form of SHC Transportation Contract
      10.8         Form of Director Indemnification Agreement
      10.9         Form of Phantom Unit Award Agreement
      10.10   **     Branded Marketer Agreement between Susser Petroleum Company LLC and Chevron Products Company effective September 1, 2011
      10.11   **+     Unbranded Supply Agreement, dated July 28, 2006, by and between Susser Petroleum Company, LP and Valero Marketing and Supply Company, L.P. (Asterisks located within the exhibit denote information which has been deleted pursuant to a confidential treatment request filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission)
      10.12   **+     Branded Distributor Marketing Agreement (Valero Brand) dated July 28, 2006, by and between Valero Marketing and Supply Company and Susser Petroleum Company, LP (Asterisks located within the exhibit denote information which has been deleted pursuant to a confidential treatment request filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission)

II-2


Table of Contents

 
  Exhibit
Number
  Description
      10.13   **+     Branded Distributor Marketing Agreement (Shamrock Brand) dated July 28, 2006, by and between Valero Marketing and Supply Company and Susser Petroleum Company, LP (Asterisks located within the exhibit denote information which has been deleted pursuant to a confidential treatment request filed with the Securities Exchange Commission)
      10.14   **+     Master Agreement, dated July 28, 2006, by and between Valero Marketing and Supply Company and Susser Petroleum Company, LP, as amended (Asterisks located within the exhibit denote information which has been deleted pursuant to a confidential treatment request filed with the Securities Exchange Commission)
      21.1   **     List of Subsidiaries of Susser Petroleum Partners LP
      23.1         Consent of Ernst & Young LLP
      23.2         Consent of Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. (contained in Exhibit 5.1)
      23.3         Consent of Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. (contained in Exhibit 8.1)
      23.4         Consent of Director Nominee – David P. Engel
      23.5         Consent of Director Nominee – Armand S. Shapiro
      23.6         Consent of Director Nominee – Bryan F. Smith Jr.
      23.7         Consent of Director Nominee – Sam J. Susser
      24.1   **     Powers of Attorney

*
To be filed by amendment

**
Previously filed

+
Portions of this exhibit have been omitted pursuant to a request for confidential treatment.

ITEM 17.    UNDERTAKINGS.

              The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes to provide to the underwriters at the closing specified in the underwriting agreement certificates in such denominations and registered in such names as required by the underwriters to permit prompt delivery to each purchaser.

              Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is, therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against such liabilities (other than the payment by the registrant of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the registrant in the successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being registered, the registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue.

              The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes that, for the purpose of determining liability of the registrant under the Securities Act to any purchaser in the initial distribution of the securities, in a primary offering of securities of the undersigned registrant pursuant to this registration statement, regardless of the underwriting method used to sell the securities to the purchaser, if the securities are offered or sold to such purchaser by means of any of the following communications, the undersigned

II-3


Table of Contents

registrant will be a seller to the purchaser and will be considered to offer or sell such securities to such purchaser:

              (1)   Any preliminary prospectus or prospectus of the undersigned registrant relating to the offering required to be filed pursuant to Rule 424;

              (2)   Any free writing prospectus relating to the offering prepared by or on behalf of the undersigned registrant or used or referred to by the undersigned registrant;

              (3)   The portion of any other free writing prospectus relating to the offering containing material information about the undersigned registrant or its securities provided by or on behalf of the undersigned registrant; and

              (4)   Any other communication that is an offer in the offering made by the undersigned registrant to the purchaser.

              The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes that:

              (1)   For purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act, the information omitted from the form of prospectus filed as part of this registration statement in reliance upon Rule 430A and contained in a form of prospectus filed by the registrant pursuant to Rule 424(b)(1) or (4) or 497(h) under the Securities Act shall be deemed to be part of this registration statement as of the time it was declared effective.

              (2)   For the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities Act, each post-effective amendment that contains a form of prospectus shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.

              The undersigned registrant undertakes to send to each common unitholder, at least on an annual basis, a detailed statement of any transactions with Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC or its subsidiaries, and of fees, commissions, compensation and other benefits paid, or accrued to Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC or its subsidiaries for the fiscal year completed, showing the amount paid or accrued to each recipient and the services performed.

              The registrant undertakes to provide to the common unitholders the financial statements required by Form 10-K for the first full fiscal year of operations of the registrant.

II-4


Table of Contents


SIGNATURES

              Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, the registrant has duly caused this Registration Statement to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Houston, State of Texas, on August 29, 2012.

    Susser Petroleum Partners LP

 

 

By:

 

Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC

 

 

By:

 

/s/ SAM L. SUSSER

Sam L. Susser
Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of the Board of Directors

              Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, this Registration Statement has been signed below by the following persons in the capacities and the dates indicated.

Signature
 
Title
 
Date

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
/s/ SAM L. SUSSER

Sam L. Susser
  Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of the Board of Directors (Principal Executive Officer)   August 29, 2012

/s/ MARY E. SULLIVAN*

Mary E. Sullivan

 

Executive Vice President, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer (Principal Financial Officer and Principal Accounting Officer)

 

August 29, 2012

*By:

 

/s/ SAM L. SUSSER

Sam L. Susser
Attorney-in-Fact

 

 

 

 

II-5


Table of Contents

 
  Exhibit
Number
  Description
      1.1         Form of Underwriting Agreement
      3.1   **     Certificate of Limited Partnership of Susser Petroleum Partners LP
      3.2   **     Agreement of Limited Partnership of Susser Petroleum Partners LP
      3.3         Form of First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of Susser Petroleum Partners LP (included as Appendix A in the prospectus included in this Registration Statement)
      3.4   **     Certificate of Formation of Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC
      3.5   **     Limited Liability Company Agreement of Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC
      3.6         Form of Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement of Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC
      5.1         Form of Opinion of Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. as to the legality of the securities being registered
      8.1         Form of Opinion of Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. relating to tax matters
      10.1         Form of Contribution Agreement
      10.2   **     Form of Susser Petroleum Partners LP 2012 Long-Term Incentive Plan
      10.3         Form of Omnibus Agreement
      10.4         Form of Revolving Credit Agreement
      10.5         Form of Term Loan Agreement
      10.6         Form of SHC Distribution Contract
      10.7   *     Form of SHC Transportation Contract
      10.8         Form of Director Indemnification Agreement
      10.9         Form of Phantom Unit Award Agreement
      10.10   **     Branded Marketer Agreement between Susser Petroleum Company LLC and Chevron Products Company effective September 1, 2011
      10.11   **+     Unbranded Supply Agreement, dated July 28, 2006, by and between Susser Petroleum Company, LP and Valero Marketing and Supply Company, L.P. (Asterisks located within the exhibit denote information which has been deleted pursuant to a confidential treatment request filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission)
      10.12   **+     Branded Distributor Marketing Agreement (Valero Brand) dated July 28, 2006, by and between Valero Marketing and Supply Company and Susser Petroleum Company, LP (Asterisks located within the exhibit denote information which has been deleted pursuant to a confidential treatment request filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission)
      10.13   **+     Branded Distributor Marketing Agreement (Shamrock Brand) dated July 28, 2006, by and between Valero Marketing and Supply Company and Susser Petroleum Company, LP (Asterisks located within the exhibit denote information which has been deleted pursuant to a confidential treatment request filed with the Securities Exchange Commission)
      10.14   **+     Master Agreement, dated July 28, 2006, by and between Valero Marketing and Supply Company and Susser Petroleum Company, LP, as amended (Asterisks located within the exhibit denote information which has been deleted pursuant to a confidential treatment request filed with the Securities Exchange Commission)
      21.1   **     List of Subsidiaries of Susser Petroleum Partners LP
      23.1         Consent of Ernst & Young LLP
      23.2         Consent of Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. (contained in Exhibit 5.1)
      23.3         Consent of Vinson & Elkins L.L.P. (contained in Exhibit 8.1)
      23.4         Consent of Director Nominee – David P. Engel
      23.5         Consent of Director Nominee – Armand S. Shapiro
      23.6         Consent of Director Nominee – Bryan F. Smith Jr.
      23.7         Consent of Director Nominee – Sam J. Susser

II-6


Table of Contents

 
  Exhibit
Number
  Description
      24.1   **     Powers of Attorney

*
To be filed by amendment

**
Previously filed

+
Portions of this exhibit have been omitted pursuant to a request for confidential treatment.

II-7




Exhibit 1.1

 

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP
(a Delaware limited partnership)

 

[ · ] Common Units
Representing Limited Partner Interests

 

FORM OF UNDERWRITING AGREEMENT

 

Dated:  [ · ], 2012

 



 

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP

 

[ · ] Common Units
Representing Limited Partner Interests

 

UNDERWRITING AGREEMENT

 

[ · ], 2012

 

Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
Incorporated

Barclays Capital Inc.

as Representatives of the several Underwriters

 

c/o Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
Incorporated

One Bryant Park
New York, New York 10036

 

Ladies and Gentlemen:

 

Susser Petroleum Partners LP, a Delaware limited partnership (the “ Partnership ”), confirms its agreement with Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated (“ Merrill Lynch ”), Barclays Capital Inc. (“ Barclays ”) and each of the other Underwriters named in Schedule A hereto (collectively, the “ Underwriters ,” which term shall also include any underwriter substituted as hereinafter provided in Section 10 hereof), for whom Merrill Lynch and Barclays are acting as representatives (in such capacity, the “ Representatives ”), with respect to (i) the sale by the Partnership and the purchase by the Underwriters, acting severally and not jointly, of the respective numbers of common units representing limited partner interests in the Partnership (the “ Common Units ”) set forth in Schedule A hereto and (ii) the grant by the Partnership to the Underwriters, acting severally and not jointly, of the option described in Section 2(b) hereof to purchase all or any part of [ · ] additional Common Units.  The aforesaid [ · ] Common Units (the “ Initial Securities ”) to be purchased by the Underwriters and all or any part of the [ · ] Common Units subject to the option described in Section 2(b) hereof (the “ Option Securities ”) are herein called, collectively, the “ Securities .”

 

Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (the “ General Partner ”), is the sole general partner of the Partnership and a wholly owned subsidiary of Susser Holdings Corporation, a Delaware corporation (“ SHC ”).  SHC, the General Partner and the Partnership are together referred to herein as the “ Partnership Parties .” At the Closing Time (as defined below), upon consummation of the Formation Transactions (as defined below), (i) the Partnership will be the sole member of Susser Petroleum Operating Company LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“ Susser Operating ”), and (ii) Susser Operating will be the sole member of each of T&C Wholesale, LLC, a Texas limited liability company (“ T&C Wholesale ”), and Susser Petroleum Property Company, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“ Propco ”). Susser Operating, T&C Wholesale and Propco are collectively referred to herein as the “ Operating Subsidiaries ,” and together with the General Partner and

 



 

the Partnership, as the “ Partnership Entities .”  The Partnership Entities, SHC, Susser Petroleum Company LLC, a Texas limited liability company (“ SPC ”), Stripes LLC, a Texas limited liability company (“ Stripes ”) and Susser Holdings, L.L.C., a Delaware limited liability company (“ Holdings ”), are collectively referred to herein as the “ Susser Entities .”

 

It is understood and agreed to by all parties hereto that at or prior to the Closing Time, the following transactions (the “ Formation Transactions ”) will occur:

 

(a)           SPC will contribute substantially all of its wholesale motor fuel distribution business and associated rights and obligations (other than its contracts and assets relating to motor fuel consignment locations and transportation services) to Susser Operating;

 

(b)           SPC, Susser Operating and Stripes will enter into a ten-year distribution agreement (the “ SHC Distribution Contract ”);

 

(c)           SPC, Susser Operating and T&C Wholesale will enter into a ten-year transportation logistics agreement (the “ SHC Transportation Contract ”);

 

(d)           SHC, SPC, Stripes, Holdings, the General Partner and the Partnership will enter into a Contribution Agreement (the “ Contribution Agreement ”), pursuant to which, among other things, (1) SPC will contribute to the Partnership all of the equity interests in Susser Operating, (2) the General Partner will maintain a 0.0% non-economic general partner interest in the Partnership, and (3) the Partnership will issue to SHC and/or Stripes an aggregate of [ · ] Common Units, representing a [ · ]% limited partner interest in the Partnership, and [ · ] subordinated units representing limited partner interests in the Partnership (“ Subordinated Units ”), representing a [ · ]% limited partner interest in the Partnership, and all of the Incentive Distribution Rights (as defined below) and (4) the Partnership will distribute to SHC and/or Stripes $[ · ] million sourced to new debt recourse to the General Partner (the “ Recourse Debt ”), $[ · ] million as reimbursement for certain capital expenditures and $[ · ] million from borrowings of the Partnership to partially satisfy the Asset Sales Covenant (as defined in the Contribution Agreement);

 

(e)           The Partnership will issue to the public [ · ] Common Units representing a [ · ]% limited partner interest in the Partnership;

 

(f)            The Partnership will enter into a $250 million revolving credit facility (the “ Revolving Credit Facility ”) and a term loan facility (the “ Term Loan Facility ” and, collectively with the Revolving Credit Facility, the “ Credit Facilities ”) and will borrow $[ · ] million of Recourse Debt under the term loan facility;

 

(g)           The Partnership will use the proceeds from the issuance and sale of the Initial Securities, after deducting underwriting discounts, structuring fees and offering expenses, and the proceeds of the Recourse Debt as described under the heading “Use of Proceeds” in the Prospectus;

 

(h)           The Partnership will enter into an omnibus agreement (the “ Omnibus Agreement ”) with SHC, pursuant to which, among other things, (i) SHC will provide the Partnership with certain rights relating to certain future business opportunities, (ii) SHC will provide certain operational services to the Partnership in support of the Partnership’s operations and various centralized corporate services, and (iii) the parties thereto will agree to certain indemnification obligations;

 

(i)            The Partnership will amend and restate its agreement of limited partnership (such agreement, together with any amendments and/or restatements thereof on or prior to the Closing Time or applicable Date of Delivery (as the case may be), the “ Partnership  Agreement ”); and

 

2



 

(j)            The General Partner will amend and restate its limited liability company agreement (such agreement, together with any amendments and/or restatements thereof on or prior to the Closing Time or applicable Date of Delivery (as the case may be), the “ GP LLC Agreement ”).

 

This Agreement, the SHC Distribution Contract, the SHC Transportation Contract, the Contribution Agreement, the Credit Facilities and the Omnibus Agreement are referred to collectively herein as the “ Transaction Agreements ” and each, individually, as a “ Transaction Agreement .” The Transaction Agreements and the Organizational Agreements (as defined below) are referred to collectively herein as the “ Operative Agreements ” and each, individually, as an “ Operative Agreement .”

 

The Partnership understands that the Underwriters propose to make a public offering of the Securities as soon as the Representatives deems advisable after this Agreement has been executed and delivered.

 

The Partnership and the Underwriters agree that up to [ · ] Common Units to be purchased by the Underwriters (the “ Reserved Securities ”) shall be reserved for sale by the Underwriters to certain persons designated by the Partnership (the “ Invitees ”), as part of the distribution of the Securities by the Underwriters, subject to the terms of this Agreement, the applicable rules, regulations and interpretations of the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, Inc. (“ FINRA ”) and all other applicable laws, rules and regulations.  The Partnership solely determined, without any direct or indirect participation by the Underwriters, the Invitees who will purchase Reserved Securities (including the amount to be purchased by such persons) sold by the Underwriters.  To the extent that such Reserved Securities are not orally confirmed for purchase by Invitees by 9:00 A.M. (New York City time) on the first business day after the date of this Agreement, such Reserved Securities may be offered to the public as part of the public offering contemplated hereby.

 

The Partnership has filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “ Commission ”) a registration statement on Form S-1 (No. 333-182276), including the related preliminary prospectus or prospectuses, covering the registration of the sale of the Securities under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “ 1933 Act ”).  Promptly after execution and delivery of this Agreement, the Partnership will prepare and file a prospectus in accordance with the provisions of Rule 430A (“ Rule 430A ”) of the rules and regulations of the Commission under the 1933 Act (the “ 1933 Act Regulations ”) and Rule 424(b) (“ Rule 424(b) ”) of the 1933 Act Regulations.  The information included in such prospectus that was omitted from such registration statement at the time it became effective but that is deemed to be part of such registration statement at the time it became effective pursuant to Rule 430A(b) is herein called the “ Rule 430A Information .”  Such registration statement, including the amendments thereto, the exhibits thereto and any schedules thereto, at the time it became effective, and including the Rule 430A Information, is herein called the “ Registration Statement .”  Any registration statement filed pursuant to Rule 462(b) of the 1933 Act Regulations is herein called the “ Rule 462(b) Registration Statement ” and, after such filing, the term “ Registration Statement ” shall include the Rule 462(b) Registration Statement.  Each prospectus used prior to the effectiveness of the Registration Statement, and each prospectus that omitted the Rule 430A Information that was used after such effectiveness and prior to the execution and delivery of this Agreement, is herein called a “preliminary prospectus.”  The final prospectus, in the form first furnished to the Underwriters for use in connection with the offering of the Securities, is herein called the “ Prospectus .”  For purposes of this Agreement, all references to the Registration Statement, any preliminary prospectus, the Prospectus or any amendment or supplement to any of the foregoing shall be deemed to include the copy filed with the Commission pursuant to its Electronic Data Gathering, Analysis and Retrieval system or any successor system (“ EDGAR ”).

 

This Agreement is to confirm the agreement among the Partnership Parties and the Underwriters concerning the purchase of the Securities from the Partnership by the Underwriters.

 

3



 

As used in this Agreement:

 

Applicable Time ” means [    :00 P. M.], New York City time, on [ · ], 2012 or such other time as agreed by the Partnership and Merrill Lynch.

 

General Disclosure Package ” means any Issuer General Use Free Writing Prospectus issued at or prior to the Applicable Time, the most recent preliminary prospectus that is distributed to investors prior to the Applicable Time and the information included on Schedule B-1 hereto, all considered together.

 

Issuer Free Writing Prospectus ” means any “issuer free writing prospectus,” as defined in Rule 433 of the 1933 Act Regulations (“ Rule 433 ”), including without limitation any “free writing prospectus” (as defined in Rule 405 of the 1933 Act Regulations (“ Rule 405 ”)) relating to the Securities that is (i) required to be filed with the Commission by the Partnership, (ii) a “road show that is a written communication” within the meaning of Rule 433(d)(8)(i), whether or not required to be filed with the Commission, or (iii) exempt from filing with the Commission pursuant to Rule 433(d)(5)(i) because it contains a description of the Securities or of the offering that does not reflect the final terms, in each case in the form filed or required to be filed with the Commission or, if not required to be filed, in the form retained in the Partnership’s records pursuant to Rule 433(g).

 

Issuer General Use Free Writing Prospectus ” means any Issuer Free Writing Prospectus that is intended for general distribution to prospective investors (other than a “ bona fide electronic road show,” as defined in Rule 433 (the “ Bona Fide Electronic Road Show ”)), as evidenced by its being specified in Schedule B-2 hereto.

 

Issuer Limited Use Free Writing Prospectus ” means any Issuer Free Writing Prospectus that is not an Issuer General Use Free Writing Prospectus.

 

SECTION 1.         Representations and Warranties .

 

(a)           Representations and Warranties by the Partnership Parties .  Each of the Partnership Parties, jointly and severally, represents and warrants to each Underwriter as of the date hereof, the Applicable Time, the Closing Time and any Date of Delivery (as defined in Section 2(b) below), and agrees with each Underwriter, as follows:

 

(i)            Registration Statement and Prospectuses .  Each of the Registration Statement and any post-effective amendment thereto has become effective under the 1933 Act.  No stop order suspending the effectiveness of the Registration Statement or any post-effective amendment thereto has been issued under the 1933 Act, no order preventing or suspending the use of any preliminary prospectus, any Issuer Free Writing Prospectus or the Prospectus has been issued and no proceedings for any of those purposes have been instituted or are pending or, to the knowledge of any of the Partnership Parties, contemplated.  The Partnership has complied with each request (if any) from the Commission for additional information.

 

Each of the Registration Statement and any post-effective amendment thereto, at the time it became effective, complied in all material respects with the requirements of the 1933 Act and the 1933 Act Regulations.  Each preliminary prospectus, the Prospectus and any amendment or supplement thereto, at the time each was filed with the Commission, complied in all material

 

4



 

respects with the requirements of the 1933 Act and the 1933 Act Regulations.  Each preliminary prospectus delivered to the Underwriters for use in connection with this offering and the Prospectus was or will be identical to the electronically transmitted copies thereof filed with the Commission pursuant to EDGAR, except to the extent permitted by Regulation S-T.

 

(ii)           Accurate Disclosure .  Neither the Registration Statement nor any post-effective amendment thereto, at its effective time contained an untrue statement of a material fact or omitted to state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not misleading.  As of the Applicable Time, neither (A) the General Disclosure Package nor (B) any individual Issuer Limited Use Free Writing Prospectus, when considered together with the General Disclosure Package, included an untrue statement of a material fact or omitted to state a material fact necessary in order to make the statements therein, in the light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading.  Neither the Prospectus nor any amendment or supplement thereto [(including any prospectus wrapper)], as of its issue date, at the time of any filing with the Commission pursuant to Rule 424(b), at the Closing Time or at any Date of Delivery, will include an untrue statement of a material fact or will omit to state a material fact necessary in order to make the statements therein, in the light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading.

 

The representations and warranties in this subsection shall not apply to statements in or omissions from the Registration Statement (or any amendment thereto), the General Disclosure Package or the Prospectus (or any amendment or supplement thereto) made in reliance upon and in conformity with written information furnished to the Partnership by any Underwriter through the Representatives expressly for use therein.  For purposes of this Agreement, the only information so furnished shall be the information in the first paragraph under the heading “Underwriting—Commissions and Discounts,” the information in the second, third and fourth paragraphs under the heading “Underwriting—Price Stabilization, Short Positions and Penalty Bids” and the information under the heading “Underwriting—Electronic Distribution” in each case contained in the Prospectus (collectively, the “ Underwriter Information ”).

 

(iii)          Issuer Free Writing Prospectuses .  No Issuer Free Writing Prospectus conflicts or will conflict with the information contained in the Registration Statement or the Prospectus, and any preliminary or other prospectus deemed to be a part thereof that has not been superseded or modified.  The foregoing sentence does not apply to statements in or omissions from any Issuer Free Writing Prospectus based upon and in conformity with the Underwriter Information. The Partnership has made available a Bona Fide Electronic Road Show in compliance with Rule 433(d)(8)(ii) such that no filing of any “road show” (as defined in Rule 433(h)) is required in connection with the offering of the Securities.

 

(iv)          Partnership Not Ineligible Issuer .  At the time of filing the Registration Statement and any post-effective amendment thereto, at the earliest time thereafter that the Partnership or another offering participant made a bona fide offer (within the meaning of Rule 164(h)(2) of the 1933 Act Regulations) of the Securities and at the date hereof, the Partnership was not and is not an “ineligible issuer,” as defined in Rule 405, without taking account of any determination by the Commission pursuant to Rule 405 that it is not necessary that the Partnership be considered an ineligible issuer.

 

(v)           Independent Accountants .  Ernst & Young LLP, who has certified certain financial statements and supporting schedules included in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus, is an independent registered public accounting firm with

 

5



 

respect to the Partnership as required by the 1933 Act, the 1933 Act Regulations and the Public Accounting Oversight Board.

 

(vi)          Financial Statements; Non-GAAP Financial Measures .  The historical financial statements included in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus, together with the related schedules and notes, present fairly the financial position of SPC, the Partnership’s predecessor for accounting purposes (the “ Predecessor ”), at the dates indicated and the statement of operations, shareholder’s equity and cash flows of the Predecessor for the periods specified; and said financial statements have been prepared in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (“ GAAP ”) applied on a consistent basis throughout the periods involved (except as otherwise noted therein).  The supporting schedules, if any, present fairly in accordance with GAAP the information required to be stated therein. The summary financial and statistical data set forth in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus under the caption “Summary—Summary Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data,” and the selected financial data set forth under the caption “Selected Historical Financial Data” in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus are presented fairly in all material respects and prepared on a basis consistent with that of the audited financial statements and unaudited financial statements, as applicable, from which they have been derived. The pro forma financial statements included in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus include assumptions that provide a reasonable basis for presenting the significant effects directly attributable to the transactions and events described therein, the related pro forma adjustments give appropriate effect to those assumptions, and the pro forma adjustments reflect the proper application of those adjustments to the historical financial statement amounts in the pro forma financial statements included in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus. The pro forma financial statements included in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus comply as to form in all material respects with the applicable requirements of Regulation S-X under the 1933 Act. All other financial information included in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus has been derived from the accounting records of the Predecessor and presents fairly the information shown thereby. Except as included therein, no historical or pro forma financial statements or supporting schedules are required to be included or incorporated by reference in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package or the Prospectus under the 1933 Act or the 1933 Act Regulations.  All disclosures contained in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package or the Prospectus regarding “non-GAAP financial measures” (as such term is defined by the rules and regulations of the Commission) comply with Regulation G of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “ 1934 Act ”) and Item 10 of Regulation S-K of the 1933 Act, to the extent applicable.

 

(vii)         Forward-Looking Statements and Supporting Information . No forward-looking statement contained in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package or the Prospectus within the coverage of Rule 175(b) under the 1933 Act, including (but not limited to) any statements with respect to projected results of operations, estimated available cash and future cash distributions of the Partnership, and any statements made in support thereof or related thereto under the heading “Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions,” and the anticipated ratio of taxable income to distributions, has been made or reaffirmed without a reasonable basis or has been disclosed other than in good faith.

 

(viii)        No Material Adverse Change in Business .  Except as otherwise stated therein, since the respective dates as of which information is given in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package or the Prospectus, (A) there has been no material adverse change, or

 

6



 

any development that could reasonably be expected to (1) result in a material adverse change in the condition, financial or otherwise, or in the earnings, properties, business, operations or business prospects of the Partnership Entities, whether or not arising in the ordinary course of business, or (2) materially and adversely affect the ability of any of the Partnership Parties to perform its obligations pursuant to this Agreement (each such change, a “ Material Adverse Effect ”), (B) there have been no transactions entered into by any of the Partnership Entities, other than those in the ordinary course of business, which are material with respect to the Partnership Entities, considered as one enterprise, (C) there have been no liabilities or obligations, direct or contingent, incurred by any of the Partnership Entities that are material to the Partnership Entities taken as a whole, (D) there has been no change in the capitalization, short-term debt or long-term debt of the Partnership Entities and (E) there has been no dividend or distribution of any kind declared, paid or made by the Partnership Entities on any class of equity securities

 

(ix)          Formation of Susser Entities and Good Standing of Partnership Entities .  Each of the Susser Entities has been duly formed and is validly existing as a corporation, limited partnership or limited liability company, as the case may be, and is in good standing under the laws of its jurisdiction of organization (as set forth on Schedule C hereto), and has all corporate, partnership or limited liability company power and authority, as the case may be, necessary to own, lease and operate its properties and to conduct its business as described in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus. Each of the Partnership Entities is duly qualified as a foreign corporation, partnership or limited liability company, as applicable, to transact business and is in good standing in each other jurisdiction in which such qualification is required, whether by reason of the ownership or leasing of property or the conduct of business (as set forth on Schedule C hereto), except for any failures to be so qualified or in good standing that would not result in a Material Adverse Effect. Schedule C hereto accurately sets forth the jurisdiction of organization and each jurisdiction of foreign qualification for each of the Partnership Entities.

 

(x)           Ownership of General Partner .  SHC, as the sole member of the General Partner, directly owns 100% of the issued and outstanding membership interests in the General Partner; such membership interests have been duly authorized and validly issued in accordance with the GP LLC Agreement and are fully paid (to the extent required by the GP LLC Agreement) and non-assessable (except as such non-assessability may be limited by Sections 18-607 and 18-804 of the Delaware Limited Liability Company Act (the “ Delaware LLC Act ”)); and SHC owns such membership interests free and clear of all Liens.

 

(xi)          Ownership of the General Partner Interest in the Partnership .  The General Partner is the sole general partner of the Partnership, with a 0.0% non-economic general partner interest in the Partnership (the “ General Partner Interest ”).  The General Partner Interest has been duly authorized and validly issued in accordance with the Partnership Agreement; and the General Partner owns the General Partner Interest free and clear of all Liens.

 

(xii)         Ownership of Sponsor Units . At the Closing Time, after giving effect to the Formation Transactions (and assuming no purchase of Option Securities by the Underwriters at the Closing Time), [SHC] will own [ · ] Common Units and [ · ] Subordinated Units and Stripes will own [ · ] Common Units and [ · ] Subordinated Units (such Common Units and Subordinated Units being collectively referred to herein as the “ Sponsor Units ”); the Sponsor Units and the limited partner interests represented thereby will have been duly authorized and validly issued in accordance with the Partnership Agreement and will be fully paid (to the extent required by the Partnership Agreement) and non-assessable (except as such non-assessability may be affected by Sections 17-303, 17-607 and 17-804 of the Delaware Revised Uniform Limited Partnership Act

 

7



 

(the “ Delaware LP Act ”)); and SHC and Stripes will own their respective Sponsor Units free and clear of all Liens.

 

(xiii)        Ownership of Incentive Distribution Rights .  At the Closing Time, after giving effect to the Formation Transactions, and at each Date of Delivery, SHC will be the record holder of all of the Incentive Distribution Rights (as such term is defined in the Partnership Agreement, the “ Incentive Distribution Rights ”); such Incentive Distribution Rights will have been duly authorized and validly issued in accordance with the Partnership Agreement, and will be fully paid (to the extent required under the Partnership Agreement) and non-assessable (except as such non-assessability may be affected by matters described in Sections 17-303, 17-607 and 17-804 of the Delaware LP Act); and SHC will own the Incentive Distribution Rights free and clear of all Liens.

 

(xiv)        Ownership of Susser Operating . At the Closing Time, after giving effect to the Formation Transactions, and at each Date of Delivery, the Partnership will be the owner of 100% of the issued and outstanding membership interests in Susser Operating; such membership interests will have been duly authorized and validly issued in accordance with the limited liability company agreement of Susser Operating (such agreement, together with any amendments and/or restatements thereof on or prior to the Closing Time or applicable Date of Delivery (as the case may be), the “ Susser Operating LLC Agreement ”) and will be fully paid (to the extent required by the Susser Operating LLC Agreement) and non-assessable (except as such non-assessability may be limited by Sections 18-607 and 18-804 of the Delaware LLC Act); and the Partnership will own such membership interests free and clear of all Liens, other than Liens created pursuant to the Credit Facilities.

 

(xv)         Ownership of T&C Wholesale . At the Closing Time, after giving effect to the Formation Transactions, and at each Date of Delivery, Susser Operating will be the owner of 100% of the issued and outstanding membership interests in T&C Wholesale; such membership interests will have been duly authorized and validly issued in accordance with the limited liability company agreement of T&C Wholesale (such agreement, together with any amendments and/or restatements thereof on or prior to the Closing Time or applicable Date of Delivery (as the case may be), the “ T&C Wholesale LLC Agreement ”) and will be fully paid (to the extent required by the T&C Wholesale LLC Agreement) and non-assessable (except as such non-assessability may be limited by Section 101.206 of the TBOC); and Susser Operating will own such membership interests free and clear of all Liens, other than Liens created pursuant to the Credit Facilities.

 

(xvi)        Ownership of Propco .  At the Closing Time, after giving effect to the Formation Transactions, and at each Date of Delivery, Susser Operating will be the owner of 100% of the issued and outstanding membership interests in Propco; such membership interests will have been duly authorized and validly issued in accordance with the limited liability company agreement of Propco (such agreement, together with any amendments and/or restatements thereof on or prior to the Closing Time or applicable Date of Delivery (as the case may be), the “ Propco LLC Agreement ”) and will be fully paid (to the extent required by the Propco LLC Agreement) and non-assessable (except as such non-assessability may be limited by Sections 18-607 and 18-804 of the Delaware LLC Act); and Susser Operating will own such membership interests free and clear of all Liens, other than Liens created pursuant to the Credit Facilities.  The GP LLC Agreement, the Partnership Agreement, the Susser Operating LLC Agreement, the T&C Wholesale LLC Agreement and the Propco LLC Agreement are referred to collectively herein as the “ Organizational Agreements ” and each, individually, as an “ Organizational Agreement .”

 

8



 

(xvii)       No Other Subsidiaries . None of the Partnership Entities owns or, at the Closing Time and each Date of Delivery, will own, directly or indirectly, an equity interest in, or long-term debt securities of, any corporation, partnership, limited liability company, joint venture, association or other entity, other than another Partnership Entity.

 

(xviii)      No Restrictions on the Operating Subsidiaries . At the Closing Time, after giving effect to the Formation Transactions, and at each Date of Delivery, the Operating Subsidiaries will not be prohibited, directly or indirectly, under any agreement or other instrument to which it is a party or is subject, from paying any dividends to the Partnership, from making any other distribution on such subsidiary’s equity securities, from repaying to the Partnership any loans or advances to such subsidiary from the Partnership or from transferring any of such subsidiary’s properties or assets to the Partnership or any other subsidiary of the Partnership, except as set forth in the Credit Facilities.

 

(xix)        Authority . Each of the Susser Entities has the full corporate, partnership or limited liability company right, power and authority, as the case may be, necessary (A) to execute and deliver this Agreement and each of the Operative Agreements to which it is a party and to perform its obligations hereunder and thereunder; and all action required to be taken for the due and proper authorization, execution and delivery by it of this Agreement and each of the Operative Agreements to which it is a party and the consummation by it of the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby has been duly and validly taken, (B) in the case of the Partnership, issue, to sell and deliver the Securities, the Sponsor Units and the Incentive Distribution Rights and (C) in the case of the General Partner, to act as the general partner of the Partnership.

 

(xx)         Authorization, Execution and Delivery of Agreement .  This Agreement has been duly authorized, executed and delivered by each of the Partnership Parties.

 

(xxi)        Authorization, Execution, Delivery and Enforceability of Certain Agreements . At or before the Closing Time and each applicable Date of Delivery:

 

(A)          the GP LLC Agreement will have been duly authorized, executed and delivered by SHC and will be a valid and legally binding agreement of SHC, enforceable against SHC in accordance with its terms;

 

(B)          the Partnership Agreement will have been duly authorized, executed and delivered by SHC and the General Partner, and will be a valid and legally binding agreement of SHC and the General Partner, enforceable against each of them in accordance with its terms;

 

(C)          the Susser Operating LLC Agreement will have been duly authorized, executed and delivered by the Partnership and will be a valid and legally binding agreement of the Partnership, enforceable against the Partnership in accordance with its terms;

 

(D)          the T&C Wholesale LLC Agreement will have been duly authorized, executed and delivered by Susser Operating and will be a valid and legally binding agreement of Susser Operating, enforceable against Susser Operating in accordance with its terms;

 

9


 

(E)           the Propco LLC Agreement will have been duly authorized, executed and delivered by Susser Operating and will be a valid and legally binding agreement of Susser Operating, enforceable against Susser Operating in accordance with its terms;

 

(F)           the SHC Distribution Contract has been duly authorized, executed and delivered by SPC, Susser Operating and Stripes and is a valid and legally binding agreement of SPC, Susser Operating and Stripes, enforceable against each of them in accordance with its terms;

 

(G)           the SHC Transportation Contract has been duly authorized, executed and delivered by SPC, Susser Operating and T&C Wholesale is a valid and legally binding agreement of SPC, Susser Operating and T&C Wholesale, enforceable against each of them in accordance with its terms;

 

(H)          the Contribution Agreement will have been duly authorized, executed and delivered by SHC, SPC, Stripes, Holdings, the General Partner and the Partnership and will be a valid and legally binding agreement of each of them, enforceable against each of them in accordance with its terms;

 

(I)            the Omnibus Agreement will have been duly authorized, executed and delivered by SHC, the General Partner and the Partnership and will be a valid and legally binding agreement of SHC, the General Partner and the Partnership, enforceable against each of them in accordance with its terms;

 

(J)            the Credit Facilities will have been duly authorized, executed and delivered by the Partnership and will be a valid and legally binding agreement of the Partnership, enforceable against the Partnership in accordance with its terms;

 

provided, that, with respect to each agreement described in this Section 1(a)(xxi), the enforceability thereof may be limited by bankruptcy, insolvency, fraudulent transfer, reorganization, moratorium and similar laws relating to or affecting creditors’ rights generally and by general principles of equity (regardless of whether such enforceability is considered in a proceeding in equity or at law); provided further, that the indemnity, contribution and exoneration provisions contained in any of such agreements may be limited by applicable laws and public policy.

 

(xxii)        Legal Sufficiency of Contribution Agreement . The Contribution Agreement, together with any bills of sale, conveyances and similar transfer documents relating to the transactions contemplated thereby (collectively, the “ Contribution Documents ”), are legally sufficient to transfer or convey to the Partnership, directly or indirectly, all of the assets and properties necessary to enable the Partnership Entities to conduct their operations in all material respects as contemplated in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus, subject to the conditions, reservations, encumbrances and limitations contained in the Contribution Documents and described in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus. The Partnership Entities have directly or indirectly succeeded in all material respects to the business, assets, properties, liabilities and operations reflected in the pro forma financial statements of the Partnership.

 

(xxiii)       Authorization of Securities .  The Securities to be purchased by the Underwriters from the Partnership, and the limited partner interests represented thereby, have been duly authorized for issuance and sale to the Underwriters pursuant to this Agreement and, when issued

 

10



 

and delivered by the Partnership pursuant to this Agreement against payment of the consideration set forth herein, will be validly issued, fully paid (to the extent required under the Partnership Agreement) and non-assessable (except as such non-assessability may be affected by Section 17-303, 17-607 or 17-804 of the Delaware LP Act); and other than the Sponsor Units and the Incentive Distribution Rights, the Securities will be the only limited partner interests of the Partnership issued and outstanding.

 

(xxiv)       Conformity of Securities to Description .  The Securities, when issued and delivered in accordance with the terms of the Partnership Agreement and this Agreement against payment therefor as provided therein and herein, will conform, and the Sponsor Units, the General Partner Interest and the Incentive Distribution Rights conform, or when issued and delivered in accordance with the terms of the Partnership Agreement will conform, in all material respects to the statements relating thereto contained in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus, and such description conforms to the rights set forth in the instruments defining the same.  No holder of Securities will be subject to personal liability solely by reason of being such a holder.

 

(xxv)        No Options, Preemptive Rights, Registration Rights, or Other Rights .  Except as described in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus, there are no options, warrants, preemptive rights, rights of first refusal or other rights to subscribe for or to purchase, nor any restriction upon the voting or transfer of, any equity securities of any of the Partnership Entities, in each case pursuant to the certificate of limited partnership, formation or incorporation, bylaws, agreement of limited partnership, limited liability company agreement or any other organizational documents (collectively, “ Organizational Documents ”) of any such Partnership Entity or any other agreement or other instrument to which any such Partnership Entity is a party or by which any such Partnership Entity may be bound. Neither the filing of the Registration Statement nor the offering, issuance or sale of the Securities as contemplated by this Agreement gives rise to any rights for or relating to the registration of any Common Units or other securities of the Partnership.

 

(xxvi)       Absence of Violations, Defaults and Conflicts .  None of the Susser Entities is (A) in violation of its Organizational Documents, (B) in violation, breach or default, and no event has occurred that, with notice or lapse of time or both, would constitute such a violation or breach of, or default under, any contract, indenture, mortgage, deed of trust, loan or credit agreement, note, lease or other agreement or instrument to which any of the Susser Entities is or, at Closing, will be a party or by which it or any of them may be bound or to which any of the properties or assets of any of the Susser Entities is subject (collectively, “ Agreements and Instruments ”), except for any such violations, breaches and defaults that would not, singly or in the aggregate, result in a Material Adverse Effect, or (C) in violation of any law, statute, rule, regulation, judgment, order, writ or decree of any arbitrator, court, governmental body, regulatory body, administrative agency or other authority, body or agency having jurisdiction over any of the Susser Entities or any of their respective properties, assets or operations (each, a “ Governmental Entity ”), except for any such violations that would not, singly or in the aggregate, result in a Material Adverse Effect.  The execution, delivery and performance of this Agreement and the Operative Agreements (as the case may be) and the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby and in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus (including the issuance and sale of the Securities and the use of the proceeds from the sale of the Securities as described therein under the caption “Use of Proceeds”) do not and will not, whether with or without the giving of notice or passage of time or both, constitute a breach or violation of, or default or Repayment Event (as defined below) under, or result in the creation or imposition of any Lien upon any properties or assets of any of the Susser Entities pursuant to, the Agreements

 

11



 

and Instruments (except for any such violations, breaches, defaults, Repayment Events, liens, charges or encumbrances that would not, singly or in the aggregate, result in a Material Adverse Effect and other than Liens created pursuant to the Credit Facilities), nor will such action result in (x) any violation of the provisions of the Organizational Documents of any of the Susser Entities or (y) any violation of any law, statute, rule, regulation, judgment, order, writ or decree of any Governmental Entity, except in the case of clause (y), for any such violations that would not, singly or in the aggregate, result in a Material Adverse Effect.  As used herein, a “ Repayment Event ” means any event or condition which gives the holder of any note, debenture or other evidence of indebtedness (or any person acting on such holder’s behalf) the right to require the repurchase, redemption or repayment of all or a portion of such indebtedness by any of the Susser Entities.

 

(xxvii)      Absence of Labor Dispute .  No labor dispute with the employees of any of the Susser Entities engaged in the business of the Partnership Entities exists or, to the knowledge of the Susser Entities, is imminent, which, in any case, would result in a Material Adverse Effect.

 

(xxviii)     Absence of Proceedings .  There are no legal or governmental actions, suits or proceedings pending or, to the knowledge of the Partnership Parties, threatened (i) against the Susser Entities or (ii) which has as the subject thereof any property owned or leased by, the Susser Entities, which, in the case of clauses (i) and (ii) above, if determined adversely to the Susser Entities, would result in a Material Adverse Effect or adversely affect the consummation of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement.

 

(xxix)       Accuracy of Exhibits .  There are no contracts or documents which are required to be described in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package or the Prospectus or to be filed as exhibits to the Registration Statement which have not been so described or filed as required (and the preliminary prospectus contains in all material respects the same description of the foregoing matters contained in the Prospectus). Each such contract or document that is described in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package or the Prospectus conforms in all material respects to the description thereof. Except as described in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus, none of the Susser Entities has sent or received any notice indicating the termination of or intention to terminate any of the contracts or agreements referred to or described in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus or filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement.

 

(xxx)        Absence of Further Requirements .  No filing with, or authorization, approval, consent, license, order, registration, qualification or decree of, any Governmental Entity is necessary or required for the performance by any of the Susser Entities of its obligations hereunder or under any of the other Operative Agreements, in connection with the offering, issuance or sale of the Securities hereunder or the consummation of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement or the other Operative Agreements, except (A) such as have been already obtained or as may be required under the 1933 Act, the 1933 Act Regulations, the rules of the New York Stock Exchange, state securities laws or the rules of FINRA and (B) such as have been obtained under the laws and regulations of jurisdictions outside the United States in which the Reserved Securities were offered.

 

(xxxi)       Possession of Licenses and Permits .  Each of the Partnership Entities possesses such permits, licenses, approvals, consents and other authorizations (collectively, “ Governmental Licenses ”) issued by the appropriate Governmental Entities necessary to conduct the business now operated by them, except for any failures to possess a Governmental License that would not, singly or in the aggregate, result in a Material Adverse Effect.  Each of the Partnership Entities is

 

12



 

in compliance with the terms and conditions of all Governmental Licenses, except for any failures to comply that would not, singly or in the aggregate, result in a Material Adverse Effect.  All of the Governmental Licenses are valid and in full force and effect, except for any failures of such Governmental Licenses to be in full force and effect that would not, singly or in the aggregate, result in a Material Adverse Effect.  None of the Partnership Entities has received any notice of proceedings relating to the revocation or modification of any Governmental Licenses which, singly or in the aggregate, if the subject of an unfavorable decision, ruling or finding, would result in a Material Adverse Effect.

 

(xxxii)      Title to Property .  The Partnership Entities have good and marketable title to all real property owned by them and good title to all other property owned by them, in each case, free and clear of all mortgages, pledges, liens, security interests, claims, restrictions or encumbrances of any kind except such as (A) are described in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus or (B) do not, singly or in the aggregate, materially affect the value of such property and do not interfere with the use made and proposed to be made of such property by the Partnership Entities; and all of the leases and subleases material to the business of the Partnership Entities, considered as one enterprise, and under which any of the Partnership Entities holds properties described in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package or the Prospectus, are in full force and effect, and none of the Partnership Entities has any notice of any material claim of any sort that has been asserted by anyone adverse to the rights of any of the Partnership Entities under any of the leases or subleases mentioned above, or affecting or questioning the rights of any such Partnership Entity to the continued possession of the leased or subleased premises under any such lease or sublease.

 

(xxxiii)     Possession of Intellectual Property .  The Partnership Entities own or possess, or can acquire on reasonable terms, adequate patents, patent rights, licenses, inventions, copyrights, know-how (including trade secrets and other unpatented and/or unpatentable proprietary or confidential information, systems or procedures), trademarks, service marks, trade names or other intellectual property (collectively, “ Intellectual Property ”) necessary to carry on the business now operated by them, and none of the Partnership Entities has received any notice or is otherwise aware of any infringement of or conflict with asserted rights of others with respect to any Intellectual Property or of any facts or circumstances which would render any Intellectual Property invalid or inadequate to protect the interest of the Partnership Entities therein, and which infringements or conflicts (if the subject of any unfavorable decision, ruling or finding) or invalidities or inadequacies, singly or in the aggregate, would result in a Material Adverse Effect.

 

(xxxiv)     Environmental Laws .  Except as described in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus or would not, singly or in the aggregate, result in a Material Adverse Effect, (A) none of the Partnership Entities is in violation of any federal, state, local or foreign statute, law, rule, regulation, ordinance, code, policy or rule of common law or any judicial or administrative interpretation thereof, including any judicial or administrative order, consent, decree or judgment, relating to pollution or protection of human health, the environment (including, without limitation, ambient air, surface water, groundwater, land surface or subsurface strata) or wildlife, including, without limitation, laws and regulations relating to the Release (defined below) or threatened Release of chemicals, pollutants, contaminants, wastes, toxic substances, hazardous substances, petroleum or petroleum products, asbestos-containing materials or mold (collectively, “ Hazardous Materials ”) or to the manufacture, processing, distribution, use, treatment, storage, disposal, transport or handling of Hazardous Materials (collectively, “ Environmental Laws ”), (B) the Partnership Entities have all permits, authorizations and approvals required under any applicable Environmental Laws and are each in compliance with their requirements, (C) there are no pending or threatened administrative,

 

13



 

regulatory or judicial actions, suits, demands, demand letters, claims, liens, notices of noncompliance or violation, investigation or proceedings relating to any Environmental Law against any of the Partnership Entities and (D) there are no events or circumstances that would reasonably be expected to form the basis of an order for clean-up or remediation, or an action, suit or proceeding by any private party or Governmental Entity, against or affecting any of the Partnership Entities relating to Hazardous Materials or any Environmental Laws. The term “ Release ” means any spilling, leaking, seepage, pumping, pouring, emitting, emptying, discharging, injecting, escaping, leaching, dumping, disposing, depositing, dispersing, or migrating in, into or through the environment, or in, into from or through any building or structure.

 

(xxxv)      Hazardous Materials . Except as disclosed in the Registration Statement, General Disclosure Package and Prospectus, there has been no storage, generation, transportation, use, handling, treatment, Release or threat of Release of Hazardous Materials by, relating to or caused by any of the Partnership Entities (or, to the knowledge of the Partnership Entities, any other entity (including any predecessor) for whose acts or omissions any of the Partnership Entities is or could reasonably be expected to be liable) at, on, under or from any property or facility now or previously owned, operated or leased by any of the Partnership Entities, or at, on, under or from any other property or facility, in violation of any Environmental Laws or in a manner or amount or to a location that could reasonably be expected to result in any liability under any Environmental Law, except for any violations or liabilities that would not, singly or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect.

 

(xxxvi)     Review of Environmental Laws . In the ordinary course of its business, the Susser Entities conduct a periodic review of the effect of Environmental Laws on the business, operations and properties of the Partnership Entities, in the course of which they identified and evaluated associated costs and liabilities (including, without limitation, any capital or operating expenditures required for clean-up, closure of properties or compliance with Environmental Laws, or any permit, license or approval, any related constraints on operating activities and any potential liabilities to third parties). On the basis of such review, the Partnership Entities have concluded that such associated costs and liabilities would not, singly or in the aggregate, have a Material Adverse Effect, except as described in or contemplated in the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus.

 

(xxxvii)    Compliance with ERISA . (A) Each employee benefit plan, within the meaning of Section 3(3) of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended (“ ERISA ”), for which the Partnership or any member of its “Controlled Group” (defined as any organization which is a member of a controlled group of corporations within the meaning of Section 414 of the Internal Revenue Code (the “ Code ”)) would have any liability (each, a “ Plan ”) has been maintained in compliance with its terms and the requirements of any applicable statutes, orders, rules and regulations, including but not limited to ERISA and the Code, except for any instances of noncompliance that would not, singly or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect; (B) no prohibited transaction, within the meaning of Section 406 of ERISA or Section 4975 of the Code, has occurred with respect to any Plan, excluding transactions effected pursuant to a statutory or administrative exemption, that would result in a Material Adverse Effect; (C) for each Plan that is subject to the funding rules of Section 412 of the Code or Section 302 of ERISA, the minimum funding standard of Section 412 of the Code or Section 302 of ERISA, as applicable, has been satisfied (without taking into account any waiver thereof or extension of any amortization period) and is reasonably expected to be satisfied in the future (without taking into account any waiver thereof or extension of any amortization period); (D) the fair market value of the assets of each Plan that is subject to Title IV of ERISA (other

 

14



 

than a “multiemployer plan”) exceeds the present value of all benefits accrued under such Plan (determined based on those assumptions used to fund such Plan); (E) no “reportable event” (within the meaning of Section 4043(c) of ERISA) has occurred or is reasonably expected to occur that either has resulted, or would result, in a Material Adverse Effect; (F) neither the Partnership nor any member of the Controlled Group has incurred, nor reasonably expects to incur, any liability under Title IV of ERISA (other than contributions to the Plan or premiums to the Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation, in the ordinary course and without default) in respect of a Plan (including a “multiemployer plan,” within the meaning of Section 4001(a)(3) of ERISA); and (G) there is no pending audit or investigation by the Internal Revenue Service, the U.S. Department of Labor, the Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation or any other governmental agency or any foreign regulatory agency with respect to any Plan that would result in a Material Adverse Effect.  Neither of the following events has occurred or is reasonably likely to occur: (1) an increase in the aggregate amount of contributions required to be made to all Plans by the Partnership Entities in the Predecessor’s current fiscal year compared to the amount of such contributions made in the Predecessor’s most recently completed fiscal year that is expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect; or (2) an increase in the Partnership Entities’ “accumulated post-retirement benefit obligations” (within the meaning of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards 106) compared to the amount of such obligations in the Partnership’s most recently completed fiscal year that is expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect.

 

(xxxviii)   Accounting Controls and Disclosure Controls .  The Partnership Entities maintain effective internal control over financial reporting (as defined under Rule 13a-15 and 15d-15 under the rules and regulations of the Commission under the 1934 Act (the “ 1934 Act Regulations ”)) and a system of internal accounting controls sufficient to provide reasonable assurances that (A) transactions are executed in accordance with management’s general or specific authorization; (B) transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in conformity with GAAP and to maintain accountability for assets; (C) access to assets is permitted only in accordance with management’s general or specific authorization; and (D) the recorded accountability for assets is compared with the existing assets at reasonable intervals and appropriate action is taken with respect to any differences.  Except as described in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus, (1) since the date of the most recent balance sheet included in the Registration Statement, (i) there has been no material weakness in the Partnership Entities’ internal control over financial reporting (whether or not remediated) and (ii) there has been no change in the Partnership Entities’ internal control over financial reporting that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the Partnership Entities’ internal control over financial reporting, and (2) none of the Partnership Entities is aware of any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the Partnership Entities’ internal control over financial reporting.

 

The Partnership Entities maintain an effective system of disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rule 13a-15 and Rule 15d-15 under the 1934 Act Regulations) that are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed by the Partnership in the reports that it files or submits, or will file or submit, under the 1934 Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the Commission’s rules and forms, and that all such information is accumulated and communicated to the Partnership’s management, including its principal executive officer or officers and principal financial officer or officers, or persons performing similar functions, as appropriate, to allow timely decisions regarding disclosure. Such disclosure controls and procedures are effective in all material respects to perform the functions for which they are established to the extent required by Rule 13a-15 of the 1934 Act.

 

15



 

(xxxix)      Compliance with the Sarbanes-Oxley Act.   The Partnership Entities have taken all necessary actions to ensure that, upon the effectiveness of the Registration Statement, they will be in compliance with all provisions of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and all rules and regulations promulgated thereunder or implementing the provisions thereof (the “ Sarbanes-Oxley Act ”) that are then in effect and with which the Partnership Entities are required to comply as of the effectiveness of the Registration Statement, and are actively taking steps to ensure that they will be in compliance with other provisions of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act not currently in effect, upon the effectiveness of such provisions, or which will become applicable to the Partnership Entities at all times after the effectiveness of the Registration Statement.

 

(xl)           Tax Returns .  Each of the Partnership Entities has filed (or has obtained extensions with respect to) all foreign, federal, state and local tax returns that are required to be filed through the date hereof, except in any case in which the failure so to file would not, individually or in the aggregate, be reasonably expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, and has timely paid all taxes (including, without limitation, any estimated taxes) required to be paid by it and any other assessment, fine or penalty levied against it, to the extent that any of the foregoing is due and payable, other than (a) those that are currently being contested in good faith by appropriate actions and for which adequate reserves have been established or (b) those which, if not paid, would not, singly or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect.

 

(xli)          Insurance .  The Partnership Entities carry or are entitled to the benefits of insurance, with financially sound and reputable insurers, in such amounts and covering such risks as is generally maintained by companies of established repute engaged in the same or similar business, and all such insurance is in full force and effect. No Partnership Entity has any reason to believe that it will not be able (A) to renew its existing insurance coverage as and when such policies expire or (B) to obtain comparable coverage from similar institutions as may be necessary or appropriate to conduct its business as now conducted and at a cost that would not result in a Material Adverse Effect.  None of the Partnership Entities has been denied any insurance coverage which it has sought or for which it has applied.

 

(xlii)         Investment Company Act .  None of the Partnership Entities is required, and upon the issuance and sale of the Securities as herein contemplated and the application of the net proceeds therefrom as described in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus, none of the Partnership Entities will be required, to register as an “investment company” under the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (the “ 1940 Act ”).

 

(xliii)        Absence of Manipulation .  None of the Susser Entities has taken, nor will any of the Susser Entities take, directly or indirectly, any action which is designed, or would be expected, to cause or result in, or which constitutes, the stabilization or manipulation of the price of any security of the Partnership to facilitate the sale or resale of the Securities or a violation of Regulation M under the 1934 Act.

 

(xliv)       Foreign Corrupt Practices Act .  No Partnership Entity nor, to the knowledge of any of the Partnership Parties, any director, officer, agent, employee, affiliate or other person acting on behalf of or providing services to any Partnership Entity is aware of or has taken any action, directly or indirectly, that would result in a violation by such persons of the Foreign Corrupt Practices Act of 1977, as amended, and the rules and regulations thereunder (the “ FCPA ”), including, without limitation, making use of the mails or any means or instrumentality of interstate commerce corruptly in furtherance of an offer, payment, promise to pay or authorization of the payment of any money, or other property, gift, promise to give, or

 

16



 

authorization of the giving of anything of value to any “foreign official” (as such term is defined in the FCPA) or any foreign political party or official thereof or any candidate for foreign political office, in contravention of the FCPA; and the Partnership Entities and, to the knowledge of any of the Partnership Parties, their affiliates have conducted their businesses in compliance with the FCPA and have instituted and maintain policies and procedures designed to ensure, and which are reasonably expected to continue to ensure, continued compliance therewith.

 

(xlv)        Money Laundering Laws .  The operations of each of the Partnership Entities are and have been conducted at all times in compliance with applicable financial recordkeeping and reporting requirements of the Currency and Foreign Transactions Reporting Act of 1970, as amended, the money laundering statutes of all jurisdictions, the rules and regulations thereunder and any related or similar rules, regulations or guidelines, issued, administered or enforced by any Governmental Entity (collectively, the “ Money Laundering Laws ”); and no action, suit or proceeding by or before any Governmental Entity involving any of the Partnership Entities with respect to the Money Laundering Laws is pending or, to the knowledge of each of the Partnership Parties, threatened.

 

(xlvi)       OFAC .  None of the Partnership Entities nor, to the knowledge of any of the Partnership Parties, any director, officer, agent, employee, affiliate, representative or other person acting on behalf or providing services to any Partnership Entity is an individual or entity (“ Person ”) currently the subject or target of any  sanctions administered or enforced by the United States Government, including, without limitation, the U.S. Department of the Treasury’s Office of Foreign Assets Control (OFAC), the United Nations Security Council (UNSC), the European Union, Her Majesty’s Treasury (HMT), or other relevant sanctions authority (collectively, “ Sanctions ”), nor is any Partnership Entity located, organized or resident in a country or territory that is the subject of Sanctions; and no Partnership Entity will directly or indirectly use the proceeds of the sale of the Securities, or lend, contribute or otherwise make available such proceeds to any subsidiaries, joint venture partners or other Person, to fund any activities of or business with any Person, or in any country or territory, that, at the time of such funding, is the subject of Sanctions or in any other manner that will result in a violation by any Person (including any Person participating in the transaction, whether as underwriter, advisor, investor or otherwise) of Sanctions.

 

(xlvii)      Sales of Reserved Securities .  In connection with any offer and sale of Reserved Securities outside the United States, each preliminary prospectus, the Prospectus, any prospectus wrapper and any amendment or supplement thereto, at the time it was filed, complied and will comply in all material respects with any applicable laws or regulations of foreign jurisdictions in which the same is distributed.  The Partnership has not offered, or caused the Representatives to offer, Reserved Securities to any person with the specific intent to unlawfully influence (i) a customer or supplier of any Susser Entity or any of their affiliates to alter the customer’s or supplier’s level or type of business with any such entity or (ii) a trade journalist or publication to write or publish favorable information about any Susser Entity or any of their affiliates, or their respective businesses or products.

 

(xlviii)     Lending Relationship Except as disclosed in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus, no Susser Entity (i) has any material lending or other relationship with any bank or lending affiliate of any Underwriter and (ii) intends to use any of the proceeds from the sale of the Securities to repay any outstanding debt owed to any affiliate of any Underwriter.

 

17



 

(xlix)        No Undisclosed Relationships . No relationship, direct or indirect, exists between or among any of the Partnership Entities, on the one hand, and the directors, officers, equityholders, customers or suppliers of any of the Partnership Entities, on the other, that is required by the 1933 Act to be described in the Registration Statement and the Prospectus and that is not so described in such documents and in the General Disclosure Package.

 

(l)            No Broker’s Fees . None of the Susser Entities or any of their respective subsidiaries is a party to any contract, agreement or understanding with any person (other than this Agreement) that would give rise to a valid claim against the Partnership Entities or any Underwriter for a brokerage commission, finder’s fee or like payment in connection with the offering and sale of the Securities.

 

(li)           Private Placement . The issuance of the Sponsor Units and the Incentive Distribution Rights to SHC and Stripes is exempt from the registration requirements of the 1933 Act and securities laws of any state having jurisdiction with respect thereto, and none of the Susser Entities has taken or will take any action that would cause the loss of such exemption. The Partnership has not sold or issued any securities that would be integrated with the offering of the Securities contemplated by this Agreement pursuant to the 1933 Act, the 1933 Act Regulations or the interpretations thereof by the Commission.

 

(lii)          NYSE Listing of Common Units . The Securities have been approved for listing, subject to official notice of issuance and evidence of satisfactory distribution, on the New York Stock Exchange.

 

(liii)         Distribution of Offering Materials . The Partnership has not distributed and, prior to the later to occur of any Date of Delivery and the completion of the distribution of the Securities, will not distribute any offering material in connection with the offering and sale of the Securities other than any preliminary prospectus, the Prospectus, any Issuer Free Writing Prospectus to which the Representatives have consented in accordance with Section 3(l), any press release or other announcement permitted by Rule 134 or Rule 135 under the 1933 Act and, in connection with the offer and sale of the Reserved Securities, the enrollment materials prepared by Merrill Lynch on behalf of the Partnership.

 

(liv)         Statistical and Market-Related Data .  Any statistical and market-related data included in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package or the Prospectus are based on or derived from sources that the Partnership Entities believe, after reasonable inquiry, to be reliable and accurate and, to the extent required, the Partnership Entities have obtained the written consent to the use of such data from such sources.

 

(lv)          No Debt Securities . None of the Partnership Entities has any debt securities or preferred equity that is rated by any “nationally recognized statistical rating organization” (as that term is defined by the Commission for purposes of Rule 436(g)(2) under the 1933 Act).

 

(b)           Officer’s Certificates .  Any certificate signed by any officer of any of the Susser Entities and delivered to the Representatives or to counsel for the Underwriters in connection with the offering of the Securities shall be deemed a representation and warranty by each of the Susser Entities to each Underwriter as to the matters covered thereby.

 

18


 

SECTION 2.         Sale and Delivery to Underwriters; Closing .

 

(a)           Initial Securities .  On the basis of the representations and warranties herein contained and subject to the terms and conditions herein set forth, the Partnership agrees to sell to each Underwriter, severally and not jointly, and each Underwriter, severally and not jointly, agrees to purchase from the Partnership, at the price per Common Unit set forth in Schedule A, that number of Initial Securities set forth in Schedule A opposite the name of such Underwriter, plus any additional number of Initial Securities which such Underwriter may become obligated to purchase pursuant to the provisions of Section 10 hereof, subject, in each case, to such adjustments among the Underwriters as Merrill Lynch in its sole discretion shall make to eliminate any sales or purchases of fractional Common Units.

 

(b)           Option Securities .  In addition, on the basis of the representations and warranties herein contained and subject to the terms and conditions herein set forth, the Partnership hereby grants an option to the Underwriters, severally and not jointly, to purchase up to an additional [ · ] Common Units, at the price per Common Unit set forth in Schedule A, less an amount per Common Unit equal to any dividends or distributions declared by the Partnership and payable on the Initial Securities but not payable on the Option Securities.  The option hereby granted may be exercised for 30 days after the date hereof and may be exercised in whole or in part at any time from time to time upon notice by the Representatives to the Partnership setting forth the number of Option Securities as to which the several Underwriters are then exercising the option and the time and date of payment and delivery for such Option Securities.  Any such time and date of delivery (a “ Date of Delivery ”) shall be determined by the Representatives, but shall not be later than seven full business days after the exercise of said option, nor in any event prior to the Closing Time.  If the option is exercised as to all or any portion of the Option Securities, each of the Underwriters, acting severally and not jointly, will purchase that proportion of the total number of Option Securities then being purchased which the number of Initial Securities set forth in Schedule A opposite the name of such Underwriter bears to the total number of Initial Securities, subject, in each case, to such adjustments as Merrill Lynch in its sole discretion shall make to eliminate any sales or purchases of fractional Common Units.

 

(c)           Payment .  Payment of the purchase price for, and delivery of, the Initial Securities shall be made at the offices of Andrews Kurth LLP, 600 Travis, Suite 4200, Houston, Texas 77002, or at such other place as shall be agreed upon by the Representatives and the Partnership, at 10:00 A.M. (New York City time) on [ · ], 2012 (unless postponed in accordance with the provisions of Section 10), or such other time not later than ten business days after such date as shall be agreed upon by the Representatives and the Partnership (such time and date of payment and delivery being herein called “ Closing Time ”).

 

In addition, in the event that any or all of the Option Securities are purchased by the Underwriters, payment of the purchase price for, and delivery of, such Option Securities shall be made at the above-mentioned offices, or at such other place as shall be agreed upon by the Representatives and the Partnership, on each Date of Delivery as specified in the notice from the Representatives to the Partnership.

 

Payment shall be made to the Partnership by wire transfer of immediately available funds to a bank account designated by the Partnership against delivery to the Representatives for the respective accounts of the Underwriters of the Securities to be purchased by them.  Delivery of the Securities shall be made through the facilities of The Depository Trust Company (“ DTC ”) unless the Representatives shall otherwise instruct.  It is understood that each Underwriter has authorized the Representatives, for its account, to accept delivery of, receipt for, and make payment of the purchase price for, the Initial Securities and the Option Securities, if any, which it has agreed to purchase.  Merrill Lynch, individually and not as representative of the Underwriters, may (but shall not be obligated to) make payment of the purchase price for the Initial Securities or the Option Securities, if any, to be purchased by any

 

19



 

Underwriter whose funds have not been received by the Closing Time or the relevant Date of Delivery, as the case may be, but such payment shall not relieve such Underwriter from its obligations hereunder.

 

SECTION 3.         Covenants of the Partnership Parties .  Each of the Partnership Parties, jointly and severally, covenants with each Underwriter as follows:

 

(a)           Compliance with Securities Regulations and Commission Requests .  The Partnership, subject to Section 3(b), will comply with the requirements of Rule 430A, and will notify the Representatives immediately, and confirm the notice in writing, (i) when any post-effective amendment to the Registration Statement shall become effective or any amendment or supplement to the Prospectus shall have been filed, (ii) of the receipt of any comments from the Commission, (iii) of any request by the Commission for any amendment to the Registration Statement or any amendment or supplement to the Prospectus or for additional information, (iv) of the issuance by the Commission of any stop order suspending the effectiveness of the Registration Statement or any post-effective amendment or of any order preventing or suspending the use of any preliminary prospectus or the Prospectus, or of the suspension of the qualification of the Securities for offering or sale in any jurisdiction, or of the initiation or threatening of any proceedings for any of such purposes or of any examination pursuant to Section 8(d) or 8(e) of the 1933 Act concerning the Registration Statement and (v) if the Partnership becomes the subject of a proceeding under Section 8A of the 1933 Act in connection with the offering of the Securities.  The Partnership will effect all filings required under Rule 424(b), in the manner and within the time period required by Rule 424(b) (without reliance on Rule 424(b)(8)), and will take such steps as it deems necessary to ascertain promptly whether the form of prospectus transmitted for filing under Rule 424(b) was received for filing by the Commission and, in the event that it was not, it will promptly file such prospectus.  The Partnership will use its reasonable best efforts to prevent the issuance of any stop order, prevention or suspension and, if any such order is issued, to obtain the lifting thereof as soon as practicable.

 

(b)           Continued Compliance with Securities Laws .  The Partnership will comply with the 1933 Act and the 1933 Act Regulations so as to permit the completion of the distribution of the Securities as contemplated in this Agreement and in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus.  If at any time when a prospectus relating to the Securities is (or, but for the exception afforded by Rule 172 of the 1933 Act Regulations (“ Rule 172 ”), would be) required by the 1933 Act to be delivered in connection with sales of the Securities, any event shall occur or condition shall exist as a result of which it is necessary, in the opinion of counsel for the Underwriters or for the Partnership, to (i) amend the Registration Statement in order that the Registration Statement will not include an untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not misleading, (ii) amend or supplement the General Disclosure Package or the Prospectus in order that the General Disclosure Package or the Prospectus, as the case may be, will not include any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary in order to make the statements therein, in the light of the circumstances existing at the time it is delivered to a purchaser, not misleading or (iii) amend the Registration Statement or amend or supplement the General Disclosure Package or the Prospectus, as the case may be, in order to comply with the requirements of the 1933 Act or the 1933 Act Regulations, the Partnership will promptly (A) give the Representatives notice of such event, (B) prepare any amendment or supplement as may be necessary to correct such statement or omission or to make the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package or the Prospectus comply with such requirements and, a reasonable amount of time prior to any proposed filing or use, furnish the Representatives with copies of any such amendment or supplement and (C) file with the Commission any such amendment or supplement; provided that the Partnership shall not file or use any such amendment or supplement to which the Representatives or counsel for the Underwriters shall reasonably object.  The Partnership will furnish to the Underwriters such number of copies of such amendment or supplement as the Underwriters may reasonably request.  The Partnership will give the

 

20



 

Representatives notice of its intention to make any filing made pursuant to the 1934 Act or 1934 Act Regulations from the Applicable Time to the Closing Time and will furnish the Representatives with copies of any such documents a reasonable amount of time prior to such proposed filing, as the case may be, and will not file or use any such document to which the Representatives or counsel for the Underwriters shall reasonably object.

 

(c)           Delivery of Registration Statements .  The Partnership has furnished or will deliver to the Representatives and counsel for the Underwriters, without charge, signed copies of the Registration Statement as originally filed and each amendment thereto (including exhibits filed therewith) and, if requested, signed copies of all consents and certificates of experts, and will also deliver to the Representatives, without charge, a conformed copy of the Registration Statement as originally filed and each amendment thereto (without exhibits) for each of the Underwriters.  The copies of the Registration Statement and each amendment thereto furnished to the Underwriters will be identical to the electronically transmitted copies thereof filed with the Commission pursuant to EDGAR, except to the extent permitted by Regulation S-T.

 

(d)           Delivery of Prospectuses .  The Partnership has delivered to each Underwriter, without charge, as many copies of each preliminary prospectus as such Underwriter reasonably requested, and the Partnership hereby consents to the use of such copies for purposes permitted by the 1933 Act.  The Partnership will furnish to each Underwriter, without charge, during the period when a prospectus relating to the Securities is (or, but for the exception afforded by Rule 172, would be) required to be delivered under the 1933 Act, such number of copies of the Prospectus (as amended or supplemented) as such Underwriter may reasonably request.  The Prospectus and any amendments or supplements thereto furnished to the Underwriters will be identical to the electronically transmitted copies thereof filed with the Commission pursuant to EDGAR, except to the extent permitted by Regulation S-T.

 

(e)           Blue Sky Qualifications .  The Partnership will use its commercially reasonable efforts, in cooperation with the Underwriters, to qualify the Securities for offering and sale under the applicable securities laws of such states and other jurisdictions (domestic or foreign) as the Representatives may designate and to maintain such qualifications in effect so long as required to complete the distribution of the Securities; provided, however, that the Partnership shall not be obligated to file any general consent to service of process or to qualify as a foreign corporation or as a dealer in securities in any jurisdiction in which it is not so qualified or to subject itself to taxation in respect of doing business in any jurisdiction in which it is not otherwise so subject.

 

(f)            Rule 158 .  The Partnership will timely file such reports pursuant to the 1934 Act as are necessary in order to make generally available to its securityholders as soon as practicable an earnings statement for the purposes of, and to provide to the Underwriters the benefits contemplated by, the last paragraph of Section 11(a) of the 1933 Act.

 

(g)           Use of Proceeds .  The Partnership will use the net proceeds received by it from the sale of the Securities in the manner specified in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus under “Use of Proceeds.”

 

(h)           Listing .  The Partnership will use its best efforts to effect and maintain the listing of the Common Units (including the Securities) on the New York Stock Exchange.

 

(i)            Restriction on Sale of Securities .  During a period of 180 days from the date of the Prospectus, no Susser Entity will, without the prior written consent of Merrill Lynch, (i) directly or indirectly offer, pledge, sell, contract to sell, sell any option or contract to purchase, purchase any option or contract to sell, grant any option, right or warrant to purchase, or otherwise transfer or dispose of any

 

21



 

Common Units or any securities convertible into or exercisable or exchangeable for Common Units, or file any registration statement under the 1933 Act with respect to any of the foregoing, or publicly disclose the intention to make any such offer, sale, pledge, disposition or filing, or (ii) enter into any swap or any other agreement or any transaction that transfers, in whole or in part, directly or indirectly, any of the economic consequences of ownership of the Common Units or any such other securities, whether any such swap or transaction described in clause (i) or (ii) above is to be settled by delivery of Common Units or such other securities, in cash or otherwise.  The foregoing sentence shall not apply to (A) the Securities to be sold hereunder, (B) any Common Units issued or options to purchase Common Units granted pursuant to existing employee benefit or equity compensation plans of the Partnership referred to in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus and any registration statement on Form S-8 related thereto or (C) securities equal to up to 10% of the Partnership’s outstanding Common Units and Subordinated Units issued by the Company in connection with the acquisition by the Company or any of its subsidiaries of the securities, business, property or other assets of another person or entity or pursuant to any plan assumed by the Partnership in connection with such acquisition; provided , however , that securities issued by the Partnership pursuant to clause (C) shall be subject to the restrictions set forth in this Section 3(i).  Notwithstanding the foregoing, if (1) during the last 17 days of the 180-day restricted period the Partnership issues an earnings release or material news or a material event relating to the Partnership occurs or (2) prior to the expiration of the 180-day restricted period, the Partnership announces that it will issue an earnings release or becomes aware that material news or a material event will occur during the 16-day period beginning on the last day of the 180-day restricted period, the restrictions imposed in this clause (i) shall continue to apply until the expiration of the 18-day period beginning on the date of the issuance of the earnings release or the occurrence of the material news or material event, unless Merrill Lynch waives, in writing, such extension.

 

(j)            Reporting Requirements .  The Partnership, during the period when a Prospectus relating to the Securities is (or, but for the exception afforded by Rule 172, would be) required to be delivered under the 1933 Act, will file all documents required to be filed with the Commission pursuant to the 1934 Act within the time periods required by the 1934 Act and 1934 Act Regulations.  Additionally, the Partnership shall report the use of proceeds from the issuance of the Common Units as may be required under Rule 463 under the 1933 Act.

 

(k)           Issuer Free Writing Prospectuses .  The Partnership agrees that, unless it obtains the prior written consent of the Representatives, it will not make any offer relating to the Securities that would constitute an Issuer Free Writing Prospectus or that would otherwise constitute a “free writing prospectus,” or a portion thereof, required to be filed by the Partnership with the Commission or retained by the Partnership under Rule 433; provided that the Representatives will be deemed to have consented to each Issuer Free Writing Prospectus listed on Schedule B-2 hereto and any “road show that is a written communication” within the meaning of Rule 433(d)(8)(i) that has been reviewed by the Representatives.  The Partnership represents that it has treated or agrees that it will treat each such free writing prospectus consented to, or deemed consented to, by the Representatives as an “issuer free writing prospectus,” as defined in Rule 433, and that it has complied and will comply with the applicable requirements of Rule 433 with respect thereto, including timely filing with the Commission where required, legending and record keeping.  If at any time following issuance of an Issuer Free Writing Prospectus there occurred or occurs an event or development as a result of which such Issuer Free Writing Prospectus conflicted or would conflict with the information contained in the Registration Statement, any preliminary prospectus or the Prospectus or included or would include an untrue statement of a material fact or omitted or would omit to state a material fact necessary in order to make the statements therein, in the light of the circumstances existing at that subsequent time, not misleading, the Partnership will promptly notify the Representatives and will promptly amend or supplement, at its own expense, such Issuer Free Writing Prospectus to eliminate or correct such conflict, untrue statement or omission.

 

22



 

SECTION 4.         Payment of Expenses .

 

(a)           Expenses .  The Partnership will pay or cause to be paid all expenses incident to the performance of its obligations under this Agreement, including (i) the preparation, printing and filing of the Registration Statement (including financial statements and exhibits) as originally filed and each amendment thereto, (ii) the preparation, printing and delivery to the Underwriters of copies of each preliminary prospectus, each Issuer Free Writing Prospectus and the Prospectus and any amendments or supplements thereto and any costs associated with electronic delivery of any of the foregoing by the Underwriters to investors, (iii) any preparation, issuance and delivery of certificates for the Securities to the Underwriters, including any unit or other transfer taxes and any stamp or other duties payable upon the sale, issuance or delivery of the Securities to the Underwriters, (iv) the fees and disbursements of the Partnership’s counsel, accountants and other advisors, (v) the qualification of the Securities under securities laws in accordance with the provisions of Section 3(e) hereof, including filing fees and the reasonable fees and disbursements of counsel for the Underwriters in connection therewith and in connection with the preparation of the Blue Sky Survey and any supplement thereto, (vi) the fees and expenses of any transfer agent or registrar for the Securities, (vii) the costs and expenses of the Partnership relating to investor presentations on any “road show” undertaken in connection with the marketing of the Securities, including without limitation, expenses associated with the production of road show slides and graphics, fees and expenses of any consultants engaged in connection with the road show presentations, travel and lodging expenses of the officers of the Partnership Parties and any such consultants (provided that the travel and lodging expenses of the Representatives shall be paid for by the Underwriters), and the cost of aircraft and other transportation chartered in connection with the road show, including any aircraft owned by any officer or director of the Partnership (provided that 50% of the cost of any aircraft chartered in connection with the road show shall be paid by the Underwriters and the remaining 50% of the cost of any aircraft chartered in connection with the road show shall be paid by the Partnership), (viii) the filing fees incident to, and the reasonable fees and disbursements of counsel to the Underwriters in connection with, the review by FINRA of the terms of the sale of the Securities, (ix) the fees and expenses incurred in connection with the listing of the Securities on the New York Stock Exchange and (x) all costs and expenses of the Underwriters, including the fees and disbursements of counsel for the Underwriters, in connection with matters related to the Reserved Securities which are designated by the Partnership for sale to Invitees.

 

(b)           Termination of Agreement .  If this Agreement is terminated by the Representatives in accordance with the provisions of Section 5, Section 9(a)(i) or (iii) or Section 10 hereof, the Partnership shall reimburse the Underwriters for all of their reasonable out-of-pocket expenses, including the reasonable fees and disbursements of counsel for the Underwriters.

 

SECTION 5.         Conditions of Underwriters’ Obligations .  The obligations of the several Underwriters hereunder are subject to the accuracy of the representations and warranties of the Partnership Parties contained herein or in certificates of any officer of any of the Partnership Parties delivered pursuant to the provisions hereof, to the performance by the Partnership Parties of their covenants and other obligations hereunder, and to the following further conditions:

 

(a)           Effectiveness of Registration Statement; Rule 430A Information .  The Registration Statement, including any Rule 462(b) Registration Statement, has become effective and, at the Closing Time or the applicable Date of Delivery, no stop order suspending the effectiveness of the Registration Statement or any post-effective amendment thereto has been issued under the 1933 Act, no order preventing or suspending the use of any preliminary prospectus or the Prospectus has been issued and no proceedings for any of those purposes have been instituted or are pending or, to the knowledge of any of the Partnership Parties, contemplated; and the Partnership has complied with each request (if any) from the Commission for additional information.  A prospectus containing the Rule 430A Information shall

 

23



 

have been filed with the Commission in the manner and within the time frame required by Rule 424(b) without reliance on Rule 424(b)(8) or a post-effective amendment providing such information shall have been filed with, and declared effective by, the Commission in accordance with the requirements of Rule 430A.

 

(b)           Opinion of Counsel for the Partnership .  At the Closing Time, the Representatives shall have received the favorable opinion, dated the Closing Time, of Vinson & Elkins, L.L.P., counsel for the Partnership, in form and substance satisfactory to counsel for the Underwriters, together with signed or reproduced copies of such letter for each of the other Underwriters to the effect set forth in Exhibit A hereto and to such further effect as counsel to the Underwriters may reasonably request.

 

(c)           Opinion of Counsel for Underwriters .  At the Closing Time, the Representatives shall have received the favorable opinion, dated the Closing Time, of Andrews Kurth LLP, counsel for the Underwriters, together with signed or reproduced copies of such letter for each of the other Underwriters with respect to the matters set forth in clauses (viii), (xii) (solely as to preemptive or other similar rights arising by operation of law or under the governing or organizational documents of the Partnership Entities), (xiii), (xvi), (xvii) (solely as to the information in the Prospectus under “Description of the Common Units”) and the penultimate paragraph of Exhibit A hereto, and other related matters as the Representatives may require.  In giving such opinion such counsel may rely, as to all matters governed by the laws of jurisdictions other than the law of the State of New York, the Delaware Revised Uniform Limited Partnership Act, the Delaware Limited Liability Company Act and the federal securities laws of the United States, upon the opinions of counsel satisfactory to the Representatives.  Such counsel may also state that, insofar as such opinion involves factual matters, they have relied, to the extent they deem proper, upon certificates of officers and other representatives of the Susser Entities and certificates of public officials.

 

(d)           Officers’ Certificate .  At the Closing Time, there shall not have been, since the date hereof or since the respective dates as of which information is given in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package or the Prospectus, any material adverse change in the condition, financial or otherwise, or in the earnings, properties, management, unitholders’ or members’ equity, as applicable, business affairs or business prospects of the Partnership Entities considered as one enterprise, whether or not arising in the ordinary course of business, and the Representatives shall have received a certificate of the Chief Executive Officer or the President of the General Partner and of the chief financial or chief accounting officer of the General Partner, dated the Closing Time, to the effect that (i) there has been no such material adverse change, (ii) the representations and warranties of the Partnership Parties in this Agreement are true and correct with the same force and effect as though expressly made at and as of the Closing Time (except to the extent such representations and warranties expressly relate to an earlier date, in which case, as of such earlier date), (iii) each of the Partnership Parties has complied with all agreements and satisfied all conditions on its part to be performed or satisfied at or prior to the Closing Time, and (iv) no stop order suspending the effectiveness of the Registration Statement under the 1933 Act has been issued, no order preventing or suspending the use of any preliminary prospectus or the Prospectus has been issued and no proceedings for any of those purposes have been instituted or are pending or, to their knowledge, threatened by the Commission.

 

(e)           Accountant’s Comfort Letter .  At the time of the execution of this Agreement, the Representatives shall have received from Ernst & Young LLP a letter, dated such date, in form and substance satisfactory to the Representatives, together with signed or reproduced copies of such letter for each of the other Underwriters containing statements and information of the type ordinarily included in accountants’ “comfort letters” to underwriters with respect to the financial statements and certain financial information contained in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus.

 

24



 

(f)            Bring-down Comfort Letter .  At the Closing Time, the Representatives shall have received from Ernst & Young LLP a letter, dated as of the Closing Time, to the effect that they reaffirm the statements made in the letter furnished pursuant to subsection (e) of this Section, except that the specified date referred to shall be a date not more than three business days prior to the Closing Time.

 

(g)         Approval of Listing .  At the Closing Time, the Securities shall have been approved for listing on the New York Stock Exchange, subject only to official notice of issuance.

 

(h)         No Objection .  FINRA shall have confirmed in writing that it has not raised any objection with respect to the fairness and reasonableness of the underwriting terms and arrangements relating to the offering of the Securities.

 

(i)          Lock-up Agreements .  At the date of this Agreement, the Representatives shall have received an agreement, substantially in the form of Exhibit B hereto, signed by the persons and entities listed on Schedule D hereto (each such person, a “ Lock-Up Party ”).

 

(j)            Formation Transactions. In connection with the sale of the Initial Securities at the Closing Time, the Formation Transactions shall have been duly consummated at the respective times and on the terms contemplated by this Agreement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus, and the Representatives shall have received such evidence that the Formation Transactions have been consummated as the Representatives may reasonably request.

 

(k)           Conditions to Purchase of Option Securities .  In the event that the Underwriters exercise their option provided in Section 2(b) hereof to purchase all or any portion of the Option Securities, the representations and warranties of the Partnership Parties contained herein and the statements in any certificates furnished by any of the Partnership Parties hereunder shall be true and correct as of each Date of Delivery and, at the relevant Date of Delivery, the Representatives shall have received:

 

(i)            Officers’ Certificate .  A certificate, dated such Date of Delivery, of the Chief Executive Officer or the President of the General Partner and of the chief financial or chief accounting officer of the General Partner confirming that the certificate delivered at the Closing Time pursuant to Section 5(d) hereof remains true and correct as of such Date of Delivery.

 

(ii)           Opinion of Counsel for the Partnership .  If requested by the Representatives, the favorable opinion of Vinson & Elkins, L.L.P., counsel for the Partnership, in form and substance satisfactory to counsel for the Underwriters, dated such Date of Delivery, relating to the Option Securities to be purchased on such Date of Delivery and otherwise to the same effect as the opinion required by Section 5(b) hereof.

 

(iii)          Opinion of Counsel for Underwriters .  If requested by the Representatives, the favorable opinion of Andrews Kurth LLP, counsel for the Underwriters, dated such Date of Delivery, relating to the Option Securities to be purchased on such Date of Delivery and otherwise to the same effect as the opinion required by Section 5(c) hereof.

 

(v)           Bring-down Comfort Letter If requested by the Representatives, a letter from Ernst & Young LLP, in form and substance satisfactory to the Representatives and dated such Date of Delivery, substantially in the same form and substance as the letter furnished to the Representatives pursuant to Section 5(e) hereof, except that the specified date in the letter furnished pursuant to this paragraph shall be a date not more than three business days prior to such Date of Delivery.

 

25



 

(l)            Additional Documents .  At the Closing Time and at each Date of Delivery (if any), counsel for the Underwriters shall have been furnished with such documents and opinions as they may require for the purpose of enabling them to pass upon the issuance and sale of the Securities as herein contemplated, or in order to evidence the accuracy of any of the representations or warranties, or the fulfillment of any of the conditions, herein contained; and all proceedings taken by the Partnership Parties in connection with the issuance and sale of the Securities as herein contemplated shall be satisfactory in form and substance to the Representatives and counsel for the Underwriters.

 

(m)          Termination of Agreement .  If any condition specified in this Section shall not have been fulfilled when and as required to be fulfilled, this Agreement, or, in the case of any condition to the purchase of Option Securities on a Date of Delivery which is after the Closing Time, the obligations of the several Underwriters to purchase the relevant Option Securities, may be terminated by the Representatives by notice to the Partnership at any time at or prior to Closing Time or such Date of Delivery, as the case may be, and such termination shall be without liability of any party to any other party except as provided in Section 4 and except that Sections 1, 6, 7, 8, 14, 15 and 16 shall survive any such termination and remain in full force and effect.

 

SECTION 6.         Indemnification .

 

(a)           Indemnification of the Underwriters .  Each of the Partnership Parties agrees to indemnify and hold harmless each Underwriter, its affiliates (as such term is defined in Rule 501(b) under the 1933 Act (each, an “ Affiliate ”)), its selling agents and each person, if any, who controls any Underwriter within the meaning of Section 15 of the 1933 Act or Section 20 of the 1934 Act as follows:

 

(i)            against any and all loss, liability, claim, damage and expense whatsoever, as incurred, arising out of any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement of a material fact contained in the Registration Statement (or any amendment thereto), including the Rule 430A Information, or the omission or alleged omission therefrom of a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not misleading or arising out of any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement of a material fact included (A) in any preliminary prospectus, any Issuer Free Writing Prospectus, the General Disclosure Package or the Prospectus (or any amendment or supplement of the foregoing), or any “issuer information” filed or required to be filed pursuant to Rule 433(d) under the 1933 Act, or (B) in any materials or information provided to investors by, or with the approval of, the Partnership in connection with the marketing of the offering of the Securities (“ Marketing Materials ”), including any roadshow or investor presentations made to investors by the Partnership (whether in person or electronically), or the omission or alleged omission in any preliminary prospectus, Issuer Free Writing Prospectus, Prospectus or in any Marketing Materials of a material fact necessary in order to make the statements therein, in the light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading;

 

(ii)           against any and all loss, liability, claim, damage and expense whatsoever, as incurred, to the extent of the aggregate amount paid in settlement of any litigation, or any investigation or proceeding by any governmental agency or body, commenced or threatened, or of any claim whatsoever based upon any such untrue statement or omission, or any such alleged untrue statement or omission; provided that (subject to Section 6(d) below) any such settlement is effected with the written consent of the Partnership;

 

(iii)          against any and all expense whatsoever, as incurred (including the fees and disbursements of counsel chosen by the Representatives), reasonably incurred in investigating, preparing or defending against any litigation, or any investigation or proceeding by any

 

26



 

governmental agency or body, commenced or threatened, or any claim whatsoever based upon any such untrue statement or omission, or any such alleged untrue statement or omission, to the extent that any such expense is not paid under (i) or (ii) above;

 

provided, however, that this indemnity agreement shall not apply to any loss, liability, claim, damage or expense to the extent arising out of any untrue statement or omission or alleged untrue statement or omission made in the Registration Statement (or any amendment thereto), including the Rule 430A Information, the General Disclosure Package or the Prospectus (or any amendment or supplement thereto) in reliance upon and in conformity with the Underwriter Information.

 

(b)           Indemnification of the Partnership Parties .  Each Underwriter agrees, severally and not jointly, to indemnify and hold harmless the Partnership Parties, each director and officer of the General Partner who signed the Registration Statement, and each person, if any, who controls the Partnership Parties within the meaning of Section 15 of the 1933 Act or Section 20 of the 1934 Act, against any and all loss, liability, claim, damage and expense described in the indemnity contained in subsection (a) of this Section, as incurred, but only with respect to untrue statements or omissions, or alleged untrue statements or omissions, made in the Registration Statement (or any amendment thereto), including the Rule 430A Information, the General Disclosure Package or the Prospectus (or any amendment or supplement thereto) in reliance upon and in conformity with the Underwriter Information.

 

(c)           Actions against Parties; Notification .  Each indemnified party shall give notice as promptly as reasonably practicable to each indemnifying party of any action commenced against it in respect of which indemnity may be sought hereunder, but failure to so notify an indemnifying party shall not relieve such indemnifying party from any liability hereunder to the extent it is not materially prejudiced as a result thereof and in any event shall not relieve it from any liability which it may have otherwise than on account of this indemnity agreement.  In the case of parties indemnified pursuant to Section 6(a) above, counsel to the indemnified parties shall be selected by the Representatives, and, in the case of parties indemnified pursuant to Section 6(b) above, counsel to the indemnified parties shall be selected by the Partnership.  An indemnifying party may participate at its own expense in the defense of any such action; provided, however, that counsel to the indemnifying party shall not (except with the consent of the indemnified party) also be counsel to the indemnified party.  In no event shall the indemnifying parties be liable for fees and expenses of more than one counsel (in addition to any local counsel) separate from their own counsel for all indemnified parties in connection with any one action or separate but similar or related actions in the same jurisdiction arising out of the same general allegations or circumstances.  The indemnifying party under this Section 6 shall not be liable for any settlement of any proceeding effected without its written consent, but if settled with such consent or if there be a final judgment for the plaintiff, the indemnifying party agrees to indemnify the indemnified party against any loss, claim, damage, liability or expense by reason of such settlement or judgment. Notwithstanding the foregoing sentence, if at any time an indemnified party shall have requested an indemnifying party to reimburse the indemnified party for fees and expenses of counsel as contemplated by this Section 6, the indemnifying party agrees that it shall be liable for any settlement of any proceeding effected without its written consent if (i) such settlement is entered into more than 60 days after receipt by such indemnifying party of the aforesaid request, (ii) such indemnifying party shall not have reimbursed the indemnified party in accordance with such request or disputed in good faith the indemnified party’s entitlement to such reimbursement prior to the date of such settlement and (iii) such indemnified party shall have given the indemnifying party at least 60 days prior notice of its intention to settle. No indemnifying party shall, without the prior written consent of the indemnified party, effect any settlement, compromise or consent to the entry of judgment in any pending or threatened action, suit or proceeding in respect of which any indemnified party is or could have been a party and indemnity was or could have been sought hereunder by such indemnified party, unless such settlement, compromise or consent (i) includes an unconditional release of such indemnified party from all liability on claims that are the subject matter of such action,

 

27



 

suit or proceeding and (ii) does not include any statements as to, any findings of or admission of fault, culpability or failure to act by or on behalf of any indemnified party.

 

(e)           Indemnification for Reserved Securities .  In connection with the offer and sale of the Reserved Securities, each of the Partnership Parties agrees to indemnify and hold harmless the Underwriters, their Affiliates and selling agents and each person, if any, who controls any Underwriter within the meaning of either Section 15 of the 1933 Act or Section 20 of the 1934 Act, from and against any and all loss, liability, claim, damage and expense (including, without limitation, any legal or other expenses reasonably incurred in connection with defending, investigating or settling any such action or claim), as incurred, (i) arising out of the violation of any applicable laws or regulations of foreign jurisdictions where Reserved Securities have been offered, (ii) arising out of any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement of a material fact contained in any prospectus wrapper or other material prepared by or with the consent of the Partnership for distribution to Invitees in connection with the offering of the Reserved Securities or caused by any omission or alleged omission to state therein a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not misleading, (iii) caused by the failure of any Invitee to pay for and accept delivery of Reserved Securities which have been orally confirmed for purchase by any Invitee by 9:00 A.M. (New York City time) on the first business day after the date of the Agreement or (iv) related to, or arising out of or in connection with, the offering of the Reserved Securities.

 

SECTION 7.         Contribution .  If the indemnification provided for in Section 6 hereof is for any reason unavailable to or insufficient to hold harmless an indemnified party in respect of any losses, liabilities, claims, damages or expenses referred to therein, then each indemnifying party shall contribute to the aggregate amount of such losses, liabilities, claims, damages and expenses incurred by such indemnified party, as incurred, (i) in such proportion as is appropriate to reflect the relative benefits received by the Partnership Parties, on the one hand, and the Underwriters, on the other hand, from the offering of the Securities pursuant to this Agreement or (ii) if the allocation provided by clause (i) is not permitted by applicable law, in such proportion as is appropriate to reflect not only the relative benefits referred to in clause (i) above but also the relative fault of the Partnership Parties, on the one hand, and of the Underwriters, on the other hand, in connection with the statements or omissions that resulted in such losses, liabilities, claims, damages or expenses, as well as any other relevant equitable considerations.

 

The relative benefits received by the Partnership Parties, on the one hand, and the Underwriters, on the other hand, in connection with the offering of the Securities pursuant to this Agreement shall be deemed to be in the same respective proportions as the total net proceeds from the offering of the Securities pursuant to this Agreement (before deducting expenses) received by the Partnership, on the one hand, and the total underwriting discount received by the Underwriters, on the other hand, in each case as set forth on the cover of the Prospectus, bear to the aggregate initial public offering price of the Securities as set forth on the cover of the Prospectus.

 

The relative fault of the Partnership Parties, on the one hand, and the Underwriters, on the other hand, shall be determined by reference to, among other things, whether any such untrue or alleged untrue statement of a material fact or omission or alleged omission to state a material fact relates to information supplied by the Partnership Parties or by the Underwriters and the parties’ relative intent, knowledge, access to information and opportunity to correct or prevent such statement or omission or any violation of the nature referred to in Section 6(e) hereof.

 

The Partnership Parties and the Underwriters agree that it would not be just and equitable if contribution pursuant to this Section 7 were determined by pro rata allocation (even if the Underwriters were treated as one entity for such purpose) or by any other method of allocation which does not take account of the equitable considerations referred to above in this Section 7.  The aggregate amount of

 

28



 

losses, liabilities, claims, damages and expenses incurred by an indemnified party and referred to above in this Section 7 shall be deemed to include any legal or other expenses reasonably incurred by such indemnified party in investigating, preparing or defending against any litigation, or any investigation or proceeding by any governmental agency or body, commenced or threatened, or any claim whatsoever based upon any such untrue or alleged untrue statement or omission or alleged omission.

 

Notwithstanding the provisions of this Section 7, no Underwriter shall be required to contribute any amount in excess of the underwriting commissions received by such Underwriter in connection with the Common Units underwritten by it and distributed to the public.

 

No person guilty of fraudulent misrepresentation (within the meaning of Section 11(f) of the 1933 Act) shall be entitled to contribution from any person who was not guilty of such fraudulent misrepresentation.

 

For purposes of this Section 7, each person, if any, who controls an Underwriter within the meaning of Section 15 of the 1933 Act or Section 20 of the 1934 Act and each Underwriter’s Affiliates and selling agents shall have the same rights to contribution as such Underwriter, and each director and officer of the General Partner who signed the Registration Statement, and each person, if any, who controls the Partnership Parties within the meaning of Section 15 of the 1933 Act or Section 20 of the 1934 Act shall have the same rights to contribution as the Partnership Parties.  The Underwriters’ respective obligations to contribute pursuant to this Section 7 are several, and not joint, in proportion to the number of Initial Securities set forth opposite their respective names in Schedule A hereto.

 

SECTION 8.         Representations, Warranties and Agreements to Survive .  All representations, warranties and agreements contained in this Agreement or in certificates of officers of any of the Partnership Parties submitted pursuant hereto, shall remain operative and in full force and effect regardless of (i) any investigation made by or on behalf of any Underwriter or its Affiliates or selling agents, any person controlling any Underwriter, its officers or directors or any person controlling the Susser Entities and (ii) delivery of and payment for the Securities.

 

SECTION 9.         Termination of Agreement .

 

(a)           Termination .  The Representatives may terminate this Agreement, by notice to the Partnership, at any time at or prior to the Closing Time (i) if there has been, in the judgment of the Representatives, since the time of execution of this Agreement or since the respective dates as of which information is given in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package or the Prospectus, any material adverse change in the condition, financial or otherwise, or in the earnings, properties, management, unitholders’ or members’ equity, as applicable, business affairs or business prospects of the Partnership Entities considered as one enterprise, whether or not arising in the ordinary course of business, or (ii) if there has occurred any material adverse change in the financial markets in the United States or the international financial markets, any outbreak of hostilities or escalation thereof or other calamity or crisis or any change or development involving a prospective change in national or international political, financial or economic conditions, in each case the effect of which is such as to make it, in the judgment of the Representatives, impracticable or inadvisable to proceed with the completion of the offering or to enforce contracts for the sale of the Securities, or (iii) if trading in any securities of the Partnership has been suspended or materially limited by the Commission or the New York Stock Exchange (other than due to the circumstances described in clause (iv) of this Section 9(a)), or (iv) if trading generally on the American Stock Exchange or the New York Stock Exchange or the Nasdaq Stock Market has been suspended or materially limited, or minimum or maximum prices for trading have been fixed, or maximum ranges for prices have been required, by any of said exchanges or by order of the Commission, FINRA or any other governmental authority, or (v) a material disruption has

 

29



 

occurred in commercial banking or securities settlement or clearance services in the United States, or (vi) if a banking moratorium has been declared by either Federal or New York authorities.

 

(b)           Liabilities .  If this Agreement is terminated pursuant to this Section, such termination shall be without liability of any party to any other party except as provided in Section 4 hereof, and provided further that Sections 1, 6, 7, 8, 14, 15 and 16 shall survive such termination and remain in full force and effect.

 

SECTION 10.       Default by One or More of the Underwriters .  If one or more of the Underwriters shall fail at the Closing Time or a Date of Delivery to purchase the Securities which it or they are obligated to purchase under this Agreement (the “ Defaulted Securities ”), the Representatives shall have the right, within 24 hours thereafter, to make arrangements for one or more of the non-defaulting Underwriters, or any other underwriters, to purchase all, but not less than all, of the Defaulted Securities in such amounts as may be agreed upon and upon the terms herein set forth. If, however, the Representatives shall not have completed such arrangements within such 24-hour period, then:

 

(i)            if the number of Defaulted Securities does not exceed 10% of the number of Securities to be purchased on such date, each of the non-defaulting Underwriters shall be obligated, severally and not jointly, to purchase the full amount thereof in the proportions that their respective underwriting obligations hereunder bear to the underwriting obligations of all non-defaulting Underwriters, or

 

(ii)           if the number of Defaulted Securities exceeds 10% of the number of Securities to be purchased on such date, this Agreement or, with respect to any Date of Delivery which occurs after the Closing Time, the obligation of the Underwriters to purchase, and the Partnership to sell, the Option Securities to be purchased and sold on such Date of Delivery shall terminate without liability on the part of any non-defaulting Underwriter.

 

No action taken pursuant to this Section 10 shall relieve any defaulting Underwriter from liability in respect of its default.

 

In the event of any such default which does not result in a termination of this Agreement or, in the case of a Date of Delivery which is after the Closing Time, which does not result in a termination of the obligation of the Underwriters to purchase and the Partnership to sell the relevant Option Securities, as the case may be, either the (i) Representatives or (ii) the Partnership shall have the right to postpone the Closing Time or the relevant Date of Delivery, as the case may be, for a period not exceeding seven days in order to effect any required changes in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package or the Prospectus or in any other documents or arrangements.  As used herein, the term “ Underwriter ” includes any person substituted for an Underwriter under this Section 10.

 

SECTION 11.       Notices .  All notices and other communications hereunder shall be in writing and shall be deemed to have been duly given if mailed or transmitted by any standard form of telecommunication.  Notices to the Underwriters shall be directed to Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated at One Bryant Park, New York, New York 10036, attention of Syndicate Department, with a copy to ECM Legal, and to Barclays Capital Inc. at 745 Seventh Avenue, New York, New York 10019, Attention: Syndicate Registration (Fax: 646-834-8133), with a copy, in the case of any notice pursuant to Section 6(c), to the Director of Litigation, Office of the General Counsel, Barclays Capital Inc., 745 Seventh Avenue, New York, New York 10019; notices to the Partnership shall be directed to it at Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC at 555 East Airtex Drive, Houston, Texas 77073, attention of the General Counsel.

 

30


 

 

SECTION 12.       No Advisory or Fiduciary Relationship .  Each of the Partnership Parties acknowledges and agrees that (a) the purchase and sale of the Securities pursuant to this Agreement, including the determination of the initial public offering price of the Securities and any related discounts and commissions, is an arm’s-length commercial transaction between the Partnership Parties, on the one hand, and the several Underwriters, on the other hand, (b) in connection with the offering of the Securities and the process leading thereto, each Underwriter is and has been acting solely as a principal and is not the agent or fiduciary of any of the Partnership Parties, any of their subsidiaries or their respective equityholders, creditors, employees or any other party, (c) no Underwriter has assumed or will assume an advisory or fiduciary responsibility in favor of any of the Partnership Parties with respect to the offering of the Securities or the process leading thereto (irrespective of whether such Underwriter has advised or is currently advising any of the Partnership Parties or any of their subsidiaries on other matters) and no Underwriter has any obligation to any of the Partnership Parties with respect to the offering of the Securities except the obligations expressly set forth in this Agreement, (d) the Underwriters and their respective affiliates may be engaged in a broad range of transactions that involve interests that differ from those of the Partnership Parties and (e) the Underwriters have not provided any legal, accounting, regulatory or tax advice with respect to the offering of the Securities and the Partnership Parties have consulted their own respective legal, accounting, regulatory and tax advisors to the extent they deemed appropriate.

 

SECTION 13.       Parties .  This Agreement shall each inure to the benefit of and be binding upon the Underwriters and the Partnership Parties and their respective successors.  Nothing expressed or mentioned in this Agreement is intended or shall be construed to give any person, firm or corporation, other than the Underwriters and the Partnership Parties and their respective successors and the controlling persons and officers and directors referred to in Sections 6 and 7 and their heirs and legal representatives, any legal or equitable right, remedy or claim under or in respect of this Agreement or any provision herein contained.  This Agreement and all conditions and provisions hereof are intended to be for the sole and exclusive benefit of the Underwriters and the Partnership Parties and their respective successors, and said controlling persons and officers and directors and their heirs and legal representatives, and for the benefit of no other person, firm or corporation.  No purchaser of Securities from any Underwriter shall be deemed to be a successor by reason merely of such purchase.

 

SECTION 14.       Trial by Jury .  Each of the Partnership Parties (on its behalf and, to the extent permitted by applicable law, on behalf of its equityholders and affiliates) and each of the Underwriters hereby irrevocably waives, to the fullest extent permitted by applicable law, any and all right to trial by jury in any legal proceeding arising out of or relating to this Agreement or the transactions contemplated hereby.

 

SECTION 15.       GOVERNING LAW .  THIS AGREEMENT AND ANY CLAIM, CONTROVERSY OR DISPUTE ARISING UNDER OR RELATED TO THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF, THE STATE OF NEW YORK WITHOUT REGARD TO ITS CHOICE OF LAW PROVISIONS.

 

SECTION 16.       Consent to Jurisdiction; Waiver of Immunity . Any legal suit, action or proceeding arising out of or based upon this Agreement or the transactions contemplated hereby (“ Related Proceedings ”) shall be instituted in (i) the federal courts of the United States of America located in the City and County of New York, Borough of Manhattan or (ii) the courts of the State of New York located in the City and County of New York, Borough of Manhattan (collectively, the “ Specified Courts ”), and each party irrevocably submits to the exclusive jurisdiction (except for proceedings instituted in regard to the enforcement of a judgment of any such court (a “ Related Judgment ”), as to which such jurisdiction is non-exclusive) of such courts in any such suit, action or proceeding.  Service of any process, summons, notice or document by mail to such party’s address set forth above shall be effective service of process for

 

31



 

any suit, action or other proceeding brought in any such court.  The parties irrevocably and unconditionally waive any objection to the laying of venue of any suit, action or other proceeding in the Specified Courts and irrevocably and unconditionally waive and agree not to plead or claim in any such court that any such suit, action or other proceeding brought in any such court has been brought in an inconvenient forum.

 

SECTION 17.       TIME . TIME SHALL BE OF THE ESSENCE OF THIS AGREEMENT. EXCEPT AS OTHERWISE SET FORTH HEREIN, SPECIFIED TIMES OF DAY REFER TO NEW YORK CITY TIME.

 

SECTION 18.       Counterparts .  This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts, each of which shall be deemed to be an original, but all such counterparts shall together constitute one and the same Agreement.

 

SECTION 19.       Effect of Headings .  The Section headings herein are for convenience only and shall not affect the construction hereof.

 

32



 

If the foregoing is in accordance with your understanding of our agreement, please sign and return to the Partnership a counterpart hereof, whereupon this instrument, along with all counterparts, will become a binding agreement among the Underwriters and the Partnership Parties in accordance with its terms.

 

 

Very truly yours,

 

 

 

 

 

SUSSER HOLDINGS CORPORATION

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS GP LLC

 

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP

 

 

 

 

 

 

By:

Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC,

 

 

its general partner

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

 

 

Name:

 

 

 

Title:

 

33



 

CONFIRMED AND ACCEPTED,

 

as of the date first above written:

 

 

 

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH

 

INCORPORATED

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

 

 

 

 

BARCLAYS CAPITAL INC.

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

 

For themselves and as Representatives of the other Underwriters named in Schedule A hereto.

 

34



 

SCHEDULE A

 

The initial public offering price per common unit for the Securities shall be $[ · ].

 

The purchase price per common unit for the Securities to be paid by the several Underwriters shall be $[ · ], being an amount equal to the initial public offering price set forth above less $[ · ] per common unit, subject to adjustment in accordance with Section 2(b) for distributions declared by the Partnership and payable on the Initial Securities but not payable on the Option Securities.

 

Name of Underwriter

 

Number of
Initial Securities

 

 

 

Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated

 

 

Barclays Capital Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total

 

[ · ]

 

Sch A-1



 

SCHEDULE B-1

 

Pricing Terms

 

1.             The Partnership is selling [ · ] common units representing limited partner interests in the Partnership.

 

2.             The Partnership has granted an option to the Underwriters, severally and not jointly, to purchase up to an additional [ · ] common units.

 

3.             The initial public offering price per common unit for the Securities shall be $[ · ].

 

SCHEDULE B-2

 

Free Writing Prospectuses

 

[SPECIFY EACH ISSUER GENERAL USE FREE WRITING PROSPECTUS]

 

[NONE]

 

Sch B - 1



 

SCHEDULE C

 

Jurisdictions of Formation and Foreign Qualification

 

Entity

 

Jurisdiction of
Incorporation

 

Jurisdiction(s) of Foreign
Qualification

 

 

 

 

 

Susser Holdings Corporation

 

Delaware

 

None

 

 

 

 

 

Susser Petroleum Partners LP

 

Delaware

 

[•]

 

 

 

 

 

Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC

 

Delaware

 

[•]

 

 

 

 

 

Susser Petroleum Operating Company LLC

 

Delaware

 

[•]

 

 

 

 

 

Susser Petroleum Property Company LLC

 

Delaware

 

[•]

 

 

 

 

 

T&C Wholesale LLC

 

Texas

 

None

 

 

 

 

 

Susser Petroleum Company LLC

 

Texas

 

Louisiana, New Mexico, Oklahoma

 

 

 

 

 

Stripes LLC

 

Texas

 

New Mexico, Oklahoma

 

Sch C - 1



 

SCHEDULE D

 

List of Persons and Entities Subject to Lock-up

 

Susser Holdings Corporation

 

Stripes LLC

 

Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC

 

Sam L. Susser

 

E.V. Bonner, Jr.

 

Rocky B. Dewbre

 

Mary E. Sullivan

 

David P. Engel

 

Armand S. Shapiro

 

Bryan F. Smith Jr.

 

Sam J. Susser

 

Sch D - 1


 

Exhibit A

 

FORM OF OPINION OF PARTNERSHIP’S COUNSEL
TO BE DELIVERED PURSUANT TO SECTION 5(b)

 

(i)            Each of the Partnership Entities has been duly formed, and each of the Susser Entities is validly existing as a corporation, limited partnership or limited liability company, as the case may be, and is in good standing under the laws of its jurisdiction of organization (as set forth on Schedule I hereto).

 

(ii)           Each of the Susser Entities has all corporate, partnership or limited liability company power and authority, as the case may be, necessary to (A) own, lease and operate its properties and to conduct its business as described in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus and (B) enter into and perform its obligations under each Operative Agreement to which it is a party.

 

(iii)          Each of the Partnership Entities is duly qualified as a foreign corporation, partnership or limited liability company, as applicable, to transact business and is in good standing in each jurisdiction set forth opposite its name on an annex to be attached to such counsel’s opinion.

 

(iv)          SHC, as the sole member of the General Partner, directly owns 100% of the issued and outstanding membership interests in the General Partner; such membership interests have been duly authorized and validly issued in accordance with the GP LLC Agreement and are fully paid (to the extent required by the GP LLC Agreement) and non-assessable (except as such non-assessability may be limited by Sections 18-607 and 18-804 of the Delaware LLC Act); and SHC owns such membership interests free and clear of all Liens (other than Liens arising under or in connection with the Credit Facilities) (A) in respect of which a financing statement under the Uniform Commercial Code of the State of Delaware naming SHC as debtor is on file in the office of the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware as of [ · ], 2012 or (B) otherwise known to us, without independent investigation, other than those created by or arising under the Delaware LLC Act.

 

(v)           The General Partner is the sole general partner of the Partnership, with a 0.0% non-economic general partner interest in the Partnership; such general partner interest has been duly authorized and validly issued in accordance with the Partnership Agreement; and the General Partner owns such general partner interest free and clear of all Liens (other than Liens arising under or in connection with the Credit Facilities) (A) in respect of which a financing statement under the Uniform Commercial Code of the State of Delaware naming the General Partner as debtor is on file in the office of the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware as of [ · ], 2012 or (B) otherwise known to us, without independent investigation, other than those created by or arising under the Delaware LLP Act.

 

(vi)          As of the date hereof, immediately after the issuance and sale of the [Initial] Securities to the Underwriters in accordance with the Underwriting Agreement, the issued and outstanding limited partner interests in the Partnership consist of (A) the [ · ] Common Units and [ · ] Subordinated Units issued to SHC and the [ · ] Common Units and [ · ] Subordinated Units issued to Stripes, collectively constituting the Sponsor Units, (B) [ · ] Common Units constituting the [Initial] Securities and (C) the Incentive Distribution Rights issued to SHC.

 

(vii)         The Sponsor Units and the Incentive Distribution Rights, and the limited partner interests represented thereby, have been duly authorized and validly issued in accordance with the Partnership Agreement and are fully paid (to the extent required by the Partnership Agreement) and non-assessable

 

A-1



 

(except as such non-assessability may be affected by Sections 17-303, 17-607 and 17-804 of the Delaware LP Act); and SHC and Stripes own their respective Sponsor Units and the Incentive Distribution Rights free and clear of all Liens (other than Liens arising under or in connection with the Credit Agreement) (A) in respect of which a financing statement (i) under the Uniform Commercial Code of the State of Delaware naming SHC as debtor is on file in the office of the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware or (ii) under the Uniform Commercial Code of the State of Texas or naming Stripes as debtor is on file in the office of the Secretary of State of the State of Texas, each as of [ · ], 2012 or (B) otherwise known to us, without independent investigation, other than those created by or arising under the Delaware LLP Act.

 

(viii)        The Securities, and the limited partner interests represented thereby, have been duly authorized for issuance and sale to the Underwriters in accordance with the Partnership Agreement and, when issued and delivered by the Partnership pursuant to the Underwriting Agreement against payment of the consideration set forth therein, will be validly issued, fully paid (to the extent required under the Partnership Agreement) and non-assessable (except as such non-assessability may be affected by Section 17-303, 17-607 or 17-804 of the Delaware LP Act).

 

(ix)          The Partnership, as the sole member of Susser Operating, directly owns 100% of the issued and outstanding membership interests in Susser Operating; such membership interests have been duly authorized and validly issued in accordance with the Susser Operating LLC Agreement and are fully paid (to the extent required by the Susser Operating LLC Agreement) and non-assessable (except as such non-assessability may be limited by Sections 18-607 and 18-804 of the Delaware LLC Act); and the Partnership owns such membership interests free and clear of all Liens (other than Liens arising under or in connection with the Credit Facilities) (A) in respect of which a financing statement under the Uniform Commercial Code of the State of Delaware naming the Partnership as debtor is on file in the office of the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware as of [ · ], 2012 or (B) otherwise known to us, without independent investigation, other than those created by or arising under the Delaware LLC Act.

 

(x)           Susser Operating, as the sole member of T&C Wholesale, directly owns 100% of the issued and outstanding membership interests in T&C Wholesale; such membership interests have been duly authorized and validly issued in accordance with the T&C Wholesale LLC Agreement and are fully paid (to the extent required by the T&C Wholesale LLC Agreement) and non-assessable (except as such non-assessability may be limited by Section 101.206 of the TBOC); and Susser Operating owns such membership interests free and clear of all Liens (other than Liens arising under or in connection with the Credit Agreement) (A) in respect of which a financing statement under the Uniform Commercial Code of the State of Delaware naming Susser Operating as debtor is on file in the office of the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware as of [ · ], 2012 or (B) otherwise known to us, without independent investigation other than those created by or arising under the Delaware LLP Act.

 

(xi)          Susser Operating, as the sole member of Propco, directly owns 100% of the issued and outstanding membership interests in Propco; such membership interests have been duly authorized and validly issued in accordance with the Propco LLC Agreement and are fully paid (to the extent required by the Propco LLC Agreement) and non-assessable (except as such non-assessability may be limited by Sections 18-607 and 18-804 of the Delaware LLC Act); and Susser Operating owns such membership interests free and clear of all Liens (other than Liens arising under or in connection with the Credit Agreement) (A) in respect of which a financing statement under the Uniform Commercial Code of the State of Delaware naming Susser Operating as debtor is on file in the office of the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware as of [ · ], 2012 or (B) otherwise known to us, without independent investigation other than those created by or arising under the Delaware LLP Act.

 

(xii)         Except as described in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus, (A) there are no options, warrants, preemptive rights, rights of first refusal or other rights

 

A-2



 

to subscribe for or to purchase, nor any restriction upon the voting or transfer of, any equity securities of any of the Partnership Entities, in each case pursuant to the Organizational Documents of any such Partnership Entity or any agreement filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement, and (B) to such counsel’s knowledge, neither the filing of the Registration Statement nor the offering, issuance or sale of the Securities as contemplated by the Underwriting Agreement gives rise to any rights for or relating to the registration of any Common Units or other securities of the Partnership.

 

(xiii)        The Underwriting Agreement has been duly authorized, executed and delivered by each of the Partnership Parties.

 

(xiv)        Each of the Operative Agreements has been duly authorized, executed and delivered by the Susser Entities party thereto, and is a valid and legally binding agreement of the Susser Entities party thereto, enforceable against such Susser Entities in accordance with its terms, under applicable laws of the State of Delaware; provided that, with respect to each agreement described in this Section (xiv), the enforceability thereof may be limited by (x) bankruptcy, insolvency, fraudulent transfer, reorganization, moratorium and similar laws relating to or affecting creditors’ rights generally and by general principles of equity (regardless of whether such enforceability is considered in a proceeding in equity or at law) and (y) public policy, applicable law relating to fiduciary duties and indemnification and an implied covenant of good faith and fair dealing.

 

(xv)         The Registration Statement has been declared effective by the Commission under the 1933 Act and the 1933 Act Regulations; any required filing of the Prospectus pursuant to Rule 424(b) has been made in the manner and within the time period required by Rule 424(b) (without reference to Rule 424(b)(8)); and, to the best of our knowledge, no stop order suspending the effectiveness of the Registration Statement or any Rule 462(b) Registration Statement has been issued under the 1933 Act or any order preventing or suspending the use of any preliminary prospectus, any Issuer Free Writing Prospectus or the Prospectus has been issued and no proceedings for any such purpose have been instituted or are pending or threatened by the Commission or any other Governmental Entity.

 

(xvi)        The Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus, and each amendment or supplement to the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus, as of their respective effective or issue dates (other than the financial statements and supporting schedules and other financial data included therein or omitted therefrom, as to which we express no opinion) appear on their face to comply as to form in all material respects with the requirements of the 1933 Act and the 1933 Act Regulations.

 

(xvii)       The information in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus under “Our Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions,” “Provisions of Our Partnership Agreement Relating to Cash Distributions,” “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources—Our Anticipated New Credit Facilities,” “Business—Environmental Matters,” “Business—Other Government Regulation,” “Certain Relationships and Related Transactions,” “Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties,” “Description of the Common Units,” “The Partnership Agreement” and “Investment in Susser Petroleum Partners LP by Employee Benefit Plans” and in the Registration Statement under Item 14, to the extent that it constitutes summaries of matters of law or legal proceedings, or legal conclusions, [or summaries of contracts and other documents to which any Partnership Entity is a party,] has been reviewed by us and is correct in all material respects.

 

(xviii)      Our opinion that is filed as Exhibit 8.1 to the Registration Statement is confirmed, and the Underwriters may rely upon such opinion as if it were addressed to them.

 

A-3



 

(xix)        No filing with, or authorization, approval, consent, license, order, registration, qualification or decree of, any Governmental Entity is necessary or required for the performance by any of the Susser Entities of its obligations hereunder or under any of the other Operative Agreements, in connection with the offering, issuance or sale of the Securities hereunder or the consummation of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement or the other Operative Agreements, except (A) such as have been already obtained or as may be required under the 1933 Act, the 1933 Act Regulations, the rules of the NYSE, state securities laws or the rules of FINRA and (B) such as have been obtained under the laws and regulations of jurisdictions outside the United States in which the Reserved Securities were offered.

 

(xx)         The execution, delivery and performance of the Underwriting Agreement and the Operative Agreements (as the case may be) and the consummation of the transactions contemplated thereby and in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus (including the issuance and sale of the Securities and the use of the proceeds from the sale of the Securities as described therein under the caption “Use of Proceeds”) and compliance by each of the Susser Entities with its obligations thereunder (as the case may be) do not and will not, whether with or without the giving of notice or passage of time or both, (i) constitute a breach or violation of, or default or Repayment Event under, or result in the creation or imposition of any Lien (other than Liens arising under or in connection with the Credit Agreement) upon any properties or assets of any of the [Susser Entities] pursuant to (A) the Organizational Documents of any such Partnership Entity, (B) any agreement filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement or (C) any of the agreements listed on Annex A hereto (each such document in (A), (B) and (C), an “ Applicable Agreement ”), (ii) result in any violation of the provisions of the Organizational Documents of any of the Susser Entities or (iii) result in any violation of applicable laws of the State of New York, applicable laws of the United States of America, the Delaware General Corporation Law, the Delaware LP Act, the Delaware LLC Act; other than, with respect to (i) and (iii), breaches, violations, defaults, Repayment Events or Liens that would not, singly or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect or materially impair the ability of any of the Susser Entities to consummate such transactions.

 

(xxi)        The Partnership is not required, and upon the issuance and sale of the Securities as contemplated in the Underwriting Agreement and the application of the net proceeds therefrom as described in the Registration Statement, the General Disclosure Package and the Prospectus will not be required, to register as an “investment company” under the 1940 Act.

 

Nothing has come to our attention that would lead us to believe that the Registration Statement or any amendment thereto, including the Rule 430A Information, (except for financial statements and schedules and other financial data included or omitted therefrom, as to which we make no statement), at the time such Registration Statement or any such amendment became effective, contained an untrue statement of a material fact or omitted to state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not misleading or that the Prospectus or any amendment or supplement thereto (except for financial statements and schedules and other financial data included therein or omitted therefrom, as to which we make no statement), at the time the Prospectus was issued, at the time any such amended or supplemented prospectus was issued or at the Closing Time, included or includes an untrue statement of a material fact or omitted or omits to state a material fact necessary in order to make the statements therein, in the light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading.  In addition, nothing has come to our attention that would lead us to believe that the General Disclosure Package (except for the financial statements and schedules and other financial data included therein or omitted therefrom, as to which we make no statement) as of the Applicable Time, contained any untrue statement of a material fact or omitted to state any material fact necessary in order to make the statements therein, in the light of circumstances under which they were made, not misleading.  With respect to statements contained in the General Disclosure Package, any statement contained in any of the constituent

 

A-4



 

documents shall be deemed to be modified or superseded to the extent that any information contained in subsequent constituent documents modifies or replaces such statement.

 

In rendering such opinions, such counsel may rely as to matters of fact (but not as to legal conclusions), to the extent they deem proper, on certificates of responsible officers of the Partnership and public officials.  Such opinion shall not state that it is to be governed or qualified by, or that it is otherwise subject to, any treatise, written policy or other document relating to legal opinions, including, without limitation, the Legal Opinion Accord of the ABA Section of Business Law (1991).

 

A-5



 

[Form of lock-up from directors, officers or other stockholders pursuant to Section 5(i)]

 

Exhibit B

 

[ · ], 2012

 

Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
Incorporated,

Barclays Capital Inc.

as Representatives of the several
Underwriters to be named in the
within-mentioned Underwriting Agreement

 

c/o   Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
Incorporated

 

One Bryant Park
New York, New York  10036

 

Re:          Proposed Public Offering by Susser Petroleum Partners LP

 

Dear Sirs:

 

The undersigned understands that Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated (“ Merrill Lynch ”) and Barclays Capital Inc., (collectively, the “ Representatives ”) propose to enter into an Underwriting Agreement (the “ Underwriting Agreement ”) with Susser Petroleum Partners LP, a Delaware limited partnership (the “ Partnership ”), providing for the public offering of common units representing limited partner interests in the Partnership (the “ Common Units ”).  In recognition of the benefit that such an offering will confer upon the undersigned, and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the undersigned agrees with each underwriter to be named in the Underwriting Agreement that, during the period beginning on the date hereof and ending on the date that is 180 days from the date of the Underwriting Agreement (subject to extensions as discussed below), the undersigned will not, without the prior written consent of Merrill Lynch, directly or indirectly (i) offer, pledge, sell, contract to sell, sell any option or contract to purchase, purchase any option or contract to sell, grant any option, right or warrant for the sale of, or otherwise dispose of or transfer any Common Units or any securities convertible into or exchangeable or exercisable for Common Units, whether now owned or hereafter acquired by the undersigned or with respect to which the undersigned has or hereafter acquires the power of disposition (collectively, the “ Lock-Up Securities ”), or exercise any right with respect to the registration of any of the Lock-up Securities, or file or cause to be filed any registration statement in connection therewith, under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or (ii) enter into any swap or any other agreement or any transaction that transfers, in whole or in part, directly or indirectly, the economic consequence of ownership of the Lock-Up Securities, whether any such swap or transaction is to be settled by delivery of Common Units or other securities, in cash or otherwise.

 

Notwithstanding the foregoing, and subject to the conditions below, the undersigned may transfer the Lock-Up Securities without the prior written consent of Merrill Lynch, provided that (1) Merrill

 

B-1



 

Lynch receives a signed lock-up agreement for the balance of the lockup period from each donee, trustee, distributee, or transferee, as the case may be, (2) any such transfer shall not involve a disposition for value, (3) such transfers are not required to be reported with the Securities and Exchange Commission on Form 4 in accordance with Section 16 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and (4) the undersigned does not otherwise voluntarily effect any public filing or report regarding such transfers:

 

(i)                                      as a bona fide gift or gifts; or

 

(ii)                                   to any trust for the direct or indirect benefit of the undersigned or the immediate family of the undersigned (for purposes of this lock-up agreement, “immediate family” shall mean any relationship by blood, marriage or adoption, not more remote than first cousin); or

 

(iii)                                as a distribution to limited partners or stockholders of the undersigned; or

 

(iv)                               to the undersigned’s affiliates or to any investment fund or other entity controlled or managed by the undersigned.

 

Furthermore, the undersigned may sell Common Units purchased by the undersigned on the open market following the public offering if and only if (i) such sales are not required to be reported in any public report or filing with the Securities Exchange Commission, or otherwise and (ii) the undersigned does not otherwise voluntarily effect any public filing or report regarding such sales.

 

Notwithstanding the foregoing, if:

 

(1)           during the last 17 days of the 180-day lock-up period, the Partnership issues an earnings release or material news or a material event relating to the Partnership occurs; or

 

(2)           prior to the expiration of the 180-day lock-up period, the Partnership announces that it will release earnings results or becomes aware that material news or a material event will occur during the 16-day period beginning on the last day of the 180-day lock-up period,

 

the restrictions imposed by this lock-up agreement shall continue to apply until the expiration of the 18-day period beginning on the issuance of the earnings release or the occurrence of the material news or material event, as applicable, unless Merrill Lynch waives, in writing, such extension.

 

The undersigned agrees that, prior to engaging in any transaction or taking any other action that is subject to the terms of this lock-up agreement during the period from the date of this lock-up agreement to and including the 34 th  day following the expiration of the initial 180-day lock-up period, it will give notice thereof to the Partnership and will not consummate such transaction or take any such action unless it has received written confirmation from the Partnership that the 180-day lock-up period (as may have been extended pursuant to the previous paragraph) has expired.

 

The undersigned also agrees and consents to the entry of stop transfer instructions with the Partnership’s transfer agent and registrar against the transfer of the Lock-Up Securities except in compliance with the foregoing restrictions.

 

B-2



 

 

Very truly yours,

 

 

 

Signature:

 

 

 

 

 

Print Name:

 

 

B-3




Exhibit 3.6

 

 

 

FORM OF

 

AMENDED AND RESTATED

 

LIMITED LIABILITY COMPANY AGREEMENT

 

OF

 

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS GP LLC

 

 

 



 

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

ARTICLE I

DEFINITIONS

 

 

 

Section 1.1

Definitions

1

Section 1.2

Construction

4

 

 

 

ARTICLE II

ORGANIZATION

 

 

 

Section 2.1

Formation

4

Section 2.2

Name

4

Section 2.3

Registered Office; Registered Agent; Principal Office; Other Offices

4

Section 2.4

Purpose and Business

4

Section 2.5

Powers

5

Section 2.6

Term

5

Section 2.7

Title to Company Assets

5

 

 

 

ARTICLE III

RIGHTS OF SOLE MEMBER

 

 

 

Section 3.1

Voting

5

Section 3.2

Distribution

6

 

 

 

ARTICLE IV

CAPITAL CONTRIBUTIONS; PREEMPTIVE RIGHTS;

NATURE OF MEMBERSHIP INTEREST

 

 

 

Section 4.1

Initial Capital Contributions

6

Section 4.2

Additional Capital Contributions

6

Section 4.3

No Preemptive Rights

6

Section 4.4

Fully Paid and Non-Assessable Nature of Membership Interests

6

 

 

 

ARTICLE V

MANAGEMENT AND OPERATION OF BUSINESS

 

 

 

Section 5.1

Establishment of the Board

6

Section 5.2

The Board; Delegation of Authority and Duties

7

Section 5.3

Term of Office

8

Section 5.4

Meetings of the Board and Committees

8

Section 5.5

Voting

9

Section 5.6

Responsibility and Authority of the Board

9

Section 5.7

Devotion of Time

10

Section 5.8

Certificate of Formation

10

Section 5.9

Benefit Plans

11

Section 5.10

Indemnification

11

Section 5.11

Liability of Indemnitees

13

Section 5.12

Reliance by Third Parties

13

 

i



 

Section 5.13

Other Business of Members

14

 

 

 

ARTICLE VI

OFFICERS

 

 

 

Section 6.1

Officers

14

Section 6.2

Compensation

16

 

 

 

ARTICLE VII

BOOKS, RECORDS, ACCOUNTING AND REPORTS

 

 

 

Section 7.1

Records and Accounting

16

Section 7.2

Reports

16

Section 7.3

Bank Accounts

17

 

 

 

ARTICLE VIII

DISSOLUTION AND LIQUIDATION

 

 

 

Section 8.1

Dissolution

17

Section 8.2

Effect of Dissolution

17

Section 8.3

Application of Proceeds

17

 

 

 

ARTICLE IX

GENERAL PROVISIONS

 

 

 

Section 9.1

Addresses and Notices

18

Section 9.2

Creditors

18

Section 9.3

Applicable Law

18

Section 9.4

Invalidity of Provisions

19

Section 9.5

Third Party Beneficiaries

19

 

ii



 

AMENDED AND RESTATED LIMITED LIABILTY COMPANY AGREEMENT

 

OF

 

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS GP LLC

 

THIS AMENDED AND RESTATED LIMITED LIABILTY COMPANY AGREEMENT of SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS GP LLC (the “ Company ”), dated as of [ · ], 2012 is entered into by Susser Holdings Corporation, a Delaware corporation (“ SHC ”), as sole member of the Company as of the date hereof (in such capacity, the “ Sole Member ”).

 

RECITALS:

 

WHEREAS , SHC formed the Company as a limited liability company under the Delaware Limited Liability Company Act by filing a Certificate of Formation with the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware effective as of June 11, 2012.

 

WHEREAS , the Company was previously governed by that certain Limited Liability Company Agreement (the “ Original LLC Agreement ”) dated as of June 11, 2012.

 

WHEREAS , SHC now desires to amend and restate the Original LLC Agreement in its entirety by executing this Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement.

 

NOW THEREFORE , in consideration of the covenants, conditions and agreements contained herein, the Sole Member hereby enters into this Agreement:

 

ARTICLE I
DEFINITIONS

 

Section 1.1                 Definitions.

 

The following definitions shall be for all purposes, unless otherwise clearly indicated to the contrary, applied to the terms used in this Agreement.

 

Act ” means the Delaware Limited Liability Company Act, 6 Del. C. § 18-101, et seq., as amended, supplemented or restated from time to time, and any successor to such statute.

 

Affiliate ” means, with respect to any Person, any other Person that directly or indirectly through one or more intermediaries’ controls, is controlled by or is under common control with, the Person in question. As used herein, the term “control” means the possession, direct or indirect, of the power to direct or cause the direction of the management and policies of a Person, whether through ownership of voting securities, by contract or otherwise.

 

Agreement ” means this Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement of Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC, as it may be amended, supplemented or restated from

 

1



 

time to time. The Agreement constitutes a “ limited liability company agreement ” as such term is defined in the Act.

 

Board ” means the board of directors of the Company.

 

Capital Contribution ” means any cash, cash equivalents or the value of Contributed Property contributed to the Company.

 

Certificate of Formation ” means the Certificate of Formation of the Company filed with the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware as referenced in Section 2.1 , as such Certificate of Formation may be amended, supplemented or restated from time to time.

 

Chairman ” has the meaning assigned to such term in Section 5.2(d) .

 

Common Units ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the Partnership Agreement.

 

Company ” means Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, and any successors thereto.  For the avoidance of doubt, references in this Agreement to the Company shall not include the Partnership or any of its Subsidiaries.

 

Company Group ” means the Company and any Subsidiary of the Company, treated as a single consolidated entity.

 

Contributed Property ” means each property, contract, or other asset, in such form as may be permitted by the Act, but excluding cash, contributed to the Company.

 

Directors ” has the meaning assigned to such term in Section 5.1 .

 

Group Member ” means a member of the Company Group.

 

Indemnitee ” means (a) the Sole Member; (b) any Person who is or was an Affiliate of the Company; (c) any Person who is or was a member, partner, director, officer, fiduciary or trustee of the Company, any Group Member or the Partnership; (d) any Person who is or was serving at the request of the Sole Member as a member, partner, director, officer, fiduciary or trustee of another Person, in each case, acting in such capacity, provided , that a Person shall not be an Indemnitee by reason of providing, on a fee-for-services basis, trustee, fiduciary or custodial services; and (e) any Person the Company designates as an “Indemnitee” for purposes of this Agreement.

 

Independent Director ” has the meaning assigned to such term in Section 5.2(c)(ii) .

 

Initial Public Offering ” means the initial offering and sale of common units representing limited partner interests in the Partnership to the public.

 

Listing Date ” means the first day upon which the Common Units are listed or admitted to trading on the New York Stock Exchange or another national securities exchange.

 

2



 

Membership Interest ” means all of the Sole Member’s rights and interest in the Company in the Sole Member’s capacity as the Sole Member, all as provided in the Certificate of Formation, this Agreement and the Act, including, without limitation, the Sole Member’s interest in the capital, income, gain, deductions, losses and credits of the Company.

 

Officer ” has the meaning given to such term in Section 6.1(a) .

 

Original LLC Agreement ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the Recitals to this Agreement.

 

Partners ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the Partnership Agreement.

 

Partnership ” means Susser Petroleum Partners LP, a Delaware limited partnership.

 

Partnership Agreement ” means the First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of Susser Petroleum Partners LP, as it may be amended, supplemented or restated from time to time.

 

Partnership Interest ” means an interest in the Partnership, which shall include any general partner interest and limited partner interests but shall exclude any options, rights, warrants, appreciation rights tracking and phantom interests, and other economic interests relating to an equity interest in the Partnership.

 

“Person ” means an individual or a corporation, limited liability company, partnership, joint venture, trust, unincorporated organization, association, government agency or political subdivision thereof or other entity .

 

SHC ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the introductory paragraph of this Agreement.

 

Sole Member ” means SHC or any successor member of the Company.

 

Subsidiary ” means, with respect to any Person, (a) a corporation of which more than 50% of the voting power of shares entitled (without regard to the occurrence of any contingency) to vote in the election of directors or other governing body of such corporation is owned, directly or indirectly, at the date of determination, by such Person, by one or more Subsidiaries of such Person or a combination thereof, (b) a partnership (whether general or limited) in which such Person or a Subsidiary of such Person is, at the date of determination, a general partner of such partnership, but only if such Person, directly or by one or more Subsidiaries of such Person, or a combination thereof, controls such partnership, directly or indirectly, at the date of determination or (c) any other Person in which such Person, one or more Subsidiaries of such Person, or a combination thereof, directly or indirectly, at the date of determination, has (i) at least a majority ownership interest or (ii) the power to elect or direct the election of a majority of the directors or other governing body of such Person.

 

3


 

Section 1.2                 Construction.

 

(a)           Unless the context requires otherwise:  (i) capitalized terms used herein but not otherwise defined shall have the meanings assigned to such terms in the Partnership Agreement; (ii) any pronoun used in this Agreement shall include the corresponding masculine, feminine or neuter forms; (iii) references to Articles and Sections refer to Articles and Sections of this Agreement; and (iv) the term “ include ” or “ includes ” means includes, without limitation, and “ including ” means including, without limitation.

 

(b)           A reference to any Person includes such Person’s successors and permitted assigns.

 

ARTICLE II
ORGANIZATION

 

Section 2.1                 Formation.

 

On June 11, 2012, SHC formed the Company as a limited liability company pursuant to the provisions of the Act by virtue of the filing of the Certificate of Formation with the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware.

 

Section 2.2                 Name.  The name of the Company shall be “Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC”.  The Company’s business may be conducted under any other name or names deemed necessary or appropriate by the Board in its discretion, including, if consented to by the Board, the name of the Partnership.  The words “Limited Liability Company,” “L.L.C.” or “LLC” or similar words or letters shall be included in the Company’s name where necessary for the purpose of complying with the laws of any jurisdiction that so requires.  The Board in its discretion may change the name of the Company at any time and from time to time and shall promptly notify the Sole Member of such change.

 

Section 2.3                 Registered Office; Registered Agent; Principal Office; Other Offices.

 

Unless and until changed by the Board, the registered office of the Company in the State of Delaware shall be located at 1209 Orange Street, Wilmington, Delaware 19801, and the registered agent for service of process on the Company in the State of Delaware at such registered office shall be The Corporation Trust Company.  The principal office of the Company shall be located at 555 East Airtex Drive, Houston, Texas 77073, or such other place as the Board may from time to time designate.  The Company may maintain offices at such other place or places within or outside the State of Delaware as the Board deems necessary or appropriate.

 

Section 2.4                 Purpose and Business. The purpose and nature of the business to be conducted by the Company shall be to (a) serve as the general partner of the Partnership and, in connection therewith, to exercise all rights conferred upon the Company as the general partner of the Partnership in accordance with the Partnership Agreement; (b) engage directly in, or enter into or form any corporation, partnership, joint venture, limited liability company or other arrangement to engage indirectly in, any business activity that the Company is permitted to engage in and, in connection therewith, to exercise all of the rights and powers conferred upon the Company pursuant to the agreements relating to such business activity; (c) engage directly in, or enter into

 

4



 

or form any corporation, partnership, joint venture, limited liability company or other arrangement to engage indirectly in, any business activity that is approved by the Sole Member and that lawfully may be conducted by a limited liability company organized pursuant to the Act and, in connection therewith, to exercise all of the rights and powers conferred upon the Company pursuant to the agreements relating to such business activity; (d) guarantee, mortgage, pledge or encumber any or all of its assets in connection with any indebtedness of any Affiliate of the Company and (e) do anything necessary or appropriate to the foregoing, including the making of capital contributions or loans to a Group Member, the Partnership or any Subsidiary of the Partnership.

 

Section 2.5                 Powers.

 

The Company shall be empowered to do any and all acts and things necessary, appropriate, proper, advisable, incidental to or convenient for the furtherance and accomplishment of the purposes and business described in Section 2.4 and for the protection and benefit of the Company.

 

Section 2.6                 Term.

 

The term of the Company commenced upon the filing of the Certificate of Formation in accordance with the Act and shall continue in existence in perpetuity or until the dissolution of the Company in accordance with the provisions of Article VIII .  The existence of the Company as a separate legal entity shall continue until the cancellation of the Certificate of Formation as provided in the Act.

 

Section 2.7                 Title to Company Assets.

 

Title to Company assets, whether real, personal or mixed and whether tangible or intangible, shall be deemed to be owned by the Company as an entity, and the Sole Member shall not have any ownership interest in such Company assets or any portion thereof.

 

ARTICLE III
RIGHTS OF SOLE MEMBER

 

Section 3.1                 Voting.

 

Unless otherwise granted to the Board by this Agreement, the Directors shall not have any voting or management rights with respect to the Company and the Sole Member shall possess all voting rights in all matters relating to the Company, including, without limitation, matters relating to the amendment of this Agreement (except as provided in Section 2.2) , any merger, consolidation or conversion of the Company, any sale of all or substantially all of the assets of the Company and the termination, dissolution and liquidation of the Company.  The Sole Member may act by written consent without a meeting with respect to any action it could act upon at a meeting.

 

5



 

Section 3.2                 Distribution.

 

Distributions by the Company of cash or other property shall be made to the Sole Member at such time as the Sole Member deems appropriate.

 

ARTICLE IV
CAPITAL CONTRIBUTIONS; PREEMPTIVE RIGHTS;
NATURE OF MEMBERSHIP INTEREST

 

Section 4.1                 Initial Capital Contributions.

 

On June 11, 2012, in connection with the formation of the Company, the Sole Member made a contribution to the capital of the Company in the amount of $1,000 in exchange for all of the Membership Interests.

 

Section 4.2                 Additional Capital Contributions.

 

The Sole Member shall not be obligated to make additional Capital Contributions to the Company.

 

Section 4.3                 No Preemptive Rights.

 

No Person shall have preemptive, preferential or other similar rights with respect to: (a)additional Capital Contributions; (b) issuance or sale of any class or series of Membership Interests, whether unissued, held in the treasury or hereafter created; (c) issuance of any obligations, evidences of indebtedness or other securities of the Company convertible into or exchangeable for, or carrying or accompanied by any rights to receive, purchase or subscribe to, any such Membership Interests; (d) issuance of any right of subscription to or right to receive, or any warrant or option for the purchase of, any such Membership Interests; or (e) issuance or sale of any other securities that may be issued or sold by the Company.

 

Section 4.4                 Fully Paid and Non-Assessable Nature of Membership Interests.

 

All Membership Interests issued pursuant to, and in accordance with, the requirements of this Article IV shall be fully paid and non-assessable Membership Interests, except as such non-assessability may be affected by Section 18-607 and 18-804 of the Act.

 

ARTICLE V
MANAGEMENT AND OPERATION OF BUSINESS

 

Section 5.1                 Establishment of the Board.

 

The number of directors (the “ Directors ”) constituting the board of directors of the Company shall be at least [three] and not more than [twelve], unless otherwise fixed from time to time pursuant to action by the Sole Member.  The Directors shall be elected or approved by the Sole Member.  The Directors shall serve as Directors of the Company for their term of office established pursuant to Section 5.3 .

 

6



 

Section 5.2                 The Board; Delegation of Authority and Duties.

 

(a)           Sole Members and Board .  Except as otherwise provided in this Agreement, the business and affairs of the Company shall be managed under the direction of the Board, which shall possess all rights and powers which are possessed by “managers” under the Act and otherwise by applicable law, pursuant to Section 18-402 of the Act, subject to the provisions of this Agreement.  Except as otherwise provided for herein, the Sole Member hereby consents to the exercise by the Board of all such powers and rights conferred on it by the Act or otherwise by applicable law with respect to the management and control of the Company.

 

(b)           Delegation by the Board .  The Board shall have the power and authority to delegate to one or more other Persons the Board’s rights and powers to manage and control the business and affairs of the Company, including delegating such rights and powers of the Board to agents and employees of the Company (including Officers).  The Board may authorize any Person (including, without limitation, the Sole Member, or any Director or Officer) to enter into any document on behalf of the Company and perform the obligations of the Company thereunder.

 

(c)           Committees .

 

(i)                 The Board may establish committees of the Board and may delegate any of its responsibilities to such committees.

 

(ii)                On or before the Listing Date, the Board shall have an audit committee comprised of at least one Director as of such Listing Date, at least two Directors within 90 days of the Listing Date and at least three Directors within one year of the Listing Date, all of whom shall be Independent Directors.  Such audit committee shall establish a written audit committee charter in accordance with the rules of the principal national securities exchange on which a class of Partnership Interests of the Partnership are listed or admitted to trading, as amended from time to time.  “ Independent Director ” shall mean Directors meeting independence standards required of directors who serve on an audit committee of a board of directors established by the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and the rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission thereunder and by the national securities exchange on which any class of Partnership Interests of the Partnership are listed or admitted to trading.

 

(d)           Chairman of the Board .   The Board may elect a chairman (the “ Chairman ”) of the Board.  The Chairman of the Board, if elected, shall be a member of the Board and shall preside at all meetings of the Board and of the partners of the Partnership.  The Chairman of the Board shall not be an Officer by virtue of being the Chairman of the Board but may otherwise be an Officer.  The Chairman of the Board may be removed either with or without cause at any time by the affirmative vote of a majority of the Board.  No removal or resignation as Chairman of the Board shall affect such Chairman’s status as a Director.

 

7



 

Section 5.3                 Term of Office.

 

Once designated pursuant to Section 5.1 , a Director shall continue in office until the removal of such Director in accordance with the provisions of this Agreement or until the earlier death or resignation of such Director.  Any Director may resign at any time by giving written notice of such Director’s resignation to the Board.  Any such resignation shall take effect at the time the Board receives such notice or at any later effective time specified in such notice.  Unless otherwise specified in such notice, the acceptance by the Board of such Director’s resignation shall not be necessary to make such resignation effective.  Vacancies and newly created directorships resulting from any increase in the authorized number of Directors or from any other cause shall be filled by the Sole Member.  Notwithstanding anything herein or under applicable law to the contrary, any Director may be removed at any time with or without cause by the Sole Member.

 

Section 5.4                 Meetings of the Board and Committees.

 

(a)           Meetings .  The Board (or any committee of the Board) shall meet at such time and at such place as the Chairman of the Board (or the chairman of such committee) may designate.  If no Chairman has been elected or is serving, the Board shall meet at such time and such place as a majority of the Directors may designate.  Written notice of all regular meetings of the Board (or any committee of the Board) must be given to all Directors (or all members of such committee) at least two days prior to the regular meeting of the Board (or such committee).  Special meetings of the Board (or any committee of the Board) shall be held at the request of the Chairman, a majority of the Directors (or a majority of the members of such committee) or the Sole Member upon at least two days (if the meeting is to be held in person) or twenty-four hours (if the meeting is to be held telephonically) oral or written notice to the Directors (or the members of such committee) or upon such shorter notice as may be approved by the Directors (or the members of such committee), which approval may be given before or after the relevant meeting to which the notice relates.  All notices and other communications to be given to Directors (or members of a committee) shall be sufficiently given for all purposes hereunder if in writing and delivered by hand, courier or overnight delivery service or three days after being mailed by certified or registered mail, return receipt requested, with appropriate postage prepaid, or when received in the form of a telegram, as an attachment to an electronic mail message or facsimile, and shall be directed to the address, electronic mail address or facsimile number as such Director (or member) shall designate by notice to the Company.  Neither the business to be transacted at, nor the purpose of, any regular or special meeting of the Board (or committee) need be specified in the notice of such meeting.  Any Director (or member of such committee) may waive the requirement of such notice as to such Director (or such member).

 

(b)           Conduct of Meetings .  Any meeting of the Board (or any committee of the Board) may be held in person or by telephone conference or similar communications equipment by means of which all persons participating in the meeting can hear each other, and such participation in a meeting shall constitute presence in person at such meeting.

 

(c)           Quorum .  Fifty percent or more of all Directors (or members of a committee of the Board), present in person or participating in accordance with Section 5.4(b) , shall constitute a quorum for the transaction of business, but if at any meeting of the Board (or

 

8



 

committee) there shall be less than a quorum present, a majority of the Directors (or members of a committee) present may adjourn the meeting without further notice.  The Directors (or members of a committee) present at a duly organized meeting may continue to transact business until adjournment, notwithstanding the withdrawal of enough Directors (or members of a committee) to leave less than a quorum; provided , however , that only the acts of the Directors (or members of a committee) meeting the requirements of Section 5.5 shall be deemed to be acts of the Board (or such committee).

 

Section 5.5                 Voting.

 

Except as otherwise provided in this Agreement, the effectiveness of any vote, consent or other action of the Board (or any committee) in respect of any matter shall require either (i) the presence of a quorum and the affirmative vote of at least a majority of the Directors (or members of such committee) present or (ii) the written consent (in lieu of meeting) of the Directors (or members of such committee) having not less than the minimum number of votes that would be necessary to authorize or take such action at a meeting of the Board (or any committee) at which all Directors (or members of such committee) entitled to vote thereon were present and voted.  Any Director may vote in person or by proxy (pursuant to a power of attorney) on any matter that is to be voted on by the Board at a meeting thereof.

 

Section 5.6                 Responsibility and Authority of the Board.

 

(a)           General.  Except as otherwise provided in this Agreement, the relative authority and functions of the Board, on the one hand, and the Officers, on the other hand, shall be identical to the relative authority and functions of the board of directors and officers, respectively, of a corporation organized under the General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware.  The Officers shall be vested with such powers and duties as are set forth in Section 6.1 hereof and as are specified by the Board from time to time.  Accordingly, except as otherwise specifically provided in this Agreement, the day-to-day activities of the Company shall be conducted on the Company’s behalf by the Officers who shall be agents of the Company. In addition to the powers and authorities expressly conferred on the Board by this Agreement, the Board may exercise all such powers of the Company and do all such acts and things as are not restricted by this Agreement, the Partnership Agreement, the Act or applicable law.

 

(b)           Member Consent Required for Extraordinary Matters.  Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, the Board will not take any action without approval of the Sole Member with respect to an extraordinary matter that would have, or would reasonably be expected to have, a material effect, directly or indirectly, on the Sole Member’s interests in the Company.  The type of extraordinary matter referred to in the prior sentence which requires approval of the Sole Member shall include, but not be limited to, the following:  (i) commencement of any action relating to bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization or relief of debtors by the Company or a material Subsidiary thereof; (ii) a merger, consolidation, recapitalization or similar transaction involving the Company, the Partnership or a material Subsidiary thereof; (iii) a sale, exchange or other transfer not in the ordinary course of business of a substantial portion of the assets of the Partnership or a material Subsidiary of the Partnership, viewed on a consolidated basis, in one or a series of related transactions; (iv) dissolution or liquidation of the Company or the Partnership; and (v) a material amendment of

 

9



 

the Partnership Agreement.  An extraordinary matter will be deemed approved by the Sole Member if the Board receives a written, facsimile or electronic instruction evidencing such approval from the Sole Member or if a majority of the Directors that do not qualify as Independent Directors because of their affiliation with the Sole Member, approve such matter.  To the fullest extent permitted by law, a Director, acting as such, shall have no duty, responsibility or liability to the Sole Member with respect to any action by the Board approved by the Sole Member.

 

(c)           Member-Managed Decisions.

 

Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, the Sole Member shall have exclusive authority over the internal business and affairs of the Company that do not relate to management and control of the Partnership and its subsidiaries.  For illustrative purposes, the internal business and affairs of the Company where the Sole Member shall have exclusive authority include (i) the amount and timing of distributions paid by the Company, (ii) the issuance or repurchase of any equity interests in the Company, (iii) the prosecution, settlement or management of any claim made directly against the Company, (iv) the decision to sell, convey, transfer or pledge any asset of the Company, (v) the decision to amend, modify or waive any rights relating to the assets of the Company and (vi) the decision to enter into any agreement to incur an obligation of the Company other than an agreement entered into for and on behalf of the Partnership for which the Company is liable exclusively by virtue of the Company’s capacity as general partner of the Partnership or of any of its Affiliates.

 

In addition, notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, the Sole Member shall have exclusive authority to cause the Company to exercise the rights of the Company as general partner of the Partnership (or those exercisable after the Company ceases to be the general partner of the Partnership) where (a) the Company makes a determination or takes or declines to take any other action in its individual capacity under the Partnership Agreement, as opposed to its capacity as the general partner of the Partnership or (b) where the Partnership Agreement permits the Company to make a determination or take or decline to take any other action in its sole discretion.  For illustrative purposes, a list of provisions where the Company would be acting in its individual capacity or is permitted to act in its sole discretion is contained in Appendix A hereto.

 

Section 5.7                 Devotion of Time.

 

The Directors shall not be obligated and shall not be expected to devote all of their time or business efforts to the affairs of the Company (except, to the extent appropriate, in their capacity as employees of the Company).

 

Section 5.8                 Certificate of Formation.

 

The Sole Member caused the Certificate of Formation to be filed with the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware as required by the Act and certain other certificates or documents it determined in its discretion to be necessary or appropriate for the qualification and operation of the Company in certain other states.  The Board shall use all reasonable efforts to cause to be filed such additional certificates or documents as may be determined by the Board to be

 

10



 

necessary or appropriate for the formation, continuation, qualification and operation of a limited liability company in the State of Delaware or any other state in which the Company may elect to do business or own property.  To the extent that such action is determined by the Board to be necessary or appropriate, the Board shall cause the Officers to file amendments to and restatements of the Certificate of Formation and do all things to maintain the Company as a limited liability company under the laws of the State of Delaware or of any other state in which the Company may elect to do business or own property.

 

Section 5.9                 Benefit Plans.

 

The Board may propose and adopt on behalf of the Company employee benefit plans, employee programs and employee practices, or cause the Company to issue Partnership Interests, in connection with or pursuant to any employee benefit plan, employee program or employee practice maintained or sponsored by any Group Member or any Affiliate thereof, in each case for the benefit of employees of the Company, any Group Member or any Affiliate thereof, or any of them, in respect of services performed, directly or indirectly, for the benefit of any Group Member.

 

Section 5.10               Indemnification.

 

(a)           To the fullest extent permitted by law but subject to the limitations expressly provided in this Agreement, all Indemnitees shall be indemnified and held harmless by the Company from and against any and all losses, claims, damages, liabilities, joint or several, expenses (including legal fees and expenses), judgments, fines, penalties, interest, settlements or other amounts arising from any and all threatened, pending or completed claims, demands, actions, suits or proceedings, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative, and whether formal or informal and including appeals, in which any Indemnitee may be involved, or is threatened to be involved, as a party or otherwise, by reason of its status as an Indemnitee and acting (or refraining to act) in such capacity on behalf of or for the benefit of the Company; provided , that the Indemnitee shall not be indemnified and held harmless if there has been a final and non-appealable judgment entered by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that, in respect of the matter for which the Indemnitee is seeking indemnification pursuant to this Section 5.10 , the Indemnitee acted in bad faith or engaged in fraud, willful misconduct or, in the case of a criminal matter, acted with knowledge that the Indemnitee’s conduct was unlawful.  Any indemnification pursuant to this Section 5.10 shall be made only out of the assets of the Company, it being agreed that the Sole Member shall not be personally liable for such indemnification and shall have no obligation to contribute or loan any monies or property to the Company to enable it to effectuate such indemnification.

 

(b)           To the fullest extent permitted by law, expenses (including legal fees and expenses) incurred by an Indemnitee who is indemnified pursuant to Section 5.10(a)  in appearing at, participating in or defending any claim, demand, action, suit or proceeding shall, from time to time, be advanced by the Company prior to a final and non-appealable judgment entered by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that, in respect of the matter for which the Indemnitee is seeking indemnification pursuant to this Section 5.10 , that the Indemnitee is not entitled to be indemnified upon receipt by the Company of any undertaking by or on behalf of

 

11



 

the Indemnitee to repay such amount if it shall be ultimately determined that the Indemnitee is not entitled to be indemnified as authorized by this Section 5.10 .

 

(c)           The indemnification provided by this Section 5.10 shall be in addition to any other rights to which an Indemnitee may be entitled under any agreement, as a matter of law, in equity or otherwise, both as to actions in the Indemnitee’s capacity as an Indemnitee and as to actions in any other capacity, and shall continue as to an Indemnitee who has ceased to serve in such capacity and shall inure to the benefit of the heirs, successors, assigns and administrators of the Indemnitee.

 

(d)           The Company may purchase and maintain (or reimburse the Sole Member or its Affiliates for the cost of) insurance, on behalf of the Directors, the Officers, the Sole Member, its Affiliates, the Indemnitees and such other Persons as the Sole Member shall determine, against any liability that may be asserted against, or expense that may be incurred by, such Person in connection with the Company’s activities or such Person’s activities on behalf of the Company, regardless of whether the Company would have the power to indemnify such Person against such liability under the provisions of this Agreement.

 

(e)           For purposes of this Section 5.10 , the Company shall be deemed to have requested an Indemnitee to serve as fiduciary of an employee benefit plan whenever the performance by it of its duties to the Company also imposes duties on, or otherwise involves services by, it to the plan or participants or beneficiaries of the plan; excise taxes assessed on an Indemnitee with respect to an employee benefit plan pursuant to applicable law shall constitute “fines” within the meaning of Section 5.10(a) ; and action taken or omitted by an Indemnitee with respect to any employee benefit plan in the performance of its duties for a purpose reasonably believed by it to be in the best interest of the participants and beneficiaries of the plan shall be deemed to be for a purpose that is in the best interests of the Company.

 

(f)            In no event may an Indemnitee subject the Sole Member to personal liability by reason of the indemnification provisions set forth in this Agreement.

 

(g)           An Indemnitee shall not be denied indemnification in whole or in part under this Section 5.10 because the Indemnitee had an interest in the transaction with respect to which the indemnification applies if the transaction was otherwise permitted by the terms of this Agreement.

 

(h)           The provisions of this Section 5.10 are for the benefit of the Indemnitees and their heirs, successors, assigns, executors and administrators and shall not be deemed to create any rights for the benefit of any other Persons.

 

(i)            No amendment, modification or repeal of this Section 5.10 shall in any manner terminate, reduce or impair the right of any past, present or future Indemnitee to be indemnified by the Company, nor the obligations of the Company to indemnify any such Indemnitee under and in accordance with the provisions of this Section 5.10 as in effect immediately prior to such amendment, modification or repeal with respect to claims arising from or relating to matters occurring, in whole or in part, prior to such amendment, modification or repeal, regardless of when such claims may arise or be asserted.

 

12


 

Section 5.11              Liability of Indemnitees.

 

(a)           Notwithstanding anything to the contrary set forth in this Agreement or the Partnership Agreement, no Indemnitee shall be liable for monetary damages to the Company, the Sole Member or any other Persons who have acquired interests in the Company, for losses sustained or liabilities incurred as a result of any act or omission of an Indemnitee unless there has been a final and non-appealable judgment entered by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that, in respect of the matter in question, the Indemnitee acted in bad faith or engaged in fraud, willful misconduct or, in the case of a criminal matter, acted with knowledge that the Indemnitee’s conduct was criminal.

 

(b)           To the extent that, at law or in equity, an Indemnitee has duties (including fiduciary duties) and liabilities relating thereto to the Partnership or to the Partners and any other Indemnitee acting in connection with the Partnership’s business or affairs shall not be liable to the Partnership or to any Partner for its good faith reliance on the provisions of this Agreement.

 

(c)           Any amendment, modification or repeal of this Section 5.11 shall be prospective only and shall not in any way affect the limitations on the liability of the Indemnitees under this Section 5.11 as in effect immediately prior to such amendment, modification or repeal with respect to claims arising from or relating to matters occurring, in whole or in part, prior to such amendment, modification or repeal, regardless of when such claims may arise or be asserted.

 

Section 5.12              Reliance by Third Parties.

 

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Agreement, any Person dealing with the Company shall be entitled to assume that any Officer authorized by the Board to act for and on behalf of and in the name of the Company has full power and authority to encumber, sell or otherwise use in any manner any and all assets of the Company and to enter into any authorized contracts on behalf of the Company, and such Person shall be entitled to deal with any such Officer as if it were the Company’s sole party in interest, both legally and beneficially.  The Sole Member hereby waives any and all defenses or other remedies that may be available against such Person to contest, negate or disaffirm any action of any such Officer in connection with any such dealing.  In no event shall any Person dealing with any such Officer or its representatives be obligated to ascertain that the terms of the Agreement have been complied with or to inquire into the necessity or expedience of any act or action of any such Officer or its representatives.  Each and every certificate, document or other instrument executed on behalf of the Company by any Officer authorized by the Board shall be conclusive evidence in favor of any and every Person relying thereon or claiming thereunder that (a) at the time of the execution and delivery of such certificate, document or instrument, this Agreement was in full force and effect, (b) the Person executing and delivering such certificate, document or instrument was duly authorized and empowered to do so for and on behalf of and in the name of the Company and (c) such certificate, document or instrument was duly executed and delivered in accordance with the terms and provisions of this Agreement and is binding upon the Company.

 

13



 

Section 5.13              Other Business of Members.

 

(a)           Existing Business Ventures .  The Sole Member, each Director and their respective Affiliates may engage in or possess an interest in other business ventures of any nature or description, independently or with others, similar or dissimilar to the business of the Company or the Partnership, and the Company, the Partnership, the Directors and the Sole Member shall have no rights by virtue of this Agreement in and to such independent ventures or the income or profits derived therefrom, and the pursuit of any such venture, even if competitive with the business of the Company or the Partnership, shall not be deemed wrongful or improper or a breach of any duty.

 

(b)           Business Opportunities .  None of the Sole Member, any Director or any of their respective Affiliates shall be obligated to present any particular investment opportunity to the Company or the Partnership even if such opportunity is of a character that the Company, the Partnership or any of their respective Subsidiaries might reasonably be deemed to have pursued or had the ability or desire to pursue if granted the opportunity to do so, and the Sole Member, each Director or any of their respective Affiliates shall have the right to take for such person’s own account (individually or as a partner or fiduciary) or to recommend to others any such particular investment opportunity, and any such action shall not constitute a breach of any duty or otherwise existing at law in equity or otherwise.

 

ARTICLE VI
OFFICERS

 

Section 6.1                 Officers.

 

(a)           Generally .  The Board shall appoint agents of the Company, referred to as “ Officers ” of the Company as described in this Section 6.1 , who shall be responsible for the day-to-day business affairs of the Company, subject to the overall direction and control of the Board.  Unless provided otherwise by the Board, the Officers shall have the titles, power, authority and duties described below in this Section 6.1 .

 

(b)           Titles and Number .  The Officers shall be one or more Presidents, any and all Vice Presidents, the Secretary and any and all Assistant Secretaries and any Treasurer and any and all Assistant Treasurers and any other Officers appointed pursuant to this Section 6.1 .  There shall be appointed from time to time, in accordance with this Section 6.1 , such Vice Presidents, Secretaries, Assistant Secretaries, Treasurers and Assistant Treasurers as the Board may desire.  Any Person may hold two or more offices.

 

(i)            President .  The Board shall elect one or more individuals to serve as President.  In general, each President, subject to the direction and supervision of the Board, shall have general and active management and control of the affairs and business and general supervision of the Company, and the Partnership and its subsidiaries, and its officers, agents and employees, and shall perform all duties incident to the office of President of the Company and such other duties as may be prescribed from time to time by the Board.  Each President shall have the nonexclusive authority to sign on behalf of the Company any deeds,

 

14



 

mortgages, leases, bonds, notes, certificates, contracts or other instruments, except in cases where the execution thereof shall be expressly delegated by the Board or by this Agreement to some other Officer or agent of the Company or shall be required by law to be otherwise executed.  In the absence of the Chairman, or the Vice Chairman, if there is one, or in the event of the Chairman’s inability or refusal to act, a President shall perform the duties of the Chairman, and each President, when so acting, shall have all of the powers of the Chairman.

 

(ii)           Vice Presidents .  The Board, in its discretion, may elect one or more Vice Presidents.  If a President does not have the role of chief financial officer of the Company, to have responsibility to oversee the financial operations of the Company, and the Partnership and its subsidiaries, the Board shall elect one or more individuals to serve as Vice Presidents and chief financial officers.   In the absence of any President or in the event of a Presidents’ inability or refusal to act, the Vice President (or in the event there be more than one Vice President, the Vice Presidents in the order designated, or in the absence of any designation, then in the order of their election) shall perform the duties of a President, and the Vice President, when so acting, shall have all of the powers and be subject to all the restrictions upon a President.  Each Vice President shall perform such other duties as from time to time may be assigned by a President or the Board.

 

(iii)          Secretary and Assistant Secretaries .  The Board, in its discretion, may elect a Secretary and one or more Assistant Secretaries.  The Secretary shall record or cause to be recorded in books provided for that purpose the minutes of the meetings or actions of the Board, of the Sole Member and of the Partners of the Partnership, shall see that all notices are duly given in accordance with the provisions of this Agreement and as required by law, shall be custodian of all records (other than financial), shall see that the books, reports, statements, certificates and all other documents and records required by law are properly kept and filed, and, in general, shall perform all duties incident to the office of Secretary and such other duties as may, from time to time, be assigned to him by this Agreement, the Board or a President.  The Assistant Secretaries shall exercise the powers of the Secretary during that Officer’s absence or inability or refusal to act.

 

(iv)          Treasurer and Assistant Treasurers .  The Board, in its discretion, may elect a Treasurer and one or more Assistant Treasurers.  The Treasurer shall keep or cause to be kept the books of account of the Company and shall render statements of the financial affairs of the Company in such form and as often as required by this Agreement, the Board or a President.  The Treasurer, subject to the order of the Board, shall have the custody of all funds and securities of the Company.  The Treasurer shall perform all other duties commonly incident to his office and shall perform such other duties and have such other powers as this Agreement, the Board or a President, shall designate from time to time.  The Assistant Treasurers shall exercise the power of the Treasurer during that Officer’s absence or inability or refusal to act.  Each of the Assistant Treasurers shall possess the same power as the Treasurer to sign all certificates, contracts,

 

15



 

obligations and other instruments of the Company.  If no Treasurer or Assistant Treasurer is appointed and serving or in the absence of the appointed Treasurer and Assistant Treasurer, a President or such other Officer as the Board shall select, shall have the powers and duties conferred upon the Treasurer.

 

(c)           Other Officers and Agents .  The Board may appoint such other Officers and agents as may from time to time appear to be necessary or advisable in the conduct of the affairs of the Company, who shall hold their offices for such terms and shall exercise such powers and perform such duties as shall be determined from time to time by the Board.

 

(d)           Appointment and Term of Office .  The Officers shall be appointed by the Board at such time and for such terms as the Board shall determine.  Any Officer may be removed, with or without cause, only by the Board.  Vacancies in any office may be filled only by the Board.

 

(e)           Powers of Attorney .  The Board may grant powers of attorney or other authority as appropriate to establish and evidence the authority of the Officers and other Persons.

 

(f)            Officers’ Delegation of Authority .  Unless otherwise provided by resolution of the Board, no Officer shall have the power or authority to delegate to any Person such Officer’s rights and powers as an Officer to manage the business and affairs of the Company.

 

Section 6.2                 Compensation.

 

The Officers shall receive such compensation for their services as may be designated by the Board or any committee thereof established for the purpose of setting compensation.

 

ARTICLE VII
BOOKS, RECORDS, ACCOUNTING AND REPORTS

 

Section 7.1                 Records and Accounting.

 

The Board shall keep or cause to be kept at the principal office of the Company appropriate books and records with respect to the Company’s business.  The books of account of the Company shall be (i) maintained on the basis of a fiscal year that is the calendar year and (ii) maintained on an accrual basis in accordance with U.S. GAAP, consistently applied.

 

Section 7.2                 Reports.

 

With respect to each calendar year, the Board shall prepare, or cause to be prepared, and deliver, or cause to be delivered, to the Sole Member:

 

(a)           Within 120 days after the end of such calendar year, a profit and loss statement and a statement of cash flows for such year and a balance sheet as of the end of such year.

 

16



 

(b)           Such federal, state and local income tax returns and such other accounting, tax information and schedules as shall be necessary for the preparation by the Sole Member on or before June 15 following the end of each calendar year of its income tax return with respect to such year.

 

Section 7.3                 Bank Accounts.

 

Funds of the Company shall be deposited in such banks or other depositories as shall be designated from time to time by the Board.  All withdrawals from any such depository shall be made only as authorized by the Board and shall be made only by check, wire transfer, debit memorandum or other written instruction.

 

ARTICLE VIII
DISSOLUTION AND LIQUIDATION

 

Section 8.1                 Dissolution .

 

(a)           The Company shall be of perpetual duration; however, the Company shall dissolve, and its affairs shall be wound up, upon:

 

(i)                 an election to dissolve the Company by the Sole Member;

 

(ii)                the entry of a decree of judicial dissolution of the Company pursuant to the provisions of the Act; or

 

(iii)               a merger or consolidation under the Act where the Company is not the surviving entity in such merger or consolidation.

 

(b)           No other event shall cause a dissolution of the Company.

 

Section 8.2                 Effect of Dissolution.

 

Except as otherwise provided in this Agreement, upon the dissolution of the Company, the Sole Member shall take such actions as may be required pursuant to the Act and shall proceed to wind up, liquidate and terminate the business and affairs of the Company.  In connection with such winding up, the Sole Member shall have the authority to liquidate and reduce to cash (to the extent necessary or appropriate) the assets of the Company as promptly as is consistent with obtaining fair value therefor, to apply and distribute the proceeds of such liquidation and any remaining assets in accordance with the provisions of Section 8.3 , and to do any and all acts and things authorized by, and in accordance with, the Act and other applicable laws for the purpose of winding up and liquidation.

 

Section 8.3                 Application of Proceeds.

 

Upon dissolution and liquidation of the Company, the assets of the Company shall be applied and distributed in the following order of priority:

 

17



 

(a)           First, to the payment of debts and liabilities of the Company (including to the Sole Member to the extent permitted by applicable law) and the expenses of liquidation;

 

(b)           Second, to the setting up of such reserves as the Person required or authorized by law to wind up the Company’s affairs may reasonably deem necessary or appropriate for any disputed, contingent or unforeseen liabilities or obligations of the Company, provided that any such reserves shall be paid over by such Person to an escrow agent appointed by the Sole Member, to be held by such agent or its successor for such period as such Person shall deem advisable for the purpose of applying such reserves to the payment of such liabilities or obligations and, at the expiration of such period, the balance of such reserves, if any, shall be distributed as hereinafter provided; and

 

(c)           Thereafter, the remainder to the Sole Member.

 

ARTICLE IX
GENERAL PROVISIONS

 

Section 9.1                 Addresses and Notices.

 

Any notice, demand, request, report or proxy materials required or permitted to be given or made to the Sole Member under this Agreement shall be in writing and shall be deemed given or made when delivered in person or when sent by first class United States mail or by other means of written communication to the Sole Member at the address described below. Any notice to the Company shall be deemed given if received by a President at the principal office of the Company designated pursuant to Section 2.3 . The Company may rely and shall be protected in relying on any notice or other document from the Sole Member or other Person if believed by it to be genuine.

 

If to the Sole Member:

 

Susser Holdings Corporation

4525 Ayers Street

Corpus Christi, Texas 78415

Attention:  E. V. Bonner, Jr.

Telephone:  (361) 884-2463

 

Section 9.2                 Creditors.

 

None of the provisions of this Agreement shall be for the benefit of, or shall be enforceable by, any creditor of the Company.

 

Section 9.3                 Applicable Law.

 

This Agreement shall be construed in accordance with and governed by the laws of the State of Delaware, without regard to the principles of conflicts of law.

 

18



 

Section 9.4                 Invalidity of Provisions.

 

If any provision of this Agreement is or becomes invalid, illegal or unenforceable in any respect, the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions contained herein shall not be affected thereby.

 

Section 9.5                 Third Party Beneficiaries.

 

The Sole Member agrees that any Indemnitee shall be entitled to assert rights and remedies hereunder as a third-party beneficiary hereto with respect to those provisions of this Agreement affording a right, benefit or privilege to such Indemnitee.

 

[The Remainder Of This Page Is Intentionally Blank]

 

19



 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF , the Member has executed this Agreement as of the date first written above.

 

 

 

SUSSER HOLDINGS CORPORATION

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

Name:

Sam L. Susser

 

Title:

President and Chief Executive Officer

 

 

AMENDED AND RESTATED LIMITED LIABILITY COMPANY AGREEMENT

OF

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS GP LLC

 



 

Appendix A

 

The following are provisions of the Partnership Agreement where the Company is permitted to act in its sole discretion or would be acting in its individual capacity.  Capitalized terms used but not defined in this Appendix A have the meanings assigned to them in the Partnership Agreement.

 

(a)           Section 2.4 (“ Purpose and Business ”), with respect to decisions to propose or approve the conduct by the Partnership of any business;

 

(b)           Sections 4.6(a ) and (b)  (“ Transfer of the General Partner Interest ”), solely with respect to the decision by the Company to transfer its general partner interest in the Partnership;

 

(c)           Section 5.8 (“ Limited Preemptive Right ”);

 

(d)           Section 6.9 (“ Entity-Level Taxation ”);

 

(e)           Section 7.5(d)  (relating to the right of the Company and its Affiliates to purchase Units or other Partnership Securities and exercise rights related thereto)

 

(f)            Section 7.7 (“ Indemnification ”), solely with respect to any decision by the Company to exercise its rights as an “Indemnitee”;

 

(g)           Section 7.12 (“ Registration Rights of the General Partner and its Affiliates ”), solely with respect to any decision to exercise registration rights of the Company;

 

(h)           Section 11.1 (“ Withdrawal of the General Partner ”), solely with respect to the decision by the Company to withdraw as General Partner of the Partnership and to giving notices required thereunder;

 

(i)            Section 11.3(a)  and (b)  (“ Interest of Departing General Partner and Successor General Partner ”); and

 

(j)            Section 13.2 (“ Amendment Procedures ”)

 

(k)           Section 15.1 (“ Right to Acquire Limited Partner Interests ”).

 

APPENDIX A

AMENDED AND RESTATED LIMITED LIABILITY COMPANY AGREEMENT

OF

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS GP LLC

 




Exhibit 5.1

 

 

[ · ], 2012

 

Susser Petroleum Partners LP
555 East Airtex Drive

Houston, Texas 77073

 

Ladies and Gentlemen:

 

We have acted as counsel to Susser Petroleum Partners LP, a Delaware limited partnership (the “ Partnership ”), in connection with the registration under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “ Securities Act ”), of the offering and sale of up to an aggregate of [ · ] common units representing limited partner interests in the Partnership (the “ Common Units ”) and up to an additional [ · ] Common Units pursuant to the underwriters’ option to purchase additional Common Units.

 

We are rendering this opinion as of the time the Registration Statement, as defined below, becomes effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of the Securities Act.

 

As the basis for the opinion hereinafter expressed, we examined such statutes, including the Delaware Revised Uniform Limited Partnership Act (the “ Delaware Act ”), partnership records and documents, certificates of partnership and public officials, and other instruments and documents as we deemed necessary or advisable for the purposes of this opinion. In such examination, we have assumed the authenticity of all documents submitted to us as originals and the conformity with the original documents of all documents submitted to us as copies.

 

Based on the foregoing and on such legal considerations as we deem relevant, we are of the opinion that:

 

1.                   The Partnership has been duly formed and is validly existing as a limited partnership under the Delaware Act.

 

2.                   The Common Units, when issued and delivered on behalf of the Partnership against payment therefor as described in the Partnership’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 (File No. 333-182276), as amended (the “ Registration Statement ”), to which this opinion is an exhibit and relating to the Common Units, will be duly authorized, validly issued, fully paid and non-assessable.

 

The foregoing opinion is limited to the laws of the United States of America, the Constitution of the State of Delaware and the Delaware Act, as interpreted by federal courts and the courts of the State of Delaware.

 

We hereby consent to the reference to us under the heading “Validity of Our Common Units” in the Registration Statement and the filing of this opinion as an exhibit to the Registration Statement. In giving this consent, we do not admit that we are within the category of persons whose consent is required under Section 7 of the Securities Act and the rules and regulations thereunder.

 

 

 

Very truly yours,

 

 

 

 

 

Vinson & Elkins LLP Attorneys at Law

Abu Dhabi Austin Beijing Dallas Dubai Hong Kong Houston

London Moscow New York Palo Alto Shanghai Tokyo Washington

First City Tower, 1001 Fannin Street, Suite 2500

Houston, TX 77002-6760

Tel +1.713.758.2222 Fax +1.713.758.2346 www.velaw.com

 




Exhibit 8.1

 

 

[•], 2012

 

Susser Petroleum Partners LP

555 East Airtex Drive
Houston, Texas 77073

 

RE:          Susser Petroleum Partners LP Registration Statement on Form S-1

 

Ladies and Gentlemen:

 

We have acted as counsel for Susser Petroleum Partners LP (the “ Partnership ”), a Delaware limited partnership, with respect to certain legal matters in connection with the offer and sale of common units (the “ Common Units ”) representing limited partner interests in the Partnership. We have also participated in the preparation of a Prospectus (the “ Prospectus ”), forming part of the Registration Statement on Form S-1, No. 333-182276 (the “ Registration Statement ”).

 

This opinion is based on various facts and assumptions, and is conditioned upon certain representations made by the Partnership as to factual matters through a certificate of an officer of the Partnership (the “ Officer’s Certificate ”). In addition, this opinion is based upon the factual representations of the Partnership concerning its business, properties and governing documents as set forth in the Registration Statement.

 

In our capacity as counsel to the Partnership, we have made such legal and factual examinations and inquiries, including an examination of originals or copies certified or otherwise identified to our satisfaction of such documents, corporate records and other instruments, as we have deemed necessary or appropriate for purposes of this opinion. In our examination, we have assumed the authenticity of all documents submitted to us as originals, the genuineness of all signatures thereon, the legal capacity of natural persons executing such documents and the conformity to authentic original documents of all documents submitted to us as copies. For the purpose of our opinion, we have not made an independent investigation or audit of the facts set forth in the above-referenced documents or in the Officer’s Certificate. In addition, in rendering this opinion we have assumed the truth and accuracy of all representations and statements made to us which are qualified as to knowledge or belief, without regard to such qualification.

 

We are opining herein as to the effect on the subject transaction only of the federal income tax laws of the United States, and we express no opinion with respect to the applicability thereto, or the effect thereon, of other federal laws, foreign laws, the laws of any state or any other jurisdiction or as to any matters of municipal law or the laws of any other local agencies within any state.  Based on the facts, assumptions and representations set forth herein, the discussion in the Prospectus under the caption “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences,” insofar as such discussion purports to constitute a summary of U.S. federal income tax law and regulations or legal conclusions with respect thereto, constitute the opinion of Vinson & Elkins LLP as to the material U.S. federal income tax

 

Vinson & Elkins LLP Attorneys at Law

Abu Dhabi Austin Beijing Dallas Dubai Hong Kong Houston London

Moscow New York Palo Alto Riyadh Shanghai Tokyo Washington

First City Tower, 1001 Fannin Street, Suite 2500

Houston, TX 77002-6760

Tel +1.713.758.2222 Fax +1.713.758.2346 www.velaw.com

 



 

consequences of the matters described therein. No opinion is expressed as to any matter not discussed therein.

 

This opinion is rendered to you as of the effective date of the Registration Statement, and we undertake no obligation to update this opinion subsequent to the date hereof. This opinion is based on various statutory provisions, regulations promulgated thereunder and interpretations thereof by the Internal Revenue Service and the courts having jurisdiction over such matters, all of which are subject to change either prospectively or retroactively. Also, any variation or difference in the facts from those set forth in the representations described above, including in the Registration Statement and the Officer’s Certificate, may affect the conclusions stated herein.

 

This opinion is furnished to you, and is for your use in connection with the transactions set forth in the Registration Statement. This opinion may not be relied upon by you for any other purpose or furnished to, assigned to, quoted to or relied upon by any other person, firm or other entity, for any purpose, without our prior written consent. However, this opinion may be relied upon by you and by persons entitled to rely on it pursuant to applicable provisions of federal securities law, including persons purchasing Common Units pursuant to the Registration Statement.

 

We hereby consent to the filing of this opinion as an exhibit to the Prospectus and to the use of our name under the captions “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences” and “Legal Matters” in the Registration Statement.  We further consent to the incorporation by reference of this letter and consent into any registration statement filed pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act with respect to the Common Units.  By giving this consent, we do not admit that we are within the category of persons whose consent is required under Section 7 of the Securities Act and the rules and regulations thereunder.

 

 

Very truly yours,

 

 

 

 

 

 

 




Exhibit 10.1

 

FORM OF

 

CONTRIBUTION AGREEMENT

 

By and Among

 

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP

 

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS GP LLC

 

SUSSER HOLDINGS CORPORATION

 

SUSSER HOLDINGS, L.L.C.

 

STRIPES LLC

 

and

 

SUSSER PETROLEUM COMPANY LLC

 

Dated as of [ · ], 2012

 



 

CONTRIBUTION AGREEMENT

 

This Contribution Agreement, dated as of [ · ], 2012 (this “ Agreement ”), is by and among Susser Petroleum Partners LP, a Delaware limited partnership (the “ Partnership ”), Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (the “ General Partner ”), Susser Holdings Corporation, a Delaware corporation (“ SHC ”), Susser Holdings, L.L.C., a Delaware limited liability company (“ Holdings ”), Stripes LLC, a Texas limited liability company (“ Stripes ”) and Susser Petroleum Company LLC, a Texas limited liability company (“ SPC ”).  The above-named entities are sometimes referred to in this Agreement each as a “ Party” and collectively as the “ Parties .”  Capitalized terms used herein shall have the meanings assigned to such terms in Article I.

 

RECITALS

 

WHEREAS , the General Partner and SHC have formed the Partnership under the terms of the Delaware Revised Uniform Limited Partnership Act (the “ Delaware LP Act ”), for the purpose of engaging in any business activity that is approved by the General Partner and that lawfully may be conducted by a limited partnership organized pursuant to the Delaware LP Act.

 

WHEREAS , in connection with the Offering, and in order to accomplish the objectives and purposes in the preceding recital each of the following actions has been taken prior to the date hereof:

 

1.                                        SHC formed the General Partner under the terms of the Delaware Limited Liability Company Act (the “ Delaware LLC Act ”) and contributed $1,000 in exchange for all of the member interests in the General Partner.

 

2.                                        The General Partner and SHC formed the Partnership under the terms of the Delaware LP Act and contributed $0 and $1,000, respectively, in exchange for a 0% non-economic general partner interest and a 100% limited partner interest, respectively, in the Partnership.

 

3.                                        SPC formed Susser Petroleum Operating Company LLC (“ Susser Operating ”) under the terms of the Delaware LLC Act and contributed $1,000 in exchange for all of the membership interests in Susser Operating.

 

4.                                        Susser Operating formed Susser Petroleum Property Company LLC (“ Susser Propco ”) under the terms of the Delaware LLC Act and contributed $1,000 in exchange for all of the membership interests in Susser Propco.

 

5.                                        T&C Wholesale, Inc. filed a certificate of conversion under the terms of the Texas Business Organizations Code (“ TBOC ”) to convert to a limited liability company named T&C Wholesale, LLC (“ T&C Wholesale ”).

 

6.                                        SPC contributed T&C Wholesale to Susser Operating.

 

7.                                        SHC, Susser Operating, Stripes and SPC entered into the SHC Distribution Contract.

 



 

8.                                        Susser Operating and SPC entered into the SHC Transportation Contract.

 

9.                                        Holdings distributed $[ · ] to SHC in compliance with the Asset Sales Covenant.

 

10.                                  Susser Propco filed an election on Form 8832 to be treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes that will be effective as of the date of the closing of the Offering.

 

WHEREAS , concurrently with the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby, each of the following transactions shall occur in the following order:

 

1.                                        SHC or its subsidiaries shall sell, convey, assign, transfer, contribute and deliver to Susser Operating:

 

a.                                        all of SPC’s right, title, duties, obligations and interests as tenant under the certain leases and subleases, and other agreements ancillary thereto, together with all modifications, addenda and amendments thereto, more particularly described on Schedule A attached hereto (the “ Tenant Leases ”), pursuant to that certain Assignment and Assumption of Lease Agreements (SPC as Tenant), dated as of [ · ] (the “ Tenant Lease Assignment ”);

 

b.                                       all of SPC’s right, title, duties, obligations and interests as landlord under the certain leases and subleases, and other agreements ancillary thereto, together with all modifications, addenda and amendments thereto, more particularly described on Schedule B attached hereto (the “ Landlord Leases ”), pursuant to that certain Assignment and Assumption of Lease Agreements (SPC as Landlord), dated as of [ · ] (the “ Landlord Lease Assignment ”);

 

c.                                        all of SPC’s right, title, duties, obligations and interests under certain vendor agreements, related to, among other things, certain merchandise purchasing and promotional programs arranged with dealers and vendors, and other agreements ancillary thereto, more particularly described on Schedule C attached hereto (the “ Vendor Agreements ”), pursuant to that certain Assignment and Assumption of Vendor Agreements, dated as of [ · ] (the “ Vendor Agreement Assignment ”);

 

d.                                       all of SPC’s right, title, duties, obligations and interests under certain marketer, distributor and supply agreements, pursuant to which, among other things, SPC purchases motor fuel from oil companies and refiners, and other agreements ancillary thereto, more particularly described on Schedule D attached hereto (the “ Fuel Supplier Agreements ”), pursuant to that certain Assignment and Assumption of Fuel Supplier Agreements, dated as of [ · ] (the “ Fuel Supplier Agreement Assignment ”);

 

e.                                        all of SPC’s right, title, duties, obligations and interests under certain fuel supply and management fee agreements, pursuant to which, among other

 

2



 

things, SPC distributes motor fuel to convenience stores and other retail fuel outlets, and other agreements ancillary thereto, more particularly described on Schedule E attached hereto (the “ Dealer Supply Agreements ”), pursuant to that certain Assignment and Assumption of Dealer Supply Agreements, dated as of [ · ] (the “ Dealer Supply Agreement Assignment ”);

 

f.                                          all of SHC’s or its subsidiaries’ right, title and interests in certain real property owned in fee and located in [Texas and [ · ]], together with all benefits, privileges, easements, tenements, hereditaments thereon or appertaining thereto, and any and all right, title and interest in and to adjacent roads and rights-of-way, more particularly described on Schedule F attached hereto (the “ Conveyed Real Property ”), pursuant to certain Special Warranty Deeds, dated as of [ · ] (the “ Special Warranty Deeds ”); and

 

g.                                       [all of SHC’s or its subsidiaries’ right, title and interests in and to certain personal property, more particularly described on Schedule G attached hereto (the “ Conveyed Personal Property ”), pursuant to certain Bills of Sale, dated as of [ · ] (the “ Bills of Sale ”)].

 

The Tenant Leases, Landlord Leases, Vendor Agreements, Fuel Supplier Agreements, Dealer Supply Agreements, Conveyed Real Property and Conveyed Personal Property are collectively referred to herein as the “ Contributed Assets .”  The Tenant Lease Assignment, Landlord Lease Assignment, Vendor Agreement Assignment, Fuel Supplier Agreement Assignment, Dealer Supply Agreement Assignment, Special Warranty Deeds and Bills of Sale, and other agreements ancillary thereto, are collectively referred to herein as the “ Assignment Documents .”

 

2.                                        SPC shall convey and contribute to the Partnership all of SPC’s right, title and interest in and to all of the membership interests in Susser Operating (the “ Susser Operating Interests ”), in exchange for the conveyance and distribution by the Partnership to SHC or its subsidiaries of:

 

a.                                        [ · ] Common Units representing a [ · ]% limited partner interest in the Partnership, [all of which] will be conveyed by the Partnership to Stripes;

 

b.                                       [ · ] Subordinated Units representing a [ · ]% limited partner interest in the Partnership, of which [ · ] Subordinated Units will be conveyed by the Partnership to SHC and [ · ] Subordinated Units will be conveyed by the Partnership to Stripes;

 

c.                                        the Incentive Distribution Rights, all of which will be conveyed by the Partnership to SHC;

 

d.                                       cash in the amount of $[ · ], as described in paragraphs [4, 5, 6, and 7] below, all of which shall be conveyed by the Partnership to SHC; and

 

3



 

e.                                        the right for SHC to either (i) receive up to an additional [ · ] Common Units, (ii) receive a cash distribution of the proceeds of the Over-Allotment Option if the Underwriters exercise the Over-Allotment Option, or (iii) a combination of both (i) and (ii).

 

3.                                        The Partnership shall redeem the 100% limited partner interest in the Partnership held by SHC and refund and distribute to SHC the initial capital contribution made by it to the Partnership along with 100% of any interest or other profit that resulted from the investment or other use of such initial capital contribution.

 

4.                                        At the Effective Time, the public, through the Underwriters, shall contribute to the Partnership $[ · ] ($[ · ] net of the Underwriters’ discount) in exchange for [ · ] Common Units representing a [ · ]% limited partner interest in the Partnership in connection with the Offering.

 

5.                                        The Partnership shall use a portion of the proceeds from the Offering to make a distribution of $[ · ] to the Issuer Group to reimburse the Issuer Group for certain capital expenditures incurred with respect to the Contributed Assets and to partially satisfy the Asset Sales Covenant under the Holdings Indenture.

 

6.                                        SHC will transfer $[ · ] to the Issuer Group as partial payment for the Contributed Assets to partially satisfy the Asset Sales Covenant under the Holdings Indenture.

 

7.                                        The Partnership will (i) use the remainder of the proceeds from the Offering of $[ · ] to purchase U.S. Treasury or other similar securities (“ Treasuries ”), (ii) pledge the Treasuries as collateral for a new loan that is fully guaranteed by SHC (the “ Recourse Loan ”), and (iii) distribute the proceeds from the Recourse Loan to the Issuer Group.

 

8.                                        SHC will (i) borrow the amount needed to satisfy the Asset Sales Covenant, $[ · ], and (ii) transfer such amount to the Issuer Group as partial payment for the Contributed Assets.

 

9.                                        Upon the expiration of period during which the Underwriters may exercise their Over-Allotment Option, if the Underwriters have not exercised any portion of the Over-Allotment Option, the Partnership will issue [ · ] additional Common Units to Stripes.  However, to the extent that the Underwriters exercise any portion of the Over-Allotment Option, the Partnership will (i) use the proceeds from the Over-Allotment Option to purchase additional Treasuries, (ii) use the Treasuries as collateral to borrow an equal amount of debt guaranteed by SHC (the “ Over-Allotment Option Debt ”), (iii) distribute the proceeds of the Over-Allotment Option Debt to SHC, and (iv) issue to SHC a number of Common Units equal to [ · ] less the number of Common Units purchased by the Underwriters in connection in the Over-Allotment Option.

 

NOW , THEREFORE , in consideration of the mutual covenants, representations, warranties and agreements herein contained, the Parties hereto agree as follows:

 

4



 

ARTICLE I
DEFINITIONS

 

The terms set forth below in this Article I shall have the meanings ascribed to them below or in the part of this Agreement referred to below:

 

Agreement ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the preamble.

 

Asset Sales Covenant ” means the covenant set forth in Section 4.40 of the Holdings Indenture.

 

Assignment Documents ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

Bills of Sale ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

Commission ” means the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission.

 

Common Units ” means the common units representing limited partner interests in the Partnership.

 

Contributed Assets ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

Conveyed Personal Property ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

Conveyed Real Property ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

Dealer Supply Agreement Assignment ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

Dealer Supply Agreements ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

Delaware LLC Act ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

Delaware LP Act ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

Effective Time ” means immediately prior to the closing of the initial public offering pursuant to the Underwriting Agreement.

 

Fuel Supplier Agreement Assignment ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

Fuel Supplier Agreements ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

General Partner ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the preamble.

 

Holdings ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the preamble.

 

5



 

Holdings Indenture ” means that certain Indenture dated as of May 7, 2010, by and among Holdings, Susser Finance Corporation, the guarantors named therein and Wells Fargo Bank, N.A., as Trustee, relating to the issuance of the 8.50% Senior Notes due 2016 of Holdings.

 

Incentive Distribution Rights ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the Partnership Agreement.

 

Issuer Group ” means Holdings and its restricted subsidiaries.

 

Landlord Lease Assignment ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

Landlord Leases ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

Offering means the initial offering and sale of Common Units to the public, as described in the Registration Statement, including any offer and sale of Common Units pursuant to the exercise of the Over-Allotment Option.

 

Option Closing Date ” means the date of the closing of the sale of Common Units issued pursuant to the Over-Allotment Option

 

Over-Allotment Option Debt ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

Over-Allotment Option ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the Partnership Agreement.

 

Partnership ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the preamble.

 

Partnership Agreement ” means the First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of the Partnership, dated as of [ · ], 2012.

 

Recourse Loan ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

Registration Statement ” means the Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed with the Commission (Registration No. 333- 182276), as amended and effective pursuant to the Securities Act at the Effective Time.

 

Securities Act ” means the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

 

SHC ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the preamble.

 

SHC Distribution Contract ” means that certain fuel supply agreement by and among SHC, Susser Operating, Stripes and SPC, dated as of [ · ], 2012.

 

SHC Transportation Contract ” means that certain transportation services agreement by and among Susser Operating and SPC, dated as of [ · ], 2012.

 

SPC ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the preamble.

 

Special Warranty Deeds ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

6



 

Stripes ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the preamble.

 

Subordinated Units ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the Partnership Agreement.

 

Susser Operating ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

Susser Operating Interests ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

Susser Propco ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

T&C Wholesale ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

TBOC ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

Tenant Lease Assignment ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

Tenant Leases ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

Treasuries ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

Underwriters ” means those underwriters listed in the Underwriting Agreement.

 

Underwriting Agreement ” means that certain Underwriting Agreement between SHC, the Partnership, the General Partner and the Underwriters, dated as of [ · ], 2012.

 

Vendor Agreement Assignment ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

Vendor Agreements ” has the meaning assigned to such term in the recitals.

 

ARTICLE II
CONTRIBUTION, ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS AND DISTRIBUTIONS

 

Section 2.1            Election to Treat Susser Propco as a Corporation .  The Parties acknowledge that on or before the date hereof, Susser Propco has filed a valid election on Internal Revenue Service Form 8832 for Susser Propco to be treated for U.S. federal income tax purposes as a corporation, effective two days prior to the Effective Time.

 

Section 2.2            Conveyance of Contributed Assets to Susser Operating . The Parties acknowledge the sale, conveyance, assignment, transfer, contribution and delivery by SHC and its subsidiaries to Susser Operating of the Contributed Assets pursuant to the Assignment Documents.

 

Section 2.3            Contribution of Susser Operating Interests to the Partnership .  SHC and the Issuer Group hereby grant, contribute, bargain, convey, assign, transfer, set over and deliver to the Partnership, its successors and assigns, for its and their own use forever, all right, title and interest in and to the Susser Operating Interests as a contribution of capital to the Partnership in exchange for:

 

7



 

(a)   [ · ] Common Units representing a [ · ]% limited partner interest in the Partnership (based upon the number of Common Units expected to be outstanding following the expiration of the Over-Allotment Option period), [all of which] will be conveyed by the Partnership to Stripes;

 

(b)   [ · ] Subordinated Units representing a [ · ]% limited partner interest in the Partnership (based upon the number of Common Units expected to be outstanding following the expiration of the Over-Allotment Option period), of which [ · ] Subordinated Units will be conveyed by the Partnership to SHC and [ · ] Subordinated Units will be conveyed by the Partnership to Stripes;

 

(c)   Incentive Distribution Rights, all of which will be conveyed by the Partnership to SHC;

 

(d)   a right to receive a distribution of $[ · ] from the Partnership in whole or in part reimbursing the Issuer Group for pre-formation capital expenditures with respect to the Contributed Assets and to partially satisfy the Asset Sales Covenant;

 

(e)   a right to receive a distribution of $[ · ] from the Partnership to partially satisfy the Asset Sales Covenant;

 

(f)    a right to receive a distribution of $[ · ] from the proceeds of the Recourse Loan; and

 

(g)   a right to receive a distribution of $[ · ] from borrowings of the Partnership as partial payment for the Contributed Assets.

 

The Partnership hereby accepts the Susser Operating Interests as a contribution to the capital of the Partnership.

 

Section 2.4            Purchase of Treasuries by the Partnership and Incurrence of Recourse Loan .  The Parties acknowledge (i) the purchase by the Partnership of $[ · ] of Treasuries, (ii) the pledge of the Treasuries as collateral for the Recourse Loan; and (iii) the distribution of the proceeds of $[ · ] from the Recourse Loan to the Issuer Group.

 

Section 2.5            Underwriters’ Cash Contribution .  The Parties acknowledge that the Underwriters have, pursuant to the Underwriting Agreement, made a capital contribution to the Partnership of $[ · ] in cash ($[ · ] net to the Partnership after the Underwriters’ discount of $[ · ] and structuring fee of $[ · ] ) in exchange for the issuance by the Partnership to the Underwriters of [ · ] Common Units, based upon the Underwriters full exercise of the Over-Allotment Option (representing a [ · ]% limited partner interest in the Partnership based upon the number of Common Units expected to be outstanding following the expiration of the Over-Allotment Option period).

 

Section 2.6            Payment of Transaction Expenses and Distribution by the Partnership .  The SHC and the Issuer Group acknowledge the payment and distribution by the Partnership, in connection with the transactions contemplated hereby, of:

 

(a)   estimated transaction expenses in the amount of approximately $[ · ] (inclusive of the Underwriters’ discount and any structuring fee);

 

8



 

(b)   $[ · ] of the net proceeds of the Offering to SHC and the Issuer Group as a reimbursement for certain pre-formation capital expenditures;

 

(c)   a payment of $[ · ] from the net proceeds of the Offering to SHC to partially satisfy the Asset Sales Covenant; and

 

(d)   a distribution of $[ · ] to SHC from the proceeds of the Recourse Loan to partially satisfy the Asset Sales Covenant.

 

Section 2.7            Additional Borrowings to Satisfy the Asset Sales Covenant . The Parties acknowledge the borrowing by the Partnership of $[•] and the transfer such amount to the Issuer Group as partial payment for the Contributed Assets to satisfy the Asset Sales Covenant.

 

Section 2.8            Redemption of the Initial Partner Interests in the Partnership and the Return of Initial Capital Contributions .  The Partnership hereby redeems the 100% limited partner interest in the Partnership held by SHC and hereby refunds and distributes to SHC the initial capital contribution made by it to the Partnership along with 100% of any interest or other profit that resulted from the investment or other use of such initial capital contribution.

 

ARTICLE III
ADDITIONAL TRANSACTIONS

 

Section 3.1            Sale and Purchase of Additional Common Units .  If the Over-Allotment Option is exercised in whole or in part, the Underwriters shall contribute additional cash to the Partnership, in exchange for up to an additional [ · ] Common Units on the basis of the initial public offering price per Common Unit set forth in the Registration Statement, net of the Underwriters’ discount and structuring fee.

 

Section 3.2            Exercise of the Over-Allotment Option . The Parties hereby acknowledge that, upon the expiration of the Over-Allotment Option period, if the Underwriters have not exercised any portion of the Over-Allotment Option, the Partnership will issue [ · ] additional Common Units to SHC.  However, to the extent that the Underwriters exercise any portion of the Over-Allotment Option, the Partnership will (i) use the proceeds from the Over-Allotment Option to purchase additional Treasuries, (ii) use the Treasuries as collateral to borrow the Over-Allotment Option Debt, (iii) distribute the proceeds of the Over-Allotment Option Debt to SHC, and (iv) issue to SHC a number of Common Units equal to [ · ] less the number of Common Units purchased by the Underwriters in connection in the Over-Allotment Option.

 

ARTICLE IV
FURTHER ASSURANCES

 

From time to time after the Effective Time, and without any further consideration, the Parties agree to execute, acknowledge and deliver all such additional deeds, assignments, bills of sale, conveyances, instruments, notices, releases, acquittances and other documents, and to do all such other acts and things, all in accordance with applicable law, as may be necessary or appropriate (a) more fully to assure that the applicable Parties own all of the properties, rights, titles, interests, estates, remedies, powers and privileges granted by this Agreement, or which are intended to be so granted, (b) more fully and effectively to vest in the applicable Parties and their

 

9



 

respective successors and assigns beneficial and record title to the interests contributed and assigned by this Agreement or intended to be so and (c) more fully and effectively to carry out the purposes and intent of this Agreement.

 

ARTICLE V
EFFECTIVE TIME

 

Notwithstanding anything contained in this Agreement to the contrary, none of the provisions of Article II of this Agreement shall be operative or have any effect until the Effective Time, at which time all the provisions of Article II of this Agreement shall be effective and operative in accordance with Article VI, without further action by any Party hereto.

 

ARTICLE VI
MISCELLANEOUS

 

Section 6.1            Order of Completion of Transactions .            The transactions provided for in Article II and Article VI of this Agreement shall be completed immediately following the Effective Time in the following order:  first, the transactions provided for in Article II shall be completed in the order set forth therein; and second, following the completion of the transactions provided for in Article II, the transactions provided for in Article IV, if they occur, shall be completed.

 

Section 6.2            Headings; References; Interpretation .           All Article and Section headings in this Agreement are for convenience only and shall not be deemed to control or affect the meaning or construction of any of the provisions hereof. The words “hereof,” “herein” and “hereunder” and words of similar import, when used in this Agreement, shall refer to this Agreement as a whole, including, without limitation, all Schedules and Exhibits attached hereto, and not to any particular provision of this Agreement. All references herein to Articles, Sections, Schedules and Exhibits shall, unless the context requires a different construction, be deemed to be references to the Articles and Sections of this Agreement and the Schedules and Exhibits attached hereto, and all such Schedules and Exhibits attached hereto are hereby incorporated herein and made a part hereof for all purposes. All personal pronouns used in this Agreement, whether used in the masculine, feminine or neuter gender, shall include all other genders, and the singular shall include the plural and vice versa. The use herein of the word “including” following any general statement, term or matter shall not be construed to limit such statement, term or matter to the specific items or matters set forth immediately following such word or to similar items or matters, whether or not non-limiting language (such as “without limitation”, “but not limited to”, or words of similar import) is used with reference thereto, but rather shall be deemed to refer to all other items or matters that could reasonably fall within the broadest possible scope of such general statement, term or matter.

 

Section 6.3            Successors and Assigns .   This Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the Parties and their respective successors and assigns.

 

Section 6.4            No Third Party Rights .      The provisions of this Agreement are intended to bind the Parties as to each other and are not intended to and do not create rights in

 

10



 

any other person or confer upon any other person any benefits, rights or remedies, and no person is or is intended to be a third party beneficiary of any of the provisions of this Agreement.

 

Section 6.5            Counterparts .       This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts with the same effect as if all signatory Parties had signed the same document.  All counterparts shall be construed together and shall constitute one and the same instrument.

 

Section 6.6            Choice of Law .      This Agreement shall be subject to and governed by the laws of the State of Texas. Each Party hereby submits to the jurisdiction of the state and federal courts in the State of Texas and to venue in Houston, Texas.

 

Section 6.7            Severability .         If any of the provisions of this Agreement are held by any court of competent jurisdiction to contravene, or to be invalid under, the laws of any political body having jurisdiction over the subject matter hereof, such contravention or invalidity shall not invalidate the entire Agreement. Instead, this Agreement shall be construed as if it did not contain the particular provisions or provisions held to be invalid and an equitable adjustment shall be made and necessary provision added so as to give effect to the intention of the Parties as expressed in this Agreement at the time of execution of this Agreement.

 

Section 6.8            Amendment or Modification .             This Agreement may be amended or modified from time to time only by the written agreement of all the Parties. Each such instrument shall be reduced to writing and shall be designated on its face as an amendment to this Agreement.

 

Section 6.9            Integration .           This Agreement and the instruments referenced herein supersede all previous understandings or agreements among the Parties, whether oral or written, with respect to the subject matter of this Agreement and such instruments. This Agreement and such instruments contain the entire understanding of the Parties with respect to the subject matter hereof and thereof. No understanding, representation, promise or agreement, whether oral or written, is intended to be or shall be included in or form part of this Agreement unless it is contained in a written amendment hereto executed by the parties hereto after the date of this Agreement.

 

Section 6.10         Deed; Bill of Sale; Assignment .       To the extent required and permitted by applicable law, this Agreement shall also constitute a “deed,” “bill of sale” or “assignment” of the assets and interests referenced herein.

 

[ Signature Pages Follow ]

 

11



 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties to this Agreement have caused it to be duly executed as of the date first above written.

 

 

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP

 

 

 

By:

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS GP LLC,

 

 

its general partner

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

 

 

 

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS GP LLC

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

 

 

 

SUSSER HOLDINGS CORPORATION

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

 

 

 

SUSSER HOLDINGS, L.L.C.

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

 

 

 

STRIPES LLC

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

 

 

 

SUSSER PETROLEUM COMPANY LLC

 

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

Signature Page to Contribution Agreement

 




Exhibit 10.3

 

FORM OF OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

 

among

 

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP,

 

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS GP LLC

 

and

 

SUSSER HOLDINGS CORPORATION

 



 

OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

 

This OMNIBUS AGREEMENT (“ Agreement ”) is entered into on, and effective as of, the Closing Date (as defined herein), among Susser Holdings Corporation, a Delaware corporation (“ SHC ”), Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (the “ General Partner ”), and Susser Petroleum Partners LP, a Delaware limited partnership (the “ Partnership ”).  The above-named entities are sometimes referred to in this Agreement each as a “ Party ” and collectively as the “ Parties .”

 

R E C I T A L S:

 

1.              The Parties desire by their execution of this Agreement to evidence their agreement, as more fully set forth in Article II , with respect to certain business opportunities to be offered to the Partnership by the SHC Entities (as defined herein) and certain obligations of the Partnership to the SHC Entities.

 

2.              The Parties desire by their execution of this Agreement to evidence their agreement, as more fully set forth in Article III , with respect to certain indemnification obligations of the Parties.

 

3.              The Parties desire by their execution of this Agreement to evidence their agreement, as more fully set forth in Article IV , with respect to the amount to be paid by the Partnership for certain general and administrative services to be performed by SHC and its Affiliates (as defined herein) as well as direct expenses, including operating expenses, incurred by SHC and its Affiliates for and on behalf of the Partnership Entities (as defined herein) and other services to be provided to the Partnership.

 

4.              The Parties desire by their execution of this Agreement to evidence their agreement, as more fully set forth in Article V , with respect to the granting of a license from SHC to the Partnership Entities.

 

In consideration of the premises and the covenants, conditions and agreements contained herein, and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the Parties hereby agree as follows:

 

ARTICLE I
Definitions

 

1.1            Definitions

 

As used in this Agreement, the following terms shall have the respective meanings set forth below:

 

Affiliate ” has the meaning given such term in the Partnership Agreement.

 

Agreement ” means this Omnibus Agreement, as it may be amended, modified or supplemented from time to time in accordance with the terms hereof.

 



 

Alternate Fuel Sales Rate ” means the per gallon fee that the Partnership will receive for certain motor fuel volumes distributed to SHC under the certain circumstances outlined in Article II hereto.  The Alternate Fuel Sales Rate, at any given time, is equal to the Partnership Prior-Year Distribution Cost, excluding the Partnership’s cost to purchase the motor fuel, plus a profit margin equal to 30% of the Partnership Prior-Year Distribution Cost.  The Alternate Fuel Sales Rate shall be recalculated annually on April 1 of each year based upon the audited financials statements of the Partnership for the prior fiscal year.  The Alternate Fuel Sales Rate shall become effective immediately upon recalculation on April 1 of each year and  will remain effective for twelve months.   Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Alternate Fuel Sales Rate in effect for the year in which an SHC Store becomes subject to the SHC Distribution Contract shall remain in effect, without adjustment or recalculation, with respect to such SHC Store for the balance of the term of such SHC Store under the SHC Distribution Contract.

 

Annual Construction Plan ” has the meaning given such term in Section 2.3 of this Agreement.

 

Cause ” has the meaning given such term in the Partnership Agreement.

 

Certificate of Cost ” has the meaning given such term in Section 2.2(d)  of this Agreement.

 

Closing Date ” means the date of the closing of the Partnership’s initial public offering of Common Units.

 

Common Units ” has the meaning given such term in the Partnership Agreement.

 

Conflicts Committee ” has the meaning given such term in the Partnership Agreement.

 

Contribution Agreement ” means that certain Contribution, Conveyance and Assumption Agreement, dated as of the Closing Date, by and among the General Partner, the Partnership, Susser Petroleum Company LLC, SHC and certain other parties, together with the additional conveyance documents and instruments contemplated or referenced thereunder.

 

Covered Environmental Losses ” means all Losses arising out of or under or related to Environmental Laws including costs and expenses of any Environmental Activity, court costs and reasonable attorney’s and experts’ fees or other measures required or necessary under Environmental Laws, and the cost and expense of any environmental or toxic tort pre-trial, trial or appellate legal or litigation support work of any and every kind or character, fixed or contingent, by reason of or arising out of:

 

(i)             any violation or correction of violation of Environmental Laws, including performance of any Environmental Activity associated in any way with the ownership or operation of Partnership Assets; or

 

(ii)            any event, circumstance, action, omission or condition associated in any way with ownership or operation of the Partnership Assets (including the exposure to or presence of Hazardous Substances on, under, about, Releasing or threatening to be Released to or from the Partnership Assets or the exposure to or Release or threatened

 

2



 

Release of Hazardous Substances arising out of operation of the Partnership Assets at non-Partnership Asset locations).

 

Environmental Activity ” shall mean any investigation, study, assessment, evaluation, sampling, testing, monitoring, containment, removal, disposal, closure, corrective action, remediation (regardless of whether active or passive), natural attenuation, restoration, bioremediation, response, repair, corrective measure, cleanup or abatement that is required, necessary or conducted under any applicable Environmental Law, including institutional or engineering controls or participation in a governmental voluntary cleanup program to conduct voluntary investigatory and remedial actions for the clean-up, removal or remediation of Hazardous Substances that exceed actionable levels established pursuant to Environmental Laws, or participation in a supplemental environmental project in partial or whole mitigation of a fine or penalty.

 

Environmental Laws ” means all federal, state, regional and local laws, statutes, rules, regulations, orders, judgments, settlements, ordinances, codes, injunctions, decrees, Environmental Permits and other legally enforceable requirements and rules of common law relating to (a) pollution or protection of human health and safety, the environment or natural resources, including the federal Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation and Liability Act, the Superfund Amendments and Reauthorization Act, the Resource Conservation and Recovery Act, the Clean Air Act, the Clean Water Act, the Safe Drinking Water Act, the Toxic Substances Control Act, the Oil Pollution Act of 1990, the federal Hazardous Materials Transportation Act, the Marine Mammal Protection Act, the Endangered Species Act, the National Environmental Policy Act, the federal Occupational Safety and Health Act and other environmental conservation and protection laws, each as amended through the Closing Date, (b) any Release or threatened Release of, or any exposure of any Person or property to, any Hazardous Substances or (c) the generation, manufacture, processing, distribution, use, treatment, storage, disposal, transport, arrangement for disposal or transport, handling or Release of any Hazardous Substances.

 

Environmental Permit ” means any permit, approval, identification number, license, registration, certification, filing, notice, consent, exemption, variance or other authorization required under or issued pursuant to any applicable Environmental Law.

 

Estimated Option Purchase Price ” has the meaning given such term in Section 2.2(d)  of this Agreement.

 

Exchange Act ” means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

 

Exercise Notice ” has the meaning given such term in Section 2.2(c)  of this Agreement.

 

Existing SHC Store ” has the meaning given such term in Section 2.2(b)  of this Agreement.

 

First Year Option Period ” has the meaning given such term in Section 2.2(a)  of this Agreement.

 

3



 

First Year Option Stores ” has the meaning given such term in Section 2.2(a)  of this Agreement.

 

Future SHC Store ” has the meaning given such term in Section 2.2(b)  of this Agreement.

 

General Partner ” has the meaning given such term in the introduction to this Agreement.

 

Hazardous Substance ” means (a) any substance that is designated, defined or classified as a hazardous waste, solid waste, hazardous material, pollutant, contaminant, toxic or hazardous substance, or terms of similar meaning, or that is otherwise regulated by, or as to which liability may attach under any Environmental Law, including any hazardous substance as defined under the Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation and Liability Act, as amended, (b) oil as defined in the Oil Pollution Act of 1990, as amended, including oil, gasoline, natural gas, fuel oil, motor oil, waste oil, diesel fuel, jet fuel and other refined petroleum hydrocarbons and petroleum products, or any components, fractions or derivatives thereof, and (c) radioactive materials, asbestos containing materials, polychlorinated biphenyls or radon.

 

Indemnified Party ” means each Partnership Group Member or each SHC Entity, as the case may be, in their capacities as parties entitled to indemnification in accordance with Article III .

 

Indemnifying Party ” means each of the Partnership or SHC, as the case may be, in their capacity as the parties from whom indemnification may be required in accordance with Article III .

 

Lease ” has the meaning given such term in Section 2.2(e)  of this Agreement.

 

License ” has the meaning given such term in Section 5.1 of this Agreement.

 

Losses ” means all losses, damages, liabilities, claims, demands, causes of action, judgments, settlements, fines, penalties, costs and expenses (including court costs and reasonable attorney’s and experts’ fees) of any and every kind or character, fixed or contingent.

 

Mark ” has the meaning given such term in Section 5.1 of this Agreement.

 

Name ” has the meaning given such term in Section 5.1 of this Agreement.

 

Option Closing Date ” has the meaning given such term in Section 2.2(c)  of this Agreement.

 

Option Purchase Price ” has the meaning given such term in Section 2.2(d)  of this Agreement.

 

Option Stores ” means the First Year Option Stores, the Second Year Option Stores and the Third Year Option Stores.

 

4



 

Option Periods ” means the First Year Option Period, the Second Year Option Period and the Third Year Option Period.

 

Partnership ” has the meaning given such term in the introduction to this Agreement.

 

Partnership Agreement ” means the First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of Susser Petroleum Partners LP, dated as of the Closing Date, as such agreement is in effect on the Closing Date immediately following the completion of the initial public offering of the Common Units.

 

Partnership Assets ” means the wholesale motor fuel distribution assets, properties and associated infrastructure and equity interests owned directly or indirectly by the Partnership upon completion of the initial public offering described in the Registration Statement.

 

Partnership Entities ” means the General Partner and each Partnership Group Member.

 

Partnership Group ” means the Partnership and its Subsidiaries.

 

Partnership Group Member ” means any member of the Partnership Group.

 

Partnership Indemnitee ” means any Person who is an Indemnitee as defined in the Partnership Agreement; provided , however , that for purposes of this definition, the term “ Indemnitee ” shall exclude SHC and any Affiliate of SHC that is not a Partnership Group Member.

 

Partnership Prior-Year Distribution Cost ” means, for purposes of determining the Alternate Fuel Sales Rate, at any given time, the Partnership’s per-gallon motor fuel distribution cost for the prior year, which is calculated as: (a) the sum of (i) general and administrative expense, other operating expenses and net Texas margin tax expense (other than any Texas margin taxes related to rental income received by the Partnership), each as reflected in the Partnership’s audited financial statements for such year, and (ii) maintenance capital expenditures for such year, (b) divided by the total number of gallons sold by the Partnership during such fiscal year.  The Partnership Prior-Year Distribution Cost shall be recalculated annually on April 1 of each year based upon the audited financials statements of the Partnership for the prior fiscal year.

 

Party ” and “ Parties ” are defined in the introduction to this Agreement.

 

Permitted Liens ” means those matters set forth on any survey of the SHC Stores and all easements conditions and restrictions, if any, relating to the SHC Stores, to the extent and only to the extent that the same may still be in force and effect, shown of record in the office of the County in which the SHC Stores are located, and zoning, building and other laws, regulations and ordinances of any and all municipal, governmental and quasi-governmental bodies and agencies having jurisdiction over the SHC Stores or any part thereof, statutory liens for ad valorem taxes and standby fees on the SHC Stores which are not yet delinquent, license or access agreements (including cross or reciprocal access agreements), utility easements, leases, and purchase money security interests in equipment or fixtures located on the SHC Stores after the date of conveyance.

 

5



 

Person ” means an individual or a corporation, limited liability company, partnership, joint venture, trust, business trust, employee benefit plan, unincorporated organization, association, government body or agency or political subdivision thereof or other entity.

 

Pre-Existing Distribution Contract ” has the meaning given such term in Section 2.1(b)  of this Agreement.

 

Preliminary Option Store List ” has the meaning given such term in Section 2.2(b)  of this Agreement.

 

Preliminary Purchase Notice ” has the meaning given such term in Section 2.2(b)  of this Agreement.

 

Proposed Acquisition ” has the meaning given such term in Section 2.4 of this Agreement.

 

Proposed Acquisition Notice ” has the meaning given such term in Section 2.4 of this Agreement.

 

Registration Statement ” means the Registration Statement on Form S-1 (File No. 333-182276), as amended, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission with respect to the proposed initial public offering of Common Units by the Partnership.

 

Release ” means any depositing, spilling, leaking, pumping, pouring, placing, emitting, discarding, abandoning, emptying, discharging, migrating, injecting, escaping, leaching, dumping or disposing into the environment.

 

Retained Assets ” means the equipment, properties, equity interests and other assets owned by any of the SHC Entities that were not conveyed, contributed or otherwise transferred to the Partnership Group pursuant to the Contribution Agreement or any other documents relating to the transactions referred to in the Contribution Agreement.

 

Sale and Leaseback Option ” has the meaning given such term in Section 2.2 of this Agreement.

 

Second Year Option Period ” has the meaning given such term in Section 2.2(a)  of this Agreement.

 

Second Year Option Stores ” has the meaning given such term in Section 2.2(a)  of this Agreement.

 

Services ” has the meaning given such term in Section 4.1 of this Agreement.

 

SHC ” has the meaning given such term in the introduction to this Agreement.

 

6



 

SHC Consignment Contract ” means any contract between SHC and a third party that provides that SHC will sell motor fuel on a consignment basis at a convenience store or retail fuel outlet owned or leased by the third party.

 

SHC Distribution Contract ” means that certain Fuel Distribution Agreement, dated as of [ · ], by and among Susser Petroleum Operating Company LLC, Susser Petroleum Company LLC and Stripes LLC, providing for the wholesale distribution of motor fuel by the Partnership Entities to the SHC Stores (or any location at which the SHC Entities sell fuel pursuant to any SHC Consignment Contract).

 

SHC Entities ” means SHC and any Person controlled, directly or indirectly, by SHC other than the General Partner or a member of the Partnership Group; and “ SHC Entity ” means any of the SHC Entities.

 

SHC Store ” means any retail convenience store operated by the SHC Entities at which SHC sells motor fuel.

 

Subsidiary ” has the meaning given such term in the Partnership Agreement.

 

Third Year Option Period ” has the meaning given such term in Section 2.2(a)  of this Agreement.

 

Third Year Option Stores ” has the meaning given such term in Section 2.2(a)  of this Agreement.

 

Voting Stock ” means securities of any class of a Person entitling the holders thereof to vote on a regular basis in the election of members of the board of directors or other governing body of such Person.

 

ARTICLE II
Business Opportunities Offered to the Partnership

 

2.1            Exclusive Right and Obligation to Distribute Motor Fuel Volumes Sold by SHC .

 

(a)            Exclusive Motor Fuel Distribution .  Except as permitted by Section 2.1(c) , for a period of ten year following the Closing Date,

 

(i)             Each SHC Entity is required to purchase all motor fuel volumes that it sells for its own account from a Partnership Group Member; and

 

(ii)            The Partnership shall cause one or more of the Partnership Group Members to distribute all motor fuel volumes that SHC may desire to purchase from the Partnership Group.

 

(b)            Determination of Distribution Terms .  All motor fuel volumes required by SHC for its own account will be provided to SHC pursuant to the terms of the SHC Distribution Contract. Any motor fuel volumes required by SHC for its own account for Future SHC Stores

 

7



 

or SHC Consignment Contracts that are not subject to the SHC Distribution Contract as of the date of Closing (and which do not become subject to the SHC Distribution Contract in accordance with Section 2.2(e)(iii)  following an exercise of the Partnership’s Sale and Leaseback Option) shall be provided by the Partnership to SHC (i) pursuant to such terms as they may mutually agree to following good faith negotiations or, (ii) in the event that the Partnership and SHC do not reach agreement following such negotiations, at the Partnership’s cost per gallon (as defined in the commodity schedule attached to the  SHC Distribution Contract)(the “ Partnership’s Cost Per Gallon ”) plus the Alternate Fuel Sales Rate.

 

(c)            Permitted Exceptions .

 

(i)             Notwithstanding any provision of Section 2.1(a)  to the contrary, any SHC Entity may purchase motor fuel from a third party in the event that such SHC Entity acquires a retail convenience store or other retail fuel outlet that is subject to an existing motor fuel wholesale distribution agreement (“ Pre-Existing Distribution Contract ”) at the time of its acquisition by SHC; provided that SHC shall be required to purchase its motor fuel requirements for any such store from the Partnership Group as soon as reasonably possible and, in any case, no later than the expiration of the remaining initial term of the applicable Pre-Existing Distribution Contract.

 

(ii)            Any SHC Entity shall be permitted to contract with any third party to sell motor fuel on a consignment basis (where the third party, as consignor, holds title to the motor fuel until it is sold to the retail customer) as permitted pursuant to Section 3 of the SHC Distribution Contract.

 

(iii)           SHC may purchase motor fuel pursuant to bulk sales contracts until the earlier of (a) the date the Partnership Group Members obtains the necessary permits to purchase motor fuel pursuant to bulk sales contracts or (b) 60 days following the Closing Date; provided, however, that SHC will sell any volumes purchased pursuant to this Section 2.1(c)(iii) to the Partnership at cost to SHC for such motor fuels.

 

(iv)           If during any period of this Agreement, the amount of any motor fuel volumes that Partnership is required to deliver to SHC is prescribed by government rules, regulations or orders, or if for any reason the Partnership’s supplies of motor fuel are inadequate to meet the needs of SHC and its other customers, the Partnership, in its sole discretion, may allocate motor fuel to SHC and its other customers and any shortfall in volumes requested by SHC pursuant to Section 2.1(a)(ii) of this agreement shall not be deemed to be a breach of this Agreement.   In the event that the Partnership is unable to distribute all motor fuel volumes that SHC desires to purchase from the Partnership, SHC may purchase from third parties its requirements of any motor fuel volumes in excess of the amounts of such motor fuel supplied by the Partnership Group Members.

 

2.2            Sale and Leaseback Option . SHC, on behalf of itself and the other SHC Entities, hereby grants to the Partnership Group Members the option (the “ Sale and Leaseback Option ”) to purchase SHC Stores and simultaneously lease such stores back to SHC, subject to the provisions of this Section 2.2 .

 

8



 

(a)            Exercise Period and Scope of Sale and Leaseback Option .

 

(i)             The Sale and Leaseback Option will include up to 75 SHC Stores and extend for three years after the Closing Date as follows:

 

(A)           during the period beginning on the Closing Date and ending on the first anniversary of the Closing Date (the “ First Year Option Period ”),  the Partnership Group Members shall have the right to purchase no fewer than 15 SHC Stores (the “ First Year Option Stores ”), to be selected in accordance with the provisions of Section 2.2(b)  herein, and the Partnership may exercise from time to time and at its sole discretion the Sale and Leaseback Option with respect to any or all of the First Year Option Stores during the First Year Option Period;

 

(B)            during the period beginning on the day after the first anniversary of the Closing Date and ending on the second anniversary of the Closing Date (the “ Second Year Option Period ”), the Partnership Group Members shall have the right to purchase no fewer than 25 SHC Stores (the “ Second Year Option Stores ”), to be selected in accordance with the provisions of Section 2.2(b)  herein, and the Partnership may exercise from time to time and at its sole discretion the Sale and Leaseback Option with respect to any or all of the Second Year Option Stores during the Second Year Option Period; and

 

(C)            during the period beginning on the day after the second anniversary of the Closing Date and ending on the third anniversary of the Closing Date (the “ Third Year Option Period ”), the Partnership Group Members shall have the right to purchase no fewer than 35 SHC Stores (the “ Third Year Option Stores ”), to be selected in accordance with the provisions of Section 2.2(b)  herein, and the Partnership may exercise from time to time and at its sole discretion the Sale and Leaseback Option with respect to any or all of the Third Year Option Stores during the Third Year Option Period.

 

(ii)            Notwithstanding any provision of Section 2.2(a)(i)  to the contrary, the Parties may mutually agree to accelerate the identification and designation of Option Stores and the exercise of the Sale and Leaseback Option.

 

(b)            Determination of Option Stores .

 

(i)             Option Stores may consist of any SHC Stores existing prior to the Closing (each, an “ Existing SHC Store ”) or any SHC Stores constructed or acquired by SHC after the Closing (each, a “ Future SHC Store ”), in either case, that are owned by SHC or will be owned by SHC at the time of any exercise of the Sale and Leaseback Option; provided, however , that SHC may not designate any Existing SHC Stores as Option Stores unless there are no Future SHC Stores identified on any Annual Construction Plan delivered during the Option Periods that have not previously been designated as Option Stores.  Each SHC Store designated as an Option Store shall continue to be deemed an Option Store for any subsequent Option Periods until and unless such Option Store is purchased pursuant to the Sale and Leaseback Option or removed in accordance with Section 2.2(b)(iii) .

 

9


 

(ii)            Within [X] days following the Closing Date, SHC shall provide a preliminary list to the Partnership of the Future SHC Stores that SHC anticipates opening prior to the end of fiscal year 2012, indicating those Future Stores that will be included as Option Stores for the First Year Option Period (the “ Preliminary Option Store List ”).  Thereafter, Option Stores shall be identified on the Annual Construction Plan provided pursuant to Section 2.3 and may be identified by SHC in any Proposed Acquisition Notice provided pursuant to Section 2.4 .

 

(iii)           No later than fifteen (15) days after the Partnership’s receipt of a Preliminary Option Store List and any Annual Construction Plan, the Partnership will give SHC a preliminary indication of the Option Stores the Partnership intends to purchase during the current Option Period (each, a “ Preliminary Purchase Notice ”).  For avoidance of doubt, the Preliminary Purchase Notices will not be binding on SHC or the Partnership but will be provided in good faith to assist with each Party’s planning and budgetary processes.  Subject to the provisions of Section 2.2(b)(i) , prior to the delivery of a definitive Exercise Notice as to any Option Store pursuant to Section 2.2(c)  below, SHC may revise the Preliminary Option Store List and any Annual Construction Plan at any time to effect a substitution of any Option Store and the Partnership will similarly retain the right to revise any Preliminary Purchase Notice to remove or substitute any Option Store.  Written notice of any such substitution or revision shall be delivered in accordance with the provisions of Section 6.2 .

 

(c)            Exercise Notice . In order to exercise the Sale and Leaseback Option, the Partnership will provide written notice to SHC of its desire to exercise the Sale and Leaseback Option (each such notice, an “ Exercise Notice ”), indicating one or more Option Stores that the Partnership would like to purchase and the proposed date of the closing of such purchase (each, an “ Option Closing Date ”).  Such Exercise Notice must be sent prior to the expiration of the applicable Option Period; provided , however , that if the Exercise Notice has been sent by the Partnership prior to the expiration of the applicable Option Period, the Option Period shall automatically be extended until the Option Closing Date set forth in the applicable Exercise Notice.  The exercise of any Sale and Leaseback Option pursuant to this Section 2.2(c)  will not require the approval of the Conflicts Committee.

 

(d)            Purchase Price; Adjustment of Purchase Price .

 

(i)             Within thirty (30) days of receipt of an Exercise Notice, SHC shall provide the Partnership with the purchase price of each Option Store identified in such Exercise Notice (each, an “ Option Purchase Price ”), which purchase price shall be equal to (i) SHC’s actual cost to construct such Option Store, including real estate and construction costs, calculated consistently with SHC’s prior practices when engaging in sale and leaseback transaction with third parties or (ii) SHC’s actual cost to acquire such Option Store if acquired from a third party, in either case, as indicated on a worksheet showing the calculation of such  cost, certified in writing by an appropriate officer of SHC (each, a “ Certificate of Cost ”).  As to any Future SHC Store purchased pursuant to the Sale and Leaseback Option prior to the date the final cost of such store has been conclusively determined, the estimated cost (the “ Estimated Option Purchase Price ”) may be provided in lieu of actual cost.

 

(ii)            With respect to any New SHC Store purchased by the Partnership prior to the date the final cost to SHC to construct the store has been determined, within one

 

10



 

hundred twenty (120) days after the Option Closing Date, SHC shall deliver an amended Certificate of Cost reflecting the actual cost to construct the store, together with a worksheet, certified in writing by an appropriate officer of SHC, showing the difference, if any, between the Estimated Option Purchase Price and the Option Purchase Price.  Within five (5) days after the Partnership’s receipt of the Certificate of Cost:

 

(A)           if the Option Purchase Price exceeds the Estimated Option Purchase Price, the Partnership shall promptly deliver to SHC, by wire transfer of immediately available funds to the account designated by SHC, an amount equal to such excess;

 

(B)            if the Estimated Option Purchase Price exceeds the Option Purchase Price, SHC shall promptly deliver to the Partnership, by wire transfer of immediately available funds to the account designated by the Partnership, an amount equal to such excess; and

 

(C)            if the Estimated Option Purchase Price is equal to the Estimated Option Purchase Price, neither SHC nor the Partnership shall have any further obligation under this Section 2.2(c) .

 

(e)            Sale and Leaseback Transaction Closing .

 

(i)             Option Store Sale Closing.  On the Option Closing Date, SHC shall transfer [indefeasible title] to the applicable Option Stores to the Partnership or such other member of the Partnership Group designated by the Partnership, free and clear of any liens other than Permitted Liens, and, in exchange therefore, the Partnership shall pay to SHC the Option Purchase Price or the Estimated Option Purchase Price, as applicable.

 

(ii)            Lease Agreement.   Simultaneously with the purchase of an Option Store by a member of the Partnership Group, the applicable SHC Entity, as lessee, and the applicable Partnership Group Member, as lessor, will enter into a lease agreement (“ Lease ”) with respect to the purchased Option Store, the form of which is attached hereto as Exhibit B . The Lease will provide for an initial annual rental rate of 8% of the Option Purchase Price and an initial term of 15 years from the date of execution, renewable at SHC’s option for five consecutive five-year renewal terms.  If SHC exercises its renewal option under a Lease, the annual rental rate will increase by 15% for the first five-year renewal period, and by an additional 5% for each subsequent five-year renewal period.

 

(iii)           Addition of Purchased Option Stores to SHC Distribution Contract .  To the extent not already included in the SHC Distribution Contract, each Option Store purchased by the Partnership will be added to the SHC Distribution Contract for a term of ten years from the Option Closing Date and motor fuel supplied to such Option Store location shall be sold by the Partnership, on a per-gallon basis, at a margin of $0.03 above the Partnership’s Cost Per Gallon.

 

2.3            Annual Construction Plan .  Within fifteen (15) days prior to the end of each fiscal year, beginning with the first fiscal year ending after the Closing Date, SHC shall provide a

 

11



 

construction plan to the Partnership (“ Annual Construction Plan ”) which shall reflect, among other things:

 

(a)            The Future SHC Stores that SHC expects to construct and open during the following fiscal year including the location, anticipated date of opening or acquisition and, if available, estimated annual volumes of fuel expected to be sold at such locations, and whether each such Future SHC Store is being designated as an Option Store, or if such Future SHC Store is not so designated, the terms upon which SHC proposes to offer the Partnership the right to distribute fuel to such Future SHC Store;

 

(b)            Any locations at which SHC expects to execute or acquire SHC Consignment Contracts in the ordinary course of business during the next following year, including the location, anticipated date of opening and/or acquisition and, if available, estimated annual volumes of fuel expected to be sold at such locations, and the proposed terms upon which SHC proposes to offer the Partnership the right to distribute fuel to such location; and

 

(c)            The proposed terms for any sale and leaseback transactions with respect to any SHC Store that SHC intends to offer for sale to the Partnership (“ Additional Sale Leaseback Stores ”), outside of the Sale and Leaseback Option granted hereunder.

 

2.4            Right to Participate in Acquisitions .  In the event that any SHC Entity proposes to acquire from a third party any convenience stores, wholesale motor fuel distribution agreements, convenience store sites, independently operated consignment locations, or any other retail or wholesale fuel distribution assets, contracts or operations or any entity that owns the same, on a stand-along basis or as part of a larger acquisition (in any such case, a “ Proposed Acquisition ”), SHC shall promptly provide notice to the Partnership (“ Proposed Acquisition Notice ”) of the Proposed Acquisition and offer the Partnership the opportunity to (a) acquire any wholesale fuel distribution assets, contracts or operations included in such Proposed Acquisition and (b) to negotiate the fuel supply terms for distributing fuel to any retail stores or consignment locations included in such Proposed Acquisition, subject to the exceptions provided in Section 2.1(c) . The Partnership may elect not to participate in such Proposed Acquisition or negotiate with SHC in good faith to determine the terms upon which to jointly pursue the Proposed Acquisition. If within [seven (7)] days after the Partnership’s receipt of the Proposed Acquisition Notice, the Partnership has not elected to participate in such Proposed Acquisition or if SHC and the Partnership have not otherwise reached an agreement on the acquisition terms within [30] days after the Partnership’s receipt of the Proposed Acquisition Notice [or such shorter period of time as may be specified in any process or by the seller], SHC may proceed with the Proposed Acquisition without the Partnership’s participation.

 

ARTICLE III
Indemnification

 

3.1            Environmental Indemnification .

 

(a)            Subject to the provisions of Section 3.3 , SHC shall indemnify, defend and hold harmless the Partnership Group and the Partnership Indemnitees from and against any

 

12



 

Covered Environmental Losses suffered or incurred by the Partnership Group or any Partnership Indemnitee relating to:

 

(i)             the Partnership Assets, but only to the extent the violations, events, omissions or conditions giving rise to such Covered Environmental Losses occurred or existed on or before the Closing Date, even if such liability does not accrue until after the Closing Date; and

 

(ii)            the Retained Assets.

 

(b)            Subject to the provisions of Section 3.3 , the Partnership shall indemnify, defend and hold harmless the SHC Entities from and against any Covered Environmental Losses suffered or incurred by the SHC Entities relating to the Partnership Assets, but only to the extent the violations, events, omissions or conditions giving rise to such Covered Environmental Losses first occurred after the Closing Date; provided however , that the SHC Entities shall not be entitled to the indemnity in this Section 3.1(b)  for Covered Environmental Losses to the extent caused by gross negligence, bad faith or fraud or willful misconduct of any SHC Entity.

 

(c)            The aggregate liability of SHC under Section 3.1(a)(i)  shall not exceed $15 million and such indemnification obligation shall survive for three years from the Closing Date; provided, however , that any such indemnification obligation with respect to any Covered Environmental Losses shall survive the time at which it would otherwise expire pursuant to this Section 3.1(c)  if notice of any such Covered Environmental Losses is properly given to SHC prior to such time.  The aggregate liability of the Partnership under Section 3.1(b)  shall not exceed $15 million and such indemnification obligation shall survive for three years from the Closing Date; provided, however , that any such indemnification obligation with respect to any Covered Environmental Losses shall survive the time at which it would otherwise expire pursuant to this Section 3.1(c)  if notice of any such Covered Environmental Losses is properly given to the Partnership prior to such time.

 

(d)            No claims may be made for indemnification pursuant to Section 3.1 unless and until, and no Party shall be liable to provide indemnification pursuant to this Section 3.1 unless and until, the aggregate dollar amount of the Losses suffered or incurred by the Indemnified Party exceeds $250,000 and then only for Losses in excess of $250,000, subject to the limitations of Section 3.1(c) .

 

(e)            Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, in no event shall SHC or the Partnership have any indemnification obligations under this Agreement for Losses that arise solely as a result of additions to or modifications of Environmental Laws promulgated after the Closing Date.

 

3.2            Additional Indemnification .

 

(a)            Subject to the provisions of Section 3.3 , SHC shall indemnify, defend and hold harmless the Partnership Group and the Partnership Indemnitees from and against any Losses suffered or incurred by the Partnership Group or any Partnership Indemnitee resulting from or arising out of:

 

13



 

(i)             the failure of the Partnership Group to have good and marketable title to the Partnership Assets, to the extent that such failure renders the Partnership Group liable or unable to use or operate the Partnership Assets in substantially the same manner that the Partnership Assets were used and operated by the SHC Entities immediately prior to the Closing Date as generally described in the Registration Statement;

 

(ii)            the failure of the Partnership Group to have on the Closing Date any consent, license, permit or approval necessary to allow the Partnership Group to own or operate the Partnership Assets in substantially the same manner that the Partnership Assets were owned or operated by the SHC Entities immediately prior to the Closing Date;

 

(iii)           the cost of curing any failure or condition set forth in clause (i)  or clause (ii)  of this Section 3.2(a)  that does not allow any Partnership Asset to be operated in substantially the same manner that the Partnership Assets were owned and operated immediately prior to the Closing Date;

 

(iv)           all federal, state and local income tax liabilities attributable to the ownership or operation of the Partnership Assets prior to the Closing Date, including (A) any such income tax liabilities of the Partnership Group that may result from the consummation of the formation transactions for the Partnership Group occurring on or prior to the Closing Date and (B) any income tax liabilities arising under Treasury Regulation Section 1.1502-6 and any similar provisions from applicable state, local or foreign law, by contract, as successor, transferee or otherwise and which income tax is attributable to having been a member of any consolidated combined or unitary group prior to the Closing Date; and

 

(v)            (A) the assets or operations of the SHC Entities and (B) the Partnership Assets and the operations of any Partnership Group Member prior to the Closing Date, except to the extent that SHC is indemnified with respect to the Losses described under Section 3.1(b) ;

 

provided; however, that in the case of clauses (i), (ii), (iii) and (v) above, such indemnification obligations shall survive for three years from the Closing Date; and that in the case of clause (iv) above, such indemnification obligations shall survive until sixty (60) days after termination of any applicable statute of limitations; provided , further , however , that any such indemnification obligations provided for in this Section 3.2(a)  shall survive the time at which they would otherwise expire pursuant to this Section 3.2(a)  if notice of any such Losses is properly given to SHC prior to such time.

 

(b)            Subject to the provisions of Section 3.3 , in addition to and not in limitation of the indemnification provided under this Article III , the Partnership shall indemnify, defend and hold harmless the SHC Entities from and against any Losses suffered or incurred by the SHC Entities by reason of or arising out of events and conditions associated with the operation of the Partnership Assets that occur on or after the Closing Date (other than Covered Environmental Losses, which are covered by Section 3.1 ).

 

(c)            Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, in no event will the Indemnifying Party be obligated to indemnify the Indemnified Party for any claims, losses or

 

14



 

expenses or income taxes referred to in Section 3.1(a)  and Section 3.2(a)(i)-(iv) , if, and to the extent that such claims, losses or expenses or income taxes were either (i) reserved for in the Indemnified Party’s financial statements as of the Closing Date, or (ii) are recovered under available insurance coverage, from contractual rights or other recoveries against any third party.

 

3.3            Indemnification Procedures .

 

(a)            The Indemnified Party agrees that within a reasonable period of time after it becomes aware of facts giving rise to a claim for indemnification pursuant to this Article III , it will provide notice thereof in writing to the Indemnifying Party specifying the nature of and specific basis for such claim; provided , however , that the Indemnified Party shall not submit claims more frequently than once a calendar quarter (or twice in the case of the last calendar quarter prior to the expiration of the applicable indemnity coverage under this Agreement).  Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Indemnified Party’s failure to provide notice under this Section 3.3 will not relieve the Indemnifying Party from liability hereunder with respect to such matter except in the event and only to the extent that the Indemnifying Party is materially prejudiced by such failure or delay or the Indemnifying Party does not receive notice of the claim prior to the expiration of the applicable indemnity survival period in Sections 3.1 and 3.2 .

 

(b)            The Indemnifying Party shall have the right to control all aspects of the defense of (and any counterclaims with respect to) any claims brought against the Indemnified Party that are covered by the indemnification set forth in this Article III , including the selection of counsel (provided that if such claim involves Covered Environmental Losses, such counsel shall be reasonably acceptable to the Indemnified Party), determination of whether to appeal any decision of any court or similar authority, performance of any Environmental Activity associated with any Covered Environmental Losses and the settling of any matter or any issues relating thereto; provided , however , that no such settlement shall be entered into without the consent (which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld, conditioned or delayed) of the Indemnified Party unless it includes a full release of the Indemnified Party from such matter or issues, as the case may be, and does not include the admission of fault, culpability of failure to act, by or on behalf of such Indemnified Party.

 

(c)            The Indemnified Party agrees to cooperate fully with the Indemnifying Party with respect to all aspects of the defense of any claims covered by the indemnification set forth in this Article III , including the prompt furnishing to the Indemnifying Party of any correspondence or other notice relating thereto that the Indemnified Party may receive, permitting the names of the Indemnified Party to be utilized in connection with such defense, the making available to the Indemnifying Party of any files, records or other information of the Indemnified Party that the Indemnifying Party considers relevant to such defense and the making available to the Indemnifying Party of any employees of the Indemnified Party; provided , however , that in connection therewith the Indemnifying Party agrees to use reasonable efforts to minimize the impact thereof on the operations of the Indemnified Party and further agrees to maintain the confidentiality of all files, records and other information furnished by the Indemnified Party pursuant to this Section 3.3 . In no event shall the obligation of the Indemnified Party to cooperate with the Indemnifying Party as set forth in the immediately preceding sentence be construed as imposing upon the Indemnified Party an obligation to hire and pay for counsel in connection with the defense of any claims covered by the indemnification

 

15



 

set forth in this Article III ; provided , however , that the Indemnified Party may, at its own option, cost and expense, hire and pay for counsel in connection with any such defense. The Indemnifying Party agrees to keep any such counsel hired by the Indemnified Party reasonably informed as to the status of any such defense, but the Indemnifying Party shall have the right to retain sole control over such defense.

 

(d)            In determining the amount of any loss, cost, damage or expense for which the Indemnified Party is entitled to indemnification under this Agreement, the gross amount of the indemnification will be reduced by (i) any insurance proceeds realized by the Indemnified Party, and such correlative insurance benefit shall be net of any incremental insurance premium that becomes due and payable by the Indemnified Party as a result of such claim, (ii) all amounts recovered by the Indemnified Party under contractual indemnities from third parties and (iii) any correlative tax benefit.

 

(e)            NOTWITHSTANDING ANYTHING HEREIN TO THE CONTRARY, IN NO EVENT SHALL ANY PARTY’S INDEMNIFICATION OBLIGATION HEREUNDER COVER OR INCLUDE CONSEQUENTIAL, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, PUNITIVE, EXEMPLARY, SPECIAL OR SIMILAR DAMAGES OR LOST PROFITS SUFFERED BY ANY OTHER PARTY ENTITLED TO INDEMNIFICATION UNDER THIS AGREEMENT.

 

ARTICLE IV
Provision of Services; Reimbursement

 

4.1            Agreement to Provide Services .  Until such time as this Agreement is terminated as provided in Section 6.4 , SHC hereby agrees to provide the Partnership Group with such general and administrative services and management and operating services as may be necessary to manage and operate the business and affairs of the Partnership Group, including accounting, audit, business development, corporate record keeping, treasury services (including cash management), real property/land, legal, operations/engineering, investor relations, risk management, commercial/marketing, information technology, insurance, government relations/compliance, tax, payroll, human resources and environmental, health and safety (collectively, “ Services ”).  The Services shall be consistent in nature and quality to the services of such type previously provided by SHC or its Affiliates in connection with the management and operation of the Partnership Assets prior to the Closing Date.

 

4.2            Reimbursement by Partnership .  Subject to and in accordance with the terms and provisions of this Article IV and such reasonable allocation and other procedures as may be agreed upon by SHC and the General Partner from time to time, the Partnership hereby agrees to reimburse SHC for all reasonable direct and indirect costs and expenses incurred by SHC or its Affiliates (other than the Partnership Group) in connection with the provision of the Services to the Partnership Group, including the following:

 

(a)            any payments or expenses incurred for insurance coverage and negotiated instruments (including surety bonds and performance bonds) provided by underwriters with respect to the Partnership Assets or the business of the Partnership Group;

 

16



 

(b)            any costs incurred in connection with the provision of information technology services;

 

(c)            salaries and related benefits and expenses of personnel employed by SHC or its Affiliates (other than the Partnership Group) who render Services to the Partnership Group, plus general and administrative expenses associated with such personnel; it being agreed, however, that such allocation shall not include any costs or expenses attributable to SHC equity compensation awards;

 

(d)            any taxes or other direct expenses paid by SHC or its Affiliates for the benefit of the Partnership Group; and

 

(e)            all expenses and expenditures incurred by SHC or its Affiliates as a result of the Partnership becoming and continuing as a publicly traded entity, including costs associated with annual and quarterly reports, tax return and Schedule K-1 preparation and distribution, independent auditor fees, partnership governance and compliance, registrar and transfer agent fees, legal fees and independent director compensation;

 

it being agreed, however, that to the extent any reimbursable costs or expenses incurred by SHC or its Affiliates consist of an allocated portion of costs and expenses incurred by SHC or its Affiliates for the benefit of both the Partnership Group and the other Affiliates of SHC, such allocation shall be made on a reasonable cost reimbursement basis as determined by SHC.

 

4.3            Agency Designation and Powers .

 

(a)            Designation of Partnership as Agent .  SHC hereby appoints the Partnership as its agent to perform certain Financial Administration Functions for the benefit of SHC during the term of this Agreement and to exercise such powers and perform such duties as are expressly delegated to SHC by the terms of this Agreement, together with such powers as are reasonably incidental thereto.  Partnership hereby accepts such appointment and agrees to perform such Financial Administration Functions as required by SHC.  Except for the duties and responsibilities expressly set forth in this Agreement, Partnership shall not have or be deemed to have any fiduciary relationship with SHC, and no implied covenants, functions, responsibilities, duties, obligations or liabilities shall be read into this Agreement, or otherwise exist against Partnership.  Further, it is acknowledged and agreed that Partnership shall not be obligated to follow any such direction of SHC under this Agreement, if Partnership, in its sole discretion, determines complying with such direction could expose Partnership to any material liability or violation of law, regardless of whether Partnership is indemnified therefor.

 

(b)            Designation of SHC as Agent .  Partnership hereby appoints the SHC as its agent to perform certain Financial Administration Functions for the benefit of Partnership during the term of this Agreement and to exercise such powers and perform such duties as are expressly delegated to Partnership by the terms of this Agreement, together with such powers as are reasonably incidental thereto.  SHC hereby accepts such appointment and agrees to perform such Financial Administration Functions as required by the Partnership.  Except for the duties and responsibilities expressly set forth in this Agreement, SHC shall not have or be deemed to have any fiduciary relationship with Partnership, and no implied covenants, functions, responsibilities,

 

17



 

duties, obligations or liabilities shall be read into this Agreement, or otherwise exist against SHC.  Further, it is acknowledged and agreed that SHC shall not be obligated to follow any such direction of Partnership under this Agreement, if SHC, in its sole discretion, determines complying with such direction could expose SHC to any material liability or violation of law, regardless of whether SHC is indemnified therefor.  The term “ Agent ” as used in this Agreement shall refer to each of the Partnership in its capacity as agent to SHC as set forth in Section 4.3(a) and SHC in its capacity as agent to the Partnership as set forth in Section 4.3(b).  The term “ Principal ” as used in this Agreement shall refer to each of the SHC in its capacity as principal of Partnership as set forth in Section 4.3(a) and Partnership in its capacity as principal of Partnership as set forth in Section 4.3(b).

 

(c)            Authorization .  The parties hereto agree that Agent shall have general authority to perform the following functions for the benefit of the Principal (such functions collectively described as “ Financial Administration Functions ”) :

 

(i)             Invoicing;

 

(ii)            Collection of accounts receivable;

 

(iii)           Collection of notes receivable;

 

(iv)           Credit card processing;

 

(v)            Billing and collection of rent and property taxes;

 

(vi)           Credit management;

 

(vii)          Application/posting of payments;

 

(viii)         Payment of vendors;

 

(ix)            Employee benefit management;

 

(x)             payroll processing;

 

(xi)            Human resource management;

 

(xii)           IT/web portal management.

 

(d)            Limitation of Liability; Indemnification .  Neither Agent nor any of its representatives shall be liable to Principal or its affiliates (or any Person asserting any claim with respect to any of them) for any action taken or omitted to be taken by it or them hereunder or under this Agreement in good faith and reasonably believed by it or them to be within the discretion or power conferred upon it or them by this Agreement or be responsible for the consequences of any error of judgment, except to the extent arising from its gross negligence, willful misconduct or fraud.   Principal hereby agrees to defend, indemnify and hold Agent harmless from and against all losses, costs or liabilities which Agent may incur with respect to any claim asserted against Agent by reason of its acting under this Agreement.

 

18



 

4.4            [Netting of Payments . Agent will promptly transmit to Principal all documents, monies, bills, invoices, correspondence and other communications received by Agent on behalf of Principal from any other party in connection with providing the Financial Administration Functions. If any amounts are payable by each Party to the other, then, on such date, each Party’s obligation to make payment of any such amount will be automatically satisfied and discharged and, if the aggregate amount that would otherwise have been payable by one Party exceeds the aggregate amount that would otherwise have been payable by the other Party, replaced by an obligation upon the Party by whom the larger aggregate amount would have been payable to pay to the other Party the excess of the larger aggregate amount over the smaller aggregate amount.]

 

ARTICLE V
License of Name and Mark

 

5.1            Grant of License .  Upon the terms and conditions set forth in this Article V , SHC hereby grants and conveys to each of the entities currently or hereafter comprising a part of the Partnership Group a nontransferable, nonexclusive, royalty free right and license (“ License ”) to use the name “Susser” (the “ Name ”) and any associated or related marks (the “ Mark ”).

 

5.2            Ownership and Quality .  The Partnership agrees that ownership of the Name and the Mark and the goodwill relating thereto shall remain vested in SHC both during the term of this License and thereafter, and the Partnership further agrees, and agrees to cause the other members of the Partnership Group, never to challenge, contest or question the validity of SHC’s ownership of the Name and Mark or any registration thereto by SHC.  In connection with the use of the Name and the Mark, the Partnership and any other member of the Partnership Group shall not in any manner represent that they have any ownership in the Name and the Mark or registration thereof except as set forth herein, and the Partnership, on behalf of itself and the other members of the Partnership Group, acknowledges that the use of the Name and the Mark shall not create any right, title or interest in or to the Name and the Mark, and all use of the Name and the Mark by the Partnership or any other member of the Partnership Group, shall inure to the benefit of SHC.  The Partnership agrees, and agrees to cause the other members of the Partnership Group, to use the Name and Mark in accordance with such quality standards established by SHC and communicated to the Partnership from time to time, it being understood that the products and services offered by the members of the Partnership Group immediately before the Closing Date are of a quality that is acceptable to SHC and justifies the License.

 

5.3            Termination .  The License shall terminate upon a termination of this Agreement pursuant to Section 6.4 .

 

ARTICLE VI
Miscellaneous

 

6.1            Choice of Law; Submission to Jurisdiction .  This Agreement shall be subject to and governed by the laws of the State of Delaware, excluding any conflicts-of-law rule or principle that might refer the construction or interpretation of this Agreement to the laws of another state.  Each Party hereby submits to the jurisdiction of the state and federal courts in the State of Delaware and to venue in Delaware.

 

19


 

6.2            Notice .  All notices or requests or consents provided for by, or permitted to be given pursuant to, this Agreement must be in writing and must be given by depositing same in the United States mail, addressed to the Person to be notified, postpaid, and registered or certified with return receipt requested or by delivering such notice in person or by telecopier or telegram to such Party.  Notice given by personal delivery or mail shall be effective upon actual receipt.  Notice given by telegram or telecopier shall be effective upon actual receipt if received during the recipient’s normal business hours or at the beginning of the recipient’s next business day after receipt if not received during the recipient’s normal business hours.  All notices to be sent to a Party pursuant to this Agreement shall be sent to or made at the address set forth below or at such other address as such Party may stipulate to the other Parties in the manner provided in this Section 6.2 .

 

For notice to SHC:

 

Susser Holdings Corporation
4525 Ayers Street
Corpus Christi, Texas 78415
Attention: General Counsel
Phone: (361) 884-2463

 

For notice to the Partnership Entities:

 

Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC
555 East Airtex Drive
Houston, Texas 77073
Attention: General Counsel
Phone: (832) 234-3600

 

6.3            Entire Agreement .  This Agreement constitutes the entire agreement of the Parties relating to the matters contained herein, superseding all prior contracts or agreements, whether oral or written, relating to the matters contained herein.  In the event of a conflict between the provisions of this Agreement and the provisions of the Partnership Agreement, the provisions of the Partnership Agreement shall control.

 

6.4            Termination .

 

(a)            Termination by SHC .  Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement, if the General Partner is removed as general partner of the Partnership under circumstances where Cause does not exist and the Common Units held by the General Partner, SHC and their Affiliates are not voted in favor of such removal, then this Agreement, other than the provisions set forth in Article III hereof, may be terminated by SHC with 180 days’ prior written notice.

 

(b)            Survival of Obligations under Article III .  For the avoidance of doubt, the Parties’ indemnification obligations under Article III shall survive the termination of this Agreement in accordance with their respective terms.

 

20



 

6.5            Effect of Waiver or Consent .  No waiver or consent, express or implied, by any Party to or of any breach or default by any Person in the performance by such Person of its obligations hereunder shall be deemed or construed to be a consent or waiver to or of any other breach or default in the performance by such Person of the same or any other obligations of such Person hereunder.  Failure on the part of a Party to complain of any act of any Person or to declare any Person in default, irrespective of how long such failure continues, shall not constitute a waiver by such Party of its rights hereunder until the applicable statute of limitations period has run.

 

6.6            Amendment or Modification .  This Agreement may be amended or modified from time to time only by the written agreement of all the Parties; provided , however , that the Partnership may not, without the prior approval of the Conflicts Committee, agree to any amendment or modification of this Agreement that, in the reasonable discretion of the General Partner, would be adverse in any material respect to the holders of Common Units.  Each such instrument shall be reduced to writing and shall be designated on its face an “Amendment” or an “Addendum” to this Agreement.

 

6.7            Assignment; Third-Party Beneficiaries .  No Party shall have the right to assign any of its rights or obligations under this Agreement without the consent of the other Parties hereto.  Each of the Parties hereto specifically agrees that each Partnership Group Member, whether or not a Party to this Agreement, shall be entitled to assert rights and remedies hereunder as third-party beneficiaries hereto with respect to those provisions of this Agreement affording a right, benefit or privilege to any such entity.  Except as contemplated by the preceding sentence, this Agreement does not create any rights or benefits for any entity or individual other than the Parties.

 

6.8            Successors .  This Agreement shall bind and inure to the benefit of the Parties and to their respective successors and assigns.

 

6.9            Continuation of Work During Dispute .  Notwithstanding any dispute, it shall be the responsibility of each Party to continue to perform its obligations under this Agreement pending resolution of the dispute.

 

6.10          Counterparts .  This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts, including facsimile counterparts, with the same effect as if all signatory Parties had signed the same document.  All counterparts shall be construed together and shall constitute one and the same instrument.

 

6.11          Severability .  If any provision of this Agreement or the application thereof to any Person or circumstance shall be held invalid or unenforceable by a court or regulatory body of competent jurisdiction, the remainder of this Agreement and the application of such provision to other Persons or circumstances shall not be affected thereby and shall be enforced to the greatest extent permitted by law.

 

6.12          Rules of Construction .  Whenever the context requires, the gender of all words used in this Agreement shall include the masculine, feminine and neuter, and the number of all words shall include the singular and plural.  All references to Article numbers and Section

 

21



 

numbers refer to Articles and Sections of this Agreement.  Unless otherwise specifically indicated or the context otherwise requires, the terms “include,” “includes” and “including” as used in this Agreement shall be deemed to be followed by the words “without limitation.”

 

6.13          Further Assurances .  In connection with this Agreement and all transactions contemplated by this Agreement, each Party agrees to execute and deliver such additional documents and instruments and to perform such additional acts as may be necessary or appropriate to effectuate, carry out and perform all of the terms, provisions and conditions of this Agreement and all such transactions.

 

6.14          Withholding or Granting of Consent .  Unless otherwise provided herein, each Party may, with respect to any consent or approval that it is entitled to grant pursuant to this Agreement, grant or withhold such consent or approval in its sole and uncontrolled discretion, with or without cause, and subject to such conditions as it shall deem appropriate.

 

6.15          Laws and Regulations .  Notwithstanding any provision of this Agreement to the contrary, no Party shall take any act, or fail to take any act, under this Agreement which would violate any applicable law, statute, rule or regulation.

 

6.16          Negation of Rights of Limited Partners, Assignees and Third Parties .  Except as set forth in Section 6.7 , the provisions of this Agreement are enforceable solely by the Parties, and no stockholder, limited partner, member or assignee of SHC, the Partnership or other Person shall have the right, separate and apart from SHC or the Partnership, to enforce any provision of this Agreement or to compel any Party to comply with the terms of this Agreement.

 

6.17          No Recourse Against Officers or Directors .  For the avoidance of doubt, the provisions of this Agreement shall not give rise to any right of recourse against any officer or director of SHC, the General Partner, the Partnership or any Partnership Group Member.

 

6.18          Legal Compliance .  The Parties acknowledge and agree that this Agreement, and all services provided under this Agreement, are intended to comply with any and all laws and legal obligations and that this Agreement should be construed and interpreted with this purpose in mind.

 

[ Signature Page Follows ]

 

22



 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Parties have executed this Agreement on, and effective as of, the Closing Date.

 

 

SUSSER HOLDINGS CORPORATION

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

Name:

Sam L. Susser

 

Title:

President and Chief Executive Officer

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP

 

 

 

 

 

By:

Susser Petroleum GP LLC, its general partner

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

Name:

Rocky B. Dewbre

 

Title:

President and Chief Operating Officer

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

SUSSER PETROLEUM GP LLC

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

Name:

Rocky B. Dewbre

 

Title:

President and Chief Operating Officer

 

Signature Page to the Omnibus Agreement

 




Exhibit 10.4

 

[ Published CUSIP Number:          ]

 

FORM OF

 

CREDIT AGREEMENT

 

DATED AS OF [                           , 2012]

 

AMONG

 

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP,

 

AS THE BORROWER,

 

BANK OF AMERICA, N.A.,
AS ADMINISTRATIVE AGENT, SWING LINE LENDER AND
L/C ISSUER,

 

AND

 

THE OTHER LENDERS PARTY HERETO

 

MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH INCORPORATED

 

AS SOLE LEAD ARRANGER AND SOLE BOOK MANAGER

 



 

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

 

 

Page

ARTICLE I.

DEFINITIONS AND ACCOUNTING TERMS

1

1.01

Defined Terms

1

1.02

Other Interpretive Provisions

30

1.03

Accounting Terms

30

1.04

Rounding

31

1.05

Times of Day

31

1.06

Letter of Credit Amounts

31

ARTICLE II.

THE COMMITMENTS AND CREDIT EXTENSIONS

32

2.01

The Loans

32

2.02

Borrowings, Conversions and Continuations of Loans

32

2.03

Letters of Credit

33

2.04

Swing Line Loans

41

2.05

Prepayments

44

2.06

Termination or Reduction of Commitments

45

2.07

Repayment of Loans

46

2.08

Interest

46

2.09

Fees

47

2.10

Computation of Interest and Fees; Retroactive Adjustments of Applicable Rate

47

2.11

Evidence of Debt

48

2.12

Payments Generally; Administrative Agent’s Clawback

48

2.13

Sharing of Payments by Lenders

50

2.14

Increase in Commitments

51

2.15

Cash Collateral

52

2.16

Defaulting Lenders

53

ARTICLE III.

TAXES, YIELD PROTECTION AND ILLEGALITY

56

3.01

Taxes

56

3.02

Illegality

60

3.03

Inability to Determine Rates

61

3.04

Increased Costs

61

3.05

Compensation for Losses

62

3.06

Mitigation Obligations; Replacement of Lenders

63

 

i



 

TABLE OF CONTENTS
(CONTINUED)

 

 

 

Page

3.07

Survival

63

ARTICLE IV.

CONDITIONS PRECEDENT TO CREDIT EXTENSIONS

64

4.01

Conditions of Initial Credit Extension

64

4.02

Conditions to all Credit Extensions

67

ARTICLE V.

REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

68

5.01

Existence, Qualification and Power

68

5.02

Authorization; No Contravention

68

5.03

Governmental Authorization; Other Consents

68

5.04

Binding Effect

69

5.05

Financial Statements; No Material Adverse Effect

69

5.06

Litigation

69

5.07

No Default

70

5.08

Ownership of Property; Liens

70

5.09

Environmental Compliance

70

5.10

Insurance

71

5.11

Taxes

72

5.12

ERISA Compliance

72

5.13

Subsidiaries; Equity Interests; Loan Parties

73

5.14

Margin Regulations; Investment Company Act

73

5.15

Disclosure

73

5.16

Compliance with Laws

73

5.17

Intellectual Property; Licenses, Etc.

74

5.18

Material Contracts

74

5.19

Solvency

74

5.20

Casualty, Etc.

74

5.21

Labor Matters

74

5.22

Collateral Documents

74

ARTICLE VI.

AFFIRMATIVE COVENANTS

74

6.01

Financial Statements

75

6.02

Certificates; Other Information

75

 

ii



 

TABLE OF CONTENTS
(CONTINUED)

 

 

 

Page

6.03

Notices

78

6.04

Payment of Obligations

78

6.05

Preservation of Existence, Etc.

78

6.06

Maintenance of Properties

79

6.07

Maintenance of Insurance; Flood Insurance

79

6.08

Compliance with Laws

79

6.09

Books and Records

80

6.10

Inspection Rights

80

6.11

Use of Proceeds

80

6.12

Covenant to Guarantee Obligations and Give Security

80

6.13

Compliance with Environmental Laws

86

6.14

Preparation of Environmental Reports

86

6.15

Further Assurances

86

6.16

Compliance with Terms of Leaseholds

87

6.17

Material Contracts

87

ARTICLE VII.

NEGATIVE COVENANTS

87

7.01

Liens

87

7.02

Indebtedness

90

7.03

Investments

92

7.04

Fundamental Changes

93

7.05

Dispositions

93

7.06

Restricted Payments

95

7.07

Change in Nature of Business

95

7.08

Transactions with Affiliates

95

7.09

Burdensome Agreements

96

7.10

Use of Proceeds

97

7.11

Financial Covenants

97

7.12

Accounting Changes

97

7.13

Prepayments, Etc.

97

7.14

Amendment, Etc.

97

 

iii



 

TABLE OF CONTENTS
(CONTINUED)

 

 

 

Page

7.15

Limitation on Speculative Hedging

98

ARTICLE VIII.

EVENTS OF DEFAULT AND REMEDIES

98

8.01

Events of Default

98

8.02

Remedies upon Event of Default

100

8.03

Application of Funds

101

ARTICLE IX.

ADMINISTRATIVE AGENT

102

9.01

Appointment and Authority

102

9.02

Rights as a Lender

103

9.03

Exculpatory Provisions

103

9.04

Reliance by Administrative Agent

104

9.05

Delegation of Duties

104

9.06

Resignation of Administrative Agent

105

9.07

Non-Reliance on Administrative Agent and Other Lenders

106

9.08

No Other Duties, Etc.

106

9.09

Administrative Agent May File Proofs of Claim

106

9.10

Collateral and Guaranty Matters

107

9.11

Secured Cash Management Agreements and Secured Hedge Agreements

108

ARTICLE X.

MISCELLANEOUS

108

10.01

Amendments, Etc.

108

10.02

Notices; Effectiveness; Electronic Communications

110

10.03

No Waiver; Cumulative Remedies; Enforcement

112

10.04

Expenses; Indemnity; Damage Waiver

113

10.05

Payments Set Aside

115

10.06

Successors and Assigns

115

10.07

Treatment of Certain Information; Confidentiality

119

10.08

Right of Setoff

120

10.09

Interest Rate Limitation

121

10.10

Counterparts; Integration; Effectiveness

121

10.11

Survival of Representations and Warranties

121

10.12

Severability

122

 

iv



 

TABLE OF CONTENTS
(CONTINUED)

 

 

 

Page

10.13

Replacement of Lenders

122

10.14

Governing Law; Jurisdiction; Etc.

123

10.15

Waiver of Jury Trial

124

10.16

No Advisory or Fiduciary Responsibility

124

10.17

Electronic Execution of Assignments and Certain Other Documents

125

10.18

USA PATRIOT Act

125

10.19

ENTIRE AGREEMENT

125

 

v



 

TABLE OF CONTENTS
(CONTINUED)

 

SCHEDULES

 

2.01                                                                            Commitments and Applicable Percentages

5.11                                                                            Tax Sharing Agreements

5.13                                                                            Loan Parties; Subsidiaries and Other Equity Investments

5.18                                                                            Material Contracts

6.12                                                                            Subsidiary Guarantors

7.01                                                                            Existing Liens

7.02                                                                            Existing Indebtedness

7.03                                                                            Existing Investments

7.09                                                                            Burdensome Agreements

10.02                                                                      Administrative Agent’s Office, Certain Addresses for Notices

 

EXHIBITS

 

Form of

A                                                                                       Revolving Credit Loan Notice

B                                                                                         Note

C                                                                                         Compliance Certificate

D-1                                                                              Assignment and Assumption

D-2                                                                              Administrative Questionnaire

 

vi



 

CREDIT AGREEMENT

 

This CREDIT AGREEMENT (“ Agreement ”) is entered into as of [                            ], 2012, among SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP, a Delaware limited partnership (the “ Borrower ”), each lender from time to time party hereto (collectively, the “ Lenders ” and individually, a “ Lender ”), and BANK OF AMERICA, N.A., as Administrative Agent, Swing Line Lender and L/C Issuer.

 

PRELIMINARY STATEMENTS:

 

The Borrower has requested that the Lenders provide a revolving credit facility, and the Lenders have indicated their willingness to lend and the L/C Issuer has indicated its willingness to issue letters of credit, in each case, on the terms and subject to the conditions set forth herein.

 

In consideration of the mutual covenants and agreements herein contained, the parties hereto covenant and agree as follows:

 

ARTICLE I.
DEFINITIONS AND ACCOUNTING TERMS

 

1.01                         Defined Terms .  As used in this Agreement, the following terms shall have the meanings set forth below:

 

Acquisition ” means the acquisition, directly or indirectly, by any Person of (a) a majority of the Equity Interests of another Person, (b) all or substantially all of the assets of another Person, (c) all or substantially all of a line of business or division of another Person, (in each case above (i) whether or not involving a merger or a consolidation with such other Person and (ii) whether in one transaction or a series of related transactions), or (d) any other properties or assets of a Person (but in any case excluding any ordinary course capital expenditures of the Loan Parties or replacements of existing equipment, property or assets of the Loan Parties).

 

Acquisition Consideration ” means, in connection with any Acquisition, the total cash and noncash consideration (including the fair market value of all Equity Interests issued or transferred to the sellers thereof, earnouts and other contingent payment obligations to, and all assumptions of debt, liabilities and other obligations in connection therewith) paid by or on behalf of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries for such Acquisition; provided , that any earnout or other contingent future payment shall be considered Acquisition Consideration only to the extent of the reserve, if any, required under GAAP at the time of such sale to be established in respect thereof by the Borrower or any Subsidiary.

 

Act ” has the meaning specified in Section 10.18 .

 

Administrative Agent ” means Bank of America in its capacity as administrative agent under any of the Loan Documents, or any successor administrative agent.

 

Administrative Agent’s Office ” means the Administrative Agent’s address and, as appropriate, account as set forth on Schedule 10.02 , or such other address or account as the Administrative Agent may from time to time notify to the Borrower and the Lenders.

 



 

Administrative Questionnaire ” means an Administrative Questionnaire in substantially the form of Exhibit D-2 or any other form approved by the Administrative Agent.

 

Affiliate ” means, with respect to a specified Person, another Person that directly, or indirectly through one or more intermediaries, Controls or is Controlled by or is under common Control with the Person specified.

 

Aggregate Commitments ” means the Commitments of all the Lenders.  As of the Closing Date, the Aggregate Commitments are $250,000,000.

 

Agreement ” means this Credit Agreement.

 

Applicable Percentage ” means, with respect to any Lender at any time, the percentage (carried out to the ninth decimal place) of the Aggregate Commitments represented by such Lender’s Commitment at such time, subject to adjustment as provided in Section 2.16 .  If the commitment of each Lender to make Loans and the obligation of the L/C Issuer to make L/C Credit Extensions have been terminated pursuant to Section 8.02 , or if the Commitments have expired, then the Applicable Percentage of each Lender in respect of the Aggregate Commitments shall be determined based on the Applicable Percentage of such Lender in respect of the Aggregate Commitments most recently in effect, giving effect to any subsequent assignments.  The initial Applicable Percentage of each Lender is set forth opposite the name of such Lender on Schedule 2.01 or in the Assignment and Assumption pursuant to which such Lender becomes a party hereto, as applicable.

 

Applicable Rate ” means, from time to time, the applicable percentage per annum set forth below determined by reference to the Consolidated Total Leverage Ratio as set forth in the most recent Compliance Certificate received by the Administrative Agent pursuant to Section 6.02(a) :

 

Applicable Rate

 

Pricing
Level

 

Consolidated Total
Leverage Ratio

 

Eurodollar
Rate

(Letters of
Credit)

 

Base Rate

 

Commitment
Fee

 

1

 

> 4.50

 

3.25

%

2.25

%

0.50

%

2

 

> 4.00 but < 4.50

 

3.00

%

2.00

%

0.50

%

3

 

> 3.50 but < 4.00

 

2.75

%

1.75

%

0.50

%

4

 

> 3.00 but < 3.50

 

2.50

%

1.50

%

0.50

%

5

 

> 2.50 but < 3.00

 

2.25

%

1.25

%

0.375

%

6

 

< 2.50

 

2.00

%

1.00

%

0.375

%

 

provided that, subject to the proviso in the following sentence, for the period beginning on the Closing Date through the date the first Compliance Certificate is delivered pursuant to Section 6.02(a) , Pricing Level 6 shall apply.  Any increase or decrease in the Applicable Rate resulting from a change in the Consolidated Total Leverage Ratio shall become effective as of the first Business Day immediately following the date a Compliance Certificate is delivered pursuant to Section 6.02(a) ; provided , however , that if a Compliance Certificate is not delivered when due in

 

2



 

accordance with such Section, then, upon the request of the Required Lenders, Pricing Level 1 shall apply as of the first Business Day after the date on which such Compliance Certificate was required to have been delivered and in each case shall remain in effect until the date on which such Compliance Certificate is delivered.

 

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this definition, the determination of the Applicable Rate for any period shall be subject to the provisions of Section 2.10(b) .

 

Approved Fund ” means any Fund that is administered or managed by (a) a Lender, (b) an Affiliate of a Lender or (c) an entity or an Affiliate of an entity that administers or manages a Lender.

 

Arranger ” means Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated, in its capacity as sole lead arranger and sole book manager.

 

Assignment and Assumption ” means an assignment and assumption entered into by a Lender and an Eligible Assignee (with the consent of any party whose consent is required by Section 10.06(b) ), and accepted by the Administrative Agent, in substantially the form of Exhibit D-1 or any other form (including electronic documentation generated by MarkitClear or other electronic platform) approved by the Administrative Agent.

 

Attributable Indebtedness ” means, on any date, (a) in respect of any Capitalized Lease of any Person, the capitalized amount thereof that would appear on a balance sheet of such Person prepared as of such date in accordance with GAAP and (b) in respect of any Synthetic Lease Obligation, the capitalized amount of the remaining lease or similar payments under the relevant lease or other applicable agreement or instrument that would appear on a balance sheet of such Person prepared as of such date in accordance with GAAP if such lease or other agreement or instrument were accounted for as a Capitalized Lease.

 

Audited Financial Statements ” means the audited financial statements of Borrower’s Predecessor and its Subsidiaries for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2011, as presented in the Registration Statement.

 

AutoBorrow Agreement ” means the AutoBorrow Service Agreement dated as of [              ], 2012, between the Borrower and the Swing Line Lender.

 

Available Cash ” has the meaning set forth in the Borrower Partnership Agreement as in effect on the date hereof.  For avoidance of doubt, any amendment or other modification to the definition of “Available Cash” in the Borrower Partnership Agreement after the date hereof will not be effective for purposes of this Agreement without the approval of the Required Lenders.

 

Availability Period ” means the period from and including the Closing Date to the earliest of (i) the Maturity Date, (ii) the date of termination of the Commitments pursuant to Section 2.06 , and (iii) the date of termination of the commitment of each Lender to make Revolving Credit Loans and of the obligation of the L/C Issuer to make L/C Credit Extensions pursuant to Section 8.02 .

 

Bank of America ” means Bank of America, N.A. and its successors.

 

3


 

Base Rate ” means for any day a fluctuating rate per annum equal to the highest of (a) the Federal Funds Rate plus 1/2 of 1%, (b) the rate of interest in effect for such day as publicly announced from time to time by Bank of America as its “ prime rate ”, and (c) the Eurodollar Rate (as set forth in clause (b) of the definition thereof) plus 1.00%.  The “ prime rate ” is a rate set by Bank of America based upon various factors including Bank of America’s costs and desired return, general economic conditions and other factors, and is used as a reference point for pricing some loans, which may be priced at, above, or below such announced rate.  Any change in such prime rate announced by Bank of America shall take effect at the opening of business on the day specified in the public announcement of such change.

 

Base Rate Loan ” means a Revolving Credit Loan that bears interest based on the Base Rate.

 

Borrower ” has the meaning specified in the introductory paragraph hereto.

 

Borrower IPO ” means an initial registered public offering of the Common Units of the Borrower to the public pursuant to the Registration Statement which results in the Common Units of the Borrower being traded on a national securities exchange.

 

Borrower Materials ” has the meaning specified in Section 6.02 .

 

Borrower Partnership Agreement ” means that certain First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of Susser Petroleum Partners LP dated as of [              ], 2012, among the General Partner, [                      ] and the other limited partners party thereto.

 

Borrower’s Predecessor ” means Susser Petroleum Company, the Borrower’s predecessor for accounting purposes as set forth in the Registration Statement.

 

Borrowing ” means a Revolving Credit Borrowing or a Swing Line Borrowing, as the context may require.

 

Business Day ” means any day other than a Saturday, Sunday or other day on which commercial banks are authorized to close under the Laws of, or are in fact closed in, the state where the Administrative Agent’s Office is located and, if such day relates to any Eurodollar Rate Loan, means any such day that is also a London Banking Day.

 

Capitalized Leases ” means all leases that have been or should be, in accordance with GAAP, recorded as capitalized leases.

 

Cash Collateralize ” means to pledge and deposit with or deliver to the Administrative Agent, for the benefit of one or more of the L/C Issuer or the Lenders, as collateral for L/C Obligations or obligations of the Lenders to fund participations in respect of L/C Obligations, cash or deposit account balances or, if the Administrative Agent and the L/C Issuer shall agree in their sole discretion, other credit support, in each case pursuant to documentation in form and substance satisfactory to the Administrative Agent and the L/C Issuer. “Cash Collateral” shall have a meaning correlative to the foregoing and shall include the proceeds of such cash collateral and other credit support.

 

4



 

Cash Equivalents ” means any of the following types of Investments, to the extent owned by the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries free and clear of all Liens (other than Liens created under the Collateral Documents and other Liens permitted hereunder):

 

(a)                                  readily marketable obligations issued or directly and fully guaranteed or insured by the United States of America or any agency or instrumentality thereof having maturities of not more than 360 days from the date of acquisition thereof; provided that the full faith and credit of the United States of America is pledged in support thereof;

 

(b)                                  time deposits with, or insured certificates of deposit or bankers’ acceptances of, any commercial bank that (i) (A) is a Lender or (B) is organized under the laws of the United States of America, any state thereof or the District of Columbia or is the principal banking subsidiary of a bank holding company organized under the laws of the United States of America, any state thereof or the District of Columbia, and is a member of the Federal Reserve System, (ii) issues (or the parent of which issues) commercial paper rated as described in clause (c) of this definition and (iii) has combined capital and surplus of at least $1,000,000,000, in each case with maturities of not more than 180 days from the date of acquisition thereof;

 

(c)                                   commercial paper issued by any Person organized under the laws of any state of the United States of America and rated at least “ Prime-1 ” (or the then equivalent grade) by Moody’s or at least “ A-1 ” (or the then equivalent grade) by S&P, in each case with maturities of not more than 180 days from the date of acquisition thereof; and

 

(d)                                  Investments, classified in accordance with GAAP as current assets of the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries, in money market investment programs registered under the Investment Company Act of 1940, which are administered by financial institutions that have the highest rating obtainable from either Moody’s or S&P, and the portfolios of which are limited solely to Investments of the character, quality and maturity described in clauses (a), (b) and (c) of this definition.

 

Cash Management Agreement ” means any agreement to provide cash management services, including treasury, depository, overdraft, credit or debit card, electronic funds transfer and other cash management arrangements.

 

Cash Management Bank ” means any Person that, at the time it enters into a Cash Management Agreement, is a Lender or an Affiliate of a Lender, in its capacity as a party to such Cash Management Agreement.

 

CERCLA ” means the Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation and Liability Act of 1980, as amended.

 

CERCLIS ” means the Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation and Liability Information System maintained by the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency.

 

CFC ” means a Person that is a controlled foreign corporation under Section 957 of the Code.

 

5



 

Change in Law ” means the occurrence, after the date of this Agreement, of any of the following: (a) the adoption or taking effect of any law, rule, regulation or treaty, (b) any change in any law, rule, regulation or treaty or in the administration, interpretation, implementation or application thereof by any Governmental Authority or (c) the making or issuance of any request, rule, guideline or directive (whether or not having the force of law) by any Governmental Authority; provided that notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, (x) the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act and all requests, rules, guidelines or directives thereunder or issued in connection therewith and (y) all requests, rules, guidelines or directives promulgated by the Bank for International Settlements, the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (or any successor or similar authority) or the United States or foreign regulatory authorities, in each case pursuant to Basel III, shall in each case be deemed to be a “Change in Law”, regardless of the date enacted, adopted or issued.

 

Change of Control ” means any of the following events or conditions: (a) the General Partner shall cease to be the sole general partner of the Borrower; (b) Holdings shall cease, directly or indirectly, to own and control legally and beneficially more than 50% of the Equity Interests in the General Partner or any Person (other than Holdings) shall Control the General Partner; or (c) a “change of control” or any comparable term under, and as defined in, any indenture, note agreement or other agreement governing any Qualified Offering that results in an “event of default” under such Qualified Offering, such Qualified Offering becoming due and payable before its maturity, or such Qualified Offering being subject to a repurchase, retirement or redemption right or option (whether or not exercised).

 

Closing Date ” means the first date all the conditions precedent in Section 4.01 are satisfied or waived in accordance with Section 10.01 .

 

Closing Date Financial Statements ” means the pro forma unaudited consolidated financial statements of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries, as presented in the Registration Statement.

 

Code ” means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.

 

Collateral ” means all of the “ Collateral ” and “ Mortgaged Property ” referred to in the Collateral Documents and all of the other property that is or is intended under the terms of the Collateral Documents to be subject to Liens in favor of the Administrative Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties to secure the Obligations.  For the avoidance of doubt, the Collateral shall not include the Excluded Assets.

 

Collateral Documents ” means, collectively, the Security Agreement, each of the Mortgages, collateral assignments, security agreement supplements, intellectual property security agreement supplements, security agreements, pledge agreements or other similar agreements delivered to the Administrative Agent pursuant to Section 6.12 , and each of the other agreements, instruments or documents that creates or purports to create a Lien in favor of the Administrative Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties to secure the Obligations.

 

Collateral Loss ” means any loss, damage, destruction or other casualty to, or any condemnation of, any Collateral.

 

6



 

Commitment ” means, as to each Lender, its obligation to (a) make Revolving Credit Loans to the Borrower pursuant to Section 2.01(b) , (b) purchase participations in L/C Obligations, and (c) purchase participations in Swing Line Loans, in an aggregate principal amount at any one time outstanding not to exceed the amount set forth opposite such Lender’s name on Schedule 2.01 under the caption “ Commitment ” or opposite such caption in the Assignment and Assumption pursuant to which such Lender becomes a party hereto, as applicable, as such amount may be adjusted from time to time in accordance with this Agreement.

 

Common Units ” means the common units and subordinated units representing limited partner interests in the Borrower.

 

Compliance Certificate ” means a certificate substantially in the form of Exhibit C .

 

Connection Income Taxes ” means Other Connection Taxes that are imposed on or measured by net income (however denominated) or that are franchise Taxes or branch profits Taxes.

 

Consolidated EBITDA ” means, at any date of determination, an amount equal to Consolidated Net Income of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis for the most recently completed Measurement Period plus (a) the following to the extent deducted in calculating such Consolidated Net Income: (i) Consolidated Interest Charges, (ii) the provision for Federal, state, local and foreign income taxes payable, (iii) depreciation and amortization expense, (iv) unusual, extraordinary or non-recurring losses or charges related to asset sales, (v) the cumulative effect of a change in accounting principles, (vi) non-cash management compensation consisting of Equity Interests, (vii) non-recurring costs (including restructuring costs, extraordinary costs, and transaction costs related to the Transaction) and expenses and charges resulting from equity offerings, Investments, Acquisitions, recapitalizations or the incurrence or repayment of Indebtedness (including a refinancing thereof), in each case, permitted under this Agreement, in an aggregate amount not to exceed, for any such costs relating to transactions other than the Transaction, 10% of Consolidated EBITDA (as shown on the consolidated financial statements of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries most recently delivered to the Administrative Agent in accordance with Section 6.01 but without giving effect to this clause (vii) in such calculation) for any Measurement Period, and (viii) unrealized losses resulting from mark to market accounting for hedging activities, including, without limitation those resulting from the application of FASB Accounting Standards Codification 815 (“ FASB ASC 815 ”) and (ix) other expenses or losses reducing such Consolidated Net Income which do not represent a cash item in such period or any future period (in each case of or by the Borrower and its Subsidiaries for such Measurement Period) and minus (b) the following to the extent included in calculating such Consolidated Net Income:  (i) Federal, state, local and foreign income tax credits, (ii) unrealized gains resulting from mark to market accounting for hedging activities, including, without limitation, those resulting from the application of FASB ASC 815 and (iii) all other non-cash items increasing Consolidated Net Income (in each case of or by the Borrower and its Subsidiaries for such Measurement Period).  Consolidated EBITDA shall be calculated for each Measurement Period, on a Pro Forma Basis, after giving effect to, without duplication, any Material Acquisition (as defined below) and any Material Disposition (as defined below) and, at the Borrower’s election, any other Acquisition or Disposition, in each

 

7



 

case, made during each period commencing on the first day of such period through the date of such transaction (the “ Reference Period ”) as if such Acquisition or Disposition and any related incurrence or repayment of Indebtedness occurred on the first day of the Reference Period.  As used in this definition, “ Material Acquisition ” means any Acquisition with Acquisition Consideration of $15,000,000 or more and “ Material Disposition ” means any Disposition resulting in net sale proceeds of $15,000,000 or more.

 

Consolidated Funded Indebtedness ” means, as of any date of determination, for the Borrower and its Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, the sum of (a) the outstanding principal amount of all non-contingent obligations, whether current or long-term, for borrowed money (including Obligations hereunder, but excluding L/C Obligations) and all obligations evidenced by bonds, debentures, notes, loan agreements or other similar instruments, (b) all purchase money Indebtedness, (c) all direct (but not contingent) obligations arising under letters of credit (including standby and commercial), bankers’ acceptances, bank guaranties, surety bonds and similar instruments (in each case, to the extent unreimbursed), (d) all obligations in respect of the deferred purchase price of property or services (other than accrued expenses and trade accounts payable in the ordinary course of business), (e) all Attributable Indebtedness, (f) without duplication, all direct (but not contingent) obligations arising under Guarantees with respect to outstanding Indebtedness of the types specified in clauses (a) through (e) above of Persons other than the Borrower or any Subsidiary Guarantor, and (g) all Indebtedness of the types referred to in clauses (a) through (f) above of any partnership or joint venture (other than a joint venture that is itself a corporation or limited liability company) in which the Borrower or a Subsidiary is a general partner or joint venturer, unless such Indebtedness is expressly made non-recourse to the Borrower or such Subsidiary.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, outstanding principal amounts of the Lakehead Loan owing by the Borrower shall be excluded from the calculation of Consolidated Funded Indebtedness to the extent a corresponding amount of Lakehead Loan Collateral is pledged to secure the repayment thereof in accordance with the terms of the Lakehead Loan Documents.

 

Consolidated Interest Charges ” means, for any Measurement Period, for the Borrower and its Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, (a) the sum of (i) all interest, premium payments, debt discount, fees, charges and related expenses in connection with borrowed money (including capitalized interest) or in connection with the deferred purchase price of assets, in each case to the extent treated as interest in accordance with GAAP, (ii) all interest paid or payable with respect to discontinued operations and (iii) the portion of rent expense under Capitalized Leases that is treated as interest in accordance with GAAP minus (b) interest income received by the Borrower in respect of the Lakehead Loan Collateral.  “Consolidated Interest Charges” shall not include (1) upfront fees paid in connection with this Agreement or any facility for borrowed money in which the fees are paid from the proceeds of such facility, (2) Indebtedness or lease issuance costs which have to be amortized, (3) lease payments on any office equipment or real property, (4) any principal components paid on all lease payments, (5) gains, losses or other charges as a result of the early retirement of Indebtedness and (6) any other non-cash interest expense).

 

Consolidated Interest Coverage Ratio ” means, as of any date of determination, the ratio of (a) Consolidated EBITDA to (b) Consolidated Interest Charges for the most recently completed Measurement Period for which financial statements are available.

 

8



 

Consolidated Net Income ” means, at any date of determination, the net income (or loss) of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries, determined on a consolidated basis for the most recently completed Measurement Period; provided that Consolidated Net Income shall exclude (a) extraordinary gains and extraordinary losses for such Measurement Period, (b) the net income of any Subsidiary during such Measurement Period to the extent that the declaration or payment of dividends or similar distributions by such Subsidiary of such income is not permitted by operation of the terms of its Organization Documents or any agreement, instrument or Law applicable to such Subsidiary during such Measurement Period and (c) any income (or loss) for such Measurement Period of any Person in which the Borrower and its Subsidiaries has an interest (which interest does not cause the net income or loss of such other Person to be consolidated with the net income or loss of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries in accordance with GAAP), except to the extent of any income actually distributed as a cash dividend or other cash distribution by such Person during such Measurement Period to the Borrower or its Subsidiaries (and in the case of a cash dividend or other distribution to a Subsidiary, such Subsidiary is not precluded from further distributing such amount to the Borrower as described in clause (b) of this proviso).

 

Consolidated Senior Secured Funded Indebtedness ” means, as of any date of determination, Consolidated Funded Indebtedness that is secured by Liens on any Property of the Borrower or its Subsidiaries.

 

Consolidated Senior Secured Leverage Ratio ” means, as of any date of determination, the ratio of (a) Consolidated Senior Secured Funded Indebtedness as of such date to (b) Consolidated EBITDA for the most recently completed Measurement Period for which financial statements are available.

 

Consolidated Total Assets ” means, with respect to the Borrower and its Subsidiaries, the amount which, in accordance with GAAP, is set forth under the caption “Total Assets” (or any like caption) on the consolidated balance sheet of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries.

 

Consolidated Total Leverage Ratio ” means, as of any date of determination, the ratio of (a) Consolidated Funded Indebtedness (less the sum of (i) cash in excess of $10,000,000 held by the Borrower and its Subsidiaries as of such date (excluding restricted cash) and (ii) the aggregate amount of Cash Equivalents permitted pursuant to Section 7.03(a) held by the Borrower, excluding, for the avoidance of doubt, the Lakehead Loan Collateral) as of such date to (b) Consolidated EBITDA for the most recently completed Measurement Period for which financial statements are available.

 

Contractual Obligation ” means, as to any Person, any provision of any security issued by such Person or of any agreement, instrument or other undertaking to which such Person is a party or by which it or any of its property is bound.

 

Contributing Affiliates ” means Holdings, Susser Petroleum Company and any other Affiliate of Holdings that contributes or otherwise transfers assets to any Loan Party, whether on, prior to or after the Closing Date as described in the Registration Statement.

 

9



 

Contributed Assets ” means the assets contributed or otherwise transferred by the applicable Contributing Affiliate to any Loan Party whether on, prior to or after the Closing Date, including without limitation the assets contributed by certain Contributing Affiliates to the Loan Parties on or prior to the Closing Date as described in the Registration Statement.

 

Control ” means the possession, directly or indirectly, of the power to direct or cause the direction of the management or policies of a Person, whether through the ability to exercise voting power, by contract or otherwise.  “ Controlling ” and “ Controlled ” have meanings correlative thereto.

 

Credit Extension ” means each of the following:  (a) a Borrowing and (b) an L/C Credit Extension.

 

Debtor Relief Laws ” means the Bankruptcy Code of the United States, and all other liquidation, conservatorship, bankruptcy, assignment for the benefit of creditors, moratorium, rearrangement, receivership, insolvency, reorganization, or similar debtor relief Laws of the United States or other applicable jurisdictions from time to time in effect.

 

Default ” means any event or condition that constitutes an Event of Default or that, with the giving of any notice, the passage of time, or both, would be an Event of Default.

 

Default Rate ” means (a) when used with respect to Obligations other than Letter of Credit Fees, an interest rate equal to (i) the Base Rate plus (ii) the Applicable Rate, if any, applicable to Base Rate Loans plus (iii) 2% per annum; provided , however , that with respect to a Eurodollar Rate Loan, the Default Rate shall be an interest rate equal to the interest rate (including any Applicable Rate) otherwise applicable to such Loan plus 2% per annum and (b) when used with respect to Letter of Credit Fees, a rate equal to the Applicable Rate plus 2% per annum.

 

Defaulting Lender ” means, subject to Section 2.16(b) , any Lender that (a) has failed to (i) fund all or any portion of its Loans within two Business Days of the date such Loans were required to be funded hereunder unless such Lender notifies the Administrative Agent and the Borrower in writing that such failure is the result of such Lender’s determination that one or more conditions precedent to funding (each of which conditions precedent, together with any applicable default, shall be specifically identified in such writing) has not been satisfied, or (ii) pay to the Administrative Agent, the L/C Issuer, the Swing Line Lender or any other Lender any other amount required to be paid by it hereunder (including in respect of its participation in Letters of Credit or Swing Line Loans) within two Business Days of the date when due, (b) has notified the Borrower, the Administrative Agent, the L/C Issuer or the Swing Line Lender in writing that it does not intend to comply with its funding obligations hereunder, or has made a public statement to that effect (unless such writing or public statement relates to such Lender’s obligation to fund a Loan hereunder and states that such position is based on such Lender’s determination that a condition precedent to funding (which condition precedent, together with any applicable default, shall be specifically identified in such writing or public statement) cannot be satisfied), (c) has failed, within three Business Days after written request by the Administrative Agent or the Borrower, to confirm in writing to the Administrative Agent and the Borrower that it will comply with its prospective funding obligations hereunder ( provided that

 

10



 

such Lender shall cease to be a Defaulting Lender pursuant to this clause (c) upon receipt of such written confirmation by the Administrative Agent and the Borrower), or (d) has, or has a direct or indirect parent company that has, (i) become the subject of a proceeding under any Debtor Relief Law, or (ii) had appointed for it a receiver, custodian, conservator, trustee, administrator, assignee for the benefit of creditors or similar Person charged with reorganization or liquidation of its business or assets, including the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation or any other state or federal regulatory authority acting in such a capacity; provided that a Lender shall not be a Defaulting Lender solely by virtue of the ownership or acquisition of any Equity Interest in that Lender or any direct or indirect parent company thereof by a Governmental Authority so long as such ownership interest does not result in or provide such Lender with immunity from the jurisdiction of courts within the United States or from the enforcement of judgments or writs of attachment on its assets or permit such Lender (or such Governmental Authority) to reject, repudiate, disavow or disaffirm any contracts or agreements made with such Lender.  Any determination by the Administrative Agent that a Lender is a Defaulting Lender under any one or more of clauses (a) through (d) above, and of the effective date of such status, shall be conclusive and binding absent manifest error, and such Lender shall be deemed to be a Defaulting Lender (subject to Section 2.16(b) ) as of the date established therefor by the Administrative Agent in a written notice of such determination, which shall be delivered by the Administrative Agent to the Borrower, the L/C Issuer, the Swing Line Lender and each other Lender promptly following such determination.

 

Disposition ” or “ Dispose ” means the sale, transfer, license, lease or other disposition (including any sale and leaseback transaction) of any property by any Person (or the granting of any option or other right to do any of the foregoing), including any sale, assignment, transfer or other disposal, with or without recourse, of any notes or accounts receivable or any rights and claims associated therewith.

 

Dollar ” and “ $ ” mean lawful money of the United States.

 

Eligible Assignee ” means any Person that meets the requirements to be an assignee under Section 10.06(b)(iii) , and (v) (subject to such consents, if any, as may be required under Section 10.06(b)(iii) ).

 

Environmental Laws ” means any and all applicable Federal, state, local, and foreign statutes, laws, regulations, ordinances, rules, judgments, orders, decrees, permits, licenses or governmental restrictions relating to pollution and the protection of the environment or the release of any materials into the environment, including those related to hazardous substances or wastes, air emissions and discharges to waste or public systems.

 

Environmental Liability ” means any liability, contingent or otherwise (including any liability for damages, costs of environmental remediation, fines, penalties or indemnities), of the Borrower, any other Loan Party or any of their respective Subsidiaries or any Contributing Affiliate directly or indirectly resulting from or based upon (a) violation of any Environmental Law, (b) the generation, use, handling, transportation, storage, treatment or disposal of any Hazardous Materials, (c) exposure to any Hazardous Materials, (d) the release or threatened release of any Hazardous Materials into the environment or (e) any contract, agreement or other

 

11



 

written consensual arrangement pursuant to which liability is assumed or imposed with respect to any of the foregoing.

 

Environmental Permit ” means any permit, approval, identification number, license or other authorization required under any Environmental Law.

 

Equity Interests ” means, with respect to any Person, all of the shares of capital stock of (or other ownership or profit interests in) such Person, all of the warrants, options or other rights for the purchase or acquisition from such Person of shares of capital stock of (or other ownership or profit interests in) such Person, all of the securities convertible into or exchangeable for shares of capital stock of (or other ownership or profit interests in) such Person or warrants, rights or options for the purchase or acquisition from such Person of such shares (or such other interests), and all of the other ownership or profit interests in such Person (including partnership, member or trust interests therein), whether voting or nonvoting, and whether or not such shares, warrants, options, rights or other interests are outstanding on any date of determination (provided, however, that debt securities that are or by their terms may be convertible or exchangeable into or for Equity Interests shall not constitute Equity Interests prior to conversion or exchange thereof).

 

ERISA ” means the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974.

 

ERISA Affiliate ” means any trade or business (whether or not incorporated) under common control with the Borrower within the meaning of Section 414(b) or (c) of the Code (and Sections 414(m) and (o) of the Code for purposes of provisions relating to Section 412 of the Code).

 

ERISA Event ” means (a) a Reportable Event with respect to a Pension Plan; (b) the withdrawal of the Borrower or any ERISA Affiliate from a Pension Plan subject to Section 4063 of ERISA during a plan year in which such entity was a “substantial employer” as defined in Section 4001(a)(2) of ERISA or a cessation of operations that is treated as such a withdrawal under Section 4062(e) of ERISA; (c) a complete or partial withdrawal by the Borrower or any ERISA Affiliate from a Multiemployer Plan or notification that a Multiemployer Plan is in reorganization; (d) the filing of a notice of intent to terminate, the treatment of a plan amendment as a termination under Section 4041 or 4041A of ERISA, or the institution by the PBGC of proceedings to terminate a Pension Plan or Multiemployer Plan; (e) any event or condition which constitutes grounds under Section 4042 of ERISA for the termination of, or the appointment of a trustee to administer, any Pension Plan; (f) the determination that any Pension Plan or Multiemployer Plan is considered an at-risk plan or a plan in endangered or critical status within the meaning of Sections 430, 431 and 432 of the Code or Sections 303, 304 and 305 of ERISA; or (g) the imposition of any liability under Title IV of ERISA, other than for PBGC premiums due but not delinquent under Section 4007 of ERISA, upon the Borrower or any ERISA Affiliate.

 

Eurodollar Rate ” means:

 

(a)                                  for any Interest Period with respect to a Eurodollar Rate Loan, the rate per annum equal to (i) the British Bankers Association LIBOR Rate (“ BBA LIBOR ”), as published by

 

12



 

Reuters (or such other commercially available source providing quotations of BBA LIBOR as may be designated by the Administrative Agent from time to time) at approximately 10:00 a.m., London time, two London Banking Days prior to the commencement of such Interest Period, for Dollar deposits (for delivery on the first day of such Interest Period) with a term equivalent to such Interest Period or, (ii) if such rate is not available at such time for any reason, the rate per annum determined by the Administrative Agent to be the rate at which deposits in Dollars for delivery on the first day of such Interest Period in same day funds in the approximate amount of the Eurodollar Rate Loan being made, continued or converted and with a term equivalent to such Interest Period would be offered by Bank of America’s London Branch to major banks in the London interbank eurodollar market at their request at approximately 10:00 a.m. (London time) two London Banking Days prior to the commencement of such Interest Period; and

 

(b)                                  for any interest calculation with respect to a Base Rate Loan on any date, the rate per annum equal to (i) BBA LIBOR, at approximately10:00 a.m., London time determined two London Banking Days prior to such date for Dollar deposits being delivered in the London interbank market for a term of one month commencing that day or (ii) if such published rate is not available at such time for any reason, the rate per annum determined by the Administrative Agent to be the rate at which deposits in Dollars for delivery on the date of determination in same day funds in the approximate amount of the Base Rate Loan being made or maintained and with a term equal to one month would be offered by Bank of America’s London Branch to major banks in the London interbank Eurodollar market at their request at the date and time of determination.

 

Eurodollar Rate Loan ” means a Revolving Credit Loan that bears interest at a rate based on clause (a) of the definition of “ Eurodollar Rate ”.

 

Event of Default ” has the meaning specified in Section 8.01 .

 

Excluded Assets ” means (a) the Lakehead Loan Collateral (for so long as, and to the extent that it secures, the Lakehead Loan); (b) all owned real property and fixtures of the Borrower and Guarantors, unless and until (i) the Mortgage Trigger occurs and (ii) the Required Lenders request delivery of mortgages covering such owned real property; (c) those assets over which the granting of security interests in such assets would be prohibited by contract (including permitted Liens, leases and licenses), organizational documents, joint venture agreements, shareholders’ agreements, applicable Laws or regulation (in each case, except to the extent such prohibition is unenforceable after giving effect to applicable provisions of the UCC, other than proceeds thereof, the assignment of which is expressly deemed effective under the UCC notwithstanding such prohibitions); (d) margin stock limited to $100,000 and (e) those assets as to which the Administrative Agent reasonably determines that the cost of obtaining such a security interest or perfection thereof are excessive in relation to the benefit to the Lenders of the security to be afforded thereby.

 

Excluded Taxes means any of the following Taxes imposed on or with respect to any Recipient or required to be withheld or deducted from a payment to a Recipient, (a) Taxes imposed on or measured by net income (however denominated), franchise Taxes, and branch profits Taxes, in each case, (i) imposed as a result of such Recipient being organized under the laws of, or having its principal office or, in the case of any Lender, its Lending Office located in,

 

13


 

the jurisdiction imposing such Tax (or any political subdivision thereof) or (ii) that are Other Connection Taxes, (b) in the case of a Lender, U.S. federal withholding Taxes imposed on amounts payable to or for the account of such Lender with respect to an applicable interest in a Loan or Commitment pursuant to a law in effect on the date on which (i) such Lender acquires such interest in the Loan or Commitment (other than pursuant to an assignment request by the Borrower under Section 3.06(b) ) or (ii) such Lender changes its Lending Office, except in each case to the extent that, pursuant to Section 3.01(a) or (c) , amounts with respect to such Taxes were payable either to such Lender’s assignor immediately before such Lender became a party hereto or to such Lender immediately before it changed its Lending Office, (c) Taxes attributable to such Recipient’s failure to comply with Section 3.01(e) and (d) any U.S. federal withholding Taxes imposed pursuant to FATCA.

 

Existing Susser Credit Agreement ” means the Amended and Restated Credit Agreement dated as of May 7, 2010 among Susser Holdings, L.L.C., as borrower, Holdings, as parent guarantor, the lenders parties thereto and Bank of America, as administrative agent.

 

FASB ASC ” means the Accounting Standards Codification of the Financial Accounting Standards Board.

 

FATCA ” means Sections 1471 through 1474 of the Code, as of the date of this Agreement (or any amended or successor version that is substantively comparable and not materially more onerous to comply with) , any current or future regulations or official interpretations thereof and any agreements entered into pursuant to Section 1471(b)(1) of the Code.

 

Federal Funds Rate ” means, for any day, the rate per annum equal to the weighted average of the rates on overnight Federal funds transactions with members of the Federal Reserve System arranged by Federal funds brokers on such day, as published by the Federal Reserve Bank of New York on the Business Day next succeeding such day; provided that (a) if such day is not a Business Day, the Federal Funds Rate for such day shall be such rate on such transactions on the next preceding Business Day as so published on the next succeeding Business Day, and (b) if no such rate is so published on such next succeeding Business Day, the Federal Funds Rate for such day shall be the average rate (rounded upward, if necessary, to a whole multiple of 1/100 of 1%) charged to Bank of America on such day on such transactions as determined by the Administrative Agent.

 

Fee Letter ” means the letter agreement, dated August 13, 2012, among Holdings, the Borrower, Bank of America and the Arranger.

 

Flood Insurance Regulations ” means The National Flood Insurance Reform Act of 1994.

 

Foreign Lender ” means a Lender that is not a U.S. Person.

 

FRB ” means the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System of the United States.

 

Fronting Exposure ” means, at any time there is a Defaulting Lender, (a) with respect to the L/C Issuer, such Defaulting Lender’s Applicable Percentage of the outstanding L/C

 

14



 

Obligations other than L/C Obligations as to which such Defaulting Lender’s participation obligation has been reallocated to other Lenders or Cash Collateralized in accordance with the terms hereof, and (b) with respect to the Swing Line Lender, such Defaulting Lender’s Applicable Percentage of Swing Line Loans other than Swing Line Loans as to which such Defaulting Lender’s participation obligation has been reallocated to other Lenders in accordance with the terms hereof.

 

Fund ” means any Person (other than a natural Person) that is (or will be) engaged in making, purchasing, holding or otherwise investing in commercial loans and similar extensions of credit in the ordinary course of its activities.

 

GAAP ” means generally accepted accounting principles in the United States set forth in the opinions and pronouncements of the Accounting Principles Board and the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants and statements and pronouncements of the Financial Accounting Standards Board or such other principles as may be approved by a significant segment of the accounting profession in the United States, that are applicable to the circumstances as of the date of determination, consistently applied.

 

General Partner ” means Susser Petroleum Partners GP, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company and the sole general partner of the Borrower.

 

Governmental Authority ” means the government of the United States or any other nation, or of any political subdivision thereof, whether state or local, and any agency, authority, instrumentality, regulatory body, court, central bank or other entity exercising executive, legislative, judicial, taxing, regulatory or administrative powers or functions of or pertaining to government (including any supra-national bodies such as the European Union or the European Central Bank).

 

Guarantee ” means, as to any Person, any obligation, contingent or otherwise, of such Person guaranteeing or having the economic effect of guaranteeing any Indebtedness or other obligation payable or performable by another Person (the “ primary obligor ”) in any manner, whether directly or indirectly, and including any obligation of such Person, direct or indirect, (i) to purchase or pay (or advance or supply funds for the purchase or payment of) such Indebtedness or other obligation, (ii) to purchase or lease property, securities or services for the purpose of assuring the obligee in respect of such Indebtedness or other obligation of the payment or performance of such Indebtedness or other obligation, (iii) to maintain working capital, equity capital or any other financial statement condition or liquidity or level of income or cash flow of the primary obligor so as to enable the primary obligor to pay such Indebtedness or other obligation, or (iv) entered into for the purpose of assuring in any other manner the obligee in respect of such Indebtedness or other obligation of the payment or performance thereof or to protect such obligee against loss in respect thereof (in whole or in part); provided , that the term “Guarantee” shall not include endorsements for collection or deposit, in either case in the ordinary course of business, or customary and reasonable indemnity obligations in effect on the Closing Date or entered into thereafter in the ordinary course of business.  The amount of any Guarantee shall be deemed to be an amount equal to the stated or determinable amount of the related primary obligation, or portion thereof, in respect of which such Guarantee is made or, if not stated or determinable, the maximum reasonably anticipated liability in respect thereof as

 

15



 

determined by the guaranteeing Person in good faith.  The term “ Guarantee ” as a verb has a corresponding meaning.

 

Guarantors ” means, collectively, Holdings and the Subsidiary Guarantors.

 

Hazardous Materials ” means all explosive or radioactive substances or wastes and all hazardous or toxic substances, wastes or other pollutants, including petroleum or petroleum distillates, asbestos or asbestos-containing materials, polychlorinated biphenyls, radon gas, infectious or medical wastes and all other substances or wastes of any nature regulated pursuant to any Environmental Law.

 

Hedge Bank ” means any Person that, at the time it enters into a Swap Contract, is a Lender or an Affiliate of a Lender, in its capacity as a party to such Swap Contract.

 

Holdings ” means Susser Holdings Corporation, a Delaware corporation and any legal successor.

 

Holdings Guaranty ” means the Guaranty of collection made by Holdings in favor of the Secured Parties.

 

Immaterial Subsidiary ” means, subject to Section 6.12(f) , any Wholly Owned Subsidiary of the Borrower having total assets with an aggregate book value, as of the end of the fiscal quarter most recently ended and for which financial statements have been delivered pursuant to Section 6.01(a) or 6.01(b) , not exceeding the lesser of (x) $5,000,000 and (y) 2.5% of Consolidated Total Assets as of the end of such fiscal quarter; provided that any Wholly Owned Subsidiary shall automatically cease to be an Immaterial Subsidiary if such Wholly Owned Subsidiary no longer meets the requirements set forth in this definition.

 

Indebtedness ” means, as to any Person at a particular time, without duplication, all of the following, whether or not included as indebtedness or liabilities in accordance with GAAP:

 

(a)                                  all obligations of such Person for borrowed money and all obligations of such Person evidenced by bonds, debentures, notes, loan agreements or other similar instruments;

 

(b)                                  the maximum amount of all direct or contingent obligations of such Person arising under letters of credit (including standby and commercial), bankers’ acceptances, bank guaranties, surety bonds and similar instruments;

 

(c)                                   net obligations of such Person under any Swap Contract;

 

(d)                                  all obligations of such Person to pay the deferred purchase price of property or services (other than trade accounts payable in the ordinary course of business and not more than 90 days past due unless being contested in good faith and for which adequate reserves have been established and reported in accordance with GAAP);

 

(e)                                   indebtedness (excluding prepaid interest thereon) secured by a Lien on property owned or being purchased by such Person (including indebtedness arising under conditional

 

16



 

sales or other title retention agreements), whether or not such indebtedness shall have been assumed by such Person or is limited in recourse;

 

(f)                                    all Attributable Indebtedness;

 

(g)                                   all obligations of such Person to purchase, redeem, retire, defease or otherwise make any payment in respect of any Equity Interest in such Person or any other Person or any warrant, right or option to acquire such Equity Interest, valued, in the case of a redeemable preferred interest, at the greater of its voluntary or involuntary liquidation preference plus accrued and unpaid dividends; and

 

(h)                                  all Guarantees of such Person in respect of any of the foregoing.

 

For all purposes hereof, the Indebtedness of any Person shall include the Indebtedness of any partnership or joint venture (other than a joint venture that is itself a corporation or limited liability company) in which such Person is a general partner or a joint venturer, unless such Indebtedness is expressly made non-recourse to such Person.  For the purposes of clause (c), the amount of any net obligation under any Swap Contract on any date shall be deemed to be the Swap Termination Value thereof as of such date. For the purposes of clause (e), the amount of any Indebtedness of any Person shall be deemed to be equal to the lesser of (x) the aggregate unpaid amount of such Indebtedness and (y) the fair market value of the property encumbered thereby as reasonably determined by such Person in good faith.

 

Indemnified Taxes ” means (a) Taxes, other than Excluded Taxes, imposed on or with respect to any payment made by or on account of any obligation of any Loan Party under any Loan Document and (b) to the extent not otherwise described in (a), Other Taxes.

 

Indemnitees ” has the meaning specified in Section 10.04(b) .

 

Information ” has the meaning specified in Section 10.07 .

 

Interest Payment Date ” means, (a) as to any Eurodollar Rate Loan, the last day of each Interest Period applicable to such Loan and the Maturity Date; provided , however , that if any Interest Period for a Eurodollar Rate Loan exceeds three months, the respective dates that fall every three months after the beginning of such Interest Period shall also be Interest Payment Dates; and (b) as to any Base Rate Loan or Swing Line Loan, the last Business Day of each March, June, September and December and the Maturity Date.

 

Interest Period ” means as to each Eurodollar Rate Loan, the period commencing on the date such Eurodollar Rate Loan is disbursed or converted to or continued as a Eurodollar Rate Loan and ending on the date one, two, three or six months thereafter, as selected by the Borrower in its Revolving Credit Loan Notice , or such other period that is twelve months or less requested by the Borrower and consented to by all the Lenders; provided that:

 

(i)                                      any Interest Period that would otherwise end on a day that is not a Business Day shall be extended to the next succeeding Business Day unless, in the case of a Eurodollar Rate Loan, such Business Day falls in another calendar month, in which case such Interest Period shall end on the next preceding Business Day;

 

17



 

(ii)                                   any Interest Period pertaining to a Eurodollar Rate Loan that begins on the last Business Day of a calendar month (or on a day for which there is no numerically corresponding day in the calendar month at the end of such Interest Period) shall end on the last Business Day of the calendar month at the end of such Interest Period; and

 

(iii)                                no Interest Period shall extend beyond the Maturity Date.

 

Investment ” means, as to any Person, any direct or indirect acquisition or investment by such Person, whether by means of (a) the purchase or other acquisition of Equity Interests of another Person, (b) a loan, advance or capital contribution to, Guarantee or assumption of debt of, or purchase or other acquisition of any other debt or interest in, another Person, or (c) the purchase or other acquisition (in one transaction or a series of transactions) of assets of another Person that constitute a business unit or all or a substantial part of the business of, such Person.  For purposes of covenant compliance, the amount of any Investment shall be the amount actually invested, without adjustment for subsequent increases or decreases in the value of such Investment.  “ Investment ” shall exclude extensions of trade credit by the Borrower and its Subsidiaries on commercially reasonably terms in accordance with the normal trade practices of the Borrower or such Subsidiary, as the case may be.

 

IRS ” means the United States Internal Revenue Service.

 

ISP ” means, with respect to any Letter of Credit, the “ International Standby Practices 1998 ” published by the Institute of International Banking Law & Practice, Inc. (or such later version thereof as may be in effect at the time of issuance).

 

Issuer Documents ” means with respect to any Letter of Credit, the Letter of Credit Application, and any other document, agreement and instrument entered into by the L/C Issuer and the Borrower (or any Subsidiary) or in favor of the L/C Issuer and relating to such Letter of Credit.

 

Lakehead Loan ” means the $[175,000,000] term loan made to the Borrower pursuant to the Lakehead Loan Documents.

 

Lakehead Loan Collateral ” means [TBD].

 

Lakehead Loan Documents ” means (a) the Term Loan and Security Agreement dated of even date herewith between the Borrower and Bank of America, N.A., as lender and (b) [                ]

 

Laws ” means, collectively, all international, foreign, Federal, state and local statutes, treaties, rules, guidelines, regulations, ordinances, codes and administrative or judicial precedents or authorities, including the interpretation or administration thereof by any Governmental Authority charged with the enforcement, interpretation or administration thereof, and all applicable administrative orders, directed duties, requests, licenses, authorizations and permits of, and agreements with, any Governmental Authority, in each case whether or not having the force of law.

 

18



 

L/C Advance ” means, with respect to each Lender, such Lender’s funding of its participation in any L/C Borrowing in accordance with its Applicable Percentage.

 

L/C Borrowing ” means an extension of credit resulting from a drawing under any Letter of Credit which has not been reimbursed on the date when made or refinanced as a Revolving Credit Borrowing.

 

L/C Credit Extension ” means, with respect to any Letter of Credit, the issuance thereof or extension of the expiry date thereof, or the increase of the amount thereof.

 

L/C Issuer ” means Bank of America in its capacity as issuer of Letters of Credit hereunder, or any successor issuer of Letters of Credit hereunder.

 

L/C Obligations ” means, as at any date of determination, the aggregate amount available to be drawn under all outstanding Letters of Credit plus the aggregate of all Unreimbursed Amounts, including all L/C Borrowings.  For purposes of computing the amount available to be drawn under any Letter of Credit, the amount of such Letter of Credit shall be determined in accordance with Section 1.06 .  For all purposes of this Agreement, if on any date of determination a Letter of Credit has expired by its terms but any amount may still be drawn thereunder by reason of the operation of Rule 3.14 of the ISP, such Letter of Credit shall be deemed to be “ outstanding ” in the amount so remaining available to be drawn.

 

Lender ” has the meaning specified in the introductory paragraph hereto and, unless the context requires otherwise, includes the Swing Line Lender.

 

Lending Office ” means, as to any Lender, the office or offices of such Lender described as such in such Lender’s Administrative Questionnaire, or such other office or offices as a Lender may from time to time notify the Borrower and the Administrative Agent.

 

Letter of Credit ” means any standby letter of credit issued hereunder providing for the payment of cash upon the honoring of a presentation thereunder.

 

Letter of Credit Application ” means an application and agreement for the issuance or amendment of a Letter of Credit in the form from time to time in use by the L/C Issuer.

 

Letter of Credit Expiration Date ” means the day that is seven days prior to the Maturity Date then in effect (or, if such day is not a Business Day, the next preceding Business Day).

 

Letter of Credit Fee ” has the meaning specified in Section 2.03(h) .

 

Letter of Credit Sublimit ” means an amount equal to $75,000,000.  The Letter of Credit Sublimit is part of, and not in addition to, the Aggregate Commitments.

 

Lien ” means any interest in Property securing an obligation owed to, or a claim by, a Person other than the owner of the Property, whether such interest is based on the common law, statute or contract, and whether such obligation or claim is fixed or contingent, and including but not limited to the lien or security interest arising from any mortgage, pledge, hypothecation, assignment, deposit arrangement, encumbrance, charge, or preference, priority or other security

 

19



 

interest or preferential arrangement in the nature of a security interest. The term “ Lien ” shall include any conditional sale or other title retention agreement, any easement, right of way or other encumbrance on title to real property, and any financing lease having substantially the same economic effect as any of the foregoing.

 

Loan ” means an extension of credit by a Lender to the Borrower under Article II in the form of a Revolving Credit Loan or a Swing Line Loan.

 

Loan Documents ” means, collectively, (a) this Agreement, (b) the Notes, (c) the Holdings Guaranty, (d) the Subsidiary Guaranty, (e) the Collateral Documents, (f) the Fee Letter, (g) each Issuer Document, (h) the AutoBorrow Agreement, (i) any arrangements entered into by the L/C Issuer and the Borrower pursuant to Section 2.03(a)(iii) , (j) any agreement creating or perfecting rights in Cash Collateral pursuant to the provisions of Section 2.15 of this Agreement, (k) each Secured Hedge Agreement and (l) each Secured Cash Management Agreement; provided that for purposes of the definition of “Material Adverse Effect” and Articles IV through X (other than Section 8.03 , Section 10.04 , and Section 10.16 ), “Loan Documents” shall not include Secured Hedge Agreements or Secured Cash Management Agreements.

 

Loan Parties ” means, collectively, the Borrower and each Subsidiary Guarantor.

 

London Banking Day ” means any day on which dealings in Dollar deposits are conducted by and between banks in the London interbank eurodollar market.

 

Material Adverse Effect ” means a material adverse change in, or a material adverse effect on (a) the operations, business, properties, liabilities or financial condition of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries taken as a whole; (b) the ability of the Borrower, together with the Guarantors taken as a whole, to perform its obligations under the Loan Documents to which it is a party; or (c) the legality, validity, binding effect or enforceability against the Borrower or any Guarantor of, or material rights and remedies of the Administrative Agent or any Lender under, the Loan Documents to which the Borrower or such Guarantor is a party.

 

Material Contract ” means (a) the Susser Contribution Agreement and any similar type of agreement relating to the transfer of the Contributed Assets, (b) all material fuel supply, marketer and/or distributor agreements, including those listed on Schedule 5.18 , together with amendments, restatements, extensions and replacements thereof, (c) the Susser Distribution Contract, the Susser Omnibus Agreement, and the Susser Transportation Contract together with amendments, restatements, extensions and replacements thereof, and (d) any other documents, agreements or instruments (i) to which any Loan Party is a party, and (ii) which, if breached, terminated or cancelled, could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

Maturity Date ” means [                  ], 2017; provided , however , that if such date is not a Business Day, the Maturity Date shall be the next preceding Business Day.

 

Measurement Period ” means, at any date of determination, the most recently completed four fiscal quarters of the Borrower or, if fewer than four consecutive fiscal quarters of the Borrower have been completed since the Closing Date, the fiscal quarters of the Borrower that have been completed since the Closing Date; provided that: (a) for purposes of determining the amount of Consolidated EBITDA to be included in the calculation of the Consolidated Interest

 

20



 

Coverage Ratio, Consolidated Total Leverage Ratio and Consolidated Senior Secured Leverage Ratio for the fiscal quarter ended December 31, 2012, such amount for the Measurement Period then ended shall equal such Consolidated EBITDA for such fiscal quarter multiplied by four; (b) for purposes of determining the amount of Consolidated EBITDA to be included in the calculation of the Consolidated Interest Coverage Ratio, Consolidated Total Leverage Ratio and Consolidated Senior Secured Leverage Ratio for the fiscal quarter ended March 31, 2013, such amount for the Measurement Period then ended shall equal such Consolidated EBITDA for the two fiscal quarter period then ended multiplied by two; and (c) for purposes of determining the amount of Consolidated EBITDA to be included in the calculation of the Consolidated Interest Coverage Ratio, Consolidated Total Leverage Ratio and Consolidated Senior Secured Leverage Ratio for the fiscal quarter ended June 30, 2013, such amount for the Measurement Period then ended shall equal such Consolidated EBITDA for the three fiscal quarter period then ended multiplied by 4/3; and provided further that (x) for purposes of determining the amount of Consolidated Interest Charges to be included in the calculation of the Consolidated Interest Coverage Ratio for the fiscal quarter ended December 31, 2012, such amount for the Measurement Period then ended shall equal such Consolidated Interest Charges for such fiscal quarter multiplied by four; (y) for purposes of determining the amount of Consolidated Interest Charges to be included in the calculation of the Consolidated Interest Coverage Ratio for the fiscal quarter ended March 31, 2013, such amount for the Measurement Period then ended shall equal such Consolidated Interest Charges for the two fiscal quarter period then ended multiplied by two; and (z) for purposes of determining the amount of Consolidated Interest Charges to be included in the calculation of the Consolidated Interest Coverage Ratio for the fiscal quarter ended June 30, 2013, such amount for the Measurement Period then ended shall equal such Consolidated Interest Charges for the three fiscal quarter period then ended multiplied by 4/3 .

 

Minimum Collateral Amount ” means, at any time, (i) with respect to Cash Collateral consisting of cash or deposit account balances provided to reduce or eliminate Fronting Exposure during the existence of a Defaulting Lender, an amount equal to 100% of the Fronting Exposure of the L/C Issuer with respect to Letters of Credit issued and outstanding at such time, (ii) with respect to Cash Collateral consisting of cash or deposit account balances provided in accordance with the provisions of Section 2.15(a)(i), (a)(ii) or (a)(iii) , an amount equal to 100% of the Outstanding Amount of all LC Obligations, and (iii) otherwise, an amount determined by the Administrative Agent and the L/C Issuer in their sole discretion.

 

Moody’s ” means Moody’s Investors Service, Inc. and any successor thereto.

 

Mortgages ” means, collectively, each of the mortgages or deeds of trust executed by the Borrower or any of other Loan Party in favor of the Administrative Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties in form and substance reasonably acceptable to the Administrative Agent.

 

Mortgage Delivery Date ” means the date that is 60 days (or such longer period as the Administrative Agent may agree in its sole discretion) after the date the Administrative Agent has notified the Borrower in writing that the Required Lenders have requested the Borrower or its applicable Subsidiary grant Liens on certain real property pursuant to Section 6.12 ; provided that, if such date is not a Business Day, then the Mortgage Delivery Date shall be the Business Day immediately preceding such date.

 

21



 

Mortgage Trigger ” means the delivery of a Compliance Certificate reflecting a Consolidated Total Leverage Ratio for any Measurement Period of greater than 3.00:1:00.

 

Multiemployer Plan ” means any employee benefit plan of the type described in Section 4001(a)(3) of ERISA, to which the Borrower or any ERISA Affiliate makes or is obligated to make contributions or with respect to which the Borrower or any ERISA Affiliate may have any liability, contingent or otherwise.

 

Multiple Employer Plan ” means a Plan which has two or more contributing sponsors (including the Borrower or any ERISA Affiliate) at least two of whom are not under common control, as such a plan is described in Section 4064 of ERISA.

 

Non-Consenting Lender ” means any Lender that does not approve any consent, waiver or amendment that (i) requires the approval of all Lenders or all affected Lenders in accordance with the terms of Section 10.01 and (ii) has been approved by the Required Lenders.

 

Non-Defaulting Lender ” means, at any time, each Lender that is not a Defaulting Lender at such time.

 

Note ” means a promissory note made by the Borrower in favor of a Lender evidencing Revolving Credit Loans or Swing Line Loans, as the case may be, made by such Lender, substantially in the form of Exhibit B .

 

NPL ” means the National Priorities List under CERCLA.

 

Obligations ” means all advances to, and debts, liabilities, obligations, covenants and duties of, any Loan Party arising under any Loan Document or otherwise with respect to any Loan, Letter of Credit, Secured Cash Management Agreement or Secured Hedge Agreement, in each case whether direct or indirect (including those acquired by assumption), absolute or contingent, due or to become due, now existing or hereafter arising and including interest and fees that accrue after the commencement by or against any Loan Party or any Affiliate thereof of any proceeding under any Debtor Relief Laws naming such Person as the debtor in such proceeding, regardless of whether such interest and fees are allowed claims in such proceeding.

 

Organization Documents ” means, (a) with respect to any corporation, the certificate or articles of incorporation and the bylaws (or equivalent or comparable constitutive documents with respect to any non-U.S. jurisdiction); (b) with respect to any limited liability company, the certificate or articles of formation or organization and operating agreement; and (c) with respect to any partnership, joint venture, trust or other form of business entity, the partnership, joint venture or other applicable agreement of formation or organization and any agreement, instrument, filing or notice with respect thereto filed in connection with its formation or organization with the applicable Governmental Authority in the jurisdiction of its formation or organization and, if applicable, any certificate or articles of formation or organization of such entity.

 

Other Connection Taxes ” means, with respect to any Recipient, Taxes imposed as a result of a present or former connection between such Recipient and the jurisdiction imposing such Tax (other than connections arising from such Recipient having executed, delivered,

 

22



 

become a party to, performed its obligations under, received payments under, received or perfected a security interest under, engaged in any other transaction pursuant to or enforced any Loan Document, or sold or assigned an interest in any Loan, the Commitments or Loan Document).

 

Other Taxes ” means all present or future stamp, court or documentary, intangible, recording, filing or similar Taxes that arise from any payment made under, from the execution, delivery, performance, enforcement or registration of, from the receipt or perfection of a security interest under, or otherwise with respect to, any Loan Document, except any such Taxes that are Other Connection Taxes imposed with respect to an assignment (other than an assignment made pursuant to Section 3.06 ) treating the assignee and assignor with respect to any assignment as the Recipient for purposes of the definition of Other Connection Taxes.

 

Outstanding Amount ” means (a) with respect to Revolving Credit Loans and Swing Line Loans on any date, the aggregate outstanding principal amount thereof after giving effect to any borrowings and prepayments or repayments of Revolving Credit Loans and Swing Line Loans, as the case may be, occurring on such date; and (b) with respect to any L/C Obligations on any date, the amount of such L/C Obligations on such date after giving effect to any L/C Credit Extension occurring on such date and any other changes in the aggregate amount of the L/C Obligations as of such date, including as a result of any reimbursements by the Borrower of Unreimbursed Amounts.

 

Participant ” has the meaning specified in Section 10.06(d) .

 

Participant Register ” has the meaning specified in Section 10.06(d) .

 

PBGC ” means the Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation.

 

Pension Act ” means the Pension Protection Act of 2006.

 

Pension Funding Rules ” means the rules of the Code and ERISA regarding minimum required contributions (including any installment payment thereof) to Pension Plans and set forth in, with respect to plan years ending prior to the effective date of the Pension Act, Section 412 of the Code and Section 302 of ERISA, each as in effect prior to the Pension Act and, thereafter, Section 412, 430, 431, 432 and 436 of the Code and Sections 302, 303, 304 and 305 of ERISA.

 

Pension Plan ” means any employee pension benefit plan (including a Multiple Employer Plan, but excluding a Multiemployer Plan) that is maintained or is contributed to by the Borrower and any ERISA Affiliate and is either covered by Title IV of ERISA or is subject to the minimum funding standards under Section 412 of the Code.

 

Permitted Sale/Leaseback Transactions ” means (i) sale-leaseback transactions between the Borrower or any Subsidiary Guarantor, as owner/lessor and Stripes as lessee with respect to Stripes Properties, (ii) sale-leaseback transactions with respect to Stripes Properties provided that the aggregate fair market value of the properties Disposed of by Susser PropCo or other Loan Party in reliance on this clause (ii) shall not exceed (when combined with Dispositions made pursuant to Section 7.05(m) ) $10,000,000, and (iii) sale-leaseback transactions with respect to properties other than Stripes Properties.

 

23


 

Person ” means any natural person, corporation, limited liability company, trust, joint venture, association, company, partnership, Governmental Authority or other entity.

 

Plan ” means any employee benefit plan within the meaning of Section 3(3) of ERISA (including a Pension Plan, but excluding a Multiemployer Plan), established by the Borrower or, with respect to any such plan that is subject to Section 412 of the Code or Title IV of ERISA, any ERISA Affiliate.

 

Platform ” has the meaning specified in Section 6.02 .

 

Pro Forma Basis ” shall mean on a basis in accordance with GAAP and Regulation S X and otherwise reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent, which shall include an assumption that (a) all Acquisitions made, and any Indebtedness incurred or repaid in connection therewith, during the most recently completed Measurement Period and (b) all Dispositions completed, and any Indebtedness incurred or repaid in connection therewith, during such Measurement Period have, in either case, been made or repaid on the first day of such Measurement Period including, in each such case, pro forma adjustments arising out of events which are (i) directly attributable to a specific transaction, (ii) factually supportable, and (iii) expected to have a continuing impact, and in each case otherwise demonstrated to and approved by the Administrative Agent in its reasonable discretion.

 

Public Lender ” has the meaning specified in Section 6.02 .

 

Qualified Offering ” means unsecured Indebtedness issued by the Borrower in accordance with Section 7.02(h)  and pursuant to which the Borrower receives not less than $200,000,000 of gross cash proceeds from the issuance thereof.

 

Recipient ” means the Administrative Agent, any Lender or the L/C Issuer.

 

Register ” has the meaning specified in Section 10.06(c) .

 

Registration Statement ” means that certain Form S-1 Registration Statement No. 333-182276 filed on June 21, 2012 with the SEC with respect to the Common Units, as amended from time to time through [              ], 2012.

 

Related Parties ” means, with respect to any Person, such Person’s Affiliates and the partners, directors, officers, employees, agents, trustees, administrators, managers, advisors and representatives of such Person and of such Person’s Affiliates.

 

Reportable Event ” means any of the events set forth in Section 4043(c) of ERISA, other than events for which the 30 day notice period has been waived.

 

Removal Effective Date ” has the meaning specified in Section 9.06(b) .

 

Request for Credit Extension ” means (a) with respect to a Borrowing, conversion or continuation of Revolving Credit Loans, a Revolving Credit Loan Notice, (b) with respect to an L/C Credit Extension, a Letter of Credit Application, and (c) with respect to a Swing Line Loan, any transfer of funds pursuant to the AutoBorrow Agreement.

 

24



 

Required Lenders ” means, at any time, Lenders having Total Credit Exposures representing more than 50% of the Total Credit Exposures of all Lenders.  The Total Credit Exposure of any Defaulting Lender shall be disregarded in determining Required Lenders at any time; provided that, the amount of any participation in any Swing Line Loan and Unreimbursed Amounts that such Defaulting Lender has failed to fund that have not been reallocated to and funded by another Lender shall be deemed to be held by the Lender that is the Swing Line Lender or L/C Issuer, as the case may be, in making such determination.

 

Responsible Officer ” means, with respect to any Person, the chief executive officer, president, chief financial officer, any executive vice president, treasurer, assistant treasurer or controller of such Person (or its general partner or other governing body, as applicable) and, solely for purposes of the delivery of incumbency certificates pursuant to Section 4.01 , the secretary or any assistant secretary of such Person (or its general partner or other governing body, as applicable) and, solely for purposes of notices given pursuant to Article II , any other officer of such Person (or its general partner or other governing body, as applicable) so designated by any of the foregoing officers in a notice to the Administrative Agent.  Any document delivered hereunder that is signed by a Responsible Officer of Holdings, a Loan Party or the General Partner on behalf of such Loan Party shall be conclusively presumed to have been authorized by all necessary corporate, partnership and/or other action on the part of Holdings, such Loan Party or the General Partner, as applicable, and such Responsible Officer shall be conclusively presumed to have acted on behalf of Holdings, such Loan Party or the General Partner, as applicable.

 

Restricted Payment ” means any dividend or other distribution (whether in cash, securities or other property) with respect to any capital stock or other Equity Interest of any Person or any of its Subsidiaries, or any payment (whether in cash, securities or other property), including any sinking fund or similar deposit, on account of the purchase, redemption, retirement, defeasance, acquisition, cancellation or termination of any such capital stock or other Equity Interest, or on account of any return of capital to any Person’s stockholders, partners or members (or the equivalent of any thereof), or any option, warrant or other right to acquire any such dividend or other distribution or payment.

 

Revolving Credit Borrowing ” means a borrowing consisting of simultaneous Revolving Credit Loans of the same Type and, in the case of Eurodollar Rate Loans, having the same Interest Period made by each of the Lenders pursuant to Section 2.01(b) .

 

Revolving Credit Exposure ” means, as to any Lender at any time, the aggregate principal amount at such time of its outstanding Revolving Credit Loans and such Lender’s participation in L/C Obligations and Swing Line Loans at such time.

 

Revolving Credit Loan ” has the meaning specified in Section 2.01(c) .

 

Revolving Credit Loan Notice ” means a notice of (a) a Revolving Credit Borrowing, (b) a conversion of Loans from one Type to the other, or (c) a continuation of Eurodollar Rate Loans, pursuant to Section 2.02(a) , which, if in writing, shall be substantially in the form of Exhibit A .

 

25



 

S&P ” means Standard & Poor’s Financial Services LLC, a subsidiary of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc., and any successor thereto.

 

SEC ” means the Securities and Exchange Commission, or any Governmental Authority succeeding to any of its principal functions.

 

Secured Cash Management Agreement ” means any Cash Management Agreement that is entered into by and between any Loan Party and any Cash Management Bank.

 

Secured Hedge Agreement ” means any Swap Contract that is entered into by and between any Loan Party and any Hedge Bank.

 

Secured Parties ” means, collectively, the Administrative Agent, the Lenders, the L/C Issuer, the Hedge Banks, the Cash Management Banks, each co-agent or sub-agent appointed by the Administrative Agent from time to time pursuant to Section 9.05 , and the other Persons the Obligations owing to which are or are purported to be secured by the Collateral under the terms of the Collateral Documents.

 

Security Agreement ” means the Security Agreement dated as of [            ], 2012 among the Borrower, the Subsidiary Guarantors and the Administrative Agent.

 

Solvent ” and “ Solvency ” mean, with respect to any Person on any date of determination, that on such date (a) the fair value of the property of such Person is greater than the total amount of liabilities, including contingent liabilities, of such Person, (b) the present fair salable value of the assets of such Person is not less than the amount that will be required to pay the probable liability of such Person on its debts as they become absolute and matured, (c) such Person does not intend to, and does not believe that it will, incur debts or liabilities beyond such Person’s ability to pay such debts and liabilities as they mature, (d) such Person is not engaged in business or a transaction, and is not about to engage in business or a transaction, for which such Person’s property would constitute an unreasonably small capital, and (e) such Person is able to pay its debts and liabilities, contingent obligations and other commitments as they mature in the ordinary course of business.  The amount of contingent liabilities at any time shall be computed as the amount that, in the light of all the facts and circumstances existing at such time, represents the amount that can reasonably be expected to become an actual or matured liability.

 

Specified Acquisition ” means any Acquisition made by the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries in which the Acquisition Consideration therefor exceeds $50,000,000.

 

Specified Acquisition Period ” means, upon Borrower’s election pursuant to Section 6.02(l) , (a) the fiscal quarter during which the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries consummates a Specified Acquisition and (b) the two fiscal quarters immediately following the fiscal quarter described in clause (a); provided , however, that (i) no more than one Specified Acquisition Period may be in effect at any one time, (ii) no Specified Acquisition Period may become effective if the Borrower fails to timely elect such Specified Acquisition Period pursuant to the terms of Section 6.02(l)  and (iii) no more than one Specified Acquisition Period may be elected with respect to any particular Specified Acquisition.

 

Stripes ” means Stripes LLC, a Texas limited liability company.

 

26



 

Stripes Properties ” means (i) the up to 75 new or recently constructed convenience stores which may be acquired by the Borrower or its Subsidiaries pursuant to a right of first refusal contained in the Susser Omnibus Agreement and (ii) any other convenience stores which may be constructed by the Borrower or its Subsidiaries or acquired by the Borrower or its Subsidiaries from Holdings or any of its Subsidiaries or Affiliates (other than the Borrower and its Subsidiaries) after the Closing Date pursuant to the Susser Omnibus Agreement or other arrangements.

 

Subsidiary ” of a Person means a corporation, partnership, joint venture, limited liability company or other business entity of which a majority of the shares of securities or other interests having ordinary voting power for the election of directors or other governing body (other than securities or interests having such power only by reason of the happening of a contingency) are at the time beneficially owned, or the management of which is otherwise controlled, directly, or indirectly through one or more intermediaries, or both, by such Person.  Unless otherwise specified, all references herein to a “ Subsidiary ” or to “ Subsidiaries ” shall refer to a Subsidiary or Subsidiaries of the Borrower.

 

Subsidiary Guarantors ” means the Wholly Owned Subsidiaries of the Borrower listed on Schedule 6.12, each other Wholly Owned Subsidiary of the Borrower that shall be required to execute and deliver a guaranty or guaranty supplement pursuant to Section 6.12 and each other Subsidiary of the Borrower that chooses to execute and deliver a Subsidiary Guaranty or supplement thereto.

 

Subsidiary Guaranty ” means the Guaranty made by the Subsidiary Guarantors in favor of the Secured Parties, together with each other guaranty and guaranty supplement delivered pursuant to Section 6.12 or otherwise.

 

Susser Consent ” means the Consent and Agreement dated as of [              ], 2012 among the Borrower, Holdings, Susser Petroleum Company, Susser Operating, Susser PropCo, [other Affiliates of the Loan Parties that are counterparties to a Material Contract] and the Administrative Agent.

 

Susser Contribution Agreement ” means the [Contribution Agreement dated as of [                  ], 2012 among the Borrower, the General Partner, Holdings, [Susser Holdings, L.L.C.] and Susser Petroleum Company, pursuant to which Susser Petroleum Company will contribute to Susser Operating the Contributed Assets (as defined therein) in exchange for Holdings contributing 100% of the Equity Interests of Susser Operating to the Borrower.] [Note: based on current draft of contribution agreement.  To be confirmed.]

 

Susser Distribution Contract ” means the Fuel Distribution Agreement dated as of [              ], 2012 among Susser Operating and Holdings.

 

Susser Omnibus Agreement ” means the Omnibus Agreement, dated as of [                  ] among Holdings, the General Partner and the Borrower.

 

Susser Operating ” means Susser Petroleum Operating Company LLC, a Delaware limited liability company and a Wholly Owned Subsidiary of the Borrower.

 

27



 

Susser Petroleum Company ” means Susser Petroleum Company LLC, a Texas limited liability company and a Wholly Owned Subsidiary of Holdings.

 

Susser PropCo ” means Susser Petroleum Property Company LLC, a Delaware limited liability company.

 

Susser Transportation Contract ” means the [            ] dated as of [              ], 2012 among Susser Petroleum Company, Susser Operating and one or more of Susser Operating’s Wholly-Owned Subsidiaries.

 

Swap Contract ” means (a) any and all rate swap transactions, basis swaps, credit derivative transactions, forward rate transactions, commodity swaps, commodity options, forward commodity contracts, equity or equity index swaps or options, bond or bond price or bond index swaps or options or forward bond or forward bond price or forward bond index transactions, interest rate options, forward foreign exchange transactions, cap transactions, floor transactions, collar transactions, currency swap transactions, cross-currency rate swap transactions, currency options, spot contracts, or any other similar transactions or any combination of any of the foregoing (including any options to enter into any of the foregoing), whether or not any such transaction is governed by or subject to any master agreement, and (b) any and all transactions of any kind, and the related confirmations, which are subject to the terms and conditions of, or governed by, any form of master agreement published by the International Swaps and Derivatives Association, Inc., any International Foreign Exchange Master Agreement, or any other master agreement (any such master agreement, together with any related schedules, a “ Master Agreement ”), including any such obligations or liabilities under any Master Agreement.

 

Swap Termination Value ” means, in respect of any one or more Swap Contracts, after taking into account the effect of any legally enforceable netting agreement relating to such Swap Contracts, (a) for any date on or after the date such Swap Contracts have been closed out and termination value(s) determined in accordance therewith, such termination value(s), and (b) for any date prior to the date referenced in clause (a), the amount(s) determined as the mark-to-market value(s) for such Swap Contracts, as determined based upon one or more mid-market or other readily available quotations provided by any recognized dealer in such Swap Contracts (which may include a Lender or any Affiliate of a Lender).

 

Swing Line Borrowing ” means a borrowing of a Swing Line Loan pursuant to Section 2.04 .

 

Swing Line Lender ” means Bank of America in its capacity as provider of Swing Line Loans, or any successor swing line lender hereunder.

 

Swing Line Loan ” has the meaning specified in Section 2.04(a) .

 

Swing Line Sublimit ” means an amount equal to the lesser of (a) $25,000,000 and (b) the Aggregate Commitments.  The Swing Line Sublimit is part of, and not in addition to, the Aggregate Commitments.

 

28



 

Synthetic Lease Obligation ” means the monetary obligation of a Person under (a) a so-called synthetic, off-balance sheet or tax retention lease, or (b) an agreement for the use or possession of property (including sale and leaseback transactions), in each case, creating obligations that do not appear on the balance sheet of such Person but which, upon the application of any Debtor Relief Laws to such Person, would be characterized as the indebtedness of such Person (without regard to accounting treatment).

 

Taxes ” means all present or future taxes, levies, imposts, duties, deductions, withholdings (including backup withholding), assessments, fees or other charges imposed by any Governmental Authority, including any interest, additions to tax or penalties applicable thereto.

 

Threshold Amount ” means $12,500,000.

 

Total Credit Exposure ” means, as to any Lender at any time, the unused Commitments and Revolving Credit Exposure of such Lender at such time.

 

Total Outstandings ” means the aggregate Outstanding Amount of all Loans and all L/C Obligations.

 

Transaction ” means, collectively, the contribution of Contributed Assets on or prior to the Closing Date, the consummation of the Borrower IPO and the incurrence of the Lakehead Loan.

 

Transfer Documents ” means, collectively, the Susser Contribution Agreement and any other material documents, agreements and instruments executed by a Loan Party or any Contributing Affiliate in connection with the transfer of the Contributed Assets to the Loan Parties whether on, prior to or after the Closing Date.

 

Type ” means, with respect to a Loan, its character as a Base Rate Loan or a Eurodollar Rate Loan.

 

UCC ” means the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect in the State of New York; provided that, if perfection or the effect of perfection or non-perfection or the priority of any security interest in any Collateral is governed by the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect in a jurisdiction other than the State of New York, “ UCC ” means the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect from time to time in such other jurisdiction for purposes of the provisions hereof relating to such perfection, effect of perfection or non-perfection or priority.

 

United States ” and “ U.S. ” mean the United States of America.

 

Unreimbursed Amount ” has the meaning specified in Section 2.03(c)(i) .

 

U.S. Person ” means any Person that is a “United States Person” as defined in Section 7701(a)(30) of the Code.

 

U.S. Tax Compliance Certificate ” has the meaning specified in Section 3.01(e) .

 

29



 

Wholly Owned Subsidiary ” means any Subsidiary of a Person of which all of the issued and outstanding Equity Interests are directly or indirectly (through one or more Subsidiaries) owned by such Person, excluding directors’ qualifying shares if applicable.  Unless otherwise specified, “ Wholly Owned Subsidiary ” shall be a reference to a Wholly Owned Subsidiary of the Borrower.

 

Withholding Agent ” means any Loan Party and the Administrative Agent.

 

1.02        Other Interpretive Provisions .  With reference to this Agreement and each other Loan Document, unless otherwise specified herein or in such other Loan Document:

 

(a)           The definitions of terms herein shall apply equally to the singular and plural forms of the terms defined.  Whenever the context may require, any pronoun shall include the corresponding masculine, feminine and neuter forms.  The words “ include ,” “ includes ” and “ including ” shall be deemed to be followed by the phrase “ without limitation .”  The word “ will ” shall be construed to have the same meaning and effect as the word “ shall .”  Unless the context requires otherwise, (i) any definition of or reference to any agreement, instrument or other document (including any Organization Document) shall be construed as referring to such agreement, instrument or other document as from time to time amended, supplemented or otherwise modified (subject to any restrictions on such amendments, supplements or modifications set forth herein or in any other Loan Document), (ii) any reference herein to any Person shall be construed to include such Person’s successors and assigns, (iii) the words “ herein ,” “ hereof ” and “ hereunder ,” and words of similar import when used in any Loan Document, shall be construed to refer to such Loan Document in its entirety and not to any particular provision thereof, (iv) all references in a Loan Document to Articles, Sections, Preliminary Statements, Exhibits and Schedules shall be construed to refer to Articles and Sections of, and Preliminary Statements, Exhibits and Schedules to, the Loan Document in which such references appear, (v) any reference to any law shall include all statutory and regulatory provisions consolidating, amending, replacing or interpreting such law and any reference to any law or regulation shall, unless otherwise specified, refer to such law or regulation as amended, modified or supplemented from time to time, and (vi) the words “ asset ” and “ property ” shall be construed to have the same meaning and effect and to refer to any and all tangible and intangible assets and properties, including cash, securities, accounts and contract rights.

 

(b)           In the computation of periods of time from a specified date to a later specified date, the word “ from ” means “ from and including ;” the words “ to ” and “ until ” each mean “ to but excluding ;” and the word “ through ” means “ to and including .”

 

(c)           Section headings herein and in the other Loan Documents are included for convenience of reference only and shall not affect the interpretation of this Agreement or any other Loan Document.

 

1.03        Accounting Terms .  (a)  Generally .  All accounting terms not specifically or completely defined herein shall be construed in conformity with, and all financial data (including financial ratios and other financial calculations) required to be submitted pursuant to this Agreement shall be prepared in conformity with, GAAP applied on a consistent basis, as in

 

30



 

effect from time to time, applied in a manner consistent with that used in preparing the Audited Financial Statements, except as otherwise specifically prescribed herein.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, for purposes of determining compliance with any covenant (including the computation of any financial covenant) contained herein, Indebtedness of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries shall be deemed to be carried at 100% of the outstanding principal amount thereof, and the effects of FASB ASC 825 and FASB ASC 470-20 on financial liabilities shall be disregarded.

 

(b)           Changes in GAAP .  If at any time any change in GAAP would affect the computation of any financial ratio or requirement set forth in any Loan Document, and either the Borrower or the Required Lenders shall so request, the Administrative Agent, the Lenders and the Borrower shall negotiate in good faith to amend such ratio or requirement to preserve the original intent thereof in light of such change in GAAP (subject to the approval of the Required Lenders); provided that , until so amended, (A) such ratio or requirement shall continue to be computed in accordance with GAAP prior to such change therein and (B) the Borrower shall provide to the Administrative Agent and the Lenders financial statements and other documents required under this Agreement or as reasonably requested hereunder setting forth a reconciliation between calculations of such ratio or requirement made before and after giving effect to such change in GAAP.

 

(c)           Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities .  All references herein to consolidated financial statements of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries or to the determination of any amount for the Borrower and its Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis or any similar reference shall, in each case, be deemed to include each variable interest entity that the Borrower is required to consolidate pursuant to FASB ASC 810 as if such variable interest entity were a Subsidiary as defined herein.

 

1.04        Rounding .  Any financial ratios required to be maintained by the Borrower pursuant to this Agreement shall be calculated by dividing the appropriate component by the other component, carrying the result to one place more than the number of places by which such ratio is expressed herein and rounding the result up or down to the nearest number (with a rounding-up if there is no nearest number).

 

1.05        Times of Day .  Unless otherwise specified, all references herein to times of day shall be references to Central time (daylight or standard, as applicable).

 

1.06        Letter of Credit Amounts .  Unless otherwise specified herein, the amount of a Letter of Credit at any time shall be deemed to be the stated amount of such Letter of Credit in effect at such time; provided , however , that with respect to any Letter of Credit that, by its terms or the terms of any Issuer Document related thereto, provides for one or more automatic increases in the stated amount thereof, the amount of such Letter of Credit shall be deemed to be the maximum stated amount of such Letter of Credit after giving effect to all such increases, whether or not such maximum stated amount is in effect at such time.

 

31



 

ARTICLE II.
THE COMMITMENTS AND CREDIT EXTENSIONS

 

2.01        The Loans .  Subject to the terms and conditions set forth herein, each Lender severally agrees to make loans (each such loan, a “ Revolving Credit Loan ”) to the Borrower from time to time, on any Business Day during the Availability Period, in an aggregate amount not to exceed at any time outstanding the amount of such Lender’s Commitment; provided, however, that after giving effect to any Revolving Credit Borrowing, (i) the Total Outstandings shall not exceed the Aggregate Commitments, and (ii) the Revolving Credit Exposure of any Lender shall not exceed such Lender’s Commitment.  Within the limits of each Lender’s Commitment, and subject to the other terms and conditions hereof, the Borrower may borrow under this Section 2.01 , prepay under Section 2.05 , and reborrow under this Section 2.01 .  Revolving Credit Loans may be Base Rate Loans or Eurodollar Rate Loans, as further provided herein.

 

2.02        Borrowings, Conversions and Continuations of Loans .  (a) Each Revolving Credit Borrowing, each conversion of Revolving Credit Loans from one Type to the other, and each continuation of Eurodollar Rate Loans shall be made upon the Borrower’s irrevocable notice to the Administrative Agent, which may be given by telephone.  Each such notice must be received by the Administrative Agent not later than 12:00 noon (i) three Business Days prior to the requested date of any Borrowing of, conversion to or continuation of Eurodollar Rate Loans or of any conversion of Eurodollar Rate Loans to Base Rate Loans, and (ii) on the requested date of any Borrowing of Base Rate Loans; provided , however , that if the Borrower wishes to request Eurodollar Rate Loans having an Interest Period other than one, two, three or six months in duration as provided in the definition of “ Interest Period ,” the applicable notice must be received by the Administrative Agent not later than 12:00 noon four Business Days prior to the requested date of such Borrowing, conversion or continuation, whereupon the Administrative Agent shall give prompt notice to the Lenders of such request and determine whether the requested Interest Period is acceptable to all of them.  Not later than 12:00 noon, three Business Days before the requested date of such Borrowing, conversion or continuation, the Administrative Agent shall notify the Borrower (which notice may be by telephone) whether or not the requested Interest Period has been consented to by all the Lenders.  Each telephonic notice by the Borrower pursuant to this Section 2.02(a)  must be confirmed promptly by delivery to the Administrative Agent of a written Revolving Credit Loan Notice, appropriately completed and signed by a Responsible Officer of the Borrower.  Each Borrowing of, conversion to or continuation of Eurodollar Rate Loans shall be in a principal amount of $5,000,000 or a whole multiple of $1,000,000 in excess thereof.  Except as provided in Sections 2.03(c)  and 2.04(c) , each Borrowing of or conversion to Base Rate Loans shall be in a principal amount of $500,000 or a whole multiple of $100,000 in excess thereof.  Each Revolving Credit Loan Notice  (whether telephonic or written) shall specify (i) whether the Borrower is requesting a Revolving Credit Borrowing, a conversion of Revolving Credit Loans from one Type to the other, or a continuation of Eurodollar Rate Loans, (ii) the requested date of the Borrowing, conversion or continuation, as the case may be (which shall be a Business Day), (iii) the principal amount of Loans to be borrowed, converted or continued, (iv) the Type of Loans to be borrowed or to which existing Revolving Credit Loans are to be converted, and (v) if applicable, the duration of the Interest Period with respect thereto.  If the Borrower fails to specify a Type of Loan in a Revolving Credit Loan Notice or if the Borrower fails to give a timely notice requesting a conversion or continuation, then the Revolving Credit Loans shall be made as, or converted to, Base Rate Loans.  Any such automatic conversion to Base Rate Loans shall be effective as of the last day of the Interest Period then in effect with respect to the applicable Eurodollar Rate Loans.

 

32



 

If the Borrower requests a Borrowing of, conversion to, or continuation of Eurodollar Rate Loans in any such Revolving Credit Loan Notice, but fails to specify an Interest Period, it will be deemed to have specified an Interest Period of one month.  Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, a Swing Line Loan may not be converted to a Eurodollar Rate Loan.

 

(b)           Following receipt of a Revolving Credit Loan Notice, the Administrative Agent shall promptly notify each Lender of the amount of its Applicable Percentage of the Revolving Credit Loans, and if no timely notice of a conversion or continuation is provided by the Borrower, the Administrative Agent shall notify each Lender of the details of any automatic conversion to Base Rate Loans described in Section 2.02(a) .  In the case of a Revolving Credit Borrowing, each Lender shall make the amount of its Loan available to the Administrative Agent in immediately available funds at the Administrative Agent’s Office not later than 1:00 p.m. on the Business Day specified in the applicable Revolving Credit Loan Notice.  Upon satisfaction of the applicable conditions set forth in Section 4.02 (and, if such Borrowing is the initial Credit Extension, Section 4.01 ), the Administrative Agent shall make all funds so received available to the Borrower in like funds as received by the Administrative Agent either by (i) crediting the account of the Borrower on the books of Bank of America with the amount of such funds or (ii) wire transfer of such funds, in each case in accordance with instructions provided to (and reasonably acceptable to) the Administrative Agent by the Borrower; provided , however , that if, on the date a Revolving Credit Loan Notice with respect to a Revolving Credit Borrowing is given by the Borrower, there are L/C Borrowings outstanding, then the proceeds of such Revolving Credit Borrowing, first , shall be applied to the payment in full of any such L/C Borrowings, and second , shall be made available to the Borrower as provided above.

 

(c)           Except as otherwise provided herein, a Eurodollar Rate Loan may be continued or converted only on the last day of an Interest Period for such Eurodollar Rate Loan.  During the existence of a Default, no Loans may be requested as, converted to or continued as Eurodollar Rate Loans without the consent of the Required Lenders.

 

(d)           The Administrative Agent shall promptly notify the Borrower and the Lenders of the interest rate applicable to any Interest Period for Eurodollar Rate Loans upon determination of such interest rate.  At any time that Base Rate Loans are outstanding, the Administrative Agent shall notify the Borrower and the Lenders of any change in Bank of America’s prime rate used in determining the Base Rate promptly following the public announcement of such change.

 

(e)           After giving effect to all Revolving Credit Borrowings, all conversions of Revolving Credit Loans from one Type to the other, and all continuations of Revolving Credit Loans as the same Type, there shall not be more than ten (10) Interest Periods in effect with respect to Revolving Credit Loans.

 

(f)            Anything in this Section 2.02 to the contrary notwithstanding, the Borrower may not select the Eurodollar Rate for any Credit Extension requested to be made within 3 Business Days of the Closing Date .

 

2.03        Letters of Credit .  (a)  The Letter of Credit Commitment .  (i) Subject to the terms and conditions set forth herein, (A) the L/C Issuer agrees, in reliance upon the agreements of the Lenders set forth in this Section 2.03 , (1) from time to time on any Business Day during the

 

33


 

period from the Closing Date until the Letter of Credit Expiration Date, to issue Letters of Credit for the account of the Borrower or any Subsidiary, and to amend or extend Letters of Credit previously issued by it, in accordance with Section 2.03(b) , and (2) to honor drawings under the Letters of Credit; and (B) the Lenders severally agree to participate in Letters of Credit issued for the account of the Borrower or its Subsidiaries and any drawings thereunder; provided that after giving effect to any L/C Credit Extension with respect to any Letter of Credit, (x) the Total Outstandings shall not exceed the Aggregate Commitments, (y) the Revolving Credit Exposure of any Lender shall not exceed such Lender’s Commitment, and (z) the Outstanding Amount of the L/C Obligations shall not exceed the Letter of Credit Sublimit.  Each request by the Borrower for the issuance or amendment of a Letter of Credit shall be deemed to be a representation by the Borrower that the L/C Credit Extension so requested complies with the conditions set forth in the proviso to the preceding sentence.  Within the foregoing limits, and subject to the terms and conditions hereof, the Borrower’s ability to obtain Letters of Credit shall be fully revolving, and accordingly the Borrower may, during the foregoing period, obtain Letters of Credit to replace Letters of Credit that have expired or that have been drawn upon and reimbursed.

 

(ii)                                   The L/C Issuer shall not issue any Letter of Credit if:

 

(A)                                subject to Section 2.03(b)(iii) , the expiry date of the requested Letter of Credit would occur more than twelve months after the date of issuance or last extension, unless the Required Lenders have approved such expiry date; or

 

(B)                                the expiry date of the requested Letter of Credit would occur after the Letter of Credit Expiration Date, unless all the Lenders have approved such expiry date.

 

(iii)                                The L/C Issuer shall not be under any obligation to issue any Letter of Credit if:

 

(A)                                any order, judgment or decree of any Governmental Authority or arbitrator shall by its terms purport to enjoin or restrain the L/C Issuer from issuing the Letter of Credit, or any Law applicable to the L/C Issuer or any request or directive (whether or not having the force of law) from any Governmental Authority with jurisdiction over the L/C Issuer shall prohibit, or request that the L/C Issuer refrain from, the issuance of letters of credit generally or the Letter of Credit in particular or shall impose upon the L/C Issuer with respect to the Letter of Credit any restriction, reserve or capital requirement (for which the L/C Issuer is not otherwise compensated hereunder) not in effect on the Closing Date, or shall impose upon the L/C Issuer any unreimbursed loss, cost or expense which was not applicable on the Closing Date and which the L/C Issuer in good faith deems material to it;

 

(B)                                the issuance of the Letter of Credit would violate one or more policies of the L/C Issuer applicable to letters of credit generally;

 

(C)                                except as otherwise agreed by the Administrative Agent and the L/C Issuer, such Letter of Credit is in an initial stated amount less than $10,000;

 

34



 

(D)                                the Letter of Credit is to be denominated in a currency other than Dollars;

 

(E)                                 any Lender is at that time a Defaulting Lender, unless the L/C Issuer has entered into arrangements, including the delivery of Cash Collateral, satisfactory to the L/C Issuer (in its sole discretion) with the Borrower or such Lender to eliminate the L/C Issuer’s actual or potential Fronting Exposure (after giving effect to Section 2.18(a)(iv )) with respect to the Defaulting Lender arising from either the Letter of Credit then proposed to be issued or that Letter of Credit and all other L/C Obligations as to which the L/C Issuer has actual or potential Fronting Exposure, as it may elect in its sole discretion.

 

(iv)                               The L/C Issuer shall not amend any Letter of Credit if the L/C Issuer would not be permitted at such time to issue the Letter of Credit in its amended form under the terms hereof.

 

(v)                                  The L/C Issuer shall be under no obligation to amend any Letter of Credit if (A) the L/C Issuer would have no obligation at such time to issue the Letter of Credit in its amended form under the terms hereof, or (B) the beneficiary of the Letter of Credit does not accept the proposed amendment to the Letter of Credit.

 

(vi)                               The L/C Issuer shall act on behalf of the Lenders with respect to any Letters of Credit issued by it and the documents associated therewith, and the L/C Issuer shall have all of the benefits and immunities (A) provided to the Administrative Agent in Article IX with respect to any acts taken or omissions suffered by the L/C Issuer in connection with Letters of Credit issued by it or proposed to be issued by it and Issuer Documents pertaining to such Letters of Credit as fully as if the term “ Administrative Agent ” as used in Article IX included the L/C Issuer with respect to such acts or omissions, and (B) as additionally provided herein with respect to the L/C Issuer.

 

(b)                                  Procedures for Issuance and Amendment of Letters of Credit; Auto-Extension Letters of Credit .  (i) Each Letter of Credit shall be issued or amended, as the case may be, upon the request of the Borrower delivered to the L/C Issuer (with a copy to the Administrative Agent) in the form of a Letter of Credit Application, appropriately completed and signed by a Responsible Officer of the Borrower.  Such Letter of Credit Application may be sent by facsimile, by United States mail, by overnight courier, by electronic transmission using the system provided by the L/C Issuer, by personal delivery or by any other means acceptable to the L/C Issuer.  Such Letter of Credit Application must be received by the L/C Issuer and the Administrative Agent not later than 11:00 p.m. at least two Business Days (or such later date and time as the Administrative Agent and the L/C Issuer may agree in a particular instance in their sole discretion) prior to the proposed issuance date or date of amendment, as the case may be.  In the case of a request for an initial issuance of a Letter of Credit, such Letter of Credit Application shall specify in form and detail reasonably satisfactory to the L/C Issuer:  (A) the proposed issuance date of the requested Letter of Credit (which shall be a Business Day); (B) the amount thereof; (C) the expiry date thereof; (D) the name and address of the beneficiary thereof; (E) the documents to be presented by such beneficiary in case of any drawing thereunder; (F) the full text of any certificate to be presented by such beneficiary in case of any drawing thereunder; (G)

 

35



 

the purpose and nature of the requested Letter of Credit; and (H) such other matters as the L/C Issuer may reasonably request.  In the case of a request for an amendment of any outstanding Letter of Credit, such Letter of Credit Application shall specify in form and detail reasonably satisfactory to the L/C Issuer (1) the Letter of Credit to be amended; (2) the proposed date of amendment thereof (which shall be a Business Day); (3) the nature of the proposed amendment; and (4) such other matters as the L/C Issuer may reasonably request.  Additionally, the Borrower shall furnish to the L/C Issuer and the Administrative Agent such other documents and information pertaining to such requested Letter of Credit issuance or amendment, including any Issuer Documents, as the L/C Issuer or the Administrative Agent may request.

 

(ii)                                   Promptly after receipt of any Letter of Credit Application, the L/C Issuer will confirm with the Administrative Agent (by telephone or in writing) that the Administrative Agent has received a copy of such Letter of Credit Application from the Borrower and, if not, the L/C Issuer will provide the Administrative Agent with a copy thereof.  Unless the L/C Issuer has received written notice from any Lender, the Administrative Agent or any Loan Party, at least one Business Day prior to the requested date of issuance or amendment of the applicable Letter of Credit, that one or more applicable conditions contained in Article IV shall not then be satisfied, then, subject to the terms and conditions hereof, the L/C Issuer shall, on the requested date, issue a Letter of Credit for the account of the Borrower (or the applicable Subsidiary) or enter into the applicable amendment, as the case may be, in each case in accordance with the L/C Issuer’s usual and customary business practices.  Immediately upon the issuance of each Letter of Credit, each Lender shall be deemed to, and hereby irrevocably and unconditionally agrees to, purchase from the L/C Issuer a risk participation in such Letter of Credit in an amount equal to the product of such Lender’s Applicable Percentage times the amount of such Letter of Credit.

 

(iii)                                If the Borrower so requests in any applicable Letter of Credit Application, the L/C Issuer may, in its sole and absolute discretion, agree to issue a Letter of Credit that has automatic extension provisions (each, an “ Auto-Extension Letter of Credit ”); provided that any such Auto-Extension Letter of Credit must permit the L/C Issuer to prevent any such extension at least once in each twelve-month period (commencing with the date of issuance of such Letter of Credit) by giving prior notice to the beneficiary thereof not later than a day (the “ Non-Extension Notice Date ”) in each such twelve-month period to be agreed upon at the time such Letter of Credit is issued.  Unless otherwise directed by the L/C Issuer, the Borrower shall not be required to make a specific request to the L/C Issuer for any such extension.  Once an Auto-Extension Letter of Credit has been issued, the Lenders shall be deemed to have authorized (but may not require) the L/C Issuer to permit the extension of such Letter of Credit at any time to an expiry date not later than the Letter of Credit Expiration Date; provided , however , that the L/C Issuer shall not permit any such extension if (A) the L/C Issuer has determined that it would not be permitted, or would have no obligation at such time to issue such Letter of Credit in its revised form (as extended) under the terms hereof (by reason of the provisions of clause (ii) or (iii) of Section 2.03(a)  or otherwise), or (B) it has received notice (which may be by telephone or in writing) on or before the day that is seven Business Days before the Non-Extension Notice Date (1) from the Administrative Agent that the Required Lenders have elected not to permit such extension or (2) from the

 

36



 

Administrative Agent, any Lender or the Borrower that one or more of the applicable conditions specified in Section 4.02 is not then satisfied, and in each such case directing the L/C Issuer not to permit such extension.

 

(iv)                               Promptly after its delivery of any Letter of Credit or any amendment to a Letter of Credit to an advising bank with respect thereto or to the beneficiary thereof, the L/C Issuer will also deliver to the Borrower and the Administrative Agent a true and complete copy of such Letter of Credit or amendment.

 

(c)                                   Drawings and Reimbursements; Funding of Participations .  (i) Upon receipt from the beneficiary of any Letter of Credit of any notice of a drawing under such Letter of Credit, the L/C Issuer shall notify the Borrower and the Administrative Agent thereof.  Not later than 11:00 p.m. on the date of any payment by the L/C Issuer under a Letter of Credit (each such date, an “ Honor Date ”), the Borrower shall reimburse the L/C Issuer through the Administrative Agent in an amount equal to the amount of such drawing.  If the Borrower fails to so reimburse the L/C Issuer by such time, the Administrative Agent shall promptly notify each Lender of the Honor Date, the amount of the unreimbursed drawing (the “ Unreimbursed Amount ”), and the amount of such Lender’s Applicable Percentage thereof.  In such event, the Borrower shall be deemed to have requested a Revolving Credit Borrowing of Base Rate Loans to be disbursed on the Honor Date in an amount equal to the Unreimbursed Amount, without regard to the minimum and multiples specified in Section 2.02 for the principal amount of Base Rate Loans, but subject to the amount of the unutilized portion of the Commitments and the conditions set forth in Section 4.02 (other than the delivery of a Revolving Credit Loan Notice).  Any notice given by the L/C Issuer or the Administrative Agent pursuant to this Section 2.03(c)(i)  may be given by telephone if immediately confirmed in writing; provided that the lack of such an immediate confirmation shall not affect the conclusiveness or binding effect of such notice.

 

(ii)                                   Each Lender shall upon any notice pursuant to Section 2.03(c)(i)  make funds available (and the Administrative Agent may apply Cash Collateral provided for this purpose) for the account of the L/C Issuer at the Administrative Agent’s Office in an amount equal to its Applicable Percentage of the Unreimbursed Amount not later than 12:00 noon on the Business Day specified in such notice by the Administrative Agent, whereupon, subject to the provisions of Section 2.03(c)(iii) , each Lender that so makes funds available shall be deemed to have made a Base Rate Loan to the Borrower in such amount.  The Administrative Agent shall remit the funds so received to the L/C Issuer.

 

(iii)                                With respect to any Unreimbursed Amount that is not fully refinanced by a Revolving Credit Borrowing of Base Rate Loans because the conditions set forth in Section 4.02 cannot be satisfied or for any other reason, the Borrower shall be deemed to have incurred from the L/C Issuer an L/C Borrowing in the amount of the Unreimbursed Amount that is not so refinanced, which L/C Borrowing shall (1) be due and payable on demand (together with interest) and (2) if such L/C Borrowing were incurred because the conditions set forth in Section 4.02 cannot be satisfied, bear interest at the Default Rate. In such event, each Lender’s payment to the Administrative Agent for the account of the L/C Issuer pursuant to Section 2.03(c)(ii)  shall be deemed payment in respect of its participation in such L/C Borrowing and shall constitute an L/C Advance from such Lender in satisfaction of its participation obligation under this Section 2.03 .

 

37



 

(iv)                               Until each Lender funds its Revolving Credit Loan or L/C Advance pursuant to this Section 2.03(c)  to reimburse the L/C Issuer for any amount drawn under any Letter of Credit, interest in respect of such Lender’s Applicable Percentage of such amount shall be solely for the account of the L/C Issuer.

 

(v)                                  Each Lender’s obligation to make Revolving Credit Loans or L/C Advances to reimburse the L/C Issuer for amounts drawn under Letters of Credit, as contemplated by this Section 2.03(c) , shall be absolute and unconditional and shall not be affected by any circumstance, including (A) any setoff, counterclaim, recoupment, defense or other right which such Lender may have against the L/C Issuer, the Borrower or any other Person for any reason whatsoever; (B) the occurrence or continuance of a Default, or (C) any other occurrence, event or condition, whether or not similar to any of the foregoing; provided , however , that each Lender’s obligation to make Revolving Credit Loans pursuant to this Section 2.03(c)  is subject to the conditions set forth in Section 4.02 (other than delivery by the Borrower of a Revolving Credit Loan Notice ).  No such making of an L/C Advance shall relieve or otherwise impair the obligation of the Borrower to reimburse the L/C Issuer for the amount of any payment made by the L/C Issuer under any Letter of Credit, together with interest as provided herein.

 

(vi)                               If any Lender fails to make available to the Administrative Agent for the account of the L/C Issuer any amount required to be paid by such Lender pursuant to the foregoing provisions of this Section 2.03(c)  by the time specified in Section 2.03(c)(ii) , then, without limiting the other provisions of this Agreement, the L/C Issuer shall be entitled to recover from such Lender (acting through the Administrative Agent), on demand, such amount with interest thereon for the period from the date such payment is required to the date on which such payment is immediately available to the L/C Issuer at a rate per annum equal to the greater of the Federal Funds Rate and a rate determined by the L/C Issuer in accordance with banking industry rules on interbank compensation, plus any administrative, processing or similar fees customarily charged by the L/C Issuer in connection with the foregoing.  If such Lender pays such amount (with interest and fees as aforesaid), the amount so paid shall constitute such Lender’s Revolving Credit Loan included in the relevant Committed Borrowing or L/C Advance in respect of the relevant L/C Borrowing, as the case may be.  A certificate of the L/C Issuer submitted to any Lender (through the Administrative Agent) with respect to any amounts owing under this Section 2.03(c)(vi)  shall be conclusive absent manifest error.

 

(d)                                  Repayment of Participations .  (i) At any time after the L/C Issuer has made a payment under any Letter of Credit and has received from any Lender such Lender’s L/C Advance in respect of such payment in accordance with Section 2.03(c) , if the Administrative Agent receives for the account of the L/C Issuer any payment in respect of the related Unreimbursed Amount or interest thereon (whether directly from the Borrower or otherwise, including proceeds of Cash Collateral applied thereto by the Administrative Agent), the Administrative Agent will distribute to such Lender its Applicable Percentage thereof in the same funds as those received by the Administrative Agent.

 

(ii)                                   If any payment received by the Administrative Agent for the account of the L/C Issuer pursuant to Section 2.03(c)(i)  is required to be returned under any of the

 

38



 

circumstances described in Section 10.05 (including pursuant to any settlement entered into by the L/C Issuer in its discretion), each Lender shall pay to the Administrative Agent for the account of the L/C Issuer its Applicable Percentage thereof on demand of the Administrative Agent, plus interest thereon from the date of such demand to the date such amount is returned by such Lender, at a rate per annum equal to the Federal Funds Rate from time to time in effect.  The obligations of the Lenders under this clause shall survive the payment in full of the Obligations and the termination of this Agreement.

 

(e)                                   Obligations Absolute .  The obligation of the Borrower to reimburse the L/C Issuer for each drawing under each Letter of Credit and to repay each L/C Borrowing shall be absolute, unconditional and irrevocable, and shall be paid strictly in accordance with the terms of this Agreement under all circumstances, including the following:

 

(i)                                      any lack of validity or enforceability of such Letter of Credit, this Agreement, or any other Loan Document;

 

(ii)                                   the existence of any claim, counterclaim, setoff, defense or other right that the Borrower or any Subsidiary may have at any time against any beneficiary or any transferee of such Letter of Credit (or any Person for whom any such beneficiary or any such transferee may be acting), the L/C Issuer or any other Person, whether in connection with this Agreement, the transactions contemplated hereby or by such Letter of Credit or any agreement or instrument relating thereto, or any unrelated transaction;

 

(iii)                                any draft, demand, certificate or other document presented under such Letter of Credit proving to be forged, fraudulent, invalid or insufficient in any respect or any statement therein being untrue or inaccurate in any respect; or any loss or delay in the transmission or otherwise of any document required in order to make a drawing under such Letter of Credit;

 

(iv)                               any payment by the L/C Issuer under such Letter of Credit against presentation of a draft or certificate that does not strictly comply with the terms of such Letter of Credit; or any payment made by the L/C Issuer under such Letter of Credit to any Person purporting to be a trustee in bankruptcy, debtor-in-possession, assignee for the benefit of creditors, liquidator, receiver or other representative of or successor to any beneficiary or any transferee of such Letter of Credit, including any arising in connection with any proceeding under any Debtor Relief Law; or

 

(v)                                  any other circumstance or happening whatsoever, whether or not similar to any of the foregoing, including any other circumstance that might otherwise constitute a defense available to, or a discharge of, the Borrower, any of its Subsidiaries or Holdings; provided , however, that nothing contained in this paragraph (e) shall be deemed to constitute a waiver of any remedies of the Borrower in connection with the Letters of Credit or the Borrower’s rights under paragraph (f) below.

 

The Borrower shall promptly examine a copy of each Letter of Credit and each amendment thereto that is delivered to it and, in the event of any claim of noncompliance with the Borrower’s instructions or other irregularity, the Borrower will promptly notify the L/C Issuer.

 

39



 

The Borrower shall be conclusively deemed to have waived any such claim against the L/C Issuer and its correspondents unless such notice is given as aforesaid.

 

(f)                                    Role of L/C Issuer .  Each Lender and the Borrower agree that, in paying any drawing under a Letter of Credit, the L/C Issuer shall not have any responsibility to obtain any document (other than any sight draft, certificates and documents expressly required by the Letter of Credit) or to ascertain or inquire as to the validity or accuracy of any such document or the authority of the Person executing or delivering any such document.  None of the L/C Issuer, the Administrative Agent, any of their respective Related Parties nor any correspondent, participant or assignee of the L/C Issuer shall be liable to any Lender for (i) any action taken or omitted in connection herewith at the request or with the approval of the Lenders or the Required Lenders, as applicable; (ii) any action taken or omitted in the absence of gross negligence or willful misconduct; or (iii) the due execution, effectiveness, validity or enforceability of any document or instrument related to any Letter of Credit or Issuer Document.  The Borrower hereby assumes all risks of the acts or omissions of any beneficiary or transferee with respect to its use of any Letter of Credit; provided , however , that this assumption is not intended to, and shall not, preclude the Borrower’s pursuing such rights and remedies as it may have against the beneficiary or transferee at law or under any other agreement.  None of the L/C Issuer, the Administrative Agent, any of their respective Related Parties nor any correspondent, participant or assignee of the L/C Issuer shall be liable or responsible for any of the matters described in clauses (i) through (v) of Section 2.03(e) ; provided , however , that anything in such clauses to the contrary notwithstanding, the Borrower may have a claim against the L/C Issuer, and the L/C Issuer may be liable to the Borrower, to the extent, but only to the extent, of any direct, as opposed to consequential or exemplary, damages suffered by the Borrower which the Borrower proves were caused by the L/C Issuer’s willful misconduct or gross negligence or the L/C Issuer’s willful failure to pay under any Letter of Credit after the presentation to it by the beneficiary of a sight draft and certificate(s) strictly complying with the terms and conditions of a Letter of Credit.  In furtherance and not in limitation of the foregoing, the L/C Issuer may accept documents that appear on their face to be in order, without responsibility for further investigation, regardless of any notice or information to the contrary, and the L/C Issuer shall not be responsible for the validity or sufficiency of any instrument transferring or assigning or purporting to transfer or assign a Letter of Credit or the rights or benefits thereunder or proceeds thereof, in whole or in part, which may prove to be invalid or ineffective for any reason.  The L/C Issuer may send a Letter of Credit or conduct any communication to or from the beneficiary via the Society for Worldwide Interbank Financial Telecommunication (“ SWIFT ”) message or overnight courier, or any other commercially reasonable means of communicating with a beneficiary.

 

(g)                                   Applicability of ISP; Limitation of Liability .  Unless otherwise expressly agreed by the L/C Issuer and the Borrower when a Letter of Credit is issued, the rules of the ISP shall apply to each Letter of Credit.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, the L/C Issuer shall not be responsible to the Borrower for, and the L/C Issuer’s rights and remedies against the Borrower shall not be impaired by, any action or inaction of the L/C Issuer required or permitted under any law, order, or practice that is required or permitted to be applied to any Letter of Credit or this Agreement, including the Law or any order of a jurisdiction where the L/C Issuer or the beneficiary is located, the practice stated in the ISP or in the decisions, opinions, practice statements, or official commentary of the ICC Banking Commission, the Bankers Association for Finance and Trade - International Financial Services Association (BAFT-IFSA), or the Institute

 

40



 

of International Banking Law & Practice, whether or not any Letter of Credit chooses such law or practice.

 

(h)                                  Letter of Credit Fees .  The Borrower shall pay to the Administrative Agent for the account of each Lender in accordance, subject to Section 2.16 , with its Applicable Percentage a Letter of Credit fee (the “ Letter of Credit Fee ”) each Letter of Credit equal to the Applicable Rate times the daily amount available to be drawn under such Letter of Credit.  For purposes of computing the daily amount available to be drawn under any Letter of Credit, the amount of such Letter of Credit shall be determined in accordance with Section 1.06 .  Letter of Credit Fees shall be (i) due and payable on the first Business Day after the end of each March, June, September and December, commencing with the first such date to occur after the issuance of such Letter of Credit, on the Letter of Credit Expiration Date and thereafter on demand and (ii) computed on a quarterly basis in arrears.  If there is any change in the Applicable Rate during any quarter, the daily amount available to be drawn under each Letter of Credit shall be computed and multiplied by the Applicable Rate separately for each period during such quarter that such Applicable Rate was in effect.  Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein, upon the request of the Required Lenders, while any Event of Default exists under Section 8.01 (a) , (f) , or (g) , all Letter of Credit Fees shall accrue at the Default Rate.

 

(i)                                      Fronting Fee and Documentary and Processing Charges Payable to L/C Issuer .  The Borrower shall pay directly to the L/C Issuer for its own account a fronting fee with respect to each Letter of Credit, at the rate per annum specified in the Fee Letter, computed on the daily amount available to be drawn under such Letter of Credit on a quarterly basis in arrears.  Such fronting fee shall be due and payable on the tenth Business Day after the end of each March, June, September and December in respect of the most recently-ended quarterly period (or portion thereof, in the case of the first payment), commencing with the first such date to occur after the issuance of such Letter of Credit, on the Letter of Credit Expiration Date and thereafter on demand.  For purposes of computing the daily amount available to be drawn under any Letter of Credit, the amount of such Letter of Credit shall be determined in accordance with Section 1.06 .  In addition, the Borrower shall pay directly to the L/C Issuer for its own account the customary issuance, presentation, amendment and other processing fees, and other standard costs and charges, of the L/C Issuer relating to letters of credit as from time to time in effect.  Such customary fees and standard costs and charges are due and payable on demand and are nonrefundable.

 

(j)                                     Conflict with Issuer Documents .  In the event of any conflict between the terms hereof and the terms of any Issuer Document, the terms hereof shall control.

 

(k)                                  Letters of Credit Issued for Subsidiaries .  Notwithstanding that a Letter of Credit issued or outstanding hereunder is in support of any obligations of, or is for the account of, a Subsidiary, the Borrower shall be obligated to reimburse the L/C Issuer hereunder for any and all drawings under such Letter of Credit.  The Borrower hereby acknowledges that the issuance of Letters of Credit for the account of Subsidiaries inures to the benefit of the Borrower, and that the Borrower’s business derives substantial benefits from the businesses of such Subsidiaries.

 

2.04                         Swing Line Loans .  (a)  The Swing Line .  Subject to the terms and conditions set forth herein and in the AutoBorrow Agreement, the Swing Line Lender, in reliance upon the

 

41



 

agreements of the other Lenders set forth in this Section 2.04 , may in its sole discretion make loans (each such loan, a “ Swing Line Loan ”) to the Borrower pursuant to the AutoBorrow Agreement during the Availability Period in an aggregate amount not to exceed at any time outstanding the amount of the Swing Line Sublimit, notwithstanding the fact that such Swing Line Loans, when aggregated with the Applicable Percentage of the Outstanding Amount of Revolving Credit Loans and L/C Obligations of the Lender acting as Swing Line Lender, may exceed the amount of such Lender’s Commitment; provided , however , that (x) after giving effect to any Swing Line Loan, (i) the Total Outstandings shall not exceed the Aggregate Commitments, and (ii) the Revolving Credit Exposure of any Lender shall not exceed such Lender’s Commitment (taking into account each Lender’s Applicable Percentage of such Swing Line Loan), (y) the Borrower shall not use the proceeds of any Swing Line Loan to refinance any outstanding Swing Line Loan, and (z) the Swing Line Lender shall not be under any obligation to make any Swing Line Loan if it shall determine (which determination shall be conclusive and binding absent manifest error) that it has, or by such Credit Extension may have, Fronting Exposure.  Within the foregoing limits, and subject to the other terms and conditions hereof, the Borrower may borrow, prepay, and reborrow Swing Line Loans in each case, pursuant to the AutoBorrow Agreement.  No Lender shall have any rights under the AutoBorrow Agreement (but each Lender shall have the obligation to purchase and fund risk participations in the Swing Line Loans and to refinance Swing Line Loans as provided below).  Each Swing Line Loan shall be a Base Rate Loan.  Immediately upon the making of a Swing Line Loan, each Lender shall be deemed to, and hereby irrevocably and unconditionally agrees to, purchase from the Swing Line Lender a risk participation in such Swing Line Loan in an amount equal to the product of such Lender’s Applicable Percentage times the amount of such Swing Line Loan.

 

(b)                                  Borrowing Procedures Each Swing Line Borrowing, and each prepayment thereof, shall be made as provided in the AutoBorrow Agreement.

 

(c)                                   Refinancing of Swing Line Loans .  (i) The Swing Line Lender at any time in its sole and absolute discretion may request, on behalf of the Borrower (which hereby irrevocably authorizes the Swing Line Lender to so request on its behalf), that each Lender make a Base Rate Loan in an amount equal to such Lender’s Applicable Percentage of the amount of Swing Line Loans then outstanding.  Such request shall be made in writing (which written request shall be deemed to be a Revolving Credit Loan Notice for purposes hereof) and in accordance with the requirements of Section 2.02 , without regard to the minimum and multiples specified therein for the principal amount of Base Rate Loans, but subject to the unutilized portion of the Aggregate Commitments and the conditions set forth in Section 4.02 .  The Swing Line Lender shall furnish the Borrower with a copy of the applicable Revolving Credit Loan Notice promptly after delivering such notice to the Administrative Agent.  Each Lender shall make an amount equal to its Applicable Percentage of the amount specified in such Revolving Credit Loan Notice available to the Administrative Agent in immediately available funds (and the Administrative Agent may apply Cash Collateral available with respect to the applicable Swing Line Loan) for the account of the Swing Line Lender at the Administrative Agent’s Office not later than 12:00 noon on the day specified in such Revolving Credit Loan Notice, whereupon, subject to Section 2.04(c)(ii) , each Lender that so makes funds available shall be deemed to have made a Base Rate Loan to the Borrower in such amount.  The Administrative Agent shall remit the funds so received to the Swing Line Lender.

 

42



 

(ii)                                   If for any reason any Swing Line Loan cannot be refinanced by such a Revolving Credit Borrowing in accordance with Section 2.04(c)(i) , the request for Base Rate Loans submitted by the Swing Line Lender as set forth herein shall be deemed to be a request by the Swing Line Lender that each of the Lenders fund its risk participation in the relevant Swing Line Loan and each Lender’s payment to the Administrative Agent for the account of the Swing Line Lender pursuant to Section 2.04(c)(i)  shall be deemed payment in respect of such participation.

 

(iii)                                If any Lender fails to make available to the Administrative Agent for the account of the Swing Line Lender any amount required to be paid by such Lender pursuant to the foregoing provisions of this Section 2.04(c)  by the time specified in Section 2.04(c)(i) , the Swing Line Lender shall be entitled to recover from such Lender (acting through the Administrative Agent), on demand, such amount with interest thereon for the period from the date such payment is required to the date on which such payment is immediately available to the Swing Line Lender at a rate per annum equal to the greater of the Federal Funds Rate and a rate determined by the Swing Line Lender in accordance with banking industry rules on interbank compensation, plus any administrative, processing or similar fees customarily charged by the Swing Line Lender in connection with the foregoing.  If such Lender pays such amount (with interest and fees as aforesaid), the amount so paid shall constitute such Lender’s Revolving Credit Loan included in the relevant Committed Borrowing or funded participation in the relevant Swing Line Loan, as the case may be.  A certificate of the Swing Line Lender submitted to any Lender (through the Administrative Agent) with respect to any amounts owing under this clause (iii) shall be conclusive absent manifest error.

 

(iv)                               Each Lender’s obligation to make Revolving Credit Loans or to purchase and fund risk participations in Swing Line Loans pursuant to this Section 2.04(c)  shall be absolute and unconditional and shall not be affected by any circumstance, including (A) any setoff, counterclaim, recoupment, defense or other right which such Lender may have against the Swing Line Lender, the Borrower or any other Person for any reason whatsoever, (B) the occurrence or continuance of a Default, or (C) any other occurrence, event or condition, whether or not similar to any of the foregoing; provided , however , that each Lender’s obligation to make Revolving Credit Loans pursuant to this Section 2.04(c)  is subject to the conditions set forth in Section 4.02 .  No such funding of risk participations shall relieve or otherwise impair the obligation of the Borrower to repay Swing Line Loans, together with interest as provided herein.

 

(d)                                  Repayment of Participations .  (i) At any time after any Lender has purchased and funded a risk participation in a Swing Line Loan, if the Swing Line Lender receives any payment on account of such Swing Line Loan, the Swing Line Lender will distribute to such Lender its Applicable Percentage thereof in the same funds as those received by the Swing Line Lender.

 

(ii)                                   If any payment received by the Swing Line Lender in respect of principal or interest on any Swing Line Loan is required to be returned by the Swing Line Lender under any of the circumstances described in Section 10.05 (including pursuant to any settlement entered into by the Swing Line Lender in its discretion), each Lender shall pay to the Swing Line Lender its Applicable Percentage thereof on demand of the

 

43


 

Administrative Agent, plus interest thereon from the date of such demand to the date such amount is returned, at a rate per annum equal to the Federal Funds Rate.  The Administrative Agent will make such demand upon the request of the Swing Line Lender.  The obligations of the Lenders under this clause shall survive the payment in full of the Obligations and the termination of this Agreement.

 

(e)                                   Interest for Account of Swing Line Lender .  The Swing Line Lender shall be responsible for invoicing the Borrower for interest on the Swing Line Loans.  Until each Lender funds its Base Rate Loan or risk participation pursuant to this Section 2.04 to refinance such Lender’s Applicable Percentage of any Swing Line Loan, interest in respect of such Applicable Percentage shall be solely for the account of the Swing Line Lender.

 

(f)                                    Payments Directly to Swing Line Lender .  The Borrower shall make all payments of principal and interest in respect of the Swing Line Loans directly to the Swing Line Lender.

 

(g)                                   Termination of the Swing Line Loan Facility .  The Swing Line Lender may terminate and/or suspend the Swing Line Loan facility in accordance with the AutoBorrow Agreement.  Upon any such termination, the Swing Line Sublimit shall automatically reduce to zero.

 

(h)                                  Acknowledgment .  The Borrower and the Swing Line Lender acknowledge and agree that this Agreement constitutes the “Line of Credit” as defined in the AutoBorrow Agreement.

 

2.05                         Prepayments .  (a)  Optional .  The Borrower may, upon notice to the Administrative Agent, at any time or from time to time voluntarily prepay Revolving Credit Loans in whole or in part without premium or penalty; provided that (A) such notice must be received by the Administrative Agent not later than 12:00 noon (1) three Business Days prior to any date of prepayment of Eurodollar Rate Loans and (2) on the date of prepayment of Base Rate Loans; (B) any prepayment of Eurodollar Rate Loans shall be in a principal amount of $5,000,000 or a whole multiple of $1,000,000 in excess thereof; and (C) any prepayment of Base Rate Loans shall be in a principal amount of $500,000 or a whole multiple of $100,000 in excess thereof or, in each case, if less, the entire principal amount thereof then outstanding.  Each such notice shall specify the date and amount of such prepayment and the Type(s) of Loans to be prepaid and, if Eurodollar Rate Loans are to be prepaid, the Interest Period(s) of such Loans.  The Administrative Agent will promptly notify each Lender of its receipt of each such notice, and of the amount of such Lender’s Applicable Percentage of such prepayment.  If such notice is given by the Borrower, the Borrower shall make such prepayment and the payment amount specified in such notice shall be due and payable on the date specified therein.  Any prepayment of a Revolving Credit Loan shall be accompanied by all accrued interest on the amount prepaid, together with any additional amounts required pursuant to Section 3.05 .  Subject to Section 2.16 , each such prepayment shall be applied to the Revolving Credit Loans of the Lenders in accordance with their respective Applicable Percentages.

 

44



 

(b)                                  Mandatory .

 

(i)                                      If for any reason the Total Outstandings at any time exceed the Aggregate Commitments at such time, the Borrower shall immediately prepay Revolving Credit Loans, Swing Line Loans and L/C Borrowings and/or Cash Collateralize the L/C Obligations (other than the L/C Borrowings) in an aggregate amount equal to such excess.

 

(ii)                                   Upon the occurrence or issuance by the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries of any Indebtedness (other than Indebtedness expressly permitted to be incurred or issued pursuant to Section 7.02 ), the Borrower shall prepay an aggregate principal amount of Loans equal to 100% of all net cash proceeds received therefrom immediately upon receipt thereof by the Borrower or such Subsidiary.

 

(iii)                                If the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries receives any condemnation proceeds or insurance proceeds (other than business interruption insurance proceeds) on account of any Collateral Loss in excess of $2,000,000, then the Borrower shall, promptly upon receipt thereof, apply (or cause the applicable Subsidiary to apply) such proceeds first , as a mandatory prepayment of the then outstanding Revolving Credit Loans, second , if an Event of Default is continuing, to Cash Collateralize the then Outstanding Amount of all L/C Obligations in an amount equal to 100% of the amount thereof, and third , any remaining amounts may be retained by the Borrower or the applicable Subsidiary; provided , however, that if no Event of Default is continuing, the Borrower or the applicable Subsidiary may, at its election, within 12 months after the receipt of such proceeds, replace or repair the equipment, fixed assets or real property in respect of which such proceeds were received; and provided , further, that any cash proceeds not so applied within such 12 month period shall be immediately applied to the prepayment of the Revolving Credit Loans (if any are then outstanding) as set forth in this Section 2.05(b)(iii).

 

(iv)                               Any mandatory prepayments hereunder shall be accompanied by all accrued interest on the amount prepaid together with any additional amounts required pursuant to Section 3.05 .

 

2.06                         Termination or Reduction of Commitments .  The Borrower may, upon notice to the Administrative Agent, terminate the Aggregate Commitments, the Letter of Credit Sublimit or the Swing Line Sublimit, or from time to time permanently reduce the Aggregate Commitments, the Letter of Credit Sublimit or the Swing Line Sublimit; provided that (i) any such notice shall be received by the Administrative Agent not later than 11:00 p.m. five Business Days prior to the date of termination or reduction, (ii) any such partial reduction shall be in an aggregate amount of $10,000,000 or any whole multiple of $1,000,000 in excess thereof and (iii) the Borrower shall not terminate or reduce (A) the Aggregate Commitments if, after giving effect thereto and to any concurrent prepayments hereunder, the Total Outstandings would exceed the Aggregate Commitments, (B) the Letter of Credit Sublimit if, after giving effect thereto, the Outstanding Amount of L/C Obligations not fully Cash Collateralized hereunder would exceed the Letter of Credit Sublimit, or (C) the Swing Line Sublimit if, after giving effect thereto and to any concurrent prepayments hereunder, the Outstanding Amount of Swing Line Loans would exceed the Letter of Credit Sublimit.  The Administrative Agent will promptly notify the Lenders of any termination or reduction of the Letter of Credit Sublimit, Swing Line Sublimit or the

 

45



 

Aggregate Commitments under this Section 2.06 .  Upon any reduction of the Aggregate Commitments, the Commitment of each Lender shall be reduced by such Lender’s Applicable Percentage of such reduction amount.  All fees accrued until the effective date of any termination of the Aggregate Commitments shall be paid on the effective date of such termination.

 

2.07                         Repayment of Loans .  (a)  Revolving Credit Loans .  The Borrower shall repay to the Lenders on the Maturity Date the aggregate principal amount of all Revolving Credit Loans outstanding on such date.

 

(b)                                  Swing Line Loans .  The Borrower shall repay each Swing Line Loan on the earlier to occur of (i) demand therefor by the Swing Line Lender and, (ii) the Maturity Date.

 

2.08                         Interest .  (a) Subject to the provisions of Section 2.08(b) , (i) each Eurodollar Rate Loan shall bear interest on the outstanding principal amount thereof for each Interest Period at a rate per annum equal to the Eurodollar Rate for such Interest Period plus the Applicable Rate; (ii) each Base Rate Loan shall bear interest on the outstanding principal amount thereof from the applicable borrowing date at a rate per annum equal to the Base Rate plus the Applicable Rate; and (iii) each Swing Line Loan shall bear interest on the outstanding principal amount thereof from the applicable borrowing date at a rate per annum equal to (A) the Base Rate plus (B) the Applicable Rate less 0.50%.

 

(b)                                  (i)                                      If any amount of principal of any Loan is not paid when due, whether at stated maturity, by acceleration or otherwise, such amount shall thereafter bear interest at a fluctuating interest rate per annum at all times equal to the Default Rate to the fullest extent permitted by applicable Laws.

 

(ii)                                   If any amount (other than principal of any Loan) payable by the Borrower under any Loan Document is not paid when due (after giving effect to any applicable grace periods), whether at stated maturity, by acceleration or otherwise, then upon the request of the Required Lenders such amount shall thereafter bear interest at a fluctuating interest rate per annum at all times equal to the Default Rate to the fullest extent permitted by applicable Laws.

 

(iii)                                Upon the request of the Required Lenders, while any Event of Default exists (other than as set forth in clauses (b)(i) and (b)(ii) above), the Borrower shall pay interest on the principal amount of all outstanding Obligations hereunder at a fluctuating interest rate per annum at all times equal to the Default Rate to the fullest extent permitted by applicable Laws.

 

(iv)                               Accrued and unpaid interest on past due amounts (including interest on past due interest) shall be due and payable upon demand.

 

(c)                                   Interest on each Loan shall be due and payable in arrears on each Interest Payment Date applicable thereto and at such other times as may be specified herein.  Interest hereunder shall be due and payable in accordance with the terms hereof before and after judgment, and before and after the commencement of any proceeding under any Debtor Relief Law.

 

46



 

2.09                         Fees .  In addition to certain fees described in Sections 2.03(h)  and (i) :

 

(a)                                  Commitment Fee .  The Borrower shall pay to the Administrative Agent for the account of each Lender in accordance with its Applicable Percentage, a commitment fee equal to the Applicable Rate times the actual daily amount by which the Aggregate Commitments exceed the sum of (i) the Outstanding Amount of Revolving Credit Loans and (ii) the Outstanding Amount of L/C Obligations, subject to adjustment as provided in Section 2.16 .  For the avoidance of doubt, the Outstanding Amount of Swing Line Loans shall not be counted towards or considered usage of the Aggregate Commitments for purposes of determining the commitment fee.  The commitment fee shall accrue at all times during the Availability Period, including at any time during which one or more of the conditions in Article IV is not met, and shall be due and payable quarterly in arrears on the last Business Day of each March, June, September and December, commencing December 31, 2012, and on the last day of the Availability Period.  The commitment fee shall be calculated quarterly in arrears, and if there is any change in the Applicable Fee Rate during any quarter, the actual daily amount shall be computed and multiplied by the Applicable Fee Rate separately for each period during such quarter that such Applicable Fee Rate was in effect.

 

(b)                                  Other Fees .  (i) The Borrower shall pay to the Arranger and the Administrative Agent for their own respective accounts fees in the amounts and at the times specified in the Fee Letter.  Such fees shall be fully earned when paid and shall not be refundable for any reason whatsoever.

 

(ii)                                   The Borrower shall pay to the Lenders such fees as shall have been separately agreed upon in writing in the amounts and at the times so specified.  Such fees shall be fully earned when paid and shall not be refundable for any reason whatsoever.

 

2.10                         Computation of Interest and Fees; Retroactive Adjustments of Applicable Rate .  (a) All computations of interest for Base Rate Loans (including Base Rate Loans determined by reference to the Eurodollar Rate) shall be made on the basis of a year of 365 or 366 days, as the case may be, and actual days elapsed.  All other computations of fees and interest shall be made on the basis of a 360-day year and actual days elapsed (which results in more fees or interest, as applicable, being paid than if computed on the basis of a 365-day year).  Interest shall accrue on each Loan for the day on which the Loan is made, and shall not accrue on a Loan, or any portion thereof, for the day on which the Loan or such portion is paid, provided that any Loan that is repaid on the same day on which it is made shall, subject to Section 2.12(a) , bear interest for one day.  Each determination by the Administrative Agent of an interest rate or fee hereunder shall be conclusive and binding for all purposes, absent manifest error.

 

(b)                                  If, as a result of any restatement of or other adjustment to the financial statements of the Borrower or for any other reason, the Borrower or the Lenders determine that (i) the Consolidated Total Leverage Ratio as calculated by the Borrower as of any applicable date was inaccurate and (ii) a proper calculation of the Consolidated Total Leverage Ratio would have resulted in higher pricing for such period, the Borrower shall immediately and retroactively be obligated to pay to the Administrative Agent for the account of the applicable Lenders or the L/C Issuer, as the case may be, promptly on demand by the Administrative Agent (or, after the occurrence of an actual or deemed entry of an order for relief with respect to the Borrower under

 

47



 

the Bankruptcy Code of the United States, automatically and without further action by the Administrative Agent, any Lender or the L/C Issuer), an amount equal to the excess of the amount of interest and fees that should have been paid for such period over the amount of interest and fees actually paid for such period.  This paragraph shall not limit the rights of the Administrative Agent, any Lender or the L/C Issuer, as the case may be, under Section 2.03(c)(iii) , 2.03(h)  or 2.08(b)  or under Article VIII .  The Borrower’s obligations under this paragraph shall survive the termination of the Aggregate Commitments and the repayment of all other Obligations hereunder.

 

2.11                         Evidence of Debt .  (a) The Credit Extensions made by each Lender shall be evidenced by one or more accounts or records maintained by such Lender and by the Administrative Agent in the ordinary course of business.  The accounts or records maintained by the Administrative Agent and each Lender shall be conclusive absent manifest error of the amount of the Credit Extensions made by the Lenders to the Borrower and the interest and payments thereon.  Any failure to so record or any error in doing so shall not, however, limit or otherwise affect the obligation of the Borrower hereunder to pay any amount owing with respect to the Obligations.  In the event of any conflict between the accounts and records maintained by any Lender and the accounts and records of the Administrative Agent in respect of such matters, the accounts and records of the Administrative Agent shall control in the absence of manifest error.  Upon the request of any Lender made through the Administrative Agent, the Borrower shall execute and deliver to such Lender (through the Administrative Agent) a Note, which shall evidence such Lender’s Loans in addition to such accounts or records.  Each Lender may attach schedules to its Note and endorse thereon the date, Type (if applicable), amount and maturity of its Loans and payments with respect thereto.

 

(b)                                  In addition to the accounts and records referred to in Section 2.11(a)  above, each Lender and the Administrative Agent shall maintain in accordance with its usual practice accounts or records evidencing the purchases and sales by such Lender of participations in Letters of Credit and Swing Line Loans.  In the event of any conflict between the accounts and records maintained by the Administrative Agent and the accounts and records of any Lender in respect of such matters, the accounts and records of the Administrative Agent shall control in the absence of manifest error.

 

2.12                         Payments Generally; Administrative Agent’s Clawback .  (a)  General .  All payments to be made by the Borrower shall be made free and clear of and without condition or deduction for any counterclaim, defense, recoupment or setoff.  Except as otherwise expressly provided herein, all payments by the Borrower hereunder shall be made to the Administrative Agent, for the account of the respective Lenders to which such payment is owed, at the Administrative Agent’s Office in Dollars and in immediately available funds not later than 1:00 p.m. on the date specified herein.  The Administrative Agent will promptly distribute to each Lender its Applicable Percentage (or other applicable share as provided herein) of such payment in like funds as received by wire transfer to such Lender’s Lending Office.  All payments received by the Administrative Agent after 1:00 p.m. shall be deemed received on the next succeeding Business Day and any applicable interest or fee shall continue to accrue.  If any payment to be made by the Borrower shall come due on a day other than a Business Day, payment shall be made on the next following Business Day, and such extension of time shall be reflected on computing interest or fees, as the case may be.

 

48



 

(b)                                  (i)                                      Funding by Lenders; Presumption by Administrative Agent .  Unless the Administrative Agent shall have received notice from a Lender prior to the proposed date of any Borrowing of Eurodollar Rate Loans (or, in the case of any Borrowing of Base Rate Loans, prior to 11:00 a.m. on the date of such Borrowing) that such Lender will not make available to the Administrative Agent such Lender’s share of such Borrowing, the Administrative Agent may assume that such Lender has made such share available on such date in accordance with Section 2.02 (or, in the case of a Borrowing of Base Rate Loans, that such Lender has made such share available in accordance with and at the time required by Section 2.02 ) and may, in reliance upon such assumption, make available to the Borrower a corresponding amount.  In such event, if a Lender has not in fact made its share of the applicable Borrowing available to the Administrative Agent, then the applicable Lender and the Borrower severally agree to pay to the Administrative Agent forthwith on demand such corresponding amount in immediately available funds with interest thereon, for each day from and including the date such amount is made available to the Borrower to but excluding the date of payment to the Administrative Agent, at (A) in the case of a payment to be made by such Lender, the greater of the Federal Funds Rate and a rate determined by the Administrative Agent in accordance with banking industry rules on interbank compensation, plus any administrative, processing or similar fees customarily charged by the Administrative Agent in connection with the foregoing, and (B) in the case of a payment to be made by the Borrower, the interest rate applicable to Base Rate Loans.  If the Borrower and such Lender shall pay such interest to the Administrative Agent for the same or an overlapping period, the Administrative Agent shall promptly remit to the Borrower the amount of such interest paid by the Borrower for such period.  If such Lender pays its share of the applicable Borrowing to the Administrative Agent, then the amount so paid shall constitute such Lender’s Loan included in such Borrowing.  Any payment by the Borrower shall be without prejudice to any claim the Borrower may have against a Lender that shall have failed to make such payment to the Administrative Agent.

 

(ii)                                   Payments by Borrower; Presumptions by Administrative Agent .  Unless the Administrative Agent shall have received notice from the Borrower prior to the time at which any payment is due to the Administrative Agent for the account of the Lenders or the L/C Issuer hereunder that the Borrower will not make such payment, the Administrative Agent may assume that the Borrower has made such payment on such date in accordance herewith and may, in reliance upon such assumption, distribute to the Lenders or the L/C Issuer, as the case may be, the amount due.  In such event, if the Borrower has not in fact made such payment, then each of the Lenders or the L/C Issuer, as the case may be, severally agrees to repay to the Administrative Agent forthwith on demand the amount so distributed to such Lender or the L/C Issuer, in immediately available funds with interest thereon, for each day from and including the date such amount is distributed to it to but excluding the date of payment to the Administrative Agent, at the greater of the Federal Funds Rate and a rate determined by the Administrative Agent in accordance with banking industry rules on interbank compensation.

 

A notice of the Administrative Agent to any Lender or the Borrower with respect to any amount owing under this subsection (b) shall be conclusive, absent manifest error.

 

49



 

(c)                                   Failure to Satisfy Conditions Precedent .  If any Lender makes available to the Administrative Agent funds for any Loan to be made by such Lender as provided in the foregoing provisions of this Article II , and such funds are not made available to the Borrower by the Administrative Agent because the conditions to the applicable Credit Extension set forth in Article IV are not satisfied or waived in accordance with the terms hereof, the Administrative Agent shall return such funds (in like funds as received from such Lender) to such Lender, without interest.

 

(d)                                  Obligations of Lenders Several .  The obligations of the Lenders hereunder to make Revolving Credit Loans, to fund participations in Letters of Credit and Swing Line Loans and to make payments pursuant to Section 10.04(c)  are several and not joint.  The failure of any Lender to make any Loan, to fund any such participation or to make any payment under Section 10.04(c)  on any date required hereunder shall not relieve any other Lender of its corresponding obligation to do so on such date, and no Lender shall be responsible for the failure of any other Lender to so make its Loan, to purchase its participation or to make its payment under Section 10.04(c) .

 

(e)                                   Funding Source .  Nothing herein shall be deemed to obligate any Lender to obtain the funds for any Loan in any particular place or manner or to constitute a representation by any Lender that it has obtained or will obtain the funds for any Loan in any particular place or manner.

 

(f)                                    Insufficient Funds .  If at any time insufficient funds are received by and available to the Administrative Agent to pay fully all amounts of principal, L/C Borrowings, interest and fees then due hereunder, such funds shall be applied (i)  first , toward payment of interest and fees then due hereunder, ratably among the parties entitled thereto in accordance with the amounts of interest and fees then due to such parties, and (ii)  second , toward payment of principal and L/C Borrowings then due hereunder, ratably among the parties entitled thereto in accordance with the amounts of principal and L/C Borrowings then due to such parties.

 

2.13                         Sharing of Payments by Lenders .  If any Lender shall, by exercising any right of setoff or counterclaim or otherwise, obtain payment in respect of (a) Obligations due and payable to such Lender hereunder and under the other Loan Documents at such time in excess of its ratable share (according to the proportion of (i) the amount of such Obligations due and payable to such Lender at such time to (ii) the aggregate amount of the Obligations due and payable to all Lenders hereunder and under the other Loan Documents at such time) of payments on account of the Obligations due and payable to all Lenders hereunder and under the other Loan Documents at such time obtained by all the Lenders at such time or (b) Obligations in respect of any of the Facilities owing (but not due and payable) to such Lender hereunder and under the other Loan Documents at such time in excess of its ratable share (according to the proportion of (i) the amount of such Obligations owing (but not due and payable) to such Lender at such time to (ii) the aggregate amount of the Obligations owing (but not due and payable) to all Lenders hereunder and under the other Loan Parties at such time) of payment on account of the Obligations owing (but not due and payable) to all Lenders hereunder and under the other Loan Documents at such time obtained by all of the Lenders at such time then the Lender receiving such greater proportion shall (a) notify the Administrative Agent of such fact, and (b) purchase (for cash at face value) participations in the Revolving Credit Loans and subparticipations in L/C

 

50



 

Obligations and Swing Line Loans of the other Lenders, or make such other adjustments as shall be equitable, so that the benefit of all such payments shall be shared by the Lenders ratably in accordance with the aggregate amount of Obligations then due and payable to the Lenders or owing (but not due and payable) to the Lenders, as the case may be, provided that:

 

(i)                                      if any such participations or subparticipations are purchased and all or any portion of the payment giving rise thereto is recovered, such participations or subparticipations shall be rescinded and the purchase price restored to the extent of such recovery, without interest; and

 

(ii)                                   the provisions of this Section shall not be construed to apply to (A) any payment made by or on behalf of the Borrower pursuant to and in accordance with the express terms of this Agreement (including the application of funds arising from the existence of a Defaulting Lender), (B) the application of Cash Collateral provided for in Section 2.15 , or (C) any payment obtained by a Lender as consideration for the assignment of or sale of a participation in any of its Loans or subparticipations in L/C Obligations or Swing Line Loans to any assignee or participant, other than an assignment to the Borrower or any Affiliate thereof (as to which the provisions of this Section shall apply).

 

The Borrower consents to the foregoing and agrees, to the extent it may effectively do so under applicable Law, that any Lender acquiring a participation pursuant to the foregoing arrangements may exercise against the Borrower rights of setoff and counterclaim with respect to such participation as fully as if such Lender were a direct creditor of the Borrower in the amount of such participation.

 

2.14                         Increase in Commitments .  (a)  Request for Increase .  Provided there exists no Default, upon notice to the Administrative Agent (which shall promptly notify the Lenders), the Borrower may from time to time, request an increase in the Aggregate Commitments by an amount (for all such requests) not exceeding $100,000,000; provided that (i) any such request for an increase shall be in a minimum amount of $10,000,000, and (ii) the Borrower may make a maximum of four such requests.  At the time of sending such notice, the Borrower (in consultation with the Administrative Agent) shall specify the time period within which each Lender is requested to respond.

 

(b)                                  Lender Elections to Increase .  Each Lender shall notify the Administrative Agent within such time period whether or not it agrees to increase its Commitment and, if so, whether by an amount equal to, greater than, or less than its Applicable Percentage of such requested increase.  Any Lender not responding within such time period shall be deemed to have declined to increase its Commitment.

 

(c)                                   Notification by Administrative Agent; Additional Lenders .  The Administrative Agent shall notify the Borrower and each Lender of the Lenders’ responses to each request made hereunder.  At any time that it seeks an increase in the Aggregate Commitments, the Borrower may also invite one or more Persons who are not Lenders to become Lenders (each, an “ Additional Lender ”), subject to the approval of the Administrative Agent, the L/C Issuer and the

 

51



 

Swing Line Lender, pursuant to a joinder agreement in form and substance satisfactory to the Administrative Agent and its counsel.

 

(d)                                  Effective Date and Allocations .  If the Aggregate Commitments are increased in accordance with this Section, the Administrative Agent and the Borrower shall determine the effective date (the “ Revolving Credit Increase Effective Date ”) and the final allocation of such increase.  The Administrative Agent shall promptly notify the Borrower and the Lenders of the final allocation of such increase and the Revolving Credit Increase Effective Date.

 

(e)                                   Conditions to Effectiveness of Increase .  As a condition precedent to such increase, the Borrower shall deliver to the Administrative Agent a certificate of each Loan Party dated as of the Revolving Credit Increase Effective Date (in sufficient copies for each Lender) signed by a Responsible Officer of such Loan Party or the General Partner acting on behalf of such Loan Party (x) certifying and attaching the resolutions adopted by such Loan Party approving or consenting to such increase, and (y) in the case of the Borrower, certifying that, before and after giving effect to such increase, (A) the representations and warranties contained in Article V and the other Loan Documents are true and correct on and as of the Revolving Credit Increase Effective Date, except to the extent that such representations and warranties specifically refer to an earlier date, in which case they are true and correct as of such earlier date, and except that for purposes of this Section 2.14 , the representations and warranties contained in subsections (a) and (b) of Section 5.05 shall be deemed to refer to the most recent statements furnished pursuant to clauses (a) and (b), respectively, of Section 6.01 , and (B) no Default exists.  The Borrower shall prepay any Revolving Credit Loans outstanding on the Revolving Credit Increase Effective Date (and pay any additional amounts required pursuant to Section 3.05 ) to the extent necessary to keep the outstanding Revolving Credit Loans ratable with any revised Applicable Percentages arising from any nonratable increase in the Commitments under this Section.

 

(f)                                    Conflicting Provisions .  This Section shall supersede any provisions in Section 2.13 or 10.01 to the contrary.

 

2.15                         Cash Collateral.

 

(a)                                  Certain Credit Support Events .  If (i) the L/C Issuer has honored any full or partial drawing request under any Letter of Credit and such drawing has resulted in an L/C Borrowing, (ii) as of the Letter of Credit Expiration Date, any L/C Obligation for any reason remains outstanding, (iii) the Borrower shall be required to provide Cash Collateral pursuant to Section 8.02(c) , or (iv) there shall exist a Defaulting Lender, the Borrower shall immediately (in the case of clause (iii)  above) or within one Business Day (in all other cases) following any request by the Administrative Agent or the L/C Issuer, provide Cash Collateral in an amount not less than the applicable Minimum Collateral Amount (determined in the case of Cash Collateral provided pursuant to clause (iv)  above, after giving effect to Section 2.16(a)(iv)  and any Cash Collateral provided by the Defaulting Lender).

 

(b)                                  Grant of Security Interest .  The Borrower, and to the extent provided by any Defaulting Lender, such Defaulting Lender, hereby grants to (and subjects to the control of) the Administrative Agent, for the benefit of the Administrative Agent, the L/C Issuer and the

 

52



 

Lenders, and agrees to maintain, a first priority security interest in all such cash, deposit accounts and all balances therein, and all other property so provided as collateral pursuant hereto, and in all proceeds of the foregoing, all as security for the obligations to which such Cash Collateral may be applied pursuant to Section 2.15(c) .  If at any time the Administrative Agent determines that Cash Collateral is subject to any right or claim of any Person other than the Administrative Agent or the L/C Issuer as herein provided, or that the total amount of such Cash Collateral is less than the Minimum Collateral Amount, the Borrower will, promptly upon demand by the Administrative Agent, pay or provide to the Administrative Agent additional Cash Collateral in an amount sufficient to eliminate such deficiency. All Cash Collateral (other than credit support not constituting funds subject to deposit) shall be maintained in blocked, non-interest bearing deposit accounts at Bank of America. The Borrower shall pay on demand therefor from time to time all customary account opening, activity and other administrative fees and charges in connection with the maintenance and disbursement of Cash Collateral.

 

(c)                                   Application .   Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this Agreement, Cash Collateral provided under any of this Section 2.15 or Sections 2.03 , 2.05 , 2.16 or 8.02 in respect of Letters of Credit shall be held and applied to the satisfaction of the specific L/C Obligations, obligations to fund participations therein (including, as to Cash Collateral provided by a Defaulting Lender, any interest accrued on such obligation) and other obligations for which the Cash Collateral was so provided, prior to any other application of such property as may be provided for herein.

 

(d)                                  Release .  Cash Collateral (or the appropriate portion thereof) provided to reduce Fronting Exposure or to secure other obligations shall be released promptly following (i) the elimination of the applicable Fronting Exposure or other obligations giving rise thereto (including by the termination of Defaulting Lender status of the applicable Lender (or, as appropriate, its assignee following compliance with Section 10.06(b)(vi) )) or (ii) the determination by the Administrative Agent and the L/C Issuer that there exists excess Cash Collateral; provided , however, (x) that Cash Collateral furnished by or on behalf of a Loan Party shall not be released during the continuance of a Default or Event of Default (and following application as provided in this Section 2.15 may be otherwise applied in accordance with Section 8.03 ) and (y) the Person providing Cash Collateral and the L/C Issuer may agree that Cash Collateral shall not be released but instead held to support future anticipated Fronting Exposure or other obligations.

 

2.16                         Defaulting Lenders .  (a)  Adjustments .  Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this Agreement, if any Lender becomes a Defaulting Lender, then, until such time as that Lender is no longer a Defaulting Lender, to the extent permitted by applicable Law:

 

(i)                                      Waivers and Amendments .  Such Defaulting Lender’s right to approve or disapprove any amendment, waiver or consent with respect to this Agreement shall be restricted as set forth in the definition of “Required Lenders” and Section 10.01 .

 

(ii)                                   Defaulting Lender Waterfall .  Any payment of principal, interest, fees or other amounts received by the Administrative Agent for the account of such Defaulting Lender (whether voluntary or mandatory, at maturity, pursuant to Article VIII or otherwise) or received by the Administrative Agent from a Defaulting Lender pursuant to

 

53


 

 

 

Section 10.08 shall be applied at such time or times as may be determined by the Administrative Agent as follows: first , to the payment of any amounts owing by such Defaulting Lender to the Administrative Agent hereunder; second , to the payment on a pro rata basis of any amounts owing by such Defaulting Lender to the L/C Issuer or Swing Line Lender hereunder; third , to Cash Collateralize the L/C Issuer’s Fronting Exposure with respect to such Defaulting Lender in accordance with Section 2.15 ; fourth , as the Borrower may request (so long as no Default or Event of Default exists), to the funding of any Loan in respect of which such Defaulting Lender has failed to fund its portion thereof as required by this Agreement, as determined by the Administrative Agent; fifth , if so determined by the Administrative Agent and the Borrower, to be held in a deposit account and released pro rata in order to (x) satisfy such Defaulting Lender’s potential future funding obligations with respect to Loans under this Agreement and (y) Cash Collateralize the L/C Issuer’s future Fronting Exposure with respect to such Defaulting Lender with respect to future Letters of Credit issued under this Agreement, in accordance with Section 2.15 ; sixth , to the payment of any amounts owing to the Lenders, the L/C Issuer or Swing Line Lender as a result of any judgment of a court of competent jurisdiction obtained by any Lender, the L/C Issuer or the Swing Line Lender against such Defaulting Lender as a result of such Defaulting Lender’s breach of its obligations under this Agreement; seventh , so long as no Default or Event of Default exists, to the payment of any amounts owing to the Borrower as a result of any judgment of a court of competent jurisdiction obtained by the Borrower against such Defaulting Lender as a result of such Defaulting Lender’s breach of its obligations under this Agreement; and eighth , to such Defaulting Lender or as otherwise directed by a court of competent jurisdiction; provided that if (x) such payment is a payment of the principal amount of any Loans or L/C Borrowings in respect of which such Defaulting Lender has not fully funded its appropriate share, and (y) such Loans were made or the related Letters of Credit were issued at a time when the conditions set forth in Section 4.02 were satisfied or waived, such payment shall be applied solely to pay the Loans of, and L/C Obligations owed to, all Non-Defaulting Lenders on a pro rata basis prior to being applied to the payment of any Loans of, or L/C Obligations owed to, such Defaulting Lender until such time as all Loans and funded and unfunded participations in L/C Obligations and Swing Line Loans are held by the Lenders pro rata in accordance with the Commitments hereunder without giving effect to Section 2.16(a)(iv) . Any payments, prepayments or other amounts paid or payable to a Defaulting Lender that are applied (or held) to pay amounts owed by a Defaulting Lender or to post Cash Collateral pursuant to this Section 2.16(a)(ii) shall be deemed paid to and redirected by such Defaulting Lender, and each Lender irrevocably consents hereto.

 

(iii)                                Certain Fees .

 

(A)                                No Defaulting Lender shall be entitled to receive any fee payable under Section 2.09(a)  for any period during which that Lender is a Defaulting Lender (and the Borrower shall not be required to pay any such fee that otherwise would have been required to have been paid to that Defaulting Lender).

 

(B)                                Each Defaulting Lender shall be entitled to receive Letter of Credit Fees for any period during which that Lender is a Defaulting Lender only to the

 

54



 

extent allocable to its Applicable Percentage of the stated amount of Letters of Credit for which it has provided Cash Collateral pursuant to Section 2.15 .

 

(C)                                With respect to any fee payable under Section 2.09(a)  or (b)  or any Letter of Credit Fee not required to be paid to any Defaulting Lender pursuant to clause (A)  or (B)  above, the Borrower shall (x) pay to each Non-Defaulting Lender that portion of any such fee otherwise payable to such Defaulting Lender with respect to such Defaulting Lender’s participation in L/C Obligations or Swing Line Loans that has been reallocated to such Non-Defaulting Lender pursuant to clause (iv)  below, (y) pay to the L/C Issuer and Swing Line Lender, as applicable, the amount of any such fee otherwise payable to such Defaulting Lender to the extent allocable to such L/C Issuer’s or Swing Line Lender’s Fronting Exposure to such Defaulting Lender, and (z) not be required to pay the remaining amount of any such fee.

 

(iv)                               Reallocation of Applicable Percentages to Reduce Fronting Exposure .  All or any part of such Defaulting Lender’s participation in L/C Obligations and Swing Line Loans shall be reallocated among the Non-Defaulting Lenders in accordance with their respective Applicable Percentages (calculated without regard to such Defaulting Lender’s Commitment) but only to the extent that (x) the conditions set forth in Section 4.02 are satisfied at the time of such reallocation (and, unless the Borrower shall have otherwise notified the Administrative Agent at such time, the Borrower shall be deemed to have represented and warranted that such conditions are satisfied at such time), and (y) such reallocation does not cause the aggregate Revolving Credit Exposure of any Non-Defaulting Lender to exceed such Non-Defaulting Lender’s Commitment.  No reallocation hereunder shall constitute a waiver or release of any claim of any party hereunder against a Defaulting Lender arising from that Lender having become a Defaulting Lender, including any claim of a Non-Defaulting Lender as a result of such Non-Defaulting Lender’s increased exposure following such reallocation.

 

(v)                                  Cash Collateral, Repayment of Swing Line Loans .  If the reallocation described in clause (a)(iv)  above cannot, or can only partially, be effected, the Borrower shall, without prejudice to any right or remedy available to it hereunder or under applicable Law, (x) first, prepay Swing Line Loans in an amount equal to the Swing Line Lenders’ Fronting Exposure and (y) second, Cash Collateralize the L/C Issuers’ Fronting Exposure in accordance with the procedures set forth in Section 2.15 .

 

(b)                                  Defaulting Lender Cure .   If the Borrower, the Administrative Agent, Swing Line Lender and the L/C Issuer agree in writing that a Lender is no longer a Defaulting Lender, the Administrative Agent will so notify the parties hereto, whereupon as of the effective date specified in such notice and subject to any conditions set forth therein (which may include arrangements with respect to any Cash Collateral), that Lender will, to the extent applicable, purchase at par that portion of outstanding Loans of the other Lenders or take such other actions as the Administrative Agent may determine to be necessary to cause the Revolving Credit Loans and funded and unfunded participations in Letters of Credit and Swing Line Loans to be held on a pro rata basis by the Lenders in accordance with their Applicable Percentages (without giving effect to Section 2.16(a)(iv) ), whereupon such Lender will cease to be a Defaulting Lender;

 

55



 

provided that no adjustments will be made retroactively with respect to fees accrued or payments made by or on behalf of the Borrower while that Lender was a Defaulting Lender; and provided , further , that except to the extent otherwise expressly agreed by the affected parties, no change hereunder from Defaulting Lender to Lender will constitute a waiver or release of any claim of any party hereunder arising from that Lender’s having been a Defaulting Lender.

 

ARTICLE III.
TAXES, YIELD PROTECTION AND ILLEGALITY

 

3.01                         Taxes .  (a)  Payments Free of Taxes; Obligation to Withhold; Payments on Account of Taxes .  Any and all payments by or on account of any obligation of any Loan Party under any Loan Document shall be made without deduction or withholding for any Taxes, except as required by applicable Laws.  If any applicable Law (as determined in the good faith discretion of an applicable Withholding Agent) requires the deduction or withholding of any Tax from any such payment by a Withholding Agent, then the applicable Withholding Agent shall be entitled to make such deduction or withholding and shall timely pay the full amount deducted or withheld to the relevant Governmental Authority in accordance with applicable Law and, if such Tax is an Indemnified Tax, then the sum payable by the applicable Loan Party shall be increased as necessary so that after such deduction or withholding has been made (including such deductions and withholdings of Indemnified Taxes applicable to additional sums payable under this Section) the applicable Recipient receives an amount equal to the sum it would have received had no such deduction or withholding been made.

 

(b)                                  Payment of Other Taxes by the Borrower .  Without limiting the provisions of subsection (a) above, the Borrower shall timely pay to the relevant Governmental Authority in accordance with applicable Law, or at the option of the Administrative Agent timely reimburse it for the payment of, any Other Taxes.

 

(c)                                   Tax Indemnifications .  (i) The Borrower shall, and does hereby, indemnify each Recipient, and shall make payment in respect thereof within 10 days after demand therefor, for the full amount of any Indemnified Taxes (including Indemnified Taxes imposed or asserted on or attributable to amounts payable under this Section 3.01 ) payable or paid by such Recipient or required to be withheld or deducted from a payment to such Recipient, and any reasonable expenses arising therefrom or with respect thereto, whether or not such Indemnified Taxes were correctly or legally imposed or asserted by the relevant Governmental Authority; provided, however, the Borrower shall not be required to indemnify a Recipient pursuant to this Section 3.01(c) for any Indemnified Taxes unless such Recipient makes written demand on the Borrower for indemnification no later than nine months after the earlier of (i) the date on which the relevant Governmental Authority makes written demand upon such Recipient for payment of such Indemnified Taxes, and (ii) the date on which such Recipient has made payment of such Indemnified Taxes (except that, if the Indemnified Taxes imposed or asserted giving rise to such claims are retroactive, then the nine-month period referred to above shall be extended to include the period of retroactive effect thereof).  A certificate as to the amount of such payment or liability delivered to the Borrower by a Lender (with a copy to the Administrative Agent), or by the Administrative Agent on its own behalf or on behalf of a Lender, shall be conclusive absent manifest error.  The Borrower shall, and does hereby, indemnify the Administrative Agent, and shall make payment in respect thereof within 10 days after demand therefor, for any amount

 

56



 

which a Lender or the L/C Issuer for any reason fails to pay indefeasibly to the Administrative Agent as required pursuant to Section 3.01(c)(ii) below.

 

(ii)                                   Each Lender shall, and does hereby, severally indemnify, and shall make payment in respect thereof within 10 days after demand therefor, to ( x ) the Administrative Agent for any Indemnified Taxes attributable to such Lender (but only to the extent that the Borrower has not already indemnified the Administrative Agent for such Indemnified Taxes and without limiting the obligation of the Borrower to do so), ( y ) the Administrative Agent and the Borrower, as applicable, for any Taxes attributable to such Lender’s failure to comply with the provisions of Section 10.06(d)  relating to the maintenance of a Participant Register and ( z ) the Administrative Agent and the Borrower, as applicable, for any Excluded Taxes attributable to such Lender that are payable or paid by the Administrative Agent or the Borrower in connection with any Loan Document, and any reasonable expenses arising therefrom or with respect thereto, whether or not such Taxes were correctly or legally imposed or asserted by the relevant Governmental Authority.  A certificate as to the amount of such payment or liability delivered to any Lender by the Administrative Agent shall be conclusive absent manifest error.  Each Lender and the L/C Issuer hereby authorizes the Administrative Agent to set off and apply any and all amounts at any time owing to such Lender under this Agreement or any other Loan Document against any amount due to the Administrative Agent under this clause (ii) .

 

(d)                                  Evidence of Payments .  As soon as practicable after any payment of Taxes by the Borrower or the Administrative Agent to a Governmental Authority as provided in this Section 3.01 , the Borrower shall deliver to the Administrative Agent or the Administrative Agent shall deliver to the Borrower, as the case may be, the original or a certified copy of a receipt issued by such Governmental Authority evidencing such payment, a copy of any return reporting such payment or other evidence of such payment reasonably satisfactory to the Borrower or the Administrative Agent, as the case may be.

 

(e)                                   Status of Lenders; Tax Documentation .

 

(i)                                      Any Lender that is entitled to an exemption from or reduction of withholding Tax with respect to payments made under any Loan Document shall deliver to the Borrower and the Administrative Agent, at the time or times reasonably requested by the Borrower or the Administrative Agent, such properly completed and executed documentation reasonably requested by the Borrower or the Administrative Agent as will permit such payments to be made without withholding or at a reduced rate of withholding.  In addition, any Lender, if reasonably requested by the Borrower or the Administrative Agent, shall deliver such other documentation prescribed by applicable Law or reasonably requested by the Borrower or the Administrative Agent as will enable the Borrower or the Administrative Agent to determine whether or not such Lender is subject to backup withholding or information reporting requirements.  Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in the preceding two sentences, the completion, execution and submission of such documentation (other than such documentation set forth in Section 3.01(e)(ii)(A) , (ii)(B)  and ( ii)(C)  below) shall not be required if in the Lender’s reasonable judgment such completion, execution or submission would subject such

 

57



 

Lender to any material unreimbursed cost or expense or would materially prejudice the legal or commercial position of such Lender.

 

(ii)                                   Without limiting the generality of the foregoing,

 

(A)                                any Lender that is a U.S. Person shall deliver to the Borrower and the Administrative Agent on or prior to the date on which such Lender becomes a Lender under this Agreement (and from time to time thereafter upon the reasonable request of the Borrower or the Administrative Agent), executed originals of IRS Form W-9 certifying that such Lender is exempt from U.S. federal backup withholding tax;

 

(B)                                any Foreign Lender shall, to the extent it is legally entitled to do so, deliver to the Borrower and the Administrative Agent (in such number of copies as shall be requested by the recipient) on or prior to the date on which such Foreign Lender becomes a Lender under this Agreement (and from time to time thereafter upon the reasonable request of the Borrower or the Administrative Agent), whichever of the following is applicable:

 

(1)                                  in the case of a Foreign Lender claiming the benefits of an income tax treaty to which the United States is a party (x) with respect to payments of interest under any Loan Document, executed originals of IRS Form W-8BEN establishing an exemption from, or reduction of, U.S. federal withholding Tax pursuant to the “interest” article of such tax treaty and (y) with respect to any other applicable payments under any Loan Document, IRS Form W-8BEN establishing an exemption from, or reduction of, U.S. federal withholding Tax pursuant to the “business profits” or “other income” article of such tax treaty;

 

(2)                                  executed originals of IRS Form W-8ECI;

 

(3)                                  in the case of a Foreign Lender claiming the benefits of the exemption for portfolio interest under Section 881(c) of the Code, (x) a certificate substantially in the form of Exhibit       -1 to the effect that such Foreign Lender is not a “bank” within the meaning of Section 881(c)(3)(A) of the Code, a “10 percent shareholder” of the Borrower within the meaning of Section 881(c)(3)(B) of the Code, or a “controlled foreign corporation” described in Section 881(c)(3)(C) of the Code (a “ U.S. Tax Compliance Certificate ”) and (y) executed originals of IRS Form W-8BEN;

 

(4)                                  to the extent that a Foreign Lender is not the beneficial owner, executed originals of IRS Form W-8IMY, accompanied by IRS Form W-8ECI, IRS Form W-8BEN, a U.S. Tax Compliance Certificate substantially in the form of Exhibit     -2 or Exhibit       -3, IRS Form W-9, and/or other certification documents from each beneficial owner, as applicable; provided that if the Foreign Lender is a partnership and one or

 

58



 

more direct or indirect partners of such Foreign Lender are claiming the portfolio interest exemption, such Foreign Lender may provide a U.S. Tax Compliance Certificate substantially in the form of Exhibit     -4 on behalf of each such direct and indirect partner; or

 

(5)                                  executed originals of any other form prescribed by applicable Laws as a basis for claiming exemption from or a reduction in U.S. Federal withholding tax together with such supplementary documentation as may be prescribed by applicable Laws to permit the Borrower or the Administrative Agent to determine the withholding or deduction required to be made; and

 

(C)                                if a payment made to a Recipient under any Loan Document would be subject to U.S. federal withholding Tax imposed by FATCA if such Recipient were to fail to comply with the applicable reporting requirements of FATCA (including those contained in Section 1471(b) or 1472(b) of the Code, as applicable), such Recipient shall deliver to the Borrower and the Administrative Agent at the time or times prescribed by law and at such time or times reasonably requested by the Borrower or the Administrative Agent such documentation prescribed by applicable law (including as prescribed by Section 1471(b)(3)(C)(i) of the Code) and such additional documentation reasonably requested by the Borrower or the Administrative Agent as may be necessary for the Borrower and the Administrative Agent to comply with their obligations under FATCA and to determine that such Recipient has complied with such Recipient’s obligations under FATCA or to determine the amount to deduct and withhold from such payment.  Solely for purposes of this clause (C), “FATCA” shall include any amendments made to FATCA after the date of this Agreement.

 

Each Lender agrees that if any form or certification it previously delivered pursuant to this Section 3.01 expires or becomes obsolete or inaccurate in any respect, it shall update such form or certification or promptly notify the Borrower and the Administrative Agent in writing of its legal inability to do so.

 

(f)                                    Treatment of Certain Refunds .  Unless required by applicable Laws, at no time shall the Administrative Agent have any obligation to file for or otherwise pursue on behalf of a Lender or the L/C Issuer, or have any obligation to pay to any Lender or the L/C Issuer, any refund of Taxes withheld or deducted from funds paid for the account of such Lender or the L/C Issuer, as the case may be.  If any Recipient determines, in its sole discretion exercised in good faith, that it has received a refund of any Taxes as to which it has been indemnified by the Borrower or with respect to which the Borrower has paid additional amounts pursuant to this Section 3.01 , it shall pay to the Borrower an amount equal to such refund (but only to the extent of indemnity payments made, or additional amounts paid, by the Borrower under this Section 3.01 with respect to the Taxes giving rise to such refund), net of all out-of-pocket expenses (including Taxes) incurred by such Recipient, and without interest (other than any interest paid by the relevant Governmental Authority with respect to such refund), provided that the Borrower, upon the request of the Recipient, agrees to repay the amount paid over to the Borrower (plus any penalties, interest or other charges imposed by the relevant Governmental

 

59



 

Authority) to the Recipient in the event the Recipient is required to repay such refund to such Governmental Authority.  Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this subsection, in no event will the applicable Recipient be required to pay any amount to the Borrower pursuant to this subsection the payment of which would place the Recipient in a less favorable net after-Tax position than such Recipient would have been in if the Tax subject to indemnification and giving rise to such refund had not been deducted, withheld or otherwise imposed and the indemnification payments or additional amounts with respect to such Tax had never been paid.  This subsection shall not be construed to require any Recipient to make available its tax returns (or any other information relating to its taxes that it deems confidential) to the Borrower or any other Person.

 

(g)                                   Defined Terms .  For purposes of this Section 3.01, the term “Lender” includes any L/C Issuer and the term “applicable Law” includes FATCA.

 

3.02                         Survival .  Each party’s obligations under this Section 3.01 shall survive the resignation or replacement of the Administrative Agent or any assignment of rights by, or the replacement of, a Lender or the L/C Issuer, the termination of the Commitments and the repayment, satisfaction or discharge of all other Obligations.

 

3.03                         Illegality .  If any Lender determines that any Law has made it unlawful, or that any Governmental Authority has asserted that it is unlawful, for any Lender or its Lending Office to make, maintain or fund Loans whose interest is determined by reference to the Eurodollar Rate, or to determine or charge interest rates based upon the Eurodollar Rate, or any Governmental Authority has imposed material restrictions on the authority of such Lender to purchase or sell, or to take deposits of, Dollars in the London interbank market, then, on notice thereof by such Lender to the Borrower through the Administrative Agent, (i) any obligation of such Lender to make or continue Eurodollar Rate Loans or to convert Base Rate Loans to Eurodollar Rate Loans shall be suspended, and (ii) if such notice asserts the illegality of such Lender making or maintaining Base Rate Loans the interest rate on which is determined by reference to the Eurodollar Rate component of the Base Rate, the interest rate on which Base Rate Loans of such Lender shall, if necessary to avoid such illegality, be determined by the Administrative Agent without reference to the Eurodollar Rate component of the Base Rate, in each case until such Lender notifies the Administrative Agent and the Borrower that the circumstances giving rise to such determination no longer exist.  Upon receipt of such notice, (x) the Borrower shall, upon demand from such Lender (with a copy to the Administrative Agent), prepay or, if applicable, convert all Eurodollar Rate Loans of such Lender to Base Rate Loans (the interest rate on which Base Rate Loans of such Lender shall, if necessary to avoid such illegality, be determined by the Administrative Agent without reference to the Eurodollar Rate component of the Base Rate), either on the last day of the Interest Period therefor, if such Lender may lawfully continue to maintain such Eurodollar Rate Loans to such day, or immediately, if such Lender may not lawfully continue to maintain such Eurodollar Rate Loans and (y) if such notice asserts the illegality of such Lender determining or charging interest rates based upon the Eurodollar Rate, the Administrative Agent shall during the period of such suspension compute the Base Rate applicable to such Lender without reference to the Eurodollar Rate component thereof until the Administrative Agent is advised in writing by such Lender that it is no longer illegal  for such Lender to determine or charge interest rates based upon the

 

60



 

Eurodollar Rate.  Upon any such prepayment or conversion, the Borrower shall also pay accrued interest on the amount so prepaid or converted.

 

3.04                         Inability to Determine Rates .  If the Required Lenders determine that for any reason in connection with any request for a Eurodollar Rate Loan or a conversion to or continuation thereof that (a) Dollar deposits are not being offered to banks in the London interbank eurodollar market for the applicable amount and Interest Period of such Eurodollar Rate Loan, (b) adequate and reasonable means do not exist for determining the Eurodollar Rate for any requested Interest Period with respect to a proposed Eurodollar Rate Loan or in connection with an existing or proposed Base Rate Loan, or (c) the Eurodollar Rate for any requested Interest Period with respect to a proposed Eurodollar Rate Loan does not adequately and fairly reflect the cost to such Lenders of funding such Loan, the Administrative Agent will promptly so notify the Borrower and each Lender.  Thereafter, (x) the obligation of the Lenders to make or maintain Eurodollar Rate Loans shall be suspended, and (y) in the event of a determination described in the preceding sentence with respect to the Eurodollar Rate component of the Base Rate, the utilization of the Eurodollar Rate component in determining the Base Rate shall be suspended, in each case until the Administrative Agent (upon the instruction of the Required Lenders) revokes such notice.  Upon receipt of such notice, the Borrower may revoke any pending request for a Borrowing of, conversion to or continuation of Eurodollar Rate Loans or, failing that, will be deemed to have converted such request into a request for a Committed Borrowing of Base Rate Loans in the amount specified therein.

 

3.05                         Increased Costs .  (a)  Increased Costs Generally .  If any Change in Law shall:

 

(i)                                      impose, modify or deem applicable any reserve, special deposit, compulsory loan, insurance charge or similar requirement against assets of, deposits with or for the account of, or credit extended or participated in by, any Lender (except any reserve requirement contemplated by Section 3.04(e) ) or the L/C Issuer;

 

(ii)                                   subject any Recipient to any Taxes (other than (A) Indemnified Taxes, (B) Taxes described in clauses (b) through (d) of the definition of Excluded Taxes and (C) Connection Income Taxes) on its loans, loan principal, letters of credit, commitments, or other obligations, or its deposits, reserves, other liabilities or capital attributable thereto; or

 

(iii)                                impose on any Lender or the L/C Issuer or the London interbank market any other condition, cost or expense affecting this Agreement or Eurodollar Rate Loans made by such Lender or any Letter of Credit or participation therein;

 

and the result of any of the foregoing shall be to increase the cost to such Lender of making, converting to, continuing or maintaining any Loan the interest on which is determined by reference to the Eurodollar Rate (or of maintaining its obligation to make any such Loan), or to increase the cost to such Lender or the L/C Issuer of participating in, issuing or maintaining any Letter of Credit (or of maintaining its obligation to participate in or to issue any Letter of Credit), or to reduce the amount of any sum received or receivable by such Lender or the L/C Issuer hereunder (whether of principal, interest or any other amount) then, upon request of such Lender or the L/C Issuer, the Borrower will pay to such Lender or the L/C Issuer, as the case may be,

 

61



 

such additional amount or amounts as will compensate such Lender or the L/C Issuer, as the case may be, for such additional costs incurred or reduction suffered.

 

(b)                                  Capital Requirements .  If any Lender or the L/C Issuer determines that any Change in Law affecting such Lender or the L/C Issuer or any Lending Office of such Lender or such Lender’s or the L/C Issuer’s holding company, if any, regarding capital or liquidity requirements has or would have the effect of reducing the rate of return on such Lender’s or the L/C Issuer’s capital or on the capital of such Lender’s or the L/C Issuer’s holding company, if any, as a consequence of this Agreement, the Commitments of such Lender or the Loans made by, or participations in Letters of Credit or Swing Line Loans held by, such Lender, or the Letters of Credit issued by the L/C Issuer, to a level below that which such Lender or the L/C Issuer or such Lender’s or the L/C Issuer’s holding company could have achieved but for such Change in Law (taking into consideration such Lender’s or the L/C Issuer’s policies and the policies of such Lender’s or the L/C Issuer’s holding company with respect to capital adequacy), then from time to time the Borrower will pay to such Lender or the L/C Issuer, as the case may be, such additional amount or amounts as will compensate such Lender or the L/C Issuer or such Lender’s or the L/C Issuer’s holding company for any such reduction suffered.

 

(c)                                   Certificates for Reimbursement .  A certificate of a Lender or the L/C Issuer setting forth the amount or amounts necessary to compensate such Lender or the L/C Issuer or its holding company, as the case may be, as specified in subsection (a) or (b) of this Section and delivered to the Borrower shall be conclusive absent manifest error.  The Borrower shall pay such Lender or the L/C Issuer, as the case may be, the amount shown as due on any such certificate within 10 days after receipt thereof.

 

(d)                                  Delay in Requests .  Failure or delay on the part of any Lender or the L/C Issuer to demand compensation pursuant to the foregoing provisions of this Section 3.04 shall not constitute a waiver of such Lender’s or the L/C Issuer’s right to demand such compensation, provided that the Borrower shall not be required to compensate a Lender or the L/C Issuer pursuant to the foregoing provisions of this Section for any increased costs incurred or reductions suffered more than nine months prior to the date that such Lender or the L/C Issuer, as the case may be, notifies the Borrower of the Change in Law giving rise to such increased costs or reductions and of such Lender’s or the L/C Issuer’s intention to claim compensation therefor (except that, if the Change in Law giving rise to such increased costs or reductions is retroactive, then the nine-month period referred to above shall be extended to include the period of retroactive effect thereof).

 

3.06                         Compensation for Losses .  Upon demand of any Lender (with a copy to the Administrative Agent) from time to time, the Borrower shall promptly compensate such Lender for and hold such Lender harmless from any loss, cost or expense incurred by it as a result of:

 

(a)                                  any continuation, conversion, payment or prepayment of any Loan other than a Base Rate Loan on a day other than the last day of the Interest Period for such Loan (whether voluntary, mandatory, automatic, by reason of acceleration, or otherwise);

 

62



 

(b)                                  any failure by the Borrower (for a reason other than the failure of such Lender to make a Loan) to prepay, borrow, continue or convert any Loan other than a Base Rate Loan on the date or in the amount notified by the Borrower; or

 

(c)                                   any assignment of a Eurodollar Rate Loan on a day other than the last day of the Interest Period therefor as a result of a request by the Borrower pursuant to Section 10.13 ;

 

including any loss of anticipated profits and any loss or expense arising from the liquidation or reemployment of funds obtained by it to maintain such Loan or from fees payable to terminate the deposits from which such funds were obtained.  The Borrower shall also pay any customary administrative fees charged by such Lender in connection with the foregoing.

 

For purposes of calculating amounts payable by the Borrower to the Lenders under this Section 3.05 , each Lender shall be deemed to have funded each Eurodollar Rate Loan made by it at the Eurodollar Rate for such Loan by a matching deposit or other borrowing in the London interbank eurodollar market for a comparable amount and for a comparable period, whether or not such Eurodollar Rate Loan was in fact so funded.

 

3.07                         Mitigation Obligations; Replacement of Lenders .  (a)  Designation of a Different Lending Office .  If any Lender requests compensation under Section 3.04 , or requires the Borrower to pay any Indemnified Taxes or additional amounts to any Lender, the L/C Issuer, or any Governmental Authority for the account of any Lender or the L/C Issuer pursuant to Section 3.01 , or if any Lender gives a notice pursuant to Section 3.02 , then at the request of the Borrower such Lender or the L/C Issuer shall, as applicable, use reasonable efforts to designate a different Lending Office for funding or booking its Loans hereunder or to assign its rights and obligations hereunder to another of its offices, branches or affiliates, if, in the judgment of such Lender or the L/C Issuer, such designation or assignment (i) would eliminate or reduce amounts payable pursuant to Section 3.01 or 3.04 , as the case may be, in the future, or eliminate the need for the notice pursuant to Section 3.02 , as applicable, and (ii) in each case, would not subject such Lender or the L/C Issuer, as the case may be, to any unreimbursed cost or expense and would not otherwise be disadvantageous to such Lender or the L/C Issuer, as the case may be.  The Borrower hereby agrees to pay all reasonable costs and expenses incurred by any Lender or the L/C Issuer in connection with any such designation or assignment.

 

(b)                                  Replacement of Lenders .  If any Lender requests compensation under Section 3.04 , or if the Borrower is required to pay any Indemnified Taxes or additional amounts to any Lender or any Governmental Authority for the account of any Lender pursuant to Section 3.01 and, in each case, such Lender has declined or is unable to designate a different lending office in accordance with Section 3.06(a) , the Borrower may replace such Lender in accordance with Section 10.13 .

 

3.08                         Survival .  All of the Borrower’s obligations under this Article III shall survive termination of the Aggregate Commitments, repayment of all other Obligations hereunder, and resignation of the Administrative Agent.

 

63


 

ARTICLE IV.
CONDITIONS PRECEDENT TO CREDIT EXTENSIONS

 

4.01        Conditions of Initial Credit Extension .  The obligation of the L/C Issuer and each Lender to enter into this Agreement is subject to satisfaction of the following conditions precedent:

 

(a)                                  The Administrative Agent’s receipt of the following, each of which shall be originals or telecopies (followed promptly by originals) unless otherwise specified, each properly executed by a Responsible Officer of Holdings, the General Partner or the signing Loan Party, as applicable, each dated the Closing Date (or, in the case of certificates of governmental officials, a recent date before the Closing Date) and each in form and substance satisfactory to the Administrative Agent and each of the Lenders:

 

(i)                                      executed counterparts of this Agreement, the Holdings Guaranty and the Subsidiary Guaranty, sufficient in number for distribution to the Administrative Agent, each Lender and the Borrower;

 

(ii)                                   executed counterparts of the AutoBorrow Agreement;

 

(iii)                                a Note executed by the Borrower in favor of each Lender requesting a Note;

 

(iv)                               the Security Agreement duly executed by each Loan Party, together with:

 

(A)                                certificates representing the pledged Equity Interests referred to therein accompanied by undated stock powers executed in blank and instruments evidencing any pledged Indebtedness required to be delivered pursuant to the thresholds set forth in Section 6.12 indorsed in blank,

 

(B)                                proper financing statements in form appropriate for filing under the Uniform Commercial Code of all jurisdictions that the Administrative Agent may deem necessary or desirable in order to perfect the Liens created under the Security Agreement, covering the Collateral described in the Security Agreement (including, to the extent applicable, receipt of UCC-3 termination statements and “control” (within the meaning of Section 8-106 of the UCC) with respect to uncertificated securities),

 

(C)                                copies of all Uniform Commercial Code, judgment and tax lien searches with respect to the personal property Collateral, together with copies of the financing statements (or similar documents) disclosed by such searches, and accompanied by evidence that any Liens indicated in any such financing statements that are not permitted by Section 7.01 have been or contemporaneously will be released or terminated (or otherwise provided for in a manner reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent), and

 

(D)                                the Susser Consent, duly executed by each party thereto;

 

(v)                                  such certificates of resolutions or other action, incumbency certificates and/or other certificates of Responsible Officers of the General Partner, the Borrower and each Guarantor as the Administrative Agent may require evidencing the identity,

 

64



 

authority and capacity of each Responsible Officer thereof authorized to act as a Responsible Officer in connection with this Agreement and the other Loan Documents to which the Borrower or such Guarantor is a party or is to be a party;

 

(vi)                               such documents and certifications as the Administrative Agent may reasonably require to evidence that the Borrower, the General Partner and each Guarantor is duly organized or formed, and that each such Person is validly existing, in good standing and qualified to engage in business in each jurisdiction where its ownership, lease or operation of properties or the conduct of its business requires such qualification;

 

(vii)                            a favorable opinion of Vinson & Elkins LLP, counsel to the Loan Parties, addressed to the Administrative Agent and each Lender, as to the matters concerning the General Partner, Holdings, the Loan Parties and the Loan Documents as the Required Lenders may reasonably request;

 

(viii)                         a certificate of a Responsible Officer of the Borrower on behalf of all Loan Parties either (A) certifying that it has received all material consents, licenses and approvals required in connection with the consummation by such Loan Party or Loan Parties of the Transaction and the execution, delivery and performance by the Borrower and each Guarantor and the validity against the Borrower or such Guarantor of the Loan Documents to which it is a party, and such consents, licenses and approvals are in full force and effect, or (B) stating that no such consents, licenses or approvals are so required;

 

(ix)                               a certificate signed by a Responsible Officer of the Borrower certifying that (A) the conditions specified in Sections 4.02(a) and (b) have been satisfied and (B) that there has been no event or circumstance since the date of the Audited Financial Statements that has had a Material Adverse Effect;

 

(x)                                  the Audited Financial Statements and the Closing Date Financial Statements;

 

(xi)                               forecasts prepared by management of the Borrower as to the Borrower and its Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, including consolidated balance sheets and statements of income or operations and cash flows of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries on an annual basis for each of the fiscal years ending December 31, 2012 through December 31, 2017;

 

(xii)                            certificates attesting to the Solvency of the Borrower, individually and together with its Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, before and after giving effect to the execution and delivery of the Loan Documents, any Credit Extension to be made on the Closing Date and the consummation of the Transaction, from the chief financial officer of the Borrower;

 

(xiii)                         at least three (3) Business Days prior to the Closing Date, all documentation and other information with respect to the General Partner, Holdings and the Loan Parties required by regulatory authorities under applicable “know-your-

 

65



 

customer” and anti-money laundering rules and regulations, including without limitation, the Act;

 

(xiv)                        evidence that all insurance required to be maintained pursuant to the Loan Documents has been obtained and is in effect, together with the certificates of insurance and endorsements, naming the Administrative Agent, on behalf of the Lenders, as an additional insured or loss payee, as the case may be, under all insurance policies maintained with respect to the assets and properties of the Loan Parties that constitutes Collateral on the Closing Date;

 

(xv)                           evidence that the Existing Susser Credit Agreement has been, or concurrently with the Closing Date is, amended to permit the Transaction and the transactions contemplated by the Loan Documents; and

 

(xvi)                        such other assurances, certificates, documents, consents, reports or opinions as the Administrative Agent, the L/C Issuer, the Swing Line Lender or any Lender reasonably may require.

 

(b)                                  (i) All fees required to be paid to the Administrative Agent and the Arranger on or before the Closing Date shall have been paid and (ii) all fees required to be paid to the Lenders on or before the Closing Date shall have been paid.

 

(c)                                   Unless waived by the Administrative Agent, the Borrower shall have paid all fees, charges and disbursements of counsel to the Administrative Agent (directly to such counsel if requested by the Administrative Agent) to the extent invoiced prior to or on the Closing Date, plus such additional amounts of such fees, charges and disbursements as shall constitute its reasonable estimate of such fees, charges and disbursements incurred or to be incurred by it through the closing proceedings ( provided that such estimate shall not thereafter preclude a final settling of accounts between the Borrower and the Administrative Agent).

 

(d)                                  Other than as permitted by Section 7.02 and any Indebtedness incurred pursuant to this Agreement, after giving effect to the Transaction and the transactions contemplated hereby, no third-party indebtedness for borrowed money of the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries shall remain outstanding as of the Closing Date.

 

(e)                                   There shall be no actions, suits, proceedings, claims or disputes ongoing, pending or, to the knowledge of the Borrower, threatened in any court or conducted before or by any arbitrator or Governmental Authority, by or against Holdings, the General Partner, the Borrower or any of their respective Subsidiaries that (i) purport to affect or pertain to the Transaction, this Agreement or any other Loan Document, or the extensions of credit contemplated hereby or (ii) either individually or in the aggregate could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

(f)                                    The Loan Parties shall have provided true, correct, and complete copies of all Material Contracts to the Administrative Agent and the Lenders to the extent not previously provided, and the Administrative Agent and the Lenders shall be satisfied in their reasonable discretion with their review thereof.  None of the terms or conditions to closing of any party set forth in the Material Contracts shall have been amended, modified or supplemented without the

 

66



 

prior written consent of the Administrative Agent and all conditions to closing stated therein shall have been satisfied or, with the prior written consent of the Administrative Agent, waived (except to the extent such amendments, modifications, supplements or conditions to closing which have been waived, individually or in the aggregate, could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect).

 

(g)                                   The Transaction shall have been, or concurrently with the Closing Date be, completed in accordance with the terms of the Transfer Documents and applicable Law.

 

Without limiting the generality of the provisions of the last paragraph of Section 9.03 , for purposes of determining compliance with the conditions specified in this Section 4.01 , each Lender that has signed this Agreement shall be deemed to have consented to, approved or accepted or to be satisfied with, each document or other matter required thereunder to be consented to or approved by or acceptable or satisfactory to a Lender unless the Administrative Agent shall have received notice from such Lender prior to the proposed Closing Date specifying its objection thereto.

 

4.02                         Conditions to all Credit Extensions .  The obligation of each Lender to honor any Request for Credit Extension (other than a Revolving Credit Loan Notice requesting only a conversion of Revolving Credit Loans to the other Type, or a continuation of Eurodollar Rate Loans) is subject to the following conditions precedent:

 

(a)                                  The representations and warranties of the Borrower contained in Article V or any other Loan Document, or which are contained in any document furnished at any time under or in connection herewith or therewith, shall be true and correct in all material respects (except for such representations and warranties that have a materiality or Material Adverse Effect qualification, which shall be true and correct in all respects) on and as of the date of such Credit Extension, except to the extent that such representations and warranties specifically refer to an earlier date, in which case they shall be true and correct in all material respects (except for such representations and warranties that have a materiality or Material Adverse Effect qualification, which shall be true and correct in all respects) as of such earlier date, and except that for purposes of this Section 4.02 , the representations and warranties contained in Sections 5.05(a) and (b) shall be deemed to refer to the most recent statements furnished pursuant to Sections 6.01(a) and (b) , respectively.

 

(b)                                  No Default shall exist, or would result from such proposed Credit Extension or from the application of the proceeds thereof.

 

(c)                                   The Administrative Agent and, if applicable, the L/C Issuer or the Swing Line Lender shall have received a Request for Credit Extension in accordance with the requirements hereof.

 

Each Request for Credit Extension (other than a Revolving Credit Loan Notice requesting only a conversion of Revolving Credit Loans to the other Type or a continuation of Eurodollar Rate Loans) submitted by the Borrower shall be deemed to be a representation and warranty that the conditions specified in Sections 4.02(a) and (b) have been satisfied on and as of the date of the applicable Credit Extension.

 

67



 

ARTICLE V.
REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

 

The Borrower represents and warrants to the Administrative Agent and the Lenders that:

 

5.01                         Existence, Qualification and Power .  Each Loan Party and each of its Subsidiaries (a) is duly organized or formed, validly existing and, as applicable, in good standing under the Laws of the jurisdiction of its incorporation or organization, (b) has all requisite power and authority and all requisite governmental licenses, authorizations, consents and approvals to (i) own or lease its assets and carry on its business and (ii) execute, deliver and perform its obligations under the Loan Documents and Transfer Documents to which it is a party and consummate the Transaction, and (c) is duly qualified and is licensed and, as applicable, in good standing under the Laws of each jurisdiction where its ownership, lease or operation of properties or the conduct of its business requires such qualification or license; except in each case referred to in clause (b)(i) or (c), to the extent that failure to do so could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

5.02                         Authorization; No Contravention .  The execution, delivery and performance by each Loan Party of each Loan Document and Transfer Document to which such Person is or is to be a party have been duly authorized by all necessary corporate or other organizational action, and do not and will not (a) contravene the terms of any of such Person’s Organization Documents; (b) result in the creation of any Lien (other than the Lien created pursuant to the Loan Documents), conflict with or result in any breach or contravention of, or require any payment to be made under (i) any material note, indenture, credit agreement, security agreement, credit support agreement, or other similar agreement to which any Loan Party is a party or any Material Contract (ii) any order, injunction, writ or decree of any Governmental Authority or any arbitral award to which such Person or its property is subject; or (c) violate any Law applicable to such Person or its property.

 

5.03                         Governmental Authorization; Other Consents .  No approval, consent, exemption, authorization, or other action by, or notice to, or filing with, any Governmental Authority or any other Person is necessary or required in connection with (a) the execution, delivery or performance by, or enforcement against, any Loan Party of this Agreement or any other Loan Document or Transfer Document, or for the consummation of the Transaction, (b) the grant by any Loan Party of the Liens granted by it pursuant to the Collateral Documents, (c) the perfection or maintenance of the Liens created under the Collateral Documents (including the first priority nature thereof subject to the Liens permitted under Section 7.01 ) or (d) the exercise by the Administrative Agent or any Lender of its rights under the Loan Documents or the remedies in respect of the Collateral pursuant to the Collateral Documents except for (i) the authorizations, approvals, actions, notices and filings which have been duly obtained, taken, given or made and are in full force and effect and (ii) authorizations, approvals, actions, notices and filings which are not required by the express terms of the Collateral Documents to be taken or delivered by any Loan Party as of the Closing Date.  All applicable waiting periods in connection with the Transaction have expired without any action having been taken by any Governmental Authority restraining, preventing or imposing materially adverse conditions upon the Transaction or the rights of the Loan Parties or their Subsidiaries freely to transfer or

 

68



 

otherwise dispose of, or to create any Lien on, any properties now owned or hereafter acquired by any of them.

 

5.04                         Binding Effect .  This Agreement has been, and each other Loan Document, when delivered hereunder, will have been, duly executed and delivered by each Loan Party that is party thereto.  This Agreement constitutes, and each other Loan Document when so delivered will constitute, a legal, valid and binding obligation of such Loan Party, enforceable against each Loan Party that is party thereto in accordance with its terms, except as may be limited by any applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium, or similar laws affecting creditors’ rights generally or by general principles of equity.

 

5.05                         Financial Statements; No Material Adverse Effect .  (a) The Audited Financial Statements (i) were prepared in accordance with GAAP consistently applied throughout the period covered thereby, except as otherwise expressly noted therein; (ii) fairly present the financial condition of the Borrower’s Predecessor and its Subsidiaries as of the date thereof and their results of operations for the period covered thereby in accordance with GAAP consistently applied throughout the period covered thereby, except as otherwise expressly noted therein; and (iii) show all material indebtedness and other liabilities, direct or contingent, of the Borrower’s Predecessor and its Subsidiaries as of the date thereof, including liabilities for taxes, material commitments and Indebtedness.

 

(b)                                  The Closing Date Financial Statements were prepared on the basis of assumptions, data, information, tests, or conditions believed to be reasonable at the time such Closing Date Financial Statements were furnished.  The Closing Date Financial Statements fairly presents in all material respects the financial position of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries as of date thereof and after giving effect to the Transaction and were prepared in accordance with GAAP (except as otherwise noted therein) consistently applied.

 

(c)                                   Since the date of the Audited Financial Statements, there has been no event or circumstance, either individually or in the aggregate, that has had or could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

(d)                                  The consolidated forecasted balance sheets, statements of income and cash flows of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries delivered pursuant to Section 4.01 or Section 6.01(c) were prepared in good faith on the basis of the assumptions stated therein, which assumptions were fair in light of the conditions existing at the time of delivery of such forecasts, and represented, at the time of delivery, the Borrower’s best estimate of its future financial condition and performance (it being understood that such forecasts are estimates and are subject to significant uncertainties and contingencies, and that actual results during the period or periods covered by any such forecasts may differ significantly from the projected results and such differences may be material).

 

5.06                         Litigation .  As of the Closing Date, there are no actions, suits, proceedings, claims or disputes pending or, to the knowledge of the Borrower, threatened or contemplated, at law, in equity, in arbitration or before any Governmental Authority, by or against Holdings, the General Partner, the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries or against any of their properties or revenues that (a) purport to adversely affect or enjoin, prohibit or restrain this Agreement

 

69



 

(including the extensions of credit hereby), any other Loan Document, any Transfer Document or the consummation of the Transaction or (b) either individually or in the aggregate, if determined adversely, could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.  Since the Closing Date, there are no actions, suits, proceedings, claims or disputes pending or, to the knowledge of the Borrower, threatened or contemplated, at law, in equity, in arbitration or before any Governmental Authority, by or against Holdings, the General Partner, the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries or against any of their properties or revenues that either individually or in the aggregate, if determined adversely, could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

5.07                         No Default .  Neither any Loan Party nor any Subsidiary thereof is in default under or with respect to, or a party to, any Contractual Obligation that could, either individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.  No Default has occurred and is continuing or would result from the consummation of the Transaction, the transactions contemplated by this Agreement or any other Loan Document.

 

5.08                         Ownership of Real Property; Liens .  Each Loan Party and each of its Subsidiaries has good record and indefeasible title in fee simple to, or valid leasehold interests in, all real property necessary or used in the ordinary conduct of its business, except for defects that, individually or in the aggregate, (i) do not materially interfere with the ordinary conduct of its business or (ii) could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.  None of such property is subject to any Lien, except for Liens permitted by Section 7.01 .

 

5.09                         Environmental Compliance .  (a) The Loan Parties and their respective Subsidiaries in the ordinary course of business evaluate the effect of existing Environmental Laws and claims alleging potential liability or responsibility for violation of any Environmental Law on their respective businesses, operations and properties, and as a result thereof the Borrower has reasonably concluded that such Environmental Laws and claims could not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.  Prior to contributing the applicable Contributed Assets, the Contributing Affiliates evaluated the effect of existing and proposed Environmental Laws and known or suspected Environmental Liabilities on their respective businesses, operations and properties, and as a result thereof the Borrower has concluded that such Environmental Laws and Environmental Liabilities could not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

(b)                                  None of the properties currently or formerly owned or operated by any Loan Party or any of its Subsidiaries is listed or proposed for listing on the NPL or on the CERCLIS or any analogous foreign, state or local list.  Except as could not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, (i) there are no and never have been any surface impoundments, septic tanks, pits, sumps or lagoons in which Hazardous Materials are being or have been treated, stored or disposed on any property currently owned or operated by any Loan Party or any of its Subsidiaries or, to the best of the knowledge of the Loan Parties, on any property formerly owned or operated by any Loan Party or any of its Subsidiaries, (ii) there is no asbestos or asbestos-containing material on any property currently owned or operated by any Loan Party or any of its Subsidiaries, and (iii) Hazardous Materials have not been released, discharged or disposed of on any property currently or formerly owned or operated by any Loan Party or any of its Subsidiaries.

 

70



 

(c)                                   Except for matters that, either individually or in the aggregate, could not reasonably expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, (i) neither any Loan Party nor any of its Subsidiaries is undertaking, and has not completed, either individually or together with other potentially responsible parties, any investigation or assessment or remedial or response action relating to any actual or threatened release, discharge or disposal of Hazardous Materials at any site, location or operation, either voluntarily or pursuant to the order of any Governmental Authority or the requirements of any Environmental Law; and all Hazardous Materials generated, used, treated, handled or stored at, or transported to or from, any property currently or formerly owned or operated by any Loan Party or any of its Subsidiaries have been disposed of in a manner not reasonably expected to result in material liability to any Loan Party or any of its Subsidiaries; and (ii) prior to contributing the applicable Contributed Assets, and with respect to the Contributed Assets only, neither any Contributing Affiliate nor any of its Subsidiaries had undertaken, and had not completed, either individually or together with other potentially responsible parties, any investigation or assessment or remedial or response action relating to any actual, threatened, or suspected release, discharge or disposal of Hazardous Materials at any site, location or operation, either voluntarily or pursuant to the order of any Governmental Authority or the requirements of any Environmental Law; and all Hazardous Materials generated, used, treated, handled or stored at, or transported to or from, any property owned or operated at or prior to the time of the contribution of the applicable Contributed Assets by any Contributing Affiliate or any of its Subsidiaries were disposed of in a manner not reasonably expected to result in any Environmental Liability to any Contributing Affiliate or any of its Subsidiaries.

 

(d)                                  Except for matters that, individually or in the aggregate, could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, (i) the Loan Parties and their Subsidiaries are and have been in compliance with all applicable Environmental Laws and are not subject to any pending or threatened claim or proceeding relating to Environmental Laws or Hazardous Materials, and (ii) prior to contributing the applicable Contributed Assets and with respect to the Contributed Assets only, the Contributing Affiliates were in compliance with all applicable Environmental Laws and were not subject to any pending or threatened claim or proceeding relating to Environmental Laws or Hazardous Materials.

 

(e)                                   Except for matters that, individually or in the aggregate, could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, (i) the Borrower and each of its Subsidiaries (A) have obtained all Environmental Permits necessary for the ownership and operation of its real properties and the conduct of its Business, which are in full force and effect; (B) have been and are in compliance with all terms and conditions of such Environmental Permits; and (C) have not received written notice of any violation or alleged violation of any Environmental Permit, and (ii) prior to contributing the applicable Contributed Assets, each of the Contributing Affiliates (A) had obtained all Environmental Permits necessary for the ownership and operation of the Contributed Assets, which were in full force and effect at such time; (B) were in compliance with all terms and conditions of such Environmental Permits; and (C) had not received written notice of any violation or alleged violation of any Environmental Permit.

 

5.10                         Insurance .  The properties of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries are insured with financially sound and reputable insurers, in such amounts, with such deductibles and covering such risks (including as to self-insurance) as are customarily carried by companies engaged in

 

71



 

similar businesses and owning similar properties in localities where the Borrower or the applicable Subsidiary operates.

 

5.11                         Taxes .  The Borrower and its Subsidiaries have filed (or caused to be filed) all Federal, state and other material tax returns required to be filed, and have paid all material Federal, state and other taxes, assessments, fees and other governmental charges levied or imposed upon them or their properties, income or assets otherwise due and payable, except those which are being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings diligently conducted and for which adequate reserves have been provided in accordance with GAAP.  There is no proposed tax assessment against the Borrower or any Subsidiary that would, if made, have a Material Adverse Effect.  The charges, accruals and revenues on the books of the Borrower and each Subsidiary are adequate.  Neither any Loan Party nor any Subsidiary thereof is party to any tax sharing agreement except as set forth on Schedule 5.11 .

 

5.12                         ERISA Compliance .  (a) Each Plan is in compliance with the applicable provisions of ERISA, the Code and other Federal or state laws, except for failures to be in such compliance that, individually or in the aggregate, could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.  Each Pension Plan that is intended to be a qualified plan under Section 401(a) of the Code has received a favorable determination or opinion letter from the Internal Revenue Service to the effect that the form of such Plan is qualified under Section 401(a) of the Code and the trust related thereto has been determined by the Internal Revenue Service to be exempt from federal income tax under Section 501(a) of the Code, or an application for such a letter is currently being processed by the Internal Revenue Service.  To the knowledge of the Borrower, nothing has occurred that would prevent or cause the loss of such tax-qualified status.

 

(b)                                  There are no pending or, to the knowledge of the Borrower, threatened claims, actions or lawsuits, or action by any Governmental Authority, with respect to any Plan that could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.  There has been no prohibited transaction or violation of the fiduciary responsibility rules with respect to any Plan that has resulted or could reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect.

 

(c)                                   (i) No ERISA Event has occurred, and neither the Borrower nor any ERISA Affiliate is aware of any fact, event or circumstance that could reasonably be expected to constitute or result in an ERISA Event with respect to any Pension Plan; (ii) the Borrower and each ERISA Affiliate has met all applicable requirements under the Pension Funding Rules in respect of each Pension Plan, and no waiver of the minimum funding standards under the Pension Funding Rules has been applied for or obtained; (iii) neither the Borrower nor any ERISA Affiliate has incurred any liability to the PBGC other than for the payment of premiums, and there are no premium payments which have become due that are unpaid; (iv) neither the Borrower nor any ERISA Affiliate has engaged in a transaction that could be subject to Section 4069 or Section 4212(c) of ERISA; and (v) no Pension Plan has been terminated by the plan administrator thereof nor by the PBGC, and no event or circumstance has occurred or exists that could reasonably be expected to cause the PBGC to institute proceedings under Title IV of ERISA to terminate any Pension Plan, which in the case of the items listed in clauses (i) through (v) above, could, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to result in liability of the Borrower in an aggregate amount in excess of the Threshold Amount.

 

72



 

5.13                         Subsidiaries; Equity Interests; Loan Parties .  As of the Closing Date, the Borrower has no Subsidiaries other than those specifically disclosed in Part (a) of Schedule 5.13 , and all of the outstanding Equity Interests in such Subsidiaries have been validly issued, are fully paid and non-assessable and are owned by a Loan Party in the amounts specified on Part (a) of Schedule 5.13 free and clear of all Liens except those created under the Collateral Documents.  As of the Closing Date , no Loan Party has any equity investments in any other corporation or entity other than those specifically disclosed in Part (b) of Schedule 5.13 .  Set forth on Part (c) of Schedule 5.13 is a complete and accurate list of all Loan Parties, showing as of the Closing Date (as to each Loan Party) the jurisdiction of its incorporation, the address of its principal place of business and its U.S. taxpayer identification number.

 

5.14                         Margin Regulations; Investment Company Act .  (a) The Borrower is not engaged and will not engage, principally or as one of its important activities, in the business of purchasing or carrying margin stock (within the meaning of Regulation U issued by the FRB), or extending credit for the purpose of purchasing or carrying margin stock.  None of the proceeds of any Credit Extension hereunder will be used by the Borrower or any Subsidiary to purchase or carry margin stock (within the meaning of Regulation U issued by the FRB) .

 

(b)                                  None of the Borrower, any Person Controlling the Borrower, or any Subsidiary is or is required to be registered as an “ investment company ” under the Investment Company Act of 1940.

 

5.15                         Disclosure .  The Borrower has disclosed to the Administrative Agent and the Lenders all agreements, instruments and corporate or other restrictions to which it or any of its Subsidiaries is subject, and all other matters known to it, that, individually or in the aggregate, could reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect.  No report, financial statement, certificate or other written information (other than third-party data and information of a general nature made available in any electronic data room) furnished by or on behalf of any Loan Party to the Administrative Agent or any Lender in connection with the transactions contemplated hereby and the negotiation of this Agreement or delivered hereunder or under any other Loan Document (in each case as modified or supplemented by other information so furnished) contains, as of the date such information was furnished (or, if such information expressly relates to an earlier date, such earlier date) any material misstatement of fact or omits to state any material fact necessary to make the statements therein, in the light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading taken as a whole; provided that with respect to projected financial information, the Borrower represents only that such information was prepared in good faith based upon assumptions believed to be reasonable at the time (it being understood that such forecasts are estimates and are subject to significant uncertainties and contingencies, and that actual results during the period or periods covered by any such forecasts may differ significantly from the projected results and such differences may be material).

 

5.16                         Compliance with Laws .  Each Loan Party and each Subsidiary thereof is in compliance in all material respects with the requirements of all Laws and all orders, writs, injunctions and decrees applicable to it or to its properties, except in such instances in which (a) such requirement of Law or order, writ, injunction or decree is being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings diligently conducted or (b) the failure to comply therewith, either

 

73


 

individually or in the aggregate, could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

5.17                         Intellectual Property; Licenses, Etc .  The Borrower and each of its Subsidiaries own, or possess the right to use, all of the trademarks, service marks, trade names, copyrights, patents, patent rights, franchises, licenses and other intellectual property rights that are reasonably necessary for the operation of their respective businesses, without conflict with the rights of any other Person.  No claim or litigation regarding any of the foregoing is pending or, to the best knowledge of the Borrower, threatened, which, either individually or in the aggregate, could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

5.18                         Material Contracts.   Schedule 5.18 sets forth an accurate and complete list of all Material Contracts (including all amendments thereto) in effect on or as of the Closing Date to which Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries is a party or is bound (other than the Loan Documents, the Susser Contribution Agreement, the Susser Distribution Contract, the Susser Omnibus Agreement, and the Susser Transportation Contract)).  Complete copies of such documents have been made available to the Administrative Agent.  All Material Contracts are in full force and effect and have not been terminated (except any such Material Contract that has expired by its terms) and neither Borrower nor any of its Subsidiaries is in default thereunder, and to their knowledge, there is no uncured default by any counterparty thereto.  None of the Material Contracts prohibit the transactions contemplated hereby.

 

5.19                         Solvency .  The Borrower, individually and together with the each other Loan Party on a consolidated basis, is Solvent.

 

5.20                         Casualty, Etc .  Neither the businesses nor the properties of any Loan Party or any of its Subsidiaries are affected by any fire, explosion, accident, strike, lockout or other labor dispute, drought, storm, hail, earthquake, embargo, act of God or of the public enemy or other casualty (whether or not covered by insurance) that, either individually or in the aggregate, could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

5.21                         Collateral Documents .  The provisions of the Collateral Documents are effective to create in favor of the Administrative Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties a legal, valid and enforceable first priority Lien (subject to Liens permitted by Section 7.01 ) on all right, title and interest of the respective Loan Parties in the Collateral described therein.  Except for filings to be made on or after the Closing Date and as contemplated hereby and by the Collateral Documents, no filing or other action will be necessary to perfect such Liens (except for any such filings or other actions not required by the express terms of the Collateral Documents to be taken as of the Closing Date).

 

ARTICLE VI.
AFFIRMATIVE COVENANTS

 

So long as any Lender shall have any Commitment hereunder, any Loan or other Obligation hereunder shall remain unpaid or unsatisfied, or any Letter of Credit shall remain outstanding, the Borrower shall, and shall (except in the case of the covenants set forth in Sections 6.01 , 6.02 , 6.03 and 6.11 ) cause each Subsidiary to:

 

74



 

6.01                         Financial Statements .  Deliver to the Administrative Agent, in form and detail satisfactory to the Administrative Agent:

 

(a)                                  as soon as available, but in any event within 90 days after the end of each fiscal year of the Borrower, a consolidated balance sheet of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries as at the end of such fiscal year, and the related consolidated statements of income or operations, changes in partnership equity, and cash flows for such fiscal year, setting forth in each case in comparative form the figures for the previous fiscal year, all in reasonable detail and prepared in accordance with GAAP, such consolidated statements to be audited and accompanied by a report and opinion of an independent certified public accountant of nationally recognized standing reasonably acceptable to the Required Lenders, which report and opinion shall be prepared in accordance with generally accepted auditing standards and shall not be subject to any “ going concern ” or like qualification or exception or any qualification or exception as to the scope of such audit;

 

(b)                                  Beginning with the fiscal quarter ending December 31, 2012, as soon as available, but in any event within 45 days after the end of each of the first three fiscal quarters of each fiscal year of the Borrower, a consolidated balance sheet of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries as at the end of such fiscal quarter, and the related consolidated statements of income or operations, changes in partnership equity, and cash flows for such fiscal quarter and for the portion of the Borrower’s fiscal year then ended, setting forth in each case in comparative form the figures for the corresponding fiscal quarter of the previous fiscal year and the corresponding portion of the previous fiscal year, all in reasonable detail, such consolidated statements to be certified by a Responsible Officer of the Borrower as fairly presenting the financial condition, results of operations, partnership equity and cash flows of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries in accordance with GAAP, subject only to normal year-end audit adjustments and the absence of footnotes;

 

(c)                                   as soon as available, but in any event within 90 days after the end of each fiscal year of the Borrower, an annual business plan and budget of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, including forecasts prepared by management of the Borrower, in form satisfactory to the Administrative Agent and the Required Lenders, of consolidated balance sheets and statements of income or operations and cash flows of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries on an annual basis for the immediately following fiscal year (including the fiscal year in which the Maturity Date occurs).

 

As to any information contained in materials furnished pursuant to Section 6.02(c) , the Borrower shall not be separately required to furnish such information under Section 6.01(a) or (b) above, but the foregoing shall not be in derogation of the obligation of the Borrower to furnish the information and materials described in Sections 6.01(a) and (b) above at the times specified therein.

 

6.02                         Certificates; Other Information .  Deliver to the Administrative Agent, in form and detail satisfactory to the Administrative Agent:

 

(a)                                  concurrently with the delivery of the financial statements referred to in Sections 6.01(a) and (b) , a duly completed Compliance Certificate signed by a Responsible Officer of the Borrower, which shall include a description in detail reasonably satisfactory to the

 

75



 

Administrative Agent of all promissory notes, including intercompany promissory notes, including between or among any of the Loan Parties or a Loan Party and any Affiliate of a Loan Party and received by a Loan Party since the date of the previous Compliance Certificate to the extent required to be pledged by a Loan Party pursuant to the Collateral Documents (in each case, which delivery may, unless the Administrative Agent, or a Lender requests executed originals, be by electronic communication including fax or email and shall be deemed to be an original authentic counterpart thereof for all purposes;

 

(b)                                  [Reserved];

 

(c)                                   promptly after the same are available, copies of each annual report, proxy or financial statement or other report or communication sent to the stockholders, partners or members (or the equivalent of any thereof) of any Loan Party, and copies of all annual, regular, periodic and special reports and registration statements which the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries may file or be required to file with the SEC under Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, or with any national securities exchange, and in any case not otherwise required to be delivered to the Administrative Agent pursuant hereto;

 

(d)                                  promptly after the furnishing or receipt thereof, (i) copies of any material statement or report furnished to any holder of debt securities in a principal amount greater than the Threshold Amount of any Loan Party or of any of its Subsidiaries, or (ii) any notice received from any holder of debt securities in a principal amount greater than the Threshold Amount of any Loan Party or of any of its Subsidiaries, pursuant to the terms of any indenture, loan or credit or similar agreement, in each case, regarding or related to any material breach or default by the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries or any change of control (as defined in such agreement);

 

(e)                                   Upon request from the Administrative Agent, a report summarizing the insurance coverage (specifying type, amount and carrier) in effect for each Loan Party and its Subsidiaries and containing such additional information as the Administrative Agent, or any Lender through the Administrative Agent, may reasonably specify;

 

(f)                                    [Reserved];

 

(g)                                   [Reserved];

 

(h)                                  promptly after the assertion or occurrence thereof, notice of any action or proceeding against or of any noncompliance by any Loan Party or any of its Subsidiaries with any Environmental Law or Environmental Permit that could (i) reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect or (ii) cause any real property described in any Collateral Documents to be subject to any new and material restrictions on ownership, occupancy, use or transferability under any Environmental Law;

 

(i)                                      at least concurrently with the closing thereof, notice of any acquisition or divestiture by the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries of any assets or properties in excess of $15,000,000; provided that the Borrower shall not be required to deliver any notice or documentation pursuant to this paragraph with respect to any Permitted Sale/Leaseback Transactions;

 

76



 

(j)                                     promptly upon its becoming available, copies of all notices or documents received by the Borrower or any Loan Party pursuant to any Material Contract alleging a material default or nonperformance by such Person thereunder or terminating or suspending any such Material Contract to the extent any of the foregoing could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect;

 

(k)                                  concurrently with the designation of any Wholly Owned Subsidiary as an Immaterial Subsidiary, a written notice of such designation signed by a Responsible Officer of the Borrower (which delivery may, unless the Administrative Agent requests executed originals, be by electronic communication including fax or email and shall be deemed to be an original authentic counterpart thereof for all purposes), and if requested by the Administrative Agent, the consolidating financial information of such Immaterial Subsidiary accompanied by a certificate signed by a Responsible Officer of the Borrower certifying that such consolidating financial information fairly presents in all material respects the consolidated financial condition of such Immaterial Subsidiary;

 

(l)                                      if the Borrower elects to have a Specified Acquisition Period apply with respect to a Specified Acquisition, written notice of such election concurrently with the delivery of the Compliance Certificate required under Section 6.02(b) for the fiscal quarter during which the Specified Acquisition occurred; and

 

(m)                              promptly, such additional information regarding the business, financial, legal or corporate affairs of any Loan Party or any Subsidiary thereof, or compliance with the terms of the Loan Documents, as the Administrative Agent or any Lender may from time to time reasonably request.

 

Documents required to be delivered pursuant to Section 6.01(a) or (b) or Section 6.02(c) (to the extent any such documents are included in materials otherwise filed with the SEC) may be delivered electronically and if so delivered, shall be deemed to have been delivered on the date (i) on which the Borrower posts such documents, or provides a link thereto on the Borrower’s website on the Internet at the website address listed on Schedule 10.02 ; or (ii) on which such documents are posted on the Borrower’s behalf on an Internet or intranet website, if any, to which each Lender and the Administrative Agent have access (whether a commercial, third-party website or whether sponsored by the Administrative Agent).  The Administrative Agent shall have no obligation to request the delivery of or to maintain paper copies of the documents referred to above, and in any event shall have no responsibility to monitor compliance by the Borrower with any such request by a Lender for delivery, and each Lender shall be solely responsible for requesting delivery to it or maintaining its copies of such documents.

 

The Borrower hereby acknowledges that (a) the Administrative Agent and/or the Arranger may, but shall not be obligated to, make available to the Lenders and the L/C Issuer materials and/or information provided by or on behalf of the Borrower hereunder (collectively, “ Borrower Materials ”) by posting the Borrower Materials on Debt Domain, IntraLinks, Syndtrak or another similar electronic system (the “ Platform ”) and (b) certain of the Lenders (each, a “ Public Lender ”) may have personnel who do not wish to receive material non-public information with respect to the Borrower or its Affiliates, or the respective securities of any of the foregoing, and who may be engaged in investment and other market-related activities with respect to such

 

77



 

Persons’ securities.  The Borrower hereby agrees that it will use commercially reasonable efforts to identify that portion of the Borrower Materials that may be distributed to the Public Lenders and that (w) all such Borrower Materials shall be clearly and conspicuously marked “ PUBLIC ” which, at a minimum, shall mean that the word “ PUBLIC ” shall appear prominently on the first page thereof; (x) by marking Borrower Materials “ PUBLIC ,” the Borrower shall be deemed to have authorized the Administrative Agent, the Arranger, the L/C Issuer and the Lenders to treat such Borrower Materials as not containing any material non-public information (although it may be sensitive and proprietary) with respect to the Borrower or its securities for purposes of United States Federal and state securities laws ( provided , however , that to the extent such Borrower Materials constitute Information, they shall be treated as set forth in Section 10.07 ); (y) all Borrower Materials marked “ PUBLIC ” are permitted to be made available through a portion of the Platform designated “ Public Side Information ;” and (z) the Administrative Agent and the Arranger shall be entitled to treat any Borrower Materials that are not marked “ PUBLIC ” as being suitable only for posting on a portion of the Platform not designated “ Public Side Information .”

 

6.03                         Notices .  Promptly notify the Administrative Agent and each Lender:

 

(a)                                  of the occurrence of any Default;

 

(b)                                  of any matter that has resulted or could reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect;

 

(c)                                   of the occurrence of any ERISA Event;

 

(d)                                  of any material change in accounting policies or financial reporting practices by any Loan Party or any Subsidiary thereof, including any determination by the Borrower referred to in Section 2.10(b) ; and

 

(e)                                   of the occurrence of any Collateral Loss affecting property with a fair market value in excess of $5,000,000 (or where lost revenues of the Loan Parties related to Collateral Loss could reasonably be expected to exceed $5,000,000 or which Collateral Loss is otherwise material to the operations of the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries).

 

Each notice pursuant to Section 6.03 (other than Section 6.03(e) ) shall be accompanied by a statement of a Responsible Officer of the Borrower setting forth details of the occurrence referred to therein and stating what action the Borrower has taken and proposes to take with respect thereto.  Each notice pursuant to Section 6.03(a) shall describe with particularity any and all provisions of this Agreement and any other Loan Document that have been breached.

 

6.04                         Payment of Obligations .  Pay and discharge as the same shall become due and payable, all material tax liabilities, assessments and governmental charges or levies upon it or its properties or assets, unless the same are being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings diligently conducted and adequate reserves in accordance with GAAP are being maintained by the Borrower or such Subsidiary..

 

6.05                         Preservation of Existence, Etc .  (a)  Preserve, renew and maintain in full force and effect its legal existence and good standing under the Laws of the jurisdiction of its

 

78



 

organization except in a transaction permitted by Section 7.04 or 7.05 ; (b) take all reasonable action to maintain all rights, privileges, permits, licenses and franchises necessary or desirable in the normal conduct of its business, except to the extent that failure to do so could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect; and (c) preserve or renew all of its registered patents, trademarks, trade names and service marks, the non-preservation of which could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

6.06                         Maintenance of Properties .  (a) Maintain, preserve and protect (or cause to be maintained, preserved and protected) all of its material properties necessary in the operation of its business in good working order and condition, ordinary wear and tear excepted; and (b) make or cause to be made all necessary repairs thereto and renewals and replacements thereof except where the failure to do so could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect; and (c) use the standard of care typical in the industry in the operation and maintenance of its facilities.

 

6.07                         Maintenance of Insurance; Flood Insurance .

 

(a)                                  Maintain with financially sound and reputable insurers reasonably acceptable to the Administrative Agent, insurance with respect to its properties and business against loss or damage of the kinds customarily insured against by Persons engaged in the same or similar business, of such types and in such amounts (after giving effect to any self-insurance) as are customarily carried under similar circumstances by such other Persons and providing for not less than 30 days’ prior notice to the Administrative Agent of termination, lapse or cancellation of such insurance.

 

(b)                                  With respect to properties that are subject to a Mortgage and on which Buildings or Manufactured Mobile Homes (each as defined in the Flood Insurance Regulations) are located (where such improvements are subject to such Mortgage), the Borrower will, and will cause its Subsidiaries to provide the Administrative Agent, with a standard flood hazard determination form for such property, and obtain flood insurance in such total amount as the Administrative Agent or the Required Lenders may from time to time reasonably require, if at any time the area in which any improvements located on any properties that are subject to a Mortgage (where such improvements are subject to such Mortgage) are within a “flood hazard area” in any Flood Insurance Rate Map published by the Federal Emergency Management Agency (or any successor agency), and otherwise comply with the Flood Insurance Regulations.  In addition, to the extent the Borrower or any Subsidiary fails to obtain or maintain satisfactory flood insurance required pursuant to the preceding sentence with respect to any relevant property, the Administrative Agent shall be permitted, in its sole discretion, to obtain forced placed insurance at the Borrower’s expense to ensure compliance with any applicable flood insurance Laws.

 

6.08                         Compliance with Laws .  Comply in all material respects with the requirements of all Laws and all orders, writs, injunctions and decrees applicable to it or to its business or property, except in such instances in which (a) such requirement of Law or order, writ, injunction or decree is being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings diligently conducted; or (b) the failure to comply therewith could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

79



 

6.09                         Books and Records .  (a) Maintain proper books of record and account, in which full, true and correct entries in conformity with GAAP consistently applied shall be made of all financial transactions and matters involving the assets and business of the Borrower or such Subsidiary, as the case may be; and (b) maintain such books of record and account in material conformity with all applicable requirements of any Governmental Authority having regulatory jurisdiction over the Borrower or such Subsidiary, as the case may be.

 

6.10                         Inspection Rights .  Permit representatives and independent contractors of the Administrative Agent and, at any time an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, the Lenders, to visit and inspect any of its properties, to examine its corporate, financial and operating records, and make copies thereof or abstracts therefrom, and to discuss its affairs, finances and accounts with its directors, officers, and independent public accountants, all at such reasonable times during normal business hours and as often as reasonably requested; provided that except during the continuation of an Event of Default, such visits and inspections shall not occur more than once in any calendar year, and provided further that the Borrower is given at least three Business Days’ advance notice thereof and reasonable opportunity to be present when independent public accountants or other third parties are contacted.

 

6.11                         Use of Proceeds .  Use the proceeds of the initial Credit Extension on the Closing Date for the payment of fees and expenses relating to this Agreement and the Borrower IPO; and thereafter, use the proceeds of the other Credit Extensions for working capital, capital expenditures, acquisitions, Restricted Payments permitted pursuant to Section 7.06 and other general corporate purposes not in contravention of any Law or of any Loan Document.

 

6.12                         Covenant to Guarantee Obligations and Give Security .  (a) Upon the formation or acquisition of any new direct or indirect Wholly-Owned Subsidiary (other than any CFC, any Subsidiary that is held directly or indirectly by a CFC or any Immaterial Subsidiary) by any Loan Party (for the purpose of this paragraph, reference to such formation or acquisition shall include any Wholly Owned Subsidiary that ceases to be an Immaterial Subsidiary), then the Borrower shall, at the Borrower’s expense:

 

(i)                                      within 30 days after such formation or acquisition (or such longer period as the Administrative Agent may determine in its sole discretion), cause such Subsidiary, and cause each direct and indirect parent of such Subsidiary (if it has not already done so), to duly execute and deliver to the Administrative Agent a guaranty or guaranty supplement, in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent, guaranteeing the Obligations,

 

(ii)                                   within 30 days after such formation or acquisition (or such longer period as the Administrative Agent may determine in its sole discretion), furnish to the Administrative Agent a summary description of the material real property, promissory notes (or other instruments), the Equity Interests and, if requested by the Administrative Agent, other personal properties of such Subsidiary, in detail reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent,

 

(iii)                                within 30 days after such formation or acquisition (or such longer period as the Administrative Agent may determine in its sole discretion), cause such Subsidiary

 

80



 

and each direct and indirect parent of such Subsidiary (if it has not already done so) to duly execute and deliver to the Administrative Agent security agreement supplements, and other security and pledge agreements, as specified by and in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent (including, to the extent certificated, delivery of all pledged Equity Interests in and of such Subsidiary, securing payment of all the Obligations and constituting Liens on all the personal property of the type constituting Collateral of such Subsidiary or such parent,

 

(iv)                               within 30 days after such formation or acquisition (or such longer period as the Administrative Agent may determine in its sole discretion), cause such Subsidiary and each direct and indirect parent of such Subsidiary (if it has not already done so) to take whatever action may be necessary or advisable in the opinion of the Administrative Agent to vest in the Administrative Agent (or in any representative of the Administrative Agent designated by it) valid and subsisting Liens on the Collateral purported to be subject to the security agreement supplements and security and pledge agreements delivered pursuant to this Section 6.12 , enforceable against all third parties in accordance with their terms; provided that the actions required under this paragraph shall be limited in any event to (1) the filing of UCC financing statements in such Subsidiary’s jurisdiction of organization, (2) delivery of certificates representing any pledged Equity Interests consisting of certificated securities with appropriate transfer powers, (3) delivery of promissory notes or instruments with appropriate endorsements to the extent required to be delivered pursuant to the Collateral Documents (provided that the aggregate amount of all promissory notes payable to the Borrower and its Subsidiaries exceeds $[              ]) and (4) granting the Administrative Agent control (within the meaning of the UCC) over any pledged Equity Interests consisting of uncertificated securities,

 

(v)                                  if requested by the Administrative Agent, within 60 days after such request (or such longer period as the Administrative Agent may determine in its sole discretion), deliver to the Administrative Agent, a signed copy of a favorable opinion, addressed to the Administrative Agent and the other Secured Parties, of counsel for the Loan Parties acceptable to the Administrative Agent as to the matters contained in clauses (i), (iii) and (iv) above, and as to such other matters as the Administrative Agent may reasonably request, and

 

(vi)                               if the Mortgage Trigger has occurred and to the extent requested by the Required Lenders, cause such Subsidiary to, on or before the Mortgage Delivery Date, (A) duly execute and deliver Mortgages to the Administrative Agent, as specified by and in form and substance satisfactory to the Administrative Agent, securing payment of all the Obligations of such Subsidiary under the Loan Documents and constituting Liens on the owned real properties of such Subsidiary as fully described in such Mortgages, (B) take whatever action (including the recording of deeds of trust and mortgages and the filing of fixture filings) may be necessary or advisable in the opinion of the Administrative Agent to vest in the Administrative Agent (or in any representative of the Administrative Agent designated by it) valid and subsisting Liens on the real properties purported to be subject to the Mortgages delivered pursuant to this Section 6.12 , enforceable against all third parties in accordance with their terms, (C) if requested by the

 

81



 

Administrative Agent, deliver to the Administrative Agent a signed copy of a favorable opinion, addressed to the Administrative Agent and the other Secured Parties, of counsel for the Loan Parties acceptable to the Administrative Agent as to the matters contained in clauses (A) and (B) above, and as to such matters as the Administrative Agent may reasonably request and (D) deliver to the Administrative Agent title commitments, flood determinations and flood insurance, if applicable, with respect to each parcel of real property owned by such Subsidiary, each in scope, form and substance satisfactory to the Administrative Agent, together with surveys that are in possession of such Subsidiary; provided , however , that to the extent that any Loan Party or any of its Subsidiaries shall have otherwise received any surveys with respect to such real property, such surveys shall, promptly after the receipt thereof, be delivered to the Administrative Agent (but in any event no obligation to obtain additional surveys shall be evidenced by this section).

 

(b)                                  Upon the acquisition of (1) if the Mortgage Trigger has occurred, real property, (2) Equity Interests in any Person (other than any Wholly-Owned Subsidiary, CFC, any Subsidiary that is held directly or indirectly by a CFC or any Immaterial Subsidiary), and (3) if requested by the Administrative Agent, any other property, in each case, other than Excluded Assets, if such property, in the judgment of the Administrative Agent, shall not already be subject to a perfected first priority security interest in favor of the Administrative Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties, then the Borrower shall, at the Borrower’s expense:

 

(i)                                      within 30 days after such acquisition or request (or such longer period as the Administrative Agent may determine in its sole discretion), furnish to the Administrative Agent a summary description of the property so acquired in detail reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent,

 

(ii)                                   within 30 days after such acquisition or request (or such longer period as the Administrative Agent may determine in its sole discretion), cause the applicable Loan Party to duly execute and deliver to the Administrative Agent security agreement supplements, and other security and pledge agreements, as specified by and in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent, securing payment of all the Obligations and constituting Liens on all the personal property of the type constituting Collateral of such Loan Party so acquired,

 

(iii)                                within 30 days after such acquisition or request (or such longer period as the Administrative Agent may determine in its sole discretion), cause the applicable Loan Party to take whatever action may be necessary or advisable in the opinion of the Administrative Agent to vest in the Administrative Agent (or in any representative of the Administrative Agent designated by it) valid and subsisting Liens on the Collateral so acquired, enforceable against all third parties; provided that the actions required under this paragraph shall be limited in any event to (1) the filing of UCC financing statements in such Loan Party’s jurisdiction of organization, (2) delivery of certificates representing any pledged Equity Interests consisting of certificated securities with appropriate transfer powers, (3) delivery of promissory notes or instruments with appropriate endorsements to the extent required to be delivered pursuant to the Collateral Documents (provided that the aggregate amount of all promissory notes payable to the Borrower and its Subsidiaries exceeds $[              ]) and (4) granting the Administrative Agent control

 

82



 

(within the meaning of the UCC) over any pledged Equity Interests consisting of uncertificated securities,

 

(iv)                               if requested by the Administrative Agent, within 60 days after such request (or such longer period as the Administrative Agent may determine in its sole discretion), deliver to the Administrative Agent, a signed copy of a favorable opinion, addressed to the Administrative Agent and the other Secured Parties, of counsel for the Loan Parties acceptable to the Administrative Agent as to the matters contained in clauses (ii) and (iii), and as to such other matters as the Administrative Agent may reasonably request, and

 

(v)                                  if the Mortgage Trigger has occurred and to the extent requested by the Required Lenders, cause the applicable Loan Party to, on or before the Mortgage Delivery Date, (A) duly execute and deliver Mortgages to the Administrative Agent, as specified by and in form and substance satisfactory to the Administrative Agent, securing payment of all the Obligations of such Loan Party, under the Loan Documents and constituting Liens on the owned real properties of such Loan Party so acquired, (B) take whatever action (including the recording of deeds of trust and mortgages and the filing of fixture filings) may be necessary or advisable in the opinion of the Administrative Agent to vest in the Administrative Agent (or in any representative of the Administrative Agent designated by it) valid and subsisting Liens on such acquired real properties purported to be subject to the Mortgages, delivered pursuant to this Section 6.12 , enforceable against all third parties in accordance with their terms, (C) if requested by the Administrative Agent, deliver to the Administrative Agent a signed copy of a favorable opinion, addressed to the Administrative Agent and the other Secured Parties, of counsel for the Loan Parties acceptable to the Administrative Agent as to the matters contained in clauses (A) and (B) above, and as to such other matters as the Administrative Agent may reasonably request and (D) deliver to the Administrative Agent title commitments, flood determinations and flood insurance, if applicable, with respect to each parcel of real property acquired by such Loan Party, each in scope, form and substance satisfactory to the Administrative Agent, together with surveys that are in possession of such Loan Party; provided , however, that to the extent that any Loan Party shall have otherwise received any surveys with respect to such acquired real property, such surveys shall, promptly after the receipt thereof, be delivered to the Administrative Agent (but in any event no obligation to obtain additional surveys shall be evidenced by this section).

 

(c)                                   Upon the request of the Administrative Agent following the occurrence and during the continuance of an Event of Default, the Borrower shall, at the Borrower’s expense:

 

(i)                                      within 30 days after such request (or such longer period as the Administrative Agent may determine in its sole discretion), furnish to the Administrative Agent a summary description of the material real and personal properties of the Loan Parties and their respective Wholly Owned Subsidiaries in detail reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent,

 

(ii)                                   within 30 days after such request (or such longer period as the Administrative Agent may determine in its sole discretion), duly execute and deliver, and

 

83


 

cause each Wholly Owned Subsidiary (other than any CFC or a Subsidiary that is held directly by a CFC) of the Borrower (if it has not already done so) to duly execute and deliver, to the Administrative Agent (A) if it has not already done so, a guaranty or guaranty supplement, in form and substance satisfactory to the Administrative Agent, guaranteeing the other Loan Parties’ obligations under the Loan Documents and (B) Mortgages, security agreement supplements and other security and pledge agreements (in each case, covering the real and personal properties of such Subsidiary constituting Collateral), as specified by and in form and substance satisfactory to the Administrative Agent (including delivery of all pledged Equity Interests and pledged Indebtedness in and of such Subsidiary, securing payment of all the Obligations and constituting Liens on all such properties),

 

(iii)                                within 30 days after such request (or such longer period as the Administrative Agent may determine in its sole discretion), take, and cause each Wholly Owned Subsidiary (other than any CFC or a Subsidiary that is held directly by a CFC) of the Borrower to take, whatever action may be necessary or advisable in the opinion of the Administrative Agent to vest in the Administrative Agent (or in any representative of the Administrative Agent designated by it) valid and subsisting Liens on the properties purported to be subject to the Mortgages, security agreement supplements, and security and pledge agreements delivered pursuant to this Section 6.12 , enforceable against all third parties in accordance with their terms, ( provided that the actions required under this paragraph shall be limited in any event to (1) the filing of UCC financing statements in such Subsidiary’s jurisdiction of organization, (2) delivery of certificates representing any pledged Equity Interests consisting of certificated securities with appropriate transfer powers, (3) delivery of promissory notes or instruments with appropriate endorsements to the extent required to be delivered pursuant to the Collateral Documents, (4) granting the Administrative Agent control (within the meaning of the UCC) over any pledged Equity Interests consisting of uncertificated securities and (5) the filing of Mortgages with the appropriate office in the jurisdiction where the real property covered by such instrument is located,

 

(iv)                               if requested by the Administrative Agent, within 60 days after such request (or such longer period as the Administrative Agent may determine in its sole discretion), deliver to the Administrative Agent, a signed copy of a favorable opinion, addressed to the Administrative Agent and the other Secured Parties, of counsel for the Loan Parties acceptable to the Administrative Agent as to the matters contained in clauses (i), (iii) and (iv) above, and as to such other matters as the Administrative Agent may reasonably request, and

 

(v)                                  as promptly as practicable after such request, deliver, upon the request of the Administrative Agent in its sole discretion, to the Administrative Agent with respect to each parcel of real property owned by the Borrower and its Subsidiaries, title commitments, flood determinations and flood insurance, if applicable, with respect to each parcel of real property owned by the Borrower and its Subsidiaries, each in scope, form and substance satisfactory to the Administrative Agent, together with surveys that are in possession of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries; provided , however , that to the extent that the Borrower and its Subsidiaries shall have otherwise received any surveys

 

84



 

with respect to such real property, such surveys shall, promptly after the receipt thereof, be delivered to the Administrative Agent (but in any event no obligation to obtain additional surveys shall be evidenced by this section).

 

(d)                                  If the Mortgage Trigger occurs and to the extent requested by the Required Lenders, the Borrower shall, and shall cause each other Loan Party to, on or before the Mortgage Delivery Date, (i) duly execute and deliver Mortgages to the Administrative Agent, as specified by and in form and substance satisfactory to the Administrative Agent, securing payment of all the Obligations of such Loan Party under the Loan Documents and constituting Liens on the owned real properties of such Loan Party to the extent so requested, (ii) take whatever action (including the recording of deeds of trust and mortgages and the filing of fixture filings) may be necessary or advisable in the opinion of the Administrative Agent to vest in the Administrative Agent (or in any representative of the Administrative Agent designated by it) valid and subsisting Liens on such real properties purported to be subject to the Mortgages delivered pursuant to this Section 6.12(c) , enforceable against all third parties in accordance with their terms, (iii) deliver to the Administrative Agent title commitments, flood determinations and flood insurance, if applicable, with respect to each parcel of real property owned by such Loan Party, each in scope, form and substance satisfactory to the Administrative Agent, together with surveys that are in possession of such Loan Party; provided , however , that to the extent that any Loan Party shall have otherwise received any surveys with respect to such real property, such surveys shall, promptly after the receipt thereof, be delivered to the Administrative Agent (but in any event no obligation to obtain additional surveys shall be evidenced by this section).

 

(e)                                   With respect to any real property which is subject to (a) a Mortgage and (b) a lease made by a Loan Party, as lessor, and any Affiliate of a Loan Party, as lessee, the Borrower covenants that it shall, and shall cause the applicable Loan Party to cause each such lease to be, by its terms, specifically subordinated to any mortgage of the property subject to the lease, and the Administrative Agent agrees to enter into a non-disturbance and attornment agreement, on terms reasonably satisfactory to the Borrower and Administrative Agent, with such lessor and lessee.

 

(f)                                    Upon the formation or acquisition of any new direct Subsidiary that is classified as a CFC and directly owned by a Loan Party (unless such Subsidiary is designated as an Immaterial Subsidiary), the Borrower shall, at Borrower’s sole expense within 30 days after such formation or acquisition (or such longer period as may be agreed by the Administrative Agent in its sole discretion), cause such new Subsidiary, and cause each Loan Party that is a direct parent of such new Subsidiary (if it has not already done so), to (i) duly execute and deliver to the Administrative Agent pledge agreements in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent that represent a pledge of 66% of the total voting power of the total outstanding Equity Interests of such new Subsidiary, (ii) deliver a signed copy of a favorable opinion, addressed to the Administrative Agent and the other Secured Parties, of counsel for the Loan Parties (including any applicable foreign counsel) acceptable to the Administrative Agent as to the matters contained in clause (i) above and as to such other matters as the Administrative Agent may reasonably request and (iii) take whatever action (including with respect to any applicable foreign Laws) may be necessary or advisable in the opinion of the Administrative Agent to vest in the Administrative Agent (or in any representative of the Administrative Agent designated by it) valid and subsisting Liens on 66% of the total voting power of the total

 

85



 

outstanding Equity Interests of such new Subsidiary.  It is understood and agreed that this Section 6.12(e) shall not apply to (x) any new direct Subsidiary that is held directly or indirectly by a CFC or (y) any Immaterial Subsidiary.

 

(g)                                   Notwithstanding the foregoing, if at any time all Immaterial Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, have total assets with an aggregate book value of 5% of Consolidated Total Assets as of the most recently ended fiscal quarter for which financial statements have been delivered pursuant to Section 6.01(a) or 6.01(b) , then the Borrower shall designate which of such Subsidiaries shall no longer constitute “Immaterial Subsidiaries” for purposes of this Credit Agreement to the extent necessary to cause such excess to be eliminated and, with respect to any Subsidiary that ceases to be an Immaterial Subsidiary as a result of such designation, the Borrower shall take, and cause such Subsidiary to take, such action as is necessary to comply with this Section 6.12 .

 

6.13                         Compliance with Environmental Laws .  Comply, and cause all lessees and other Persons operating or occupying its properties to comply, in all material respects, with all applicable Environmental Laws and Environmental Permits; obtain and renew all Environmental Permits necessary for its operations and properties; and conduct any investigation, study, sampling and testing, and undertake any cleanup, removal, remedial or other action necessary to remove and clean up all Hazardous Materials from any of its properties, to the extent required by applicable Environmental Laws; provided , however , that neither the Borrower nor any of its Subsidiaries shall be required to undertake any such cleanup, removal, remedial or other action to the extent that its obligation to do so is being contested in good faith and by proper proceedings and appropriate reserves are being maintained with respect to such circumstances in accordance with GAAP.

 

6.14                         Further Assurances .  Promptly (or within the time periods specified in Section 6.12 , if applicable) upon request by the Administrative Agent, or any Lender through the Administrative Agent, (a) correct any material defect or error that may be discovered in any Loan Document or in the execution, acknowledgment, filing or recordation thereof, and (b) do, execute, acknowledge, deliver, record, re-record, file, re-file, register and re-register any and all such further acts, deeds, certificates, assurances and other instruments as the Administrative Agent, or any Lender through the Administrative Agent, may reasonably require from time to time in order to (i) carry out more effectively the purposes of the Loan Documents, (ii) to the fullest extent permitted by applicable law, subject any Loan Party’s or any of its Subsidiaries’ properties, assets, rights or interests to the Liens now or hereafter intended to be covered by any of the Collateral Documents, (iii) perfect and maintain the validity, effectiveness and priority of any of the Collateral Documents and any of the Liens intended to be created thereunder ( provided that the Borrower’s obligation to perfect any of the Liens is limited in any event to (1) the filing of UCC financing statements in the applicable Loan Party’s jurisdiction of organization, (2) delivery of certificates representing any pledged Equity Interests consisting of certificated securities with appropriate transfer powers, (3) only in the event so requested by the Administrative Agent, delivery of promissory notes or instruments with appropriate endorsements ( provided that the aggregate amount of all promissory notes payable to the Borrower and its Subsidiaries exceeds $[                  ]), (4) granting the Administrative Agent control (within the meaning of the UCC) over any pledged Equity Interests consisting of uncertificated securities and (5) if the Mortgage Trigger has occurred and to the extent requested

 

86



 

by the Required Lenders, the filing of Mortgages and fixture filings with the appropriate office in the jurisdiction where the real property covered by such instrument is located) and (iv) assure, convey, grant, assign, transfer, preserve, protect and confirm more effectively unto the Secured Parties the rights granted or now or hereafter intended to be granted to the Secured Parties under any Loan Document or under any other instrument executed in connection with any Loan Document to which any Loan Party or any of its Subsidiaries is or is to be a party, and cause each of its Subsidiaries to do so.

 

6.15                         Compliance with Terms of Leaseholds .  Administer all leases of real property to which the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries is a party in the ordinary course of business, and cause each of its Subsidiaries to do so, except, in any case, where the failure to do so, either individually or in the aggregate, could not be reasonably expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

6.16                         Material Contracts .  Perform and observe all the terms and provisions of each Material Contract to be performed or observed by it, and cause each of its Subsidiaries to do so, except, in any case, where the failure to do so, either individually or in the aggregate, could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

ARTICLE VII.
NEGATIVE COVENANTS

 

So long as any Lender shall have any Commitment hereunder, any Loan or other Obligation hereunder shall remain unpaid or unsatisfied, or any Letter of Credit shall remain outstanding, the Borrower shall not, nor shall it permit any Subsidiary to, directly or indirectly:

 

7.01                         Liens .  Create, incur, assume or suffer to exist any Lien upon any of its property, assets or revenues, whether now owned or hereafter acquired, or assign any accounts or other right to receive income, other than the following:

 

(a)                                  Liens pursuant to any Loan Document;

 

(b)                                  Liens existing on the date hereof and listed on Part A of Schedule 7.01 and any renewals or extensions thereof, provided that (i) the scope of property covered thereby is not increased, (ii) the amount secured or benefited thereby is not increased except as contemplated by Section 7.02(d) , (iii) the direct or any contingent obligor with respect thereto is not changed and (iv) any renewal or extension of the obligations secured or benefited thereby is permitted by Section 7.02(d) ;

 

(c)                                   Liens for taxes not yet due or which are being contested in good faith and by appropriate proceedings diligently conducted, if adequate reserves with respect thereto are maintained on the books of the applicable Person in accordance with GAAP;

 

(d)                                  carriers’, warehousemen’s, mechanics’, materialmen’s, repairmen’s or other like Liens arising in the ordinary course of business which are not overdue for a period of more than 60 days or which are being contested in good faith and by appropriate proceedings diligently conducted, if adequate reserves with respect thereto are maintained on the books of the applicable Person;

 

87



 

(e)                                   pledges or deposits in the ordinary course of business in connection with workers’ compensation, unemployment insurance and other social security legislation, other than any Lien imposed by ERISA;

 

(f)                                    deposits to secure the performance of bids, trade contracts and leases (other than Indebtedness), statutory obligations, surety and appeal bonds, performance bonds and other obligations of a like nature incurred in the ordinary course of business;

 

(g)                                   zoning restrictions, easements, rights-of-way, restrictions and other similar encumbrances affecting real property which, in the aggregate, are not substantial in amount, and which do not in any case materially detract from the value of the property subject thereto or materially interfere with the ordinary conduct of the business of the applicable Person;

 

(h)                                  Liens securing judgments for the payment of money not constituting an Event of Default under Section 8.01(h) ;

 

(i)                                      Liens securing Indebtedness permitted under Section 7.02(f) ; provided that (i) such Liens do not at any time encumber any property other than the property financed by such Indebtedness and (ii) the Indebtedness secured thereby does not exceed the cost or fair market value, whichever is lower, of the property being acquired on the date of acquisition;

 

(j)                                     Liens on property of a Person existing at the time such Person is merged into or consolidated with the Borrower or any Subsidiary of the Borrower or becomes a Subsidiary of the Borrower; provided that such Liens were not created in contemplation of such merger, consolidation or Investment and do not extend to any assets other than those of the Person merged into or consolidated with the Borrower or such Subsidiary or acquired by the Borrower or such Subsidiary, and the applicable Indebtedness secured by such Lien is permitted under Section 7.02(g) ;

 

(k)                                  Liens arising solely by virtue of any statutory or common law provision relating to banker’s liens, rights of set-off or similar rights and remedies, or under general depositary agreements, and burdening only deposit accounts or other funds maintained with a creditor depository institution;

 

(l)                                      Liens arising from precautionary Uniform Commercial Code financing statements relating to operating leases and other contractual arrangements entered into in the ordinary course of business that describe only the property subject to such operating lease or contractual arrangement;

 

(m)                              Liens granted on the Lakehead Loan Collateral to secure the Lakehead Loan;

 

(n)                                  Liens arising in connection with Permitted Sale/Leaseback Transactions; provided that such Liens do not extend to any assets other than those subject to the applicable Permitted Sale/Leaseback Transaction;

 

(o)                                  landlords’ Liens listed on Part B of Schedule 7.02 or to which the Administrative Agent consents in writing;

 

88



 

(p)                                  Liens on equipment of such Person, arising in the ordinary course of business, granted by such Person to secure a third party’s Indebtedness in order for such Person to obtain a fuel supply agreement, provided , that no such Lien is spread to cover any additional property (other than after-acquired property that is affixed or incorporated into the property covered by such Lien) or Indebtedness;

 

(q)                                  Liens on Equity Interests of any joint venture or partnership (other than a Wholly-Owned Subsidiary) owned by the Borrower or any Subsidiary to the extent securing Indebtedness of such joint venture or partnership that is non-recourse to the Borrower or any Subsidiary;

 

(r)                                     Liens on inventory securing purchase money Indebtedness permitted under Sections 7.02(f) ; provided that each such Lien secures only the purchase money Indebtedness incurred in connection with the acquisition of such inventory and each such Lien encumbers only the inventory purchased in connection with the incurrence of such purchase money Indebtedness;

 

(s)                                    so long as no action to enforce such Lien has been commenced, Liens for the benefit of non-Affiliate counterparties to fuel supply agreements entered into in the ordinary course of business on deposits, funds, credits, credit card settlement accounts or other property of a similar scope and nature, which Liens secure the Borrower’s or the applicable Subsidiary’s obligations under such fuel supply agreements;

 

(t)                                     any interest or title of a lessor or sublessor under any lease entered into by the Borrower or any Subsidiary in the ordinary course of business and covering only the assets so leased and any Liens on such lessor’s or sublessor’s interest or title;

 

(u)                                  (i) leases, subleases, licenses or sublicenses granted to any other person in the ordinary course of business and (ii) the rights reserved or vested in any person by the terms of any lease, license, franchise, grant or permit held by the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries or by a statutory provision to terminate any such lease, license, franchise, grant or permit or to require periodic payments as a condition to the continuance thereof;

 

(v)                                  Liens in favor of customs and revenue authorities arising as a matter of law to secure payment of customs duties in connection with the importation of goods in the ordinary course of business securing payment of amounts not yet due or which are being contested in good faith and by appropriate proceedings diligently conducted, if adequate reserves with respect thereto are maintained on the books of the applicable Person in accordance with GAAP;

 

(w)                                Liens (i) (A) on advances of cash or Cash Equivalents in favor of the seller of any property to be acquired in an Investment permitted under Section7.03 to be applied against the purchase price for such Investment, and (B) consisting of an agreement to Dispose of any property in a Disposition permitted under Section 7.05 , in each case, solely to the extent such Investment or Disposition, as the case may be, would have been permitted on the date of the creation of such Lien and (ii) on cash earnest money deposits made by the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries in connection with any letter of intent or purchase agreement permitted hereunder;

 

89



 

(x)                                  Liens arising out of conditional sale, title retention, consignment or similar arrangements for sale of goods entered into by the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries in the ordinary course or business not prohibited by this Agreement;

 

(y)                                  other Liens not otherwise permitted hereunder securing any obligations (including Indebtedness) outstanding in an aggregate principal amount not to exceed $10,000,000; provided that no such Lien shall extend to or cover any Collateral.

 

7.02                         Indebtedness .  Create, incur, assume or suffer to exist any Indebtedness, except:

 

(a)                                  obligations (contingent or otherwise) existing or arising under any Swap Contract, provided that (i) such obligations are (or were) entered into by such Person in the ordinary course of business for the purpose of directly mitigating risks associated with fluctuations in interest rates or foreign exchange rates and (ii) such Swap Contract does not contain any provision exonerating the non-defaulting party from its obligation to make payments on outstanding transactions to the defaulting party;

 

(b)                                  Indebtedness of (i)(A) a Loan Party owing to another Loan Party or (B) a Subsidiary of the Borrower owed to the Borrower or a Subsidiary Guarantor, which Indebtedness, in each case, shall (1) constitute pledged Indebtedness under the Security Agreement, (2) be on terms (including subordination terms) reasonably acceptable to the Administrative Agent and (3) be otherwise permitted under the provisions of Section 7.03 or (ii) a Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party to a Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party;

 

(c)                                   Indebtedness under the Loan Documents;

 

(d)                                  Indebtedness outstanding on the date hereof and listed on Schedule 7.02 and any refinancings, refundings, renewals or extensions thereof; provided that the amount of such Indebtedness is not increased at the time of such refinancing, refunding, renewal or extension except by an amount equal to a reasonable premium or other reasonable amount paid, and fees and expenses reasonably incurred, in connection with such refinancing and by an amount equal to any existing commitments unutilized thereunder and the direct or any contingent obligor with respect thereto is not changed, as a result of or in connection with such refinancing, refunding, renewal or extension; and provided , still further , that the terms relating to principal amount, amortization, maturity, collateral (if any) and subordination (if any), and other material terms taken as a whole, of any such refinancing, refunding, renewing or extending Indebtedness, and of any agreement entered into and of any instrument issued in connection therewith, are no less favorable in any material respect to the Loan Parties or the Lenders than the terms of any agreement or instrument governing the Indebtedness being refinanced, refunded, renewed or extended and the interest rate applicable to any such refinancing, refunding, renewing or extending Indebtedness does not exceed the then applicable market interest rate;

 

(e)                                   Guarantees of the Borrower or any Subsidiary in respect of (i) Indebtedness otherwise permitted hereunder of the Borrower or any Subsidiary Guarantor or (ii) Indebtedness incurred by joint ventures or Subsidiaries that are not Loan Parties, in each case, constituting Investments otherwise permitted hereunder; provided that with respect to Guarantees by a Loan Party of Indebtedness of joint ventures or Subsidiaries that are not Loan Parties, the aggregate

 

90



 

amount of Indebtedness guaranteed pursuant to such Guarantees shall not exceed (when combined with all Investments made pursuant to Section 7.03(d)(iv) ) $20,000,000;

 

(f)                                    Indebtedness in respect of Capitalized Leases, Synthetic Lease Obligations and purchase money obligations for inventory or fixed or capital assets within the limitations set forth in Section 7.01(i) ; provided , however , that the aggregate amount of all such Indebtedness at any one time outstanding shall not exceed $20,000,000;

 

(g)                                   Indebtedness of any Person that becomes a Subsidiary of the Borrower after the date hereof in accordance with the terms of Section 7.03(g) , which Indebtedness is existing at the time such Person becomes a Subsidiary of the Borrower (other than Indebtedness incurred solely in contemplation of such Person’s becoming a Subsidiary of the Borrower);

 

(h)                                  unsecured Indebtedness issued by the Borrower provided that (i) immediately prior to and after giving effect to the issuance of such Indebtedness, there would be no Default under this Agreement, (ii) such Indebtedness’ scheduled maturity is no earlier than twelve (12) months after the Maturity Date, (iii) such Indebtedness does not require any scheduled repayments, defeasance or redemption (or sinking fund therefor) of any principal amount thereof prior to maturity (other than Indebtedness convertible into Equity Interests of the Borrower), (iv) the indenture or other agreement governing such Indebtedness shall not contain (A) maintenance financial covenants or (B) other terms and conditions that are (taken as a whole) more restrictive on the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries than the terms and conditions of this Agreement, and any refinancings, refundings, renewals or extensions thereof; provided that the terms of such refinancing, refunding, renewing, or extending Indebtedness satisfy the requirements of this Section 7.02(h) ;

 

(i)                                      Indebtedness in respect of performance, surety or appeal bonds provided in the ordinary course of business, but excluding (in each case) incurred through the borrowing of money or contingent liabilities in respect thereof;

 

(j)                                     Indebtedness incurred by the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries in a Disposition under agreements providing for, and in the form of, indemnification, the adjustment of the purchase price or similar adjustments and earn outs;

 

(k)                                  Cash management obligations and Indebtedness incurred by the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries in respect of netting services, overdraft protections and similar arrangements in each case in connection with cash management and deposit accounts in the ordinary course of business;

 

(l)                                      Indebtedness consisting of (i) the financing of insurance premiums or (ii) take-or-pay obligations of the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries contained in supply arrangements, in each case, in the ordinary course of business;

 

(m)                              Indebtedness consisting of obligations of the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries under deferred compensation or other similar arrangements incurred by such Person in the ordinary course of business and in connection with any Acquisition permitted under Section 7.03(g) ; and

 

91



 

(n)                                  Indebtedness in an aggregate principal amount not exceeding $5,000,000 that constitutes Acquisition Consideration with respect to an Acquisition permitted hereunder on an unsecured subordinated basis, which subordination agreement shall be on terms reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent; provided that the terms and provisions of such Indebtedness shall be reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent.

 

(o)                                  Indebtedness under the Lakehead Loan Documents, provide that aggregate principal amount of all such Indebtedness does not exceed $[175,000,000];

 

(p)                                  unsecured Indebtedness in an aggregate principal amount not to exceed $20,000,000 at any time outstanding.

 

7.03                         Investments .  Make or hold any Investments, except:

 

(a)                                  Investments held by the Borrower and its Subsidiaries in the form of Cash Equivalents;

 

(b)                                  Investments held by the Borrower in the form of Lakehead Loan Collateral;

 

(c)                                   advances to officers, directors and employees of the General Partner, the Borrower and the Borrower’s Subsidiaries in an aggregate amount not to exceed $500,000 at any time outstanding, for travel, entertainment, relocation and analogous ordinary business purposes;

 

(d)                                  (i) Investments by the Borrower and its Subsidiaries in their respective Subsidiaries outstanding on the date hereof, (ii) additional Investments by the Borrower and its Subsidiaries in Loan Parties, (iii) additional Investments by Subsidiaries of the Borrower that are not Loan Parties in other Subsidiaries that are not Loan Parties and (iv) so long as no Default has occurred and is continuing or would result from such Investment, additional Investments by the Loan Parties in joint ventures or Subsidiaries that are not Loan Parties in an aggregate amount invested from the date hereof not to exceed $20,000,000 (when combined with any Guarantees entered into pursuant to Section 7.02(e)(ii)) ;

 

(e)                                   Investments consisting of extensions of credit in the nature of accounts receivable or notes receivable arising from the grant of trade credit in the ordinary course of business, and Investments received in satisfaction or partial satisfaction thereof from financially troubled account debtors to the extent reasonably necessary in order to prevent or limit loss;

 

(f)                                    Guarantees permitted by Section 7.02 ;

 

(g)                                   Acquisitions (by purchase or merger) provided that (i) a Loan Party is the acquiring or surviving entity; (ii) no Default or Event of Default exists and the Acquisition could not reasonably be expected to cause a Default or an Event of Default; (iii) before and after giving effect to such Acquisition on a Pro Forma Basis, the Borrower and its Subsidiaries would have been in compliance with Section 7.11 as of the end of the most recently ended fiscal quarter; (iv) the requirement of Section 7.07 is satisfied and the target is not hostile; (v) if such Acquisition is of Equity Interests, the issuer of such Equity Interests shall be an entity organized under the laws of the United States and shall become a Wholly Owned Subsidiary upon consummation of such Acquisition; and (vi) with respect to any Acquisition for which the Acquisition Consideration

 

92



 

exceeds $15,000,000, the Administrative Agent shall have received, at least five (5) Business Days prior to the date on which any such Acquisition is to be consummated, a certificate of a Responsible Officer of the Borrower, in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent and the Required Lenders, certifying that all of the requirements set forth in this Section 7.03(g) have been satisfied or will be satisfied on or prior to the date on which such Acquisition is consummated;

 

(h)                                  other Investments to which the Administrative Agent has consented in writing;

 

(i)                                      Investments received in connection with the bankruptcy or reorganization of, or settlement of delinquent accounts and disputes with, customers and suppliers, in each case in the ordinary course of business;

 

(j)                                     Investments consisting of any deferred portion of the sales price received by the Borrower or any Subsidiary in connection with any Disposition permitted pursuant to Section 7.05 ;

 

(k)                                  so long as no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or would result from such Investment, other Investments not exceeding $20,000,000 in the aggregate in any fiscal year of the Borrower.

 

7.04                         Fundamental Changes .  Merge, dissolve, liquidate, consolidate with or into another Person, or Dispose of (whether in one transaction or in a series of transactions) all or substantially all of its assets (whether now owned or hereafter acquired) to or in favor of any Person, except that, so long as no Default exists or would result therefrom:

 

(a)                                  any Subsidiary may merge with (i) the Borrower, provided that the Borrower shall be the continuing or surviving Person, or (ii) any one or more other Subsidiaries, provided that when any Loan Party is merging with another Subsidiary, such Loan Party shall be the continuing or surviving Person;

 

(b)                                  any Loan Party may Dispose of all or substantially all of its assets (upon voluntary liquidation or otherwise) to the Borrower or to another Loan Party;

 

(c)                                   any Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party may dispose of all or substantially all its assets (including any Disposition that is in the nature of a liquidation) to (i) another Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party or (ii) to a Loan Party; and

 

(d)                                  a Loan Party may merge or consolidate with any Person in accordance with Section 7.03(g) .

 

7.05                         Dispositions .  Make any Disposition or enter into any agreement to make any Disposition, except:

 

(a)                                  Dispositions of obsolete or worn out property, whether now owned or hereafter acquired, in the ordinary course of business;

 

93


 

(b)                                  ordinary-course-of-business Dispositions of (i) inventory; (ii) Cash Equivalents; (iii) overdue accounts receivable in connection with the compromise or collection thereof (and not in connection with any financing transaction); and (iv) leases, subleases, rights of way, easements, licenses, and sublicenses that, individually and in the aggregate, do not materially interfere with the ordinary conduct of the business of the Borrower or its Subsidiaries and do not materially detract from the value or the use of the property which they affect;

 

(c)                                   Dispositions of equipment to the extent that (i) such property is exchanged for credit against the purchase price of similar replacement property or (ii) the proceeds of such Disposition are reasonably promptly applied to the purchase price of such replacement property;

 

(d)                                  Dispositions of property by any Subsidiary to the Borrower or to a Wholly Owned Subsidiary; provided that if the transferor of such property is a Loan Party, the transferee thereof must also be a Loan Party;

 

(e)                                   Dispositions permitted by Section 7.04 ;

 

(f)                                    Permitted Sale/Leaseback Transactions;

 

(g)                                   Dispositions of the Lakehead Loan Collateral to the extent permitted by the Lakehead Loan (including any mandatory prepayments required thereunder);

 

(h)                                  Dispositions of property (i) resulting from the condemnation thereof or (ii) that has suffered a casualty (constituting a total loss or constructive total loss of such property), in each case upon or after receipt of the condemnation proceeds or insurance proceeds of such condemnation or casualty, as applicable, provided that the cash proceeds therefrom are applied in accordance with Section 2.05(b)(ii) ;

 

(i)                                      Dispositions of real property (other than Stripes Properties) or non-operating assets;

 

(j)                                     Dispositions in the ordinary course of business consisting of the abandonment of intellectual property rights which, in the reasonable good faith determination of the Borrower, are not material to the conduct of the business of the Borrower or any of the Subsidiaries;

 

(k)                                  Dispositions of Investments in joint ventures;

 

(l)                                      other Dispositions of property or assets (other than Stripes Properties) in connection with the formation or operation of joint ventures in accordance with Section 7.03(d)  and (k) ;

 

(m)                              Dispositions of Stripes Properties in an aggregate amount not to exceed (when aggregated with Permitted Sale/Leaseback Transactions under clause (ii) of the definition thereof) $10,000,000;

 

(n)                                  Dispositions by the Borrower and its Subsidiaries of property or assets (other than Stripes Properties) not otherwise permitted under this Section 7.05 ; provided that (i) at the time of such Disposition, no Default shall exist or would result from such Disposition, (ii) the

 

94



 

aggregate book value of all property Disposed of in reliance on this clause (n) in any fiscal year shall not exceed $15,000,000 and (iii) at least 75% of the purchase price for such asset shall be paid to the Borrower or such Subsidiary in cash;

 

provided , however, that any Disposition pursuant to Section 7.05(c), (f), (g), (h), (i), (k) (l) , and (m)  shall be for fair market value.

 

7.06                         Restricted Payments .  Declare or make, directly or indirectly, any Restricted Payment, or incur any obligation (contingent or otherwise) to do so, except that, so long as no Default shall have occurred and be continuing at the time of any action described below or would result therefrom:

 

(a)                                  each Subsidiary may make Restricted Payments to the Borrower, any Subsidiaries of the Borrower that are Loan Parties and any other Person that owns a direct Equity Interest in such Subsidiary, ratably according to their respective holdings of the type of Equity Interest in respect of which such Restricted Payment is being made;

 

(b)                                  the Borrower and each Subsidiary may declare and make dividend payments or other distributions payable solely in the common or subordinated Equity Interests of such Person and the Borrower may issue common Equity Interests upon the conversion of subordinated Equity Interests;

 

(c)                                   the Borrower and each Subsidiary may purchase, redeem or otherwise acquire its Equity Interests with the proceeds received from the substantially concurrent issue of new common or subordinated Equity Interests;

 

(d)                                  the Borrower may make Restricted Payments to Holdings on the Closing Date as described in “Use of Proceeds” in the Registration Statement;

 

(e)                                   the Borrower may make Restricted Payments with respect to any fiscal quarter in an aggregate amount not to exceed Available Cash with respect to such fiscal quarter;

 

(f)                                    the Borrower may make Restricted Payments to holders of convertible Indebtedness permitted pursuant to Section 7.02(h) , payable solely in the common or subordinated Equity Interests of the Borrower; and

 

(g)                                   the Borrower may make Restricted Payments in connection with awards issued under any long term incentive compensation plan by accepting forfeitures or holding back any portion of the Equity Interests underlying any such award in exchange for (i) satisfying any recipient tax obligation due upon the vesting of (or lapse of restrictions upon) such award or (ii) waiving the payment of any exercise price in connection with the exercise of any such award.

 

7.07                         Change in Nature of Business .  Engage in any material line of business substantially different from those lines of business conducted by the Borrower and its Subsidiaries on the date hereof or any business substantially related or incidental thereto.

 

7.08                         Transactions with Affiliates .  Enter into any transaction of any kind with any Affiliate of the Borrower, whether or not in the ordinary course of business, other than on fair

 

95



 

and reasonable terms substantially as favorable to the Borrower or such Subsidiary as would be obtainable by the Borrower or such Subsidiary at the time in a comparable arm’s length transaction with a Person other than an Affiliate; provided that the foregoing restriction shall not apply to (i) transactions between or among the Loan Parties, (ii) Restricted Payments permitted by Section 7.06 , (iii) transactions pursuant to the Material Contracts, (iv) transactions approved by the conflicts committee of the General Partner in accordance with the Borrower Partnership Agreement, (v) any employment or compensation agreement, deferred compensation plans, employee benefits plan, equity incentive or equity-based plans, profits interests, officer, supervisor and director indemnification agreement or insurance, stay bonuses, severance or similar agreement and arrangements, in the ordinary course of business, (vi) reasonable and customary director, officer, supervisor and employee fees and compensation and other benefits (including retirement, health, stock option and other benefit plans) and indemnification arrangements, (vii) non-material transactions with Holdings or any of its Subsidiaries entered into in the ordinary course of business so long as, in each case, after giving effect thereto, no Default or Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing and each such transaction is entered into in good faith and is in the best interests of the Borrower, and (vii) any corporate sharing agreements with respect to tax sharing and general overhead and administrative matters.

 

7.09                         Burdensome Agreements .  Enter into or permit to exist any Contractual Obligation (other than this Agreement or any other Loan Document) that limits the ability (i) of any Subsidiary to make Restricted Payments to the Borrower or any Subsidiary Guarantor or to otherwise transfer property to or invest in the Borrower or any Subsidiary Guarantor, (ii) of any Subsidiary required to be a Guarantor hereunder to Guarantee the Indebtedness of the Borrower or (iii) of the Borrower or any Subsidiary Guarantor hereunder to create, incur, assume or suffer to exist Liens on property of such Person; provided , however , that this clause (iii) shall not prohibit (A) any negative pledge incurred or provided in favor of any holder of Indebtedness permitted under Section 7.02(f)  or (g)  solely to the extent any such negative pledge relates to the property financed by or the subject of such Indebtedness or (B) customary non-assignment provisions in purchase and sale or exchange agreements or similar operational agreements, or provisions in licenses, easements or leases, in each case entered into in the ordinary course of business and consistent with past practices, which restrict the transfer, assignment or encumbrance thereof; provided , further that clauses (i), (ii) and (iii) shall not apply (x) to any contract or agreement in effect (A) as of the Closing Date and set forth on Schedule 7.09 (and any replacements or extensions of any such contracts or agreements that do not materially expand any such limitations), (B) at the time any Subsidiary becomes a Subsidiary of the Borrower, so long as such agreement was not entered into solely in contemplation of such Person becoming a Subsidiary of the Borrower (and any replacements or extensions of any such contracts or agreements that do not materially expand any such limitations) or (C) at the time any property is acquired, so long as such restrictions relate only to the property so acquired and the agreement was not entered into solely in contemplation of such Person becoming a Subsidiary of the Borrower (and any replacements or extensions of any such contracts or agreements that do not materially expand any such limitations) or (y) to any encumbrances or restrictions contained in the organizational documents of a joint venture permitted pursuant to Section 7.03 encumbering or restricting the disposition or distribution of assets of property of the joint venture.

 

96



 

7.10                         Use of Proceeds .  Use the proceeds of any Credit Extension, whether directly or indirectly, and whether immediately, incidentally or ultimately, to purchase or carry margin stock (within the meaning of Regulation U of the FRB) or to extend credit to others for the purpose of purchasing or carrying margin stock or to refund indebtedness originally incurred for such purpose.

 

7.11                         Financial Covenants .  (a)  Consolidated Interest Coverage Ratio .  Beginning with the fiscal quarter ending December 31, 2012, permit the Consolidated Interest Coverage Ratio as of the end of any fiscal quarter of the Borrower to be less than 2.50 to 1.00.

 

(b)                                  Consolidated Total Leverage Ratio .  Beginning with the fiscal quarter ending December 31, 2012, permit the Consolidated Total Leverage Ratio at any time during any period of four fiscal quarters of the Borrower to be greater than (i) during a Specified Acquisition Period (A) if a Qualified Offering has not been consummated, 5.00 to 1.00 and (B) if a Qualified Offering has been consummated, 5.50 to 1.00 and (ii) at all other times, (A) if a Qualified Offering has not been consummated, 4.50 to 1.00 and (B) if a Qualified Offering has been consummated, 5.00 to 1.00.

 

(c)                                   Consolidated Senior Secured Leverage Ratio .  If a Qualified Offering has been consummated, permit the Consolidated Senior Secured Leverage Ratio at any time during any period of four fiscal quarters of the Borrower to be greater than 3.50 to 1.00.

 

7.12                         Accounting Changes .  Make any change in (a) accounting policies or reporting practices, except as required or permitted by GAAP, or (b) fiscal year.

 

7.13                         Prepayments, Etc. of Indebtedness .  Prepay, redeem, purchase, defease or otherwise satisfy prior to the scheduled maturity thereof in any manner, or make any payment in violation of any subordination terms of, any Indebtedness, except (a) the prepayment of the Credit Extensions in accordance with the terms of this Agreement, (b) prepayments of the Lakehead Loan, (c) regularly scheduled or required repayments or redemptions of Indebtedness set forth in Schedule 7.02 and refinancings and refundings of such Indebtedness in compliance with Section 7.02(d)  and (d) refinancings, refundings and conversions into Equity Interests of Indebtedness incurred pursuant to Section 7.02(h) .

 

7.14                         Amendment, Etc. of Organization Documents, Material Contracts and Indebtedness .  (a)  Amend any of its Organization Documents (including the Borrower Partnership Agreement), unless such amendments, modifications, or supplements could not reasonably be expected to be materially adverse to the rights of the Administrative Agent or the Lenders, (b) amend, modify, or supplement any of the Material Contracts unless such amendments, modifications, or supplements, individually or in the aggregate, could not reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect or (c) amend, modify or otherwise change, or consent to any amendment, modification or change to (or otherwise permit) the Lakehead Loan Documents or the terms of or documents evidencing any Indebtedness incurred pursuant to Section 7.02(h) , in each case, in a manner that could reasonably be expected to be adverse to the Lenders .

 

97



 

7.15                         Limitation on Speculative Hedging.  (a) Enter into any Swap Contract for speculative purposes, or (b) be party to or otherwise enter into any Swap Contract which is entered into for reasons other than as a part of its normal business operations as a risk management strategy and/or hedge against changes resulting from market conditions related to the Borrower’s or its Subsidiaries’ operations.

 

ARTICLE VIII.
EVENTS OF DEFAULT AND REMEDIES

 

8.01                         Events of Default .  Any of the following shall constitute an Event of Default:

 

(a)                                  Non-Payment .  The Borrower or any other Loan Party fails to (i) pay when and as required to be paid herein, any amount of principal of any Loan or any L/C Obligation or deposit any funds as Cash Collateral in respect of L/C Obligations, or (ii) pay within three days after the same becomes due, any interest on any Loan or on any L/C Obligation, or any fee due hereunder, or (iii) pay within five days after the same becomes due, any other amount payable hereunder or under any other Loan Document; or

 

(b)                                  Specific Covenants .  (i) The Borrower fails to perform or observe any term, covenant or agreement contained in any of Section 6.05 , 6.11 , 6.12 or Article VII ; or

 

(c)                                   Other Defaults .  Any Loan Party fails to perform or observe any other covenant or agreement contained in (i)  Sections 6.01 , 6.02(a) , 6.02(d) , 6.02(h) , 6.02(j) , 6.03 or 6.07 of this Agreement and such failure continues for 10 days after the earlier to occur of (1) notice thereof from the Administrative Agent to the Borrower (which notice will be given at the request of any Lender) or (2) a Responsible Officer of the Borrower becomes aware of any such failure or (ii) any covenant (not specified in clause (i) above or in Sections 8.01(a)  or (b)  above) in any Loan Document on its part to be performed or observed and such failure continues for 30 days after the earlier to occur of (1) notice thereof from the Administrative Agent to the Borrower (which notice will be given at the request of any Lender) or (2) a Responsible Officer of the Borrower becomes aware of any such failure; or

 

(d)                                  Representations and Warranties . Any representation, warranty, certification or statement of fact made or deemed made by or on behalf of the Borrower or any other Loan Party herein, in any other Loan Document, or in any document delivered in connection herewith or therewith that does not have a materiality or Material Adverse Effect qualification shall be incorrect or misleading in any material respect when made or deemed made or (ii) any representation, warranty, certification or statement of fact made or deemed made by or on behalf of the Borrower or any other Loan Party herein, in any other Loan Document, or in any document delivered in connection herewith or therewith that has a materiality or Material Adverse Effect qualification shall be incorrect or misleading in any respect when made or deemed made; or

 

(e)                                   Cross-Default .  (i) Any Loan Party or any Subsidiary thereof (A) fails to make any payment when due (whether by scheduled maturity, required prepayment, acceleration, demand, or otherwise) in respect of any Indebtedness or Guarantee (other than Indebtedness hereunder and Indebtedness under Swap Contracts) having an aggregate principal amount

 

98



 

(including undrawn committed or available amounts and including amounts owing to all creditors under any combined or syndicated credit arrangement) of more than the Threshold Amount, or (B) fails to observe or perform any other agreement or condition relating to any such Indebtedness or Guarantee or contained in any instrument or agreement evidencing, securing or relating thereto, or any other event occurs, the effect of which default or other event is to cause, or to permit the holder or holders of such Indebtedness or the beneficiary or beneficiaries of such Guarantee (or a trustee or agent on behalf of such holder or holders or beneficiary or beneficiaries) to cause, with the giving of notice if required, such Indebtedness to be demanded or to become due or to be repurchased, prepaid, defeased or redeemed (automatically or otherwise), or an offer to repurchase, prepay, defease or redeem such Indebtedness to be made, prior to its stated maturity, or such Guarantee to become payable or cash collateral in respect thereof to be demanded; or (ii) there occurs under any Swap Contract an Early Termination Date (as defined in such Swap Contract) resulting from (A) any event of default under such Swap Contract as to which a Loan Party or any Subsidiary thereof is the Defaulting Party (as defined in such Swap Contract) or (B) any Termination Event (as so defined) under such Swap Contract as to which a Loan Party or any Subsidiary thereof is an Affected Party (as so defined) and, in either event, the Swap Termination Value owed by such Loan Party or such Subsidiary as a result thereof is greater than the Threshold Amount; or

 

(f)                                    Insolvency Proceedings, Etc .  Any Loan Party or any Subsidiary thereof institutes or consents to the institution of any proceeding under any Debtor Relief Law, or makes an assignment for the benefit of creditors; or applies for or consents to the appointment of any receiver, trustee, custodian, conservator, liquidator, rehabilitator or similar officer for it or for all or any material part of its property; or any receiver, trustee, custodian, conservator, liquidator, rehabilitator or similar officer is appointed without the application or consent of such Person and the appointment continues undischarged or unstayed for 60 calendar days; or any proceeding under any Debtor Relief Law relating to any such Person or to all or any material part of its property is instituted without the consent of such Person and continues undismissed or unstayed for 60 calendar days, or an order for relief is entered in any such proceeding; or

 

(g)                                   Inability to Pay Debts; Attachment .  (i) Any Loan Party or any Subsidiary thereof becomes unable or admits in writing its inability or fails generally to pay its debts as they become due, or (ii) any writ or warrant of attachment or execution or similar process is issued or levied against all or any material part of the property of any such Person and is not released, vacated or fully bonded within 30 days after its issue or levy; or

 

(h)                                  Judgments .  There is entered against any Loan Party or any Subsidiary thereof (i) one or more final judgments or orders for the payment of money in an aggregate amount (as to all such judgments and orders) exceeding the Threshold Amount (to the extent not covered by independent third-party insurance as to which the insurer has been notified of the potential claim and does not dispute coverage), or (ii) any one or more non-monetary final judgments that have, or could reasonably be expected to have, individually or in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect and, in either case, (A) enforcement proceedings are commenced by any creditor upon such judgment or order, or (B) there is a period of 30 consecutive days during which a stay of enforcement of such judgment, by reason of a pending appeal or otherwise, is not in effect; or

 

99



 

(i)                                      ERISA .  (i) An ERISA Event occurs which has resulted or could reasonably be expected to result in liability of the Borrower under Title IV of ERISA to a Pension Plan, Multiemployer Plan or the PBGC in an aggregate amount in excess of the Threshold Amount, or (ii) the Borrower or any ERISA Affiliate fails to pay when due, after the expiration of any applicable grace period, any installment payment with respect to its withdrawal liability under Section 4201 of ERISA under a Multiemployer Plan in an aggregate amount in excess of the Threshold Amount; or

 

(j)                                     Invalidity of Loan Documents .  Any provision of any Loan Document, at any time after its execution and delivery and for any reason other than as expressly permitted hereunder or thereunder or satisfaction in full of all the Obligations, ceases to be in full force and effect; or any Loan Party contests in any manner the validity or enforceability of any provision of any Loan Document; or any Loan Party denies that it has any or further liability or obligation under any provision of any Loan Document, or purports to revoke, terminate or rescind any provision of any Loan Document; or

 

(k)                                  Change of Control .  There occurs any Change of Control; or

 

(l)                                      Lakehead Loan — Event of Default .  There occurs any “Event of Default” as such term is defined in any Lakehead Loan Document.

 

(m)                              Collateral Documents . The Liens created by the Collateral Documents shall cease to be perfected, or shall cease to have the priority contemplated by the Collateral Documents, on a material portion of the Collateral in each case otherwise than in accordance with the terms thereof or with the express prior written agreement, consent or approval of the Lenders.

 

(n)                                  Material Contracts .  (i) Any default or event of default shall have occurred under any of the Material Contracts which has not been cured within any applicable grace period and which default or event of default could, individually or in the aggregate with any other defaults or events of default under the Material Contracts, reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, or (ii) any of the Material Contracts shall have terminated prior to its stated or scheduled expiration or maturity, which termination, individually or in the aggregate with any other terminations of Material Contracts, could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

8.02                         Remedies upon Event of Default .  If any Event of Default occurs and is continuing, the Administrative Agent shall, at the request of, or may, with the consent of, the Required Lenders, take any or all of the following actions:

 

(a)                                  declare the commitment of each Lender to make Loans and any obligation of the L/C Issuer to make L/C Credit Extensions to be terminated, whereupon such commitments and obligation shall be terminated;

 

(b)                                  declare the unpaid principal amount of all outstanding Loans, all interest accrued and unpaid thereon, and all other amounts owing or payable hereunder or under any other Loan Document to be immediately due and payable, without presentment, demand, protest or other notice of any kind, all of which are hereby expressly waived by the Borrower;

 

100



 

(c)                                   require that the Borrower Cash Collateralize the L/C Obligations (in an amount equal to the Minimum Collateral Amount with respect thereto); and

 

(d)                                  exercise on behalf of itself, the Lenders and the L/C Issuer all rights and remedies available to it, the Lenders and the L/C Issuer under the Loan Documents;

 

provided , however , that upon the occurrence of an actual or deemed entry of an order for relief with respect to the Borrower under the Bankruptcy Code of the United States, the obligation of each Lender to make Loans and any obligation of the L/C Issuer to make L/C Credit Extensions shall automatically terminate, the unpaid principal amount of all outstanding Loans and all interest and other amounts as aforesaid shall automatically become due and payable, and the obligation of the Borrower to Cash Collateralize the L/C Obligations as aforesaid shall automatically become effective, in each case without further act of the Administrative Agent or any Lender.

 

8.03                         Application of Funds .  After the exercise of remedies provided for in Section 8.02 (or after the Loans have automatically become immediately due and payable and the L/C Obligations have automatically been required to be Cash Collateralized as set forth in the proviso to Section 8.02 ), any amounts received on account of the Obligations shall, subject to the provisions of Sections 2.15 and 2.16 , be applied by the Administrative Agent in the following order:

 

First , to payment of that portion of the Obligations constituting fees, indemnities, expenses and other amounts (including fees, charges and disbursements of counsel to the Administrative Agent and amounts payable under Article III ) payable to the Administrative Agent in its capacity as such;

 

Second , to payment of that portion of the Obligations constituting fees, indemnities and other amounts (other than principal, interest and Letter of Credit Fees) payable to the Lenders and the L/C Issuer (including fees, charges and disbursements of counsel to the respective Lenders and the L/C Issuer (including fees and time charges for attorneys who may be employees of any Lender or the L/C Issuer) arising under the Loan Documents and amounts payable under Article III , ratably among them in proportion to the respective amounts described in this clause Second payable to them;

 

Third , to payment of that portion of the Obligations constituting accrued and unpaid Letter of Credit Fees and interest on the Loans, L/C Borrowings and other Obligations arising under the Loan Documents, ratably among the Lenders and the L/C Issuer in proportion to the respective amounts described in this clause Third payable to them;

 

Fourth , to payment of that portion of the Obligations constituting unpaid principal of the Loans, L/C Borrowings and Obligations then owing under Secured Hedge Agreements and Secured Cash Management Agreements, ratably among the Lenders, the L/C Issuer, the Hedge Banks and the Cash Management Banks in proportion to the respective amounts described in this clause Fourth held by them;

 

Fifth , to the Administrative Agent for the account of the L/C Issuer, to Cash Collateralize that portion of L/C Obligations comprised of the aggregate undrawn amount of Letters of Credit to

 

101



 

the extent not otherwise Cash Collateralized by the Borrower pursuant to Sections 2.03 and 2.15 ; and

 

Last , the balance, if any, after all of the Obligations have been indefeasibly paid in full, to the Borrower or as otherwise required by Law.

 

Subject to Section 2.03(c)  and 2.15 , amounts used to Cash Collateralize the aggregate undrawn amount of Letters of Credit pursuant to clause Fifth above shall be applied to satisfy drawings under such Letters of Credit as they occur.  If any amount remains on deposit as Cash Collateral after all Letters of Credit have either been fully drawn or expired, such remaining amount shall be applied to the other Obligations, if any, in the order set forth above.

 

Notwithstanding the foregoing, Obligations arising under Secured Cash Management Agreements and Secured Hedge Agreements shall be excluded from the application described above if the Administrative Agent has not received written notice thereof, together with such supporting documentation as the Administrative Agent may request, from the applicable Cash Management Bank or Hedge Bank, as the case may be.  Each Cash Management Bank or Hedge Bank not a party to the Credit Agreement that has given the notice contemplated by the preceding sentence shall, by such notice, be deemed to have acknowledged and accepted the appointment of the Administrative Agent pursuant to the terms of Article IX hereof for itself and its Affiliates as if a “ Lender ” party hereto.

 

ARTICLE IX.
ADMINISTRATIVE AGENT

 

9.01                         Appointment and Authority .  (a) Each of the Lenders and the L/C Issuer hereby irrevocably appoints Bank of America to act on its behalf as the Administrative Agent hereunder and under the other Loan Documents and authorizes the Administrative Agent to take such actions on its behalf and to exercise such powers as are delegated to the Administrative Agent by the terms hereof or thereof, together with such actions and powers as are reasonably incidental thereto.  The provisions of this Article are solely for the benefit of the Administrative Agent, the Lenders and the L/C Issuer, and the Borrower shall not have rights as a third party beneficiary of any of such provisions.  It is understood and agreed that the use of the term “agent” herein or in any other Loan Documents (or any other similar term) with reference to the Administrative Agent is not intended to connote any fiduciary or other implied (or express) obligations arising under agency doctrine of any applicable Law. Instead such term is used as a matter of market custom, and is intended to create or reflect only an administrative relationship between contracting parties.

 

(b)                                  The Administrative Agent shall also act as the “ collateral agent ” under the Loan Documents, and each of the Lenders (including in its capacities as a potential Hedge Bank and a potential Cash Management Bank) and the L/C Issuer hereby irrevocably appoints and authorizes the Administrative Agent to act as the agent of such Lender and the L/C Issuer for purposes of acquiring, holding and enforcing any and all Liens on Collateral granted by any of the Loan Parties to secure any of the Obligations, together with such powers and discretion as are reasonably incidental thereto.  In this connection, the Administrative Agent, as “ collateral agent ” and any co-agents, sub-agents and attorneys-in-fact appointed by the Administrative Agent

 

102



 

pursuant to Section 9.05 for purposes of holding or enforcing any Lien on the Collateral (or any portion thereof) granted under the Collateral Documents, or for exercising any rights and remedies thereunder at the direction of the Administrative Agent), shall be entitled to the benefits of all provisions of this Article IX and Article X (including Section 10.04(c) , as though such co-agents, sub-agents and attorneys-in-fact were the “ collateral agent ” under the Loan Documents) as if set forth in full herein with respect thereto.

 

9.02                         Rights as a Lender .  The Person serving as the Administrative Agent hereunder shall have the same rights and powers in its capacity as a Lender as any other Lender and may exercise the same as though it were not the Administrative Agent and the term “ Lender ” or “ Lenders ” shall, unless otherwise expressly indicated or unless the context otherwise requires, include the Person serving as the Administrative Agent hereunder in its individual capacity.  Such Person and its Affiliates may accept deposits from, lend money to, own securities of, act as the financial advisor or in any other advisory capacity for and generally engage in any kind of business with the Borrower or any Subsidiary or other Affiliate thereof as if such Person were not the Administrative Agent hereunder and without any duty to account therefor to the Lenders.

 

9.03                         Exculpatory Provisions .  The Administrative Agent shall not have any duties or obligations except those expressly set forth herein and in the other Loan Documents, and its duties hereunder shall be administrative in nature.  Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, the Administrative Agent:

 

(a)                                  shall not be subject to any fiduciary or other implied duties, regardless of whether a Default has occurred and is continuing;

 

(b)                                  shall not have any duty to take any discretionary action or exercise any discretionary powers, except discretionary rights and powers expressly contemplated hereby or by the other Loan Documents that the Administrative Agent is required to exercise as directed in writing by the Required Lenders (or such other number or percentage of the Lenders as shall be expressly provided for herein or in the other Loan Documents), provided that the Administrative Agent shall not be required to take any action that, in its opinion or the opinion of its counsel, may expose the Administrative Agent to liability or that is contrary to any Loan Document or applicable law, including for the avoidance of doubt any action that may be in violation of the automatic stay under any Debtor Relief Law or that may effect a forfeiture, modification or termination of property of a Defaulting Lender in violation of any Debtor Relief Law; and; and

 

(c)                                   shall not, except as expressly set forth herein and in the other Loan Documents, have any duty to disclose, and shall not be liable for the failure to disclose, any information relating to the Borrower or any of its Affiliates that is communicated to or obtained by the Person serving as the Administrative Agent or any of its Affiliates in any capacity.

 

(d)                                  The Administrative Agent shall not be liable for any action taken or not taken by it (i) with the consent or at the request of the Required Lenders (or such other number or percentage of the Lenders as shall be necessary, or as the Administrative Agent shall believe in good faith shall be necessary, under the circumstances as provided in Sections 10.01 and 8.02 ) or (ii) in the absence of its own gross negligence or willful misconduct as determined by a court of competent jurisdiction by final and nonappealable judgment..  The Administrative Agent shall be

 

103


 

deemed not to have knowledge of any Default unless and until notice describing such Default is given in writing to the Administrative Agent by the Borrower, a Lender or the L/C Issuer.

 

(e)                                   The Administrative Agent shall not be responsible for or have any duty to ascertain or inquire into (i) any statement, warranty or representation made in or in connection with this Agreement or any other Loan Document, (ii) the contents of any certificate, report or other document delivered hereunder or thereunder or in connection herewith or therewith, (iii) the performance or observance of any of the covenants, agreements or other terms or conditions set forth herein or therein or the occurrence of any Default, (iv) the validity, enforceability, effectiveness or genuineness of this Agreement, any other Loan Document or any other agreement, instrument or document, or the creation, perfection or priority of any Lien purported to be created by the Collateral Documents, (v) the value or the sufficiency of any Collateral, or (v) the satisfaction of any condition set forth in Article IV or elsewhere herein, other than to confirm receipt of items expressly required to be delivered to the Administrative Agent.

 

9.04                         Reliance by Administrative Agent .  The Administrative Agent shall be entitled to rely upon, and shall not incur any liability for relying upon, any notice, request, certificate, consent, statement, instrument, document or other writing (including any electronic message, Internet or intranet website posting or other distribution) believed by it to be genuine and to have been signed, sent or otherwise authenticated by the proper Person.  The Administrative Agent also may rely upon any statement made to it orally or by telephone and believed by it to have been made by the proper Person, and shall not incur any liability for relying thereon.  In determining compliance with any condition hereunder to the making of a Loan, or the issuance, extension, renewal or increase of a Letter of Credit, that by its terms must be fulfilled to the satisfaction of a Lender or the L/C Issuer, the Administrative Agent may presume that such condition is satisfactory to such Lender or the L/C Issuer unless the Administrative Agent shall have received notice to the contrary from such Lender or the L/C Issuer prior to the making of such Loan or the issuance of such Letter of Credit.  The Administrative Agent may consult with legal counsel (who may be counsel for the Borrower), independent accountants and other experts selected by it, and shall not be liable for any action taken or not taken by it in accordance with the advice of any such counsel, accountants or experts.

 

9.05                         Delegation of Duties .  The Administrative Agent may perform any and all of its duties and exercise its rights and powers hereunder or under any other Loan Document by or through any one or more sub-agents appointed by the Administrative Agent.  The Administrative Agent and any such sub-agent may perform any and all of its duties and exercise its rights and powers by or through their respective Related Parties.  The exculpatory provisions of this Article shall apply to any such sub-agent and to the Related Parties of the Administrative Agent and any such sub-agent, and shall apply to their respective activities in connection with the syndication of the credit facilities provided for herein as well as activities as Administrative Agent.  The Administrative Agent shall not be responsible for the negligence or misconduct of any sub-agents except to the extent that a court of competent jurisdiction determines in a final and non appealable judgment that the Administrative Agent acted with gross negligence or willful misconduct in the selection of such sub-agents.

 

104



 

9.06                         Resignation of Administrative Agent .

 

(a)                                  The Administrative Agent may at any time give notice of its resignation to the Lenders, the L/C Issuer and the Borrower.  Upon receipt of any such notice of resignation, the Required Lenders shall have the right, in consultation with the Borrower, to appoint a successor, which shall be a bank with an office in the United States, or an Affiliate of any such bank with an office in the United States.  If no such successor shall have been so appointed by the Required Lenders and shall have accepted such appointment within 30 days after the retiring Administrative Agent gives notice of its resignation (or such earlier day as shall be agreed by the Required Lenders) (the “ Resignation Effective Date ”), then the retiring Administrative Agent may (but shall not be obligated to) on behalf of the Lenders and the L/C Issuer, appoint a successor Administrative Agent meeting the qualifications set forth above.  Whether or not a successor has been appointed, such resignation shall become effective in accordance with such notice on the Resignation Effective Date.

 

(b)                                  If the Person serving as Administrative Agent is a Defaulting Lender pursuant to clause (d)  of the definition thereof, the Required Lenders may, to the extent permitted by applicable law, by notice in writing to the Borrower and such Person remove such Person as Administrative Agent and, in consultation with the Borrower, appoint a successor. If no such successor shall have been so appointed by the Required Lenders and shall have accepted such appointment within 30 days (or such earlier day as shall be agreed by the Required Lenders) (the “ Removal Effective Date ”), then such removal shall nonetheless become effective in accordance with such notice on the Removal Effective Date.

 

(c)                                   With effect from the Resignation Effective Date or the Removal Effective Date (as applicable) (1) the retiring or removed Administrative Agent shall be discharged from its duties and obligations hereunder and under the other Loan Documents and (2) except for any indemnity payments or other amounts then owed to the retiring or removed Administrative Agent, all payments, communications and determinations provided to be made by, to or through the Administrative Agent shall instead be made by or to each Lender and the L/C Issuer directly, until such time, if any, as the Required Lenders appoint a successor Administrative Agent as provided for above.  Upon the acceptance of a successor’s appointment as Administrative Agent hereunder, such successor shall succeed to and become vested with all of the rights, powers, privileges and duties of the retiring (or removed) Administrative Agent (other than as provided in Section 3.01(g)  and other than any rights to indemnity payments or other amounts owed to the retiring or removed Administrative Agent as of the Resignation Effective Date or the Removal Effective Date, as applicable), and the retiring or removed Administrative Agent shall be discharged from all of its duties and obligations hereunder or under the other Loan Documents (if not already discharged therefrom as provided above in this Section).  The fees payable by the Borrower to a successor Administrative Agent shall be the same as those payable to its predecessor unless otherwise agreed between the Borrower and such successor.  After the retiring or removed Administrative Agent’s resignation or removal hereunder and under the other Loan Documents, the provisions of this Article and Section 10.04 shall continue in effect for the benefit of such retiring or removed Administrative Agent, its sub-agents and their respective Related Parties in respect of any actions taken or omitted to be taken by any of them while the retiring or removed Administrative Agent was acting as Administrative Agent.

 

(d)                                  Any resignation by Bank of America as Administrative Agent pursuant to this Section shall also constitute its resignation as L/C Issuer and Swing Line Lender.  If Bank of

 

105



 

America resigns as an L/C Issuer, it shall retain all the rights, powers, privileges and duties of the L/C Issuer hereunder with respect to all Letters of Credit outstanding as of the effective date of its resignation as L/C Issuer and all L/C Obligations with respect thereto, including the right to require the Lenders to make Base Rate Loans or fund risk participations in Unreimbursed Amounts pursuant to Section 2.03(c) .  If Bank of America resigns as Swing Line Lender, it shall retain all the rights of the Swing Line Lender provided for hereunder with respect to Swing Line Loans made by it and outstanding as of the effective date of such resignation, including the right to require the Lenders to make Base Rate Loans or fund risk participations in outstanding Swing Line Loans pursuant to Section 2.04(c) .  Upon the appointment by the Borrower of a successor L/C Issuer or Swing Line Lender hereunder (which successor shall in all cases be a Lender other than a Defaulting Lender), (a) such successor shall succeed to and become vested with all of the rights, powers, privileges and duties of the retiring L/C Issuer or Swing Line Lender, as applicable, (b) the retiring L/C Issuer and Swing Line Lender shall be discharged from all of their respective duties and obligations hereunder or under the other Loan Documents, and (c) the successor L/C Issuer shall issue letters of credit in substitution for the Letters of Credit, if any, outstanding at the time of such succession or make other arrangements satisfactory to Bank of America to effectively assume the obligations of Bank of America with respect to such Letters of Credit.

 

9.07                         Non-Reliance on Administrative Agent and Other Lenders .  Each Lender and the L/C Issuer acknowledges that it has, independently and without reliance upon the Administrative Agent or any other Lender or any of their Related Parties and based on such documents and information as it has deemed appropriate, made its own credit analysis and decision to enter into this Agreement.  Each Lender and the L/C Issuer also acknowledges that it will, independently and without reliance upon the Administrative Agent or any other Lender or any of their Related Parties and based on such documents and information as it shall from time to time deem appropriate, continue to make its own decisions in taking or not taking action under or based upon this Agreement, any other Loan Document or any related agreement or any document furnished hereunder or thereunder.

 

9.08                         No Other Duties, Etc .  Anything herein to the contrary notwithstanding, none of the Book Manager or the Arranger listed on the cover page hereof shall have any powers, duties or responsibilities under this Agreement or any of the other Loan Documents, except in its capacity, as applicable, as the Administrative Agent, a Lender or the L/C Issuer hereunder.

 

9.09                         Administrative Agent May File Proofs of Claim .  In case of the pendency of any proceeding under any Debtor Relief Law or any other judicial proceeding relative to any Loan Party, the Administrative Agent (irrespective of whether the principal of any Loan or L/C Obligation shall then be due and payable as herein expressed or by declaration or otherwise and irrespective of whether the Administrative Agent shall have made any demand on the Borrower) shall be entitled and empowered, by intervention in such proceeding or otherwise

 

(a)                                  to file and prove a claim for the whole amount of the principal and interest owing and unpaid in respect of the Loans, L/C Obligations and all other Obligations that are owing and unpaid and to file such other documents as may be necessary or advisable in order to have the claims of the Lenders, the L/C Issuer and the Administrative Agent (including any claim for the reasonable compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Lenders, the L/C Issuer

 

106



 

and the Administrative Agent and their respective agents and counsel and all other amounts due the Lenders, the L/C Issuer and the Administrative Agent under Sections 2.03(i)  and (j) , 2.09 and 10.04 ) allowed in such judicial proceeding; and

 

(b)                                  to collect and receive any monies or other property payable or deliverable on any such claims and to distribute the same;

 

and any custodian, receiver, assignee, trustee, liquidator, sequestrator or other similar official in any such judicial proceeding is hereby authorized by each Lender and the L/C Issuer to make such payments to the Administrative Agent and, if the Administrative Agent shall consent to the making of such payments directly to the Lenders and the L/C Issuer, to pay to the Administrative Agent any amount due for the reasonable compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Administrative Agent and its agents and counsel, and any other amounts due the Administrative Agent under Sections 2.09 and 10.04 .

 

Nothing contained herein shall be deemed to authorize the Administrative Agent to authorize or consent to or accept or adopt on behalf of any Lender or the L/C Issuer any plan of reorganization, arrangement, adjustment or composition affecting the Obligations or the rights of any Lender or the L/C Issuer to authorize the Administrative Agent to vote in respect of the claim of any Lender or the L/C Issuer or in any such proceeding.

 

9.10                         Collateral and Guaranty Matters .  Without limiting the provisions of Section 9.09 , the Lenders (including in its capacities as a potential Cash Management Bank and a potential Hedge Bank) and the L/C Issuer irrevocably authorize the Administrative Agent, at its option and in its discretion,

 

(a)                                  to release any Lien on any property granted to or held by the Administrative Agent under any Loan Document (i) upon termination of the Aggregate Commitments and payment in full of all Obligations (other than (A) contingent indemnification obligations and (B) obligations and liabilities under Secured Cash Management Agreements and Secured Hedge Agreements as to which arrangements satisfactory to the applicable Cash Management Bank or Hedge Bank shall have been made) and the expiration or termination of all Letters of Credit (other than Letters of Credit as to which other arrangements satisfactory to the Administrative Agent and the L/C Issuer shall have been made), (ii) that is sold or otherwise disposed of or to be sold or otherwise disposed of as part of or in connection with any sale or other disposition permitted hereunder or under any other Loan Document, or (iii)  if approved, authorized or ratified in writing in accordance with Section 10.01 ;

 

(b)                                  to subordinate any Lien on any property granted to or held by the Administrative Agent under any Loan Document to the holder of any Lien on such property that is permitted by Section 7.01(i) ;

 

(c)                                   to release any Subsidiary Guarantor from its obligations under the Subsidiary Guaranty if such Subsidiary Guarantor ceases to be a Subsidiary of the Borrower as a result of a transaction permitted under the Loan Documents (or is re-designated as an Immaterial Subsidiary); and

 

107



 

(d)                                  to release Holdings from its obligations under the Holdings Guaranty upon expiration or termination of such Guaranty in accordance with its terms or otherwise as permitted under the Loan Documents.

 

Upon request by the Administrative Agent at any time, the Required Lenders will confirm in writing the Administrative Agent’s authority to release or subordinate its interest in particular types or items of property, or to release any Subsidiary Guarantor from its obligations under the Subsidiary Guaranty pursuant to this Section 9.10 .  In each case as specified in this Section 9.10 , the Administrative Agent will, at the Borrower’s expense, execute and deliver to the applicable Loan Party such documents as such Loan Party may reasonably request to evidence the release of such item of Collateral from the assignment and security interest granted under the Collateral Documents or to subordinate its interest in such item, or to release such Subsidiary Guarantor from its obligations under the Subsidiary Guaranty, in each case in accordance with the terms of the Loan Documents and this Section 9.10 .

 

The Administrative Agent shall not be responsible for or have a duty to ascertain or inquire into any representation or warranty regarding the existence, value or collectability of the Collateral, the existence, priority or perfection of the Administrative Agent’s Lien thereon, or any certificate prepared by any Loan Party in connection therewith, nor shall the Administrative Agent be responsible or liable to the Lenders for any failure to monitor or maintain any portion of the Collateral.

 

9.11                         Secured Cash Management Agreements and Secured Hedge Agreements .  No Cash Management Bank or Hedge Bank that obtains the benefits of Section 8.03 , the Holdings Guaranty, the Subsidiary Guaranty or any Collateral by virtue of the provisions hereof or of the Holdings Guaranty or the Subsidiary Guaranty or any Collateral Document shall have any right to notice of any action or to consent to, direct or object to any action hereunder or under any other Loan Document or otherwise in respect of the Collateral (including the release or impairment of any Collateral) other than in its capacity as a Lender and, in such case, only to the extent expressly provided in the Loan Documents.  Notwithstanding any other provision of this Article IX to the contrary, the Administrative Agent shall not be required to verify the payment of, or that other satisfactory arrangements have been made with respect to, Obligations arising under Secured Cash Management Agreements and Secured Hedge Agreements unless the Administrative Agent has received written notice of such Obligations, together with such supporting documentation as the Administrative Agent may request, from the applicable Cash Management Bank or Hedge Bank, as the case may be.

 

ARTICLE X.
MISCELLANEOUS

 

10.01                  Amendments, Etc .  No amendment or waiver of any provision of this Agreement or any other Loan Document, and no consent to any departure by the Borrower or any other Loan Party therefrom, shall be effective unless in writing signed by the Required Lenders and the Borrower or the applicable Loan Party, as the case may be, and acknowledged by the Administrative Agent, and each such waiver or consent shall be effective only in the specific instance and for the specific purpose for which given; provided , however , that no such amendment, waiver or consent shall:

 

108



 

(a)                                  waive any condition set forth in Section 4.01 (other than Section 4.01(b)(i)  or (c) ), or, in the case of the Credit Extension to be made on the Closing Date, if any, Section 4.02 , without the written consent of each Lender;

 

(b)                                  extend or increase the Commitment of any Lender (or reinstate any Commitment terminated pursuant to Section 8.02 ) without the written consent of such Lender;

 

(c)                                   postpone any date fixed by this Agreement or any other Loan Document for any payment of principal, interest, fees or other amounts due to the Lenders (or any of them) without the written consent of each Lender directly affected thereby;

 

(d)                                  reduce the principal of, or the rate of interest specified herein on, any Loan or L/C Borrowing, or (subject to clause (iv) of the second proviso to this Section 10.01 ) any fees or other amounts payable hereunder or under any other Loan Document, or change the manner of computation of any financial ratio (including any change in any applicable defined term) used in determining the Applicable Rate that would result in a reduction of any interest rate on any Loan or any fee payable hereunder without the written consent of each Lender entitled to such amount; provided , however , that only the consent of the Required Lenders shall be necessary to amend the definition of “ Default Rate ” or to waive any obligation of the Borrower to pay interest or Letter of Credit Fees at the Default Rate;

 

(e)                                   change Section 2.13 or Section 8.03 in a manner that would alter the pro rata sharing of payments required thereby without the written consent of each Lender;

 

(f)                                    change any provision of this Section 10.01 or the definition of “ Required Lenders ” or any other provision hereof specifying the number or percentage of Lenders required to amend, waive or otherwise modify any rights hereunder or make any determination or grant any consent hereunder without the written consent of each Lender;

 

(g)                                   release all or substantially all of the Collateral in any transaction or series of related transactions, without the written consent of each Lender; or

 

(h)                                  release all or substantially all of the value of the Subsidiary Guaranty, without the written consent of each Lender, except to the extent the release of any Subsidiary Guarantor from its Subsidiary Guaranty is permitted pursuant to Section 9.10 (in which case such release may be made by the Administrative Agent acting alone);

 

and provided , further , that (i) no amendment, waiver or consent shall, unless in writing and signed by the L/C Issuer in addition to the Lenders required above, affect the rights or duties of the L/C Issuer under this Agreement or any Issuer Document relating to any Letter of Credit issued or to be issued by it; (ii) no amendment, waiver or consent shall, unless in writing and signed by the Swing Line Lender in addition to the Lenders required above, affect the rights or duties of the Swing Line Lender under this Agreement; (iii) no amendment, waiver or consent shall, unless in writing and signed by the Administrative Agent in addition to the Lenders required above, affect the rights or duties of the Administrative Agent under this Agreement or any other Loan Document; and (iv) the Fee Letter may be amended, or rights or privileges thereunder waived, in a writing executed only by the parties thereto.  Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, no Defaulting Lender shall have any right to approve or disapprove any

 

109



 

amendment, waiver or consent hereunder (and any amendment, waiver or consent which by its terms requires the consent of all Lenders or each affected Lender may be effected with the consent of the applicable Lenders other than Defaulting Lenders), except that (x) the Commitment of any Defaulting Lender may not be increased or extended without the consent of such Lender and (y) any waiver, amendment or modification requiring the consent of all Lenders or each affected Lender that by its terms affects any Defaulting Lender disproportionately adversely relative to other affected Lenders shall require the consent of such Defaulting Lender.

 

If any Lender does not consent to a proposed amendment, waiver, consent or release with respect to any Loan Document that requires the consent of all or all affected Lenders and that has been approved by the Required Lenders, the Borrower may replace such non-consenting Lender in accordance with Section 10.13 ; provided that such amendment, waiver, consent or release can be effected as a result of the assignment contemplated by such Section (together with all other such assignments required by the Borrower to be made pursuant to this paragraph).

 

10.02                  Notices; Effectiveness; Electronic Communications .  (a)  Notices Generally .  Except in the case of notices and other communications expressly permitted to be given by telephone (and except as provided in subsection (b) below), all notices and other communications provided for herein shall be in writing and shall be delivered by hand or overnight courier service, mailed by certified or registered mail or sent by facsimile as follows, and all notices and other communications expressly permitted hereunder to be given by telephone shall be made to the applicable telephone number, as follows:

 

(i)                                      if to the Borrower, Holdings or any other Loan Party, the Administrative Agent, the L/C Issuer or the Swing Line Lender, to the address, facsimile number, electronic mail address or telephone number specified for such Person on Schedule 10.02 ; and

 

(ii)                                   if to any other Lender, to the address, facsimile number, electronic mail address or telephone number specified in its Administrative Questionnaire (including, as appropriate, notices delivered solely to the Person designated by a Lender on its Administrative Questionnaire then in effect for the delivery of notices that may contain material non-public information relating to the Borrower).

 

Notices and other communications sent by hand or overnight courier service, or mailed by certified or registered mail, shall be deemed to have been given when received; notices and other communications sent by facsimile shall be deemed to have been given when sent (except that, if not given during normal business hours for the recipient, shall be deemed to have been given at the opening of business on the next Business Day for the recipient).  Notices and other communications delivered through electronic communications to the extent provided in subsection (b) below shall be effective as provided in such subsection (b).

 

(b)                                  Electronic Communications .  Notices and other communications to the Lenders and the L/C Issuer hereunder may be delivered or furnished by electronic communication (including e-mail and Internet or intranet websites) pursuant to procedures approved by the Administrative Agent, provided that the foregoing shall not apply to notices to any Lender or the L/C Issuer pursuant to Article II if such Lender or the L/C Issuer, as applicable, has notified the

 

110



 

Administrative Agent that it is incapable of receiving notices under such Article by electronic communication.  The Administrative Agent, the Swingline Lender, the L/C Issuer or the Borrower may each, in its discretion, agree to accept notices and other communications to it hereunder by electronic communications pursuant to procedures approved by it, provided that approval of such procedures may be limited to particular notices or communications.

 

Unless the Administrative Agent otherwise prescribes, (i) notices and other communications sent to an e-mail address shall be deemed received upon the sender’s receipt of an acknowledgement from the intended recipient (such as by the “ return receipt requested ” function, as available, return e-mail or other written acknowledgement), and (ii) notices or communications posted to an Internet or intranet website shall be deemed received upon the deemed receipt by the intended recipient at its e-mail address as described in the foregoing clause (i) of notification that such notice or communication is available and identifying the website address therefor; provided that, for both clauses (i)  and (ii) , if such notice, email or other communication is not sent during the normal business hours of the recipient, such notice, email or communication shall be deemed to have been sent at the opening of business on the next business day for the recipient.

 

(c)                                   The Platform .  THE PLATFORM IS PROVIDED “ AS IS ” AND “ AS AVAILABLE .”  THE AGENT PARTIES (AS DEFINED BELOW) DO NOT WARRANT THE ACCURACY OR COMPLETENESS OF THE BORROWER MATERIALS OR THE ADEQUACY OF THE PLATFORM, AND EXPRESSLY DISCLAIM LIABILITY FOR ERRORS IN OR OMISSIONS FROM THE BORROWER MATERIALS.  NO WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR STATUTORY, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, NON-INFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS OR FREEDOM FROM VIRUSES OR OTHER CODE DEFECTS, IS MADE BY ANY AGENT PARTY IN CONNECTION WITH THE BORROWER MATERIALS OR THE PLATFORM.  In no event shall the Administrative Agent or any of its Related Parties (collectively, the “ Agent Parties ”) have any liability to the Loan Parties, any Lender, the L/C Issuer or any other Person for losses, claims, damages, liabilities or expenses of any kind (whether in tort, contract or otherwise) arising out of the Borrower’s, any other Loan Party’s or the Administrative Agent’s transmission of Borrower Materials through the Internet.

 

(d)                                  Change of Address, Etc .  Each of the Borrower, the Administrative Agent, the L/C Issuer and the Swing Line Lender may change its address, facsimile or telephone number for notices and other communications hereunder by notice to the other parties hereto.  Each other Lender may change its address, facsimile or telephone number for notices and other communications hereunder by notice to the Borrower, the Administrative Agent, the L/C Issuer and the Swing Line Lender.  In addition, each Lender agrees to notify the Administrative Agent from time to time to ensure that the Administrative Agent has on record (i) an effective address, contact name, telephone number, facsimile number and electronic mail address to which notices and other communications may be sent and (ii) accurate wire instructions for such Lender.  Furthermore, each Public Lender agrees to cause at least one individual at or on behalf of such Public Lender to at all times have selected the “ Private Side Information ” or similar designation on the content declaration screen of the Platform in order to enable such Public Lender or its delegate, in accordance with such Public Lender’s compliance procedures and applicable Law, including United States Federal and state securities Laws, to make reference to Borrower

 

111



 

Materials that are not made available through the “ Public Side Information ” portion of the Platform and that may contain material non-public information with respect to the Borrower or its securities for purposes of United States Federal or state securities laws.

 

(e)                                   Reliance by Administrative Agent, L/C Issuer and Lenders .   The Administrative Agent, the L/C Issuer and the Lenders shall be entitled to rely and act upon any notices (including telephonic or electronic Revolving Credit Loan Notices, Letter of Credit Applications and Swing Line Loan Notices) purportedly given by or on behalf of the Borrower even if (i) such notices were not made in a manner specified herein, were incomplete or were not preceded or followed by any other form of notice specified herein, or (ii) the terms thereof, as understood by the recipient, varied from any confirmation thereof.  The Borrower shall indemnify the Administrative Agent, the L/C Issuer, each Lender and the Related Parties of each of them from all losses, costs, expenses and liabilities resulting from the reliance by such Person on each notice purportedly given by or on behalf of the Borrower.  All telephonic notices to and other telephonic communications with the Administrative Agent may be recorded by the Administrative Agent, and each of the parties hereto hereby consents to such recording.

 

10.03                  No Waiver; Cumulative Remedies; Enforcement .  No failure by any Lender, the L/C Issuer or the Administrative Agent to exercise, and no delay by any such Person in exercising, any right, remedy, power or privilege hereunder or under any other Loan Document shall operate as a waiver thereof; nor shall any single or partial exercise of any right, remedy, power or privilege hereunder preclude any other or further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other right, remedy, power or privilege.  The rights, remedies, powers and privileges herein provided, and provided under each other Loan Document, are cumulative and not exclusive of any rights, remedies, powers and privileges provided by law.

 

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein or in any other Loan Document, the authority to enforce rights and remedies hereunder and under the other Loan Documents against the Loan Parties or any of them shall be vested exclusively in, and all actions and proceedings at law in connection with such enforcement shall be instituted and maintained exclusively by, the Administrative Agent in accordance with Section 8.02 for the benefit of all the Lenders and the L/C Issuer; provided , however , that the foregoing shall not prohibit (a) the Administrative Agent from exercising on its own behalf the rights and remedies that inure to its benefit (solely in its capacity as Administrative Agent) hereunder and under the other Loan Documents, (b) the L/C Issuer or the Swing Line Lender from exercising the rights and remedies that inure to its benefit (solely in its capacity as L/C Issuer or Swing Line Lender, as the case may be) hereunder and under the other Loan Documents, (c) any Lender from exercising setoff rights in accordance with Section 10.08 (subject to the terms of Section 2.13 ), or (d) any Lender from filing proofs of claim or appearing and filing pleadings on its own behalf during the pendency of a proceeding relative to any Loan Party under any Debtor Relief Law; and provided , further , that if at any time there is no Person acting as Administrative Agent hereunder and under the other Loan Documents, then (i) the Required Lenders shall have the rights otherwise ascribed to the Administrative Agent pursuant to Section 8.02 and (ii) in addition to the matters set forth in clauses (b), (c) and (d) of the preceding proviso and subject to Section 2.13 , any Lender may, with the consent of the Required Lenders, enforce any rights and remedies available to it and as authorized by the Required Lenders.

 

112



 

10.04                  Expenses; Indemnity; Damage Waiver .  (a)  Costs and Expenses .  The Borrower shall pay (i) all reasonable and documented out-of-pocket expenses incurred by the Administrative Agent and its Affiliates (including the reasonable fees, charges and disbursements of counsel for the Administrative Agent), in connection with the syndication of the credit facilities provided for herein, the preparation, negotiation, execution, delivery and administration of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents or any amendments, modifications or waivers of the provisions hereof or thereof (whether or not the transactions contemplated hereby or thereby shall be consummated), (ii) all reasonable and documented out-of-pocket expenses incurred by the L/C Issuer in connection with the issuance, amendment, renewal or extension of any Letter of Credit or any demand for payment thereunder and (iii) all documented, out-of-pocket expenses incurred by the Administrative Agent, any Lender or the L/C Issuer (including the fees, charges and disbursements of any counsel for the Administrative Agent, any Lender or the L/C Issuer), in connection with the enforcement or protection of its rights (A) in connection with this Agreement and the other Loan Documents, including its rights under this Section, or (B) in connection with Loans made or Letters of Credit issued hereunder, including all such out-of-pocket expenses incurred during any workout, restructuring or negotiations in respect of such Loans or Letters of Credit.

 

(b)                                  Indemnification by the Borrower .  The Borrower shall indemnify the Administrative Agent (and any sub-agent thereof), each Lender and the L/C Issuer, and each Related Party of any of the foregoing Persons (each such Person being called an “ Indemnitee ”) against, and hold each Indemnitee harmless from, any and all losses, claims, damages, liabilities and related expenses (including the fees, charges and disbursements of any counsel for any Indemnitee (which may include the allocated cost of internal counsel)), incurred by any Indemnitee or asserted against any Indemnitee by any Person (including the Borrower or any other Loan Party) other than such Indemnitee and its Related Parties arising out of, in connection with, or as a result of (i) the execution or delivery of this Agreement, any other Loan Document or any agreement or instrument contemplated hereby or thereby, the performance by the parties hereto of their respective obligations hereunder or thereunder or the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby or thereby, or, in the case of the Administrative Agent (and any sub-agent thereof) and its Related Parties only, the administration of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents, (ii) any Loan or Letter of Credit or the use or proposed use of the proceeds therefrom (including any refusal by the L/C Issuer to honor a demand for payment under a Letter of Credit if the documents presented in connection with such demand do not strictly comply with the terms of such Letter of Credit), (iii) any actual or alleged presence or release of Hazardous Materials on or from any property owned or operated by the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries, or any Environmental Liability arising with respect to the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries, or (iv) any actual or prospective claim, litigation, investigation or proceeding relating to any of the foregoing, whether based on contract, tort or any other theory, whether brought by a third party or by the Borrower or any other Loan Party, and regardless of whether any Indemnitee is a party thereto,  IN ALL CASES, WHETHER OR NOT CAUSED BY OR ARISING, IN WHOLE OR IN PART, OUT OF THE COMPARATIVE, CONTRIBUTORY OR SOLE NEGLIGENCE OF THE INDEMNITEE ; provided that such indemnity shall not, as to any Indemnitee, be available to the extent that such losses, claims, damages, liabilities or related expenses (x) are determined by a court of competent jurisdiction by final and nonappealable judgment to have resulted from the gross negligence or willful misconduct of such Indemnitee or (y) result from a claim brought by the Borrower or any other

 

113


 

Loan Party against an Indemnitee for breach in bad faith of such Indemnitee’s obligations hereunder or under any other Loan Document, if the Borrower or such Loan Party has obtained a final and nonappealable judgment in its favor on such claim as determined by a court of competent jurisdiction.

 

(c)                                   Reimbursement by Lenders .  To the extent that the Borrower for any reason fails to indefeasibly pay any amount required under subsection (a) or (b) of this Section to be paid by it to the Administrative Agent (or any sub-agent thereof), the L/C Issuer, the Swing Line Lender or any Related Party of any of the foregoing, each Lender severally agrees to pay to the Administrative Agent (or any such sub-agent), the L/C Issuer, the Swing Line Lender or such Related Party, as the case may be, such Lender’s pro rata share (determined as of the time that the applicable unreimbursed expense or indemnity payment is sought based on each Lender’s share of the Total Credit Exposure at such time) of such unpaid amount (including any such unpaid amount in respect of a claim asserted by such Lender), such payment to be made severally among them based on such Lenders’ Applicable Percentage (determined as of the time that the applicable unreimbursed expense or indemnity payment is sought), provided , further that, the unreimbursed expense or indemnified loss, claim, damage, liability or related expense, as the case may be, was incurred by or asserted against the Administrative Agent (or any such sub-agent), the L/C Issuer or the Swing Line Lender in its capacity as such, or against any Related Party of any of the foregoing acting for the Administrative Agent (or any such sub-agent), the L/C Issuer or the Swing Line Lender in connection with such capacity.  The obligations of the Lenders under this subsection (c) are subject to the provisions of Section 2.12(d) .

 

(d)                                  Waiver of Consequential Damages, Etc .  To the fullest extent permitted by applicable law, the Borrower shall not assert, and hereby waives, and acknowledges that no other Person shall have, any claim against any Indemnitee, on any theory of liability, for special, indirect, consequential or punitive damages (as opposed to direct or actual damages) arising out of, in connection with, or as a result of, this Agreement, any other Loan Document or any agreement or instrument contemplated hereby, the transactions contemplated hereby or thereby, any Loan or Letter of Credit or the use of the proceeds thereof.  No Indemnitee referred to in subsection (b) above shall be liable for any damages arising from the use by unintended recipients of any information or other materials distributed to such unintended recipients by such Indemnitee through telecommunications, electronic or other information transmission systems in connection with this Agreement or the other Loan Documents or the transactions contemplated hereby or thereby other than for direct or actual damages resulting from the gross negligence or willful misconduct of such Indemnitee as determined by a final and nonappealable judgment of a court of competent jurisdiction.

 

(e)                                   Payments .  All amounts due under this Section shall be payable not later than ten Business Days after demand therefor.

 

(f)                                    Survival .  The agreements in this Section and the indemnity provisions of Section 10.02(e)  shall survive the resignation of the Administrative Agent, the L/C Issuer and the Swing Line Lender, the replacement of any Lender, the termination of the Aggregate Commitments and the repayment, satisfaction or discharge of all the other Obligations.

 

114



 

10.05                  Payments Set Aside .  To the extent that any payment by or on behalf of the Borrower is made to the Administrative Agent, the L/C Issuer or any Lender, or the Administrative Agent, the L/C Issuer or any Lender exercises its right of setoff, and such payment or the proceeds of such setoff or any part thereof is subsequently invalidated, declared to be fraudulent or preferential, set aside or required (including pursuant to any settlement entered into by the Administrative Agent, the L/C Issuer or such Lender in its discretion) to be repaid to a trustee, receiver or any other party, in connection with any proceeding under any Debtor Relief Law or otherwise, then (a) to the extent of such recovery, the obligation or part thereof originally intended to be satisfied shall be revived and continued in full force and effect as if such payment had not been made or such setoff had not occurred, and (b) each Lender and the L/C Issuer severally agrees to pay to the Administrative Agent upon demand its applicable share (without duplication) of any amount so recovered from or repaid by the Administrative Agent, plus interest thereon from the date of such demand to the date such payment is made at a rate per annum equal to the Federal Funds Rate from time to time in effect.  The obligations of the Lenders and the L/C Issuer under clause (b) of the preceding sentence shall survive the payment in full of the Obligations and the termination of this Agreement.

 

10.06                  Successors and Assigns .  (a)  Successors and Assigns Generally .  The provisions of this Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the parties hereto and their respective successors and assigns permitted hereby, except that the Borrower may not assign or otherwise transfer any of its rights or obligations hereunder without the prior written consent of the Administrative Agent and each Lender and no Lender may assign or otherwise transfer any of its rights or obligations hereunder except (i) to an assignee in accordance with the provisions of Section 10.06(b) , (ii) by way of participation in accordance with the provisions of Section 10.06(d) , or (iii) by way of pledge or assignment of a security interest subject to the restrictions of Section 10.06(f) (and any other attempted assignment or transfer by any party hereto shall be null and void).  Nothing in this Agreement, expressed or implied, shall be construed to confer upon any Person (other than the parties hereto, their respective successors and assigns permitted hereby, Participants to the extent provided in subsection (d) of this Section and, to the extent expressly contemplated hereby, the Related Parties of each of the Administrative Agent, the L/C Issuer and the Lenders) any legal or equitable right, remedy or claim under or by reason of this Agreement.

 

(b)                                  Assignments by Lenders .  Any Lender may at any time assign to one or more assignees all or a portion of its rights and obligations under this Agreement (including all or a portion of its Commitment(s) and the Loans (including for purposes of this Section 10.06(b) , participations in L/C Obligations and in Swing Line Loans) at the time owing to it); provided that any such assignment shall be subject to the following conditions:

 

(i)                                      Minimum Amounts .

 

(A)                                in the case of an assignment of the entire remaining amount of the assigning Lender’s Commitment and the Loans at the time owing to it or in the case of an assignment to a Lender, an Affiliate of a Lender or an Approved Fund, no minimum amount need be assigned; and

 

(B)                                in any case not described in subsection (b)(i)(A) of this Section,

 

115



 

the aggregate amount of the Commitment (which for this purpose includes Loans outstanding thereunder) or, if the applicable Commitment is not then in effect, the principal outstanding balance of the Loans of the assigning Lender subject to each such assignment, determined as of the date the Assignment and Assumption with respect to such assignment is delivered to the Administrative Agent or, if “ Trade Date ” is specified in the Assignment and Assumption, as of the Trade Date, shall not be less than $5,000,000, unless each of the Administrative Agent and, so long as no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing, the Borrower otherwise consents (each such consent not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed);

 

(ii)                                   Proportionate Amounts .  Each partial assignment shall be made as an assignment of a proportionate part of all the assigning Lender’s rights and obligations under this Agreement with respect to the Loans or the Commitment assigned, except that this clause (ii) shall not apply to the Swing Line Lender’s rights and obligations in respect of Swing Line Loans;

 

(iii)                                Required Consents .  No consent shall be required for any assignment except to the extent required by subsection (b)(i)(B) of this Section and, in addition:

 

(A)                                the consent of the Borrower (such consent not to be unreasonably withheld) shall be required unless (1) an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing at the time of such assignment or (2) such assignment is to a Lender, an Affiliate of a Lender or an Approved Fund; provided that the Borrower shall be deemed to have consented to any such assignment unless it shall object thereto by written notice to the Administrative Agent within five (5) Business Days after having received notice thereof;

 

(B)                                the consent of the Administrative Agent (such consent not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed) shall be required if such assignment is to a Person that is not a Lender, an Affiliate of such Lender or an Approved Fund with respect to such Lender; and

 

(C)                                the consent of the L/C Issuer and the Swing Line Lender shall be required for any assignment.

 

(iv)                               Assignment and Assumption .  The parties to each assignment shall execute and deliver to the Administrative Agent an Assignment and Assumption, together with a processing and recordation fee in the amount of $3,500; provided , however , that the Administrative Agent may, in its sole discretion, elect to waive such processing and recordation fee in the case of any assignment.  The assignee, if it is not a Lender, shall deliver to the Administrative Agent an Administrative Questionnaire.

 

(v)                                  No Assignment to Certain Persons .  No such assignment shall be made (A) to the Borrower, Holdings or their Affiliates or Subsidiaries, (B) to any Defaulting Lender or any of its Subsidiaries, or any Person who, upon becoming a Lender hereunder, would constitute any of the foregoing Persons described in this clause (B), or (C) to a natural Person.

 

116



 

(vi)                               Certain Additional Payments .  In connection with any assignment of rights and obligations of any Defaulting Lender hereunder, no such assignment shall be effective unless and until, in addition to the other conditions thereto set forth herein, the parties to the assignment shall make such additional payments to the Administrative Agent in an aggregate amount sufficient, upon distribution thereof as appropriate (which may be outright payment, purchases by the assignee of participations or subparticipations, or other compensating actions, including funding, with the consent of the Borrower and the Administrative Agent, the applicable pro rata share of Loans previously requested but not funded by the Defaulting Lender, to each of which the applicable assignee and assignor hereby irrevocably consent), to (x) pay and satisfy in full all payment liabilities then owed by such Defaulting Lender to the Administrative Agent, the L/C Issuer or any Lender hereunder (and interest accrued thereon) and (y) acquire (and fund as appropriate) its full pro rata share of all Loans and participations in Letters of Credit and Swing Line Loans in accordance with its Applicable Percentage.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, in the event that any assignment of rights and obligations of any Defaulting Lender hereunder shall become effective under applicable Law without compliance with the provisions of this paragraph, then the assignee of such interest shall be deemed to be a Defaulting Lender for all purposes of this Agreement until such compliance occurs.

 

Subject to acceptance and recording thereof by the Administrative Agent pursuant to subsection (c) of this Section, from and after the effective date specified in each Assignment and Assumption, the assignee thereunder shall be a party to this Agreement and, to the extent of the interest assigned by such Assignment and Assumption, have the rights and obligations of a Lender under this Agreement, and the assigning Lender thereunder shall, to the extent of the interest assigned by such Assignment and Assumption, be released from its obligations under this Agreement (and, in the case of an Assignment and Assumption covering all of the assigning Lender’s rights and obligations under this Agreement, such Lender shall cease to be a party hereto) but shall continue to be entitled to the benefits of Sections 3.01 , 3.04 , 3.05 and 10.04 with respect to facts and circumstances occurring prior to the effective date of such assignment; provided , that except to the extent otherwise expressly agreed by the affected parties, no assignment by a Defaulting Lender will constitute a waiver or release of any claim of any party hereunder arising from that Lender’s having been a Defaulting Lender.  Upon request, the Borrower (at its expense) shall execute and deliver a Note to the assignee Lender.  Any assignment or transfer by a Lender of rights or obligations under this Agreement that does not comply with this subsection shall be treated for purposes of this Agreement as a sale by such Lender of a participation in such rights and obligations in accordance with Section 10.06(d) .

 

(c)                                   Register .  The Administrative Agent, acting solely for this purpose as an agent of the Borrower (and such agency being solely for tax purposes), shall maintain at the Administrative Agent’s Office a copy of each Assignment and Assumption delivered to it (or the equivalent thereof in electronic form) and a register for the recordation of the names and addresses of the Lenders, and the Commitments of, and principal amounts (and stated interest) of the Loans and L/C Obligations owing to, each Lender pursuant to the terms hereof from time to time (the “ Register ”).  The entries in the Register shall be conclusive absent manifest error, and the Borrower, the Administrative Agent and the Lenders shall treat each Person whose name is recorded in the Register pursuant to the terms hereof as a Lender hereunder for all purposes of

 

117



 

this Agreement.  The Register shall be available for inspection by the Borrower and any Lender, at any reasonable time and from time to time upon reasonable prior notice.

 

(d)                                  Participations .  Any Lender may at any time, without the consent of, or notice to, the Borrower or the Administrative Agent, sell participations to any Person (other than a natural Person, a Defaulting Lender or Holdings or the Borrower or any of their respective Affiliates or Subsidiaries) (each, a “ Participant ”) in all or a portion of such Lender’s rights and/or obligations under this Agreement (including all or a portion of its Commitment and/or the Loans (including such Lender’s participations in L/C Obligations and/or Swing Line Loans) owing to it); provided that (i) such Lender’s obligations under this Agreement shall remain unchanged, (ii) such Lender shall remain solely responsible to the other parties hereto for the performance of such obligations and (iii) the Borrower, the Administrative Agent, the Lenders and the L/C Issuer shall continue to deal solely and directly with such Lender in connection with such Lender’s rights and obligations under this Agreement.  Any agreement or instrument pursuant to which a Lender sells such a participation shall provide that such Lender shall retain the sole right to enforce this Agreement and to approve any amendment, modification or waiver of any provision of this Agreement; provided that such agreement or instrument may provide that such Lender will not, without the consent of the Participant, agree to any amendment, waiver or other modification described in the first proviso to Section 10.01 that affects such Participant. To the extent permitted by law, each Participant also shall be entitled to the benefits of Section 10.08 as though it were a Lender, provided such Participant agrees to be subject to Section 2.13 as though it were a Lender.  For the avoidance of doubt, each Lender shall be responsible for the indemnity under Section 10.04(c) without regard to the existence of any participation.

 

Any agreement or instrument pursuant to which a Lender sells such a participation shall provide that such Lender shall retain the sole right to enforce this Agreement and to approve any amendment, modification or waiver of any provision of this Agreement; provided that such agreement or instrument may provide that such Lender will not, without the consent of the Participant, agree to any amendment, waiver or other modification described in the first proviso to Section 10.01 that affects such Participant.  The Borrower agrees that each Participant shall be entitled to the benefits of Sections 3.01 , 3.04 and 3.05 to the same extent as if it were a Lender and had acquired its interest by assignment pursuant to subsection (b)  of this Section (it being understood that the documentation required under Section 3.01(e)  shall be delivered to the Lender who sells the participation) to the same extent as if it were a Lender and had acquired its interest by assignment pursuant to paragraph (b) of this Section; provided that such Participant (A) agrees to be subject to the provisions of Sections 3.06 and 10.13 as if it were an assignee under paragraph (b) of this Section and (B) shall not be entitled to receive any greater payment under Sections 3.01 or 3.04 , with respect to any participation, than the Lender from whom it acquired the applicable participation would have been entitled to receive had the participation not been sold.  Each Lender that sells a participation agrees, at the Borrower’s request and expense, to use reasonable efforts to cooperate with the Borrower to effectuate the provisions of Section 3.06 with respect to any Participant.  To the extent permitted by law, each Participant also shall be entitled to the benefits of Section 10.08 as though it were a Lender; provided that such Participant agrees to be subject to Section 2.13 as though it were a Lender.  Each Lender that sells a participation shall, acting solely for this purpose as an agent of the Borrower, maintain a register on which it enters the name and address of each Participant and the principal amounts (and stated interest) of each Participant’s interest in the Loans or other obligations under

 

118



 

the Loan Documents (the “ Participant Register ”); provided that no Lender shall have any obligation to disclose all or any portion of the Participant Register (including the identity of any Participant or any information relating to a Participant’s interest in any commitments, loans, letters of credit or its other obligations under any Loan Document) to any Person except to the extent that such disclosure is necessary to establish that such commitment, loan, letter of credit or other obligation is in registered form under Section 5f.103-1(c) of the United States Treasury Regulations.  The entries in the Participant Register shall be conclusive absent manifest error, and such Lender shall treat each Person whose name is recorded in the Participant Register as the owner of such participation for all purposes of this Agreement notwithstanding any notice to the contrary.  For the avoidance of doubt, the Administrative Agent (in its capacity as Administrative Agent) shall have no responsibility for maintaining a Participant Register.

 

(e)                                   Certain Pledges .  Any Lender may at any time pledge or assign a security interest in all or any portion of its rights under this Agreement (including under its Note, if any) to secure obligations of such Lender, including any pledge or assignment to secure obligations to a Federal Reserve Bank; provided that no such pledge or assignment shall release such Lender from any of its obligations hereunder or substitute any such pledgee or assignee for such Lender as a party hereto.

 

(f)                                    Resignation as L/C Issuer or Swing Line Lender after Assignment .  Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein, if at any time Bank of America assigns all of its Commitment and Revolving Credit Loans pursuant to Section 10.06(b) , Bank of America may, (i) upon 30 days’ notice to the Borrower and the Lenders, resign as L/C Issuer and/or (ii) upon 30 days’ notice to the Borrower, resign as Swing Line Lender.  In the event of any such resignation as L/C Issuer or Swing Line Lender, the Borrower shall be entitled to appoint from among the Lenders a successor L/C Issuer or Swing Line Lender hereunder; provided , however , that no failure by the Borrower to appoint any such successor shall affect the resignation of Bank of America as L/C Issuer or Swing Line Lender, as the case may be.  If Bank of America resigns as L/C Issuer, it shall retain all the rights, powers, privileges and duties of the L/C Issuer hereunder with respect to all Letters of Credit outstanding as of the effective date of its resignation as L/C Issuer and all L/C Obligations with respect thereto (including the right to require the Lenders to make Base Rate Loans or fund risk participations in Unreimbursed Amounts pursuant to Section 2.03(c) ).  If Bank of America resigns as Swing Line Lender, it shall retain all the rights of the Swing Line Lender provided for hereunder with respect to Swing Line Loans made by it and outstanding as of the effective date of such resignation, including the right to require the Lenders to make Base Rate Loans or fund risk participations in outstanding Swing Line Loans pursuant to Section 2.04(c) .  Upon the appointment of a successor L/C Issuer and/or Swing Line Lender, (a) such successor shall succeed to and become vested with all of the rights, powers, privileges and duties of the retiring L/C Issuer or Swing Line Lender, as the case may be, and (b) the successor L/C Issuer shall issue letters of credit in substitution for the Letters of Credit, if any, outstanding at the time of such succession or make other arrangements satisfactory to Bank of America to effectively assume the obligations of Bank of America with respect to such Letters of Credit.

 

10.07                  Treatment of Certain Information; Confidentiality .  Each of the Administrative Agent, the Lenders and the L/C Issuer agrees to maintain the confidentiality of the Information (as defined below), except that Information may be disclosed (a) to its Affiliates

 

119



 

and to its Related Parties (it being understood that the Persons to whom such disclosure is made will be informed of the confidential nature of such Information and instructed to keep such Information confidential), (b) to the extent required or requested by any regulatory authority purporting to have jurisdiction over such Person or its Related Parties (including any self-regulatory authority, such as the National Association of Insurance Commissioners), (c) to the extent required by applicable laws or regulations or by any subpoena or similar legal process, (d) to any other party hereto, (e) in connection with the exercise of any remedies hereunder or under any other Loan Document or any action or proceeding relating to this Agreement or any other Loan Document or the enforcement of rights hereunder or thereunder, (f) subject to an agreement containing provisions substantially the same as those of this Section, to (i) any assignee of or Participant in, or any prospective assignee of or Participant in, any of its rights or obligations under this Agreement or any Eligible Assignee invited to be a Lender pursuant to Section 2.14(c)  or (ii) any actual or prospective party (or its Related Parties) to any swap, derivative or other transaction under which payments are to be made by reference to the Borrower and its obligations, this Agreement or payments hereunder, (g) on a confidential basis to (i)  any rating agency in connection with rating the Borrower or its Subsidiaries or the credit facilities provided hereunder or (ii) the CUSIP Service Bureau or any similar agency in connection with the issuance and monitoring of CUSIP numbers or other market identifiers with respect to the credit facilities provided hereunder, (h) with the consent of the Borrower or (i) to the extent such Information (i) becomes publicly available other than as a result of a breach of this Section or (ii) becomes available to the Administrative Agent, any Lender, the L/C Issuer or any of their respective Affiliates on a nonconfidential basis from a source other than the Borrower.  For purposes of this Section, “ Information ” means all information received from the Borrower or any Subsidiary relating to the Borrower or any Subsidiary or any of their respective businesses, other than any such information that is available to the Administrative Agent, any Lender or the L/C Issuer on a nonconfidential basis prior to disclosure by the Borrower or any Subsidiary, provided that, in the case of information received from the Borrower or any Subsidiary after the date hereof, such information is clearly identified at the time of delivery as confidential.  Any Person required to maintain the confidentiality of Information as provided in this Section shall be considered to have complied with its obligation to do so if such Person has exercised the same degree of care to maintain the confidentiality of such Information as such Person would accord to its own confidential information.

 

Each of the Administrative Agent, the Lenders and the L/C Issuer acknowledges that (a) the Information may include material non-public information concerning the Borrower or a Subsidiary, as the case may be, (b) it has developed compliance procedures regarding the use of material non-public information and (c) it will handle such material non-public information in accordance with applicable Law, including United States Federal and state securities Laws.

 

10.08                  Right of Setoff .  If an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, each Lender, the L/C Issuer and each of their respective Affiliates is hereby authorized at any time and from time to time, to the fullest extent permitted by applicable law, to set off and apply any and all deposits (general or special, time or demand, provisional or final, in whatever currency) at any time held and other obligations (in whatever currency) at any time owing by such Lender, the L/C Issuer or any such Affiliate to or for the credit or the account of the Borrower against any and all of the obligations of the Borrower now or hereafter existing under this Agreement or any other Loan Document to such Lender or the L/C Issuer or their respective

 

120



 

Affiliates, irrespective of whether or not such Lender, L/C Issuer or Affiliate shall have made any demand under this Agreement or any other Loan Document and although such obligations of the Borrower may be contingent or unmatured or are owed to a branch, office or Affiliate of such Lender or the L/C Issuer different from the branch, office or Affiliate holding such deposit or obligated on such indebtedness; provided, that in the event that any Defaulting Lender shall exercise any such right of setoff, (x) all amounts so set off shall be paid over immediately to the Administrative Agent for further application in accordance with the provisions of Section 2.16 and, pending such payment, shall be segregated by such Defaulting Lender from its other funds and deemed held in trust for the benefit of the Administrative Agent, the L/C Issuer and the Lenders, and (y) the Defaulting Lender shall provide promptly to the Administrative Agent a statement describing in reasonable detail the Obligations owing to such Defaulting Lender as to which it exercised such right of setoff.  The rights of each Lender, the L/C Issuer and their respective Affiliates under this Section are in addition to other rights and remedies (including other rights of setoff) that such Lender, the L/C Issuer or their respective Affiliates may have.  Each Lender and the L/C Issuer agrees to notify the Borrower and the Administrative Agent promptly after any such setoff and application, provided that the failure to give such notice shall not affect the validity of such setoff and application.

 

10.09                  Interest Rate Limitation .  Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in any Loan Document, the interest paid or agreed to be paid under the Loan Documents shall not exceed the maximum rate of non-usurious interest permitted by applicable Law (the “ Maximum Rate ”).  If the Administrative Agent or any Lender shall receive interest in an amount that exceeds the Maximum Rate, the excess interest shall be applied to the principal of the Loans or, if it exceeds such unpaid principal, refunded to the Borrower.  In determining whether the interest contracted for, charged, or received by the Administrative Agent or a Lender exceeds the Maximum Rate, such Person may, to the extent permitted by applicable Law, (a) characterize any payment that is not principal as an expense, fee, or premium rather than interest, (b) exclude voluntary prepayments and the effects thereof, and (c) amortize, prorate, allocate, and spread in equal or unequal parts the total amount of interest throughout the contemplated term of the Obligations hereunder.

 

10.10                  Counterparts; Integration; Effectiveness .  This Agreement may be executed in counterparts (and by different parties hereto in different counterparts), each of which shall constitute an original, but all of which when taken together shall constitute a single contract.  This Agreement and the other Loan Documents, and any separate letter agreements with respect to fees payable to the Administrative Agent or the L/C Issuer, constitute the entire contract among the parties relating to the subject matter hereof and supersede any and all previous agreements and understandings, oral or written, relating to the subject matter hereof.  Except as provided in Section 4.01 , this Agreement shall become effective when it shall have been executed by the Administrative Agent and when the Administrative Agent shall have received counterparts hereof that, when taken together, bear the signatures of each of the other parties hereto.  Delivery of an executed counterpart of a signature page of this Agreement by facsimile or other electronic imaging means (e.g. “pdf” or “tif”) shall be effective as delivery of a manually executed counterpart of this Agreement.

 

10.11                  Survival of Representations and Warranties .  All representations and warranties made hereunder and in any other Loan Document or other document delivered

 

121



 

pursuant hereto or thereto or in connection herewith or therewith shall survive the execution and delivery hereof and thereof.  Such representations and warranties have been or will be relied upon by the Administrative Agent and each Lender, regardless of any investigation made by the Administrative Agent or any Lender or on their behalf and notwithstanding that the Administrative Agent or any Lender may have had notice or knowledge of any Default at the time of any Credit Extension, and shall continue in full force and effect as long as any Loan or any other Obligation hereunder shall remain unpaid or unsatisfied or any Letter of Credit shall remain outstanding.

 

10.12                  Severability .  If any provision of this Agreement or the other Loan Documents is held to be illegal, invalid or unenforceable, (a) the legality, validity and enforceability of the remaining provisions of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents shall not be affected or impaired thereby and (b) the parties shall endeavor in good faith negotiations to replace the illegal, invalid or unenforceable provisions with valid provisions the economic effect of which comes as close as possible to that of the illegal, invalid or unenforceable provisions.  The invalidity of a provision in a particular jurisdiction shall not invalidate or render unenforceable such provision in any other jurisdiction.  Without limiting the foregoing provisions of this Section 10.12 , if and to the extent that the enforceability of any provisions in this Agreement relating to Defaulting Lenders shall be limited by Debtor Relief Laws, as determined in good faith by the Administrative Agent, the L/C Issuer or the Swing Line Lender, as applicable, then such provisions shall be deemed to be in effect only to the extent not so limited.

 

10.13                  Replacement of Lenders .  If the Borrower is entitled to replace a Lender pursuant to the provisions of Section 3.06 , or if any Lender is a Defaulting Lender or a Non-Consenting Lender, then the Borrower may, at its sole expense and effort, upon notice to such Lender and the Administrative Agent, require such Lender to assign and delegate, without recourse (in accordance with and subject to the restrictions contained in, and consents required by, Section 10.06 ), all of its interests, rights (other than its existing rights to payments pursuant to Sections 3.01 and 3.04 ) and obligations under this Agreement and the related Loan Documents to an Eligible Assignee that shall assume such obligations (which assignee may be another Lender, if a Lender accepts such assignment), provided that:

 

(a)                                  the Borrower shall have paid to the Administrative Agent the assignment fee (if any) specified in Section 10.06(b) ;

 

(b)                                  such Lender shall have received payment of an amount equal to the outstanding principal of its Loans and L/C Advances, accrued interest thereon, accrued fees and all other amounts payable to it hereunder and under the other Loan Documents (including any amounts under Section 3.05 ) from the assignee (to the extent of such outstanding principal and accrued interest and fees) or the Borrower (in the case of all other amounts);

 

(c)                                   in the case of any such assignment resulting from a claim for compensation under Section 3.04 or payments required to be made pursuant to Section 3.01 , such assignment will result in a reduction in such compensation or payments thereafter;

 

(d)                                  such assignment does not conflict with applicable Laws; and

 

122



 

(e)                                   in the case of an assignment resulting from a Lender becoming a Non-Consenting Lender, the applicable assignee shall have consented to the applicable amendment, waiver or consent.

 

A Lender shall not be required to make any such assignment or delegation if, prior thereto, as a result of a waiver by such Lender or otherwise, the circumstances entitling the Borrower to require such assignment and delegation cease to apply.

 

10.14                  Governing Law; Jurisdiction; Etc .  (a)  GOVERNING LAW .  THIS AGREEMENT AND THE OTHER LOAN DOCUMENTS AND ANY CLAIMS, CONTROVERSY, DISPUTE OR CAUSE OF ACTION (WHETHER IN CONTRACT OR TORT OR OTHERWISE) BASED UPON, ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO THIS AGREEMENT OR ANY OTHER LOAN DOCUMENT (EXCEPT, AS TO ANY OTHER LOAN DOCUMENT, AS EXPRESSLY SET FORTH THEREIN) AND THE TRANSACTIONS CONTEMPLATED HEREBY AND THEREBY SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAW OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK.

 

(b)                                  SUBMISSION TO JURISDICTION .  THE BORROWER IRREVOCABLY AND UNCONDITIONALLY AGREES THAT IT WILL NOT COMMENCE ANY ACTION, LITIGATION OR PROCEEDING OF ANY KIND OR DESCRIPTION, WHETHER IN LAW OR EQUITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT OR IN TORT OR OTHERWISE, AGAINST THE ADMINISTRATIVE AGENT, ANY LENDER, THE L/C ISSUER, OR ANY RELATED PARTY OF THE FOREGOING IN ANY WAY RELATING TO THIS AGREEMENT OR ANY OTHER LOAN DOCUMENT OR THE TRANSACTIONS RELATING HERETO OR THERETO, IN ANY FORUM OTHER THAN THE COURTS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK SITTING IN NEW YORK COUNTY AND OF THE UNITED STATES DISTRICT COURT OF THE SOUTHERN DISTRICT OF NEW YORK, AND ANY APPELLATE COURT FROM ANY THEREOF, AND EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO IRREVOCABLY AND UNCONDITIONALLY SUBMITS TO THE JURISDICTION OF SUCH COURTS AND AGREES THAT ALL CLAIMS IN RESPECT OF ANY SUCH ACTION, LITIGATION OR PROCEEDING MAY BE HEARD AND DETERMINED IN SUCH NEW YORK STATE COURT OR, TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, IN SUCH FEDERAL COURT.  EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO AGREES THAT A FINAL JUDGMENT IN ANY SUCH ACTION, LITIGATION OR PROCEEDING SHALL BE CONCLUSIVE AND MAY BE ENFORCED IN OTHER JURISDICTIONS BY SUIT ON THE JUDGMENT OR IN ANY OTHER MANNER PROVIDED BY LAW.  NOTHING IN THIS AGREEMENT OR IN ANY OTHER LOAN DOCUMENT SHALL AFFECT ANY RIGHT THAT THE ADMINISTRATIVE AGENT, ANY LENDER OR THE L/C ISSUER MAY OTHERWISE HAVE TO BRING ANY ACTION OR PROCEEDING RELATING TO THIS AGREEMENT OR ANY OTHER LOAN DOCUMENT AGAINST THE BORROWER OR ITS PROPERTIES IN THE COURTS OF ANY JURISDICTION.

 

(c)                                   WAIVER OF VENUE .  THE BORROWER IRREVOCABLY AND UNCONDITIONALLY WAIVES, TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, ANY OBJECTION THAT IT MAY NOW OR HEREAFTER HAVE TO THE LAYING OF VENUE OF ANY ACTION OR PROCEEDING ARISING OUT OF OR

 

123


 

RELATING TO THIS AGREEMENT OR ANY OTHER LOAN DOCUMENT IN ANY COURT REFERRED TO IN PARAGRAPH (B) OF THIS SECTION.  EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO HEREBY IRREVOCABLY WAIVES, TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, THE DEFENSE OF AN INCONVENIENT FORUM TO THE MAINTENANCE OF SUCH ACTION OR PROCEEDING IN ANY SUCH COURT.

 

(d)           SERVICE OF PROCESS .  EACH PARTY HERETO IRREVOCABLY CONSENTS TO SERVICE OF PROCESS IN THE MANNER PROVIDED FOR NOTICES IN SECTION 10.02 .  NOTHING IN THIS AGREEMENT WILL AFFECT THE RIGHT OF ANY PARTY HERETO TO SERVE PROCESS IN ANY OTHER MANNER PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW

 

10.15      Waiver of Jury Trial .  EACH PARTY HERETO HEREBY IRREVOCABLY WAIVES, TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, ANY RIGHT IT MAY HAVE TO A TRIAL BY JURY IN ANY LEGAL PROCEEDING DIRECTLY OR INDIRECTLY ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO THIS AGREEMENT OR ANY OTHER LOAN DOCUMENT OR THE TRANSACTIONS CONTEMPLATED HEREBY OR THEREBY (WHETHER BASED ON CONTRACT, TORT OR ANY OTHER THEORY).  EACH PARTY HERETO (A) CERTIFIES THAT NO REPRESENTATIVE, AGENT OR ATTORNEY OF ANY OTHER PERSON HAS REPRESENTED, EXPRESSLY OR OTHERWISE, THAT SUCH OTHER PERSON WOULD NOT, IN THE EVENT OF LITIGATION, SEEK TO ENFORCE THE FOREGOING WAIVER AND (B) ACKNOWLEDGES THAT IT AND THE OTHER PARTIES HERETO HAVE BEEN INDUCED TO ENTER INTO THIS AGREEMENT AND THE OTHER LOAN DOCUMENTS BY, AMONG OTHER THINGS, THE MUTUAL WAIVERS AND CERTIFICATIONS IN THIS SECTION.

 

10.16      No Advisory or Fiduciary Responsibility .  In connection with all aspects of each transaction contemplated hereby (including in connection with any amendment, waiver or other modification hereof or of any other Loan Document), the Borrower acknowledges and agrees that: (i) (A) the arranging and other services regarding this Agreement provided by the Administrative Agent , the Arranger, and the Lenders are arm’s-length commercial transactions between the Borrower and its Affiliates, on the one hand, and the Administrative Agent , the Arranger, and the Lenders, on the other hand, (B) the Borrower has consulted its own legal, accounting, regulatory and tax advisors to the extent it has deemed appropriate, and (C) the Borrower is capable of evaluating, and understands and accepts, the terms, risks and conditions of the transactions contemplated hereby and by the other Loan Documents; (ii) (A) the Administrative Agent , the Arranger and each Lender is and has been acting solely as a principal and, except as expressly agreed in writing by the relevant parties, has not been, is not, and will not be acting as an advisor, agent or fiduciary for the Borrower or any of its Affiliates, or any other Person and (B) neither the Administrative Agent , the Arranger nor any Lender has any obligation to the Borrower or any of its Affiliates with respect to the transactions contemplated hereby except those obligations expressly set forth herein and in the other Loan Documents; and (iii) the Administrative Agent , the Arranger and the Lenders and their respective Affiliates may be engaged in a broad range of transactions that involve interests that differ from those of the Borrower and its Affiliates, and neither the Administrative Agent , the Arranger, nor any Lender has any obligation to disclose any of such interests to the Borrower or its Affiliates.  To the

 

124



 

fullest extent permitted by law, the Borrower hereby waives and releases any claims that it may have against the Administrative Agent , the Arranger or any Lender with respect to any breach or alleged breach of agency or fiduciary duty in connection with any aspect of any transaction contemplated hereby.

 

10.17      Electronic Execution of Assignments and Certain Other Documents .  The words “ execute ,” “ execution ,” “ signed ,” “ signature ,” and words of like import in any Assignment and Assumption or in any amendment or other modification hereof (including waivers and consents) shall be deemed to include electronic signatures, the electronic matching of assignment terms and contract formations on electronic platforms approved by the Administrative Agent, or the keeping of records in electronic form, each of which shall be of the same legal effect, validity or enforceability as a manually executed signature or the use of a paper-based recordkeeping system, as the case may be, to the extent and as provided for in any applicable law, including the Federal Electronic Signatures in Global and National Commerce Act, the New York State Electronic Signatures and Records Act, or any other similar state laws based on the Uniform Electronic Transactions Act.

 

10.18      USA PATRIOT Act .  Each Lender that is subject to the Act (as hereinafter defined) and the Administrative Agent (for itself and not on behalf of any Lender) hereby notifies the Borrower that pursuant to the requirements of the USA Patriot Act (Title III of Pub. L. 107-56 (signed into law October 26, 2001)) (the “ Act ”), it is required to obtain, verify and record information that identifies each Loan Party, which information includes the name and address of each Loan Party and other information that will allow such Lender or the Administrative Agent, as applicable, to identify each Loan Party in accordance with the Act.  The Borrower shall, promptly following a request by the Administrative Agent or any Lender, provide all documentation and other information that the Administrative Agent or such Lender requests in order to comply with its ongoing obligations under applicable “ know your customer ” an anti-money laundering rules and regulations, including the Act.

 

10.19      ENTIRE AGREEMENT .  THIS AGREEMENT AND THE OTHER LOAN DOCUMENTS REPRESENT THE FINAL AGREEMENT AMONG THE PARTIES AND MAY NOT BE CONTRADICTED BY EVIDENCE OF PRIOR, CONTEMPORANEOUS, OR SUBSEQUENT ORAL AGREEMENTS OF THE PARTIES.  THERE ARE NO UNWRITTEN ORAL AGREEMENTS AMONG THE PARTIES.

 

125



 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Agreement to be duly executed as of the date first above written.

 

 

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP

 

 

 

By: Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC,

its general partner

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

 

Signature Page to Credit Agreement

 



 

 

BANK OF AMERICA, N.A., as

 

Administrative Agent

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

 

Signature Page to Credit Agreement

 



 

 

BANK OF AMERICA, N.A., as a Lender,

L/C Issuer and Swing Line Lender

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

 

Signature Page to Credit Agreement

 



 

 

[LENDERS]

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

 

Signature Page to Credit Agreement

 



 

Schedule 1.01

 

COMMITMENTS

 

AND APPLICABLE PERCENTAGES

 

Lender

 

Revolving Credit
Commitment

 

Applicable Percentage

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

TOTAL

 

$

250,000,000

 

100.000000000

%

 

Schedule 2.01 — Credit Agreement

 




Exhibit 10.5

 

FORM OF

 

$[175,000,000] TERM LOAN AND SECURITY AGREEMENT

 

This TERM LOAN AND SECURITY AGREEMENT is entered into as of [              ] [    ], 2012 between SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP, a Delaware limited partnership (the “ Borrower ”), and BANK OF AMERICA, N.A. (the “ Lender ”).

 

PRELIMINARY STATEMENTS:

 

A.            The Borrower has requested that the Lender provide a term loan facility, and the Lender has indicated its willingness to lend on the terms and subject to the conditions set forth herein.

 

B.              Terms not defined herein have the meanings assigned to them in Exhibit A hereto.

 

In consideration of the mutual covenants and agreements herein contained, the parties hereto covenant and agree as follows:

 

Section 1.                   The Facility.

 

(a)                                   The Commitment.  Subject to the terms and conditions set forth herein, the Lender agrees to make a (i) single loan  to the Borrower on the Closing Date in an amount equal to $[                  ] (the “ Initial Loan ”), and (ii) subject to the satisfaction of the conditions set forth in Section 2(b) , a single additional loan to the Borrower in an amount not to exceed $[                  ] (the “ Subsequent Loan ”, and together with the Initial Loan, the “ Loans ”).  Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein, in no event shall the aggregate outstanding principal amount of the Loans exceed $[175,000,000].  Amounts borrowed under this Section 1(a) and repaid or prepaid may not be reborrowed.  The Loans may be Base Rate Loans or Eurodollar Rate Loans, as further provided herein.

 

(b)                                  Borrowings, Conversions, Continuations.  The Borrower may request that the Loans be (i) made as or converted to Base Rate Loans by irrevocable notice to be received by the Lender not later than 11:00 a.m. on the Business Day of the borrowing or conversion, or (ii) made or continued as, or converted to, Eurodollar Rate Loans by irrevocable notice to be received by the Lender not later than 11:00 a.m. three Business Days prior to the Business Day of the borrowing, continuation or conversion.  Subject to the following paragraph, if the Borrower fails to give a notice of conversion or continuation prior to the end of any Interest Period in respect of a Eurodollar Rate Loan, the Borrower shall be deemed to have requested that such Loan be continued as a Eurodollar Loan with a one month interest period.  If the Borrower requests that a Loan be continued as or converted to a Eurodollar Rate Loan, but fails to specify an Interest Period with respect thereto, then, subject to the following paragraph, the Borrower shall be deemed to have selected an Interest Period of one month with respect to such Loan.  Notices pursuant to this Section 1(b) may be given by telephone if promptly confirmed in writing.

 



 

Except as otherwise provided herein, a Eurodollar Rate Loan may be continued or converted only on the last day of an Interest Period for such Eurodollar Rate Loan.  During the existence of a Default, no Loan may be converted to or continued as a Eurodollar Rate Loan without the consent of the Lender.

 

(c)                                   Interest; Computations.  At the option of the Borrower, the Loans shall bear interest at a rate per annum equal to (i) the Eurodollar Rate plus the Applicable Rate; or (ii) the Base Rate plus the Applicable Rate.

 

The Borrower promises to pay interest (i) for any Eurodollar Rate Loan, (A) on the last day of the applicable Interest Period, and, if the Interest Period is longer than three months, on the respective dates that fall every three months after the beginning of the Interest Period, and (B) on the date of any conversion of such Loan to a Base Rate Loan, and (ii) for any Base Rate Loan, on the last Business Day of each calendar quarter.  The Borrower further promises to pay all accrued and unpaid interest on the Loans on the Maturity Date.

 

If any amount of principal of any Loan is not paid when due (after giving effect to any applicable grace periods), whether at stated maturity, by acceleration or otherwise, such amount shall thereafter bear interest at a fluctuating interest rate per annum at all times equal to the Default Rate to the fullest extent permitted by applicable Law.  If any amount (other than principal of any Loan) payable by the Borrower under any Loan Document is not paid when due (after giving effect to any applicable grace periods), whether at stated maturity, by acceleration or otherwise, then upon the request of the Lender, such amount shall thereafter bear interest at a fluctuating interest rate per annum at all times equal to the Default Rate to the fullest extent permitted by applicable Law.  Upon the request of the Lender, while any Event of Default exists (other than as set forth in the previous two sentences), the Borrower shall pay interest on the principal amount of all outstanding Obligations at a fluctuating interest rate per annum at all times equal to the Default Rate to the fullest extent permitted by applicable Law.  Accrued and unpaid interest on past due amounts shall be payable on demand.

 

All computations of interest for a Base Rate Loan (including a Base Rate Loan determined by reference to the Eurodollar Rate)  shall be made on the basis of a year of 365 or 366 days, as the case may be, and actual days elapsed.  All other computations of fees and interest shall be made on the basis of a 360-day year and actual days elapsed (which results in more fees or interest, as applicable, being paid than if computed on the basis of a 365-day year).

 

(d)                                  Evidence of Loans.   The Loans and all payments thereon shall be evidenced by the Lender’s loan accounts and records; provided , however , that upon the request of the Lender, each of the Loans may be evidenced by a promissory note in the form of Exhibit B hereto (each, a “ Note ”), in addition to such loan accounts and records.  Such loan accounts, records and Notes shall be conclusive absent manifest error of the amount of the Loans and payments thereon.  Any failure to record the Loans or payment thereon or any error in doing so shall not limit or

 

2



 

otherwise affect the obligation of the Borrower to pay any amount owing with respect to the Loans.

 

(e)                                   Repayment; Payments Generally .  The Borrower shall repay to the Lender on the Maturity Date the aggregate principal amount of the Loans outstanding on such date.

 

The Borrower shall make all payments required hereunder not later than 2:00 p.m. on the date of payment in immediately available funds in Dollars at the office of the Lender located at [                  ] or such other address as the Lender may from time to time notify the Borrower in writing (the “ Lending Office ”).  All payments received by the Lender after 2:00 p.m. shall be deemed received on the next succeeding Business Day and any applicable interest or fee shall continue to accrue.

 

If any payment to be made by the Borrower hereunder shall come due on a day other than a Business Day, payment shall be made on the next following Business Day, and such extension of time shall be reflected on computing interest or fees, as the case may be.

 

All payments by the Borrower to the Lender hereunder shall be made to the Lender in full without set-off or counterclaim and free and clear of and exempt from, and without deduction or withholding for or on account of, any present or future taxes, levies, imposts, duties or charges of whatsoever nature imposed by any government or any political subdivision or taxing authority thereof.  The Borrower shall reimburse the Lender, within 10 days after demand, for any taxes imposed on or withheld from such payments (other than taxes imposed on the Lender’s income, and franchise taxes imposed on the Lender, by the jurisdiction under the laws of which the Lender is organized or any political subdivision thereof).

 

(f)                                     Prepayments.  The Borrower may, upon three Business Days’ notice, in the case of a Eurodollar Rate Loan, and upon same-day notice in the case of a Base Rate Loan, prepay the Loans on any Business Day; provided that, in the case of a prepayment of a Eurodollar Rate Loan, the Borrower pays all Breakage Costs (if any) associated with such prepayment on the date of such prepayment.  Prepayments of the Loans must be accompanied by a payment of interest on the amount so prepaid.  Prepayments of (i) a Eurodollar Rate Loan must be in a principal amount of $2,000,000 or a whole multiple of $500,000 in excess thereof, and (ii) a Base Rate Loan must be in a principal amount of at least $500,000 or a whole multiple of $100,000 in excess thereof or, in each case, if less, the entire principal amount of the Loans then outstanding.

 

Section 2.                   Conditions Precedent to the Loans.

 

(a)           The obligation of the Lender to make the Initial Loan hereunder is subject to satisfaction of the following conditions precedent:

 

3



 

(i)              Receipt by the Lender of the following items, each in form and substance satisfactory to the Lender:

 

(A)                               executed counterparts of this Agreement and the Guaranty, duly executed and delivered by each Loan Party that is a party thereto;

 

(B)                                 [executed counterparts of the Account Control Agreement, duly executed and delivered by the Borrower and the Intermediary];

 

(C)                                 if requested by the Lender, a Note evidencing the Initial Loan executed by the Borrower in favor of the Lender;

 

(D)                                Permitted Collateral with a value of not less than the Required Collateral Amount, calculated after giving effect to the making of the Initial Loan on the Closing Date;

 

(E)                                  evidence that all action that the Lender may deem necessary or desirable in order to perfect the Liens created hereunder has been taken;

 

(F)                                  such certificates of resolutions or other action, incumbency certificates and/or other certificates of Responsible Officers of each Loan Party or the General Partner acting on behalf of each Loan Party as the Lender may require evidencing the identity, authority and capacity of each Responsible Officer thereof authorized to act as a Responsible Officer in connection with this Agreement and the other Loan Documents to which such Loan Party is a party or is to be a party;

 

(G)                                 such documents and certifications as the Lender may reasonably require to evidence that each Loan Party is duly organized or formed, and that each Loan Party is validly existing, in good standing and qualified to engage in business in each jurisdiction where its ownership, lease or operation of properties or the conduct of its business requires such qualification, except to the extent that failure to do so could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect;

 

(H)                                a favorable opinion of Vinson & Elkins LLP, counsel to the Loan Parties, addressed to the Lender, as to the matters concerning the Loan Parties and the Loan Documents as the Lender may reasonably request;

 

(I)                                     a certificate signed by a Responsible Officer of the Borrower certifying as to the matters set forth in Section 2(a)(ii) below;

 

(J)                                    a certificate from the chief financial officer of the Borrower attesting to the Solvency of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis before and after giving effect to the execution

 

4



 

and delivery of the Loan Documents, the making of the Initial Loan on the Closing Date, the purchase of the Required Collateral Amount as of the Closing Date and the consummation of the Transactions; and

 

(K)                                all documentation and other information that the Lender requests in order to comply with its ongoing obligations under applicable “know your customer” an anti-money laundering rules and regulations, including the Act.

 

(ii)                                   The Specified Representations shall be true and correct in all respects.

 

(iii)                                The Transactions shall have been completed in accordance with the terms of the Transfer Documents and applicable Law.

 

(iv)                               The “Closing Date” as defined in the Revolving Credit Agreement shall have occurred or shall occur substantially simultaneously with the Closing Date.

 

(v)                                  The Borrower shall have paid all fees, charges and disbursements of counsel to the Lender (directly to such counsel if requested by the Lender) to the extent invoiced prior to or on the Closing Date, plus such additional amounts of such fees, charges and disbursements as shall constitute its reasonable estimate of such fees, charges and disbursements incurred or to be incurred by it through the closing proceedings (provided that such estimate shall not thereafter preclude a final settling of accounts between the Borrower and the Lender).

 

(b)          The obligation of the Lender to make the Subsequent Loan hereunder is subject to satisfaction of the following conditions precedent:

 

(i)                                      The Specified Representations shall be true and correct in all respects.

 

(ii)                                   No Default shall exist, or would result from the making of such Subsequent Loan or from the application of the proceeds thereof.

 

(iii)                                The Lender shall have received a request for such Subsequent Loan in accordance with Section 1(b) .

 

(iv)                               Such Subsequent Loan shall be made on or prior to the date that is 30 days after the Closing Date.

 

(v)                                  The Lender shall have received Permitted Collateral with a value of not less than the Required Collateral Amount, calculated after giving effect to the making of the Subsequent Loan.

 

Any request for the Subsequent Loan submitted by the Borrower shall be deemed to be a representation and warranty that the conditions specified in Sections 2(b)(i) and 2(b)(ii) have been satisfied on and as of the date of the making of such Subsequent Loan.

 

5



 

Section 3.                   Representations and Warranties.   The Borrower represents and warrants to the Lender on the Closing Date and on the date, if any, on which the Subsequent Loan is made, that:

 

(a)                                   Existence, Qualification and Power.  The Borrower (i) is duly organized or formed, validly existing and, as applicable, in good standing under the Laws of the jurisdiction of its organization, (ii) has all requisite power and authority and all requisite governmental licenses, authorizations, consents and approvals to (A) own or lease its assets and carry on its business and (B) execute, deliver and perform its obligations under the Loan Documents and Transfer Documents to which it is a party and consummate the Transactions, and (iii) is duly qualified and is licensed and, as applicable, in good standing under the Laws of each jurisdiction where its ownership, lease or operation of properties or the conduct of its business requires such qualification or license; except in each case referred to in clause (ii)(A) or (iii), to the extent that failure to do so could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

(b)                                  Authorization; No Contravention.  The execution, delivery and performance by the Borrower of each Loan Document and Transfer Document to which it is or is to be a party (i) have been duly authorized by all necessary organizational action, and (ii) do not and will not (A) contravene the terms of the Borrower’s certificate of formation or limited partnership agreement; (B) result in the creation of any Lien (other than the Lien created pursuant to the Loan Documents), conflict with or result in any breach or contravention of, or require any payment to be made under (1) any material note, indenture, credit agreement, security agreement, credit support agreement, or other similar agreement to which the Borrower is a party or any Material Contract or (2) any order, injunction, writ or decree of any Governmental Authority or any arbitral award to which the Borrower or its property is subject; or (C) violate any Law applicable to the Borrower or its property.

 

(c)                                   Governmental Authorization; Other Consents.   No approval, consent, exemption, authorization, or other action by, or notice to, or filing with, any Governmental Authority or any other Person is necessary or required in connection with (i) the execution, delivery or performance by, or enforcement against, the Borrower of this Agreement or any other Loan Document or Transfer Document, or for the consummation of the Transactions, (ii) the grant by the Borrower of the Liens pursuant to the Loan Documents, (iii) the perfection or maintenance of the Liens created under the Loan Documents (including the first priority nature thereof) or (iv) the exercise by the Lender of its rights under the Loan Documents or the remedies in respect of the Collateral except for (A) authorizations, approvals, actions, notices and filings which have been duly obtained, taken, given or made and are in full force and effect and (B) authorizations, approvals, actions, notices and filings which are not required by the express terms of the Loan Documents to be taken or delivered by the Borrower as of the Closing Date.  All applicable waiting periods in connection with the Transactions have expired without any action having been taken by any Governmental Authority restraining, preventing or imposing materially adverse

 

6



 

conditions upon the Transactions or the rights of the Borrower freely to transfer or otherwise dispose of, or to create any Lien on, any properties now owned or hereafter acquired by it.

 

(d)                                  Binding Effect.  This Agreement has been, and each other Loan Document to which the Borrower is a party, when delivered hereunder, will have been, duly executed and delivered by the Borrower.  This Agreement constitutes, and each other Loan Document to which the Borrower is a party when so delivered will constitute, a legal, valid and binding obligation of the Borrower, enforceable against the Borrower in accordance with its terms, except as may be limited by any applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium, or similar laws affecting creditors’ rights generally or by general principles of equity.

 

(e)                                   No Default.   No Default has occurred and is continuing or would result from the consummation of the Transactions, the transactions contemplated by this Agreement or any other Loan Document.

 

(f)                                     Margin Regulations; Investment Company Act.

 

(i)                                      The Borrower is not engaged and will not engage, principally or as one of its important activities, in the business of purchasing or carrying margin stock (within the meaning of Regulation U issued by the FRB), or extending credit for the purpose of purchasing or carrying margin stock.  None of the proceeds of any Loan will be used by the Borrower or any Subsidiary to purchase or carry margin stock (within the meaning of Regulation U issued by the FRB).

 

(ii)                                   None of the Borrower, any Person Controlling the Borrower, or any Subsidiary is or is required to be registered as an “investment company” under the Investment Company Act of 1940.

 

(g)                                  Solvency.   The Borrower, together with its Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, before and after giving effect to the execution and delivery of the Loan Documents, the making of the Loans, the purchase of the Required Collateral Amount and the consummation of the Transactions, is Solvent.

 

(h)                                  Disclosure.   The Borrower has disclosed to the Lender all agreements, instruments and corporate or other restrictions to which it or any of its Subsidiaries or any other Loan Party is subject, and all other matters known to it, that, individually or in the aggregate, could reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect.  No report, financial statement, certificate or other written information (other than third-party data and information of a general nature made available in any electronic data room) furnished by or on behalf of the Borrower to the Lender in connection with the transactions contemplated hereby and the negotiation of this Agreement or delivered hereunder or under any other Loan Document (in each case as modified or supplemented by other information so furnished) contains, as of the date such information was furnished (or, if such information expressly relates to an earlier date, such earlier date) any material misstatement of fact or omits to state any material fact necessary to make

 

7



 

the statements therein, in the light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading taken as a whole; provided that with respect to projected financial information, the Borrower represents only that such information was prepared in good faith based upon assumptions believed to be reasonable at the time (it being understood that such forecasts are estimates and are subject to significant uncertainties and contingencies, and that actual results during the period or periods covered by any such forecasts may differ significantly from the projected results and such differences may be material).

 

(i)                                      Title to Collateral; No Other Liens.   The Borrower owns the Collateral free and clear of any and all Liens or claims of others except for Liens in favor of the Lender created by the Loan Documents.  No financing statement or other public notice with respect to all or any part of the Collateral is on file or of record in any public office, except such as have been filed in favor of the Lender pursuant to the Loan Documents.  The Borrower has not granted “control” (within the meaning of the UCC) over the Collateral Account or any other Collateral to any Person, other than the Lender.

 

(j)                                      Perfected First Priority Liens.   The security interests granted pursuant to this Agreement and any other Loan Document, upon completion of the filing of financing statements describing the Collateral in the office of the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware, and the taking of all applicable actions in respect of creation, attachment, perfection or priority contemplated by Section 4(g) in respect of Collateral in which a security interest cannot be perfected by the filing of a financing statement, will constitute valid perfected security interests in all of the Collateral in favor of the Lender as collateral security for the Obligations, enforceable in accordance with the terms hereof against all creditors of the Borrower and any Persons purporting to purchase any Collateral from the Borrower to the extent provided in the UCC.

 

(k)                                   Required Collateral Amount.   After giving effect to the Loans, the value of the Collateral is greater than or equal to the Required Collateral Amount.

 

(l)                                      Borrower’s Legal Name; Jurisdiction of Organization; Chief Executive Office; Taxpayer Identification Number.   The Borrower’s exact legal name is set forth on the signature page hereof.  The Borrower’s jurisdiction of organization, type of organization, identification number from the jurisdiction of organization, U.S. taxpayer identification number and the location of the Borrower’s chief executive office or sole place of business are specified on Schedule I hereto.

 

Section 4.                   Affirmative Covenants .  So long as principal of and interest on the Loans or any other amount payable hereunder or under any other Loan Document remains unpaid or unsatisfied, the Borrower shall:

 

(a)                                   Financial Statements.   Deliver to the Lender, in form and detail satisfactory to the Lender:

 

8



 

(i)                                      as soon as available, but in any event within 90 days after the end of each fiscal year of the Borrower, a consolidated balance sheet of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries as at the end of such fiscal year, and the related consolidated statements of income or operations, changes in partnership equity, and cash flows for such fiscal year, setting forth in each case in comparative form the figures for the previous fiscal year, all in reasonable detail and prepared in accordance with GAAP, such consolidated statements to be audited and accompanied by a report and opinion of an independent certified public accountant of nationally recognized standing reasonably acceptable to the Lender, which report and opinion shall be prepared in accordance with generally accepted auditing standards and shall not be subject to any “ going concern ” or like qualification or exception or any qualification or exception as to the scope of such audit;

 

(ii)                                   beginning with the fiscal quarter ending December 31, 2012, as soon as available, but in any event within 45 days after the end of each of the first three fiscal quarters of each fiscal year of the Borrower, a consolidated balance sheet of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries as at the end of such fiscal quarter, and the related consolidated statements of income or operations, changes in partnership equity, and cash flows for such fiscal quarter and for the portion of the Borrower’s fiscal year then ended, setting forth in each case in comparative form the figures for the corresponding fiscal quarter of the previous fiscal year and the corresponding portion of the previous fiscal year, all in reasonable detail, such consolidated statements to be certified by a Responsible Officer of the Borrower as fairly presenting the financial condition, results of operations, partnership equity and cash flows of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries in accordance with GAAP, subject only to normal year-end audit adjustments and the absence of footnotes; and

 

As to any information contained in materials furnished pursuant to Section 4(b)(ii) , the Borrower shall not be separately required to furnish such information under Section 4(a)(i) or 4(a)(ii) above, but the foregoing shall not be in derogation of the obligation of the Borrower to furnish the information and materials described in Sections 4(a)(i) and 4(a)(ii) above at the times specified therein.  Additionally, the Borrower shall not be separately required to deliver the information or materials under Section 4(a)(i) or 4(a)(ii) to the extent such information or materials have previously been delivered to the Administrative Agent if the Lender is the Administrative Agent at the time of such delivery.

 

(b)                                  Certificates; Other Information.  Deliver to Lender, in form and detail satisfactory to the Lender:

 

(i)                                      concurrently with the delivery of the financial statements referred to in Sections 4(a)(i) and 4(a)(ii) , a duly completed certificate, in form and substance satisfactory to the Lender, signed by a Responsible Officer of the Borrower and certifying that no Default or Event of Default has occurred and is continuing;

 

9



 

(ii)                                   promptly after the same are available, copies of each annual report, proxy or financial statement or other report or communication sent to the stockholders, partners or members (or the equivalent of any thereof) of any Loan Party, and copies of all annual, regular, periodic and special reports and registration statements which the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries may file or be required to file with the SEC under Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, or with any national securities exchange, and in any case not otherwise required to be delivered to the Lender pursuant hereto;

 

(iii)                                promptly after the furnishing or receipt thereof, (A) copies of any material statement or report furnished to any holder of debt securities in a principal amount greater than $12,500,000 of any Loan Party or of any of its Subsidiaries, or (B) any notice received from any holder of debt securities in a principal amount greater than $12,500,000 of any Loan Party or of any of its Subsidiaries, pursuant to the terms of any indenture, loan or credit or similar agreement, in each case, regarding or related to any material breach or default by any Loan Party or any of its Subsidiaries or any change of control (as defined in such agreement); and

 

(iv)                               promptly, such additional information regarding the business, financial, legal or corporate affairs of any Loan Party or any Subsidiary of the Borrower, or compliance with the terms of the Loan Documents, as the Lender may from time to time reasonably request.

 

Documents required to be delivered (a) pursuant to Section 4(a)(i) or 4(a)(ii) or Section 4(b)(ii) (to the extent any such documents are included in materials otherwise filed with the SEC) may be delivered electronically and if so delivered, shall be deemed to have been delivered to the Lender on the date on which the Borrower posts such documents, or provides a link thereto on the Borrower’s website on the Internet at the website address [                  ]; and (b) pursuant to Section 4(b) (other than Section 4(b)(i) or (iv) ) shall be deemed to have been delivered to the Lender on the date on which such documents are delivered to the Administrative Agent if the Lender is the Administrative Agent at the time of such delivery.

 

(c)                                   Notices.  Promptly notify the Lender:

 

(i)                                      of the occurrence of any Default; and

 

(ii)                                   of any matter that has resulted or could reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect.

 

Each notice pursuant to this Section 4(c) shall be accompanied by a statement of a Responsible Officer of the Borrower setting forth details of the occurrence referred to therein and stating what action the Borrower has taken and proposes to take with respect thereto.  Each notice pursuant to Section 4(c)(i) shall describe with particularity any and all provisions of this Agreement and any other Loan Document that have been breached.

 

(d)                                  Preservation of Existence, Etc .  (i)  Preserve, renew and maintain in full force and effect its legal existence and good standing under the Laws of the jurisdiction

 

10


 

of its organization; (ii) take all reasonable action to maintain all rights, privileges, permits, licenses and franchises necessary or desirable in the normal conduct of its business, except to the extent that failure to do so could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect; and (iii) preserve or renew all of its registered patents, trademarks, trade names and service marks, the non-preservation of which could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

(e)                                   Use of Proceeds.   Use the proceeds of the Loans solely to make payments to the Guarantor and certain of its Subsidiaries to finance, in part, the Borrower’s acquisition of the Contributed Assets.

 

(f)                                     Required Collateral Amount.

 

(i)                                      The Borrower shall maintain the Collateral Account at all times that any portion of the Loans shall remain outstanding.

 

(ii)                                   The Borrower shall, at all times, maintain Permitted Collateral in the Collateral Account or otherwise have pledged Permitted Collateral to the Lender with a value greater than or equal to [102]% of the outstanding principal amount of the Loans (the “ Required Collateral Amount ”).

 

(iii)                                If, at any time, the Required Collateral Amount exceeds the value of the Collateral, the Borrower shall immediately deposit additional Permitted Collateral into the Collateral Account to eliminate such excess. [In accordance with the terms of the Account Control Agreement,] the Borrower shall direct the investment of items deposited into the Collateral Account; provided , that (A) all Collateral shall consist of Permitted Collateral at all times and (B) the Borrower shall not be permitted to Dispose of any Collateral except pursuant to Section 4(f)(iv) .  The Borrower shall treat all income, gains or losses from the investment of items in the Collateral Account as its own income or loss, and the Lender shall have no liability for any such gain or loss.

 

(iv)                               Upon any prepayment of the Loans, the Borrower shall be permitted to liquidate and/or withdraw Collateral from the Collateral Account (or otherwise request to have Collateral returned to it) in an amount up to such prepayment; provided , that after such withdrawal, the value of the Collateral shall be greater than or equal to the Required Collateral Amount, as calculated after giving effect of such prepayment of the Loans.  In the event that the Borrower shall elect to make such a withdrawal or request, the Lender shall (A) direct the Intermediary to liquidate the applicable Collateral and remit the proceeds to the Borrower, and/or (B) otherwise return the applicable Collateral to the Borrower.

 

(v)                                  If, at the end of any fiscal quarter of the Borrower, the value of the Collateral exceeds [102]% of the principal amount of the Loans outstanding at such time, then, upon the request of the Borrower, provided no Default or Event of Default has occurred and is continuing, the Lender shall (A) direct the

 

11



 

Intermediary to pay and transfer to the Borrower cash, to the extent available, in the Collateral Account and/or (B) otherwise return Collateral to the Borrower, in either case, in an amount equal to such excess.

 

(g)                                  Perfection of Security Interest in Collateral.   The Borrower shall maintain the security interests created by the Loan Documents as perfected first priority security interests subject to no other Liens, and shall defend such security interests against the claims and demands of all Persons.  The Borrower further agrees to take all action reasonably requested by the Lender to insure the attachment, perfection and priority of, and the ability of the Lender to enforce in accordance with the Loan Documents and under applicable Law, the security interest in any and all of the Collateral, including, without limitation, (i) executing, delivering and, where appropriate, filing financing statements and amendments relating thereto under the UCC, to the extent, if any, that the Borrower’s signature thereon is required therefor; and (ii) complying with any provision of any statute, law, regulation or treaty of the United States, including the Uniform Commercial Code of any applicable jurisdictions as to any Collateral if compliance with such provision is a condition to the attachment, perfection or priority of, or the ability of the Lender to enforce, the security interest in such Collateral.  If any of the Collateral consists of certificated securities (as defined in the UCC), the Borrower shall immediately deliver the same to the Lender, accompanied by such instruments of transfer or assignment duly executed in blank as the Lender may from time to time specify (and any such certificated securities shall not be included in any determination of whether the value of the Collateral is equal to or greater than the Required Collateral Amount until such securities are so delivered to the Lender).

 

(h)                                  Further Assurances.  Promptly upon request by the Lender, (i) correct any material defect or error that may be discovered in any Loan Document or in the execution, acknowledgment, filing or recordation thereof, and (ii) do, execute, acknowledge, deliver, record, re-record, file, re-file, register and re-register any and all such further acts, deeds, certificates, assurances and other instruments as the Lender may reasonably require from time to time in order to (A) carry out more effectively the purposes of the Loan Documents, (B) to the fullest extent permitted by applicable Law, subject any Collateral to the Liens now or hereafter intended to be covered by any of the Loan Documents, (C) perfect and maintain the validity, effectiveness and priority of any of the Loan Documents and any of the Liens intended to be created thereunder and (D) assure, convey, grant, assign, transfer, preserve, protect and confirm more effectively unto the Lender the rights granted or now or hereafter intended to be granted to the Lender under any Loan Document or under any other instrument executed in connection with any Loan Document to which any Loan Party is or is to be a party.

 

Section 5.                   Negative Covenants.  So long as principal of and interest on the Loans or any other amount payable hereunder or under any other Loan Document remains unpaid or unsatisfied, the Borrower shall not:

 

12



 

(a)                                   Use of Proceeds.  Use the proceeds of any Loan, directly or indirectly, immediately, incidentally or ultimately, to purchase or carry margin stock (within the meaning of Regulation U of the FRB) or to extend credit to others for the purpose of purchasing or carrying margin stock or to refund indebtedness originally incurred for such purpose.

 

(b)                                  Liens.   Create, incur, assume or suffer to exist any Lien upon any of the Collateral, whether now owned or hereafter acquired, other than the Lien created in favor of the Lender pursuant to the Loan Documents.

 

(c)                                   Disposition of Collateral.   Make any Disposition of Collateral or enter into any agreement to make any Disposition of Collateral, except as expressly permitted by Section 4(f)(iv) .

 

(d)                                  Burdensome Agreements.  Enter into or permit to exist any Contractual Obligation (other than this Agreement or any other Loan Document) that limits the ability of the Borrower to create, incur, assume or suffer to exist Liens on the Collateral.

 

(e)                                   Change in Name, etc.   Except upon 30 days’ prior written notice to the Lender (or such lesser period to which the Lender may agree in writing), (i) change its type of organization, jurisdiction of organization or other legal structure, (ii) change its organizational number if it has one, or (iii) change its name.  Promptly following such notice to the Lender, the Borrower shall deliver to the Lender all additional approved financing statements and other executed documents reasonably requested by the Lender to maintain the validity, perfection and priority of the security interests provided for or required herein or in any other Loan Document.

 

Section 6.                   Security.

 

(a)                                   Grant of Security.  To secure the prompt payment in full when due, whether by lapse of time, acceleration, mandatory prepayment or otherwise, of the Obligations, the Borrower hereby grants to the Lender, a continuing security interest in, and a right to set off against, any and all right, title and interest of the Borrower in and to the Collateral Account, all other amounts maintained in the Collateral Account and all other Collateral.

 

(b)                                  Exercise of Remedies.  Upon the occurrence and during the continuance of an Event of Default, the Lender may, at the Lender’s option, exercise all the rights and remedies of a secured party under the UCC or otherwise available to the Lender under applicable Law.

 

(c)                                   Application of Proceeds.  Unless otherwise specified herein, any cash proceeds received by the Lender from the sale of, collection of, or other realization upon any part of the Collateral or any other amounts received by the Lender hereunder may be, at the discretion of the Lender (i) held by the Lender as cash collateral for the Obligations or (ii) applied to the Obligations in such order as the Lender may determine.  Any surplus cash collateral or cash proceeds held by the Lender after

 

13



 

payment in full of the Obligations shall be paid over to the Borrower or to whomever may be lawfully entitled to receive such surplus.

 

(d)                                  Reinstatement.  The obligations of the Borrower under this Section 6 shall continue to be effective or automatically be reinstated, as the case may be, if at any time payment of any of the Obligations is rescinded or otherwise must be restored or returned by the Lender upon the insolvency, bankruptcy, dissolution, liquidation or reorganization of the Borrower or any other obligor or otherwise, all as though such payment had not been made.

 

Section 7.                   Events of Default.  The following are “ Events of Default ”:

 

(a)                                   The Borrower or any other Loan Party fails to (i) pay when and as required to be paid herein, any amount of principal of the Loans or, or (ii) pay within three days after the same becomes due, any interest on the Loans or any fee due hereunder, or (iii) pay within five days after the same becomes due, any other amount payable hereunder or under any other Loan Document; or

 

(b)                                  The Borrower fails to perform or observe any term, covenant or agreement contained in any of 4(d) , 4(e) , 4(f) or Section 5 ;

 

(c)                                   Any Loan Party fails to perform or observe any other covenant or agreement contained in (i) Sections 4(a) , 4(b)(i) , 4(b)(iii) or 4(c) of this Agreement and such failure continues for 10 days after the earlier to occur of (A) notice thereof from the Lender to the Borrower or (B) a Responsible Officer of the Borrower becomes aware of any such failure or (ii) any covenant (not specified in clause (i) above or in Sections 7(a) or 7(b) above) in any Loan Document on its part to be performed or observed and such failure continues for 30 days after the earlier to occur of (A) notice thereof from the Lender to the Borrower or (B) a Responsible Officer of the Borrower becomes aware of any such failure; or

 

(d)                                  (i) Any representation, warranty, certification or statement of fact made or deemed made by or on behalf of the Borrower or any other Loan Party herein, in any other Loan Document, or in any document delivered in connection herewith or therewith that does not have a materiality or Material Adverse Effect qualification shall be incorrect or misleading in any material respect when made or deemed made or (ii) any representation, warranty, certification or statement of fact made or deemed made by or on behalf of the Borrower or any other Loan Party herein, in any other Loan Document, or in any document delivered in connection herewith or therewith that has a materiality or Material Adverse Effect qualification shall be incorrect or misleading in any respect when made or deemed made; or

 

(e)                                   There occurs any “Event of Default” as such term is defined in the Revolving Credit Agreement (or, if the Revolving Credit Agreement has ceased to be in effect, there occurs any event or there exists any circumstance that would have constituted an “Event of Default” under and as defined in the Revolving Credit Agreement were such Revolving Credit then in effect); or

 

14



 

(f)                                     Any Loan Party institutes or consents to the institution of any proceeding under any Debtor Relief Law, or makes an assignment for the benefit of creditors; or applies for or consents to the appointment of any receiver, trustee, custodian, conservator, liquidator, rehabilitator or similar officer for it or for all or any material part of its property; or any receiver, trustee, custodian, conservator, liquidator, rehabilitator or similar officer is appointed without the application or consent of such Person and the appointment continues undischarged or unstayed for 60 calendar days; or any proceeding under any Debtor Relief Law relating to any such Person or to all or any material part of its property is instituted without the consent of such Person and continues undismissed or unstayed for 60 calendar days, or an order for relief is entered in any such proceeding; or

 

(g)                                  (i) Any Loan Party becomes unable or admits in writing its inability or fails generally to pay its debts as they become due, or (ii) any writ or warrant of attachment or execution or similar process is issued or levied against all or any material part of the property of any such Person and is not released, vacated or fully bonded within 30 days after its issue or levy; or

 

(h)                                  There is entered against any Loan Party (i) one or more final judgments or orders for the payment of money in an aggregate amount (as to all such judgments and orders) exceeding $12,500,000 (to the extent not covered by independent third-party insurance as to which the insurer has been notified of the potential claim and does not dispute coverage), or (ii) any one or more non-monetary final judgments that have, or could reasonably be expected to have, individually or in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect and, in either case, (A) enforcement proceedings are commenced by any creditor upon such judgment or order, or (B) there is a period of 30 consecutive days during which a stay of enforcement of such judgment, by reason of a pending appeal or otherwise, is not in effect; or

 

(i)                                      Any provision of any Loan Document, at any time after its execution and delivery and for any reason other than as expressly permitted hereunder or thereunder or satisfaction in full of all the Obligations, ceases to be in full force and effect; or any Loan Party contests in any manner the validity or enforceability of any provision of any Loan Document; or any Loan Party denies that it has any or further liability or obligation under any provision of any Loan Document, or purports to revoke, terminate or rescind any provision of any Loan Document; or

 

(j)                                      The Lender shall cease to have a valid, perfected, first priority Lien on the Collateral for any reason; or

 

(k)                                   A Change of Control occurs.

 

Upon the occurrence of an Event of Default, the Lender may (i) declare all sums outstanding hereunder and under the other Loan Documents, including all interest thereon, to be immediately due and payable, whereupon the same shall become and be immediately due and payable, without notice of default, presentment or demand for payment, protest or notice of nonpayment or dishonor, or other notices or demands of any

 

15



 

kind or character, all of which are hereby expressly waived, and (ii) liquidate the Collateral and apply the proceeds thereof to repay the Loans then outstanding;

 

provided , however , that upon the occurrence of an actual or deemed entry of an order for relief with respect to the Borrower under the Bankruptcy Code of the United States, the unpaid principal amount of the outstanding Loan and all interest and other amounts as aforesaid shall automatically become due and payable, without further act of the Lender.

 

Section 8.                   Yield Protection and Illegality.

 

(a)                                   The Borrower shall be obligated to pay to the Lender all Breakage Costs.

 

(b)                                  If the Lender determines that any Law has made it unlawful, or that any Governmental Authority has asserted that it is unlawful, for the Lender or its Lending Office to make, maintain or fund Loans whose interest is determined by reference to the Eurodollar Rate, or to determine or charge interest rates based upon the Eurodollar Rate, or any Governmental Authority has imposed material restrictions on the authority of the Lender to purchase or sell, or to take deposits of, Dollars in the London interbank market, then, on notice thereof by such Lender to the Borrower, (i) any obligation of the Lender to make or continue Eurodollar Rate Loans or to convert Base Rate Loans to Eurodollar Rate Loans shall be suspended, and (ii) if such notice asserts the illegality of the Lender making or maintaining Base Rate Loans the interest rate on which is determined by reference to the Eurodollar Rate component of the Base Rate, the interest rate on which Base Rate Loans of the Lender shall, if necessary to avoid such illegality, be determined by the Lender without reference to the Eurodollar Rate component of the Base Rate, in each case until the Lender notifies the Borrower that the circumstances giving rise to such determination no longer exist.  Upon receipt of such notice, (A) the Borrower shall, upon demand from the Lender, prepay or, if applicable, convert any Eurodollar Rate Loan to a Base Rate Loan (the interest rate on which Base Rate Loan shall, if necessary to avoid such illegality, be determined by the Lender without reference to the Eurodollar Rate component of the Base Rate), either on the last day of the Interest Period therefor, if the Lender may lawfully continue to maintain such Eurodollar Rate Loans to such day, or immediately, if the Lender may not lawfully continue to maintain such Eurodollar Rate Loans and (B) if such notice asserts the illegality of the Lender determining or charging interest rates based upon the Eurodollar Rate, the Lender shall during the period of such suspension compute the Base Rate without reference to the Eurodollar Rate component thereof until the Lender determines that it is no longer illegal  for the Lender to determine or charge interest rates based upon the Eurodollar Rate.  Upon any such prepayment or conversion, the Borrower shall also pay accrued interest on the amount so prepaid or converted.

 

(c)                                   If the Lender determines, in its sole discretion, that for any reason in connection with any request for a Eurodollar Rate Loan or a conversion to or continuation thereof that (i) Dollar deposits are not being offered to banks in the London interbank eurodollar market for the applicable amount and Interest Period of such Eurodollar Rate Loan, (ii) adequate and reasonable means do not exist for

 

16



 

determining the Eurodollar Rate for any requested Interest Period with respect to a proposed Eurodollar Rate Loan or in connection with an existing or proposed Base Rate Loan, or (iii) the Eurodollar Rate for any requested Interest Period with respect to a proposed Eurodollar Rate Loan does not adequately and fairly reflect the cost to the Lender of funding such Loan, the Lender will promptly so notify the Borrower.  Thereafter, (A) the obligation of the Lender to make or maintain a Eurodollar Rate Loan shall be suspended, and (B) in the event of a determination described in the preceding sentence with respect to the Eurodollar Rate component of the Base Rate, the utilization of the Eurodollar Rate component in determining the Base Rate shall be suspended, in each case until the Lender revokes such notice.  Upon receipt of such notice, the Borrower may revoke any pending request for a borrowing of, conversion to or continuation of a Eurodollar Rate Loan or, failing that, will be deemed to have converted such request into a request for a borrowing of a Base Rate Loan in the amount specified therein.

 

(d)                                  If any Change in Law shall:

 

(i)                                      impose, modify or deem applicable any reserve, special deposit, compulsory loan, insurance charge or similar requirement against assets of, deposits with or for the account of, or credit extended or participated in by, the Lender,

 

(ii)                                   subject the Lender to any taxes (other than taxes imposed on the Lender’s income, and franchise taxes imposed on the Lender by the jurisdiction under the laws of which the Lender is organized or any political subdivision thereof) on its loans, loan principal, commitments, or other obligations, or its deposits, reserves, other liabilities or capital attributable thereto, or

 

(iii)                                impose on the Lender or the London interbank market any other condition, cost or expense affecting this Agreement or Eurodollar Rate Loans made by the Lender,

 

and the result of any of the foregoing shall be to increase the cost to the Lender of making, converting to, continuing or maintaining any Loan the interest on which is determined by reference to the Eurodollar Rate (or of maintaining its obligation to make any such Loan), or to reduce the amount of any sum received or receivable by such Lender (whether of principal, interest or any other amount) then, upon request of the Lender, the Borrower will pay to the Lender such additional amount or amounts as will compensate the Lender for such additional costs incurred or reduction suffered.

 

(e)                                   If the Lender determines that any Change in Law affecting the Lender or its Lending Office or the Lender’s holding company, if any, regarding capital or liquidity requirements has or would have the effect of reducing the rate of return on the Lender’s capital or on the capital of the Lender’s holding company, if any, as a consequence of this Agreement, the commitment of the Lender hereunder or the Loans made by the Lender to a level below that which the Lender or the Lender’s holding company could have achieved but for such Change in Law (taking into consideration the Lender’s policies and the policies of the Lender’s holding company with respect to capital adequacy), then from time to time the

 

17



 

Borrower will pay to the Lender such additional amount or amounts as will compensate the Lender or the Lender’s or the Lender’s holding company for any such reduction suffered.

 

(f)                                     A certificate of the Lender setting forth the amount or amounts necessary to compensate the Lender or its holding company, as the case may be, as specified in Section 8(d) or 8(e) of this Section and delivered to the Borrower shall be conclusive absent manifest error.  The Borrower shall pay to the Lender the amount shown as due on any such certificate within 10 days after receipt thereof.

 

(g)                                  Failure or delay on the part of the Lender to demand compensation pursuant to the foregoing provisions of Section 8(d) or 8(e) shall not constitute a waiver of the Lender’s right to demand such compensation, provided that the Borrower shall not be required to compensate the Lender pursuant to the foregoing provisions of this Section for any increased costs incurred or reductions suffered more than nine months prior to the date that the Lender notifies the Borrower of the Change in Law giving rise to such increased costs or reductions and of the Lender’s intention to claim compensation therefor (except that, if the Change in Law giving rise to such increased costs or reductions is retroactive, then the nine-month period referred to above shall be extended to include the period of retroactive effect thereof).

 

(h)                                  All of the Borrower’s obligations under this Section 8 shall survive termination of this Agreement and repayment of the Obligations.

 

Section 9.                   Miscellaneous.

 

(a)                                   All financial computations required under this Agreement shall be made, and all financial information required under this Agreement shall be prepared, in accordance with GAAP.

 

(b)                                  Unless otherwise specified, all references herein to times of day shall be references to Central time (daylight or standard, as applicable).

 

(c)                                   Any definition of or reference to any agreement, instrument or other document shall be construed as referring to such agreement, instrument or other document as from time to time amended, supplemented or otherwise modified (subject to any restrictions on such amendments, supplements or modifications set forth herein or in any other Loan Document).

 

(d)                                  No amendment or waiver of any provision of this Agreement or of any other Loan Document and no consent by the Lender to any departure therefrom by the Borrower shall be effective unless such amendment, waiver or consent shall be in writing and signed by a duly authorized officer of the Lender, and any such amendment, waiver or consent shall then be effective only for the period and on the conditions and for the specific instance specified in such writing.  No failure or delay by the Lender in exercising any right, power or privilege hereunder shall operate as a waiver thereof, nor shall any single or partial exercise thereof

 

18



 

preclude any other or further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other rights, power or privilege.

 

(e)                                   Except as otherwise expressly provided herein, notices and other communications to each party provided for herein shall be in writing and shall be delivered by hand or overnight courier service, mailed or sent by facsimile to the address provided from time to time by such party.  Notices and other communications sent by hand or overnight courier service, or mailed by certified or registered mail, shall be deemed to have been given when received; notices and other communications sent by facsimile shall be deemed to have been given when sent (except that, if not given during normal business hours for the recipient, shall be deemed to have been given at the opening of business on the next Business Day for the recipient).  Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein, all notices (by whatever means) to the Lender pursuant to Section 1(b) hereof shall be effective only upon receipt.  Any notice or other communication permitted to be given, made or confirmed by telephone hereunder shall be given, made or confirmed by means of a telephone call to the intended recipient at the number specified in writing by such Person for such purpose, it being understood and agreed that a voicemail message shall in no event be effective as a notice, communication or confirmation hereunder.

 

(f)                                     The Lender shall be entitled to rely and act upon any notices (including telephonic notices of borrowings, conversions and continuations) purportedly given by or on behalf of the Borrower even if (i) such notices were not made in a manner specified herein, were incomplete or were not preceded or followed by any other form of notice specified herein, or (ii) the terms thereof, as understood by the recipient, varied from any confirmation thereof.  The Borrower shall indemnify each Indemnitee from all losses, costs, expenses and liabilities resulting from the reliance by such Person on each notice purportedly given by or on behalf of the Borrower.  All telephonic notices to and other communications with the Lender may be recorded by the Lender, and the Borrower hereby consents to such recording.

 

(g)                                  This Agreement shall inure to the benefit of the parties hereto and their respective successors and assigns, except that the Borrower may not assign its rights and obligations hereunder without the prior written consent of the Lender.  The Lender may at any time (i) assign all or any part of its rights and obligations hereunder to any other Person with the consent of the Borrower, provided that no such consent shall be required if the assignment is to an Affiliate of the Lender or if an Event of Default exists, (ii) grant to any other Person participating interests in all or part of its rights and obligations hereunder without notice to the Borrower, and (iii) pledge or assign a security interest in all or any portion of its rights under this Agreement (including under the Notes, if any) to secure obligations of the Lender, including any pledge or assignment to secure obligations to a Federal Reserve Bank (provided that no such pledge or assignment referred to in this clause (iii) shall release the Lender from any of its obligations hereunder or substitute any such pledgee or assignee for the Lender as a party hereto).  The Borrower agrees to execute any documents reasonably

 

19



 

requested by the Lender in connection with any assignment referred to in the foregoing clause (i).  All information provided by or on behalf of the Borrower to the Lender or its Affiliates may be furnished by the Lender to its Affiliates and to any actual or proposed assignee or participant.

 

(h)                                  The Borrower shall pay (i) all reasonable and documented out-of-pocket expenses incurred by the Lender and its Affiliates (including the reasonable fees, charges and disbursements of counsel for the Lender), in connection with the preparation, negotiation, execution, delivery and administration of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents or any amendments, modifications or waivers of the provisions hereof or thereof (whether or not the transactions contemplated hereby or thereby shall be consummated), and (ii) all and documented out of pocket expenses incurred by the Lender (including the fees, charges and disbursements of any counsel for the Lender), in connection with the enforcement or protection of its rights (A) in connection with this Agreement and the other Loan Documents, including its rights under this Section, or (B) in connection with the Loans made hereunder, including all such out-of-pocket expenses incurred during any workout, restructuring or negotiations in respect of the Loan.

 

(i)                                      The Borrower shall indemnify the Lender and its Related Parties (each such Person being called an “ Indemnitee ”) against, and hold each Indemnitee harmless from, any and all losses, claims, damages, liabilities and related expenses (including the fees, charges and disbursements of any counsel for any Indemnitee, incurred by any Indemnitee or asserted against any Indemnitee by any Person (including any Loan Party or any of its Subsidiaries) other than such Indemnitee and its Related Parties arising out of, in connection with, or as a result of (i) the execution or delivery of this Agreement, any other Loan Document or any agreement or instrument contemplated hereby or thereby, the performance by the parties hereto of their respective obligations hereunder or thereunder or the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby or thereby, or the administration of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents, (ii) the Loans or the use or proposed use of the proceeds therefrom, (iii) any actual or alleged presence or release of Hazardous Materials on or from any property owned or operated by either Loan Party or any of its Subsidiaries, or any Environmental Liability arising with respect to either Loan Party or any of its Subsidiaries, or (iv) any actual or prospective claim, litigation, investigation or proceeding relating to any of the foregoing, whether based on contract, tort or any other theory, whether brought by a third party or by any Loan Party or Subsidiary thereof, and regardless of whether any Indemnitee is a party thereto, IN ALL CASES, WHETHER OR NOT CAUSED BY OR ARISING, IN WHOLE OR IN PART, OUT OF THE COMPARATIVE, CONTRIBUTORY OR SOLE NEGLIGENCE OF THE INDEMNITEE; provided that such indemnity shall not, as to any Indemnitee, be available to the extent that such losses, claims, damages, liabilities or related expenses (x) are determined by a court of competent jurisdiction by final and nonappealable judgment to have resulted from the gross negligence or willful misconduct of such Indemnitee or (y) result from a claim brought by the Borrower or any other Loan Party against an Indemnitee for breach in bad faith of such Indemnitee’s obligations hereunder or under any other Loan Document, if

 

20


 

the Borrower or such Loan Party has obtained a final and nonappealable judgment in its favor on such claim as determined by a court of competent jurisdiction.

 

(j)                                      To the fullest extent permitted by applicable law, the Borrower shall not assert, and hereby waives, and acknowledges that no other Person shall have, any claim against any Indemnitee, on any theory of liability, for special, indirect, consequential or punitive damages (as opposed to direct or actual damages) arising out of, in connection with, or as a result of, this Agreement, any other Loan Document or any agreement or instrument contemplated hereby, the transactions contemplated hereby or thereby, any Loan or the use of the proceeds thereof.  No Indemnitee shall be liable for any damages arising from the use by unintended recipients of any information or other materials distributed to such unintended recipients by such Indemnitee through telecommunications, electronic or other information transmission systems in connection with this Agreement or the other Loan Documents or the transactions contemplated hereby or thereby other than for direct or actual damages resulting from the gross negligence or willful misconduct of such Indemnitee as determined by a final and nonappealable judgment of a court of competent jurisdiction.

 

(k)                                   All amounts due under this Section shall be payable not later than ten Business Days after demand therefor.

 

(l)                                      The agreements in this Section and the indemnity provisions of Section 9(i)  shall survive the termination of this Agreement and the repayment, satisfaction or discharge of the Obligations.

 

(m)                                To the extent that any payment by or on behalf of the Borrower is made to the Lender, or the Lender exercises its right of setoff, and such payment or the proceeds of such setoff or any part thereof is subsequently invalidated, declared to be fraudulent or preferential, set aside or required (including pursuant to any settlement entered into by the Lender in its discretion) to be repaid to a trustee, receiver or any other party, in connection with any proceeding under any Debtor Relief Law or otherwise, then to the extent of such recovery, the obligation or part thereof originally intended to be satisfied shall be revived and continued in full force and effect as if such payment had not been made or such setoff had not occurred.

 

(n)                                  If any provision of this Agreement or the other Loan Documents is held to be illegal, invalid or unenforceable, (i) the legality, validity and enforceability of the remaining provisions of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents shall not be affected or impaired thereby and (ii) the parties shall endeavor in good faith negotiations to replace the illegal, invalid or unenforceable provisions with valid provisions the economic effect of which comes as close as possible to that of the illegal, invalid or unenforceable provisions.  The invalidity of a provision in a particular jurisdiction shall not invalidate or render unenforceable such provision in any other jurisdiction.

 

21



 

(o)                                  All representations and warranties made hereunder and in any other Loan Document or other document delivered pursuant hereto or thereto or in connection herewith or therewith shall survive the execution and delivery hereof and thereof.  Such representations and warranties have been or will be relied upon by the Lender, regardless of any investigation made by the Lender or on its behalf and notwithstanding that the Lender may have had notice or knowledge of any Default at the time of the making of any Loan, and shall continue in full force and effect as long as the Loans or any other Obligation hereunder shall remain unpaid or unsatisfied.

 

(p)                                  This Agreement may be executed in one or more counterparts, and each counterpart, when so executed, shall be deemed an original but all such counterparts shall constitute but one and the same instrument.

 

(q)                                  THIS AGREEMENT AND THE OTHER LOAN DOCUMENTS AND ANY CLAIMS, CONTROVERSY, DISPUTE OR CAUSE OF ACTION (WHETHER IN CONTRACT OR TORT OR OTHERWISE) BASED UPON, ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO THIS AGREEMENT OR ANY OTHER LOAN DOCUMENT (EXCEPT, AS TO ANY OTHER LOAN DOCUMENT, AS EXPRESSLY SET FORTH THEREIN) AND THE TRANSACTIONS CONTEMPLATED HEREBY AND THEREBY SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAW OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK.

 

(r)                                     THE BORROWER IRREVOCABLY AND UNCONDITIONALLY AGREES THAT IT WILL NOT COMMENCE ANY ACTION, LITIGATION OR PROCEEDING OF ANY KIND OR DESCRIPTION, WHETHER IN LAW OR EQUITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT OR IN TORT OR OTHERWISE, AGAINST THE LENDER OR ANY OF ITS RELATED PARTIES IN ANY WAY RELATING TO THIS AGREEMENT OR ANY OTHER LOAN DOCUMENT OR THE TRANSACTIONS RELATING HERETO OR THERETO, IN ANY FORUM OTHER THAN THE COURTS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK SITTING IN NEW YORK COUNTY AND OF THE UNITED STATES DISTRICT COURT OF THE SOUTHERN DISTRICT OF NEW YORK, AND ANY APPELLATE COURT FROM ANY THEREOF, AND EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO IRREVOCABLY AND UNCONDITIONALLY SUBMITS TO THE JURISDICTION OF SUCH COURTS  AND AGREES THAT ALL CLAIMS IN RESPECT OF ANY SUCH ACTION, LITIGATION OR PROCEEDING MAY BE HEARD AND DETERMINED IN SUCH NEW YORK STATE COURT OR, TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, IN SUCH FEDERAL COURT.  EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO AGREES THAT A FINAL JUDGMENT IN ANY SUCH ACTION, LITIGATION OR PROCEEDING SHALL BE CONCLUSIVE AND MAY BE ENFORCED IN OTHER JURISDICTIONS BY SUIT ON THE JUDGMENT OR IN ANY OTHER MANNER PROVIDED BY LAW.  NOTHING IN THIS AGREEMENT OR IN ANY OTHER LOAN DOCUMENT SHALL AFFECT ANY RIGHT THAT THE LENDER MAY OTHERWISE HAVE TO BRING ANY ACTION

 

22



 

OR PROCEEDING RELATING TO THIS AGREEMENT OR ANY OTHER LOAN DOCUMENT AGAINST THE BORROWER OR ITS PROPERTIES IN THE COURTS OF ANY JURISDICTION.

 

(s)                                   EACH PARTY IRREVOCABLY AND UNCONDITIONALLY WAIVES, TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, ANY OBJECTION THAT IT MAY NOW OR HEREAFTER HAVE TO THE LAYING OF VENUE OF ANY ACTION OR PROCEEDING ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO THIS AGREEMENT OR ANY OTHER LOAN DOCUMENT IN ANY COURT REFERRED TO IN SECTION 9(R) .  EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO HEREBY IRREVOCABLY WAIVES, TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, THE DEFENSE OF AN INCONVENIENT FORUM TO THE MAINTENANCE OF SUCH ACTION OR PROCEEDING IN ANY SUCH COURT.

 

(t)                                     EACH PARTY HERETO IRREVOCABLY CONSENTS TO SERVICE OF PROCESS IN THE MANNER PROVIDED FOR NOTICES IN SECTION 9(E) .  NOTHING IN THIS AGREEMENT WILL AFFECT THE RIGHT OF ANY PARTY HERETO TO SERVE PROCESS IN ANY OTHER MANNER PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW.

 

(u)                                  EACH PARTY HERETO HEREBY IRREVOCABLY WAIVES, TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, ANY RIGHT IT MAY HAVE TO A TRIAL BY JURY IN ANY LEGAL PROCEEDING DIRECTLY OR INDIRECTLY ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO THIS AGREEMENT OR ANY OTHER LOAN DOCUMENT OR THE TRANSACTIONS CONTEMPLATED HEREBY OR THEREBY (WHETHER BASED ON CONTRACT, TORT OR ANY OTHER THEORY).  EACH PARTY HERETO (I) CERTIFIES THAT NO REPRESENTATIVE, AGENT OR ATTORNEY OF ANY OTHER PERSON HAS REPRESENTED, EXPRESSLY OR OTHERWISE, THAT SUCH OTHER PERSON WOULD NOT, IN THE EVENT OF LITIGATION, SEEK TO ENFORCE THE FOREGOING WAIVER AND (II) ACKNOWLEDGES THAT IT AND THE OTHER PARTIES HERETO HAVE BEEN INDUCED TO ENTER INTO THIS AGREEMENT AND THE OTHER LOAN DOCUMENTS BY, AMONG OTHER THINGS, THE MUTUAL WAIVERS AND CERTIFICATIONS IN THIS SECTION.

 

(v)                                  The Lender hereby notifies the Borrower that pursuant to the requirements of the USA PATRIOT Act (Title III of Pub.L. 107-56 (signed into law October 26, 2001)) (the “ Act ”), the Lender is required to obtain, verify and record information that identifies the Borrower, which information includes the name and address of the Borrower and other information that will allow the Lender to identify the Borrower in accordance with the Act.  The Borrower shall, promptly following a request by the Lender, provide all documentation and other information that the Lender requests in order to comply with its ongoing obligations under applicable “know your customer” and anti-money laundering rules and regulations, including the Act.

 

23



 

(W)                            THIS AGREEMENT AND THE OTHER LOAN DOCUMENTS REPRESENT THE FINAL AGREEMENT BETWEEN THE PARTIES AND MAY NOT BE CONTRADICTED BY EVIDENCE OF PRIOR, CONTEMPORANEOUS, OR SUBSEQUENT ORAL AGREEMENTS OF THE PARTIES.  THERE ARE NO UNWRITTEN ORAL AGREEMENTS BETWEEN THE PARTIES.

 

[Remainder of Page Intentionally Left Blank]

 

24



 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Agreement to be duly executed as of the date first above written.

 

 

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP, AS BORROWER

 

 

 

 

BY:

SUSSER PARTNERS GP LLC,

 

 

ITS GENERAL PARTNER

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

 

Signature Page to Term Loan and Security Agreement

(Susser Petroleum Partners LP)

 



 

 

BANK OF AMERICA, N.A., as Lender

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

 

Signature Page to Term Loan and Security Agreement

(Susser Petroleum Partners LP)

 



 

EXHIBIT A

 

DEFINITIONS

 

Account Control Agreement:

 

The Account Control Agreement dated as of the date hereof among the Borrower (as Debtor), Intermediary (as Intermediary) and the Lender (as Bank).

 

 

 

Act:

 

Has the meaning set forth in Section 9(v) .

 

 

 

Administrative Agent:

 

The Person acting as Administrative Agent from time to time under and as defined in the Revolving Credit Agreement.

 

 

 

Affiliate:

 

With respect to a specified Person, another Person that directly, or indirectly through one or more intermediaries, Controls or is Controlled by or is under common Control with the Person specified.

 

 

 

Agreement:

 

This Term Loan and Security Agreement, as amended, restated, extended, supplemented or otherwise modified in writing from time to time.

 

 

 

Applicable Rate:

 

An applicable percentage per annum equal to (a) in the case of a Eurodollar Rate Loan, 0.25% and (b) in the case of a Base Rate Loan, 0%. 

 

 

 

Base Rate:

 

For any day a fluctuating rate per annum equal to the highest of (a) the Federal Funds Rate plus 1/2 of 1%, (b) the rate of interest in effect for such day as publicly announced from time to time by the Lender as its “prime rate”, and (c) the Eurodollar Rate (as set forth in clause (b) of the definition thereof) plus 1.00%.  The “prime rate” is a rate set by the Lender based upon various factors including the Lender’s costs and desired return, general economic conditions and other factors, and is used as a reference point for pricing some loans, which may be priced at, above, or below such announced rate.  Any change in such prime rate announced by the Lender shall take effect at the opening of business on the day specified in the public announcement of such change.

 

 

 

Base Rate Loan:

 

A Loan bearing interest based on the Base Rate.

 

 

 

Borrower:

 

Has the meaning set forth in the preamble hereto.

 

 

 

Borrower IPO:

 

An initial registered public offering of the Common Units of the Borrower to the public pursuant to the Registration Statement which results in the Common Units of the Borrower being traded on a national securities exchange.

 

Exhibit A to Term Loan and Security Agreement

(Susser Petroleum Partners LP)

 

1



 

Breakage Costs:

 

Any loss, cost or expense incurred by the Lender (including any loss of anticipated profits and any loss or expense arising from the liquidation or reemployment of funds obtained by the Lender to maintain the relevant Eurodollar Rate Loan or from fees payable to terminate the deposits from which such funds were obtained) as a result of (i) any continuation, conversion, payment or prepayment of any Eurodollar Rate Loan on a day other than the last day of the Interest Period therefor (whether voluntary, mandatory, automatic, by reason of acceleration, or otherwise); or (ii) any failure by the Borrower (for a reason other than the failure of the Lender to make any Loan when all conditions to making such Loan have been met by the Borrower in accordance with the terms hereof) to prepay, borrow, continue or convert any Eurodollar Rate Loan on a date or in the amount notified by the Borrower.  A certificate of the Lender as to its costs of funds, losses and expenses incurred shall be conclusive absent manifest error.

 

 

 

Business Day:

 

Any day other than a Saturday, Sunday or other day on which commercial banks are authorized to close under the Laws of, or are in fact closed in, the state where the Lending Office is located and, if such day relates to any Eurodollar Rate Loan, means any such day that is also a London Banking Day.

 

 

 

Change in Law:

 

The occurrence, after the date of this Agreement, of any of the following: (a) the adoption or taking effect of any law, rule, regulation or treaty, (b) any change in any law, rule, regulation or treaty or in the administration, interpretation, implementation or application thereof by any Governmental Authority or (c) the making or issuance of any request, rule, guideline or directive (whether or not having the force of law) by any Governmental Authority; provided that notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, (x) the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act and all requests, rules, guidelines or directives thereunder or issued in connection therewith and (y) all requests, rules, guidelines or directives promulgated by the Bank for International Settlements, the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (or any successor or similar authority) or the United States or foreign regulatory authorities, in each case pursuant to Basel III, shall in each case be deemed to be a “Change in Law”, regardless of the date enacted, adopted or issued.

 

2



 

Change of Control:

 

Any of the following events or conditions: (a) the General Partner shall cease to be the sole general partner of the Borrower; (b) the Guarantor shall cease, directly or indirectly, to own and control legally and beneficially more than 50% of the Equity Interests in the General Partner or any Person (other than the Guarantor) shall Control the General Partner; or (c) a “change of control” or any comparable term under, and as defined in, any indenture, note agreement or other agreement governing any Qualified Offering that results in an “event of default” under such Qualified Offering, such Qualified Offering becoming due and payable before its maturity, or such Qualified Offering being subject to a repurchase, retirement or redemption right or option (whether or not exercised).

 

 

 

Closing Date:

 

The first date all the conditions precedent in Section 2(a)  are satisfied or waived in accordance with Section 9(d) .

 

 

 

Collateral:

 

All assets and property maintained in the Collateral Account and [                ].

 

 

 

Collateral Account:

 

The account of the Borrower numbered [              ] with the [Intermediary].

 

 

 

Common Units:

 

The common units and subordinated units representing limited partner interests in the Borrower.

 

 

 

Contractual Obligation:

 

As to any Person, any provision of any security issued by such Person or of any agreement, instrument or other undertaking to which such Person is a party or by which it or any of its property is bound.

 

 

 

Contributing Affiliates:

 

The Guarantor, Susser Petroleum Company and any other Affiliate of the Guarantor that contributes or otherwise transfers assets to the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries, whether on, prior to or after the Closing Date as described in the Registration Statement.

 

 

 

Contributed Assets:

 

The assets contributed or otherwise transferred by the applicable Contributing Affiliate to the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries whether on, prior to or after the Closing Date, including without limitation the assets contributed by certain Contributing Affiliates to the Borrower and its Subsidiaries on or prior to the Closing Date as described in the Registration Statement.

 

 

 

Control:

 

The possession, directly or indirectly, of the power to direct or cause the direction of the management or policies of a Person, whether through the ability to exercise voting power, by contract or otherwise.  “Controlling” and “Controlled” have meanings correlative thereto.

 

3



 

Debtor Relief Laws:

 

The Bankruptcy Code of the United States, and all other liquidation, conservatorship, bankruptcy, assignment for the benefit of creditors, moratorium, rearrangement, receivership, insolvency, reorganization, or similar debtor relief Laws of the United States or other applicable jurisdictions from time to time in effect.

 

 

 

Default:

 

Any event or condition that constitutes an Event of Default or that, with the giving of any notice, the passage of time, or both, would be an Event of Default.

 

 

 

Default Rate:

 

An interest rate equal to (i) the Base Rate plus (ii) the Applicable Rate, if any, applicable to Base Rate Loans plus (iii) 2% per annum; provided , however, that with respect to a Eurodollar Rate Loan, the Default Rate shall be an interest rate equal to the interest rate (including any Applicable Rate) otherwise applicable to such Loan plus 2% per annum.

 

 

 

Disposition or Dispose:

 

The sale, transfer, license, lease or other disposition (including any sale and leaseback transaction) of any property by any Person (or the granting of any option or other right to do any of the foregoing), including any sale, assignment, transfer or other disposal, with or without recourse, of any notes or accounts receivable or any rights and claims associated therewith.

 

 

 

Dollar or $:

 

The lawful currency of the United States of America.

 

 

 

Environmental Laws:

 

Any and all applicable Federal, state, local, and foreign statutes, laws, regulations, ordinances, rules, judgments, orders, decrees, permits, licenses or governmental restrictions relating to pollution and the protection of the environment or the release of any materials into the environment, including those related to hazardous substances or wastes, air emissions and discharges to waste or public systems.

 

 

 

Environmental Liability:

 

Any liability, contingent or otherwise (including any liability for damages, costs of environmental remediation, fines, penalties or indemnities), of the Borrower, any other Loan Party or any of their respective Subsidiaries or any Contributing Affiliate directly or indirectly resulting from or based upon (a) violation of any Environmental Law, (b) the generation, use, handling, transportation, storage, treatment or disposal of any Hazardous Materials, (c) exposure to any Hazardous Materials, (d) the release or threatened release of any Hazardous Materials into the environment or (e) any contract, agreement or other written consensual arrangement pursuant to which liability is assumed or imposed with respect to any of the foregoing.

 

4


 

Equity Interests:

 

With respect to any Person, all of the shares of capital stock of (or other ownership or profit interests in) such Person, all of the warrants, options or other rights for the purchase or acquisition from such Person of shares of capital stock of (or other ownership or profit interests in) such Person, all of the securities convertible into or exchangeable for shares of capital stock of (or other ownership or profit interests in) such Person or warrants, rights or options for the purchase or acquisition from such Person of such shares (or such other interests), and all of the other ownership or profit interests in such Person (including partnership, member or trust interests therein), whether voting or nonvoting, and whether or not such shares, warrants, options, rights or other interests are outstanding on any date of determination (provided, however, that debt securities that are or by their terms may be convertible or exchangeable into or for Equity Interests shall not constitute Equity Interests prior to conversion or exchange thereof).

 

 

 

Eurodollar Rate:

 

(a) For any Interest Period with respect to a Eurodollar Rate Loan, the rate per annum equal to (i) the British Bankers Association LIBOR Rate (“ BBA LIBOR ”), as published by Reuters (or such other commercially available source providing quotations of BBA LIBOR as may be designated by the Lender from time to time) at approximately 10:00 a.m., London time, two London Banking Days prior to the commencement of such Interest Period, for Dollar deposits (for delivery on the first day of such Interest Period) with a term equivalent to such Interest Period or, (ii) if such rate is not available at such time for any reason, the rate per annum determined by the Lender to be the rate at which deposits in Dollars for delivery on the first day of such Interest Period in same day funds in the approximate amount of the Eurodollar Rate Loan being made, continued or converted and with a term equivalent to such Interest Period would be offered by the Lender’s London Branch to major banks in the London interbank eurodollar market at their request at approximately 10:00 a.m. (London time) two London Banking Days prior to the commencement of such Interest Period; and

 

(b) For any interest calculation with respect to a Base Rate Loan on any date, the rate per annum equal to (i) BBA LIBOR, at approximately 10:00 a.m., London time determined two London Banking Days prior to such date for Dollar deposits being delivered in the London interbank market for a term of one month commencing that day or (ii) if such published rate is not available at such time for any reason, the rate per annum determined by the Lender to be the rate at which deposits in Dollars for delivery on the date of determination in same day funds in the approximate amount of the Base Rate Loan being

 

5



 

 

 

made or maintained and with a term equal to one month would be offered by the Lender’s London Branch to major banks in the London interbank Eurodollar market at their request at the date and time of determination.

 

 

 

Eurodollar Rate Loan:

 

A Loan bearing interest based on the Eurodollar Rate.

 

 

 

Event of Default:

 

Has the meaning set forth in Section 7 .

 

 

 

Federal Funds Rate:

 

For any day, the rate per annum equal to the weighted average of the rates on overnight Federal funds transactions with members of the Federal Reserve System arranged by Federal funds brokers on such day, as published by the Federal Reserve Bank of New York on the Business Day next succeeding such day; provided that (a) if such day is not a Business Day, the Federal Funds Rate for such day shall be such rate on such transactions on the next preceding Business Day as so published on the next succeeding Business Day, and (b) if no such rate is so published on such next succeeding Business Day, the Federal Funds Rate for such day shall be the average rate (rounded upward, if necessary, to a whole multiple of 1/100 of 1%) charged to the Lender on such day on such transactions as determined by the Lender.

 

 

 

FRB:

 

The Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System of the United States.

 

 

 

GAAP:

 

Generally accepted accounting principles in the United States set forth in the opinions and pronouncements of the Accounting Principles Board and the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants and statements and pronouncements of the Financial Accounting Standards Board or such other principles as may be approved by a significant segment of the accounting profession in the United States, that are applicable to the circumstances as of the date of determination, consistently applied.

 

 

 

General Partner:

 

Susser Petroleum Partners GP, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company and the sole general partner of the Borrower.

 

 

 

Governmental Authority:

 

The government of the United States or any other nation, or of any political subdivision thereof, whether state or local, and any agency, authority, instrumentality, regulatory body, court, central bank or other entity exercising executive, legislative, judicial, taxing, regulatory or administrative powers or functions of or pertaining to government (including any supra-national bodies such as the European Union or the European Central Bank).

 

6



 

Guarantor:

 

Susser Holdings Corporation, a Delaware corporation.

 

 

 

Guaranty:

 

The Guaranty dated as of the date hereof made by the Guarantor in favor of the Lender, as amended, restated, extended, supplemented or otherwise modified in writing from time to time.

 

 

 

Hazardous Materials:

 

All explosive or radioactive substances or wastes and all hazardous or toxic substances, wastes or other pollutants, including petroleum or petroleum distillates, asbestos or asbestos-containing materials, polychlorinated biphenyls, radon gas, infectious or medical wastes and all other substances or wastes of any nature regulated pursuant to any Environmental Law.

 

 

 

Indemnitee:

 

Has the meaning set forth in Section 9(i) .

 

 

 

Intermediary:

 

Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated, as Intermediary under the Account Control Agreement.

 

 

 

Interest Period:

 

For a Eurodollar Rate Loan, the period commencing on the date such Eurodollar Rate Loan is disbursed or converted to or continued as a Eurodollar Rate Loan and ending on the date one, two, three, six, nine or twelve months thereafter, as selected by the Borrower in accordance with the terms hereof or such other period requested by the Borrower and consented to by the Lender; provided that:

 

(a)           any Interest Period that would otherwise end on a day that is not a Business Day shall be extended to the next succeeding Business Day unless, in the case of a Eurodollar Rate Loan, such Business Day falls in another calendar month, in which case such Interest Period shall end on the next preceding Business Day;

 

(b)           any Interest Period pertaining to a Eurodollar Rate Loan that begins on the last Business Day of a calendar month (or on a day for which there is no numerically corresponding day in the calendar month at the end of such Interest Period) shall end on the last Business Day of the calendar month at the end of such Interest Period; and

 

 

 

 

 

(c)           no Interest Period shall extend beyond the Maturity Date.

 

 

 

Laws:

 

Collectively, all international, foreign, Federal, state and local statutes, treaties, rules, guidelines, regulations, ordinances, codes and administrative or judicial precedents or authorities, including the interpretation or administration thereof by any Governmental Authority

 

7



 

 

 

charged with the enforcement, interpretation or administration thereof, and all applicable administrative orders, directed duties, requests, licenses, authorizations and permits of, and agreements with, any Governmental Authority, in each case whether or not having the force of law.

 

 

 

Lender:

 

Has the meaning set forth in the preamble hereto.

 

 

 

Lending Office:

 

Has the meaning set forth in Section 1(e) .

 

 

 

Lien:

 

Any interest in property securing an obligation owed to, or a claim by, a Person other than the owner of the property, whether such interest is based on the common law, statute or contract, and whether such obligation or claim is fixed or contingent, and including but not limited to the lien or security interest arising from any mortgage, pledge, hypothecation, assignment, deposit arrangement, encumbrance, charge, or preference, priority or other security interest or preferential arrangement in the nature of a security interest. The term “Lien” shall include any conditional sale or other title retention agreement, any easement, right of way or other encumbrance on title to real property, and any financing lease having substantially the same economic effect as any of the foregoing.

 

 

 

Loan Documents:

 

This Agreement, the Guaranty, the Notes (if any), [the Account Control Agreement,] and each other document executed and delivered in connection with the granting, attachment and perfection of the Lender’s security interest in the Collateral.

 

 

 

Loan Parties:

 

The Borrower and the Guarantor.

 

 

 

London Banking Day:

 

Any day on which dealings in Dollar deposits are conducted by and between banks in the London interbank eurodollar market.

 

 

 

Material Adverse Effect:

 

A material adverse change in, or a material adverse effect on (a)  the operations, business, properties, liabilities or financial condition of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries taken as a whole; (b) the ability of any Loan Party to perform its obligations under the Loan Documents to which it is a party; or (c) the legality, validity, binding effect or enforceability against the Borrower or the Guarantor of, or material rights and remedies of the Lender under, the Loan Documents to which the Borrower or such Guarantor is a party.

 

8



 

Material Contract:

 

(a) The Susser Contribution Agreement and any similar type of agreement relating to the transfer of the Contributed Assets, (b) all material fuel supply, marketer and/or distributor agreements, including those listed on Schedule 5.18 to the Revolving Credit Agreement, together with amendments, restatements, extensions and replacements thereof, (c) the Susser Distribution Contract, the Susser Omnibus Agreement, and the Susser Transportation Contract together with amendments, restatements, extensions and replacements thereof, and (d) any other documents, agreements or instruments (i) to which any the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries is a party, and (ii) which, if breached, terminated or cancelled, could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

 

 

Maturity Date:

 

[              ] [    ], 2015(1); provided , however, that if such date is not a Business Day, the Maturity Date shall be the next preceding Business Day.

 

 

 

Note:

 

Has the meaning set forth in Section 1(d) .

 

 

 

Obligations:

 

All advances to, and debts, liabilities, obligations, covenants and duties of, any Loan Party arising under any Loan Document or otherwise with respect to the Loans, in each case whether direct or indirect (including those acquired by assumption), absolute or contingent, due or to become due, now existing or hereafter arising and including interest and fees that accrue after the commencement by or against any Loan Party or any Affiliate thereof of any proceeding under any Debtor Relief Laws naming such Person as the debtor in such proceeding, regardless of whether such interest and fees are allowed claims in such proceeding.

 

 

 

Permitted Collateral:

 

[                            ]. 

 

 

 

Person:

 

Any natural person, corporation, limited liability company, trust, joint venture, association, company, partnership, Governmental Authority or other entity.

 

 

 

Qualified Offering:

 

Has the meaning set forth in the Revolving Credit Agreement.

 

 

 

Registration Statement:

 

That certain Form S-1 Registration Statement No. 333-182276 filed on June 21, 2012 with the SEC with respect to the Common Units, as amended from time to time through [              ], 2012.

 


(1) To be 3 years from Closing Date.

 

9



 

Related Parties:

 

With respect to any Person, such Person’s Affiliates and the partners, directors, officers, employees, agents, trustees, administrators, managers, advisors and representatives of such Person and of such Person’s Affiliates.

 

 

 

Required Collateral Amount:

 

Has the meaning set forth in Section 4(f)(ii) .

 

 

 

Responsible Officer:

 

With respect to any Person, the chief executive officer, president, chief financial officer, any executive vice president, treasurer, assistant treasurer or controller of such Person (or its general partner or other governing body, as applicable) and, solely for purposes of the delivery of incumbency certificates pursuant to Section 2(a)(i)(F) , the secretary or any assistant secretary of a Loan Party.  Any document delivered hereunder that is signed by a Responsible Officer of a Loan Party or the General Partner on behalf of such Loan Party shall be conclusively presumed to have been authorized by all necessary corporate, partnership and/or other action on the part of such Loan Party or the General Partner, as applicable, and such Responsible Officer shall be conclusively presumed to have acted on behalf of such Loan Party or the General Partner, as applicable.

 

 

 

Revolving Credit Agreement:

 

The Credit Agreement dated as of the date hereof among the Borrower, Bank of America, N.A., as administrative agent, and the lenders party thereto, as amended, modified, refinanced or replaced.

 

 

 

SEC:

 

The Securities and Exchange Commission, or any Governmental Authority succeeding to any of its principal functions.

 

 

 

Specified Representations:

 

The representations and warranties set forth in Sections 3(a)(i) , 3(a)(ii)(B) , 3(b)(i) , 3(b)(ii)(A) , 3(d) , 3(f)  and 3(g) .

 

 

 

Solvent and Solvency:

 

With respect to any Person on any date of determination, that on such date (a) the fair value of the property of such Person is greater than the total amount of liabilities, including contingent liabilities, of such Person, (b) the present fair salable value of the assets of such Person is not less than the amount that will be required to pay the probable liability of such Person on its debts as they become absolute and matured, (c) such Person does not intend to, and does not believe that it will, incur debts or liabilities beyond such Person’s ability to pay such debts and liabilities as they mature, (d) such Person is not engaged in business or a transaction, and is not about to engage in business or a transaction, for which such Person’s property would constitute an unreasonably small capital, and (e) such Person is able to pay its debts and liabilities, contingent obligations and other commitments as they

 

10



 

 

 

mature in the ordinary course of business.  The amount of contingent liabilities at any time shall be computed as the amount that, in the light of all the facts and circumstances existing at such time, represents the amount that can reasonably be expected to become an actual or matured liability.

 

 

 

Subsidiary:

 

With respect to any Person, a corporation, partnership, joint venture, limited liability company or other business entity of which a majority of the shares of securities or other interests having ordinary voting power for the election of directors or other governing body (other than securities or interests having such power only by reason of the happening of a contingency) are at the time beneficially owned, or the management of which is otherwise controlled, directly, or indirectly through one or more intermediaries, or both, by such Person.  Unless otherwise specified, all references herein to a “Subsidiary” or to “Subsidiaries” shall refer to a Subsidiary or Subsidiaries of the Borrower.

 

 

 

Susser Contribution Agreement:

 

The [Contribution Agreement dated as of [                  ], 2012 among the Borrower, the General Partner, the Guarantor, [Susser Holdings, L.L.C.] and Susser Petroleum Company, pursuant to which Susser Petroleum Company will contribute to Susser Operating the Contributed Assets (as defined therein) in exchange for the Guarantor contributing 100% of the Equity Interests of Susser Operating to the Borrower.]   [Note: based on current draft of contribution agreement.  To be confirmed.]

 

 

 

Susser Distribution Contract:

 

The Fuel Distribution Agreement dated as of [              ], 2012 among Susser Operating and the Guarantor.

 

 

 

Susser Omnibus Agreement:

 

The Omnibus Agreement, dated as of [                  ] among the Guarantor, the General Partner and the Borrower.

 

 

 

Susser Operating:

 

Susser Petroleum Operating Company LLC, a Delaware limited liability company and a wholly owned Subsidiary of the Borrower.

 

 

 

Susser Petroleum Company:

 

Susser Petroleum Company LLC, a Texas limited liability company and a wholly owned Subsidiary of the Guarantor.

 

 

 

Susser Transportation Contract:

 

The [            ] dated as of [              ], 2012 among Susser Petroleum Company, Susser Operating and one or more of Susser Operating’s wholly owned Subsidiaries.

 

11



 

Transactions:

 

Collectively, the contribution of Contributed Assets on or prior to the Closing Date, the consummation of the Borrower IPO and the execution and delivery by the Borrower of the Revolving Credit Agreement and the borrowing of any loans thereunder on the Closing Date.

 

 

 

Transfer Documents:

 

Collectively, the Susser Contribution Agreement and any other material documents, agreements and instruments executed by the Borrower, any Subsidiary thereof or any Contributing Affiliate in connection with the transfer of the Contributed Assets to the Borrower or any Subsidiary thereof whether on, prior to or after the Closing Date.

 

 

 

UCC:

 

The Uniform Commercial Code as in effect in the State of New York; provided that, if perfection or the effect of perfection or non-perfection or the priority of any security interest in any Collateral is governed by the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect in a jurisdiction other than the State of New York, “UCC” means the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect from time to time in such other jurisdiction for purposes of the provisions hereof relating to such perfection, effect of perfection or non-perfection or priority.

 

12



 

EXHIBIT B

 

FORM OF PROMISSORY NOTE

 

$[                      ]

                   ,      

 

FOR VALUE RECEIVED, the undersigned, SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP, a Delaware limited partnership (the “ Borrower ”), hereby promises to pay to the order of BANK OF AMERICA, N.A. (the “ Lender ”) the principal sum of [                    ] Dollars ($[                        ]) or, if less, the aggregate unpaid principal amount of the [Initial] [Subsequent] Loan made by the Lender to the Borrower pursuant to the Term Loan and Security Agreement dated as of [                ] [    ], 2012 (as it may be amended, restated, extended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time, being hereinafter called the “ Agreement ”), between the Borrower and the Lender, on the Maturity Date.  The Borrower further promises to pay interest on the unpaid principal amount of the Loan evidenced hereby from time to time at the rates, on the dates, and otherwise as provided in the Agreement.

 

All payments of principal and interest shall be made to the Lender for its account in Dollars in immediately available funds at the Lending Office.  If any amount is not paid in full when due hereunder, such unpaid amount shall bear interest, to be paid upon demand, from the due date thereof until the date of actual payment (and before as well as after judgment) computed at the per annum rate set forth in the Agreement.

 

This promissory note is one of the Notes referred to in the Agreement, is entitled to the benefits thereof and may be prepaid in whole or in part subject to the terms and conditions provided therein.  This promissory note is also entitled to the benefits of the Guaranty and the other Loan Documents and is secured by the Collateral.  Upon the occurrence and continuation of one or more of the Events of Default specified in the Agreement, all amounts then remaining unpaid on this promissory note shall become, or may be declared to be, immediately due and payable all as provided in the Agreement.  The [Initial] [Subsequent] Loan made by the Lender shall be evidenced by one or more loan accounts or records maintained by the Lender in the ordinary course of business.  The Lender may also attach schedules to this promissory note and endorse thereon the date, amount and maturity of the [Initial] [Subsequent] Loan and payments with respect thereto.

 

The Borrower, for itself, its successors and assigns, hereby waives diligence, presentment, protest and demand and notice of protest, demand, dishonor and non-payment of this promissory note.

 

Unless otherwise defined herein, terms defined in the Agreement are used herein with their defined meanings therein.

 

Exhibit B to Term Loan Credit Facility

(Susser Petroleum Partners LP)

 

1



 

THIS NOTE SHALL BE GOVERNED BY AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK.

 

 

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP, AS BORROWER

 

 

 

 

BY:

SUSSER PARTNERS GP LLC,

 

 

ITS GENERAL PARTNER

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

 

1



 

SCHEDULE I

 

CERTAIN BORROWER INFORMATION

 

Jurisdiction of Organization:

 

 

 

Type of Organization:

 

 

 

Organizational Identification Number:

 

 

 

Location of Chief Executive Office or Sole Place of Business:

 

 

Schedule I to Term Loan Credit Facility

(Susser Petroleum Partners LP)

 

1




Exhibit 10.6

 

FORM OF FUEL DISTRIBUTION AGREEMENT

 

This Fuel Distribution Agreement (the “ Agreement ”) made and entered into between Susser Petroleum Operating Company LLC , with a business address of 555 East Airtex Drive, Houston, Texas 77073 (the “ Seller ”), and Susser Holdings Corporation , Stripes LLC and Susser Petroluem Company LLC, each with a business address of 4525 Ayers, Corpus Christi, Texas 78415 (collectively, with all of their respective divisions, subsidiaries or affiliates, other than the Partnership as defined below, the “ Purchaser ” or “ SHC ”).  The above-named entities are sometimes referred to in this Agreement each as a “ Party ” and collectively as the “ Parties .”

 

Seller is a subsidiary of Susser Petroleum Partners LP (the “ Partnership ”).  The Partnership, Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC, the general partner of the Partnership (the “ General Partner ”), and SHC have entered into an Omnibus Agreement of even date herewith (the “ Omnibus Agreement ”)  in which the Partnership and SHC agree to enter into the SHC Distribution Contract for the exclusive right and obligation of the Partnership to distribute motor fuels sold by SHC.  This Agreement shall serve as the SHC Distribution Contract under which Seller shall perform the obligations of the Partnership.

 

Unless otherwise defined herein, all capitalized terms shall have the meanings ascribed to them in the Omnibus Agreement.

 

WITNESSETH:

 

In consideration of the mutual promises herein contained, Seller shall sell and deliver to Purchaser its requirements for all branded and unbranded motor fuels  (i) required by Purchaser for resale at all SHC Stores and SHC Consignment Contract sites (all SHC Stores and SHC Consignment Contract sites referred to hereinafter collectively as  the “ SHC Sites ”) or (ii) otherwise required by Purchaser (the “ Other SHC Volumes ”), subject to the permitted exceptions set forth in Section 2.1(c) of the Omnibus Agreement. Purchaser shall purchase, receive and pay for such motor fuels, including branded product(s) under designated trademarks, service marks, trade names, brand names, or other brand identifications (the “ Proprietary Marks ”) and other unbranded products, of the kind and in the quantities and under the terms and conditions specifically set forth in Commodity Schedule(s) annexed hereto and made a part hereof.  Seller’s suppliers of branded products under each such supplier’s Proprietary Marks, unbranded products and their successor(s) and assigns are each referred to hereinafter as the “ Supplier ” and collectively as “ Suppliers ”.

 

1.                                        Term .  This Agreement shall commence on the Effective Date (defined below), and shall remain in effect until terminated, as set forth in Section 23 below (the “ Term ”).

 

2.                                        Locations .  All SHC Sites that purchase motor fuels for resale are subject to this Agreement until the applicable termination date for such SHC Site set forth in Section 25 of this Agreement or such SHC Site is removed from this Agreement in accordance with Section 3 of this Agreement.

 

3.                                        Permitted Removal of Locations .

 

(a)                                   Purchaser may only remove SHC Stores or SHC Consignment Contracts from this Agreement in the event (i) that SHC makes a Permitted Sale, Closure or Conversion of an SHC Store or (ii) an SHC Consignment Contract terminates and is not renewed.  For purposes of this Agreement, a “ Permitted Sale, Closure or Conversion ” shall include any sale or closure of SHC Store or conversion of any SHC Store from sales by Purchaser to a contract with any third party to sell motor fuel on a consignment basis (where the third party, as consignor, holds title to the motor fuel until it is sold to the retail customers) where (A) such SHC Store was supplied at the Partnership’s Cost per Gallon plus the Alternate Fuel Sales Rate (“ AFSR Stores ”), (B) SHC has agreed to substitute one or more locations [comprising equivalent volumes  at the same price per gallon removed SHC Site within [•] months of closure, sale or conversion], (C) SHC has received consent of Partnership for sale, closure or conversion or (D) such sale, closure or conversion does not cause the aggregate number of SHC Sites closed, sold or converted in any fiscal year to exceed 20 SHC Sites.

 

(b)                                  In order to add or remove any SHC Store or SHC Consignment Contract to or from this Agreement pursuant to Section 3(a), Purchaser shall provide at least sixty (60) days’ advance written or electronic

 

1



 

notice to Seller indicating site location, address, estimated volume by product, brand and effective date of such change (“ Supply Change Request ”).  If such Supply Change Request involves a brand request for a Supplier’s trademarks, Seller shall use commercially reasonable efforts to obtain authorization from the applicable Supplier for such brand.  If brand authorization is not obtained, unbranded product will be supplied.

 

4.                                        Products .  The Commodity Schedule forming a part of this Agreement is affixed at or before the signing hereof. This Agreement may be amended from time to time by adding additional schedules or deleting or substituting revised schedules.  Such schedules executed by an authorized representative of Seller and by Purchaser shall be become a part of this Agreement.

 

5.                                        Quantity .  Seller shall sell and deliver to Purchaser and Purchaser shall purchase and receive from Seller Purchaser’s requirements of the product(s) covered by this Agreement as Purchaser may require from time to time until the applicable termination date with respect to any such volumes set forth in Section 25 of this Agreement.  However, if during any period of this Agreement, the amount of any motor fuel volumes that Seller is required to deliver to Purchaser is prescribed by government rules, regulations or orders, or if for any reason the Seller’s supplies of motor fuel are inadequate to meet the needs of Purchaser and its other customers, the Seller, in its sole discretion, may allocate motor fuel to Purchaser and its other customers and any shortfall in volumes requested by Purchaser shall not be deemed to be a breach of this Agreement.   In the event that the Seller is unable to distribute all motor fuel volumes that Purchaser desires to purchase from the Seller, Purchaser may purchase from third parties its requirements of any motor fuel volumes in excess of the amounts of such motor fuel supplied by the Seller.

 

6.                                        Price/Method of Payment .  (a) The price of the product(s) covered by this Agreement shall be as stated in the applicable Commodity Schedule(s).  Purchaser shall initially pay within seven (7) days of delivery, which may be shortened [or lengthened] as necessary to be concurrent with Seller’s applicable payment due date to Supplier, by way of Electronic Funds Transfer (“ EFT ”), or such other means approved by Seller, for all goods delivered to Purchaser hereunder.

 

(b)                                  Purchaser will establish a commercial account with a financial institution that provides EFT services and will authorize Seller to initiate transfers of funds between Purchaser’s account and Seller’s accounts for payment of all amounts due to Seller under this Agreement.  Should any EFT transaction be rejected by Purchaser’s financial institution for any reason, Seller may, at its sole discretion, require subsequent payments be made in cash or by other means satisfactory to Seller.

 

(c)                                   If at any time the financial responsibility of Purchaser shall become impaired or unsatisfactory to Seller, or should Purchaser be in arrears in his accounts with Seller, Seller may require, as a condition of making further deliveries under this Agreement, payment by Purchaser of all past due accounts and cash payment prior to, or upon, all such future deliveries or may require Purchaser to provide to Seller adequate assurance of its performance.

 

(d)                                  Payments not received on the applicable due date will bear interest at a rate of 10% per annum.

 

7.                                        Control .  Purchaser is an independent business with the exclusive right to direct and control the business operation at the SHC Sites, including the establishment of the prices at which products are sold.

 

8.                                        Liability .  Neither Seller nor Supplier shall be liable to Purchaser or to any other person for any damage to or loss of property, or for injury to or death of persons, or for the violation by Purchaser or any other person, of any governmental statute, law, regulation, rule, or ordinance, arising from the operation or activities of Purchaser or any other person pursuant to this Agreement.  Purchaser shall indemnify, protect, defend, and save Seller and Supplier harmless from and against any and all losses, claims, liabilities, environmental cleanup costs, fines, penalties, suits and actions, judgments and costs, including attorneys’ fees and the costs of litigation, which shall arise from or grow out of any injury to or death of persons, or damage to or loss of property, or violation by Purchaser or any other person, of any governmental statute, law, regulation, rule, or ordinance, directly or indirectly resulting from, or in any way connected with (i) Purchaser’s performance of this Agreement, (ii) operation of Purchaser, or activities of any other person, at the SHC Sites, or (iii) the condition of the SHC Sites or of the adjoining streets, sidewalks or ways, irrespective of whether such injury, death, damage or loss is sustained by Purchaser or any other person, firm or corporation which may seek to hold Seller liable.  The existence or non-existence of any insurance that may be required under this Agreement will not limit Purchaser’s indemnity or other obligations under this Agreement.  This indemnity shall survive the termination or nonrenewal of this Agreement.

 



 

9.                                        Credit Cards .  (a) As long as Supplier accepts specified credit cards, fleet cards, debit cards, or other similar transaction authorization cards (the “ Transaction Cards ”), Purchaser shall accept and honor all Transaction Cards identified in Supplier’s Transaction Card manuals or other guidelines (“ Card Guide ”) or agreements, whether in written or electronic form, for the purchase of authorized products and services at all locations branded with Supplier’s Brand.

 

(b)                                  For each transaction not authorized, disputed by a customer, or otherwise subject to charge back under the Card Guide, Seller may either charge the amount to Purchaser’s account or require Purchaser to make immediate refund to Seller, including refund by draft or EFT initiated by Seller, without any deduction for any processing fee.

 

(c)                                   Purchaser acknowledges receipt of a copy of the Card Guide and shall comply fully with the operating rules, terms and conditions thereof.  Without limiting any rights or remedies available to Seller, if Purchaser fails to comply with this paragraph 8, Seller or Supplier may limit or terminate Purchaser’s right to participate in Supplier’s Transaction Card program or Purchaser’s right to use Supplier’s Proprietary Marks.

 

(d)                                  Purchaser understands and acknowledges that the Payment Card Industry Data Security Standard as amended from time to time (the “ PCI DSS ”) contains clearly defined standards setting forth the duties of merchants, like the Purchaser, to secure sensitive cardholder data.  Purchaser is and shall remain informed of the PCI DSS as the PCI DSS pertains to the Purchaser’s business at the SHC Sites.  In addition to the requirements of the Card Guide, Purchaser shall at all times during the term of this Agreement, and at its sole expense, (i) comply with the PCI DSS; (ii) cause all point-of-sale (“ POS ”) and other related network hardware and software at the SHC Sites to be, and remain, PCI DSS certified and compliant; (iii) regularly monitor, test, and/or assess the POS and related hardware and software at the SHC Sites pursuant to the PCI DSS; and (iv) permit Seller and/or Supplier and/or Transaction Card representative to inspect and/or test the POS and other related network hardware and software at the SHC Sites.

 

(e)                                   Purchaser shall indemnify, defend and hold Seller harmless for any and all losses, fines, penalties, damages, costs or expenses including without limitation attorney’s fees, arising out of the Purchaser’s breach or violation of, or failure to comply with, the PCI DSS or the Card Guide.  The indemnity provision contained in this subparagraph (e) to this paragraph 8 shall survive termination of this Agreement.

 

10.                                  Delivery/Title/Risk of Loss .  Delivery, passage of title and risk of loss of the product(s) covered by this Agreement shall be as set forth in the attached Commodity Schedule(s).

 

11.                                  Taxes .  It is agreed that any duty, tax, fee or other charge Seller may be required to collect or pay under any law now in effect or hereafter enacted with respect to the production, manufacture, inspection, transportation, storage, sale, delivery or use of the product(s) covered by this Agreement shall be added to the prices to be paid by Purchaser for product(s) purchased hereunder.  If Purchaser claims exemption from any of the aforesaid taxes, then Purchaser shall furnish Seller with a properly completed and executed exemption certificate in the form prescribed by the appropriate taxing authority in lieu of payment to such taxes or reimbursement of such taxes to Seller.

 

12.                                  Failure To Perform .  (a) Any delays in or failure of performance of either party hereto shall not constitute default hereunder or give rise to any claims for damages if and to the extent that such delay or failure is caused by occurrences beyond the reasonable control of the affected party which, by the exercise of reasonable diligence, said party is unable to prevent or provide against, including, but not limited to, acts of God or the public enemy; expropriation or confiscation of facilities; compliance with any order or request of any governmental authority; acts of war, rebellion, terror, or sabotage or damage resulting therefrom; embargoes or other import or export restrictions; fires, floods, storms, explosions, accidents, or breakdowns; riots; strikes or other concerted acts of workers, whether direct or indirect; or any other causes whether or not of the same class or kind as those specifically above named .  A party whose performance is affected by any of the causes set forth in the preceding sentence shall give prompt written notice thereof to the other party.

 

(b)                                  Seller shall be under no obligation to make deliveries hereunder at any time when in Seller’s sole judgment it has reason to believe that such delivery would likely cause strikes to be called against it or cause its properties to be picketed.

 



 

(c)                                   Seller shall not be required to make up deliveries omitted on account of any of the causes set forth in subparagraph (a) above.

 

(d)                                  Nothing in this paragraph shall excuse Purchaser from making payment when due for deliveries made under the Agreement.

 

13.                                  Determination of Quantity and Quality .  The quantity and quality of product(s) sold hereunder shall be for all purposes conclusively deemed to be the quantity and quality set forth in Seller’s document of delivery unless, within seventy-two (72) hours of the time of delivery, Purchaser delivers to Seller written notice of any claimed shortage in quantity or claimed deviation in quality, or where discovery of any such shortage or deviation could not reasonably have been discovered by careful inspection at the time of delivery, within three (3) days after discovery.  Purchaser’s written notice, or the absence thereof, shall be conclusive with respect to the fact of and the time and date of notice under this paragraph.  Time is of the essence in complying with this provision.

 

14.                                  Trademarks .  (a) Subject to the approval of  the applicable Suppliers, Seller grants to Purchaser the non-exclusive right to use such Supplier’s Proprietary Marks, if applicable, at the SHC Sites in connection with the advertising, marketing, and resale of the branded petroleum products purchased from Seller under this Agreement.  Purchaser agrees that with respect to any SHC Site where it sells branded product, petroleum products of other Suppliers or unbranded products will not be sold by Purchaser under the applicable Supplier’s Proprietary Marks.  Purchaser understands, acknowledges, and agrees that the applicable Suppliers may promulgate from time to time standards, policies, guidelines, procedures, marketing programs and other requirements (“ Image and Operations Guidelines ”) regarding image, signage, appearance, station operations, and other matters related to the sale of motor fuels under the Proprietary Marks of such Suppliers.  Purchaser shall, at its own expense, comply fully with the Image and Operations Guidelines of the applicable Suppliers and cause its employees to do the same.

 

(b)                                  Subject to Purchaser’s approval, Seller shall have the right to substitute the Proprietary Marks of another Supplier or any new supplier for any existing Supplier for any SHC Site (each such substitute, a “ Substituted Supplier ”).  In the event of such substitution, all references to the Supplier in this Agreement shall be deemed to refer to the Substituted Supplier and all references to the Proprietary Marks shall be deemed to refer to the trademarks, brand names, and/or other brand identifications of said Substituted Supplier.

 

(c)                                   Upon sixty (60) days’ advance written or electronic notice to Seller, Purchaser may request a change of brand at any SHC Site by submitting a Supply Change Request as noted in Paragraph 2 above.  Seller shall use commercially reasonable efforts to obtain authorization from the requested Supplier for such brand change.  If brand authorization is not obtained, Seller shall either  (i) continue supplying the existing brand, or (ii) supply unbranded product, subject to Purchaser reimbursing Seller for any costs incurred by Seller as the result of  any such rebranding (or attempted rebranding).

 

(d)                                  Upon termination, nonrenewal, or expiration of this Agreement or prior thereto upon demand by Seller or Supplier, Purchaser’s right to use the Proprietary Marks will terminate, and Purchaser shall discontinue the posting, mounting, display or other use of the applicable Suppliers’ Proprietary Marks.  In the event that Purchaser fails to do so to the satisfaction of Seller or Supplier, subject to applicable law, Seller and Supplier (i) shall have the right to cause any and all signage, placards, and other displays bearing the Proprietary Marks to be removed from the SHC Sites; and (ii) shall have the right to use any means necessary to remove, cover or obliterate the Proprietary Marks, including entry to the SHC Sites to do so.  In the event the Seller or Supplier take any such action hereunder, Purchaser shall bear all costs and expenses thereof, including without limitation the costs of removing, obliterating, or covering the Proprietary Marks and attorney fees and other legal costs and expenses.  Under no circumstances will Purchaser display signage bearing the Proprietary Marks of the applicable Supplier at any SHC Site without the prior written approval of Seller.

 

(e)                                   Purchaser acknowledges and understands that it is not an owner or a licensee of the Proprietary Marks.  Purchaser shall not mix, commingle, blend, adulterate, or otherwise change the composition of any of the product(s) purchased hereunder and resold by Purchaser at a particular SHC Site under said Proprietary Marks of the Supplier of such SHC Site with other products or substances in any manner.

 

(f)                                     Seller and the applicable Suppliers are hereby given the right to enter the SHC Sites to examine at any time, and from time to time, the contents of Purchaser’s tanks or containers in which said product(s) purchased

 



 

hereunder are stored and to take samples therefrom, and if in the opinion of Seller or Supplier any samples thus taken are not said product(s) and in the condition in which delivered by Seller to Purchaser then Seller may at its option terminate this Agreement.

 

(g)                                  Purchaser shall take no action, or otherwise do anything, or fail to do anything that will diminish, reduce, injure, dilute, or otherwise damage the value of the Proprietary Marks or trademarks or other identifications of Supplier.

 

15.                                  Inspection of Records; Audit .  Seller and Supplier have a right to inspect Purchaser’s operation of the businesses at the SHC Sites and to verify that Purchaser is complying with (a) all its contractual obligations contained in this Agreement; and (b) all federal, state and local laws and regulations pertaining to the environmental protection and trademark use.  Purchaser shall permit Seller and Supplier to enter the SHC Sites unimpeded to review and audit all station records including, but not limited to, all records of deliveries, sales and inventory reconciliation, to take samples of motor fuels stored at the SHC Sites, and to inspect equipment.  Seller and Supplier may, at any reasonable time and without prior notice, conduct a walk through and visual inspection of the SHC Sites.

 

16.                                  Customer Service and Complaints .  While using the Proprietary Marks, Purchaser shall render appropriate, prompt, efficient, courteous service at the SHC Stores to Purchaser’s customers for such product(s) and respond expeditiously to all complaints of such customers, making fair adjustment when appropriate.

 

17.                                  Quality, Specification or Name of Product .  From time to time, Seller’s Suppliers may change the quality, grade, specifications, or availability of products covered by this Agreement and in such event Seller may change or alter the quality, grade or specifications.  Seller may, in its discretion, upon giving notice to Purchaser, either change or alter (a) the quality, grade, or specifications of any product(s) covered by this Agreement or (b) the availability of any such product(s).  Any such change or discontinuation shall not affect the purchase requirements set forth in the Commodity Schedule(s) attached hereto.  Seller shall give Purchaser written notice of discontinuance of the manufacture of any product(s) covered by this Agreement.  The Agreement shall terminate as to such discontinued product(s) when such notice is effective.

 

18.                                  Assignment .  Neither party shall transfer or assign its interest in this Agreement, in whole or in part, directly or indirectly, without the prior written consent of the other party.

 

19.                                  Waiver .  A Party may not waive the provisions of this Agreement except by a written instrument executed by that Party.  No failure or delay in exercising any right, power or privilege or requiring the satisfaction of any condition hereunder, and no course of dealing between the Parties operates as a waiver or estoppel of any right, remedy or condition.  No single or partial exercise of any right or remedy under this Agreement precludes any simultaneous or subsequent exercise of any other right, power or privilege.  The rights and remedies set forth in this Agreement are not exclusive of, but are cumulative to, any rights or remedies now or subsequently existing at law, in equity or by statute.  No waiver by either party of any breach of any of the covenants or conditions herein contained to be performed by the other party shall be construed as a waiver of any succeeding breach of the same or any other covenant or condition.  No assignment or transfer shall affect the continuing primary liability of Purchaser (which liability, following assignment or transfer shall be joint and several with the assignee).  No consent to any of the foregoing shall operate as a waiver in any subsequent instance.

 

20.                                  Environmental Compliance .  (a) Purchaser is and shall remain informed about and comply with all local, state and federal laws, statutes, regulations and ordinances related to environmental protection or compliance relevant to Purchaser’s operations at the SHC Sites, whether currently in effect or which may come into effect in the future, including, where applicable, obligations imposed on the “owner” and “operator” of an underground storage tank system (“ UST ”).  Purchaser acknowledges that it is aware of hazards or risks in handling or using motor fuel products.  Purchaser shall maintain compliance with all safety and health related governmental requirements concerning each product and shall take such steps as are reasonable and practicable to inform its employees, agents, contractors and customers of any hazards or risks associated with such product.

 

(b)                                  Purchaser shall comply with all applicable local, state and federal UST compliance requirements, whether currently in effect or which may come into effect in the future, including, but not limited to: (i) required

 



 

inspections of any release detection equipment for USTs and product lines; (ii) required inspections of any automatic tank gauging equipment; and (iii) maintenance and required inspections of any vapor recovery equipment.

 

(c)                                   Purchaser shall make accurate daily physical measurement of all products stored in USTs and perform accurate daily and monthly reconciliation of such measurements with metered sales and product deliveries in accordance with Seller, state, local and federal requirements.  Purchaser shall develop and maintain accurate written records of the daily physical product measurements and daily and monthly reconciliation.  Purchaser shall immediately notify Seller and any appropriate local, state or federal governmental agency after discovery of any inventory loss or other condition which may be the result of a leaking UST or other equipment failure.  Purchaser shall immediately investigate and undertake all appropriate initial abatement and other emergency measures to contain, treat, mitigate and/or remediate a discharge, spill, or release of motor fuels or other petroleum products at the SHC Sites.  Purchaser and Seller shall cooperate at all times during any such investigation or remedial activity.

 

(d)                                  Purchaser is and shall remain informed about and comply with all applicable local, state and federal requirements related to the generation, handling, transportation, treatment, storage and/or disposal of solid or hazardous wastes.  Purchaser also shall implement appropriate recycling, waste management and waste minimization practices and procedures as necessary to remain in compliance with all applicable local, state and federal environmental protection and compliance requirements.

 

(e)                                   Purchaser agrees that representatives of Seller shall be permitted to enter upon the SHC Sites from time to time to perform physical measurements and reconciliation of product stored in USTs and to inspect and/or test any equipment and records used for complying with any local, state, or federal environmental protection or environmental compliance requirements, including, but not limited to, Purchaser’s reconciliation and inspection records.  However, Seller is not obligated to make any such inspections or tests.

 

(f)                                     Purchaser shall properly maintain all USTs, hoses, connections, and associated equipment at the SHC Sites.  Seller may, without liability to Purchaser, refuse to make delivery of products covered under this Agreement if Seller believes any UST, hose, connection, or associated equipment is not safely maintained or in compliance with applicable safety standards.  Purchaser shall not use the UST at the SHC Sites including, without limitation, the associated product lines, hoses, and motor fuel dispensing equipment, during the life of this Agreement for any purpose other than the storage, handling, marketing, and distribution of the Seller’s petroleum products.

 

(g)                                  Purchaser shall indemnify, defend, protect and hold Seller, its employees, officers, directors, managers, partners, equityholders, agents and affiliates harmless from and against any and all liabilities, losses, obligations, claims, damages (consequential or otherwise), penalties, suits, actions, judgments, costs and expenses (including attorneys’ fees) of whatever nature for personal injury (including death) of persons (including, without limitation, agents and employees of Seller or Purchaser) or property damage (including, without limitation, damage to the property of Seller or Purchaser), which may be imposed on, incurred by or asserted against Seller directly or indirectly, (i) caused in whole or in part by Purchaser’s failure to comply with the terms of this paragraph 19 or with any local, state or federal law, statute, regulation or ordinance, whether currently in effect or which may come into effect, related to environmental protection or environmental compliance, including those relating to USTs, or (ii) for any releases or discharges of petroleum products into the environment caused, in whole or in part, by the acts or omissions of Purchaser, its employees, agents, contractors, customers, licensees, or invitees.  This indemnity in no way limits, and is intended to be within the scope of, the general indemnity set forth in paragraph 7 hereof.  The terms and provisions of this paragraph 19 shall survive the expiration, nonrenewal, or termination of this Agreement.

 

21.                                  Notices .  All written notices required or permitted to be given by this Agreement may be sent by facsimile or mutually acceptable electronic means, a nationally recognized overnight courier service, first class mail or hand delivered and shall be deemed to be duly given if delivered personally or sent by certified or overnight mail to the address set forth above or to such other address as may be furnished by either party to the other in writing in accordance with the provisions of this paragraph.  The date of mailing shall be deemed the date of giving such notice, except for notice of change of address, which must be received to be effective.

 

22.                                  Equipment .  [Purchaser shall provide all necessary buildings, improvements, equipment, tools, and like appliances, except for material containing the Proprietary Marks of Suppliers, including sign faces, which shall be retained by Seller (“ Seller Retained Equipment ”).  Title to all Seller Retained Equipment shall at all times remain

 



 

with Seller.  Should any Seller Retained Equipment be levied upon, Purchaser shall immediately notify both the levying creditor, disclaiming ownership, and Seller.  Purchaser shall not encumber or remove Seller Retained Equipment or cause to be done anything thereto that damages or otherwise disturbs Seller’s title to Seller Retained Equipment.  Purchaser shall pay the cost of repair or replacement of any damage to Seller Retained Equipment.]

 

23.                                  Termination .

 

(a)                                   This Agreement shall terminate with respect to all volumes sold to SHC Stores and SHC Consignment Contract sites in operation by Purchaser as of the Effective Date of this Agreement (“ Closing Date SHC Sites ”) on a date that is ten (10) years from the Effective Date, unless an extension with respect to such volumes is mutually agreed upon in writing by the Parties.

 

(b)                                  This Agreement shall terminate with respect to all volumes sold to any Option Stores purchased by the Partnership on a date that is ten (10) years from the Option Closing Date for such Option Store, unless an extension with respect to such volumes is mutually agreed upon in writing by the Parties.

 

(c)                                   This Agreement shall terminate with respect to all volumes sold to all SHC Sites not identified in Section 22(a) or (b) and Other SHC Volumes on a date that is ten (10) years from the Effective Date, unless another termination date is mutually agreed upon in writing by the Parties in connection with any arrangement agreed to pursuant to Section 2.1(b)(i) of the Omnibus Agreement or an extension with respect to any such volumes is otherwise mutually agreed upon in writing by the Parties.

 

(d)                                  This Agreement shall terminate as specifically set forth in any section of this Agreement.  Seller may suspend deliveries or terminate this Agreement if: (i) Purchaser becomes insolvent or commits an act of bankruptcy or takes advantage of any law for the benefit of debtors or Purchaser’s creditors, or if a receiver is appointed for Purchaser; (ii) Purchaser breaches any provision of this Agreement, including without limitation failure to pay in a timely manner any sums due, failure to comply with other section(s) of this Agreement or any portion thereof, or upon assignment of the Agreement by Purchaser contrary to the Assignment section, or (iii) Purchaser is a corporation or other entity and loses its charter or is otherwise prevented from doing business in accordance with applicable law.

 

(e)                                   With one hundred eighty (180) days’ advance written notice, Purchaser may terminate this Agreement if Seller fails to cure a material breach within thirty (30) days of being notified in writing by Purchaser of such breach.

 

(f)                                     Upon Supplier’s revocation of Seller’s right to use or grant the use of its Proprietary Marks, Seller may, upon sixty (60) days’ prior notice, either terminate such affected SHC Sites from this Agreement, substitute another Supplier’s Proprietary Marks at Purchaser’s expense at such affected SHC Sites or supply unbranded products at such affected SHC Sites.  Seller will not be liable for the consequences of such loss.

 

(g)                                  Purchaser agrees not to engage in or permit any illegal or improper act or conduct, on or about the SHC Sites, which act or conduct is detrimental to Seller or any member of the public.  Subject to any other requirements of law, at the option of Seller, Seller may  cease deliveries to the applicable SHC Sites until the illegal acts or conduct have been remedied to the satisfaction of Seller and the applicable Suppliers or terminate this Agreement with respect to the applicable SHC Sites without further notice, (i) upon the failure of Purchaser to desist from any such further acts or conduct after notice from Seller to do so, or (ii) upon Purchaser’s failure to pay any amount when and as due within forty-eight (48) hours of notice of such, and no forbearance, course of dealing, or prior payment shall affect these rights of termination.

 

(h)                                  Upon termination hereof or of Seller’s right to use or grant the use of Supplier’s Proprietary Marks, Seller or Supplier shall have the right, at its option, to enter upon the SHC Sites and to debrand, remove, paint out, or obliterate any signs, symbols or colors on said SHC Sites as to any of Supplier’s trademarks or on the buildings or equipment thereof which in Seller’s opinion would lead a patron to believe that such Supplier’s products are being offered for sale at the SHC Sites.

 

(i)                                      Termination hereof by either party for any reason shall not relieve any party of any obligation theretofore accrued under this Agreement.

 



 

24.                                  Purchaser’s Insurance Requirements .  Purchaser shall obtain insurance of the type and coverage amounts that Seller may reasonably require from time to time consistent with past practices of Purchaser.  All such insurance will name Seller and Suppliers designated by Seller as additional insureds and will be primary as to any other existing, valid and collectible insurance.  If Seller so requires, Purchaser shall furnish Seller with certificates of such insurance that provide that coverage will not be canceled or materially changed prior to thirty (30) days’ advance written notice to Seller.  The insurance required hereunder in no way limits or restricts Purchaser’s obligations under the law or this Agreement as to indemnification of Seller.

 

25.                                  Nature of Agreement/No Third Party Beneficiary .  (a) In consideration of the granting and execution of this Agreement, it is agreed that there shall be no contractual obligation to extend or renew the period or terms of this Agreement in any way, and the parties agree that this Agreement shall not be considered or deemed to be any form of “joint venture” or “partnership” at the SHC Sites of Purchaser or elsewhere.  This Agreement shall bind the executors, administrators, personal representatives, assigns, and successors of the respective parties.

 

(b)                                  This Agreement is personal to the Purchaser and is intended for the sole use and benefit of Seller and Purchaser.  Nothing contained herein shall be deemed, interpreted, or construed to create, or express any intent to create, third party beneficiary rights in favor of any person or entity, except for any indemnified party (or other person entitled to be indemnified pursuant to this Agreement), and Seller and Purchaser specifically state and agree that no such intent exists.

 

26.                                  Compliance with Laws .  Without limitation of paragraph 20 above, Purchaser shall comply with all laws, statutes, regulations, ordinances, and rules of all applicable governmental authorities with respect to the operation of its business at the SHC Sites.  It is the intention of neither party to violate statutory nor common law and if any section, sentence, paragraph, clause or combination of same is in violation of any law, such sentence, paragraph, clause or combination of same shall be inoperative and the remainder of this Agreement shall remain binding upon the parties hereto.

 

27.                                  Express Warranties .  Seller warrants that the product(s) supplied hereunder will conform to the promises and affirmations of fact made in Seller’s current technical literature and printed advertisements, if any, related specifically to such product(s); that it will convey good title to the product(s) supplied hereunder, free of all liens, and that the product(s) supplied hereunder meet such specifications as have been expressly made a part of this Agreement.  THE FOREGOING WARRANTIES ARE EXCLUSIVE AND ARE IN LIEU OF ALL OTHER WARRANTIES, WHETHER WRITTEN, ORAL OR IMPLIED.  THE WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY, IN OTHER RESPECTS THAN EXPRESSLY SET FORTH HEREIN, AND WARRANTY OF FITNESS FOR PARTICULAR PURPOSE, IN OTHER RESPECTS THAN EXPRESSLY SET FORTH HEREIN, ARE EXPRESSLY EXCLUDED AND DISCLAIMED.

 

28.                                  Non-Exclusive Territory .  Nothing in this Agreement grants Purchaser an exclusive territory to market and resell any petroleum products.  Seller reserves the right to market and sell, and authorize others to market and sell, petroleum products in any manner Seller chooses, including through its own retail outlets or through designated wholesalers or other retailers.

 

29.                                  Entire Agreement .  This Agreement[, together with the Omnibus Agreement,] cancels and supersedes all prior written and unwritten agreements, promises, and understandings between the parties pertaining to the matters covered under this Agreement, except any indebtedness owed to Seller by Purchaser, and is a final, complete and exclusive statement of the agreement between Seller and Purchaser.  This Agreement may be modified only by a writing signed by both of the parties or their duly authorized agent.  THERE ARE NO ORAL UNDERSTANDINGS, REPRESENTATIONS OR WARRANTIES AFFECTING IT.  EXECUTION OF THIS CONTRACT BY PURCHASER IS AN ACKNOWLEDGEMENT THAT NO REPRESENTATIONS NOT SET FORTH IN WRITING HEREIN HAVE BEEN MADE OR RELIED UPON BY PURCHASER.

 

30.                                  Damages.  NO CLAIM SHALL BE MADE UNDER THIS CONTRACT FOR SPECIAL, PUNITIVE, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES.

 

31.                                  Commencement .  Neither this Agreement nor any modification thereof shall be binding on Seller until and unless signed by an authorized representative of Seller.  Commencement of performance hereunder prior to signing as above stipulated in no case shall be construed as a waiver by Seller of this requirement.

 



 

32.                                  Accord .  The parties have discussed the provisions of this Agreement and find them fair and mutually satisfactory and further agree that in all respects the provisions are reasonable and of material significance to the relationship of the parties hereunder.

 

33.                                  Joint and Several Obligations .  All acknowledgments, representations, warranties, debts, and obligations of performance of Purchaser under this Agreement are made, and binding on all those signing this Agreement, jointly and severally as the Purchaser.

 

34.                                  Successors and Assigns .  This Agreement binds and benefits Purchaser and Seller and their respective permitted successors and assigns.

 

35.                                  Severability .  If any provision of this Agreement is determined by a court or arbitrator to be invalid, illegal or unenforceable, the remaining provisions of this Agreement shall remain in full force if the essential terms and conditions of this Agreement for each party remain valid, binding and enforceable.  If any provision of this Agreement is so broad as to be unenforceable, such provision shall be interpreted to be only so broad as enforceable.

 

36.                                  Counterparts .  The Parties may execute this Agreement in multiple counterparts, each of which constitutes an original, and all of which constitute only one agreement.  The signatures of all of the parties need not appear on the same counterpart, and delivery of an executed counterpart signature page by facsimile or other electronic transmission is as effective as executing and delivering this Agreement in the presence of the other parties to this Agreement.  This Agreement is effective upon delivery of one executed counterpart from each party to the other party.

 

37.                                  Governing Law .  The laws of the State of Texas (without giving effect to its conflicts of law principles) govern all matters arising out of or relating to this Agreement and all of the transactions it contemplates, including without limitation its validity, interpretation, construction, performance (including the details of performance) and enforcement.

 

38.                                  Survival .  Sections [•].  [•] and [•] shall survive the execution and delivery and termination or expiration of this Agreement.

 

39.                                  Headings .  The descriptive headings of the articles, sections and subsections of this Agreement are for convenience only and do not constitute a part of this Agreement.

 



 

This Agreement shall be effective as of                                           , 201     (the “ Effective Date ”).

 

SELLER:  Susser Petroleum Operating Company LLC

 

By:

 

 

 

 

 

Print Name:

 

 

 

 

 

Title:

 

 

 

PURCHASER:  Susser Holdings Corporation

 

By:

 

 

 

 

 

Print Name:

 

 

 

 

 

Title:

 

 

 

PURCHASER:  Stripes LLC

 

By:

 

 

 

 

 

Print Name:

 

 

 

 

 

Title:

 

 

 

PURCHASER:  Susser Petroleum Company LLC

 

By:

 

 

 

 

 

Print Name:

 

 

 

 

 

Title:

 

 

 



 

COMMODITY SCHEDULE

 

This Commodity Schedule is attached to, and made a part of, a Fuel Distribution Agreement between Purchaser and Seller dated                                   , 2012 (the “Agreement”).  Unless otherwise indicated, the capitalized terms used in this Commodity Schedule shall have the same meaning used in the Agreement.

 

1.                                        Products :  All motor fuel products allowed by law to be sold to the general public including branded (to the extent Seller may obtain such branded product) and unbranded motor fuels and shall include, but not limited to, unleaded gasoline, plus unleaded gasoline, supreme unleaded gasoline, diesel fuel, ethanol, biodiesel, diesel exhaust fluid.  Gasoline products shall include conventional, reformulated and ethanol blended motor fuels.

 

2.                                        Quantity .  All of Purchaser’s requirements for Product, for delivery upon reasonable notice to Seller at the SHC Sites or as otherwise directed in writing by the Purchaser.

 

3.                                        Delivery .  Delivery shall be complete on unloading of the tank wagon or transport truck.

 

4.                                        Title .  Title to product covered under the Agreement shall pass to Purchaser as it is delivered to Purchaser’s tanks or other storage containers.

 

5.                                        Risk of Loss .  Risk of loss of product shall pass to Purchaser as it is delivered to Purchaser’s tanks or other storage containers.

 

6.                                        Inspection .  Purchaser shall have the right, at its expense, to have an inspection made at delivery point, provided such inspection shall not delay shipment.  Should Purchaser fail to make inspection, it shall accept Seller’s inspection and measurement.

 

7.                                        Price .  The Seller’s price per gallon to be paid by Purchaser shall be Seller’s net cost per gallon at the applicable terminal in effect at the time loading commences, plus (i) all applicable taxes and all fees, including State loading and environmental fees, if any, (ii) the cost of transporting the product to Purchaser and (iii) plus Seller’s Margin per gallon as set forth below for each SHC Site.  [Seller’s net cost per gallon shall be determined in the same manner as past practice.] Seller’s cost for motor fuel sold out of its bulk inventories shall be based upon a transfer price consistent with past practice, or as mutually agreed between the parties.  All prices charged by Seller are subject to the provisions of applicable law.

 

Seller’s Margin for volumes purchased pursuant to this Agreement shall be as follows:

 

(i)                                      Seller’s Margin shall be equal to three cents ($.03) per gallon for all volumes sold to Closing Date SHC Sites and Option Stores purchased by the Partnership.

 

(ii)                                   Seller’s Margin shall  be the Alternate Fuel Sales Rate for all volumes sold to all SHC Stores, SHC Consignment Contract sites not identified in Section 22(a) or (b) of this Agreement or Other SHC Volumes, unless a different rate is mutually agreed upon in writing by the Parties with respect to any such volumes.  [For the avoidance of doubt, as provided in the Omnibus Agreement, the Alternate Fuel Sales Rate will not be recalculated or adjusted on an annual basis or otherwise, in respect of an SHC Store, once Seller commences deliveries to such SHC Store pursuant to this Agreement.]

 




Exhibit 10.8

 

FORM OF

 

DIRECTOR INDEMNIFICATION AGREEMENT

 

This Indemnification Agreement (this “ Agreement ”) is made and entered into as of this           day of                       , 2012, by and among Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (the “ General Partner ”); Susser Petroleum Partners LP, a Delaware limited partnership (the “ Partnership ,” and together with the General Partner, the “ Companies ” and each a “ Company ”); and [ DIRECTOR’S NAME ] (“ Indemnitee ”).  Each of the defined terms used in this Agreement shall have the definition set forth in Section 14 of this Agreement.

 

WHEREAS , in light of the litigation costs and risks to directors and officers resulting from their service to companies and the desire of the Companies to attract and retain qualified individuals to serve as directors and officers, it is reasonable, prudent and necessary for the Companies to indemnify and advance expenses on behalf of the directors (including directors that also serve as officers) of the General Partner to the extent permitted by applicable law so that they will serve or continue to serve the Companies free from undue concern regarding such risks;

 

WHEREAS , the Companies have requested that Indemnitee serve or continue to serve as a director (and officer, as applicable) of the General Partner and may have requested or may in the future request that Indemnitee serve one or more Enterprises as a director or in other capacities;

 

WHEREAS, in order to induce Indemnitee to serve, or to continue to serve, as a director of the General Partner, and to agree to serve, from time to time, as any Company may request, in any other Corporate Status, the Companies are executing this Agreement;

 

WHEREAS , Indemnitee is willing to serve as a director of the General Partner or in any other Corporate Status on the condition that Indemnitee be so indemnified;

 

WHEREAS , the indemnification provisions of this Agreement are a supplement to and in furtherance of the Certificate of Limited Partnership of the Partnership, as amended from time to time after the date hereof (the “ Partnership Certificate ”), the First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of the Partnership, as amended from time to time after the date hereof in accordance with the terms thereof (the “ Partnership Agreement ”), the Certificate of Formation of the General Partner, as amended from time to time after the date hereof (the “ General Partner Certificate ”), and the Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement of the General Partner, as amended from time to time after the date hereof in accordance with the terms thereof (the “ General Partner Agreement ” and, together with the Partnership Certificate, the Partnership Agreement and the General Partner Certificate, the “ Company Organizational Documents ”), any organizational documents of any other Enterprise (collectively, the “ Enterprise Organizational Documents ”) and any resolutions adopted by the Board of Directors (pursuant to the General Partner Agreement or the Partnership Agreement) or similar governing body of any other Enterprise, and shall not be deemed to be a substitute therefor nor to diminish or abrogate any rights of Indemnitee thereunder; and

 

1



 

WHEREAS , to the extent Indemnitee is employed by a Sponsor Company, Indemnitee may have certain rights to indemnification, advancement of expenses or insurance provided by the Designating Partners (or their affiliates), which Indemnitee, the Companies and the Designating Partners (or their affiliates) intend to be secondary to the primary obligation of the Enterprise Entities to indemnify Indemnitee as provided herein or as provided in the Company Organizational Documents or other Enterprise Organizational Documents, with the Companies’ acknowledgement of and agreement to the foregoing being a material condition to Indemnitee’s willingness to serve as a director of the General Partner or in any other Corporate Status.

 

NOW, THEREFORE , in consideration of the premises and the covenants contained herein, the Companies and Indemnitee do hereby covenant and agree as follows:

 

1.                                        Services by Indemnitee .  Indemnitee will serve or continue to serve as a director of the General Partner (and an officer, if applicable), for so long as Indemnitee is duly elected or appointed or until Indemnitee tenders Indemnitee’s resignation or is removed in accordance with the General Partner Agreement.  Indemnitee may from time to time also agree to serve, as any Company may request from time to time, in any other Corporate Status.  Indemnitee and each Company each acknowledge that they have entered into this Agreement as a means of inducing Indemnitee to serve, or continue to serve, the Companies and any Enterprise in such capacities.  Indemnitee may at any time and for any reason resign from such position or positions (subject to any other contractual obligation or any obligation imposed by operation of law).

 

2.                                        Indemnification—General .  On the terms and subject to the conditions of this Agreement, the Companies shall, to the fullest extent permitted under applicable law and so long as Indemnitee has not engaged in Disabling Conduct, indemnify Indemnitee with respect to, and hold Indemnitee harmless from and against, all losses, liabilities, judgments, fines, penalties, costs, Expenses and other amounts that Indemnitee reasonably incurs and that result from, arise in connection with or are by reason of Indemnitee’s Corporate Status and shall advance Expenses to Indemnitee.  The obligations of the Companies under this Agreement (a) are joint and several obligations of each Company, (b) shall continue after such time as Indemnitee ceases to serve as a director of the General Partner or in any other Corporate Status and (c) include, without limitation, claims for monetary damages against Indemnitee in respect of any actual or alleged liability or other loss of Indemnitee, to the fullest extent permitted under applicable law as in existence on the date hereof (and to such greater extent as applicable law may hereafter from time to time permit) provided that Indemnitee has not engaged in Disabling Conduct.  The other provisions in this Agreement are provided in addition to and as a means of furtherance and implementation of, and not in limitation of, the obligations expressed in this Section 2.

 

3.                                        Proceedings Other Than Proceedings by or in the Right of the Companies .  If, in connection with or by reason of Indemnitee’s Corporate Status, Indemnitee was, is, or is threatened to be made, a party to or a participant in any Proceeding, other than a Proceeding by or in the right of any of the Companies to procure a judgment in its favor, the Companies shall, to the fullest extent permitted under applicable law and so long as Indemnitee has not engaged in Disabling Conduct, indemnify Indemnitee with respect to, and hold Indemnitee harmless from and against, all Expenses, liabilities, judgments, penalties, fines and amounts paid in settlement (including all interest, assessments and other charges paid or payable in connection with or in respect of such liabilities, judgments, penalties, fines and amounts paid in settlement) reasonably

 

2



 

incurred by Indemnitee or on behalf of Indemnitee in connection with such Proceeding or any claim, issue or matter therein.

 

4.                                        Proceedings by or in the Right of the Companies .  If, by reason of Indemnitee’s Corporate Status, Indemnitee was, is, or is threatened to be made, a party to or a participant in any Proceeding by or in the right of any of the Companies to procure a judgment in its favor, the Companies shall, to the fullest extent permitted under applicable law and so long as Indemnitee has not engaged in Disabling Conduct, indemnify Indemnitee with respect to, and hold Indemnitee harmless from and against, all Expenses reasonably incurred by Indemnitee or on behalf of Indemnitee in connection with such Proceeding; provided , however , that indemnification against such Expenses shall be made in respect of any claim, issue or matter in such Proceeding as to which Indemnitee shall have been adjudged by a court of competent jurisdiction to be liable to the applicable Company only if (and only to the extent that) the court in which such Proceeding shall have been brought or is pending shall determine that, despite such adjudication of liability and in view of all circumstances, Indemnitee is fairly and reasonably entitled to indemnity for such Expenses which the court shall deem proper.

 

5.                                        Mandatory Indemnification in Case of Successful Defense .  Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement, to the extent that Indemnitee is, by reason of Indemnitee’s Corporate Status, a party to (or a participant in) and is successful, on the merits or otherwise, in defense of any Proceeding (including, without limitation, any Proceeding brought by or in the right of any Company), the Companies shall, to the fullest extent permitted under applicable law and so long as Indemnitee has not engaged in Disabling Conduct, indemnify Indemnitee with respect to, and hold Indemnitee harmless from and against, all Expenses reasonably incurred by Indemnitee or on behalf of Indemnitee in connection therewith.  If Indemnitee is not wholly successful in defense of such Proceeding but is successful, on the merits or otherwise, as to one or more but less than all claims, issues or matters in such Proceeding, the Companies shall, to the fullest extent permitted under applicable law and so long as Indemnitee has not engaged in Disabling Conduct, indemnify Indemnitee against all Expenses reasonably incurred by Indemnitee or on behalf of Indemnitee in connection with each successfully resolved claim, issue or matter.  For purposes of this Section 5 and without limitation, the termination of any claim, issue or matter in such a Proceeding by dismissal, with or without prejudice, on substantive or procedural grounds, shall be deemed to be a successful result as to such claim, issue or matter.

 

6.                                        Partial Indemnification .  If Indemnitee is entitled under any provision of this Agreement or otherwise to indemnification by any of the Companies for some or a portion of the Expenses, liabilities, judgments, penalties, fines and amounts paid in settlement (including all interest, assessments and other charges paid or payable in connection with or in respect of such liabilities, judgments, penalties, fines and amounts paid in settlement) incurred by Indemnitee or on behalf of Indemnitee in connection with a Proceeding or any claim, issue or matter therein, in whole or in part, the Companies shall, to the fullest extent permitted under applicable law and so long as Indemnitee has not engaged in Disabling Conduct, indemnify Indemnitee to the fullest extent to which Indemnitee is entitled to such indemnification.

 

3



 

7.                                        Indemnification for Additional Expenses Incurred to Secure Recovery or as Witness .

 

(a)            The Companies shall, to the fullest extent permitted under applicable law and so long as Indemnitee has not engaged in Disabling Conduct, indemnify Indemnitee with respect to, and hold Indemnitee harmless from and against, any and all Expenses and, if requested by Indemnitee, shall advance on an as-incurred basis (as provided in Section 8 of this Agreement) such Expenses to Indemnitee, which are reasonably incurred by Indemnitee in connection with any action or proceeding or part thereof brought by Indemnitee for (i) indemnification or advance payment of Expenses by the Companies under this Agreement, the Company Organizational Documents or other Enterprise Organizational Document, or any other agreement; or (ii) recovery under any director and officer liability insurance policies maintained by any Company or other Enterprise.

 

(b)            To the extent that Indemnitee is, by reason of Indemnitee’s Corporate Status, a witness (or is forced or asked to respond to discovery requests) in any Proceeding to which Indemnitee is not a party, the Companies shall, to the fullest extent permitted under applicable law and so long as Indemnitee has not engaged in Disabling Conduct, indemnify Indemnitee with respect to, and hold Indemnitee harmless from and against, and the Companies will advance on an as-incurred basis (as provided in Section 8 of this Agreement), all Expenses reasonably incurred by Indemnitee or on behalf of Indemnitee in connection therewith.

 

8.                                        Advancement of Expenses .  The Companies shall, to the fullest extent permitted under applicable law, pay on a current and as-incurred basis all Expenses incurred by Indemnitee in connection with any Proceeding in any way connected with, resulting from or relating to Indemnitee’s Corporate Status.  The advancement of such Expenses shall be paid within ten (10) days after receipt by any Company of a properly submitted written request for advancement from Indemnitee pursuant to Section 9(c)(i) of this Agreement, without regard to whether an Adverse Determination has been or may be made, except as contemplated by the last sentence of Section 9(f)  of this Agreement.  Upon submission of a request for advancement of Expenses pursuant to Section 9(c)  of this Agreement, Indemnitee shall be entitled to advancement of Expenses as provided in this Section 8 , and such advancement of Expenses shall continue until such time (if any) as there is a final non-appealable judicial determination that Indemnitee is not entitled to indemnification or that Indemnitee engaged in Disabling Conduct.  Indemnitee shall repay all such amounts advanced if and to the extent that it shall ultimately be determined in a decision by a court of competent jurisdiction from which no appeal can be taken that Indemnitee is not entitled to be indemnified by the Companies for such Expenses or that Indemnitee engaged in Disabling Conduct.  Such repayment obligation shall be unsecured and shall not bear interest.  The Companies shall not impose on Indemnitee additional conditions to advancement or require from Indemnitee additional undertakings regarding repayment, except as set forth in this Agreement.

 

9.                                        Indemnification Procedures .

 

(a)                                   Notice of Proceeding .  Indemnitee agrees to notify the Companies promptly upon being served with any summons, citation, subpoena, complaint, indictment,

 

4



 

information or other document relating to any Proceeding or matter which may be subject to indemnification or advancement of Expenses hereunder.  Any failure by Indemnitee to notify any Company will relieve such Company of its advancement or indemnification obligations under this Agreement only to the extent such Company can establish that such omission to notify resulted in actual prejudice to it, and the omission to notify such Company will, in any event, not relieve any Company from any liability which it may have to indemnify Indemnitee or advance Expenses to Indemnitee otherwise than under this Agreement.  If, at the time of receipt of any such notice, the Companies have director and officer insurance policies in effect, the Companies will promptly notify the relevant insurers in accordance with the procedures and requirements of such policies.

 

(b)                                  Defense; Settlement .

 

(i)             The Companies shall not, without the prior written consent of Indemnitee, which may be provided or withheld in Indemnitee’s sole discretion, effect any settlement of any Proceeding against Indemnitee, or any proceeding which could have been brought against Indemnitee or which potentially or actually imposes any cost, liability, exposure or burden on Indemnitee, unless such settlement solely involves the payment of money or performance of any obligation by Persons other than Indemnitee and includes an unconditional release of Indemnitee from all liability on any matters that are the subject of such Proceeding and an acknowledgment that Indemnitee denies all wrongdoing in connection with such matters.  The Companies shall not be obligated to indemnify Indemnitee for amounts paid in settlement of a Proceeding against Indemnitee if such settlement is effected by Indemnitee without the Companies’ prior written consent, which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld.

 

(ii)            In any Proceeding in connection with which Indemnitee has submitted a Company with a written request for advancement and/or indemnification of Expenses pursuant to Section 9(c)  of this Agreement, such Company shall be entitled to assume the defense of such Proceeding, with counsel approved by Indemnitee, which approval shall not be unreasonably withheld, upon the delivery to Indemnitee of written notice of such Company’s election to do so.  After delivery of such notice, approval of such counsel by Indemnitee, and retention of such counsel by such Company, Indemnitee shall nevertheless be entitled to employ or continue to employ his own counsel in such Proceeding.  Employment of such counsel by Indemnitee shall be at the cost and expense of the Companies unless and until the Companies shall have demonstrated to the reasonable satisfaction of Indemnitee and Indemnitee’s counsel that there is no conflict of interest between the Company and Indemnitee in such Proceeding, after which time, further employment of such counsel by the Indemnitee shall be at the cost and expense of Indemnitee.

 

5



 

(c)                                   Request for Advancement; Request for Indemnification .

 

(i)             To obtain advancement of Expenses under this Agreement, Indemnitee shall submit to the Companies a written request therefor, together with such invoices or other supporting information as may be reasonably requested by the Companies and reasonably available to Indemnitee, and, only to the extent required by applicable law which cannot be waived, an unsecured written undertaking to repay amounts advanced.  The Companies shall make advance payment of Expenses to Indemnitee no later than ten (10) days after receipt of the written request for advancement (and each subsequent request for advancement) by Indemnitee.  If, at the time of receipt of any such written request for advancement of Expenses, the Companies have director and officer insurance policies in effect, the Companies will promptly notify the relevant insurers in accordance with the procedures and requirements of such policies.

 

(ii)            To obtain indemnification under this Agreement, Indemnitee shall submit a written request therefor.  The time at which Indemnitee submits a written request for indemnification shall be determined by the Indemnitee in the Indemnitee’s sole discretion.  Once Indemnitee submits such a written request for indemnification (and only at such time that Indemnitee submits such a written request for indemnification), a Determination shall thereafter be made, as provided in and only to the extent required by Section 9(d)  of this Agreement.  In no event shall a Determination be made, or required to be made, as a condition to or otherwise in connection with any advancement of Expenses pursuant to Section 8 and Section 9(c)(i)  of this Agreement.  If, at the time of receipt of any such request for indemnification, the Companies have director and officer insurance policies in effect, the Companies will promptly notify the relevant insurers in accordance with the procedures and requirements of such policies.

 

(d)                                  Determination .  Any Determination shall be made within thirty (30) days after receipt of Indemnitee’s written request for indemnification pursuant to Section 9(c)(ii) (or in the case of a Determination to be made by Independent Counsel within thirty (30) days of the selection of Independent Counsel) and such Determination shall be made, subject to Section 9(g), in the specific case as follows:

 

(i)             If a Potential Change in Control or a Change in Control shall have occurred, by Independent Counsel (selected in accordance with Section 9(e)) in a written opinion to the Board of Directors, a copy of which opinion shall be delivered to Indemnitee, unless Indemnitee shall request that such Determination be made by the Board of Directors, or a committee of the Board of Directors, in which case the Determination shall be made by the Persons and in the manners provided for in clauses (x) or (y) of Section 9(d)(ii) below; or

 

6



 

(ii)            If a Potential Change in Control or a Change in Control shall not have occurred, (x) by the Board of Directors by a majority vote of the Disinterested Directors even though less than a quorum of the Board of Directors, (y) by a majority vote of a committee consisting solely of one or more Disinterested Directors designated to act in the matter by a majority vote of all Disinterested Directors, even though less than a quorum of the Board of Directors, or (z) if there are no Disinterested Directors or, if such Disinterested Directors so direct, by Independent Counsel in a written opinion to the Board of Directors, a copy of which shall be delivered to Indemnitee, with Independent Counsel being selected by a vote of the Disinterested Directors as set forth in clauses (x) or (y) of this Section 9(d)(ii), or if such vote is not obtainable or such a committee of Disinterested Directors cannot be established, by a majority vote of the Board of Directors.

 

If a Determination is made that Indemnitee is entitled to indemnification, payment to Indemnitee shall be made within ten (10) days after such Determination.  Indemnitee shall reasonably cooperate with the Persons making such Determination, including providing to such Persons upon reasonable advance request any documentation or information which is not privileged or otherwise protected from disclosure and which is reasonably available to Indemnitee and reasonably necessary to the making of such Determination.  Any Expenses incurred by Indemnitee in so cooperating with the Persons making such Determination shall be advanced and borne by the Companies (irrespective of the Determination as to Indemnitee’s entitlement to indemnification), and each Company shall indemnify and hold Indemnitee harmless therefrom.

 

(e)                                   Independent Counsel .  If a Potential Change in Control or a Change in Control shall not have occurred and the Determination is to be made by Independent Counsel, the Independent Counsel shall be selected by (i) a majority vote of the Disinterested Directors, even though less than a quorum of the Board or (ii) if there are no Disinterested Directors, a majority vote of the Board, and the General Partner shall give written notice to Indemnitee, within ten (10) days after receipt by the General Partner of Indemnitee’s request for indemnification, specifying the identity and address of the Independent Counsel so selected.  If a Potential Change in Control or a Change in Control shall have occurred and the Determination is to be made by Independent Counsel, the Independent Counsel shall be selected by Indemnitee, and Indemnitee shall give written notice to the General Partner, within ten (10) days after submission of Indemnitee’s request for indemnification, specifying the identity and address of the Independent Counsel so selected (unless Indemnitee shall request that such selection be made by (i) a majority vote of the Disinterested Directors, even though less than a quorum of the Board, or (ii) if there are no Disinterested Directors, a majority vote of the Board, in which event the General Partner shall give written notice to Indemnitee within ten (10) days after receipt of Indemnitee’s request that such selection be made by a majority vote of the Disinterested Directors or the Board, as applicable, specifying the identity and address of the Independent Counsel so selected).  In

 

7



 

either event, (A) such notice to Indemnitee or the General Partner, as the case may be, shall be accompanied by a written affirmation of the Independent Counsel so selected that it satisfies the requirements of the definition of “Independent Counsel” in Section 14 of this Agreement and that it agrees to serve in such capacity and (B) Indemnitee or the General Partner, as the case may be, may, within seven (7) days after such written notice of selection shall have been given, deliver to the General Partner or to Indemnitee, as the case may be, a written objection to such selection.  Any objection to the selection of Independent Counsel pursuant to this Section 9(e) may be asserted only on the ground that the Independent Counsel so selected does not meet the requirements of the definition of “Independent Counsel” in Section 14 of this Agreement, and the objection shall set forth with particularity the factual basis of such assertion.  If such written objection is timely made, the Independent Counsel so selected may not serve as Independent Counsel unless and until a court of competent jurisdiction (a “Court”) has determined that such objection is without merit.  In the event of a timely written objection to a choice of Independent Counsel, the party originally selecting the Independent Counsel shall have seven (7) days to make an alternate selection of Independent Counsel and to give written notice of such selection to the other party, after which time such other party shall have five (5) days to make a written objection to such alternate selection.  If, within thirty (30) days after submission of Indemnitee’s request for indemnification pursuant to Section 9(c)(ii), no Independent Counsel shall have been selected and not objected to, either the General Partner or Indemnitee may petition the Court for resolution of any objection that shall have been made by the General Partner or Indemnitee to the other’s selection of Independent Counsel or for the appointment as Independent Counsel of a Person selected by the Court or by such other Person as the Court shall designate, and the Person with respect to whom an objection is so resolved or the Person so appointed shall act as Independent Counsel under Section 9(d).  The Companies shall pay any and all fees and expenses reasonably incurred by such Independent Counsel in connection with acting pursuant to Section 9(d), and the Companies shall pay all fees and expenses reasonably incurred incident to the procedures of this Section 9(e), regardless of the manner in which such Independent Counsel was selected or appointed.  Upon the due commencement of any Proceeding or arbitration pursuant to Section 9(f) of this Agreement, Independent Counsel shall be discharged and relieved of any further responsibility in such capacity, pending final disposition of such Proceeding or arbitration and subject to the applicable standards of professional conduct then prevailing.

 

(f)                                     Consequences of Determination; Remedies of Indemnitee .  The Companies shall be bound by and shall have no right to challenge a Favorable Determination.  If an Adverse Determination is made, or if for any other reason the Companies do not make timely indemnification payments or advances of Expenses, Indemnitee shall have the right to commence a Proceeding before a Court to challenge such Adverse Determination or to require the Companies to make such payments or advances (and the Companies shall have the right to defend their position in such Proceeding and to appeal any adverse judgment in such Proceeding).  Indemnitee

 

8



 

shall be entitled to be indemnified for all Expenses incurred in connection with such a Proceeding and to have such Expenses advanced by the Companies in accordance with Section 8 of this Agreement.  If Indemnitee fails to challenge an Adverse Determination, or if Indemnitee challenges an Adverse Determination and such Adverse Determination has been upheld by a final judgment of a Court from which no appeal can be taken, then, to the extent and only to the extent required by such Adverse Determination or final judgment, the Companies shall not be obligated to indemnify Indemnitee under this Agreement.

 

(g)                                  Presumptions; Burden and Standard of Proof .  The parties intend and agree that, to the extent permitted by law, in connection with any Determination by any Person, including a Court:

 

(i)             it will be presumed that Indemnitee is entitled to indemnification under this Agreement, and the Enterprise or any other Person challenging such right will have the burden of proof to overcome that presumption in connection with any Determination contrary to that presumption;

 

(ii)            the termination of any action, suit or proceeding by judgment, order, settlement, conviction, or upon a plea of nolo contendere or its equivalent, shall not, of itself, create a presumption that Indemnitee did not act in good faith and in a manner which Indemnitee reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the best interests of the applicable Enterprise, or, with respect to any criminal action or proceeding, that Indemnitee had reasonable cause to believe that Indemnitee’s conduct was unlawful, or that Indemnitee did not act in accordance with any other applicable standard of conduct imposed by contract, applicable law or otherwise;

 

(iii)           Indemnitee will be deemed to have acted in good faith if it is determined by a majority of the board of directors or other governing body of the applicable Enterprise or by Independent Counsel, as applicable, that Indemnitee’s action is based on the records or books of account of the applicable Enterprise, including financial statements, or on information supplied to Indemnitee by the officers, employees, or committees of the board of directors or other governing body of the applicable Enterprise, or on the advice of legal counsel for the applicable Enterprise or on information or records given in reports made to the applicable Enterprise by an independent certified public accountant or by an appraiser or other expert or advisor selected by the applicable Enterprise; and

 

(iv)           the knowledge and actions, or failure to act, of any director, officer, manager, representative, agent or employee of any Enterprise or other relevant enterprises will not be imputed to Indemnitee in a manner that limits or otherwise adversely affects Indemnitee’s rights hereunder.

 

9



 

The provisions of this Section 9(g)  shall not be deemed to be exclusive or to limit in any way the other circumstances in which Indemnitee may be deemed to have met the applicable standard of conduct set forth in this Agreement.

 

10.                                  Insurance; Subrogation; Other Rights of Recovery, Etc .

 

(a)                                   Each Company shall use its reasonable best efforts to purchase and maintain a policy or policies of insurance with reputable insurance companies with A.M. Best ratings of “A” or better, providing Indemnitee with coverage for any liability asserted against, and incurred by, Indemnitee or on Indemnitee’s behalf by reason of Indemnitee’s Corporate Status, or arising out of Indemnitee’s status as such, whether or not any such Company would have the power to indemnify Indemnitee against such liability.  Such insurance policies shall have coverage terms and policy limits at least as favorable to Indemnitee as the insurance coverage provided to any other current or former officer or director of the General Partner.  If a Company has such insurance in effect at the time it receives from Indemnitee any notice of the commencement of an action, suit, proceeding or other claim, such Company shall give prompt notice of the commencement of such action, suit, proceeding or other claim to the insurers in accordance with the procedures set forth in the policy.  The Companies shall thereafter take all necessary or desirable action to cause such insurers to pay, on behalf of Indemnitee, all amounts payable as a result of such action, suit, proceeding or other claim in accordance with the terms of such policy, provided that the Companies shall not be liable to pay or advance to Indemnitee any amounts otherwise indemnifiable under this Agreement or under any other indemnification agreement if and to the extent that Indemnitee has otherwise actually received such payment under any insurance policy, contract, agreement or otherwise.  The Companies shall continue to provide such insurance coverage to Indemnitee for a period of at least six (6) years after Indemnitee ceases to serve as a director or any other Corporate Status.

 

(b)                                  Subject to Section 10(d) , in the event of any payment by any Company under this Agreement, such Company shall be subrogated to the extent of such payment to all of the rights of recovery of Indemnitee against any other Enterprise, and Indemnitee hereby agrees, as a condition to obtaining any advancement or indemnification from the Companies, to assign to such Company all of Indemnitee’s rights to obtain from such other Enterprise such amounts to the extent that they have been paid by such Company to or for the benefit of Indemnitee as advancement or indemnification under this Agreement and are adequate to indemnify Indemnitee with respect to the costs, Expenses or other items to the full extent that Indemnitee is entitled to indemnification or other payment hereunder; and Indemnitee will (upon request by the Companies) execute all papers required and take all action necessary to secure such rights, including execution of such documents as are necessary to enable such Company to bring suit or enforce such rights.  In addition, if the General Partner, on behalf of itself, pays or causes to be paid (including advancement of Expenses), for any reason, any amounts otherwise indemnifiable or payable hereunder or under any

 

10



 

other indemnification agreement or arrangement (whether pursuant to contract, Company Organizational Documents or other Enterprise Organizational Documents or otherwise) with Indemnitee, then the Partnership shall fully indemnify, reimburse and hold harmless the General Partner for all such payments actually made by the General Partner.

 

(c)                                   Each of the Companies hereby unconditionally and irrevocably waives, relinquishes and releases, and covenants and agrees not to exercise (and to cause each of the other Enterprises not to exercise), any rights that such Company or other Enterprise, as the case may be, may now have or hereafter acquire against any Designating Partner (or former Designating Partner) or any of their respective affiliates that arise from or relate to the existence, payment, performance or enforcement of the Companies’ obligations under this Agreement or under any other indemnification agreement or arrangement (whether pursuant to contract, Company Organizational Documents or other Enterprise Organizational Documents or otherwise) with any Person, including, without limitation, any right of subrogation (whether pursuant to contract or common law), reimbursement, exoneration, contribution or indemnification, or to be held harmless, and any right to participate in any claim or remedy of Indemnitee against any Designating Partner (or former Designating Partner) or any of their respective affiliates, whether or not such claim, remedy or right arises in equity or under contract, statute or common law, including, without limitation, the right to take or receive from any Designating Partner (or former Designating Partner) or any of their respective affiliates, directly or indirectly, in cash or other property or by set-off or in any other manner, payment or security on account of such claim, remedy or right.

 

(d)                                  The Companies shall not be liable to pay or advance to Indemnitee any amounts otherwise indemnifiable under this Agreement or under any other indemnification agreement if and to the extent that Indemnitee has otherwise actually received such payment under any insurance policy, contract, agreement or otherwise; provided , however , that (i) the Companies hereby agree on behalf of themselves and each other Enterprise Entity, that, irrespective of whether Indemnitee is employed by a Sponsor Company and therefore may have certain rights to indemnification, advancement of expenses or insurance provided by the Designating Partners or their affiliates, the Enterprise Entities are the indemnitors of first resort under this Agreement, the Company Organizational Documents or other Enterprise Organizational Documents or any other indemnification agreement, arrangement or undertaking ( i . e ., the Enterprise Entities’ obligations to Indemnitee under this Agreement or any other agreement or undertaking to provide advancement of Expenses and indemnification to Indemnitee are primary without regard to any rights Indemnitee may have to seek or obtain indemnification or advancement of Expenses from any Designating Partner or any of its affiliates other than an Enterprise Entity (or any former Designating Partner or any of its affiliates other than an Enterprise Entity) or from any insurance policy for the benefit of such Indemnitee (other than any directors’ and officers’ insurance policy for the benefit of such Indemnitee maintained or paid for by any

 

11


 

Enterprise), and any obligation of any Designating Partner (or any affiliate thereof other than any Enterprise) to provide advancement or indemnification for all or any portion of the same Expenses, liabilities, judgments, penalties, fines and amounts paid in settlement (including all interest, assessments and other charges paid or payable in connection with or in respect of such Expenses, liabilities, judgments, penalties, fines and amounts paid in settlement) incurred by Indemnitee and any rights of recovery of Indemnitee under any insurance policy for the benefit of such Indemnitee (other than any directors’ and officers’ insurance policy for the benefit of such Indemnitee maintained or paid for by any Enterprise) are secondary), and (ii) if any Designating Partner or any of its affiliates other than an Enterprise Entity (or any former Designating Partner or any of its affiliates other than an Enterprise Entity) pays or causes to be paid, for any reason, or if Indemnitee collects under any insurance policy for the benefit of such Indemnitee (other than any directors’ and officers’ insurance policy for the benefit of such Indemnitee maintained or paid for by any Enterprise), any amounts otherwise payable or indemnifiable hereunder or under any other indemnification agreement, arrangement or undertaking (whether pursuant to contract, organizational document or otherwise) with Indemnitee, then (x) such Designating Partner, former Designating Partner (or affiliate, as the case may be) or insurer, as applicable, shall be fully subrogated to all rights of Indemnitee with respect to such payment and (y) the Companies shall fully indemnify, reimburse and hold harmless such Designating Partner, former Designating Partner (or such affiliate) or insurer, as applicable, for all such payments actually made by such Designating Partner, former Designating Partner (or such affiliate) or insurer.

 

(e)                                   Subject to Section 10(d) , the Companies’ obligation to indemnify or advance Expenses hereunder to Indemnitee in respect of or relating to Indemnitee’s Corporate Status shall be reduced by any amount Indemnitee has actually received as payment of indemnification or advancement of Expenses from such other Enterprise, except to the extent that such indemnification payments and advance payment of Expenses when taken together with any such amount actually received from other Enterprises or under director and officer insurance policies maintained by one or more Enterprises are inadequate to fully pay all costs, Expenses or other items to the full extent that Indemnitee is otherwise entitled to indemnification or other payment hereunder.

 

(f)                                    Except for the rights set forth in Sections 10(c) , 10(d)  and 10(e)  of this Agreement, the rights to indemnification and advancement of Expenses as provided by this Agreement shall not be deemed exclusive of any other rights to which Indemnitee may at any time, whenever conferred or arising, be entitled under applicable law, the Company Organizational Documents or other Enterprise Organizational Documents or any other agreement, resolution of directors (or similar governing body) of any Enterprise, or otherwise.  Indemnitee’s rights under this Agreement are present contractual rights that fully vest upon Indemnitee’s first service as a director (and officer, if applicable) of the General Partner.  The Parties hereby agree that Sections 10(c) , 10(d)  and 10(e)  of this Agreement shall be deemed exclusive and shall be deemed to modify, amend and

 

12



 

clarify any right to indemnification or advancement provided to Indemnitee under any other contract, agreement or document with any Enterprise relating to advancement or indemnification.

 

(g)                                   No amendment, alteration or repeal of this Agreement or of any provision hereof shall limit or restrict any right of Indemnitee under this Agreement in respect of any action taken or omitted by such Indemnitee in Indemnitee’s Corporate Status prior to such amendment, alteration or repeal.  The assertion or employment of any right or remedy hereunder, or otherwise, shall not prevent the concurrent assertion or employment of any other right or remedy.

 

11.                                Employment Rights; Successors; Third Party Beneficiaries .

 

(a)                                  Nothing contained in this Agreement shall be construed as giving Indemnitee any right to be, or to be retained, in the employment of any of the Enterprise Entities.  This Agreement shall continue in force as provided above after Indemnitee has ceased to serve as a director of the General Partner or in any other Corporate Status.

 

(b)                                  This Agreement shall be binding upon each of the Companies and their successors and assigns and shall inure to the benefit of Indemnitee and Indemnitee’s heirs, executors and administrators.

 

(c)                                   The Designating Partners are express third party beneficiaries of this Agreement, are entitled to rely upon this Agreement, and may specifically enforce the Companies’ obligations hereunder (including but not limited to the obligations specified in Section 10 of this Agreement) as though a party hereunder.

 

12.                                Severability .  If any provision or provisions of this Agreement shall be held to be invalid, illegal or unenforceable for any reason whatsoever:  (a) the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions of this Agreement (including, without limitation, each portion of any Section of this Agreement containing any such provision held to be invalid, illegal or unenforceable, that is not itself invalid, illegal or unenforceable) shall not in any way be affected or impaired thereby; (b) such provision or provisions shall be deemed reformed to the extent necessary to conform to applicable law and to give the maximum effect to the intent of the parties hereto; and (c) to the fullest extent possible, the provisions of this Agreement (including, without limitation, each portion of any Section of this Agreement containing any such provision held to be invalid, illegal or unenforceable, that is not itself invalid, illegal or unenforceable) shall be construed so as to give effect to the intent manifested thereby.

 

13.                                Exceptions to Right of Indemnification or Advancement of Expenses .  Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement and except as provided in Section 7(a)  of this Agreement or as may otherwise be agreed by any Company, Indemnitee shall not be entitled to indemnification or advancement of Expenses under this Agreement with respect to any Proceeding initiated by Indemnitee (other than a Proceeding by Indemnitee (i) to enforce Indemnitee’s rights under this Agreement or (ii) to enforce any other rights of Indemnitee to indemnification, advancement or contribution from the Companies under any other contract,

 

13



 

Company Organizational Document, Enterprise Organizational Document or under statute or other law), unless the initiation of such Proceeding or making of such claim shall have been approved by the Board of Directors of the General Partner.  In addition, n otwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement to the contrary, to the extent that Indemnitee is an officer of a Company or any Enterprise, Indemnitee shall not be entitled to indemnification or advancement of Expenses under this Agreement with respect to any Proceeding if it is determined by a majority of the board of directors or other governing body of the applicable Enterprise or by Independent Counsel, as applicable, that Indemnitee did not act in good faith and in a manner Indemnitee reasonably believed to be in, or not opposed to, the best interests of the Companies or any such Enterprise.

 

14.                                Definitions .  For purposes of this Agreement:

 

(a)                                  Adverse Determination ” shall have the meaning set forth in the definition of Determination.

 

(b)                                  Beneficial Owner ” shall have the meanings set forth in Rule 13d-3 promulgated under the Exchange Act as in effect on the date hereof.

 

(c)                                   Board of Directors ” or “ Board ” means the board of directors of the General Partner.

 

(d)                                  Change of Control ” shall be deemed to have occurred with respect to the General Partner or the Partnership if any change in control or similar event, however denominated, shall occur under and as defined in the General Partner Agreement.

 

(e)                                   Corporate Status ” describes the status of a person by reason of such person’s past, present or future service as a director or officer or in any capacity for any Enterprise at the request of a Company.

 

(f)                                    Designating Partners ” means any of the Sponsors Companies, in each case so long as an individual employed by a Sponsor Company, or any of their respective affiliates, serves as a director of the General Partner or in any other Corporate Status.

 

(g)                                   Determination ” means a determination that either (x) indemnification of Indemnitee is proper in the circumstances because Indemnitee met a particular standard of conduct (a “ Favorable Determination ”) or (y) indemnification of Indemnitee is not proper in the circumstances because Indemnitee failed to meet a particular standard of conduct (an “ Adverse Determination ”).  An Adverse Determination shall include the decision that a Determination was required in connection with indemnification and the decision as to the applicable standard of conduct.

 

(h)                                  Disabling Conduct ” means, with respect to Indemnitee, any act or omission resulting from fraud, gross negligence, willful breach of any Company Organizational Document or other Enterprise Organizational Document or a

 

14



 

willful illegal act (other than an act or omission treated as a criminal violation in a foreign country that is not a criminal violation in the United States).

 

(i)                                      Disinterested Director ” means, with respect to any request by Indemnitee for indemnification hereunder, a director of the General Partner who at the time of the vote is not a party to the Proceeding in respect of which indemnification is sought by Indemnitee.

 

(j)                                     Enterprise ” shall mean each of the Companies and their respective subsidiaries and any other entity, constituent entity (including any constituent of a constituent) absorbed in a consolidation or merger to which any Company (or any of its subsidiaries) is a party, limited liability company, partnership, joint venture, trust, employee benefit plan, or other enterprise of which Indemnitee is or was serving at the request of a Company as a director, officer, trustee, manager, venturer, proprietor, partner, member, employee, agent, fiduciary or similar functionary.

 

(k)                                  Enterprise Entity ” means any Enterprise.

 

(l)                                      Equity Interests ” means shares of capital stock, partnership interests, membership interests in a limited liability company, beneficial interests in a trust or other equity ownership interests in a Person, and any warrants, options or other rights entitling the holder thereof to purchase or acquire any such equity interest.

 

(m)                              Exchange Act ” means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and the rules and regulations promulgated thereunder.

 

(n)                                  Expenses ” shall mean all reasonable direct and indirect costs, fees and expenses of any type or nature whatsoever and shall specifically include, without limitation, all reasonable attorneys’ fees, retainers, court costs, transcript costs, fees and costs of experts, witness fees, travel expenses, duplicating costs, printing and binding costs, telephone charges, postage, delivery service fees, and all other disbursements or expenses of the types customarily incurred in connection with prosecuting, defending, preparing to prosecute or defend, investigating, being or preparing to be a witness in, or otherwise participating in, a Proceeding, including, but not limited to, the premium for appeal bonds, attachment bonds or similar bonds and all interest, assessments and other charges paid or payable in connection with or in respect of any such Expenses, and shall also specifically include, without limitation, all reasonable attorneys’ fees and all other expenses incurred by or on behalf of Indemnitee in connection with preparing and submitting any requests or statements for indemnification, advancement, contribution or any other right provided by this Agreement.  “Expenses,” however, shall not include amounts paid in settlement by Indemnitee or the amounts of judgments or fines against Indemnitee.

 

(o)                                  Favorable Determination ” shall have the meaning set forth in the definition of Determination.

 

15



 

(p)                                  Independent Counsel ” means, at any time, any law firm, or a member of a law firm, that (a) is experienced in matters of limited partnership, limited liability company or corporation law, as applicable, and (b) is not, at such time, or has not been in the three years prior to such time, retained to represent: (i) any Enterprise or Indemnitee in any matter material to either such party (other than with respect to matters concerning Indemnitee under this Agreement, or of other indemnities under similar indemnification agreements), (ii) any other party to the Proceeding giving rise to a claim for indemnification hereunder or (iii) the Beneficial Owner, directly or indirectly, of securities of any Company representing 5% or more of the ownership interests or the voting power of such Company’s then outstanding ownership interests or voting securities, respectively.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, the term “Independent Counsel” shall not include any Person who, under the applicable standards of professional conduct then prevailing, would have a conflict of interest in representing any of the Companies or Indemnitee in an action to determine Indemnitee’s rights under this Agreement.  The Companies agree to pay the reasonable fees and expenses of the Independent Counsel referred to above and to fully indemnify such counsel against any and all Expenses, claims, liabilities and damages arising out of or relating to this Agreement or its engagement pursuant hereto and to be jointly and severally liable therefor.

 

(q)                                  Person ” means any individual, entity or group (within the meaning of Rule 13d-5 of the Exchange Act but excluding any employee benefit plan of such person and its subsidiaries, and any person or entity acting in its capacity as trustee, agent or other fiduciary or administrator of any such plan ).

 

(r)                                     Potential Change in Control ” shall be deemed to have occurred if (i) any Person shall have announced publicly an intention to take actions to effect a Change in Control, or commenced any action that, if successful, would reasonably be expected to result in the occurrence of a Change in Control; (ii) the General Partner enters into an agreement or arrangement on behalf of itself or the Partnership, the consummation of which would result in the occurrence of a Change in Control; or (iii) any other event occurs that the Board declares to be a Potential Change of Control.

 

(s)                                    Proceeding ” includes any actual, threatened, pending or completed action, suit, arbitration, alternate dispute resolution mechanism, investigation, inquiry, administrative hearing or any other actual, threatened, pending or completed proceeding, whether brought by or in the right of any Enterprise or otherwise and whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative in nature, in which Indemnitee was, is, may be or will be involved as a party, witness or otherwise, by reason of Indemnitee’s Corporate Status or by reason of any action taken by Indemnitee or of any inaction on Indemnitee’s part while acting as director (or officer, as applicable) of the General Partner or serving any other Enterprise (in each case whether or not he is acting or serving in any such capacity or has such status at the time any liability or expense is incurred for which indemnification or advancement of Expenses can be provided under this Agreement).

 

16



 

(t)                                     Sponsor Companies ” means Susser Holdings Corporation, a Delaware corporation, and any other entity that is an affiliate of Susser Holdings Corporation (other than the Companies).

 

15.                                Construction .  Whenever required by the context, as used in this Agreement the singular number shall include the plural, the plural shall include the singular, and all words herein in any gender shall be deemed to include (as appropriate) the masculine, feminine and neuter genders.

 

16.                                Reliance .  The Companies expressly confirm and agree that they have entered into this Agreement and assumed the obligations imposed on each of them hereby in order to induce Indemnitee to serve as a director (and officer, as applicable) of the General Partner, and the Companies acknowledge that Indemnitee is relying upon this Agreement in serving as a director (and officer, as applicable) of the General Partner or in any other Corporate Status.

 

17.                                Modification and Waiver .  No supplement, modification or amendment of this Agreement shall be binding unless executed in a writing identified as such by all of the parties hereto.  No waiver of any of the provisions of this Agreement shall be deemed or shall constitute a waiver of any other provisions hereof (whether or not similar) nor shall such waiver constitute a continuing waiver.

 

18.                                Notice Mechanics .  All notices, requests, demands or other communications hereunder shall be in writing and shall be deemed to have been duly given if (i) delivered by hand and receipted for by the party to whom said notice or other communication shall have been direct, or (ii) mailed by certified or registered mail with postage prepaid, on the third business day after the date on which it is so mailed:

 

(a)                                  If to Indemnitee to:

 

555 East Airtex Drive
Houston, Texas 77073

 

Attn: [ DIRECTOR’S NAME ]

 

(b)                                  If to any Company, to:

 

Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC
555 East Airtex Drive
Houston, Texas 77073

 

Attn: General Counsel

 

or to such other address as may have been furnished (in the manner prescribed above) as follows:  (a) in the case of a change in address for notices to Indemnitee, furnished by Indemnitee to the

 

17



 

Companies and (b) in the case of a change in address for notices to any Company, furnished by the Companies to Indemnitee.

 

19.                                Contribution .  To the fullest extent permitted under applicable law and so long as Indemnitee has not engaged in Disabling Conduct, if the indemnification provided for in this Agreement is unavailable to Indemnitee for any reason whatsoever, the Companies, in lieu of indemnifying Indemnitee, shall contribute to the amount incurred by Indemnitee, whether for judgments, fines, penalties, excise taxes, amounts paid or to be paid in settlement or for reasonably incurred Expenses, in connection with any claim relating to an indemnifiable event under this Agreement, in such proportion as is deemed fair and reasonable in light of all of the circumstances of such Proceeding in order to reflect (i) the relative benefits received by the Companies and Indemnitee as a result of the event(s) or transaction(s) giving cause to such Proceeding; or (ii) the relative fault of the Companies (and their other directors, officers, employees and agents) and Indemnitee in connection with such event(s) or transaction(s).

 

20.                                Governing Law; Submission to Jurisdiction; Appointment of Agent for Service of Process .  This Agreement and the legal relations among the parties shall, to the fullest extent permitted by law, be governed by, and construed and enforced in accordance with, the laws of the State of Delaware, without regard to its conflict of laws rules.  The Companies and Indemnitee hereby irrevocably and unconditionally (i) agree that any action or proceeding arising out of or in connection with this Agreement shall be brought only in the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware (the “ Trial Court ”), and not in any other state or federal court in the United States of America or any court in any other country, (ii) consent to submit to the exclusive jurisdiction of the Trial Court for purposes of any action or proceeding arising out of or in connection with this Agreement, (iii) waive any objection to the laying of venue of any such action or proceeding in the Trial Court and (iv) waive, and agree not to plead or to make, any claim that any such action or proceeding brought in the Trial Court has been brought in an improper or otherwise inconvenient forum.

 

21.                                Headings .  The headings of the paragraphs of this Agreement are inserted for convenience only and shall not be deemed to constitute part of this Agreement or to affect the construction thereof.

 

22.                                Counterparts .  This Agreement may be executed in one or more counterparts, each of which shall for all purposes be deemed to be an original but all of which together shall constitute one and the same Agreement.

 

[ Remainder of Page Intentionally Blank ]

 

18



 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have executed this Agreement on the day and year first above written.

 

General Partner:

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS GP LLC

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

 

 

Name:

 

 

 

Title:

 

 

 

 

Partnership:

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP

 

 

 

 

 

By: Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC, its general partner

 

 

 

By:

 

 

 

 

Name:

 

 

 

Title:

 

 

 

 

Indemnitee:

 

 

 

 

Name: [ DIRECTOR’S NAME ]

 

Signature Page to Director Indemnification Agreement— [ DIRECTOR’S NAME ]

 




Exhibit 10.9

 

FORM OF

 

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS LP

2012 LONG TERM INCENTIVE PLAN

 

PHANTOM UNIT AGREEMENT

 

This Phantom Unit Agreement (this “ Agreement ”) is made and entered into by and between Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (the “ Company ”), and the individual to whom the corresponding Grant (as hereinafter defined) is made (the “ Service Provider ”).  This Agreement is entered into as of the day set forth in the Grant Award Notification Letter (the “ Date of Grant ”).  Capitalized terms used in this Agreement but not otherwise defined herein shall have the meanings ascribed to such terms in the Plan (as defined below), unless the context requires otherwise.

 

W I T N E S S E T H :

 

WHEREAS , the Company has adopted the Susser Petroleum Partners LP 2012 Long Term Incentive Plan (the “ Plan ”) to attract, retain and motivate employees, officers, directors and consultants; and

 

WHEREAS , the Board of Directors of the Company (the “ Board ”) has authorized the grant to employees and officers of phantom units of the Company and its affiliates as part of their compensation for direct services provided to the Partnership.

 

NOW, THEREFORE , in consideration of the Service Provider’s agreement to provide or to continue providing services, the Service Provider and the Company agree as follows:

 

SECTION 1.           Grant .

 

The Company hereby grants to the Service Provider as of the Date of Grant an award of the number of Phantom Units as set forth in the Grant Award Notification Letter delivered to the Service Provider, subject to the terms and conditions set forth in this Agreement, including, without limitation, those restrictions described in Section 2 and the Grant Award Notification Letter, whereby each Phantom Unit represents the right to receive one Unit of Susser Petroleum Partners LP (the “ Partnership ”) (each, a “ Phantom Unit ”) upon vesting.  The Company shall establish and maintain a bookkeeping account on its records for the Service Provider (a “ Phantom Unit Account ”) and shall record in such Phantom Unit Account (a) the number of Phantom Units granted to the Service Provider, and (b) the number of Units deliverable to the Service Provider on account of Phantom Units that have vested.  No Units shall be issued to the Service Provider at the time the grant is made and the Service Provider shall not be, nor have any of the rights and privileges of, a unit holder or limited partner of the Partnership with respect to any Phantom Units recorded in the Phantom Unit Account.  The Service Provider shall not have any interest in any fund or specific assets of the Partnership by reason of this Award or the Phantom Unit Account established for the Service Provider.

 



 

SECTION 2.           Vesting; Expiration of Restrictions and Risk of Forfeiture .

 

The Phantom Units are restricted in that they may be forfeited to the Company and in that they may not, except as otherwise provided in Section 6, be transferred or otherwise disposed of by the Service Provider.  Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, the forfeiture restrictions on the Phantom Units shall lapse, and the Phantom Units shall vest according to the schedule included in the Grant Award Notification Letter; provided, however, that such restrictions will lapse, and the Phantom Units shall vest in accordance with the foregoing provision only if the Service Provider has been an employee of the Company, the Partnership, or any other entity which is an affiliate (within the meaning of such term under the Exchange Act and the rules promulgated thereunder) of any of the foregoing entities (collectively, the “ Partnership Entities ”) continuously from the Date of Grant until the date of vesting.

 

SECTION 3.           Change in Control .

 

Notwithstanding Section 2 of this Agreement, in the event of a Change in Control occurring prior to the date all Phantom Units have vested in accordance with Section 2 above, all restrictions described in Section 2 shall lapse and all Phantom Units granted pursuant to this Agreement shall become immediately vested and nonforfeitable and the Company shall deliver the Units (or the amount of cash, other property or securities, if any, equal to the amount that would have been attained by the Service Provider if he were a unit holder as of the date of the occurrence of such event) to the Service Provider as soon as practicable thereafter.

 

SECTION 4.           Termination of Employment .

 

(a)           Termination for Any Reason   If the Service Provider ceases providing services to the Partnership Entities for any reason other than the Service Provider’s death or Disability (as defined below) prior to the date all Phantom Units have vested in accordance with Section 2 above, then all Phantom Units granted pursuant to this Agreement that have not yet vested shall become null and void as of the date of such termination.

 

(b)           Termination Due to Death or Disability .  If the Service Provider ceases providing services to the Partnership Entities due to death or Disability prior to the date all Phantom Units have vested in accordance with Section 2 above, then all restrictions described in Section 2 shall lapse and all Phantom Units granted pursuant to this Agreement shall become immediately vested and nonforfeitable and the Company shall deliver Units to the Service Provider as soon as practicable thereafter, but in no event later than 60 days following the separation from service.

 

“Disability” means that the Service Provider is unable to engage in substantial gainful activity by reason of any medically determinable physical or mental impairment that can be expected to result in death or can be expected to last for a continuous period of not less than 12 months.

 

(c)           Proscribed Conduct .  Notwithstanding anything to the contrary set forth in the Plan or this Agreement, except as otherwise set forth in an employment agreement between the Service Provider and the Company or any of its subsidiaries, in the event a Service Provider who is also an employee of the Company or any subsidiary of affiliate, engages in Proscribed Conduct after the termination of his service for any reason, such Service Provider shall forfeit all Units the Service Provider acquired upon settlement of any Phantom Units.  To the extent such

 

2



 

Service Provider disposed of any such Units prior to such forfeiture, the Company shall be entitled to the Fair Market Value of such Units at the time of the disposition.

 

“Proscribed Conduct” means a breach by a Service Provider of any restrictive covenants contained in any employment agreement between the Service Provider and the Company or any subsidiary, or if there are no such covenants or any such covenants are inapplicable for any reason, then “Proscribed Conduct” means, during the one-year period following termination of service, a Service Provider’s (a) unauthorized disclosure of confidential information related to the Company or its subsidiaries, (b) directly or indirectly engaging in, or owning or controlling any interest in, or acting as a director, officer or employer of, or consultant to or otherwise be employed by any business engaged in the operation of wholesale fuel distribution or any other business conducted by the Company or the Partnership in any county in which the Company operates on the date of such Service Provider’s termination of service, (c) hiring, directly or indirectly, any individual who was an employee of the Company or its subsidiaries or affiliates within the 12 months period prior to the date the Service Provider employs or seeks to employ such individual, or soliciting or inducing, directly or indirectly, any such individual to terminate his or her service with the Company, or its subsidiaries or affiliates, or (d) causing, inducing or encouraging any actual or prospective client, customer, supplier, dealer or licensor of the Company or the Partnership or any other person or entity that has a business relationship with the Company, the Partnership or any subsidiary or affiliate, to terminate or modify any such actual or prospective relationship.

 

SECTION 5.           Delivery/Payment Date; Manner of Payment .

 

The date or dates of delivery of the Units related to the Service Provider’s Phantom Units will be date or dates on which the restrictions on such Phantom Units expire as provided in Section 2, 3 or 4 of this Agreement.  The value of any fractional Phantom Units shall be paid in cash at the time Units are issued to the Service Provider in connection with the Phantom Units.  The value of the fractional Phantom Units shall equal the percentage of a Unit represented by a fractional Phantom Unit multiplied by the Fair Market Value of the Unit.  The value of such Units shall not bear any interest owing to the passage of time.

 

SECTION 6.           Limitations on Transfer.

 

The Service Provider agrees that he shall not dispose of (meaning, without limitation, sell, transfer, pledge, exchange, hypothecate or otherwise dispose of) any Phantom Units hereby acquired prior to the date the Phantom Units are vested and Units are delivered.  Any attempted disposition of the Phantom Units in violation of the preceding sentence shall be null and void.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, part or all of the Phantom Units or rights under this Agreement may be transferred to a spouse pursuant to a domestic relations order issued by a court of competent jurisdiction; provided, however, that such Phantom Units shall continue to be held pursuant to this Agreement, and the transferee under the domestic relations order shall agree that the Phantom Units so transferred shall continue to be subject to the terms of this Agreement, including forfeiture in accordance with Sections 2 and 4 of this Agreement.

 

3



 

SECTION 7.           Nontransferability of Agreement.

 

This Agreement and all rights under this Agreement shall not be transferable by the Service Provider other than by will or pursuant to applicable laws of descent and distribution.  Any rights and privileges of the Service Provider in connection herewith shall not be transferred, assigned, pledged or hypothecated by the Service Provider or by any other person or persons, in any way, whether by operation of law, or otherwise, and shall not be subject to execution, attachment, garnishment or similar process.  In the event of any such occurrence, the Phantom Units shall automatically be forfeited.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, all or some of the Phantom Units or rights under this Agreement may be transferred to a spouse pursuant to a domestic relations order issued by a court of competent jurisdiction, subject to the limitations on such transfer described in Section 6.

 

SECTION 8.           Adjustment.

 

The number of Phantom Units granted to the Service Provider pursuant to this Agreement shall be adjusted to reflect distributions of the Partnership paid in units, unit splits or other changes in the capital structure of the Partnership, all in accordance with the Plan.  All provisions of this Agreement shall be applicable to such new or additional or different units or securities distributed or issued pursuant to the Plan to the same extent that such provisions are applicable to the units with respect to which they were distributed or issued.

 

SECTION 9.           Securities Act.

 

The Company shall not be required to deliver any Units hereunder if, in the opinion of counsel for the Company, such delivery would violate the Securities Act of 1933 or any other applicable federal or state securities laws or regulations or the rules of the exchange upon which the Company’s Units are traded.

 

SECTION 10.           Copy of Plan.

 

By the execution of this Agreement, the Service Provider acknowledges receipt of a copy of the Plan.  If any provision of this Agreement is held to be illegal, invalid or unenforceable under any applicable law, then such provision will be deemed to be modified to the minimum extent necessary to render it legal, valid and enforceable; and if such provision cannot be so modified, then this Agreement will be construed as if not containing the provision held to be invalid, and the rights and obligations of the parties will be construed and enforced accordingly.

 

SECTION 11.         Notices.

 

Whenever any notice is required or permitted hereunder, such notice must be in writing and personally delivered or sent by mail.  Any such notice required or permitted to be delivered hereunder shall be deemed to be delivered on the date on which it is personally delivered or, whether actually received or not, on the third business day (on which banking institutions in the State of Texas are open) after it is deposited in the United States mail, certified or registered, postage prepaid, addressed to the person who is to receive it at the address which such person has theretofore specified by written notice delivered in accordance herewith.  The Company or the Service Provider may change at any time and from time to time by written notice to the other, the address which it or he previously specified for receiving notices.  The Company and the Service

 

4



 

Provider agree that any notices shall be given to the Company or to the Service Provider at the following addresses:

 

Company:                                                                                                                      Susser Petroleum Partners GP LLC
Human Resources Department
4525 Ayers Street
Corpus Christi, Texas 78415

 

Service Provider:                                                                                  At the Service Provider’s current address as shown in the Company’s records.

 

SECTION 12.                           General Provisions.

 

(a)           Administration.  This Agreement shall at all times be subject to the terms and conditions of the Plan.  The Committee shall have sole and complete discretion with respect to all matters reserved to it by the Plan and decisions of the majority of the Committee with respect thereto and with respect to this Agreement shall be final and binding upon the Service Provider and the Company.  In the event of any conflict between the terms and conditions of this Agreement and the Plan, the provisions of the Plan shall control.

 

(b)           Continuation of Service.  This Agreement shall not be construed to confer upon the Service Provider any right to continue in the service of the Partnership Entities.

 

(c)           Governing Law.  This Agreement shall be interpreted and administered under the laws of the State of Delaware, without giving effect to any conflict of laws provisions.

 

(d)           Amendments.  This Agreement may be amended only by a written agreement executed by the Company and the Service Provider, except that the Committee may unilaterally waive any conditions or rights under, amend any terms of, or alter this Agreement provided no such change (other than pursuant to Section 7(b), 7(c), 7(d), 7(e), or 7(g) of the Plan) materially reduces the rights or benefits of the Service Provider with respect to the Phantom Units without his consent.

 

(e)           Binding Effect.  This Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of any successor or successors of the Company and upon any person lawfully claiming under the Service Provider.

 

(f)            Entire Agreement.  This Agreement constitutes the entire agreement of the parties with regard to this subject matter hereof, and contains all the covenants, promises, representations, warranties and agreements between the parties with respect to the Phantom Units granted hereby.  Without limiting the scope of the preceding sentence, all prior understandings and agreements, if any, among the parties hereto relating to the subject matter hereof are hereby null and void and of no further force and effect.

 

(g)           No Liability for Good Faith Determinations.  Neither the Partnership Entities nor the members of the Committee and the Board shall be liable for any act, omission or

 

5



 

determination taken or made in good faith with respect to this Agreement or the Phantom Units granted hereunder.

 

(h)           No Guarantee of Interests.  The Board and the Partnership Entities do not guarantee the Units from loss or depreciation.

 

(i)            Withholding Taxes .  To the extent that the vesting of a Phantom Unit or distribution thereon results in the receipt of compensation by the Service Provider with respect to which any of the Partnership Entities has a tax withholding obligation pursuant to applicable law, unless other arrangements have been made by the Service Provider that are acceptable to such Partnership Entity, the Service Provider shall deliver to the Partnership Entity such amount of money as the Partnership Entity may require to meet its withholding obligations under applicable law.  No issuance of a Unit shall be made pursuant to this Agreement until the Service Provider has paid or made arrangements approved by the Partnership Entity to satisfy in full the applicable tax withholding requirements of the Partnership Entity with respect to such event.

 

(j)            Insider Trading Policy .  The terms of the Company’s Insider Trading Policy with respect to Units are incorporated herein by reference.

 

[SIGNATURE PAGE TO FOLLOW]

 

6



 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF , the Company has caused this Agreement to be executed by its officer thereunto duly authorized, and the Service Provider has set his hand as to the date and year first above written.

 

 

SUSSER PETROLEUM PARTNERS GP LLC

 

 

 

By:

 

 

 

 

 

Name:

 

 

 

 

 

Title:

 

 

 

 

 

 

[SERVICE PROVIDER NAME]

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Service Provider

 

7




Exhibit 23.1

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

              We consent to the reference to our firm under the caption "Experts" and to the use of our report dated June 21, 2012, with respect to the consolidated financial statements of Susser Petroleum Company LLC (Predecessor), and our report dated June 21, 2012, with respect to the balance sheet of Susser Petroleum Partners LP, in the Registration Statement on Form S-1 (Registration No. 333-182276), as amended, and related Prospectus of Susser Petroleum Partners LP dated August 29, 2012.

/s/ Ernst & Young LLP
San Antonio, Texas
August 29, 2012
   



QuickLinks -- Click here to rapidly navigate through this document


Exhibit 23.4

Consent of Director Nominee

              Pursuant to Rule 438 of Regulation C promulgated under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the " Securities Act "), in connection with the Registration Statement on Form S-1 (the " Registration Statement ") of Susser Petroleum Partners LP, the undersigned hereby consents to being named and described as a director nominee in the Registration Statement and any amendment or supplement to any prospectus included in such Registration Statement, any amendment to such Registration Statement or any subsequent Registration Statement filed pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act and to the filing or attachment of this consent with such Registration Statement and any amendment or supplement thereto.

              IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned has executed this consent as of the 25th day of July, 2012.

/s/ DAVID P. ENGEL

DAVID P. ENGEL
   



QuickLinks


QuickLinks -- Click here to rapidly navigate through this document


Exhibit 23.5

Consent of Director Nominee

              Pursuant to Rule 438 of Regulation C promulgated under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the " Securities Act "), in connection with the Registration Statement on Form S-1 (the " Registration Statement ") of Susser Petroleum Partners LP, the undersigned hereby consents to being named and described as a director nominee in the Registration Statement and any amendment or supplement to any prospectus included in such Registration Statement, any amendment to such Registration Statement or any subsequent Registration Statement filed pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act and to the filing or attachment of this consent with such Registration Statement and any amendment or supplement thereto.

              IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned has executed this consent as of the 25th day of July, 2012.

/s/ ARMAND S. SHAPIRO

ARMAND S. SHAPIRO
   



QuickLinks


QuickLinks -- Click here to rapidly navigate through this document


Exhibit 23.6

Consent of Director Nominee

              Pursuant to Rule 438 of Regulation C promulgated under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the " Securities Act "), in connection with the Registration Statement on Form S-1 (the " Registration Statement ") of Susser Petroleum Partners LP, the undersigned hereby consents to being named and described as a director nominee in the Registration Statement and any amendment or supplement to any prospectus included in such Registration Statement, any amendment to such Registration Statement or any subsequent Registration Statement filed pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act and to the filing or attachment of this consent with such Registration Statement and any amendment or supplement thereto.

              IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned has executed this consent as of the 10th day of August, 2012.

/s/ BRYAN F. SMITH JR.

BRYAN F. SMITH JR.
   



QuickLinks


QuickLinks -- Click here to rapidly navigate through this document


Exhibit 23.7


Consent of Director Nominee

              Pursuant to Rule 438 of Regulation C promulgated under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the " Securities Act "), in connection with the Registration Statement on Form S-1 (the " Registration Statement ") of Susser Petroleum Partners LP, the undersigned hereby consents to being named and described as a director nominee in the Registration Statement and any amendment or supplement to any prospectus included in such Registration Statement, any amendment to such Registration Statement or any subsequent Registration Statement filed pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act and to the filing or attachment of this consent with such Registration Statement and any amendment or supplement thereto.

              IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned has executed this consent as of the 25th day of July, 2012.

/s/ SAM J. SUSSER

SAM J. SUSSER
   



QuickLinks

Consent of Director Nominee